0% found this document useful (0 votes)
2K views1,860 pages

Ecostruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021: System Guide

Uploaded by

Carlos Salgado
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
2K views1,860 pages

Ecostruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021: System Guide

Uploaded by

Carlos Salgado
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 1860

EcoStruxure™

Power Monitoring Expert 2021


System Guide
7EN02-0445-00
05/2021
Legal Information
The Schneider Electric brand and any trademarks of Schneider Electric SE and its subsidiaries
referred to in this guide are the property of Schneider Electric SE or its subsidiaries. All other brands
may be trademarks of their respective owners.

This guide and its content are protected under applicable copyright laws and furnished for
informational use only. No part of this guide may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any
means (electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise), for any purpose, without the
prior written permission of Schneider Electric.

Schneider Electric does not grant any right or license for commercial use of the guide or its content,
except for a non-exclusive and personal license to consult it on an "as is" basis. Schneider Electric
products and equipment should be installed, operated, serviced, and maintained only by qualified
personnel.

As standards, specifications, and designs change from time to time, information contained in this
guide may be subject to change without notice.

To the extent permitted by applicable law, no responsibility or liability is assumed by Schneider


Electric and its subsidiaries for any errors or omissions in the informational content of this material
or consequences arising out of or resulting from the use of the information contained herein.
Safety Information
Important Information
Read these instructions carefully and look at the equipment to become familiar with the
device before trying to install, operate, service or maintain it. The following special
messages may appear throughout this bulletin or on the equipment to warn of potential
hazards or to call attention to information that clarifies or simplifies a procedure.

The addition of either symbol to a "Danger" or "Warning" safety label


indicates that an electrical hazard exists which will result in personal injury if
the instructions are not followed.
This is the safety alert symbol. It is used to alert you to potential personal
injury hazards. Obey all safety messages that follow this symbol to avoid
possible injury or death.

DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious
injury.

WARNING
WARNING indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or
serious injury.

CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in minor or
moderate injury.

NOTICE
NOTICE is used to address practices not related to physical injury.

Please Note
Electrical equipment should be installed, operated, serviced and maintained only by qualified
personnel. No responsibility is assumed by Schneider Electric for any consequences arising out of
the use of this material.

A qualified person is one who has skills and knowledge related to the construction, installation, and
operation of electrical equipment and has received safety training to recognize and avoid the
hazards involved.
Safety Information EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Contents
Safety Information 3
Safety Precautions 20
Overview 21
About this document 21
Document updates 21
Document revisions 21
Document organization and content 22
How to use this document 22
What's new in Power Monitoring Expert 2021 23
Highlights of this release 23
Details of this release 23
Resources 27
Cybersecurity 30
Cybersecurity awareness 30
Cybersecurity features 30
Recommended actions 31
Plan 34
Planning checklist 35
System architecture 36
Client types 38
Engineering Client 38
Web Client 38
IT Requirements 40
Computer Hardware 41
Operating Environment 48
Network connectivity 52
Other IT considerations 53
System maintenance 54
Designing for maintenance 54
Database maintenance 55
System health review 65
Disaster recovery strategy 72
Identify disaster recovery objectives 72
IT architecture and resources plan 73
Backup plan 74
Recovery plan 80
Recommended consolidated disaster recovery strategy plan 81
Cybersecurity 82
Obtain security certificates 82
Obtain antivirus and application whitelisting software 82
Plan user access 82

4 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Safety Information

Plan your network security 82


Plan to install PME in an intranet environment 83
Plan IP port use 83
Plan your site security 83
Plan for the implementation of cybersecurity standards 83
Licensing 84
Licensing overview 85
Licensing process 91
Licensing tools 93
Important notes on licensing 94
Operating System licensing 96
SQL Server Licensing 97
Other software licensing 98
System installation and upgrades 99
Install planning 100
Upgrade planning 103
Migration planning 107
Feature selection and design 109
Real-time Monitoring 110
Alarm Management 112
Analytics and Visualization 114
Backup Power Module design 116
Breaker Performance Module Design 120
Capacity Management Module Design 122
Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design 125
Energy Analysis Reports Module design 127
Energy Billing Module design 129
Event Notification Module Design 131
Insulation Monitoring Module Design 133
Power Quality Performance Module Design 135
Device Networks 140
Device networks overview 141
Network types 142
Network performance 144
Time synchronization 146
Tools 147
System Integration 148
Overview 149
Integration technologies 150
Integration with EcoStruxure™ Power Operation (PO) 153
Integration with EcoStruxure™ Building Operation (EBO) - Planning 154
Deployment considerations 178
Power Quality (PQ) Performance Module 179
PME/EBO Integration 181

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 5


Safety Information EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Install and Upgrade 184


New system install 185
Before Installing the software 185
Installation process 189
Installing the SQL Server 189
Installing the PME software 199
After installing the software 217
Install the PME/EBO Integration solution 221
System update 227
Types of updates 227
Before updating the software 228
Updating the software 229
After updating the software 232
System upgrade 233
Before upgrading the software 233
In-Place upgrade 237
Side-by-Side upgrade 239
After upgrading the software 258
System migration 262
Before migrating the software 262
System migration 264
After migrating the software 277
Cybersecurity 279
Install antivirus and application whitelisting software 279
Verify install file integrity and authenticity 279
Protect the System Key 279
Install latest updates for OS and SQL Server 279
Check computer for cybersecurity issues 280
Install your network security measures 280
Tools 281
PME Installer 281
Configuration Manager 284
Off-site configuration 290
Version Upgrade 290
Backup and restore 290
Server Migration 290
Configuration Library 290
Save to Archive 294
Write to System 294
Configure 308
Alarms configuration 311
Adding a new Alarms view 313
Copying an Alarms view 315
Editing an Alarms view 316

6 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Safety Information

Sharing an Alarms view 317


Moving an Alarms view 318
Deleting an Alarms view 319
Setting a default Alarms view 320
Deactivating alarms 321
Cybersecurity 323
Install security certificate 323
Set up encrypted database communication for Distributed Database architectures 323
Configure application whitelisting software 324
Configure antivirus software on your SQL Server 324
Configure PME users and user groups 324
Customize user account privileges 325
Restrict Windows login permissions for the PME server 325
Change the SQL Server Express sa account password 325
Configure session timeout settings 325
Configure system integration security settings 325
Do not install or use a web browser on the server computer 325
Set up your network security 325
Disable unused IP ports 325
Disable unused hardware ports 326
Dashboards configuration 327
Adding a new dashboard 328
Editing a dashboard 330
Sharing a dashboard 331
Moving a dashboard 332
Deleting a dashboard 333
Set default options for a dashboard 334
Configuring a slideshow 335
Adding a gadget to a dashboard 338
Editing a gadget 339
Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard 340
Database maintenance 341
Managing database maintenance tasks for Standalone PME systems 342
Setting up database maintenance tasks for Distributed PME systems 344
Diagrams configuration 349
Configuring Devices diagrams 351
Configuring a network diagram 352
Creating custom diagrams 353
Set default options for a diagram 354
Set Diagrams control options 355
Diagram Library 357
Diagrams registry settings 359
Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access 361
Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams 363

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 7


Safety Information EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site 364


Duplicate Data logging 365
Licensing configuration 366
Activating a license 367
Returning a license 370
Refreshing a license 373
Viewing which licenses have been activated on a system 374
Reports configuration 375
Setting Reports prerequisites 377
Meeting individual report requirements 379
Adding a new report 380
Copying a report 382
Editing a report 383
Moving a report 384
Deleting a report 385
Sharing a report 386
Subscribing to a report 388
Changing a report subscription 392
Deleting a report subscription 393
Uploading a Report Template 394
Software Alarms configuration 395
Real-time Alarms 395
Logged Data Alarms 396
Software Alarms considerations 397
Adding a new Alarm Rule 399
Enabling or disabling an Alarm Rule 401
Editing an Alarm Rule 402
Duplicating an Alarm Rule 403
Deleting an Alarm Rule 404
Using the Setpoint Calculator 405
Adding a Schedule 406
Schedules 407
System integration 408
Integration with EcoStruxure™ Power Operation 409
Integration with EcoStruxure Building Operation - Configuring 410
System performance 436
Device communications 436
Operating conditions 436
Performance related settings 438
Time synchronization for ION meters 441
Enabling and configuring time synchronization 441
Time synchronization blackout 442
Trends configuration 445
Adding a new trend 446

8 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Safety Information

Editing a trend 448


Sharing a trend 449
Moving a trend 450
Deleting a trend 451
Software Modules 452
Backup Power Module configuration 453
Breaker Performance Module configuration 479
Capacity Management Module configuration 490
Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration 497
Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration 499
Energy Billing Module configuration 511
Event Notification Module configuration 513
Insulation Monitoring Module configuration 544
Power Quality Performance Module configuration 563
Paste the Power Quality Performance Framework 573
Open the Power Quality Indicator Diagrams 575
Configure the Framework for the Equipment Diagrams 579
Configure the Equipment Diagram Detail Pages 585
Configure the Equipment Diagram Group Pages 588
Configure the Equipment Diagram Landing Pages 597
Power Quality Group definition 601
Edit PowerQualityGroup.csv 602
Import / Export Power Quality Group Definition 605
Set up Power Quality Overview Dashboards 609
Set up Power Quality Detail Dashboards 610
Breaker Configuration Tool 629
Configuring breaker devices 631
Configuring switchboards 631
Configuring groups 632
Generating Vista diagrams 632
Designer 634
Getting started with Designer 634
Node diagrams and the Designer interface 635
ION module overview 645
Using ION modules 647
Linking ION modules 654
Configuring ION modules 660
Configuring Security module 664
Copying and pasting ION modules 665
Viewing output registers, setup registers, and inputs 673
Setting Values for External Input Modules 675
Device Manager 677
Adding a device 680
Editing a device 682

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 9


Safety Information EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Deleting a device 684


Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device 686
Enabling or disabling a device 688
Viewing a device diagram 690
Adding a site 691
Editing a site 693
Deleting a site 695
Connecting or disconnecting a site 697
Enabling or disabling a site 699
Exporting network configuration for use in a different system 701
Importing network configuration from a different system 703
Viewing system device license status 704
Device Type Editor 706
Creating a Modbus Device Type 707
Editing a Modbus Device Type 709
Adding Software Logging to a Modbus Device Type 710
Creating an OPC Device Type 711
Editing an OPC Device Type 713
Installing a Device Type on the System 713
Downstream Device Assistant 715
Detecting downstream devices 715
Downstream Device Assistant basics 717
Downstream Device Assistant functions 721
Downstream Device Assistant commands 725
Event Watcher Manager 726
Creating a template 726
Adding an event watcher 727
Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module 729
Starting the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module 730
Define Generators 731
Define Transfer Switches 739
Define Equipment 745
Define Groups 747
View the Run History 749
EPSS Vista Diagrams 751
Generator Power Configuration Utility 755
Generator Power configuration restrictions 756
Defining generator systems 757
Defining generator groups 759
Defining generators 760
Defining generator loads 761
Defining utilities 762
Generator system redundancy types 763
Hierarchy Configuration Utility 767

10 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Safety Information

Hierarchy Configuration Utility command and options 767


Populating a hierarchy 770
Saving and restoring a hierarchy configuration 776
Installing or saving a hierarchy template 778
Refreshing the hierarchy cache 779
Deleting hierarchy configuration content 780
Hierarchy template structure 780
Hierarchy Manager 791
Hierarchy templates 791
Creating a hierarchy 794
Creating an apportioned meter 799
Creating a virtual meter 800
Dynamic hierarchy 801
Meter apportionment 801
Virtual meter 802
Data aggregation in Hierarchies 802
Using hierarchies in other applications 803
Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool for ANSI 805
Prerequisites 805
User Interface 805
Defining Isolated Power Panels (ANSI) 806
Defining Areas 807
Defining Groups 808
Generating Vista diagrams 808
Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool for IEC 810
Prerequisites 810
User Interface 810
Defining Isolated Power Panels (IEC) 811
Defining Areas 812
Defining Groups 812
Generating Vista diagrams 813
Log Viewer 815
Log Viewer User Interface 815
Logical Device editors 818
Using the Logical Device Type Editor 818
Using the Logical Device Editor 823
Creating multiple logical devices 826
Management Console 829
The Management Console interface 829
Management Console network components 831
Setting up your network in Management Console 834
Renaming devices and groups 839
Configure managed circuits 840
Accessing meters with security 841

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 11


Safety Information EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring connection schedules 842


System Log events 843
Setting up large systems 844
Manual Data Editor 852
Editing existing logged measurement data 853
Adding manually collected measurement data 856
Viewing previous change details 858
Reverting previous data edits 859
Creating new measurements 861
OPC Server Support 862
Introduction to OPC 862
Optional OPC server license 863
OPC measurement support 863
OPC Server Assistant 863
Viewing OPC data 865
Power Losses Configuration Utility 866
Power Losses configuration restrictions 867
Defining transformers for Power Losses 867
Defining UPS modules for Power Losses 868
PQDIF Exporter 870
Configuring the PQDIF Exporter 870
PQDIF Exporter main window 873
PQDIF Exporter jobs 874
Closing the PQDIF Exporter window 879
Rate Editor 880
Rate Editor User Interface 880
Remote Modem Setup 881
Using Remote Modem Setup 881
Software Logging 882
System use notification 883
Time of Use Editor 885
Adding or editing a schedule 885
Adding or editing a sub-schedule 886
Configuring seasons 887
Adding special days 889
Configuring Day groups 889
Configuring TOU names and TOU periods 890
Update EWS Server 892
Update OPC Server 892
Upload Report Template 893
Uploading Single Report Template 894
Uploading Multiple Report Template (Report Pack) 894
UPS Configuration Tool 895
Configuring UPS groups 895

12 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Safety Information

Generating a Vista diagram 897


UPS Power Configuration Utility 899
UPS Power configuration restrictions 900
Defining UPS systems 901
Defining UPS groups 902
Defining UPS modules 904
Defining UPS loads 905
UPS system redundancy types 905
User Manager 913
Users 915
Adding a standard user 918
Adding a Windows user 920
Adding a Windows group 922
Changing a username 924
Changing a user password 926
Changing a user access level 928
Changing user details 930
Deleting a user 932
User Groups 934
Adding a user group 937
Adding a user to a user group 939
Adding sources to a user group 941
Changing a user group name 943
Removing a user from a user group 945
Removing sources from a user group 947
Changing application access for a user group 949
Moving a user between user groups 951
Deleting a user group 953
Viewing Web Applications user license information 955
Customizing Access Level Privileges 957
Virtual Processor service (VIP) 959
Using the Virtual Processor 960
Distributed control 960
Setting global parameters 964
Virtual Processor setup 965
Configuring the Modbus Slave port 965
Modifying the Global Parameters 966
Web Applications settings 967
Alarm Views 968
EWS Login 969
Personal Preferences 969
Report Theme 970
System Language 970
System Theme 971

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 13


Safety Information EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Diagnostics and Usage 973


Registration 974
Authorized Hosts 974
Integration Utility 975
Login Options 976
Session Timeout 976
Administer 978
Basic administration tasks 979
Cybersecurity 980
Renew security certificate 980
Securely store the system key 980
Apply PME updates 980
Verify update file integrity and authenticity 980
Apply OS and SQL Server updates 980
Review user accounts on a regular basis 981
Keep network security up-to-date 981
Keep computer hardware secure 981
Perform security audits 981
Database Manager 982
Prerequisites 982
Database Manager interface 983
Manual actions 984
Restoring a database 987
Operate 990
Introduction to Power Monitoring Expert (PME) 992
Supported operating systems and SQL Server versions 992
PME software components 992
(PME) Windows Services 994
Power Monitoring Expert databases 994
Getting started 994
Customizing and navigating interface displays 996
Alarms 1000
Overview 1000
View types 1000
Incidents, Alarms, and Events 1002
Alarm Acknowledgment 1002
Analysis tools 1003
Time display 1003
Terminology 1003
Viewing incidents 1004
Viewing alarms 1006
Viewing events 1008
Viewing Disturbance Direction 1010
Viewing Load Impact 1012

14 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Safety Information

Viewing a timeline analysis 1014


Viewing Voltage Tolerance 1016
Viewing waveforms 1018
Acknowledging alarms 1020
Incidents 1024
Alarms 1026
Events 1030
Disturbance Direction 1032
Load Impact 1034
Timeline analysis 1036
Voltage Tolerance 1038
Waveforms 1041
Dashboards 1043
Time display 1043
Viewing Dashboards 1044
Dashboard Slideshows 1045
Playing a Slideshow 1046
Gadgets 1047
Diagrams 1072
The Diagrams user interface 1074
User authentication 1075
Viewing historical (trend) data 1076
Viewing meter events 1078
Viewing user diagram of devices with security 1079
Performing manual control actions 1080
Stale data and error indicators 1082
Power Quality Performance diagrams 1083
Insulation Monitoring diagrams 1093
UPS Auto Test diagrams 1120
EPSS diagrams 1123
Breaker Aging diagrams 1127
Reports 1130
Report templates 1131
Subscriptions 1133
Time display 1133
Terminology 1133
Generating a report 1134
Downloading a report 1135
Report descriptions 1136
System integration 1335
Integration with EcoStruxure Building Operation - Operating 1336
Trends 1343
Time display 1344
Vista 1345

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 15


Safety Information EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The Vista interface 1345


Vista user diagrams 1348
Monitoring your system in Vista 1350
Viewing real-time data 1353
Viewing logged data 1354
Viewing user diagram of devices with security 1357
Controlling system functions 1357
Plotting logged data 1358
The Log View Plotter interface 1359
Creating and customizing a user diagram 1372
Editing a user diagram 1373
Customizing a diagram object 1377
Linking a diagram object to a data source 1389
Querying the database 1390
Customizing a diagram window 1396
Web Applications 1401
Overview 1401
Web Applications User Interface 1402
Time Display in Web Applications 1403
Software Modules 1405
Backup Power Module operation 1406
Breaker Performance Module operation 1408
Capacity Management Module operation 1409
Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation 1410
Energy Analysis Reports Module operation 1411
Energy Billing Module operation 1413
Event Notification Module operation 1415
Insulation Monitoring Module operation 1417
Power Quality Performance Module operation 1418
Troubleshoot 1420
Tools for troubleshooting 1421
Diagnostics Viewer 1423
Decommission 1436
Applications 1437
Disturbance Direction Indicators 1438
Overview 1438
Components 1440
Prerequisites 1440
Limitations 1441
Design 1441
Configuration 1442
Operation 1446
Maintenance 1448
Thermal Monitoring of Low Voltage (LV) Busways 1451

16 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Safety Information

Overview 1451
Components 1452
Prerequisites 1453
Limitations 1453
Design 1453
Configuration 1454
Operation 1458
Maintenance 1460
Thermal Monitoring of Medium Voltage (MV) Substations 1462
Overview 1462
Components 1463
Prerequisites 1464
Limitations 1464
Design 1465
Configuration 1465
Operation 1469
Maintenance 1472
Reference 1473
Cybersecurity Reference 1474
Data encryption 1474
PME accounts 1474
PME Services 1475
Network shares 1475
Session timeout 1475
System integration security 1476
Verifying file integrity and authenticity 1476
Planning references 1478
Accessing the ION Database with 3rd-party applications 1479
Database growth calculations 1480
Default device type support 1482
IIS Application Pools 1488
Insulation Monitoring Design for ANSI 1489
IP Ports 1496
Licensing resources 1498
Using Floating License Manager after system upgrade 1499
PME Databases 1500
PME Windows services 1501
SQL Server accounts 1506
Windows accounts 1508
Installation and Upgrade references 1510
Setting SQL Server memory options 1511
Setup Types and applicable Installer pages 1513
Upgrade tools and resources 1514
Estimated task time for SBS upgrades 1515

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 17


Safety Information EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Network communication test 1516


Enabling TCP/IP protocol in SQL Server Express 1517
Installing and binding security certificates 1518
Enabling HTTP connections for PME 1521
Configuring first time Alarms processing 1523
Installing PME with manual installation of the databases 1524
PME 2021 Install notes 1531
PME 2021 Upgrade notes 1532
PME release history 1537
Configuration Manager 1539
Configuration References 1550
Software Alarms references 1552
Backup Power Module references 1563
Breaker Performance Module references 1574
Capacity Management Module references 1577
Dashboards references 1581
Database maintenance references 1595
Device Manager references 1603
Device Type Editor references 1607
Energy Analysis Reports Module references 1619
Energy Billing Module references 1625
Event Notification configuration references 1628
General references 1639
Insulation Monitoring Module references 1650
License Configuration Tool references 1652
Manual Data Editor references 1656
OPC references 1663
Power Quality Performance Module references 1665
Reports references 1675
System Integration 1677
Trends references 1731
User Manager references 1736
VIP Setup references 1742
Web Applications settings references 1744
Operation references 1746
Alarms references 1747
Dashboards references 1777
Power Quality Performance Module references 1782
Reports references 1786
Trends references 1845
Decommissioning Reference 1850
Destroy 1850
Overwrite 1851
Applications References 1853

18 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Safety Information

Thermal Monitoring of LV Busways Application References 1854


Glossary 1858

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 19


Safety Precautions EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Safety Precautions
During installation or use of this software, pay attention to all safety messages that occur in the
software and that are included in the documentation. The following safety messages apply to this
software in its entirety.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software or devices for critical control or protection applications where human
or equipment safety relies on the operation of the control action.
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-specific
cybersecurity policies.

20 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Overview

Overview
About this document
This guide is intended for Application Engineers, System Integrators, or other qualified personnel
who are responsible for designing, installing, configuring, maintaining, and using EcoStruxure™
Power Monitoring Expert (PME) software.

This document is not a tutorial, it was written with the assumption that you have been trained in the
deployment and use of PME.

This document does not discuss the planning, design, and operation of the electrical power system
that is being monitored.

Document updates
This document is available online through the Schneider Electric website. We may update the online
version over time to improve clarity and accuracy. If you see differences between your local copy
and the online version, use the online version as your reference. See Resources for contact
information.

Document revisions
Revision Number: Rev 00
MRP#: 7EN02-0445-00
Release Date: May 2021

This is the initial release of the PME 2021 System Guide.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 21


Overview EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Document organization and content


This document is organized by the following functional life-cycle stages: Planning, Installing and
Upgrading, Configuring, Administering, Operating, Troubleshooting, and Decommissioning.

Some tools, tasks, or functions are specific to a particular stage, others are part of different stages.
For example, deciding on which computer hardware to use, is done during the Planning stage.
Licensing, in contrast, has a Planning component, to purchase the correct licenses, and a
Configuring component, to activate the licenses on the system.

Reference is a resource chapter that contains detailed information. Use Reference information to
deepen your understanding of Power Monitoring Expert concepts, and to complete complex
procedures that might require additional information. The Reference section content is organized to
mirror the structure of the functional life-cycle stages.

How to use this document


The best way to use this document is by using document bookmarks and the introductory pages for
each chapter. Use the Bookmarks to navigate to the chapter introduction, and then use the chapter
link page to navigate to the content you are looking for. Much of the content contains hyperlinks to
connect related content.

You can also use the table of contents to navigate through the document, or use Find to search for
specific content.

22 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Overview

What's new in Power Monitoring Expert 2021


PME 2021 is a major release that introduces a number of new features and improvements. We
strongly recommend you to upgrade your existing PME system to version 2021.

Highlights of this release


• New cursor mode analysis of waveform to understand how voltage and current was changed
before, during, and after the power quality disturbance.

• New licensing engine to support typical virtual machine maintenance operation without
reactivating licenses.

• New site level power quality performance analysis to understand power quality issues for a
specific site.

• New Reports: KPI by TOU Report, Measurement Statistics Report, Measurement Statistics
Export Report, Profile Report, Scaled Energy Usage Report, and SARFI Report.

Details of this release


NOTE: The following is a selected list of changes for this release, it is not a comprehensive list.

Web Applications

Item Details
You can now analyze the waveform point by point, to understand
New cursor mode analysis how voltage and current was changed before, during, and after the
power quality disturbance.
You can now set up Alarms to monitor the data log status of devices
New data log status alarm
especially devices connected via gateway.
You can now generate pre-authenticated links to PME resources.
New integration utility Use these links to integrate web applications (Dashboard,
setting Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, Reports, and EWS measurements) into
third-party systems.

Software Modules and Licenses

Item Details
Added support of Galaxy V series (Galaxy VM, VS, and VX)
Backup Power Module
devices.
Breaker Performance Added support of Micrologic 7.2/7.3 E and Micrologic
Module 2.0/5.0/6.0/7.0 Xi devices.
Data Exchange Module Added new report:
license Measurement Statistics Export Report

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 23


Overview EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Item Details
Improved gadgets:
Consumption Ranking
Energy Analysis
Heat Map
Dashboards Module
Pareto Chart
Sankey
Energy Analysis Reports Added new report:
Module KPI by TOU Report
Power Quality Performance You can now view power quality diagrams, reports, and gadgets
Module based on the site associated with the user.

Tools

Item Details
You can use single tool for all license related actions like activation,
License Configuration Tool return, and refresh. Single activation ID for a given system and the
activation ID will remain the same for subscription renewal.
Upload Report Template You can use the upload report template tool to upload custom report
Tool packs or report template.

Reporting

Item Details
KPI by TOU Report
Measurement Statistics Report
Measurement Statistics Export Report
New reports
Profile Report
Scaled Energy Usage Report
SARFI Report
Energy Usage by TOU Report
Improved reports
Multiple Trend Report
Consumption Ranking
Heat Map
Improved gadgets Pareto Chart
Sankey
Table

Operating Environment

Item Details
New SQL Server version
SQL Server 2019 (Standard and Express) is now supported.
support
New SQL Express version
SQL Server 2019 Express is now on ISO
on ISO

24 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Overview

For the complete list of supported operating systems and SQL Server versions, see the IT
Requirements chapter in this guide.

Devices

Item Details
The following device types are now supported in PME 2021:

• Acti 9 Active

• Easergy P3

• Easergy P5

• Galaxy VS
New device type support • HDPM6000 series (HDPM6000, HDPM6000B, HDPM6000R,
and HDPM6000S)

• PM5600/5700 PQ

• PowerTag/PowerLogic Tag F160 & Rope

• SMD LV Thermal Monitoring

• Vigilohm IM400 series


The following device types are updated in PME 2021:

• CL110/TH110

• Micrologic 2.0/3.0/5.0/6.0/7.0 X/Xi


Updated device type
• PM2000 series
support
• PM5500/5600/5700 non-PQ

• PowerTag 63A/PowerLogic Tag QO & EDB

• PowerTag NSX M250/M630

Cybersecurity

Item Details
During installation, supervisor account password must comply with
Enforced password policy
the enforced password policy.
Several cybersecurity improvements to improve the security
Other improvements
posture.

Performance

Item Details
User manager Improvements for Windows Active Directory users.
System maintenance and Recommendations for system maintenance and database recovery
database recovery is available under Plan chapter of System Guide.
Quality improvements PME2021 includes a wide range of quality improvements.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 25


Overview EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Miscellaneous

Item Details
PME2021 additionally supports following two languages:

New language support • Norwegian Bokmål

• Turkish
SQL Server 2019 Standard Edition (English) is available for
SQL Server resale
purchase from Schneider Electric for use with PME2021.

Removed/Replaced Functionality

Item Details
Removed upload report The upload report template functionality is removed from web
functionality from web applications. To replace this functionality, upload report template
applications tool is available in Management Console.
Removed support of Floating License Manager and License Manager are no longer
Floating License Manager supported. New License Configuration Tool is available for license
and License Manager configuration.

26 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Overview

Resources
The Resources page is a central reference for any resources that are referred to in this guide but that
are not included in the guide.

Download Center

NOTE: The EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert System Guide includes the content of the
following guides: What's New Guide, IT Guide, Web Applications Guide, and the Insulation
Monitoring User Guide.

The following EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 documents are available on the
Schneider Electric Download Center: 

• System Guide (English) – Document number 7EN02-04445

• What's New Guide (English) – Document number 7EN12-0335

• Insulation Monitoring User Guide (English) – Document number 7EN02-0449

• Web Applications Guide (Multilingual) – (English) Document number 7EN02-0446

Exchange (requires login)

NOTE: On the Exchange you can find discussion forums, key content, service providers, and
knowledge base articles. You can also sign-up to become a service provider. To gain access to
the Exchange and its content, register at https://exchange.se.com/.

• Schneider Electric Exchange - EcoStruxure Power Monitoring Expert (Portal)

• Power Monitoring Expert Promote & Sell


PME End User License Agreement

• Power Monitoring Expert Design and Quote:


Tools (Commissioning Time Calculator, Daisy Chain Calculator, Database Growth
Calculator, Secondary Server Calculator)

Documents (IT Guide (English), PME System Guide)

EWS Specification

Standard Scope of Work Packages

Device Support Matrix

Part Numbers list

• Power Monitoring Expert Install and Maintain:


Information on PME software updates

Application Notes

Drivers

Help Files

Upgrade Map

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 27


Overview EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Tools (Configuration Manager, ETL Guides)

Documents (PME System Guide, PME/EBO Integration Solution Guide, Insulation


Monitoring User Guide)

Standard Scope of Work Packages

PME Scripts

• EcoStruxure Building Operation documents on Exchange:


Architectural Guidelines - EcoStruxure Building Operation

IT System Planning Guide - EcoStruxure Building Management

EcoStruxure Building Operation - System Reference Guide

EcoStruxure Building Operation - Technical Reference Guide

EcoStruxure Building Operation - IT Reference Guide

• Other documents and files on Exchange:


PO System Guide

EcoStruxure Power Digital Applications for Large Buildings & Critical Facilities - Design
Guide for North America

How Do I Extend the DDD Indicators Application to Support More Than 30 Devices

Exchange Community (requires login)

• PME Exchange Community (Online support and collaboration)


Software updates (see Announcements and Downloads)

• PME ETL download

• Billing Module Toolkit

• Device Drivers
PME Device Driver Summary Spreadsheet (shows native and downloadable drivers;
includes links to downloadable drivers)

PME Device Driver downloads (SE, LE- Enter the device name in the search box to find the
driver)

PME Device Driver downloads (CE)

Other

• Schneider Electric Cybersecurity Support Portal

• Schneider Electric Knowledge Base

• PME Sales Portal

• Schneider Data Privacy and Cookie Policy

• PME 7.2 Service Pack 2

28 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Overview

Technical Support

• Schneider Electric Support (Support)

• mySchneider app
24/7 support. Mobile catalog. Access to expert help.

• Offline Licensing Support


Offline license activation, return, and refresh

External Resources

The following are resources that are referenced in different sections of this guide; they provide
additional information and downloadable components.

Microsoft® technical documentation:

• Microsoft® SQL Server® Data-Tier Application Framework Installer Download


(DacFramework.msi)

• How to choose antivirus software to run on computers that are running SQL Server

• How to determine which versions and service pack levels of the Microsoft .NET Framework are
installed

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 29


Cybersecurity EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Cybersecurity
This section includes information on how to help secure your system.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-specific
cybersecurity policies.

Cybersecurity awareness
Knowledge is first step to prevent cyber intrusions. Review the following resources to increase your
cybersecurity awareness:

• Securing Power Monitoring and Control Systems (Schneider Electric White Paper)

• Social engineering (security)

To find out about the latest cybersecurity news, sign up for security notifications, or to report a
vulnerability, visit the Schneider Electric Cybersecurity Support Portal. See Resources for link
information.

RECOMMENDATION: Sign-up for security notification emails on the Schneider Electric


Cybersecurity Support Portal.

Cybersecurity features
PME includes features that help to secure your system, including:

• Data encryption using SHA-512 and AES-256 cryptography (At Rest) and TLS 1.2 / HTTPS (In
Transit)

• Compatibility with antivirus and whitelisting software

• User account management, optionally using Windows Active Directory integration

• Session timeout of inactive user sessions

For more information on these and other features, see Recommended actions.

NOTE: PME2021 complies with the requirements of the security relevant standards for Security
Level 1 (SL 1) according to IEC 62443-4-1 and IEC 62443-4-2.

30 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Cybersecurity

Recommended actions
PME is designed for a defense in depth security strategy, in compliance with IEC 62443, the global
standard for industrial automation control system security. A defense in depth strategy is a multi-
layered approach to cybersecurity with intentional redundancies to increase the security of a
system as a whole.
The different defense in depth layers can be described as:

• Data Layer (includes access control and encryption of data)

• Application Layer (includes antivirus software and application hardening)

• Host Layer (includes patch implementation, user authentication)

• Network Layer (includes IPsec, intrusion detection system)

• Perimeter Layer (includes firewalls, VPN)

• Physical Layer (includes guards, switches, locks, ports, physical access)

• Policies

To help secure your system, you must take specific actions for the different layers and at every
stage of the project life-cycle. The following shows the actions we recommend to help secure your
system, organized by life-cycle stage:

NOTE: The list of recommended actions below is not a complete list of possible cybersecurity
measures. It is meant to be a starting point to improve the security of your system. Consult with
cybersecurity experts to plan, install, configure, administer, and decommission your system
based on your needs.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 31


Cybersecurity EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Life-cycle Stage Layer Recommended Action


Data Layer Obtain security certificates.
Obtain antivirus and application whitelisting
Application Layer
software.
Host Layer Plan user access.
Network Layer Plan your network security.
Planning
Plan to install PME in an intranet environment.
Perimeter Layer
Plan IP port use.
Physical Layer Plan your site security.
Plan for the implementation of cybersecurity
Policies
standards.
Install antivirus and application whitelisting
software.
Application Layer Verify install file integrity and authenticity.
Installing, Protect the System Key.
Upgrading Apply PME updates.
Install latest updates for OS and SQL Server.
Host Layer
Check computer for cybersecurity issues.
Network Layer Install your network security measures.
Install security certificate.
Data Layer Set up encrypted database communication for
Distributed Database architectures
Configure application whitelisting software.
Application Layer
Configure antivirus software on your SQL Server.
Configure PME users and user groups.
Customize user account privileges.
Restrict Windows login permissions for the PME
Configuring server.
Host Layer Change the SQL Server Express sa account
password.
Configure session timeout settings.
Do not install or use a web browser on the server
computer.
Network Layer Set up your network security.
Perimeter Layer Disable unused IP ports.
Physical Layer Disable unused hardware ports.

32 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Cybersecurity

Life-cycle Stage Layer Recommended Action


Renew security certificate.
Data Layer
Securely store the system key.
Apply PME updates.
Application Layer
Verify update file integrity and authenticity.

Administering Apply OS and SQL Server updates.


Host Layer
Review user accounts on a regular basis.
Network Layer Keep network security up-to-date.
Physical Layer Keep computer hardware secure.
Policies Perform security audits
Decommissioning Host Layer Decommission your system at the end of its life.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 33


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Plan
Use the information provided in this chapter to prepare for an installation or upgrade of a Power
Monitoring Expert (PME) system.

Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for:

Topic Content
This is a planning tool to remind you of the different decisions that
Planning checklist have be made and actions that have to be taken during the planning
process.
Discusses where the system software and the database server can
System architecture
be installed.
Client types Introduces the different PME software client types.
Provides information on information technology components, such
IT Requirements
as computer hardware, operating environment, and networking.
Provides information on database maintenance and recommended
System maintenance
actions.
Provides information on disaster recovery and recommended
Disaster recovery strategy
strategy.
Cybersecurity Provides recommended actions to help secure your system.
Licensing Provides information on software licensing for PME systems.
System installation and Lists considerations related to new system installs and system
upgrades upgrades.
Provides an overview of the features and modules available in the
Feature selection and
software. It introduces the different functions, applications and
design
modules and discusses dependencies and design considerations.
Provides information on the communication links between the
Device Networks
software and the monitoring devices.
Provides information on the different approaches and technologies
System Integration
for integrating PME with other systems.
Provides information on the time, effort, and expertise that is
Deployment considerations
required to deploy a PME system.
Links to reference information related to the content of the Planning
Planning references
chapter.

34 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Planning checklist
The following checklist has an entry for each of the sections in the planning chapter of this guide.
Use the list as a planning tool to remind you of the different decisions that have be made and actions
that have to be taken during the planning process.

Item Details Completed


Decide which architecture to use (Standalone,
System Architecture
Distributed Database).

Decide which type of clients and how many of each
Client Types
are needed (Web Clients, Engineering Clients).

Decide which computer hardware, and operating
software to use (OS, SQL Server).
IT requirements
Understand the network related dependencies, and

plan for them.
Understand the system maintenance needs and
System maintenance
recommended actions.

Disaster recovery Understand on disaster recovery and recommended
strategy strategy

Understand which licenses (PME, OS, SQL, ...) are
Licensing required for your system and plan to purchase them □
in time for the deployment.
System installation Understand the prerequisites and the different
and upgrades options for new installs and upgrades.

Define which features and modules you want to
Feature Selection and setup for the user.
design Understand the prerequisites and dependencies, and

plan for them.
Understand the device network options (Ethernet,
serial).
Device networks
Match the devices with features and modules

(device capabilities, performance, and so on).
Understand the security needs of your customer and
application. Develop a security strategy and plan for
Cybersecurity the system, the network, the devices, and other □
relevant components (data encryption, virus and
malware detection, firewalls, ...).
Understand the different approaches and
technologies for integrating PME with other systems,
System integration
for example, OPC, EWS, ETL, ODBC, PQDIF, VIP,

....
Deployment Understand the complexity of the deployment and
considerations the time and expertise required.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 35


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

System architecture
PME is a client-server, on-premise software application that collects power monitoring data through
a network of connected devices. The power monitoring data is processed and stored using
Microsoft SQL Server and can be accessed by users in a variety of formats through different user
interfaces.

PME is deployed in one of two basic architectures: Standalone or Distributed Database.

Standalone architecture
In a Standalone architecture, all PME system files, the SQL Server database, and any other tools or
utilities are installed on the same computer. You access the power monitoring data through clients.

Distributed Database architecture


In a Distributed Database architecture, all PME system files, tools, and utilities are installed on one
computer. The database server is installed on a second computer. There are no PME system files
installed on the database server except for the historical database files. You access the power
monitoring data through clients.

36 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

The following example diagram shows both architectures in the context of the overall system,
including the monitoring devices:

Which architecture you should choose


We recommend you use the Standalone architecture. It is easier and more cost effective to deploy,
and there are no performance advantages in using a Distributed Database architecture.

However, in some cases it might be necessary to use the Distributed Database architecture, such
as:

• Your customer wants to use an existing SQL server.

• Your customer IT requirements do not allow a Microsoft SQL Server to be installed with another
application on the same server.

• The application requires Microsoft SQL Server redundancy with SQL Clustering or other third-
party tools.

• The application requires specific rules for database management, for example SQL jobs, back-
ups, data security, and so on.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 37


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Client types
In PME you use clients to access the configuration tools and the applications for viewing data.
There are two different types of clients:

• Engineering Clients configure and administer the system.

• Web Clients view power monitoring information.

NOTE: See Licensing for details on client licensing.

Engineering Client
An Engineering Client is an administrative interface in PME that is used to configure and administer
the system. Engineering Clients include tools such as the Management Console, Vista, and
Designer.

One Engineering Client is installed, by default, on the PME server. Additional Engineering Clients
can be installed on other computers, for example on a portable notebook computer, that are more
accessible than the server. Engineering Clients require a Base Access license.

Web Client
A Web Client is used to view power monitoring information such as real-time data, historical
information, and alarms which are used in day-to-day power management tasks.

Web Clients access the data on the server through a Web browser. No installation is required. Web
Clients can run on any computer on the network. Web Clients require a Client Access license.

Web Clients can access the Web Applications (Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, and
Reports) in PME.

To set up a Web Client, enter the fully qualified domain name of the PME server or its IP address,
followed by /Web into your browser.

Examples:
• http://10.160.42.1/Web
• http://PMEServer.MyCompany.com/Web

NOTE: Web is the default root directory. The root directory is configurable and can be changed
during installation.

By default, the first application on the navigation bar in Web Applications opens in the browser. To
specify which application should open first, add one of the following application parameters to the
Web address: (Note that the parameters are case-sensitive.)

38 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

#Dashboards, #Diagrams, #Trends, #Alarms, #Reports

For example, http://PMEServer.MyCompany.com/Web/#Alarms opens the Alarms


application in the browser.

NOTE: For cybersecurity and performance reasons, we recommend that you do not use a Web
Client on the PME server computer.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 39


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

IT Requirements
This section provides information on specifications and requirements related to information
technology (IT) components, such as computer hardware, operating environment, and networking.

Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for:

Topic Content
Computer Hardware Computer types, CPU, RAM, and HDDs.
Operating Environment OS, DB server, Web browser, and other compatible software.
Required network shares, Windows domain compatibility, IPv6
Network connectivity
compatibility, and IP port requirements.
Other IT considerations Computer name limitations, display resolution.

40 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Computer Hardware
The performance of a computer is determined by the following factors:

• Computer type (desktop, workstation, or server)

• Central processing unit (CPU)

• Random-access memory (RAM)

• Data storage, for example Hard Disk Drive (HDD)

When choosing the computer hardware for your PME system, you need to consider the following:

• Number of devices in the system

• Number of concurrent users

• System performance expectations

• Data exchange with other systems

• Historical data logging needs

• System availability and recovery needs

NOTE: Undersized computer hardware is a common source of performance issues with PME
systems.

Choosing Computer Type, CPU, and RAM


The computer type, CPU, and RAM determine the overall performance and reliability of the system.
CPU is important for device communications and RAM affects SQL Server performance.

As a starting point for the selection of these components, we are defining two different system
categories, Basic Systems and Advanced Systems. Decide which category best describes your
system needs and then use the information provided in the tables below to define your computer
hardware specifications.

Basic Systems
A basic system is defined by any of the following characteristics:

• Factory default measurement logging (logging frequency ≥ 15 minutes)

• No custom applications

• No Power Quality Performance monitoring

• Only a small number of branch circuit monitor devices in the system

• A mix of device type with approximately:


70% entry level devices (for example iEM3xxx)

20% intermediate level devices (for example PM55xx)

10% advanced level devices (for example ION9000)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 41


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Minimum recommended computer hardware for servers in Basic Systems:

System Size Devices Users Computer Hardware

Desktop
Small ≤ 100 ≤5 Intel Core i5 (4 core)*
8 GB (RAM)

Workstation
≤ 250 ≤ 10 Intel Xeon Bronze (6 core)*
16 GB (RAM)
Medium
Server
≤ 600 ≤ 10 Intel Xeon Bronze (8 core)*
24 GB (RAM)

Server
Large ≤ 2500 ≤ 10 Intel Xeon Silver (10 core)*
32 GB (RAM)

*Equivalent or higher processor

Advanced Systems
An advanced system is defined by any of the following characteristics:

• Custom measurement logging with <15-minute intervals

• Custom applications using the VIP module

• Power Quality Performance monitoring

• Large number of concurrent users

• High percentage of advanced level devices in the system

• Large number of branch circuit monitor devices in the system

• Large scale data exchange with third party systems (for example through OPC, ETL, or EWS)

• Other resource intensive software systems installed on the same computer

• Distributed Database architecture

Minimum recommended computer hardware for servers in Advanced Systems:

42 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

RAM
Distributed Distributed
System OPC Computer Database Database
Devices Users Standalone
Size Tags Hardware architecture - architecture -
architecture
Application Database
Server Server

Workstation
Intel Xeon W-
Small ≤ 100 ≤ 15 5000 16 GB 16 GB 16 GB
21xx (4
Core)*

Server
Intel Xeon
≤ 250 ≤ 20 10000 24 GB 16 GB 24 GB
Bronze (8
core)*
Medium
Server
Intel Xeon
≤ 600 ≤ 35 30000 32 GB 24 GB 32 GB
Silver (10
core)*

Server
Intel Xeon
Large ≤ 2500 ≤ 50 50000 64 GB 32 GB 64 GB
Silver (12
core)*

*Equivalent or higher processor

Client Computers
Since all the data processing is done on the server, the client computer hardware recommendations
are the same for Basic Systems and Advanced Systems.

Minimum recommended computer hardware for clients:

• Engineering Client
Intel Core i3 (2 core or better)

4 GB of RAM

• Web Client
2 GHz, Dual Core processor

4 GB of RAM

Monitor resolution of 1280 x 960 pixels

NOTE: To improve the information display, we recommend a minimum monitor resolution of


1440 x 1080.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 43


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Choosing Data Storage


The type of data storage determines the historical data access performance and the amount of
historical data that can be stored in the system. Data storage configurations are also important for
system availability and recovery.

Storage Size
The data storage must have enough space for the different programs and applications that are
running on the computer. This includes space for the historical data that is recorded by the system
and some free space as a buffer.

The following table shows the estimated storage space that is required, without the historical data
logs. The estimates are rounded up and allow for updates and system maintenance.

Component Storage Space
Windows Operating System software 100 GB
Microsoft SQL Server software 2 GB
PME software 5 GB
PME system databases 5 GB
PME historical database (see below)
Free space 30% of the storage size

PME historical database

The storage space that is required for the historical database (ION_Data), is equal to five times the
size of the main database file (ION_data.mdf):
Storage Space for ION_Data (GB) = 5x .mdf (GB)

It can be broken down into the following components, where ION_data.mdf size is the estimated
maximum size when PME is in steady-state:

Component Storage Space
Main database file (.mdf) (1x) ION_data.mdf size
Transaction log file (.ldf) (1x) ION_data.mdf size
Last two full backups (2x) ION_data.mdf size
Free Space for Backups or tempDB (1x) ION_data.mdf size
Total (5x) ION_data.mdf size

Optionally, the component can include storage of archive database when data archive and / or trim
strategy is performed. For medium to large systems (250-2,500 devices), we recommend you to
perform data archive and / or trim strategy to support healthy database. See Archive and Trim
strategy for more information.

NOTE: Use the Database Growth Calculator tool to estimate the database size for 'n' years of
archive data. The tool is available through the Exchange Community. See Resources for link
information.

44 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

The estimates above are based on the following assumptions:

• The .ldf file is typically just 10% of the .mdf size, but occasionally expands to 100% during
normal operation.

• The system default is to keep two database backups.

• 100% of the .mdf size is required for free space. The tempDB will occasionally expand to 100%
of the total .mdf size, but not at the same time as a backup. If the backups and tempDB are on
different hard drive groups, each of them require x1 .mdf in hard drive space.

Main Database File Size (ION_data.mdf)

Unlike the system software, the historical database size is continuously growing. Its size and
growth can be estimated based on the amount of:

• Factory default measurement logging

• Custom measurement logging

• Power quality event logging

Also, the database is configured to automatically grow by 10% when required to create room for
additional measurements. This growth operation can occur at any time and you need to consider it in
the database size calculations.

NOTE: Use the Database Growth Calculator tool to estimate the database growth for your
system. The tool is available through the Exchange Community. See Resources for link
information.

For optimum performance, minimize database auto-growth by configuring the database container to
the estimated maximum size after growth. During commissioning, use the Database Growth
Calculator tool to estimate the maximum ION_Data database size based on your data retention
policy, and configure the database container to the estimated maximum value. For example, if the
ION_data database file is estimated for 2 TB and above in container size then split the database in
to multiple files. For more details on how to set database container size and / or to add new files to
be database, see Increase the Size of a Database. You can view the size of the ION_Data
database using the Database Manager tool.

Storage Performance and Availability

Storage Type

The two main storage solutions that are available are Hard Disk Drives (HDD) and Solid-State
Drives (SSD). HDDs are good at providing cheap, bulk storage for non-performance critical data.
SSDs are good at providing strategic storage for high performance data. We recommend that you
use SSDs for the Microsoft Message Queuing (MSMQ) storage in medium, large, and extra large
PME systems.

Storage Configuration

Storage drives can be configured as single drives or a number of separate drives. For a small Basic
Systems, a single drive is sufficient. For all other systems, we recommend that you divide the data
storage into different drives.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 45


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For medium to large systems (250-2,500 devices):

Drive Type Components


Software: OS, PME, SQL
SSD Databases: ApplicationModules, ION_Network, ION_SystemLog
MSMQ
HDD or SSD SQL tempdb
HDD or SSD ION_Data
HDD or SSD ION_Data.ldf
HDD or SSD ION_Data archive database, database backups

RAID Systems

In addition to separating the software components into different drive groups, redundant arrays
(RAID) can be used to improve performance and add simple redundancy. In a RAID 1 configuration,
one drive is a complete copy of a second drive. If either of the two drives stops operating, the other
takes over without any data loss. The faulty drive can then be replaced to restore the RAID
configuration.

Recommended RAID 1 configurations:


2x Drive

Group 0
Component
Drive 1+2
OS ü
tempDB ü
MDF ü
LDF ü
Backups and archive ü

4x Drive

Group 0 Group 1
Component
Drive 1+2 Drive 3+4
OS ü
tempDB ü
MDF ü
LDF ü
Backups and archive ü

46 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

6x Drive

Group 0 Group 1 Group 2


Component
Drive 1+2 Drive 3+4 Drive 5+6
OS ü
tempDB ü
MDF ü
LDF ü
Backups and archive ü

8x Drive

Component Group 0 Group 1 Group 2 Group 3


Drive 1+2 Drive 3+4 Drive 5+6 Drive 7+8
OS ü
tempDB ü
MDF ü
LDF ü
Backups and archive ü

NOTE: Plan for system growth by having a computer with space for additional drives. This makes
it easy to add additional storage as the system grows.

NOTE: It is possible to use other RAID configurations, such as RAID 0 or RAID 5. These
configurations are not discussed in this document.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 47


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Operating Environment
PME supports the following environments and software:

NOTE: The operating system and SQL Server combination you choose must be supported by
Microsoft. This applies to edition, version, and 32-/64-bit.

NOTE: Apply the latest updates to the operating system and database system before installing or
upgrading PME.

Software Supported Versions


Windows 10 Professional/Enterprise
Windows Server 2012 Standard
Operating system* Windows Server 2012 R2 Standard/Enterprise
Windows Server 2016 Standard
Windows Server 2019 Standard
SQL Server 2012 Express
SQL Server 2014 Express
SQL Server 2016 Express
SQL Server 2017 Express
SQL Server 2019 Express (included with PME 2021 )
Database system**
SQL Server 2012 Standard/Enterprise/Business Intelligence
SQL Server 2014 Standard/Enterprise/Business Intelligence
SQL Server 2016 Standard/Enterprise/Business Intelligence
SQL Server 2017 Standard/Enterprise/Business Intelligence
SQL Server 2019 Standard/Enterprise/Business Intelligence
VMWare Workstation 10
VMWare ESX1 6.0
Oracle Virtual Box 5.0.4
Virtual environment*** Microsoft Hyper-V from Windows 8.1, Windows Server 2012
Citrix XenServer 6.2
Parallels Desktop 10
QEMU-KVM
Microsoft Excel Microsoft Excel 2013, 2016, 365
Google Chrome version 42 and later
Mozilla Firefox version 35 and later
Desktop Web browser
Apple Safari versions 7 or 8 and later
Microsoft Edge
Mobile Web browser Safari on iOS8.3+ operating systems, Chrome on Android systems
.NET Framework .NET 4.6 or higher

* For information on choosing an operating system, see Operating System considerations.

** PME includes a free version of SQL Server Express. You have the option to install this Express
version during the installation of PME, if you don't want to use a different SQL Server. For
information on the limitations when using SQL Server Express, see SQL Server considerations.

48 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

*** You must configure virtual environments with a supported Windows operating system and SQL
Server edition. It is possible to mix virtual and non-virtual environments for PME server and clients.

Windows Updates

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Apply the latest updates and hotfixes to your Operating System and software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Critical and routine Windows Updates can be applied to the operating systems hosting the PME
server and clients without prior approval by Schneider Electric.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before installing the update, verify that the system is not performing critical control actions
that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system operation after the update.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Before installing the update, verify that the system data results are not used for critical
decision making that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system data results after the update.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Localization
PME supports the following languages:

English, Chinese (Traditional and Simplified), Czech, French, German, Italian, Norwegian
(Bokmål), Polish, Portuguese, Russian, Spanish, Swedish, and Turkish.

A non-English version of PME only supports an operating system and SQL Server of the same
locale. For example, a Spanish version of the product must be used with a Spanish version of SQL
Server and an operating system with a regional setting of Spanish.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 49


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The English version of PME can be used with a supported language, non-English operating system
and SQL Server as long as both have the same locale. For example, an English version of the
product can be used with a German version of SQL Server and an operating system with a regional
setting of German.

Operating System considerations


Windows or Windows Server?
PME supports both Windows and Windows Server operating systems. However, we recommend
you use the Windows Server for the following reasons:

• Windows Server can use server-class computer hardware. It can access more CPUs and more
RAM than Windows. For example, Windows 10 is limited to two physical CPUs.

• Windows Server offers better performance for running PME services.

32-bit or 64-bit systems?

PME supports 64-bit operating systems only.

SQL Server considerations


Express Version or Full version?
Microsoft SQL Server is available as a free, scaled down Express version, and as a priced, full
server version. You can use both versions with PME. However, the Express version has the
following built in limitations:

• Maximum database size of 10 GB.

• No SQL Server Agent service.

• Limited to lesser of 1 socket or 4 cores.

• Limited to use a maximum of 1 GB of the total system RAM.

In addition, PME has the following limitations when used with SQL Server Express:

• Only supported for Standalone systems, not for Distributed Database systems.

• Not supported for systems with Power Quality Performance module.

NOTE: PME includes a free version of SQL Server Express. You have the option to install this
Express version during the installation of PME, if you do not want to use a different SQL Server.

Existing or new SQL Server?


You can use PME with an existing SQL Server, or you can install a new one. The following table
lists the installation requirements for new and existing SQL Server types:

Type Description
PME requires a certain configuration of the SQL Server. Find the
New SQL Server Standard installation instructions for SQL Server in the Install and Upgrade
chapter of this guide.

50 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Type Description
PME includes a free version of SQL Server Express. You have the
New SQL Server Express
option to install this Express version during the installation of PME.
To use an existing instance of SQL Server Standard , the SQL
Existing SQL Server Server setup wizard must be rerun to configure the software
Standard correctly for use with PME. Find the configuration instructions for
SQL Server in the Install and Upgrade chapter of this guide.
Existing SQL Server The PME installer can add a new instance to an existing SQL
Express Server Express for use with PME.

NOTE: The operating system and SQL Server combination you choose must be supported by
Microsoft. This applies to edition, version, and 32-/64-bit.

SQL Server clustering


Clustering refers to a group of two or more SQL Servers that work together and appear as a single
server to the outside. When a client connects to an SQL Server cluster, it appears that there is only
a single SQL Server. In case of a server failure, the remaining servers take over without an
interruption. Using clustering increases system availability.

PME can be used in a clustered environment when deployed in a Distributed Database architecture.

• The Application Server is deployed in a non-clustered environment.

• The SQL Server component is deployed in the clustered environment.

NOTE: SQL Server clustering is only supported for Distributed Database systems, not for
Standalone systems.

SQL Server compute capacity


When using SQL Server in virtualized environment, there is a defined compute capacity limit on the
sockets and cores of CPU as per the SQL Server edition. The performance of the SQL server
depends on this compute capacity limit. See Compute capacity limits by edition of SQL Server for
more information. Plan your SQL server virtualized environment deployment as per the compute
capacity limit to achieve better performance.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 51


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Network connectivity
Network communication
The PME server, database server, and clients must be able to communicate with each other over
the network using TCP/IP protocol. The licensing component of PME requires that PME clients and
server can resolve each other’s address by name (not just fully qualified domain name or IP
address). If a proxy server is used on the network, then a local address bypass must be configured
on the PME server.

An Internet connection is not required for PME to function correctly.

Network shares
Engineering Clients require that the Power Monitoring Expert folder on the PME server is shared
with full read and write permissions. File and Printer Sharing must be enabled.

Windows Domain compatibility


Domain membership is not required for PME to function.

• PME can be installed on servers in a domain environment, however it cannot be installed on


domain controllers. If PME is installed on a server that is subsequently changed to a domain
controller, the software ceases to function correctly.

• For Distributed Database installations of PME, the Database Manager tool can only be used if
the database server and the PME application server are in the same domain. The Database
Manager cannot be used, in a distributed database installation, if the database server and the
PME application server are in workgroups.

• A domain account is required for Side-by-Side upgrades of distributed systems using the
Configuration Manager Tool. This domain account must be:
A member of the Administrators group on the PME server

Added as a Login in SQL Server with sysadmin role in the database instance.

• PME supports Windows Active Directory services for user account sharing.

IPv6 compatibility
PME supports IPv6 (and IPv4) for communications with metering devices. The software
components of PME require IPv4. That means PME can be used on computers with single stack
IPv4 or dual stack IPv4/IPv6 network adapters.

IP Port Requirements
PME uses certain ports for the communication between its components and the connected devices.
Which ports are required for a specific installation depends on the system configuration and the
monitoring devices used. See IP Ports for a list of relevant ports.

52 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Other IT considerations
Internet Information Services (IIS) .NET Trust Level
The .NET Trust Level for PME web applications and Default Web Site must be set to Full
(internal), in IIS Manager. See IIS Application Pools for a list of PME web (ASP.NET) applications.

PME Server name limitations


The computer name for the PME server must have 15 characters or less, and use only letters,
numbers or hyphens.

NOTE: The computer name must not be changed after the PME software is installed. If the
computer name is changed after the install, the software ceases to function correctly. If that
occurs, contact Technical Support for assistance.

Display resolution
The minimum display resolution for PME user interfaces is 1280 x 960 pixels.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 53


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

System maintenance
Once a PME system is installed and commissioned, it must be maintained on a regular basis.
Without periodic, proactive system maintenance, system performance degrades over time and the
system operates with poor performance (timeouts and sluggish response) and eventually becomes
unusable.

This section provides guidelines and recommendations for creating a maintenance schedule. Proper
adherence to the maintenance guide ensures a steady-state operation of a PME system.

This section does not detail troubleshooting system issues, but identifies the steps to develop a
maintenance plan that should allow for a commissioned system to continuously run at optimal
performance.

A maintenance plan keeps your PME system healthy. A comprehensive maintenance plan starts in
the system planning stage before commissioning. The plan should include frequent monitoring and
system reviews, and maintenance tasks to ensure the system is operating under healthy
conditions.

The following sections provide recommendations for developing your maintenance plan:

• Designing for maintenance

• Database maintenance

• System health review

Designing for maintenance


Before installing and deploying a system, it is important to plan and design the IT architecture in
support of maintenance and backup activities. Maintenance and backup activities often require
additional resources (CPU, RAM and hard drive space) to perform and complete the activity. The
recommendations are as follows:

• System sizing

Size a system for the final state (for example: maximum devices, maximum logging
parameters, etc) to ensure that the system runs in a healthy state for a longer time. See IT
Requirements for recommended system sizing.

• Storage space allocation

Make sure there is enough hard drive space to perform database maintenance, archive and trim
operations. See Storage Performance and Availability for recommended hard drive sizing.

• Disk I/O performance

Disk read/write operations impacts system performance. Plan to have different storage devices
installed for the system files, the database files, and the Microsoft Message Queuing (MSMQ)
files. See Choosing Data Storage for recommended storage information.

• Pre-size databases

By default, ION_Data database is configured with a 10% auto-growth parameter. This growth
operation can lead to a fragmented database and hard drive and can impact database

54 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

performance over time. To minimize the use of the auto-growth feature, pre-allocate hard drive
space for the ION_Data database during system commissioning, including systems running
SQL Server Express. See Database growth for recommendation on database growth.

• Database auto growth

For systems expected to have large ION_Data databases (> 100 GB), change the default auto-
growth setting to a fixed size rather than by percentage (Default is 10%). In this case, the
database auto-grows when the database exceeds the preset container size. This ensures better
control of database growth. Auto-growth events are expensive operations that slow down the
performance of your database. Take the following preventive steps to ensure your auto-growth
is in control:

Minimize future auto-growth events by monitoring the growth of your databases, and re-
establishing auto-growth settings when a database growth profile changes.

Monitor auto-growth events so you can be alerted when your databases grow.

Consider defragmenting your database file system.

See SQL Server Database Growth and Autogrowth Settings for more information.

Database maintenance
PME uses databases to store information such as system configuration, data logs, and system
event log messages. These databases must be maintained to preserve performance, manage disk
space usage, and guard against data loss in case of database failure. Maintenance is the key to a
healthy system that supports system longevity and future scalability. You must not ignore
maintenance. Non-maintenance may lead to system downtime and you might need to rebuild the
system from scratch.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the database at regular intervals.
• Back up the database before upgrading or migrating the system.
• Back up the database before trimming it.
• Back up the database before making manual database edits.
• Verify correct database behavior after making database or system changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

Database maintenance for PME includes the following key activities:

• Performance maintenance

• Accurate and up-to-date query statistics

• Minimize index fragmentation

• Data archive and trim

• Database integrity check

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 55


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Based on the key activities, see Consolidated recommendation for database maintenance.

Performance maintenance
For performance maintenance, enable and schedule the following daily maintenance tasks for all
PME systems of any configuration:

Maintenance Tasks*
Maintenance
Database Type of Data (update statistics Size
Trim**
and index Notification
defragmentation)
Web Applications related
ApplicationModules configuration data and system ✓ ✓ –
event log entries.

NOTE:
For
systems
with SQL
Historical power system data such Server
Express,
ION_Data as interval data logs, waveforms ✓ ✓
and alarms. enable
SQL
Express
Database
Size
Notificatio
n.

Device network and other system


ION_Network ✓ – –
configuration data.
Non-Web Applications related
ION_SystemLog ✓ ✓ –
system event log entries.

* See Default maintenance task settings for basic task definitions.


** Keep the last 30 days of data.

In Standalone PME systems, the database maintenance tasks are pre-configured and scheduled to
run automatically by default. For Distributed Database PME systems, you need to configure the
tasks and set up the schedules manually.

For more information, see the Database maintenance section in the Configuring chapter of this
guide.

56 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Accurate and up-to-date query statistics


SQL Server uses statistics to create query plans that improve query performance. As the database
increases and holds more data, the statistics becomes less relevant over the time. Updating
statistics ensures that queries run with relevant statistics.

For all systems, it is recommend to update database statistics daily. The following table shows the
default database maintenance task schedules for standalone systems:

Database Task* Trigger Time


ApplicationModules Maintenance Daily at 03:30
ION_Data Maintenance Daily at 02:00
ION_Network Maintenance Daily at 07:30
ION_SystemLog Maintenance Daily at 07:05

* See Default maintenance task settings for basic task definitions.

In distributed systems, the database maintenance tasks are not pre-configured. You need to set up
these tasks manually.

These scheduled tasks trigger the DatabaseMaintenance.ps1 Windows PowerShell script. This
script executes the local [Maintenance].[UpdateStatisticsAll] stored procedure in each database.

Check the PME system logs and SQL Server logs to confirm that the scheduled tasks are
completed successfully. The log might report errors if an issue arises. As the database grows,
these jobs will take longer time to complete.

See Microsoft’s SQL Server documentation on SQL Server Query Statistics for more information
about query statistics.

For more information, see the Database maintenance section in the Configuring chapter of this
guide.

Minimize index fragmentation


Database index maintenance is important to ensure optimal performance. When data is written to
the databases, fragmentation occurs. Heavy fragmented indexes can degrade query performance
and reduce PME’s response time.

To minimize index fragmentation, monitor the fragmentation regularly and perform re-indexing.

For small to medium size systems:


It is recommend to re-index daily. The following table shows the default database maintenance task
schedules for standalone systems:

Database Task* Trigger Time


ApplicationModules Maintenance Daily at 03:30
ION_Data Maintenance Daily at 02:00
ION_Network Maintenance Daily at 07:30
ION_SystemLog Maintenance Daily at 07:05

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 57


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

* See Default maintenance task settings for basic task definitions.

In distributed systems, the database maintenance tasks are not pre-configured. You need to set up
these tasks manually.

These scheduled tasks trigger the DatabaseMaintenance.ps1 Windows PowerShell script. This
script executes the local [Maintenance].[ DefragIndexAll] stored procedure in each database.

Check the PME system logs and SQL Server logs to confirm that the scheduled tasks are
completed successfully. The log might report errors if an issue arises. As the database grows,
these jobs will take longer to complete.

For large systems:


For large systems with ION_Data growing over 100 GB in size, it is important to review the
frequency of the [ION_Data] database maintenance scheduled task and switch to running them
manually.

Index fragmentation in ION_Data is unavoidable for large systems because of the amount of data
written to the system and queried on a regular basis. Index fragmentation is also common when
database reads exceeds database writes, that is, when PME is configured with added components
to move data from PME to another non-PME system.

For large systems, you need to monitor the index fragmentation daily. To monitor, run the following
SQL commands against the database:

• DBCC SHOWCONTIG

• sys.dm_db_index_physical_stats

Both the commands generate a report on index fragmentation. The time it takes to complete these
statements depend on the amount of data in the table and the level of fragmentation. The more
fragmented the index, the longer the query will run. You should expect the query to return results
within 1 to 20 minutes.

DBCC SHOWCONTIG
DBCC SHOWCONTIG displays fragmentation information for the data and indexes for specified
tables.

NOTE: This command applies to SQL Server 2008 to 2019 and is expected to be deprecated in a
future version of SQL Server.

For ION_Data, run the following commands:


USE ION_Data

GO

DBCC SHOWCONTIG WITH TABLERESULTS, ALL_INDEXES

Review the output from DBCC SHOWCONTIG for the following three statistics:

Average Page Density:

Shows the accurate indication of how full your pages are. A high percentage means the pages are
almost full, and a low percentage indicates much free space. This value should be compared to the
fill factor setting specified when the index was created to decide whether or not the index is

58 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

internally fragmented. The fill factor is the percentage of space on each leaf-level page that should
be filled with data, and it is applied only when the index is created, rebuilt or reorganized. If the
Average Page Density and Fill Factor are close in value, then it would suggest that there is little
index fragmentation.

Scan Density:

Shows the ratio between the Best Count of extents that should be necessary to read when scanning
all the pages of the index, and the Actual Count of extents that was read. This percentage should be
as close to 100% as possible. Defining an acceptable level is difficult, but anything under 75%
definitely indicates external fragmentation.

Logical Scan Fragmentation:

Shows the ratio of pages that are out of logical order. The value should be as close to 0% as
possible and anything over 10% indicates external fragmentation.

See DBCC SHOWCONTIG (Transact-SQL) for more information on DBCC SHOWCONTIG


command.

sys.dm_db_index_physical_stats
sys.dm_db_index_physical_stats also returns size and fragmentation information for the data and
indexes of the specified table or view in SQL Server. This command is available in SQL Server 2005
or later.

For ION_Data, run the following commands to show fragmentation details for tables with more than
100,000 rows and a fragmentation level of greater than 50%. Comment out the WHERE clause to
show results for all table indices. The output is sorted by fragmentation level from highest to lowest.
USE ION_Data

GO

SELECT

DB_NAME(db_id()) AS DatabaseName,

OBJECT_NAME(object_id) AS TableName,

object_id,

index_id,

index_type_desc,

avg_fragmentation_in_percent,

fragment_count,

page_count,

avg_page_space_used_in_percent,

record_count

FROM

sys.dm_db_index_physical_stats(db_id(),DEFAULT, DEFAULT,
DEFAULT, 'SAMPLED')

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 59


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

WHERE

(record_count > 100000) AND (avg_fragmentation_in_percent > 50)

ORDER BY

avg_fragmentation_in_percent DESC;

When reviewing the output from sys.dm_db_index_physical_stats, review the values in the avg_
fragmentation_in_percent column. You should defragement the indexes, if the fragementation is
10% and above.

See sys.dm_db_index_physical_stats (Transact-SQL) for more information on sys.dm_db_index_


physical_stats command.

Correcting index fragmentation


Any index with over 10% fragmentation should be corrected.

There are different corrective statements depending on the level of fragmentation. For PME, select
the statements as follows:

Fragmentation
Corrective Statement Remarks
Percentage
Reorganizing an index uses minimal
ALTER INDEX system resources and is an online
10 to 30%
REORGANIZE operation, which means PME can remain
online during this operation.
Rebuilding an index drops and re-creates
the index. Depending on the type of index
ALTER INDEX REBUILD and Database Engine version, a rebuild
> 30%
WITH (ONLINE = OFF) operation can be done online or offline. For
large indexes, it is recommended to
perform this operation offline.

See Resolve index fragmentation by reorganizing or rebuilding indexes for more information on
correcting index fragmentation.

Data archive and trim


The archive strategy supports data retention and compliance, while the trim strategy supports
disaster recovery goals.

Archive and Trim shortens the backup process by keeping only business critical data in the live
database and also reduces the resource demands in the disaster recovery efforts by shrinking the
database to backup and restore.

Archiving is not recommended since it fractures the data into multiple databases. PME is unable to
query multiple databases at the same time to make comparisons in the data. It is possible to run
reports against an archived database, but it can only be done on one database at a time.

However, the ION_Data database may need to be reduced in size for two reasons:

60 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

• SQL Server Express is used as the database engine, which has a limit of 10 GB for the .mdf
file.

• SQL Server (Standard or Enterprise edition) is used as the database engine and the ION_Data
database has become so large that query performance (in Vista for example) is not acceptable
to the PME system users. It is also important to ensure that the ION_Data database is trimmed
well within the hard drive size, as it can affect the operation of PME.

For PME systems with considerable database growth (medium to very large systems), it is
important to consider frequent removal of older and lesser used data from ION_Data. PME includes
an ION_Data data archive maintenance task by default. The database archive task is pre-
configured and disabled for standalone systems, while it must be manually added for distributed
systems.

To determine if data archiving is needed, you must:

• Understand the importance of archive and trim

• Determine the data retention needs

• Develop the archive and trim strategy

Understand the importance of archive and trim


The purpose of the archive is to remove data from the live ION_Data database to reduce its overall
size. An archive is a copy of a subset of data from the live ION_Data database based on a date
range and the type of data (Data Records, Waveforms and Events).

When an ION_Data archive is created, it is attached to the SQL Server database engine so that its
data is still accessible to Vista and Diagrams. However, the data is not available to other
applications in the Web Applications component.

NOTE: Data archival in PME is different from the normal terminology of archiving. PME's archive
task does not remove data from the database, it only copies data to the archive. Once the data is
archived in PME, it cannot be re-imported back.

We recommend to manually trim the database of historical data after each archive task.

Determine the data retention needs


The live system only needs to hold as much data as needed for business. Consider the following
questions along with the business use cases to determine the data retention needs:

• What is the oldest date of data that is needed for trends and alarms?

• Is it sufficient to review older data trends only through web reports or diagrams?

• What date range of data is needed for historical reporting – start and end dates?

• How often should data be archived?

Develop the archive and trim strategy


These questions determine key aspects of the archive and trim strategy, in particular:

• When to archive data from the live database?

• When to trim data from the live database?

• When to delete historical archives?

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 61


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example: Archive and Trim Strategy


The following diagram illustrates an example ION_Data archive and trim strategy for a small to
medium system that started data collection in Q4 2016 and the strategy planned till 2021.

Based on the business needs, the data retention requirements are:

• Perform analysis with at least two calendar years of data in the main PME system

• Reporting on the last 3 calendar years of data

• Data older than 3 calendar years can be deleted

The example strategy is as follows:

• Keep two calendar years of data in the main ION_Data database.

• Start archive activity at the end of Q1 of the third year.

NOTE: There should be 2 years and 3 months of data in ION_Data.

In this example, archive data from start of Q4 Year 1 to end of Q1 Year 3 into the database
called ION_Data Archive Year 1. This results in a new archive database named ION_Data_
Archive_2017 containing data from 01 September 2016 to 01 April 2018.

• Backup the newly created archive database.

• Schedule the archive activity once per year starting at the end of Q1 of the current year.

NOTE: Archive the older year of data with an additional 3 months on each side of the year of
interest.

• After each successful archive, backup the newly created archive database.

• Schedule the trim activity to trim data in the last 3 months of the dataset from the main ION_
Data database.

• Schedule the trim to run every 3 months.

• When an archive database contains data older than 3 years, mark the archive database for
deletion.

• Delete the marked archive database after 12 months of non-use.

62 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

NOTE: This strategy creates an overlap of data for every year.

Recommendation for archive and trim


• Archive and trim the ION_Data database often and in small batches. Together these two tasks
reduce the size of ION_Data and its backup files.

• Archive historical data often even when disk space is not an issue or when not using SQL
express.

• Trim historical data in small batches and often.

• Always perform a database trim after verifying a new archive.

Recommended consolidated archive and trim plan for systems


The recommended consolidated archive plan of ION_Data database for the different purpose of
PME system are as follows:

Purpose of PME system


Real-time monitoring &
Analysis & decision Critical large advanced
Archive troubleshooting
making (Capacity distributed system
strategy (Electric distribution
management, Energy (with mix of real-time
parameter monitoring & alarming,
usage analysis, Power and analysis based
Insulation monitoring,
Quality compliance) applications)
Backup power testing)
Maximum data
retention (ION_
Data and 4 years 1 year 4 years
Archive
databases)
Live data in
3 years 1 year 2 years
ION_Data
ION_Data
Start after end of year 3 Not applicable Start after end of year 2
archives
Archive
Annually Not applicable Every 3 months
frequency
Number of
archives to store 1 Not applicable 8
on server
Additional IT
resources Use database growth Use database growth
needed for calculator to estimate Not applicable calculator to estimate
archive size archive database size archive database
databases*

*See Database growth for recommendation on database growth.

The recommended consolidated trim plan of ION_Data database for the different purpose of PME
system are as follows:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 63


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Purpose of PME system


Real-time monitoring &
Analysis & decision Critical large advanced
troubleshooting
Trim strategy making (Capacity distributed system
(Electric distribution
parameter management, Energy (with mix of real-time
monitoring & alarming,
usage analysis, Power and analysis based
Insulation monitoring,
Quality compliance) applications)
Backup power testing)
Data with timestamps Data with timestamps Data with timestamps
Trim older than 3 years from older than 1 year from older than 2 years from
today today today
Trim frequency Monthly Monthly Monthly

Database integrity check


Database corruption is a rare event that is usually caused by inoperative hardware on the server. A
database integrity check reviews the allocation and structural integrity of all objects in each
database to ensure it is not corrupt.

Run DBCC CHECKDB in SQL Server Management Studio on all PME related databases once per
month or quarter.

Check for errors reported in the output of DBCC CHECKDB. A database with integrity displays the
following at the end of the output.
CHECKDB found 0 allocation errors and 0 consistency errors in database
'ION_Data'.

DBCC execution completed. If DBCC printed error messages, contact your


system administrator.

See DBCC CHECKDB (Transact-SQL) for more information on database integrity.

Consolidated recommendation for database maintenance


Based on the key activities discussed, the following is the consolidated recommendation for
database maintenance as per the systems:

For all systems (Small, Medium, and Large):

• Schedule the ApplicationModules database trim task to run daily.

• Schedule the ION_SystemLog database trim task to run daily.

• If the number of connected devices have increased over time, review hardware and hard drive
space requirements at least once per year to ensure server specifications meets growing
demand.

• Review the frequency of the ION_Data database maintenance task as the system grows.
Reduce the frequency from daily to weekly to monthly as the database grows and the
maintenance tasks (Update statistics and re-indexing) take longer to complete.

• Never shrink the database container; it causes fragmentation.

• Archive and trim the ION_Data database regularly and in batches, such as 3 to 12 month data
sets. Refer to Historical Data Archive and Trim Strategy for more information.

64 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

• Commission PME’s default ION_Data archive Windows scheduled task.

• Develop a process and schedule for:

Verifying the newly created archive database

Backing up the newly created archive database

Deleting the archive database when necessary

For large ION_Data databases (> 100 GB):

Large ION_Data databases require additional effort to maintain because all the maintenance task
might not run completely.

• Disable the ION_Data database maintenance task

With large systems, index fragmentation occurs quickly and is unavoidable.

Defragmentation takes lot of time and the performance gained because of defragmentation
is comparatively less.

If you plan to rebuild indexes, ensure that you have an equivalent amount of free space as
the database size.

• If ION_Data database increases over 100 GB unexpectedly, it can be due to following reasons:

Database fragmentation can occur when there are more database read than database write
actions.

Power quality and / or waveform logging is enabled accidentally, then power quality data
increases.

More data points are logged than usual and frequent logging is performed.

• Defragmenting indexes may require a lot of free hard drive space to allow reindexing to
succeed. Review hard drive space requirements.

System health review


You can adjust the system for optimal performance by monitoring the state of a system.

Frequent review of system health is to ensure optimal system health over the long term. This task
involves identifying and resolving potential issues. It is recommended to perform system health
checks at least once per month or quarter depending on the amount of data flowing into the system
and how often the system is used.

It is recommended to use the following approach to set up regular system health checks:

1. Determine which system health checks are appropriate. The following is a list of system
health checks appropriate for most of the PME system. Customized PME systems might
include additional checks or have some removed, however all system health checks listed
should be considered:

List of checks Application Server Database Server


Anti-malware ✓ ✓
Services running ✓ -

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 65


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

List of checks Application Server Database Server


Message queues ✓ -
Device communication ✓ -
Processor usage ✓ ✓
Memory usage ✓ ✓
Disk usage ✓ ✓
File system growth ✓ ✓
File system fragmentation ✓ ✓
Log files ✓ ✓
Windows scheduled task history and status ✓ ✓
Database growth - ✓
Database fragmentation - ✓
Database integrity - ✓
Database backup - ✓
Software licensing ✓ ✓
Software updates ✓ ✓

2. Identify and document how the above information can be collected for the system health
review. See Tools for troubleshooting. Note the following tools:

PME Diagnostic Tool - Install and deploy this tool to obtain a snapshot of the current state
of the system. See PME Diagnostics tool for more information.

PME Diagnostics Viewer. See Diagnostics Viewer for more information.

3. Create a template system health report. This report should contain at least the following
information:

Report date

Contact information

A list of each system health check with the following information for each line item:

Status – Passed, Caution, or Failed

Description of contributing factor to the given status

Recommended action

4. Determine a storage location for system health reports. Reports should be stored in a
consistent location and they should be accessible by administrators and support users.

5. Create an initial system health report.

6. In the location created in step 4, save the template report and the initial system health report.

The following table provides the information on list of system checks on why the check is required
and what you need to check:

66 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

List of checks Why What to check


If the PME server has an internet • Check for warnings and threats.
connection, it is at risk for viruses and
• If threats were found, were the
malware. The anti-malware software
Anti-Malware infected files quarantined?
should be monitoring for threats in real-
time and running full scans once per • Check that the latest anti-malware
month. definitions are installed.

• Use Windows Services, Windows


Event Logs and Diagnostics
Viewer – Service Diagnostics to
ensure all ION, SQL Server and IIS
Services These services are core of PME and services are running.
running must always be running.
• If they are stopped, investigate
logs for root cause.

See Diagnostics Viewer for more


information.
• Log Inserter writes log data into a
message queue instead of writing
it to SQL Server directly. Another
process (the Log Subsystem
Router Service) reads the
messages from the queue and Use Diagnostics Viewer – Log Pipeline
writes the data to SQL Server. Service to check status of PME
Message MSMQs.
queues • The message queues should be at
or near zero the majority of the See Diagnostics Viewer for more
time. One indicator of poor system information.
health is when PME is operating in
steady-state and the message
queue size stays above zero for
any queue for an extended period
of time.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 67


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

List of checks Why What to check


• Use Diagnostics Viewer –
Communication Diagnostics to
check for communication issues,
such as Timeouts or Log Inserter
issues.

Networking issues can lead to • Repeated and frequent timeouts


communication loss with devices. For are common for long daisy chains –
devices without onboard logging, this is a sign that the loop
Device performance needs to be
communication loss means data loss.
communication assessed.
Monitor device communications often
to ensure the expected devices are • The LogInserter service diagnostic
communicating. will reveal which devices cannot
log data at the device level, and
which DataRecorders have issues
(reference LogHandle column).

See Diagnostics Viewer for more


information.
• Is CPU trend showing at least 20%
free?

• Are processes using and releasing


CPU resources?

In Windows Resource Monitor, track


Processor CPU usage over time should be less the following object counters:
usage than 80%.
• Processor: % Privileged Time

• Processor: %User Time

• System: Processor Queue Length

See Monitor CPU Usage for more


information.
Prevent low memory problems by Use Windows Resource Monitor to
applying the appropriate server track the following object counters over
resources (RAM, CPU) as the system time to determine normal usage and
grows. Take into consideration future identify issues:
Memory usage extensions of the system and • Memory: Available Bytes
upgrades, which could be performed in-
place if the server is prepared ahead. • Memory: Pages/sec
Monitor memory usage to confirm that See Monitor Memory Usage for more
it is within range. information.

68 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

List of checks Why What to check


Use Windows Resource Monitor to
track the following object counters for
each disk:

Primary

• PhysicalDisk: Avg. Disk sec/Write

• PhysicalDisk: Avg. Disk sec/Read

There is a risk of disk I/O issues Secondary


Disk usage particularly in PME systems with large
• PhysicalDisk: Avg. Disk Queue
ION_Data databases.
Length

• PhysicalDisk: Disk Bytes/sec

• PhysicalDisk: Disk Transfers/sec

Track these counters over time to


determine normal usage and identify
issues. See Monitoring Disk Usage for
more information.
If a disk completely fills up, data loss
occurs. You must ensure the all disks
have adequate disk space for all
maintenance tasks (defragmentation,
backups, database reindexing). There
should be at least 20 - 30% free disk
space at all times for optimum
• Ensure file system fragmentation
performance. Possible causes of file
job is running regularly
system growth include database file
growth, log file growth, data archives, • Check for unsustainable file
File system and space used by 3rd party software. system growth. If found, take
growth preventive action to reduce the risk
The best preventive measure is to
of a full disk, that is, add more disk
track of the disk space usage and
space or adjust system
assess the growth over time. If the
configuration to reduce disk space
used space for a disk has consistently
usage.
increased for several months and the
percent free disk space is below 30%
then action is required. Investigate the
root cause of the growth, and develop a
plan to either prevent more disk space
from being used or for more disk space
to be added.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 69


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

List of checks Why What to check


• Pre-allocate hard drive space for
the ION_Data database. See
If file system (or disk) fragmentation is Diagnostics Viewer for more
greater than 40% on the database information.
drive, SQL server experiences a
thrashing/page faulting condition when • Check file system fragmentation
manipulating a large volume of rows. on all drives used by PME at least
File system
once per month
fragmentation For PME, file system fragmentation
usually results in database auto- • Schedule time and perform file
growth. It is most common in small and system defragmentation if
medium databases because of the necessary. For standalone
SQL express database size limit. systems, ensure SQL Server
services are stopped before
defragmentation.
Check:

• ION_SystemLog

• IIS Logs

• Windows Event Logs

There are many logs that contain • SQL Server Logs


critical error information, non-critical
• Check for unexpected errors in the
error information, warnings, and
log files
informational messages. Logs can be a
good source of information for how well • Check for errors related to PME
Log files
a system is performing as well as components
gathering data for troubleshooting • Check log size to ensure total size
specific issues. is not excessively large (> 1 GB)
IIS logs should be trimmed regularly. • Archive historical logs if folder has
too many log files.

Sometimes certain irrelevant errors or


warnings can be ignored. Any
anomalous messages in these logs
should be recorded and investigated.
PME’s default database maintenance
Windows tasks are configured as Windows • Check Windows Scheduled Task
scheduled task Scheduled tasks. Logs, if any.
history and Ensure scheduled tasks are • Check PME System Logs for
status successfully launched at the errors related to these tasks.
scheduled time and completing.

70 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

List of checks Why What to check


Unexpected database growth can lead
to poor performance. Usually
significant database growth is a trigger.

Database Unexpected database growth suggests Check database growth since the last
growth possible excessive data logging due to system health check. Does the growth
device misconfiguration. For example, align with expectations?
unexpected high-frequency logging (1
second logging intervals) or waveform
logging when waveform data is not
necessary.
Database fragmentation, if not
Database Check for index fragmentation over
addressed, is a common cause of poor
fragmentation 10%
system performance.
Database corruption is a rare event that
is usually caused by inoperative • Run DBCC CHECKDB on all PME
hardware on the server. A database related databases.
Database
integrity check reviews the allocation
integrity • Check for errors reported in the
and structural integrity of all objects in
each database to ensure it is not output of DBCC CHECKDB.
corrupt.
• Review SQL Server Logs for errors
related to each job.

Database Confirm that the backup scheduled • Confirm that the expected
backup tasks are completing successfully. database backup files exist, and
that copies of the backups have
been made to another media and
off-site.
Software To ensure all PME and SQL Server
Check that the license is still valid.
licensing features are functional.
The latest updates ensure the system Check to see if software is out-dated
Software
has the latest cybersecurity protection, and identify when is the correct time for
updates
and known software bugs are fixed. an upgrade.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 71


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Disaster recovery strategy


Disaster recovery requires planning and assessment to develop a strategy that meets both the
business requirement and PME system configuration. The disaster recovery strategy is the result of
two objectives:

• Data retention - The amount of data required in the active system.

• System recovery - The minimal state of the system that should be recovered after a disaster
and the acceptable limit of data and time loss.

Disasters can occur at any time and, if unprepared, such events can lead to data loss and service
disruptions. Factors leading to system disasters include:

• Inoperative hardware

• Sudden power interruption / outage

• External threats such as malware, virus attacks, hacking

• Human errors such as accidental data deletion

• Implementation or upgrade issues

• Database corruption, such as a database exceeding the maximum expected size or allowable
hard drive space

• Natural disasters (For example, earthquakes, fire, flood, storms, and so on)

Some SQL Server disasters cannot be prevented, so it is important to prepare a complete disaster
recovery plan (DRP) to ensure minimal impact on service and data availability.

An effective disaster recovery plan should comprise:

• Identify disaster recovery objectives

• IT architecture and resources plan

• Backup plan

• Recovery plan

Developing the plan requires collaboration with the IT team, application champions (administrators,
power users) and recovery experts.

NOTE: If you have limited time and resource to define the strategy, you can consider third-party
products and services for assistance.

Identify disaster recovery objectives


The plan starts with identifying disaster recovery objectives. This includes the business aspect of
the system. You might want to consider the value of the PME system and the data it contains:

• What is the business cost of one day of downtime, both explicit and implied?

• What would be the result if an hour’s, day's or month's worth of analysis, reporting, alarming
and data were lost?

• What would be the result of a complete loss of the PME system?

72 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

If your system is not critical, you may decide the best strategy is a simple one where a new PME
system is redeployed in the event of a disaster and device data is re-imported and you experience
potentially irrelevant historical data loss. If your system is critical, you may develop a plan for a
quick recovery with minimal data loss.

You must set a written expectation of what constitutes an acceptable loss. Consider the following
questions:

• What is an acceptable level of data loss in your PME systems?

The answer to this question determines the Recovery Point Objective (RPO) objective. It is
the maximum amount of recent data the business can lose when a disaster strikes. It helps to
measure how much time can occur between your last data backup and the disaster without
causing serious damage to your business. RPO is used to determine how often to perform data
backups.

For example, your backup schedule is set to daily at midnight and a disaster occurs at 8 AM. At
the point of the disaster, you would have lost 8 hours’ worth of data. If your RPO is one day of
data then the loss of the last 8 hours of data is not an issue. However, if your RPO is one hour
of data, then you must revise your backup schedule to at least one backup per hour.

• What is an acceptable recovery time?

The answer to this question determines the Recovery Time Objective (RTO) objective. It is
the amount of time the business can survive without the system after a disaster and before
operations are restored to normal. It determines how quickly you need to recover the PME
system after a disaster.

For example, if your RTO is 24 hours, you can wait up to 24 hours before the system must be
available to users. If data and infrastructure are not recovered within 24 hours, the business
might be impacted.

• What level of disaster should we be prepared for?

Identify the possible disasters that could affect your PME system and the level of impact of
each disaster. For example: If your PME system is an on-premise solution, you should prepare
for disasters such as power loss, fire, flood, etc. If your PME system is hosted on off-site
servers in a data center, prepare for natural disasters but with low priority compared to
cybersecurity risks.

IT architecture and resources plan


It is important to design the IT architecture so you can allocate the necessary hardware and
networking resources in support of optimal performance and disaster recovery. Maintenance and
backup activities often require additional resources (CPU, RAM and hard drive space) to perform
and complete the activity. You can also prevent disasters using additional hardware. The
recommended best practices are as follows:

• Hard drive space allocation

Ensure there is enough hard drive space to perform backup operations and take at least two
backup files. The spare hard drives can ensure minimal rebuild time. RAID arrays (commonly
used on all PME systems) can protect against disk damages. See Storage Performance and
Availability for recommended hard drive sizing.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 73


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Backup power

UPS systems and redundant power supplies to servers can prevent server power interruption.

• Connection redundancy

If available, redundant data links can protect critical data transmission when the communication
cannot be established in the network.

• Standby servers

With supporting infrastructure and cost, standby servers can provide another set of hardware
that can replace the PME system hardware in the event of an inoperative server. This approach
is valuable when PME is a critical system.

Backup plan
Creating backups are a key part of every PME deployment. A backup solution unique to the PME
deployment can be created based on the recovery objectives, the PME system, and available IT
resources. The backup plan should comprise:

• Components backup

• Backup frequency

• Storage and retention of backup

• Test the backup

Once you have a strategy with details, document the details and supporting processes. Whenever a
system or process change occurs, review and update this document. Store the document outside of
the PME server.

Components backup
The following table contains the components of a standard PME system that must be considered for
backup:

Component Name Description


Sometimes called the NOM (Network Object
Model), the ION_Network database stores
device information, such as, device name,
device type and connection address (for
example, IP address and TCP/IP port or
PME Database ION_Network
device/Modbus ID). It also contains information
about the optional Application Module settings,
other ION Servers, Sites, Dial Out Modems,
and Connection Schedules. There is only one
ION_Network per system

74 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Component Name Description


The Application_Modules database contains
configuration settings (for example, layouts,
colors, application events, and so on) and
PMEDatabase Application Module
cached historical data for some of the Web
Applications (for example, Dashboards and
Trends).
The ION_Data database contains the historical
data, events and waveforms from devices
connected to the system. This includes:
PME Database ION_Data
onboard logging configured on devices; and,
PC-based logging configured in the device
translators and the Virtual Processors.
The ION_Data archive databases contain
PME Database ION_Data archive historical data that have been sectioned off from
the main ION_Data database.
The master database is the core system
database for a SQL Server installation. It
System Database master
contains information such as SQL Server
credentials and system configuration settings.
The model database is used as a template for
System Database model all databases created on the SQL Server
instance.
The msdb database is used by SQL Server
Agent for scheduling alerts and jobs. msdb also
System Database msdb
contains history tables such as the backup and
restore history tables.
The application folder is where all the program
and configuration files for PME are stored. By
PME Files PME
default this is “%Program Files%\Schneider
Electric\Power Monitoring Expert”
The SQL Server folder is where all the program
and configuration files for SQL Server, SQL
System Files SQL Server Server Reporting Services, and SQL Server
Agent are stored. By default, this is “%Program
Files%\Microsoft SQL Server”.
Contains configuration information for the entire
System Files Windows registry
server

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 75


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Component Name Description


It is advised to take an image of the entire PME
application and database servers (excluding the
actual database files – MDF, NDF, and LDF
System files). This backs up other important
Full Server Backup
and PME Files configuration information such as service
credentials, security policies, and IIS setup. It
can be important when simplifying and reducing
the time taken for a system recovery.

All PME databases should be backed up frequently and a full server backup should be taken upon
system configuration changes (for example, Vista diagrams, updating device drivers, registry
settings, VIP framework changes, and so on). Use Configuration Manager for performing the
backup.

Database recovery model


When backing up databases it is important to choose an appropriate recovery model. The recovery
model is a database property that controls how transactions are logged, whether the transaction log
requires (and allows) backing up, and what types of restore operations are available.

PME databases use one of two recovery models:

• Simple recovery model

Complete database backup is taken and a restore can only be done up to the point when the
backup was taken.

• Full recovery model

Provides backup options such as differential, incremental, and transaction log. The restore can
be done using different options.

All PME databases are configured with the simple recovery model by default. The ION_Data
database recovery model should be updated to reflect your backup plan.

The recovery model is determined by comparing the disaster identification time with the backup
schedule. For example, as per the following diagram:

76 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

A system that is configured to have a single backup cannot be recovered. System is not accessed
by users over the weekend, and becomes inoperative such that the automated backup jobs are still
able to run. In this case, the backup would not be valid and there would be loss of the complete PME
system.

You can prevent this situation by setting the ION_Data database recovery model to Full, thus
allowing more refined backup options.

In the case of critical PME systems, consider:

• Being aware of your disaster identification time and adjust your backup schedule appropriately

• Using a full recovery model with several differential backups (advanced configuration)

• Keeping multiple backup copies on a rotational basis

The key benefit of the full recovery model is that it can restore a database exactly to any point in
time since the last full backup was taken, including potentially to the point the disaster occurred,
resulting in no data loss. It should only be used if simple recovery is not sufficient to meet the
recovery needs as it incurs cost of performance and storage space.

Backup frequency
By default, PME is configured to backup the ApplicationModules and ION_Network databases on a
daily basis, while the ION_Data database is backed up once per week. This default configuration
assumes that meters installed throughout the network have onboard memory and onboard logging
enabled with a log of at least 14 days of data. This weekly frequency balances the need for
performance in steady state and disaster recovery preparation. Frequent transaction log backups
can lead to an unnecessarily bloated LDF file, which can cause performance issues.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 77


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

If your PME system is critical, it is important to ensure you have a frequent backup strategy to
support quick recovery. In this case, the recommended practices are:

• Set the ION_Data database recovery model to Full

• Schedule daily full backups

• Schedule hourly transaction log backups

• Continue to keep the last 2 full backup files on the server

• Increase hard drive storage space by the 2 x size of a ION_Data.MDF file for the additional
transaction log backup files

• Keep the last 24 transaction log backup files on the server

The recommended backup configuration and frequency for PME and system database are as
follows:

Recovery Backup
Component Name Description
Model Frequency
PME Database ION_Network All Simple Daily
PME Database Application Module All Simple Daily
For systems with meters
PME Database ION_Data that have at least 14 days Simple Weekly
of onboard logging
For systems without
onboard logging or for
critical systems

NOTE: Perform hourly


PME Database * ION_Data transaction logs backup. Full Daily
Review data storage
requirements for the
additional transaction log
backup files

Upon
PME Database ION_Data archive All Simple
creation
System Database master All Simple Daily
As
System Database model All Full
required
System Database msdb All Simple Daily

Additionally, all the components should be manually backed up after an update.

The recommended backup configuration and frequency for PME and system files are as follows:

78 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Component Name Backup frequency


• Backup upon significant system change
PME Files PME • Use Configuration Manager to backup and archive
PME files. Be sure to deselect the database options
• Backup upon significant system change

System Files SQL Server • Backup “%PROGRAMFILES%


Microsoft SQL Server” folder upon major system
changes (hotfixes and upgrades)
System Files Windows registry Monthly and after a significant system change
• Annually or upon significant system change

System Full Server • Backup the entire PME application and database
and PME Files Backup servers (excluding MDF, NDF, and LDF database
files) once a year and after each significant system
change (upgrade)

Storage and retention of backup


In the PME Planning stage, we recommend to have enough additional hard drive space to support at
least three times the expected size of the main ION_Data (MDF) database. This estimation
assumes that two backup files are stored on the production server.

We recommend the following storage and retention strategy:

• Follow the 3-2-1 Rule

Store backups locally on a RAID protected drive for the shortest amount of recovery time.

Store a copy of backups on a centralized set of disks so you can recover the backups on
another server if the production SQL Server encounters a critical issue.

Store a copy of the backups off-site on external drives or in the cloud in case a site disaster
occurs.

• Set up automated processes to backup and move files to separate locations.

• Maintain a reasonable set of backups off site and outside of the PME servers. We recommend
the following backup retention strategy. Check with your legal team on keeping certain amount
of critical data in the event of a disaster.

10 daily backups

5 weekly backups

6 monthly backups

3 on-demand or annual backups

• Historical backup files should be stored off-site.

• Delete the old backup files on a regular basis in order to manage the storage cost.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 79


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Test the backup


A critical aspect to the backup strategy is to ensure that you can recover files from the backups.
Prepare a test procedure to verify that the backup files contain the expected data and that the
backups can actually be restored, that is, the backup files are not corrupt.

When practicing the restore procedure, ensure that you restore to a different server and at a different
location.

This practice ensures that the recovery team:

• Knows the steps to follow when recovering from a data loss or disaster.

• Has existing infrastructure to support a recovery.

• Can stay calm and act efficiently in a real disaster situation.

Recovery plan
Backup files are worthless if they cannot be restored, so you must have a recovery plan with the
goal of getting a recovered PME system functional with minimum downtime and data loss. The
disaster recovery objectives and backup and archive strategies help create a recovery strategy.

The most important point to remember when creating a recovery plan is that it is not valid until it is
actually tested, and your recovery position is good as your last recovery test. Once you have a
recovery plan, allocate some time to test your disaster recovery strategy. Be aware of who is
executing the recovery as well. Do not assume that a specific person is available to restore the
PME system.

We recommend the following approach to developing a recovery strategy:

1. Set a time expectation for recovery (Recovery Time Objective).

2. Identify the necessary hardware, software, backup and archive files and types (full,
differential, and log).

Ensure resources – physical (servers, software, network) and personnel – are allocated and
assigned, so they are readily available if a disaster strikes.

3. Document the entire recovery procedure.

If you have a large recovery time window, such as 1 week, you may have enough time to
contact PME support team to assist in a recovery procedure. If you have a smaller time
window then any PME administrator (factoring in employee turnover) should be capable of
performing a restore, so this procedure should be well documented. At a minimum, all backup
and archive locations should be documented and accessible to any PME administrator. Store
the documentation outside of the PME production servers.

NOTE: Training PME administrators and / or support staff on PME disaster recovery may be
important to ensure you have redundant personnel available.

4. Schedule system downtime and test the restore procedure. This is a necessary step to ensure
the disaster recovery strategy is valid. Track the time the recovery procedure takes to verify
your time expectation for recovery is valid. Take corrective action for any areas missed in your
recovery documentation, backup, or archive strategies.

80 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

5. Progressively update recovery documentation after any major system changes are made that
changes the restore procedure.

NOTE: See SQL Server Limitations on Restoring System Databases in cases where a full SQL
server recovery is needed.

Recommended consolidated disaster recovery strategy plan


The recommended consolidated disaster recovery strategy plan of ION_Data database for the
different purpose of PME system are as follows:

Purpose of PME system


Real-time monitoring &
Disaster Analysis & decision Critical large advanced
troubleshooting
recovery making (Capacity distributed system
(Electric distribution
strategy management, Energy (with mix of real-time
monitoring & alarming,
parameter usage analysis, Power and analysis based
Insulation monitoring,
Quality compliance) applications)
Backup power testing)
On board logging (14 to
Device memory None None
30 days)
Recovery point As close to the point of
Up to 1 week Yesterday
objective disaster as possible
Recovery time
24 hours 36 hours 24 hours
objective
Database
Simple Simple Full
recovery model
Full backup with
Full with weekly Full with weekly Full with daily
frequency
Additional
Transaction logs with
backup with Not applicable Differential with daily
hourly
frequency
Number of full
backup files to 2 2 2
store on server
Number of Depends on how often
additional the transaction log
Not applicable 2 to 6
backup files to backup files are
store on server validated
Additional IT
resources Additional storage Additional storage
needed for Standard required for differential required for transaction
additional backup log backup
backup files*

*See IT Requirements for recommended system sizing.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 81


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Cybersecurity
This section provides information to help you plan your system security.

Obtain security certificates


PME uses Transport Layer Security (TLS) 1.2 for an encrypted, authenticated connection using
HTTPS between the server and its web clients. Both self-signed and authority issued certificates
are supported. PME is installed with a self-signed certificate and a self-signed certificate is
configured automatically. We recommend that you replace this with a security certificates from a
Certificate Authority (CA).

You also need a certificate for the database server computer to use an encrypted connection
between PME and the SQL database server in a Distributed Database architecture installation. See
Set up encrypted database communication for Distributed Database architectures for more
information on this topic and for links to Microsoft articles with certificate requirements for SQL
server computers.

See Data encryption for information on data encryption, at rest and in transit, in PME.

Obtain antivirus and application whitelisting software


PME can be used with antivirus (AV) software.

PME can be used with application whitelisting software products such as McAfee Application
Control software. See Configure application whitelisting software for more information.

NOTE: AV software can have a significant impact on system performance if not set up correctly.
In particular, SQL Server performance can be affected if data and log files are not excluded from
on-access scans. See Configure antivirus software on your SQL Server for more information.

Plan user access


Define a list of user accounts, access levels, and access permissions for your PME system. See
PME accounts, Network shares, and Session timeout for more information.

Plan your network security


Determine the network security measures for your IT and device networks to provide your desired
level of security.
This can include:

• use of industrial firewalls

• use of intrusion detection and prevention systems (IDS, IPS)

• application of ISO27001 (Information Security Management System Standard [=policies and


procedures])

• managing wireless access and remote access

• device security

• deep packet inspection firewalls

• physically securing device access

82 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Determine what level of expertise will be required to deploy and maintain the network architectures
and security measures. Plan to have this expertise available for the system deployment and
maintenance.

Plan to install PME in an intranet environment


PME is designed for an intranet environment within a secured network infrastructure. PME is NOT
designed for direct Internet connection.

Plan IP port use


Determine which IP ports are required and which ones can be disabled. See IP Ports for details on
PME port requirements.

Plan your site security


Determine the hardware locking measures required to provide your desired level of security.
This can include:

• personnel access restrictions to server locations

• physical locking of the computer, for example with a cable

• cementing the USB drive

• removing the CD-ROM drive

• tools such as McAfee® Enterprise Policy Orchestrator (ePO) suite of products

• industrial, security hardened PCs such as the Magelis Box

Define workarounds and alternatives for cybersecurity-imposed restrictions, for example, for USB
and CD-ROM drive access.

Plan for the implementation of cybersecurity standards


Consider implementing cybersecurity standards such as:

• IEC62443, the global standard for industrial automation control system security.

• ISO27001, a specification for an information security management system.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 83


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Licensing
This section provides information on software licensing for PME systems.

Use the links in the following tables to find the content you are looking for:

PME Licensing:

Topic Content
Licensing overview The licensing model and the different license types in PME
Licensing process High level flow diagrams showing the licensing process.
Licensing tools Different tools related to licensing.
Important notes on licensing A list of items for you to consider when planning a PME system.
Licensing resources Links and contact information for other license related resources.

Operating Environment Licensing:

Topic Content
Operating System licensing Microsoft Windows operating system software licensing.
SQL Server Licensing Microsoft SQL Server software licensing.
Other software licensing Third party software application licensing.

For information on how to configure licensing in PME, see the Licensing configuration section in the
Configuring chapter of this guide.

84 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Licensing overview
PME is a proprietary software that uses licensing to control its use and distribution. The licensing is
enforced through mechanisms that disable certain software functions if no valid license has been
activated.

To use PME, you must purchase software licenses and activate them in the system. The licenses
give you the right to use the software according to the terms and conditions described in the
software End User License Agreement (EULA). The licenses generally do not expire, unless stated
otherwise in the software EULA. PME licenses are per system. If you have multiple systems, you
must purchase separate licenses for each. Multi-system, or enterprise licenses are not available.

PME uses a modular licensing structure where different licenses enable different functions in the
software. Some of these functions are optional, others are required. The licenses are cumulative,
meaning that you can add additional licenses to a system, to enable additional functionality.

See Resources for information on where to find a copy of the PME EULA.

License activation
Purchased licenses must be activated either through online or offline methods. An Internet
connection for the PME server is required for online activation. Offline activation must be done from
an alternate Internet-connected computer or smart-phone with web access. See Activating a
license for details.

Licenses are tied to the host computer (physical or virtual). If PME needs to be moved to a new
computer, the licenses must first be returned and then reactivated on the new computer.

License types
PME licenses bundle together one or more PME features. For example, a Base license includes two
Client Access license.

The following table shows the different licenses that are available for PME:

Type Description
New system installations include a time limited Trial license.

The Trial license:

• enables all of the PME features (except Connected Services)

• includes an unlimited Device license

• includes an unlimited Client Access license


Trial license
• may be extended on demand (See Licensing resources for
contact information.)

• cannot be reinstalled

• remains active for 90 days until a purchased license is


activated

• expires after 90 days

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 85


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Type Description
This is a required license. It enables the PME server functions and
the basic system functions. Without the Base license the system is
not functional. The same Base license can be used for Standalone
Base license or Distributed Database systems.

The Base license also includes two Client Access licenses. With
Base license, engineering client can be accessed.

86 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Type Description
The Express Base license is similar to the Base license but with
reduced functionality. It is intended for small starter or entry-level
systems. The following shows the differences between Base and
Express Base licenses:

Express
Feature Base
Base
Included device
10 None
licenses
PQ Reports No Yes
Device Licenses Max of 10
Yes
(DL) additional
Client Licenses Max of 2
Yes
Expansion (CL) additional
(optional): Unlimited DL No Yes
Unlimited CL No Yes
Data Exchange
No Yes
Module
Express Base license
Energy Billing No Yes
Energy Analysis
Yes Yes
Reports
Energy Analysis
Yes Yes
Dashboards
Capacity
No Yes
SW Modules Management
(optional) Insulation
No Yes
Monitoring
PQ Performance No Yes
Breaker
No Yes
Performance
Backup Power No Yes
Event Notification No Yes
To
Edition Upgrade Standard n/a
Edition

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 87


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Type Description
This is a required license. It enables the use of monitoring devices
in PME.
Depending on the locale, device licenses are sold as:

• Bundles of 5, 25, 50, 100, 200, unlimited - for the US, Canada,
and India.

• Individual licenses, with 3 different license types - for countries


other than the US, Canada, and India:
E for entry-range device types
Device license M for mid-range device types

S for high-end device types

See the Default device type support list for details on which
device types require which licenses.

NOTE: Unlimited individual device licenses are available.

NOTE: At least one device license must be activated in the


system for PME to be able to communicate with a device.

This is a required license. It allow access to Web Applications.

• Client Access licenses are assigned to users.

• Each user needs their own Client Access license.

• A Client Access license is assigned and bound to a new user


when they first log into the PME web applications.

• The supervisor account also needs a Client Access license.


Client Access license
• To free up an assigned Client Access license, the user must be
deleted in PME.

NOTE: An unlimited Client Access license is available that


includes unlimited web application use.

NOTE: Management Console does not require a license.

88 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Type Description
This is an optional license. It enables the use of a Software Module.
Each Software Module requires its own specific license. The
following Software Modules exist in PME:

• Backup Power Module

• Breaker Performance Module

• Capacity Management Module


Software Module license • Energy Analysis Dashboard Module

• Energy Analysis Reports Module

• Energy Billing Module

• Event Notification Module

• Insulation Monitoring Module

• Power Quality Performance Module


This is an optional license. It enables the use of the following
features and functions in PME:

• OPC DA Server

• Measurement Aggregation Export Report

• Measurement Statistics Export Report


Data Exchange Module
license • VIP Modbus Slave functionality

• COMTRADE export with ETL

NOTE: OPC DA Server licenses on older PME systems will


automatically be converted to Data Exchange Module licenses on
upgrade.

Developer/Demo license This is a special license. Contact Schneider Electric for details.

Related topics:

• Licensing overview

• Licensing process

• Licensing tools

• Important notes on licensing

• Operating System licensing

• SQL Server Licensing

• Other software licensing

• Licensing configuration

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 89


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For reference information see:

• Device license information

• Licensing resources

90 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Licensing process
The licensing process is different for new systems, system upgrades, and system migrations. The
following shows the high-level process for each. For further information, see the resources provided
in Licensing resources.

New system licensing


The following flowchart shows the high-level licensing process for new PME systems:

System upgrade licensing


The following flowchart shows the high-level licensing process for PME system upgrades:

(*) PME systems must be upgraded using a services plan with software assurance.

System migration licensing


The following flowchart shows the high-level licensing process for moving a PME system to a new
server, or reinstalling it on the same server after the operating system has been reinstalled:

See System migration and license returns for more details.

Related topics:

• Licensing overview

• Licensing process

• Licensing tools

• Important notes on licensing

• Operating System licensing

• SQL Server Licensing

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 91


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Other software licensing

• Licensing configuration

For reference information see:

• Device license information

• Licensing resources

92 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Licensing tools
The tools you use during the licensing process are the Sales Portal and the License Configuration
Tool.

Sales Portal
The Sales portal is an online tool. Use it to create the Bill of Materials (BOM) for your license
purchase, to activate or renew a service plan, and to generate licenses. You can also view license
information for an existing system. The sales portal can be accessed through an Internet connection
with a computer or a mobile device.

For information on how to access the sales portal, see Licensing resources.

License Configuration Tool


The License Configuration Tool is a tool that is installed with PME. Use the License Configuration
Tool to activate licenses, return licenses, refresh licenses or to view all the licenses that have been
activated in the system. Also use the tool to view information about the trial licenses.

TIP: You can access the License Configuration Tool in the install location within
....\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring Expert\License Configuration
Tool.

Related topics:

• Licensing overview

• Licensing process

• Licensing tools

• Important notes on licensing

• Operating System licensing

• SQL Server Licensing

• Other software licensing

• Licensing configuration

For reference information see:

• Device license information

• Licensing resources

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 93


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Important notes on licensing


Consider the following licensing related items, when planning a PME system:

Trial license and new system installations


New system installations of PME have a Trial license that expires after 90 days. The Trial license
enables all of the software features. We recommend that you have purchased license activation IDs
ready when the system is deployed. Trial license deactivates after the purchased licenses have
been activated.

Trial license and system upgrades


A new Trial license is given when you upgrade a PME system to version 2021.

Upgrade licenses
PME systems must be upgraded using a services plan with software assurance. Activating or
renewing a services plan might add extra time to the licensing process.

Starting from PME 2021, License Configuration Tool is used for license configuration. Floating
License Manager and License Manager are not supported for license configuration. These two
applications are unusable after system upgrade.

NOTE: It is recommended to uninstall Floating License Manager and License Manager from
Control Panel after system upgrade. If you have other systems installed on the same server, for
which the licensing is based on Floating License Manager, see Using Floating License Manager
after system upgrade for steps to use Floating License Manager.

For system upgrade, you must return the licenses using Floating License Manager and after
upgrade, activate the new license using License Configuration Tool. For new license contact Sales
Portal. See Licensing resources section for Sales Portal contact details.

System migration and license returns


A license can only be activated on one PME server at a time. For a system migration, you must
return the licenses on the old system and then activate the license on the new system. No trial
license is given for a migrated system. Contact Technical Support if you forgot to return the licenses
on the old system and they have become untrusted. See Licensing resources for contact
information.

NOTE: System migration includes the case where you reinstall PME on the same server after the
operating system has been reinstalled.

Licensing and Firewalls


The PME clients access a licensing service that is running on the PME server to confirm that valid
licensing has been activated. The IP port used by the licensing server must not be blocked if a
firewall is used between the PME client and server. See IP Ports for details.

Related topics:

• Licensing overview

• Licensing process

94 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

• Licensing tools

• Important notes on licensing

• Operating System licensing

• SQL Server Licensing

• Other software licensing

• Licensing configuration

For reference information see:

• Device license information

• Licensing resources

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 95


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Operating System licensing


PME is designed to run on a Microsoft Windows operating system. You must have a computer with
a supported and licensed version of Microsoft Windows to install PME. See Operating Environment
for a list of supported Microsoft Windows versions and editions.

The operating system license is not included in the PME license. Schneider Electric does not resell
Microsoft Windows licenses.

Related topics:

• Licensing overview

• Licensing process

• Licensing tools

• Important notes on licensing

• Operating system licensing

• SQL Server Licensing

• Other software licensing

• Licensing configuration

For reference information see:

• Device license information

• Licensing resources

96 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

SQL Server Licensing


PME is designed to operate with a Microsoft SQL Server database system. See Operating
Environment for a list of supported Microsoft SQL Server versions and editions.

Microsoft SQL Server is available as a free, scaled down Express version, and as a licensed, full
server version. You can use both versions with PME. For information on the limitations when using
SQL Server Express, see SQL Server considerations.

A free version of SQL Server Express is included in the PME installation files and you have the
option to install it during the installation of PME.

You can purchase licenses for a full server version from Microsoft or from Schneider Electric.
Schneider Electric only resells licenses for specific versions and editions of Microsoft SQL Server,
that are compatible with PME. Contact Schneider Electric for details. See Resources for contact
information.

Related topics:

• Licensing overview

• Licensing process

• Licensing tools

• Important notes on licensing

• Operating System licensing

• SQL Server licensing

• Other software licensing

• Licensing configuration

For reference information see:

• Device license information

• Licensing resources

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 97


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Other software licensing


PME can be used with a number of third party, add-on applications. These applications can be
integrated with PME or can be used standalone. Check the licensing requirements of these
applications before using them with PME.

Third party software licenses for add-on applications are not included in the PME license. Schneider
Electric does not resell third party add-on licenses.

Examples of third-party add-on applications include:

• Microsoft Office

• Virtual Machine software

• Third party OPC server/client software

• Virus and malware detection and application control software

Related topics:

• Licensing overview

• Licensing process

• Licensing tools

• Important notes on licensing

• Operating System licensing

• SQL Server Licensing

• Other software licensing

• Licensing configuration

For reference information see:

• Device license information

• Licensing resources

98 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

System installation and upgrades


This section provides information on planning for a system installation or upgrade.

Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for:

Topic Content
Install planning Things to consider when preparing for a new system installation.
Upgrade planning Things to consider when preparing for a system upgrade.
Migration planning Things to consider when preparing for a system migration.
PME Installer Installer overview, operation, and functions.
PME 2021 Install notes Release notes for PME 2021, related to system installation.
PME 2021 Upgrade notes Release notes for PME 2021, related to system upgrade.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 99


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Install planning
Prerequisites
To plan for the installation of the software, review all relevant sections in the Plan chapter of this
guide. In particular, review the sections on system architecture, client types, IT requirements,
licensing, cybersecurity, and deployment considerations. Also review the Install and Upgrade
chapter which provides details on the installation work-flow.

Setup types
In alignment with the system architectures, the PME Installer provides the following Setup Type
options:

• Standalone Server

• Application Server

• Secondary Server

• Engineering Client

Standalone Server
This setup type is used for a Standalone architecture. For information on PME system
architectures, see System architecture.

The Standalone Server installation includes all PME server components, an Engineering Client, and
(optionally) a version of SQL Server Express.

Application Server
This setup type is used for a Distributed Database architecture. For information on PME system
architectures, see System architecture.

The Application Server installation includes all PME server components and an Engineering Client.

NOTE: Before you can install the Application Server, you must have the remote database server
ready with an installed and configured version of SQL Server. Only full versions of SQL Server are
supported in this architecture. SQL Server Express versions are not supported.

Complete the following tasks before installing an Application Server:

• Ensure that the Windows user or the SQL Server user specified on the Database Software
page of the Installer is a member of the sysadmin SQL Server role.

• Ensure that all of the servers on the network can communicate with each other. For information
on how to test network communications, see Network communication test.

Secondary Server
Secondary Server installations are not common and are used only in exceptional circumstances.
Secondary Server installations require advanced network configuration. Contact Technical
Services if you think you need a Secondary Server.

Engineering Client
This setup type is used to install Engineering Clients on client computers for both Standalone and
Distributed Database architectures. For information on PME Client types, see Client types.

100 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

The Engineering Client installation includes all Engineering tools and applications.

NOTE: You must install a Standalone Server or an Application Server before installing an
Engineering Client.

The following dependencies exist:

• The PME system key, from the Standalone Server or the Application Server is required to install
an Engineering Client.

• For Standalone Servers with SQL Server Express, the TCP/IP protocol must be enabled in the
database for Engineering Clients to be able to connect to the server. For information on how to
enable this protocol, see Enabling TCP/IP protocol in SQL Server Express.

• If you intend to use Engineering Clients in a firewall-enabled environment, contact Technical


Support for installation considerations.

NOTE: Web clients do not require any software installation. Using a supported browser, Web
clients access power monitoring data through the web server running on the PME server. For
information on Web Clients, see Client types.

TLS 1.2 and digital certificates


PME supports Transport Layer Security (TLS) 1.2 for encrypted database connections and web
client communications using HTTPS.

The default configuration of the software only allows HTTPS connections between the PME
application server and the web clients. This requires that a digital certificate issued by a trusted
Certificate Authority is bound to the default website. If no bound certificate is detected during the
installation of the software, a self-signed certificate is installed. The self-signed certificate is
intended as a temporary solution until an authority issued certificate is installed.

NOTE: Plan to have an authority issued security certificate installed before, or shortly after the
installation of PME.

For information on how to enable HTTP connections for PME, see Enabling HTTP connections for
PME.

Windows Integrated Authentication for SQL Server

NOTE: Windows Integrated Authentication is not supported for PME systems with Secondary
Servers.

PME can be installed with either SQL Server Authentication or Windows Integrated Authentication
for SQL database server access.

SQL Server Authentication

This is the traditional way of installing PME with database access through both Windows accounts
and SQL user accounts. With SQL Server Authentication, the PME installer creates a number of
SQL accounts and a Windows account during the installation of the software. These accounts are
then used during operation to access the databases. See SQL Server accounts for details on which
accounts are created.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 101


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Windows Integrated Authentication

With Windows Integrated Authentication PME uses a Windows account, instead of the SQL
accounts, to access the SQL server databases. You must create this Windows account before
installing the software and provide account details during the installation. The Windows account
must have the required access permissions to the SQL Server database. See Windows accounts
for account details. See Before Installing the software and After installing the software for more
information on Windows Integrated Authentication requirements.

NOTE: When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, the Windows account
that is used to access the database is also used to run the PME services and the IIS Application
Pools.

Cybersecurity
Review the cybersecurity information. See Cybersecurity for details.

Miscellaneous
Hard disk drive (HDD) allocation
HDD read/write operations have a big impact on system performance. To optimize your system
performance, plan to have different HDDs installed for the system files, the database files, and the
Microsoft Message Queuing (MSMQ) files.

The software uses MSMQ for writing device data logs to the SQL database. By storing the MSMQ
files on a different HDD from the database files, both can be written to simultaneously, increasing
system performance. For details on optimizing SQL Server performance and changing the MSMQ
storage location, see information from Microsoft and other sources available online.

Database growth
The database occasionally grows by 10% to create room for additional measurements. This growth
operation can occur at any time and can have a significant impact on server and database operation.
Therefore, it is recommended that you pre-allocate the hard drive space for the database during the
initial commissioning phase of the system. For example, if you calculate that a database will grow
to 500 GB over 5 years, it is recommended that you pre-allocate the hard drive space to avoid the
effects of the periodic growth operations.

Other
• Install and configure the Terminal Server component if Terminal Server connection to the PME
Primary Server is required. Refer to the “Terminal Server Licensing Overview” topic in your
Microsoft Windows documentation to learn about Terminal Server Licensing requirements.

• Configure the Remote Desktop Connection if you require remote connection to a PME primary
server, see support information provided by Microsoft.

• If you plan to use TAPI modem drivers for Windows (WinModems) in your PME system, install
and configure the WinModems. See Adding a modem for more information.

Related topics:

• Install and Upgrade

102 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Upgrade planning
Prerequisites
To plan for the upgrade of the software, review all relevant sections in the Plan chapter of this guide.
In particular, review the sections on system architecture, client types, IT requirements, licensing,
cybersecurity, and deployment considerations. Also review the Install and Upgrade chapter which
provides details on the upgrade work-flow.

Upgrade support and limitations


Upgrade version support
The PME upgrade tools support upgrades of software versions that are up to 2 major releases
behind the latest version. That means the following upgrades are supported for PME 2021:

From To
PME 2020 PME 2021
PME 9.0 PME 2021
PME 8.2 PME 2021

* PME 8.1, 8.0, and 7.2.2 systems cannot be upgraded using the PME 2021 installer. To upgrade a
PME 8.1, 8.0, and 7.2.2 system, use the Configuration Manager 2021 tool. See Upgrades from
PME 8.1, 8.0, and 7.2.2 for more information.

See PME release history for more information.

NOTE: To upgrade PME 7.2.x systems, you must first apply the latest service packs to get the
systems to version PME 7.2.2. See Upgrade tools and resources for information on where to find
the service packs.

Contact technical support if you want to upgrade older versions of the software that are not
supported by the tools.

Upgrade limitations
• Only upgrades within the same architecture are supported (Standalone -> Standalone,
Distributed Database -> Distributed Database).

• Only upgrades within the same language are supported, for example English -> English,
Spanish -> Spanish, ... .

Upgrade limitations specific to side-by-side upgrades


• You cannot downgrade to an earlier version of SQL. For example go from a PME with SQL 2016
to PME with SQL 2012. You can always migrate to a new version of SQL Server.

• You cannot downgrade to SQL Express from any version of SQL. You can however migrate
from SQL Express to any other version of SQL.

Determine your upgrade path


An upgrade path describes from which older system to which newer system PME is upgraded. The
upgrade path includes the PME version and edition and the system architecture. For example,
upgrading from PME 2020 Standard Edition standalone architecture to PME 2021 Standard Edition

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 103


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

standalone architecture is an upgrade path.

There are many possible upgrade paths, but only some are supported by the In-Place and Side-by-
Side upgrade tools and procedures. Use the Upgrade Map tool to find the supported upgrade paths
and methods for your system. See Upgrade tools and resources for information on where to get the
Upgrade Map tool.

NOTE: Upgrade paths that are not listed by the Upgrade Map are considered custom upgrades. If
you need to perform a custom upgrade, contact technical support for help.

Determine the upgrade type

NOTE: Determine your upgrade path before deciding on the upgrade type. Not all upgrade types
are supported for all upgrade paths.

There are two different upgrade types, In-Place Upgrade and Side-by-Side (SBS) Upgrade. Each
type uses different tools and has different prerequisites.

In-place upgrade
Use an In-Place upgrade to upgrade an older version of PME to the latest version on the same
computer. The upgrade replaces the old system files with new files and leaves the old configuration
and data in place. After the upgrade, the new software has the same configuration and data as the
old. The installer of the new PME version performs an In-Place upgrade automatically if it detects
that an old version of the software exists on the computer.

Advantages of an in-place upgrade

• The installer of the new software automatically does the upgrade.

• Very little user interaction is needed.

• The same computer is used for the new version of the software as for the old version before.

• All non-PME settings and configurations on the computer stay as they were.

Disadvantages of an in-place upgrade

• The computer hardware is the same as before, which means the performance of the new
system on the old computer might not be as expected.

• The OS and DB Server versions are the same as before, which means the performance of the
new system on the old OS and DB Server versions might not be as expected.

• The power monitoring system is unavailable during the upgrade process until the new system
has been put into service.

• The old system is no longer available after the upgrade. A downgrade is not possible.

• Only more recent versions of the software can be upgraded in place. An in-place upgrade for
older versions may not be possible.

104 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Side-by-side upgrade
Use an SBS upgrade to copy the configuration and data of an old PME system to a new system on
a different computer. The new version of PME is installed on a new computer. The old version of
PME stays installed on the old computer. After the SBS upgrade, the new software has the same
configuration and data as the old one but exists on a different computer. SBS upgrades are
performed manually with the Configuration Manager tool. See Upgrade tools and resources for
information on where to get the Configuration Manager tool.

Advantages of an SBS upgrade

• The new PME system is installed on a new computer that can be sized to meet your
performance expectations.

• The new PME system is installed on a new OS and DB server version.

• The old PME system stays in service until the new system is ready to be put into service.

• A parallel operation of the old and new systems for a certain amount of time might be possible.

• The old system stays available after the upgrade.

• Many older PME versions and editions can be upgraded SBS.

Disadvantages of an SBS upgrade

• The upgrade process is more complex than an in-place upgrade and takes more time.

• A new computer is used for the new version of the software, which means that any non-PME
settings and configurations must be recreated on the new computer.

TLS 1.2 and security certificates


See TLS 1.2 and digital certificates in the Install Planning section of this guide for details.

Windows Integrated Authentication for SQL Server

NOTE: Windows Integrated Authentication is not supported for PME systems with Secondary
Servers.

PME can be installed with either SQL Server Authentication or Windows Integrated Authentication
for SQL database server access.

SQL Server Authentication

This is the traditional way of installing PME with database access through both Windows accounts
and SQL user accounts. With SQL Server Authentication, the PME installer creates a number of
SQL accounts and a Windows account during the installation of the software. These accounts are
then used during operation to access the databases. See SQL Server accounts for details on which
accounts are created.

Windows Integrated Authentication

With Windows Integrated Authentication PME uses a Windows account, instead of the SQL
accounts, to access the SQL server databases. You must create this Windows account before
installing the software and provide account details during the installation. The Windows account

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 105


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

must have the required access permissions to the SQL Server database. See Windows accounts
for account details. See Before upgrading the software and After upgrading the software for more
information on Windows Integrated Authentication requirements.

NOTE: When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, the Windows account
that is used to access the database is also used to run the PME services and the IIS Application
Pools.

Cybersecurity
Review the cybersecurity information. See Cybersecurity for details.

Miscellaneous
Hard disk drive (HDD) allocation
HDD read/write operations have a big impact on system performance. To optimize your system
performance, plan to have different HDDs installed for the system files, the database files, and the
Microsoft Message Queuing (MSMQ) files.

The software uses MSMQ for writing device data logs to the SQL database. By storing the MSMQ
files on a different HDD from the database files, both can be written to simultaneously, increasing
system performance. For details on optimizing SQL Server performance and changing the MSMQ
storage location, see information from Microsoft and other sources available online.

Historical Data Management


Consider archiving and trimming the historical data in the existing system before upgrading. This
reduces the upgrade time and improves performance on the new system. After the upgrade, the
Alarms Web application processes existing Power Quality data the first time it starts up. This
processing is very time consuming. You can control how much of the existing data is processed to
reduce the processing time. See Configuring first time Alarms processing for more information.
Related topics:

• Install and Upgrade

106 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Migration planning
System migration
During a system migration, you are copying the configuration of one PME system to another PME
system on a different computer. Both PME systems are the same version. Before you can migrate
an existing system, you must first install the new version of PME on the new computer, following
the new system install procedures. The Configuration Manager tool that is used to help with the
migration only supports the migration of the PME version it was built for. For example Configuration
Manager 2021 can only be used to migrate PME2021 systems. Example applications for system
migrations include off-site configuration, and computer hardware upgrades.

TIP: You can use the system migration workflow to rename your PME server computer. To do
this, save the configuration with Configuration Manager, uninstall PME, rename the server, re-
install PME, write the configuration with Configuration Manager.

Prerequisites
To plan for the migration of the software, review all relevant sections in the Plan chapter of this
guide. In particular, review the sections on system architecture, client types, IT requirements,
licensing, cybersecurity, and deployment considerations. Also review the Install and Upgrade
chapter which provides details on the migration work-flow.

Windows Integrated Authentication for SQL Server

NOTE: Windows Integrated Authentication is not supported for PME systems with Secondary
Servers.

PME can be installed with either SQL Server Authentication or Windows Integrated Authentication
for SQL database server access.

SQL Server Authentication

This is the traditional way of installing PME with database access through both Windows accounts
and SQL user accounts. With SQL Server Authentication, the PME installer creates a number of
SQL accounts and a Windows account during the installation of the software. These accounts are
then used during operation to access the databases. See SQL Server accounts for details on which
accounts are created.

Windows Integrated Authentication

With Windows Integrated Authentication PME uses a Windows account, instead of the SQL
accounts, to access the SQL server databases. You must create this Windows account before
installing the software and provide account details during the installation. The Windows account
must have the required access permissions to the SQL Server database. See Windows accounts
for account details. See Before migrating the software and After migrating the software for more
information on Windows Integrated Authentication requirements.

NOTE: When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, the Windows account
that is used to access the database is also used to run the PME services and the IIS Application
Pools.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 107


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Cybersecurity
Review the cybersecurity information. See Cybersecurity for details.

Related topics:

• Install and Upgrade

108 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Feature selection and design


This section provides an overview of the features and modules available in PME. It introduces the
different functions, applications and modules and discusses dependencies and design
considerations.

Use the links in the following tables to find the content you are looking for:

Software features:

Feature Details
This includes the Diagrams, Trends, Dashboards, and Vista
Real-time Monitoring
applications.
This includes the Alarm Viewer, the Alarm Annunciator, and
Alarm Management
Software Alarms.
Analytics and Visualization This includes the Dashboards and Reports applications.

Software modules:

Module Application
Backup Power Module Generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) performance
design monitoring and reporting, including battery health.
Breaker Performance
Circuit breaker aging and breaker settings monitoring.
Module Design
Generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) capacity
Capacity Management
monitoring and reporting. Includes transformer and UPS loss
Module Design
monitoring.
Energy Analysis Dashboard Gadgets for identifying consumption patterns and anomalies and for
Module design comparing different consumers over time.
Energy Analysis Reports Reports for energy consumption monitoring and modeling, including
Module design energy usage by process area or by product output.
Energy Billing Module Energy-based billing and reporting, including consumption
design monitoring and reporting at the branch circuit level.
Event Notification Module
Notifications of power system events via email or SMS.
Design
Insulation Monitoring Monitoring for isolated power systems, such as the ones found in
Module Design hospital operating rooms.
Power Quality Performance Analysis of power quality events and disturbances and their impact
Module Design on the monitored system.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 109


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Real-time Monitoring
Real-time monitoring is the viewing of power monitoring data as it is being measured by the
monitoring devices. The data is transferred from the device through the communication network to
the software, where it is displayed. The software displays the data, either as individual
measurements, or as part of a sequence, such as a trend. The data might be temporarily stored by
the software while it is being displayed, but it is not logged into the database for long-term storage.

Components
The following applications are used to view real-time data:

• Diagrams

• Trends

• Dashboards

• Vista

For details on how to use these applications see the Operate chapter. For details on how to
configure these applications see the Configure chapter.

Prerequisites
The measurement data you want to display must be available from the devices. That means that the
devices must provide the measurements and the device driver must support the measurements.
The devices must also be online and communicating for the data to be available in the user
interface.

Design Considerations
Consider which of the real-time applications best meet the user needs. The Trends and Dashboards
applications only require a small amount of configuration. The amount of configuration and custom
engineering required to create diagrams for the Vista and Diagrams application depend on the user
needs. Creating nested, graphical diagrams, or facility one-line diagrams might require a
considerable amount of time and effort.

Ensure that the monitoring devices that are used have the capabilities required to provide the
desired real-time data.

The Trends application can take advantage of historical data to show trends that seamlessly extend
from the present into the past. The required measurements must be recorded by the monitoring
devices if you want to use historical data with trends.

Related topics:
Software features

• Real-time monitoring

• Alarm Management

• Analytics and Visualization

110 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Software Modules

• Backup Power Module design

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Billing Module design

• Event Notification Module Design

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 111


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Alarm Management
Alarm management is the viewing, analyzing, and processing of software generated and device
based Incidents and Alarms. It might also include the configuration of these alarms on the devices
and in the software.

Alarm conditions are monitored by the devices, or by the software. When a condition is met, an
Alarm is logged to the database and displayed in the software. The software processes the Alarm
information to categorize the Alarm and associate it with an Incident. Users can acknowledge
Alarms.

Components
The following applications are used for Alarm management:

• Alarms (Viewer)

• Alarm Annunciator

• Software Alarms

For details on how to use these applications see the Operate chapter. For details on how to
configure these applications see the Configure chapter.

Prerequisites
The alarm conditions must be defined and actively monitored on the devices or in the software. That
means that the devices or the software must indicate the active or inactive alarm states and must
log the alarm details into the database. Software alarms require real-time communications with the
devices that are monitoring the measurements that are being alarmed on.

Design Considerations
Carefully choose the alarm conditions on the devices and in the software. Alarming on too many,
too few, or incorrect alarm conditions leads to poor system performance for alarm management.

When using software alarms, keep in mind that:

• Reliable communication links to the devices that are providing the measurements are required.

• There is a greater and less predictable time delay than for device-based alarming

• Alarms are logged with the date and time of the software server, not the monitoring device.

Consider setting up logging of alarm related information, such as waveform captures or system
states. This additional information might be valuable when analyzing Incidents. When creating
Alarm Views, consider the needs of the users and their applications.

Related topics:
Software features

• Real-time Monitoring

• Alarm management

• Analytics and Visualization

112 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Software Modules

• Backup Power Module design

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Billing Module design

• Event Notification Module Design

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 113


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Analytics and Visualization


Analytics and visualization are the processing of historical, logged power monitoring data to
discover and highlight patterns and relationships. The data is aggregated, transformed, and
correlated, and then displayed in a format that makes it possible to understand its meaning. A
simple example is a load profile chart, that shows a graphical view of power demand measurements
over time. A complex example is a modeling report that shows the delta between an expected,
modeled consumption and the actual consumption of a facility over time.

Components
The following applications are used for analytics and visualization:

• Dashboards

• Reports

For details on how to use these applications see the Operate chapter. For details on how to
configure these applications see the Configure chapter.

Prerequisites
The measurement data you want to analyze or visualize must be available in the database as
historical data logs. This includes data recorded by the monitoring devices and any third-party data,
such as weather measurements, or process measurements, that might be required. Individual
reports or dashboard gadgets might have specific requirements that must be met.

The use of some of the reports and gadgets is not included in the BASE license for the system, and
requires additional licensing.

Design Considerations
The features related to these applications vary greatly in complexity and input requirements. It is
important that you understand the user needs and that you manage the user expectations. There
might be a need to provide user training to interpret the visualizations and to get the most value from
the results.

Some dashboards and reports require input data from specialized devices, such as high-end power
monitoring devices with advanced power quality monitoring capabilities, or advanced breaker
monitoring. The required data must be available from the devices in the system to provide the
analytics and visualizations.

Some dashboard gadgets and reports require input data that might not be directly monitored and
recorded by the software, for example weather data or process data. This data has to be imported
into the database. Upfront planning and the use of third-party tools might be required to get this data.

Expect an iterative approach when working with your users to provide the results they are looking
for.

Related topics:
Software features

• Real-time Monitoring

• Alarm Management

• Analytics and visualization

114 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Software Modules

• Backup Power Module design

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Billing Module design

• Event Notification Module Design

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 115


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Backup Power Module design


The Backup Power Module provides generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) monitoring
and reporting. It reports on generator and UPS performance and battery health.

The Generator Test EPSS Report can be configured to conform to the requirements for an
Emergency Power Supply System (EPSS) test, including automatic transfer switches (ATS). For
example, the report shows the transfer time of the lead ATS and indicates whether the transfer time
passes or does not pass the test requirements. See Emergency Power Supply Systems for more
information on EPSS.

Components
The following applications and features are part of this module:
Reports:

• Generator Activity Report

• Generator Battery Health Report

• Generator Battery Health Export

• Generator Test EPSS Report

• Generator Load Summary Report

• UPS Auto Test Report

• UPS Battery Health Report

Tools:

• Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module (includes a generator run
history)

• UPS Configuration Tool

Diagrams:

• EPSS Vista Diagrams

• UPS Auto Test Diagrams

Prerequisites
• The different reports have different input requirements. See Supported measurements and
devices for more information.

• The measurement data for the reports must be available as historical data logs in the database.

• The generators, UPSs, and other equipment must be configured in the configuration tools
before running the reports.

• This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

Design Considerations
• This module contains reports for different applications. Only some of these applications might
apply to your system.

116 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

• Some of the reports only work with certain device types.

• The generator test report is complex. Configuring this report takes time and expertise.

Design considerations for EPSS reporting


The Generator Test EPSS report and diagrams require specific generator and ATS data. Depending
on the EPSS configuration and type of equipment used, one or more monitoring devices, and the
ATS itself, can provide this data.

The following tables shows the required and optional data, for each ATS and generator:

Data Measurements Importance Comments


This data is typically
available through
digital output signals
Normal Required
from the ATS.(**)
Test Required
ATS Status Indicators NOTE: All statuses for
Emergency Required
a specific ATS must
Power Outage Optional(*)
be recorded by the
same monitoring
device.
This data needs to be
provided by a power
ATS Load Data kW or kVA Optional(*) monitoring device
connected to the ATS
load-side feeder.(**)
This data is typically
available through
Stopped Required digital output signals
Running Required from the generator.
Generator Status
Starting Optional(*) NOTE: All statuses for
Indicators
Emergency Power Source Optional(*) a specific generator
Available (EPA) must be recorded by
the same monitoring
device.
This data needs to be
Vln a,b,c,avg; Vll ab,
provided by a power
Generator Electrical bc,ca,avg
Required monitoring device
Data I a,b,c,avg; kW tot; kVA tot;
connected to the
PF sign tot; Frequency
generator feeder.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 117


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Data Measurements Importance Comments


This data is typically
available through
analog output signals
Engine Temperature Required (see from the generator.
Comments) NOTE: Generator
Exhaust Gas (single or dual) Required (see Engine data is only
Generator Engine Data
Comments) required for certain
Engine Oil Pressure and Optional(*) EPSS test evaluation
other engine parameters methods. See Editing
the generator
Evaluation Method for
details.

(*) This data can be included in the report, but it is not required to configure and run the report.
(**) The ASCO 4000 and ASCO 7000 ATS can provide logging of ATS status and load
measurements. These ATS types are natively supported in PME. Depending on the ATS
configuration, no external ATS status and load measurements might be required if these ATS types
are used.

The digital and analog output data from the ATS and generator can be recorded by the power
monitoring devices used to measure the ATS load data and generator electrical data. See Supported
measurements and devices for monitoring device recommendations.

NOTE: Do not use software logging for the ATS and generator status data. Software logging
introduces unpredictable time delays which result in low timestamp accuracy for the logged data.
Always use device on-board logging for this data.

For more information on EPSS testing, see EPSS test.

NOTE: The Generator Test EPSS Report supports both Open Transition Transfer (OTT) and
Closed Transition Transfer (CTT) power transfers. By default, the Power Monitoring Expert
system is set for OTT. To run a CTT test, visit the PME Exchange Community and download the
necessary scripts, from the Install and Maintain section.

Related topics:
Backup Power topics

• Backup Power Module design

• Backup Power Module configuration

• Backup Power Module operation

Other software features

• Real-time Monitoring

• Alarm Management

• Analytics and Visualization

118 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Other Software Modules

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Billing Module design

• Event Notification Module Design

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 119


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Breaker Performance Module Design


The Breaker Performance Module monitors aging and wear of circuit breakers and reports on
breaker protection settings. It provides historical and real-time information for aging and wear related
breaker parameters. You can also set up alarming on these parameters.

Components
The following applications and features are used for this module:

• Breaker Aging Report

• Breaker Settings Report

• Vista diagrams

• VIP framework

• ION Software Modbus Gateway Service

• Breaker Aging Calculation Service

• Breaker Configuration Tool

Prerequisites
• This module can only be used with specific device types, see Supported devices for more
information.

• The measurement data for the reports must be available as historical data logs in the database.

• This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

Design Considerations
• This module only works with the devices listed above under Prerequisites.

• Configuring this module takes time and expertise.

Related topics:
Breaker Performance Module topics

• Breaker Performance Module design

• Breaker Performance Module configuration

• Breaker Performance Module operation

Other software features

• Real-time Monitoring

• Alarm Management

• Analytics and Visualization

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module design

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

120 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Billing Module design

• Event Notification Module Design

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 121


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Capacity Management Module Design


The Capacity Management Module provides generator, Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS), and
general equipment monitoring and reporting. It also includes transformer and UPS loss monitoring
and reporting. The losses are reported in terms of energy and cost.

Components
The following applications and features are part of this module:

Reports:

• Branch Circuit Power Report

• Equipment Capacity Report

• Generator Capacity Report

• Generator Power Report

• Power Losses Report

• UPS Power Report

Tools:

• Generator Performance Configuration Tool

• Generator Power Configuration Utility

• UPS Power Configuration Utility

• Power Losses Configuration Utility

Diagrams:

• Equipment Vista Diagrams

Prerequisites
• The measurement data for the reports must be available as historical data logs in the database
before running the report.

• This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

Report Needs
• A hierarchy must be configured using the data center hierarchy
template.

• Branch circuit level measurements for current and power must


Branch Circuit Power exist.
Report
• A meter on the main incomer is needed for coincident demand
measurements.

(See Supported measurements and devices for more information.)

122 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Report Needs
• The generators and equipment must be configured in the
Equipment Capacity Report Generator Performance Configuration Tool before running the
Generator Capacity Report reports.

(See Supported Measurements and Devices for more information.)


• The generators must be configured in the Generator Power
Generator Power Report Configuration Utility before running the report.

(See Supported Measurements and Devices for more information.)


• The transformers and UPS must be monitored on both the
primary and secondary side (in and out) for the loss
calculations.
Power Losses Report
• The transformers and UPS must be configured in the Power
Losses Configuration Utility before running the report.

(See Supported Measurements and Devices for more information.)


• The UPS must be configured in the UPS Power Configuration
UPS Power Report Utility before running the report.

(See Supported Measurements and Devices for more information.)

Design Considerations
• Some of the reports only work with certain device types.

Related topics:
Capacity Management Module topics

• Capacity Management Module design

• Capacity Management Module configuration

• Capacity Management Module operation

Other software features

• Real-time Monitoring

• Alarm Management

• Analytics and Visualization

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module design

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Billing Module design

• Event Notification Module Design

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 123


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

124 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design


The Energy Analysis Dashboard Module includes dashboard gadgets that help you break down
consumption by load type, visualize consumption cost, and do an 80/20 analysis to identify the
largest consumers. You can identify consumption patterns and anomalies and compare different
consumers over time.

Components
The following gadgets are part of this module:

• Sankey gadget

• Pareto Chart gadget

• Aggregated Pareto Chart gadget

• Heat Map gadget

• Consumption Ranking gadget

• Aggregated Consumption Ranking gadget

Prerequisites
• The gadgets need consumption data, for example electrical consumption (kWh) or WAGES
(water, air, gas, effluent, steam) consumption.

• The consumption measurement data for the gadgets must be available as historical data logs in
the database.

• For the Sankey gadget you need to set up a hierarchy for the input measurements. See
Hierarchy Manager for information on setting up a hierarchy.

Design Considerations
No special design considerations.

Related topics:
Energy Analysis Dashboard Module topics

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation

Other software features

• Real-time Monitoring

• Alarm Management

• Analytics and Visualization

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module design

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Capacity Management Module Design

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 125


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Billing Module design

• Event Notification Module Design

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

126 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Energy Analysis Reports Module design


The Energy Analysis Reports Module includes reports that help you understand energy usage
patterns to find energy waste, analyze transformer and circuit capacity and assess energy usage by
process area or by product output. Use the energy modeling capabilities in this module, to forecast
consumption, identify unexpected changes in your consumption, or identify actual savings as a
result of energy management measures.

Components
The following reports are part of this module:

• Create Model Report

• Duration Curve Report

• Energy Modeling Reports

• Energy Regression Analysis Report

• Energy Usage Per State Report

• KPI Report

• KPI by TOU Report

• Multi Equipment Operation Report

• Power Usage Per State Report

• PUE Summary Report

• Single Equipment Operation Report

• Use Model Report

Prerequisites
• The different reports have different input requirements. See Supported measurements and
devices for more information.

• The measurement data for the reports must be available as historical data logs in the database.

• Before you can use the energy modeling report you must create a model.

• This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

Design Considerations
• Consider how to measure and log the different states for the Per State reports.

• You might have to import state measurements into PME (I/O, Modbus, OPC, ETL) if they are
captured in a different system.

• The Energy Regression Analysis Report is a complex report which requires some expertise to
create and to interpret the results correctly.

• The KPI Report requires some upfront planning to define the KPI calculations and ensure that
the required input parameters are available in the system.

• PUE Category 1 and 2 (based on the Uptime Institute recommendations) are supported.

• The energy modeling report is complex. Configuring this report takes time and expertise.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 127


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Related topics:
Energy Analysis Reports Module topics

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Reports Module operation

Other software features

• Real-time Monitoring

• Alarm Management

• Analytics and Visualization

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module design

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Billing Module design

• Event Notification Module Design

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

128 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Energy Billing Module design


The Energy Billing Module is a fully functional energy-based billing reporting system. It also
provides load and consumption monitoring and reporting at the branch circuit level, which is typically
used in data center applications.

Components
The following reports are part of this module:

• Billing Report

• Billing Summary Report

• Billing Verification Report

• Energy by IT Customer Report

• Multiple Billing Report

• Multiple Billing Export Report

Prerequisites
This module requires the following:

• A certain hierarchy configuration and a rate file configuration.

• Energy, or demand, or WAGES type input measurements. Any device type that can provide
these measurement types can be used.

• A Time of Use (TOU) schedule might have to be configured.

• For the Energy by IT Customer Report, branch circuit level measurements are required, see
Supported measurements and devices for more information.

• The measurement data for the reports must be available as historical data logs in the database.

• This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

Basic Energy and Demand measurements have been pre-mapped for this module, but might have to
be adjusted or added to in the rate file. See Supported measurements and devices for more
information.

Design Considerations
• Setting up the hierarchy and the rate file requires manual xml file editing.

• Importing the hierarchy requires command line tool use.

• Expect 2-3 days of deployment time to configure this module.

• The monitoring devices providing the billing data should have revenue metering accuracy.

• The monitoring devices might require analog or digital inputs for WAGES monitoring.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 129


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Related topics:
Energy Billing Module topics

• Energy Billing Module design

• Energy Billing Module configuration

• Energy Billing Module operation

Other software features

• Real-time Monitoring

• Alarm Management

• Analytics and Visualization

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module design

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Event Notification Module Design

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

130 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Event Notification Module Design


Use the Event Notification Module (ENM) to notify recipients about critical power system events.
ENM can send notifications of power system events through email or SMS. ENM uses the Alarms
application to detect system events. You can set up notifications for activity in any of the event,
alarm, or incident views. The notification details are defined in a notification rule. A notification rule
can be enabled or disabled, and you can use a schedule to determine when the rule is applied. You
can define more than one notification rule.

Components
The following application is used for this module:

• Notifications

Prerequisites
To configure a notification rule, you need:

• One or more alarm views to use to trigger the notification. This can be default system views or
custom views.

• Recipient information such as an email address or a phone number (for SMS notification).

• SMTP server information if you want to use email notifications.

• SMS account information from Twilio if you want to use SMS notifications.

NOTE: The SMS capabilities of the Event Notification Module are built on technology from
Twilio, a third-party vendor. To use SMS with notifications, you need to open an account with
Twilio and sign up for SMS service. See the Twilio web site for more information.

• This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

Design Considerations
Consider the following when setting up notifications:

• Configure the alarm views so that they only display the alarms you want to be notified on.

• Decide if you want to be notified on all activity in the alarm view or only when an alarm goes
active or when a new incident occurs.

• Decide if you want the notification to be sent immediately when the activity is detected, or after
a short delay to wait for additional activity (reduces the number of notifications sent during an
incident).

• Use maintenance mode to temporarily disable all notifications before a planned power system
event, for example a planned shutdown.

• Test the notification delivery. Check your spam filter inbox and settings if you do not receive the
test email.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 131


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Related topics:
Event Notification Module topics

• Event Notification Module design

• Event Notification Module configuration

• Event Notification Module operation

Other software features

• Real-time Monitoring

• Alarm Management

• Analytics and Visualization

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module design

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Billing Module design

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

132 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Insulation Monitoring Module Design


The Insulation Monitoring Module provides monitoring for isolated (IT) power systems, such as the
ones found in hospital operating rooms. It also helps in locating isolation faults. The module can be
configured for applications based on the IEC standard, and for applications based on the
ANSI standard.

Components
The following components are part of this module:

• Insulation Monitoring Report

• Vista diagrams

• VIP framework

• Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool

Prerequisites
• This module can only be used with specific device types, see Supported measurements and
devices for more information.

• The measurement data for the report must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Design Considerations
• In IEC configuration, the module monitors insulation resistance.

• In ANSI configuration, the module monitors total hazard current.

• This module requires the configuration of VIP frameworks and Vista diagrams.

• This module is used for very specific applications. It needs certain types of devices and
equipment.

See Insulation Monitoring Design for ANSI for more information on this application in the ANSI
market.

Related topics:
Insulation Monitoring Module topics

• Insulation Monitoring Module design

• Insulation Monitoring Module configuration

• Insulation Monitoring Module operation

Other software features

• Real-time Monitoring

• Alarm Management

• Analytics and Visualization

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 133


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module design

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Billing Module design

• Event Notification Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

134 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Power Quality Performance Module Design


The Power Quality (PQ) Performance Module analyzes power quality event and disturbance data as
well as power factor measurements. It determines the potential impacts of power quality on the
monitored power system and displays the results in graphical formats, with color coding to highlight
problem areas. The module combines standard software features with specialized components to
produce its outputs. The module can also analyzes power quality event and disturbance data as
well as power factor measurements based on the hierarchy sites, which are assigned to a user
group.

The following diagram shows the different elements that are part of this module:

For definitions and classifications of power quality phenomena, see power quality events and
disturbances.

Components
The following applications and features are used for this module:

• Diagrams
PQ Indicator diagrams

Standardized Equipment diagrams

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 135


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Dashboards
Power Quality Rating gadget

Power Quality Rating Trend gadget

Power Quality Incident Breakdown gadget

Power Quality Incident Impact gadget

Power Quality Incident Location gadget

Power Quality Impact gadget

Power Quality Impact Trend gadget

Power Factor Impact gadget

Power Factor Impact Trend gadget

• Reports
Power Quality Impact report

Power Quality Analysis report

• VIP

Prerequisites
This module has very specific requirements regarding system configuration and available
measurements:

• Most of the gadgets and reports require advanced power quality measurements taken by the
monitoring devices. The power quality data is aggregated across multiple devices and depends
on data from the right device types in the right monitoring locations, see Device Selection for
Power Quality Performance monitoring for more information.

• The Standardized Equipment diagrams are designed for very specific equipment types. See the
Standardized Equipment Diagrams device list for details on compatible device types.

• For the Impact gadgets and report, process impact alarms are required. These alarms might
require measurements from third party equipment, which might have to be brought into the
system.

• For the Impact gadgets and report, billing rates must be defined to convert the measured values
into cost data.

The following diagrams show the power quality inputs that are required for the different diagrams,
gadgets, and reports:

Indicator diagrams

136 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Rating gadgets

Incident gadgets

PQ Impact gadgets and report

PF Impact gadgets

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 137


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

PQ Analysis report

See Required measurements for Power Quality Performance monitoring for more information.

Design Considerations
The power quality information provided by this module is only as good as the data monitored by the
devices. To get the full value, use the device types recommended for the different monitoring
locations.

Use the Advanced Systems hardware and SQL Server database servers (not Express) for systems
with the PQ Performance Module.

Time synchronization of the devices and the software is very important for this module. The
standard time synchronization methods for devices in the software are sufficient. High accuracy
time synchronization, such as IRIG-B, can be used, but is not required.

Review the configuration steps for this module to identify any unexpected requirements or
dependencies.

If the devices that are used for power quality performance monitoring do not support all the required
power quality measurements, then the information that is based on these measurements is not
displayed in the gadgets, diagrams, and reports. However, other power quality information, that is
based on available measurements might still be displayed. In this case, analyze which module
outputs are affected and manage the user expectations accordingly.

Related topics:

138 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Power Quality Performance Module topics

• Power Quality Performance Module design

• Power Quality Performance Module configuration

• Power Quality Performance Module operation

Other software features

• Real-time Monitoring

• Alarm Management

• Analytics and Visualization

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module design

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Billing Module design

• Event Notification Module Design

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 139


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Device Networks
This section provides information on the communication links between the software and the
monitoring devices.

Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for:

Topic Content
Device network basics and the supported protocols and device
Device networks overview
types.
Network types Ethernet and serial communication networks.
Network performance Ways to improve the device communication performance.
Time synchronization Time synchronization on the monitoring device network.
Tools The Daisy Chain Calculator tool.

140 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Device networks overview


PME is a software application that processes, stores, analyzes, and displays power system data
and information. PME collects the source data from devices that are installed in the electrical
system that is being monitored. Each device must be connected to a communication network
through which the software initiates the data retrieval.

Examples of monitoring devices include:

• Power and energy monitoring devices

• Contactors and protection relays

• Circuit breaker trip units

• Smart panels

• Power quality mitigation equipment

• Programmable Logic Controllers (PLCs)

PME supports the following communication protocols:

• Modbus™ TCP

• Modbus™ RTU

• ION™

• OPC DA

For a device to be compatible with PME, it must support one of these communication protocols.

Related topics:

• Device networks overview

• Network types

• Network performance

• Time synchronization

• Tools

For reference information see:

• Default device type support (list of pre-configured device types in PME)

• Resources (information on where to find additional, add-on device types)

• Device Type Editor

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 141


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Network types
The two basic types of communication networks for PME are Ethernet and serial.

Ethernet (TCP) networks


Ethernet (TCP) device networks can be integrated into regular corporate LANs or they can be
separate, independent networks, providing a higher level of security and availability.

Devices are configured in PME by providing fixed IP addresses (IPv4 or IPv6) and ports, or based
on host names. Host names must be used for devices with dynamic address assignment, for
example using the DHCP protocol. When host names are used in PME, then a host name resolution
mechanism is required by the external IT network.

Device communications are based on encapsulated Modbus or ION protocol and are not encrypted.
Bandwidth requirements per device are typically low, but depend heavily on the amount and type of
data requested from the device by PME.

Ethernet (TCP) networks are in many ways superior to serial networks and we recommend that you
use Ethernet (TCP) networks whenever possible.

Serial device networks


Serial communication is the traditional way of connecting devices to PME. Serial communications
require an intermediate converter or gateway, for example a Link150, to establish a network
connection. The performance of a serial communication network can become the limiting factor for
the overall system performance.

NOTE: If you use an ION meter as a gateway, with Ethergate protocol, you lose the ability to
multi-master the serial devices.

Serial device communications are based on Modbus RTU or ION protocol and are not encrypted.
See Tools for information on how to design a serial network.

PME also supports communication through telephone modems.

Reasons for using serial networks include:

• The device type only supports serial communications.

• A serial communication network is already in place.

• The existing Ethernet (TCP) networks do not allow the connection of monitoring devices.

• Serial communications are less affected by electrical noise.

Ethernet (TCP) networks are in many ways superior to serial networks and we recommend that you
use Ethernet (TCP) networks whenever possible.

Related topics:

• Device networks overview

• Network types

• Network performance

• Time synchronization

• Tools

142 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

For reference information see:

• Default device type support (list of pre-configured device types in PME)

• Resources (information on where to find additional, add-on device types)

• Device Type Editor

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 143


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Network performance
Communications between the software and the devices consist of:

• On demand, real-time data requests, for example for Diagrams or Dashboards displays.

• Periodic polling and uploading of data logs, events, and waveform records.

To optimize the on demand and background polling performance, consider the following when
designing the system and the communication network:

• Real-time data polling periods should be set to meet the user needs. Do not poll with high speed
when it is not needed. Real-time data clients include Vista, Diagrams, OPC, VIP, Trends, and
EWS.

• Disable devices that are not presently commissioned or functional. This includes devices that
are inoperable, or that have a communication error rate >5%.

• Connect high-end devices with power quality monitoring features, such as the ION9000,
directly through Ethernet, not serial. These devices can generate large amounts of logged data,
such as power quality data, which requires a high bandwidth connection to the monitoring
software. If a direct Ethernet connection is not possible, then connect the devices through small
serial loops, with one or two devices per loop.

NOTE: Test the data upload performance when using high-end devices on serial networks.
Depending on configuration and operating conditions, it is possible for devices to have a higher
data generation rate than can be uploaded over a serial network.

NOTE: The ION9000T, a high-end power monitoring device with high speed transient capture,
will not upload high speed transient waveform data to the software if it is connected through a
serial connection.

• Setup the devices to only log those measurements that are needed to meet the user needs.

• Schedule the log uploads to occur at times when the system usage is low, for example during
night time or off hours.

• Use the Daisy Chain Calculator tool to determine the maximum number of devices in a serial
loop for your system. See Tools for more information.

• In most applications, Ethernet networks will provide a better performance than serial networks.

Related topics:

• Device networks overview

• Network types

• Network performance

• Time synchronization

• Tools

For reference information see:

144 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

• Default device type support (list of pre-configured device types in PME)

• Resources (information on where to find additional, add-on device types)

• Device Type Editor

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 145


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Time synchronization
To maintain accurate time in the monitoring system, the devices must be time synchronized.
Depending on the synchronization mechanism, different levels of time accuracy can be achieved.
PME has the ability to synchronize devices to the PME server computer clock. This can be done
over serial networks and Ethernet networks. See Time synchronization for ION meters and Time
synchronization blackout for more details.

The time synchronization to the computer clock using the regular communications protocols can
maintain a system time accuracy in the range of seconds. This is accurate enough for many
applications. However, for applications such as power event analysis or protection coordination
studies, that require high absolute and relative time accuracy, you need to use other time
synchronization methods for the devices, such as PTP or GPS time synchronization.

NOTE: Time synchronization might be disabled by default in certain monitoring devices. Configure
time synchronization for your devices and the software as part of the device or system
deployment. Choose a single time synchronization source per device.

Related topics:

• Device networks overview

• Network types

• Network performance

• Time synchronization

• Tools

For reference information see:

• Default device type support (list of pre-configured device types in PME)

• Resources (information on where to find additional, add-on device types)

• Device Type Editor

146 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Tools
Use the Daisy Chain Calculator tool to design your serial communication networks. This tool helps
you estimate the communication utilization for serial daisy chains. You can use it for new system
design and for optimizing existing systems.

NOTE: The Daisy Chain Calculator is available through the Exchange Community. See
Resources for link information.

Related topics:

• Device networks overview

• Network types

• Network performance

• Time synchronization

• Tools

For reference information see:

• Default device type support (list of pre-configured device types in PME)

• Resources (information on where to find additional, add-on device types)

• Device Type Editor

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 147


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

System Integration
This section provides information on the different approaches and technologies for integrating PME
with other systems.

Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for:

Topic Content
Overview Integration basics and the supported technologies.
Integration technologies OPC, EWS, ETL, ODBC, PQDIF, VIP
Integration with PO References to PO documentation.
Detailed planning information on the integration of PME with
Integration with EBO
EcoStruxure Building Operation.

148 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Overview
In addition to data collection from monitoring devices, PME can also connect to and share data with
other systems or software. Using PME in such a connected way is called system integration.

In an integrated system, PME either acts as a server, providing data to other systems, or as a
client, receiving data from other systems, or both at the same time. Real-time data and historical
data can be exchanged between the systems.

The reason for integrating systems is to leverage the strengths and capabilities of each system in
order to provide value that could not be achieved with any of the systems alone.

PME offers the following technologies for system integration:

• OPC DA server for exporting real-time data.

• OPC DA client for importing real-time data.

• EWS server for exporting real-time data, historical data, and alarm data.

• ETL for exporting or importing historical data.

• ODBC for providing access to historical data.

• PQDIF for exporting power quality data.

• VIP for exporting or importing real-time data or historical data.

Each of these technologies has its strengths and weaknesses. Which technologies to use depends
on the system capabilities, the application needs, and the performance expectations. See
Integration technologies for more details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 149


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Integration technologies
The following sections discuss the integration technologies available in PME.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-specific
cybersecurity policies.

Open Platform Communications (OPC)


OPC is an industry standard for data exchange between software applications and control devices
from different manufacturers. The OPC standard includes separate specifications for different data
types. PME supports the OPC Data Access (DA) specification, OPC DA 2.05a, which is used for
real-time data.

PME includes an OPC server and an OPC client, which means it can export and import real-time
data to or from another system.

The following shows an example where the OPC server capabilities in PME are used to share
device real-time data with another application:

The following shows an example where the OPC client capabilities in PME are used to bring device
real-time data into PME from another application:

150 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

See OPC Server Support for more information.

RECOMMENDATION: Use an OPC tunneling application for OPC data exchange over a network

EcoStruxure Web Services (EWS)


EWS is a Schneider Electric standard for sharing data between EcoStruxure™ software platforms.
It is based on SOAP 1.2, an industry standard Web Services technology.

PME includes an EWS server, which means that EWS can be used to export real-time data,
historical data, and alarms from PME to another system.

PME does not include an EWS client, which means that EWS cannot be used to import data into
PME from another system.

Visit the Exchange Community Web site for more information on EWS. See Resources for contact
information.

Extract Transform Load (ETL)


The ETL is a proprietary software application that copies historical data from one data store to
another data store. During the copy process, the ETL can modify the data, to make it fit the target
data store or target application. The ETL can be used to copy data as a one-time transaction, or it
can be scheduled to copy data automatically on an ongoing basis.

The following graphic shows the data source and target stores and formats that are supported by the
ETL:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 151


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Visit the Exchange Community Web site for more information on ETL. See Resources for contact
information.

Open Database Connectivity (ODBC)


ODBC is a standard application programming interface (API) for accessing database management
systems (DBMS). PME is ODBC-compliant, which makes it possible to access any historical data
in the PME database from any other, ODBC-compliant application. See Accessing the ION
Database with 3rd-party applications for an example using Microsoft Excel to access data in the
PME database.

Power Quality Data Interchange Format (PQDIF)


PQDIF is a standard power quality data interchange format for exchanging power quality data
between software applications and monitoring devices. PME can export power quality data in
PQDIF format. See PQDIF Exporter for more information.

Virtual Processor (VIP)


The VIP is a PME component. Use the VIP for data import, data export, data processing, and
control functions. It supports a variety of protocols and standards. See Virtual Processor service
(VIP) for more information. The following protocols and formats are supported by the VIP:
Data Import

• ION

• Modbus

• XML web pages

• SQL databases

Data Export

• ION

• SQL Databases

• SMTP email

• SMS text

• .exe program

152 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Integration with EcoStruxure™ Power Operation (PO)


The goal of this integration is to combine the PME Reports and Dashboards features with the Power
Operation functionality. In the integrated system, PO shows PME reports and dashboards
embedded in the PO user interfaces for a seamless user experience.

For planning and configuration information on this integration see the Power Operation 2021
System Guide.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 153


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Integration with EcoStruxure™ Building Operation (EBO) - Planning


The integration of PME with EBO – hereafter referred to as PME/EBO Integration solution – is an
engineered solution that embeds features of EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert (PME) into
EcoStruxure™ Building Operation (Building Operation).

The PME/EBO Integration solution provides access to PME Dashboards, Reports, Diagrams,
alarm and real-time data through Building Operation, for a seamless user experience.

PME/EBO Integration solution is intended for large buildings, such as high-rise commercial office
buildings, shopping malls, and university campuses. It provides easy to understand energy
information for building managers with limited electrical systems knowledge.

This integration planning section includes the following topics:

• Solution Components

• Solution Limitations

• Software compatibility

• Computer hardware

• Solution architectures

• Guidance on choosing an architecture

• Communications and data transfer

NOTE: The deployment of the PME/EBO Integration solution requires application engineering
expertise in installing and configuring EBO and PME.

154 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Solution Components
The PME/EBO Integration solution includes the following components:

Building Operation 3.2.3


Building Operation software provides integrated monitoring, control and management of energy,
HVAC systems, lighting and fire safety systems. It is a centralized system with scalability from a
single building to a global enterprise.

Power Monitoring Expert 2021


Power Monitoring Expert is a supervisory software for power management applications. It enables
you to maximize operational efficiency, optimize your power distribution system, and improve your
bottom-line performance.

EcoStruxure™ Web Services (EWS)


EcoStruxure Web Services (EWS) is a Schneider Electric standard for sharing data among various
EcoStruxure software platforms to facilitate the creation of EcoStruxure solutions. EWS is based
on conventional Web Services technology (SOAP, WSDL) and provides a way for solution
architects and solution development teams to build solutions that require data to be shared among
different EcoStruxure software platforms.

SmartWidgets
SmartWidgets are device driver packages for Building Operation. SmartWidgets make it fast and
easy for you to add devices like Power Meters to the software. They are easy to install, and they
provide Modbus register mappings for the common measurements for a given device type. They
also provide Building Operation graphics components for consistent visualization and interaction
with devices.

Extract Transform Load (ETL) Tool


The Extract, Transform, Load (ETL) tool connects to the Building Operation EWS server on either
Enterprise Server or Application Server, extracts select historical data from trend logs, and inserts
the data into the PME database. This makes trend data from Building Operation available to PME
Dashboards and Reports.

Solution Limitations
Only the PME Standalone Architecture installation type, where the PME application server and the
database server are installed on the same computer, is supported by the PME/EBO Integration
solution. The PME Distributed Database architecture installation type is not supported. See System
architecture for more information on PME installation architectures.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 155


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Software compatibility
This section describes the PME/EBO Integration solution software compatibility as well as the
operating environment requirements.

NOTICE
LOSS OF COMMUNICATION
• Activate product and component licenses prior to the expiry of the trial license.
• Activate sufficient licenses for the servers and devices in your system.
• Export the existing hierarchy template out of Power Monitoring Expert before importing a new
template. The new template can overwrite the existing template, which can permanently
remove all information contained in the original.
• Backup or archive any SQL Server database data before adjusting any database memory
options.
• Only personnel with advanced knowledge of SQL Server databases should make database
parameter changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in loss of data.

NOTICE
UNAUTHORIZED OR UNINTENDED ACCESS TO CUSTOMER DATA
• Personnel setting up the PME/EBO Integration third-party authentication must be aware that
links to data are not secure.
• Do not setup access links to sensitive or secure data.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unauthorized or unintended access to
sensitive or secure customer data.

Building Operation and PME version compatibility


The PME/EBO Integration solution supports the following software versions:

EBO EBO EBO


PME Version SBO 1.6 SBO 1.7 SBO 1.8 SBO 1.9
2.0 3.0.1 3.2.3
8.0 Y Y
8.1 Y Y Y
8.2 Y Y Y
9.0 Y Y
2020 Y
2021 Y

156 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Operating Environment

PME

See Operating Environment for supported operating systems and SQL Server versions.

Building Operation

See IT System Planning Guide - EcoStruxure Building Management for supported operating
systems and SQL Server versions.

Integration requirements
• For deployments where Building Operation and PME are installed on the same server, the
operating environment must be supported by both systems.

• The following browsers are supported when using PME Web Applications in Building Operation
WebStation:
Microsoft Edge

Google Chrome

Mozilla Firefox

• Installing PME and Building Operation Report Server on the same computer is NOT supported.

• Sharing SQL Server between PME and Building Operation Report Server is NOT supported.

Port Settings

PME

See IP Ports for more information.

Building Operation

The Enterprise Server uses HTTP and TCP protocols to communicate with other servers and
clients. In the Software Administrator, you configure the port number of each protocol the Enterprise
Server listens to when communicating through a specific protocol. Refer to the IT System Planning
Guide - EcoStruxure Building Management for a full list of required open ports.

Changing Port Settings

Building Operation and PME both use the same HTTP (80) and HTTPS (443) ports by default. If you
install Enterprise Server and PME on the same computer, you must change these ports for Building
Operation to avoid a port conflict.

For example, use 8080 and 446 as shown below:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 157


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Therefore, during the design phase, the IT policy needs to be checked to make sure this is
acceptable. If it is not, PME and the Enterprise Server should not be installed on the same computer
and should instead be installed on separate servers.

158 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Computer hardware
PME
See Computer Hardware for information on hardware specifications.

Building Operation
For information on Building Operation hardware specifications, see the IT System Planning Guide -
EcoStruxure Building Management.

PME and Building Operation on the same computer

CPU and RAM

As a general guideline, we recommend that you use the PME Advanced Systems hardware
specifications for systems based on Architecture 2 where the PME and Building Operation software
is installed on the same server.

HDD

To install PME and Building Operation on the same server, add 2 GB to the required PME HDD
space for the Building Operation application and additional space for historical data in Building
Operation.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 159


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Solution architectures

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software or devices for critical control or protection applications where human
or equipment safety relies on the operation of the control action.
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

The PME/EBO Integration solution supports the following integration architectures:

• Architecture 1 - Devices connected to Building Operation

• Architecture 2 - Devices connected to PME

NOTE: Hybrid versions of the architectures are possible, to meet specific application needs.

The following diagram shows an integrated view of both architectures:

160 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Architecture 1 – Devices Connected to Building Operation


• Power devices are connected to Building Operation (Automation Server or Enterprise Server).

• Logging of historical data is done by Building Operation (Automation Server or Enterprise


Server).

• Historical data (Trend Logs), for display in Dashboards and Reports, is copied from Building
Operation to PME using the ETL.

NOTE: (Optional) Historical data for simple trending can be displayed directly through Building
Operation Trend objects.

• PME serves up historical data views in its Web Applications (Dashboards, Reports) to Building
Operation through its secured Web Server.

Architecture 2 – Devices Connected to PME


• Power devices are connected to PME.

• Logging of historical data is done by PME.

NOTE: (Optional) Historical data for simple trending can be copied to Building Operation via
EWS and displayed through Trend objects.

• Real-time data and alarm data are provided to Building Operation via EWS

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 161


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• PME serves up historical data views in its Web Applications (Dashboards, Reports) to Building
Operation through its Web Server

Real-time Data Flow


Regardless of how the data is collected, directly by Building Operation or by PME, it will be viewed
by the user in Building Operation user interface.

Architecture 1

Building Operation collects the real-time data from the devices through an Automation Server or
Enterprise Server.

Architecture 2

PME collects the real-time data and provides it to Building Operation through EWS.

Alarms Data Flow


All alarm data must end up in the Building Operation database, whether the alarms are triggered in
Building Operation or PME.

In Architecture 1, all alarm data is logged directly to the Building Operation database. You must
configure power alarms in Building Operation, manually, or through existing alarms in the
SmartWidget.

In Architecture 2, power alarm data is first logged to the PME database and then copied to the
Building Operation database using EWS. You must configure device based or software-based
power alarms in PME.

Historical Data Flow

Historical Data for Simple Trending in Building Operation

You can use the Building Operation Trend objects for displaying simple trend data. In this case, any
historical data collected in PME, that is to be displayed in Building Operation, needs to be copied to
Building Operation.

NOTE: This does not involve PME Dashboards or Reports.

Architecture 1

Building Operation collects the historical data directly.

Architecture 2

PME collects the historical data and copies it to Building Operation via EWS.

NOTE: The data transfer interval can be set to the PME logging interval, for example 15 minutes,
or to a longer interval, such as once per day, to transfer a larger set of data per connection.

162 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Historical Data for Dashboards and Reports

For complex historical data and larger data sets, use the PME Dashboards and Reports
applications for displaying the data. In this case, any historical data in Building Operation that is to
be displayed in a dashboard or report needs to be copied to PME, using the ETL tool.

Architecture 1

Building Operation collects the historical data and copies it to PME, using the ETL tool.

Architecture 2

PME collects the historical data directly.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 163


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Guidance on choosing an architecture


There are a number of factors to consider when choosing whether to use Architecture 1,
Architecture 2, or a combination of the two. The key factors to consider are:

• Data Collection

• User experience

• Commissioning time

• IT Considerations

NOTE: Hybrid versions of the architectures are possible, to meet specific application needs.

Data Collection
To decide which architecture is best for data collection, consider the following:

A. Device type of the power monitoring devices

B. Number of registers to be requested

C. Device location

A. Device Type

Which types of power devices are used in the system is the most important aspect to consider
when selecting an architecture.

Use the flow chart below to help you with the decision-making process:

164 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Descriptions:
SE (Schneider Electric) device

Most of the SE meters and circuit breakers are supported in PME by default. In addition, a large
number of add-on device drivers for PME can be downloaded from the Exchange community. For
those device types that are not supported by existing drivers, you can create custom drivers with
tools provided by PME. The commissioning time is reduced when there are pre-existing drivers for
your device types in PME.

Building Operation has SmartWidgets for some of the SE power devices. For those device types
that are not supported, you must perform manual mapping in order to communicate to the device.
The commissioning time is reduced when there is a SmartWidget for your device.

NOTE: If the device uses a protocol other than Modbus, further investigation on gateways might
be needed before choosing a communication architecture.

ION meter

ION meters use ION protocol, which is supported by PME but not by Building Operation. Therefore,
it is required to connect these meters to PME (à Architecture 2).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 165


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: Most of the ION meters also support Modbus protocol. However, advanced functions,
such as waveforms, on-board logging or on-board alarms, are not available through Modbus
communication. Therefore, connecting an ION meter through Modbus is not recommended.

Multi-address device

A Multi-address device is a Modbus device that has multiple Modbus IDs, such as the Masterpact.
Multi-address devices are supported in PME but not in Building Operation. In Building Operation,
multiple Modbus devices need to be created for each multi-address device, because each Building
Operation device can only have one Modbus ID. This increases the complexity of the system tree
structure and requires more commissioning time and effort as compared to PME (à Architecture 2).
PQ (Power Quality) functions

If the devices have PQ functions and you want to make use of these functions, Architecture 2 is
recommended because PME provides access to events, waveforms, reports, and all other power
quality related information (à Architecture 2).
On-board logging

If the devices have on-board logging functions, Architecture 2 is recommended because PME can
retrieve the on-board logs instead of doing software-based logging, like Building Operation (à
Architecture 2).

NOTE: On-board data logging is typically more reliable and more accurate than software-based
logging.

On-board alarming

If the devices have on-board alarming functions, Architecture 2 is recommended because PME can
retrieve the on-board alarms instead of monitoring the values and generating alarms in the software,
like Building Operation (à Architecture 2).

NOTE: On-board alarming is typically more reliable and more accurate than software-based
alarming, which is particularly important for power failure root cause analysis.

Conclusion:

For many applications, Architecture 2 is the better choice with regards to power monitoring device
types. However, when only low-end power meters, energy meters, or pulse meters are used, there
is no difference between the two architectures.

B. Number of Registers to be Requested

If only kWh and a few power measurements are needed from a device, then either Architecture 2 or
Architecture 1 can be used, as long as the existing Automation Server can handle the Modbus serial
loop communication of the power devices.

However, if many measurements are needed for each power device, we recommend you use
Architecture 2 to keep communication of the power devices separated from the building automation
devices.

166 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

C. Device Location

Consider the device location and communication network layout when choosing an architecture. If
all power devices are located together in the electrical room, then we recommend you use
communication gateways, such as the Link150, to connect them with dedicated daisy chains.
However, when a limited number of devices is located close to an Automation Server, it might be to
connect them directly to that server.

TIP: Since you can combine the two architectures, choose the most convenient way to connect to
the devices.

User experience
The user experience differs between the two architectures in two ways:

• The types of graphics available to display real-time power device data

• The update rate for real-time values

Graphics for Power Devices

Architecture 1

Real-time data is collected and displayed directly by Building Operation. If there is a SmartWidget
available for a device type in Building Operation, users can use the pre-built graphics in the
SmartWidget. If there is no SmartWidget for the device, users must build their own graphics based
on their needs.

Architecture 2

Real-time data is collected by PME and then transferred to Building Operation through EWS. This
real-time data can then be displayed in the same way as in Architecture 1.

However, it is also possible to use the native PME diagrams to display the data, and then integrated
the diagrams into Building Operation through the PME Web Applications. This provides much more
detailed electrical views with more electrical information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 167


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Here is an example of a PME diagram with real-time data:

Unlike Building Operation, PME has native support for many types of power devices. Using the
diagrams in PME provides electrical views with more detailed information, reducing commissioning
time. However, for simple power devices with only a few registers, the extended diagrams from
PME become less valuable.

NOTE: If a device type is not natively supported by PME, additional commissioning time is
needed for creating a custom device type and diagrams.

Update Rate for Real-time Values

The number of communication layers the real-time values have to go through, in each polling cycle,
differs between the two architectures. This can affect the real-time data update rate in the user
interface.

Architecture 1

In Architecture 1, Building Operation polls the devices directly. The update rate of the real-time
values in the user interface depends on the following:

• Serial communication speed

• Number of devices in the serial loop and number of registers to be requested

• Capability of the Automation Server or Enterprise Server and its load

Architecture 2

In Architecture 2, PME polls the devices directly and then transfers the data to Building Operation
through EWS. The update rate of the real-time value in user interface depends on the following:

• Update rate for EWS communication

• Serial communication speed

• Number of devices in the serial loop and numbers of registers to be requested

168 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

• Capability of the PME server

• Bandwidth allocation between real-time and log retrieving of PME

Because of the added communication layers, and the available real-time data bandwidth in PME,
the update rate for a real-time value for architecture 2 is typically slower than Architecture 1. Refer
to Communications and data transfer for more information.

Conclusion

If the real-time update rate is your top priority and only a small number of registers are needed,
choose Architecture 1. Otherwise, choose Architecture 2 to make use of all the functions of your
power devices.

Commissioning time
The engineering time required for the integration varies for different architectures. See the
PME/EBO Integration section for details.

IT Considerations
The server recommendations are different for Architecture 1 and Architecture 2. See Computer
hardware for more information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 169


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Communications and data transfer


System communication design varies significantly between Architecture 1 and Architecture 2.

Architecture 1

Device Communications

In Architecture 1, device communications are handled by Building Operation (Enterprise Server,


Automation Server, or any other BMS field-level devices).

Refer to the Architectural Guidelines - EcoStruxure Building Management document and relevant
device documentation for more communication design information.

Logging Data in Building Operation

In Architecture 1, historical data is collected in TrendLogs. TrendLogs can be fed by any Building
Operation variables, including BACnet, LON, XML, or Modbus Point.

NOTE: When logging data in Building Operation, it is recommended to use interval trend log to log
the raw data from meters. The cumulative raw data is then inserted into the PME database by the
ETL tool. PME Dashboards and Reports have an aggregation mechanism to make use of the data.
Hourly, daily, and monthly usage does not need to be calculated in Building Operation for PME
use.

If both Trendlog and Extended Trendlog are used, it is recommended to send the data in the
Trendlog to PME (via ETL) to avoid the lagging between Extended Trendlog and Trendlog.

It is recommended to plan the variables to be logged during the design phase so that the size of the
Trendlog files can be forecast. Also, it is important to plan which Trendlogs are to be transferred to
PME in order to forecast the size and growth of the database.

ETL Jobs

An ETL job is a set of task definitions that the ETL engine follows in order to Extract, Transform, and
Load data from one data source to another. An ETL job contains an extract task to pull the data, a
transform task to manipulate the data, and a load task that applies the data to the new location.

170 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

After the job is set up, you can set the job to run as a service. When set to run as a service, a job
automatically runs at set times based on the settings you input in the Job tab. The Sleep Time
Between Execution value (in seconds) allows you to define the frequency with a default value of
3600 seconds. The value defines when new data can be displayed in the Dashboards and Reports.
You can use a smaller value if you want the job to run more frequently. For meter interval data, 900
seconds is usually fast enough for the updates. When increasing this value, consider the Building
Operation Trendlog size to make sure it can be covered before being overwritten in order to prevent
missing TrendLogs.

ETL does not use any of the PME processes, so this has little impact on PME performance while
loading. SQL supports multi-threading and will serve both ETL and PME needs. If SQL is
overloaded, the data buffer handles it.

Architecture 2

Real-time Communication

The following flow chart shows the detail of the real-time data flow in PME when integrating with
Building Operation under Architecture 2.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 171


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

EWS Communication

There are two configurable settings that control the EWS communication and that you can use to
optimize system performance: Value Poll Interval, in Building Operation, and Real-time Refresh
Rate, in PME.

Value Poll Interval


In the Building Operation EWS Interface, you can configure the Value Poll Interval, which defines
the frequency of the EWS polling, for real-time values. The default value is 20 seconds.

Real-time Refresh Rate


In the PME EWS server web.config file, in ...\Power Monitoring
Expert\applications\EWS, you can set the Real-time Refresh Rate. This setting controls how
often the PME EWS server updates the real-time data it serves up. The default Real-time Refresh
Rate setting is 30 seconds.

172 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Default set of EWS web.config file settings in PME:


<appSettings>
<add key="ServiceInventoryEndpoint"
value="http://STANDALONE:23102/CoreServicesHost/Inventory/InventoryService" />
<add key="EWSRealTimeTimeout" value="120" />
<add key="ServiceLocation" value="EWS Services" />
<add key="DigestAuthenticationModule_Realm" value="DataExchangeService" />
<add key="AllowMD5DigestHash" value="1" />
<add key="EWSEnabled" value="1" />
<add key="ContainerItemStructure" value="0" />
<add key="NaNValue" value="" />
<add key="ConcatSourceAlarmEventId" value="1" />
<add key="RealTimeRefreshRate" value="30" />
<add key="RealTimeSessions" value="10" />
<add key="InternalStructureCacheTimeInSeconds" value="120" />
<add key="NumberOfDaysBackToInclude" value="10" />
<add key="InvalidAlarmTypes" value="ALM_CONTROL_EVENT,ALM_LOOSE_DROPOUT,ALM_
GENERIC_EVENT,ALM_CLOCK" />
</appSettings>

Communication Performance

The following shows the results of an EWS server performance test in PME:

NOTE: This test was performed on an earlier version of the PME/EBO Integration solution, called
Power Manager at that time.

Computer Type: Server


OS: Windows Server 2012 R2
SQL: 2012 Standard SP1
CPU: x2 Intel Xeon E56xx (4 core)
RAM: 24 GB
HDD: x6 300 GB
Software: Building Operation 1.6 + Power Manager 1.0

Number of Tags per Average Response


Number of Devices Total Number of tags
Device Time (s)
5 1 5 <1
5 4 20 < 1
5 10 50 1.25
500 1 500 3
500 4 2000 6

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 173


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Number of Tags per Average Response


Number of Devices Total Number of tags
Device Time (s)
500 10 5000 13.5
1500 1 1500 5.75
1500 4 6000 18
2000 1 2500 6.5

NOTE: The EWS response time is independent of the measurement and device type, as long as
the number of measurements, and the number of devices they were distributed across, remains
the same.

The chart below shows a graphical representation of the EWS response time vs. Number of tags in
an EWS request:

As discussed previously, the EWS request is sent from Building Operation only when there is a
need, for example a graphic is open. Therefore, typically an EWS request from Building Operation to
PME contains less than 1000 tags. For example, if 100 devices are shown in one graphic, and each
has four bound values, then an EWS request for the 400 values (tags) is sent to the PME EWS
Server when the graphic is opened in Building Operation. In case, based on the above test results,
the EWS response time is about three seconds. This provides plenty of buffer time with a 20 second
value polling setting in Building Operation as the default.

NOTE: Consider the impact on other parts of the Building Operation system, when tuning the
polling rate to achieve faster refresh.

Alarm Communication

In Architecture 1, alarms are created in Building Operation, Automation Server or Enterprise Server.

174 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

In Architecture 2, technically the alarms can be created in both systems, PME or Building
Operation. A proper design of the alarm generation logic and communication is important for a
successful solution.

PME Alarms
PME alarm data is transferred to Building Operation using EWS. It is important to understand the
two possible sources of an alarm in the PME system:

• On-board alarm – Generated and logged in the device (meter, circuit breaker, and so on)

• Software-based alarm – Generated by the PME software and logged in the computer cache.

On-board Alarms

For important alarms, such as circuit breaker trips, power outage, or over current, try to use the
device on-board alarms in circuit breakers or meters. Even for a less important alarms, on-board
alarms are recommended to use to gain higher system reliability and also to make use of the device
functionality.

Software based Alarms

If the device does not have on-board alarming, or additional alarms need to be created, it is
recommended to create the alarm in Software Alarms in PME, rather than create an alarm in
Building Operation based on real-time values read via EWS.

NOTE: VIP alarms are not exposed through EWS.

EWS Alarm Communication


The following flow chart shows the details of the alarm data flow in PME when integrating with
Building Operation under Architecture 2.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 175


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

PME alarms are polled only if the Alarm Polling is enabled for the EWS interface in Building
Operation.

A filter can be configured to poll only the alarms that are needed.

The priority of an alarm or event can be configured in the PME system. The typical PME alarm
priority categorization is:

• High priority alarm: 193 - 255

• Med priority alarm: 128 - 192

176 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

• Low priority alarm: 64 -127

• Information: 0 - 63.

NOTE: Any alarm priority setting greater than 255, in Building Operation, will be set to 255 for
PME.

When a user acknowledges EWS alarms in Building Operation, the corresponding alarms in the
PME system are also acknowledged automatically.

Performance: Alarm Latency

With the default software settings, an on-board alarm event is expected to be seen, in Building
Operation within 90s on average. The settings can be tuned to achieve faster performance. Using
the same concept, for a software-based alarm, the latency depends on the Building Operation EWS
polling rate and the alarm polling rate defined for the alarm.

NOTE: Consider the impact on other parts of the system, such as the real-time data performance
when tuning the polling rate to achieve a faster alarm refresh rate.

Best Practice for Using EWS Alarms in Building Operation

When choosing Architecture 2, it is not recommended to create Building Operation alarms based on
real-time values read via EWS. For real-time values, EWS communication only takes place when
there is a need, for instance, a graphic is opened by the user. In contrast, if an alarm is created
based on an EWS tag, then the EWS real-time subscription for this value will be constantly active.

However, in Building Operation, the EWS alarm object is not the same as a regular alarm object. If
there are requirements for consistent alarm messages, alarm priority, and user action associations,
which EWS alarms may not meet, it is recommended to use the Building Operation Sum Alarm
function to create a new alarm on top of one or more EWS alarms. Then the newly created Building
Operation alarm can be managed consistently with other Building Operation alarms. Refer to
Building Operation online help for more information about the Sum Alarm function.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 177


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Deployment considerations
This section provides information on the time, effort, and expertise that is required to deploy PME
systems and its components.

Use the links in the following table below to find the content you are looking for:

Topic Content
Power Quality (PQ)
Prerequisites and configuration time estimates.
Performance Module
Commissioning time estimates for the integration of PME and
PME/EBO Integration
EcoStruxure Building Operation (EBO).

178 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Power Quality (PQ) Performance Module


Commissioning Time Estimates
This section provides time estimates for the deployment of the PQ Performance module.

Prerequisites

Competency

Application Engineers who are responsible for deploying the PQ Performance module must have a
basic knowledge of power quality and also be familiar with the following:

• Power Monitoring Expert software systems.

• Schneider Electric power meters and circuit breakers

• Microsoft Windows operating systems

• Microsoft SQL Server.

We strongly recommend that you take the PME PQ Performance technical training from your local
or regional training center.

Time Estimates
The following time estimates are based on the configuration steps documented for the PQ
Performance module. The assumption is that all the prerequisites are met. For details on how to
configure this module, see the Configure chapter.

Configuration Step Time (min.) Comments


(Per device). This might include
verifying PQ event detection, PQ
Device Preparation 2
disturbance logging, and time
synchronization.
Global configuration 1
Configure PQ Indicator Diagram 2
Configure Equipment Diagram
Landing page and grouping page 15
Detail page 5 Per corrective equipment
Configure PQ Impact Gadgets and
Reports
Using electrical value (e.g. current drop)
for this estimate. Using a non-electrical,
Acquire Process Impact Signal 0 process related measurement might
require additional time to get the signal
through DI, OPC, PLC, ... .
Set Up Process Impact Alarms 5

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 179


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuration Step Time (min.) Comments


(Per group). This does not take into
account the time required to understand
Set Up PQ Groups 1
the relationship between a customer's
production and electrical distribution.
Configure Power Factor Impact
Gadgets
Using one of the sample rate files.
Set Up the Power Factor Impact Rate This is site-specific and based on the
1
File rate structure of the customer's utility
contract.
Set Up the Incomer Meters in the
2
Hierarchy
Set Up PQ Performance Dashboards
and Reports
One PQ overview dashboard and one
Set Up PQ Performance Dashboards 6
PQ detail dashboard
Set Up PQ Performance Reports 1 Per report as required
This is site-specific, and highly
dependent on the customer
requirements. It might require a
Fine-Tuning *
deep understanding of the local
power quality standards and
particular customer needs.
Change Device Inclusion and Exclusion
-
for the Analysis
Change PQ Indicator Thresholds -
Disable Unused PQ Indicators -

* This is site-specific, and highly dependent on the customer requirements. It might require a deep
understanding of the local power quality standards and particular customer needs.

180 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

PME/EBO Integration
The engineering time required for the integration varies for different architectures. Typically, it is
faster to deploy Architecture 2 than Architecture 1 for the following reasons:

• When the power devices are supported by PME, it is faster to configure the devices in
Architecture 2 than in Architecture 1, even when there are SmartWidgets available in Building
Operation. When no SmartWidgets are available, the time for creating the Modbus map in
Building Operation can be considerable.

• Configuring the ETL to setup the historical data transfer from Building Operation to PME, which
is required for Architecture 1, can add considerable deployment time.

Architecture 1
Below are commissioning time estimates for PME/EBO Integration solutions for Architecture 1:

Standard
Average
Architecture 1 Configuration Workflow Deviation
Time (min)
(min)
Installing and licensing Building Operation *
1.1 Installing and licensing License Server
1.2 Installing Enterprise Server
1.3 Installing Workstation
1 16.7 1.5
Installing Building Operation Connector
1.4
components, snippets, and binding template
Single-server install only: Changing Building
1.5
Operation ports
Installing and licensing PME *
2.1 Installing PME
2 54.7 18.4
2.2 Activating PME licenses
2.3 Single-server install only: Changing PME ports
Configure the devices in Building Operation with
SmartWidgets
3.1 Configuring Modbus Master Interface
3 3.2 Importing SmartWidgets 81.7 36.6
3.3 Modifying SmartWidgets graphic
3.4 Creating trend logs for SmartWidgets
3.5 Copy, paste and edit to have the full system
ETL
4.1 Installing ETL
4.2 Creating ETL job
4 40.3 30.3
4.3 Adding and configuring the tasks
4.4 Configuring the mapping
4.5 Run job once and then register as a service

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 181


Plan EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Web Application Integration Utility Settings and


Building Operation Import
5 5.1 Configuring web applications 12.7 15
5.2 Exporting the XML
5.3 Importing the XML
Setting up Dashboards and Reports *
6 6.1 Configuring Dashboards 39.7 21.1
6.2 Configuring Reports
Setting up Graphics *
7 7.1 Setting up Electrical One Line Diagram 141.7 40.8
7.2 Setting up System Network Health screen
Total 387.3 116.9

* These steps are identical for both architectures.

Architecture 2
Below are commissioning time estimates for PME/EBO Integration solutions for Architecture 2:

Standard
Average
Architecture 2 Configuration Workflow Deviation
Time (min)
(min)
Installing and licensing Building Operation *
1.1 Installing and licensing License Server
1.2 Installing Enterprise Server
1.3 Installing Workstation
1 14.0 6.1
Installing Building Operation Connector
1.4
components, snippets, and binding template
Single-server install only: Changing Building
1.5
Operation ports
Installing and licensing PME *
2.1 Installing PME
2 41.0 8.2
2.2 Activating PME licenses
2.3 Single-server install only: Changing PME ports
Configure the devices in PME
3.1 Adding Devices in PME
3 23.0 9.0
3.2 Generating a Vista Network Diagram
3.3 Update EWS Server
Web Application Integration Utility Settings and
Building Operation Import
4 4.1 Configuring web applications 15.3 7.8
4.2 Exporting the XML
4.3 Importing the XML

182 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Plan

Setting up Dashboards and Reports *


5 5.1 Configuring Dashboards 29.7 8
5.2 Configuring Reports
Setting up Graphics *
6 6.1 Setting up Electrical One Line Diagram 138.7 27.7
6.2 Setting up System Network Health screen
Total 261.7 66.8

* These steps are identical for both architectures.

Estimation Guidelines
Below are guidelines for estimating the engineering time required to set up the key components of
an PME/EBO Integration solution.

Software Installation
The installation and licensing of the solution does not vary based on the size of the system.

Device Configuration
The time required to configure the devices varies greatly based on the device types and their native
support in the system. Do not simply multiply the amount of time provided in our commissioning
time estimates by the number of devices in your system. Use the estimates only as a general
guideline for the engineering time that might be required.

ETL
Configuring the ETL to setup the historical data transfer from Building Operation to PME is an
additional task for Architecture 1, which takes a considerable amount of time. The required effort
depends on the number of devices, device types, and the number of logs and measurement types.
The use of batch editing, when configuring the Mapping in the ETL, can significantly reduce the
configuration time.

Web Application Integration Utility Settings


The time it takes to integrate PME and Building Operation by using the Web Application Integration
Utility Settings does not vary based on the size of the system. The exception being the following:

• The time it takes to export the XML will vary somewhat based on size of the system.

• The export and import in Building Operation takes slightly longer for larger systems.

Setting up Dashboards and Reports


The time for setting up Dashboards and Reports is determined by the customer needs. The
reference system used for estimation covers basic Dashboards and Reports for the power
management of a building.

Setting up Graphics
For the graphics configuration (Electrical Network Graphics) the time recorded was the time to build
them from scratch. The default Electric One Line Diagram ANSI/IEC and default Electrical Health
Summary Screen is part of the reference system package. Time can be saved by modifying the
default diagrams rather than building them from scratch.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 183


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Install and Upgrade


Use the information provided in this chapter for installing or upgrading a Power Monitoring Expert
(PME) system.

The topics in this section are organized into the following:

• New system install

• System update

• System upgrade

• System migration

• Cybersecurity

• Tools

• References

184 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

New system install


Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for.

Topic Content
Before Installing the Provides information and reminders for you to consider before
software starting the installation.
Provides detailed information on installing the SQL Server and the
Installation process
PME software.
After installing the software Provides procedures for you to complete after the installation.
PME 2021 Install notes Provides release notes related to the installation of PME 2021.
Installing the PME/EBO Provides information on installing the PME/EBO Integration
Integration solution solution.

Before Installing the software


Review the prerequisites
Before starting the installation, review the Plan chapter in this guide and confirm that your system
meets all the relevant prerequisites. In particular, review the install planning, computer hardware,
operating environment, network connectivity, and licensing requirements. Also review the PME
2021 Install notes, which provide information regarding installation that is specific to the latest
version of the software.

Cybersecurity
Review the cybersecurity information. See Cybersecurity for details.

Use an account with administrative privileges to install the software


For installing PME, log on to your Windows system using an account that is a member of the
Administrators group.

NOTE: Permissions for the Administrators group can be restricted by system policies which might
affect the PME installation. Work with your network administrator to resolve any permissions
issues.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-specific
cybersecurity policies.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 185


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Create a file share for Engineering clients and Secondary servers


Engineering clients and Secondary servers must be able to access files on the PME application
server. This is done through sharing the Power Monitoring Expert product folder on the server. You
must set up this file share before installing Engineering clients or Secondary servers.

NOTE: Vista and Designer, on Engineering clients and Secondary servers, use this file share to
access diagram files on the application server.

To create a file share for Engineering clients and Secondary servers:

1. On the PME application server, open File Explorer.

2. Navigate to the PME product folder ...\Power Monitoring Expert.

3. Right-click the product folder and select Properties, this opens the Properties window.

4. In Properties, select the Sharing tab.

5. On the Sharing tab, select Advanced Sharing.

6. In Advanced Sharing, add a new share with the following details:


Select Share this folder

Share name: ION-Ent

Comments (Optional): Power Monitoring Expert file share

Permissions:
Groups or user names: Select the user that will be installing the Engineering client or
Secondary server, and the users that will be accessing them. Alternatively, select the
Everyone group.

RECOMMENDATION: Select individual users instead of Everyone. That limits


access to specific users and increases cybersecurity.

Permissions: Change and Read

7. Click OK in Advanced Sharing.

8. Click Apply and the OK in the Properties window.

Windows Integrated Authentication for SQL Server


If you are planning to install PME with Windows Integrated Authentication, then complete the
following before starting the install:

NOTE: Windows Integrated Authentication is not supported for PME systems with Secondary
Servers.

Standalone architecture

On the PME application server:

• Add the Windows account for the user who is installing the software to the local Administrator
group.

186 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

• Add the Windows account for the install user to the SQL database logins with a sysadmin
Server Role.

NOTE: You can remove this account from the SQL database logins after PME is installed.

• Add the Windows account that is used by PME to access the databases to the local
Administrator group.

• Set the 'Logon As A Service' privilege for the database access account.

Distributed Database architecture

On the Windows Domain, in the Active Directory:

• Add an account for the user who is installing PME. This only needs to be a domain user
account, not a domain admin account.

• Add an account that PME will use to access the databases. This only needs to be a domain
user account, not a domain admin account.

On the PME application server:

• Add the account for the install user to the local Administrator group.

• Add the database access account for PME to the local Administrator group.

• Set the 'Logon As A Service' privileges for the database access account.

On the database server:

• Add the account for the install user to the local Administrator group.

• Add the account for the install user to the SQL database logins with a sysadmin Server Role.

NOTE: You can remove this account from the SQL database logins after PME is installed.

NOTE: When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, the Windows account
that is used to access the database is also used to run the PME services and the IIS Application
Pools.

Update the operating system


Run the Windows Update service to install the latest security patches and hotfixes from Microsoft.

Install troubleshooting
Unsuccessful installation due to invalid account passwords
Problem:

The installation of PME was not successful, after changing the Windows accounts or database
accounts passwords to passwords that do not meet the password policies.

Background:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 187


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

PME uses Windows accounts and database accounts to run its services and access the
databases. These accounts are created during the installation of the software. The installer
generates default passwords for these accounts. The default passwords are long and complex and
most likely comply with your Windows and SQL Server password policies.

The installer also gives you the option to change these default passwords. If you decide to change
the passwords, the passwords you are providing must comply with your Windows and SQL Server
password policies. The software installer cannot validate the passwords at the time you enter them.
If the passwords are not valid, the installation will not be successful.
Solution:
If the installation does not succeed because the passwords do not meet the policies, do the
following:

1. Complete the installation, skipping any unsuccessful steps.

2. After the installation is complete, run the installer again.

NOTE: The installer will detect that the software has been installed on this computer, and
open in maintenance mode.

3. Select Reset Accounts.

4. Follow the wizard and change the passwords for the Windows and database accounts to
passwords that meet the password policies. Allow the installer to complete the account reset.

5. Click Close to close the installer.

188 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Installation process
The installation is a two-step process that must be performed in the following order:

1. Installing the SQL Server.

2. Installing the PME software.

NOTE: The same PME installer is used to install a Standalone Server, Application Server, or
Engineering Client. Which component is installed is determined by the Setup Type, which you
select during the installation. Based on this Setup Type, the installer displays the appropriate
setup pages. See Setup Types and applicable Installer pages for more information.

For information on the different Setup Types, see Standalone Server, Application Server,
Engineering Client.

Web Clients do not need to be installed. For information on Web Clients, see Client types.

Installing the SQL Server


There are several options for the installation of the SQL Server. You must choose one of these
options and complete the installation of SQL Server before you can install PME.

Option 1 - Install a new, full SQL Server version.


For detailed installation instructions for this option, continue with Installing a new SQL Server.

Option 2 - Reuse an existing SQL Server version instance.


This can be a full SQL Server version or a SQL Server Express version. To reuse an existing SQL
Server instance, configuration steps are required to prepare this instance for use with PME. For
detailed configuration instructions, continue with Configuring an existing SQL Server.

Option 3 - Use the SQL Server Express version included in PME


The SQL Server Express is installed by the PME installer as part of the software installation
process. For detailed instructions, continue with Installing the PME software.

NOTE: Option 3 is only supported for Standalone architectures. Distributed Database


architectures require the full version of SQL Server.

For information on choosing a supported SQL Server version, see Operating Environment, SQL
Server considerations, and SQL Server Licensing.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 189


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Installing a new SQL Server


Log into Windows as a user with administrative privileges. Make sure that no other programs are
running; save your work and close any open applications.

The installation steps are generally the same for all supported SQL Servers. For illustration
purposes, the images in the following steps are from the SQL Server 2014 Standard edition
installation unless indicated otherwise.

1. Insert the SQL Server Installation DVD in your DVD drive or access the installation media on
your system, then navigate to the root directory on the DVD and double-click setup.exe to
open the SQL Server Installation Center.

2. Select Installation in the left pane and New SQL Server stand-alone installation or add
features to an existing installation on the right.

3. Follow the steps provided by the installation wizard until you reach the Setup Role page, for
SQL Server 2012 and 2014, or the Feature Selection page, for SQL Server 2016, 2017, and
2019.

NOTE: Whenever a validation process occurs during installation, if validation is not


successful, follow the instructions in the wizard to resolve the problem and click Re-run.
Click Next when the validation is successful.

4. (For SQL Server 2012 and 2014) Setup Role page:

Leave SQL Server Feature Installation selected, and click Next.

5. Feature Selection page:

Under Instance Features, select Database Engine Services.

(For SQL Server 2012 and 2014) Under Shared Features, select Management Tools - Basic
and Management Tools - Complete.

(For SQL Server 2016, 2017, and 2019) The Management Tools are installed in a separate
Web-based process after completing the installation of SQL Server.

190 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Click Next.

6. Feature Rules page:

This page identifies any errors related to the feature selection validation. If successful, the
next page opens. If not successful, follow the instructions on the page and click Re-run. Click
Next when the process completes successfully.

7. Instance Configuration page:

Select Named instance and enter a name in the Instance Name field, for example ION. (Do
not use an underscore character ( _ ) within the instance name.) Click in the Instance ID field
to automatically add your Instance name entry. Click Next.

8. Server Configuration page:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 191


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Change the Account Name for SQL Server Agent and SQL Server Database Engine to NT
AUTHORITY\SYSTEM (your local system account). To do this, highlight the existing entries
in the Account Name column and enter NT AUTHORITY\SYSTEM for the two services. (For
SQL Server 2017 and 2019) Select Grant Perform Volume Maintenance Task privileges
to SQL Server Database Engine Service. Click Next.

NOTE:
If you specify a Windows account other than the local system account, when you begin
installing PME, the Check System page in the Installer indicates that the service account
under which the SQL Server currently runs does not have the required system permissions.
To resolve this situation, you need to do one of the following:
Temporarily change the SQL Server service to run under an account that has Write
permissions to (1) the folder created for the product's databases (the default is the install
location for ...\Power Monitoring Expert\), and (2), for the current logged-in
user's Temp folder. (To find the full path to the Temp folder, click Start > Run, enter
%Temp% and click OK.) The default local system account is an example of an account
with these privileges.

Temporarily grant Write permission for the two folders mentioned above to the Windows
account that the SQL Server service runs under. Use the Windows Services control
panel to identify this account. (Click Start > Administrative Tools > Services, right-
click SQL Server, click the Log On tab in the SQL Server Properties dialog.)

Revert the temporary changes after the installation of PME completes.

SQL Server 2014:

192 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

SQL Server 2017 and 2019:

9. Database Engine Configuration page, on the Server Configuration tab:


a. Select Mixed Mode.

NOTE: If you are planning to install PME with Windows Integrated Authentication, then
you can choose to configure the database engine either with Windows Authentication
Mode or Mixed Mode. Mixed Mode authentication is also referred to as SQL Server
authentication in this document.

b. (For Mixed Mode) Type a password for the SQL Server system administrator (sa) account
in the Enter password and Confirm password fields. (Keep a record of the password for
future use.)

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices for password creation and management.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury,


equipment damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access - such as least privilege,
separation of duties - vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator
to ensure that user access adheres to the site-specific cybersecurity policies.

c. Click Add Current User to add the SQL Server Administrator if it is not specified by
default.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 193


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

d. (For SQL Server 2012 and 2014) Click the Data Directories tab. (For SQL Server 2016,
2017, and 2019) Click the TempDB tab.

e. Specify a drive for the TempDB directories (Data and Log). If possible, locate these files
on different drives than the database directories to improve performance. Click Next.

NOTE: The specification of different drives is for performance reasons. If all of the files
are located on the same drive, data that is being inserted, updated, or deleted can
potentially result in slower write operations than if the Temp DB directories are located
on a separate drive. The specification of different drives is dependent on your hardware
configuration and may not be possible in all cases.

SQL Server 2014:

194 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

SQL Server 2017 and 2019:

10. Feature Configuration Rules page: 

The rules are run automatically to validate that the installation can proceed. If validation is
successful, the next page opens. This can be very quick and it might seem that the install
wizard jumps directly to the next page. If validation is not successful, follow the instructions
on the page and click Re-run. Click Next when the validation is successful.

11. Ready to Install page:

The page shows the SQL Server features that are about to be installed. Click Install.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 195


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The Installation Progress page provides a visual indication of the progress of the installation.
When the installation finishes, the Complete page opens.

12. Complete page:

Contains information about the Setup operations or possible next steps, as well as
supplemental information related to your installation. Click Close to close the setup dialog.

13. (For SQL Server 2016, 2017 and 2019) In SQL Server Installation Center, click Install SQL
Server Management Tools to launch the download page for the installation of SQL Server
Management Studio. Follow the instructions to install SQL Server Management Studio. A
system reboot is required after installing SQL Server Management Studio.

NOTE: Internet access is required. If Internet access is not possible from this server,
download the SQL Server Management Studio setup file on a different computer and copy it
to the SQL Server computer for installation.

196 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

14. Go to the Maintenance page in the SQL Server Installation Center and click Launch
Windows Update to search for product updates that you can install.

15. Close the SQL Server Installation Center.

16. (Recommended) Set the SQL Server memory options. See Setting SQL Server memory
options for more information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 197


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring an existing SQL Server


If you have an existing installation of SQL Server Express, the PME Installer adds the instance that
is required by PME.

If you have an existing installation of SQL Server Standard Edition, then rerun the SQL Server Setup
wizard and follow the steps described in Installing a new SQL Server.

In most cases, fewer steps are required. The Instance Configuration page is slightly different, as
noted below.
The Instance Configuration page:

1. Enter a name in the Instance Name field, for example ION. (Do not use an underscore
character ( _ ) within the instance name.)

2. Click in the Instance ID field to automatically add your Instance name entry.

3. Click Next.

Any existing instance names appear in the Installed Instances area on the page. If
Management Studio Tools have previously been installed, they are identified as the shared
components SSMS, and Adv_SSMS.

Complete the remaining steps in the instance addition process and close the SQL Server
Installation Center.

(Recommended) Set the SQL Server memory options. See Setting SQL Server memory options for
more information.

For SQL Server 2016, 2017, and 2019, if SQL Server Management Tools need to be installed, click
Install SQL Server Management Tools in the SQL Server Installation Center to launch the
download page for their installation. Internet access is required.

198 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Installing the PME software


NOTE: Perform the software installation directly on the server, do not do a remote installation.

NOTE: As part of the software installation you need to provide SQL Server credentials with
sysadmin privileges on the database server. For Distributed Database architectures, if you are not
able to provide these kinds of credentials, see Installing PME with manual installation of the
databases for an alternate installation method.

Start the installation process by inserting the PME DVD into the DVD drive. If the installation does
not start automatically, use Windows Explorer to navigate to the DVD drive and double-click
MainSetup.exe.

1. Install Microsoft .NET Framework if prompted.

After installing the .NET Framework, you are prompted to restart your system. After the
restart, double-click MainSetup.exe to continue the PME installation.

2. Application Language page:

Select the Application Language and click Next.

The Application Language setting determines the language that is displayed in the following
installer pages and the language of the PME system that is installed.

3. Welcome page:

Review the reminders for tasks to complete before continuing with the installation, and click
Next.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 199


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. License Agreement page:

Read the End User License Agreement (EULA) on the License Agreement page. If you
accept the terms of the license agreement, click I Agree to proceed.

5. Setup Type page:

Select the Setup Type you want to install and click Next.

Standalone Server:

Application Server:

Secondary Server

200 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

NOTE: Secondary Server installations are not common and are used only in exceptional
circumstances. They require advanced network configuration. Contact Technical Services if
you think you need a Secondary Server.

NOTE: Secondary servers must be able to access files on the primary application server.
This is done through a file share on the primary server. You must set up this file share before
continuing with the Secondary server install. The install will not be successful if the file share
cannot be found. For details on how to set up the file share, see Create a file share for
Engineering clients and Secondary servers.

Engineering Client:

NOTE: Engineering clients must be able to access files on the application server. This is
done through a file share on the server. You must set up this file share before continuing with
the Engineering client install. The install will not be successful if the file share cannot be
found. For details on how to set up the file share, see Create a file share for Engineering
clients and Secondary servers.

NOTE: Not all of the following installer pages are shown for all Setup Types. See Setup
Types and applicable Installer pages for more information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 201


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

6. (Standalone Server and Application Server) System Key page:

Select Generate a system key or Import a system key and click Next.

Generate a system key for the initial installation of a Standalone Server or Application Server
setup type, or when you are re-installing one of those setup types and a system key is not
available.

Import a system key when you are re-installing a Standalone Server, or an Application Server
setup type and you have the system key that you previously exported.

7. (Standalone Server and Application Server) Export System Key page:

It is mandatory that you export the system key. Next is enabled after you complete the export.
a. Click Export System Key to open the file explorer.

b. Navigate to the location where you want to store the system key.

c. Type a file name for the system key and click Save.

d. Click Next.

The system key is required if you install an Engineering Client, or if you need to uninstall and
then reinstall Power Monitoring Expert.

NOTE: You can export the system key at any time after the installation. See PME Installer
for details.

202 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

8. (Engineering Client) Import System Key page:

The Engineering Client installation needs to use the system key that you exported when you
installed a Standalone Server or an Application Server.
a. Ensure that the system key is available.

b. Click Import System Key to open a file explorer.

c. Navigate to and click the system key file.

d. Click Open to add the system key location to the Import System Key page.

e. Click Next.

9. (Standalone Server and Application Server) Web Application page:

Change the default URL path for the Web Applications component of the product, or use the
default values, and click Next.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 203


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

10. (Engineering Client) Application Server page:

Enter or select the PME Application Server and click Next.

NOTE: The first time you are installing an Engineering Client for a system, the selection box
on this page is empty. Manually enter the name of the Application Server or Standalone
Server. For repeated client installs, you can select the server name from the box.

11. (Standalone Server and Application Server) Diagnostics and Usage and Connected
Services page:

Enable or disable these services and click Next.

Diagnostics and Usage, when enabled, collects and sends system data to Schneider Electric.
We use this data to help improve our software by understanding how you use it. See
Diagnostics and Usage for details.

Connected Services, when enabled, collects and sends energy and power data to Schneider
Electric. We can use this data to identify data issues in your power monitoring system or
power quality issues within your electrical distribution system. See Connected Services for
details.

See Resources for a link to the Privacy Policy.

204 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

12. File Destination page:

This page shows the default installation location for the product folders and files. Use the
browse button to select a different location if desired. Click Next. Click Yes if you are
prompted to create the folder.

13. (Standalone Server and Application Server) Supervisor Account page:

Enter and confirm a password for the supervisor account for the software.

The supervisor account has the highest level of access to the system. Use this account to
configure the system. The entered password must meet the length and complexity
requirements, which is displayed on the page. Next is enabled after the password meets the
requirements.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 205


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices for password creation and management.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access - such as least privilege,
separation of duties - vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to
ensure that user access adheres to the site-specific cybersecurity policies.

NOTE: If you continue to the next pages in the Installer and then return to this page by
clicking Back, the page contains a Change Password button. If you want to change the
password that you initially entered, click Change Password, type the new password in the
fields, and click Next to proceed.

14. (Standalone Server and Application Server) Windows Accounts page:

Use the default password for the Windows accounts or change the password and click Next.

NOTE: If you change the password, the password you are providing must comply with the
password policies of the Windows server and the SQL server.
The software installer cannot validate the password at the time you enter it.
If the password is not valid, the installation will not be successful. In that case, complete the
installation, skipping any unsuccessful steps. See Unsuccessful installation due to invalid
account passwords for information on how to repair the unsuccessful install.

PME uses two Windows accounts for its operation, IONMaintenance and IONUser. By
default, the password for these accounts is generated automatically by the installer. The same
password is used for both accounts.

206 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

The IONMaintenance account is used to run PME database jobs in Windows Task
Scheduler. The IONUser account is used for subscriptions created in the Reports application
when the generated report is created using the fileshare option.

NOTE: If you want to later change the settings for the database jobs in Windows Task
Scheduler, you need the password for the IONMaintenance account. In this case you
must choose your own password for the Windows Accounts on this page since the default
password cannot be retrieved.

NOTE: You can change the Windows Accounts password at any time after the installation.
See PME Installer for details.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices for password creation and management.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access - such as least privilege,
separation of duties - vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to
ensure that user access adheres to the site-specific cybersecurity policies.

15. (Standalone Server and Application Server) Database Accounts page:

Select Use SQL Server Authentication or Use Windows Integrated Authentication for
the PME database accounts. For SQL Server Authentication, use the default password for the
database accounts, or change the password. For Windows Integrated Authentication, specify
an existing Windows account. Click Next.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 207


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: Windows Integrated Authentication is not supported for PME systems with
Secondary Servers.

NOTE: If you change the password, the password you are providing must comply with the
password policies of the Windows server and the SQL server.
The software installer cannot validate the password at the time you enter it.
If the password is not valid, the installation will not be successful. In that case, complete the
installation, skipping any unsuccessful steps. See Unsuccessful installation due to invalid
account passwords for information on how to repair the unsuccessful install.

With SQL Server Authentication, PME uses three SQL accounts for its database access,
ION, ionedsd and AMUser. These accounts are created by the installer. By default, the
password for these accounts is generated automatically by the installer. The same password
is used for all three accounts.

With Windows Integrated Authentication, PME uses one Windows account for its database
access. You must choose an existing account or create a new one with the correct access
permissions. We recommend you create a new, dedicated Windows account for this.

NOTE: The Windows account for Windows Integrated Authentication must be created
outside of the PME installer. You cannot create this account through the installer.

NOTE: When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, the Windows
account that is used to access the database is also used to run the PME services and the IIS
Application Pools.

NOTE: You can change the password for the SQL accounts and update the password for the
Integrated Authentication Windows account at any time after the installation. See PME
Installer for details.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices for password creation and management.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access - such as least privilege,
separation of duties - vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to
ensure that user access adheres to the site-specific cybersecurity policies.

208 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

NOTE: For Windows Integrated Authentication, enter the Windows account User Name as
DOMAIN\UserName or COMPUTERNAME\UserName.

16. (Standalone Server and Application Server) SQL Server page:


For a Standalone Server setup type when no SQL Server instance is detected

The page indicates that SQL Server Express will be installed. Click Next.

For a Standalone Server setup type when the detected SQL Server instances include
one with the name ION

Select the database server instance, provide the necessary authentication values, and
click Next.

NOTE: The user account, Windows or SQL, that is specified in this step, is used for the
installation of PME and for future password changes. This is different from the database
accounts that are used during the operation of the software. These accounts were
defined in the previous step.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 209


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: For the Windows Authentication option, the current Windows user needs to be a
member of the sysadmin SQL Server role. For the specified SQL Server authentication
option, the SQL Server user needs to be a member of the sysadmin SQL Server role.

Select the SQL Server instance that you were planning to use with PME when you
installed or reconfigured the SQL Server.

For a Standalone Server setup type when the detected SQL Server instances do not
include one with the name ION

Select either the Install SQL Server Express on this computer option to install an
instance specifically for use with PME or select one of the detected database instances
you want to use with PME. Click Next.

NOTE: The user account, Windows or SQL, that is specified in this step, is used for
PME installation. This is different from the database accounts that are used during the
operation of the software. These accounts were defined in the previous step.

210 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

After the completion of the SQL Server Express installation, a system check is performed
to verify that the mandatory prerequisites have been met. The results of the verification
are shown on the Check System page.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices for password creation and management.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury,


equipment damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access - such as least privilege,
separation of duties - vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator
to ensure that user access adheres to the site-specific cybersecurity policies.

NOTE: We recommend that you change the SQL Server Express sa account password
after installing PME.

For an Application Server setup type

If this is the first time that you are installing an application server, the dropdown field for
the remote database server is empty. Ensure that your database server is defined in your
system network and type its name and the SQL Server instance in the Database Server
field, where the format is server_name\instance_name.

Click Next.

NOTE: The user account, Windows or SQL, that is specified in this step, is used for
PME installation. This is different from the database accounts that are used during the
operation of the software. These accounts were defined in the previous step.

NOTE: For the Windows Authentication option, the current Windows user needs to be a
member of the sysadmin SQL Server role. For the specified SQL Server authentication
option, the SQL Server user needs to be a member of the sysadmin SQL Server role.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 211


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

17. (Standalone Server and Application Server) Database Files Destination page:

For the Standalone Server setup type

This page shows the installation location for the PME databases. Click Next. Click Yes if you
are prompted to create the folder.

For the Application Server setup type

This page shows the database file location on the database server that you selected on the
Database Software page.

NOTE: Enter the path to the folder on the database server where you want to install the
database files (MDF and LDF files). The installer will create this folder if it does not exist.

212 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

18. Check System page:

The Check System page verifies that the mandatory prerequisites have been met before
proceeding. If there is a problem, the item is identified and clicking on it displays additional
information about the situation. Click Next.

Note that if you specified a Windows account other than the local system account when you
installed SQL Server, the Check System page will show that the service account under which
the SQL Server currently runs does not have the required system permissions. In that case do
one of the following:
Temporarily change the SQL Server service to run under an account that has Write
permissions to (1) the folder created for the product's databases (the default is the install
location for ...\Power Monitoring Expert\), and (2) the current logged-in user's
Temp folder. (To find the full path to the Temp folder, click Start > Run, enter %Temp%
and click OK.) The default local system account is an example of an account with these
privileges.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 213


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Temporarily grant Write permission for the two folders mentioned above to the Windows
account that the SQL Server service runs under. Use the Windows Services control panel
to identify this account. (Click Start > Administrative Tools > Services, right-click SQL
Server, click the Log On tab in the SQL Server Properties dialog.)

Revert the temporary changes after the installation of PME completes.

19. Ready to Configure page:

The Ready to Configure page summarizes your configuration for the installation of the
software. Click Install to begin the installation.

20. Copy Files page:

The Copy Files page indicates the progress as files are copied to the server as part of the
installation.

214 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

When the copy operation is complete, the system configuration process begins and is shown
on the Configure System page. Click Next when the configuration process ends.

The Configure System page shows each of the configuration steps. If a configuration step is
not successful, an X appears in a column to the left of the item. Click the link on the message
text on the right of the item to display instructions for resolving the error. If you correct the
problem, click Try Again to continue with the installation. Otherwise, cancel the install
process until you can resolve the problem.

21. Complete page:

The Complete page contains links that open the Installation Log and start the Web
Applications component, respectively.

The Installation Log summarizes the processing that took place during the installation
process. (You can access the installation log at a later time in the install location within
...\Power Monitoring Expert\SetupLogs).

Click the Web Application link to verify that Web Applications component launches
successfully in a browser.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 215


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

22. Click Close to close the installer.

216 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

After installing the software


Perform the following procedures after you install the PME software.

(Recommended) Complete the product registration


You can complete the product registration by entering your information in SETTINGS >
Registration & Analytics > Registration in Web Applications. Registered systems display a
personalized login page with customer and service provider information.

Activate software licenses


The installed software includes a 90-day trial license for all features of the product. You must
activate valid purchased software licenses within 90 days, otherwise some software functionality is
disabled.

NOTICE
LOSS OF COMMUNICATION
• Activate product and component licenses prior to the expiry of the trial license.
• Activate sufficient licenses for the servers and devices in your system.
• Export the existing hierarchy template out of Power Monitoring Expert before importing a new
template. The new template can overwrite the existing template, which can permanently
remove all information contained in the original.
• Backup or archive any SQL Server database data before adjusting any database memory
options.
• Only personnel with advanced knowledge of SQL Server databases should make database
parameter changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in loss of data.

For information on how to activate licenses, see Licensing configuration. For general information on
licensing, see Licensing.

(Recommended) Restart the system


Restart (reboot) your system.

Cybersecurity
Review the cybersecurity information. See Cybersecurity for details.

Revert write permissions for the SQL Server service


If you implemented write permissions for the SQL Server service during installation of SQL Server,
revert those changes since they are only intended as a temporary measure to ensure a successful
installation of SQL Server. See the information related to specifying the Account Name in Installing
a new SQL Server.

(Recommended) Set SQL Server memory options


Set the SQL Server memory options. See Setting SQL Server memory options for more information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 217


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Install a security certificate for TLS 1.2


PME uses Transport Layer Security (TLS) 1.2 for an encrypted, authenticated connection using
HTTPS between the server and the Web clients.

A security certificate must be installed on the PME server and must be bound to the Default Web
Site, which is used by PME. By default, if no bound certificate is detected, PME is installed with a
self-signed certificate.

RECOMMENDATION: We strongly recommend that you replace the self-signed certificate with
an authority issued certificate.

For information on how to install and bind a certificate, see Installing and binding security
certificates.

For information on how to enable HTTP connections for PME, see Enabling HTTP connections for
PME.

Windows Integrated Authentication for SQL Server


If you installed PME to use Windows Integrated Authentication, then you need to manually add the
Windows accounts for Engineering tool users to the SQL database server. This is needed for using
the tools on the PME server or on Engineering clients. Engineering tools include applications such
as Vista, Designer, Management Console, and Management Console tools.

We recommend that you:

• Create a Window group for PME Engineering Client users.

• Add the Windows group to PME as a User. See Adding a Windows group for details.

• Add the Windows group to the SQL database server with db_owner role for the PME databases.
(See work flow steps below)

• Add all users who need to access to Engineering client applications to the Windows group. All
members of this Windows group now have the required permissions to access PME and the
database through the Engineering Client applications.

• Remove the Windows account for the install user from the SQL database logins. See Before
Installing the software for more information on this account.

To add a Windows group to the SQL database server,

1. Start Microsoft SQL Server Management Studio on the database server.

2. Connect with an account with sysadmin privileges.

3. Navigate to Security > Logins, right-click Logins, and select New Login from the context
menu. This opens the Login - New window.

4. In Login - New, select Windows authentication, click Search, and locate the Windows
group you want to add.

5. In the Select a page pane on the left, select User Mapping.

6. In User Mapping, select all 4 PME databases (ApplicationModules, ION_Data, ION_Network,


ION_Systemlog), then select db_owner as database role membership.

7. Click OK.

218 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

If you don't want to create a Windows group:


To add an individual Windows user account to the SQL database server,

1. Start Microsoft SQL Server Management Studio on the database server.

2. Connect with an account with sysadmin privileges.

3. Navigate to Security > Logins, right-click Logins, and select New Login from the context
menu. This opens the Login - New window.

4. In Login - New, select Windows authentication, click Search, and locate the Windows user
you want to add.

5. In the Select a page pane on the left, select User Mapping.

6. In User Mapping, select all 4 PME databases (ApplicationModules, ION_Data, ION_Network,


ION_Systemlog), then select db_owner as database role membership.

7. Click OK.

NOTE: When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, the Windows account
that is used to access the database is also used to run the PME services and the IIS Application
Pools.

Check services
Open the Windows Services dialog and ensure that all of the necessary ION services are started.
The services run under the Local System or the NT AUTHORITY\System account, by default. You
can change the Log On As attribute of a service by specifying the account and password. Use the
Log On tab on the service properties dialog to do this. The Log On As account must have
read/write permissions on the product's installation directory, which by default is ...\Power
Monitoring Expert\.

For more information the ION Windows Services, see PME Windows services.

(Optional) Create Windows user groups


You can create Microsoft Windows local user groups on a PME primary server (that is, on the
Standalone Server or the Primary Server) as a way to manage user access through group
permissions. The table below shows the permissions assigned to an administrator group and a user
group:

Access to Access to
Group Name ...\Power Monitoring ...\Power Monitoring
Expert\system Expert\config
Administrator_Group_Name,
which is the name you create Full Control Full Control
for your administrator group.
User_Group_Name, which is
the name you create for your Read Change
user group.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 219


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Review Windows Task Scheduler


The Windows Task Scheduler has pre-configured scheduled jobs for performing backups,
maintenance, size notification, trims, and archiving (on the ION_Data database) on the PME
databases. Review these schedules and make any modifications that you require.

For more information on Database Manager and Windows Task Scheduler, see Database Manager.

Check IIS
Ensure that Internet Information Services (IIS) is working by typing the URL
http://localhost/ in the address field of your browser to display an IIS image. In some cases,
security restrictions may block access to this web page.

Set up Web Clients


Set up Web Client access in your browser, by entering the fully qualified domain name of the server
hosting PME, or its IP address, followed by the path name. The path name is configurable during the
install of the software. The default path name is /Web. Example: https://ServerName/Web or
https://10.152.35.18/Web. For more information on Web Clients, see Client types.

Configure SQL Express for Engineering Client access


An Engineering Client can connect to a Standalone Server if the TCP/IP protocol is enabled in SQL
Express. For information on how to enable this protocol, see Enabling TCP/IP protocol in SQL
Server Express.

220 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Install the PME/EBO Integration solution


Installing the PME/EBO Integration solution includes the following steps:

1. Downloading the PME/EBO Integration Toolkit

2. Installing EcoStruxure Building Operation

3. Installing the components, snippets, and binding template

4. Installing PME

5. Installing ETL (only for Architecture 1 solutions)

NOTE: Steps 1 - 4 are required for both solution architectures.

See the following sections for details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 221


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. Downloading the PME/EBO Integration Toolkit


The PME/EBO Integration Toolkit is used to integrate PME into Building Operation WorkStation.

Starting with PME 2021,

• The Toolkit contains ETL only. To get the toolkit, download the PME_EBO Integration
Tools.zip file from the Exchange Extranet (see Resources for link information). Extract the
files in the zip archive to the location on the Building Operation server, where you want to run
the tools.

• The Building Operation components, snippets, and binding template are available in PME ISO
under EBO Integration Files folder. Copy this folder to the location on the Building Operation
server, where you want to run the tools.

• The Integration Utility is a Web application settings in PME. Open the Settings page from the
SETTINGS link in the Web Applications banner and navigate to Security -> Integrations->
Integration Utility.

222 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

2. Installing Building Operation


The following describes the installation and licensing of Building Operation. Refer to the
“Installation” section in the EcoStruxure Building Operation IT Reference Guide for more
information.

To install Building Operation

1. Install License Administrator.


a. When the License Administrator installation wizard prompts, include the License
Administrator and License Server components.

b. Open License Administrator and activate the licenses.

NOTICE
LOSS OF COMMUNICATION
• Activate product and component licenses prior to the expiry of the trial license.
• Activate sufficient licenses for the servers and devices in your system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in loss of data.

2. Install Enterprise Server.

3. Install Workstation.

Changing Building Operation port settings (for single server installation only)

If Building Operation and PME are installed on the same server, you must change the ports used by
Building Operation through the Software Administrator in order to avoid conflicts between Building
Operation and PME. The default ports of 80 and 443 are reserved for PME.

To change the Building Operation server ports:

1. Open Software Administrator.

2. Click Stop Service if the service is currently running.

3. Under Communication Ports, change the values for the server ports, for example change the
HTTP Port to 8080 and the HTTPS Port to 446.

NOTE: For the HTTP server port, do not use the value 80, and for the HTTPS server port, do
not use the value 443—these values are reserved for PME.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 223


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Click Start Service, allow time for the service to start, and then click OK to exit.

After you changed the server port settings, you must modify the Building Operation Workstation
login.

To modify the Building Operation Workstation login:

1. Open Workstation.

2. Add ":446" (the HTTPS port defined above) to the server information. For example, if your
server name is "Standalone", make it appear as "Standalone:446".

3. Provide your user name and password credentials and click Log on.

224 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

3. Installing the components, snippets, and binding template


Install the components, snippets, and the binding template into Building Operation.

Components are standardized, predefined graphics that represent features in a live system. They
are located in dedicated libraries, and are displayed in the Components pane. You add components
to a graphic instead of drawing all the drawing objects yourself to simplify the graphics creation
process.

Snippets are standardized, predefined functions that typically represent a feature in a live system.
They are located in dedicated libraries, and are displayed in the Snippets pane.

The binding template is used to automatically bind EcoStruxure Web Services (EWS)
measurements or SmartWidget values to corresponding measurements in Building Operation
graphics library objects. Using the binding template, you create bindings between the Automation
Server program variables, internal values, and I/O points.

NOTE: Before you install these tools, close the Building Operation Graphics Editor.

Installing Components and Snippets


1. In File Explorer, navigate to where you copied the EBO Integration Files folder from the PME
ISO.

2. Navigate to the EBO Integration Files > Graphics Editor > Components folder.

3. Double-click each file in the Components folder. The components (ANSI Symbols, Generic
Components, IEC Symbols, and Meter Graphics) are installed in the Graphics Editor and
appear in the Components pane at the left.

4. Navigate to the EBO Integration Files > Graphics Editor > Snippets folder.

5. Double-click the file in the Snippets folder. The snippets are installed and appear in the
Snippets pane at the left.

Importing the Binding Template


1. Log on to WorkStation.

2. In the System Tree, expand Server > System.

3. Right-click Binding Templates and select Import from the list. The Open dialog appears.

4. Navigate to EBO Integration Files > WorkStation and select Power Manager - Binding
Template.xml.

5. Click Open. The Import dialog appears.

6. Click Import.

7. Click Close when the import is complete.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 225


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Installing PME
See New system install for details on how to install and license PME.

5. Installing ETL (only for Architecture 1 solutions)


The ETL is only used with Architecture 1, where it copies historical data from Building Operation to
PME. The ETL installer is included in the PME/EBO Integration Toolkit.

NOTE: On Windows Operating Systems with restricted permissions, the ETL tool might not
initialize and load its plugins on start up. This is due to limited write permission on the ETL default
install folder (...\Program Files\...). A possible solution is to install ETL to a custom folder
with write permission (for example, C:\ETL).

To install the ETL

1. In File Explorer, navigate to where you extracted the PME/EBO Integration Toolkit.

2. Navigate to PME_EBO Integration Tools, and run the ETL.exe to open the installer.

3. Follow the install pages and instructions, using the default settings where possible, until you
have completed the installation.

226 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

System update
Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for.

Topic Content
Provides information on the different types of updates, such as
Types of updates
cumulative update, hotfix, and so on.
Before updating the Provides information and reminders for you to consider before
software starting the update.
Provides detailed information on the installation of the different
Updating the software
types of updates.
After updating the software Provides procedures for you to complete after the update.

Types of updates
Cumulative Update (CU)
A CU is a PME software update that provides general product improvements. There can be more
than one CU release for a particular software version. The latest CU for a software version includes
the improvements of any previous CUs. You only need to install the latest CU; it is not necessary to
install older CUs or install them in the order in which they were released.
The following is true for a CU:

• It is a general update that is released to all PME users.

• It applies to all systems of that version of the software.

• It applies to all language versions of the software.

• It is covered by the existing licensing of the system.

• It does not change the existing trial license status on the system.

• It contains the improvements of the previous CUs for this version of the software.

• It consists of a single, executable installer.

NOTE: We recommend that you install available CUs for your version of the software. Check the
Exchange Community for information on available updates. See Resources for a link to the
Exchange Community.

NOTE: To find out which CU version is installed on your system, check Help > About in any of
the Engineering applications, or check the Windows registry at HKEY_LOCAL_
MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring
Expert\2021\CumulativeUpdate.

Hotfix
A hotfix is a PME software update that provides specific product improvements for certain
installations or applications. A hotfix is not a general product update.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 227


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The following is true for a hotfix:

• It is a specific update that is released to a targeted set of PME users.

• It applies to specific, selected systems.

• It is covered by the existing licensing of the system.

• It does not change the existing trial license status on the system.

• It can be a single file or a number of files of different types.

• It does not include an installer, it includes manual install instructions instead.

NOTE: Technical Support will help determine if a hotfix is needed for a system.

Add-on device driver


PME is installed with pre-configured support for a large number of device types, also known as
device drivers. Many more device drivers are available as downloadable add-on device drivers.
The following is true for an add-on device driver:

• It might be a general update for all PME users, or targeted at specific installations or
applications.

• It might be covered by the existing licensing of the system, or require additional licensing.

• It does not change the existing trial license status on the system.

• It consists of a compressed archive file or an executable installer file.

• The file includes the device driver and related resources, such as diagrams, measurement
mapping information, and release notes.

• It includes an installer.

NOTE: Only users with a need for the specific device type support should install an add-on device
driver on their system.

Before updating the software


Download the update
Download the update from the official download location. Do not use updates that you received from
an unknown source. Download the update in advance if you are updating a system without internet
connection.

Verify the update file integrity and authenticity


Verifying the update file integrity helps identify unexpected changes in the file caused by download
issues or by tampering with the file.

NOTE: Do not use an update file for which the integrity cannot be confirmed. In that case,
download the update again and check its integrity. Repeat this process until you have a correctly
downloaded update file with confirmed integrity.

For details on how to verify the update file integrity, see Verifying file integrity and authenticity.

228 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Confirm system compatibility


Confirm that the update is intended for your PME system before installing the update. It must be
designed for or compatible with your software version and your system must meet any other
compatibility requirements that are listed for the update.

NOTE: You cannot uninstall a Cumulative Update after it has been installed.

Review release notes


Review the release notes for the update. The release notes provide high level information on the
software changes included in the update.

Updating the software


Installing a Cumulative Update (CU)
CUs provide product improvements. See Cumulative Update (CU) for more information.

NOTE: Check the digital signature on the CU install file and confirm that it is OK and shows
Schneider Electric as the signer. Do not install the CU if the signer name is different, for example
Unknown. See Verify the update file integrity and authenticity for more information.

NOTE: PME services are stopped during the installation of a CU. This can affect communications
and data processing.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before installing the update, verify that the system is not performing critical control actions
that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system operation after the update.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Before installing the update, verify that the system data results are not used for critical
decision making that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system data results after the update.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To install a CU:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 229


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. On the PME application server computer, log in with the local Administrator Windows user
account or with an account that is a member of the Administrators group.

2. Take PME out of service by informing system users of the outage and disabling any
automated system control or third-party interactions.

3. Close all Engineering Client applications (Management Console, Vista, Designer, any
Management Console tools).

NOTE: Web client applications can remain open but might experience a service interruption
during the update.

4. Run the CU install file.

5. Follow the steps in the installer to install the update.

6. If your system includes secondary PME application servers or Engineering Clients, then you
need to install the CU on each of these servers and clients.
To install the CU on secondary servers and Engineering Clients:
a. Log into each server or client with the local Administrator Windows user account or with
an account that is a member of the Administrators group.

b. Run the CU install file.

c. Follow the steps in the installer to install the update.

7. After the installation of the CU, verify the correct operation of the PME system and put the
system back into service.

8. Restart any Web client applications that experienced a service interruption during the update.

Installing a Hotfix
A hotfix provides specific product improvements for certain installations or applications. See Hotfix
for more information.

NOTE: PME communications and data processing might be affected during the installation of a
hotfix. Review the information provided with the hotfix for more information.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before installing the update, verify that the system is not performing critical control actions
that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system operation after the update.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

230 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Before installing the update, verify that the system data results are not used for critical
decision making that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system data results after the update.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To install a hotfix, follow the instructions provided with the hotfix. A hotfix includes updates for
individual files that need to be manually installed on the system.

NOTE: Take the PME system out of service, if the hotfix instructions indicate that the system
availability is impacted during the installation. To take the system out of service, inform system
users of the outage and disable any automated system control or third party interactions.

Installing an add-on device driver


Add-on device drivers provide additional device type support for PME. See Add-on device driver for
more information.

NOTE: PME services are stopped during the installation of a CU. This can affect communications
and data processing.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before installing the update, verify that the system is not performing critical control actions
that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system operation after the update.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Before installing the update, verify that the system data results are not used for critical
decision making that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system data results after the update.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To install an add-on device driver:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 231


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. On the PME application server computer, log in with the local Administrator Windows user
account or with an account that is a member of the Administrators group.

2. Take PME out of service by informing system users of the outage and disabling any
automated system control or third party interactions.

3. On the PME application server, extract the downloaded add-on device driver archive file to a
location of your choice, for example a temporary folder.

4. Open the folder with the extracted files and double-click the .udf file. This will start the driver
installer.

NOTE: Review the release notes that are included with the driver files for any additional
information and install instructions.

5. Complete the steps in the driver install wizard.

6. Close the driver installer.

7. Done.

After updating the software


After installing a Cumulative Update (CU)
After you have installed a CU, do not simply use the Reconfigure function of the original installer of
your PME software anymore.

To reconfigure the software, after installing CUs, you must run the Reconfigure function of the
original installer first, and then run the Reconfigure function of each CU installer in sequential order.
For example, if you have installed CU1 and CU2 on your system, you must run Reconfigure on the
original PME installer, then Reconfigure on the CU1 installer, and then Reconfigure on the CU2
installer. See Reconfigure for information on this function.

232 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

System upgrade
Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for.

Topic Content
Before upgrading the Provides information and reminders for you to consider before
software starting the upgrade.
Provides detailed information on the In-Place upgrade of the PME
In-Place upgrade
software.
Provides detailed information on the Side-by-Side upgrade of the
Side-by-Side upgrade
PME software.
After upgrading the software Provides procedures for you to complete after the upgrade.
PME 2021 Upgrade notes Provides release notes related to the upgrade of PME 2021.

Before upgrading the software


Review the prerequisites
Before starting the upgrade, review the Plan chapter in this guide and confirm that your system
meets all the relevant prerequisites. In particular, review the upgrade planning, computer hardware,
operating environment, network connectivity, and licensing requirements including Upgrade
licenses. Also review the PME 2021 Upgrade notes, which provide information regarding upgrades
that is specific to the latest version of the software.

Backup the databases


Backup the ION_Data, ION_Network, ION_SystemLog, and ApplicationModules databases before
starting the upgrade. Keep the backups in a secure and safe location. Use these backups to restore
the original databases in case data is deleted or lost, accidentally, during the upgrade.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the database at regular intervals.
• Back up the database before upgrading or migrating the system.
• Back up the database before trimming it.
• Back up the database before making manual database edits.
• Verify correct database behavior after making database or system changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity
Review the cybersecurity information. See Cybersecurity for details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 233


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Upgrade Path
An upgrade path describes from which older system to which newer system PME is upgraded.
There are many possible upgrade paths, but only some are supported by the In-Place and Side-by-
Side upgrade tools and procedures. See Determine your upgrade path for information on how to
determine your upgrade path.

Upgrade Type
There are two different upgrade types, In-Place Upgrade and Side-by-Side (SBS) Upgrade. Each
type uses different tools and has different prerequisites. See Determine the upgrade type for
information on upgrade types.

Service Packs
The In-Place and SBS upgrade tools require the latest service pack versions of the older PME
systems to be installed before the upgrade. For example, PME 2021 can upgrade a PME 7.2.2
system, but it cannot upgrade a PME 7.2.0 system. If you have PME 7.2.0, you must apply the
service pack first to get the system to PME 7.2.2 before you can do an upgrade.

Your upgrade path determines if your old system requires a service pack installation before the
upgrade. See Determine your upgrade path for more information. See Upgrade tools and resources
for information on where to get the latest service packs for older versions of PME.

Operating Environment
A requirement for in-place upgrades is that the Operating System and Database Server versions are
supported by the new PME system. The Upgrade Map tool, in Determine your upgrade path,
identifies any Operating Environment perquisites for your upgrade path.

Licensing
Product licensing might have changed between the old version of PME and the new version.
Review Licensing and in particular Important notes on licensing for more information, and make sure
you have the correct licenses for the new system before starting the upgrade.

Windows Integrated Authentication for SQL Server


If you are planning to upgrade PME to use Windows Integrated Authentication, then complete the
following before starting the upgrade:

NOTE: Windows Integrated Authentication is not supported for PME systems with Secondary
Servers.

Standalone architecture

On the PME application server:

• Add the Windows account for the user who is upgrading the software to the local Administrator
group.

• Add the Windows account for the upgrade user to the SQL database logins with a sysadmin
Server Role.

234 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

NOTE: You can remove this account from the SQL database logins after PME is upgraded.

• Add the Windows account that is used by PME to access the databases to the local
Administrator group.

• Set the 'Logon As A Service' privilege for the database access account.

Distributed Database architecture

On the Windows Domain, in the Active Directory:

• Add an account for the user who is upgrading PME. This only needs to be a domain user
account, not a domain admin account.

• Add an account that PME will use to access the databases. This only needs to be a domain
user account, not a domain admin account.

On the PME application server:

• Add the account for the upgrade user to the local Administrator group.

• Add the database access account for PME to the local Administrator group.

• Set the 'Logon As A Service' privileges for the database access account.

On the database server:

• Add the account for the upgrade user to the local Administrator group.

• Add the account for the upgrade user to the SQL database logins with a sysadmin Server Role.

NOTE: You can remove this account from the SQL database logins after PME is upgraded.

NOTE: When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, the Windows account
that is used to access the database is also used to run the PME services and the IIS Application
Pools.

Upgrade troubleshooting
Rolling back an unsuccessful PME in-place upgrade
Under certain circumstances the database upgrades, which are part of the system upgrade, might
not be successful. Use the following steps to rollback an upgrade where the database upgrades
were not successful. After completing these steps, your system should be back in the state it was
in before the upgrade.
To rollback an in-place upgrade with unsuccessful database upgrades:

1. Close the PME installer.

2. Restore the PME databases from backup, using Microsoft SQL Server Management Studio.

NOTE: Backing up the databases was an optional, recommended step in the in-place
upgrade workflow of the software installer.

3. Open the Windows Service panel and start all ION services. Also, re-enable and start the
Application Modules services as follows:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 235


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: The installer stopped the ION services and disabled the Application Module services
during the upgrade.

ION Application Modules Alarm Service Host (Startup Type = Manual)

ION Application Modules Core Services Host (Startup Type = Automatic)

ION Applications Modules Data Services Host (Startup Type = Automatic)

ION Applications Modules Provider Engine Host (Startup Type = Automatic)

4. Open Internet Information Services Manager (IIS Manager) and start the PME application
pools:
Application Modules AppPool

ION AppPool

WebReporterAppPool

5. Verify that the system is operating as expected.

236 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

In-Place upgrade
Use an In-Place upgrade to upgrade an older version of PME to the latest version on the same
computer. An In-Place upgrade is done with the PME installer. The installer automatically detects
an existing, older PME installation and performs an In-Place upgrade instead of a new install.
The installer completes the following steps during an in-place upgrade:

1. (Optional) Backing up the existing PME databases.

RECOMMENDATION: We strongly recommend that you back up the databases. Database


backups are required for rolling back an unsuccessful upgrade.

2. Saving the system settings and configuration.

3. Upgrading the databases.

4. Uninstalling the old PME software.

5. Installing the new PME software.

6. Installing the old system settings and configuration.

NOTE: The same PME installer is used to upgrade a Standalone Server, Application Server, or
Engineering Client. The installer automatically detects which older components are installed and
runs the upgrade accordingly.

Upgrade instructions

NOTE: The PME system will be unavailable, after you start the upgrade, until the upgrade is
complete and the new system has been put into service.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before installing the upgrade, verify that the system is not performing critical control actions
that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system operation after the upgrade.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Before installing the upgrade, verify that the system data results are not used for critical
decision making that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system data results after the upgrade.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 237


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To upgrade the system:

1. On the PME application server computer, log in with the local Administrator Windows user
account or with an account that is a member of the Administrators group.

2. Take PME out of service by informing system users of the outage and disabling any
automated system control or third party interactions.

3. Close all PME Engineering Client applications (Management Console, Vista, Designer, any
Management Console tools).

NOTE: Web client applications can remain open but will experience a service interruption.
You need to restart web clients after the upgrade.

4. Follow the steps for Installing the PME software. Some of the installer pages differ slightly for
system upgrades and new installs. Some pages are not applicable to upgrades and will not be
shown. Simply follow the instructions on the installer pages

5. After the upgrade, verify the correct operation of the PME system and put the system back
into service.

6. Restart any web client applications that experienced a service interruption during the upgrade.

Upgrades for Distributed Database architectures


The installer upgrade workflow includes a step which provides the option to automatically back up
the databases for Standalone architectures. This option is not available for Distributed Database
architectures. For Distributed Database architectures, you need to back up the databases manually
on the database server.

238 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Side-by-Side upgrade
Use a Side-by-side (SBS) upgrade to copy the configuration of an old PME system to a new system
on a different computer. SBS upgrades are performed manually with the Configuration Manager tool.

NOTE: SBS upgrades only apply to Standalone Servers and Application Servers. There is no
SBS upgrade for Engineering Clients.

Upgrading a configuration from an old system to a new system using Configuration Manager is
accomplished in six steps and must be done in the following order:

• Step 1 – Prepare both systems

• Step 2 - Transfer the Configuration

• Step 3 - Initialize the Configuration

• Step 4 - Manually Recreate Customizations

• Step 5 - Service the System

• Step 6 - Perform a Post-upgrade System Check

See Estimated task time for SBS upgrades for information on the expected upgrade time.

NOTE: The old PME system can keep running while the configuration is upgraded. However, you
might experience some performance degradation if two systems are working with the same
monitoring devices.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 239


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Step 1 – Prepare both systems


Before upgrading, it is important to understand the operational state of both the old and the new
systems.

Assess the old system


Assess the old system by completing the following procedures:

1. Review the old PME system to see if Devices, Vista Diagrams, Reports, Web
Applications, and any other configurations are working as expected.

2. Check the system log for errors. Correct any items in error or note them down so you can
address them on the new system after the migration.

3. Look for database archives that need to be migrated.

NOTE: Verify that the database archives you want to include for upgrade are compatible
with the old PME version. Database archives that are not compatible will not be written to
the new system.

4. Check the size of the databases and consider what is needed in the new system.
Upgrading large amounts of historical data can be time consuming. Trim large databases
to avoid long upgrade times.

5. Determine whether the old report packs have been upgraded to work on the new system.
Report packs must be upgraded to be compatible with the new version of PME before they
can be installed on the new system.

6. Run the Diagnostic Tool that is found at ...\Power Monitoring


Expert\Diagnostics Tool\Diagnostics Tool.exe.

The Diagnostics Tool output provides a snapshot of the current state of the system.
Reviewing this helps in identifying current or potential issues. It is advised that you select
all the commands to run to get a full view of this system. Unzip the files (if compressed)
and open the HTML page by clicking on index.html for an overview of the results. Fix
any issues as needed before upgrading.

7. (Only for PME versions 8.2 and newer) Have a copy of the system key for the old system.

NOTE: The migration of the ION_Data database is often the most time consuming part of the
system migration. You can expect this process to take about 1 hour for each 15 GB in database
size. It is often better to trim the database or archive portions that are no longer needed before the
migration. This is especially important for large database sizes. Plan this part of the migration
carefully.

Install and assess the new system

NOTE: The procedures in this document assume that the new PME system is installed correctly
on the new computer, and that it is in a factory default configured state. Any custom configuration
that exists on the new system will be overwritten by the procedures in this document. Any custom
configuration that exists might cause the migration to fail in unexpected ways.

Install the new version of PME. See New system install for more information. After the installation
is complete, assess the new system:

240 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

1. Check a few of the basic functions such as the system log for errors, and inspect the
System Configuration Report.

2. Open the Web Applications and ensure that there are no Dashboards and that the default
Web Reports are available.

3. Run the Diagnostics Tool at ...\Power Monitoring Expert\Diagnostics


Tool\Diagnostics Tool.exe.

4. Ensure that the remaining trial license period is sufficient for transferring the source
configuration and validating the new system.

NOTE: You should have at least four times the size of the old PME databases in free hard disk
space on the new system to allow for: backups, disk usage during the database upgrade process,
and increase in the database size after the migration. Before writing a saved configuration to a
system, Configuration Manager performs a disk space check to ensure there is sufficient disk
space for the configuration and databases. If there is not enough free disk space, Configuration
Manager will display a warning.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 241


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Step 2 - Transfer the Configuration


Use Configuration Manager to transfer the configuration from the source system to the target
system.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before writing a configuration verify that the system is not performing critical control actions
that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system operation after writing a configuration.
• Verify that you are writing to the correct new, factory installed target system.
• Avoid introducing malicious software into your system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Before writing a configuration verify that the system data results are not used for critical
decision making that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system data results after writing a configuration.
• Do not introduce malicious software into your system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the system configuration before writing a new configuration.
• Verify the correctness of a configuration before writing it to the system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in irreversible database changes.

Distributed systems
For a distributed system, the target system database server and PME server must be in the same
domain.

To run the Configuration Manager on the target PME server, log into Windows with a domain
account that meets the following conditions:

• It is a member of the administrators group on the PME server.

• It has been added as a Login in SQL Server with sysadmin role in the PME database instance

242 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

NOTE: The configuration transfer will not succeed if the above conditions are not met.

To transfer the configuration:

1. On the PME application server of the old system:


a. Open Configuration Manager.

b. Click Read from System.

c. After the operation completes, review the log for errors. Correct errors that could cause
problems on the new system.

d. (Optional) Repeat steps b. and c. until the errors and warnings have been eliminated or
have a known recovery process that will be applied on the destination system.

e. (Optional) Add explanatory notes or attach files to the configuration.

f. Click Save to Archive to save the configuration to archive.

g. (Only for PME versions 8.2 and newer) Export the PME system key. This can be done
through the PME installer.

NOTE: The system key of the old source system is required to write the configuration to
the new target system. Make sure this key is available when writing the configuration
with the Configuration Manager.

h. Copy the archive file for transfer to the new system.

i. Create a backup of the ION_Data, ION_Network, and ApplicationModules databases on


the DB server using SQL Server Management Studio

j. Create a backup of any historical database archives that you want to use on the new
system.

k. Copy the database backup files for transfer to the new system.

NOTE: Keep the configuration archive and database backups secure during and after the
transfer to prevent unauthorized access.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-
specific cybersecurity policies.

2. On the new PME system:


a. Delete the existing ION_Data, ION_Network, and ApplicationModules databases on the
DB server.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 243


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

b. Restore the databases (ION_Data, ION_Network, ApplicationModules) and historical


database archives from the old system onto the new database server.

c. Log into the new PME application server Windows operating system with a domain
account that meets the conditions described above.

d. Open Configuration Manager.

e. Click Load from Archive to load the archived configuration from the old system.

f. Click Write to System to write the configuration to the new system.

NOTE: During the write to system, the Configuration Manager will prompt for the system
key from the old source system, if that system was PME version 8.2 or newer.

g. Review the log for errors. Correct any errors that will cause problems on the new system.

NOTE: The new PME system is NOT operational yet. You must manually complete the upgrade.
See the following sections for detailed information on how to complete the upgrade.

Standalone systems
To transfer the configuration:

1. On the old system:


a. Open Configuration Manager.

b. Click Read from System.

c. After the operation completes, review the log for errors. Correct errors that could cause
problems on the new system.

d. (Optional) Repeat steps b. and c. until the errors and warnings have been eliminated or
have a known recovery process that will be applied on the destination system.

e. (Optional) Add explanatory notes or attach files to the configuration.

f. Click Save to Archive. You can optionally save the historical data.

g. (Only for PME versions 8.2 and newer) Export the PME system key. This can be done
through the PME installer.

NOTE: The system key of the old source system is required to write the configuration to
the new target system. Make sure this key is available when writing the configuration
with the Configuration Manager.

h. Copy the archive file for transfer to the new system.

2. On the new PME system:


a. Open Configuration Manager.

b. Click Load from Archive to load the archived configuration from the old system.

c. Click Write to System to write the configuration to the new system.

NOTE: During the write to system, the Configuration Manager will prompt for the system

244 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

key from the old source system, if that system was PME version 8.2 or newer.

d. Review the log for errors. Correct any errors that will cause problems on the new system.

NOTE: The new PME system is NOT operational yet. You must manually complete the upgrade.
See the following sections for detailed information on how to complete the upgrade.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 245


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Step 3 - Initialize the Configuration


After you use Configuration Manager to write the configuration to the new PME system, the system
is NOT in an operational state yet. You must manually initialize the new system.

Carefully review the topics in this section to initialize the new system.

Reconfigure the System


The PME installer configures many settings when installing the software. During the configuration
transfer using Configuration Manager, some of these settings are affected and must be reconfigured
when Write to System completes.

Run the PME installer in Reconfigure mode on the target system after Write to System completes
to ensure that all application settings are configured correctly. See PME Installer for information on
Reconfigure mode.

NOTE: If manual changes to the Web Applications web.config file are required, then make those
edits before reconfiguring the system. See Step 4 - Manually Recreate Customizations and Web
Application web.config for more information.

Install Missing Drivers


PME is installed with a large number of pre-configured device types. Many more device types are
available as downloadable add-on drivers from the Exchange community. See Default device type
support for information on pre-configured device types in PME.

TIP: Configuration Manager flags missing device drivers as warnings in the Log, and indicates
whether there are newer versions that should be installed. The tool also logs warnings for drivers
that do not match the expected default for the version of PME. These could be drivers that were
installed after the release of PME, or that were modified after the install.

NOTE: Review any device driver warnings in the Configuration Manager Log. Install missing
device drivers and updated drivers to the latest versions if necessary.

For information on where to find the required device drivers, see Resources.

Custom Device Drivers


Custom device drivers that are detected by Configuration Manager on the source system will be
saved to the configuration archive. During the Write to System, the driver packages (UDF files) are
copied to the CM Migration Files folder on the target system. Review the UDF driver packages in
the CM Migration Files folder on the target system after Write to System and determine if any of
them need to be installed on the new system. To install a driver on the new system, double click the
UDF file to start the PME Driver Package installer.

SE driver replacements for older LE drivers

Some LE device drivers (drivers that were downloaded) from the old PME system may have
become Standard Edition (SE) drivers (i.e. default drivers) in the newest version. This results in two
entries in the device type list for the same type.

246 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

You can see these device type entries in the Management Console: one is an LE type carried over
from the earlier version; the other is the SE version that was installed during upgrade.

Manually changing the device type can unlink previously logged data. Therefore, an upgrade to SE
should be performed.

The original LE device type might work on the target system but it might not be as fully-featured as
the natively-released version.

NOTE: A possible consequence of upgrading the device type is that any custom diagrams may no
longer work correctly.

To upgrade the driver:

1. In Management Console right-click on the device instance to be upgraded, and select


Upgrade LE Device.

A warning message is displayed asking to confirm that it is okay to stop and restart PME
Services.

2. Click OK if this is acceptable.

Clicking OK executes the device upgrade. A message is displayed when the upgrade is
finished.

After you close the Upgrade status window, the device type of the instance will change.

This procedure applies to both CE and LE drivers listed below. The list of drivers that need to be
upgraded include:

For information on where to find downloadable device drivers, see Resources.

UDF Drivers

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 247


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Custom UDF drivers detected by Configuration Manager on the source system will be saved to the
configuration archive. During the Write to System, the driver packages (UDF files) are copied to the
CM Migration Files folder on the target system. Review the UDF driver packages in the CM
Migration Files folder on the target system after Write to System and determine if any of them need
to be installed on the new system. To install a driver on the new system, double click the UDF file to
start the PME Driver Package installer.

Reports Database
Verify that the correct reporting database is selected.

To verify the reports database:

1. Open Management Console.

2. Under Tools > Reports Configuration, click Location of report data in the Reports tab
and confirm that it is set to the database that you want to report on.

Web report subscriptions


Since the system was moved from one computer to another, it is possible that file paths that were
previously configured for saving reports as part of a subscription need to be changed. See
Subscribing to a report for more information.

248 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Step 4 - Manually Recreate Customizations


Configuration Manager copies all configuration files to the target system, however, it does not install
all configuration files on the new target system because:

1. The source system contains customizations that cannot be automatically transferred by


Configuration Manager.

2. The target system contains new default values and changes that should not be overwritten.

Configuration Manager copies all customized configuration files that are not automatically installed
in the system to ...\Power Monitoring Expert\CM Migration Files

For example:

Review this folder and decide which customizations you want to recreate on the new system.

The topics that comprise this section consist of all possible configuration customizations. However,
most systems in the field only use a small subset of these.

Alert Monitor

NOTE: The Alert Monitor feature is no longer available in PME.

Custom Report Templates


Report templates must be compatible with the version of PME that they are running on. Older
versions of custom report templates are not compatible with newer versions of PME.

To upgrade the templates to versions that are supported on the new PME system:

Copy compatible templates onto the target system and install them after Configuration Manager has
finished the Write to System.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 249


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Default Device Drivers


It is possible to customize device drivers in PME, for example by adding software logging with the
Device Type Editor. The customizations are stored in the ION and XML translator files under
...\config\translators.

To recreate default device driver customizations from the source system:

1. Navigate to ...\Power Monitoring Expert\CM Migration Files.

2. Determine whether the files copied to the CM Migration Files folder were customized.

3. Manually recreate any desired customizations on the target system by customizing the
new version of the driver.

NOTE: Since this process may need to be followed for any future PME upgrades, note the
customizations for future upgrades.

Dial Out Modems


Any modems—physical or WinModem—that were used on the source system to connect to remote
devices, or equivalent hardware resources, need to be setup and configured on the target computer
or operating system.

Check the communication port mappings as they may be different.

Test each modem or serial port to verify that everything works as expected.

EWS User
If you are upgrading from PME 7.2.2, you must create an EWS user account on the new systems.

NOTE: EWS server must be enabled in PME for the user account configuration UI to be visible in
the Web Applications Settings.

To create an EWS user account in PME:

1. Ensure EWS server is enabled.

2. Open the Web Applications.

3. Under SETTINGS > Integrations > EWS Login, click Set Credentials.

4. Enter a User name and Password and click Save.

NOTE: Update all EWS clients with the new account details.

EWS Server Settings


It is possible to customize EWS configuration parameters, create custom device type extension
files, and customize default device type extension files.

To recreate customized EWS configuration parameters:

250 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

1. In Windows Explorer, navigate to ...Power Monitoring


Expert\Applications\EWS\web.config.

2. Compare the target default file to the source files in the CM Migration Files folder.

3. Manually recreate the settings you want to use on the target system.

To recreate custom device type extension files for EWS:

1. In Windows Explorer, navigate to ...Power Monitoring


Expert\system\WebServices\Extensions\.

2. Compare the target default files to the source files in the CM Migration Files folder.

3. Copy the custom device type definition XML files that you want to include to the new system.

To recreate customized default device type extension files:

1. In Windows Explorer, navigate to ...Power Monitoring


Expert\system\WebServices\Extensions\.

2. Compare the target default files to the source files in the CM Migration Files folder.

3. Recreate the customized default device type definitions you want to use on the target system.

Update EWS Server


In Management Console, select Tools > System > Update EWS Server to initialize the
EWS server. (This step is only needed if EWS is used in the target system.)

LogInserter and Query Server


LogInserter and Query Server in PME are controlled by the settings and configuration of the Log
Acquisition and Query modules.

NOTE: Customization to these files is quite rare. Determine whether PME performance
enhancements require the recreation the LogInserter and Query Server customizations.

To recreate the module customizations:

1. In Windows Explorer, navigate to ...Power Monitoring


Expert\config\cfg\logsrv\ and open the module configuration files.

2. Compare the target default files to the source files in the CM Migration Files folder.

3. In ION Designer, open LogInserter and edit the Log Acquisition and Query modules to include
the source customizations.

OPC Server Settings


It is possible to create custom device type definitions, or customize the default device type
definitions for OPC, and customize DefaultMeasurements.xml.

To recreate custom device type definitions from the source system:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 251


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. Check the CM Migration Files folder to see if there are any custom device type
definitions for OPC.

2. In Windows Explorer, navigate to ...Power Monitoring


Expert\system\IONServices\DefaultMeasurementsExt\ and copy the custom
device type definition XML files that you want to include to the new system.

To recreate customized default device type definitions from the source system:

1. In Windows Explorer, navigate to ...Power Monitoring


Expert\system\IONServices\DefaultMeasurementsExt\.

2. Check the default device type extension XML files from the source in the CM Migration
Files folder.

3. Recreate the customized default device type definitions that you want to include to the new
system.

To recreate customizations in DefaultMeasurements.xml:

1. Check the DefaultMeasurements.xml copied to the CM Migration Files folder to


see if it was customized.

2. In Windows Explorer, navigate to ...Power Monitoring


Expert\system\IONServices\.

3. From a sub directory, duplicate an existing OPC ext.xml file.

NOTE: These files are merged in memory into the master DefaultMeasurements.xml
file without needing to modify the master file.

4. Open the file, delete the content of the original device and then replace it with the new device
content.

5. Save the file.

Update OPC Server
In Management Console, select Tools > System > Update OPC Server to initialize the
OPC server. (This step is needed only if OPC is used in the target system.)

PQDIF Exporter
Configuration Manager does not automatically install the PQDIF configuration files because the
older files are not compatible with the newer version of PME.

To update the PQDIF configuration files:

1. In Windows Explorer, navigate to ...Power Monitoring


Expert\config\exporters\PQDIF\.

2. Compare the target default files to the source files in the CM Migration Files folder.

3. Recreate the customized PQDIF configuration files that you want to include to the new
system.

252 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Update PQDIF Exporter Database Connection


To update the PQDIF exporter database connection:

1. In Windows Explorer, navigate to ...Power Monitoring


Expert\config\exporters\PQDIF\config\.

2. Open PQDIFExporterConfig.xml and edit the file to specify database connection


settings.

PME Registry Keys


Configuration Manager installs the NetworkDiagram key, any custom DeviceInfo keys, and
the Cloud Agent keys (if the source system was registered) on the target system. Any other
customizations to the registry must be recreated manually.

To recreate PME registry keys:

1. Review the source registry keys in the CM Migration FilesSystem


Registry\system\Registry\Registry.xml.

2. Recreate any customized registry keys on that you want to use on the target system.

PME Services
Configuration Manager does not transfer customizations in services settings from the source to the
target.

Recreate PME Services settings customizations in service settings using Microsoft Windows
Services.

Additionally, custom VIPs need to be manually started after Configuration Manager completes the
Write to System and the system is ready to be put into service.

Scheduled Jobs
Configuration Manager does not automatically install scheduled jobs from the source system to the
target system.

To recreate scheduled jobs on the new system:

1. In the CM Migration Files folder, check the copied files or review the scheduled jobs on
the source system and then compare it to the target system configuration.

2. Recreate any desired customizations manually on the target system.

NOTE: Ensure that the user permissions for Windows Task Scheduler are set correctly on the
target system.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 253


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Web Application Custom Tabs


Configuration Manager does not automatically recreate any custom tabs or links on the target
system. If you used custom tabs in the source system, you need to manually recreate those tabs in
the target system. See Customizing the Web Applications links and Adding idle detection to custom
Web Application links for more information.

Web Application web.config


Configuration Manager does not automatically install the source system web.config file on the
target system because there could settings in the file that are incompatible between source and
target system.

To recreate web.config customizations:

1. In the CM Migration Files folder, check the copied web.config file and compare it to
the target system default web.config file in
...\Applications\SystemDataService\.

2. Back up web.config on the target system and then edit the file as needed.

NOTE: You must reconfigure the system after editing the Web Applications web.config file. That
means you have to return to Step 3 - Initialize the Configuration in the workflow.

Web Report Packs


Report packs must be compatible with the version of PME they are running on; older versions of
custom report packs are not compatible with newer versions of PME. Upgrade the report packs to
versions that are supported on the newer PME system before installing them.

254 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Step 5 - Service the System


After manually recreating configuration customizations, the system is ready to be put into service.
Review the steps in this section to finalize the system transfer.

System reboot
At this point, many configuration changes are complete and it is recommended that you reboot the
system.

PME Hotfixes
If the target system had any hotfixes applied to it before you ran the Reconfigure step, they need to
be reinstalled after you reboot the system.

Clear browser cache


Following a configuration transfer, it is recommended that you:

1. Delete the browser cache.

This will clear any old configurations or cached pages that might have been on the system
before the transfer. If you are unsure about how to do this, an Internet search can help you
find out how to delete the cache on every supported browser.

2. Re-run saved Web reports and re-save them.

This ensures that the reports can be read correctly on the new system.

Enable Server, Sites, and Devices


Configuration Manager leaves the server, sites, and devices in a disabled state after Write to
System. This is a safety precaution to ensure that the PME system does not go into service until it
is ready and its correct configuration has been verified.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software or devices for critical control or protection applications where human
or equipment safety relies on the operation of the control action.
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

Perform all required manual tasks, especially installing missing device drivers, and then enable the
server, sites, and devices through the Management Console.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 255


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Test that each device can display the default diagram. If communication problems exist, address
them before proceeding.

256 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Step 6 - Perform a Post-upgrade System Check


Verify that the new system is configured correctly. Use the checklist below to do a system walk-
through. For each item in the checklist, make sure the system behaves the way you expect.

For example:

• Are all devices configured and communicating?

• Is all the information present?

• Are measurements being displayed and are they updating?

• Are reports running and returning the expected data?

NOTE: You might have to configure some of the new features, that did not exist in the old version
of PME, before they can be used.

Checklist

NOTE: The following list is intended to be a starting point for your system check. Each system
configuration is different. Your system might require additional checks to verify the correct
configuration. Test your system carefully to ensure it is functioning as expected.

To perform a walk-through on your new system:

1. Check the system log in the Management Console for errors.

2. Check the Devices, Sites, and other settings in Management Console.

3. Check the availability of the archived databases for reporting in Reports Configuration in
the Management Console.

4. Log into Vista, verify the network diagram, real time data, and data logs.

5. Verify that Vista diagram links function.

6. Check the data and functions provided by the VIPs.

7. Log into the Web Applications.

8. Run the Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, and Reports.

9. In Web Reporter, run saved/custom reports and verify the report subscription.

10. Check any scheduled tasks.

11. Review the user accounts and passwords to ensure they meet your cybersecurity
requirements.

12. Review the alarm configuration.

13. Review the Software Modules configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 257


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

After upgrading the software


Perform the following procedures after you upgrade the PME software.

Activate software licenses

NOTICE
LOSS OF COMMUNICATION
• Activate product and component licenses prior to the expiry of the trial license.
• Activate sufficient licenses for the servers and devices in your system.
• Export the existing hierarchy template out of Power Monitoring Expert before importing a new
template. The new template can overwrite the existing template, which can permanently
remove all information contained in the original.
• Backup or archive any SQL Server database data before adjusting any database memory
options.
• Only personnel with advanced knowledge of SQL Server databases should make database
parameter changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in loss of data.

For In-Place upgrades:

The newly installed software includes a 90-day trial license for all features of the product. You must
activate valid purchased software licenses within 90 days, otherwise some software functionality is
disabled.
For SBS upgrades:

The newly installed software includes a 90-day trial license for all features of the product. You must
activate valid purchased software licenses within 90 days, otherwise some software functionality is
disabled.

After you are satisfied with the new system, return your old licenses and then activate the licenses
on the new PME system.

NOTE: After you return the licenses, the old system is no longer functional.

For information on how to activate licenses, see Licensing configuration. For general information on
licensing, see Licensing.

(Recommended) Restart the system


Restart (reboot) your system.

Verify correct database behavior


Verify that the system can access the databases by checking configuration settings and historical
data logs. Confirm that the amount of historical data in the database is as expected. Use the
database backups to restore any data that might have been deleted or lost, accidentally, during the
upgrade.

258 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the database at regular intervals.
• Back up the database before upgrading or migrating the system.
• Back up the database before trimming it.
• Back up the database before making manual database edits.
• Verify correct database behavior after making database or system changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity
Review the cybersecurity information. See Cybersecurity for details.

Install a security certificate for TLS 1.2


See Install a security certificate for TLS 1.2 in the Install section of this guide for details.

Windows Integrated Authentication for SQL Server


If you upgraded PME to use Windows Integrated Authentication, then you need to manually add the
Windows accounts for Engineering tool users to the SQL database server. This is needed for using
the tools on the PME server or on Engineering clients. Engineering tools include applications such
as Vista, Designer, Management Console, and Management Console tools.

We recommend that you:

• Create a Windows group for PME Engineering Client users.

• Add the Windows group to PME as a User. See Adding a Windows group for details.

• Add the Windows group to the SQL database server with db_owner role for the PME databases.
(See work flow steps below)

• Add all users who need to access to Engineering client applications to the Windows group. All
members of this Windows group now have the required permissions to access PME and the
database through the Engineering Client applications.

• Remove the Windows account for the upgrade user from the SQL database logins. See Before
upgrading the software for more information on this account.

To add a Windows group to the SQL database server,

1. Start Microsoft SQL Server Management Studio on the database server.

2. Connect with an account with sysadmin privileges.

3. Navigate to Security > Logins, right-click Logins, and select New Login from the context
menu. This opens the Login - New window.

4. In Login - New, select Windows authentication, click Search, and locate the Windows
group you want to add.

5. In the Select a page pane on the left, select User Mapping.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 259


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

6. In User Mapping, select all 4 PME databases (ApplicationModules, ION_Data, ION_Network,


ION_Systemlog), then select db_owner as database role membership.

7. Click OK.

If you don't want to create a Windows group:


To add an individual Windows user account to the SQL database server,

1. Start Microsoft SQL Server Management Studio on the database server.

2. Connect with an account with sysadmin privileges.

3. Navigate to Security > Logins, right-click Logins, and select New Login from the context
menu. This opens the Login - New window.

4. In Login - New, select Windows authentication, click Search, and locate the Windows user
you want to add.

5. In the Select a page pane on the left, select User Mapping.

6. In User Mapping, select all 4 PME databases (ApplicationModules, ION_Data, ION_Network,


ION_Systemlog), then select db_owner as database role membership.

7. Click OK.

NOTE: When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, the Windows account
that is used to access the database is also used to run the PME services and the IIS Application
Pools.

Check services
Open the Windows Services dialog and ensure that all of the necessary ION services are started.
The services run under the Local System account, by default. You can change the Log On As
attribute of a service by specifying the account and password. Use the Log On tab on the service
properties dialog to do this. The Log On As account must have read/write permissions on the
product's installation directory, which by default is ...\Schneider Electric\Power
Monitoring Expert.

For more information on the ION Windows Services, see PME Windows services.

(For Standalone architecture only) Review Windows Task Scheduler


The Windows Task Scheduler has preconfigured scheduled jobs for performing backups,
maintenance, size notification, trims, and archiving (on the ION_Data database) on the PME
databases. Review these schedules and make any modifications that you require.

For more information on Database Manager and Windows Task Scheduler, see Database Manager.

Check IIS
Confirm that Internet Information Services (IIS) is working by typing the URL
http://localhost/ in the address field of your browser to display an IIS image. In some cases,
security restrictions may block access to this web page.

260 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

(Optional) Configure first time Alarms processing


After the upgrade, the Alarms Web application processes existing Power Quality data the first time
it starts up. This processing can be very time consuming. You can control how much of the existing
data is processed to reduce the processing time. See Configuring first time Alarms processing for
more information.

Set up Web Clients


Set up Web Client access in your browser, by entering the fully qualified domain name of the server
hosting PME, or its IP address, followed by the path name. The path name is configurable during the
install of the software. The default path name is /Web. Example: https://ServerName/Web or
https://10.152.35.18/Web. For more information on Web Clients, see Client types.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 261


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

System migration
Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for.

Topic Content
Before migrating the Provides information and reminders for you to consider before
software starting the migration.
System migration Provides detailed information on the migration of the PME software.
After migrating the software Provides procedures for you to complete after the migration.

Before migrating the software


Review the prerequisites
Before starting the migration, review the Plan chapter in this guide and confirm that your system
meets all the relevant prerequisites. In particular, review the computer hardware, operating
environment, network connectivity, and licensing requirements, including System migration and
license returns. Also review the PME 2021 Install notes and PME 2021 Upgrade notes, which
provide information that is specific to the latest version of the software.

Backup the databases


Backup the ION_Data, ION_Network, ION_SystemLog, and ApplicationModules databases before
starting the migration. Keep the backups in a secure and safe location. Use these backups to
restore the original databases in case data is deleted or lost, accidentally, during the migration.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the database at regular intervals.
• Back up the database before upgrading or migrating the system.
• Back up the database before trimming it.
• Back up the database before making manual database edits.
• Verify correct database behavior after making database or system changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity
Review the cybersecurity information. See Cybersecurity for details.

Windows Integrated Authentication for SQL Server


If you are planning to install PME with Windows Integrated Authentication on the new system, see
Windows Integrated Authentication for SQL Server for up-front configuration steps.

262 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

NOTE: Windows Integrated Authentication is not supported for PME systems with Secondary
Servers.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 263


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

System migration
Use a system migration to copy the configuration of one PME system to another PME system on a
different computer. System migrations are performed manually with the Configuration Manager tool.

NOTE: System migration only applies to Standalone Serves and Application Servers. There is no
migration for Engineering Clients.

Migrating a configuration from an old system to a new system using Configuration Manager is
accomplished in six steps and must be done in the following order:

• Step 1 – Prepare both systems

• Step 2 - Transfer the Configuration

• Step 3 - Initialize the Configuration

• Step 4 - Manually Recreate Customizations

• Step 5 - Service the System

• Step 6 - Perform a Post-migration System Check

See Estimated task time for SBS upgrades for information on the expected upgrade time.

NOTE: The old PME system can keep running while the configuration is migrated. However, you
might experience some performance degradation if two systems are working with the devices.

264 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Step 1 – Prepare both systems


Before migrating, it is important to understand the operational state of both the old and the new
systems.

Assess the old system


Assess the old system by completing the following procedures:

1. Review the old PME system to see if Devices, Vista Diagrams, Reports, and any other
configurations are working as expected.

2. Check the system log for errors. Correct any items in error or note them down so you can
address them on the new system after the migration.

3. Check the size of the historical data database (ION_Data) and look for database archives
that need to be migrated.

4. Check the size of the databases and consider what is needed in the new system.
Transferring large amounts of historical data can be time consuming. Trim large databases
to avoid long transfer times.

5. Run the Diagnostic Tool that is found at ...\Power Monitoring


Expert\Diagnostics Tool\Diagnostics Tool.exe.

The Diagnostics Tool output provides a snapshot of the current state of the system.
Reviewing this helps in identifying current or potential issues. It is advised that you select
all the commands to run to get a full view of this system. Unzip the files (if compressed)
and open the HTML page by clicking on index.html for an overview of the results. Fix
any issues as needed before upgrading.

6. Have a copy of the system key for the old system.

NOTE: The migration of the ION_Data database is often the most time consuming part of the
system migration. You can expect this process to take about 1 hour for each 15 GB in database
size. It is often better to trim the database or archive portions that are no longer needed before the
migration. This is especially important for large database sizes. Plan this part of the migration
carefully.

Install and assess the new system

NOTE: The procedures in this document assume that the new PME system is installed correctly
on the new computer, and that it is in a factory default configured state. Any custom configuration
that exists on the new system will be overwritten by the procedures in this document. Any custom
configuration that exists might cause the migration to fail in unexpected ways.

Install the new version of PME. See New system install for more information. After the installation
is complete, assess the new system:

1. Check a few of the basic functions such as the system log for errors, and inspect the
System Configuration Report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 265


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2. Open the Web Applications and ensure that there are no Dashboards and that the default
Web Reports are available.

3. Run the Diagnostics Tool at ...\Power Monitoring Expert\Diagnostics


Tool\Diagnostics Tool.exe.

4. Ensure that the remaining trial license period is sufficient for transferring the source
configuration and validating the new system.

NOTE: You should have at least four times the size of the old PME databases in free hard disk
space on the new system to allow for: backups, disk usage during the database upgrade process,
and increase in the database size after the migration. Before writing a saved configuration to a
system, Configuration Manager performs a disk space check to ensure there is sufficient disk
space for the configuration and databases. If there is not enough free disk space, Configuration
Manager will display a warning.

266 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Step 2 - Transfer the Configuration


Use Configuration Manager to transfer the configuration from the source system to the target
system.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before writing a configuration verify that the system is not performing critical control actions
that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system operation after writing a configuration.
• Verify that you are writing to the correct new, factory installed target system.
• Avoid introducing malicious software into your system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Before writing a configuration verify that the system data results are not used for critical
decision making that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system data results after writing a configuration.
• Do not introduce malicious software into your system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the system configuration before writing a new configuration.
• Verify the correctness of a configuration before writing it to the system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in irreversible database changes.

Distributed systems
For a distributed system, the target system database server and PME server must be in the same
domain.

To run the Configuration Manager on the target PME server, log into Windows with a domain
account that meets the following conditions:

• It is a member of the administrators group on the PME server

• It has been added as a Login in SQL Server with sysadmin role in the PME database instance

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 267


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: The configuration transfer will not succeed if the above conditions are not met.

To transfer the configuration:

1. On the old system:


a. Open Configuration Manager.

b. Click Read from System.

c. After the operation completes, review the log for errors. Correct errors that could cause
problems on the new system.

d. (Optional) Repeat steps b. and c. until the errors and warnings have been eliminated or
have a known recovery process that will be applied on the destination system.

e. (Optional) Add explanatory notes or attach files to the configuration.

f. Click Save to Archive to save the configuration to archive.

g. Export the PME system key. This can be done through the PME installer.

NOTE: The system key of the old source system is required to write the configuration to
the new target system. Make sure this key is available when writing the configuration
with the Configuration Manager.

h. Copy the archive file for transfer to the new system.

i. Create a backup of the ION_Data, ION_Network, and ApplicationModules databases on


the DB server using SQL Server Management Studio

j. Create a backup of any historical database archives that you want to use on the new
system.

k. Copy the database backup files for transfer to the new system.

NOTE: Keep the configuration archive and database backups secure during and after the
transfer to prevent unauthorized access.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-
specific cybersecurity policies.

2. On the new PME system:


a. Delete the existing ION_Data, ION_Network, and ApplicationModules databases on the
DB server.

268 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

b. Restore the databases (ION_Data, ION_Network, ApplicationModules) and historical


database archives from the old system onto the new database server.

c. Log into the new PME server Windows operating system with a domain account that
meets the conditions described above.

d. Open Configuration Manager.

e. Click Load from Archive to load the archived configuration from the old system.

f. Click Write to System to write the configuration to the new system.

NOTE: During the write to system, the Configuration Manager will prompt for the system
key from the old source system.

g. Review the log for errors. Correct any errors that will cause problems on the new system.

Standalone systems
To transfer the configuration:

1. On the old system:


a. Open Configuration Manager.

b. Click Read from System.

c. After the operation completes, review the log for errors. Correct errors that could cause
problems on the new system.

d. (Optional) Repeat steps b. and c. until the errors and warnings have been eliminated or
have a known recovery process that will be applied on the destination system.

e. (Optional) Add explanatory notes or attach files to the configuration.

f. Click Save to Archive. You can optionally save the historical data.

g. Export the PME system key. This can be done through the PME installer.

NOTE: The system key of the old source system is required to write the configuration to
the new target system. Make sure this key is available when writing the configuration
with the Configuration Manager.

h. Copy the archive file for transfer to the new system.

2. On the new PME system:


a. Open Configuration Manager.

b. Click Load from Archive to load the archived configuration from the old system.

c. Click Write to System to write the configuration to the new system.

NOTE: During the write to system, the Configuration Manager will prompt for the system
key from the old source system.

d. Review the log for errors. Correct any errors that will cause problems on the new system.

NOTE: The new PME system is NOT operational yet. You must manually complete the migration.
See the following sections for detailed information on how to complete the migration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 269


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Step 3 - Initialize the Configuration


After you use Configuration Manager to write the configuration to the new PME system, the system
is NOT in an operational state yet. You must manually initialize the new system.

Carefully review the topics in this section to initialize the new system.

Reconfigure the System


The PME installer configures many settings when installing the software. During the configuration
transfer using Configuration Manager, some of these settings are affected and must be reconfigured
when Write to System completes.

Run the PME installer in Reconfigure mode on the target system after Write to System completes
to ensure that all application settings are configured correctly. See PME Installer for information on
Reconfigure mode.

Install Missing Drivers


PME is installed with a large number of pre-configured device types. Many more device types are
available as downloadable add-on drivers from the Exchange community. See Default device type
support for information on pre-configured device types in PME.

TIP: Configuration Manager flags missing device drivers as warnings in the Log, and indicates
whether there are newer versions that should be installed. The tool also logs warnings for drivers
that do not match the expected default for the version of PME. These could be drivers that were
installed after the release of PME, or that were modified after the install.

NOTE: Review any device driver warnings in the Configuration Manager Log. Install missing
device drivers and updated drivers to the latest versions if necessary.

For information on where to find the required device drivers, see Resources.

Reports Database
Verify that the correct reporting database is selected.

To verify the reports database:

1. Open Management Console.

2. Under Tools > Reports Configuration, click Location of report data in the Reports tab
and confirm that it is set to the database that you want to report on.

Web report subscriptions


Since the system was moved from one computer to another, it is possible that file paths that were
previously configured for saving reports as part of a subscription need to be changed. See
Subscribing to a report for more information.

270 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Step 4 - Manually Recreate Customizations


Configuration Manager copies all configuration files to the target system, however, it does not install
all configuration files on the new target system because:

1. The source system contains customizations that cannot be automatically transferred by


Configuration Manager.

2. The target system contains new default values and changes that should not be overwritten.

Configuration Manager copies all customized configuration files that are not automatically installed
in the system to ...\Power Monitoring Expert\CM Migration Files

For example:

Review this folder and decide which customizations you want to recreate on the new system.

The topics that comprise this section consist of all possible configuration customizations. However,
most systems in the field only use a small subset of these.

Alert Monitor

NOTE: The Alert Monitor feature is no longer available in PME.

Dial Out Modems


Any modems—physical or WinModem—that were used on the source system to connect to remote
devices, or equivalent hardware resources, need to be setup and configured on the target computer
or operating system.

Check the communication port mappings as they may be different.

Test each modem or serial port to verify that everything works as expected.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 271


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Update EWS Server


In Management Console, select Tools > System > Update EWS Server to initialize the
EWS server. (This step is only needed if EWS is used in the target system.)

LogInserter and Query Server


LogInserter and Query Server in PME are controlled by the settings and configuration of the Log
Acquisition and Query modules.

NOTE: Customization to these files is quite rare. Determine whether PME performance
enhancements require the recreation the LogInserter and Query Server customizations.

To recreate the module customizations:

1. In Windows Explorer, navigate to ...Power Monitoring


Expert\config\cfg\logsrv\ and open the module configuration files.

2. Compare the target default files to the source files in the CM Migration Files folder.

3. In ION Designer, open LogInserter and edit the Log Acquisition and Query modules to include
the source customizations.

Update OPC Server
In Management Console, select Tools > System > Update OPC Server to initialize the
OPC server. (This step is needed only if OPC is used in the target system.)

Update PQDIF Exporter Database Connection


To update the PQDIF exporter database connection:

1. In Windows Explorer, navigate to ...Power Monitoring


Expert\config\exporters\PQDIF\config\.

2. Open PQDIFExporterConfig.xml and edit the file to specify database connection


settings.

PME Registry Keys


Configuration Manager installs the NetworkDiagram key, any custom DeviceInfo keys, and
the Cloud Agent keys (if the source system was registered) on the target system. Any other
customizations to the registry must be recreated manually.

To recreate PME registry keys:

1. Review the source registry keys in the CM Migration FilesSystem


Registry\system\Registry\Registry.xml.

2. Recreate any customized registry keys on that you want to use on the target system.

272 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

PME Services
Configuration Manager does not transfer customizations in services settings from the source to the
target.

Recreate PME Services settings customizations in service settings using Microsoft Windows
Services.

Additionally, custom VIPs need to be manually started after Configuration Manager completes the
Write to System and the system is ready to be put into service.

Scheduled Jobs
Configuration Manager does not automatically install scheduled jobs from the source system to the
target system.

To recreate scheduled jobs on the new system:

1. In the CM Migration Files folder, check the copied files or review the scheduled jobs on
the source system and then compare it to the target system configuration.

2. Recreate any desired customizations manually on the target system.

NOTE: Ensure that the user permissions for Windows Task Scheduler are set correctly on the
target system.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 273


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Step 5 - Service the System


After manually recreating configuration customizations, the system is ready to be put into service.
Review the steps in this section to finalize the system transfer.

System reboot
At this point, many configuration changes are complete and it is recommended that you reboot the
system.

PME Hotfixes
If the target system had any hotfixes applied to it before you ran the Reconfigure step, they need to
be reinstalled after you reboot the system.

Clear browser cache


Following a configuration transfer, it is recommended that you:

1. Delete the browser cache.

This will clear any old configurations or cached pages that might have been on the system
before the transfer. If you are unsure about how to do this, an Internet search can help you
find out how to delete the cache on every supported browser.

2. Re-run saved Web reports and re-save them.

This ensures that the reports can be read correctly on the new system.

Enable Server, Sites, and Devices


Configuration Manager leaves the server, sites, and devices in a disabled state after Write to
System. This is a safety precaution to ensure that the PME system does not go into service until it
is ready and its correct configuration has been verified.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software or devices for critical control or protection applications where human
or equipment safety relies on the operation of the control action.
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

Perform all required manual tasks, especially installing missing device drivers, and then enable the
server, sites, and devices through the Management Console.

274 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Test that each device can display the default diagram. If communication problems exist, address
them before proceeding.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 275


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Step 6 - Perform a Post-migration System Check


Verify that the new system is configured correctly. Use the checklist below to do a system walk-
through. For each item in the checklist, make sure the system behaves the way you expect.

For example:

• Are all devices configured and communicating?

• Is all the information present?

• Are measurements being displayed and are they updating?

• Are reports running and returning the expected data?

Checklist

NOTE: The following list is intended to be a starting point for your system check. Each system
configuration is different. Your system might require additional checks to verify the correct
configuration. Test your system carefully to ensure it is functioning as expected.

To perform a walk-through on your new system:

1. Check the system log in the Management Console for errors.

2. Check the Devices, Sites, and other settings in Management Console.

3. Check the availability of the archived databases for reporting in Reports Configuration in
the Management Console.

4. Log into Vista, verify the network diagram, real time data, and data logs.

5. Verify that Vista diagram links function.

6. Check the data and functions provided by the VIPs.

7. Log into the Web Applications.

8. Run the Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, and Reports.

9. In Web Reporter, run saved/custom reports and verify the report subscription.

10. Check any scheduled tasks.

11. Review the user accounts and passwords to ensure they meet your cybersecurity
requirements.

12. Review the alarm configuration.

13. Review the Software Modules configuration.

276 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

After migrating the software


Perform the following procedures after you migrate the PME software.

Activate software licenses

NOTICE
LOSS OF COMMUNICATION
• Activate product and component licenses prior to the expiry of the trial license.
• Activate sufficient licenses for the servers and devices in your system.
• Export the existing hierarchy template out of Power Monitoring Expert before importing a new
template. The new template can overwrite the existing template, which can permanently
remove all information contained in the original.
• Backup or archive any SQL Server database data before adjusting any database memory
options.
• Only personnel with advanced knowledge of SQL Server databases should make database
parameter changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in loss of data.

The installed software includes a 90-day trial license for all features of the product. You must
activate valid purchased software licenses within 90 days, otherwise some software functionality is
disabled.

After you are satisfied with the new system, return your old licenses and then activate the licenses
on the new PME system.

NOTE: After you return the licenses, the old system is no longer functional.

For information on how to activate licenses, see Licensing configuration. For general information on
licensing, see Licensing.

(Recommended) Restart the system


Restart (reboot) your system.

Verify correct database behavior


Verify that the system can access the databases by checking configuration settings and historical
data logs. Confirm that the amount of historical data in the database is as expected. Use the
database backups to restore any data that might have been deleted or lost, accidentally, during the
migration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 277


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the database at regular intervals.
• Back up the database before upgrading or migrating the system.
• Back up the database before trimming it.
• Back up the database before making manual database edits.
• Verify correct database behavior after making database or system changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity
Review the cybersecurity information. See Cybersecurity for details.

Windows Integrated Authentication for SQL Server


If you installed the new PME system with Windows Integrated Authentication, see Windows
Integrated Authentication for SQL Server for post-install configuration steps.

Check services
Open the Windows Services dialog and ensure that all of the necessary ION services are started.
The services run under the Local System account, by default. You can change the Log On As
attribute of a service by specifying the account and password. Use the Log On tab on the service
properties dialog to do this. The Log On As account must have read/write permissions on the
product's installation directory, which by default is ...\Schneider Electric\Power
Monitoring Expert.

For more information the ION Windows Services, see PME Windows services.

(For Standalone architecture only) Review Windows Task Scheduler


The Windows Task Scheduler has preconfigured scheduled jobs for performing backups,
maintenance, size notification, trims, and archiving (on the ION_Data database) on the PME
databases. Review these schedules and make any modifications that you require.

For more information on Database Manager and Windows Task Scheduler, see Database Manager.

Check IIS
Ensure that Internet Information Services (IIS) is working by typing the URL
http://localhost/ in the address field of your browser to display an IIS image. In some cases,
security restrictions may block access to this web page.

Set up Web Clients


Set up Web Client access in your browser, by entering the fully qualified domain name of the server
hosting PME, or its IP address, followed by the path name. The path name is configurable during the
install of the software. The default path name is /Web. Example: https://ServerName/Web or
https://10.152.35.18/Web. For more information on Web Clients, see Client types.

278 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Cybersecurity
This section provides information on how to help secure your system during the Installing and
Upgrading phase.

Install antivirus and application whitelisting software


Install the antivirus and application whitelisting software.

NOTE: Application whitelisting software can prevent a legitimate application from executing, if not
configured correctly. See Configure application whitelisting software for more information.

Verify install file integrity and authenticity

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-specific
cybersecurity policies.

Verify the file integrity and authenticity for software updates and other components before installing
them in the system. Do not install files for which the integrity and authenticity cannot be confirmed.
For details on how to verify file integrity and authenticity, see Verifying file integrity and authenticity.

Protect the System Key


During the installation of PME, a system key is generated and a copy of this key is exported as a
.key file. This system key is the encryption key used by the software to encrypt user and system
credentials. A PME server retains the original key in the registry. The exported copy is needed for
the installation of Engineering clients and Secondary servers. It is also needed in case of a future
side-by-side system upgrade or migration.

As long as the PME server has the original key stored in the registry, it is possible to use the
installer to export a copy at any time. However, if the original key is deleted from the server, it
cannot be recreated or exported. In that case, you can use the exported copy to restore the system
key in the registry. Without the system key, PME user accounts can no longer be accessed.

NOTE: Protect the exported system key in a location accessible only to authorized users. An
unauthorized user might be able to use the system key to gain access to your power monitoring
software and devices.

Install latest updates for OS and SQL Server


Install the latest updates for the operating system and the SQL Server.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 279


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Check computer for cybersecurity issues


Check the pre-existing computer hardware and software for malware and other potential
cybersecurity issues.

For example,

• Scan the system with up-to-date antivirus/antimalware tool

• Check the Windows user accounts and access permissions

• Verify firewall settings to ensure least-access

• Verify computer hardware integrity

Install your network security measures


Install the network security hardware and software measures for your IT and device networks.

280 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Tools
This section contains information on tools that are used for installing and upgrading PME.

Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for.

Topic Content
Provides information on the PME installer and the following installer
PME Installer tasks: Reconfigure, Reset Accounts, Export System Key, Import
System Key, Uninstall.
Provides information on the Configuration Manager tool that is used
Configuration Manager
for Side-by-Side upgrades and system migrations.

PME Installer
Overview
Use the PME installer to:

• Install PME on a new system. See New system install for more information.

• Upgrade PME on an existing system. See System upgrade for more information.

• Perform system maintenance and repair tasks. See below for more information.

Installer Operation
The installer:

• Runs pre-installation checks

• Installs the required .NET Framework (if needed)

• Provides the option to install SQL Server Express

• Allows users to set the PME, Windows, and SQL Server account passwords.

• Allows users to export or import the PME system key.

• Installs and configures all PME application files and services.

The installer produces a detailed installation log file which is saved inside the PME folder structure
on the PME server.

Installer system maintenance tasks


You use the installer for the following maintenance tasks:

• Reconfigure

• Reset Accounts

• Export System Key

• Import System Key

• Uninstall

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 281


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To restart the Installer:

1. Open the Control Panel and select Programs and Features.

2. Select PME within the list of programs.

3. Click Change in the header area of the list of programs. This opens the installer in
maintenance mode.

Reconfigure
Reconfigure lets you rerun the configuration part of the PME install process. Reconfigure reverts
many of the system settings and components to the install defaults.

Typically, you would use Reconfigure to repair or troubleshoot a damaged system. Consult with
Technical Support before running a reconfigure if you are not familiar with the details of this
operation.

NOTE: If your system is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, you can use
Reconfigure to change which account is used. To only update the password for the account, run
Reset Accounts.

Reset Accounts
As part of the initial installation of PME, you were given the option to set or change the default
passwords for the supervisor account, the Windows accounts, and the database accounts. Reset
Accounts lets you change those passwords.

The dialog sequence is as follows: (1) Supervisor Account page, (2) Windows Accounts page, (3)
Database Accounts page, (4) Database Software page, (5) Reset Accounts progress dialog.

NOTE: If your system is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, you can use Reset
Accounts to update the password for the Integrated Authentication Windows account. To change
which account is used, run Reconfigure.

282 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

You can rerun Reset Accounts as often as required, and you can use it to change none, some, or
all of the passwords.

Export System Key


As part of the initial installation of PME, you had to export the system key. Export System Key lets
you export the system key again in case the originally exported key has been lost.

The system key is required for the installation of an Engineering Client, or if you need to uninstall
and then reinstall PME.

Import System Key


Import System Key lets you import a key into an existing PME system.

Typically, you would import a system key during a side-by-side upgrade or migration of the PME
server.

Uninstall
Uninstall removes system files and components and prepares the computer for a re-installation of
PME. Uninstall does not remove all files from the system. It also does not remove the databases.
To remove all files and components you must decommission the system. You risk disclosing your
power system data, system configuration, user information, and passwords if you don’t
decommission the system at the end of its life. See Decommission for more details.

NOTICE
UNAUTHORIZED OR UNINTENDED ACCESS TO CONFIDENTIAL DATA
• Decommission the system at the end of its life by following the instructions provided with the
software.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unauthorized or unintended access to
sensitive or secure data.

Typically, you would use Uninstall to repair or troubleshoot a damaged system.

NOTE: As part of the uninstall workflow, you have the option to leave the databases attached to
the database server, making it easier to re-install the software.

Consult with Technical Support before performing an uninstall if you are not familiar with the details
of this operation.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 283


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuration Manager
EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert (PME) configuration can be modified or added to during the
commissioning phase and throughout the lifetime of the software.

Because configuration information is stored in the software in various places such as the database,
the Windows Registry, the file system, and configuration files, managing a PME configuration is a
complex, time consuming operation.

Configuration Manager reduces the time it takes to work with PME configurations by reading and
displaying a system's configuration information. Once read, you can inspect and save the
configuration information to an archive file. You can then transfer the archived configuration
information to other systems.

NOTE: Configuration Manager is an add-on tool for PME. It is not included in the software install.
See Resources for Configuration Manager download information.

This help file contains information to help you understand:

• Off-site configuration

• Using the Tool

See Configuration Manager for more information on the Configuration Manager Configuration
Manager User Interface.

284 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Requirements
To use the Configuration Manager, your Windows user account must have administrative rights on
Windows and must exist as a Login in SQL Server with sysadmin role in the database instance.

Supported configurations
Configuration Manager 2021 supports configurations for systems with Standalone and Distributed
Database architecture. It supports all language versions of PME. The following upgrade and
migration paths are supported:

Source System Target System Architectures * Languages ** Editions ***


PME 7.2.2 PME 2021 All All All
PME 8.x PME 2021 All All All
PME 9.0 PME 2021 All All n/a
PME 2020 PME 2021 All All n/a
PME 2021 PME 2021 All All n/a

* Architectures = Standalone and Distributed Database architectures


** Languages = The localized versions of PME
*** Editions = Standard Editions, Healthcare (HC) Edition, Data Center (DC) Edition, Buildings (BD)
Edition
Limitations:

• Changing languages between source and target system is not supported.

• Archived configurations saved with an earlier version of Configuration Manager are not
compatible with this release of the tool.

SQL Server Editions
If your archived configuration does not include historical data, you can migrate a system using any
SQL Server edition combination. However, if your archived configuration includes historical data,
migrate a system using the following:

Source SQL Server Edition Target SQL Server Edition


Express Express
Express Standard
Standard Standard

NOTE: You cannot restore data or configuration from a newer version of SQL to an older version.
For example, if the source system uses SQL Server 2016, you cannot restore the configuration to
a target system using SQL Server 2012.

Localization
The Configuration Manager is available in English only; it cannot be localized into other languages.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 285


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Version History
The following shows the tool release history:

Version Release Release Date Source Systems Target Systems


PME 2021
PME 2020
CM 2021 Latest May 2021 PME 9.0 PME 2021
PME 8.x
PME 7.2.2
PME 2020
PME 9.0
CM 2020 Release 6 Nov 2019 PME 2020
PME 8.x
PME 7.2.2
PME 9.0
CM 9.0 Release 5 Aug 2018 PME 8.2 PME 9.0
PME 7.2.2
ION Enterprise
6.0.1
CM 2.1.0 Release 4 Apr 2017 PME 8.2
PME 7.2.2
PME 8.2
ION Enterprise
6.0.1
CM 2.0.0 Release 3 Aug 2016 PME 8.1
PME 7.2.2
PME 8.1
CM 1.1.0 Release 2 Apr 2015 PME 7.2.2 PME 7.2.2
CM 1.0.0 Release 1  Nov 2014 PME 7.2.2 PME 7.2.2

286 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Getting Started
See the following to get started quickly:

• Review the Tool Design section to get a good idea of how the Configuration Manager is
designed as well as its capabilities before you use it.

• Review the Using the Tool section to understand how to perform the most common tasks using
Configuration Manager.

Basic Steps
Here are the basic steps for using the Configuration Manager:

NOTE: Run Configuration Manager as Administrator user. To do this, right-click the Configuration
Manager program icon and select Run as administrator from the context menu.

On the source machine:

1. Open the tool and select Read from System.

2. (Optional) Review the log and correct any system errors.

3. (Optional) Add descriptive notes or attach resource files that you want to save with the
configuration.

4. Select Save to Archive to save the configuration to an archive.

On the target machine:

1. Open the tool and select Load from Archive.

2. Navigate to and then select the archived configuration.

3. Select Write to System to write the configuration to the system.

Tool Design
The Configuration Manager reads and displays a PME system's configuration information.
Configuration Manager can be used to save and then write a saved configuration and optional
historical data to a PME system.

Before using the Configuration Manager, carefully review the topics in this section.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 287


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

How the tool works


Configuration Manager consists of a number of jobs that read and write power monitoring system
configuration components and databases.

Read from System


When Configuration Manager reads a source system, it determines the installed power monitoring
system version on the source machine, and then compares the source system to a default
configuration of that version. Configuration Manager considers non-default values to be customized;
when Read from System completes these values are displayed in the tool as customizations.

Configuration Manager also scans the system for compatible historical database archives. You can
choose to include these to be saved to archive with the configuration.

NOTE: Configuration Manager does not display source historical database archives that were
saved using an unsupported power monitoring system version. These historical database archives
cannot be saved with the configuration. To include unsupported historical database archives with
the configuration, upgrade them to a supported version before using Configuration Manager.

Save to Archive
When Configuration Manager saves a configuration to archive, it copies the customized values,
files, and configuration databases into a single archive folder in a user selected location. The
historical database and historical database archives can optionally be included in the archive. Any
notes or attachments created in the Configuration Manager are also included in the archive folder.

Load from Archive


When Configuration Manager loads an archived configuration, it retrieves and displays the content
of the archive, including notes and attachments. Once open, you can inspect the configuration, add
notes and attachments, and write it to a target system.

Write to System

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before writing a configuration verify that the system is not performing critical control actions
that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system operation after writing a configuration.
• Verify that you are writing to the correct new, factory installed target system.
• Avoid introducing malicious software into your system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

288 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Before writing a configuration verify that the system data results are not used for critical
decision making that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system data results after writing a configuration.
• Do not introduce malicious software into your system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-specific
cybersecurity policies.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the system configuration before writing a new configuration.
• Verify the correctness of a configuration before writing it to the system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in irreversible database changes.

When Configuration Manager writes a saved archive to a target system, it scans the target version
to verify that it is the supported version of PME. It then copies all customized configuration values
to the target. If replacing the default values is compatible with the target system, Configuration
Manager copies the customized files directly to the PME system. Configuration components that
cannot be automatically updated due to overwriting issues are copied to the following folder:
...\Power Monitoring Expert\CM Migration Files. You must add these components
manually. See Side-by-Side upgrade or System migration for detailed information on how to perform
a system upgrade or migration with the Configuration Manager.

NOTE: Configuration Manager is designed to write to a newly-installed PME system. Writing a


configuration to a system that was previously customized could negatively impact the system
configuration. See Writing to a Customized PME System for details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 289


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

When to use the tool


The Configuration Manager reduces the time it takes to manage configuration information by
automating many of the required steps. Review the following scenarios to understand when to use
the tool.

NOTE: To use the Configuration Manager to upgrade or migrate an existing power monitoring
system, you must install it on both the source and target power monitoring systems that you want
to work with.

NOTE: Configuration Manager does not read, save, or write all component customizations. See
Side-by-Side upgrade or System migration for detailed information on how to perform a system
upgrade or migration with the Configuration Manager.

NOTE: Configuration Manager does not transfer PME licenses, nor does it provide warnings about
licensing issues.

Off-site configuration
Perform the off-site configuration of a PME system, and then transfer the configuration information
into a new, non-configured PME system.

Version Upgrade
You can use the Configuration Manager to transfer the configuration of an older PME system into a
newly installed PME system. See Requirements for supported upgrade paths.

NOTE: Configuration Manager does not read, save, or write all component customizations. See
Side-by-Side upgrade or System migration for detailed information on how to perform a system
upgrade or migration with the Configuration Manager.

Backup and restore


You can use Configuration Manager to back up and restore a configuration from an archived
configuration. For example, you can recover a newly-deployed system that crashes shortly after
you deploy it.

Server Migration
You can use Configuration Manager to move a PME configuration from a system on one computer
to a system on a different computer. For example, to upgrade to a newer, more powerful server
computer or a newer operating system.

Configuration Library
You can use the Configuration Manager to create a set of system configurations that can be used as
templates for PME deployments. Doing so simplifies and speeds up the deployment by providing a
base configuration that can then be customized and built upon.

Security
Transferring sensitive PME configuration information between systems and IT networks introduces
security risks.

290 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-specific
cybersecurity policies.

Carefully review the following information to understand the potential security risks that are
introduced when you use the Configuration Manager, and how to minimize these risks.

NOTE: The information contained in this topic is not exhaustive; if you are uncertain about security
protocols, consult your IT department.

Managing the PME system key

(The following applies to PME version 8.2 and newer)

In order to write a source system archive to a PME target system, a copy of the source system key
is required. During the write to system work flow, you are prompted to enter the source system key:

The source system key can be exported from the source system using the PME installer.

NOTE: Keep the system key in a secure location, protected from unauthorized access.

The Configuration Manager displays a reminder for the need to export the key at the end of a save to
archive for a PME configuration:

NOTE: No system key is required for writing PME 7.2.2 archives.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 291


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: The Configuration Manager cannot determine if the provided key is correct for the source
system configuration. If an incorrect key is provided, the write to system will continue without
warnings. However, the following Reconfigure step in the migration process will fail and the target
system will not be functional. To correct the situation see Reconfigure fails after Write to System.

Attaching files to an archive

The following table lists the potential security risks that could arise when you attach files to an
archive: 

Configuration Manager Behavior Security Risk


Files can be added to a configuration as An attached file could introduce malicious
attachments. software or viruses into a configuration archive.
Configuration Manager runs in an Administrator Malicious software or viruses would have the
level Windows account. same level of access to the server.
Configuration Manager uses PME supervisor- Malicious software or viruses would have the
level account access. same level of access to PME.
PME is typically installed on a server type Malicious software or viruses loaded into PME
computer in a customer network. might infect the entire network.

To minimize the risk of someone using the Configuration Manager to introduce malicious software
or viruses into a PME system or an IT network:

• Virus scan all files before attaching them to a configuration.

• Be certain that you know where an archived configuration comes from before you write it to a
system.

• Virus scan all attached files that are written to the target machine.

• Follow all corporate security policies.

Adding a password when saving an archive

An archive contains detailed and sensitive information about a PME system. Unauthorized
individuals might gain access to this information.

Given this security risk, consider using the following safety precautions when working with the
Configuration Manager:

• Add a password when you save a configuration to an archive

• Do not share a saved configuration archive

• Follow all corporate security policies.

When you save a configuration to an archive, you are prompted to enter a password:

292 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

A password-protected archive cannot be loaded into Configuration Manager without providing the
correct password. Additionally, files in a password-protected archive cannot be opened or copied
without providing the password:

Smart Disk Space


If disk drives that are relevant to PME or other applications on the computer run out of free space it
could negatively impact the computer operation. The Configuration Manager includes a free disk
space check to prevent this from happening.

Before the Configuration Manager saves a configuration to an archive or writes a configuration to a


new PME system, it calculates the disk space required to complete the operation, as well as the
free disk space that would remain after the operation is complete.

The tool also checks whether the configuration is being written to a local disk, a network drive, or a
removable disk. If it is a local disk, the tool uses a minimum threshold to determine whether or not to
display a disk space warning. The default warning threshold value is 10 GB. If the expected
remaining free disk space is less than this threshold, you are warned that there may not be sufficient
free space left after the configuration is written.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 293


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: The Configuration Manager does not perform threshold checks on network drives or
removable disks.

Required disk space estimation

The Configuration Manager uses the following logic to estimate the required disk space:

NOTE: The Configuration Manager looks at both the .mdf and .ldf file sizes and adds them up for
the estimation.

Save to Archive
2x historical data (ION_Data + ION_Data archives) + 2x (unzipped archive + attachments)

Write to System

Upgrades:

Drive Required Disk Space Calculation


1x historical data (ION_Data + ION_Data archives) + 2x unzipped
PME Install
archive folder
SQL Server Temp DB 1x historical data (ION_Data + ION_Data archives)
PME Database 1x historical data (ION_Data + ION_Data archives)

Migrations:

Drive Required Disk Space Calculation


1x historical data (ION_Data + ION_Data archives) + 2x unzipped
Drive - PME Install
archive folder
Drive - SQL Server Temp
1x historical data (ION_Data + ION_Data archives)
DB

Changing the warning threshold value

You can change the default threshold value by editing the Configuration Manager's configuration
file.

NOTE: Lowering the threshold value can render the disk space warning feature ineffective in
preventing the system from running out of disk space.

To change the threshold value:

1. Close the Configuration Manager.

2. Navigate to the ...\<Configuration Manager extraction


location>\Configuration Manager\bin\ folder and then open
ConfigurationManager.Settings.xml with an XML or text editor.

294 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

3. In the DiskSpaceManagementThresholdsInBytes tag, edit the Warning threshold


value as required. Threshold values are in bytes.

4. Save and close the file.

5. Restart the Configuration Manager.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 295


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Using the Tool


You can use the Configuration Manager to read, inspect, copy, and transfer a PME configuration
between systems.

Before using the Configuration Manager, review the requirements to make sure that your PME
system meets the minimum requirements. Also review Tool Design to understand the Configuration
Manager capabilities and limitations.

See Side-by-Side upgrade or System migration for detailed information on how to perform a system
upgrade or migration with the Configuration Manager.

Starting Configuration Manager


To start the Configuration Manager:

1. Navigate to the ...<Configuration Manager extraction


location>\ConfigurationManager folder (typically this folder is on your desktop) and
then open ConfigurationManager.exe.

If your system does not meet the Configuration Manager Requirements, functionality will be limited.
For example, if you run Configuration Manager on a machine that does not host a power monitoring
system, the following message appears:

296 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Next steps:

• Reading a System

• Loading a Configuration from an Archive

See Configuration ManagerConfiguration Manager User Interface for a description of the controls
and options available in the tool.

Reading a System
Reading a system provides you with configuration information about the power monitoring system
that is installed and configured on your system. Once the Configuration Manager reads a
configuration, you can inspect the configuration to see its component information and resolve any
problems that are written to the log. You can also copy the configuration by saving it as an archive
file.

To read a system:

1. Review the requirements and open the Configuration Manager.

2. Click Read from System.

NOTE: If there is no system on the machine from which you open the Configuration
Manager, or your system is not supported by the tool, you will not be able to read a system.

3. The configuration loads:

NOTE: Read from system will continue even if errors occur. Review the log after reading
from system for possible warnings or errors.

4. Click OK when the Read from System process completes successfully.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 297


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

5. Scroll through the components to see the number of instances of each system component.

TIP: Click a column header to sort components alphabetically. Right-click and click Clear
Sort to display the default sort.

Next, you can:

• Add notes or and attachments to the configuration

• Export the configuration by saving the configuration to an archive file.

Adding Attachments to a Configuration

You can add attachments to a configuration to provide supporting resources to the configuration.
Attachments can be: restore and validate procedures, checklists, knowledge base articles,
deployment documents, customer order forms, graphics, and so on.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-specific
cybersecurity policies.

NOTE: Adding attachments can introduce malicious software or viruses to the configuration. See
Configuration Manager security for details on how to minimize potential security risks.

To attach a file to a configuration:

1. Read a system.

2. Click the Attachments tab.

298 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

3. Click Add.

4. Navigate to and select the files that you want to attach and then click Open.

The file is attached to the configuration. The file name, type, size, date added to the
configuration, and date modified are displayed.

5. Click Save to Archive.

The attached files are saved with the configuration.

NOTE: Attachments that you add to a configuration are lost if you do not save the
configuration to an archive.

TIP: If you want to reread from a system, you do not need to re-add attachments. Attachments
that you add prior to rereading a system are retained in memory and will be loaded again.

To open an attachment, in the attachment row click (Open).

To download an attachment, in the attachment row click (Save As).

To delete an attachment, in the attachment row click (Delete).

Adding Notes to a Configuration

You can add notes to a configuration to provide additional information about the configuration.
Examples of notes are: hand-off instructions, tips, reminders, and known issues.

TIP: You can prevent others from seeing sensitive notes by adding a password to the archive
when you save it.

To add a note to a configuration:

1. Read a system.

2. Click the Notes tab.

3. Click Add.

The note is given a time stamp.

4. Enter a subject, your name, and the note.

The note is automatically added to the configuration as you type.

5. Click Save to Archive.

The notes are saved with the configuration.

NOTE: Notes that you add to a configuration are lost if you do not save the configuration to
an archive.

TIP: If you want to reread from a system, you do not need to re-add notes. Notes that you add prior
to rereading a system are retained in memory and will be loaded again.

To add another note, click Add.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 299


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To delete a note, highlight the note that you want to delete and then click Delete.

TIP: To delete multiple notes press either Shift or Ctrl, click the notes that you want to delete to
highlight them, and then click Delete.

Saving to Archive
Saving a configuration to an archive file lets you copy the system that is loaded in the Configuration
Manager and save it as a ZIP file. You can then use the Configuration Manager to load and write the
archived configuration and historical data to the new system.

To save a configuration to an archive file:

1. Read a system into Configuration Manager.

2. (Optional) Add any pertinent notes or attachments to the configuration.

3. Click Save to Archive.

The Save As dialog opens with the file name format: Configuration-<SOURCE_SERVER_
NAME-SourceVersion_yyyy-mm-dd_hh-mm-ss>.zip.

4. Navigate to the location where you want to save the archive file and click Save.

NOTE: You cannot save an archive to a network drive. To save an archive to a network
location save it to a local drive and then copy it to the network location.

5. (Optional) Exclude the historical database and historical database archives from the archive
by de-selecting them.

TIP: Exclude the historical database or historical database archives if disk space is a
concern or if you do not want to overwrite the historical data on the target system.

6. (Optional) Enter a password for the archive.

7. Click Save.

The Configuration Manager copies the system and saves it to an archive file.

300 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

NOTE: Save to archive will continue even if errors occur. Review the log to determine
whether you need to correct them and then save to archive again.

For PME version 8.2 and newer configurations, Configuration Manager displays a reminder for
the need to export the system key (see Security for more details):

8. When the Save To Archive operation completes, click OK.

The archive is saved to the ...\<Configuration Manager extraction


location>\Archives folder and is named Configuration-<SOURCE_SERVER_NAME-
SourceVersion_yyyy-mm-dd_hh-mm-ss>.zip.

The saved archive configuration information appears beside the source system:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 301


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Copy the saved archive file to another file location on a local or mapped network drive, an external
drive, or the target system.

Loading a Configuration from an Archive


Loading a configuration from an archive lets you open a previously saved configuration archive into
the Configuration Manager. Once open, you can inspect the configuration, add notes and
attachments, and write it to a target system.

To load an archived configuration:

1. Review the requirements.

2. Click Load from Archive.

3. Navigate to the location of the archive (default is ...\<Configuration Manager


extraction path>\Archives), select the saved configuration archive file, and then click
Open.

4. (Optional) If the archive is password-protected, enter the password and then click OK.

The archived configuration is loaded in the Configuration Manager.

You can inspect the configuration, add notes and attachments (which will be automatically saved),
or write it to the target system.

302 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

NOTE: Configuration Manager saves new notes and attachments into the loaded archive
automatically when they are added. No additional user action is required.

Writing a Configuration to a System


Writing a configuration to a system transfers an archived source system to the target system.
Perform this task to upgrade or migrate a customized configuration to a new PME system.

NOTE: Configuration Manager is designed to write to a newly-installed PME system. Writing a


configuration to a system that was previously customized could negatively impact the system
configuration. See Writing to a Customized PME System for details.

Writing a configuration to a target system overwrites the existing target configuration; once started,
the operation cannot be canceled or rolled back.

NOTE: After a configuration is successfully written to a system, the system is not in an


operational state; you must manually complete the configuration. See Side-by-Side upgrade or
System migration for detailed information on how to perform a system upgrade or migration with
the Configuration Manager.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before writing a configuration verify that the system is not performing critical control actions
that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system operation after writing a configuration.
• Verify that you are writing to the correct new, factory installed target system.
• Avoid introducing malicious software into your system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Before writing a configuration verify that the system data results are not used for critical
decision making that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system data results after writing a configuration.
• Do not introduce malicious software into your system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 303


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To write an archived system configuration to a target system:

1. Review the requirements.

2. Read the target system first to verify that you are writing to the correct system.

TIP: Prior to writing an archive to a target system, backup the target configuration by saving
it to an archive.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the system configuration before writing a new configuration.
• Verify the correctness of a configuration before writing it to the system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in irreversible database changes.

3. Load an archived configuration into the Configuration Manager.

4. Click Write to System.

5. (Optional) Include the historical database and historical database archives then click Next.

For PME version 8.2 and newer configurations, Configuration Manager prompts to enter the
source system key (see Security for more details):

304 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

NOTE: The Configuration Manager cannot determine if the provided key is correct for the
source system configuration. If an incorrect key is provided, the write to system will continue
without warnings. However, the following Reconfigure step in the migration process will fail
and the target system will not be functional. To correct the situation see Reconfigure fails
after Write to System.

6. Review how the Write to System operation will impact the target system and then click Write.

NOTE: Write to system will continue even if errors occur. Review the log to determine
whether you need to correct errors in the target system.

7. Complete the manual configuration tasks. See Side-by-Side upgrade or System migration for
detailed information on how to perform a system upgrade or migration with the Configuration
Manager.

Reviewing the Log


When you use the Configuration Manager to interact with a PME system or an archived
configuration, the Configuration Manager captures the information in the log.

Review the log and resolve any problems in the configuration prior to saving a system to an archive
or writing it to another system.

To review the log:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 305


Install and Upgrade EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. Read a system or load a saved configuration from an archive before proceeding.

2. Click Log to view the log messages.

TIP: Click a column header to sort the entries.

NOTE: The log is not saved with the archive; it is retained while the tool is running only. Restarting
the tool erases the log.

For each Configuration Manager session, Configuration Manager saves a copy of the log in
...\<Configuration Manager extraction location>\Configuration
Manager\Logs\. There will be a new file for each CM tool session.

TIP: If you are saving a configuration to archive, attach the latest log file to the configuration and
then save it.

If you encounter problems with the configuration and you want to resolve them before you save or
write the configuration:

1. Close the Configuration Manager.

2. Resolve any problems in the configuration.

3. Read the configuration again to verify that the problems were resolved.

4. Save the configuration to an archive or write the configuration to the system.

306 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Install and Upgrade

Manual Tasks
Configuration components that cannot be automatically updated due to overwriting issues are
copied to the following folder on the target system: ...\Power Monitoring Expert\CM
Migration Files. You must add these components manually. See Side-by-Side upgrade or
System migration for detailed information on how to perform a system upgrade or migration with the
Configuration Manager.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 307


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure
This chapter describes the different tools and tasks for configuring Power Monitoring Expert (PME).

The chapter is organized by functions, software modules, and configuration tools.

Use the information in the following tables to find the content you are looking for:

Main functions:

Function Task
Alarms configuration Configure alarm and incident views in Web Applications.
Cybersecurity Provides recommended actions to help secure your system.
Dashboards configuration Configure Dashboards and Slideshows in Web Applications.
Database maintenance Configure and schedule tasks such as backup, archive, and trim.
Diagrams configuration Configure Diagrams in Web Applications.
Duplicate Data logging Enable the logging of duplicate historical data records.
Licensing configuration Configure the software and device licenses.
Reports configuration Configure Reports in Web Applications.
Software Alarms Configure Software Alarms.
System integration Integrate PME with other EcoStruxure™ systems.
System performance Customize system parameters to optimize performance.
Time synchronization Configuring time synchronization for monitoring devices.
Trends configuration Configure Trends in Web Applications.

Software modules:

Module Application
Backup Power Module Generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) performance
configuration monitoring and reporting, including battery health.
Breaker Performance
Circuit breaker aging and breaker settings monitoring.
Module configuration
Generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) capacity
Capacity Management
monitoring and reporting. Includes transformer and UPS loss
Module configuration
monitoring.
Energy Analysis Dashboard Gadgets for identifying consumption patterns and anomalies and for
Module configuration comparing different consumers over time.
Energy Analysis Reports Reports for energy consumption monitoring and modeling, including
Module configuration energy usage by process area or by product output.
Energy Billing Module Energy-based billing and reporting, including consumption
configuration monitoring and reporting at the branch circuit level.

308 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Module Application
Event Notification Module
Notifications of power system events via email or SMS.
configuration
Insulation Monitoring Monitoring for isolated power systems, such as the ones found in
Module configuration hospital operating rooms.
Power Quality Performance Analysis of power quality events and disturbances and their impact
Module configuration on the monitored system.

Configuration tools and other functions:

Tool Task
Configure the Breaker Aging Module and the Breaker Settings
Breaker Configuration Tool
report.
Designer Configure ION devices and the VIP.
Device Manager Add and manage devices and sites.
Device Type Editor Create device drivers for Modbus and OPC devices.
Downstream Device
Manage downstream devices.
Assistant
Event Watcher Manager  Define events to trigger report subscriptions.
Generator Performance
Configuration Tool with Configure the Multi-Source Management Module.
EPSS Test Module
Generator Power
Configure the Multi-Source Management Module.
Configuration Utility
Hierarchy Configuration
Bulk configure Hierarchies.
Utility
Configure and maintain Hierarchies, Apportioned Meters, Virtual
Hierarchy Manager
Meters.
Perform the following tasks: Reconfigure, Reset Accounts, Export
Installer
System Key, Import System Key, Uninstall
Insulation Monitoring
Configure the Insulation Monitoring Module for ANSI applications.
Configuration Tool for ANSI
Insulation Monitoring
Configure the Insulation Monitoring Module for IEC applications.
Configuration Tool for IEC
Log Viewer View system events for troubleshooting and auditing.
Logical Device editors Create logical device types and logical devices.
Setup the device network, create Managed Circuits, configure
Management Console
Connection Schedules.
Manually edit logged measurement data to correct incorrect data or
Manual Data Editor
add new data.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 309


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Tool Task
OPC Server Support Define which measurements to expose to the OPC server.
Power Losses
Configure the Power Efficiency Module.
Configuration Utility
PQDIF Exporter Export Power Quality data to PQDIF format.
Rate Editor Configure rates for billing reports.
Configure dialup modems that will be connected to meters at
Remote Modem Setup
remote locations.
Software Logging Add or edit software based data logging for Modbus device types.
Set up a system use notification to be displayed before users can
System use notification
log into the system.
Time of Use Editor  Define Time of Use schedules for reports.
Update EWS Server Update EWS measurement mappings.
Update OPC Server Update OPC measurement mappings.
Upload Report Template Upload report template
UPS Configuration Tool Configure the Multi-Source Management Module.
UPS Power Configuration
Configure the Multi-Source Management Module.
Utility
User Manager Configure Users and User Groups.
Virtual Processor service
Configure the VIP to perform data processing and control functions.
(VIP)
Virtual Processor setup Configure the VIP service.
Configure Web apps localization, EcoStruxure Web Services Login,
Web Applications settings Diagnostics and Usage, Report Themes, Alarm Viewer,
Annunciator and more.

References:

Topic Content
Links to reference information related to the content of the
Configuration References
Configuring chapter.

310 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Alarms configuration
TIP: You can open the alarm viewer from the ALARMS link in the Web Applications banner.

Use the Alarms application to view incidents, alarms and events. You access the information in the
Alarms application through views which are saved in the view library. PME comes with several pre-
configured system views. These system views cannot be deleted or modified, but you can create
additional views and customize them to meet your needs.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

For information on how to configure the Alarms application, see:

• Adding a new Alarms view

• Copying an Alarms view

• Editing an Alarms view

• Sharing an Alarms view

• Moving an Alarms view

• Deleting an Alarms view

• Setting a default Alarms view

• Changing the alarm viewer settings

• Deactivating alarms

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 311


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For reference information see:

• Alarms UI

For information on how to use Alarms, see Alarms.

312 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Adding a new Alarms view


Add new Alarms views to access certain types of alarms, incidents, or events. For example, create
views to only see unacknowledged alarms, high priority alarms, or power quality incidents. You can
also create views that only include certain sources, and so eliminate information you are not
interested in.
To add a completely new Alarms view:

1. In the alarm viewer, open the view library and navigate to the folder where you want to create
the view.

(Optional) Add a new folder by clicking Add Folder at the bottom of the library panel, or
by clicking Add Folder in the Options menu at the top of the library.

NOTE: The System Views folder is read-only. You cannot add folders or alarm views to the
System Views folder.

2. In the view library, at the bottom of the panel, click Add View , or click Add View in the
Options menu at the top of the library. This creates a new view and opens the view
settings.

3. In View Settings, enter a view name, select a location where to save the view in the library,
set access permissions, and select the view type.

NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

4. Adjust the filter settings for Priority, State, Sources, and Categories to customize the view if
necessary.

NOTE: Not all of these filters are available for all view types.

5. Save the view.

To add a copy of an existing Alarms view:

1. In the alarm viewer, open the view library and navigate to the view you want to copy.

2. Right-click the view name or click Options for this view and select Duplicate to create a
copy in the same folder. Select Copy To to create a copy in a different folder.

3. (Optional) In the view library, select the new view, right-click the view name or click Options
for this view, and select Edit to open View Settings. You can also open View Settings by
double-clicking the view name. Change the view name, location, access permissions and
view type, and adjust the filter settings for Priority, State, Sources, and Categories to
customize the view if necessary.

NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 313


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: Not all of these filters are available for all view types.

4. Save the view.

NOTE: To add a copy of a system view, use Copy To to create a copy in a different location. You
can also open the System View for Edit and then click Save as New in the view settings to create
a copy in View Library > Home. You cannot use Duplicate because the System Views folder is
read-only.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarms view

• Copying an Alarms view

• Editing an Alarms view

• Sharing an Alarms view

• Moving an Alarms view

• Deleting an Alarms view

• Setting a default Alarms view

• Changing the alarm viewer settings

• Deactivating alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms UI

For information on how to use Alarms, see Alarms.

314 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Copying an Alarms view


Copy Alarms views to quickly create new views that are the same as, or similar to existing views.
For example, create a copy of a view to experiment with the view settings without affecting the
original view. You can also use a copy of a view as a starting point for a new view that shares many
of the settings of the original view.
To copy an Alarms view:

1. In the alarm viewer, open the view library and navigate to the view you want to copy.

2. Right-click the view name or click Options for this view and select Duplicate to create a
copy in the same folder. Select Copy To to create a copy in a different folder.

3. (Optional) In the view library, select the new view, right-click the view name or click Options
for this view, and select Edit to open View Settings. You can also open View Settings by
double-clicking the view name. Change the view name, and adjust the filter settings for
Priority, State, Sources, and Categories to customize the view if necessary.

NOTE: Not all of these filters are available for all view types.

4. Save the View.

NOTE: You cannot Duplicate a system view because the System Views folder is read-only. Use
Copy To instead to create a copy in a different location.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarms view

• Copying an Alarms view

• Editing an Alarms view

• Sharing an Alarms view

• Moving an Alarms view

• Deleting an Alarms view

• Setting a default Alarms view

• Changing the alarm viewer settings

• Deactivating alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms UI

For information on how to use Alarms, see Alarms.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 315


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Editing an Alarms view


Edit Alarms views to update the view name, the filter settings, or the location of the view in the view
library.

NOTE: You cannot overwrite system views. If you edit the settings of a system view and click
Save as New, a copy of the view is created in View Library > Home.

To edit an Alarms view:

1. In the alarm viewer, open the view library and navigate to the view you want to edit.

2. Right-click the view name or click Options for this view and select Edit to open View
Settings. You can also open View Settings by double-clicking the view name. Change the
view name, location, access permissions and view type, and adjust the filter settings for
Priority, State, Sources, and Categories to customize the view as necessary.

NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

NOTE: Not all of these filters are available for all view types.

3. Save the view.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarms view

• Copying an Alarms view

• Editing an Alarms view

• Sharing an Alarms view

• Moving an Alarms view

• Deleting an Alarms view

• Setting a default Alarms view

• Changing the alarm viewer settings

• Deactivating alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms UI

For information on how to use Alarms, see Alarms.

316 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Sharing an Alarms view


Share Alarms views with other user groups.

NOTE: For Sharing to be enabled, at least one user group, in addition to the Global group, must be
configured. To share an item with another user group, you must be a member of that group. The
item to be shared must be marked as Public, not Private.

To share an Alarm view:

1. In the alarm viewer, open the view library and navigate to the view you want to share.

2. Right-click the view name or click Options for this view and select Share. This opens the
Share View window.

3. In Share View, select the user groups you want to share this view with.
(Optional) Specify a name for the shared view. The groups you are sharing this view with will
see this name. The name of the original view remains unchanged.

4. Click OK to share this view.

NOTE: When you share an item with another user group, it appears in the Shared folder of this
group. You cannot share a shared item.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarms view

• Copying an Alarms view

• Editing an Alarms view

• Sharing an Alarms view

• Moving an Alarms view

• Deleting an Alarms view

• Setting a default Alarms view

• Changing the alarm viewer settings

• Deactivating alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms UI

For information on how to use Alarms, see Alarms.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 317


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Moving an Alarms view


Move Alarms views to a different location in the view library to make them easier to find or easier to
manage.
To move an Alarms view:

1. In the alarm viewer, open the view library and navigate to the view you want to move.

2. Right-click the view name or click Options for this view and select Move To. This opens
the Select Location window.

3. In Select Location, select the location you want to move this view to.

4. Click OK to move the view.

NOTE: You cannot move system views or the System Views folder.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarms view

• Copying an Alarms view

• Editing an Alarms view

• Sharing an Alarms view

• Moving an Alarms view

• Deleting an Alarms view

• Setting a default Alarms view

• Changing the alarm viewer settings

• Deactivating alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms UI

For information on how to use Alarms, see Alarms.

318 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Deleting an Alarms view


Delete Alarms views that are no longer needed.
To delete an Alarms view:

1. In the alarm viewer, open the view library and navigate to the view you want to delete.

2. Right-click the view name or click Options for this view, and select Delete

3. In Delete Content, click Yes, to delete the view from the view library.

NOTE: You cannot delete system views or the System Views folder.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarms view

• Copying an Alarms view

• Editing an Alarms view

• Sharing an Alarms view

• Moving an Alarms view

• Deleting an Alarms view

• Setting a default Alarms view

• Changing the alarm viewer settings

• Deactivating alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms UI

For information on how to use Alarms, see Alarms.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 319


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Setting a default Alarms view


The default Alarms view is the view that opens when you first open the Alarms application. You can
set a default for your own workspace or the entire system.

NOTE: Access to this application or function is controlled by user privileges. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

To set a default Alarms view:

1. In the alarm viewer, open the view library and navigate to the view you want to set as default.

2. Right-click the view name or click Options for this view and select Set as default. This
opens the Configure Default Item dialog.

3. In Configure Default Item, enable Set as my default or Set as system default.

4. Click OK to save the default settings.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarms view

• Copying an Alarms view

• Editing an Alarms view

• Sharing an Alarms view

• Moving an Alarms view

• Deleting an Alarms view

• Setting a default Alarms view

• Changing the alarm viewer settings

• Deactivating alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms UI

For information on how to use Alarms, see Alarms.

320 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Deactivating alarms
Active alarms can continue to appear in the Alarms viewer if, for example, an alarm dropout has not
been configured, or a device has been removed from the network after an alarm was issued. In such
cases you can use the Deactivate Alarms utility to remove these permanently active alarms from
the Alarms viewer.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

NOTE: There can be a time delay between submitting a deactivation request with this utility and
when the alarm is deactivated in the system.

To use the Deactivate Alarms utility:

1. Open Management Console and select Tools > Deactivate Alarms to open the dialog.

2. Select a date for the Show Active Alarms older than field if you want to change the default
date.

3. Click Load Active Alarms to display a list of the active alarms that are older than the date
specified.

4. Use the Select column to select the alarms that you want to set to an inactive state. You can
also click Select All to select all the alarms displayed in the grid. Use Select None to clear the
selection of any alarms listed.

5. Click Set Selected Alarms to Inactive.

NOTE: The Active column displays N for all alarms set to the inactive state.

NOTE: Allow a few minutes of time for the alarm to be deactivated in the system. There can
be a time delay between submitting a deactivation request with this utility and when the
alarm is deactivated in the system.

6. Click Done to close the Deactivate Alarms dialog and then close Management Console.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 321


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

When you log in to Management Console again and open the Deactivate Alarms dialog, the
number of alarms shown in the Alarms Displayed field matches the number in the Alarms
Displayed field in the All Active Alarms view in the Alarms application. (The Alarms
application is available in the Web Applications component.)

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarms view

• Copying an Alarms view

• Editing an Alarms view

• Sharing an Alarms view

• Moving an Alarms view

• Deleting an Alarms view

• Setting a default Alarms view

• Changing the alarm viewer settings

• Deactivate alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms UI

For information on how to use Alarms, see Alarms.

322 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Cybersecurity
This section provides information on how to help secure your system during the Configuring phase.

Install security certificate


PME is installed with a self-signed certificate and a self-signed certificate is configured
automatically. We recommend that you replace this with a security certificate from a Certificate
Authority (CA).

See Data encryption for information on data encryption, at rest and in transit, in PME.

Set up encrypted database communication for Distributed Database


architectures
We recommend that the connections between PME and the SQL database server, in Distributed
Database architecture installations, are encrypted using at least Transport Layer Security (TLS) 1.2.
This requires a certificate from a public certification authority for the SQL Server computer and the
configuration of both servers to use encrypted connections.

NOTE: Only the communication between the PME application server and the database server will
be encrypted, not the data in the database.

NOTE: The use of self-signed certificates is supported but we recommend that you use a
certificate from a certification authority.

High level configuration steps:

1. Install a Server Authentication certificate from a public certification authority on the SQL
Server computer.

2. Take PME out of service by informing system users of the outage and disabling any
automated system control or third-party interactions.

3. Stop all PME services.

4. Configure the SQL server to force encrypted connections.

5. Configure PME to use encryption on database connections. See Configure database


connection encryption for more information.

6. Confirm that the PME application server computer can verify the ownership of the certificate
used by the SQL Server computer.

7. Restart PME, verify the correct operation of the system, and put the system back into service.

Detailed configuration information:

• See Enable Encrypted Connections to the Database Engine, a Microsoft document, for
information on certificate requirements, as well as detailed installation and configuration
instructions.

• See TLS 1.2 support for Microsoft SQL Server, a Microsoft document, for information on TLS
1.2 support in different versions of SQL Server.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 323


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure application whitelisting software


Application whitelisting software, such as McAfee Application Control, is used to prevent
unauthorized applications from running on your system.

When you deploy whitelisting software to help protect a system, it scans the system and creates a
whitelist of all executable binaries and scripts present on the system. The whitelist also includes
hidden files and folders.

The whitelist includes all authorized files and determines trusted or known files. In Enabled mode,
only files that are present in the whitelist can execute. All files in the whitelist are protected and
cannot be changed or deleted. An executable binary or script that is not in the whitelist is said to be
unauthorized and is prevented from running.
Consider the following when using whitelisting software with PME:

• Complete the system configuration before setting up and enabling the whitelisting software.

• Any program or script that should be able to update the system will need to be configured as an
updater.

• After solidification, no updates or extensions, such as add-on device drivers, may be installed.

• Disable the whitelisting software when making changes to the PME system. Enable it again
after the change.

• Follow the instructions of the software vendor for installing, configuring, and operating the
whitelisting software.

NOTE: Verify the correct operation of your PME system after you enable the whitelisting software.

Configure antivirus software on your SQL Server


We recommend that you run anti virus software on your SQL server. Follow the recommendations
described in Microsoft Support article (ID: 309422). See Resources for link information.

NOTE: Antivirus software can have a significant impact on system performance if it is not set up
correctly. Consider the following:

• SQL Server performance can be affected if data and log files are not excluded from on-access
scans.

• Special configuration of the antivirus software might be required.

• Follow the instructions of the software vendor for installing, configuring, and operating the
antivirus and whitelisting software.

Configure PME users and user groups


There are no pre-configured user accounts or user groups in a newly installed system. One
supervisor account is created, with a user defined password, during the installation of the software.
Create additional user accounts and groups after installation. PME supports Windows users and
groups for integration with Windows and Active Directory.

324 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

RECOMMENDATION: Use Windows users instead of standard users in your PME system to
improve cybersecurity. Windows offers advanced user management functions, such as enforcing
password strength and limiting the number of invalid login attempts. These functions are required
for IEC 62443 compliance, the global standard for industrial automation control system security.

For information on creating users and user groups, and on setting user access levels, see User
Manager.

Customize user account privileges


You can configure user account privileges in Web Applications > Settings > Users > System
Users > User Manager. See Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

Restrict Windows login permissions for the PME server


We recommend that you restrict the Windows login permissions for the PME server computer to
PME system administrators only. Preventing non-administrator users from logging into the server
reduces the risk of unauthorized system changes and increases the cybersecurity of your system.

Change the SQL Server Express sa account password


If SQL Server Express is installed, with SQL Server authentication, through the PME installer,
change the sa account password after the installation is complete.

Configure session timeout settings


You can configure session timeout settings in Web Applications > Settings > Security > Session
Timeout. See Session timeout for information on this feature. See Configure Session Timeout for
configuration details.

Configure system integration security settings


You can configure system integration settings in Web Applications > Settings > Security >
Integrations. See System integration security for information on this feature. See Configure
Authorized Hosts and Configure Integration Utility for configuration details.

Do not install or use a web browser on the server computer


Using a web browser on a server computer increases the vulnerability of the server and the network.
Access PME web clients on client computers only, not on the server.

RECOMMENDATION: Remove the PME Web Applications shortcuts from the server.

Set up your network security


Set up the network security measures for your IT and device networks.

Disable unused IP ports


Disable or block IP ports that are not required for the operation of your system. See IP Ports for
details on PME port requirements.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 325


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Disable unused hardware ports


Computer ports and inputs, such as USB ports or DVD drives are not required for PME to function
correctly. These inputs can be permanently disabled if necessary. The same applies to the AutoRun
and AutoPlay functionality which can also be disabled without affecting the operation of the
software.

326 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Dashboards configuration
Use the Dashboards application to view high level historical and real-time data, for example Key
Performance Indicators (KPIs). The information in the Dashboards application is accessed through
dashboards with gadgets. Dashboards are saved in the Dashboard Library. In addition to viewing
individual dashboards, you can create slideshows to automatically display a sequence of
dashboards.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Power Monitoring Expert (PME) does not provide any pre-configured dashboards or slideshows.
Configure your own dashboards, gadgets, and slideshows to meet your needs.

Open the Dashboards application from the Dashboards link in the Web Applications banner.
For information on how to configure the Dashboards application, see:
Dashboards:

• Adding a new dashboard

• Editing a dashboard

• Sharing a dashboard

• Moving a dashboard

• Deleting a dashboard

• Set default options for a dashboard

• Configuring a slideshow

Gadgets:

• Adding a gadget to a dashboard

• Editing a gadget

• Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard

For reference information see Dashboards user interface (UI).

For information on how to use Dashboards, see Dashboards.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 327


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a new dashboard


Add new dashboards to view high level historical and real-time data, for example in the form of Key
Performance Indicators (KPIs).
To add a completely new dashboard:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboard Library and navigate to the folder where you want to
create the dashboard.

2. (Optional) Add a new folder by clicking Add Folder at the bottom of the library panel, or
by clicking Add Folder in the Options menu at the top of the library.

3. In the Dashboard Library, at the bottom of the panel, click Add Dashboard . This creates
a new dashboard and opens the Dashboard Settings.

4. In Dashboard Settings, enter a dashboard name, select a location and set the access
permissions to Public or Private.

NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

5. (Optional) Click Styling to open the Dashboard Styling window. In Dashboard Styling, select
a background image or background color for the dashboard and set the default opacity for the
gadgets. See Styling a dashboard for more details.

6. (Optional) You can add gadgets to the dashboard now or save the empty dashboard and add
gadgets later. See Adding a gadget to a dashboard for more details.

7. Save the dashboard.

To add a copy of an existing dashboard to the Library:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboard Library and navigate to the dashboard you want to copy.
(Optional) Add a new folder by clicking Add Folder at the bottom of the library panel, or
by clicking Add Folder in the Options menu at the top of the library.

2. Right-click the dashboard name or click Options for this dashboard and select Duplicate to
create a copy in the same folder. Select Copy To to create a copy in a different folder.

3. (Optional) In the Dashboard Library, select the new dashboard, right-click the dashboard name
or click Options for this dashboard, and select Edit to open the Dashboard Settings.
Change the dashboard name, Location, and access permissions.

NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

4. Save the modified Dashboard Settings.

328 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Related topics:
Dashboards:

• Adding a new dashboard

• Editing a dashboard

• Sharing a dashboard

• Moving a dashboard

• Deleting a dashboard

• Set default options for a dashboard

• Configuring a slideshow

Gadgets:

• Adding a gadget to a dashboard

• Editing a gadget

• Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to use Dashboards, see Dashboards.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 329


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Editing a dashboard
Edit dashboards to update the dashboard name, add new gadgets, change the dashboard styling,
change the access permissions or change the location of the dashboard in the Dashboard Library.
To edit a dashboard:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboard Library and navigate to the dashboard you want to edit.

2. Right-click the dashboard name or click Options for this dashboard and select Edit to open
the Dashboard Settings. Change the dashboard name, add gadgets, change the dashboard
styling, change the access permissions, or change the location of the dashboard in the
Library. For dashboard styling, see Styling a dashboard for more details.

NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

3. Save the modified dashboard settings.

Related topics:
Dashboards:

• Adding a new dashboard

• Editing a dashboard

• Sharing a dashboard

• Moving a dashboard

• Deleting a dashboard

• Set default options for a dashboard

• Configuring a slideshow

Gadgets:

• Adding a gadget to a dashboard

• Editing a gadget

• Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to use Dashboards, see Dashboards.

330 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Sharing a dashboard
Share dashboards with other User Groups.

NOTE: For Sharing to be enabled, at least one user group, in addition to the Global group, must be
configured. To share an item with another user group, you must be a member of that group. The
item to be shared must be marked as Public, not Private.

To share a dashboard:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboard Library and navigate to the dashboard you want to share.

2. Right-click the dashboard name or click Options for this dashboard and select Share. This
opens the Share Dashboard window.

3. In Share Dashboard, select the User Groups you want to share this dashboard with.

4. (Optional) Specify a name for the shared dashboard. The groups you are sharing this
dashboard with will see this name. The name of the original dashboard remains unchanged.

5. Click OK to share this dashboard.

NOTE: When you share an item with another user group, it appears in the Shared folder of this
group. You cannot share a shared item.

Related topics:
Dashboards:

• Adding a new dashboard

• Editing a dashboard

• Sharing a dashboard

• Moving a dashboard

• Deleting a dashboard

• Set default options for a dashboard

• Configuring a slideshow

Gadgets:

• Adding a gadget to a dashboard

• Editing a gadget

• Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to use Dashboards, see Dashboards.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 331


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Moving a dashboard
Move dashboards to a different location in the Dashboard Library to make them easier to find or
easier to manage.
To move a dashboard:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboard Library and navigate to the dashboard you want to move.
(Optional) Add a new folder by clicking Add Folder at the bottom of the library panel, or
by clicking Add Folder in the Options menu at the top of the library.

2. Right-click the dashboard name or click Options for this dashboard and select Move To....
This opens the Select Location window.

3. In Select Location, select the location where you want to move this dashboard.

4. Click OK to move the dashboard.

Related topics:
Dashboards:

• Adding a new dashboard

• Editing a dashboard

• Sharing a dashboard

• Moving a dashboard

• Deleting a dashboard

• Set default options for a dashboard

• Configuring a slideshow

Gadgets:

• Adding a gadget to a dashboard

• Editing a gadget

• Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to use Dashboards, see Dashboards.

332 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Deleting a dashboard
Delete dashboards that are no longer needed.
To delete a dashboard:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboard Library and navigate to the dashboard you want to delete.

2. Right-click the dashboard name or click Options for this dashboard, and select Delete

3. In Delete Content, click Yes, to delete the dashboard from the Dashboard Library.

Related topics:
Dashboards:

• Adding a new dashboard

• Editing a dashboard

• Sharing a dashboard

• Moving a dashboard

• Deleting a dashboard

• Set default options for a dashboard

• Configuring a slideshow

Gadgets:

• Adding a gadget to a dashboard

• Editing a gadget

• Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to use Dashboards, see Dashboards.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 333


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Set default options for a dashboard


The default dashboard is the one that is displayed when you first open Dashboards. You can set a
dashboard to be your own personal default, or the default for the system.

NOTE: For each user, Set as my default supersedes Set as system default. For example, if a
user with supervisor-level access sets a dashboard as the system default dashboard, and another
user sets a different dashboard as their default dashboard, that user's default dashboard takes
priority over the system default dashboard, but only for them.

To set the default options for a dashboard:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboard Library and navigate to the dashboard you want to set as
default.

2. Right-click the dashboard name or click Options for this dashboard and select Set as
default to open the Configure Default Item dialog.

3. Turn on one or both of Set as my default and Set as system default.

4. Click OK to save the modified Dashboard Settings.

Related topics:
Dashboards:

• Adding a new dashboard

• Editing a dashboard

• Sharing a dashboard

• Moving a dashboard

• Deleting a dashboard

• Set default options for a dashboard

• Configuring a slideshow

Gadgets:

• Adding a gadget to a dashboard

• Editing a gadget

• Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to use Dashboards, see Dashboards.

334 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configuring a slideshow
Use the Slideshow Manager to create, edit, or delete a slideshow.

NOTE: Anyone with access to the PME web server can view a slideshow using the slideshow
URL. No user authentication is required, except when using a Table gadget (See Using Table
gadget in Slideshow for more information). Restrict network access and access to the URL to
authorized users for slideshows containing confidential information.

NOTE: If you create a Dashboard that contains multiple gadgets, use the scroll bar to view all the
gadgets. But, if you use this Dashboard in a Slideshow, you do not have access to scroll bar to
view all the gadgets. It is recommended that you consider this condition when choosing which
Dashboard to include in a Slideshow.

Creating a slideshow
To create a slideshow:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboard Library, and click Slideshow Manager in the Settings
menu at the top of the library

2. In Slideshow Manager, click Add Slideshow to open the Add New Slideshow dialog.

3. Type a name for the slideshow in the Name field.

4. Click any of the dashboards in the Shared Dashboards list to add them to the Dashboard
Playlist area on the right. Alternatively, begin typing in the Search field to filter the list for
selection.

The dashboards are listed in the Playlist area in the order that you selected them.

5. To modify the list of dashboards in the Dashboard Playlist, click the dashboard name to
display the edit options, then:
a. Click the Delete icon to remove the dashboard from the Playlist.

b. Click the Up or Down arrow to move the dashboard to an earlier or later sequence in the
Playlist, respectively.

6. Select the speed for the transition from dashboard to dashboard in the Select Transition
Time list.

7. Click OK to save your slideshow.

8. Click Close to close the Slideshow Manager.

Editing an existing slideshow


To edit an existing slideshow:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboard Library, and click Slideshow Manager in the Settings
menu at the top of the library

2. In Slideshow Manager, click the slideshow you want to edit, then click Edit to open the Edit
Slideshow dialog.

3. Change the name of slideshow, modify the dashboards in the play list, change the slide
caption for the slideshow, or adjust the slide transition time.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 335


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Click OK to save your changes and to return to the Slideshow Manager.

5. Click Close to close the Slideshow Manager.

Deleting a slideshow
To delete a slideshow:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboard Library, and click Slideshow Manager in the Settings
menu at the top of the library

2. In Slideshow Manager, click the slideshow you want to delete, then click Delete to open the
Delete Slideshow dialog.

3. Click OK to permanently delete the slideshow and to return to the Slideshow Manager.

4. Click Close to close the Slideshow Manager.

Sharing a slideshow
To share a slideshow:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboard Library, and click Slideshow Manager in the Settings
menu at the top of the library

2. In Slideshow Manager, click the slideshow you want to share, then click Share to open the
Share Slideshow URL dialog.

The dialog includes the URL for the slideshow, which you can copy and distribute so that
others can access the slideshow.

NOTE: The client browser must have access to the URL to view the slideshow.

3. Click Close to close the Slideshow Manager.

Related topics:
Dashboards:

• Adding a new dashboard

• Editing a dashboard

• Sharing a dashboard

• Moving a dashboard

• Deleting a dashboard

• Set default options for a dashboard

• Configuring a slideshow

Gadgets:

• Adding a gadget to a dashboard

• Editing a gadget

• Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard

336 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

• Using Table gadget in Slideshow

For information on how to use Dashboards, see Dashboards.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 337


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a gadget to a dashboard


Add gadgets to a dashboard to display historical and real-time data. Without gadgets, a dashboard
does not display any data.

NOTE: Gadgets that require special licensing only appear in the list after the correct licensing has
been installed.

To add a gadget to the dashboard:

1. Click Add Gadget to open the Gadget Setup dialog.


By default, all gadgets are included in the dialog. To filter the gadgets by category, click one of
the categories on the left, for example Common or Comparison.

2. Select the gadget that you want to add to the dashboard and click Next.
Gadget settings are specific to each gadget. For example, some gadgets require a data series
consisting of sources and measurements, while other gadgets have no such requirement.

See Configuring Gadgets for a description of the settings.

3. Click Next to proceed through the pages of the Gadget Setup dialog.

4. Click Finish to close the Gadget Setup dialog and to add the gadget to the dashboard.

5. Repeat the process to add additional gadgets to your dashboard.

Related topics:
Dashboards:

• Adding a new dashboard

• Editing a dashboard

• Sharing a dashboard

• Moving a dashboard

• Deleting a dashboard

• Set default options for a dashboard

• Configuring a slideshow

Gadgets:

• Adding a gadget to a dashboard

• Editing a gadget

• Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to use Dashboards, see Dashboards.

338 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Editing a gadget
To edit the settings for a gadget:

1. Click Settings in the gadget and select Edit to open the Gadget Setup.

2. In Gadget Setup, change any of the settings on the tabs.

See Configuring Gadgets for more details.

3. Click Save to update the gadget settings and to close the Gadget Setup dialog.

TIP: In gadgets where a time range has been specified when the gadgets are configured, the time
range selection is included on the gadgets in the dashboard. You can quickly change the time
range for the gadget by selecting another period of time from the list in the time range field. The
time range is applied to the gadget only while you continue to view the dashboard. If you navigate
to another dashboard and then come back to this dashboard, the time range on the gadget reverts
to the value that you set when you configured the gadget.

Related topics:
Dashboards:

• Adding a new dashboard

• Editing a dashboard

• Sharing a dashboard

• Moving a dashboard

• Deleting a dashboard

• Set default options for a dashboard

• Configuring a slideshow

Gadgets:

• Adding a gadget to a dashboard

• Editing a gadget

• Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to use Dashboards, see Dashboards.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 339


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard


You can move or resize a gadget on a dashboard when the dashboard is in edit mode.

Moving a gadget
1. Right-click a dashboard name in the Dashboard Library, then click Edit in the menu.

2. Position the mouse pointer in the title area of the gadget that you want to move.

The pointer changes to the Move shape (an image with 4 arrows).

3. Drag and drop the gadget to another position on the dashboard.

Other gadgets on the dashboard are re-positioned if additional space is required.

4. Click Finish in Dashboard Controls to save your change.

Resizing a gadget
1. Right-click a dashboard name in the Dashboard Library, then click Edit in the menu.

2. Position the mouse pointer at the lower right corner of the gadget.

A small triangular shape indicates that you can drag the corner.

3. Drag the corner to increase or reduce the size of the gadget.

Other gadgets on the dashboard are re-positioned if additional space is required.

4. Click Finish in Dashboard Controls to save your change.

Related topics:
Dashboards:

• Adding a new dashboard

• Editing a dashboard

• Sharing a dashboard

• Moving a dashboard

• Deleting a dashboard

• Set default options for a dashboard

• Configuring a slideshow

Gadgets:

• Adding a gadget to a dashboard

• Editing a gadget

• Moving or resizing a gadget on a dashboard

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to use Dashboards, see Dashboards.

340 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Database maintenance
PME uses databases to store information such as system configuration, data logs, and system
event log messages. These databases must be maintained to preserve performance, manage disk
space use, and guard against data loss in case of database failure.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the database at regular intervals.
• Back up the database before upgrading or migrating the system.
• Back up the database before trimming it.
• Back up the database before making manual database edits.
• Verify correct database behavior after making database or system changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

The following table shows the PME databases and the recommended database maintenance tasks
for each:

Database Type of Data Maintenance Tasks*


Web Applications related configuration data
ApplicationModules Backup, Maintenance, Trim
and system event log entries.
Archive, Backup,
Historical power system data such as interval
ION_Data Maintenance,
data logs, waveforms and alarms.
Size Notification**
Device network and other system
ION_Network Backup, Maintenance
configuration data
Non-Web Applications related system event
ION_SystemLog Maintenance, Trim
log entries.

* See Database maintenance task definitions for basic task definitions.


** Size Notification is only used for systems with SQL Server Express, which has a maximum
database size limit of 10 GB.

In Standalone PME systems, the database maintenance tasks are pre-configured and scheduled to
run automatically by default. For Distributed Database PME systems, you need to configure the
tasks and set up the schedules manually.

NOTE: It is best to automate the maintenance tasks, but you can run them manually on demand
using Database Manager and Microsoft SQL Server Management Studio.

The following table shows the default database maintenance task schedules for Standalone PME
systems:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 341


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Database Task Enabled Trigger Time


ApplicationModules Backup Yes Daily at 01:30
ApplicationModules Maintenance Yes Daily at 03:30
ApplicationModules Trim Yes Daily at 02:30
ION_Data Archive* No** Annually, on Jan 3 at 01:00
ION_Data Backup Yes Weekly, Fridays at 00:00
ION_Data Maintenance Yes Daily at 02:00
ION_Data Size Notification*** Yes Daily at 03:00
ION_Network Backup Yes Daily at 01:00
ION_Network Maintenance Yes Daily at 07:30
ION_SystemLog Maintenance Yes Daily at 07:05
ION_SystemLog Trim Yes Daily at 04:00

* The PME archive task does not trim the database, it only copies data to the archive.
** You need to edit the Windows user account settings before enabling the archive task. See the
Note on the ION_Data archive task for more details.
*** Size Notification is only used for systems with SQL Server Express, which has a maximum
database size limit of 10 GB.

For more information on the default task settings see Default maintenance task settings.

Managing database maintenance tasks for Standalone PME systems


In Standalone systems, the database maintenance tasks are pre-configured and scheduled to run
automatically by default. The scheduling and execution of the tasks is done with Task Scheduler in
Windows. The database interaction specific steps of the tasks are defined as Windows PowerShell
scripts.

Note on the ION_Data archive task:

NOTE: The archive task for the ION_Data database is disabled by default. The Windows user
account that is used to run this task must have a sysadmin server role in the SQL Server database
server. The Windows user account that is used by default, IONMaintenance, does not have a
sysadmin server role. To enable and run the scheduled archive task successfully, you need to add
the sysadmin role to IONMaintenance, or change the user account that is used to run this task to
an account with sysadmin role. See Database maintenance account requirements for more
information on account requirements.

To edit the task schedule settings (enable or disable tasks, set trigger times):

NOTE: The database maintenance tasks in Task Scheduler are configured to run using the
IONMaintenance Windows user account. To save any changes to the task settings in Task
Scheduler, you need to enter the password for the IONMaintenance account. See Using
IONMaintenance for database maintenance tasks for information on where to find the password.

342 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

1. On the PME application server, open Task Scheduler in Windows.

2. In the Task Scheduler Library, open the Schneider Electric > Power Monitoring Expert
folder to see the configured database maintenance tasks.

3. Edit the tasks as required:


a. To enable or disable a task, select it and use the Actions pane in Task Scheduler.

b. To edit task settings, double-click a task and make the desired changes in the Job
Properties dialog box.

4. (Optional) Select Enable All Tasks History in the Actions pane in Task Scheduler. This
turns on event recording for the scheduled tasks, which is useful for auditing and
troubleshooting.

5. Close Task Scheduler.

To edit the task script settings (change backup and archive location, set the data to keep on trim,
size notification threshold):

1. On the PME application server, open the ...\Power Monitoring


Expert\config\cfg\DbScheduledTasks\Support\Configuration.ps1 script file
in a text editor.

2. Change the values of the variables in the script file for the settings you want to change. The
following settings can be customized:

NOTE: Follow the instructions in the script file on formatting and syntax.

Setting Variable Default Value Comments


Sets the folder to which the database
backups are saved. The backup script will
create the following subfolders in this
location:
...\Power Monitoring
Backup folder ...\Data for ION_Data
$locationForBackupFiles Expert
location ...\Network for ION_Network
\Database\Backup
...\SystemLog for ION_SystemLog
...\Applications for ApplicationModules
NOTE: IONMaintenance needs Read and
Write permissions on this folder.
Sets the folder to which the database
...\Power Monitoring
Archive folder archives are saved.
$locationForArchiveDBFiles Expert
location NOTE: IONMaintenance needs Read and
\Database\Archive
Write permissions on this folder.
Data to keep Sets how many days' worth of data is left
$diagnosticsDaysToKeep 30
when trimming in the database after trimming.
Sets the maximum database size. This
value is used by the size notification task
to assess what percentage of database
space has been used.
Database size $maximumDatabaseSizeIn
9 The maximum size for a SQL Express
(max) Gigabytes
database is 10GB. The maximum size in
the script is set to 9GB to allow for a 1GB
warning buffer before the database stops
logging data.
Database size $databaseSizeNotification Sets the threshold for when a database
85
notification limit ThresholdPercentage size notification will be issued.

3. Save the script file changes and close the text editor.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 343


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Setting up database maintenance tasks for Distributed PME systems


In Distributed systems, the database maintenance tasks are not pre-configured. You need to set up
these tasks manually. The scheduling and execution of the tasks is done with Task Scheduler in
Windows. The database interaction specific steps of the tasks are defined as Windows PowerShell
scripts. Setting up the database maintenance tasks includes the following high-level steps:

NOTE: The following sections describe how to set up the different database maintenance tasks,
except for the archive task for ION_Data. See Setting up the ION_Data archive task for
Distributed PME systems for instructions on how to set up this task.

Step 1: Creating a Windows user account to run the maintenance tasks. See Database
maintenance account requirements for more information on the account requirements.

Step 2: Installing the Microsoft SQL Server Data-Tier Application Framework.

NOTE: This requires downloading the framework installer from Microsoft or copying it from the
PME installation DVD/ISO.

Step 3: Installing and configuring the Windows PowerShell script files.

NOTE: This requires copying files from the PME application server to the database server.

Step 4: Setting up task schedules in Task Scheduler.

Step 1: Creating a Windows user account to run the maintenance tasks:

1. On the database server, create a new Windows user as a member of the Users group, for
example PMEMaintenance.

NOTE: You will need the password for this account during the initial task setup, and later if
you want to edit the tasks in Task Manager in the future.

2. Open the Local Security Policy tool in Windows.

3. In the Local Security Policy tool, open the policy settings list in Security Settings > Local
Policies > User Rights Assignment.

4. Add the new Windows user to the following policies: Deny log on locally and Log on as a
batch job.

5. Close the Local Security Policy tool.

6. Open Microsoft SQL Server Management Studio.

7. Add the new Windows user as a database Login with the following roles and mappings:

Server Role: public


User Mapping:

Database Role
ApplicationModules db_backupoperator; db_ddladmin; Maintenance; public

344 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Database Role
ION_Data db_backupoperator; db_ddladmin; Maintenance; public
ION_Network db_backupoperator; db_ddladmin; Maintenance; public
ION_SystemLog db_backupoperator; db_ddladmin; Maintenance; public

8. Close Microsoft SQL Server Management Studio.

NOTE: You will need the password for this account if you want to edit the tasks in Task Manager
in the future, after the initial setup.

Next, install the Microsoft SQL Server Data-Tier Application Framework.


Step 2: Installing the Microsoft SQL Server Data-Tier Application Framework:

1. Check if the framework is already installed on the database server. To do this, find the
following registry key: HKEY_LOCAL_
MACHINE\SOFTWARE\WOW6432Node\Microsoft\Microsoft SQL Server\.
If this key includes a Data-Tier Application Framework key, then the framework is
installed. Continue with Step 3 - Installing and configuring the Windows PowerShell script files
If this key does not include a Data-Tier Application Framework key, then the framework is not
installed. Continue with the installation of the framework.

2. On the database server, download the framework installer (DacFramework.msi) from


Microsoft. See Resources for the framework installer download link.

NOTE: You can also find the framework installer (DacFramework.msi) on the PME
DVD/ISO under Setup\SetupSupport\database.

3. On the database server, install DacFramework.msi.

Next, install and configure the Windows PowerShell script files.


Step 3: Installing and configuring the Windows PowerShell script files:

1. On the database server, create a new folder. You can choose the location and folder name, for
example C:\PME_Database_Maintenance.

2. Copy the DbScheduledTasks folder from ...\Power Monitoring


Expert\config\cfg\, on the PME application server, into this new folder.

3. Open the <New Folder


Path>\DbScheduledTasks\Support\DatabaseHelper.ps1 script file in a text editor.

4. Change the values of the folder path variables in the script file to the new folder path as
follows:
a. Change the value of $customUserDirectory (line 28 in the script) to <New Folder
Path>\dbScheduledTasks\Support, for example C:\PME_Database_
Maintenance\dbScheduledTasks\Support. The default value is
C:\PMEDBs\dbScheduledTasks\Support.

b. Change the value of $customSystemDirectory (line 29 in the script) to <New Folder


Path>, for example C:\PME_Database_Maintenance. The default value is
C:\PMEDBs.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 345


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

c. (Only if you are using Windows Integrated Authentication) Change the value of
$pmeUsingIntegratedAuth (line 32 in the script) to 1. The default value is 0.

5. Save the script file changes.

6. Open the <New Folder Path>\DbScheduledTasks\Support\Configuration.ps1


script file in a text editor.

7. Change the value of the backup and archive folder path variables in the script file to the new
folder path as follows:
a. Change the value of $locationForBackupFiles (line 46 in the script) to <New Folder
Path>\Backups\, for example C:\PME_Database_Maintenance\Backups\. The
default value is ..\Database\Backup\.

b. Change the value of $locationForArchiveDBFiles (line 54 in the script) to <New


Folder Path>\Archives\, for example C:\PME_Database_
Maintenance\Archives\. The default value is ..\Database\Archives\.

8. Save the script file changes and close the text editor.

Next, set up task schedules in Task Scheduler.


Step 4: Setting up task schedules in Task Scheduler:

1. On the database server, open Task Scheduler in Windows.

2. (Optional) In the Task Scheduler Library, create a new folder for the PME database
maintenance tasks, for example Task Scheduler Library > Power Monitoring Expert.

3. Create scheduled database maintenance tasks:

NOTE: For setting up the archive task for ION_Data, see Setting up the ION_Data archive
task for Distributed PME systems

Use the following information to create the tasks. Replace the variables with the specific
settings shown in the task settings table below.
Name: <task_name>
Security options: Set the Windows user account created in Step 1 to run the task.
Security options: Select Run whether user is logged on or not.
Trigger: <trigger_time>
Action: Select Start a program.
Action: Program/script:
C:\Windows\syswow64\WindowsPowerShell\v1.0\powershell.exe
Action: Arguments: -noninteractive -nologo -file "<New Folder
Path>\DbScheduledTasks\<script_name>" -DatabaseIdentifier <DB ID>

NOTE: The "<New Folder Path>\DbScheduledTasks\<script_name>" path must be an


absolute path, not a relative path.

NOTE: Valid settings for the <task_name>, <trigger_time>, <script_name>, and <DB ID>
variables are given in the Task Settings table below.

346 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Example: ApplicationModules backup task

Name: [ApplicationModules] - Backup - Job


Security options: Set the Windows user account created in Step 1 to run the task.
Security options: Select Run whether user is logged on or not.
Trigger: Daily at 01:30 (1:30 AM)
Action: Select Start a program
Action: Program/script: C:\Windows\syswow64\WindowsPowerShell\v1.0\powershell.exe
Action: Arguments: -noninteractive -nologo -file "<New Folder
Path>\DbScheduledTasks\Backup.ps1" -DatabaseIdentifier APPS
Task Settings table:

NOTE: The task names and trigger times shown in the table are recommendations. You can
choose different names or triggers if necessary.

Task Settings
Task Name: [ApplicationModules] - Backup - Job
ApplicationModules
Trigger Time: Daily at 01:30 (1:30 AM)
backup
Action: Arguments: Script Name: Backup.ps1, DB ID: APPS
Task Name: [ApplicationModules] - MAINTENANCE - Job
ApplicationModules
Trigger Time: Daily at 03:30 (3:30 AM)
maintenance
Action: Arguments: Script Name: DatabaseMaintenance.ps1, DB ID: APPS
Task Name: [ApplicationModules] - TRIM - Job
ApplicationModules
Trigger Time: Daily at 02:30 (2:30 AM)
trim
Action: Arguments: Script Name: TrimDiagnostics.ps1, DB ID: APPS
Task Name: [ION_Data] - BACKUP - Job
ION_Data backup Trigger Time: Weekly at 00:00 (12:00 AM) on Fridays
Action: Arguments: Script Name: Backup.ps1, DB ID: ION
Task Name: [ION_Data] - MAINTENANCE - Job
ION_Data
Trigger Time: Daily at 02:00 (2:00 AM)
maintenance
Action: Arguments: Script Name: DatabaseMaintenance.ps1, DB ID: ION
Task Name: [ION_Network] - BACKUP - Job
ION_Network
Trigger Time: Daily at 01:00 (1:00 AM)
backup
Action: Arguments: Script Name: Backup.ps1, DB ID: NOM
Task Name: [ION_Network] - MAINTENANCE - Job
ION_Network
Trigger Time: Daily at 07:30 (7:30 AM)
maintenance
Action: Arguments: Script Name: DatabaseMaintenance.ps1, DB ID: NOM
Task Name: [ION_SytemLog] - MAINTENANCE - Job
ION_SystemLog
Trigger Time: Daily at 07:05 (7:05 AM)
maintenance
Action: Arguments: Script Name: DatabaseMaintenance.ps1, DB ID: SYSLOG
Task Name: [ION_SytemLog] - TRIM - Job
ION_SystemLog
Trigger Time: Daily at 04:00 (4:00 AM)
trim
Action: Arguments: Script Name: TrimDiagnostics.ps1, DB ID: SYSLOG

The completed task list should look like this:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 347


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. (Optional) Manually run each task to verify its correct operation.

5. Close Task Scheduler.

To edit the task script settings (for example to change the backup and archive location or to set the
amount of data to keep in the database on trim), open the Configuration.ps1 script file, as
described in Step 3 and change the values of the variables.
Configurable variables in Configuration.ps1:

Setting Variable Default Value Comments


Sets the folder to which the database backups are
saved. The backup script will create the following
subfolders in this location:
...\Data for ION_Data
As defined in the
Backup folder ...\Network for ION_Network
$locationForBackupFiles script file; see Step
location ...\SystemLog for ION_SystemLog
3-7.
...\Applications for ApplicationModules
NOTE: The Windows user account used to run the
backup task needs Read and Write permissions on
this folder.
Data to keep when Sets how many days' worth of data is left in the
$diagnosticsDaysToKeep 30
trimming database after trimming.

348 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Diagrams configuration
Use the Diagrams application to view historical and real-time data in one-line and graphics
diagrams.

Open the Diagrams application from the Diagrams link in the Web Applications banner.

NOTE: To display the correct local time for monitoring device data in the Diagrams application,
you must configure the TZ Offset, DST Start, DST End, and DST Offset settings on the device.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

For information on how to configure the Diagrams application, see:

• Configuring Devices diagrams

• Configuring a network diagram

• Creating custom diagrams

• Set default options for a diagram

• Set Diagrams control options

• Diagram Library

• Diagrams registry settings

• Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 349


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site

For information on how to use Diagrams, see Diagrams.

350 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configuring Devices diagrams


Devices diagrams are device type specific diagrams for each configured device in the system.
Devices diagrams are created automatically when a new device is added to the system.

NOTE: You cannot delete Devices diagrams.

NOTE: The device type specific diagrams are the same as the ones used in the default Vista
network diagram.

NOTE: It takes time for the system to generate the diagrams when you add a new device. Restart
Diagrams after adding a new device to see the new device diagrams.

Related topics:

• Configuring Devices diagrams

• Configuring a network diagram

• Creating custom diagrams

• Set default options for a diagram

• Set Diagrams control options

• Diagram Library

• Diagrams registry settings

• Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site

For information on how to use Diagrams, see Diagrams.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 351


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring a network diagram


Before you can view the network diagram in the Diagrams application, you must generate a network
diagram (network.dgm) in Vista. The Diagrams application uses the network diagram generated in
Vista for display in the browser. The network diagram is automatically added to the Diagram Library,
all you need to do is generate the network diagram in Vista, save it in the default location, and then
restart the Diagrams application.

Note that the Vista component is installed with Power Monitoring Expert on a primary server or
Engineering Client.
To generate a default network diagram in Vista:

1. Start Vista.

2. Click File > Generate network diagram.

3. Click File > Save.

Related topics:

• Configuring Devices diagrams

• Configuring a Network diagram

• Creating custom diagrams

• Set default options for a diagram

• Set Diagrams control options

• Diagram Library

• Diagrams registry settings

• Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site

For information on how to use Diagrams, see Diagrams.

352 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Creating custom diagrams


You create a custom diagram for the Diagrams application with Vista. After you created the
diagram, you must add it to the Diagram Library in the Diagrams application to make it available for
viewing.
To create a diagram:

1. Open Vista and create a new diagram. Use the Vista tools to create display objects and
embedded graphics as applicable.

2. Save the diagram to ...\Power Monitoring Expert\config\diagrams\ud or any


subfolder in this location.

Related topics:

• Configuring Devices diagrams

• Configuring a network diagram

• Creating custom diagrams

• Set default options for a diagram

• Set Diagrams control options

• Diagram Library

• Diagrams registry settings

• Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site

For information on how to use Diagrams, see Diagrams.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 353


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Set default options for a diagram


The default diagram is the one that is displayed when you first open Diagrams. You can set a
diagram to be your own personal default, or the default for the system.

NOTE: For each user, Set as my default supersedes Set as system default. For example, if a
user with supervisor-level access sets a diagram as the system default diagram, and another user
sets a different diagram as their default diagram, that user's default diagram takes priority over the
system default diagram, but only for them.

To set the default options for a diagram:

1. In Diagrams, open the Diagram Library and navigate to the diagram you want to set as default.

2. Right-click the diagram name or click Options for this diagram and select Set as default to
open the Configure Default Item dialog.

3. Turn on one or both of Set as my default and Set as system default.

4. Click OK to save the modified Diagram Settings.

Related topics:

• Configuring Devices diagrams

• Configuring a network diagram

• Creating custom diagrams

• Set default options for a diagram

• Set Diagrams control options

• Diagram Library

• Diagrams registry settings

• Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site

For information on how to use Diagrams, see Diagrams.

354 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Set Diagrams control options

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

You can enable or disable the ability to perform manual control actions in Diagrams. Manual control
actions include actions such as resetting values on devices or changing device configuration
settings. You can also set the confirmation method that is used by the software to confirm a control
action request before carrying it out.

Control in Diagrams is disabled by default.

NOTE: The required user access permissions for performing a control action are configured
individually for each control object in a diagram. This is done at design time in Vista. However, to
perform any control action in Diagrams you need at least controller-level access or higher
(operator-level, supervisor-level). This is true even if the permissions for a control object in a
diagram are set to user-level or view only-level. Only through Vista can users with user-level or
view only-level access perform control actions on such a control object. To view or change the
permissions on a control object, open the diagram in Vista. See Controlling system functions in
Vista for information on control object configuration.

NOTE: Control in Diagrams is only available when a HTTPS connection is used between the PME
server and the Web Applications client.

To enable or disable control in Diagrams:

1. Open the Settings page from the SETTINGS link in the Web Applications banner.

2. In the Settings Library select Security > Diagrams Control Options.

NOTE: Only supervisor-level users can access the Diagrams Control Options settings.

3. In Diagrams Control Options, enable or disable manual control in Diagrams.

4. Click Save.

To set the confirmation method:

NOTE: Control in Diagrams must be enabled for the confirmation method settings to be displayed.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 355


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. Open the Settings page from the SETTINGS link in the Web Applications banner.

2. In the Settings Library select Security > Diagrams Control Options.

NOTE: Only supervisor-level users can access the Diagrams Control Options settings.

3. In Diagrams Control Options, select the confirmation method - Dialog Box without
Password or Dialog Box with Password.

NOTE: Control objects in diagrams can be configured, at design time, to always require
password confirmation. This configuration has priority over the confirmation method settings
above. See Controlling system functions in Vista for information on control object
configuration.

4. Click Save.

Confirmation settings priority:

Control Object Setting Diagrams Setting Behavior


No Confirmation Confirmation Confirmation
No Confirmation Password Password
Confirmation Confirmation Confirmation
Confirmation Password Password
Password Confirmation Password
Password Password Password

Related topics:

• Configuring Devices diagrams

• Configuring a network diagram

• Creating custom diagrams

• Set default options for a diagram

• Set Diagrams control options

• Diagram Library

• Diagrams registry settings

• Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site

For information on how to use Diagrams, see Diagrams.

356 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Diagram Library
Use the Diagram Library to access all the diagrams that you can view in the Diagrams application.
You can add diagrams to the library, edit them, share them, or delete them.

NOTE: You cannot add, edit, share, or delete Devices diagrams. See Configuring Devices
diagrams for details.

NOTE: A network diagram is automatically added to the library when it is generated in Vista. See
Configuring a network diagram for details.

To add a diagram to the library:

1. In Diagrams, open the Diagram Library and navigate to the folder where you want to create the
diagram.

(Optional) Add a new folder by clicking Add Folder at the bottom of the library panel, or
by clicking Add Folder in the Options menu at the top of the library.

2. In the Diagram Library, at the bottom of the panel, click the Add Diagram icon . This
opens the Diagram Settings.

3. In Diagram Settings, enter a diagram name, select a location, and select the diagram you want
to add.

4. Save the diagram.

To add a copy of an existing diagram to the library:

1. In Diagrams, open the Diagram Library and navigate to the diagram you want to copy.

2. Right-click the diagram name or click the Options icon for this diagram and select
Duplicate to create a copy in the same folder. Select Copy To... to create a copy in a
different folder.

(Optional) Add a new folder by clicking Add Folder at the bottom of the library panel, or
by clicking Add Folder in the Options menu at the top of the library.

3. (Optional) In the Diagram Library, select the new diagram, right-click the diagram name or
click the Options icon for this diagram and select Edit to open the Diagram Settings.
Change the diagram name.

4. Save the modified diagram settings.

To edit an existing diagram in the library:

1. In Diagrams, open the Diagram Library and navigate to the diagram you want to edit.

2. Right-click the diagram name or click the Options icon for this diagram and select Edit to
open the Diagram Settings. Change the diagram name or location.

3. Save the modified Diagram Settings.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 357


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To share an existing diagram in the library:

1. In Diagrams, open the Diagram Library and navigate to the diagram you want to share.

2. Right-click the diagram name or click the Options icon for this diagram and select Share....
This opens the Share Diagram window.

3. In Share Diagram, select the user groups you want to share this diagram with.

(Optional) Specify a name for the shared diagram. The groups you are sharing this diagram
with will see this name. The name of the original diagram remains unchanged.

4. Click OK to share this diagram.

NOTE: When you share a diagram with another user group, it appears in the Shared folder of this
group. You cannot share a shared diagram.

To move an existing diagram to a different location in the library:

1. In Diagrams, open the Diagram Library and navigate to the diagram you want to move.

(Optional) Add a new folder by clicking Add Folder at the bottom of the library panel, or
by clicking Add Folder in the Options menu at the top of the library.

2. Right-click the diagram name or click the Options icon for this diagram and select Move
To.... This opens the Select Location window.

3. In Select Location, select the location you want to move this diagram to.

4. Click OK to move the diagram.

To delete a diagram from the library:

1. In Diagrams, open the Diagram Library and navigate to the diagram you want to delete.

2. Right-click the diagram name or click the Options icon for this diagram and select Delete

3. In Delete Content, click Yes, to delete the diagram from the Diagram Library.

Related topics:

• Configuring Devices diagrams

• Configuring a network diagram

• Creating custom diagrams

• Set default options for a diagram

• Set Diagrams control options

• Diagram Library

• Diagrams registry settings

• Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site

For information on how to use Diagrams, see Diagrams.

358 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Diagrams registry settings

NOTICE
IRREVERSIBLE OPERATING SYSTEM DAMAGE OR DATA CORRUPTION
Before making any changes, back up your Windows Registry in a network folder or other remote
location.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in irreparable damage to the operating
system of the computer and all existing data.

NOTE: Registry edits must be performed only by qualified and experienced personnel.

The registry keys are in HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Schneider


Electric\Power Monitoring Expert\2021\WebReach.
The following table lists the default Diagrams registry entries and settings.

Default Entries Default Settings Description


Timeout period for the autodiagram
components to communicate with the device
AutoDiagramTimeout 20000 milliseconds
and determine the appropriate template to
open.
Time limit for a diagram subscription to
update its timestamp. If the subscription is
ExpireTimeLimit 600 seconds
not updated within this time period, it is
considered expired and is removed.
HTTPRefreshInterval 10 seconds The web page refresh rate.
The name (tag) that the subscription service
SubscriptionObject pmlitem:webreachstore:
uses to find Diagrams-related information.
The part of the Web address that points to
VirtualDirectory ION the Diagrams-generated Vista diagrams for
displaying in the browser.
The real time data update rate on the web
XMLRefreshInterval 3000 milliseconds
page.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 359


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The following table lists the optional registry entries you can set for custom functionality. Modifying
system registry keys without the required knowledge or experience in these procedures can
damage the computer's operating system and all existing data.

Optional Entries Default Settings Description


This value specifies the network diagram to
display as the homepage for Diagrams. The
x-pml:/diagrams/ud/
NetworkDiagram value can be a relative path, such as the default
network.dgm
setting, or it can be an absolute file path (e.g.:
D:\customdiagrams\ud\networkB.dgm).
This value determines how long Diagrams waits
for the results of a query to return from the
database before timing out. If this registry entry
is not created or no QueryTimeout value is
specified, Diagrams times out after 60 seconds.
QueryTimeout See description.
This optional registry entry is useful if you know
that a query will take more than 60 seconds to
return its results and you do not want Diagrams
to time out before then. Specify a value that
gives you enough time to get your query results.

Related topics:

• Configuring Devices diagrams

• Configuring a network diagram

• Creating custom diagrams

• Set default options for a diagram

• Set Diagrams control options

• Diagram Library

• Diagram registry settings

• Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site

For information on how to use Diagrams, see Diagrams.

360 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access


If you access the Diagrams pages directly from a browser, without the Web Applications
framework, you will not have access to the Diagram Library. In this case, Diagrams will
automatically display the default network diagram generated with Vista.

NOTE: If you access Diagrams from outside the Web Applications framework, through a browser
using the URL https://server_name/ion (where server_name is the fully-qualified name
of the server or its IP address), you are prompted to log in using your Power Monitoring Expert
credentials.

If you have a custom network diagram on the primary server that you want to use instead of the
automatically generated network diagram, you need to modify the registry settings of the computer
where you run the Diagrams application to specify the location of the custom network diagram.
Modifying system registry keys without the required knowledge or experience in these procedures
can damage the computer's operating system and all existing data.

NOTICE
IRREVERSIBLE OPERATING SYSTEM DAMAGE OR DATA CORRUPTION
Before making any changes, back up your Windows Registry in a network folder or other remote
location.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in irreparable damage to the operating
system of the computer and all existing data.

NOTE: Registry edits must be performed only by qualified and experienced personnel.

1. Start Windows Registry Editor and navigate to:


HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring
Expert\2021\WebReach
If the Diagrams application is run on a 64-bit operating system, navigate to:
HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Schneider Electric\Power
Monitoring Expert\2021\WebReach

2. Right-click to add a new string value and name it “NetworkDiagram”.

3. Right-click NetworkDiagram, select Modify, then type the path and name of your custom
network diagram in the Value data field.

4. Click OK.

5. Restart IIS on your computer to apply the changes.

For more information, refer to the NetworkDiagram item in the table under Diagrams registry
settings. If there is no NetworkDiagram entry in the registry, then the default value “x-
pml:/diagrams/ud/network.dgm” is used.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 361


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The Network Diagram navigation button located on the date range page and the results page is
automatically updated to link to the custom network diagram you specified. However, the Network
Diagram button that exists in each meter user diagram uses a hard-coded link to “x-
pml:/diagrams/ud/network.dgm”. Use Vista to manually update the Network Diagram link in the
meter user diagrams. If you do not have access to Vista, contact your system administrator to
change the link for the grouping object in the network diagram as described below.

Changing the link for the grouping object in the network diagram
1. Start Vista and select Options > Show Toolbox to switch to Edit mode.

2. Right-click the grouping object in the network diagram to open the Grouping Object
Configuration dialog.

3. Select the Action tab and select Open User Diagram.

4. Click Browse to locate your custom network diagram. Select the diagram filename, then click
Open.

5. Click OK to save your changes.

Related topics:

• Configuring Devices diagrams

• Configuring a network diagram

• Creating custom diagrams

• Set default options for a diagram

• Set Diagrams control options

• Diagram Library

• Diagrams registry settings

• Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site

For information on how to use Diagrams, see Diagrams.

362 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams


NOTE: These diagrams are part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

Before you can use these diagrams, you must first configure the Power Quality Performance
module. You must complete the following tasks, as part of the Power Quality Performance module
configuration:

• Deploy the VIP framework for Power Quality Performance using Designer.

• Deploy and configure the Power Quality Performance Indicator and Equipment Vista diagrams.

• Configure which devices to include and exclude for each type of power quality event and
disturbance.

Related topics:

• Configuring Devices diagrams

• Configuring a network diagram

• Creating custom diagrams

• Set default options for a diagram

• Set Diagrams control options

• Diagram Library

• Diagrams registry settings

• Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site

For information on how to use Diagrams, see Diagrams.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 363


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple site


NOTE: These diagrams are part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

Before you can use these diagrams, you must first configure the Power Quality Performance
module. You must complete the following tasks, as part of the Power Quality Performance module
configuration for multiple sites:

• Deploy the VIP framework for Power Quality Performance for the sites using Designer.

• Deploy and configure the Power Quality Performance Indicator and Equipment Vista diagrams
for the sites.

Related topics:

• Configuring Devices diagrams

• Configuring a network diagram

• Creating custom diagrams

• Set default options for a diagram

• Set Diagrams control options

• Diagram Library

• Diagrams registry settings

• Configuring a custom network diagram for direct browser access

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Configuring Power Quality Performance diagrams for multiple sites

For information on how to use Diagrams, see Diagrams.

364 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Duplicate Data logging


Data records are considered duplicates if more than one record exists for the same measurement on
the same source at the same time. There are different possible causes for duplicate data in a
system, such as faulty devices, incorrect device configuration, or incorrect device time
synchronization.

By default, PME does not log duplicate data records in the historical database. It logs one of the
duplicate records in the database, and removes the other records.

Under certain circumstances, for example for audit reasons, or billing applications, it might be
desirable to log all duplicate records. For these applications, PME provides the option to enable
duplicate data logging.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
Back up the database before making manual database edits.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

To enable duplicate data collection, set the SaveDuplicates parameter, in the dbo.Registry
table in the ION_Data database, to 1.

NOTE: The duplicate entries are stored in the DataLog2Duplicate table in the ION_Data
database. You can access this data through the following reports, or through direct database
access: Trend Report, Tabular Report, Data Export - Standard, and Data Export - Extended.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 365


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Licensing configuration
Power Monitoring Expert (PME) is a proprietary software that uses licensing to control its use and
distribution. To use PME, you must purchase software licenses and activate them in the system.
PME uses a modular licensing structure where different licenses enable different functions in the
software. Some of these functions are optional, others are required. The licenses are cumulative,
meaning that you can add additional licenses to a system, to enable additional functionality.

NOTICE
LOSS OF COMMUNICATION
• Activate product and component licenses prior to the expiry of the trial license.
• Activate sufficient licenses for the servers and devices in your system.
• Export the existing hierarchy template out of Power Monitoring Expert before importing a new
template. The new template can overwrite the existing template, which can permanently
remove all information contained in the original.
• Backup or archive any SQL Server database data before adjusting any database memory
options.
• Only personnel with advanced knowledge of SQL Server databases should make database
parameter changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in loss of data.

For information on how to configure licensing, see:

• Activating a license

• Returning a license

• Refreshing a license

• Viewing which licenses have been activated on a system

For information related to license planning, see the Licensing section in the Planning chapter of this
guide.
For reference information see:

• License Configuration Tool user interface

366 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Activating a license
Activate a license to enable the use of the system after a new install, an upgrade, or a migration.
Activate licenses to enable features, such as software modules, or additional monitoring devices.

You can activate licenses online, directly from the PME server if it has an Internet connection. You
can also activate licenses offline, from an alternate internet connected computer or smartphone. In
both cases you use License Configuration Tool to activate licenses.

NOTE: You must have a valid Activation ID to activate a license. See Licensing process for more
information.

To activate a license online:

1. On the PME server, open the License Configuration Tool, and click Activate License.

A message box is displayed.

NOTE: You can access the License Configuration in the install location within
....\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring Expert\License
Configuration Tool.

2. Read the information and click OK.

The Activate License page opens.

3. On the Activate License page, enter the Activation ID, and then click Activate.

NOTE: By default, the activation method is set to Online.

The license appear in the License Configuration Tool.

4. Close the License Configuration Tool.

To activate a license offline:

1. On the PME server, open the License Configuration Tool, and click Activate License.

A message box is displayed.

NOTE: You can access the License Configuration in the install location within
....\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring Expert\License
Configuration Tool.

2. Read the information and click OK.

The Activate License page opens.

3. On the Activate License page, select Activation method to Offline.

NOTE: By default, the activation method is set to Online.

NOTE: The instructions shown on the activation method page are the same as the
instructions provided here, in this document.

4. On Initiate section, enter the Activation ID and select the location to save the activation
request file. Click Download.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 367


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The activation request file capabilityrequest.bin downloads to the selected location.

5. Copy the capabilityrequest.bin file to a computer or a web enabled device such as a


smartphone with Internet access.

6. On the Internet-connected computer or device, open a Firefox or Chrome  browser.

NOTE: Internet Explorer is not supported.

7. Browse to the Offline Licensing Web Portal (https://schneider-


electric.flexnetoperations.com/flexnet/operationsportal/logon.do).

8. Login using the activation ID.

NOTE: Contact Technical Support for help regarding the login. See Licensing resources for
contact information.

9. Click Devices drop-down and then click Offline Device Management.

The Offline Device Management window opens.

10. In Offline Device Management page, click Choose File, and then select the
capabilityrequest.bin file, and click Upload.

The Download my License Response File window opens.

11. In Download my License Response File window, click Download to save the
capabilityresponse.bin file. 

12. Copy the capabilityresponse.bin file to the PME server computer.

TIP: If you are using a smartphone, try using a USB cable to copy the file.

13. On the PME server, open the License Configuration Tool, and click Activate License.

A message box is displayed.

NOTE: You can access the License Configuration in the install location within
....\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring Expert\License
Configuration Tool.

14. Read the information and click OK.

The Activate License page opens.

15. On the Activate License page, select Activation method to Offline.

NOTE: By default, the activation method is set to Online.

16. On Complete section, select the location of the capabilityresponse.bin file, and click
Activate. 

The license appear in the License Configuration Tool.

17. Close the License Configuration Tool.

For information on how to configure licensing, see:

368 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Activating a license

• Returning a license

• Refreshing a license

• Viewing which licenses have been activated on a system

For reference information see:

• License Configuration Tool user interface

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 369


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Returning a license
Return a license before migrating a system. When you migrate a system, you must first return the
license on the old system before you can activate it again on the new system. This includes the
case where you re-install Power Monitoring Expert (PME) on the same server after the operating
system has been reinstalled.

You can return licenses online, directly from the PME server if it has an Internet connection. You
can also return licenses offline, from an alternate internet connected computer or smartphone. In
both cases you use License Configuration Tool to return licenses.

NOTE: Write down the Activation ID of the licenses before you return them. You need the ID to
activate the licenses again on the new system. See System migration and license returns for more
details.

To return a license online:

NOTE: If you have activated license using online method, you can return the license using online
method only. You cannot use offline method.

1. On the PME server, open the License Configuration Tool, and click Return License.

A message box is displayed.

NOTE: You can access the License Configuration in the install location within
....\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring Expert\License
Configuration Tool.

2. Read the information and click OK.

The Return License page opens.

3. On the Return License page, click Return.

NOTE: By default, the Return Method is set to Online

The licenses are returned and disappear from the License Configuration Tool.

4. Close the License Configuration Tool.

To return a license offline:

NOTE: If you have activated license using offline method, you can return the license using offline
method only. You cannot use online method.

1. On the PME server, open the License Configuration Tool, and click Return License.

A message box is displayed.

NOTE: You can access the License Configuration in the install location within
....\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring Expert\License
Configuration Tool.

2. Read the information and click OK.

The Return License page opens.

370 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

3. On the Return License page, select Return Method to Offline.

NOTE: By default, the Return Method is set to Online.

NOTE: The instructions shown on the Return Method page are the same as the instructions
provided here, in this document.

4. On Initiate section, select the location to save the return request file. Click Download.

The return request file capabilityrequest.bin downloads to the selected location.

5. Copy the capabilityrequest.bin file to a computer or a web enabled device such as a


smartphone with Internet access.

6. On the Internet-connected computer or device, open a Firefox or Chrome  browser.

NOTE: Internet Explorer is not supported.

7. Browse to the Offline Licensing Web Portal (https://schneider-


electric.flexnetoperations.com/flexnet/operationsportal/logon.do).

8. Login using the activation ID.

NOTE: Contact Technical Support for help regarding the login. See Licensing resources for
contact information.

9. Click Devices drop-down and then click Offline Device Management.

The Offline Device Management window opens.

10. In Offline Device Management page, click Choose File, and then select the
capabilityrequest.bin file, and click Upload.

The Download my License Response File window opens.

11. In Download my License Response File window, click Download to save the
capabilityresponse.bin file. 

12. Copy the capabilityresponse.bin file to the PME server computer.

TIP: If you are using a smartphone, try using a USB cable to copy the file.

13. On the PME server, open the License Configuration Tool, and click Return License.

A message box is displayed.

TIP: You can access the License Configuration in the install location within
....\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring Expert\License
Configuration Tool.

14. Read the information and click OK.

The Return License page opens.

15. On the Return License page, select Return Method to Offline.

NOTE: By default, the Return Method is set to Online.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 371


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

16. On Complete section, select the location of the capabilityresponse.bin file, and click
Return. 

The licenses are returned and disappear from the License Configuration Tool.

17. Close the License Configuration Tool.

For information on how to configure licensing, see:

• Activating a license

• Returning a license

• Refreshing a license

• Viewing which licenses have been activated on a system

For reference information see:

• License Configuration Tool user interface

372 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Refreshing a license
Refresh licenses to enable additional features, such as software modules, or additional monitoring
devices.

You can refresh licenses online only, directly from the PME server if it has an Internet connection.
You use License Configuration Tool to refresh licenses. Offline refresh method is not available.
To refresh a license online:

NOTE: If you have activated license using online method, you can refresh the license using online
method only.

1. On the PME server, open the License Configuration Tool, and click Refresh License.

The Refresh License page opens.

NOTE: You can access the License Configuration in the install location within
....\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring Expert\License
Configuration Tool.

2. On the Refresh License page, click Refresh.

NOTE: By default, the Refresh Method is set to Online.

The licenses are refreshed in the License Configuration Tool.

3. Close the License Configuration Tool.

For information on how to configure licensing, see:

• Activating a license

• Returning a license

• Refreshing a license

• Viewing which licenses have been activated on a system

For reference information see:

• License Configuration Tool user interface

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 373


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing which licenses have been activated on a system


Find out which licenses have been activated to plan for system expansions or upgrades. You can
view license information, in the Management Console and in the License Configuration Tool.
To find licensing information in the Management Console:

1. On the PME server, open the Management Console.

2. In Management Console, click Help > About. This opens the About Application window.

3. In About Application, view the licensing information.

4. In About Application, click OK to close the window.

To find licensing information in the License Configuration Tool:

1. On the PME server, open License Configuration Tool.

NOTE: You can access the License Configuration in the install location within
....\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring Expert\License
Configuration Tool.

2. In License Configuration Tool, click License Information. This opens the License
Information window.

3. In License Information, view the feature list, device license usage, and client access license
usage.

4. Close the License Configuration Tool.

You can also see Client Access license information in the User Manager. See Viewing Web
Applications user license information for more details.

For information on how to configure licensing, see:

• Activating a license

• Returning a license

• Refreshing a license

• Viewing which licenses have been activated on a system

For reference information see:

• License Configuration Tool user interface

374 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Reports configuration
TIP: You can open Reports from the REPORTS link in the Web Applications banner.

Use the Reports application to generate historical data reports. The reports are saved in the Report
Library. PME comes with many default report templates. Use these default templates to create new
reports or upload your own custom templates. Set up subscriptions to automatically generate and
distribute reports based on a schedule or an event.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

For information on how to configure the Reports application, refer to the following topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 375


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

376 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Setting Reports prerequisites


Before you can use Reports, you need to specify the database to use for reporting, and you need to
configure the delivery options for report subscriptions. These settings are defined in Management
Console.
To set the prerequisites:

1. Open Management Console and select Tools > Reports Configuration to open the dialog.

2. Click the Reports tab to configure general reporting options:


From the dropdown list in the Reports Database section, select the database on which to
run reports. Only those databases and database archives compatible with Reports are
listed.

(Optional) Use the slider in the Report Timeout section to set the time (in seconds) after
which Reports stops trying to complete a report generation task.

3. Click the Subscriptions tab to configure the settings for report subscriptions:
SMTP Server: Enter the IP address of your SMTP server, or the fully-qualified network
server name from which the report subscriptions are emailed.

Port: Type the port address used by your SMTP server.

Use SSL: Select this option to encrypt your user credentials.

Username: If required by your SMTP server, enter the Windows user name used to
configure the SMTP server settings.

Password: If required by your SMTP server, enter the password associated with the
Windows user name.

“From” Display Name: (Optional) Type the name that you want to appear in the “From”
field of an emailed report.

“From” Email Address: Type the email address that you want to appear in the “From”
field of the emailed report.

4. Click OK to save your changes.

Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 377


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

378 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Meeting individual report requirements


Different reports have different data requirements. These requirements must be met before you can
generate the report. For details on specific report requirements, see Report descriptions.
Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 379


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a new report


Add new reports to meet your needs for reporting on specific data or for specific report formats. For
example, create reports for power quality, energy consumption, power demand, breaker monitoring,
and many other applications.
To add a new report:

1. In Reports, open the Report Library and navigate to the folder where you want to add the
report.

(Optional) Add a new folder by clicking Add Folder at the bottom of the library panel, or
by clicking Add Folder in the Options menu at the top of the library.

2. In the Report Library, click Add Report at the bottom of the panel, or click Add Report in
the Options menu at the top of the Library. This opens Add Report - Report Template
Selection.

3. In Add Report - Report Template Selection, find and select the report template you want to use
for the new report, and click OK. This opens the report template and the Report Settings for
the new report.

4. In the report template, enter and select the input parameters that you want to use for the new
report.

NOTE: The number and type of input parameters are report template specific.

5. (Optional) Click Generate Report to test the report output and adjust the input parameters if
necessary.

6. In Report Settings, enter a report Name, select a Location and access permissions, and
select which report inputs you want to save with the report.

NOTE: Saved inputs are stored with the report and reused every time the report is generated.
To change saved input values for an existing report, see Editing a report. Inputs that are not
saved must be entered every time the report is generated.

NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

7. Click Save in Report Settings to save the report.

Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

380 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 381


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Copying a report
Copy reports to quickly create new reports that are the same as, or similar to existing reports. For
example, create a copy of a report to experiment with the input parameters without affecting the
original report. You can also use a copy of a report as a starting point for a new report that shares
many of the input settings of the original report.

To copy a report:

1. In Reports, open the Report Library and navigate to the report you want to copy.

2. Right-click the report name or click Options for this report and select Duplicate to create a
copy in the same folder. Select Copy To to create a copy in a different folder.

3. (Optional) In the Report Library, select the new report, right-click the report name or click
Options for this report and select Edit to open Report Settings. You can also open Report
Settings by double-clicking the report name. Change the report Name, Location and access
permissions, and the saved Report Inputs to customize the report if necessary.

4. Save the report.

NOTE: You cannot copy report templates.

Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

382 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Editing a report
Edit reports to update the report name, Location and access permissions, and the saved report
Inputs.
To edit a report:

1. In Reports, open the Report Library and navigate to the report you want to edit.

2. Right-click the report name or click Options for this report and select Edit to open Report
Settings. You can also open Report Settings by double-clicking the report name.

3. Change the report Name, Location and access permissions, and the saved Report Inputs to
customize the report as necessary.

NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

4. Save the report.

Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 383


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Moving a report
Move reports to a different location in the Report Library to make them easier to find or easier to
manage.
To move a report:

1. In Reports, open the Report Library and navigate to the report you want to move.

2. Right-click the report name or click Options for this report and select Move To. This opens
the Select Location window.

3. In Select Location, select the location you want to move this report to.

4. Click OK to move the report.

Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

384 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Deleting a report
Delete reports that are no longer needed.
To delete a report:

1. In Reports, open the Report Library and navigate to the report you want to delete.

2. Right-click the report name or click Options for this report, and select Delete

3. In Delete Content, click Yes, to delete the report from the Report Library.

NOTE: You cannot delete report templates.

Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 385


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Sharing a report
Share saved reports with other User Groups.

NOTE: For Sharing to be enabled, at least one user group, in addition to the Global group, must be
configured. To share an item with another user group, you must be a member of that group. The
item to be shared must be marked as Public, not Private.

To share a saved report:

1. In Reports, open the Report Library and navigate to the report you want to share.

2. Right-click the report name or click Options for this report and select Share. This opens the
Share Report window.

3. In Share Report, select the User Groups you want to share this report with.
(Optional) Specify a name for the shared report. The groups you are sharing this report with will
see this name. The name of the original report remains unchanged.

4. Click OK to share this report.

NOTE: When you share an item with another user group, it appears in the Shared folder of this
group. You cannot share a shared item.

Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

386 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 387


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Subscribing to a report
Subscribe to reports to receive scheduled report outputs or automatically generate reports based on
system events. For example, you can configure a subscription so that a report is generated monthly
and sent via email to a group of people.

NOTE: You can only create a subscription for a report that has all its inputs saved.

To subscribe to an individual report:

1. In Reports, open the Report Library and navigate to the report you want to subscribe to.

2. Right-click the report name or click Options for this report and select Subscribe to open Add
New Subscription.

3. Continue with step 4 in "To subscribe to multiple reports" below.

To subscribe to multiple reports:

1. In Reports, open the Report Library and select Manage Subscriptions from the Options
menu at the top of the Library. This opens Manage Subscriptions.

2. In Manage Subscriptions, click Add Subscriptions. This opens the reports list in Add New
Subscription.

3. From the reports list In Add New Subscription, select the reports you want to subscribe to.
Click Next.

NOTE: This creates subscriptions for all the selected reports.

4. In Add New Subscription, enter a name for the subscription in the Subscription Name field.

NOTE: This is the name that is displayed in the list when you open Manage Subscriptions
from the Options menu at the top of the Library.

5. Under Output Format, select one of the formats for the report that will be generated.

6. Under Delivery Mode, select one of the following delivery options:

Email: Click Recipients to open the Distribution List dialog.


The dialog has two tabs: Users/Groups and Manual Entry. You can use both tabs to
select and type email addresses, respectively. They are not mutually exclusive.

Users/Groups tab
The names listed on this tab are the users and groups that have been created in User
Manager. They are listed in alphabetical order. Select Order by Type to order the list
alphabetically by group then by user.
Ensure that email addresses are defined in User Manager for the users.
Select the users or groups that you want as the recipients of the generated report.
Click OK when you complete your selections.

Manual Entry tab


If you click the Manual Entry tab, type the email address of a recipient and click Add to
include the recipient's email address in the Current subscription recipients area.
Repeat this step for each recipient.

388 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

To remove an email address from the Current subscription recipients area, click an
address and then click Remove.
Click OK when the list is complete.

Email Subject field


(Optional) Type the text you want to include as the subject line in the email that is sent to
the recipients.

NOTE: The limit for the number of email recipients in a subscription is 100.

File share: Type the location of the computer and folder where you want the report to be
saved. You must type the absolute pathname to the folder (including the drive letter). The
Windows user account “IONUser” must be configured with valid credentials to read and
write to that fileshare. See your system administrator for assistance. To overwrite an
existing report (if one exists in the folder), select Overwrite existing file. To leave an
existing file in the folder and save the report with a new name, clear Overwrite existing
file.

Printer: From the dropdown list, select the printer to which you want to send the report.

NOTE: For printed subscriptions, the printer must be a local printer on the Primary
Server. For information on setting a network printer as a local printer, consult your
server's documentation.

7. In the Subscription Schedule section, select when you want the report to be generated and
delivered. (You can type the date and time in the respective fields without using the calendar
or dropdown lists). The following items include descriptions for using the calendar and
dropdown lists.
On Trigger: Select this option to configure the subscription to run when an event occurs.
Select the event from the Deliver report on trigger list that you want to use to trigger the
subscription. To use this option, you must first configure an Event Watcher. See the
Event Watcher topic in the online help for Management Console Tools for information on
creating an Event Watcher.

Once: Select this option to run the report once at the specified date and time. Click the
Date field or calendar icon to open a calendar and select the date. You can specify the
hours and minutes by typing over the entries or using the dropdown lists. You can also
click Now to set the date and time to the current server time.

Hourly: Select this option to run the report every hour. Select the time from the Deliver
Report dropdown list (for example, on the hour, 15 minutes after the hour, and so on).

Daily: Select this option to run the report once per day at the specified time. Click the
Time of Day field to open the Choose Time dialog, and either type the hours and minutes
in the respective fields or use the dropdown lists to select the hours and minutes. You can
also click Now to set the time to the current server time.

Weekly: Select this option to run the report once per week, on the day of the week and at
the time that you specify. Select the day from the dropdown list for On. Click the Time of
Day field to open the Choose Time dialog, and either type the hours and minutes in the

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 389


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

respective fields or use the dropdown lists to select the hours and minutes. You can also
click Now to set the time to the current server time.

Monthly — Absolute Monthly: Select Monthly then select Absolute Monthly to run
the report on selected days in the calendar month at a specified time. Type the days in the
On calendar day(s) field. Separate multiple dates with a comma. To select a range of
contiguous days, separate the first and last day in the range with a hyphen. For example,
to schedule the report to run on the 1st, 10th to 15th, and 20th days of the month, type 1,
10-15, 20. After you have entered the days, click the Time of Day field to open the
Choose Time dialog, and either type the hours and minutes in the respective fields or use
the dropdown lists to select the hours and minutes. You can also click Now to set the time
to the current server time.

Monthly — Relative Monthly: Select Monthly then select Relative Monthly to run the
report on a specific day of the week in a selected week of the month at a specified time.
For example, to set the subscription to run on the Monday of the last week of the month,
select Last and Monday from the dropdown lists. Click the Time of Day field to open the
Choose Time dialog, and either type the hours and minutes in the respective fields or use
the dropdown lists to select the hours and minutes. You can also click Now to set the time
to the current server time.

8. (Optional) Click Test Now to test that the report subscription is functioning.

Note that the button is disabled for the Email or Printer delivery options if configuration errors
are detected.

9. Click Save to save the subscription.

Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

390 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 391


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Changing a report subscription


Change report subscriptions to update the subscription properties such as subscription name,
output format, delivery mode, or subscription schedule.
To change a report subscription:

1. In Reports, open the Report Library and select Manage Subscriptions from the Options
menu at the top of the Library. This opens Manage Subscriptions.

2. In Manage Subscriptions, find the subscription you want to change. All existing subscriptions
are displayed in the subscriptions table.

3. To view the options for the subscription, click Edit Subscription to open the Modify
Subscription dialog.

4. In Modify Subscription, change the options in the dialog and click Save to update the
subscription.

5. Click Close.

Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

392 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Deleting a report subscription


Delete report subscriptions that are no longer needed.
To delete a report subscription:

1. In Reports, open the Report Library and select Manage Subscriptions from the Options
menu at the top of the Library. This opens Manage Subscriptions.

2. In Manage Subscriptions, find the subscription you want to delete. All existing subscriptions
are displayed in the subscriptions table.

3. Click Delete Subscription to delete the subscription. Click OK in the confirmation
dialog.

4. Click Close.

Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 393


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Uploading a Report Template


Upload custom Report Templates to generate Reports that are not available by default in the
software.

The tool to upload custom report templates is in Management Console. See the Upload Report
Template topic for information on uploading the custom report template.
Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Uploading a Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

394 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Software Alarms configuration

TIP: You can open Software Alarms rom the SETTINGS > Alarms > Software Alarms page in
Web Applications or from Management Console > Tools > Web Tools > Alarm
Configuration.

Use Software Alarms to set up software-based alarms in PME. For software-based alarms, the
alarm conditions are defined and monitored in the software instead of on the device. PME provides
Alarm Templates to simplify the configuration of software-based alarms. Software based alarms
can be defined for real-time data or for logged data.

Real-time Alarms
These Alarms are based on real-time data coming from monitoring devices. Reliable communication
links to the devices are required for these Alarms to function correctly. Use real-time Alarms for
alarming on power system operational parameters such as currents and voltages.

The following real-time Alarm Templates are available:

Template Notes
Use this alarm to monitor the breaker trip status. Alarms generated
Breaker Status
by this template are categorized as Protection alarms.
Use this alarm to monitor communications between the software
Communication Status and devices. Alarms generated by this template are categorized as
Communication Status alarms.
Use this alarm to monitor phase currents. Alarms generated by this
Over Current
template are categorized as Over Current alarms.
Use this alarm to monitor line to line phase voltages. Alarms
Over Voltage (Line to Line) generated by this template are categorized as Over Voltage
alarms.
Use this alarm to monitor line to neutral phase voltages. Alarms
Over Voltage (Line to
generated by this template are categorized as Over Voltage
Neutral)
alarms.
Use this alarm to monitor Boolean (True/False) values. Alarms
Realtime Digital Setpoint generated by this template are categorized as General Setpoint
alarms.
Use this alarm to monitor analog values. Alarms generated by this
Realtime Setpoint
template are categorized as General Setpoint alarms.
Use this alarm to monitor line to line phase voltages. Alarms
Under Voltage (Line to Line) generated by this template are categorized as Under Voltage
alarms.
Use this alarm to monitor line to neutral phase voltages. Alarms
Under Voltage (Line to
generated by this template are categorized as Under Voltage
Neutral)
alarms.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 395


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

See Real-time Alarms UI for information on Real-time Alarms configuration.

Logged Data Alarms


These Alarms are based on data that has been logged to the database. Logging of the required data
must be configured, and data logs must be in the database for these Alarms to function correctly.
Use logged data Alarms for alarming on consumption type parameters, such as energy or WAGES.

PME provides two types of logged data Alarms: Fixed Setpoint Alarms and Smart Setpoint Alarms.

Fixed Setpoint Alarms


Fixed Setpoint Alarms use pre-defined, fixed threshold values for the Active and Inactive
conditions. For example, you can configure an Over Demand Alarm that goes Active when the
Demand exceeds 800 kW and goes Inactive when the Demand falls below 600 kW. The following
Fixed Setpoint Alarm templates are available:

Template Notes
Set up Alarms for over or under demand. Demand data logs are
Demand required for this Alarm. Alarms generated by this template are
categorized as Demand alarms.
Set up Alarms for water consumption. Water volume data logs are
Water Consumption required for this Alarm. Alarms generated by this template are
categorized as Water alarms.
Set up Alarms for compressed air monitoring. Air volume data logs
Air Consumption are required for this Alarm. Alarms generated by this template are
categorized as Air alarms.
Set up Alarms for fuel gas monitoring. Gas volume data logs are
Gas Consumption required for this Alarm. Alarms generated by this template are
categorized as Gas alarms.
Set up Alarms for electric consumption. Electric energy data logs
Electricity Consumption are required for this Alarm. Alarms generated by this template are
categorized as Electricity alarms.
Set up Alarms for steam monitoring. Steam volume data logs are
Steam Consumption required for this Alarm. Alarms generated by this template are
categorized as Steam alarms.
Set up Alarms for any logged digital measurement in your system.
Datalog Digital Setpoint
Data logs for the measurement are required for this Alarm.
Set up Alarms for any logged analog measurement in your system.
Datalog Setpoint
Data logs for the measurement are required for this Alarm.
Set up Alarms to monitor the retrieval of data for devices connected
via gateway and also for devices, which is not connected to the
Data Log Status
software all the time. Alarms generated by this template are
categorized as Data Log Status alarms.

See Logged Data Alarms UI (Fixed Setpoint) for information on fixed setpoint logged data Alarm
configuration.

396 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Smart Setpoint Alarms


Smart Setpoint Alarms use threshold values for Active and Inactive conditions that are based on
data of the monitored input measurement itself. For example, you can configure an Over Demand
Alarm that goes Active when the Demand is the "Highest Value in last 30 days", or when the value
is "Abnormally High for the day of the week". The following Smart historical Alarm Templates are
available:

Template Notes
Set up Alarms for over or under demand. Demand data logs are
Demand
required for this Alarm. Alarms generated by this template are
(Smart Setpoint)
categorized as Demand alarms.
Set up Alarms for water consumption. Water volume data logs are
Water Consumption
required for this Alarm. Alarms generated by this template are
(Smart Setpoint)
categorized as Water alarms.
Set up Alarms for compressed air monitoring. Air volume data logs
Air Consumption
are required for this Alarm. Alarms generated by this template are
(Smart Setpoint)
categorized as Air alarms.
Set up Alarms for fuel gas monitoring. Gas volume data logs are
Gas Consumption
required for this Alarm. Alarms generated by this template are
(Smart Setpoint)
categorized as Gas alarms.
Set up Alarms for electric consumption. Electric energy
Electricity Consumption
measurement data logs are required for this Alarm. Alarms
(Smart Setpoint)
generated by this template are categorized as Electricity alarms.
Set up Alarms for steam monitoring. Steam volume data logs are
Steam Consumption
required for this Alarm. Alarms generated by this template are
(Smart Setpoint)
categorized as Steam alarms.
Datalog Setpoint Set up Alarms for any logged analog measurement in your system.
(Smart Setpoint) Data logs for the measurement are required for this Alarm.

See Logged Data Alarms UI (Smart Setpoint) for information on fixed setpoint logged data Alarm
configuration.

Software Alarms considerations


Take the following into account when using Software Alarms:

• Configuring many Alarm Rules with short update intervals can affect overall system
performance.

• Alarm state is not evaluated if a device is disabled. For example, a communication loss is not
triggered ON or OFF for a disabled device. Activities like maintenance on a meter can be done
without the need to change the Alarm Rule.

• Communication Loss Alarms are only applied to physical devices. Any logical devices or
downstream devices are removed from the Alarm Rule.

• The Alarm Rule name must be unique in the system. That means you cannot have two Alarm
Rules defined with the same name.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 397


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• The Alarm Name must be unique for a source. That means you cannot enable two Alarms with
the same Alarm Name for the same source.

To configure software Alarms, see:

• Adding a new Alarm Rule

• Enabling or disabling an Alarm Rule

• Editing an Alarm Rule

• Duplicating an Alarm Rule

• Deleting an Alarm Rule

• Using the Setpoint Calculator

• Adding a Schedule

For reference information see:

• Schedules

• Software Alarms UI

• Add Alarm Rule UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

398 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Adding a new Alarm Rule


Add a new Alarm Rule to monitor and alarm on specific conditions in your power system.
To add a new Alarm Rule:

1. In Software Alarms, select the Alarm Rules tab, and then click Add Alarm Rule to open the
Add Alarm Rule window.

2. In Add Alarm Rule, select the Alarm Template that best matches the Alarm you want to
create. Click Next.

3. Select the measurements to alarm on. Click Next.

NOTE: Some Alarm Templates have preselected, recommended measurements. You can
accept these recommended measurements, or select your own.

4. Specify an Alarm Name, the Input Evaluation, Active Condition, Inactive Condition, and
Advanced settings. Click Next.

NOTE: For Smart Alarms, specify the Smart Setpoint conditions instead of the Input
Evaluation.

5. Select the sources to which you want to apply this Alarm Rule. Click Next.

NOTE: Source selection is optional for adding a new alarm rule. However, the alarm rule
cannot be enabled until the sources are selected.

6. (Optional) Select an Alarm Schedule that you want to use for this Alarm Rule. Click Next.

You can Add a new Schedule by clicking Add Schedule. See Adding a Schedule for more
information

7. Specify an Alarm Rule name, enable or disable the Rule, and enable or disable real-time Alarm
Status measurements.

NOTE: By default, real-time Alarm Status measurements are disabled, which means that
information about the state of the Alarm is only available through the Alarms application.
Enable real-time Alarm Status measurements if you want to access Alarm state information
in Diagrams, Trends, or other real-time applications in PME. These status measurements
are not currently available in the VIP/Designer.

8. Click Finish.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarm Rule

• Enabling or disabling an Alarm Rule

• Editing an Alarm Rule

• Duplicating an Alarm Rule

• Deleting an Alarm Rule

• Using the Setpoint Calculator

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 399


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Adding a Schedule

• Software Alarms configuration

For reference information see:

• Schedules

• Software Alarms UI

• Add Alarm Rule UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

400 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Enabling or disabling an Alarm Rule


Enable an alarm rule to start monitoring the alarm conditions defined in the rule for the linked
sources. Disable an alarm rule to stop monitoring the alarm conditions defined in the rule for the
linked sources.
To enable or disable an Alarm Rule:

1. In Software Alarms, select the Alarm Rules tab.

2. In the Alarm Rules table, find the row of the Rule which you want to enable or disable , and
then turn Enabled on or off in this row.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarm Rule

• Enabling or disabling an Alarm Rule

• Editing an Alarm Rule

• Duplicating an Alarm Rule

• Deleting an Alarm Rule

• Using the Setpoint Calculator

• Adding a Schedule

• Software Alarms configuration

For reference information see:

• Schedules

• Software Alarms UI

• Add Alarm Rule UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 401


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Editing an Alarm Rule


Edit an existing Alarm Rule to add or remove sources and measurements, or to modify the Alarm
Rule parameters such as Active and Inactive conditions.
To edit an Alarm Rule:

1. In Software Alarms, select the Alarm Rules tab.

2. In the Alarm Rules table, find the row of the Rule which you want to edit, and then click Edit
in this row to open the Edit Alarm Rule window.

TIP: You can also open the Edit Alarm Rule window by double-clicking the Alarm Rule in the
table or through the Edit command in the right-click context menu.

3. In Edit Alarm Rule, select the tab that contains the settings you want to change.

4. Update the settings.

5. Click Save.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarm Rule

• Enabling or disabling an Alarm Rule

• Editing an Alarm Rule

• Duplicating an Alarm Rule

• Deleting an Alarm Rule

• Using the Setpoint Calculator

• Adding a Schedule

• Software Alarms configuration

For reference information see:

• Schedules

• Software Alarms UI

• Add Alarm Rule UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

402 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Duplicating an Alarm Rule


Duplicate an existing Alarm Rule to save time when creating a new Rule that is similar to an
existing Rule.
To duplicate an Alarm Rule:

1. In Software Alarms, select the Alarm Rules tab.

2. In the Alarm Rules table, find the row of the Rule which you want to duplicate, and then click

Duplicate in this row to open the Edit Alarm Rule window.

TIP: You can also duplicate an Alarm Rule through the Duplicate command in the right-click
context menu.

3. In Edit Alarm Rule, review the Rule settings in the different tabs and update the settings for
the duplicated Rule as needed.

4. Click Save.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarm Rule

• Enabling or disabling an Alarm Rule

• Editing an Alarm Rule

• Duplicating an Alarm Rule

• Deleting an Alarm Rule

• Using the Setpoint Calculator

• Adding a Schedule

• Software Alarms configuration

For reference information see:

• Schedules

• Software Alarms UI

• Add Alarm Rule UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 403


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Deleting an Alarm Rule


Delete Alarm Rules that are no longer needed.
To delete an Alarm Rule:

1. In Software Alarms, select the Alarm Rules tab.

2. In the Alarm Rules table, find the row of the Rule which you want to delete, and then click
Delete in this row. This opens the Delete Alarm Rule confirmation box.

TIP: You can also delete an Alarm Rule through the Delete command in the right-click
context menu.

3. Click Delete.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarm Rule

• Enabling or disabling an Alarm Rule

• Editing an Alarm Rule

• Duplicating an Alarm Rule

• Deleting an Alarm Rule

• Using the Setpoint Calculator

• Adding a Schedule

• Software Alarms configuration

For reference information see:

• Schedules

• Software Alarms UI

• Add Alarm Rule UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

404 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Using the Setpoint Calculator


Use the Setpoint Calculator to calculate values for the Active and Inactive Alarm conditions.

1. Click Calculate Values in the Add Alarm Rule - Details window for a new Alarm Rule, or
the Details tab in the Edit Alarm Rule window for an existing Alarm Rule. This opens Setpoint
Calculator.

2. In Setpoint Calculator, enter a baseline value for the measurement you want to monitor in the
Baseline entry field.

For example, for an Over Voltage alarm, assume you enter a baseline value of 480.

3. Enter a percentage value in the On Setpoint entry field to calculate when the alarm is set ON.

Using the voltage baseline of 480, if you enter a 105 as the percentage value for On
Setpoint, the calculated value is 504, which displays below the entry field.

Initially, the On Setpoint and Off Setpoint entry fields are linked. That is, the value you enter
in On Setpoint is automatically duplicated in the Off Setpoint entry field.

4. To set a different value for Off Setpoint , click the link button to disable the linking of the
entry fields, and then enter a percentage value in the Off Setpoint entry field.

The off setpoint value is calculated and displays below the entry field. For example, using the
voltage baseline of 480, if you enter 95 as the percentage value for Off Setpoint, the
calculated value is 456, which displays below the entry field.

5. Click Apply to add your setpoint values to the respective Active Condition and Inactive
Condition fields, or click Cancel to discard your entries and to close the Setpoint Calculator.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarm Rule

• Enabling or disabling an Alarm Rule

• Editing an Alarm Rule

• Duplicating an Alarm Rule

• Deleting an Alarm Rule

• Using the Setpoint Calculator

• Adding a Schedule

• Software Alarms configuration

For reference information see:

• Schedules

• Software Alarms UI

• Add Alarm Rule UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 405


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a Schedule
Add a Schedule to be used for controlling when Alarm Rules are active and inactive. The new
Schedule will be available in the Select Alarm Schedule selection box in the Add Alarm Rule -
Schedule window for a new Alarm Rule, or the Schedule tab in the Edit Alarm Rule window for an
existing Alarm Rule.
To add a Schedule:

1. Click Add Schedule.


You can access this control in the:
Schedules tab of the main Software Alarms user interface

Add Alarm Rule - Schedule window (when adding a new Alarm Rule)

Edit Alarm Rule > Schedule tab (when editing an existing Alarm Rule)

2. Enter a Schedule Name.

3. Define the active and inactive days and times of the Schedule.

4. Click Save.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarm Rule

• Enabling or disabling an Alarm Rule

• Editing an Alarm Rule

• Duplicating an Alarm Rule

• Deleting an Alarm Rule

• Using the Setpoint Calculator

• Adding a Schedule

• Software Alarms configuration

For reference information see:

• Schedules

• Software Alarms UI

• Add Alarm Rule UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

406 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Schedules
Use Schedules to control when an alarm rule is applied or not. Schedules are based on the time of
day and the day of the week. For example, you can set up an Over Demand Alarm with certain
threshold conditions for weekdays, and another Over Demand Alarm with different threshold
conditions for weekends.
The following rules apply to schedules:

• Schedules are applied in the timezone of each source. If an alarm rule has sources from
different timezones, then it is possible for a schedule to be active for some sources, and
inactive for other sources at the same time.

• If an alarm is in the active state when a schedule transitions to inactive, then the alarm is
deactivated.

• Real-time measurement alarms and communication status alarms are only evaluated when the
schedule is active.

• Historical measurement alarms are only evaluated against data that was logged when the
schedule was active.

NOTE: A historical data log timestamp marks the end of the logging interval. For example, a
data log with a 15 minute logging interval and timestamp of 17:00 represents data for the time
interval of 16:45 - 17:00.

Related topics:

• Adding a new Alarm Rule

• Enabling or disabling an Alarm Rule

• Editing an Alarm Rule

• Duplicating an Alarm Rule

• Deleting an Alarm Rule

• Using the Setpoint Calculator

• Adding a Schedule

• Software Alarms configuration

For reference information see:

• Schedules

• Software Alarms UI

• Add Alarm Rule UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 407


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

System integration
This section provides information on how to integrate Power Monitoring Expert with other
EcoStruxure™ systems.

Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for:

Topic Content
References to Power Operation documentation with integration
Integration with PO
configuration information.
Detailed configuration information on the integration of PME with
Integration with EBO
EcoStruxure Building Operation.

408 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Integration with EcoStruxure™ Power Operation


The goal of this integration is to combine the PME Reports and Dashboards features with the Power
Operation functionality. In the integrated system, Power Operation shows PME reports and
dashboards embedded in the Power Operation user interfaces for a seamless user experience.

For configuration information on this integration see the Power Operation System Guide.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 409


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Integration with EcoStruxure Building Operation - Configuring


Configuring the PME/EBO Integration solution includes the following steps:

1. Configuring server settings

2. Configuring communications

3. Configuring PME Web Applications

4. Integrating PME Web applications in Building Operation

5. Setting up Graphics in Building Operation

6. Configuring Dashboards and Slideshows

NOTE: These steps are required for both solution architectures, unless specifically called out in
the workflow steps.

See the following sections for details.

410 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

1. Configuring server settings


PME server

Install a security certificate for TLS 1.2

PME uses Transport Layer Security (TLS) 1.2 for an encrypted, authenticated connection using
HTTPS between the server and the Web clients.

A security certificate must be installed on the PME server and must be bound to the Default Web
Site, which is used by PME. By default, if no bound certificate is detected, PME is installed with a
self-signed certificate.

RECOMMENDATION: We strongly recommend that you replace the self-signed certificate with
an authority issued certificate.

Set SQL Server memory options

Set the SQL Server memory options to optimize system performance.

NOTE: Setting the SQL Server memory options applies only to full, standard editions of SQL
Server. It does not apply to SQL Server Express editions.

See Setting SQL Server memory options for details.

See After installing the software for additional recommended post-installation configuration steps.

Building Operation server

Add PME server as Trusted site in Internet Options

Building Operation and PME can be installed on the same server (operating system) or on two
separate servers.

When installing on separate servers, you must configure Internet Explorer on the Building Operation
computer to add the PME server URL as a Trusted site.

To add the PME server URL as a Trusted site:

1. Open Internet Explorer and navigate to Tools > Internet Options, then click Security.

2. Select Local intranet, and then click Sites. The Local intranet dialog appears.

3. (For IE 11) In Local intranet, click Advanced.

4. In the Add this website to the zone field, enter your PME server site address, and then click
Add. Your PME server site is now added as a Local intranet site zone.

5. Click OK. Your system can now authenticate your Power Monitoring Expert server.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 411


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2. Configuring Communications
The configuration of the software and device communications is dependent on the solution
architecture. The following describes the configuration required for Architecture 1 and 2.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Architecture 1
Configuring communications for Architecture 1 includes the following steps:

1. Adding devices to Building Operation

2. Configuring EWS settings in Building Operation

3. Configuring the ETL

See the following sections for details.

Adding devices to Building Operation

Add the power devices to Building Operation. For information on how to add devices to Building
Operation, see the EcoStruxure Building Operation Technical Reference Guide.

Configuring EWS settings in Building Operation

In Building Operation Workstation, navigate to <Your server name>\System\EcoStruxure


Web Services and check to see that the EWS Server settings match the following:

412 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Confirm that:

• Enable EWS Server is set to "True"

• Ensure secure communication is set to “Disabled”

• Server Value is set to “True.”

We recommended you setup a dedicated ETLUser account for EWS in Building Operation.

To create an account:

1. Navigate to <Your Server name>\System\Domains\Local\Users\ and click New >


User Account.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 413


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2. Make sure ETLUser is a member of “Administrators” account group:

Configuring the ETL

The ETL tool connects to the Building Operation EWS server, reads out the required historical data
(Trend logs), and inserts that data into the PME database. Within the ETL, the task descriptions
required to complete the data copy process are organized into Jobs.

An ETL Job contains the following:

• An Extract task to read out the data from a server (in this case, Building Operation)

• (Optional) A Transform task to edit the data

• A Load task to write the data to the new location (in this case, the PME database).

TIP: When creating a new job in ETL, you can clone an existing job, rather than making a job from
scratch. To clone a job, select an existing job from the Job Management drop down and click Edit.
In the Job tab, change the name to reflect the new job. Click the Task tab and edit the new job as
necessary. Click Apply or OK from any tab location to save the job with the new name.

The following sections describe how to configure an ETL Job for the PME/EBO Integration solution,
Architecture 1 implementation.

Prerequisites
Before configuring the ETL, confirm that:

• Building Operation is installed and configured.

• Trend logs and Extended Trend logs are setup and ready to use in Building Operation. For
information regarding Trend logs, refer to the "Trend log" section in the EcoStruxure Building
Operation System Reference Guide

• PME is installed and configured

414 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• The EWS server in Building Operation is functioning correctly.

• ETL is installed correctly

Creating an ETL job


To create an ETL job:

1. On your desktop, double-click the shortcut EcoStruxure ETL (Building Operation to PME) -
ETL Administration Tool. The ETL Engine Job Configuration Tool dialog appears.

2. Click New. The Job tab appears.

3. Enter the name of the job in the Name field. If you are running the job as a service, review and
change the Sleep Time Between Execution value, if necessary. This value determines the
length of time between jobs when a job is run as a service. The default value is 3600 seconds.

4. Click the Tasks tab. The Tasks pane appears.

TIP: See ETL tips and tricks for information such as batch edits, sorting and searching data grids,
running a job manually or as a service, editing job tasks.

Adding and configuring the Extract task


To add and configure the Extract task:

1. From the Select Category drop-down, select Extract.

2. From the Select Type drop-down, select EBO EWS Extract Task, and then click Add. The
EBO EWS Extract Task appears in the pane below.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 415


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. Select the task to show the task settings in the right pane.

4. Complete all fields as necessary for the task. Complete at least the following fields:
Web Service User Name – The Building Operation EWS user name (for example: admin)

Web Service Password – The Building Operation EWS password

Web Service URL – Replace localhost:8080 with your <server name>:<http port
number>

NOTE: The ETL does not support secure HTTP (HTTPS) URLs. Do not use HTTPS URLs with
the Building Operation EWS server.

NOTE: The ETL does not support the SHA-256 Cryptographic Hash Algorithm for authentication.
You must enable the MD5 Cryptographic Hash Algorithm for authentication in Building Operation
for the PME/EBO Integration solution. The option can be found in WorkStation Control Panel >
Security Settings > Disable MD5 Hash.

To test your EWS connection, click the Web Service URL row to display an ellipsis button. Click
the ellipsis button. Enter your Web Service URL and then click Test.

Refer to Extract task: Setting parameters and recommended values in the Reference section to see
a complete list of parameters and recommended values for each setting.

(Optional) Adding and configuring the Transform task


A Transform task is not required for the PME/EBO Integration solution. However, it is possible to
improve the data quality for the display in PME Dashboards and Reports by correcting irregular
timestamps for interval logged data. The IntervalizeDataTransformTask task in the ETL can be
used for this purpose. It is designed to adjust the log timestamps to a pre-defined interval.

416 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Below is an example of a 15-minute interval data log with irregular timestamps, before and after the
transform:

Before Transforming After Transforming (15 min. interval)


Value Timestamp Value Timestamp
1.23 23:58:12 1.23 00:00:00
2.34 00:07:11 n/a n/a
3.45 00:13:13 3.45 00:15:00
4.56 00:31:14 3.45 00:30:00
5.67 00:43:17 5.67 00:45:00

NOTE: The transform only corrects the timestamps, not the logged data values for the intervals.
This can introduce inaccuracies in the logged data.

DO NOT use this transform task,

• for Change of Value (COV) data logs

• when timestamp consistency between the data in Building Operation and PME is important

To add and configure the Intervalize Data Transform task:

1. From the Select Category drop-down, select Transform.

2. from the Select Type drop-down, select IntervalizeDataTransformTask and then click Add.
The Intervalize Transform Task appears in the pane below.

3. Select the task to show the task settings in the right pane.

4. Complete all fields as necessary for the task. Complete at least the following field:
Target Reading Interval – Set this value to your Trend log logging interval (default is
fifteen minutes).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 417


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Refer to Transform task: Setting parameters and recommended values in the Reference section to
see a complete list of parameters and recommended values for each setting.

Adding and configuring the Load task


To add and configure the Load task:

1. From the Select Category drop down, select Load.

2. Select Power Monitoring Expert Load Task from the Select Type drop-down menu, and then
click Add. The Power Monitoring Expert Load Task appears in the pane below.

3. Select the task to show the task settings in the right pane.

4. Complete all fields as necessary for the task. Complete at least the following fields:
Database Settings – Make sure all 3 database settings are correct.

Enable Recorder and Channel Creation – Set this value to True.

NOTE: If you plan to use the Energy Cost Report or Load Profile Report, review the Enable
Recorder and Channel Creation setting in Load task: Setting parameters and
recommended values.

5. After you finish configuring all necessary tasks, click Apply to save your changes without
exiting the job, or click OK to save and exit the job.

Refer to Load task: Setting parameters and recommended values in the Reference section to see a
complete list of parameters and recommended values for each setting.

Mapping Building Operation tags to PME measurements


Building Operation is a tag-based system, while PME is a Device/Measurement-based system.
Therefore, you must use the Mappings tab to manually map the tags to the corresponding
Device/Measurements.

TIP: See ETL tips and tricks for information such as batch edits, sorting and searching data grids,
running a job manually or as a service, editing job tasks.

418 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

To map tags to measurements:

1. In the ETL tool, select the job you created for the PME/EBO Integration solution.

2. Click the Mappings tab. The Mappings dialog appears.

3. Click Load Sources. Trend logs from Building Operation load and appear in the Mappings
pane.

Depending on the size and the design of your system, the Trend logs may take some time (up
to 30 minutes) to load.

After you click Load Sources, the Client status details appear at the lower left of the dialog and
show the number of tags loaded and folders searched.

4. Once loaded, identify the rows containing the Trend logs that you want to import into PME.

5. For each row, do the following:


Complete the Target Device field by selecting an existing device from the drop-down list,
or by entering a new name for a device.

NOTE:
If you create a new device, your new device name must match the PME naming
convention. The following limitations apply:
Names cannot contain spaces or the following characters: \ / : * ? " < > { } . , ' & @ |
%#

Do not use names such as CON, AUX, COM1, and LPT1 when naming sites and
devices.

Complete the Target Measurement field by selecting an existing measurement from the
drop-down list.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 419


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Refer to Measurement mapping for ETL in the Reference section to learn about the most
common, supported measurements used in PME and how to link to typical Building
Management tags.

Select the Time Zone from the dropdown list.

Change the value for the scale, if necessary.

Select the checkbox in the Included column at the left to include the Trend log in this job.

6. After you have mapped all desired Trend logs, click Apply to save the job.

Troubleshooting missing Trend logs


All Building Operation Trend logs should appear in the Trend log list. If Trend logs do not appear,
check the following:

• Missing bindings: Values that have not been bound to the graphics.

• Trend log status is not Started: If the Trend log status is not “Started” in Building Operation
through the EWS server, the Trend logs will not be exposed in the ETL tool, and therefore, those
Trend logs will not be returned or displayed in the ETL tool. All Trend logs should be exposed in
the ETL tool and appear in the Mappings tab when you click Load Sources. Before you run an
ETL job, in Building Operation, check to make sure that the Trend log status is set to “Started”;

• Meters/servers offline: The Trend logs are connected to devices or servers that are offline.

• Extended Trend log link not broken: Trend logs that are being monitored by Extended Trend logs
where the connection is not broken.

Architecture 2
Configuring communications for Architecture 2 includes the following steps:

1. Adding devices to PME

2. Updating the PME EWS server

See the following sections for details.

420 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Adding devices to PME

NOTE: Device licenses are required for all devices connected to PME. The PME trial license, that
is part of the PME/EBO Integration solution, includes an unlimited device license for the first 90
days. You must activate valid purchased licenses within 90 days, otherwise some software
functionality is disabled.

NOTICE
LOSS OF COMMUNICATION
• Activate product and component licenses prior to the expiry of the trial license.
• Activate sufficient licenses for the servers and devices in your system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in loss of data.

Use Management Console in PME to add, remove or configure system components, such as
Ethernet or serial metering devices, in your system.

NOTE: Run Management Console as Administrator user. To do this, right-click the Management
Console program icon and select Run as administrator from the context menu. If you do not run
it as Administrator, then certain tools such as Update EWS Server are not functional.

NOTE: Access to this application or function is controlled by user privileges. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

NOTICE
NETWORK INOPERABILITY
Do not make unauthorized changes in the network configuration.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in an unstable or unusable network.

See Setting up your network in Management Console or Device Manager for details on how to add
devices.

Updating the EWS Server

After adding the devices or making any changes to the device configuration in the PME, you must
update the EWS server through the Update EWS Server tool in the Management Console.

NOTE: Run Management Console as Administrator user. To do this, right-click the Management
Console program icon and select Run as administrator from the context menu. If you do not run
it as Administrator, then certain tools such as Update EWS Server are not functional.

To update EWS Server:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 421


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. Open Management Console.

2. Select Tools > System > Update EWS Server. A dialog box appears indicating that the
update to the EWS server configuration was successful.

3. Click OK when the Update EWS Server confirmation dialog appears.

422 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

3. Configuring PME Web Applications


Configuring the PME Web applications may include the following settings and tools:

• Personal Preferences

• Report Theme

• System Language

• System Theme

• Diagnostics and Usage

• Registration

• Diagrams Control Options

• Login Options

• Session Timeout

• Authorized Hosts

• Billing Rates

• Device Manager

• Hierarchies

• Modeling

• System Log

• User Manager

See Web Applications settings for details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 423


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Integrating PME Web applications in Building Operation


Integrating PME Web applications in Building Operation includes the following steps:

• Configuring Dashboard, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, Reports, and EWS measurements and
generate the import file with the web application Integration Utility settings.

• Importing the configuration file into Building Operation

• Setting up EWS credentials in PME (server) and Building Operation (client)

• Enabling embedded content in PME and Building Operation

See the following sections for details.

Prerequisites
Before using the PME/EBO Integration Utility, complete the following tasks:

• Install and configure PME.

• Install and configure Building Operation.

• (Only for Architecture 2 solutions) Add devices to PME.

• (Only for Architecture 2 solutions) Update the EWS Server.

• (Optional) Configure PME and Building Operation to use Windows Active Directory users and
user groups.

• (Optional) Install and configure an authority issued security certificate on the PME server.

Configuring web applications and generating the configuration import file for Building
Operation
You use the PME Web application Integration Utility settings, on the PME server, to configure
Dashboard, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, Reports, and EWS measurements for integration into
Building Operation. As a result of the configuration, the utility creates a configuration file, that is then
imported into Building Operation.

NOTE: The Integration Utility is a Web application settings in PME. You need to configure using
this utility on the PME computer. If Building Operation and PME are installed on separate
computers, then configure in the PME computer and extract its contents. See 1. Downloading the
PME/EBO Integration Toolkit for more information.

To configure Dashboard, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, Reports, and EWS measurements and to
generate import file:

424 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

1. Open Web Applications from the EcoStruxure Power Monitoring Expert folder on your
desktop, the Schneider Electric folder on the Start Screen, or by entering the PME server URL
into your browser Address bar, e.g. http://srv1.MyCompany.com/Web

2. Login with a supervisor-level account.

3. Navigate to Settings > Security > Integrations > Integration Utility.

4. Under Authentication Method, select the desired user type for authentication:

RECOMMENDATION: Use Windows User Authentication whenever possible.

NOTICE
UNAUTHORIZED OR UNINTENDED ACCESS TO CUSTOMER DATA
• Personnel setting up the PME/EBO Integration third-party authentication must be aware
that links to data are not secure.
• Do not setup access links to sensitive or secure data.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unauthorized or unintended access
to sensitive or secure customer data.

Select Windows User.

NOTE: Links for Windows users contain no user information. Windows users accessing
the link must have permission to access the PME system and be authenticated with
Windows. One-click login must be enabled to use the Windows user authenticated links.
See Login Options for information for enabling one-click login.

To use Windows User Authentication:


Configure Building Operation and PME to use Windows Active Directory users and
user groups.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 425


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Add the Windows account that is used for Windows Authentication to PME as a
Windows user with Operator access level or higher.

Enable One-Click Login in PME. See Login Options for details.

For information on setting up user authentication with Windows Active Directory in PME,
see Adding a Windows user and Adding a Windows group.

For information on Building Operation and Active Directory, see Setting Up User
Authentication with Windows Active Directory in Building Operation.

Select Standard User, select the desired PMEUser Name and enter the Password.

NOTE: Links for standard users embed the user's account information. Take care on
usage of these links. Links cannot be generated for standard users with supervisor
access level.

Links generated for standard users are pre-authenticated based on the access level of the
selected users. If you want to disable the pre-authentication, then Under Pre-
Authentication for Standard Users, turn Enable pre-authentication to off.

5. Under Generate Links For, select from the following web applications for which you want to
generate link:

Dashboards

Diagrams (only for Architecture 2 solutions)

Trends

Alarms

Reports

EWS Measurements (only for Architecture 2 solutions)

6. Under Link Format, select XML.

NOTE: (Optional) Select HTML to generate an HTML page of links. Use this option to verify
the links. The download HTML link must be opened in a different browser to test the links.

7. Click Generate Web Application Links.

The configuration import file in .xml format is downloaded to the default download location of
the browser.

Importing the configuration file into Building Operation


The configuration file, that was created in the previous step, needs to be imported into Building
Operation. To prepare for the import, copy the file to a location that is accessible from the Building
Operation server.

To import the configuration file into Building Operation:

426 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

1. Open Building Operation and log into WorkStation.

2. Right-click the Enterprise server (the highest level in the System Tree) and select Import....

3. Navigate to and select the configuration file.

4. Click Import. The file import process completes. A new folder called “PME/EBO Integration”
appears in the System Tree.

NOTE: You can use the web application Integration Utility settings more than once. However,
importing the configuration file multiple times without deleting the previously imported folder will
create a duplicate entry in the target Building Operation system.

Setting up EWS credentials in PME (server) and Building Operation (client)


EWS credentials must be set for both the PME EWS server and the Building Operation EWS client.
To set the credentials for the PME EWS server:

1. Open PME Web Applications and select SETTINGS > Integrations > EWS Login.

NOTE: EWS must be enabled in PME for this setting to be visible.

TIP: Access Web Applications through the Web Applications shortcut in the Power
Monitoring Expert desktop folder on the PME server. Or, to go directly to the
EWS configuration page, open the following URL: https://<server_
name>/Web/#Settings/Ews

2. Click Change Credentials or Set Credentials, if this is the first time the account is
configured and enter a User name and Password.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 427


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices for password creation and management.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access - such as least privilege,
separation of duties - vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to
ensure that user access adheres to the site-specific cybersecurity policies.

3. Click Save.

To set the credentials for the Building Operation EWS client:

1. In WorkStation, open the PME/EBO Integration folder.

2. Right-click the EWS Client and click Properties.

3. Enter the user name and password in the Authentication field.

4. Click OK.

Enabling embedded content in PME and Building Operation


PME does not allow other applications to embed its Web Applications content by default. Building
Operation does not allow external web content from another application to be embedded in its UI by
default. For the PME/EBO integration, both of these must be enabled.

428 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

To allow Building Operation to receive and embed web content from PME:

1. Log into Building Operation Workstation and select Tools > Control Panel > Security and
Communication > Security Settings.

2. In Security Settings, under WebStation, select Enable external content to be embedded in


WebStation.

To allow PME Web Applications to be embedded in Building Operation:

1. Open PME Web Applications and select SETTINGS > Security > Authorized Hosts.

2. Add the Building Operation server URL to the Hosts That Can Frame list.
Below is an example for a Building Operation server host URL of
https://localhost:446

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 429


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. Click Save.

4. Reset Internet Information Services (IIS) on the PME server.

430 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

5. Setting up Graphics in Building Operation


Building Operation Components and Snippets
The EBO integration files folder in PME ISO includes components and snippets for the creation of
Graphics in Building Operation.

NOTE: These components and snippets were installed on the Building Operation server in a
previous step. See 3. Installing the components, snippets, and binding template for details.

Components

Animated Components for ANSI and IEC


The EBO integration files folder in PME ISO includes a set of animated Components that are
based on the American National Standards Institute (ANSI) and International Electrotechnical
Commission (IEC) symbol standards. These can be used by the Building Operation Graphics
Editor.

Static device images


The EBO integration files folder in PME ISO  includes a library of device images that can be used
in the Building Operation Graphics Editor. Use the images represent the devices and equipment
present in your system. They can be added to a diagram by selecting the device from the Meter
Graphics category and dragging the image to the work area.

The library contains images for the following devices:

• ION6200 • PM5000 Series


• ION7550/7650 • EM3500 Series
• PM700 Series • Acti 9 iEM 3000 Series
• PM800 Series • Veris E50 Series
• PM3200 Series

NOTE: Device images are available for: a). meters that are bound and show data, and b). meters
that are not bound and show no data. Choose the device images that best represent your system.

Snippets

The EBO integration files folder in PME ISO includes a Building Operation snippet that is
designed to be used with the ANSI and IEC components.

Advanced Tooltip Snippet


The Advanced Tooltip Snippet provides information regarding a specific device when the pointer
hovers over it. The display text of the tool tip can be customized, and the following properties can be
defined:

• Font size

• Font color

• Number of decimal places to display

• Measurements to show

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 431


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Setting up Electrical Network Graphics


Use the Building Operation Graphics Editor to create Graphics that represents an electrical network.
For example, a one-line Graphic, that includes all of the metering devices and circuits, or an
Electrical Health Summary Graphic that shows the loading of the metered circuits in the system.
Example of a one-line Graphic, created with the Building Operation Graphics Editor:

Example of an Electrical Health Summary graphic, created with the Building Operation Graphics
Editor:

432 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Basic instructions for setting up Electrical Network Graphics

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To set up an Electrical Network Graphic:

1. Open the Building Operation Graphics Editor.

2. Create an electrical network diagram by dragging and dropping graphics onto your new file
from the imported graphics libraries (meter graphics, symbols, controls, and so on) in the left
pane.

3. For the components that you drag and drop into the graphic, select the component, and then
modify the component Name, in the General section of the Properties pane. The Name must
match the PME “GroupName.DeviceName” or the SmartWidget Name of the device for which
you want to display data.

NOTE: This Name is used by the binding template for measurement binding. See Binding
Graphics to measurements for details.

For more details on how to use the Graphics Editor, see the EcoStruxure Building Operation
Technical Reference Guide and the Building Operation Graphics Editor Web help.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 433


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Binding Graphics to measurements


The EBO integration files folder in PME ISO includes a binding template to automate the binding
of Building Operation graphics components to device measurements.

When you create the EWS interface in Building Operation Workstation, a connection is made
between Building Operation and PME. The PME/EBO Integration folder in Building Operation
Workstation then contains all the device names and measurements from PME. Any graphics
components that have the correct PME device name set up will be bound to their device counterpart
when the binding template is applied. Since the binding template also contains the Modbus Point
name often used in SmartWidgets, it can also be used to bind graphics to values from the
SmartWidgets.

NOTE: This binding template was installed on the Building Operation server in a previous step.
See 3. Installing the components, snippets, and binding template for details.

Prerequisites

Before applying the binding template, confirm the following:

• The EWS interface has been established

• The components in the Building Operation Graphics Editor diagram have been correctly
configured

• The binding template has been imported into Building Operation Workstation

Applying the binding template

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To apply the binding template:

1. In Building Operation Workstation, in the System Tree pane, right-click the graphic item for
which you want to use the binding template.

2. Select Edit Bindings from the list. The Binding point list appears in the work area.

3. Drag and drop the PME/EBO Integration folder or the folder that contains the SmartWidgets to
the PME- Basic binding template. The Confirm Binding dialog appears.

434 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

4. Confirm that the binding and binding points are correct.

5. Click File > Save when finished.

NOTE: The PME/EBO Integration binding template can only be used for an English version of the
PME/EBO Integration solution. For non-English systems, you need to manually bind the EWS
values or create a custom binding template.

NOTE: The PME/EBO Integration is also known as Power Manager. These names refer to the
same solution.

6. Configuring Dashboards and Slideshows


See Dashboards configuration for details on how to configure dashboards and slideshows.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 435


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

System performance
PME is installed with a number of factory default settings that should be acceptable for most
installations. However, the needs of individual systems can be different from one another and there
are several parameters that can be used to fine-tune PME.

Device communications
See Network performance for information on how to optimize device communications.

Operating conditions
There are two operating conditions that PME experiences when communicating with devices in the
network:

• System start-up (when first connecting to devices).

• Steady-state (during normal operation of the software).

System Start-up
During system start-up it is normal for the software to perform slowly as it communicates to devices
in the network and downloads the available historic logs. Depending on how long the devices have
been in service there could be over a month of historic logs, PQ events, and waveforms to
download. This behavior is particularly noticeable on long daisy chains that include meters with a
high quantity of on-board logged data.

After the system has downloaded the available logs from devices, the performance of PME can be
measured and, if necessary, appropriate action can be taken to improve it. The Diagnostics Viewer
in Management Console should be used to determine when the historic logs have been downloaded
from devices.

1. In Diagnostics Viewer expand Service Diagnostics and click

LOGINSERTER.<server_name>.

2. Select the available devices in the Select Nodes list.

3. Select the Log Performance tab to display the status of the historic logs in the devices.

4. Scroll to the right to show the CaughtUp column.

436 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

During system start-up the CaughtUp column displays No, indicating that there are historic logs on
the devices that have not yet been downloaded to the database. As the logs are downloaded the
individual rows change to Yes. Continue to monitor this column for several minutes to verify that the
logs have been completely downloaded. At this point the software is in steady-state operation.

Steady State
After the system has completely started up, you can use the Diagnostics Viewer to diagnose and
tune the field-level communication.

1. Ensure that all of the devices on the daisy chain to be tested are enabled.

2. Apply the desired test load to the devices on the daisy chain (for example VIP, Vista, OPC,
Diagrams, or Log Inserter).

3. In the Diagnostics Viewer, expand Communications Diagnostics and select the site of the
associated daisy chain.

4. Select the Communication Status tab.

5. Right-click the Communication Status pane and select Reset.

6. Let the system gather metrics. For real-time data loads, a few minutes is usually enough. For
logging, it is better to leave it for an hour or more, depending on logging intervals.

For each site (either a daisy chain with a gateway or an Ethernet device), the Time Util (%) column
indicates how utilized the communication channel is:

Time Util (%) Description


Increase the real-time and historical requests to the site without
0 - 70 losing performance. Still have bandwidth for periods of heavy
usage.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 437


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Time Util (%) Description


Heavy usage. Potential to saturate the bandwidth if more clients
70 - 99
connect or power quality events occur.
100 Communication channel is saturated.

A value at 100% indicates that the daisy chain is saturated and may not be providing responses as
quickly as all requesting clients are configured to meet. For example, this could mean that instead of
5 second updates in Vista, you may see it as 6 or more seconds depending on how saturated the
site is.

Conversely, a low percentage indicates room for more data requests. The user can set the software
components (Real-time clients, LogInserter) to poll more quickly to achieve better user experience,
or put more devices on the same daisy chain.

See Diagnostics Viewer for more information.

Performance related settings


PME is installed with a number of factory default settings that should be acceptable for most
installations. However, the needs of individual systems can be different from one another and there
are several parameters that can be used to fine-tune PME.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Registry Settings
The registry keys below can be used to adjust PME performance. These keys are located under
HKEY_LOCAL_ MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring Expert in the
registry. If the impact of the change is not well understood, then consider an alternate fix or consult
Technical Support for guidance.

ConnectedThreadPoolSize (DWORD; default 200): The number of sites ION SiteServer service
sends requests to simultaneously. Ideally, this value is equal to or greater than the number of sites
in the system (that is, serial sites, Ethernet gateway sites, and Ethernet devices) up to a maximum
of 400.

LI_PollingPeriod_s (DWORD; default 30): The minimum time (in seconds) between polls for a
historic log position of a given log. This is a global setting used to adjust the amount of Log Inserter
driven communication traffic for the entire system.

438 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

LI_MaxPollingPeriod_s (DWORD; default 60): This is the maximum value that LI_PollingPeriod_s
can be set to. If you increase LI_PollingPeriod_s beyond 60, you also need to increase this setting.

NOTE: Other performance tuning settings may be available. Contact a Technical Support
representative to look at your specific needs.

Scheduled Log Upload


PME has an xml file that can be used to control how and when the Log Inserter uploads logged data
from the devices to the database. It is possible to define which device logs are uploaded on a per-
device basis. and when they are uploaded. By reducing Log Inserter-generated communications
traffic, real-time performance can be improved.

This control is achieved by editing the LogAcquisitionControl.xml file. The file includes examples
of required syntax and possible configurations. Note that this feature is for advanced users only.

LogAcquisitionControl.xml is located in the \config\cfg\logsrv folder in PME.


To begin, open the control file LogAcquisitionControl.xml. It specifies:

• Which device types or device instances you want to exclude from the device polling list.
Excluding a device from the polling list has the same effect as disabling it as far as Log Inserter
is concerned. If a device is disabled in this file, the Log Inserter will no longer check it for current
log position counters or other device properties that Log Inserter usually cares about (aggregate
setup counter, device type, and serial number).

• It is possible to exclude specific recorders from specific devices from the polling ION request.

• Polling intervals can be set for any device type or device instance. They can also be set to
change based on a schedule. The schedules used by this feature are defined using the TOU
Editor tool that is available from the Tools menu in Management Console.

Gateway Transmit Delay


The transmit delay for gateways (for example, an EGX100 site) can be reduced from the default of
50ms to 0ms in some cases. Check the % error rate in Diagnostics Viewer to help ensure that
problems have not been introduced. Note that some devices, CM2000 in particular, should not have
the transmit delay set lower than 50ms to avoid over- loading the device and potentially resulting in
bad logged data.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 439


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example of the transmit delay setting in Management Console:

440 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Time synchronization for ION meters


You can synchronize the internal clocks of all networked PowerLogic™ ION™ meters and devices
through the Management Console component of Power Monitoring Expert. When they are
synchronized, all data logs have time stamps that are relative to a uniform time base.

NOTE: This information is specific to ION devices. It is not applicable to devices that are not
based on ION architecture.

Time synchronization signals are broadcast periodically over the network; each meter continually
assesses its ability to remain synchronized with the incoming broadcasts. Over a brief period, each
meter learns how its internal timing differs from that of the broadcast source and adjusts its
timekeeping to compensate. Very accurate time synchronization is achieved with this method.

Meters at modem sites are synchronized each time they are connected. The longer the duration
between connections, the larger the error in time synchronization. In the extreme case, this can
result in missing or duplicated logs. If this occurs, you can increase the frequency of connections
through the Power Monitoring Expert software connection.

NOTE: This information assumes that you are using the time synchronization function in Power
Monitoring Expert. Although other methods of time synchronization are available, such as with
ION Setup, a Network Time Protocol (NTP) server, a Global Positioning System (GPS) receiver,
or 3rd party protocols, it is important that you use only one method of time synchronization on each
network. If you use multiple methods, the timestamps will differ for the sites and devices that are
using separate time synchronizing methods.

Before you configure time synchronization on your network, you should familiarize yourself with the
Clock module settings. Once you have done this, you can decide which synchronization method
you want to use.

Enabling and configuring time synchronization


Time synchronization in Power Monitoring Expert is initially disabled and needs to be enabled and
configured through Management Console. The communications port and protocol used for
communications between the software and the networked ION devices is automatically used to
send time synchronization signals to all connected ION devices. The software sends a time sync
packet and the time is set when the packet is received.

When reviewing time synchronization messages in the system log, remember that the time in the
message is not the time to which the meter was time synced, but rather it is the time the message
was posted to the system log. The message is posted after the meter is time synced.

Note that ION time synchronization only uses the UTC setting; the LOCAL setting cannot be used.

Time synchronization values are set when sites or Ethernet devices are defined in a Power
Monitoring Expert network. Enable time synchronization or set custom intervals for supported
devices in any site through Management Console as follows:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 441


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. Start Management Console.

2. Select Sites or Devices on the System Setup pane:


Select Sites if you want to customize a particular serial, modem, or Ethernet Gateway
site.

Select Devices if you want to customize an individual Ethernet device.

3. Right-click the device or site and select Configure Device or Configure Site to open the
related configuration dialog.

4. Right-click inside the dialog and select Advanced Properties.

5. Configure the Time Synch ION Enabled or Time Synch Ethernet Enabled, and Time
Synch Interval Ethernet fields as required for your system.

6. Click OK to save you changes.

The default time synchronization interval of 3600 seconds (displayed in milliseconds) is


acceptable in most software installations.

NOTE: You need appropriate permissions to configure meters on your network. Refer to the ION
System Security technical note for details on software and meter security.

Time synchronization blackout


Time synchronization blackout is defined as a period when time synchronization cannot occur.
Utilities often record power usage at regular, predetermined intervals. For example, the utility may
schedule a recording every five minutes during an hour period (that is, 5, 10, 15, 20,..., 55, 60). If a
time sync moves the meter clock forward, the meter may miss one of the recording intervals. If a
time sync moves the meter clock backwards, the meter may get two records with the same
timestamp. The time synchronization blackout feature seeks to protect the time before and after
these recording intervals by not sending out any time sync signals at those times.

Power Monitoring Expert has time synchronization blackouts enabled automatically even though
time syncing is disabled by default in Power Monitoring Expert. The blackout intervals are every five
minutes as follows: 0, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55. Each blackout is 2 minutes and 30
seconds in duration. This duration is distributed evenly before and after the interval. The diagram
below illustrates the time synchronization blackout feature in Power Monitoring Expert.

442 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

If a regularly scheduled time sync is not sent because of a blackout interval, the software continues
trying to send the time synchronization signal every 15 seconds until the blackout period expires
and the time sync is sent.

Changing default blackout settings


To change the default settings for the interval or the blackout duration, you must edit the registry of
the computer where Power Monitoring Expert is installed. Changing the default registry settings
should be performed only by personnel with a thorough knowledge of their computer's operating
system and registry entries.

NOTICE
IRREVERSIBLE OPERATING SYSTEM DAMAGE OR DATA CORRUPTION
Before making any changes, back up your Windows Registry in a network folder or other remote
location.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in irreparable damage to the operating
system of the computer and all existing data.

NOTE: Registry edits must be performed only by qualified and experienced personnel.

There are two registry entries that control the time-synchronization blackout behavior.

Create the following registry REG_DWORD values under the HKEY_LOCAL_


MACHINE\Software\Wow6432Node\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring
Expert\<version_number> key.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 443


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

TimesyncBlackoutInterval_mins

Default value: 5

This entry is specified in minutes. It must have a value greater than 1 in order for time-
synchronization blackouts to occur. A value of 60 or greater configures blackouts to
occur once an hour.

TimesyncBlackoutDuration_secs

Default value: 150 (2 minutes 30 seconds in seconds)

This entry is specified in seconds. A value of 0 (zero) disables the blackout feature.
This entry cannot have a value greater than or equal to 3600 (one hour).

NOTE: If you want to disable the blackout feature but keep time synchronization enabled, set the
TimesyncBlackoutDuration_secs register to 0.

Do not use the following settings. They disable both the blackout feature as well as time
synchronization in general.

• TimesyncBlackoutInterval_mins < 1

• TimesyncBlackoutDuration_secs >= 3600 (1 hour)

• TimesyncBlackoutDuration_secs (the value converted to minutes) >=


TimesyncBlackoutInterval_mins

To disable time synchronization for a particular device, use Management Console. Refer to
Enabling and configuring time synchronization.

Time-synchronization blackout considerations


• Remember to specify TimesyncBlackoutInterval_mins in minutes and
TimesyncBlackoutDuration_secs in seconds.

• If your blackout values conflict or are out of range, an error is sent to the system log database. If
time synchronization signals are not occurring, check the system log to see if there’s an error
message about your blackout values.

444 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Trends configuration
Use the Trends application to view trends for real-time and historical data. The information in the
Trends application is accessed through trend graphs that are saved in the library. Power Monitoring
Expert (PME) does not provide any pre-configured trends. Configure your own trends to meet your
needs.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

Open the Trends application from the TRENDS link in the Web Applications banner.
For information on how to configure the Trends application, see:

• Adding a new trend

• Editing a trend

• Sharing a trend

• Moving a trend

• Deleting a trend

For reference information see:

• The Trends user interface

For information on how to use Trends, see Trends.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 445


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a new trend


Add new trends to monitor historical and real-time data in graphical format.
To add a completely new trend to the library:

1. In Trends, open the Trend Library and navigate to the folder where you want to create the
trend.

(Optional) Add a new folder by clicking Add Folder at the bottom of the library panel, or
by clicking Add Folder in the Options menu at the top of the library.

2. In the Trend Library, at the bottom of the panel, click Add Trend . This creates a new trend
and opens the Add Trend dialog.

3. In Add Trend, enter the configuration information on the General, Axes, Chart, and Data tabs.
See Configuring a trend for details on the configuration options.

NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

4. Save the trend.

To add a copy of an existing trend to the library:

1. In Trends, open the Trend Library and navigate to the trend you want to copy.

(Optional) Add a new folder by clicking Add Folder at the bottom of the library panel, or
by clicking Add Folder in the Options menu at the top of the library.

2. Right-click the trend name or click Options for this trend and select Duplicate to create a
copy in the same folder. Select Copy To to create a copy in a different folder.

3. (Optional) In the Trend Library, select the new trend, right-click the trend name or click
Options for this trend, and select Edit to open the trend settings. Change the trend name
and other relevant settings.

NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

4. Save the modified trend settings.

Related topics:

• Adding a new trend

• Editing a trend

• Sharing a trend

• Moving a trend

• Deleting a trend

446 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For reference information see:

• The Trends user interface

For information on how to use Trends, see Trends.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 447


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Editing a trend
Edit a trend to change the trend name, add a data series, remove a data series or change the trend
settings.
To edit a trend:

1. Open the Trend Setup dialog by:

Clicking Edit on the top right of the trend in the trend display pane.

Right-clicking a trend name in the Trend Library and selecting the Edit menu item.

Clicking Options for this trend in the Trend Library and selecting the Edit menu item.

2. Change the General, Axes, Chart, and Data settings for the trend in the Trend Setup dialog.
See Configuring a trend for details on the configuration options.

3. Save the modified settings.

Related topics:

• Adding a new trend

• Editing a trend

• Sharing a trend

• Moving a trend

• Deleting a trend

For reference information see:

• The Trends user interface

For information on how to use Trends, see Trends.

448 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Sharing a trend
Share trends with other user groups.

NOTE: For Sharing to be enabled, at least one user group, in addition to the Global group, must be
configured. To share an item with another user group, you must be a member of that group. The
item to be shared must be marked as Public, not Private.

To share a trend:

1. In Trends, open the Trend Library and navigate to the trend you want to share.

2. Right-click the trend name or click Options for this trend and select Share. This opens the
Share Trend window.

3. In Share Trend, select the user groups you want to share this trend with.

(Optional) Specify a name for the shared trend. The groups you are sharing this trend with will
see this name. The name of the original trend remains unchanged.

4. Click OK to share this trend.

NOTE: When you share an item with another user group, it appears in the Shared folder of this
group. You cannot share a shared item.

Related topics:

• Adding a new trend

• Editing a trend

• Sharing a trend

• Moving a trend

• Deleting a trend

For reference information see:

• The Trends user interface

For information on how to use Trends, see Trends.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 449


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Moving a trend
Move trends to a different location in the Library to make them easier to find or easier to manage.
To move a trend:

1. In Trends, open the Trend Library and navigate to the trend you want to move.

(Optional) Add a new folder by clicking Add Folder at the bottom of the library panel, or
by clicking Add Folder in the Options menu at the top of the library.

2. Right-click the trend name or click Options for this trend and select Move To. This opens
the Select Location window.

3. In Select Location, select the location you want to move this trend to.

4. Click OK to move the trend.

Related topics:

• Adding a new trend

• Editing a trend

• Sharing a trend

• Moving a trend

• Deleting a trend

For reference information see:

• The Trends user interface

For information on how to use Trends, see Trends.

450 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Deleting a trend
Delete trends that are no longer needed.
To delete a trend:

1. In Trends, open the Trend Library and navigate to the trend you want to delete.

2. Right-click the trend name or click Options for this trend, and select Delete

3. In Delete Content, click Yes, to delete the trend from the Trend Library.

NOTE: Access to this application or function is controlled by user privileges. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

Related topics:

• Adding a new trend

• Editing a trend

• Sharing a trend

• Moving a trend

• Deleting a trend

For reference information see:

• The Trends user interface

For information on how to use Trends, see Trends.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 451


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Software Modules
Software modules combine different software features and capabilities to create a specific set of
deliverables. Software modules are designed around a particular application. Examples of software
modules include the Power Quality Performance Module, the Energy Analysis Reports Module, and
the Breaker Performance Module.

This section provides configuration information for the software modules in PME.

Use the links in the following table to find the module you are looking for:

Module Application
Backup Power Module Generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) performance
configuration monitoring and reporting, including battery health.
Breaker Performance
Circuit breaker aging and breaker settings monitoring.
Module configuration
Generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) capacity
Capacity Management
monitoring and reporting. Includes transformer and UPS loss
Module configuration
monitoring.
Energy Analysis Dashboard Gadgets for identifying consumption patterns and anomalies and for
Module configuration comparing different consumers over time.
Energy Analysis Reports Reports for energy consumption monitoring and modeling, including
Module configuration energy usage by process area or by product output.
Energy Billing Module Energy-based billing and reporting, including consumption
configuration monitoring and reporting at the branch circuit level.
Event Notification Module
Notifications of power system events via email or SMS.
configuration
Insulation Monitoring Monitoring for isolated power systems, such as the ones found in
Module configuration hospital operating rooms.
Power Quality Performance Analysis of power quality events and disturbances and their impact
Module configuration on the monitored system.

452 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Backup Power Module configuration


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Backup Power Module provides generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) monitoring
and reporting. It reports on generator and UPS performance and battery health.

The Generator Test EPSS Report can be configured to conform to the requirements for an
Emergency Power Supply System (EPSS) test, including automatic transfer switches (ATS). For
example, the report shows the transfer time of the lead ATS and indicates whether the transfer time
passes or does not pass the test requirements. See Emergency Power Supply Systems for more
information on EPSS.

The following reports, diagrams, and tools are part of this module:

Type Reports Diagrams Tools


Generator Activity
Generator
Generator Generator Battery Health
EPSS Diagrams Performance
Performance Generator Test EPSS
Configuration(*)
Generator Load Summary
UPS Auto Test
UPS Auto Test UPS Configuration
UPS Performance diagrams
UPS Battery Health n/a n/a

(*) The Generator Performance Configuration tool includes the Run History, which is a record of the
generator run activities.

To use the reports and diagrams in this module, the module must be configured, and the
measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

For configuration information on the different component types, see:

• Configure Generator Activity Report

• Configure Generator Battery Health Report/Export

• Configure Generator Test EPSS

• Configure Generator Load Summary Report

• Configure UPS Performance

Related topics:
Backup Power Module topics

• Backup Power Module design

• Backup Power Module configuration

• Backup Power Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Breaker Performance Module configuration

• Capacity Management Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 453


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration

• Energy Billing Module configuration

• Event Notification Module configuration

• Insulation Monitoring Module configuration

• Power Quality Performance Module configuration

454 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configure Generator Activity Report

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To configure the Generator Activity Report:

1. Set up the monitoring device that records the generator electrical data in PME. See Supported
measurements and devices for details on which measurements are required.

2. Create a Generator in the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module,
and define, at a minimum, the following fields for this Generator:

Name - Enter a name for the generator.

Electrical Data - Select the Source of the electrical measurement data for the generator.
Enter the generator Nameplate Rating and select the Unit.

Status Measurements - Select the Source of the generator Status Measurements, and
the measurements used to indicate the Running and Stopped states.

3. Create a Transfer Switch in the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test
Module, and define, at a minimum, the following fields for this transfer switch:

Name - Enter a name for the transfer switch.

Status Measurements - Select the Source of the transfer switch Status Measurements,
and the measurements used to indicate the Normal, Test, and Emergency states.

NOTE: The transfer switch states are required for the Run Reason information in the report.

4. (Optional) Repeat steps 2 and 3 to add additional generators and transfer switches.

5. Create a Group in the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module, and
define, at a minimum, the following fields for this Group:

Name - Enter a name for the group.

Generators - Select the Generators you created in step 2.

Transfer Switches - Select the Transfer Switches you created in step 3.

6. Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input parameters, and
generate the report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 455


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: The groups you create with the Generator Performance Configuration Tool are available for
selection as inputs to the Generator Activity Report. All Generators that are defined in a group are
included in the report when that group is selected. You have the option to exclude generators in a
group from a report by selecting this option in the report inputs section.

For information on how to use the report, see Generator Activity Report.

456 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configure Generator Battery Health Report/Export

NOTE: Generator Battery Health Export is based on the same data as the Generator Battery
Health Report. The export version provides the raw data in CSV file format. The export file can be
imported by other systems, such as Energy Operation.

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

To configure the Generator Battery Health Report/Export:

1. Set up the monitoring device that records the generator battery voltage in PME. See Set up the
Generator Battery Health monitoring device for details.

2. Create a Generator in the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module,
and define, at a minimum, the following fields for this Generator:

Name - Enter a name for the generator.

Electrical Data - Select the Source of the electrical measurement data for the generator.
Enter the generator Nameplate Rating and select the Unit.

Status Measurements - Select the Source of the generator Status Measurements, and
the measurements used to indicate the Running and Stopped states.

Battery Waveforms - Select the Battery Waveforms check box. Select the source that
is capturing the waveform. Select the measurement recording the waveform, for example
V4 Waveform.

3. (Optional) Repeat step 2 to add additional generators.

4. Create a Group in the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module, and
define, at a minimum, the following fields for this Group:

Name - Enter a name for the group.

Generators - Select the Generators you created in step 2.

5. Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input parameters, and
generate the report.

NOTE: The groups you create with the Generator Performance Configuration Tool are available for
selection as inputs to the Generator Battery Health Report. All Generators that are defined in a
group are included in the report when that group is selected. You have the option to exclude
generators in a group from a report by selecting this option in the report inputs section.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 457


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For information on how to use the report, see Generator Battery Health Report, and Generator
Battery Health Export Report.

458 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Set up the Generator Battery Health monitoring device

NOTE: The devices used for monitoring the generator electrical data for the Generator Battery
Health Report must be able to run an ION framework and must have a V4 input for capturing the
battery voltage waveform. Only the following devices meet those requirements:
- ION9000
- ION7650
- ION7550
Other devices cannot be used for this application.

Basic setup

Install and configure the monitoring device. Refer to the device Installation Guide for more
information. Obtain the latest version of these documents from Schneider Electric Download
Center.

Connect the monitoring device to the generator as follows:

• Connect the digital signal from the generator crank relay to the digital input of the monitoring
device. This is the signal that triggers the start of the waveform recording.

• V1 - V3 voltage inputs must have PTs to isolate the ground from the system being monitored
and the battery.

• Connect V4 of the monitoring device to the positive side of the battery. Input impedance of V4
terminal, for the devices listed above, is 5 MOhm (phase - Vref).

• Connect Vref on the monitoring device to battery ground.

• Fusing must be installed according to the meter installation instructions.

• Perform a visual inspection of the connections to ensure there is physical separation between
the system connected to V1, V2 and V3, and the battery connected to V4.

• For other wiring options with PTs, see the monitoring device Installation Guide.

DANGER
ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
Treat the battery circuit as energized to the category of the installation.

Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.

Refer to the following diagram as an example for connections to the meter.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 459


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Setting up the Battery Health Framework

The Battery Health Framework is designed to capture and record a generator’s battery voltage
signature at start up. This voltage signature provides some indication of the health of the generator’s
battery bank. A typical waveform capture of the voltage drop when starting is shown next:

Note the following items about this example:

• This capture shows approximately 4 to 5 seconds' worth of data, accomplished via 3 waveform
recorders in series configured at a resolution of 16x96.

• The voltage does not immediately recover to its original value (~26 v) but it begins to ramp up.

• There is about 0.5 seconds of data before the voltage drops to approximately 20 V.

460 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Two options in the framework are possible to capture the waveform, based on how the crank relay
signal is triggered - pulse or KYZ.

Example Framework

The following figure shows the typical modules for the framework.

The types of module used are:

• Data Acquisition

• Digital Input

• Convert

• OneShot Timer

• Waveform Recorder

See the following descriptions for the way each module works in this framework.

Refer to ION Reference for details on how each module operates and for setting module
parameters.

Data Acquisition – Data Acqn 1

The V4 signal from the meter goes to the Data Acquisition module.

Digital Input – G1 Crank Relay

This module accepts the Cranking Relay signal from the field. When the signal goes high, the logic
to record the battery voltage triggers.

The Input mode can be set to Pulse or KYZ, as explained next.

Pulse Input Mode

When the Crank Relay signal goes high, a pulse is generated on the Trigger output register, labeled
"G1 Crank Relay." The setup registers for the Digital Input module are shown next.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 461


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Note that the Input Mode value is Pulse. The Trigger output can now be fed into the first Waveform
Recorder along with V4 from the Data Acquisition module.

KYZ Input Mode

If you are using the same Digital Input to handle the Generator Start signal (EPSS_Start) it is
probably set to KYZ mode.

Input Mode KYZ means that a pulse is generated on the Trigger output register when the Crank
Relay signal goes high AND when it goes low. The Convert module and One Shot Timer module
(explained later) prevent triggering the downstream logic twice.

The Crank Relay Module is setup like this:

462 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Note that the Input Mode value is KYZ.

Convert

The signal from the Digital Input module cannot be fed directly into the One Shot Timer. The Convert
module converts the digital signal to analog for the One Shot Timer.

One-Shot Timer

To prevent triggering the downstream logic twice, send the state (EPSS_Start) from the Convert
module into the One Shot Timer:

Send the output register into the first Waveform Recorder G1 Battery 1.

First Waveform Recorder – G1 Battery 1

The Data Acquisition module and G2 Crank Relay module are the inputs to the first Waveform
Recorder, labeled “G1 Battery 1.”

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 463


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

These are the setup registers for the module:

Note the following about the setup registers:

• Depth must be non-zero – 100 is a good number.

• Record Mode should be Circular.

• Format should 16x96. This means 16 samples per cycle and 96 cycles, so at 60 Hz this results
in approximately 1.6 seconds' worth of data.

• Record Delay Cycles is set to 95 to allow the “window of observation” to move so that only
post-event data is captured. Refer to ION Reference for more details.

Second and Third Waveform Recorders

The second Waveform Recorder - G1 Battery 2 - is cascaded with the first to capture another 1.6
seconds of the battery voltage signature. Do this by using the Record Complete output register on
G1 Battery 1 as a flag to trigger G1 Battery 2 to start recording.

464 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

The third Waveform Recorder - G1 Battery 3 - is cascaded with the second recorder to capture the
final 1.6 seconds of the battery voltage signature. As above, use the Record Complete output
register on G1 Battery 2 as a flag to trigger G1 Battery 3 to start recording.

The Setup Registers should be the same as first waveform recorder with different labels.

Battery Health Waveform Capture results

After the framework is complete, in Vista you should see the voltage signature that looks like the
following example image:

After you obtain this type of result, you can configure the generator in the Generator Performance
Configuration Tool and define the Battery Health Report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 465


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure Generator Test EPSS


Generator Test EPSS includes:

• Generator Test EPSS Report

• Generator Test EPSS Vista diagrams

• Generator Run History

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

NOTE: Before starting the configuration, the monitoring devices must be installed, communicating
and connected to the relevant electric circuits. The generator and automatic transfer switch (ATS)
digital and analog outputs must be connected to the equivalent inputs on the monitoring devices.

NOTE: All statuses for a specific ATS must be recorded by the same monitoring device. All
statuses for a specific generator must be recorded by the same monitoring device.

You need to configure the system before you can use any of the EPSS features. The configuration
includes these high-level steps:
Step 1: Setting up the monitoring devices in the PME software.

Step 2: Defining generators, ATSs, and groups in the Generator Performance Configuration tool.

Step 3: Generating Vista diagrams in the Generator Performance Configuration tool.

Step 4: Configuring and saving the EPSS Test report in Reports.

Step 1: Setting up the monitoring devices in the PME software:

1. Add the devices that are monitoring the generators, ATS, and load to PME, using
Management Console or Device Manager.

See EPSS devices for information on supported device types.

2. Configure the digital inputs on the devices for the generator and ATS status measurements,
for each generator and ATS, with the following settings and labels:

466 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

NOTE: PME includes ION framework templates for the generator and ATS input
measurements. These templates provide a starting point for configuring ION devices to
monitor generator and ATS status data. If you use ION devices to monitor these inputs, see
ION device frameworks for EPSS monitoring for more information.

ATS status signals:

Signal Input Setup Label(**)


Mode: KYZ
ATS Normal Event Log: On ATS Normal
Event Priority: 64
Mode: KYZ
ATS Test Event Log: On ATS Test
Event Priority: 64
Mode: KYZ
ATS Emergency Event Log: On ATS Emergency
Event Priority: 64
Mode: KYZ
ATS Power Outage(*) Event Log: On Power Outage
Event Priority: 64

Generator status signals:

Signal Input Setup Label(**)


Mode: KYZ
Generator Stopped Event Log: On Gen Stop
Event Priority: 64
Mode: KYZ
Generator Running Event Log: On Gen Run
Event Priority: 64
Mode: KYZ
Generator Starting(*) Event Log: On Gen Start
Event Priority: 64
Mode: KYZ
Emergency Power Source
Event Log: On EPA Available
Available (EPA)(*)
Event Priority: 64

(*)These signals are not required for the EPSS Test module. They can optionally be included in
the EPSS report.
(**) The labels shown in the table are recommended labels; they are recognized by PME
Alarms and categorized as Asset Monitoring alarms. PME creates measurement definitions
based on the digital input labels. You can use different labels if necessary.

3. Configure the analog inputs on the devices for the generator engine measurements, for each
generator, with the following labels:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 467


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: PME includes an ION framework template for the generator analog input
measurements. This template provides a starting point for configuring ION devices to
monitor generator engine data. If you use ION devices to monitor these inputs, see ION
device frameworks for EPSS monitoring for more information.

Signal Label(**)
Engine Temperature (or Coolant Temperature) Engine Temp
Exhaust Gas Temperature (if single exhaust) Ex Gas Temp
Exhaust Gas Temperature Left (if dual exhaust) Ex Gas L Temp
Exhaust Gas Temperature Right (if dual exhaust) Ex Gas R Temp
Engine Oil Pressure(*) Engine Oil Prssr
Other Engine related measurements, for example battery
<your custom label>
voltage(*)

(*)These signals are not required for the Generator EPSS Test module. They can optionally be
included in the EPSS report.
(**) The labels shown in the table are recommended labels. PME creates measurement
definitions based on the analog input labels. You can use different labels if necessary.

4. Configure logging on the devices for the following parameters:

NOTE: Do not use software logging for the ATS and generator status data. Software logging
introduces unpredictable time delays which result in low timestamp accuracy for the logged
data. Always use device on-board logging for this data.

Parameter Type Channels/Msrmnts Logging Interval


Log all ATS statuses
every time one of the
ATS statuses changes.
Digital Input NOTE: When one of the
ATS Status Signals 3-4
Statuses ATS statuses changes,
all the ATS statuses
must be logged with the
same timestamp.

468 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Parameter Type Channels/Msrmnts Logging Interval


Log all generator
statuses every time one
of the generator statuses
changes.
Generator Status Digital Input NOTE: When one of the
2-4
Signals Statuses generator statuses
changes, all the
generator statuses must
be logged with the same
timestamp.
Log engine data with a 1-
minute logging interval.

Generator Engine Analog Input NOTE: Use the


2 or more generator Run signal to
Data Measurements
start the logging and the
Stop signal to end the
data logging.
Log ATS load data with a
1-minute logging interval.

3-Phase Power NOTE: Use the ATS


ATS Load Data System kW tot or kVA tot Test and Emergency
Measurements(*) signals to start the
logging and the Normal
signal to end the data
logging.
Log generator electrical
data with a 1-minute
Vln a,b,c,avg; Vll logging interval.
3-Phase Power ab, bc,ca,avg
Generator Electrical
System I a,b,c,avg; kW tot; NOTE: Use the
Data generator Run signal to
Measurements kVA tot; PF sign
tot; Frequency start the logging and the
Stop signal to end the
data logging.

5. (Optional) Configure the device to generate a Transfer Time alarm in PME for an EPSS run.
See EPSS Transfer Time alarm for details.

6. (Optional) Configure the device for remotely switching the ATS into Test mode. See Remote
control of ATS Test mode for details.

Next, define the generators, ATSs, and groups in the Generator Performance Configuration tool.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 469


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Step 2: Defining generators, ATSs, and groups in the Generator Performance Configuration tool:

1. Open the Generator Performance Configuration tool.

2. On the Generators tab, add a generator, set its nameplate rating, and map the sources and
measurements for the electrical, engine, and status measurements.

3. Repeat step 2 for all the generators that are part of your emergency power supply systems.

4. On the Transfer Switches tab, add an ATS, set its priority level, and map the sources and
measurements for the load and status measurements.

5. Repeat step 4 for all the ATSs that are part of your emergency power supply systems.

6. (Optional) On the Equipment tab, add any additional equipment for which you want to include
data in the EPSS report. Map the source and measurement for this equipment.

7. On the Groups tab, add a group representing an EPSS, and assign the generators, ATSs, and
equipment that are part of the EPSS to this group.

8. Repeat step 7 for all your emergency power supply systems.

NOTE: The groups you create with the Generator Performance Configuration Tool are available for
selection as inputs to the Generator Test EPSS Report. All generators and transfer switches that
are defined in a group are included in the report when that group is selected. You have the option to
exclude generators and transfer switches in a group from a report by selecting this option in the
report inputs section.

See Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module for information on how to
use the tool.

Next, generate Vista diagrams in the Generator Performance Configuration tool.


Step 3: Generating Vista diagrams in the Generator Performance Configuration tool:

1. Open the Generator Performance Configuration tool.

2. Confirm that the Generators, ATSs, and Groups are defined.

3. On the Groups tab, click Generate Vista Diagrams.

See Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module for information on how to
use the tool.

Next, configure and save the EPSS Test report in Reports.


Step 4: Configuring and saving the EPSS Test report in Reports.

1. Open Reports in PME Web Applications.

2. Add a new Backup Power > Generator Test EPSS Report.

3. Set the report input parameters and save the report.

See Generator Test EPSS Report for information on report input parameters.

470 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configure Generator Load Summary Report

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To configure the Generator Load Summary Report:

1. Set up the monitoring device that records the generator electrical data in PME. See Supported
measurements and devices for details on which measurements are required.

2. Create a Generator in the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module,
and define, at a minimum, the following fields for this Generator:

Name - Enter a name for the generator.

Electrical Data - Select the Source of the electrical measurement data for the generator.
Enter the generator Nameplate Rating and select the Unit.

Status Measurements - Select the Source of the generator Status Measurements, and
the measurements used to indicate the Running and Stopped states.

3. (Optional) Repeat step 2 to add additional generators.

4. Create a Group in the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module, and
define, at a minimum, the following fields for this Group:

Name - Enter a name for the group.

Generators - Select the Generators you created in step 2.

5. Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input parameters, and
generate the report.

NOTE: The groups you create with the Generator Performance Configuration Tool are available for
selection as inputs to the Generator Load Summary Report. All Generators that are defined in a
group are included in the report when that group is selected. You have the option to exclude
generators in a group from a report by selecting this option in the report inputs section.

For information on how to use the report, see Generator Load Summary Report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 471


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure UPS Performance


UPS Performance includes the UPS Auto Test Report and the UPS Battery Health Report.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Configure the UPS Auto Test Report


To configure the UPS Auto Test Report:

1. Set up the UPS devices in PME.

NOTE: See Supported measurements and devices for information on supported UPS
devices for this report.

2. Set up the UPS ION framework in the VIP. See Setting up the UPS Auto Test ION framework
in the VIP for details.

3. Define the UPS devices in the UPS Configuration Tool.

4. Define a Group in the UPS Configuration Tool and add the UPS devices to the group.

5. Generate the Vista diagrams with the UPS Configuration Tool and configure the diagrams.
See Setting up the Vista Diagram for UPS Auto Test for details.

6. Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input parameters, and
generate the report.

For information on how to use the report, see UPS Auto Test Report.

Configure UPS Battery Health Report


To configure the UPS Battery Health Report:

1. Set up the monitoring device that records the battery voltage. See Set up the UPS Battery
Health monitoring device for information on how to configure the device. See Supported
measurements and devices for details on which measurements are required

2. Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input parameters, and
generate the report.

For information on how to use the report, see UPS Battery Health Report.

472 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Setting up the UPS Auto Test ION framework in the VIP


To paste a UPS framework in VIP:

1. Open Designer and open the VIP.<server_name>.node.

2. Drag a Grouping Object and open it. Make sure that the toolbox is available (Options > Show
toolbox).

3. Select Edit > Paste from framework, find UPS Alarming Status.fwn under
...\config\fmwk\EPSS\, and free paste the framework into the Grouping object.

4. Set up the framework and customize it to match your system configuration. The default
template assumes that you have two groups with five UPSs in each group.

The following example shows an instance where the user has three groups with a different
UPS in each group:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 473


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

5. Connect the inputs of each AND/OR module (UPS) to the critical operation and battery usage
status from the UPS devices.

6. Repeat this step for each UPS in the group and for all UPSs in the other groups.

7. Save the framework.

474 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Setting up the Vista Diagram for UPS Auto Test


1. Browse to ...\config\diagrams\ud\UPS\UpsGroups.dgm.

2. Link the status object from the framework that you pasted in VIP in the previous steps.

3. Repeat step 2 for all other groups. Your UPS Monitoring system is now setup.

NOTE: Any UPS in the groups that require attention show a red indicator.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 475


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Set up the UPS Battery Health monitoring device

NOTE: The devices used for monitoring the UPS electrical data for the UPS Battery Health Report
must be able to run an ION framework and must have a V4 input for capturing the battery voltage
waveform. Only the following devices meet those requirements:
- ION9000
- ION7650
- ION7550
Other devices cannot be used for this application.

Basic setup

Install and configure the monitoring device. Refer to the device Installation Guide for more
information. Obtain the latest version of these documents from Schneider Electric Download
Center.

Connect the monitoring device to the UPS as follows:

• Connect V1 - V3 to the UPS outputs. The voltage inputs must have PTs to isolate the ground
from the system being monitored and the battery.

• Connect V4 of the monitoring device to the positive side of the battery. Input impedance of V4
terminal, for the devices listed above, is 5 MOhm (phase - Vref).

• Connect Vref on the monitoring device to battery ground.

• Fusing must be installed according to the meter installation instructions.

• Perform a visual inspection of the connections to ensure there is physical separation between
the system connected to V1, V2 and V3, and the battery connected to V4.

• For other wiring options with PTs, see the monitoring device Installation Guide.

DANGER
ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
Treat the battery circuit as energized to the category of the installation.

Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.

Refer to the following diagram as an example for connections to the meter.

476 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Setting up the UPS Battery Health framework

The UPS Battery Health framework is designed to capture and record a UPS’s battery voltage
signature at start up. This voltage signature provides some indication of the health of the UPS’s
battery bank. A typical waveform capture of the voltage drop when the UPS comes online is shown
below:

Note the following items about this example:

• This capture shows about 4 - 5 seconds' worth of data, accomplished via one (1) waveform
recorder configured at a resolution of 512 x 4.

• The voltage does not immediately recover to its original value but it begins to ramp up.

• There is about 0.5 seconds of data before the voltage drop to approximately 20 V.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 477


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To paste the framework into the ION monitoring device:

1. Open Designer and open the device node of the monitoring device.

2. Drag a Grouping Object and open it. Make sure that the toolbox is available (Options > Show
toolbox).

3. Select Edit > Paste from framework, find UPS Battery Health.fwn under
...\config\fmwk\EPSS\, and free paste the framework into the Grouping object.

4. Link the Setpoint module Source input to the high speed Vln a input of the Power Meter module
of the monitoring device. This input triggers the waveform capture during the UPS test when
the UPS output turns on.

5. Check that the waveform recorder input is linked to the V4 output of the Data Acquisition
module.

6. Save the framework.

478 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Breaker Performance Module configuration


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Breaker Performance Module monitors aging and wear of circuit breakers and reports on
breaker protection settings. It provides historical and real-time information for aging and wear related
breaker parameters. You can also set up alarming on these parameters.

The following reports and diagrams are part of this module:

• Breaker Aging Report

• Breaker Settings Report

• Breaker Aging Vista diagrams

To use the reports and diagrams in this module, the module must be configured and the
measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

NOTE: Only certain Low Voltage, Schneider Electric breakers are supported by this module, see
Supported devices for more information.

NOTE: This module creates configuration files on system\bin and system\translator


folders in the PME install location and also writes configuration in the ION_Network database. As
per the latest security update of Windows, it prevent applications to write the Program Files
(x86) folder and writes to a user-specific folder under Program Data folder. To ensure proper
configuration, use an account member of the Administrator group or grant Administrator rights to
the specific users, use same user account consistently for configuring.

Configure the Breaker Aging Report


To configure the Breaker Aging Report and Vista diagrams:

1. Set up the breakers in the Management Console in PME

2. Set up the breaker aging calculations in PME. See Set Up the Breaker Aging Calculations for
details.

3. Configure Breaker Devices, Switchboards, and Groups in the Breaker Configuration Tool.

4. Configure the breaker aging ION framework in the VIP. See Pasting the Circuit Breaker
Framework in VIP for details.

5. (For the report) Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input
parameters, and generate the report.

6. (For the Vista diagrams) Use the Generate Vista Diagrams function in the Breaker
Configuration Tool to create the diagrams. Configure the diagrams after they have been
generated. See Configuring Breaker Aging Vista diagrams for details. View the diagrams in
Vista or in Web Applications Diagrams.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 479


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure the Breaker Settings Report


To configure the Breaker Settings Report:

NOTE: Step 2 in the workflow description below is optional. You can run the Breaker Settings
Report without configuring the breakers in the Breaker Configuration Tool. The benefit of
configuring breakers in the tool is that the breakers can be grouped and associated with
switchboards for reporting. Also, if you want to run the Breaker Aging Report on the same
breakers, you must configure them in the tool.

1. Set up the breakers in the Management Console in PME.

2. (Optional) Configure Breaker Devices, Switchboards, and Groups in the Breaker Configuration
Tool.

NOTE: Clear the Enable Breaker Aging check box, in the Breaker Devices tab of the
configuration tool, for breakers that are only used for the Breaker Settings Report. In that
case only the Name and Source fields are required. To configure a breaker that is used for
the Settings report and the Aging report, check the Enable Breaker Aging box and define all
the required fields.

3. To run the report, open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input
parameters, and generate the report.

NOTE: PME checks the settings of a new breaker device as soon as the device has been
added to the system. However, there can be a time delay until the settings data is available
in the database for reporting. After the initial check, PME checks the breaker settings for
updates every 24 hours.

NOTE: The groups you create with the Breaker Configuration Tool are available for selection as
inputs to the Breaker Performance reports. All breakers that are defined in a group are included in
the report when that group is selected.

For information on how to use the reports, see Circuit Breaker Aging Report and Circuit Breaker
Settings Report.

Related topics:

Breaker Performance Module topics

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Breaker Performance Module configuration

• Breaker Performance Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module configuration

• Capacity Management Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration

480 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Energy Billing Module configuration

• Event Notification Module configuration

• Insulation Monitoring Module configuration

• Power Quality Performance Module configuration

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 481


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Set Up the Breaker Aging Calculations


The breaker aging and wear calculations and assessments are performed by a background service
in PME. This service automatically detects compatible breaker devices that are configured in the
Management Console. The service connects to these breakers, retrieves the relevant data and then
performs the necessary calculations.

Setting up the breaker aging calculations includes the following steps:

• Starting the ION Software Modbus Gateway Service

• Adding a new calculation service provider

• Adding a new site for the calculation service

• Adding a Breaker Aging and Wear Provider device

See the descriptions below for details on how to complete these tasks.
To start the ION Software Modbus Gateway Service,

1. Open the Windows Services panel, for example through Administrative Tools > Services.

2. Find and start the ION Software Modbus Gateway Service and set the Startup type to
Automatic.

To add a new calculation service provider,

1. In File Explorer, navigate to ...\Power Monitoring Expert\system\bin and run


ModbusServiceConfigurationTool.exe.

2. In Modbus Services Configuration Tool, click Add.

3. From Available Services select Breaker Aging and Wear Calculation Service.

4. In Unit ID enter a value of 1 if this is the first service provider you are adding. Otherwise, enter
the next incremental value for Unit ID.

5. Click Configure.

6. In Breaker Aging Service Configuration, review the settings and leave the values at their
defaults. The defaults are a Real Time Request Polling Interval of 5 seconds and a Real

482 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Time Request Priority Level of 0. Click OK.

NOTE: These settings control the real-time data requests for breaker aging and wear
calculations. These settings do not affect other real-time data requests in the system, such
as for Vista, Diagrams, or Gadgets. Only modify these settings if certain load conditions in
the system require a change in the polling priority and frequency of meter real-time data.

Real Time Request Priority Levels:

Frequency (in seconds) Priority


0 Low
250 Medium
500 High
1000 Intermediate
5000 Urgent
10000 Control

7. In Breaker Aging Service Configuration, click OK.

8. In Modbus Service Configuration Tool, click OK. A dialog appears informing you about the
configuration change and the need to restart the ION Modbus Software Gateway Service.

9. In Configuration Changed, click Yes to continue and to restart the ION Modbus Software
Gateway Service.

To add a new site for the calculation service,

NOTE: You only need one site for the ION Modbus Software Gateway Service in your system.
Skip these steps if you have already set up a site for other applications of the Modbus Software
Gateway Service.

1. Open Management Console and log in with a supervisor-level account.

2. In the left pane, click Sites.

3. Add a new Ethernet Gateway Site. Enter the following information:


Name: Enter BreakerAgingWearSite.

TCP/IP Address: Enter <Your local PME server name or IP address>.

TCP/IP Port: Select ModbusTCP Device|502.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 483


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Click OK.

To add a Breaker Aging and Wear Provider device

1. Open Management Console and log in with a supervisor-level account.

2. In the left pane, click Devices.

3. Add a new Serial Device on Ethernet Gateway Site. Enter the following information:
Group: Enter Breakers.

Name: Enter BreakerAgingWearProvider.

Device Type: Enter Breaker Aging And Wear Provider.

Unit ID: Enter the same Unit ID you configured in the Modbus Service configuration tool.

Site: Select the BreakerAgingWearSite.

Enabled: Select Yes.

484 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

4. Click OK.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 485


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Pasting the Circuit Breaker Framework in VIP

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION

• Do not use the software or devices for critical control or protection applications where human or
equipment safety relies on the operation of the control action.

• Do not use an ION meter's digital output for any safety critical application.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

NOTE: ION modules and registers must only be configured by personnel with a thorough
understanding of ION architecture and the system in which the meters and software are installed.

The VIP framework aggregates the overall aging and wear status of each breaker in a group to
assess the group status. It also aggregates the status of each group in the system to assess the
overall status for all breakers.

1. Open Designer and log in with a supervisor-level account.

2. Open the VIP.DEFAULT node.

3. Select Edit > Paste from framework and select the


...\config\fmwk\BreakerAging\CB Aging Grouping Status
Framework.fwn framework and paste it into the VIP.

This framework is a template based on a breaker configuration with 2 groups and 5 breakers
per group. Customize this template by adding modules for additional breakers or groups, or by
removing not needed modules.

486 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

4. Connect the input of an AND/OR module labeled Device_<xx> to the Breaker Aging and Wear
Provider overall status for the respective breaker device. Match the breaker/group pairing that
you configured with the Breaker Configuration tool.

5. Repeat this step for each Circuit Breaker in each group as required.

6. Delete the Devices_<xx> and Groups_<xx> that do not exist, or add additional ones.

7. Save & Save the framework.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 487


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring Breaker Aging Vista diagrams


The breaker aging diagrams are generated with the Breaker Configuration tool. This is part of
configuring the Breaker Performance Module. The following steps assume that you have created
these diagrams. See Breaker Performance Module configuration for details.

There are three different types of diagrams: Group summary diagram, group details diagram, and
switchboard details diagram. Most of the measurements in these diagrams are automatically linked
to the correct breaker information when the diagrams are created by the Breaker Configuration tool.
You only need to manually link the group status indicators in the group summary diagram.

To link the group status indicators in the group summary diagram,

1. Open Vista and log in with a supervisor-level account.

2. Select File > Open and then choose


...\config\diagrams\ud\BreakerAging\Groups.dgm to open the group summary
diagram.

NOTE: If you saved the diagrams in a location other than the default, then browse to that
location to open the diagram.

The group summary diagram shows the group summary status and the number of breakers in
the group for each of the groups setup with the Breaker Configuration tool.

Example:

3. Manually link the group status object for each group to the output of the And/OR Module for the
group in the Circuit Breaker Aging Status framework in the VIP.

Example:

488 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

4. Save the diagram.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 489


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Capacity Management Module configuration


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Capacity Management Module provides generator, Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS), and
general equipment monitoring and reporting. It also includes transformer and UPS loss monitoring
and reporting. The losses are reported in terms of energy and cost.

The following reports, diagrams, and tools are part of this module:

Reports Diagrams Tools


Branch Circuit
n/a n/a
Power Report
Equipment
Equipment Vista Diagrams Generator Performance Configuration
Capacity Report
Generator
n/a Generator Performance Configuration
Capacity Report
Generator Power
n/a Generator Power Configuration Utility
Report
Power Losses
n/a Power Losses Configuration Utility
Report
UPS Power
n/a UPS Power Configuration Utility
Report

To use the reports and diagrams in this module, the module must be configured and the
measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.
For configuration information on the different reports, see:

• Configure the Branch Circuit Power Report

• Configure Generator and Equipment Capacity Reporting

• Configure Generator and UPS Power Reporting

• Configure the Power Losses Report

Related topics:
Capacity Management Module topics

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Capacity Management Module configuration

• Capacity Management Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module configuration

• Breaker Performance Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration

490 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration

• Energy Billing Module configuration

• Event Notification Module configuration

• Insulation Monitoring Module configuration

• Power Quality Performance Module configuration

Configure the Branch Circuit Power Report

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

To configure the Branch Circuit Power Report:

1. Set up the monitoring device that records the branch circuit data. See Supported
measurements and devices for details on which measurements are required.

2. Configure a hierarchy in PME using the ...\Power Monitoring


Expert\applications\HierarchyManager\SampleTemplates\DataCenter\
CustomerRackCircuitTemplate.xml template.

TIP: See Hierarchy Configuration Utility and Hierarchy Manager for information on how to
install and maintain a hierarchy.

3. Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input parameters, and
generate the report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 491


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure Generator and Equipment Capacity Reporting

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

NOTE: Before starting the configuration, the monitoring devices must be installed, communicating
and connected to the relevant electric circuits. Relevant generator digital outputs must be
connected to the equivalent inputs on the monitoring devices.

To configure the Generator Capacity Report:

1. Add the devices that are monitoring the generators and loads to PME, using Management
Console or Device Manager.

See Supported Measurements and Devices for information on supported device types.

2. Configure the digital inputs on the devices for the generator status measurements, for each
generator, with the following settings and labels:

Signal Input Setup Label(*)


Mode: KYZ
Generator Stopped Event Log: On Gen Stop
Event Priority: 64
Mode: KYZ
Generator Running Event Log: On Gen Run
Event Priority: 64

(*) The labels shown in the table are recommended labels. PME creates measurement
definitions based on the digital input labels. You can use different labels if necessary.

492 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

3. Configure logging on the devices for the following parameters:

Parameter Type Measurements Logging Interval


Log generator electrical data
with a 1, 5, or 15 minute
logging interval, depending
3-Phase Power on the desired resolution.
Generator Electrical kW tot or kVA
System
Data tot NOTE: Use the generator
Measurements
Run signal to start the
logging and the Stop signal
to end the data logging.
Log load data with the same
logging interval as the
generator electrical data
3-Phase Power logging.
kW tot or kVA
Load Data System
tot NOTE: Use the generator
Measurements
Run signal to start the
logging and the Stop signal
to end the data logging.
Log all generator statuses
every time one of the
generator statuses
Generator changes.
Generator Status Stopped
Digital Input Statuses NOTE: When one of the
Signals Generator
Running generator statuses
changes, all the generator
statuses must be logged
with the same timestamp.

4. Create a Generator in the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module,
and define, at a minimum, the following fields for this Generator:

Name - Enter a name for the generator.

Electrical Data - Select the Source of the electrical measurement data for the generator.
Enter the generator Nameplate Rating and select the Unit.

Status Measurements - Select the Source of the generator Status Measurements, and
the measurements used to indicate the Running and Stopped states.

Evaluation Method - Select the Evaluation Method that is used for the generator test and
the pass/fail criteria for the selected method.

5. (Optional) Repeat steps 1 and 2 to add additional generators.

6. Create a Group in the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module, and
define, at a minimum, the following fields for this Group:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 493


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Name - Enter a name for the group.

Generators - Select the Generators you created in step 2.

Load Sources - Add the loads that are supplied by the generator.

7. To run the report, open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input
parameters, and generate the report.

For information on how to use the report, see Generator Capacity Report.

To configure the Equipment Capacity Reports:

1. Add the device that is monitoring the equipment load to PME, using Management Console or
Device Manager.

See Supported Measurements and Devices for information on supported device types.

2. Configure logging on the device for the following parameters:

Parameter Type Measurements Logging Interval


Log load data with a 1, 5, or
3-Phase Power
kW tot, kVA 15 minute logging interval,
Equipment Load Data System
tot, or I avg depending on the desired
Measurements
resolution.

3. Create an Equipment item in the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test
Module, and define, at a minimum, the following fields for this Equipment:

Name - Enter a name for the equipment.

Load Data - Select the Source and Measurement for the load data. Enter the equipment
Rating and select the Unit.

4. (Optional) Repeat steps 1 and 2 to add additional generators and transfer switches.

5. Create a Group in the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module, and
define, at a minimum, the following fields for this Group:

Name - Enter a name for the group.

Equipment - Select the Equipment you created in step 2.

Load Sources - Add the loads that are connected to the equipment.

6. To run the report, open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input
parameters, and generate the report.

For information on how to use the report, see Equipment Capacity Report.

494 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configure Generator and UPS Power Reporting

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To configure the Generator Power Report,

1. Set up the monitoring devices that record the load data. See Supported Measurements and
Devices for details on which measurements are required.

2. Define the generator power system using the Generator Power Configuration Utility.

3. Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input parameters, and
generate the report.

For information on how to use the report, see Generator Power Report.

To configure the UPS Power Report,

1. Set up the monitoring devices that record the UPS output data. See Supported Measurements
and Devices for details on which measurements are required.

2. Define the UPS power system using the UPS Power Configuration Utility.

3. Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input parameters, and
generate the report.

For information on how to use the report, see UPS Power Report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 495


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure the Power Losses Report

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To configure the Power Losses Report,

1. Set up the monitoring devices that record the input and output data for the transformers and
UPS. See Supported Measurements and Devices for details on which measurements are
required.

2. Define the power losses system using the Power Losses Configuration Utility.

3. Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input parameters, and
generate the report.

For information on how to use the report, see Power Losses Report.

496 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Energy Analysis Dashboard Module includes dashboard gadgets that help you break down
consumption by load type, visualize consumption cost, and do an 80/20 analysis to identify the
largest consumers. You can identify consumption patterns and anomalies and compare different
consumers over time.
The following gadgets are part of this module:

• Sankey gadget

• Pareto Chart gadget

• Aggregated Pareto Chart gadget

• Heat Map gadget

• Consumption Ranking gadget

• Aggregated Consumption Ranking gadget

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

No special configuration is required for this module. See Dashboards configuration for information
on how to create a dashboard with gadgets.

Related topics:
Energy Analysis Dashboard Module topics

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module configuration

• Breaker Performance Module configuration

• Capacity Management Module configuration

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 497


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration

• Energy Billing Module configuration

• Event Notification Module configuration

• Insulation Monitoring Module configuration

• Power Quality Performance Module configuration

498 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Energy Analysis Reports Module includes reports that help you understand energy usage
patterns to find energy waste, analyze transformer and circuit capacity and assess energy usage by
process area or by product output. Use the energy modeling capabilities in this module, to forecast
consumption, identify unexpected changes in your consumption, or identify actual savings as a
result of energy management measures.
The following reports are part of this module:

• Create Model Report

• Duration Curve Report

• Energy Modeling Reports

• Energy Regression Analysis Report

• Energy Usage Per State Report

• KPI Report

• KPI by TOU Report

• Multi Equipment Operation Report

• Power Usage Per State Report

• PUE Summary Report

• Single Equipment Operation Report

• Use Model Report

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To configure the Energy Modeling report, see Configuring the Energy Modeling report for special
configuration information on this report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 499


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To configure the PUE Summary report:

1. Set up the monitoring devices that record the report data. See Supported measurements and
devices for details on which measurements are required.

NOTE: To use the reports in this module, the measurement data must be available as
historical data logs in the database.

2. Install the PUE VIP framework. See Loading the PUE framework into VIP.

3. Configure the framework. See Configure the PUE framework.

4. Create logical devices. See Creating Logical Devices.

5. Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input parameters, and
generate the report.

TIP: For more information on the PUE Summary Report, see Terms and Definitions and PUE
Summary Report Calculations.

To configure the Energy Analysis Reports Module (except the Energy Modeling report and the PUE
report):

1. Set up the monitoring devices that record the report data. See Supported measurements and
devices for details on which measurements are required.

NOTE: To use the reports in this module, the measurement data must be available as
historical data logs in the database.

2. Open the report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report input parameters, and
generate the report.

For information on how to use the reports in this Module, see Energy Analysis Reports

Related topics:
Energy Analysis Reports Module topics

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Reports Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module configuration

• Breaker Performance Module configuration

• Capacity Management Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration

• Energy Billing Module configuration

• Event Notification Module configuration

500 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Insulation Monitoring Module configuration

• Power Quality Performance Module configuration

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 501


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring the Energy Modeling report


Before you can use the modeling report, you must first create a model for your facility or process
with the Create Model Report. This model is then used in the Use Model Report. You only use the
Create Model report during configuration. After the model has been created, you do not need to run
this report again, unless you want to create a new model.
To create a model and use the Energy Modeling report:

1. Run the Create Model report with an initial set of parameters and analyze the results. Select
No for the Save Model Configuration input parameter.

TIP: Consider choosing a reporting period with normal consumption behavior to create your
model. For example, a good period could be "Last Year".

2. Based on the results, define sub-models and exception periods, if applicable.

3. Re-run the Create Model report using sub-models, exception periods, and modified input
parameters and analyze the results.

4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 until you are satisfied with the accuracy of the model.

5. Run the Create Model report one more time, select Yes for the Save Model Configuration
and enter a meaningful model name. This saves your model to the database.

6. Run the Use Model report with the model you created. Ensure that the sub-models and
exception periods are correctly defined for the reporting period.

7. (Optional) Setup a subscription to run the Use Model report on a regular basis. Select Yes for
the Insert Date input parameter. This saves the model output data to the database. You can
use this data in the Trends and Dashboards applications.

Defining a sub-model
Sub-models are used to improve the accuracy of the overall model by recognizing time intervals or
operating conditions with different consumption characteristics. For example, using a sub-model
that differentiates between weekdays and weekend days can be more accurate for processes that
are influenced by a workweek pattern, than using a single model for all days. Which sub-model
works best depends on the nature of the facility or process.

Sub-models are defined with the Modeling Configuration tool in the Settings > System >
Modeling area of the Web Applications. Use one of the pre-defined sub-models or create your own.
To define a sub-model:

1. In Modeling Configuration, select the Sub-Models tab.

2. Click Insert in the top right corner of the window to switch to insert mode.

3. Enter a Sub-Model Name, select a Minimum Aggregation Interval, and enter a Desired
Label, and Condition in the input boxes at the top of the main display grid.

The Condition must be a valid SQL query statement.

4. Click Insert to the right of the input boxes to insert the new sub-model definition. The
definition is moved to the bottom of the main display grid, below any pre-existing sub-model
definitions.

502 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

5. Click Search in the top right corner of the window to switch back to search mode.

6. (Optional) To edit an existing definition, click Edit to the right of the definition in the display
grid, or click any of the fields of the definition in the grid. To update the definition, after editing
it, click Update , to cancel click Cancel . To delete a sub-model definition, click Delete
.

Defining exception periods


Exception periods are special time intervals, such as holidays, with unpredictable consumption
behavior that is different from the rest of the time period. Exception periods can be defined down to a
specific time interval for a specific source and measurement.

You can either choose to model these exception periods separately, which means they will become
a sub-model, or you can choose to exclude them from the model completely.

Exception periods override sub-model definitions if they cover the same time period. For example,
you could define a holiday, a day your facility was in shutdown, or a day when you performed
system tests, as an exception period. If that day was a weekend day and you are using a sub-model
to differentiate between weekdays and weekend days, then the exception period overrides the sub-
model, which means that special day will be modeled differently than a regular weekend day.

Exception periods are defined with the Modeling Configuration tool in the Settings > System >
Modeling area of the Web Applications.
To define exception periods:

1. In Modeling Configuration, select the Exception Periods tab.

2. Click Insert in the top right corner of the window to switch to insert mode.

3. Enter an Exception Period Name, select a Source and Measurement, enter a Desired
Label, and Condition in the input boxes at the top of the main display grid.

The Condition must be a valid SQL query statement.

NOTE: The Desired Label is used to control if the exception period is excluded from the
model, or if it is treated as a sub-model. Enter the text Delete as Desired Label if you want to
exclude that period from the model. Enter any other text, for example a descriptive text such
as Holiday, if you want to sub-model the exception period. An excluded exception period will
be blank in the final model output graphic.

4. Click Insert to the right of the input boxes to insert the new exception period definition. The
definition is moved to the bottom of the main display grid, below any pre-existing exception
period definitions.

5. Click Search in the top right corner of the window to switch back to search mode.

6. (Optional) To edit an existing definition, click Edit to the right of the definition in the display
grid, or click any of the fields of the definition in the grid. To update the definition, after editing
it, click Update , to cancel click Cancel . To delete an exception definition, click Delete
.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 503


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

See a Model creation example.

504 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Loading the PUE framework into VIP

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software or devices for critical control or protection applications where human
or equipment safety relies on the operation of the control action.
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

NOTE: ION modules and registers must only be configured by personnel with a thorough
understanding of ION architecture and the system in which the meters and software are installed.

We recommend that you create a new VIP, VIP.Data_Center, to run the PUE framework. If your
PME system already has a VIP.Data_Center, or if you want to use a different preexisting VIP, then
you must be careful not to accidentally overwrite existing VIP modules when pasting the new
framework.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before pasting an ION framework verify that the system is not performing critical control
actions that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Do not overwrite an existing ION framework in the VIP using lock paste.
• Verify correct system operation after pasting an ION framework.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

NOTE: If you choose to create a custom VIP, you need to update the PUE scripts, that create the
logical devices, with the custom VIP name. See Creating Logical Devices for details on where to
find the scripts.

To create a new VIP:

1. Open a Command Prompt window.

2. Change the current folder to ...\Power Monitoring Expert\system\bin.

3. Type vip -Service -NVIP.Data_Center on the command line.

This creates a VIP service with the name VIP.Data_Center.

4. Open the Windows Services panel.

5. Start the newly created VIP service.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 505


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To load the PUE framework into the VIP:

1. Open Designer, and select File > Open. Select the VIP.Data_Center from the Select Node
box. Click OK.

2. (Optional) Create a grouping object in the VIP for the PUE framework. Open the grouping
object to paste the framework into it.

3. Select Edit > Paste from framework. The Paste from Framework screen appears.

4. Browse to ...\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring


Expert\config\fmwk\DataCenter and select the PS4DC - Data Center VIP For
Logical Devices.fwn framework file from the DataCenter folder. Click Open.

5. In the Paste Summary, select the framework modules for lock paste, then click OK.

NOTE: See Using the Paste Summary dialog for information on lock paste.

6. Click Save to safe the newly pasted framework in Designer.

Configure the PUE framework


Connect the VIP Registers
After the PUE framework is created in the VIP, you must link (connect to) the various types of data
sources as shown below to bring in real-time data. Data sources include:

• Data Center incomers

• IT Load

• HVAC loads

• Generators

• PDUs

506 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Link the data sources to the appropriate Arithmetic Module that aggregates (sums) the data. Be sure
that all unused inputs are linked to the “zero” value, as unlinked inputs will cause a “N/A” output.

Update the XML Configuration file


The PUE framework refers to an XML file named PS4DC_Config.xml in order to import data,
such as the electricity rate and system capacity limits. In order for the KPI screens to make sense
for each customer, these values must be changed to match their facility. The file’s registers are
linked to the VIP through an XML Import Module in the KPIs section of the VIP, as illustrated in the
figure below.

The PS4DC_Config.xml XML configuration file is located in the


…\config\diagrams\ud\DataCenter\KPIs folder. To edit the file, open it in a text editor and
edit the <Value> tag, as shown below:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 507


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: To implement real-time energy costs or emissions factor, you can develop a script using a
Visual Basic script or other technique that writes to the XML file in the specified format.

Updating the XML Import Module path information


The XML import module requires the correct path information to properly link to the XML file.
To update the path information for the module:

1. Open Designer and click File > Open, then select the VIP that contains the PUE frameworks.

2. In the Navigation box on the left side of the framework, double-click the KPIs grouping folder
to open the KPI sub-framework.

3. In the KPI sub-framework, right-click the PS4DC_Config_import module to open the ION


Module Setup dialog.

4. In ION Module Setup, select XIM9 URL from the Setup Register list and click Modify….

5. In the Modify String Register dialog, enter the path information to the PS4DC_Config.xml

508 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

file.

The default location for a new installation is C:\Program Files (x86)\Schneider


Electric\Power Monitoring\config\diagrams\ud\DataCenter\KPIs\PS4DC_
Config.xml.

Creating Logical Devices


To present the information from the PUE VIP framework, a number of logical devices can be
created using the included SQL scripts. Logical devices are used to present the data in a more
intuitive manner than linking directly to the values in the VIP.

NOTE: Logical devices are not included as devices in the device licensing count.

To create logical devices:

1. In Windows Explorer navigate to the ...\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring


Expert\Diagnostic\DataCenter\LogicalDevices\SQL folder.

The following SQL scripts, are available in this location:


1_Create_Custom_Measurements.sql

2_Create_Logical_Device_Types.sql

3_MakeElectricalLogicalDevices.sql

4_MakeGHGLogicalDevices.sql

5_MakeCapacityLogicalDevices.sql

6_MakeCostLogicalDevices.sql

These scripts will create a number of logical devices related to data center applications. Not
all of these devices are needed for PUE.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 509


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: The scripts are designed for a system with VIP.Data_Center. If you use a custom
VIP (not VIP.Data_Center) for the PUE framework, then you need to update these scripts.
You need to change all VIP.Data_Center references in the scripts to the name of your
custom VIP. The following scripts need to be updated: 3_
MakeElectricalLogicalDevices.sql, 4_MakeGHGLogicalDevices.sql, 5_
MakeCapacityLogicalDevices.sql, 6_MakeCostLogicalDevices.sql

2. In numeric sequence, for each script right-click the script and select Open with > SSMS -
SQL Server Management Studio from the drop down list. Run the script.

NOTE: These scripts must be run in the order indicated by their file name.

3. Restart ION Network Router Service to restart all ION services.

The scripts create five logical device types and the appropriate custom measurements. The device
types are:

• DC_Elec

• DC_GHG

• DC_PUE

• DC_Capacity

• DC_Costs

The scripts create 16 logical devices, as shown below.

The included Vista Data Center KPI files are linked to these devices. If it is necessary to change the
device names, the Vista diagrams must be edited as well.

510 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Energy Billing Module configuration


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Energy Billing Module is a fully functional energy-based billing reporting system. It also
provides load and consumption monitoring and reporting at the branch circuit level, which is typically
used in data center applications.

The following reports are part of this module:

• Billing Report

• Billing Summary Report

• Billing Verification Report

• Energy by IT Customer Report

• Multiple Billing Report

• Multiple Billing Export Report

To use the reports in this module, the module must be configured and the measurement data must
be available as historical data logs in the database.

For information on how to configure this module, download the Billing Module Toolkit from the
Exchange Community. See Resources for link information. The Billing Module Toolkit is a collection
of tutorials and examples that show you how to configure and use this module.

Energy by IT Customer Report configuration


The report requires branch circuit level energy and current measurement data. The report supports
different types of energy and current measurements, see Supported measurements and devices for
more information.

To use this report, the measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database,
and a hierarchy must be configured using the CustomerRackCircuitTemplate.xml template.

NOTE: Remember to update the Managed Circuits in the Management Console after each device
configuration change.

Hierarchy template
You can find the CustomerCircuitTemplate.xml hierarchy template at:
...\Power Monitoring
Expert\applications\HierarchyManager\SampleTemplates\DataCenter\.

For information on how to install a hierarchy template and make bulk configuration changes, see
Hierarchy Configuration Utility.

For information on how to maintain a hierarchy configuration and make individual configuration changes,
see Hierarchy Manager.

Related topics:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 511


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Energy Billing Module topics

• Energy Billing Module design

• Energy Billing Module configuration

• Energy Billing Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module configuration

• Breaker Performance Module configuration

• Capacity Management Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration

• Event Notification Module configuration

• Insulation Monitoring Module configuration

• Power Quality Performance Module configuration

512 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Event Notification Module configuration


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

Use the Event Notification Module (ENM) to notify recipients about critical power system events.
ENM can send notifications of power system events through email or SMS. ENM uses the Alarms
application to detect system events. You can set up notifications for activity in any of the event,
alarm, or incident views. The notification details are defined in a notification rule. A notification rule
can be enabled or disabled, and you can use a schedule to determine when the rule is applied. You
can define more than one notification rule.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not rely solely on Event Notification Module use for alarm notification where human or
equipment safety relies on the operation of the control action.
• Do not use Event Notification Module to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

NOTE: Other parts of the overall communication system, such as email servers and cellular phone
systems, could fail and result in notifications not being delivered. If notifications are not delivered
to recipients, conditions that cause alarming may persist and result in safety critical issues.

ENM is a built-in feature of PME. It is available for configuration as soon as the Event Notification
Module license has been activated. Before configuring notifications, review the prerequisites and
considerations in Event Notification Module Design.

TIP: You can open Notifications from SETTINGS > Alarms > Notifications in web applications.

To configure notifications, see:


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 513


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

Related topics:
Event Notification Module topics

• Event Notification Module Design

• Event Notification Module configuration

• Event Notification Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module configuration

• Breaker Performance Module configuration

• Capacity Management Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration

• Energy Billing Module configuration

• Insulation Monitoring Module configuration

• Power Quality Performance Module configuration

514 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Editing notification settings


Edit notification settings to configure the parameters that control the behavior of the application and
define the delivery options.
To edit notification settings:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Settings tab.

2. In the Settings tab, configure the following options and click Save for each:
a. General Settings:
Remote Access Host: (Optional) The URL or IP address for the PME server. This
URL is used to provide a hyperlink in the notification messages that links back to the
alarm view details in the Alarms web application.

Example:

Maintenance Mode: Maintenance mode disables all notification rules. Use this to
temporarily disable notifications and avoid unwanted messages during a planned
power system event, for example a planned shutdown.

b. Email Settings:
i. Email Settings
From Address: The recipients of email notifications will see the messages being
sent from this address. It must be formatted as an email address, but it does not
have to be from a valid, existing email account.

From Display Name: The recipients of email notifications will see the messages
coming from this sender.

Include Email Header: Set to use a header in the notification email or not.

ii. SMTP Settings


SMTP Server Host: Set the SMTP server URL or IP address.

SMTP Server Port: Set the server port number.

SMTP Server Uses SSL: Check this box if you want to use an SSL connection
to the SMTP server.

SMTP Server Credentials: Set the username and password if you use an SSL
connection to the SMTP server.

TIP: Test the email server setup by sending a test message to a valid email address in
the Test Email Recipient Address box.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 515


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

c. SMS Settings

NOTE: The SMS capabilities of the Event Notification Module are built on technology
from Twilio, a third-party vendor. To use SMS with notifications, you need to open an
account with Twilio and sign up for SMS service. See the Twilio web site for more
information.

Set the Twilio SMS Account SID, Authentication Token, and Outbound Phone Number.
This information is provided by Twilio when you open an account and sign up for SMS
service.

TIP: Test the SMS setup by sending a test message to a valid phone number in the Test
SMS Recipient Address box.

d. Alarms Settings

Use the Alarms settings to control how soon a notification is sent out after alarm activity
is detected. A shorter delay provides more immediate notification but can result in more
messages being sent. A longer delay can help aggregate additional activity into a single
message, reducing the number of notifications sent during an incident. See Notification
delay example for more details.

Choose between two pre-configured setting options and a custom option. The following
settings can be customized:
Initial Delay (seconds): The time the system waits, after an alarm activity is
detected, before sending a message.

Incremental Delay (seconds): The time the system waits if a new alarm activity is
detected during a delay period, before sending a message.

Maximum Delay (seconds): The time after which the system sends a notification
regardless of any incremental delays.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

516 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 517


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a notification rule


Add a notification rule to receive messages when alarms or incidents happen in your power system.
To add a new notification rule:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Rules tab, and then click Add Notification Rule to open
the Add Notification Rule window.

TIP: Click Duplicate or use the Duplicate command, in the right-click context menu, to
duplicate an existing notification rule.

2. In Add Notification Rule, select the alarm view for which you want to monitor the activity and
receive notifications. Click Next.

3. Select one or more recipients to receive a notification. Click Next.

TIP: You can add a new recipient to the system by clicking Add Recipient. See Adding a
recipient for more information.

4. (Optional) Select a notification schedule and the schedule timezone for this notification rule.
Click Next.

TIP: You can add a new schedule to the system by clicking Add Schedule. See Adding a
Schedule for more information.

5. Specify a notification Rule Name.

6. Enable or disable the rule.

7. Select a message template.

8. Set the Delivery Options:


a. Enable or disable email notification.

b. Enable or disable SMS notification.

c. Set which activities in the alarm view trigger a notification.

NOTE: You can choose to only receive notifications when an alarm goes active or a new
incident happens.
Or you can choose to receive notifications on all activity.

9. Click Finish.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

518 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 519


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Enabling or disabling a notification rule


Enable a notification rule to start receiving messages when alarms or incidents happen in your
power system. Disable a notification rule to stop receiving messages for alarms defined in the rule.
To enable or disable a notification rule:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Rules tab.

2. In the notification rules table, find the row of the rule which you want to enable or disable, and
then turn Enabled on or off in this row.

3. Right-click the row and select Edit Rule to open Edit Notification Rule. You can also open
Edit Notification Rule by double-clicking the row.

4. In Edit Notification Rule, select the Settings tab and then turn Rule Enabled on or off.

5. Click Save.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

520 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 521


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Editing a notification rule


Edit an existing notification rule to add or remove recipients, or to modify the notification rule
parameters such as alarm view, schedule, or delivery options.
To edit a notification rule:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Rules tab.

2. In the notification rules table, find the row of the rule which you want to edit, and then click
Edit in this row to open the Edit Notification Rule window

TIP: You can also open Edit Notification Rule through the Edit Rule command in the right-
click context menu or by double-clicking the row.

3. In Edit Notification Rule, select the tab that contains the settings you want to change.

4. Update the settings.

5. Click Save.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

522 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 523


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Deleting a notification rule


Delete a notification rule that is no longer needed.
To delete a notification rule:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Rules tab.

2. In the notification rules table, find the row of the rule which you want to delete, and then click
Delete in this row. This opens the Delete Notification Rule confirmation box.

TIP: You can also delete a notification rule through the Delete Rule command in the right-
click context menu.

3. Click Yes to confirm.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

524 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 525


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a recipient
Add a recipient to define the contact information for sending alarm notification messages. The new
recipient will be available in the notification rule wizard when adding or editing a rule.
To add a recipient:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Recipients tab, and then click Add Recipient to open the
Add Recipient window.

TIP: Click Duplicate or use the Duplicate Recipient command, in the right-click
context menu, to duplicate an existing recipient.

2. Enter the following information:


Recipient Name: The name that is displayed in the recipients table and the Available
Recipients list.

Email Address: The email address used to send email notifications to this recipient.

SMS Phone Number: The phone number used to send text notifications to this recipient.

TIP: Click Test to send a test email or test SMS message to confirm that your entries are
correct and valid.

NOTE: The notification settings for email and SMS must be configured correctly before you
can send test messages. See Editing notification settings for details.

3. Click OK.

NOTE: You can also add recipients though the notification rule wizard when adding or editing a
rule. Use the same process as described in steps 2-3 above.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

526 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 527


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Editing a recipient
Edit an existing recipient to update the recipient information such as name, email, or phone number.
To edit a recipient:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Recipients tab.

2. In the recipients table, find the row of the recipient which you want to edit, and then click Edit
in this row to open the Edit Recipients window

TIP: You can also open Edit Recipients through the Edit Recipient command in the right-
click context menu or by double-clicking the row.

3. In Edit Recipient, update the information you want to change.

4. Click OK.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

528 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 529


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Deleting a recipient
Delete a recipient that is no longer needed.

NOTE: If you delete a recipient that is used in a notification rule, then this recipient is automatically
removed from the rule.

To delete a recipient:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Recipients tab.

2. In the recipients table, find the row of the recipient which you want to delete, and then click
Delete in this row. This opens the Delete Recipient confirmation box.

TIP: You can also delete a recipient through the Delete Recipient command in the right-click
context menu.

3. Click Yes to confirm.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

530 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 531


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a template
Add a template to customize the information that is included in the alarm notification messages. The
new template will be available in the notification rule wizard when adding or editing a rule.

NOTE: You can customize the notes text and hyperlink text that is included in a message. You
cannot customize the alarm details information in the message.

To add a template:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Templates tab, and then click Add Template to open the
Add Template window.

TIP: Click Duplicate or use the Duplicate Template command, in the right-click
context menu, to duplicate an existing template.

2. Enter the following information:


Template Name: The name that is displayed in the templates table and the Message
Template drop-down box.

Note: The text that is included in the email or SMS message, after the alarm details
information.

Link: (Optional) A hyperlink that is included in the email or SMS message, after the alarm
details information and after the Note text.

3. Click OK.

NOTE: You can also add templates though the notification rule wizard when adding or editing a
rule. Use the same process as described in steps 2-3 above.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

532 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 533


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Editing a template
Edit an existing template to update the information that is included in the alarm notification
messages.
To edit a template:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Templates tab.

2. In the templates table, find the row of the template which you want to edit, and then click Edit
in this row to open the Edit Template window

TIP: You can also open Edit Template through the Edit Template command in the right-click
context menu or by double-clicking the row.

3. In Edit Template, update the information you want to change.

4. Click OK.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

534 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 535


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Deleting a template
Delete a template that is no longer needed.

NOTE: If you delete a template that is used in a notification rule, the rule changes automatically to
using the default template.

NOTE: You cannot delete the default template.

To delete a template:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Templates tab.

2. In the templates table, find the row of the template which you want to delete, and then click
Delete in this row. This opens the Delete Template confirmation box.

TIP: You can also delete a template through the Delete Template command in the right-click
context menu.

3. Click Yes to confirm.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

536 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 537


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a Schedule
Add a schedule to define the days and times when a notification rule is applied. The new schedule
will be available in the notification rule wizard when adding or editing a rule.

NOTE: A schedule only has an effect if the associated notification rule is enabled. If the rule is
disabled, the schedule is ignored.

NOTE: Schedules are shared across applications. For example, the same schedule can be used
for an alarm rule and a notification rule.

To add a schedule:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Schedules tab, and then click Add Schedule to open the
Add Schedule window.

TIP: Click Duplicate or use the Duplicate Schedule command, in the right-click
context menu, to duplicate an existing schedule.

2. Enter a schedule name.

3. Define the active and inactive days and times of the schedule.

4. Click Save.

NOTE: You can also add schedules though the notification rule wizard when adding or editing a
rule. Use the same process as described in steps 2-4 above.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

538 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 539


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Editing a schedule
Edit an existing schedule to change the days and times when a notification rule is applied.

NOTE: Schedules are shared across applications. For example, the same schedule can be used
for an alarm rule and a notification rule.

To edit a schedule:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Schedules tab.

2. In the schedules table, find the row of the schedule which you want to edit, and then click Edit
in this row to open the Edit Schedule window

TIP: You can also open Edit Schedule through the Edit Schedule command in the right-click
context menu or by double-clicking the row.

3. In Edit Schedule, update the information you want to change.

4. Click OK.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

• Deleting a schedule

540 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 541


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Deleting a schedule
Delete a schedule that is no longer needed.

NOTE: Schedules are shared across applications. Confirm that a schedule is not in use before
deleting it.

NOTE: If you delete a schedule that is used in a notification rule, then this schedule is
automatically removed from the rule.

To delete a schedule:

1. In Notification Manager, select the Schedules tab.

2. In the schedules table, find the row of the schedule which you want to delete, and then click
Delete in this row. This opens the Delete Schedule confirmation box.

TIP: You can also delete a schedule through the Delete Schedule command in the right-
click context menu.

3. Click Yes to confirm.

Related Topics:

Event Notification Module configuration


Settings

• Editing notification settings

Rules

• Adding a notification rule

• Enabling or disabling a notification rule

• Editing a notification rule

• Deleting a notification rule

Recipients

• Adding a recipient

• Editing a recipient

• Deleting a recipient

Templates

• Adding a template

• Editing a template

• Deleting a template

Schedules

• Adding a Schedule

• Editing a schedule

542 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Deleting a schedule

For reference information see:

• Notification Manager user interface

• Add Rule UI

• Add Recipient UI

• Add Template UI

• Schedules Configuration UI

• Notification delay example

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 543


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Insulation Monitoring Module configuration

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Insulation Monitoring Module provides monitoring for isolated (IT) power systems, such as the
ones found in hospital operating rooms. It also helps in locating isolation faults. The module can be
configured for applications based on the IEC standard, and for applications based on the
ANSI standard.

The following report and diagrams are part of this module:

• Insulation Monitoring Report

• Facility Summary Vista diagram

• Areas Summary Vista diagram

• Area Details Vista diagrams

To use the report and diagrams in this module, the module must be configured, and the
measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

For information on how to configure this module for the ANSI and IEC markets, see:

• ANSI: Insulation Monitoring configuration (ANSI)

• IEC: Insulation Monitoring configuration (IEC)

Related topics:
Insulation Monitoring Module topics

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Insulation Monitoring configuration

• Insulation Monitoring Module operation

544 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module configuration

• Breaker Performance Module configuration

• Capacity Management Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration

• Energy Billing Module configuration

• Event Notification Module configuration

• Power Quality Performance Module configuration

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 545


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Insulation Monitoring configuration (ANSI)


To configure the Insulation Monitoring Module for facilities in the ANSI market:

1. Install and configure the devices and hardware components. See Insulation Monitoring
Hardware Configuration for ANSI for details.

2. Use the Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool for ANSI to:


a. Configure the panels, areas, and groups

b. Generate Vista diagrams

3. Set up the VIP framework and configure the Vista diagrams. See Configuring the VIP
Framework and Vista Diagrams for ANSI for details.

4. Open the Insulation Monitoring report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report
input parameters, and generate the report.

5. View the diagrams in Vista or in Web Applications Diagrams.

546 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Insulation Monitoring Hardware Configuration for ANSI


This section contains information about the hardware devices used in an insulation monitoring
solution. Refer to the installation manuals for each device for instructions, safety messages, and
parameter details.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Configuring hardware components for ANSI

The Insulation Monitoring application includes several hardware components. Some of these
components communicate on an internal bus and must be configured with unique IP addresses and
unit IDs.

Set up the parameters for the installed hardware as described in this section.

Isolated Power Panel

The isolated power panel includes the circuit monitoring devices such as the IG6.

See the Bender Resources Web site for circuit monitoring device installation instructions.

NOTE: Make sure the clocks on all devices are correctly configured during commissioning so that
the reports you run show the correct timestamp.

IGC COM460/COM461/COM465IP Gateway

In the Insulation Monitoring application, the IGC COM460/COM461/COM465IP Gateway converts


the serial Bender BMS protocol to Modbus TCP. For this solution, note the following:

• The IP address must be unique. Set up the IP address so that the software can communicate
with it.

NOTE: Make sure to always set the unit ID to 1. Doing this sets the gateway to Master mode
on the Bender bus.

• Set the gateway to operate on its internal bus.

See the Bender Resources Web site for instructions on how to configure the gateway.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 547


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Line Isolation Monitor

The Iso-Gard™ IG6 line isolation monitor (LIM-IG6) is installed in the isolated power panel. This
device continuously calculates the total hazard current (THC) by measuring the leakage impedance
between isolated line and ground. Up to two LIM-IG6 monitors can be installed in one panel.

NOTE: Set the Unit ID of the LIM IG6 to immediately succeed the Unit ID of the COM460.

For example, if you have a branch of COM460s with the devices connected to it, such as three
IG6s, two EDS 461s, and one CMS 460, then set the Unit IDs as follows:

Device Type Unit ID


COM460 1
LIM-IG6 2
LIM-IG6 3
LIM-IG6 4
EDS 461 5
EDS 461 6
CMS 460 7

• Set the Unit ID of the Serial devices that are connected to the IGC COM46x gateway.

• Set the total hazard current level to the appropriate value for your location.

NOTE: Make sure the clocks on all devices are correctly configured during commissioning so that
the reports you run show the correct timestamp.

See the LIM-IG6 documentation for instructions on how to install and operate the device.

Circuit Fault Locator (Optional)

The EDS 151 and EDS 461 circuit fault locator identifies the specific circuits where insulation faults
could result in current leakage that exceeds the defined total hazard current level. For this solution,
note the following:

NOTE: Make sure the clocks on all devices are correctly configured during commissioning so that
the reports you run show the correct timestamp.

• Set up the unit ID on the device. This ID must be unique from the unit ID and serial ID of other
devices.

See the EDS 151 and EDS 461 documentation for instructions on how to configure the device.

Circuit Load Transformer (Optional)

The solution can include an optional SWT3 or SWT4 circuit transformer for load monitoring.

See the LIM-IG6 documentation for instructions to connect wiring to the circuit transformer and
configure the device.

548 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Temperature Sensor (Optional)

The temperature sensor monitors the temperature of the isolation transformer, if installed.
Temperature data appears in the Vista diagrams if the device is installed and set up in the
configuration tool.

See the LIM-IG6 documentation for instructions to connect wiring to the temperature sensor and
configure the device.

Load Current Evaluator (Optional)

The CMS460 Load Current Evaluator is used to detect, monitor and evaluate loads and installation
for load currents in power supplies.

NOTE: Make sure the clocks on all devices are correctly configured during commissioning so that
the reports you run show the correct timestamp.

• Set up the unit ID on the device. This ID must be unique from the unit ID and serial ID of other
devices.

See the CMS460 Load Current Evaluator documentation for instructions on how to configure the
device.

After the parameters for the hardware components are configured, set up the communications for
the devices as described next.

Configuring devices for ANSI

The following devices must be set up:

• IGC Gateway

• LIM-IG6 devices

• EDS 151 and EDS 461 circuit fault locators, if installed

• CMS460, if installed.

To configure devices:

1. Open Management Console on the server.

2. Add the IGC Gateway as follows:

3. Click Sites.

4. In the sites area, right-click and select New > Add Ethernet Gateway Site. The Ethernet
Gateway Site Configuration screen appears.

5. Enter details for the gateway:


Name - Enter a name that will be recognizable in the Insulation Monitoring Configuration
Tool.

TCP/IP Address - This address must be unique from all other gateways and devices in
the system.

TCP/IP Port - Select Modbus TCP Device 502.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 549


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Enabled - Select Yes.

Complete other fields as needed.

Example:

6. Click OK.

7. Click Devices to add the LIM-IG6 and EDS 151 / EDS 461 circuit fault locators that are
connected to the gateway.

8. In the devices area, right-click and select New > Serial Device on Ethernet Gateway Site.
The Serial Device Configuration screen appears.

9. Enter details for the LIM-IG6 or EDS 151 / EDS 461 device.


Name - Enter a name that will be recognizable in the Insulation Monitoring Configuration
Tool.

Device Type - Select the appropriate type.

Unit ID - This value must be unique from all other devices in the system.

Site - Select the gateway you just added.

Enabled - Select Yes.

Complete other fields as necessary.

10. Click OK.

550 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

11. Repeat steps 8 - 10 for all other devices connected to the gateway.

After all devices associated with the gateway are added, repeat the above steps for other gateways
and their devices in the system.

After all hardware is configured, configure the areas and devices in the Insulation Monitoring
Configuration Tool.

NOTE: Configure the gateway and all devices connected to the gateway as a group. Then set up
another gateway and its associated devices.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 551


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring the VIP Framework and Vista Diagrams for ANSI


After the diagrams have been generated with the Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool, configure
the VIP framework and link it to the diagrams to display the alarm status from the LIM-IG6 in the
diagrams.

NOTE: If there is only one LIM-IG6 in your system, you do not need to create a VIP and configure
the VIP framework. Instead, link the Vista status objects directly to the LIM-IG6. See Finalizing
the Vista Diagrams.

Creating a new VIP for the framework

You need to create a new VIP to set up the insulation monitoring VIP framework.
To create a new VIP:

1. Open a Command Prompt window.

2. Change the current folder to ...\Power Monitoring Expert\system\bin.

3. Type vip -Service -NVIP.InsulationMonitoring_Alarming on the command


line.

This creates a VIP service with the name VIP.InsulationMonitoring_Alarming.

4. Open the Windows Services panel.

5. Start the newly created VIP service.

Configuring the VIP framework

The VIP framework aggregates the alarm status for the different areas and group levels. The
framework logic combines the different statuses using an OR condition, which means the summary
status shows an alarm if one or more of the inputs are in an alarm state. The alarm summaries are
then displayed in the Vista diagrams
To configure the VIP framework:

1. Open Designer.

2. Open the VIP.InsulationMonitoring_Alarming.

3. Paste the framework Insulation Monitoring Alarming Status for ANSI.fwn in


...\config\fmwk\InsulationMonitoring into the VIP.

The framework contains two groups with four areas each. This is meant to be a starting point.
Add or remove areas, or entire groups to meet your needs. Here is an example of the default
framework:

552 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

4. Link the Common Registers > Common Alarm register from the LIM-IG6 isolation monitors
to the Area AND/OR modules. Each LIM-IG6 in an area must be linked to the AND/OR
module for this area. For example, if area 1 has three LIM-IG6, then all three must be linked to
the Area 01 AND/OR module.

5. Save the framework changes.

Finalizing the Vista Diagrams

After the VIP framework is configured, open the diagrams in Vista and link the alarm status objects
to the correct modules in the VIP framework, as shown below. The colors shown on the status
objects are:

• Green - Normal. The Total Hazard Current (THC) measurement is below the limit.

• Red - Alarm. The THC measurement exceeds the limit or the LIM-IG6 is in test mode.

• Gray - Unlinked. The object has not been connected to an alarm status register.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 553


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

See Using the diagrams for alarm status display examples.

Group Level Diagrams

In the top-level Facility Summary diagram, link the alarm status object to the AND/OR module
output for the Group Level Status in the VIP framework.

NOTE: If there is only one LIM-IG6 in your system, link the Vista status object directly to the
Common Registers > Common Alarm register on the LIM-IG6.

In the example above, you would link the status object to the output of the Group 1 AND/OR module
in the VIP.

Area Diagrams

Link the area status objects in the diagram to the corresponding Area AND/OR module outputs in
the VIP framework.

NOTE: If there is only one LIM-IG6 in your system, link the Vista status object directly to the
Common Registers > Common Alarm register on the LIM-IG6.

Area Details Diagrams

Link the area details status objects in the diagram to the corresponding Common Registers >
Common Alarm register on the LIM-IG6.

554 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Opening diagrams in Power Monitoring Expert


After you have configured the diagrams, open them in Diagrams or Vista. Confirm that all monitoring
devices are communicating as expected. Verify that all status objects in the diagrams are displayed
correctly. Fix any unlinked or incorrectly linked objects.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 555


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Insulation Monitoring configuration (IEC)


To configure the Insulation Monitoring Module for facilities in the IEC market:

1. Install and configure the devices and hardware components. See Insulation Monitoring
Hardware Configuration for IEC for details

2. Use the Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool for IEC to:


a. Configure the panels, areas, and groups.

b. Generate Vista diagrams

3. Set up the VIP framework and configure the Vista diagrams. See Configuring the VIP
Framework and Vista Diagrams for IEC for details.

4. Open the Insulation Monitoring report template in the Reports Web Application, set the report
input parameters, and generate the report.

5. View the diagrams in Vista or in Web Applications Diagrams.

556 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Insulation Monitoring Hardware Configuration for IEC


This section contains information about the hardware devices used in an insulation monitoring
solution. Refer to the installation manuals for each device for instructions, safety messages, and
parameter details.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

NOTE:
• Isolated power panels, optional monitoring devices, and communications for hardware must
be installed in the designated areas.

• The insulation monitoring device must be configured correctly, and time synced to the EGX
gateway.

Configuring devices for IEC

The following devices must be set up:

• EGX100 Gateway

• Insulation Monitoring (IM) devices

• (Optional) Insulation Fault Locator (IFL) devices

To configure devices:

1. Open Management Console on the server.

2. Add the EGX100 Gateway as follows.

3. Click Sites.

4. In the sites area, right-click and select New > Add Ethernet Gateway Site. The Ethernet
Gateway Site Configuration screen appears.

5. Enter details for the gateway:


Name - Enter a name that will be recognizable in the Insulation Monitoring Configuration
Tool.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 557


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

TCP/IP Address - This address must be unique from all other gateways and devices in
the system.

TCP/IP Port - Select Modbus TCP Device 502.

Enabled - Select Yes.

Complete other fields as needed.

6. Click OK.

7. Click Devices to add the IM and IFL devices that are connected to the gateway.

8. In the devices area, right-click and select New > Serial Device on Ethernet Gateway Site.
The Serial Device Configuration screen appears.

9. Enter the following details:


Group - Select the device group.

Name - Enter a name that will be recognizable in the Insulation Monitoring Configuration
Tool.

Device Type - Select the appropriate type.

Unit ID - This value must be unique from all other devices in the system.

Site - Select the gateway you just added.

Enabled - Select Yes.

Complete other fields as necessary.

10. Click OK.

11. Repeat steps 8 - 10 for all other devices connected to the gateway.

After all devices associated with the gateway are added, repeat the above steps for other gateways
and their devices in the system.

After all hardware is configured, configure the areas and devices in the Insulation Monitoring
Configuration Tool.

NOTE: Configure the gateway and all devices connected to the gateway as a group. Then set up
another gateway and its associated devices.

558 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configuring the VIP Framework and Vista Diagrams for IEC


After the diagrams have been generated with the Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool, configure
the VIP framework and link it to the diagrams to display the alarm status from the Insulation
Monitoring (IM) devices in the diagrams.

Creating a new VIP for the framework

You need to create a new VIP to set up the insulation monitoring VIP framework.
To create a new VIP:

1. Open a Command Prompt window.

2. Change the current folder to ...\Power Monitoring Expert\system\bin.

3. Type vip -Service -NVIP.InsulationMonitoring_Alarming on the command


line.

This creates a VIP service with the name VIP.InsulationMonitoring_Alarming.

4. Open the Windows Services panel.

5. Start the newly created VIP service.

Configuring the VIP framework

The VIP framework aggregates the alarm status for the different areas and group levels. The
framework logic combines the different statuses using an OR condition, which means the summary
status shows an alarm if one or more of the inputs are in an alarm state. The alarm summaries are
then displayed in the Vista diagrams

To configure the VIP framework:

1. Open Designer.

2. Open the VIP.InsulationMonitoring_Alarming.

3. Paste the framework Insulation Monitoring Alarming Status for IEC.fwn in


...\config\fmwk\InsulationMonitoring into the VIP.

The framework contains two groups with four areas each. This is meant to be a starting point.
Add or remove areas, or entire groups to meet your needs. Here is an example of the default
framework:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 559


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Link the Alarm Status > Insulation Status Alarm, Electrical Status Alarm, and Wiring
Connection Lost registers from the IMs to the Area AND/OR modules.

5. Save the framework changes.

Finalizing the Vista Diagrams

After the VIP framework is configured, open the diagrams in Vista and link the alarm status objects
to the correct modules in the VIP framework, as shown below. The colors shown on the status
objects are:

• Green - Normal. The Impedance measurement is below the limit.

• Red - Alarm. The Impedance measurement exceeds the limit.

• Gray - Unlinked. The object has not been connected to an alarm status register.

See Using the diagrams for alarm status display examples.

560 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Group Level Diagrams

In the top-level Facility Summary diagram, link the alarm status object to the AND/OR module
output for the Group level Status in the VIP framework.

In the example above, you would link the status object to the output of the Group 1 AND/OR module
in the VIP.

Area Diagrams

Link the area status objects in the diagram to the corresponding Area AND/OR module outputs in
the VIP framework.

Area Details Diagrams

Link the area details status objects in the diagram to the corresponding Area AND/OR module
outputs in the VIP framework.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 561


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Opening diagrams in Power Monitoring Expert


After you have configured the diagrams, open them in Diagrams or Vista. Confirm that all monitoring
devices are communicating as expected. Verify that all status objects in the diagrams are displayed
correctly. Fix any unlinked or incorrectly linked objects.

562 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Power Quality Performance Module configuration


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Power Quality (PQ) Performance Module analyzes power quality event and disturbance data as
well as power factor measurements. It determines the potential impacts of power quality on the
monitored power system and displays the results in graphical formats, with color coding to highlight
problem areas. The module combines standard software features with specialized components to
produce its outputs. The module can also analyzes power quality event and disturbance data as
well as power factor measurements based on the hierarchy sites, which are assigned to a user
group.

The following reports, diagrams, and Dashboard Gadgets are part of this module:

• Power Quality Impact report

• Power Quality Analysis report

• Power Quality Indicator diagrams

• Standardized Equipment diagrams

• Power Quality Rating gadget

• Power Quality Rating Trend gadget

• Power Quality Incident Breakdown gadget

• Power Quality Incident Impact gadget

• Power Quality Incident Location gadget

• Power Quality Impact gadget

• Power Quality Impact Trend gadget

• Power Factor Impact gadget

• Power Factor Impact Trend gadget

To use the reports, diagrams, and Dashboard Gadgets in this module, the module must be
configured. The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

For information on how to configure this module, see Configure Power Quality Performance.

For information on how to configure this module for multiple sites, see Configure Power Quality
Performance for multiple sites.

Related topics:
Power Quality Performance Module topics

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module configuration

• Power Quality Performance Module operation

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 563


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module configuration

• Breaker Performance Module configuration

• Capacity Management Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration

• Energy Billing Module configuration

• Event Notification Module configuration

• Insulation Monitoring Module configuration

564 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configure Power Quality Performance


To configure Power Quality Performance,

1. Configure the Monitoring Devices.

2. Configure Global Parameters.

3. Configure Power Quality Performance diagrams.

4. Configure Power Quality Impact Gadgets and Report .

5. Configure Power Factor Impact Gadgets.

6. Configure Power Quality Analysis Report.

7. Set up Power Quality Performance Dashboards and Reports.

8. Fine-tune Power Quality Performance.

NOTE:
No configuration is required for the following Gadgets:

Type Gadgets
Power Quality Rating Gadget
Power Quality Rating Gadgets
Power Quality Rating Trend Gadget
Power Quality Events Breakdown Gadget
Power Quality Events Detail Gadgets Power Quality Events Impact Gadget
Power Quality Events Location Gadget

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 565


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure the Monitoring Devices

The Power Quality Performance module relies on power quality measurements taken by the
monitoring devices in a system. It processes these measurements using back-end analytics
functions and VIP framework logic, and produces outputs that are displayed in Gadgets, diagrams,
and reports.

The module depends exclusively on historical data in the database. It does not use real-time data
from the devices directly. The back-end analytics does not modify the historical source data in the
database. The data is read from the database, processed, and then displayed.
The Power Quality Performance can do its analysis only if the monitoring devices (power meters,
circuit breakers) have been properly configured to capture power quality events and disturbances.
This section describes the following:

• Enable power quality event detection.

• Enable power quality disturbance logging.

• Enabling time synchronization.

Enable power quality event detection

See Supported Devices for Power Quality Performance monitoring for supported devices.
Enabling power quality event detection on the supported meters involves:

• Enabling Sag/Swell detection

• Enabling Transient detection

Disturbance direction detection (DDD) is enabled by default if supported.

NOTE: DDD, available on select meters, is used to determine if the events are undetermined,
internal, or external to the system. Without DDD, all events will show as undetermined in the
Power Quality Performance features.

You can do this by using meter configuration tools (such as ION Setup), or by configuring the meter
directly. Refer to the meter documentation for more information.

In addition, you can configure ION meters (such as, ION9000, ION7650, PM8000, etc.), in PME
Vista.

566 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

After the power quality events are detected by the meter, they are classified by Power Monitoring
Expert Power Quality Event Classification method and stored in Power Monitoring Expert database
as:

• Interruptions

• Voltage Sag

• Voltage Swell

• Transient Voltage

• Over voltage

• Under voltage

See Power Quality Performance events and disturbances for information on PME Power Quality
Event Classification.

Enable power quality disturbance logging

Power Quality Performance consumes the periodical data logs for:

• Voltage Unbalance

• Current Unbalance

• Voltage Harmonics

• Current Harmonics

• Frequency Variation

• Flicker

The supported meters are listed in Supported Devices for Power Quality Performance monitoring.
They are categorized as:

• Logged by Default – The supported measurements are logged by the default. For these
meters, no additional configuration is required. However, for brownfield installations, care must

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 567


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

be taken to see if the configuration has been modified.

• Not Logged by Default – The meter measures the value but does not log it. You need to
enable logging on these meters.

Choose the measurement to log


The supported measurements and their corresponding register labels are listed in Required
measurements for Power Quality Performance monitoring.

For example, for Voltage Unbalance, you may find both of the supported registers Voltage
Unbalance L-L Worst and Voltage Unbalance L-N Worst available in a non-ION device. Choose the
one which is required by your local standards.

Or, for Voltage Harmonics, you may find all the 8 supported registers available in a non-ION device.
If per-phase analysis is important to the customer on this device, choose the 3 per-phase
measurements based on your system and standards. If per-phase analysis is not important
(because of the load, design, or other reasons), choose only one measurement; either THD Voltage
L-L or THD Voltage L-N, which are the averages of the per-phase values.

NOTE: For each disturbance category, choose only the needed measurements from the supported
list to log. Do NOT log all of them; doing so can cause unwanted database growth and
performance issues.

Enable the logging


To enable the logging for devices categorized as “Not Logged by Default”:

• Supported measurements are logged by default for most ION meters, so configuration is not
required. For some models, where the supported measurements are not logged by default, you
can configure logging by using PME Designer.

• For non-ION meters, you can use PME Device Type Editor to configure logging:

NOTE: For non-ION devices, PQ Performance only supports the logged instantaneous values. Do
NOT log the calculated values (Mean, High, or Low). For Harmonics and Unbalance
measurements, the recommended logging Interval is 3600 seconds.

568 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• For the non-ION meters, especially PM800 (except PM810 without PME810LOG), CM3000,
and CM4000, configure the on-board logging using meter configuration tools.

NOTE: The PM800 Series devices are supported, except the PM810 without PM810LOG.

Flicker
Flicker is only available when the supported meter has a PQ framework with EN50160 evaluation
enabled. Refer to the meter documentation for more information.

Once enabled, the flicker measurements are logged in 10-minute intervals by default. There is no
need to change the logging interval.

Enabling time synchronization

Time synchronization is crucial for:

• Event clustering (the same event seen by different devices is only counted once).

• Correctly associating the process impact alarms with power quality events.

The standard synchronization between the Power Monitoring Expert server and devices is adequate
for enabling Power Quality Performance features.

• For Modbus devices, time synchronization through Modbus is activated by default.

• For all ION protocol devices (e.g. ION7650, PM8000, etc.), the application engineer needs to
enable this feature.

NOTE: High accuracy of time synchronization (such as IRIG-B, etc.), can be used to address user
requirements, but it is not required for Power Quality Performance.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 569


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To enable Power Monitoring Expert time synchronization on an ION device:

1. Connect to the device using ION Setup. On the Timezone tab for Clock, change entry for the
CL1 Time Sync Source to ETHERNET - ION. You can also do this on the meter front panel.

2. In Management Console:
a. For an Ethernet device, set the Time Synch Ethernet Enabled to Yes in the Ethernet
Device Configuration.

b. For a serial device, set the Time Synch ION Enabled to Yes in the Ethernet Gateway

570 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Site Configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 571


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure Global Parameters


You may need to change the global parameters, depending on the requirement of the customer’s
facility.

Configure the Nominal Frequency

The default nominal frequency is 60Hz.


To edit the default nominal frequency:

1. In SQL Server Management Studio, locate the dbo.vCFG_ConfigItems view in the ION_
Network database, and right-click to select "Edit Top 200 Rows".

2. Find the Frequency Nominal row.

3. Set the Value to the appropriate local nominal frequency.

572 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configure Power Quality Performance diagrams


The following sections describe how to configure the Power Quality Performance diagrams:

• Configure Power Quality Indicator Diagrams

• Configure the Standardized Equipment Diagrams

• (Optional) Create a Power Quality Performance link in the Web Applications

Configure Power Quality Indicator Diagrams

The Power Quality (PQ) Indicator Diagrams introduce simple green-yellow-red indicators for the
most common power quality problems.

The PQ Indicator Diagrams are pre-configured with default settings. Complete the following steps to
enable the functionality:

• Paste the Power Quality Performance Framework

• Open the Power Quality Indicator Diagrams

Paste the Power Quality Performance Framework


The VIP Frameworks included with the Power Quality Performance installation get data from the
Power Quality Performance Web Service to display values and drive the status objects in the
Power Quality Performance Indicator Vista diagrams.

NOTE:
• The VIP.PQADVISOR ION Service must be running to proceed with the steps below. (The
service is configured to start automatically.)

• Installing the Power Quality Performance framework onto an ION VIP Service other than
VIP.PQADVISOR is not recommended.

• Installing the Power Quality Performance framework onto an ION VIP Service that has
existing modules that have been put in by a user is not recommended.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 573


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. Open Power Monitoring Expert Designer.

2. Click File > Open.

3. Click the ‘VIP.PQADVISOR’ node and click OK.

4. Select the Edit > Paste from framework menu item.


a. Navigate to the folder containing the Power Quality Performance framework file: {root
install folder}\config\fmwk\PQPerformance

5. Click the file PQPerformance.fwn and click Open.

NOTE: Use the most current version of the fwn file available.

6. In the Paste Summary dialog:


a. Ignore items with a red check mark, as these are core modules that cannot have two
instances in the same VIP. The existing modules will work with the new framework being
pasted.

b. In the Source column, select the first list entry with a green check mark, press and hold
the Shift key, and then click the green check mark icon in the check box on the final entry.
This action applies the lock paste selection to all entries.

NOTICE
UNINTENDED DEVICE OPERATION
Do not use the lock paste option to overwrite existing destination modules.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in operational differences in


required modules.

Only use the lock paste option if you are an advanced user familiar with ION architecture.

c. In a new Power Monitoring Expert installation, no modules should be overwritten. In an


existing Power Monitoring Expert installation, there may be conflicts and the framework
paste may try to overwrite existing module; if this occurs double click the check box again
so that it returns to just a check mark, and note the module that created a conflict.

574 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

7. Press OK when pasting is complete.

The Power Quality Performance framework is visible in Designer.

8. Click Save to complete the process.

Open the Power Quality Indicator Diagrams


The PQ Indicator Diagrams are located in:
{root install folder}\config\diagrams\ud\PQPerformance

The diagrams start to function once the framework is pasted in the Power Quality Performance VIP.
You can link them to the existing Vista diagrams or use them separately.

NOTE: When a Power Quality Indicator has no supported device to feed it the required data, it
should be disabled by following the procedures in the section Disable unused Power Quality
Indicators.

Alternative symbols can be used to provide a colorblind friendly view. They are located in the folder:
{root install
folder}\config\diagrams\images\PQPerformance\Indicators\Alternate\

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 575


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Set the Query Server – Distributed system only


When using distributed PME systems, set the query server node for the following landing page
diagrams:
• LandingPage_24h.dgm

• LandingPage_7d.dgm

• LandingPage_30d.dgm

• LandingPage_12m.dgm

Configure the Standardized Equipment Diagrams

The following sections describe how to set up and configure the Standardized Equipment Pages.
Skip this section if corrective equipment does not exist in the system.

• Configure the Framework for the Equipment Diagrams

• Configure the Equipment Diagram Detail Pages

• Configure the Equipment Diagram Group Pages

• Configure the Equipment Diagram Landing Pages

Unlike the Power Quality Performance Indicator diagrams, the Equipment diagrams are not auto-
functional pages, but rather templates that you use during commissioning to provide the user with
equipment status displays with the same user experience and focus on simplification as the Power
Quality Performance Indicator pages.
The equipment diagram elements are:

• Equipment Diagram Landing Pages

• Equipment Diagram Grouping Pages

• Equipment Diagram Detail Pages

576 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Equipment Diagram Landing Pages

The Corrective Equipment Status portion of the Power Quality Performance page is a landing page.

The Equipment page is also a landing page.

Equipment Diagram Grouping Pages

When you select an element of the Equipment landing page (e.g. Capacitor Banks), the grouping
page opens. A summary entry for each device (e.g. Capacitor Bank) in the system could be
configured here.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 577


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Equipment Diagram Detail Pages

When you select an element on the Equipment Grouping Page, the equipment diagram detail page
for that device opens.

The following supported devices currently have template pages available:

• Capacitor Banks: VarPlus Logic VL6 and VL12

• Active Harmonic Filters (AHF): Accusine PCS+/PFV+

578 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Uninterruptible Power Supplies (UPS): Galaxy 5000 and 5500

All Equipment Diagrams are installed in the following location:


{root install folder}\config\diagrams\ud\Equipment

Configuration Workflow

The order of commissioning is the opposite of user workflow. Set up the Detail Pages first, and then
create the buttons for each Detail Page on the Group Pages. The Landing Pages (both Equipment
and PQ Performance Indicator), require no commissioning other than optional customization if
required.

Configure the Framework for the Equipment Diagrams


Configure the Equipment Pages of the VIP framework to display aggregated warning/alarm
indicators found on the Power Quality Performance Indicator Landing Pages and on the Equipment
Landing and Group Pages.

NOTE: The VIP.PQADVISOR service must be set up and running with the Power Quality
Performance Framework configured to commission the Equipment Diagrams.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 579


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The Power Quality Performance framework contains some template OR Logic modules and simple
instructions on configuring the VIP to work with the Equipment Pages:

1. Open VIP.PQADVISOR in Designer.

2. Open the Equipment grouping folder.

The Equipment folder contains the following:

Summary Section:

Capacitor Bank section:

580 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Active Harmonic Filters section:

The UPS section:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 581


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure device count


1. Right-click the module labeled DEVICE COUNTS to open the ION Module Setup dialog.

2. Double-click any of the ‘Formula’ Setup Registers to modify their value. The value entered
represents the number of devices of corresponding type listed directly to the right in the Output
Registers list.

3. Repeat Step 2 until there is a device count number for each of the listed devices.

Configure equipment status


1. Set up the capacitor bank by duplicating the template module labeled Cap Bank Group Item:
TEMPLATE (or by creating a new AND/OR module).

582 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

2. Right-click the new module and make the following modifications:


a. Set the mode of operation to OR.

b. Enter the name of the capacitor bank device in the Custom Label field.

3. Link the input of the new module to a device alarm status output by performing the following
steps:
a. Click the ION button on the toolbar to open the Create Link dialog.

b. Click the desired device, Alarms under Managers, Low Current Alarm under Modules,
and Low Current Alarm under Output Registers.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 583


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

c. Click OK.

d. The cursor appears with a circle; click the input of the module and select NEW Source.

4. Repeat Step 3 until each of the capacitor bank’s desired alarm status is connected to the
module.

By doing this, the output of the module outputs a ‘1’ (High) state if any of the connected alarm
states are activated.

5. Link the output of the new module to the input of the module labeled Cap Bank Landing
Page.

584 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

6. Repeat Steps 1-5 for each capacitor bank in the system.

7. Remove the link between the output of the template module and the input of the Landing Page
module:
a. Right-click the input of the Landing Page module.

b. In the resulting window select the appropriate input.

c. Click Unlink.

8. Repeat Steps 1-7 for the Active Harmonic Filter and UPS device frameworks until each
desired corrective equipment device in the system is connected.

9. Save the modified framework.

NOTE: The outputs of the modules configured for the individual devices drive the Equipment
Group Page indicators, and the outputs of the Landing Page modules drive the Landing Page
Indicators on both the Equipment Pages and Power Quality Performance Indicator pages.

Configure the Equipment Diagram Detail Pages


Each individual piece of equipment in the system can have its own detail page. These diagrams
connect directly to the devices and do not have any interaction with the Power Quality Performance
VIP service.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 585


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To set up any of the detail pages using the provided template diagrams:

1. In Windows Explorer, open the folder ...\Power Monitoring


Expert\config\diagrams\ud\Equipment that contains the DetailPage template for
one of the Equipment (UPS, Capacitor bank or Harmonic filter).

2. Highlight the template that will be used and copy it by pressing Ctrl+C and paste it using
Ctrl+V.

3. When the file is pasted, it is enabled for editing. Choose a new name for the diagram file;
preferably one that is easily associated with the device of interest.

NOTE: Take care not to overwrite the original template file by ensuring that the new file has a
new and distinct file name.

4. Open the PME Vista application and ensure that the toolbox is enabled.

5. Open the new file that was created in step 3 by selecting File > Open and navigating to the
containing folder in the dialog.

6. When the diagram opens, right-click anywhere on the background, and select Properties on
the menu.

586 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

7. In the subsequent dialog, select the Node tab.

8. On the Node tab, select Custom and then click Select to open the Select Node dialog.

9. Select the node name of the equipment for which the diagram was created, and click OK.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 587


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

10. Click OK on the properties dialog, and click Save in Vista.

Provided the correct device was selected as the parent node of the page (that is, that the
device mapping is correct), all the fields and indicators on the page should populate and be
ready for use.

Verify that the device selected is the correct type for the template being used, and that the
device is configured correctly.

Once the page has been linked to the node, there are a few manual steps that should be
completed to customize the page:

11. Customize the page as per the graphic above:


a. Update the page header to include the unique name of the device.

b. Change the picture of the device from the sample image to a custom image, such as a
standard image or an actual picture of the device.

c. Update the device model name to be more specific.

12. As a final step, click the folder icon in the Overview section to view the default diagram of the
device. Verify that the correct default diagram appears, and that the values and status shown
match what appears on the detail page.

13. Repeat all steps for other equipment.

Configure the Equipment Diagram Group Pages


Group Pages display multiple devices of a particular type from a single location.

588 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

This is made possible by creating and customizing "Buttons" that consist of grouping, numeric, text,
and status objects arranged to represent a clickable overview of a single device.

Group Pages set up and scaling


Before the Group Page for a particular device type can be populated, the logical organization of the
device grouping must be reviewed, and multiple Group Pages need to be created if necessary.

If there are less than eight devices of the Group Page type, then proceed to the Group Page Buttons
set up and Detail Page association. If there are more than eight, create more Group Page diagrams.
These new pages will be linked as tabs from the main device type Group Page.

Device scaling
The first step is to determine how many diagrams will be required by counting the number of devices
of the type in question. A single Group Page diagram has eight Button positions, so there will need
to be a Group Page diagram for each eight devices and portion thereof. For example, if the system
contains ten capacitor banks (each with its own Detail Page diagram), then there will need to be two
Group Page diagrams; one page with eight buttons, one page with two.

Alternately, a different organizational scheme can be incorporated by creating a Group Page for
each logical grouping of devices. For example, a separate Group Page can be created for each
production line in a facility, thus allowing the user to conveniently check the active harmonic filters
that are present for a production line that is experiencing problems.

Another option is to create Group Pages for different buildings or areas within a facility.

Ultimately, it is up to the deploying Application Engineer to determine the solution which makes the
most sense for the user's application.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 589


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Group scaling
Each Group Page has space for six tabs, therefore, if there are more than six Group Pages required
for a single device type, they need to be arranged into sub-types on the Landing page level. For
example, if there were twelve Group Pages for active harmonic filters, they need to be split into two
logical categories and treated separately on the Landing Page level.

For this set up guide, assume that there are only six or less Group Pages required in the steps
outlined below.

Group Page logical set up


With the number of Group Pages required in mind, complete the following preliminary setup steps:

Set up the Group Page files


1. In Windows Explorer, open the folder ...\Power Monitoring
Expert\config\diagrams\ud\Equipment that contains the Group Pages.

2. Highlight the template that will be used. Copy it by pressing Ctrl+C and paste it using Ctrl+V.

3. When the file is pasted, the file name opens for editing.

Choose a new name for the diagram file; preferably one that reflects how the Group Pages will
be organized.
Note that the original file (the one that contains the word "All" or "Pg1" in the filename) will be
the main Group Page that is linked to/from the Equipment landing page. For example, if one
were creating an active harmonic filter Group Page for each floor of a facility the filenames
would be as follows:
a. Equipment_GroupPage__AHFAll.dgm (default filename for the first floor)

b. Equipment_GroupPage_ AHF_Floor2.dgm

c. Equipment_GroupPage__AHF_Floor3.dgm

And so on.

NOTE: Use the most current version of the dgm file available.

4. Press Enter to save the file name.

5. Repeat steps 2-3 until you create all required files.

Set up tabs in the First Group Page


1. Open PME Vista and ensure that the Toolbox is enabled.

2. Open the first logical Group Page file that is to be set up by selecting File > Open from the
menu bar and navigating to the containing folder in the dialog.

3. Select the tab text (the green text Default Group in new installations) and press Ctrl+C to
copy it.

590 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

4. Press Ctrl+V to paste up to six text boxes - one for each Group Page.

5. Arrange the text boxes evenly along the tab line in up to five additional "tab" positions.

6. Change the text color for each of the pasted text boxes (but not the original) to black:
a. Right-click the text box to open the Text Box Configuration dialog.

b. Click the Text tab.

c. Select Custom and click the Font button to open the Font dialog.

d. Select Black from the Color drop down menu and click OK.

e. Click OK on the configuration dialog to complete the change.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 591


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

7. Place a new Grouping Object over top of each new text box.

8. Change the shape of each new grouping object by left-clicking the object and dragging the
black tabs that appear.

The objects will be what the user will click to navigate to other tabs; they should therefore
cover the text underneath, and should not overlap.

9. Make each new grouping object link to the Group Page diagram referenced by the text
underneath it.
a. Right-click the grouping to open the Grouping Object Configuration dialog.

b. Select the Action tab.

c. Select Open User Diagram and click the Browse button to open the Choose sub-
diagram dialog.

10. Make each new grouping object appear transparent to show the text underneath it.
a. Right-click the grouping to open the configuration dialog.

b. Select the Display tab.

c. Select None.

d. Click OK in the configuration dialog to complete the change.

11. Hold down the left mouse button and draw a marquee around the entire tab (text box and
grouping) objects.

12. Press Ctrl+C to copy the objects.

13. Save and close the diagram.

Set up tabs in subsequent Group Pages


1. Open the next Group Page diagram by selecting File > Open from the menu bar and
navigating to the containing folder in the dialog.

2. Delete any existing text box objects in the tab area by selecting them and pressing Delete.

592 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

3. Press Ctrl+V to paste the tab objects from the previous Group Page diagram.

4. Change the color of the text in the text box that represents the first Group Page to black (see
"Setting up Tabs in the First Group Page', Step 6).

5. Add a new grouping object over top of the text that represents the first Group Page, modify it to
be transparent, and link it to the first Group Page diagram file (see "Setting up Tabs in the First
Group Page', steps 8-10).

6. Delete the grouping object in the tab area that links to the current Group Page by selecting it
and pressing Delete.

7. Change the color of the text in the text box that represents the current Group Page to green.

8. Change the background image of the diagram to one that has highlighting on the correct
portion of the tab area:
a. Right-click any unpopulated space on the diagram area and select Properties on the
menu.

b. Select the Image tab in the Configuration dialog.

c. Select Custom Image and click Browse.

d. In the resulting, navigate to the following location:


…\config\diagrams\images\Equipment_Diagrams\Backgrounds

e. Select the correct background image.

Each Equipment diagram background image included in this installation is the same,
except for the position of a green highlight in the tab area. The filename of the background
image indicates where the green highlight is located. For example, "PQEquip_Lvl1BG_
Pos2.bmp" has a highlight in the second position from the left, indicated by the "Pos2"
text in the filename. Double-click the file to complete the selection.

NOTE: Use the most current version of the bmp file available.

f. Click OK to complete the change and to close the configuration dialog.

9. Repeat steps 1-8 until all Group Pages have the required tabs.

Group Page Buttons set up and Detail Page association


The following steps outline how to set up a Group page with custom buttons for each device that
has an associated Detail Page:

1. Open Vista and ensure the Toolbox is enabled.

2. Open the Group Page file that is to be set up by selecting File > Open from the menu bar and
navigating to the containing folder in the dialog.

3. Hold down the left mouse button and draw a marquee around the template button in the top left
position of the page space, selecting all objects contained within.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 593


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Press Ctrl+C to copy the button items.

5. Press Ctrl+V to paste up to seven additional buttons (for a total of eight on the page); one for
each device with a Detail Page.

6. Link an indicator (status) object to its corresponding ION module in the Power Quality
Performance Equipment VIP Framework:
a. Right-click the indicator (status) object.

b. Navigate to the correct module output by selecting the following in the Create Link dialog:
a. Node: VIP.PQADVISOR.

b. Managers: And/OR Modules.

c. Modules: the AND/OR module that was set up for the corresponding device in the

594 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Equipment Status Indicator Framework step.

d. Output registers: (module designator) Result.

7. Repeat step 6 for each indicator object on the page.

8. Link the numeric objects within the button to the corresponding outputs on the device.
a. Right-click the numeric object.

b. Navigate to the correct module output by selecting the following in the 'Create Link' dialog;
start by selecting the device in the 'Node' section and navigating to the desired numeric
output.

9. Repeat step 8 for each numeric object on the page.

10. Link the button background to the appropriate Detail Page:


a. Right-click the button (grouping object) area where there is no other object (such as
numeric or indicator).

b. Select the Action tab on the configuration dialog.

c. Select Open User Diagram and click Browse.

d. In the resulting window, navigate to the Detail diagram file.

e. Click OK on the configuration dialog to complete the change.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 595


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

11. Repeat step 10 for each button (Grouping Object) on the page.

12. Repeat this process for each (corrective) device type in the system.

The Group Page should now be configured.

13. Repeat this process for any other Group Page diagrams in the system.

Group Button measurement linking


The measurements displayed on the Group Page buttons are linked to the device measurements by
navigating to the appropriate measurement in the numeric object configuration window. To help the
deploying Application Engineer, these links are listed in more detail below along with the ION
Handle:

See the section called “How to Modify Indicators” in the Appendix called “How to Modify Power
Quality Performance Vista Diagrams” for instructions on how to link to ION Handles.
VarPlus Logic Capacitor Bank Button Measurement Display

Measurement Label in
Button Label ION Handle
Device
Power Factor - Target Target Cos Phi 01 0x8502E01
Power Factor - Measured Power Factor Total 0x8803701

Accusine PCS+ Active Harmonic Filter Button Measurement Display

Measurement Label in
Button Label ION Handle
Device
Total Load Current - A Load Current A Total 0x8100001
Total Load Current - B Load Current B Total 0x8100002
Total Load Current - C Load Current C Total 0x8100003

596 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Measurement Label in
Button Label ION Handle
Device
Load Harmonic - A Load Harmonics Current A 0x810001B
Load Harmonic - B Load Harmonics Current B 0x810001C
Load Harmonic - C Load Harmonics Current C 0x810001D

Galaxy 5500 UPS Button Measurement Display

Button Label Manager Module Output Register ION Handle


Battery Time
Time Remaining Diagnostics2 Backup Time 0xb300002
Remaining
Battery DC
Battery Voltage Voltages Voltage 0xc000018
Voltage
Total Output
Loading Power Factors Power Factor 0xb200001
Percent Load

Configure the Equipment Diagram Landing Pages


Configuring Landing Pages is the last step in setting up the Equipment Page.

The indicators (Status Objects) on the Landing Pages are linked to the output of the respective
Equipment Landing Page ION Module in the Power Quality Performance Framework of the
VIP.PQADVISOR service.

The Equipment Counts (Numeric Objects) are linked to the 'DEVICE COUNTS' ION Arithmetic
Module in the Equipment Status Indicator Framework. The number of devices of each category
within the system needs to be entered into the Setup Registers of the module.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 597


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Link the button background to the appropriate Group Page:

1. Right-click the button (grouping object) area anywhere that there is no other object (such as
numeric or indicator).

2. Select the Action tab on the Configuration dialog.

3. Select Open User Diagram and click Browse.

4. In the resulting window, navigate to the Group diagram file.

5. Click OK on the Configuration dialog to complete the change.

6. Save the diagram.

Customization might be needed under the following circumstances:

• There are more than six Group Pages (i.e. more than 48 devices) for a particular device.

• The customer's application demands multiple Landing Pages with custom groups of device
types. An example of this is pre-configured on default Landing Page; there is a tab for all
devices and a tab for corrective devices only.

When customization is required, follow the steps in this section for adding additional pages/tabs and
additional buttons. Note that the background images used for the Group Pages are the same as
those used in the Landing Pages.

(Optional) Create a Power Quality Performance link in the Web Applications

An optional step is to create a link in Web Applications to view the Power Quality Performance Vista
diagrams:

See Customizing the Web Applications links for details on how to create this link. See Adding idle
detection to custom Web Application links for information on how to add idle detection to prevent
session timeouts.

598 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configure Power Quality Impact Gadgets and Report


The Power Quality Impact Gadgets and Reports associate PQ events with process impact alarms
within a given process / production line, and applies a flat rate cost estimate to the duration of the
process impact alarm.
The following sections describe the configuration steps to make the Power Quality Impact Gadgets
work:

• Acquire process impact signals

• Set up process impact alarms

• Set up Power Quality Groups

Acquire process impact signals

A process impact alarm is designed to be created on:

• An electrical value (e.g. current, voltage, power, etc.) from a power device. In this way PME
detects the process impact independently (for example, based on a current drop).

• A process impact signal from another system or equipment. The process impact signals can
be:
Hard wired signals from the process. The signal can be from the process PLC, motor VSD,
etc. It can be hard wired to a digital input or an analog input of the meter which monitors the
corresponding load (requires AI/DI capability on the meter). The signal can also be hard
wired to a dedicated PLC, which can then be connected into PME as a Modbus device.

OPC tags from the process. Power Monitoring Expert (working as OPC client) acquires the
process impact signals from process SCADA system (working as OPC server) via OPC.

NOTE: If signals from multiple processes are connected to a single device (for example, process
A and process B signals on a PLC, power meter or OPC connection), then logical devices must be
defined to represent each process to be used in the power quality group definition.

To acquire the process impact signals (if Power Monitoring Expert is not detecting the process
impact independently), the following tasks may be required to accomplish the work:

• Using meter I/Os

• Using third-party Modbus device in Power Monitoring Expert

• Using Power Monitoring Expert as an OPC client

• Using Power Monitoring Expert Logical Device

See Power Monitoring Expert documentation for more information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 599


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Set up process impact alarms

After the process impact signals are connected into the Power Monitoring Expert system, or Power
Monitoring Expert is set up to detect the process impact independently, process impact alarms
need to be set up.
To set up process impact alarms:

1. Launch Software Alarms from Management Console > Tools > Web Tools, or from Web
Apps Settings > Alarms.

2. Select Add Alarm Rule.

3. Select the Realtime Setpoint template if the alarm is based on an analog value. Select
Realtime Digital Setpoint template if the alarm is based on a digital value.

4. Select the Measurement that will be used to determine a process impact event (e.g. Current
Avg if using the current drops to signify the process impact, or Equipment State if the
process impact signal is mapped to this measurement for the Logical Device created for the
process)

5. In the Alarm Name field, enter Process Impact Alarm.

NOTE: The string “Process Impact Alarm” is the only flag that the Power Quality Impact
report and gadgets looks for.

6. Configure the thresholds for the Active and Inactive Conditions.

7. Configure the Pickup Delay and Dropout Delay:

The alarm will go ON if the threshold has been exceeded for longer, in seconds, than the
“Pickup Delay” value.
The alarm will go OFF if the value is below the threshold for longer, in seconds, than the
“Dropout Delay” value.

8. Configure the Priority. Use a number less than 64 to prevent the alarm from appearing in the
PME Alarm Viewer.

9. Set the Realtime Interval. The recommendation is 5 seconds.

10. Select the Source for the alarm rule. If a Logical Device is created to represent a process,
select the logical device.

11. (Optional) Define and select a schedule if you want to control when the Alarm is enabled or
disabled.

12. Give the Alarm rule a name.

13. Click Finish.

For more details on how to setup software based alarming see Software Alarms configuration.

Set up Power Quality Groups

The Power Quality Groups are defined per process (for example, a production line), so that only the
power quality events captured by the meter which relate to the particular process are considered in
the impact analysis.

600 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Power Quality Groups must be defined or the Power Quality Impact gadgets and Report will not
function.

The incomer meters defined in the Power Quality Groups are also used for the Power Factor section
of the Power Quality Analysis Report.

Power Quality Group definition


Power Quality Group are defined in the PowerQualityGroups.csv file which is located under
the folder:
{root install folder}\Applications\PowerQuality\

The format of the comma delimited file is as follows:


<Power Quality Group Name>,<Incomer Meter>,<Feeder Meter>,<Load
Meter>,<Rate>
Where:

• Power Quality Group Name – The name for the group (target process). It is used for selecting
the group in Power Quality Impact gadgets and report.

• Incomer meter – The meter monitors the incomer. It typically has the PQ event detection
capability. The event it captures will be used in the analysis.

• Feeder Meter – The meter between the incomer meter and the load meter (could be multiple).
The PQ events it captures can potentially impact the process at its downstream. If a feeder
meter does not support PQ event detection, then there is no need to include it in the definition.
See the examples in next section.

• Load Meter – Contains the Process Impact Alarms. The Power Quality Impact Gadgets and
Report will not work if the load meters are not defined for the Power Quality Groups. It can be a

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 601


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

logical device if the Process Impact Alarm is defined on a logical device. See Set up process
impact alarms for more information. The load meter typically doesn’t have PQ event detection
capability.

• Rate – The flat hourly rate for the cost impact calculation

NOTE:
• The file structure only allows one incomer meter, one feeder meter, and one load meter per
row. If, for a category, more than one meter needs to be included, define them in multiple lines
with the same group name.

• The file structure allows one rate per group; define it only in the first row of the group.

• The PQ events captured by the meters in a Power Quality Group will be clustered before
associating with the Process Impact Alarms, so that the same event seen by different meters
are counted only once.

• Only the PQ events captured by the incomer meter and feeder meter are considered in the
analysis. If the load meter supports PQ event detection, and you want to include the events it
detects into the analysis, you need to define it as a feeder meter as well. See the examples in
next section.

• The incomer meters defined are also used by the Power Factor section of the Power Quality
Analysis Report to determine the incomer meters in the system. See the examples in next
section.

Edit PowerQualityGroup.csv
NOTE: Before editing the PowerQualityGroups.csv file, make sure you understand the
relationship between the power metering system and the process of the customer’s facility.

To edit the PowerQualityGroups.csv file:

1. Identify the system name of a device, go to Device Manager, select Unique System ID in the
Column Selector to add the system name to the display:

NOTE: Only the device system names are acceptable.

602 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

2. Edit the file in Excel, Notepad or other text editor. For each Power Quality Group:
a. In column B, list all related incomer meters that can detect PQ events for the group. Use
multiple rows if there is more than one incomer meter.

b. In column C, list all related feeder meters that can detect PQ events for the group. Use
multiple rows if there is more than one feeder meter.

c. In column D, list all related load meters on which the Process Impact Alarms are
configured for the group. Use multiple rows if there is more than one load meter.

d. Repeat the group name in column A for each row.

e. Specify the rate in column E for only the first row for the group.

3. Repeat step 2 for each Power Quality Group.

4. Save the file and keep the format as .csv.

NOTE:
• The list separators for the .csv are “,” for most regions, and “;” for several European countries.
The list separators will be detected from the culture settings and used by the import/export
exe.

• The rate under culture settings, other than English (en-XX), needs to be enclosed in double
quotes. For example, for Spain (es-ES), if the rate 123.456.789,0 is represented, it is input as
"123.456.789,0".

Example 1:

Take the metering layout in the following image as an example, the definition contains the following:

Example 2:

In a more complicated example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 603


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The file contains the following:

Example 3:

As explained in the previous section, in addition to Example 2, if the feeder meters do not have PQ
event detection capability, there is no need to define them. (There is no effect if they are defined.)

Example 4:

As explained in the previous section, in addition to Example 3, if the Process Impact Alarm for the
“Process A” is defined only under “Load.meter2”, then “Load.meter2” is the only meter that needs to
be defined for the “Process A”. (There is no effect if other load meters are included.)

Example 5:

As explained in the previous section, in addition to Example 4, if the “Load.meter3” can detect
sag/swell, and you want the event it captures to be included in the analysis, you need to duplicate it
as a feeder meter:

Example 6:

The incomer meters defined in the Power Quality Groups are also used for the Power Factor section
of the Power Quality Analysis Report.

If the customer does not require the Power Quality Impact feature, and only wants to enable the
Power Factor section of the Power Quality Analysis Report, the file can be created as:

604 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Import / Export Power Quality Group Definition


The tool PQGroupConfig.exe is used to import / export the Power Quality Group definition in the
PowerQualityGroups.csv file. It is located in {root install
folder}\Applications\bin

Import Power Group Quality definition


To import the definition, run the command line:
PQGroupConfig.exe import "<filepath>\<filename>"

If you are using the default file name and path, copy the following command line:
PQGroupConfig.exe import "C:\Program Files (x86)\Schneider
Electric\Power Monitoring
Expert\Applications\PowerQuality\PowerQualityGroups.csv"

Export Power Group Quality definition


To export the definition, run the command line:
PQGroupConfig.exe export "<filepath>\<filename>"

If you are using the default file name and path, copy the following command line:
PQGroupConfig.exe export "C:\Program Files (x86)\Schneider
Electric\Power Monitoring
Expert\Applications\PowerQuality\PowerQualityGroups.csv"

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 605


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure Power Factor Impact Gadgets


The Power Factor Impact Gadgets provide a clear visual indication of the impact of poor power
factor on your energy bill.

NOTE:
• The Power Factor Impact Gadgets only work for billing periods that start on the first day of the
month. Billing periods that do not start on the 1st (for example, the 20th) are not supported.

• The Viewing Period for the Power Factor Impact Gadget should be set to This Month or Last
Month. The gadget does not show meaningful information if you set the Viewing Period to
another value.

• The Aggregation Period for the Power Factor Impact Trend Gadget should be set to By
Month. The gadget does not show meaningful information if you set the Aggregation Period to
another value.

The calculated surcharge is based on the rate file defined for the PME Rate Engine. Creating or
modifying the rate files requires knowledge of the PME Rate Engine. To learn about the PME Rate
Engine, refer to PME Billing Module Toolkit.
The following sections describe the Power Factor Impact Gadgets configuration steps:

• Set up the Power Factor Impact rate file

• Set up the incomer meters in the hierarchy

Set up the Power Factor Impact rate file

There are four sample rate files in {root install folder}\config\reports\billing


report\ratelibrary based on different calculation methods that are generally used by utilities
for power factor rate penalties:
• Power Factor Impact - Active Energy Billing with PF Adjustment
Option 1.xml
• Power Factor Impact - Active Energy Billing with PF Adjustment
Option 2.xml
• Power Factor Impact - Apparent Energy Billing.xml

• Power Factor Impact - Reactive Energy Billing.xml

The rate file Power Factor Impact Rate.xml is active by default. It includes the same
calculation as the first sample file. See Power Factor Rate File Calculation for the calculations of
the sample rate files.
To set up the Power Factor Impact rate file:

1. Consult with the customer to see how the power factor penalties are calculated by the utility
provider, including the power factor target under which penalty will be charged.

2. Choose the sample file in which the power factor penalty calculation is the closest to
customer’s utility contract.

3. Copy the selected rate file to the file name "Power Factor Impact Rate.xml"

606 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

4. Modify the file to have the same power factor penalty calculation with customer’s utility
contract. To learn how to modify the rate files, please refer to the PME Billing Module Toolkit
as mentioned above.

5. Set the target to be shown in the gadgets.


a. Find PF target value by searching for "<Name>PF_target</Name>"

b. Modify the value for the Formula accordingly.

6. Save the file.

Set up the incomer meters in the hierarchy

The PME Rate Engine only works with a hierarchy node. Therefore, you need to add the meters
which are subjected to the penalty to a hierarchy. You can do this with the default hierarchy, a
custom hierarchy, or virtual meters.

The gadgets only work on a single node. If more than one physical meter needs to be defined (e.g.
dual incomer from same utility), add the meters to a single node in the hierarchy, or add meters to a
single virtual meter.
For example, to add the dual incomer meters as a virtual meter:

1. Launch Hierarchy Manager from Management Console or navigate to


http://<ServerName>/hierarchymanager in a web browser.

2. Click the Virtual Meter tab and click Add.

3. Choose a name for the virtual meter, for example Main_Incomers.

4. Click Add and select a meter to add to the Virtual Meter. Repeat until you have added all the
meters that incur PF penalties.

After the hierarchy node is defined, it can be selected in the Power Factor Impact Gadgets.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 607


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configure Power Quality Analysis Report


The Power Quality Analysis Report does not need configuration to work, unless you want to include
output for the Power Factor section in the report.

The Power Factor section reports the power factor information for the incomer meters in the system.
The report retrieves the incomer meter definition from the Power Quality Group definition. See for
more information on how to define the incomer meters.

Alternatively, the Power Factor section can be toggled off when generating the report.

608 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Set up Power Quality Performance Dashboards and Reports


This section describes best practices when using Power Quality Performance Dashboards and
Reports.

Set up Power Quality Performance Dashboards

Power Quality Performance gadgets are grouped into two groups in Power Monitoring Expert
Dashboards:

• Power Quality Overview


Power Quality Impact

Power Quality Impact Trend

Power Factor Impact

Power Factor Impact Trend

Power Quality Rating

Power Quality Rating Trend

• Power Quality Details


Power Quality Events Breakdown

Power Quality Events Impact

Power Quality Events Location

Set up Power Quality Overview Dashboards


The following image is an example of a Power Quality Overview dashboard.

Gadget viewing period


When displaying each gadget with its trending gadget, the aggregation period of each bar in the
trending gadget should match the viewing period of the non-trending gadget. Otherwise, they are not
comparable.

For example, if the non-trending gadget is set to be monthly,

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 609


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

the corresponding trending gadget should be set to a time range of Last 12 Months, and an
aggregation of By Month.

NOTE: Specifically for the Power Factor Impact Gadgets:

• The Viewing Period for the Power Factor Impact Gadget should be set to This Month or Last
Month. The gadget does not show meaningful information if you set the Viewing Period to
another value.

• The Aggregation Period for the Power Factor Impact Trend Gadget should be set to By
Month. The gadget does not show meaningful information if you set the Aggregation Period to
another value.

Set up Power Quality Detail Dashboards


The following image is an example of the Power Quality Detail dashboard. (Three regular Trend
charts for Power Factor, Harmonics, and Unbalance are combined in this dashboard.)

610 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Generate Power Quality Performance Reports

The following Power Quality Performance reports are available:

• Power Quality Analysis Report

• Power Quality Impact Report

NOTE: When you generate the Power Quality Performance reports, a reporting period longer than
12 months is not supported. Use multiple yearly reports instead.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 611


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Fine-tune Power Quality Performance


Fine-tuning Power Quality Performance is very important during commissioning to obtain useful
power quality views. It depends heavily on customer requirements, power system design, power
meters used in the system, and the power quality condition of the customer’s facility.
This section describes the following fine-tuning procedures:

• Change device inclusion and exclusion for the analysis

• Change Power Quality Indicator thresholds

• Disable unused Power Quality Indicators

Change device inclusion and exclusion for the analysis

You can include or exclude certain meters for power quality assessment by Power Quality
Performance. For example, this capability is useful when you want to include only meters which are
critical, or to exclude spare meters, etc. Also, for performance reasons, it is important to exclude
unnecessary meters.
You can include or exclude the following Power Quality Event types:

• Interruptions

• Voltage Sags

• Voltage Swells

• Transient Voltage

• Over Voltage

• Under Voltage

And you include or exclude the following Power Quality Disturbance types:

• Voltage Unbalance

• Current Unbalance

• Voltage Harmonics

• Current Harmonics

• Frequency Variation

• Flicker

Each PQ event or disturbance has an inclusion list and an exclusion list, and the following logic
applies to both lists:

1. The inclusion list is processed first:


a. If the inclusion list is empty, assume that ALL sources in the system are included. This
means all sources in the sources table.

b. If the inclusion list is not empty, use only sources that exist in the inclusion list. If a source
in the inclusion list does not exist in the sources table, do not add it to the list.

612 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

2. The exclusion list is processed last:


a. From the source list obtained in step 1, remove any source that appears in the exclusion
list.

The following features in the Power Quality Performance module which are affected by the inclusion
and exclusion lists:

• PQ Indicator Diagrams

• PQ Rating Gadget

• PQ Rating Trend Gadget

• Power Quality Events Breakdown Gadget

• Power Quality Events Impact Gadget

• Power Quality Events Location Gadget

• Power Quality Analysis Report – for all sections except the Power Factor section

NOTE: These lists do not define:

• Devices considered by the Power Quality Impact Gadgets and Report.

• Devices considered by the Power Factor Impact Gadgets.

• Devices considered for the Power Factor section of the Power Quality Analysis Report.

See the configuration sections of the above features for details.

To edit the inclusion and exclusion lists:

1. Identify the system name of the target device. Go to Device Manager, show Unique System
ID column using the Column Selector:

2. Go to SQL Server Management Studio, locate the dbo.vCFG_ConfigItems view in the ION_
Network database, and right-click and select "Edit Top 200 Rows".

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 613


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The following variables are the inclusion and exclusion lists:

614 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

3. In the Value fields, enter the comma delimited list of the devices, for example:
PQ.B1,PQ.B2,Main.BackupGenerator

4. To apply the changes immediately in the PQ Indicator Diagrams, go to the Power Quality
Performance Setup page in Vista:

Click Initialize/Update Indicators.

5. To apply the changes immediately in the Power Quality Rating Gadgets, force the gadgets to
clear their cache by “editing” the gadget, and clicking Save (no changes are required).

To exclude all sources for a given category, put a string in the inclusion and exclusion list. For
example: “disabled”.

Change Power Quality Indicator thresholds

The Power Quality Indicator threshold for each indicator is displayed on the information page. (Click
the “i” icon.)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 615


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The thresholds are used to determine the Power Quality Rating by using a color (green, orange, red)
for each Power Quality indicator. Also, only the samples which exceed the threshold are shown in
the Detail Report of the PQ Indicator diagrams.

The count thresholds specified here are used to determine the colors for a year. They get divided by
365 for Last 24 Hours, by 52 for Last 7 Days, and so on. The calculation is as follows:

Round Up ((Yearly Service Limit) x (Number of Days / 365) )

For example, for 30 days, where the yearly limit for orange is 5 and the yearly limit for red is 15:

Orange limit: (5 * (30/365)) = 0.41 which rounds up to 1.

Red limit: (15 * (30/365)) = 1.23 which rounds up to 2.

NOTE: The orange limits are >=, but the red limits are

To change the thresholds:

1. In SQL Server Management Studio, in the ION_Network database locate the dbo.vCFG_
ConfigItems view.

2. Right-click the dbo.vCFG_ConfigItems view and select Edit Top 200 Rows.

The following items are the indicator thresholds:

616 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

The count thresholds specified here are used to determine the colors for a year. They get
divided by 365 for Last 24 Hours, by 52 for Last 7 Days, and so on. The calculation is as
follows:

Round Up ((Yearly Service Limit) x (Number of Days / 365) )

For example, for 30 days, where the yearly limit for orange is 5 and the yearly limit for red is 15:

Orange limit: (5 * (30/365)) = 0.41 which rounds up to 1.

Red limit: (15 * (30/365)) = 1.23 which rounds up to 2.

NOTE: The orange limits are >=, but the red limits are >.

3. Change the threshold item value as needed.

4. For the PQ Indicator Diagrams to display the updated limit information, go to the Power
Quality Performance Setting page in Vista:

Click Import Indicator Limit Information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 617


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Change Power Quality Indicator weight factors

When setting up a baseline for the Power Quality Rating of the system, adjust the Weight Factor to
meet customer requirements, or to reflect the actual condition of the system. For example, increase
the weight for the indicator that is important to the customer, or decrease the weight for the indicator
that is not important.

NOTE: If a certain indicator is not available in the system, for example, no meter in the system can
monitor transient, set its weight to 0.

The formula used to calculate the Power Quality Rating is:

Where:

• PQ.Indicators.Value is a number indicating each Power Quality Indicator status, Green = 2 ;


Yellow= 1 ; Red = 0

• PQ.Indicators.MaxValue = 2 for each individual indicator.

• Weight Factor is an adjustable value (default=1) for assigning a different weight to each
individual indicator depending on customer requirements.

To change a weight factor:

1. In SQL Server Management Studio, in the ION_Network database locate the dbo.vCFG_
ConfigItems view.

2. Right-click the dbo.vCFG_ConfigItems view and select Edit Top 200 Rows.

The following items are the weight factors:

618 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

3. Change the weight item value as needed.

4. To apply the changes immediately in the Power Quality Rating Gadgets, force the gadgets to
clear their cache by “editing” the gadget, and then click Save (no changes are required).

Disable unused Power Quality Indicators

When a Power Quality Indicator has no supported device to feed it the required data, disable it by
using the procedures in the following sections. See Supported Devices for Power Quality
Performance monitoring for meter support information.

Disable Flicker, Frequency, Harmonics or Unbalance Indicators


Use the following procedure to disable the Flicker, Frequency, Harmonics, and Unbalance
indicators. Flicker is used specifically in this example, but the procedure is the same for the other
items.
You can also use the following procedure to disable Overvoltage and Undervoltage. However, note
that it will disable both simultaneously. If only one needs to be disabled, use the procedure in the
next section.

1. To prevent Power Quality Performance from requesting Flicker values, add a string “disabled”
to the FlickerInclusionList & FlickerExclusionList (no double quotes needed). See Change
device inclusion and exclusion for the analysis for detail steps.

2. To prevent the Power Quality Performance indicator diagrams from displaying status:
a. Edit the VIP.PQADVISOR in Designer.

b. Open the Flicker folder.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 619


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

c. Add a new Ext Bool Module.

d. Link the switch output register of the new module to the Enable input register on the 4 XML
import modules used for Flicker.
i. Right click on the newly created Ext Bool Module

ii. Change the Module Label and the switch Output Register Label to “Flicker Enable”

iii. Select the outputs for the Flicker Enable module and select “Flicker Enable”

iv. Select the input of the 24hr Flicker Count Import XML module and select “Flicker
Enable”

v. Repeat the previous step for the following:

7d Flicker Count Import XML module

30d Flicker Count Import XML module

620 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

1y Flicker Count Import XML module

vi. The result will look like this:

3. Save the VIP and close Designer.

Since the Ext Boolean has a default value of “false”, the Flicker Count Import modules are
disabled upon saving the VIP.

4. Check the Power Quality Performance Indicator Diagram.

The Flicker icon should be grey.

The details should be blank:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 621


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Disable Sag, Swell, Interruptions, Transient, or Unbalance Indicators


Use the following procedure to disable the Sag, Swell, Interruptions, and Transient indicators, if the
devices being used in the installation do not support them. Transients are used specifically in this
example, but the procedure is the same for the other items.
You can also use the following procedure to disable either Overvoltage or Undervoltage, if only one
needs to be disabled. If both need to be disabled simultaneously, then use the procedure in the
previous section.

1. To Power Quality Performance from requesting Transient values, add the string “disabled”
(without the quotes) to the TransientInclusionList and TransientExclusionList. See Change
device inclusion and exclusion for the analysis for detailed steps.

2. To prevent the Power Quality Performance indicator diagrams from displaying Transient
status:
a. Edit the VIP.PQADVISOR in Designer.

b. Open the Sag, Swell Transient, Interruption folder.

c. Right click on the 12m Event Ind Extrap module.

d. Double click on Formula 7 and add “S5 + “ to the beginning of the string. This will cause
the output of the equation to be NA because S5 is unassigned and therefore equivalent to
NA. If transients need to be added back to the system (e.g. a new meter which supports

622 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

transients is purchased for the site), then it is easy to remove the string “S5 +” from the
setup register string

e. Repeat step d for Formula 8

f. Repeat steps c, d, and e for:

24h Event Ind Extrap module

7d Event Ind Extrap module

30d Event Ind Extrap module

3. Save the VIP and close Designer.

4. Check the Power Quality Performance Indicator Diagram. The Transient Voltage icon should
be grey.

The DETAILS page should display zeros:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 623


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

624 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configure Power Quality Performance for multiple sites


To use the reports, diagrams, and dashboard gadgets for multiple sites, the module must be
configured. The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database. To
configure, follow the steps:

1. Create multiple sites and assign the devices for the created sites. See Creating a hierarchy for
information on site creation and assigning devices.

2. Add a user group for the created sites and assign devices to user group. See Adding a user
group for information on adding a user group and assigning devices to user group.

3. Perform the configuration of Power Quality Performance. See Configure Power Quality
Performance for configuration steps. Additionally, you need to perform the following specific
configuration:
Configure Power Quality Reports and Gadgets for multiple sites

Configure Power Quality Indicator diagrams for multiple sites

Configure Power Quality Reports and Gadgets for multiple sites


You need to configure power quality group with the associated user group (which is created for the
sites) to enable the power quality reports and gadgets to display as per the selected sites. See
Power Quality Group definition for more information on power quality group definition.

1. Locate the PowerQualityGroups.csv file which is located under the folder: {root
install folder}\Applications\PowerQuality\.

2. Edit the file in Excel, Notepad or other text editor. If you are using Excel, for each power
quality group, specify the associated user group name in column F. See Edit
PowerQualityGroup.csv to follow the editing steps and example on different power quality
group.

3. Repeat step 2 for each power quality group.

4. Save the file and keep the format as .csv.

5. Import the power quality group definition file. See Import / Export Power Quality Group
Definition for information regarding importing the definition file.

Configure Power Quality Indicator diagrams for multiple sites


To configure diagrams for multiple sites:

1. Create VIP service for sites

2. Create framework for sites

3. Create Vista Diagrams for sites

4. Update log viewer query functions for sites

5. (Optional) Update diagram captions for sites

Create VIP service for sites

NOTE: It is recommended that VIPs created for Power Quality Performance analytics must be
used for Power Quality Performance analytics and must not be programmed for other data
processing tasks.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 625


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

You need to create VIP service for each of the created sites.

1. Open a Command Prompt window.

2. Change the current folder to ...\Power Monitoring Expert\system\bin.

3. Type vip -Service -"N<custom name>" on the command line.

This creates a VIP service with the name <custom name>. For example: if the custom name
is Production, then created VIP service name is NVIP.Production.

4. Open the Windows Services panel.

5. Start the newly created VIP service.

6. Repeat steps 1 to 5 for creating VIP service for other sites.

Create framework for sites

The default power quality framework is designed to process all devices information in a PME
system. For multiple site, each VIP is for a specific site and the framework must be configured to
include only the sources assigned to the site.

1. Create a copy of the PQPerformance folder available in .{root install


folder}\config\fmwk\.

2. Rename the copied folder to identify for which site the folder is created. For example: Rename
to PQPerformance-Production for the Production site.

3. Open the PQPerformance-Production folder to view the PQPerformance.fwn file.

By default, the framework request analytics for the entire system via URLs similar to
http://localhost/WebServices/PowerQuality/Analytics.svc/2015-
07/Frequency?StartDaysAgo=30. To configure the specific site, the node path query
string parameter must be appended to these URLs.

The node path query contains two segments. The first segment identifies the view of the
hierarchy and the second segment identifies the node that represents the site.

For example, in the following tree view, Physical Layout is the view of the hierarchy and
Production is the node that represents the site. So, the node path is Physical
Layout/Production.

626 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Based on the above example, the updated URL with node path is


http://localhost/WebServices/PowerQuality/Analytics.svc/2015-
07/Frequency?StartDaysAgo=30&amp;nodePaths=Physical%20Layout/Produ
ction

4. Find and update all URLs in the PQPerformance.fwn file using the following regular
expression:

NOTE: Use a find and replace tool to perform the update to the XML files rather than
manually performing the changes. The recommended tool is Notepad++ find and replace
utility in regular expression mode.

Find:
(http:\/\/localhost\/WebServices\/PowerQuality\/Analytics\.svc\/20
15-07\/.*=\d{1,3})

Replace: \1&amp;nodePaths=<site specific node path here>. For example,


\1&amp;nodePaths=Physical%20Layout/Production

NOTE: Ensure the special encoding for the ampersand (&amp;) and use %20 for spaces if
they exist in the node path.

5. Lock paste the created framework in Designer. See Paste the Power Quality Performance
Framework for information on pasting the framework.

6. Repeat steps 1 to 5 for creating framework for other sites.

Create Vista Diagrams for sites

The default diagram is designed to show all devices information in a PME system. For multiple
sites, each diagram is for a specific site and the diagram must be configured to include only those
sources assigned to the site.

1. Create a copy of the PQPerformance folder available in .{root install


folder}\config\diagrams\ud\.

2. Rename the copied folder to identify for which site the folder is created. For example: Rename
to PQPerformance-Production for the Production site.

3. Find and replace all VIP reference in the folder using the following regular expression:

NOTE: Use a find and replace tool to perform the update to the XML files rather than
manually performing the changes. The recommended tool is Notepad++ find and replace
utility in regular expression mode.

Find: VIP.PQADVISOR

Replace: VIP.<node name>. For example, VIP.Production

4. Find and replace all links between the diagrams in the folder using the following regular
expression:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 627


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: Use a find and replace tool to perform the update to the XML files rather than
manually performing the changes. The recommended tool is Notepad++ find and replace
utility in regular expression mode.

Find: (xlink:href="x-pml:\/diagrams\/ud\/PQPerformance)

Replace: \1-<node name>. For example, \1-Production

5. Open the Power Quality Indicator Diagrams. See Open the Power Quality Indicator Diagrams
for information on opening the diagrams.

6. Repeat steps 1 to 5 for creating diagrams for other sites.

Update log viewer query functions for sites

The default log viewer query functions are designed to query all devices information in a PME
system. For multiple sites, each log viewer query function is for a specific site and the query must
be configured accordingly.

1. Find and replace all functional calls between the diagrams in the newly created folder for a site
using the following regular expression:

NOTE: Use a find and replace tool to perform the update to the XML files rather than
manually performing the changes. The recommended tool is Notepad++ find and replace
utility in regular expression mode.

Find: (udfPQ_List.*)(\) -- Do)

Replace: \1,'<node path>'\2. For example, \1,'Physical


Layout/Production'\2

2. Repeat step 1 for creating log viewer query functions for other sites.

(Optional) Update diagram captions for sites

The default diagram caption is Power Quality Performance. For each site created, this caption
can be changed so it can be uniquely identified.

1. Find and replace all instances of the default diagram caption in the newly created folder for a
site using the following regular expression:

NOTE: Use a find and replace tool to perform the update to the XML files rather than
manually performing the changes. The recommended tool is Notepad++ find and replace
utility in regular expression mode.

Find: (caption_position="0">)Power Quality Performance(.*<FontSpec)

Replace: \1<node name>2. For example, \1Production\2

2. Repeat step 1 for creating diagram captions for other sites.

628 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Breaker Configuration Tool


TIP: You can open the Breaker Configuration Tool from the Power Monitoring Expert >
Configuration Tools folder on your desktop.

Use the Breaker Configuration Tool to configure the Breaker Performance Module. With this tool
you define Breaker Devices, Switchboards, and Groups for the Breaker Aging Report and the
Breaker Settings Report.

The reports have different configuration requirements. Not all of the components and properties
available in the configuration tool have to be configured for both of the report templates. See
Breaker Performance Module configuration for details.

Prerequisites
• The breaker monitoring devices that are recording the breaker data must be configured in the
PME Management Console before you can configure the components and properties in the
configuration tool.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not install incorrect drivers for the circuit breaker devices in the software.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 629


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: The first time you open the Breaker Configuration Tool, you must set the regional settings
for the breaker aging engine. The Initial Configuration settings dialog is only displayed the first time
open the tool. After the initial selection, the tool remains in the selected setting for future start ups.
To show this dialog again, hold down Ctrl + Shift when opening the tool.

630 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Configuring breaker devices


To configure breaker devices:

1. In the Breaker Configuration Tool, select the Breaker Device tab, and then click New to add a
new breaker.

You can also clone an existing breaker. To clone a breaker, select it in the list and then click
Clone. In the Select Breakers to Clone dialog box that opens, select the monitoring devices
that you want to configure as breakers and click OK.

NOTE: Cloned breakers have the same configuration settings as the original. After cloning,
you can edit the settings of the new breakers if necessary. You can only create clones for
monitoring devices of the same device type as the original.

2. Enter the following information:


Name: Enter a unique name for the breaker.

Source: Select the monitoring device that is providing the data for this breaker. You can
only associate a monitoring device with one breaker in the tool.

NOTE: Select Enable Breaker Aging if this breaker is used for both the Breaker
Settings and the Breaker Aging features. Clear the check box for Enable Breaker
Aging if this breaker is only used for the Breaker Settings report.

3. (Only for Breaker Aging) Enter the following information:


Use the dropdown lists to select values for Range, Designation, Rating, and Control
Unit Rating.

Voltage: Enter a value.

4. (Only for Breaker Aging) Select Is existing breaker device if the breaker device is a pre-
existing breaker in your electrical system. Clear the check box for Is existing breaker device
if this is a new breaker in your electrical system. For pre-existing breakers, complete the
available fields.

NOTE: If you select Is existing breaker device, then you must ensure the breaker is
mapped to a switchboard, on the Switchboards tab, and Apply Historical Data is selected
for this Switchboard. Otherwise, the breaker aging calculations cannot be performed and the
diagrams will not display any values.

5. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

6. (Optional) Repeat steps 1-5 to add additional breaker devices.

Configuring switchboards
To configure switchboards:

1. In the Breaker Configuration Tool, click the Switchboards tab, and then click New to add a
new Switchboard.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 631


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2. Enter the following information:


Name: Enter a unique name for the switchboard.

Breakers: Select one or more breakers from the list. Each breaker can only be associated
with one switchboard in the system.

3. Enter the following information:


Critical Threshold % and Moderate Threshold %: Enter default values (0-100%) to be
used for each breaker associated with this switchboard when performing analysis of their
electrical aging and electrical wear levels.

Environmental Conditions: Select values for Switchboard IP, Salty Atmosphere,


Corrosive Gas, and Dust Level.

Current Environmental Data: Select values for Vibration Level, Humidity, and
Temperature.

4. (Only for Breaker Aging) Select Apply Historical Data if the switchboard is pre-existing in
your electrical system. Clear the check box for Apply Historical Data if this is a new
switchboard in your electrical system. For pre-existing switchboards, select values for
Vibration Level, Temperature, and Humidity.

5. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

6. (Optional) Repeat steps 1-5 to add additional switchboard devices.

Configuring groups
To configure groups:

1. In the Breaker Configuration Tool, click the Groups tab, and then click New to add a new
group.

2. Enter the following information:


Name: Enter a unique name for the group.

Switchboards Select one or more switchboards from the list. The same switchboard can
be used in multiple groups.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

4. (Optional) Repeat steps 1-3 to add additional groups.

Generating Vista diagrams


To generate Vista diagrams:

1. In the Breaker Configuration Tool, click the Groups tab, and then click Generate Vista
Diagrams to open the Vista Diagram Generation dialog.

NOTE: At least one group must be configured to generate Vista Diagrams.

2. In Vista Diagram Generation, select the output path for the diagram files and select the groups
for which you want to generate diagrams.

632 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

3. (Optional) Select Include Custom Logo and then select the logo image file for the diagrams.
By default, a Schneider Electric logo appears.

4. Under Options, drag the indicator to define the width of Vista diagrams you generate.

5. Click Generate Vista Diagrams to generate the diagram files, then click Close.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 633


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Designer
Use Designer to configure nodes on your network that are based on ION Architecture. The node can
be a software component or a hardware device.

NOTE: Only nodes based on ION Architecture can be configured using Designer.

Designer’s graphical user interface helps visualize a node's configuration. You can link ION
modules together to customize a node for your particular application. You can also cut, copy and
paste functionality within a single node or between different nodes.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Do not use a controlled output for any safety critical application due to possible unexpected
changes of state during power cycles, power outages, configuration changes, or firmware
upgrades.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

Only personnel with a thorough understanding of ION architecture and the system in which the
meters and software are installed can configure ION modules and registers.

For more information on ION Architecture, ION modules or ION registers, see the ION Reference.

Getting started with Designer


Designer is a programming tool intended for advanced users only. Familiarity with ION
architecture is essential, as Designer is based on ION architecture.

The functions used in traditional power monitoring are treated as discrete modular objects that can
be interconnected and customized. These objects, known as ION modules, are the basic building
blocks that comprise a node.

Designer is used to make any changes to the operation of an ION-compliant node. ION devices, the
Virtual Processor and Log Inserter are all configured using Designer.

For those already familiar with Designer, see Designer shortcuts for a list of the most commonly
used commands.

Starting, logging into and exiting Designer


To start Designer, use one of the methods outlined in Starting a component of Power Monitoring
Expert or open Management Console and select Tools > System > Designer.

For instructions on logging in to or exiting Designer, see Logging into a component and Ending a
session, respectively.

634 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Node diagrams and the Designer interface


This section describes the components of the Designer interface and of node diagrams.

Workspace
with open Core module (indicated by double
A Menu bar B Toolbar C D
node border)
diagram
Grouping
E Toolbox F Status line G H Shortcut icon
object
Time
I Module link J Module icon K L Progress indicator
display
M Communication status lights

The Designer interface


The Designer interface consists of a main screen with a title bar, a menu bar, a toolbar, a
workspace, and a status bar. When in Edit mode, the ION Modules toolbox is also displayed.

Title bar
The title bar displays the name of the program, the user name, and the name of the active node
diagram.

Menu bar
Below the title bar is the menu bar. Click on a menu name to display a list of available commands.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 635


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Toolbar
The Toolbar offers quick access to the commands used most frequently. Each command offered on
the toolbar is also available from the menu bar.

A Open E Cut
B Save F Copy
C Reset G Paste
D Create a link H Help

When you point at a toolbar button, a description of it appears in the status bar at the bottom of the
screen and on a small ToolTip beside the button.

Workspace
The main area in the center of the screen is the workspace, where you view and edit node diagrams.

Status bar
The status bar displays status information. The components, from left to right, are:

• Status line: Describes any active processes and provides brief descriptions of the currently
selected command or toolbar button. For example, when you move the pointer over a toolbar
button or click on a menu name, a brief description of the item appears in the status line.

• Time display: Displays the current time on the workstation.

• Progress indicator: Depicts the progress on an action being performed.

• Communication status lights: Indicate if Designer is currently receiving and transmitting data
on the Power Monitoring Expert network.

The node diagram


A node diagram is a graphical representation of an ION-compliant node. The node diagram displays
the actual configuration of the node. Module icons represent the ION modules in the node, while
lines drawn between these module icons show links between the ION modules.

In some cases, groups of modules are organized inside grouping windows. When closed, a grouping
window appears as a grouping object (an icon that looks like a folder). Click a group object to open
the grouping window that contains the module icons.

Using a node diagram


The node is graphically displayed as a node diagram in Designer. The node diagram contains a
number of ION modules, which represent the node's current configuration. You can change the
configuration of the node simply by editing its node diagram. For example, when you delete a
module from a node diagram, the module is removed from both the diagram and the node. You can
add, configure, link and delete modules on the node by making the corresponding changes to the
module icons in the node diagram. A module’s setup registers can be accessed and changed
through the module icon.

636 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Use Designer to configure hardware nodes (for example, ION meters) or software nodes (for
example, Virtual Processor or Log Inserter).

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
Do not leave hardware or software nodes open in Designer, as this stops log downloads from the
device.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

Default node diagrams in Designer

When a meter is opened in Designer, the default diagrams for the appropriate meter and default
template are loaded automatically.

Opening a node diagram


1. Select File > Open to open the Select Node dialog.

2. Select the node you want to open then click OK.

When you select a node from the list, Designer communicates with the specified node and
opens the applicable node diagram.

NOTICE
UNINTENDED DEVICE OPERATION
Do not open a node diagram if the node is currently being configured from its front panel.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in unplanned configuration changes.

When Designer loads a node diagram, it compares the diagram with the configuration of the node. If
there are any discrepancies between the diagram and the node, Designer updates the diagram to
match the node:

• If a diagram depicts a module that does not exist on the node, Designer deletes the module icon
from the diagram.

• If a node contains a module that is not depicted in the diagram, Designer adds the module icon
to the diagram.

• If the links between modules differ from node to diagram, Designer adjusts the diagram to
match the node.

A node diagram typically does not differ from the node's true configuration unless the node's
configuration was changed through other means (for example, with a remote display unit.)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 637


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Saving a node diagram


Saving a node diagram serves two purposes: it saves your changes to the diagram, and applies
your changes to the node.

• To save the active node diagram, select File > Send & Save.

• To save all open node diagrams, select File > Send & Save All.

Closing a node diagram


To close the node diagram(s):

• Select File > Close to close the active diagram, or

• Select File > Close All to close all open diagrams and windows.

If you attempt to close a diagram without saving your changes, Designer displays a message with a
list of the modules affected.
You can then do one of the following:

• Click OK to return to the diagram and save your work before closing the diagram.

• Click Close Anyway to discard any unsaved changes and close the diagram.

NOTE: If you reopen a diagram containing unsaved changes, Designer may list the unsaved
changes as offline modules.

Display mode versus Edit mode


There are two display modes in Designer, which affect how you navigate a node diagram. Whether
or not the toolbox is shown indicates the mode you are in: if the toolbox is open, you are in edit
mode; if it is closed, you are in display mode.

Display mode allows you to view the node diagram without making changes. To prevent
accidentally moving or deleting modules or links, use Display mode when navigating node
diagrams. In Display mode, single-click grouping objects to open associated grouping windows.

Edit mode allows you to configure the node and the appearance of the node diagram. In Edit mode,
double-click grouping objects to open associated grouping windows. Right-click objects or icons
to view configuration options.

For more information on the Toolbox, see Using the ION modules toolbox.

Designer shortcuts
Designer provides several shortcuts to assist in programming the nodes.

A Input
B Output

638 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

The following table lists the different mouse and keyboard combinations you can perform on a
module’s input or output symbols, and their corresponding functions:

Action Result
The list of inputs appears - you can select an input and link it to
Left-click input
another module's output register
The list of inputs appears with the current input values displayed in
SHIFT + left-click input
square brackets
The Delete Links dialog appears - you can break links from this
Right-click input
dialog.
The Delete Links dialog appears, showing inputs and current input
SHIFT + right-click input
values in square brackets
Left-click output The list of output registers appears
The list of output registers appears with the current register value
SHIFT + left-click output
displayed in square brackets
The list of setup registers appears - these setup registers can be
CTRL + left-click output
linked to inputs on other modules
SHIFT + CTRL + left-click The list of setup registers appears with the current register settings
output displayed in square brackets
The list of output register owners appears - you can break links from
Right-click output
this dialog
The list of setup register owners appears - you can break links from
CTRL + right-click output
this dialog

NOTE: To create a shortcut to an ION module, see Creating a shortcut to an ION module.

Designer icons
In each node diagram, Designer uses icons to represent the configuration of the node. There are two
basic types of icons: module icons and grouping icons.

Module icons represent ION modules located on the node. Grouping icons represent a group of
module icons.

NOTE: A module icon with a symbol in the lower corner is a shortcut.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 639


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Module icons
All module icons share four common elements: a label, a graphic, an input symbol and an output
symbol.

A Label C Graphic
B Input Symbol D Output Symbol

• The label displays the name of the module.

• The graphic shows a picture to distinguish one type of module from another.

• The input and output symbols provide access to the module's input and output registers. Click
the left symbol to display a list of inputs; click the right symbol to display a list of output
registers. See Linking ION modules for more information.

Module icons with a double border represent core modules; module icons with a single border
represent standard modules. For more information on core and standard modules, see Core
modules and standard modules.

Grouping icons and grouping windows


Grouping icons represent grouping windows. Click a grouping icon (left) to open its associated
grouping window (right).

A grouping window acts as a folder or sub-window where you can store icons that you want to keep
together. For example, you can use grouping windows to group module icons by application—a
single grouping window may contain all module icons required for demand or advanced setup
routines.

You can use a grouping window much like a standard window. You can create, rename or delete a
grouping window; you can move a grouping window within a diagram, and you can move a module
into or out of a grouping window.

When you finish editing the grouping window, close it to minimize the window to its corresponding
grouping icon in the node diagram.

640 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Opening a grouping window

Click on the grouping icon.

Closing a grouping window

Click the Close button .

Moving icons into a grouping window

To move an icon (or group of icons) to or from an open grouping window, select it and drag it to the
new location.

1. Click on a grouping icon to open the grouping window.

Drag the grouping window by the title bar and position it so that you can see the icon(s) that
you want to move.

2. Select the icon(s) you want to move and drag the selection into the grouping window.

When you move a linked module icon into a grouping window, the module remains linked but any
lines that represent links to modules outside the window disappear.

Creating a new grouping window

To create a new grouping window, drag the grouping object from the toolbox onto the node
diagram.

The ION modules toolbox is a collection of ION modules and generic tools that you can add to a
node diagram. If the ION modules toolbox is not displayed, select Options > Show Toolbox. See
Using the ION modules toolbox for more information.

When you point to an object in the toolbox, the name of the object is displayed on a ToolTip. You
can use ToolTips to identify the grouping object in the toolbox.

Renaming a grouping window

When you create a new grouping window, the default name is that of the node diagram. To change
the name of a grouping window, rename the grouping icon:

1. Right-click the grouping icon to open the Grouping Object Configuration dialog.

2. Select Use Custom from the Caption section and type the new name into the text box.

3. Click OK.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 641


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Changing the font of a grouping window

To change the font, font style and size of a caption:

1. Right-click the grouping icon to open the Grouping Object Configuration dialog.

2. In the Font section, do one of the following:


To use the font of the parent window, select Inherit from parent window.

To use a different font, select Custom, then click Font to open the Font dialog. Select the
font options you want then click OK to continue.

3. Click OK.

Changing the position of the caption

To change the location of the caption:

1. Right-click the grouping icon to open the Grouping Object Configuration dialog.

2. Select either Top or Bottom in the Position section to specify a caption position above or
below the grouping icon.

3. Click OK.

Deleting a grouping window

NOTE: When you delete a grouping window, any modules inside are deleted as well. Designer
displays a message before deleting modules. See Deleting or cutting an ION module for more
information on deleting modules.

1. Select the grouping icon of the window you want to delete.

2. Press the Delete key. If the grouping window contains modules, Designer displays a list of
modules that will be deleted.

Displaying default or custom icon labels


Module icons can display two types of labels: Default (left) and Custom (right).

• Default labels: All modules have a default label. The default label identifies the module by type
and, if applicable, by number. It appears in node diagrams, user diagrams and event logs unless
a custom label is available.

• Custom labels: Custom labels are available only if they have been preconfigured by a user. A
custom label usually identifies a module by its function or purpose. Custom labels are useful for
describing modules, setup registers, output registers, and Boolean ON/OFF conditions. For
information on adding custom labels, see Customizing a module label.

642 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Displaying default labels or custom labels

Select Options > Show Default Labels to toggle the option on or off.

• When Show Default Labels is selected, default labels are displayed.

• When Show Default Labels is not selected, custom labels are displayed.

This is a global setting that applies to all node diagrams.

Moving icons in a node diagram


You can move module and grouping icons anywhere in a node diagram. This is useful for organizing
your diagram (for example, by function or type) so that you can easily find a particular module or
visualize the workings of your node's configuration. You can move a single icon or group of icons
within a single node diagram, or into an open grouping window.

NOTE: Moving the icons in a node diagram does not affect the function of the modules or the node
in any way.

Moving icons

1. Select the icon(s) you want to move.

When a grouping icon is selected, all icons within its grouping window are automatically
selected as well.

2. Drag the selected icon(s) to the new location.

NOTE: When selecting a group of icons, you can only choose icons from within the active
window.

Arranging icons in a node diagram


You can use the Align and Grid options in the Layout dialog to adjust the spacing and layout of the
module and grouping icons in your node diagram. Use the Align option to specify the horizontal and
vertical arrangement of the selected icons and the Grid option to activate and configure invisible
guidelines.

NOTE: Arranging the icons in a node diagram does not affect the function of the modules or the
node in any way.

Changing the order of layered or stacked icons

If an icon appears on top of another icon that you want to bring to the front, select the icon that is
sitting on top, then click CTRL+K (or click Edit > Send to Back).

Aligning icons

The Align tab in the Layout dialog allows you to specify the horizontal and vertical alignment of
selected objects.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 643


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To align objects:

1. Select the icons that you want to align.

2. Select Edit > Layout to open the Layout dialog.

3. Select the Align tab and set the horizontal and vertical alignment of the icons.

The options in each area determine the criteria by which you can align icons. For example, if
you select Left sides under Horizontal and Space evenly under Vertical, Designer aligns all
objects in the selection by their left sides (using the leftmost object for reference) and
distributes them evenly along a vertical axis.

4. Click OK.

Using the grid

The Grid tab in the Layout dialog activates and configures an invisible grid. Icons placed onto the
grid snap to the nearest gridline to help align and space them evenly.
To activate or deactivate the grid:

1. Select Edit > Layout to open the Layout dialog.

2. Select the Grid tab.

3. Select one of the following options:


No Grid turns the grid off.

Grid size in pixels activates the grid. Type a number in the Grid size in pixels box to
specify the size of the grid (distance between grid lines).

4. Click OK to save your changes.

Designer windows
To create links between several node diagrams or grouping windows, you need to position the open
windows so you can see all the modules involved. Use the Window menu to organize open
windows in the workspace.

Arranging windows in your workspace


To arrange windows, do one of the following:

• To locate an open window and move it to the foreground, select the Window menu and select
the window name from the list of open windows.

• To arrange all open windows in the workspace, select Window > Arrange All.

Changing a window’s background color


By default, the background color of all windows in a node diagram is light gray. To select a new
background color for a window:

1. Right-click the background of the window and select Background Color to open the Color
dialog.

2. Select the color you want or click Define Custom Colors for more options.

3. Click OK.

644 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

When choosing a background color, consider how the color affects the visibility of icons and links.
Links, highlights and shadow effects used to depict the various states of an ION module may not
appear against certain background colors. For this reason, you should avoid using certain colors for
your background, particularly white, dark gray and black.

Changing a window’s default font


You can specify a default font to be used for all module icons, grouping icons and text boxes in a
window.

1. Right-click the background of the window and select Default Font to open the Font dialog.

2. Specify a new default font, size and style.

3. Click OK.

Fonts can also be specified individually for grouping windows and text boxes. See Changing the
font of a grouping window and Changing the font of a Text Box for more information.

ION module overview


After you have opened a node diagram, you can view the node’s configuration or edit it by working
with its ION modules. As described earlier, each module performs a specific function. Using
Designer, you can add, remove or link modules together to customize the function of the node.

This section explains how to add and remove ION modules from your node diagram. It describes the
basic types of modules, and explains how you can organize your node diagram by grouping modules
together, arranging them, and labeling them.

For more information on ION modules and architecture, refer to the ION Reference.

Working with ION modules


The following sections outline some considerations to remember when working with ION modules.

Output and setup registers

A register is a type of memory bank that stores a module's linking and configuration information.
Each module uses two types of registers: output registers and setup registers.

Module status: online and offline

The terms “online” and “offline” describe whether a module is currently active or not. A module is
described as online when it is functioning normally (monitoring its input and updating its output
registers). An offline module is inactive.

Anytime you send and save changes to a node, Designer temporarily takes the affected modules
offline and programs them with your changes. After they have been programmed, the modules are
then placed back online.

Normally, this is a routine procedure. However, certain circumstances may cause a module to
remain offline. For example, if the node lacks sufficient processing power to operate the module, the
module remains offline.

You can easily identify any offline modules: all offline modules are highlighted with a red outline. In
addition, whenever you open a node diagram, Designer displays a list of all offline modules in the
node.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 645


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: If you have offline modules in your node, you may be able to put them back online by
selecting File > Send & Save.

Module status: programmed vs. pending

The terms “programmed” (left) and “pending” (right) refer to whether or not a module's representation
in the node diagram matches the node itself.

Programmed: A programmed module is one that is the same both in the node diagram and in the
node. The links, labels and setup register values in the node diagram exactly match those on the
node. When you first open a node diagram, all the modules appear programmed since they are read
directly from the node itself and then displayed in the node diagram.

Pending: A pending module is one where changes have been made to the module in the node
diagram and not yet sent to the node, so the node diagram does not match the node. The borders of
pending module icons appear as a dashed line.

If you change a module in the node diagram (for example, re-link it or edit its setup registers), it does
not match the node until you select File > Send & Save. Until it is saved, the edited module is
depicted as pending to indicate that it does not match the configuration on the node. When you send
and save your changes to the node, the module becomes programmed.

Core modules and standard modules

There are two basic types of ION modules: core (left) and standard (right).

Core modules are required ION modules that are fundamental to the operation of the node. You
cannot add or delete core modules and, in some cases, you cannot configure them. Core module
icons are identified by a double border around the edge. The Power Meter module is an example of a
core module.

Standard modules are reusable ION modules. Generally, most modules in a node are standard
modules. You can add or delete standard modules as required. Standard modules icons are
identified by a single border. The Setpoint module is an example of a standard module.

Persistent modules

Similar to core modules in that they cannot be added or deleted, persistent modules are standard
modules that have been converted to core modules. These modules are created at the factory, and
can never be removed from the meter frameworks. Persistent modules are represented by icons
with single borders.

An example of a persistent module is External Pulse module #1 on the ION8600 meter. This module
pulses when the Demand Reset switch is pressed on the meter.

646 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Using ION modules


You can change the function of a node by editing the appropriate module(s) in the node diagram and
linking modules together.

This section describes how to locate an existing module, how to add a new module, and how to
delete a module. It also explains how to create a shortcut to a module and how to view the contents
of a module in text format.

After you have located or added the module you want, you can configure it using the procedure
described in Linking ION modules.

Using the ION modules toolbox


The ION Modules toolbox is a collection of ION modules and generic tools that you can add to a
node diagram. To display the ION Modules toolbox, select Options > Show Toolbox.

The type and quantity of modules offered on the toolbox varies depending on the type of node you
are configuring; however, the generic tools (the grouping and text objects) are available for all nodes.

NOTE: To identify a module in the toolbox, point to it with the mouse—the module type is
displayed as a ToolTip and on the status line at the bottom of the screen.

To add a module to your node diagram (and to the node itself), drag its icon from the toolbox into the
diagram window.

Opening the ION modules toolbox

To open the toolbox, select Options > Show Toolbox.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 647


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Closing the ION Modules Toolbox

Click the Close button or clear Options > Show Toolbox.

Locating an existing ION module


Before you can edit a module, you must first locate it in the node diagram. To find a module in a node
diagram, you can use the module tray feature of the toolbox.

Locating an existing module from the Module Tray

1. To display the module tray, right-click the toolbox icon for the type of module you want to
locate. The module tray appears beside the toolbox.

The module tray displays links to all modules of that type that are currently in use on the
node—for example, in the image above, there are 22 Setpoint modules in use by the node. To
identify a link in the tray, point to it—the module's label is displayed on the status line at the
bottom of the screen.

2. To locate a particular module, click its link in the module tray. Designer locates the module
and displays it in the center of the workspace. If the module is located inside a grouping
window, Designer opens the window to display the module.

TIP: To close the module tray, click on any module icon in the toolbox.

Adding a new ION module


Most nodes are pre-programmed at the factory to provide the most commonly required functions.
However, if the factory default configuration is not appropriate for your application, you can add a
new module.

648 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Adding a module on a node

Drag the icon of the module you want to add from the toolbox onto the node diagram.

As you drag the icon, the cursor changes shape to indicate you are placing an object.

Designer adds the module and places a pending module icon into the diagram. You can then link and
configure the module.

See Linking ION modules for more information on programming modules.

Deleting or cutting an ION module


To remove a standard module from a node, delete its icon from the node diagram. By removing
unnecessary modules from the node, you can free up resources for use elsewhere.

NOTICE
UNINTENDED DEVICE OPERATION
Do not delete any ION modules without knowing which modules are dependent on it.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in the unintended operation of the
remaining modules.

NOTE: Each time a module is deleted, all of its output registers, setup registers and input links are
deleted as well. Removing this information from the node affects the operation of any modules that
depend on it. For this reason, you should be aware of all dependent modules (also known as
owners) before you delete anything.

Checking for dependent modules


When two linked modules are located in the same window, Designer depicts the link as a line that
runs from the output register of one module to the input of another. You can easily identify the
dependent module (or owner) by the line running to its input. However, if one of the linked modules is
located in a different window, the connection is not visible. A more effective way to locate a
module's owners is to view the owners of its registers.

Viewing the owners of a module's setup and output registers

You can view a register's owners to quickly identify all dependent modules on the node. You can
determine what purpose the modules serve, and then decide whether to delete them or not.

1. Do one of the following to open the Owners dialog:


To view the owners of a module’s output registers, right-click the output symbol.

To view the owners of a module’s setup registers, hold the CTRL key and then right-click
the output symbol.

The dialog lists all of the module's registers and any dependent modules on the node
(dependent modules on other nodes are not displayed).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 649


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2. Click a register in the Registers list to display the owners of that register in the Owners list on
the right. Owner information includes the module name or label and its relevant input.

3. If necessary, delete the link between a register and one of its owners. Select the owner from
the Owners list and click Unlink. (See Deleting links for more information on deleting module
links.)

4. When you have finished viewing the register owners, click OK.

Viewing owners on other nodes

Displaying a module's register owners is an effective way to locate dependent modules on the
selected node but it does not show any dependent modules located on another node.

If you remove a module with a dependent module on another node, the dependent module's inputs
are not reset. It continues to look for the deleted output register.

If you are not sure whether a module has dependents on other nodes, check with the person who
programmed them to ensure you do not disrupt the operation of any modules on that node. If you still
want to remove the module, you may want to directly delete the link on the other node first. In this
way the module is not inadvertently linked to the next module to occupy the location of the deleted
module.

Deleting or cutting an ION module


After you have determined that you can remove an ION module without disrupting other functions,
there are two ways to remove it: delete and discard the module or cut the module to paste it in
another location.

In either case, Designer immediately removes the icon from the node diagram and deletes the
module from the node. The difference is, when you delete a module, it is discarded; when you cut a
module, it can be restored (by selecting Edit > Paste).

NOTE: You do not have to select Send & Save Changes to delete a module. Designer
immediately removes the module from both the diagram and the node.

Removing an ION module from the node

1. Select the icon(s) of the module(s) you want to remove.

2. Do one of the following:


To cut the module(s) to paste it in another location, select Edit > Cut.

To discard the module(s), press the Delete key.

NOTICE
UNINTENDED DEVICE OPERATION
Do not delete any ION modules without knowing which modules are dependent on it.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in the unintended operation of the
remaining modules.

650 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

NOTE: If a module has a dependent module on another node, Designer does NOT alert you
of the dependency when you delete it. Before you delete a module, ensure that you are aware
of all links to modules on other nodes.

Designer displays a summary of the proposed changes.

The summary lists all selected modules, and identifies those in the selection that will be
deleted (including those with dependents on that node) and those that will not. Select a module
in this list to display any additional information available in the field at the bottom of the dialog.

3. Click OK to remove the selected modules (or Cancel to abort the procedure).

Designer removes the module icon from the node diagram and deletes the module from the
node itself.

NOTE: If you delete a shortcut icon, the original module is not affected. However, when you delete
the original module, all shortcuts to that module are also deleted.

Viewing a node or module as text


You can use the View Diagram Text command to display as text the complete contents of one or
more modules or of an entire node. Use this option to view the specified information on your screen
so you can sort it, perform analysis, create a detailed record of your node’s configuration, or print a
copy for your records.

1. Select the module(s) that you want to display.

TIP: To select all modules in the node, left-click on the background of the main node window,
being careful not to click on a module icon, then select Edit > Select All.

2. Select Options > View Diagram Text to open the Text View screen. The text of any
modules that are offline appears in red.

• The Text View screen offers several ways to view, sort and find information:

• In the View dropdown list, select one of two view modes:


Use Archive to display information useful for archiving the node's configuration.

Use Diagnostic to display diagnostic information on the selected module(s).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 651


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• In the Sort by dropdown list, select the criteria by which you want to sort the data:

Archive View Diagnostic View Sorts by

Default Default Module label


Module Class Module Class Type of module
Module Name Module Name Default label
Displays offline modules first followed by online modules.
Module State
Sorts alphabetically within each group.
Displays event driven modules first, then inactive (not
Module Update updating) modules, followed by high-speed (one cycle
Period updates) modules, and finally high-accuracy (one second
updates) modules. Sorts alphabetically within each group.

• In the Find text field, type a text string and click Find to find that text string in the data.

To reset the text view after you have made a configuration change, click Refresh. If you want to
print a copy of the text view information, click Print. When you are finished viewing the text view
information, click Close.

Creating a shortcut to an ION module


To save time switching between modules in different windows, create a shortcut icon in one window
that represents the original module in the other window.

A shortcut icon is identified by a symbol in the lower left corner of a module icon.

Creating a Shortcut Icon

Hold down SHIFT+CTRL then drag the module icon(s) to the window where you want to place the
shortcut(s).

After you have created a shortcut icon, you can use it in the same way you use the original module
icon. Both icons support the same features. However, if you delete the shortcut icon, the original
module icon is not deleted; whereas if you delete the module icon, it deletes all shortcuts to that
module.

NOTE: You cannot create more than one shortcut icon per window for a single module.

Adding a text box to a node diagram


You can place a text box anywhere in a node diagram, and move it or resize it as necessary. You
can use a text box to describe any process or function in your system; for example, you can label
individual components of your system or display a block of descriptive text or instructions.

Adding a Text Box

1. Drag a Text Box object ( ) from the toolbox onto the node diagram.

A text box opens in the diagram with the default message: “Your text goes here.”

652 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

2. Right-click the text box to replace the default text with your own text. The Text Box
Configuration dialog opens.
Select the Edit Text tab, then do one of the following:

To display the name of the node in the text box, select Use Default.

3. To display your own message, select Use Custom and type your text into the field provided.

4. Click OK. The text box displays your specified text.

Resizing a Text Box

To resize a text box:

1. Select the text box.

2. Do one of the following:


To make the object larger or smaller, drag a corner handle.

To stretch the object horizontally or vertically, drag a middle handle.

Changing the font of a Text Box

The font, size and style of the text used in the text box is based on the default setting specified for
the active window. If you want to use a different font, you can specify a new font for the text box:

1. Right-click the text box to open the Text Box Configuration dialog.

2. Select the Text tab.

3. In the Font section, do one of the following.


To use the font specified for the parent window, select Inherit from parent window.

To use a different font, select Custom, then click Font to open the Font dialog. Specify a
font, style, and size. Click OK to continue.

4. Click OK.

Changing the position of the Text

To change the position of the text in the text box:

1. Right-click the text box to open the Text Box Configuration dialog.

2. Select the Text tab.

3. In the Position section, select Left, Center, or Right.

4. Click OK.

Adding a border or background color to a Text Box

To add a border to a text box or change its background color:

1. Right-click the text box to open the Text Box Configuration dialog.

2. Select the Box tab.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 653


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. Do one or more of the following:


To add a border, select Show in the Border section and click Color to select a border
color.

To set the width of the border, type a border width in the “Width in pixels” field in the Border
section.

To add a background color, select Custom in the Background Color section and click
Color to select a background color.

4. Click OK.

Linking ION modules


Linking ION modules together is the foundation of programming ION-compliant nodes in Power
Monitoring Expert. Although an ION module can perform a function in isolation, the strength and
flexibility of the ION architecture comes from the ability to interconnect modules to build more
sophisticated functions.

Choosing which ION modules to link


The first step in linking modules is to decide which modules you want to use. When choosing a
module to link, you have two choices: you can add and link a new module or you can re-link an
existing module.

In some cases, you may not want to add a new module. For example, if all the modules of a
particular type are already used, you need to re-link one of them to perform the new function. Most
devices are preconfigured at the factory to provide common measurements and calculations. If any
of these factory defaults are unnecessary in your application, you can unlink the modules involved
and reuse them.

Plan ahead before you add new modules. Unlinked modules are wasted resources.

You may find a linked module that you can use to add a new link, in order to augment the function it
is performing. For example, if you have a Setpoint module that triggers a waveform recording, then
later decide to use this trigger to reset a counter, you can link that Counter module to the same
Setpoint that controls the Waveform Recorder module.

Linking ION modules graphically


Linking modules graphically means pointing and clicking a module’s input, then clicking another
module’s output register to link it (note that both input and output register classes must be
compatible). You can use this method to link to modules on the same node or to create links across
nodes.

You can use the autolinking feature to speed up the process of linking ION modules. Typically,
linking ION modules involves connecting the output register of one module to the input of another. In
many cases, only one of the module's inputs have the same register class as the selected output
register.

If autolinking is enabled, Designer automatically selects the appropriate input and establishes the
link. If necessary, it overwrites an existing link. This relieves you from having to manually select the
input; however, you cannot see what input you are linking to.

654 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

By default, autolinking is disabled. You should only use autolinking if you are thoroughly familiar
with all the inputs and output registers of the modules you are working with so that you do not
inadvertently create undesirable links.

Enabling autolinking

To enable autolinking, select Options > Enable Autolinking. A check mark beside the option
indicates it is selected.

Disabling autolinking

To disable autolinking, clear Options > Enable Autolinking.

Linking ION modules on the same node


If the selected node is a meter such as the ION7650, the process of configuring the node primarily
involves creating links between modules on that node.

NOTE: To cancel a link-in-progress, click anywhere in the background of the window or press the
ESC key.

Linking modules using the point and click method

1. To list a module's output registers, click the output symbol on the right side of the module icon.
To list the module's setup registers, hold the CTRL key while clicking the output symbol.

Either a menu opens or, if the module has many registers, a dialog opens listing the available
registers.

2. Select the register you want to link:


In the menu, click the register you want to select.

In the dialog, double-click the register (or click it then click Select).

3. Move the cursor towards the module you want to link to. The cursor changes and a dotted line
follows it across the node diagram. This indicates you are in the process of creating a link and
it shows where the connecting line will appear in the node diagram.

If you link to a module that is in a different window than the original module (either in a different
node diagram or grouping window) the dotted line disappears but the cursor still indicates that
a link is in progress.

If the module you want is obscured by another window, click on the title bar of the window
containing the module. This brings the window to the foreground without canceling the link. (If
you click on the background of the window, the link is cancelled.)

4. Click the input symbol of the module that you want to link to display the module's inputs.
Either a menu opens or, if the module has many registers, a dialog opens listing the module's
inputs.

If the input is already linked, the label of the register it is linked to is displayed beside the input.
If you select the input, the existing link is overwritten.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 655


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The inputs that are of a different class than the selected output register are grayed out to
indicate you cannot select them.

5. Select the input you want to link to:


In the menu, click the register you want to select.

In the dialog, double-click the register (or click it then click Select).

6. Select File > Send & Save to save your changes to the node.

The procedure described above can also be performed in reverse order. You can select a module's
input first and then link it to another module's output register.

Linking modules with variable number of inputs


Some modules, such as AND/OR modules, Data Recorder modules, and Log Acquisition modules
have a variable number of inputs. In these cases, when you click on the input symbol, the menu
offers one instance of the variable input as well as any fixed inputs the module may have. When
linking to one of these modules, you can select the NEW Source item to add a new link or you can
select an existing link and overwrite it.

If the two modules are in the same window, the line remains on the screen to show the link between
the modules—when you save this change to the node, the line changes from a dotted line to a thin
black line to indicate that the link is now programmed on the node.

Linking ION modules across different nodes


If the selected node is a software node, such as the Virtual Processor or Log Inserter, many of the
links you create are to modules on other nodes. When you create links across different nodes, it is
important to keep track of these links and note what modules are dependent on others. This helps
you determine what will happen if you ever want to delete a module that is linked to a module on
another node.

NOTE: You cannot link modules on one device to another. For example, you cannot create a link
between a module on an ION7330 to a module on a different ION7330 or to a module on another
meter.

1. Open the node diagrams that contain the modules you want to link.

2. Position the diagrams within the workspace so you can see the two modules you want to link.

3. In the first node diagram, click on the output symbol of the module icon. A menu or dialog
opens listing the module's output registers.

4. In the list of output registers, click the register you want. (In the case of the dialog, click a
register and then click Select.)

5. Drag the cursor from the first node diagram to the module you want to link to in the second
node diagram. The dotted line ceases to follow the cursor if it crosses the window boundary
but the cursor changes to indicate a link is in progress.

6. Click on the input symbol of the module icon in the second node diagram. A menu or dialog
opens listing the module's inputs. Those that are of a different class than the selected output
register are grayed out to indicate you cannot select them.

656 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

7. Click the input you want, or in the case of the dialog, click the input then click Select.
Designer does not graphically represent links between modules on different nodes so you will
not see a line connecting the modules.

8. Select File > Send & Save to save your changes to the node.

This procedure can also be performed in reverse order. You can select a module's input first and
then link it to another module's output register.

NOTE: If the input is already linked, the label of the register it is linked to is displayed beside the
input. If you select this input, the existing link is overwritten.

A note about performance

While creating links, you may notice that the circle at the end of the arrow cursor is sometimes
black ( ).

This indicates that Designer is in the process of retrieving information about a module. You can still
click on the inputs or outputs of other modules, but Designer aborts the original request. To
minimize the amount of communications between Designer and the connected nodes, avoid
unnecessary clicking on the input and output symbols.

If you click on several items in a row, you only see the menu for the last item you click; however,
Designer initiates many requests for information, which may impact its performance.

Linking ION modules using the ION tree


In some cases, you may want to use the ION tree to select the register for linking. The ION tree is a
hierarchical listing of every node, manager, module, and register in the Power Monitoring Expert
network. It allows you to select a register on a node without opening the node diagram. Generally,
you use the ION tree to create links across nodes.

The ION tree is also the only way to select registers from devices that are not ION-compliant (and
use translators to make data available) such as 3000 series meters. For example, if you are
programming a Virtual Processor node and you want to sum data from several 3720 ACMs, you
must access the 3720 ACM register via the ION tree.

Using the ION tree is faster than opening a node diagram. It is useful if you want to link to a register
on a node whose diagram has not yet been opened. It is also useful if you want to link to a register,
but you are not acquainted with the configuration of the node in which it resides. You can go straight
to the register without having to navigate through an unfamiliar node diagram. Also, since a diagram
can only be accessed by one user at a time, you can use the ION tree to link to a register on another
node where the diagram is already open.

Linking modules using the ION tree

1. Click the input symbol of the module icon. A list of the module's inputs is displayed.

2. In the list of inputs, select the input you want to link.

3. Click the button in the toolbar. (To link a module's setup register, hold the CTRL key
while clicking this button.)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 657


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The Create Link dialog opens, providing access to the ION tree.

4. Specify a node, manager, module and output register: Double-click the node you want in the
Nodes box. All managers within the selected node appear in the Managers box. You can then
double-click the manager you want, and repeat this procedure for the modules and registers.

5. Click OK. The module whose inputs changed appears grayed-out to indicate it is now pending.
If both modules are in the same window of the same node diagram, a line appears to represent
the link.

6. Select File > Send & Save. The new link is established and the module appears
programmed.

The procedure described above can also be performed in the reverse order. You can click the
button first, select an output register, and then click the input symbol of a module icon to
select one of its inputs.

Deleting links
If you want to disassemble a group of linked modules and use them for another function, you can
delete the links between the modules rather than deleting the modules. Designer provides several
ways to delete links.

Fixed links

Most links between standard modules can be deleted. However, some links between core modules
are fixed and cannot be deleted. These fixed links include:

• Data Acquisition module and all Power Meter modules.

• Data Acquisition module and all FFT modules.

• FFT module and all Harmonics Analyzer modules.

• FFT module and all Symmetrical Components modules.

If you attempt to delete a fixed link, Designer informs you that the link cannot be deleted.

Deleting visible links


If the linked modules are in the same window, simply click on the link line and press the Delete key.
This works well as long as you know which output register and input are involved. For example, in
the image below, to delete the link click on the line joining the Power Meter and the Sliding Window
Demand module (its color reverses to indicate it is selected) and press Delete.

If there are multiple lines between the same modules and you only want to delete one of the links,
you may want to use the method described in Deleting links that are not visible below.

658 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Deleting links that are not visible


If you cannot see a line that links the modules (for example, if they are in different windows), or you
need to know which output registers and which inputs are involved, you must use a dialog to delete
the link between modules. You can look either at the output register owners of the first module or
you can look at the inputs of the second module to see what they are linked to, and then delete the
link from there.

Deleting a module's input links


Deleting links at a module's inputs is generally faster than deleting them at the module's output
registers because Designer does not need to check the entire node. On the other hand, there is less
information available if you view input links. All you see is the label of the output register that is
linked to the input. If this is sufficient information, proceed with this method; if not, go to the output
registers to delete the link.

Viewing a module's input links

1. Right-click the input symbol of the module icon to open the Delete Links dialog.

2. Each input and the label of the output register it is linked to are displayed in the dialog. To
delete one or more of these links, select the input and click Unlink. The output register label is
replaced with dashed lines.

3. When you have unlinked all the registers you need to, click OK.

4. Select Send & Save to unlink the modules on the node.

Deleting a module's output links


You can also delete links from the Register Owners dialog. This method gives you the most
information about the link you are deleting (the output register label and the input and label of the
module it is linked to).

Viewing a module's output links

1. Right-click the output symbol side of the module icon to open the Register Owners dialog.
(To list the module's setup registers, hold the CTRL key while right-clicking on the symbol.)

2. Select the output register you want from the Registers section. The Owners section lists all
the module inputs to which the selected register is linked.

3. To delete one or more of these links, select the module input in the Owners list box and click
Unlink. The input name is replaced with a dashed line.

4. When you have unlinked all of the module inputs you want, click OK.

5. Select Send & Save to unlink the module inputs on the node.

NOTE: Owners that reside on a different node are NOT displayed in this dialog. If you need to
delete a link between modules on different nodes, use the procedure described in Deleting a
module's input links.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 659


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring ION modules


After you have placed a module in a node diagram, you can configure the various setup parameters
of the module. It is not necessary to do this before you link the modules but you should ensure the
module is set up correctly before sending the configuration to the node.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Do not use a controlled output for any safety critical application due to possible unexpected
changes of state during power cycles, power outages, configuration changes, or firmware
upgrades.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

Only personnel with a thorough understanding of ION architecture and the system in which the
meters and software are installed can configure ION modules and registers.

Module setup parameters include the module's label; its setup registers, labels and values; and its
output register labels. To access these, right-click the module icon.

The ION Module Setup dialog opens.

The Setup Registers box lists all the setup registers of the module along with their current values or
settings. To change any of the settings or assign a custom label to a setup register, select the
register, then click Modify (or double-click on the register) to open the Modify Register dialog
where you can make modifications.

In most cases, configuring a setup register is a simple matter of entering a number, entering text, or
choosing an option from a list. (To determine the options or ranges available for a setup register,
refer to the module's description in the ION Reference.)

When you have completed all your modifications to the module, click OK to return to the node
diagram. The module icon appears pending until you send and save your changes.

Modifying enumerated, numeric bounded, and string setup registers


If the register you have selected is an enumerated, numeric bounded or string register, one of the
following dialogs appear when you click Modify:

Enumerated registers

To modify an enumerated register, select an option from the Options list.

660 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Numeric bounded registers

To modify a numeric bounded register, type a number in the Value box. The allowable range is
shown under the Value box; you are alerted if you type a number outside this range.

To enter a formatted numeric value, click Format. In the Time Interval Value dialog, you can enter
the numeric value as a date (offset from Jan 1, 1970) or a time interval.

String registers

To modify a string register, type your text in the String box.


Note that when you click Modify for a string register that is the connection string for a Log
Acquisition module or Query module, the Modify Database Connection Properties dialog opens.

Modifying calendar setup registers


The ION Scheduler module has a special class of setup register called a calendar register.
Configuring a calendar register is only necessary for nodes that have a Scheduler module. For
detailed information on how to configure a calendar register, see the description of the Scheduler
module in the ION Reference.

Modifying address setup registers


All Distributed Numeric, Distributed Boolean, and Distributed Pulse modules contain an address
setup register that references another register. You can specify a new value or clear an existing
value as required. (Currently, the Virtual Processor is the only node offering these types of
modules.)

NOTE: Currently, you can only link the address setup register to External Numeric, External
Boolean, and External Pulse registers.

Modifying an address setup register

1. Right-click a Distributed Numeric, Distributed Boolean or Distributed Pulse to open the ION
Module Setup dialog.

2. In the Setup Registers section, select a register then click Modify to open the Modify
Address Register dialog.

3. In the Modify Address Register dialog, double-click on the node, manager, module and
output register you want to use. Click OK to continue.

4. Click OK in the ION Module Setup dialog.

NOTE: You can clear the value of an address setup register. On the Modify Address Register
dialog, select Reset Register Value and then click OK.

Parent module and shared setup registers


Setup registers that are surrounded by asterisks (for example, “**PM1 PT Sec**”) indicate that the
module shares its setup registers with another (“parent”) module. An example of this is the High-
Speed Power Meter or Meter Units Power Meter module (“HS Power Meter”, “MU Power Meter”).
They share their setup registers with the parent Power Meter module.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 661


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

If you try to modify a shared setup register, a prompt identifies the register as shared and gives the
name of the parent module.

Navigate to the parent module and change the setup register there.

Using custom labels


You can assign custom labels to modules, setup registers, output registers, and Boolean ON/OFF
conditions. All modules and registers have a default label and this label is what you see in node
diagrams, user diagrams and event logs unless you specify a custom label.

Creating custom labels allows you to clearly describe what the module and its registers have been
set up to do.

However, carefully consider which modules and registers should be assigned custom labels. There
is a fixed number of labels available, but there are thousands of registers you can assign them to.
Many of these registers do not benefit from custom labels. For example, most setup registers can
be left at their default names since the only place their names might appear is in the event log.

NOTE: Some devices, such as the ION7330 and ION7700, have a 15-character limit for labels.

Customizing a module label

The ION Module Setup dialog allows you to edit the module label. The module label is the text that
appears across the top of the module icon in the node diagram. It is also the label that is used in
event logs and in the dialog for the ION tree.

1. In the ION Module Setup dialog, do one of the following:


To create a custom label, select Use Custom Label and then type a name for the label in
the box.

To use the default label, select Use Default Label.

2. Click OK to return to the node diagram.

Customizing an output register label


By providing a custom label for an output register, you can clearly indicate the information that
register contains. For example, if you have linked the Vlna output register of a Power Meter module
to a Thermal Demand module, and in turn linked the ThrmDemand output register to a Maximum
module, you may want to label the Maximum module's output register as “Va TD Maximum”
(instead of using the default name of “Maximum 1”).

1. In the ION Module Setup dialog, select the output register in the Output Registers area and
then click Modify to open the Modify Label dialog.

2. Do one of the following:


To create a custom label, select Use Custom Label and then type a name for the label in
the box.

To use the default label, select Use Default Label.

3. Click OK to return to the ION Module Setup dialog.

662 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Customizing Boolean ON/OFF labels


If the output registers of the module are Boolean, you can create custom labels to associate with the
ON and OFF conditions of these registers. These labels can clarify exactly what the ON or OFF
conditions represent. For example, if a Boolean output register is used to switch a fan on and off,
you could create a Boolean ON label called “Fan Running” and an OFF label called “Fan Not
Running.”

1. In the ION Module Setup dialog, select the Boolean output register and then click Modify to
open the Modify Boolean Register dialog.

2. Do one of the following:


To create custom labels, select Use Custom Labels and then type names for the
Register Label, ON Label and OFF Label in the appropriate fields.

To use the default labels, select Use Default Labels.

3. Click OK to return to the ION Module Setup dialog.

Customizing a setup register label

1. In the ION Module Setup dialog, select the setup register and click Modify.

2. Do one of the following:


To create a custom label, select Use Custom Label and then type a name for the label in
the field.

To use the default label, select Use Default Label.

3. Click OK to return to the ION Module Setup dialog.

Resetting ION modules in a node diagram


Designer allows you to undo certain changes you have made in a node diagram since the last time
you saved and sent your changes to the node. It refreshes the selected module icons so they reflect
what is actually on the node. Reversible changes include:

• Changing the value of a setup register.

• Changing module or register labels.

• Changing the links between modules.

NOTE: Since adding and deleting modules happens immediately on a node, you cannot undo the
deletion or the creation of a module.

To reset ION Modules:

1. Select the module(s) you want to reset.

2. Select Edit > Reset.

All the changes made to the selected modules since the last time you sent and saved the node
diagram are discarded. Modules not included in the selection are unaffected (that is, if they had
pending changes, the changes are still pending.)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 663


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Fast-linking ION modules in the Log Inserter


When linking modules in the Log Inserter, you can save time by using the Fast Linker utility. The
Fast Linker automates much of the linking process, enabling you to quickly link any combination of
event, data or waveform recorders. To access the Fast Linker options, press the CTRL key and
click on the Log Inserter inputs.

For more information on using the Fast Linker utility, refer to the description for the Log Acquisition
module in the ION Reference.

Configuring Security module


You can configure the device security through Designer. You can enable or disable security settings
of the device. The device supports standard security and advanced security.

To enable standard security,

1. Open a node diagram of the device.

2. Select Options> Change Standard Meter Security.

The Change Standard Meter Security window displays.

NOTE: If the Change Standard Meter Security option is disabled, refer to Changes in
security settings of device for more information.

3. Clear the Disable Standard Meter Password check box and type the password in the
Password field then re-type it in the Confirm Password field.

4. Click OK.

A confirmation message displays.


5. Click OK.

6. Send and save the changes in Designer.

To enable advanced security,

1. Open a node diagram of the device.

2. Right-click the Security Options module icon to open the module setup.

3. Highlight the SOP1 Enable Advanced Security register and click Modify.

NOTE: If the SOP1 Enable Advanced Security register is not listed and the SOP1 Legacy
Security Support register is listed, refer to Changes in security settings of device for more
information.

4. Select Enabled in the options dropdown and click OK in the Modify Enumerator Register
dialog.

5. Click OK in the ION Module Setup dialog to close it.

6. Add a new Security Module from the ION modules toolbox.

7. Right-click on the newly added Security Module icon to open the module setup.

8. Click Change Password button to open the Change Advanced Meter Security window.

9. Type the password in the Password field then re-type it in the Confirm Password field.

664 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

10. Click OK.

A confirmation message displays.


11. Click OK to acknowledge the message.

12. Click OK in the ION Module Setup dialog to close it.

13. Send and save the changes in Designer.

Copying and pasting ION modules


You can easily create a new function in a node diagram by copying and pasting modules. You can
copy and paste a single module, a group of modules, grouping icons, text objects, or the entire node.

You can copy modules from one node and paste them into another, as long as the node you are
pasting to supports the selected modules and has sufficient resources. When pasting modules, you
can replace existing modules or add new ones.

You can also copy modules and save them as a framework. You and other users can then reuse this
framework in other nodes. Saving a node's configuration as a framework provides a fast and easy
way to program a large number of nodes at once.

NOTE: Persistent modules cannot be deleted, but they can be overwritten during a framework
paste. Overwriting a persistent module effectively relinks its outputs and rewrites its label, but its
core functionality remains intact (for example, the Master Reset module may be relabeled, but
pulsing this module still initiates a master reset). When pasting a default framework onto a meter,
use lock-paste to ensure that all persistent modules in the "old" default framework are overwritten
by the corresponding persistent module in the "new" default framework. Persistent modules are
listed in the "ION Device Template Reference".

Copying modules
Designer offers two ways to create copies of modules: copy and paste using the product's clipboard
or copy or paste using a framework.

NOTE: The Power Monitoring Expert Clipboard is a temporary storage area that holds any
information cut or copied from Designer. This clipboard should not be confused with the Windows
Clipboard.

When you copy a selection of ION modules, you can use Copy, Cut, or Copy to Framework:

• Copy saves the selection to the clipboard and leaves the original module(s) intact.

• Cut saves the selection to the clipboard and removes the original module(s).

• Copy to framework saves the selection as a file and leaves the original modules intact.

Additional considerations include pasting with shortcuts, modules that cannot be pasted, and
cloning a node (copying and pasting an entire node configuration from one node diagram to another).

Cutting or copying ION modules to the clipboard

Use the Cut or Copy command to save a temporary copy of the selected modules to the clipboard.
You can then use the Paste command to transfer the selection from the clipboard into any node
diagram. Each copy retains the setup register values, custom labels, link information and layout of

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 665


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

the original selection.

NOTE: When selecting modules to be cut or copied, you can also include grouping icons and text
objects. If you select a grouping icon, all modules within the group are copied, as well as any
nested grouping icons.

1. Select the module(s) you want to cut or copy.

2. Do one of the following:


To cut the selection to the clipboard and remove the original, select Edit > Cut.

To copy the selection to the clipboard and retain the original, select Edit > Copy.

Designer copies the requested information to the clipboard.

After the selection has been copied to the clipboard, you can select Edit > Paste to paste it into any
user diagram.

Copying ION modules to a framework

You can use the Copy to framework command to create a framework from the selected modules.
A framework is a template that you can use to reproduce a group of modules. Unlike regular copying
and pasting, a framework is stored as a file so you can paste it later.

When you select Edit > Copy to framework, Designer copies the layout, linking and configuration
information of each module in the selected group. It saves the framework as an .fwn file. You can
then use the Paste from framework command to paste the group in another node diagram.

You can use frameworks to simplify the process of programming multiple devices with similar
configurations. For example, if you wanted to program a single function into several nodes, you
could program the first node and then copy the configuration to a framework. You could then quickly
program the other nodes by simply opening their node diagrams and pasting the framework you
created. You can also use frameworks to program an entire node at once, considerably reducing the
amount of time required to set up a large installation.

Before you save a group of modules as a framework, consider carefully which modules you want to
include. If you include core modules in your framework, you will not be able to paste them unless
you overwrite the existing core modules that correspond to those in your framework. Another
approach is to select the modules “downstream” of the core module and save them as a framework.
Then when you paste the framework into another node diagram, you can use the Maintain External
Inputs option to preserve your links to the original core modules. (See Using the Paste Summary
dialog for more information.)

NOTE: After you have saved a framework, it can be used in another node diagram, as long as the
node supports the modules included in the framework. Although it is possible to create a
framework from one node type and use it with another node type, it is advisable to restrict your use
of frameworks to nodes of the same type.

Copying a group of ION Modules to a framework

1. Select the group of module icons you want to copy.

2. Select Edit > Copy to Framework to open the Copy to Framework dialog.

666 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

3. In the File Name field, type a name for the framework, then click Save. The framework
filename extension (.fwn) is added automatically and the selection is saved as a framework
file.

After you have copied a group to a framework, you can select Edit > Paste from framework to
paste it into a node diagram.

Pasting ION modules


You can paste a saved copy of one or more modules into any node diagram. Designer offers two
ways to paste modules:

• Paste inserts a selection that has been placed on the clipboard using the Cut or Copy
command

• Paste from framework inserts a selection that has been saved as a file.

Pasting modules is a little more complicated than copying them, because the action of adding
modules to the node may require you to replace existing modules. Whether you choose Paste or
Paste from framework, Designer displays a Paste Summary dialog that explains each aspect of
the proposed changes.

You can use the Paste Summary box to define how to integrate the source modules into the
destination modules. For example, if a source module is being pasted to a destination that is already
occupied, you can either lock paste the new module over the existing one or free paste the new
module into the next available destination.

If you paste a selection that contains a shortcut, Designer may paste the shortcut as a module.
(See Pasting shortcuts for more information.)

In some cases, Designer may not paste every module in your selection. (See Modules that cannot
be pasted for more information.)

Pasting ION modules from the clipboard or a framework

When pasting modules, the first thing to do is select the node diagram and window where you want
the modules to go. If you have more than one window open, you can click on the title bar of the
window you want to make it the active window.

NOTE: You can paste modules into the same node diagram they were copied from or into a
different one.

You can paste modules from two sources: the clipboard or a framework. When you paste a
selection from either source, Designer describes the proposed changes in the Paste Summary
dialog. You can use the Paste Summary area to review your changes and make modifications as
necessary.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 667


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTICE
UNINTENDED DEVICE OPERATION
Do not use the lock paste option to overwrite existing destination modules.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in operational differences in required


modules.

Only use the lock paste option if you are an advanced user familiar with ION architecture.

NOTE: The lock paste option overwrites an existing module but the outputs from that module are
retained as inputs of other modules. Consequently, the module may not operate as expected. (See
Using the Paste Summary dialog for more information.)

Pasting ION modules into a node diagram

1. Open the window where you want the modules to go. Click in the background of the window to
clear any selected modules.

2. Do one of the following:


To paste a selection from the clipboard, select Edit > Paste.

To paste a selection from a framework, select Edit > Paste from Framework. In the
Paste from Framework box, select the file you want and then click Open.

3. The Paste Summary dialog opens. Use the Paste Summary area to review the proposed
changes (see Using the Paste Summary dialog, below, for more information). When you are
satisfied with the summary, click OK to complete the procedure.

The selection is pasted into the active window. The entire selection is automatically selected so you
can easily move it to a clear area in the window. All module icons in the selection appear as pending
until you click Send & Save to save the changes to the node.

Using the Paste Summary dialog


Before Designer pastes a selection, it displays the Paste Summary dialog. Use the Paste
Summary dialog to review and modify the proposed changes to the node diagram.

The Paste Summary dialog lists each module to be pasted and indicates its destination in the node.
For each module, a short summary of the proposed modification as well as a more detailed
description of how the module is pasted or why it cannot be pasted as requested displays in the
dialog.

668 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

The following sections describe the various areas of the Paste Summary dialog.

Source

The Source column lists each module that was copied to the clipboard or framework. Each source
module is listed by its default label unless a custom label has been specified (in which case the
default name appears in brackets after the label). Select a module in this column to view additional
information in the Details area at the bottom of the dialog.

Destination

The Destination column indicates where the copy of each source module will be placed in the node
diagram. The module label listed in the Destination column may or may not match the module label
listed in the Source column. (If the destination module is to be overwritten, it is reused; otherwise,
the next available module is used.)

Summary

The Summary column indicates whether the source module is copied into the destination as a new
module or if it replaces (overwrite) an existing module. This column also indicates if a module will
not be pasted.

NOTE: You can sort the paste summary information alphabetically by source or destination, or by
importance of summary. Click on the Source, Destination, or Summary column headers to sort
the list by the chosen criteria.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 669


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Details

The Details area located at the bottom of the dialog provides more detail than the description in the
Summary column. When you click on a module in the Source column, you can view a description of
the proposed transaction in the Details box. This description explains how a module is pasted or
offers reasons why it will not be pasted.

TIP: You can create a copy of the information displayed in the Details section of the Paste
Summary box. To copy it, use the mouse to highlight the text you want, right-click the selection,
then select Copy. You can then paste this selection into a word-processing program.

Maintain external inputs

The Maintain External Inputs check box allows you to paste the module selection with all external
links intact. If this check box is cleared, all external links (links to modules outside the selection) are
discarded.

The following example depicts an external link to a Power Meter module.

If you copied the modules on the right but omitted the Power Meter module from the selection, the
link to the Power Meter module would be external. Upon pasting the selection, the external link to
this module would be lost unless you selected “Maintain external inputs” on the Paste Summary
box.

Check Boxes (Free Paste/Lock Paste/No Paste)

The check boxes to the left of each module indicate the proposed action (that is, how the module
will be pasted):

• A green check mark indicates a free paste.

• A check mark with a lock symbol indicates a lock paste.

• A red “X” symbol indicates the module will not be pasted.

• An “X” symbol without a check box identifies a module that has no possible destination and
cannot be pasted.

670 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

You can click on a check box to change the proposed action. For example, if you click on a “free
paste” or a “will not be pasted” symbol, it changes to a “lock paste” symbol. When you
change the type of paste, the descriptions in the Summary column and the Details box also change
to describe the new action. (See Free paste or lock paste?, below, for more information.)

TIP: To change multiple module check boxes in the paste summary at the same time, click the
first check box in your list, hold down the Shift key, and then click the last check box in the list you
want to change.

Free paste or lock paste?


You can use the free paste and lock paste options to instruct Designer how to respond to potential
conflicts. For example, if you want to paste the module “Setpoint 1” into a diagram that already has a
“Setpoint 1” module, you have two options. You can either add the new module under a new name
(for example, “Setpoint 2”) or you can overwrite the existing module with the new one and reuse the
old name.

The first option in the above example is a free paste. It can be used to paste new modules into a
diagram without deleting any existing modules. This is useful for integrating new functions into a
node without disrupting the node's existing functionality. Although this may seem desirable, another
option is available. By leaving existing modules intact, a free paste can result in needless
duplication of functions. In addition, some groups of modules are interdependent and may require a
lock paste to operate correctly.

The second option in the above example is a lock paste. It instructs Designer to recreate the source
modules exactly, even if this requires Designer to overwrite existing modules in the diagram. When
used to quickly replace old modules with new ones, lock pasting is an efficient alternative to the
time-consuming process of deleting a module, adding a new one and then configuring it.

You can use a combination of both free paste and lock paste within a single paste operation.

NOTE: You can pre-select modules for Designer to reuse when free pasting. In the actual diagram
where you paste the selection, press the SHIFT key and then click on any module icons that you
don't want. When you paste the new selection, Designer has the option of replacing any of the
selected modules with the new ones.

NOTE: Overwriting a module is not the same as deleting the module and then pasting a
replacement module. If a module is overwritten, links from the outputs of that module are retained
as the inputs of other modules. If a module is deleted, these links are also deleted and do not exist
after the replacement module is pasted.

Pasting shortcuts

Identified by the symbol , a shortcut icon is a representation of a module icon that is located in
another window.

You can copy a shortcut in the same way you copy the original module, but when you paste a
shortcut, one of two things happens: It is either pasted as a shortcut to an existing module (if one is
available) or as a new module. In either case, it continues to perform its function as before.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 671


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

There is a basic reason for replacing a shortcut with a module: a shortcut cannot exist in a node
without the module it represents. When you paste a selection containing a shortcut, Designer
searches both the selection to be pasted and the destination to locate the module the shortcut
represents. If it finds the module, it pastes the shortcut as a shortcut. If it doesn't find the module, it
replaces the shortcut with a copy of the module. In this way, Designer functions so that the pasted
selection is complete and not dependent on a module that is unavailable in the destination node.

Designer performs this process automatically; it requires no input from you.

Modules that cannot be pasted


Some modules cannot be pasted because their settings are non-transferable between nodes. All
Factory, Communications, and Diagnostics modules must be individually configured for each node.

When pasting a selection that contains a Factory, Communications or Diagnostics module,


Designer pastes the location of the icons only.

Cloning a node
You can quickly configure multiple nodes by cloning a node. Essentially, cloning a node involves
copying a node's entire configuration to a framework then pasting it onto another node. This
effectively reprograms the node receiving the framework as an exact copy of the original.

NOTE: When you paste an entire node's configuration, the Factory, Communications, and
Diagnostics modules are not pasted because they could disrupt the operation of the device's
communications. If you need to change the settings of these modules, you can do so manually.

Copying a node's entire configuration

1. Open the node diagram of the node you want to copy. Ensure that you are in the main or root
window of the diagram.

2. Select Edit > Select All. All core modules, standard modules, grouping windows and text
icons are selected.

3. Select Edit > Copy to framework to open the Copy to framework dialog.

4. In the File name box, type a name for the framework and then click Save. The framework
filename extension (.fwn) is added automatically and the entire node configuration is saved in
this framework file.

After you have saved the source node's configuration as a framework, you can paste it to other
nodes of the same type. This file can also serve as a backup in case you want to restore the
configuration of the source node.

Pasting a node's entire configuration into another node

1. Open the node diagram of the node to which you want to paste the configuration. Ensure that
you are in the main or root window of the diagram.

2. Select Edit > Select All. Press the Delete key to remove the node's existing configuration. A
dialog opens listing the standard modules that will be deleted and the core modules that
cannot be deleted. Click OK to continue.

672 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

The standard modules and text icons are deleted, and the core modules (and any grouping
windows containing core modules) remain.

3. Select Edit > Select All to select the remaining module (and grouping) icons.

4. Select Edit > Paste from framework to open the Paste from framework dialog, select the
framework file that contains the node configuration you want to paste, and then click Open.

The Paste Summary dialog opens. (See Using the Paste Summary dialog for information on
using the Paste Summary box.)

5. Select all modules in the list (click last item, hold the SHIFT key, and then click first list item -
the entire list appears highlighted).

6. Change the paste type to lock paste (hold the SHIFT key and then click the paste type check
box until all modules are set to lock paste ).

7. Click OK to complete the procedure.

The selected framework is pasted into the node diagram. All module icons in the selection appear as
pending until you select Send & Save to save the changes to the node.

Viewing output registers, setup registers, and inputs


Each module icon has an input symbol and an output symbol. The input symbol (on the left)
provides access to the module's inputs and the output symbol (on the right) provides access to the
module's output and setup registers.

A Input
B Output

A register is a type of memory bank that stores a module's linking and configuration information.
Each module uses two types of registers:

• Output registers store data that has been processed by the module (such as numeric values,
event log entries, and waveform data).

• Setup registers store the module's configuration information.

Both types of registers serve as storage locations for the module.

Viewing output register information


Output register information includes the module's available output registers, the real-time values of
the output registers and the owners of the output registers. Each of these can be accessed from the
output symbol located on the right side of the module icon.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 673


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Click the output symbol to access


A the module's output register
information

Viewing available output registers

Click the output symbol.

Viewing the real-time values of output registers

Press the SHIFT key and click the output symbol.

Viewing the owners of output registers

Right-click the output symbol. This displays an output register's owners so you can identify all
dependent modules on the node and determine the purpose of each dependent module. This is
useful when determining the effects and consequences of deleting a module.

Viewing setup register information


A module's setup registers contain its configuration information. When a module processes data, it
manipulates the data according to the guidelines stored in its setup registers. Setup register
information includes the module's available setup registers, the setup register settings, and the
setup register owners. Each of these can be accessed from the output symbol located on the right
side of the module icon.

A Right-click the graphic to access the ION Module Setup dialog.


Press CTRL and click the output symbol to access the
ION Module Setup dialog.
Press CTRL+SHIFT and click the output symbol to display the
B
ION Module Setup dialog to view Setup Register settings.
Press CTRL and right-click the output symbol to view
SetupRegister owners.

674 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Viewing setup registers

Press the CTRL key and click the output symbol or right-click the graphic in the center of the
module to display the ION Module Setup dialog.

Viewing setup register settings

Press CTRL+SHIFT and click the output symbol or right-click the graphic in the center of the
module to display the ION Module Setup dialog.

Viewing setup register owners

Press the CTRL key and right-click the output symbol.

Viewing input information


Input information includes the module's inputs and a sample of its real-time input values. Each of
these can be accessed from the module's input symbol.

Click the input symbol to access the module's input


A
information

Viewing inputs

Click the input symbol.

Viewing real-time input values

Press the SHIFT key and click the input symbol.

Setting Values for External Input Modules


You can set the value for an External Numeric, External Boolean, or External String (only available
for the VIP) module through Designer. You can also trigger an External Pulse module through
Designer.
To set the value for an External module,

1. Right-click the module icon to open the module setup.

2. Highlight the output register and click Modify.

3. Enter the value you want to set into the Value box or the string into the String box and click
OK in the Modify Register dialog.

NOTE: External Boolean modules only accept a value of 0 or 1.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 675


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Click OK in the ION Module Setup dialog to close it.

5. Send and save the changes in Designer.

To trigger an External Pulse module,

1. Right-click the module icon to open the module setup.

2. Click Trigger and confirm the operation.

3. Click OK in the ION Module Setup dialog to close it.

676 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Device Manager

TIP: You can open Device Manager from SETTINGS > System > Device Manager in the Web
Applications banner.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

NOTICE
NETWORK INOPERABILITY
Do not make unauthorized changes in the network configuration.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in an unstable or unusable network.

Use Device Manager to:

• Configure devices and sites.

• Import device and site configurations from other applications, such as ION Setup.

• Export device and site configuration in CSV format for use in another PME system.

• Import device and site configuration in CSV format for efficient configuration of large systems.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 677


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Device Manager or Management Console?


Device Manager shares the site and device configuration with Management Console. That means
you can use either application to configure sites and devices. Depending on your workflow you
might prefer to work in one or the other application. Device Manager is limited to configuring sites
and devices. Management Console offers additional configuration functions, such as modem
configuration or setting up connection schedules. Management Console also provides access to
maintenance and programming tools.

NOTE: You cannot add direct serial sites or modem sites with Device Manager. Use Management
Console to add these sites.

Use Device Manager for:

• exporting device and site configuration in CSV format

• importing device and site configuration in CSV format

• configuring devices and sites in the web interface

Use Management Console for:

• adding direct serial or modem sites

• configuring modems and connection schedules

• configuring managed circuits and logical devices

• configuring devices with advanced security

• accessing any of the maintenance and programming tools

• configuring devices and sites in a Windows application on an Engineering client

For more information and details on network configuration, see Management Console.

Definitions
Sites
A site is a group of devices in the system that share a common communications link. A site can be
a direct site, a modem site, an Ethernet gateway site, or an OPC site.

Devices
A device is a meter or other component that communicates and gathers data and is installed on a
network.

To configure devices and sites, see:


Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

678 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 679


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a device
Add a device to make this device and its data available for monitoring and analysis in PME. You can
add one device at a time using the Device Manager user interface. You can also import many
devices at once using configuration import.
To add a device using the Device Manager user interface:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab, and then click Add Ethernet Device or click the
down arrow next to it to add a serial or OPC device. This opens the New Device dialog.

TIP: The right-click context menu for a device in the table has a Duplicate Device option to
create a copy of an existing device.

2. In New Device, enter the required information such as group name, device name, device type
and IP address.

TIP: Click Show Advanced to access advanced configuration settings. These settings
have factory defaults and only need to be changed for specific application needs.

3. (Optional) Enter Description information.

4. Click OK.

TIP: To add a device directly to a site, go to the Sites tab and right-click the site to open the
context menu.

To add one or more devices using configuration import:

1. In Device Manager, click Import. This opens the Import Devices and Sites dialog.

2. In Import Devices and Sites, download the configuration import template CSV file.

3. Open the downloaded configuration import template in a text editor and add the configuration
information for the devices you want to add.

4. Save the file in CSV format.

5. Return to the Device Manager Import Devices and Sites dialog and click Next.

6. Click Upload Files. This opens the Upload new files dialog.

7. In Upload new files, click Choose Files and find the configuration import template CSV file.
Click Open. Click Finish.

TIP: You can also drag and drop the configuration import file into the designated area in
Upload new files.

8. Follow the steps in the import wizard to complete the configuration import.

9. Click Finish in the import wizard.

680 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 681


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Editing a device
Edit a device to update its group name or name, or to change its configuration settings. You can edit
devices using the Device Manager user interface or configuration import.
To edit a single device using the Device Manager user interface:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the row of the device you want to edit, then right-click in the row
and select Edit Device in the context menu. This opens the Device Configuration dialog.

TIP: Double-click a row to open the Device Configuration dialog.

3. In Device Configuration, update the configuration settings as needed.

4. Click OK.

To edit multiple devices using the Device Manager user interface:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the rows of the devices you want to edit, then right-click in the
selected row area and select Edit <number> Devices in the context menu. This opens the
Device Configuration dialog.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual devices. Use Shift+click to select a block of
devices.

3. In Device Configuration, update the configuration settings as needed.

NOTE: Only those settings that are common to all selected devices can be configured at the
same time.

4. Click OK.

To edit devices using configuration import:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. Export the existing configuration in one of the following ways:


a. To export the configuration for a single device:
In the devices table, select the row of the device for which you want to export the
configuration, then right-click in the row and select Export Device Configuration for
Editing in the context menu. This exports the configuration and saves it in CSV file
format to your local Downloads folder.

b. To export the configuration for multiple devices:


In the devices table, select the rows of the devices for which you want to export the
configuration, then right-click in the selected row area and select Export
Configuration for <number> Devices for Editing in the context menu. This
exports the configuration and saves it in CSV file format to your local Downloads
folder.

682 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual devices, use Shift+click to select a


block of devices.

c. To export the configuration for all devices:


Click Options in the top right corner of the Devices pane, and then click Export
Devices Configuration for Editing in the options menu. This exports the
configuration and saves it in CSV file format to your local Downloads folder.

3. Open the exported configuration file in a text editor and edit the configuration information for
the devices as needed.

NOTE: Do not edit the content of the UniqueSystemId column.

4. Save the file in CSV format.

5. In Device Manager, click Import. This opens the import wizard.

6. Follow the steps in the import wizard to complete the configuration import.

7. Click Finish in the import wizard.

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 683


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Deleting a device
Delete a device if it is no longer needed, for example if the device has been removed from service.

NOTE: When a device is deleted in Device Manager it is marked as Historical device in the
system and removed from the default view of the devices table. All historical data associated with
the deleted device remains in the system and is still available for analysis and reporting.

TIP: Adjust the filter options in the devices grid in Device Manager to see Historical devices in the
system. See Device Manager user interface for details on the Devices filter.

To delete a device:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the row of the device you want to delete, then right-click in the row
and select Delete Device in the context menu. This opens the Delete Device confirmation
dialog.

3. In the confirmation dialog box, click OK.

To delete multiple devices:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the rows of the devices you want to delete, then right-click in the
selected row area and select Delete <number> Devices in the context menu. This opens the
Delete Device confirmation dialog.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual devices, use Shift+click to select a block of
devices.

3. In the confirmation dialog box, click OK.

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

684 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 685


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device


Disconnect an Ethernet device to temporarily remove it from the communication network, for
example for system testing. Connect an Ethernet device, that was previously disconnected, to
restore its communication network connection.
To connect a single Ethernet device:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the row of the device you want to connect.

3. Right-click in the row and select Connect Ethernet Device in the context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the device in the devices table to
confirm that the device is connected. Note that there can be a time delay until the
communication status is updated in the table.

To connect multiple Ethernet devices:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the rows of the devices you want to connect.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual devices, use Shift+click to select a block of
devices.

3. Right-click in the selected row area and select Connect <number> Ethernet Devices in the
context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the devices in the devices table to
confirm that the devices are connected. Note that there can be a time delay until the
communication status is updated in the table.

To disconnect a single Ethernet device:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the row of the device you want to disconnect.

3. Right-click in the row and select Disconnect Ethernet Device in the context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the device in the devices table to
confirm that the device is disconnected. Note that there can be a time delay until the
communication status is updated in the table.

To disconnect multiple Ethernet devices:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the rows of the devices you want to disconnect.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual devices, use Shift+click to select a block of
devices.

686 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

3. Right-click in the selected row area and select Disconnect <number> Ethernet Devices in
the context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the devices in the devices table to
confirm that the devices are disconnected. Note that there can be a time delay until the
communication status is updated in the table.

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 687


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Enabling or disabling a device


Disable a device to remove it from the communication network. For example, disable a device that
is out of service. Enable a device that was previously disabled to reconnect it to the communication
network.
To enable a single device:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the row of the device you want to enable.

3. Right-click in the row and select Enable Device in the context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the device in the devices table to
confirm that the device is enabled. Note that there can be a time delay until the
communication status is updated in the table.

To enable multiple devices:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the rows of the devices you want to enable.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual devices, use Shift+click to select a block of
devices.

3. Right-click in the selected row area and select Enable <number> Devices in the context
menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the devices in the devices table to
confirm that the devices are enabled. Note that there can be a time delay until the
communication status is updated in the table.

To disable a single device:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the row of the device you want to disable.

3. Right-click in the row and select Disable Device in the context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the device in the devices table to
confirm that the device is disabled. Note that there can be a time delay until the
communication status is updated in the table.

To disable multiple devices:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the rows of the devices you want to disable.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual devices, use Shift+click to select a block of
devices.

688 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

3. Right-click in the selected row area and select Disable <number> Devices in the context
menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the devices in the devices table to
confirm that the devices are disabled. Note that there can be a time delay until the
communication status is updated in the table.

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 689


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing a device diagram


Device diagrams are device type specific diagrams in the Diagrams application that show historical
and real-time data for a device. You can open a device diagram for a device directly from Device
Manager.

NOTE: To see data in a diagram, the device must be connected to and communicating with PME.

To view a device diagram:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. In the devices table, select the row of the device for which you want to open the diagram, then
right-click in the row and select View Device Diagram in the context menu. This opens the
device type specific diagram for this device in a new tab in your browser.

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

690 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Adding a site
A site is a gateway to establish a connection between the software and a group of devices. Add
sites to connect devices with serial communication or to connect OPC devices.

NOTE: You do not add sites for Ethernet devices. You add Ethernet devices directly to the
system. See Adding a device for details. The software automatically sets up an internal site for
each Ethernet device. These internal sites are not visible in Device Manager.

NOTE: You cannot add direct serial sites or modem sites with Device Manager. Use Management
Console to add these sites.

You can add sites through the Device Manager user interface, one site at a time. You can also add
one or more sites at the same time through importing site configuration information.
To add a site through the Device Manager user interface:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab, and then click Add Ethernet Gateway or click the
down arrow next to it to add an OPC site. This opens the New Site dialog.

TIP: The right-click context menu for a site in the table has a Duplicate Site option to create
a copy of an existing site.

2. In New Site, enter the required information such as name, IP address, and so on.

TIP: Click Show Advanced to access advanced configuration settings. These settings
have factory defaults and only need to be changed for specific application needs.

3. (Optional) Enter Description information.

4. Click OK.

To add one or more sites through configuration import:

1. In Device Manager, click Import. This opens the Import Devices and Sites dialog.

2. In Import Devices and Sites, download the configuration import template CSV file.

3. Open the downloaded configuration import template in a text editor and add the configuration
information for the sites you want to add.

4. Save the file in CSV format.

5. Return to the Device Manager Import Devices and Sites dialog and click Next.

6. Click Upload Files. This opens the Upload new files dialog.

7. In Upload new files, click Choose Files and find the configuration import template CSV file.
Click Open. Click Finish.

TIP: You can also drag and drop the configuration import file into the designated area in
Upload new files.

8. Follow the steps in the import wizard to complete the configuration import.

9. Click Finish in the import wizard.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 691


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

692 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Editing a site
Edit a site to update its name or to change its configuration settings. You can edit sites through the
Device Manager user interface or through exporting, editing, and then re-importing the site
configuration.
To edit a single site through the Device Manager user interface:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the row of the site you want to edit, then right-click in the row and
select Edit Site in the context menu. This opens the Site Configuration dialog.

TIP: You can also double-click a row to open the Site Configuration dialog.

3. In Site Configuration, update the configuration settings as needed.

4. Click OK.

To edit multiple sites through the Device Manager user interface:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the rows of the sites you want to edit, then right-click in the selected
row area and select Edit <number> Sites in the context menu. This opens the Site
Configuration dialog.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual sites, use Shift+click to select a block of
sites.

3. In Site Configuration, update the configuration settings as needed.

NOTE: Only those settings that are common to all selected sites can be configured at the
same time.

4. Click OK.

To edit sites through configuration import:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. Export the existing configuration in one of the following ways:


a. To export the configuration for a single site:
In the sites table, select the row of the site for which you want to export the
configuration, then right-click in the row and select Export Site Configuration for
Editing in the context menu. This exports the configuration and saves it in CSV file
format to your local Downloads folder.

b. To export the configuration for multiple sites:


In the sites table, select the rows of the sites for which you want to export the
configuration, then right-click in the selected row area and select Export
Configuration for <number> Sites for Editing in the context menu. This exports
the configuration and saves it in CSV file format to your local Downloads folder.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 693


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual sites, use Shift+click to select a


block of sites.

c. To export the configuration for all sites:


Click Options in the top right corner of the Sites pane, and then click Export
Sites Configuration for Editing in the options menu. This exports the configuration
and saves it in CSV file format to your local Downloads folder.

3. Open the exported configuration file in a text editor and edit the configuration information for
the sites as needed.

NOTE: Do not edit the content of the UniqueSystemId column.

4. Save the file in CSV format.

5. In Device Manager, click Import. This opens the import wizard.

6. Follow the steps in the import wizard to complete the configuration import.

7. Click Finish in the import wizard.

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

694 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Deleting a site
Delete a site if this site is no longer needed, for example if all the devices connected to the site have
been removed from service.
To delete a site:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the row of the site you want to delete, then right-click in the row and
select Delete Site in the context menu. This opens the Delete Site confirmation dialog.

3. In the confirmation dialog box, click OK.

To delete multiple sites:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the rows of the sites you want to delete, then right-click in the
selected row area and select Delete <number> Sites in the context menu. This opens the
Delete Site confirmation dialog.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual sites, use Shift+click to select a block of
sites.

3. In the confirmation dialog box, click OK.

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 695


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

696 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Connecting or disconnecting a site


Disconnect a site to temporarily remove the devices on this site from the communication network,
for example for system testing. Connect a site, that was previously disconnected, to reestablish its
communication network connection.
To connect a single site:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the row of the site you want to connect.

3. Right-click in the row and select Connect Site in the context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the site in the sites table to confirm that
the site is connected. Note that there can be a time delay until the communication status is
updated in the table.

To connect multiple sites:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the rows of the sites you want to connect.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual sites, use Shift+click to select a block of
sites.

3. Right-click in the selected row area and select Connect <number> Sites in the context
menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the sites in the sites table to confirm
that the sites are connected. Note that there can be a time delay until the communication
status is updated in the table.

To disconnect a single site:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the row of the site you want to disconnect.

3. Right-click in the row and select Disconnect Site in the context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the site in the sites table to confirm that
the site is disconnected. Note that there can be a time delay until the communication status
is updated in the table.

To disconnect multiple sites:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the rows of the sites you want to disconnect.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual sites, use Shift+click to select a block of
sites.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 697


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. Right-click in the selected row area and select Disconnect <number> Sites in the context
menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the sites in the sites table to confirm
that the sites are disconnected. Note that there can be a time delay until the communication
status is updated in the table.

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

698 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Enabling or disabling a site


Disable a site to remove this site from the communication network, for example if the devices on
this site are out of service for a longer period of time. Enable a site, that was previously disabled, to
reestablish its communication network connection.
To enable a single site:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the row of the site you want to enable.

3. Right-click in the row and select Enable Site in the context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the site in the sites table to confirm that
the site is enabled. Note that there can be a time delay until the communication status is
updated in the table.

To enable multiple sites:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the rows of the sites you want to enable.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual sites, use Shift+click to select a block of
sites.

3. Right-click in the selected row area and select Enable <number> Sites in the context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the sites in the sites table to confirm
that the sites are enabled. Note that there can be a time delay until the communication status
is updated in the table.

To disable a single site:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the row of the site you want to disable.

3. Right-click in the row and select Disable Site in the context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the site in the sites table to confirm that
the site is disabled. Note that there can be a time delay until the communication status is
updated in the table.

To disable multiple sites:

1. In Device Manager, select the Sites tab.

2. In the sites table, select the rows of the sites you want to disable.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual sites, use Shift+click to select a block of
sites.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 699


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. Right-click in the selected row area and select Disable <number> Sites in the context menu.

TIP: Inspect the Communication Status column for the sites in the sites table to confirm
that the sites are disabled. Note that there can be a time delay until the communication
status is updated in the table.

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

700 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Exporting network configuration for use in a different system


Export the device and site configuration of a system for importing into another system. For example,
configure the sites and devices in a test system and then export this configuration for use in a
production system.

NOTE: You cannot import the configuration back into the same system from which it was
exported.

To export the network configuration for use in a different system:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices or the Sites tab.

2. Click Options in the top right corner of the display pane, and then click Export Network
Configuration for Use in a Different System in the options menu. This exports the
configuration and saves it in CSV file format to your local Downloads folder.

3. Transfer the exported configuration file to the target system.

4. Import the configuration file into the target system. See Importing network configuration from a
different system for details.

NOTE: Keep the configuration file secure during and after the transfer to prevent unauthorized
access.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-specific
cybersecurity policies.
Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 701


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

702 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Importing network configuration from a different system


Import the device and site configuration that was exported from another system. For example, to
create a copy of an existing system or to transfer the configuration from a test system into a
production system. You can also import the configuration from configuration tools, such as ION
Setup.

NOTE: You cannot import the configuration back into the same system from which it was
exported.

To import the network configuration from a different system:

1. In Device Manager, click Import. This opens the import wizard.

2. Follow the steps in the import wizard. Select the configuration file from the other system when
prompted by the wizard to upload the import file.

3. Complete the configuration import in the import wizard.

4. Click Finish in the import wizard.

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

• Viewing system device license status

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 703


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing system device license status


View device license status to verify that the required device licenses are activated in your system.
For example, confirm that enough free licenses are available before adding a number of new devices
to the system.

NOTICE
LOSS OF COMMUNICATION
• Activate product and component licenses prior to the expiry of the trial license.
• Activate sufficient licenses for the servers and devices in your system.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in loss of data.

To view system device license status:

1. In Device Manager, select the Devices tab.

2. Click Options in the top right corner of the display pane, and then click View Device
Licenses in the options menu. This opens the Device License Information dialog.

Related topics:
Devices

• Adding a device

• Editing a device

• Deleting a device

• Connecting or disconnecting an Ethernet device

• Enabling or disabling a device

• Viewing a device diagram

Sites

• Adding a site

• Editing a site

• Deleting a site

• Connecting or disconnecting a site

• Enabling or disabling a site

Network

• Exporting network configuration for use in a different system

• Importing network configuration from a different system

For reference information see:

• Device Manager

• Device Manager user interface

704 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Viewing system device license status

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 705


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Device Type Editor


TIP: You can open Device Type Editor in the Management Console from the Tools > System >
Device Type Editor link.

NOTE: The Device Type Editor replaces the Modbus Device Importer (MDI) tool that was
available in older versions of the software.

Use the Device Type Editor to create device drivers for Modbus and OPC devices, in Power
Monitoring Expert, for which pre-configured drivers or downloadable add-on drivers do not exist. You
can also edit existing Modbus and OPC device drivers with the Device Type Editor.

Device drivers are called Device Types in Power Monitoring Expert.

NOTE: Before creating a new device type with the Device Type Editor, check if it is available as a
pre-configured device type or as a downloadable add-on.

NOTE: The device types you can create with the Device Type Editor are limited to reading
numeric and Boolean data from the device, and writing simple 16-bit values to the device. These
device types cannot access complex data such as historical logs, event logs, or waveform
captures.

NOTE: Drivers created with the Device Type Editor require mid-range (M) type device licenses.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

706 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For information on how to use the Device Type Editor to create device types, see:
For Modbus

• Creating a Modbus Device Type

• Editing a Modbus Device Type

• Adding Software Logging to a Modbus Device Type

• Installing a Device Type on the System

For OPC

• Creating an OPC Device Type

• Editing an OPC Device Type

• Installing a Device Type on the System

For reference information see:

• Device Type Editor User Interface

• Configuring Logging and Calculation User Interface

• Modbus Data Formats

• Modbus Register Properties

• Measurement Tree

• OPC Tags

• Default device type support

Creating a Modbus Device Type


A Modbus device type translates between the register based data structure on the Modbus device
and the ION based data structure in Power Monitoring Expert.

When you create the device type with the Device Type Editor, you first define the Modbus registers
that you want to access on the device, and then you map these registers to ION managers,
modules, and registers. You can enter the Modbus register information manually in the Device Type
Editor user interface, or use Microsoft Excel to define the register list and then copy and paste it into
the Device Type Editor. The mapping of Modbus to ION registers is done by dragging Modbus
registers onto ION registers, or the reverse, using the mouse pointer.

Prerequisites
To create a device type for a device, you need to know the details of its Modbus register map. At a
minimum, you need the Modbus addresses, data formats, and possible scaling values for the
measurements you want to access on the device. You can get this information from the device
documentation or the device manufacturer.

NOTE: Before creating a new device type with the Device Type Editor, check if it is available as a
pre-configured device type or as a downloadable add-on.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 707


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

References
See the following references for information on how to use the Device Type Editor or information
related to Modbus register definitions:

• Device Type Editor User Interface

• Configuring Logging and Calculation User Interface

• Modbus Data Formats

• Modbus Register Properties

• Measurement Tree

To create a Modbus device type:

1. In Device Type Editor, click File > New > Modbus Device Type to open a New Mapping
template.

2. Enter the Modbus register information into the Modbus Map table in the right display pane, in
one of two ways:
Add each Modbus register manually in the Device Type Editor, using the available editing
controls (right-click to open the context menu).

Use Microsoft Excel to define the register list, copy it, and paste it into the Modbus Map
table.

NOTE: The register list columns in the Excel sheet must match the column content and
positions in the Device Type Editor Modbus Map table. Confirm that the format entries
match one of the supported Modbus Data Formats and that there are no spelling
mistakes, such as added space characters or different capitalization.

3. Map each Modbus register in the Modbus Map to a measurement in the Measurement Tree in
the left pane. To see the measurements in the tree, expand the managers and modules, for
example Current > Phase Current > Current A,B,C, ... . Map the registers in one of two ways:
Using the mouse, drag the measurement you want to map in the Measurement Tree onto
the corresponding measurement in the Modbus Map.

Using the mouse, drag the Modbus register you want to map in the Modbus Map onto the
corresponding measurement in the Measurement Tree.

NOTE: If you cannot find a suitable measurement in the Measurement Tree, add a new
manager, module, and register to represent this measurement. To do this, right-click any of
the existing managers in the Measurement Tree and choose the appropriate menu options.

4. Configure the device type name and template name.


a. In the Measurement Tree, click Factory Information > Factory 1 > FAC1 Device Type
to open the String Register Details dialog for this register. In String Register Details, enter
a device type name in the Value box. This name will be visible in the Management
Console when you select a device type for a new device. Choose a name that identifies
the device, but does not match any of the existing device types.

708 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Example: For a device called "PM123", you could use a device type name of "DTE_
PM123". The device type name does not have to include DTE, but it is a good practice to
choose a string that identifies this device type as a DTE type.

b. In the Measurement Tree, click Factory Information > Factory 1 > FAC1 Template to
open the String Register Details dialog for this register. In String Register Details, enter a
template name in the Value box. This name is used to match your new device type with a
default Vista diagram, if you choose to create such a diagram. The template name should
include the device type name followed by a version number that represents the version of
your new device type.

Example: For a device type called "DTE_PM123", you could use a template name of
"DTE_PM123_V1.0.0".

5. (Optional) Click Tools > Clean Measurement Tree to remove any Measurement Tree
elements that have not been mapped to Modbus registers. This makes it easier to find the
relevant measurements in the Measurement Tree in Vista or OPC clients for example.

6. Click File > Save, to save the new device type.

Related topics
• Creating a Modbus Device Type

• Editing a Modbus Device Type

• Adding Software Logging to a Modbus Device Type

• Installing a Device Type on the System

Editing a Modbus Device Type


You can use the Device Type Editor to modify existing Modbus device types. This includes your
own, as well as factory types, which means pre-configured and downloadable add-on device types.
The factory device types have been designed and tested for compatibility with the devices and the
Power Monitoring Expert software. If you see a need to modify a factory device type, save the
modified type under a new name that does not match any of the factory device type names. This
ensures that you can identify this type as custom and it prevents it from being overwritten during a
system upgrade.

References
See the following references for information on how to use the Device Type Editor or information
related to Modbus register definitions:

• Device Type Editor User Interface

• Configuring Logging and Calculation User Interface

• Modbus Data Formats

• Modbus Register Properties

• Measurement Tree

To edit a Modbus device type:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 709


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. In Device Type Editor, click File > Open, find and select the device type you want to edit, and
click Open.

2. Modify the Modbus Map registers, the Measurement Tree mappings, or the software logging to
meet your needs.

See Creating a Modbus Device Type for details on how to perform these tasks.

3. Click File > Save, to save the modified device type under the same name. Click File > Save
As, to save the modified device type under a new name.

Related topics
• Creating a Modbus Device Type

• Editing a Modbus Device Type

• Adding Software Logging to a Modbus Device Type

• Installing a Device Type on the System

Adding Software Logging to a Modbus Device Type


The Modbus device types you create with the Device Type Editor are limited to reading numeric and
Boolean data from the device. These device types cannot access complex data such as historical
logs, event logs, or waveform captures. However, it is possible to automatically log the measured
values in Power Monitoring Expert after they are read from the device. In addition to logging the
measured values, Power Monitoring Expert can also calculate and log average, low, and high
values for these measurements.

NOTE: The data logs are timestamped with the date and time at which the software logs the value,
not the date and time the measurement was taken on the device. Device communications and
system delays determine the time delay between when the measurement is taken by the device
and when it is logged by the software.

To add software logging:

1. In Device Type Editor, open the Modbus device type for which you want to add logging.

2. Click Tools > Configure Software Logging to open the Configure Logging and Calculation
dialog.

3. In Configure Logging and Calculation, select the measurements you want to log and calculate,
and set the logging intervals.

NOTE: Only numeric output registers can be calculated and logged. All other types of
registers (for example, enumerated) do not appear on the Configure Logging and Calculation
screen.

See Configuring Logging and Calculation User Interface for information on the controls and
options available in the user interface.

4. Click OK to save the changes.

710 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Related topics
• Creating a Modbus Device Type

• Editing a Modbus Device Type

• Adding Software Logging to a Modbus Device Type

• Installing a Device Type on the System

Creating an OPC Device Type


An OPC device type translates between the tag based data structure on the OPC server and the
ION based data structure in Power Monitoring Expert.

When you create the device type with the Device Type Editor, you first define the OPC tags that
you want to access on the server, and then you map these tags to ION managers, modules, and
registers. You can enter the OPC tag information manually in the Device Type Editor user interface,
or use Microsoft Excel to define the tag list and then copy and paste it into the Device Type Editor.
The mapping of OPC tags to ION registers is done by dragging tags onto ION registers, or the
reverse, using the mouse pointer.

NOTE: The software logging of values is not available for OPC device types.

Prerequisites
To create a device type for an OPC server, you need to know the details of its tag list. You can get
this information from the OPC server documentation or the OPC server vendor. You can also get
the tag list by browsing the OPC server with an OPC client such as the OPC Test Client we ship
with PME. You can find the OPC Test Client, OpcTestClient.exe, in ...\Power
Monitoring Expert\system\bin\

References
See the following references for information on how to use the Device Type Editor or information
related to OPC tag definitions:

• Device Type Editor User Interface

• Measurement Tree

• OPC Tags

To create an OPC device type:

1. In Device Type Editor, click File > New > OPC Device Type to open a New Mapping
template.

2. Enter the OPC tag information into the OPC Map table in the right display pane, in one of two
ways:
Add each tag manually in the Device Type Editor, using the available editing controls.

Use Microsoft Excel to define the tag list, copy it, and paste it into the OPC Map table.

NOTE: The tag list columns in the Excel sheet must match the column content and
positions in the Device Type Editor OPC Map table. .

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 711


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: When entering a tag, only specify the tag name, with a leading period (.), do not
include the OPC server or device name. For example, for the tag
Opcda://Server/OpcDa.1.Channel_1.Powers.Real_Power enter
.Powers.Real_Power as the tag name in the OPC Map.

3. Map each OPC tag in the OPC Map to a measurement in the Measurement Tree in the left
pane. To see the measurements in the tree, expand the managers and modules, for example
Current > Phase Current > Current A,B,C, ... . Map the tags in one of two ways:
Using the mouse, drag the measurement you want to map in the Measurement Tree onto
the corresponding tag in the OPC Map.

Using the mouse, drag the OPC tag you want to map in the Modbus OPC Map onto the
corresponding measurement in the Measurement Tree.

NOTE: If you cannot find a suitable measurement in the Measurement Tree, add a new
manager, module, and register to represent this measurement. To do this, right-click any of
the existing managers in the Measurement Tree and choose the appropriate menu options.

4. Configure the device type name and template name.


a. In the Measurement Tree, click Factory Information > Factory 1 > FAC1 Device Type
to open the String Register Details dialog for this register. In String Register Details, enter
a device type name in the Value box. This name will be visible in the Management
Console when you select a device type for a new device. Choose a name that identifies
the OPC server, but does not match any of the existing device types.

Example: Use "OPC_ABC" as the device type name, where ABC identifies the server.

b. In the Measurement Tree, click Factory Information > Factory 1 > FAC1 Template to
open the String Register Details dialog for this register. In Edit String Register, enter a
template name in the Value box. This name is used to match your new device type with a
default Vista diagram, if you choose to create such a diagram. The template name should
include the device type name followed by a version number that represents the version of
your new device type.

Example: For a device type called "OPC_ABC", you could use a template name of
"OPC_ABC_V1.0.0".

5. (Optional) Click Tools > Clean Measurement Tree to remove any Measurement Tree
elements that have not been mapped to OPC tags. This makes it easier to find the relevant
measurements in the Measurement Tree in Vista or an OPC client for example.

6. Click File > Save, to save the new device type.

Related topics
• Creating an OPC Device Type

• Editing an OPC Device Type

• Installing a Device Type on the System

712 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Editing an OPC Device Type


You can use the Device Type Editor to modify existing OPC device types.

References
See the following references for information on how to use the Device Type Editor or information
related to OPC tag definitions:

• Device Type Editor User Interface

• Measurement Tree

• OPC Tags

To edit an OPC device type:

1. In Device Type Editor, click File > Open, find and select the device type you want to edit, and
click Open.

2. Modify the OPC tags or the Measurement Tree mappings to meet your needs.

See Creating an OPC Device Type for details on how to perform these tasks.

3. Click File > Save, to save the modified device type under the same name. Click File > Save
As, to save the modified device type under a new name.

Related topics
• Creating an OPC Device Type

• Editing an OPC Device Type

• Installing a Device Type on the System

Installing a Device Type on the System


Before a device type can be used by Power Monitoring Expert to communicate with a device, it
must be installed on the system. Follow the steps below to install a new device type or a modified
device type.

To install a new or modified device type:

1. In Device Type Editor, click Tools > Install Device Type, to open the Device Type Installer.

2. In Device Type Installer, specify the device type you want to install.

(Optional) Specify a diagram and icon to be used for this device type in the Vista and
Diagrams applications if you want to use the default diagram feature.

(Optional) Specify a measurement extension file for exposing the device measurements
through the OPC server, if desired.

3. Check the Device Type Name and Template. If you need to make changes, exit the Device
Type Installer, open the device type for editing in the Device Type Editor and correct the
names, then run the installer again.

4. Select the Protocol for your device type, Modbus or OPC.

(Optional) Select Ethernet Support if the device has Ethernet communication capabilities.

5. Click Install Device Type, to install the device type on the system.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 713


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Related topics
• Creating a Modbus Device Type

• Editing a Modbus Device Type

• Adding Software Logging to a Modbus Device Type

• Creating an OPC Device Type

• Editing an OPC Device Type

• Installing a Device Type on the System

714 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Downstream Device Assistant


Downstream Device Assistant lets you manage downstream devices. With this tool, you can
rename downstream sources, change which measurement is associated with specific data from a
source, and apply these changes to previously recorded data in ION_Data (historical database).
You can also display and manage all the physical sources (devices) in your network.

Downstream Device Assistant is an advanced application and should only be used by users with
advanced technical skills and a clear understanding of how data is interpreted and stored in the
Power Monitoring Expert databases.

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

Detecting downstream devices


A downstream device is one whose data is logged by a remote data recorder, for example:

• A Modbus slave device whose output registers are logged by a device with Modbus Mastering
capability (see illustration below).

• Any of various multiple sources in which the same measurement is being logged on a single
device, for example, an RTU that is collecting kWh pulses from multiple sources or a single
branch circuit monitor that is collecting current readings on multiple circuits.

Power Monitoring Expert


A B Ethernet C kW D Data Recorder
server
Physical source (Modbus
E F RS-485 G Downstream Devices (Modbus Slaves)
Master)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 715


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Monitoring Expert automatically detects downstream devices. The Log Inserter component
does this by looking for devices (called “physical sources”) that record or host data coming from
various downstream devices (for example, an ION meter that utilizes a Modbus Import module to
pass through data originating from a “downstream” Modbus device).

Log Inserter resolves the data from each of these downstream devices to the appropriate
measurement (for example, the label “Vll ab” resolves to the measurement “Voltage Phases AB”).
For data that cannot be resolved, Log Inserter creates measurements whose names are based on
the ION register labels.

Log Inserter uses a logical naming scheme to assign names to the downstream devices. For
example, “Modbus.34” is the name assigned to the downstream Modbus device with a slave
address “34”.

716 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Downstream Device Assistant basics


Use Downstream Device Assistant to edit the names assigned to downstream devices or to assign
the correct measurement label for a register that has an incorrect measurement mapping.

IMPORTANT: Before using the Downstream Device Assistant, make sure you save a copy of the
ION_Network and ION_Data databases, in case you need to revert to the original configuration of
these databases.

Starting the Downstream Device Assistant


1. Run the program named “DownstreamDevices.DownstreamAssistant.exe” in the ...\Power
Monitoring Expert\system\bin folder.

2. Log in using your Power Monitoring Expert credentials.

A message displays to remind you to back up your ION_Network and ION_Data databases.
Click OK to continue.

3. Downstream Device Assistant opens in Basic view or Advanced view, depending on the last
view it was in before it was closed. The first time Downstream Device Assistant is started, it
opens in Basic view.

Basic view versus Advanced view


The view determines what columns are available as well as whether an action is global (applied to
all rows containing a parameter) or specific to a row.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 717


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Columns descriptions

Columns in Both Basic and Advanced View


Column Name Description
The IsDownstream column identifies which devices in the
Assigned Source column are downstream devices. If
IsDownstream is selected, it means that the device identified in the
Assigned Source column is downstream to a physical device,
IsDownstream1
whose name is indicated in the Physical Source column. If
IsDownstream is cleared, this indicates that the device is a
physical source. Note also that a physical source has the same
Assigned Source name and Physical Source name, by default.
This is the default name that Log Inserter assigned to a downstream
or physical device. For example, “Modbus.109:MainFeed.PM7650”
is the default name assigned for the downstream Modbus device
Assigned Source
with unit ID “109”, whose measurements are being logged to a data
recorder on a Modbus Master device named “PM7650” that is part of
the “MainFeed” site (group).
This text field allows you change the current name under Assigned
Source. In Basic view, all rows that contain the same Assigned
Source name are automatically updated to the new name when you
Updated Assigned enter it in the Updated Assigned Source column. In Advanced
Source view, you can select one or more rows and rename the source using
the Updated Assigned Source column, while leaving the other
rows unchanged. See Renaming the assigned source for more
details.
This identifies the name of the physical device, for example a
Physical Source2 Modbus Master device, that is performing the data logging for a
downstream device.
This column displays either the ION label (for example, “Vln avg”) or
the descriptive name of the measurement (for example, “Average
Measurement
Voltage Line-to-Neutral”), depending on the setting in the Options
dialog; see Downstream Device Assistant options.
Additional Columns in Advanced View
This lets you redefine what is currently assigned in the
Measurement column. Click the cell to display the list of
measurements to choose from. Depending on the setting in the
Updated Measurement
Options dialog, you can select from a list containing only the most
common measurement definitions or from a list of all available
measurements; see Downstream Device Assistant options.

718 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Columns in Both Basic and Advanced View


This column displays a measurement’s register handle either in
Handle hexadecimal format or decimal format, depending on the setting in
the Options dialog; see Downstream Device Assistant options.
This identifies which user made a change to the source-
Entered By
measurement definition.
The Update Historical Database check box is automatically
selected after entering changes in the Updated Assigned Source
or Updated Measurement cell. This means that all historical
Update Historical database entries that contain the old Assigned Source name or
Database Measurement will be updated with the new name or measurement.
If you want to leave the existing data in the database unchanged,
clear the Update Historical Database check box before saving the
changes.
By default, Log Inserter automatically associates the proper
measurement to the appropriate piece of data in the data log.
Normally, the Manual check box should remain cleared. However,
if you want to specifically change the measurement or register
Manual (see the Note
handle associated with a particular address definition, select the
below)
Manual check box for that measurement. This manually overrides
Log Inserter so that it uses this new address mapping from now on
(i.e., Log Inserter does not attempt to resolve that address ever
again).

1 Do not change the value of "IsDownstream" when making changes to source/measurement


definitions, as it is automatically set by the Downstream Device Assistant
2 Do not use the Physical Source column to modify the existing name of a valid physical device, as
Log Inserter uses this name to perform proper data logging.

NOTE: It is not recommended that you select the Manual check box. This reserves the ION
register for which Manual is checked for the selected measurement. This mapping remains in
place even if the device is reconfigured such that this register is used in an entirely different
context. This may cause unexpected problems in the ION_Data database. It should be used only
if you are certain that the configuration you have chosen will not change.

Basic view
To switch to Basic view, click View > Options. In the Advanced section of the Options dialog,
clear the enable advanced features check box. Click OK.

In Basic view, when you enter a new name in the Updated Assigned Source column, all rows that
contain the same Assigned Source name are automatically filled in with the new name. Existing
data in the historical database (ION_Data) is also automatically updated to reflect the change.

Advanced view
To switch to Advanced view, click View > Options. In the Advanced section of the Options dialog,
select the enable advanced features check box. Click OK.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 719


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

In addition to the columns displayed in Basic view, Advanced view displays all the other columns
for editing individual source-measurement definitions (i.e., Updated Measurement, Handle, Entered
By, Update Historical Database, and Manual). In Advanced view, you can:

• Select and make changes to a specific row without affecting the other rows. For example, you
may want to change the source name for one particular measurement while leaving the original
source name unchanged for all the other measurements.

• Select a different measurement for one that is incorrectly mapped to a particular register handle.

• Select whether or not to update historical data for a changed source name or measurement
definition, by selecting or clearing the Update Historical Data check box, respectively.
Changing a name or definition automatically selects this check box.

• Select whether or not to allow Log Inserter to resolve the register handle to a particular source
measurement, by clearing or selecting the Manual check box, respectively. The default setting
is cleared (i.e., Log Inserter automatically resolves the register handle to the source
measurement definition). If you want to force the change so Log Inserter does not resolve the
handle to the new measurement, select the Manual check box.

Displaying physical sources


The default view for Downstream Device Assistant displays only the downstream devices. To
display the physical sources as well:

1. Click View > Select Physical Sources.

2. Select the check box beside the physical sources you want to display. Select the
Select/Clear All check box to select all physical sources or clear it to select none. Click OK.

NOTE: The Physical Sources are not displayed if you restart Downstream Device Assistant. By
default, only downstream devices are displayed when Downstream Device Assistant is started.

Sorting data
Click a column heading to sort the row entries in ascending or descending alphanumeric order,
according to that column.

Downstream Device Assistant options


Click View > Options to open the Options dialog. The dialog contains Measurements, Historical
Data, and Advanced options.

Certain options such as “show all measurements” and the “Handles” display options are disabled in
Basic View. To enable them, switch to Advanced View first (see Advanced).

Measurements
This section allows you to select whether to display the default ION label (for example, “Vln avg”) in
the Measurement column or to display the full descriptive name of the measurement (for example,
“Average Voltage Line-to-Neutral”).

In Advanced view only, you can also select whether to display all available measurements or only
the most common measurements in the list when picking a measurement in the Updated
Measurement column.

720 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Displaying ION labels versus measurement names

To change the setting:

1. Click View > Options.

2. In the Measurements section, select display ION labels to display the ION label or display
measurement names to display the full name of the measurement.

NOTE: In some situations, if "display ION labels" is selected, the displayed label may not match
the label on your meter (for example, if a custom label was used). Instead, it displays the known
default label for that particular measurement.

Updated Measurement column display

To change the setting:

1. Click View > Options and ensure Advanced is selected.

2. In the Measurements section, select show all measurements to display all available
measurements in the Updated Measurement column. To display only the most common
measurements, clear show all measurements.

Historical data
If the show connection dialog check box is cleared, the ION_Data database is automatically set
as the “Default Connection” (for historical data).

If you want to select a different database, select the show connection dialog. With this setting
enabled, the database connection dialog is displayed every time you save your changes. When the
dialog opens, select Custom Connection and specify your database connection details.

Advanced
The enable advanced features check box sets the view to Basic View if it is cleared or Advanced
View if it is selected.

Handle

Available in Advanced View only, this option specifies whether register handles are displayed as the
hexadecimal value (with the “0x” prefix) or as the decimal value.
To change the setting:

1. Click View > Options and ensure the Advanced is selected.

2. In the Handles section, select display hex to display the register handle in hexadecimal
format or display decimal to display it in decimal format.

If you want to manually resolve a register handle to a specific measurement, edit the value in the
Handle cell, then select the Manual check box before saving the changes.

Downstream Device Assistant functions


This section describes different functions you can perform using the Downstream Device
Assistant.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 721


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

Renaming the assigned source


One of the primary reasons for using the Downstream Device Assistant is to change the default
name assigned to a downstream device by the Log Inserter. For instance, instead of “Modbus.34”,
you may want to rename that device to something more meaningful such as “SM_Bldg2_Boiler7”.

Renaming an Assigned Source typically only applies to downstream devices.

Renaming the assigned source for all its measurements

1. Switch to Basic view.

2. Find the source you want to rename. Enter the new name in the Updated Assigned Source
column. All rows with measurements associated with the renamed source are automatically
updated.

If you do not want to assign the existing data in the database to the new source name, switch
to Advanced View first, then clear the Update Historical Database check box for all
appropriate rows.

3. Click File > Save.

4. A dialog opens showing a summary of the changes. Click Yes to continue. or No to cancel.

5. When the operation completes, click OK, then Close.

Renaming the assigned source for one or more measurements

1. Switch to Advanced View.

2. Select the row(s) you want to rename. To select a row, click the area just to the left of the first
column. The row is highlighted to indicate that it is selected.

3. Click Edit > Rename Source.

4. In the Source Rename box, type the new name for the downstream source. Click OK.

NOTE: By default, the Update Historical Database check box is selected for all affected
rows — this applies the change to existing data in the database. To make the change only to
data going into the database from this point forward, clear the Update Historical Database
check box for the affected rows.

5. Click File > Save. A dialog open showing a summary of the changes.

722 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

6. Click Yes to continue or No to cancel.

7. When the operation has completed, click OK, then click Close.

Cancelling changes
1. To undo all unsaved changes:
Click Edit > Reset, or

Click View > Refresh.

2. Click Yes to confirm.

Changing the measurement mapping


Log Inserter automatically associates logged data with a measurement by searching for a mapping
between the label and the measurement. However, in cases where no mapping exists, Log Inserter
creates a “measurement” that is based on the register label. To manually change this measurement
mapping:

1. Switch to Advanced View.

2. Click the Updated Measurement cell that you want to change, then select the new
measurement you want to map from the list.

3. Select the Manual check box.

4. By default, the Update Historical Database check box is selected — this applies the change
to existing data in the database (if, for example, the source and measurement mapping you are
adding already exists). To make the change only to data going into the database from this
point forward, clear the Update Historical Database check box.

5. Click File > Save. A dialog opens showing a summary of the changes. Click Yes.

6. If prompted, select which database to update. Click OK.

Adding a new downstream device mapping


To add a new address mapping that associates the source and measurement to a specific logged
quantity in the database:

1. Scroll down to the end of the table and click the last row (the one with the asterisk beside it).

2. Fill in the Updated Assigned Source and Physical Source columns. If the source is a
physical device (i.e., not downstream), the same name must be entered exactly in both
columns.

3. Click the Updated Measurement cell, then select the measurement from the list.

4. In the Handle cell, type the register handle for this measurement.

5. By default, the Update Historical Database check box is selected — this applies the change
to existing data in the database (if, for example the source and measurement mapping you are
adding already exists). To make the change only to data going into the database from this
point forward, clear the Update Historical Database check box.

6. Click File > Save. A dialog opens showing a summary of the changes. Click Yes.

7. If prompted, select which database to update. Click OK.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 723


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Updating the historical data at a later time


When you save your changes using the Downstream Device Assistant, a record of changes to the
source-measurement definitions is saved in the folder:

...\Power Monitoring Expert\config\Diagnostic\Downstream Device Assistant\

with the following filename:

“Downstream Device DefinitionsYYYY-MM-DD_hh.mm.ss.csv”

where “YYYY-MM-DD_hh.mm.ss” means current YEAR-MONTH-DAY_hour.minute.second.

If you cleared the Update Historical Database check box when you saved your changes the first
time, you can update the existing data in the database at a later time, through the use of this csv file.

How to use the Downstream Device Assistant .csv file

To update the existing data in the database with the source-measurement changes contained in the
csv file:

1. Click Edit > Historical Data. The Update Historical Data window appears.

2. Click File > Import CSV.

3. Downstream Device Assistant opens the folder that contains the csv files. Select the
Downstream Device Definitions file you want to use, then click Open.

4. Click File > Update Historical Data.

5. The Historical Data Update prompt displays how many source-measurement pairs will be
updated. Click Yes.

6. Click Yes at the Historical Data Update prompt.

7. After the operation has completed, click OK, then Close.

You can update only one ION database at a time. To select a different database, first make sure the
show connection dialog check box is selected under View > Options. You can then use the
database connection dialog to specify which database you want to update.

NOTE: If you update address definitions that affect multiple historical databases, only the first
historical database you select is automatically updated. To update the remaining historical
databases, you must import the address definitions to each one, using Edit > Update Historical
Data.

Activity log
The saved changes in the Downstream Device Assistant are stored in a log file named
“Downstream Device Historical UpdatesYYYY-MM-DD_hh.mm.ss.txt”, that contains a description
of the activities carried out when Downstream Device Assistant was updating the source-
measurement definitions.

724 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Downstream Device Assistant commands


The following summarizes the commands available in the Downstream Device Assistant:

• File > Save: Saves your changes. A copy of the changes are saved for future reference, in a
comma-separated value (.csv) data file in the ...\config\Diagnostic\Downstream Device
Assistant\ folder.

• File > Exit: Closes the Downstream Device Assistant.

• Edit > Reset: Clears the modifications made since the last save.

• Edit > Delete: Deletes the selected rows.

• Edit > Rename Source: Lets you change the name of an Assigned Source. See Renaming
the assigned source.

• Edit > Update Historical Data: Opens the “Update Historical Data” window that allows you to
open a previously-saved source-measurement definition data file (with a .csv file extension), for
the purpose of updating existing data in the database. You can also manually add, edit or delete
data entries. See Updating the historical data at a later time.

• View > Refresh: Loads the current downstream definitions from the database. Functionally the
same as Edit > Reset, as this command clears the modifications made since the last save.

• View > Options: Displays the Options dialog where you can change the settings that control
what level of detail is displayed for the source-measurement definitions.

• View > Select Physical Sources: Displays the Select Physical Sources dialog where you
can select which physical devices you want displayed in the Downstream Device Assistant.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 725


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Event Watcher Manager


The Event Watcher Manager defines events for the “On Event” selection in report subscriptions.
(For more information about report subscriptions, see Creating report subscriptions in the online help
for Reports in the Web Applications component.)
The Event Watcher Manager interface consists of two tabs:

• Event Watchers: An event watcher links a device or group of devices to the conditions defined
in a template.

• Templates: A template defines the conditions that make up an event.

TIP: For instructions on using filtering, sorting, and column selection to customize the Event
Watcher Manager interface, see Customizing and navigating interface displays.

Opening Event Watcher Manager


Open Management Console and select Tools > Event Watcher.

Symbols used in the Updated column


The following symbols are used in the Updated column to display the status of information in a row:
* Information in the row has been modified since it was last saved.
! Information in the row is inaccurate or incomplete.
+ The row is new since the user or group information was last saved.

Creating a template
Before adding an event watcher, you must have a template that defines the conditions to be
watched. You can use one of the default templates or create your own. Use the Templates tab to
define and edit templates.

Event Watcher Manager comes with default templates that can be modified for specific devices.
Test any changes to the default template to ensure that events are available for selection for report
subscriptions. In cases where a device is not supported by the default templates, you can create
custom templates to define what you need.
To define a custom template:

1. Click New in the top right corner of the tab. A new row appears in the main table for the new
template.

2. Type a name for the template. Type a description for the template if desired.

3. Use the Template Conditions section to set the conditions to be watched. See Using the
Template Conditions section, below.

4. Click Apply to save your changes, click OK to save your changes and exit Event Watcher
Manager, or click the Event Watchers tab to set up an event watcher.

726 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Using the Template Conditions section


Use this section of the interface to configure the condition the template watches for.

1. Add a condition:
To add a condition from the event log, click Select from Event Log to open the Select
Event Log Lines dialog. To select an event, click on the boxes at the left of the table to
select a check box. Click on the check box again to clear the check mark. Click OK to
return to the Templates tab.

To add a condition without selecting from the event log, click New. A new row appears in
the table for the new condition.

NOTE: It is recommended that you use Select From Event Log to add conditions. This
helps ensure that the syntax is correct. If the syntax is not correct, the event watcher will not
work. Conditions only appear in the Select Event Log Lines dialog after they have occurred in
the system.

2. Select the parameters you want to include in the condition by selecting or clearing the check
boxes below the Template Conditions table. The available parameters are: Priority, Cause,
Cause Value, Effect, Effect Value. You must include at least one parameter. If you select
multiple parameters, the event watcher only activates when all parameters are met.

The Logic of the Template Conditions


The conditions within a row of the Template Conditions table must all be true for the condition to be
met. For example, if you have a row with a Priority of greater than 220 and an Effect Value of
Disturbance, both of these must be met for the condition to be true. If you have multiple rows in the
table, the condition is met if any of the rows are true. For example, if you have a row with Priority
greater than 220 and a row with an Effect Value of Disturbance, the condition is met if either of these
are true.

Deleting and reverting


To delete a template condition, select the condition from the Template Condition table and click the
Delete button in the Edit <Template> section. To delete a template, select the template from the
main table and click the Delete button in the top right corner of the tab.

To undo changes, click Revert.

Adding an event watcher


To add an event watcher, you need a template. You can use one of the default templates or define
your own (see Creating a template). Use the Event Watchers tab to define and edit event watchers.

1. Click New to add a new event watcher. A new row appears in the main table for the new
event. Use the Event Watcher Editing Area to define the event watcher.

2. Type a name for the event watcher.

3. Select the template you want to use from the Template dropdown list.

4. Type a description of the event watcher if desired.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 727


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

5. From the Devices table, select the devices you want to include in the event watcher. Click the
check boxes to the left side of the devices to select or clear a device.

NOTE: Checking Select All will include any Query Server, Log Inserter or Virtual Processor
instances in the system. It also includes any devices or software nodes added in the future.

6. Click Apply to save your changes, click OK to save your changes and exit Event Watcher
Manager, or click the Templates tab to edit the templates.

Deleting and reverting


To delete an event watcher, select the event watcher from the table and click Delete.

To undo changes, click Revert.

728 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module


TIP: You can open the Generator Performance Configuration Tool from the Power Monitoring
Expert > Configuration Tools folder on your desktop.

Use the Generator Performance Configuration Tool to configure the Backup Power Module and the
Capacity Management Module. With this tool you define Generators, Transfer Switches,
Equipment, and Groups for the Generator Activity, Generator Battery Health, Generator Test EPSS,
Generator Load Summary, Equipment Capacity, and Generator Capacity reports. You also use this
tool to generate the EPSS Vista diagrams, and to manage the Run History of the Generators.

The report templates have different configuration requirements. Not all of the components and
properties available in the configuration tool have to be configured for all of the report templates.
See Backup Power Module configuration and Capacity Management Module configuration for
details.

Prerequisites
• The monitoring devices that are recording the generator, transfer switch, and equipment data
must be configured in the PME Management Console and must be communicating before you
can configure the components and properties in the configuration tool.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 729


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Starting the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module
To start the Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module, open the PME
folder on the desktop and double-click the Generator Performance Configuration Tool shortcut.

The Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module window contains these
tabs: Groups, Generators, Transfer Switches, Equipment, and Run History.

First Define Generators, Define Transfer Switches, and Define Equipment. Then Define Groups.
After you had the first generator test, you can View the Run History.
Use the following common controls for the tabs:

• Help - Click this to view online help for the tab.

• New - Creates a new entry in the grid.

• Delete - Deletes the selected entry from the grid.

• Revert - Returns a modified record to its original values, if OK or Apply have not been clicked.

• OK - Saves all changes and exits the configuration tool.

• Cancel - Exits the tool without saving changes.

• Apply - Saves all changes and leaves the tool open.

The Modified column in the grid area shows the status of the row data:

+ (plus) - a new entry.

* (asterisk) - a modified entry.

! (exclamation mark) - entry needs more information before it can be saved.

730 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Define Generators
Use the Generators tab to add new Generators or edit existing ones.

You can perform the following actions on this tab:

• Click New to add a new Generator to the system. See Adding a new generator for details.

• Click Clone to add a copy of an existing Generator. The tool copies many of the existing device
settings into the new entry. You can then enter the unique details of the new device. See
Cloning a Generator for details.

• Click Delete to remove records from the system.

• Click Revert (before you click Apply or OK) if you make changes to a record and want to revert
to your initial settings.

Adding a new generator


To add a new generator:

1. On the Generator tab, click New.

2. Complete the following fields to define the generator:


Name - Enter a unique name to identify the generator.

Description - (Optional) Add information about the generator, such as make and model.

Electrical Data
Source - Select the monitoring device that records the electrical data of the generator.

Prime Nameplate Rating - Enter the rated generator power output. Refer to the

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 731


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

generator's nameplate for this value.

Unit - Select the unit of measurement for the generator rating value.

Engine Temperature Data - Select the check box to enable this property. Complete the
following fields:
Source - Select the monitoring device that records the engine temperature of the
generator.

Measurement - Select the engine temperature measurement.

Unit - Select either F (for Fahrenheit) or C (for Celsius) for the temperature unit of
measurement.

NOTE: The same unit is used for the generator test Evaluation Method setting.

Exhaust Gas Temperature Data - Select the check box to enable this property.
Complete the following fields:
Source - Select the monitoring device that records the exhaust gas temperature of
the generator.

Single Exhaust or Dual Exhaust - Select whether the exhaust gas temperature is
measured for a single exhaust or a dual exhaust generator.

Measurement - Select the exhaust gas temperature measurement.

Unit - Select either F (for Fahrenheit) or C (for Celsius) for the temperature unit of
measurement.

Edit Evaluation Method - Set the evaluation method and the pass/fail criteria for
generator tests. See Editing the generator Evaluation Method for more details.

Assign Engine Data - Associate data from the monitoring device with engine data
measurements defined in the tool. See Assigning engine data for more information.

NOTE: You can define Engine data measurements in the Edit Engine Data editor at the
top of the Generators tab. See Editing Engine Data for more details.

Status Measurements - Configure the monitoring device and the measurements used to
record the generator states.
Source - Select the monitoring device that records the generator states.

Starting - Select the check box to enable this property. This state indicates that the
generator is starting. Select the measurement that provides the Starting state input,
and enter the Active Value for the measurement.

Running - This state indicates that the generator is running. Select the measurement
that provides the Running state input, and enter the Active Value for the
measurement.

Stopped - This state indicates that the generator has stopped. Select the
measurement that provides the Stopped state input, and enter the Active Value for the
measurement.

732 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

NOTE: Two stop signals could be sent from the generator controller: the initial stop
signal which is followed by 3- to 5-minute cooling period, and the final stop signal
after the cooling period is complete. If the generator has two stop signals, use the
measurement for the first stop signal before the generator goes into the cooling
mode. Do not use the stop signal after the cooling period.

Example:

Assume that the system has been configured with measurements of GENStarting,
GENRunning, and GENStopped. You assign these measurements to the Starting,
Running, and Stopped states respectively and enter 1 as the Active Value for each.
When the generator starts, the active value for GENStarting becomes 1, and
Starting is the state for the generator.

When the generator is running, the active value for GENRunning becomes 1, and
Running is the state for the generator.

When the generator stops, the active value for GENStopped becomes 1, and
Stopped is the state for the generator.

Additional notes about the Status Measurements:

If there is only one measurement to indicate that the generator is either running or
stopped, then you select that measurement for both the Running and Stopped
states, and assign a different active value for each. For example, if the measurement
used to indicate whether a generator is running or not is GenRunningStopped,
define the states like this:
For the Running state:
Select GenRunningStopped as the measurement.

Set the Active Value to 1.

When the generator is running, the active value for GenRunningStopped is 1,


and Running is the state for the generator.

For the Stopped state:


Select GenRunningStopped as the status measurement.

Set the Active Value to 0.

When the generator is stopped, the active value for GenRunningStopped is 0,


and Stopped is the state for the generator.

Monitor for EPS Available - Select the check box to enable this property. This state
indicates that the emergency power source (EPS) is available. Select the
measurement that provides the EPS Available state, enter the active value for the
state measurement, and enter the Required Time (Seconds). The Required Time
value specifies the amount of time required to be considered a pass for a generator
test evaluation.

Battery Waveforms - Select the check box to enable this property. Complete the
following fields:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 733


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Source - Select the monitoring device that captures the battery voltage signature
(waveform).

Measurement - Select the battery voltage signature (waveform capture)


measurement, for example V4 Waveform.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

4. (Optional) Repeat these steps to define other generators.

TIP: Use Clone to define additional generators with similar settings. See Cloning a
Generator.

Editing a Generator
To edit a generator:

1. On the Generators tab, select the generator in the overview table.

2. Edit the fields that define the generator properties.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

Cloning a Generator
Clone a Generator to create a copy of an existing Generator. When you clone a Generator, many of
the settings are copied into the new Generator. Some settings are reset to default values. Update
the settings for the cloned Generator and save it.
To clone a Generator:

1. On the Generators tab, select the Generator you want to use as the base for the cloned copy.

2. Click Clone to create a new, cloned Generator. Review the copied settings and update them
as necessary. Update the following settings that have been reset to default values:
Name - Enter a unique name to identify the Generator.

Electrical Data - Source - Select the monitoring device that records the electrical data of
the generator.

Status Measurements - Source - Select the monitoring device that records the generator
states.

See Adding a new generator for information on generator properties.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

734 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Editing the generator Evaluation Method


Use the Evaluation Method editor to select the evaluation method and the decision criteria for the
Pass/Fail assessment of a generator test.

To edit the Evaluation Method:

1. Click Edit Evaluation Method to open the evaluation method editor.

2. Complete the following fields:


Evaluation Method - Select an evaluation method. Define the evaluation criteria.

NOTE: Different evaluation criteria are displayed depending on which evaluation method
is selected. See the table below for details.

3. Click OK to save the configuration and close the Edit Evaluation Method window.

The following table shows the evaluation methods and their respective pass/fail criteria:

Evaluation Method Pass/Fail Criteria


To Pass, the generator must run at the Suggested Load %(*) for
Load (= Default)
the Run Duration (Minutes).
To Pass, the generator must run at or above the Minimum Engine
Engine Temperature
Temperature °C/°F for the Run Duration (Minutes).
To Pass, the generator must run at or above the Minimum Exhaust
Exhaust Gas Temperature
Gas Temperature °C/°F for the Run Duration (Minutes).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 735


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Evaluation Method Pass/Fail Criteria


To Pass, the generator must pass the selected stages
Load Bank consecutively. For each stage, it must run at the Suggested Load
%(*) for the Run Duration (Minutes).
Load OR Engine To Pass, the generator must pass either the Load or the Engine
Temperature Temperature test.
Load OR Exhaust Gas To Pass, the generator must pass either the Load or the Exhaust
Temperature Gas Temperature test.
Load AND Exhaust Gas To Pass, the generator must pass either the Load and the Exhaust
Temperature Gas Temperature test.
Load AND Engine To Pass, the generator must pass either the Load and the Engine
Temperature Temperature test.
Load OR Engine
To Pass, the generator must pass either the Load, or the Engine
Temperature OR Exhaust
Temperature, or the Exhaust Gas Temperature test.
Gas Temperature
Load OR Engine
To Pass, the generator must pass either the Load test, or the
Temperature AND Exhaust
Engine Temperature and the Exhaust Gas Temperature test.
Gas Temperature
Load AND Engine
To Pass, the generator must pass both the Load and the Engine
Temperature OR Exhaust
Temperature test, or the Exhaust Gas Temperature test.
Gas Temperature
Load AND Engine
To Pass, the generator must pass the Load and the Engine
Temperature AND Exhaust
Temperature test and the Exhaust Gas Temperature test.
Gas Temperature

(*) The Suggested Load % is based on the generator nameplate rating.


The following table shows the default test criteria for each evaluation method:

NOTE: Update these values to meet the regulations mandated by your local jurisdictions, or to
meet the manufacturer recommendations.

Test Name Stage Minimum Run Duration


Load n/a 30 % 30 minutes
Engine Temperature n/a 900 °C/°F 30 minutes
Exhaust Gas
n/a 900 °C/°F 30 minutes
Temperature
Load Bank 1 25 % 30 minutes
Load Bank 2 50 % 30 minutes
Load Bank 3 75 % 60 minutes

736 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Editing Engine Data


The Engine Data Measurements editor is used to define measurements in PME that are related to
generator engine operation, for example battery voltage, or coolant temperature. You can then map
these measurements to engine data that is recorded by a monitoring device for the generator engine.
The items being measured, typically analog data, can differ from generator to generator. Battery
voltage and coolant temperature are two common measurements.

To add engine data measurements:

1. Click Edit Engine Data to open the Edit Engine Data Measurements editor.

2. Click New to add a new measurement.

3. Complete the following fields:


Name - Enter a name for the measurement.

Units - Enter a unit for the measurement.

4. (Optional) Repeat steps 2 and 3 to add additional measurements.

5. Click OK to save the new measurement and close the Edit Engine Data Measurements
window.

Next, map the measurements that you create to the registers/measurements recorded by the
monitoring device for the generator engine. See Assigning engine data for details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 737


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Assigning engine data


The Assign Engine Data Measurements editor is used to map PME engine measurements to
engine data that is recorded by a monitoring device for the generator engine.

To assign engine data:

1. Click Assign Engine Data to open the Assign Engine Data Measurement editor.

2. Click New to add a new assignment. Complete the following fields:


Engine Data Measurement - Select the measurement you want to assign.

Source - Select the monitoring device that records the engine data of the generator.

Measurement - Select the monitoring device data that you want to map to the engine
measurement.

3. (Optional) Repeat step 2 to map additional measurements.

4. Click OK to save the measurement mapping and close the Edit Engine Data Measurements
window.

TIP: See Editing Engine Data for information on how to define engine measurements.

738 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Define Transfer Switches


Use the Transfer Switches tab to add new (Automatic) Transfer Switches (ATS) or edit existing
ones.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 739


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

You can perform the following actions on this tab:

• Click New to add a new Transfer Switch to the system. See Adding a new Transfer Switch for
details.

• Click Clone to add a copy of an existing Transfer Switch. The tool copies many of the existing
device settings into the new entry. You can then enter the unique details of the new device. See
Cloning a Transfer Switch for details.

• Click Delete to remove records from the system.

• Click Revert (before you click Apply or OK) if you make changes to a record and want to revert
to your initial settings.

Adding a new Transfer Switch


To add a new Transfer Switch:

1. On the Transfer Switch tab, click New.

2. Complete the following to define the transfer switch:


Name - Enter a unique name to identify the transfer switch.

Description - (Optional) Add information about the transfer switch.

Load Data - Select the check box to enable this property. Complete the following fields:
Source - Select the monitoring device that records the electrical data of the transfer
switch.

740 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Measurement - Select the electrical measurement you want to track for the transfer
switch, for example Current Phase Average.

Rating - Enter the rating value for the measurement, such as 400.

Unit - Enter the unit of measurement, such as A.

Priority Level - Select a priority level for this transfer switch. The Required Transfer Time
associated with the selected priority is displayed below the list box.

NOTE: You can define priority levels in the Edit Priority Levels editor at the top of the
Transfer Switches tab. See Editing Transfer Switch priority levels for more details.

Status Measurements - Configure the monitoring device and the measurements used to
record the transfer switch states.
Source - Select the monitoring device that records the transfer switch states.

Normal - This state indicates that the transfer switch is in the Normal position and
power is supplied to the load by the utility. Select the measurement that provides the
Normal state input, and enter the Active Value for the measurement.

Test - This state indicates that the transfer switch is in Test mode. Select the
measurement that provides the Test state input, and enter the Active Value for the
measurement.

Emergency - This state indicates that the transfer switch is in the Emergency
position and power is supplied to the load by the generator. Select the measurement
that provides the Emergency state input, and enter the Active Value for the
measurement.

Monitor for Power Outage - Select the check box to enable this property. Select the
measurement that indicates a power outage occurred, and enter the Active Value for
the measurement.

For example, assume that the system has measurements called EPSS_Norm,
EPSS_Test, EPSS_Emerg, and EPSS_Util. You assign these measurements to
the Normal, Test, Emergency, and Power Outage states and enter 1 as the active
value for each.

When the ATS is in the Normal position, the active value for EPSS_Norm is 1, and
Normal is the state for the ATS. When the ATS is set to the Test mode, the active
value for EPSS_Test is 1, and Test is the state for the ATS. When the ATS is in the
Emergency position, the active value for EPSS_Emerg is 1, and Emergency is the
state for the ATS. If a power outage occurs, the active value for EPSS_Util is 1, and
Power Outage is the state for the ATS.

In the EPSS Test Report, the states for the ATS and the time when they occurred are
included in the Events Summary section.

NOTE: The Transfer Switch states are used to calculate the Transfer Time and
Emergency Time shown in the Generator Test EPSS Report:
Transfer Time = The time (in seconds) it takes to switch from Normal state to
Emergency state. For testing, the switch is triggered by the test signal, for an actual

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 741


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

power outage it is triggered by the power outage signal.


Emergency Time = The duration (in hours, minutes, and seconds) the transfer
switch receives power from the generators. This is the time the generator is in the
Emergency state.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

4. (Optional) Repeat these steps to define other transfer switches.

TIP: Use Clone to define additional transfer switches with similar settings. See Cloning
a Transfer Switch.

Editing a Transfer Switch


To edit a transfer switch:

1. On the Transfer Switches tab, select the transfer switch in the overview table.

2. Edit the fields that define the transfer switch properties.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

Cloning a Transfer Switch


Clone a Transfer Switch to create a copy of an existing Transfer Switch. When you clone a Transfer
Switch, many of the settings are copied into the new Transfer Switch. Some settings are reset to
default values. Update the settings for the cloned Transfer Switch and save it.
To clone a Transfer Switch:

1. On the Transfer Switches tab, select the Transfer Switch you want to use as the base for the
cloned copy.

2. Click Clone to create a new, cloned Transfer Switch. Review the copied settings and update
them as necessary. Update the following settings that have been reset to default values:
Name - Enter a unique name to identify the transfer switch.

Status Measurements - Source - Select the monitoring device that records the transfer
switch states.

See Adding a new Transfer Switch for information on transfer switch properties.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

742 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Editing Transfer Switch priority levels


Use the Edit Priority Levels editor to edit existing transfer switch Priority Levels, or add custom
ones.

To edit the Priority Levels:

1. Click Edit Priority Levels to open Edit Priority Levels.

2. Click New to add a priority level.

3. Complete the following fields:


Name - Enter a unique name to identify the priority level.

Required Transfer Time (Seconds) - Enter the transfer time in seconds. This value
indicates the maximum acceptable time for the transfer switch to switch from the Test
state to the Emergency state.

Evaluate this Priority Level when reporting on Power Outages - Select this check
box to include a priority level in the pass or fail grading. Clear the check box to exclude the
priority level from grading. By excluding a priority level, you can exclude non-critical
switches from evaluation.

For example, if a transfer switch has a priority level of Life Safety and it must be graded
because of a power outage, then select this check box. Conversely, if a transfer switch
has a priority level of Equipment, this transfer switch may not have to be graded because
of a power outage. In this case, clear the check box.

Color Picker - Select the display color for the priority level in the report.

4. Click OK to save the configuration and close the Edit Priority Levels window.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 743


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The following table shows the default Priority Levels:

Name Required Transfer Time Power Outage Enabled


Life Safety 10 True
Critical 10 True
Equipment 30 False

744 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Define Equipment
Use the Equipment tab to add new Equipment or edit existing ones. An Equipment represents a
real life apparatus such as a piece of switch gear, or a distribution panel. You can map the
Equipment to a measurement and rating. Equipment can be added to a Group and be included in the
reports.

You can perform the following actions on this tab:

• Click New to add a new Equipment to the system. See Adding Equipment for details.

• Click Clone to add a copy of an existing Equipment. The tool copies many of the existing
device settings into the new entry. You can then enter the unique details of the new device.

• Click Delete to remove records from the system.

• Click Revert (before you click Apply or OK) if you make changes to a record and want to revert
to your initial settings.

Adding Equipment
To add a new equipment:

1. On the Equipment tab, click New.

2. Complete the following fields to define the equipment:


Name - Enter a unique name to identify the equipment.

Description - (Optional) Add information about the equipment.

Source - Select the monitoring device that records the measurement data of the
equipment.

Measurement - Select the equipment measurement, for example current.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 745


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Rating - Enter the rating for the equipment measurement, for example rated current.

Unit - Enter the unit of the measurement.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

4. (Optional) Repeat these steps to define other equipment.

TIP: Use Clone to define additional equipment with similar settings.

Editing Equipment
To edit an equipment:

1. On the Equipment tab, select the equipment in the overview table.

2. Edit the fields that define the equipment properties.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

746 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Define Groups
Use the Groups tab to add new Groups or edit existing ones. A Group combines generators,
transfer switches, and other equipment. This is used for reporting and generating Vista diagrams.

You can perform the following actions on this tab:

• Click New to add a new Group to the system. See Adding a new Group for details.

• Click Delete to remove records from the system.

• Click Revert (before you click Apply or OK) if you make changes to a record and want to revert
to your initial settings.

Adding a new Group

NOTE: You must define the Generators, Transfer Switches, and Equipment first, before you can
add them to a Group.

To add a group:

1. On the Groups tab, click New.

2. Complete the following fields to define the group:


Name - Enter a unique name to identify the group.

Test Frequency - Enter how often, in days, the group should be tested. Select the Time
Zone you want to use for reporting.

Generators - From the list, select the generators you want to include in the group.

Equipment - From the list, select the equipment you want to include in the group.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 747


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Transfer Switches - From the list, select the transfer switches you want to include in the
group.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

4. (Optional) Repeat these steps to define other groups.

Editing a Group
To edit a group:

1. On the Groups tab, select the group in the overview table.

2. Edit the fields that define the group properties.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

Adding/Editing Group Load Sources


Define Load Sources to associate a Group with the electrical loads that the generators in the group
must supply with power during an outage.

NOTE: Before configuring Load Sources, define the Priority Levels for the system. See Editing
Transfer Switch priority levels for details.

To add/edit group load sources:

1. Click Edit Load Sources to open the load sources editor.

2. In Edit Load Sources, click New to add a load source.

3. Complete the following fields:


Source - Select the monitoring device that records the electrical data of the load.

Measurement - Select the load measurement.

Priority Level - Select the priority level to assign to the load.

4. Click OK to save the configuration and close the Edit Load Sources window.

TIP: Use Clone to define additional loads with similar settings.

748 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

View the Run History


The Run History is a record of the generator run activities. Use the Run History tab to view or
modify individual generator run instances. The Run History can be used as input for Reports and
Dashboards in Power Monitoring Expert.

Click Refresh Run History to update the display to show the latest run activities.

Run Histories are based on Groups. Refresh the Run History after every configuration change to the
Groups, Generators, Transfer Switches, or Equipment. For example, if you remove a generator from
a group, the run history for that group needs to be rebuilt because that generator may have been the
reason for the detection of a run. Now that the generator is not part of the group, the system needs
to build the run history again to have accurate data.

NOTE: When you view the Run History for the first time, the processing of the existing run
information in the database can take some time.

You can perform the following actions on this tab:

• Click Detection Options to define the criteria for detecting a run event that will cause it to
appear on this tab. See Defining run detection options.

• Click Refresh Run History to update the tab with the latest run events that have occurred in
the system.

• Click Delete Run History to remove all run event records from the tab.

• Edit the details of a run instance. See Editing run history details for details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 749


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Defining run detection options


Use run detection options to define the criteria for the system to detect and record a generator run,
and to display it as part of the Run History. You can set a minimum and a maximum run length.

Set a minimum run length to prevent commissioning or maintenance activities from being recorded.
Set a maximum run length to eliminate "hanging" runs. A hanging run occurs when the stop signal
for a generator is not recorded.

To define run detection options:

1. Click Detection Options to open Run Detection Options.

2. In Run Detection Options, set Minimum Run Length (default = 15 minutes), and Maximum
Run Length (default = 48 hrs).

3. Click OK to save the changes and close the dialog box.

NOTE: In Run History, click Refresh Run History to update the tab with the run events that
match the new detection criteria.

Editing run history details


The system defines the following information as part of the Run History: Run Name, Start, End,
Reason, and Active Sources.
You can edit the Run Name and the Reason for a run. Other run details cannot be modified

NOTE: The default Run Name is the start date of the run, such as June 12 2011. If a group has
multiple runs on the same date, the subsequent runs have the same date with the run number
appended, such as June 12 2011 Run 2 and June 12 2011 Run 3.
The default Reason is based on the Transfer Switch Status Measurements, for Test and Power
Outage.

To edit the run history details:

1. Click the run record you want to modify. The run details are shown in the editor below the grid.

2. In the Name field, change the run name as necessary.

3. In the Reason list, select the correct reason for the run.

4. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

750 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

EPSS Vista Diagrams


EPSS Vista diagrams provide real-time information about the status of the generators, transfer
switches, and other components of the system. You can view the diagrams in the Diagrams Web
Application of PME.

After the Generators, Transfer Switches, and Groups are configured, you can generate the Vista
diagrams for the configured devices. The same information can be built manually in Vista, but the
Generator Performance Configuration Tool with EPSS Test Module provides a way to build these
diagrams automatically.

See Setting up the EPSS template diagram and Generating the EPSS Vista diagrams for
instructions.

After the diagrams are generated, you can open them in Vista and optimize the designs. See
EPSS Vista diagram examples for descriptions and examples of the generated diagrams.

Setting up the EPSS template diagram


Use the template diagram to produce a consistent structure for the generated diagrams. The
template file is used as a basis for the dynamically generated EPSS diagrams. The template is a
normal diagram file that the system uses to apply common elements to the generated diagrams.

With the template, you can apply linked-button elements to the generated diagrams, which will help
you reduce the amount of time to configure the diagrams.
To set up the EPSS template diagram:

1. Open Vista

2. In Vista, open the following diagram:


...\config\diagrams\ud\EPSS\templates\Epss_Template.dgm.

3. Add buttons with the appropriate links to the left side of the diagram.

4. Do not link the EPSS button to any diagram, because you will already be on the EPSS pages
when they are generated.

5. Save and close the template diagram.

When the configuration tool generates diagrams, the template is read and any objects in the
template are added to every diagram created by the tool.

NOTE: On the generated diagrams, the background image is dynamically created. The
background does not come from the EPSS template diagram.

Generating the EPSS Vista diagrams

NOTE: Before you generate the EPSS Vista diagrams:


- configure all devices and groups
- save the changes you have made to the EPSS configuration
- create an EPSS template diagram (see Setting up the EPSS template diagram)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 751


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To generate the EPSS Vista diagrams:

1. Click the Groups tab.

2. Click Generate Vista Diagramsto open the Vista Diagram Generation dialog.

3. In the Output Path field, enter or select the folder where you want to store the diagrams.

4. (Optional) In the Included EPSS Groups box, select the device groups that you want to
generate diagrams for. Clear the check box for any groups you do not want to generate.

5. (Optional) In the Transfer Switch Options box, select the colors you want to use for normal
and emergency status.

6. (Optional) Check Include Test Button on Transfer Switchesif you want to add a control
object for each ATS on the diagrams. This object allows you to manually test the ATS from the
diagram. The control must be manually linked using Vista after the diagrams have been
created.

7. (Optional) Check Include Links to EPSS Groups... if you want the device diagrams to have
a link to the EPSS Group diagram.

8. In the Diagram Width field, select the horizontal width in pixels of the diagrams.

9. (Optional) Select Facility Logo and enter the image file if you want the diagrams to include
the customer logo at the top-left of every diagram.

10. (Optional) Select Generate Facility Map if you want to include a map with the diagrams. If
you do this, you will be able to add the generator and transfer switch device locations to the
map.
a. Enter the Facility Name to appear on the map.

b. Select the image file for the map.

11. Click Generate Vista Diagrams to generate and store the diagrams in the selected output
folder.

Several diagrams will be created: the homepage that lists all EPSS groups, summary pages that list
all generators and transfer switches, and the detail pages for each EPSS Group, Generator and ATS
in the system.

You can open the diagrams in Vista and optimize the designs if necessary.

752 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

EPSS Vista diagram examples


When you generate the Vista diagrams, the following diagrams are produced:

Home Page Diagram

One Home Page diagram is generated. This diagram contains a navigation bar that has links for the
facility map, device group diagrams, and device diagrams.

EPSS Group Diagram

For each group selected on the configuration screen, one group diagram is generated. This diagram
contains an object for each generator or transfer switch in the group. A Oneline diagram for each
group is also generated and linked to the diagrams. You will need to manually configure the
generated Oneline diagrams. Several default objects are included for assistance.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 753


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Device detail Diagram

For each generator and transfer switch in a group, a diagram is generated. The device diagram
includes status information for the device, including run status, test parameters, and real-time
electrical data.

Facility Map

This diagram is generated if the option was selected on the configuration screen. This diagram
includes a moveable icon for each generator and transfer switch in all the selected device groups.
On the map diagram, you can drag and drop the device icons to the map to represent the physical
locations of those devices.

754 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Generator Power Configuration Utility


TIP: You can open the Generator Power Configuration Tool from the Power Monitoring Expert >
Configuration Tools folder on your desktop.

Use the Generator Power Configuration Utility to configure the Capacity Management Module. With
this tool you define Generator Systems for the Generator Power Report.

See Capacity Management Module configuration for details.

Prerequisites
• The monitoring devices that are recording the load data must be configured in the PME
Management Console and must be communicating before you can configure the components
and properties in the configuration tool.

User Interface

Control Description
Help Opens the help for the utility.
New Creates a new entry in the grid.
Delete Deletes the selected entry from the grid.
OK Saves all changes and exits the utility.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 755


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Control Description
Cancel Exits the utility without saving changes.
Apply Saves all changes and leaves the utility open.

Grid Area Columns Description


Modified Displays a status symbol for the record.
+ (plus) A new entry.
* (asterisk) An existing entry has been modified.
! (exclamation mark) The entry is incorrect.
System Displays the system name.
Type Displays the Generator system type (N, 2N, N+2, etc.)
Description Displays a description of the system

TIP: The tool indicates if there configuration errors. Point at the red exclamation icon to see
configuration error details.

Generator Power configuration restrictions


The Generator Power configuration tool enforces certain rules when creating a generator system,
group, or generator:

• Generator System
Name must be unique.

One or more systems are allowed.

• Generator Groups
Name must be unique.

At least one group must be present in each system.

All groups are connected to the same load.

For N, N+1, and N+2 system types:


Only one group is allowed.

Each generator in the group must have the same nameplate rating (kVA) value.

Each generator in the group must have the same derated nameplate rating (kW) value.

For 2N, 2(N+1) and 2(N+2) system types:


Up to three groups are allowed.

All groups must have the same number of generators.

All generators in the groups must have the same nameplate rating (kVA) value.

All generators in the groups must have the same derated nameplate rating (kW) value.

756 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Generators
Name must be unique.

At least one generator must be present in each group.

A maximum of 12 generators is allowed in each group.

For information on generator redundancy types, see Generator system redundancy types.

Defining generator systems


A generator system is a logical system configuration that is used for reporting power capacity.
To define a generator system:

1. Click New. The Edit System: New System area appears below the grid.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 757


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2. Click anywhere in the editor area. The Properties screen appears.

3. Complete the details for the generator system:


a. Generator System Name: Enter a name for the generator system. Each generator
system must have a unique name.

b. Description: (Optional) Enter a description for the generator system.

c. Redundancy Type: Select the redundancy type for the generator system. The different
redundancy types are explained in Generator system redundancy types.

d. Groups: Shows the number of generator groups contained in the generator system. Click
Add to add groups to the generator system. Click Remove to delete groups.

e. Generators Per Group: Shows the number of generators in each generator group in the
system. Click Add to add generators to the group. Click Remove to delete generators.

NOTE: This property is only available when the system redundancy type is 2N, 2(N+1)
or 2(N+2). To define the number of generators for a system with redundancy type N, N+1
or N+2, use the generator group properties. See Defining generator groups for more
information.

4. Click Done to save the generator system.

Related Topics:

• Defining generator groups

• Defining generators

• Defining generator loads

• Defining utilities

758 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Defining generator groups


A generator group represents a logical grouping of generators. The system contains at least one
group and can contain multiple groups. Depending on the system type, the group properties may be
different, as shown below. See Generator Power configuration restrictions for more information.
To define a generator group:

1. Click on the group object border. The Properties screen appears.

2. Complete the details for the generator group:


a. Generator Group Name: Enter a name for the group.

Each generator group must have a unique name.

b. Description: Enter a description for the group. This field is optional.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 759


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

c. Generators Per Group: Click Add to increase the number of generators in the group.
Click Remove to decrease the number. This property is available only for system
redundancy types N, N+1 or N+2.

3. Click Done to save the generator group.

Related Topics:

• Defining generator systems

• Defining generators

• Defining generator loads

• Defining utilities

Defining generators
A generator represents an actual generator device. A group contains at least one generator and can
contain multiple generators. For some system types, each group must contain the same number of
generators. See Generator Power configuration restrictions for more information.
To define a generator:

1. Click on the generator object border. The selected generator will be highlighted in blue and the
Properties screen appears.

2. Complete the details for the generator:


a. Generator Name: Enter the name for the generator.

This name must be unique for each generator in the system.

b. Description: Enter a description for the generator. This field is optional.

c. Nameplate Rating (kVA): Enter the maximum output power (kVA) of the generator. This
value must be greater than zero.

d. Derated Nameplate Rating (kW): Enter the maximum power capacity (kW) that the
generator is expected to support. This value must be equal or less than the nameplate
rating value, and greater than zero.

3. Click Done to save the generator.

760 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Related Topics:

• Defining generator systems

• Defining generator groups

• Defining generator loads

• Defining utilities

Defining generator loads


A generator load represents the logical load attached to a generator group. Each generator system
must have only one load.
To define a generator load:

1. Click the generator load element in the system diagram. The Properties screen appears.

2. Complete the details for the generator load:


a. Load Name: Enter a name for the load.

b. Description: Enter a description for the load. This field is optional.

c. Data Source: Select one or more meter sources where load data is logged for this load.

d. Additional Utilities: Click Add to increase the number of utility objects for the load.
Click Remove to decrease the number of utility objects.

3. Click Done to save the generator load.

Related Topics:

• Defining generator systems

• Defining generator groups

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 761


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Defining generators

• Defining utilities

Defining utilities
A utility represents the logical utility provider that feeds a load under normal operation. This logical
utility has no functional purpose in the calculations for power redundancy. It is used to provide a
more complete diagram representation for the generator system. A system may have one or two
utilities represented in the diagram.
To define a utility:

1. Click the utility element in the diagram. The Properties screen appears.

2. Complete the details for the utility:


a. Utility Name: Enter a name for the utility.

b. Description: Enter a description for the utility. This field is optional.

3. Click Done to save the utility.

Once the configuration of the generators, loads, and utilities are complete, click Apply to save, or
click OK to save the configuration and exit the utility.
Related Topics:

• Defining generator systems

• Defining generator groups

• Defining generators

• Defining generator loads

762 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Generator system redundancy types


You can create a generator system to achieve power redundancy for IT equipment loads in different
ways, depending on how the generators are grouped together and how they are connected to the
equipment power supplies. This configuration tool supports several industry standard
configurations.
The generator system supports the following redundancy design types:

• N Type

• N+1 Type

• N+2 Type

• 2N Type

• 2(N+1) Type

• 2(N+2) Type

Before generator-related reports can be produced you need to define a generator system in the
Generator Power Configuration Utility.

N Type
The N system configuration is for one or more generators that work together to supply power to the
IT load, when the utility or utilities’ power is unavailable. There is no redundancy. The intention is to
size the generator system to match the peak IT load on the utility power.

N+1 Type
The N+1 system configuration is for one or more generators that work together to supply power to
the IT load. There is simple generator redundancy in that one of the generators can stop functioning
or be taken off-line, if the utility power is interrupted. The load is spread among all generators, but
the peak load is such that if one generator stops working, the others will be able to assume its load.
Another way to look at it is, N generators will be able to support the peak IT load. If the peak IT load
is more than N can support, then system design redundancy will be lost.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 763


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For example, if three generators are connected to the IT loads, in an N+1 system, the peak utility
load must not exceed the non-redundant capacity of two of the generators. If it does, the designed
redundancy will be lost.

N+2 Type
The N+2 system configuration is for a group of generators that work together to supply power to a
medium voltage substation and is then distributed to low voltage loads. There is simple generator
redundancy in that any two of the generators can stop functioning or be taken off-line, if the utility
power is interrupted. The load is spread among all generators, but the utility peak load is such that if
two generators stop working, the others will be able to assume their load. Another way to look at it
is, N generators will be able to support the peak utility load. If the peak utility load is more than N
can support, then system design redundancy will be lost.

For example, if five generators are connected to the IT loads, in an N+2 system, the peak utility load
must not exceed the non-redundant capacity of three of the generators. If it does, the designed
redundancy will be lost.

764 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

2N Type
The 2N system configuration is for two groups of generators that supply power to the IT loads. In a
2N system, an entire group of generators can stop functioning or be taken off-line and the equipment
will still be supplied with power, if the utility power is interrupted. The load is spread among all
generators, but the peak load is such that, if an entire group of generators stop working, the
remaining generators will be able to assume the entire load. Another way to look at it is, N
generators will be able to support the peak utility load. If the peak utility load is more than N can
support, then system design redundancy will be lost.

In this example, there are two groups with three generators in each. In a 2N configuration, one group
of generators can go offline and the system will still have the designed redundancy. Therefore, the
value for N is three. So, the total peak utility load cannot exceed the derated nameplate of three of
the generators.

2(N+1) Type
The 2(N+1) system configuration is for two groups of generators that supply power to the IT loads.
In a 2(N+1) system, an entire group of generators plus one more generator from each of the
remaining groups can stop functioning or be taken off-line, and the equipment will still be supplied
with power, if the utility power is interrupted. The load is spread among all generators, but the peak
load is such that if an entire group’s worth of generators goes offline, plus one more from each of the
other groups stop working, the remaining generators will be able to assume the entire load. Another
way to look at it is, N generators will be able to support the peak utility load. If the peak utility load is
more than N can support, then system design redundancy will be lost.

In this example, there are two groups with five generators in each. In a 2(N+1) configuration, one
group of generators can go offline, plus one more generator from the remaining group and the
system will still have the designed redundancy. Therefore, the value for N is four. So, the total peak
utility load cannot exceed the derated nameplate of four of the generators.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 765


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2(N+2) Type
The 2(N+2) system configuration is for two groups of generators that supply power to the IT loads.
In a 2(N+2) system, an entire group of generators plus two more generators from each of the
remaining groups can stop functioning or be taken off-line and the equipment will still be supplied
with power, if the utility power is interrupted. The load is spread among all generators, but the peak
load is such that if an entire group’s worth of generators goes offline, plus two more from each of the
other groups goes offline, the remaining generators will be able to assume the entire load. Another
way to look at it is, N generators will be able to support the peak utility load. If the peak utility load is
more than N can support, then system design redundancy will be lost.

In this example, there are two groups with four generators in each. In a 2(N+2) configuration one
group of generators can stop working, plus two more generators from the remaining group and the
system will still have the designed redundancy. Therefore, the value for N is two. So, the total peak
utility load cannot exceed the derated nameplate of two of the generators.

766 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Hierarchy Configuration Utility


The Hierarchy Configuration Utility is intended for Application Engineers or advanced users working
with hierarchies in PME.

The utility is a command-line executable that allows you to save, restore, or add hierarchy content.
The primary purpose of the utility is to give you a way to add a large number of entries to a hierarchy
rather than creating individual entries in Hierarchy Manager. This task consists of:

• Saving a skeleton hierarchy configuration in a CSV file.

• Editing the CSV file to associate the devices listed in the file to the nodes of the hierarchy.

• Populating Hierarchy Manager with the updated contents of the hierarchy configuration CSV
file.

The utility also provides options for:

• Saving or replacing a hierarchy configuration currently defined in Hierarchy Manager.

• Installing or saving a hierarchy template.

• Refreshing a configuration cache to ensure that all devices are included when you save a
hierarchy configuration.

• Deleting a hierarchy configuration prior to restoring a saved configuration.

Throughout this document, references to "configuration" and "template" should be interpreted as


follows:

• configuration – the entries representing the node types, devices, and virtual meters that
comprise the content of a hierarchy.

• template – defines the node names, attributes, relationships, and views in Hierarchy Manager.

Hierarchy Configuration Utility command and options


Run the Hierarchy Configuration Utility command, HierarchyConfig.exe, from a Command
Prompt.

To open a Command Prompt window:

1. Use Windows Explorer to navigate to:

...\Power Monitoring Expert\Applications.

2. Click the bin folder and press Shift + Right-click and select Open command window here
on the context menu.

The command syntax is:


HierarchyConfig.exe option <file path>\<file name>, where:

• option: see Command options below.

• <file path>: the location of the file that the command runs on.

• <file name>: the name of the CSV or XML file, including the .csv or .xml file extension,
respectively.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 767


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Command options
Use the command as follows (type the command and press Enter):

Running the command without options


• To see a brief description of available command options:
HierarchyConfig.exe

Running the command using the config option


• To create a skeleton configuration CSV file that you can use to define a hierarchy configuration:
HierarchyConfig.exe export config <file path>\<file name>.csv

Note that this process creates a header row in the CSV file with percentage, node type names,
and virtual meter column headings. It also includes a list of the devices in the system that are
not included in a hierarchy. This allows you to specify which devices you want to include in the
hierarchy when you import the configuration.

Optional: Including all devices

Add the alldevices option at the end of the export config command to create a CSV file that
lists all of the devices, whether or not they are included in a hierarchy. This option ensures that
apportioned devices or devices that constitute a virtual meter are included in the file.

To include all devices, type the following:


HierarchyConfig.exe export config <file path>\<file name>.csv
alldevices

Note that the CSV file created with the alldevices option is intended for reference purposes
only and not for updating an existing hierarchy.

• To add the contents of the updated skeleton configuration CSV file to Hierarchy Manager:
HierarchyConfig.exe import config <file path>\<file name>.csv

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Do not use the hierarchy configuration CSV file to incrementally update an existing
hierarchy.
• Use the Hierarchy Manager application to incrementally update an existing hierarchy.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in the corruption of hierarchy data.

Optional: Adding a timestamp to configuration entries

You can also add a timestamp to the configuration entries. Adding year, month, and day
information adds a start date to the imported references corresponding to the date entered. If no
date information is provided, the start date of the hierarchy information is the system start date.

768 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

To add a timestamp, type HierarchyConfig.exe import config <file


path>\<file name>.xml [yyyy/mm/dd] where [yyyy/mm/dd] is the year, month and
day that the imported hierarchy references use as a start date.

• To back up a complete representation of the hierarchy and all virtual meters in an XML file:
HierarchyConfig.exe export config <file path>\<file name>.xml

This creates a backup of the hierarchy before you modify the hierarchy entries in Hierarchy
Manager.

• To restore a hierarchy configuration from a backup configuration XML file:


HierarchyConfig.exe import config <file path>\<file name>.xml

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Do not use the hierarchy configuration XML file to incrementally update an existing
hierarchy.
• Use the Hierarchy Manager application to incrementally update an existing hierarchy.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in the corruption of hierarchy data.

This process deletes the current hierarchy configuration defined in Hierarchy Manager and
replaces it with the hierarchy configuration in the XML file.

• To refresh a configuration cache to ensure that all devices are included in the saved
configuration:
HierarchyConfig.exe refresh config

• To delete a hierarchy configuration:


HierarchyConfig.exe delete config

Only use this process if you have previously saved your configuration.

Running the command using the template option


• To save the hierarchy template used in Hierarchy Manager:
HierarchyConfig.exe export template <file path>\<file name>.xml

The template defines the node names, attributes, and relationships used in Hierarchy Manager.

• To replace an existing hierarchy template used in Hierarchy Manager with a different one:
HierarchyConfig.exe import template <file path>\<file name>.xml

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 769


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Populating a hierarchy
After installing and commissioning PME, you can populate Hierarchy Manager by associating
devices to nodes in a skeleton configuration CSV file and importing the entries into Hierarchy
Manager. Following a successful import, you can use Hierarchy Manager to modify your hierarchy
information. You can then use hierarchies in other PME applications, such as in view-enabled
reports in the Web-based Reports application, and in the Dashboards application.

For illustration purposes, the default hierarchy template in Hierarchy Manager is used as a reference
for this task.

The skeleton configuration CSV file created from the default hierarchy template used in Hierarchy
Manager includes a header row with column headings of Devices_Full Name, _Percentage, Site_
Name, Buildings_Name, Areas_Name, and Virtual Meter_Name. It also includes a list of the
devices in the system that are not included in a hierarchy so that you can associate the devices to
the hierarchy nodes.

Different hierarchy templates can be used in Hierarchy Manager. Each hierarchy template
determines the information that is included in the configuration CSV file. For example, the Site
Building Area Tenant.xml hierarchy template file results in column headings of Devices_
Full Name, _Percentage, Site_Name, Buildings_Name, Areas_Name, Tenants_Name,
Tenants_Contact, Tenants_email, Tenants_Phone, and Virtual Meter_Name in the
configuration CSV file.
(Sample and generic hierarchy templates are located in the:
...\Applications\HierarchyManager\SampleTemplates folder.)

The procedure for updating a skeleton configuration CSV file follows a consistent pattern regardless
of the template used in Hierarchy Manager.

The process for adding a large number of entries to a hierarchy consists of:

• Saving a skeleton hierarchy configuration in a CSV file.

• Editing the CSV file.

• Updating Hierarchy Manager with the new entries and verifying the outcome.

770 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Do not use the hierarchy configuration CSV file to incrementally update an existing hierarchy.
• Use the Hierarchy Manager application to incrementally update an existing hierarchy.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in the corruption of hierarchy data.

Editing and saving a localized version of a CSV file


If you edit and save a skeleton configuration CSV file that is created from a localized version of
Hierarchy Manager with Excel, the UTF-8 encoding in the file is not preserved. This results in an
unsuccessful update in Hierarchy Manager when you import the CSV file contents.

To resolve this situation, it is recommended that you use the Google Sheets spreadsheet
application. Editing and saving a skeleton configuration CSV file with Google Sheets preserves the
UTF-8 encoding, which results in a successful import of the CSV file contents to Hierarchy
Manager.

Before you begin


Before you export the skeleton configuration CSV file from Hierarchy Manager, make sure that you
complete the following tasks:

• Plan how the hierarchy is going to be configured, such as: naming conventions, which devices
are going to be mapped to which Node, and how the different elements are grouped together.
This can save time when you enter content in the configuration CSV file and it is very important
when dealing with a large number of devices.

For illustration purposes in this task, devices are going to be mapped to a physical layout
consisting of 4 areas within a building.

• Install Microsoft Excel, or another spreadsheet application that you can use to open and edit
CSV files on your system. (See Editing and saving a localized version of a CSV file for

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 771


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

information about editing and saving a skeleton configuration CSV file from a localized version
of Hierarchy Manager.)

• Add devices, logical devices, and/or managed circuits to PME. You can add additional devices
at a later time, but you need to have an initial number of devices before you export the skeleton
configuration CSV file.

Saving a hierarchy configuration in a CSV file


This process creates a skeleton hierarchy configuration CSV file with a header row that includes
percentage, node type names, and virtual meter column headings. It also includes a list of the
devices in the system that are not included in a hierarchy. This allows you to specify which of those
devices you want to include in the hierarchy when you import the contents of the hierarchy
configuration CSV file.
If devices have recently been added, use the refresh command to update the configuration cache
before proceeding. (See Refreshing the hierarchy cache for more information.)

1. Open a Command Prompt window:

a. Use Windows Explorer to navigate to:

...\Power Monitoring Expert\Applications.

b. Click the bin folder and press Shift + Right-click and select Open command window
here on the context menu.

2. Type HierarchyConfig.exe export config <file path>\<file name> and


press Enter.

Where <file path> is the location for the exported CSV file, and <file name> is the
name of the file, including the .csv file extension. If you do not specify a file path, the current
directory is used.

NOTE: If you include spaces in the CSV file name and/or file path, you must enclose the file
path and file name in quotation marks. For example, HierarchyConfig.exe export
config "C:\test file.csv".

The items in the skeleton hierarchy configuration CSV file includes a list of devices not
included in a hierarchy, the heading _Percentage, headings for the node types, and the
heading Virtual Meter_Name.

Adding content to the configuration CSV file


The following steps describe:

• Defining the main elements (instances of a node) of the hierarchy.

• Associating devices to areas.

• Adding a virtual meters and associating devices.

772 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Defining the main elements of the hierarchy


Define the site, building, and area names in the file as follows:

1. Open the hierarchy configuration CSV file in Excel.

2. On an empty row below the list of devices, type the names that you want to use for the site,
the building, and an area association in their respective columns.

As indicated in the previous description of the physical layout, there are 4 building areas. You
now need to define the association of the 3 remaining areas to the building and site.

3. Repeat the previous step for each of Area 2, Area 3 and Area 4, as shown in the following
image.

This completes the association of the 4 areas to the building instance, Building 1, and the
site instance, Test Site.

If there are additional buildings on the site, you can repeat the pattern that you entered. For
example, if there is a Building 2 on the site, your entries would include the same site name,
Test Site, but the building name is Building 2. Note that you should use unique names for the
areas. For example, for Building 2, define the area names like B2-Area 1, B2-Area 2, and so
on.

Associating devices to areas


Complete the following steps to associate devices to specific areas:

1. Type the area name that you defined in the previous set of steps, in the Areas_Name column
on the row identifying the device full name.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 773


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For example, to associate device Test_Site.Device1 to Area 1, type Area 1 in the Areas_
Name column in that row.

2. Continue to associate any of the remaining devices to their respective areas. Note that you
can assign multiple devices to the same area. For example, the following image shows two
devices assigned to Area 3 and two to Area 4.

Adding a virtual meter and associating devices


To define a virtual meter:

1. Type the virtual meter name in the Virtual Meter_Name column on the row identifying each
device full name that you want to associate with the virtual meter.

774 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

2. To apportion a percentage of a device's value to the virtual meter, type a percent value for the
applicable device in the _Percentage column. For example, apportion 25% of Test_Site.Test_
8600_C and 75% of Test_Site.Test_8600_D to virtual meter VM1.

3. To associate a virtual meter to a specific area, add the virtual meter name to the Devices_Full
Name column on a row defining the area. For example, to associate VM1 to Area 2, add VM1
to line 13 (in this example) in the CSV file.

You can also associate a virtual meter (VM1) to another virtual meter by including the virtual
meter name in the Devices_Full Name column and adding the additional virtual meter name
on the same row under the Virtual Meter_Name column.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 775


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

When you complete your updates in the hierarchy configuration CSV file, you can now update
Hierarchy Manager by importing the contents of the CSV file.

Adding your entries to Hierarchy Manager


Complete the following steps to add the contents of the hierarchy configuration CSV file to
Hierarchy Manager:

1. Open a Command Prompt window:

a. Use Windows Explorer to navigate to:

...\Power Monitoring Expert\Applications.

b. Click the bin folder and press Shift + Right-click and select Open command window
here on the context menu.

2. Type HierarchyConfig.exe import config <file path>\<file name> and


press Enter.

Where <file path> is the location of the file you are importing, and <file name> is the
name of the file, including the .csv file extension. If you do not specify a file path, the current
directory is used.

The import process provides feedback during each stage of the import. If the import operation
is unsuccessful, the utility provides information about possible reasons for the unsuccessful
operation.

NOTE: If the CSV file name and/or file path contains spaces, you must enclose the file path
and file name in quotation marks. For example, HierarchyConfig.exe import
config "C:\test file.csv".

3. Verify the correct hierarchy configuration in Hierarchy Manager.

Saving and restoring a hierarchy configuration


The Hierarchy Configuration utility allows you to save (export) the configuration as an XML file. The
file contains a full representation of the current hierarchy in Hierarchy Manager, including:

• Nodes.

• Relationships between nodes, including their time dimensions.

• All apportionment nodes.

This lets you back up the hierarchy before modifying it in the Hierarchy Manager application. You
can import the hierarchy configuration saved in the XML file to restore your hierarchy in Hierarchy
Manager.

NOTE: Restoring (importing) a configuration XML file deletes the current hierarchy configuration
and replaces it with the one represented in the file.

776 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Do not use the hierarchy configuration XML file to incrementally update an existing hierarchy.
• Use the Hierarchy Manager application to incrementally update an existing hierarchy.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in the corruption of hierarchy data.

Saving the entire hierarchy configuration in an XML file


To save a configuration XML file:

1. Open a Command Prompt window:

a. Use Windows Explorer to navigate to:

...\Power Monitoring Expert\Applications.

b. Click the bin folder and press Shift + Right-click and select Open command window
here on the context menu.

2. Run HierarchyConfig.exe export config <file path>\<file name>, where


<file path> is the location where you want to save XML file, and <file name> is the
name of the XML file, including .xml as the file extension. If you do not specify a file path, the
current directory is used.

NOTE: If the XML file name and/or file path contains spaces, you must enclose the file path
and file name in quotation marks. For example, HierarchyConfig.exe export
config "C:\test file.xml".

Restoring the entire hierarchy configuration from an XML file

NOTE: Restoring a configuration XML file deletes the current hierarchy configuration and replaces
it with the one represented in the file.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Do not use the hierarchy configuration XML file to incrementally update an existing hierarchy.
• Use the Hierarchy Manager application to incrementally update an existing hierarchy.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in the corruption of hierarchy data.

To restore the configuration XML file:

1. Open a Command Prompt window:

a. Use Windows Explorer to navigate to:

...\Power Monitoring Expert\Applications.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 777


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

b. Click the bin folder and press Shift + Right-click and select Open command window
here on the context menu.

2. Type HierarchyConfig.exe import config <file path>\<file name>, where


<file path> is the location of the file you are importing, and <file name> is the name of
the XML file, including .xml as the file extension, to be imported. If you do not specify a file
path, the current directory is used.

3. Verify the correct hierarchy configuration in Hierarchy Manager.

Installing or saving a hierarchy template


The import template command option lets you install a hierarchy template as a replacement for
the template used in Hierarchy Manager. The export template command option lets you save a
copy of the hierarchy template used in Hierarchy Manager. Prior to using these commands, you
should back up your existing hierarchy configuration (see Saving the entire hierarchy configuration
in an XML file).

Installing a hierarchy template


Use the import template option to replace the template currently installed in your system with a
different one.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
The new template overwrites the existing template, which permanently removes all information
contained in the original. Export the existing hierarchy template from PME before importing a new
template.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in a loss of data.

When you import the hierarchy template XML file, the Hierarchy Configuration Utility performs a
validation test on the file. If the file validation is not successful, the utility does not import the file and
provides information indicating where the validation process stopped. Check for any discrepancies
in the file, save the changes and reimport the file.
To import a hierarchy template XML file:

1. Open a Command Prompt window:

a. Use Windows Explorer to navigate to:

...\Power Monitoring Expert\Applications.

b. Click the bin folder and press Shift + Right-click and select Open command window
here on the context menu.

2. Type HierarchyConfig.exe import template <file path>\<file name>,


where <file path> is the location of the XML file, and <file name> is the name of the
XML file, including .xml as the file extension, to be imported. If you do not specify a file path,

778 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

the current directory of the Hierarchy Configuration Utility is used.

The utility provides feedback for each stage of the import. If the import operation is
unsuccessful, the utility provides information about why the import is unsuccessful.

NOTE: If the XML file name and/or file path contains spaces, you must enclose the file path
and file name in quotation marks. For example, HierarchyConfig.exe import
template "C:\test file.xml".

3. Verify that the template has been successfully imported in Hierarchy Manager.

Hierarchy Manager should now display the nodes defined in the newly imported template.

Saving a hierarchy template


Use the export template option to save the Hierarchy Manager template currently installed in the
system as an XML file. The file defines the node names, attributes, relationships, and views for
Hierarchy Manager.
To export a hierarchy template XML file:

1. Open a Command Prompt window:

a. Use Windows Explorer to navigate to:

...\Power Monitoring Expert\Applications.

b. Click the bin folder and press Shift + Right-click and select Open command window
here on the context menu.

2. Type HierarchyConfig.exe export template <file path>\<file name>,


where <file path> is the location where you want to save the XML file, and <file
name> is the name of the XML file, including .xml as the file extension. If you do not specify
a file path, the current directory is used.

NOTE: If the XML file name and/or file path contains spaces, you must enclose the file path
and file name in quotation marks. For example, HierarchyConfig.exe export
template "C:\test file.xml".

3. Navigate to the location you specified to confirm that the XML file is successfully saved.

Refreshing the hierarchy cache


Use the refresh config option to refresh the configuration cache. If you recently added new devices
to PME , use this command before you export a hierarchy configuration CSV file so that an up-to-
date list of devices is included in the file. If the refresh configuration is not run, there is a possibility
that devices recently added to PME may not be present in the device list in the hierarchy
configuration CSV file. The best practice is to run the refresh config command before exporting any
CSV or XML file from Hierarchy Manager.
To refresh the configuration cache:

1. Open a Command Prompt window:

a. Use Windows Explorer to navigate to:

...\Power Monitoring Expert\Applications.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 779


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

b. Click the bin folder and press Shift + Right-click and select Open command window
here on the context menu.

2. Run HierarchyConfig.exe refresh config.

The message Configuration cache refresh complete indicates that the refresh
operation has finished.

Deleting hierarchy configuration content


Use the delete config option to remove all hierarchy configuration content from Hierarchy Manager,
such as names and properties. This allows you to start with new content. Note that this delete
process does not remove virtual meters. You need to use Hierarchy Manager to delete virtual
meters.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
Performing this operation permanently removes configuration content from the system. Ensure
that this operation is necessary before proceeding. This procedure cannot be undone.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in a loss of data.

To delete configuration content:

1. Open a Command Prompt window:

a. Use Windows Explorer to navigate to:

...\Power Monitoring Expert\Applications.

b. Click the bin folder and press Shift + Right-click and select Open command window
here on the context menu.

2. Type HierarchyConfig.exe delete config. Type yes when prompted. The utility
deletes all hierarchy configuration content. To confirm the deletion, open Hierarchy Manager.
There should be no hierarchy content displayed.

Hierarchy template structure


PME includes a number of standard hierarchy templates that provide a structure for modeling the
different aspects of your organization. This section describes the structure of a hierarchy template
XML file.

Sample and generic hierarchy templates are included with your software. You can use any of these
templates if they more closely represent the hierarchy organization you want to implement.
However, you need to have a thorough understanding of the structure of a template before making
any changes. Always back up your files before proceeding with any changes. The additional
hierarchy templates are located in:
...\Applications\HierarchyManager\SampleTemplates

NOTE: Any time you change a hierarchy template, you need to import it into Hierarchy Manager
before those changes take effect. See Installing a hierarchy template.

780 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Localizing a hierarchy template XML file

You can localize a hierarchy template XML file to display national language text on the tabs and
views in Hierarchy Manager, and also wherever hierarchies are enabled in the Web Applications
component. For example, localized hierarchy node names will display in the Source Selector in the
Reports application.

To localize the text you need to edit the displayName attribute that is used throughout a hierarchy
template XML file. For example, the display name attribute for Site in the hierarchy template file is
displayName="Site". Change the text within the quotation marks to the national language
equivalent.

The displayName attribute is used in <Type>, <Attribute>, <Reference>, and <View> xml
elements in a hierarchy template file. (See The XML elements in the template file for descriptions of
these elements.) In some cases the same text is used on displayName attributes more than once in
the hierarchy template file. Be sure to change every occurrence in the file.

When you complete the edits, follow the process described in Installing a hierarchy template to
update the hierarchy template used by Hierarchy Manager.

The hierarchy template


The hierarchy template XML file defines the Node types, attributes, and relationships used in
Hierarchy Manager. Each element of the template is defined using information contained within the
various XML tags. For example, assume that Generic 5 Level Template.xml is imported
into Hierarchy Manager. (See the Generic 5 Level Template.)

The initial page in Hierarchy Manager shows the node types and attributes defined in the hierarchy
template file. The bottom three node types are configured for devices to be connected to them.

(See Additional notes for considerations related to associating devices to more that one node level
in a hierarchy.)

The hierarchy view defined in the template is represented on the Hierarchy Manager Tree View
page as a physical layout:

The following table summarizes the major elements in a hierarchy template XML file.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 781


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Tag Description Example


<Template version="1.0"
Contains template namespace
<Template> xmlns="uri:application-
information
modules/power/model/template#">
Container tag for Type and Attribute
<Types> <Types> </Types>
elements
Defines elements that define
characteristics used by the node.
<Type> <Type displayName="level_1".../>
Each type represents a tab in
Hierarchy Manager.
<Attribute displayName="id"
dataType="String"
Defines the characteristics used in
<Attribute> uri="uri::application-
each type.
modules/power/model/attribute#name"
/>
Used to create relationships between <Reference displayName="level_2"
nodes. For a relationship to exist isReverse="true"
between nodes, each Type element target="uri:application-
<Reference>
must contain reference information modules/power/model/type#level_2"
for every other element it is uri="uri:application-
associated with. modules/power/model/relation#1_2" />
Contains elements that define how
<Views> the Node types are presented in <Views> </Views>
different hierarchical views.
Specifies the node type the view <View displayName="Generic Layout"
<View> starts at. Contains Relation rootNodeTypeUri="uri:application-
elements. modules/power/model/type#level_1">
Contained in a View element. <Relation follow="uri:application-
<Relation> Defines the order that the node types modules/power/model/relation#1_2"
are displayed in. reverse="true" />

The XML elements in the template file


This section describes each element in the template XML file.

<Template>

The <Template> element is the container for all of the XML tags.

<Template version="1.0" xmlns="uri:application-


modules/power/model/template#">

782 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

<Types>

This is a containment tag for all <Type> elements. Make sure any <Type> elements are inside this
containment tag.

<Types>
<Type...>
...
</Type>
...
</Types>

<Type>

The <Type> tag contains all the information required to define the Node. Each defined type adds a
tab in Hierarchy Manager. The tab name is defined by displayName. The <Type> tag also
contains one or more <Attribute> and <Reference> tags.

<Types>
<Type displayName="level_1" uri="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#level_1">
<Attribute... />
<Attribute... />
...
<Reference... />
...
</Type>
<Type>
...
</Type>
</Types>

To change the tab name in Hierarchy Manager from level_1 to new_name, modify
displayName in the template file from:

<Type displayName="level_1" uri= "uri:application-


modules/power/model/type#level_1">

to:

<Type displayName="new_name" uri="uri:application-


modules/power/model/type#new_name">

<Attribute>

The <Attribute> tag defines the characteristics of the <Type>. It uses dataType to determine
the format of the edit dialog that opens in Hierarchy Manager.
You need to define at least one <Attribute> element with attribute#name in the uri:
uri:application-modules.com/power/model/attribute#name.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 783


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The datatypes on the <Attribute> element can be such things as name, floor number, or breaker
ratings, depending on the template layout.

• dataType="String" - For short blocks of text (for example, name).

• dataType="LongText" - For long blocks of text (for example, notes, contact information).

• dataType="Number" - For numeric fields (for example, breaker rating in Amps).

• dataType="Boolean" - For checkboxes (for example Rack Circuit).

<Types>
<Type displayName="level_1" uri="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#level_1">
<Attribute displayName="id" dataType="String" uri="uri:application-
modules/power/
model/attribute#name" />
<Attribute... />
...
<Reference... />
...
</Type>
<Type>
...
</Type>
</Types>

To add an attribute to a node, determine the characteristic you need to capture with that attribute,
determine the appropriate dataType, and create the attribute. To define Name as one of the
characteristics for a type, the Attribute tag is written as:

<Attribute displayName="Name" dataType="String" uri="uri:application-


modules/power/model/
attribute#name" />

<Reference>

The <Reference> tag defines the relationship between types. To establish a relationship, each
<Type> element needs a <Reference> element, and each <Reference> element needs to refer
to the displayName of the related <Type>.
The following example contains references establishing a relationship between the <Type> with
displayName="level_1", and the <Type> with displayName="level_2".
Since the types are in a parent-child relationship, the reference in the child needs to contain
isReverse="true".

The last portion of the <Reference> element includes a relation name. It is used in the Relation
element within the <View> structure to define what appears on the Tree View page in Hierarchy
Manager.

784 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

<Types>
<Type displayName="level_1" uri="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#level_1">
<Attribute displayName="id" dataType="String" uri="uri:application-
modules/power
/model/attribute#name" />
<Attribute... />
...
<Reference displayName="level_2" uri="uri:applications-
modules/power/model/
relation#1_2" target="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#level_2 />
...
</Type>
<Type displayName="level_2" uri="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#level_2">
<Attribute displayName="id" dataType="String" uri="uri:application-
modules/
power/model/attribute#name" />
<Attribute... />
...
<Reference displayName="level_1" isReverse="true"
uri="uri:applications-modules/
power/model/relation#1_2" target="uri:application-
modules/power/model/
type#level_1 />
...
</Type>
</Types>

A physical or logical device, or managed circuit can be associated with any type. To configure a
type to connect with a device, create a Reference tag similar to the example below. Note that
meteredBy is a keyword, and it must be entered exactly as shown to correctly reference a device.

<Reference displayName="device" uri="uri:application-


modules/power/model/relation#meteredBy"
target="uri:application-modules/power/model/type#device" />

<Views>

This is a containment tag for all <View> elements. Views are the means by which other
applications such as Dashboards and Reports discover the set of devices that are aggregated
together. All <View> elements need to be inside this containment tag.

<Types>
<Type...>
...

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 785


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

</Type>
<Type...>
...
</Type>
</Types>
<Views>
<View... >
</View>
</Views>

<View>

The <View> tag defines how a hierarchy can be viewed in PME. These different views provide
different ways that a hierarchy can be displayed, or different ways the device data associated with
the hierarchy types can be grouped together.

The view displayName (for example Generic Layout) is defined here. The name appears on the
Tree View page of Hierarchy Manager. You can select the view as a data source in the Dashboards
and Reports applications.

The <View> tag groups together the <Relation> elements whose order determines how the view
appears.

<Types>
<Type>
...
</Type>
<Type...>
...
</Type>
</Types>
<Views>
<View displayName="Generic Layout"
rootNodeTypeUri="uri:application-modules/power/model/
type#level_1 >
<Relation... />
<Relation... />
...
</View>
</Views>

<Relation>

The <Relation> tag is used to establish how the different views of the hierarchy are structured.
The initial relation is defined in the <Reference> element within a <Type>. Specify the node type
to start at (the initial <Relation> entry), then add <Relation> entries to complete the tree.

If a <View> element contains a <Relation> with reverse="true", then the view presented
follows the relationship in the reverse order.

786 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

<Types>
<Type displayName="level_1" uri="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#level_1">
<Attribute displayName="id" dataType="String" uri="uri:application-
modules/power/
model/attribute#name" />
...
<Reference displayName="level_2" uri="uri:applications-
modules/power/model/
relation#1_2" target="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#level_2 />
</Type>
<Type displayName="level_2" uri="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#level_2">
<Attribute displayName="id" dataType="String"
uri="uri:application-modules/
power/model/attribute#name" />
<Attribute... />
...
<Reference displayName="level_1" isReverse="true"
uri="uri:applications-modules/
power/model/relation#1_2" target="uri:application-
modules/power/model/
type#level_1 />
</Type>
<Type...>
...
</Type>
</Types>
<Views>
<View displayName="Generic Layout"
rootNodeTypeUri="uri:application-modules/power/model/
type#level_1 >
<Relation follow="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#1_2"
/>
<Relation follow="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#2_3"
/>
<Relation follow="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#3_4"
/>
<Relation follow="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#4_5"
/>
...
</View>
</Views>

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 787


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Additional notes

Considerations when selecting a hierarchy view in a Web-based report

If devices are associated with more than one node in a parent-child relationship in a hierarchy tree,
only those devices first encountered in the tree are included in generated reports. All devices lower
in the hierarchy tree are ignored in generated reports.

For example, if a hierarchy tree is structured as:

Site 1

Building 1 (including associated devices)

Area 1 (including associated devices)

and you select Building 1 on the Views page of the Source Selector in a report, the generated
report includes data for the devices associated with Building 1, but not for devices in the lower
node in the tree – Area 1.

Similarly, if you select Site 1, which does not include a device association in the hierarchy, the
generated report includes data for the devices associated with the Building 1 level only, the level in
the hierarchy where devices are first encountered.

Using comment tags

If you do not require all the levels provided in the example hierarchy template XML file, you can
comment out the types you do not need, from the bottom type up. Commenting out the type, rather
than just deleting the type preserves the structure of the template file and allows you to reinstate the
type with a minimum of effort. Enclose the <Type> element within the start comment tag <!-- and
the end comment tag --> to comment it out. For example:

<!-- <Type... >


...
</Type> -->

Remove the comment tags to restore the type.

If you want to remove one or more view elements defined in a template, add comment tags around
the applicable <View> tags. Remove the comment tags to restore the View elements.

When you import the hierarchy template XML file, the Hierarchy Configuration utility performs a
validation test on the file. If the file validation is not successful, the utility does not import the file and
provides information indicating where the validation process stopped. Check for any discrepancies
in the file, save the changes and reimport the file.

788 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Generic 5 Level Template


<Template version="1.0" xmlns="uri:application-modules/power/model/template#">

<!-- This is a template for a simple 5 level hierarchy. All the relations and nodes have been pre-configured. To customize for
your purposes, search and replace "level_1" with the name of your top-level type (e.g. Site),
...
"level_5" with the name of your lowest-level type (e.g. Room)
With this template you can attach "devices" to the lower 3 levels.
-->

<Types>

<Type displayName="level_1" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/type#level_1">


<!-- every Type must have attribute#name - change displayName as needed -->
<Attribute displayName="id" dataType="String" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/attribute#name" />
<!-- use these elements to add attributes to nodes -->
<Attribute displayName="string" dataType="String" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/attribute#str" />
<Attribute displayName="notes" dataType="LongText" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/attribute#note" />
<Attribute displayName="number" dataType="Number" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/attribute#num" />
<Attribute displayName="boolean" dataType="Boolean" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/attribute#bool" />

<!-- this is how to create one half of the relationship between two nodes, you need a similar reference on the other end of the
relationship -->

<Reference displayName="level_2" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#1_2" target="uri:application-


modules/power/model/type#level_2" />
</Type>

<Type displayName="level_2" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/type#level_2">


<Attribute displayName="id" dataType="String" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/attribute#name" />
<!-- this is the other end of the relationship marked above - isReverse is opposite, relation#... must be equal -->
<Reference displayName="level_1" isReverse="true" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#1_2"
target="uri:application-modules/power/model/type#level_1" />
<Reference displayName="level_3" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#2_3" target="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#level_3" />
</Type>

<Type displayName="level_3" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/type#level_3">


<Attribute displayName="id" dataType="String" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/attribute#name" />
<Reference displayName="level_2" isReverse="true" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#2_3"
target="uri:application-modules/power/model/type#level_2" />
<Reference displayName="level_4" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#3_4" target="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#level_4" />
<Reference displayName="device" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#meteredBy" target="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#device" />
</Type>

<Type displayName="level_4" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/type#level_4">


<Attribute displayName="id" dataType="String" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/attribute#name" />
<Reference displayName="level_3" isReverse="true" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#3_4"
target="uri:application-modules/power/model/type#level_3" />
<Reference displayName="level_5" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#4_5" target="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#level_5" />
<Reference displayName="device" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#meteredBy" target="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#device" />

</Type>

<Type displayName="level_5" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/type#level_5">


<Attribute displayName="id" dataType="String" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/attribute#name" />
<Reference displayName="level_4" isReverse="true" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#4_5"
target="uri:application-modules/power/model/type#level_4" />

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 789


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

<!-- this is how to connect up a logical/physical device to provide metered data to a node this can appear anywhere in the
hierarchy e.g. main meter for building, metering points for specific loads, managed circuits for multi-circuit monitors -->
<Reference displayName="device" uri="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#meteredBy" target="uri:application-
modules/power/model/type#device" />
</Type>

</Types>

<Views>

<!-- View displayName shows up in the drop-down of Reports/Gadgets -->


<!-- specify the node type to start at, then add the relations to follow -->
<View displayName="Generic Layout" rootNodeTypeUri="uri:application-modules/power/model/type#level_1">
<Relation follow="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#1_2" />
<Relation follow="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#2_3" />
<Relation follow="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#3_4" />
<Relation follow="uri:application-modules/power/model/relation#4_5" />
</View>

<!-- do not need to add the "meteredBy" relation in the View if a "meteredBy" relation has a mapped device no matter what
level of the hierarchy then the aggregation will return the value from the mapped device -->
</Views>
</Template>

790 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Hierarchy Manager

Depending on the number of devices you are currently monitoring, organizing the data coming from
those devices can be a difficult task. Hierarchy Manager allows you to organize the devices in
EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert into recognizable views by defining their relationships as
parts of a system model. Once the model has been created, energy data associated with the
hierarchy can be grouped, aggregated, and used by other components of Power Monitoring Expert.

The Hierarchy Manager views are intended to represent the real world electrical, physical, and
business characteristics of your organization. The items contained in a view, and how those items
relate to each other are specified using a template approach. There are several example templates
included in the product to help you create the views applicable to your organization. One of these
templates is configured when Power Monitoring Expert is first installed.

Open the Hierarchy Manager from Settings > System > Hierarchies in the Web Applications
banner. You can also open Hierarchy Manager from the Tools > Web Tools menu in the
Management Console.
The following topics provide specific information regarding the features and use of the Hierarchy
Manager application:

• Hierarchy templates
Nodes

Node properties

Common elements of hierarchy templates

• Creating a hierarchy

• Creating an apportioned meter

• Creating a virtual meter

• Dynamic hierarchy

• Meter apportionment

• Virtual meter

• Using hierarchies in other applications

After you have configured the views of the hierarchy structure, you can use them in different areas
of Power Monitoring Expert.

NOTE: Before using Hierarchy Manager, ensure that devices, logical devices, or managed circuits
have been added to Power Monitoring Expert through the Management Console component.

Hierarchy templates
When the Hierarchy Manager application opens, everything displayed in the application is based on
the hierarchy template defined in the system. This template defines the parameters of the model. If
you were to describe the physical layout of a building for example, you could describe the name of

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 791


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

the building, each floor of the building, and the rooms or areas that each floor contains. The
hierarchy template for a building's physical layout does the same thing, using Nodes to represent
the different aspects of the model.

Note that a Virtual Meter Node is included in the hierarchy template. You can define virtual meters
without associating them with a hierarchy, or you can include virtual meters in a hierarchy the same
way that you include devices. You can select virtual meters for many of the reports in the Reports
application.

Each Node contains instances of that particular Node type, which in turn are defined by a set of
properties. These properties not only define the different parts of the model, they also define the
relationships that exist between the different Nodes. This is useful when aggregating the device
data used in other parts of Power Monitoring Expert.

Once the model has been created, the devices that are collecting data can be associated with the
different levels of the hierarchy that are defined in the template.

Nodes
A Node can be described as the building block of a hierarchy. Nodes are used to model a customer
system and can represent:

• Electrical equipment

• Logical concepts

• Physical locations

• Other real-world objects

Nodes are displayed in Hierarchy Manager as a set of tabs. Each tab is labeled with the name of the
part of the model it represents. Each Node displays a number of Node instances in a grid format. In
Hierarchy Manager, a Node can be described as the type of object required to model a system,
while Node instances can be thought of as the reference to the real-world objects in that system.
For example, if 'Car' is used as an example of a Node, then 'my Corvette' could describe an
instance of the Car Node.

A hierarchy that represents the physical layout of a company's industrial site might have a Site
Node, a Building Node, and an Areas Node. Each of those Nodes can contain instances of that
Node type. Under the Building Node for example, you could list the different buildings located in a
particular site. The Properties of each of these Nodes are specified by the user.

Each Node instance is represented in the system as a set of properties that define the
characteristics of that instance. These properties can be further broken down into Attributes and
References.

Node properties
Attributes and References can be used to describe the properties of a Node, and their relationships
to other Nodes. These properties provide the context that helps to describe the different parts of the

792 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

model. For example, a Node called Floors might contain attributes such as floor number, and
references such as the association between the Floors Node and the Building Node, or the
association between Floors and Areas.

Attributes
The Attributes of a Node describe the properties of that Node, such as its name and characteristics.
These Attributes could include the breaker rating of an electrical panel or contact information of a
tenant. For example, a Node called Buildings that is part of a physical layout hierarchy could have
an Attribute such as the building name.

Attributes are configurable by entering information into an Attribute field. To add Attribute content to
a new Node instance, select a tab and click Add. To edit existing Attribute content, double-click a
Node instance, or highlight it and click Edit. When the Properties dialog opens, select an attribute
field by clicking in the applicable field and entering the necessary information. Click OK when you
finish specifying all of the necessary attributes for the Node.

References
References describe how a Node in a hierarchy is associated with other Nodes. For example, in a
hierarchy that describes the physical layout of a company's building, a Node called Floor could have
a reference that describes its association with a Node called Areas. These references indicate
which offices are part of each floor. In this example, since a Floor can contain many offices, it is
considered a one-to-many association. Since an office can only be associated with a single floor, it
is considered a one-to-one association. By making these connections between the Nodes, the
hierarchy structure of the model begins to take shape.

Reference fields require clicking Add, Edit, or Delete. To add reference content to a Node instance,
click Add for the reference, then select the appropriate entry from the list that appears. You can also
enter dynamic hierarchy time ranges in this section.

To edit existing reference content, double-click the entry in the grid, or highlight it and click Edit, and
then make the necessary changes. In most cases, this change would involve either the start or end
dates of the particular reference.

To delete existing reference content, select an entry from the applicable reference type and click
Delete.

NOTE: The Delete button should not be used to end an association with a particular Node
instance. When a relationship between two Node instances ends after a certain date, the ideal
solution is to edit the references and change the To field to a specific end date that defines the
time range for the relationship. See Creating a hierarchy for more information.

Common elements of hierarchy templates


The components that make up Hierarchy Manager can appear differently depending on the hierarchy
template installed in the system. Although these different hierarchy templates can have different tab
and property names, and the relationships between the Nodes differ, the method used to modify the
hierarchy is similar for most templates. This section provides information regarding the basic steps
to modifying a hierarchy, regardless of the template used.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 793


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Hierarchy Manager has a series of tabs across the top of the page. These tabs are the
representation of the Nodes. Clicking on any of these tabs displays the instances of the Node types
in a grid format.

The process involved with creating an instance of a Node type is the same for most hierarchy
templates. To create a new instance, select the applicable tab and click Add. The Properties
window opens, containing fields that represent the properties for that particular Node instance. Any
required fields are identified with a Required message. Click in the attribute fields and enter the
necessary information. Reference fields are selected from a grid and can also have a time
dimension associated with them (see Dynamic hierarchy for additional information). Click Add to
open the Select dialog and select the applicable item from the grid. If there are no items to choose
from, you might need to create a new instance for that Node type.

To edit an instance of a Node type, click the applicable tab, double-click an instance in the grid, or
select it and click Edit. Make the changes to the applicable fields in the Properties dialog and click
OK.

To delete an existing instance of a Node type, select the applicable tab, select an instance on that
tab and click Delete. After you confirm the delete action, the instance disappears from the grid, and
any reference information regarding the deleted instance is removed from all affected Node
instances.

Tree View
Displaying the views of a template is also similar for most template types. You can see the view of
a hierarchy by clicking the Show Views link. The view shows the different levels of the hierarchy,
and the date range for each entry of the hierarchy.

Date Range: Use the To and From fields to select the date range to display the hierarchy.

Available Views: Use this section to switch between different views if there is more than one view
available. The available views are determined by the hierarchy template. Click Update when you
change the date range, the scale, or view.

Scale: Select Days or Months to provide the appropriate scale to the hierarchy view.

Beside each hierarchy level is a bar that indicates when in the date range the Node was part of the
hierarchy. If the bar has a rounded edge, the Node reference has an end date within the date range.
If the bar has a square edge, the Node reference continues beyond the date range.

You can click the pencil (edit) icon to the left of the bars to open and edit the properties for the
related item.

If you do not see a node in the hierarchy view, make sure the date range includes the date that Node
was part of the hierarchy. You can view the date range for a hierarchy entry by hovering the pointer
on it.

Creating a hierarchy
The following example uses the default hierarchy template (with Site, Buildings, and Areas nodes)
to illustrate the basic functionality of Hierarchy Manager.

794 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

In this scenario, we are the facility manager for Faber College. The college includes three buildings,
two of which have already been added to Hierarchy Manager. Building Three has just been
completed, and we must add this building to our hierarchy using Hierarchy Manager. This involves
creating a new building and areas entries, and adding devices to the areas, all beginning on a
specific date.

At the same time, renovations to Building Two have just been completed which include the
replacement of a meter. We need to swap the old device with the new one in our hierarchy by setting
the end date for the existing device and the start date for the new device. The new device must be
associated with the correct area.

Open Hierarchy Manager

NOTE: Access to this application or function is controlled by user privileges. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

1. Open Hierarchy Manager in one of the following ways:


From Web Applications Settings > System > Hierarchies

From Management Console Tools > Web Tools > Hierarchy Manager.

2. Type a user name and password in the Log In dialog, if required, and click OK to open
Hierarchy Manager.

NOTE: In the following steps, devices have already been added to the system, and the
hierarchy has been populated with site, building, and area information.

Site, Buildings, and Areas tabs represent each Node type.

Add a building to the hierarchy


1. Click the Buildings tab.

The Buildings grid includes Building One and Two, the site they are associated with, and the
areas defined for each building.

2. To add Building Three, click Add above the Buildings grid to open the Properties dialog for the
Buildings node, then enter the building name in the Name field.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 795


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. Click Add above the Site grid, in the properties dialog, to open the Add Site References
dialog and select the Faber College site name in the grid. Then click the From date field or
click the calendar icon beside it at the bottom of the dialog. Select a start date in the calendar.

4. Confirm that the date has changed in the Start Date column under Sites, then click OK.

796 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Associate areas and devices to Building Three


1. Click the Areas tab.

A new area needs to be created, Area 3. Associate this area with the new building, assign a
device to the area, and set the start date.

2. Click Add above the Areas grid to open the Properties dialog for the Areas node, then type
Area 3 in the Name field.

3. Click Add above the Building grid to open the Add Building References dialog.

4. Select Building Three in the grid.

5. Click the From field or click the calendar icon and select a start date.

6. Confirm that the date has changed in the From field under Building, then click OK.

7. Click Add above the Device grid to open the Add Device References dialog.

8. Select a device.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 797


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

9. Click the From field or click the calendar icon and select a start date.

10. Confirm that the date has changed in the Start Date column under Device, then click OK.

The following image shows the complete set of entries on the Areas tab.

View the hierarchy in a tree configuration


To see the hierarchy in a tree organization, switch to the Tree View by clicking Show Views, in the
top right corner of the Hierarchy Manager window. You can use this window to select the type of
view you want to see (if multiple views are available), and the date range for the view. Click Update
to refresh the view after you make your selections.
Click:

• The plus sign in the view to expand that entry.

• The minus sign beside an entry to collapse that part of the hierarchy.

• The pencil (edit) icon to open and edit the properties for the related item.

• The bar for each entry to see the Node name and the effective date range for that entry.

• Click Show Types to return to the initial Hierarchy Manager page.

798 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Adding and removing devices


This part of the example involves replacing a device in Building Two after a renovation. Set the end
date for the device you are replacing to the date they are removed. Then assign a new device to the
area with the start date set to the day the device is installed.

The device that you are replacing is associated with Area 2 in Building Two.
When this task is complete:

• The entry for the old device is dimmed and italicized in the hierarchy if the End Date is the
current date or earlier.

• Any reports that include the area only include data collected by the device up to this new end
date.

NOTE: Date ranges extend from start of day to start of day. This means that the end date does not
include data collected for that day.

1. Open Hierarchy Manager and click the Areas tab.

2. Double-click Area 2 in the grid or select it and click Edit to open the properties dialog.

3. Double-click Campus.Library device in the Device grid, or select it and click Edit to open the
Edit Device References dialog.

4. Click the To field, or click the calendar icon beside it, and select the end date.

5. Confirm that the date has changed in the End Date column under Device, then click OK.

6. Click Add above the Device grid to open the Add Device References dialog.

7. Select the new device, Campus.Library_NEW.

8. Click the From field or click the calendar icon beside it. Select the start date.

9. Confirm that the date has changed in the Start Date column under Device, then click OK.

When you complete these tasks, any reports that include this area with a date range that extends
beyond the device start date includes data collected by the new device as of their start date. The
reports do not include any data for the removed device as of their end date.

Creating an apportioned meter


You can create an apportioned meter when you add a device to a hierarchy node by changing the
value in the Percentage field in the Add Device References dialog. The default value is 100 percent.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 799


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The percentage can be a negative, positive, or integer value. The percentage field is restricted to 15
characters. Time intervals for apportioned meters function in the same way as devices. See Meter
apportionment for more information.
To create an apportioned meter:

1. In Hierarchy Manager, open the AREAS tab.

2. Select the area for which you want to create an apportioned meter and click Edit to open the
properties dialog.

3. In the area properties dialog, under Devices, select the device and click Edit. This opens the
Edit Device References dialog.

4. Change the value in the Percentage field.

5. If required, click the From or To fields to change the start and end dates for the apportioned
meter.

6. Click OK.

Creating a virtual meter


The Virtual Meter tab includes Add, Edit, and Delete controls above a data grid showing any
previously created virtual meters.

Add: Selecting Add opens the Properties dialog. Type a name for the virtual meter and click Add in
the Devices area to select devices to attach to it. You can attach a device, a previously created
virtual meter, or an apportioned meter in the same way you attach a device to a hierarchy node.

Time intervals for start and end dates work the same as on meters attached to hierarchy nodes.

Edit: Editing a virtual meter is like editing the relationship between a hierarchy node and a device.
You can add, edit, or delete virtual meters but you need to ensure that your changes respect time
intervals.

800 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For example, if you are replacing a meter, you need to update the End Date for it, and you need to
specify an appropriate Start Date for the new meter. Do not delete the original meter as this
removes the meter historically.

Delete: You can delete a virtual meter, but you need to take care when doing so. When you delete a
virtual meter, the relationships between all hierarchy nodes and the virtual meter are removed.

Adding a virtual meter to a hierarchy node


After you create a virtual meter, it appears in device lists with the other devices. You can attach a
virtual meter to a hierarchy node in the same way as the other devices.

See Virtual meter for more information.

Dynamic hierarchy
Another feature of Hierarchy Manager is the ability to assign devices or Node instances for discrete
units of time. Instead of devices existing in either an assigned or unassigned state independent of
time, a device can be assigned to one Node instance for a specific length of time, then assigned to
another instance for another length of time.

With this time dimension, Hierarchy Manager can be used by organizations that require an ever-
changing representation of their system. If one tenant moves out and another moves in, that change
can be reflected in the hierarchy. Energy and power usage can be tracked for each tenant over time,
and billing information can be collected, aggregated, and displayed in a report.

NOTE: If your hierarchy does not change over time you do not need to set the date ranges for the
various devices or Node instances. In Power Monitoring Expert, these static hierarchies exist from
the date when the system was first commissioned (system start), to the farthest date the system
recognizes (end of time).

Replacing or reconfiguring a device can also be captured in a hierarchy. If a device requires


replacement or reconfiguring, it can be unassigned from an instance on a specific date, and the new
or reconfigured device assigned to the same instance. The entry for the unassigned device is
grayed-out and italicized in the hierarchy if the End Date is the current date or earlier.

Dynamic hierarchies are established when you create or edit the properties of a Node instance that
is associated with a device. For example, if Customer A is set to lease a rack from a data center,
you can assign the racks and circuits to that customer on a specific date. When tenant A's lease
expires, you can remove the assignment of the racks and circuits on the expiration date and
reallocate them to tenant B.

See Creating a hierarchy for details on how to use the dynamic hierarchies function.

Meter apportionment
Meter apportionment allows you to assign a percentage of a device that has been assigned to an
area. For example, if a common area is monitored by a single meter but shared by two tenants, for
billing purposes you might want to allocate only a portion of the meter to each tenant. If tenant 1
uses 60% of the common area and tenant 2 uses 40%, you can attach 60% of a meter's reading to
the tenant 1 area node and the other 40% to the tenant 2 area node.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 801


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

See Creating an apportioned meter for more information.

Virtual meter
A virtual meter allows you to aggregate measurements from any combination of devices,
apportioned meters, or other virtual meters available in Hierarchy Manager. The newly created
virtual meter can be assigned to a node in Hierarchy Manager just like any other device and appears
in dialogs that have a Views selection. You can even create an apportioned meter from a virtual
meter.
Examples:

• Assume that there are several feeder meters connected to the main power bus and you want to
calculate the total power usage. You can create a virtual meter that includes each of the feeder
meters. Then you can choose one of the reports supporting virtual meters to generate a report
showing the total power usage for the virtual meter.

• Assume that there is a large area monitored by a single meter (M1). Within that area is a single
room that is monitored by a separate meter (M2). Tenant 1 is using the small room and Tenant 2
is using the remaining area. To calculate Tenant 2's power usage, the readings from M2 must
be subtracted from the readings of M1. This can be accomplished by assigning M1 and an
apportioned meter of M2 with an allocation of -100%, removing M2's readings from Tenant 2's
power usage calculation.

The alternative is to create a virtual meter. For example, create a new virtual meter Tenant_2_
Net_Meter, and assign the two devices, M1 and M2 (-100%), to the virtual meter. The virtual
meter is assigned to Tenant 2's node. If at some time in the future a new meter is added, you
can edit the virtual meter to include the new meter.

See Creating a virtual meter for more information.

Data aggregation in Hierarchies


A Hierarchy aggregates the measurements from the device nodes all the way up through the
different hierarchy levels. For example, a hierarchy with the levels Building > Floor > Areas, where
the monitoring devices are associated with the Areas, will show the aggregation of all the area
measurements for a floor at the Floor level and the aggregation of all floor measurements at the
Building level.
Example: Measurements aggregating up the hierarchy

Hierarchy Level 1 Hierarchy Level 2 Hierarchy Level 3 Hierarchy Level 4

Building [22kWh] (aggregated)

Floor 1 [10kWh] (aggregated)

Area 1 [7kWh] (aggregated)

Device - 5kWh (measured)

Device - 2kWh (measured)

Area 2 [3kWh] (aggregated)


Device - 3kWh (measured)

802 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Hierarchy Level 1 Hierarchy Level 2 Hierarchy Level 3 Hierarchy Level 4

Floor 2 [12kWh] (aggregated)

Area 3 [12kWh] (aggregated)

Device - 12kWh (measured)

The starting point for the aggregation in the Hierarchy is a device node. The Hierarchy will not
include measurements from nodes below the device node in the aggregation.
Example: Device nodes are the beginning of the aggregation.

Hierarchy Level 1 Hierarchy Level 2 Hierarchy Level 3 Hierarchy Level 4

Building [14kWh]
(aggregated)
Floor 1 [2kWh] (aggregated)
Device - 2kWh (measured)
Area 1 [7kWh] (aggregated)

Device - 5kWh (measured)

Device - 2kWh (measured)

Area 2 [3kWh] (aggregated)


Device - 3kWh (measured)
Floor 2 [12kWh] (aggregated)

Area 3 [12kWh] (aggregated)

Device - 12kWh (measured)

By associating a device with the Floor 1 node, this node becomes the starting point for the
aggregation. The measurements of the child nodes Area 1 and Area 2 are ignored. Only the device
measurement associated with Floor 1 is included in the aggregation.

NOTE: Not all Hierarchy nodes can have devices associated with them. If devices can be
associated with a certain node level in a hierarchy or not, is defined in the template for this
hierarchy.

Using hierarchies in other applications


You can use hierarchies in the following Power Monitoring Expert (PME) applications:

• Dashboards

• Reports

• Trends

In the Dashboards application, you can use hierarchies in the gadget data series selector to select
data from a source based on its location in the hierarchy. Selecting a hierarchy View allows you to
group device data at different aggregation points in the hierarchy. For example, it is possible to
create a dashboard that depicts the energy usage of a single floor in a building as a single data
series even though there are multiple meters monitoring different circuits.

You can also use hierarchies in several of the reports available in the Reports application. You can
use the source selector for these reports to select items from the hierarchy to include in the report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 803


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

As in the Dashboards application, a hierarchy View groups device data at different aggregation
points, which are then displayed in a report. In addition to the default reports, hierarchies can also be
used in custom reports that have been created for use in different solutions.

You can use hierarchies in the Trends application to select data from a source based on its location
in the hierarchy.

804 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool for ANSI


TIP: You can open the Insulation Monitoring Tool from the Power Monitoring Expert >
Configuration Tools folder on your desktop.

NOTE: This version of the Insulation Monitoring Tool is for the ANSI market.

Use the Insulation Monitoring Tool to configure the Insulation Monitoring Module. With this tool you
define Isolated Power Panels, Areas, and Groups for the Insulation Monitoring Report (ANSI), and
you generate Vista diagrams (ANSI).

See Insulation Monitoring Module configuration for details.

Prerequisites
• The isolated power panel monitoring devices that are recording the panel data must be
configured in the PME Management Console and must be communicating before you can
configure the components and properties in the configuration tool.

User Interface
Each tab contains a grid area and an editor area. The grid area is empty initially, but it will be
populated with entries that you define. Use the editor area to define the settings for new items or to
update the settings for existing items.
The following controls are common for the tabs:

• Help - Click this to view online help for the tab.

• New - Creates a new entry in the grid.

• Delete - Deletes the selected entry from the grid.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 805


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Revert - Returns a modified record to its original values, if OK or Apply have not been clicked.

• OK - Saves all changes and exits the configuration tool.

• Cancel - Exits the tool without saving changes.

• Apply - Saves all changes and leaves the tool open.

The Modified column in the grid area shows the status of the row data:

+ (plus) - a new entry.

* (asterisk) - a modified entry.

! (exclamation mark) - entry needs more information before it can be saved.

NOTE: The first time you open the Insulation Monitoring Tool, you must set the Configuration
Type. Choose between ANSI and IEC. For ANSI, you must also set the Total Hazard Current
Threshold. The Initial Configuration Setup dialog is only displayed the first time you open the tool.
After the initial selection, the tool remains in the selected type for future startups. To show this
dialog again and choose different settings, hold down Shift when opening the tool.

Defining Isolated Power Panels (ANSI)


Associate Line Isolation Monitoring devices (LIM-IG6) and Fault Location monitors (Bender EDS)
with power panels.
To add a new Isolated Power Panel:

1. Click the Panels tab and then click New.

2. Enter the following information:


Device: Select a Line Isolation Monitor device for this panel.

Display Name: Enter a name for the device.

Fault Location Devices: (Optional) Select the fault location monitoring devices that are
connected to the Line Insulation Monitor.

Monitoring Options: (Optional) Select the monitoring options that are configured for the
Line Isolation Monitor device.

806 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

NOTE: All Fault Location monitoring devices, Bender EDS, that are configured in the system
are displayed automatically in the Fault Location Devices list. If no devices are displayed,
that means that none are configured in the system.

3. (Optional) Repeat steps 1 - 2 to add additional Isolated Power Panels.

4. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

To update an existing Isolated Power Panel:

1. On the Panels tab, click the Isolated Power Panel you want to update.

2. Change the name, panel, and monitoring device selections as needed.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

To delete an existing Isolated Power Panel:

1. On the Panels tab, click the Isolated Power Panel you want to delete.

2. Click Delete.

NOTE: Regenerate the Vista diagrams after changing the Isolated Power Panel configuration.

Defining Areas
Associate Isolated Power Panels with areas.
To add a new Area:

1. Click the Areas tab and then click New.

2. Enter the following information:


Name: Enter a name for the area.

Panels: Select the panels that are associated with the area. The panels listed are the
ones you configured on the Panels tab.

3. (Optional) Repeat steps 1 - 2 to add additional areas.

4. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

To update an existing Area:

1. On the Areas tab, click the area you want to update.

2. Change the name and panel selection as needed.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

To delete an existing Area:

1. On the Areas tab, click the area you want to delete.

2. Click Delete.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 807


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: Regenerate the Vista diagrams after changing the Areas configuration.

Defining Groups
Combine areas into groups.
To add a new Group:

1. Click the Groups tab and then click New.

2. Enter the following information:


Name: Enter a name for the group.

Areas: Select the areas that you want to be part of the group. The areas listed are the
ones you configured on the Areas tab.

3. (Optional) Repeat steps 1 - 2 to add additional groups.

4. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

To update an existing Group:

1. On the Groups tab, click the Group you want to update.

2. Change the name and area selections as needed.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

To delete an existing Group:

1. On the Groups tab, click the Group you want to delete.

2. Click Delete.

NOTE: Regenerate the Vista diagrams after changing the Groups configuration.

Generating Vista diagrams


Create diagrams to view real-time status information on the areas in a group.
To generate Vista diagrams:

1. In the Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool, click the Groups tab, and then click Generate
Vista Diagrams to open the Vista Diagram Generation dialog.

NOTE: At least one group must be configured for the Generate Vista Diagrams command to
be available.

2. In Vista Diagram Generation, select the output path for the diagram files and select the groups
for which you want to generate diagrams.

3. (Optional) Select Include Custom Logo and then select the logo image file for the diagrams.
By default, a Schneider Electric logo is used.

808 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

4. Under Options, drag the indicator to define the width of Vista diagrams you generate.

NOTE: The Diagram Width setting determines the width of the actual Vista diagrams, the
width of the background image inside the diagrams, and the width of the boxes that show the
groups, areas, and area details information. Choose a larger value for this setting if you have
many groups or areas. Choose a smaller value if you only have a small number of groups and
areas.

5. Click Generate Vista Diagrams to generate the diagram files, then click OK and Close.

6. Check the Vista diagrams and repeat steps 4.-5. if you need to adjust the diagram width.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 809


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool for IEC


TIP: You can open the Insulation Monitoring Tool from the Power Monitoring Expert >
Configuration Tools folder on your desktop.

NOTE: This version of the Insulation Monitoring Tool is for the IEC market.

Use the Insulation Monitoring Tool to configure the Insulation Monitoring Module. With this tool you
define Isolated Power Panels, Areas, and Groups for the Insulation Monitoring Report (IEC), and
you generate Vista diagrams (IEC).

See Insulation Monitoring Module configuration for details.

Prerequisites
• The isolated power panel monitoring devices that are recording the panel data must be
configured in the PME Management Console and must be communicating before you can
configure the components and properties in the configuration tool.

User Interface
Each tab contains a grid area and an editor area. The grid area is empty initially, but it will be
populated with entries that you define. Use the editor area to define the settings for new items or to
update the settings for existing items.
The following controls are common for the tabs:

• Help - Click this to view online help for the tab.

• New - Creates a new entry in the grid.

• Delete - Deletes the selected entry from the grid.

• Revert - Returns a modified record to its original values, if OK or Apply have not been clicked.

810 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• OK - Saves all changes and exits the configuration tool.

• Cancel - Exits the tool without saving changes.

• Apply - Saves all changes and leaves the tool open.

The Modified column in the grid area shows the status of the row data:

+ (plus) - a new entry.

* (asterisk) - a modified entry.

! (exclamation mark) - entry needs more information before it can be saved.

NOTE: The first time you open the Insulation Monitoring Tool, you must set the Configuration
Type. Choose between ANSI and IEC. For ANSI, you must also set the Total Hazard Current
Threshold. The Initial Configuration Setup dialog is only displayed the first time you open the tool.
After the initial selection, the tool remains in the selected type for future startups. To show this
dialog again and choose different settings, hold down Shift when opening the tool.

Defining Isolated Power Panels (IEC)


Associate Insulation Monitoring (IM) devices and Insulation Fault Locator (IFL) devices with power
panels.
To add a new Isolated Power Panel:

1. Click the Panels tab and then click New.

2. Enter the following information:


Device: Select the IM device for this panel.

Display Name: Enter a name for the device.

Fault Location Devices: (Optional) Select the IFL device for this power panel.

NOTE: All IFL devices that are configured in the system are displayed automatically in the
Fault Location Devices list. If no devices are displayed, that means that none are configured
in the system.

3. (Optional) Repeat steps 1 - 2 to add additional Isolated Power Panels.

4. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 811


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To update an existing Isolated Power Panel:

1. On the Panels tab, click the Isolated Power Panel you want to update.

2. Make the changes as needed.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

To delete an existing Isolated Power Panel:

1. On the Panels tab, click the Isolated Power Panel you want to delete.

2. Click Delete.

NOTE: Regenerate the Vista diagrams after changing the Isolated Power Panel configuration.

Defining Areas
Associate an Isolated Power Panels with areas.
To add a new Area:

1. Click the Areas tab and then click New.

2. Enter the following information:


Name: Enter a name for the area.

Panels: Select the panel that is associated with the area. The panels listed are the ones
you configured on the Panels tab.

NOTE: With IEC, you can have only one panel per area.

3. (Optional) Repeat steps 1 - 2 to add additional areas.

4. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

To update an existing Area:

1. On the Areas tab, click the area you want to update.

2. Change the name and panel selection as needed.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

To delete an existing Area:

1. On the Areas tab, click the area you want to delete.

2. Click Delete.

NOTE: Regenerate the Vista diagrams after changing the Areas configuration.

Defining Groups
Combine areas into groups.

812 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

To add a new Group:

1. Click the Groups tab and then click New.

2. Enter the following information:


Name: Enter a name for the group.

Areas: Select the areas that you want to be part of the group. The areas listed are the
ones you configured on the Areas tab.

3. (Optional) Repeat steps 1 - 2 to add additional groups.

4. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

To update an existing Group:

1. On the Groups tab, click the Group you want to update.

2. Change the name and area selections as needed.

3. Click Apply to save the changes and keep the configuration tool open. Click OK to save the
changes and close the configuration tool.

To delete an existing Group:

1. On the Groups tab, click the Group you want to delete.

2. Click Delete.

NOTE: Regenerate the Vista diagrams after changing the Groups configuration.

Generating Vista diagrams


Create diagrams to view real-time status information on the areas in a group.
To generate Vista diagrams:

1. In the Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool, click the Groups tab, and then click Generate
Vista Diagrams to open the Vista Diagram Generation dialog.

NOTE: At least one group must be configured for the Generate Vista Diagrams command to
be available.

2. In Vista Diagram Generation, select the output path for the diagram files and select the groups
for which you want to generate diagrams.

3. (Optional) Select Include Custom Logo and then select the logo image file for the diagrams.
By default, a Schneider Electric logo is used.

4. Under Options, drag the indicator to define the width of Vista diagrams you generate.

NOTE: The Diagram Width setting determines the width of the actual Vista diagrams, the
width of the background image inside the diagrams, and the width of the boxes that show the
groups, areas, and area details information. Choose a larger value for this setting if you have
many groups or areas. Choose a smaller value if you only have a small number of groups and
areas.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 813


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

5. Click Generate Vista Diagrams to generate the diagram files, then click OK and Close.

6. Check the Vista diagrams and repeat steps 4.-5. if you need to adjust the diagram width.

814 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Log Viewer

TIP: You can open Log Viewer from the SETTINGS > System > System Log page in Web
Applications.

Use Log Viewer to view PME system events. System events are logged by the software and its
components to record certain system activities. Examples of system events include a user logging
on, a user logging off, time synchronization sent from the system to the devices, system warnings,
and so on.

NOTE: The Log Viewer only shows system events, it does not show device-based events or
historical data. To view device event log data, use Alarm Views. To view device historical data,
use Dashboards, Diagrams, or Reports.

Log Viewer User Interface

Date Range Selector.


1
Select the time range for which you want to display the system log entries.
Max Records.
2
Set the maximum number of entries to be displayed in the system log table.
Minimum Priority.
Filter lower priority log entries from the system log table view.
3
The available options, in increasing priority order, are: Diagnostics, Information, Warning,
Error, Critical.
Log Type.

Filter log entries in the system log table view based on the area of the software where they
4 originated.
The available options are: All, Application (= web application components), System (=
platform components).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 815


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Category Filter.

Filter log entries in the system log table view based on the component or function they relate
5 to.
The large number of different category options is available for this filter.

TIP: Selecting the Audit category shows user login and logoff activity.

Location Filter.
6 Enter a filter string into the text box to filter the system log table view based on the Location
column information.
Message Filter.
7 Enter a filter string into the text box to filter the system log table view based on the Message
column information.
Details Filter.
8 Enter a filter string into the text box to filter the system log table view based on the Details
column information.
Column Selector.
9
Select which columns are displayed in the system log table.
Refresh.
10
Reload the content of the system log table.
Copy Selection to Clipboard.
Copy the content of selected system log table entries to the clipboard, for use in another
application. Information for all possible columns is included in the copied details, regardless if
11
the columns are displayed in the table view or not.

TIP: Use Shift + click or Ctrl + click to select multiple rows in the table.

Export

Export the content of selected system log table entries in .csv file format, for use in another
12 application. Information for all possible columns is included in the copied details, regardless if
the columns are displayed in the table view or not.

TIP: Use Shift + click or Ctrl + click to select multiple rows in the table.

Search Logs
13 Enter a filter string into the text box to filter the system log table view based on the Details
column information.
System log table
The System log table shows system events for the selected time range and filter settings.
See 1-8 above.
14
TIP: Double-click a row in the table or select a row and hit Enter to view details for this log
entry.

Number of displayed items


15 Shows the number of items visible on this page, and the total number for the selected time
range and filter settings. See 1-8 above.

816 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Page selector.
16 Use the page selector to navigate between pages. Set the number of items that are displayed
on a page.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 817


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Logical Device editors


The logical device functionality allows you to assign logical names to output registers on physical
devices, and associate the generic inputs with standard measurements, including WAGES
measurements.

Before you can create a logical device, the physical device that it references must be created. You
can create one or more logical devices from a single physical device, or you can also create a single
logical device from several physical devices.
After you create a logical device, you can view its real-time data in the following components:

• Vista.

• The Diagrams application in the Web Applications component.

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

Each logical device has a logical device type associated with it. Each logical device type is defined
with a collection of output measurements. The measurements defined by the device type become
the output measurements for instances of that device type, that is, for the logical devices. You use
the Logical Device Type Editor to create logical device types. See Using the Logical Device Type
Editor for information about viewing, creating, editing, and deleting logical device types.

The Logical Device Editor in Management Console allows you to configure specific logical devices
by mapping input registers to output measurements that are defined in the associated device type.
See Using the Logical Device Editor for information about creating, configuring, editing, and deleting
logical devices.

Open the Logical Device editor applications from the Tools menu in the Management Console.

NOTE: Access to this application or function is controlled by user privileges. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

Using the Logical Device Type Editor


Use the Logical Device Type Editor to define a collection of output measurements for each logical
device type. Logical device types created with this editor are available for selection in the Logical
Device Editor, where you map input registers to output measurements.

818 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Open the Logical Device Type Editor


1. Start Management Console and log in using an account with supervisor-level access.

2. Select Tools > Logical Device > Logical Device Type Editor.

The top portion of the editor contains a logical device type display grid listing the logical device
types that have been defined. The bottom portion is an edit area where you can modify existing
device types and their measurements, or create new ones.

A Display grid area B Edit area - Summary tab C Edit area - Measurement tab

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 819


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The display grid area


The Modified column displays one of the following characters indicating a change of status of an
entry:
+ (plus) - a new entry.

* (asterisk) - an existing entry has been modified.

! (exclamation mark) - the entry is incomplete or in error.

The Type Name column contains the names for the defined device types. Type names must be
unique.

The System Measurements and Custom Measurements columns show the number of
measurements that have been defined for each device type.

The edit area


When a device type is selected in the display grid, the current information for that device type is
displayed in the edit area. The edit area has a Summary tab and a Measurement tab.
The Summary tab contains the following:

• A Type Name field showing the name of the device type that is selected in the display grid at
the top.

• In the Measurements area, expand System and Custom to view the measurements defined
for these respective categories. You can expand each list to show all of the measurements that
have been defined for the selected device type.

• A Notes input field that you can use to describe the device type.

The Measurement tab contains the following:

• Options that indicate whether to display the measurements with descriptive names or
engineering names.

• An Available Measurements dropdown list that contains category names for the
measurements, such as Air, Current, and Voltage. When you select one of these categories,
only those measurements associated with the selected category appear in the grid.

The default All in the list displays all of the categories and their respective measurements in the
grid.

• An available measurements grid listing the measurements available for selection when you
define a device type. Measurements that are grayed out indicate that they have been added to
the selected device type. Clicking New opens a dialog for defining a new, custom
measurement. An X in the Custom column identifies the entry as a custom measurement. The
Edit and Delete links give you the option to modify or delete custom measurements only.

NOTE: It is recommended that you add a new custom measurement only if an existing
measurement does not suffice. Factory-defined System Measurements contain considerable
information about their type and usage, which is then used throughout the system to provide
intelligent assistance in Dashboard controls and Report selections. Since custom
measurements do not have this information, their usage may not provide the expected results.

820 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• A Measurements For grid that lists the measurements that comprise the device type that is
selected in the display grid area. Use the >> button to add a measurement that you selected in
the list of available measurements to the Measurements For list for the device type.
Measurements that you select for a device type are grayed out to indicate that they have been
assigned to the device type. Use the << button to remove a selected measurement from the
Measurements For grid. Measurements that are removed are no longer grayed out in the list of
available measurements and they are available for selection.

Note that if you attempt to delete a custom measurement that has been mapped to any logical
device, a message indicates that the measurement cannot be deleted. You need to unmap the
custom measurement from the logical devices before you can delete it.

In all grids:

• Each of the columns can be sorted in ascending or descending order when you click on the
column heading.

• When you place your cursor on a column heading, a filter icon appears on the right side of the
heading area. Click this icon to open a list of items that are available for filtering. Click the item
that you want to use as the filter. When you do this, the filter condition displays on the left side
of the status area at the bottom of the grid. Click the X icon in the status area to turn off the
filter.

• The blank area immediately below a column heading is an entry field for filtering on an entry you
type in that area. For example, to filter on a specific name, enter a name under the Name
column to automatically filter the entries in the grid.

• You can drag and drop the grid column headers to rearrange the order of the columns in the grid.

Creating a new logical device type


Complete the following steps to create a new logical device type:

1. Click New on the top right of the editor.

This clears the Type Name field and resets System measurements and Custom
measurements to 0 (zero) on the Summary tab.

All is selected by default in the Available Measurements list on the Measurements tab.

2. Enter a device type name in the Type Name field.

The name appears in the logical device type display grid and an ! (exclamation) appears in the
Modified column to indicate that the device type entry is incomplete.

3. Click the Measurements tab to go to the list of measurements that are available for selection.

4. Locate and click an available measurement that you want to associate with the device type,
then click >> to add it to the Measurements For list. Repeat this step for each measurement
that you want to associate with the device type.

5. To delete a device type, click the device type in the display grid and click Delete on the top
right of the editor.

Note that Delete is disabled if any logical devices are associated with the logical device type.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 821


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Custom measurements
The following sections describe how to create, modify, or delete custom measurements. Because
factory-defined System Measurements contain considerable information about their type and
usage, custom measurements should only be created in exceptional circumstances, and only with
an understanding of the expected results from their usage.

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

Creating a new custom measurement


Complete the following steps to create a new, custom measurement:

1. Click New beside the Available Measurements dropdown list to open the New
Measurement dialog. (You can also edit a new custom measurement by clicking Edit and
modifying the entries.)

2. Enter a descriptive name and an engineering name for the new measurement in the respective
fields. For example, Voltage A-B Low is the descriptive name, and Vll ab low is the
engineering name.

3. Select the unit of measure from the Units list or add a custom unit of measure by typing it in
the Units field.

Note that the combination of the descriptive name, the engineering name, and the unit of
measure must be unique for each custom measurement.

4. Select a type of information to be measured from the Quantity list.

5. Click OK to add the measurement.

The new measurement is added as an available measurement in the grid and an X in the
Custom column indicates that it is a custom measurement.

You need to select All or Custom in the Available Measurements list to see the custom
measurement in the grid.

Modifying or deleting a custom measurement


Complete the following steps to modify a custom measurement. Note that you cannot modify or
delete system measurements.

1. Go to the Measurements tab of the Logical Device Type Editor.

2. Select the custom measurement that you want to modify or delete.

822 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Custom measurements that have been associated with a logical device type can be edited but
not deleted. Selecting Delete results in a message indicating that the custom measurement
cannot be deleted because it is mapped either to a logical device type or to a logical device
that is logging data.

3. To modify the custom measurement, click Edit to open the Edit Measurement dialog, update
the entries or selections in the dialog, and click OK to apply to changes.

4. To delete a custom measurement, click Delete.

A message confirms the deletion.

Note that if you attempt to delete a custom measurement that is associated with any logical
devices, a message indicates that the measurement cannot be deleted.

Using the Logical Device Editor


Use the Logical Device Editor to map measurements from physical devices to measurements
provided by the logical device type that is associated with a logical device.

To open the Logical Device Editor:

1. Start Management Console and log in using an account with supervisor-level access.

2. Click the Devices icon, then right-click the Display window and select New > Logical
Device.

The devices defined in Management Console are listed in the Input Devices area of the Logical
Device Editor.

The top portion of the editor consists of a header area that contains instructions, selection lists, and
input fields. The bottom portion is the mapping area that allows you to map the input registers of a
physical device to a list of measurements provided by the associated device type.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 823


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

A Header area B Mapping area

The header area


The instructions indicate the steps required to create a logical device.

The Group field is a combination input field and dropdown list. You can either enter a name for the
group or select a group from the list.

The Name field identifies the name of the logical device that you are defining. Enter the name of the
logical device in the field.

The Logical Device Type dropdown list contains the names of logical device types that are
available for selection.

The mapping area


The Input Devices grid lists the devices that are in your system. When you select a device, its
output registers are listed in the Input Device Registers area.

The Register Mapping grid is populated with a list of the output measurements that are defined for
the logical device type that you select in the Logical Device Type dropdown list. They are listed
under a generic Device Name label pending their mapping to the logical device name that you
specified. Drag an entry from the Input Device Registers list to an output measurement in the
Register Mapping grid to map the two values.

824 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Defining a logical device


1. Select a logical device type from the Logical Device Type dropdown list.

The output measurements defined for the selected logical device type are listed in the Output
Measurement column in the Register Mapping area.

2. Either select an existing group name from the Group dropdown list, or enter a group name in
the field.

3. Enter a name for the new logical device in the Name field.

4. Select one of the input devices from the Input Devices area of the editor.

The registers for the selected input device appear in the Input Device Registers area. Note
that if you choose to display the registers for the input device in an ION tree format, delays in
displaying the registers can occur for devices with a large volume of registers.

5. Map an input device register to an output measurement by dragging it to the output


measurement listed in the Register Mapping area of the editor.

The input device registers appear in bold font when they are mapped to an output
measurement.

6. Click OK to save the logical device configuration in Management Console.

Any unmapped measurements are displayed in red.

7. To edit a logical device that is in the Device panel of Management Console, double-click the
device name, or right-click the device name and select Configure Device to open the Logical
Device Editor, or click the device then select Edit > Configure Device.

Note that:
If you choose to edit the configuration of the logical device, delays can occur in displaying
the registers for devices with a large volume of configured registers.

Duplicate and Configure in Management Console's Edit menu cannot be used with
logical devices. See Creating multiple logical devices for information about creating more
than one logical device.

Considerations regarding logical devices and historical data


When a logical device is configured, historical data for an output register (that is, an output
measurement) on the physical device is automatically routed to the corresponding output
measurement on the logical device.

When a logical device is configured, historical data is logged to the logical device and not the related
physical device.

If multiple logical devices include the same input measurement from the same physical device,
historical data from that input measurement is routed to the logical device that was configured last.

Deleting a physical device that is mapped to a logical device


If a physical device that is mapped to a logical device is deleted, the mapping of input
measurements for the logical device can no longer be resolved. A message dialog opens to indicate
the result of the delete action and asks whether you want to continue with the deletion.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 825


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

If you right-click the logical device in Management Console and select Configure Device to open
the Logical Device Editor after you have deleted the physical device, a message indicates that the
physical device has been deleted. The Register Mapping grid for the logical device shows the
deleted physical device/ION handle in the Input Register column.

If you re-create the physical device, the input measurement mapping for the logical device is
automatically restored.

Renaming a physical device that is mapped to a logical device


If a physical device that is mapped to a logical device is renamed, a message dialog opens to
indicate the result of the rename action and asks whether you want to continue with renaming.

If you right-click the logical device in Management Console and select Configure Device to open
the Logical Device Editor after you have renamed the physical device, the Register Mapping grid
for the logical device shows the renamed physical device in the Device Name column.

Deleting a site which has a physical device mapped to a logical device


If a site with a physical device mapped to a logical device is deleted, the physical device is also
deleted and the mapping of input measurements for the logical device can no longer be resolved.

If you right-click the logical device in Management Console and select Configure Device to open
the Logical Device Editor after you have deleted the site, a message indicates that the physical
device has been deleted. The Register Mapping grid for the logical device shows the deleted
physical device/ION handle in the Input Register column.

Creating multiple logical devices


You can create multiple logical devices by:

• Exporting a logical device configuration to a comma-separated values (CSV) file.

• Modifying the CSV file to add multiple logical device configurations based on the original logical
device configuration.

• Importing the CSV file in Management Console to add the logical devices to the system.

Export a logical device configuration


Complete the following steps to export one or more logical device configurations to a CSV file.

1. Use the Logical Device Editor to create at least one logical device in the Devices area of
Management Console.

2. Select one or more logical devices, right-click and select Export to open the Export Status
dialog.

Note that if you choose to export the registers for the logical device, delays in the export
process can occur for logical devices with a large volume of configured registers.

3. Click the browse button on the right of the Selected File field to open the Save As dialog.

4. Navigate to the location where you want to save the file and enter a name for the file in the File
name field.

Text files (*.csv) is pre-selected in the Save as type field.

5. Click Save to return to the Export Status dialog.

826 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

The Selected File field is populated with the location and file name that you specified.

6. Click Export.

The Status column in the grid area of the dialog indicates Exported for a completed export
operation. If the export operation is not successful, for example if the input registers cannot be
retrieved for the logical device being exported, it is indicated in the Status column. Click the
link to open the log file to view additional information.

Configuration information for all of the selected logical devices is exported to the CSV file.

Create multiple entries in the CSV file


Use Microsoft Excel or a similar spreadsheet editor to open the CSV file. The column headings in
the spreadsheet are labeled as follows:

• Logical device name

• Logical device type

• Physical device name

• Physical device type

• Input register

• Output measurement

• Handle - this column heading is required but the entries are not required unless there are
duplicate labels, that is, input registers with the same name but with a different ION handle. In
this case the ION handle is required. You can view the ION handles by exporting the input
measurements from the Logical Device Type Editor.

NOTE: The column headings remain in English for localized versions of the product. This is
required for CSV file-processing purposes.

To create multiple entries for the logical device configuration, use the copy and paste function in
Excel. It is recommended that only users with supervisor-level access create multiple entries.

1. Select the rows that you want to duplicate and press Ctrl+C to copy them.

2. Place the cursor in the left-most cell of the first blank row and press Ctrl+V to paste copies of
the selected rows.

3. Continue the paste operation for as many logical device configurations that you want to
create.

4. After completing the paste operation, be sure that you use unique device names to avoid
duplicates.

You can also export all of the register names of a physical device as well as all of the measurement
names of a logical device type. This gives you the ability to use these additional CSV files to copy
and paste additional register names and measurement names into the CSV file you are using to
create the multiple logical devices.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 827


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To export all of the register names of a physical device:

1. Open the Logical Device Editor and select a physical device.

2. Right-click anywhere in the register list in the Input Device Registers area to open a menu
and select Export Device Input Registers.

3. Enter a name for the file and click OK.

To export all of the measurement names of a logical device type:

1. Open Management Console and select Tools > System > Logical Device Type Editor.

2. Select a logical device type in the logical device types area of the editor.

3. Click the Measurements tab.

4. Right-click anywhere in the grid under Measurements For and select Export
Measurements.

5. Enter a name for the file and click OK.

Import multiple logical device configurations


Complete the following steps to import the CSV file with the multiple logical device configurations. It
is recommended that only users with supervisor-level access import logical device configurations.

1. Open Management Console and select Tools > Import Logical Device in the Devices panel
of Management Console to open the Logical Device Import Form window.

Logical Device Import Form is available only when you are in the Devices panel of
Management Console,

2. Use the Browse button to navigate to and select the CSV file to import.

3. Select Overwrite Existing Devices if you want overwrite logical devices with the same name
that were previously created.

Logical devices with the same name can occur as a result of a previous import operation.

4. Click Import to add the multiple logical devices to the Devices area of Management Console.

The system performs a validation of the configuration data during the import operation. If an
error occurs during the import operation:
The Status column in the grid area indicates Failed for any logical device that is not
imported. Click Failed to view details about the cause of the unsuccessful import.

Logical devices are created for all correct entries in the CSV file. Logical device entries
that are incorrect are not created in Management Console.

828 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Management Console
Use Management Console to add, remove or configure system components, such as metering
devices, in your Power Monitoring Expert power management system. You can set up different
types of sites (communication links such as Ethernet or serial), and set up connection schedules for
these sites.

In addition, the Management Console Tools menu provides access to device and system
configuration, maintenance and programming tools.

NOTE: Run Management Console as Administrator user. To do this, right-click the Management
Console program icon and select Run as administrator from the context menu. If you do not run
it as Administrator, then certain tools such as Update EWS Server are not functional.

NOTICE
NETWORK INOPERABILITY
Do not make unauthorized changes in the network configuration.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in an unstable or unusable network.

The Management Console interface

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 829


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

System Setup pane and


A B Sort indicator C Group By Box area D Filter indicator
icons

E Column Selector F Pin/Unpin icon G Display window1 H Edit Filter button

I Current filter applied J Hover text K Show historical devices option


1 This area displays the contents of the selected System Setup icon

Window title
The window title displays the name of the software program and the current user.

System Setup pane


The icons in the System Setup pane represent categories of items you can add, remove, set up, and
view. Click an icon to go to the associated display window.

Display window
The Display window shows the contents of the item currently selected in the System Setup pane.

Refresh
To manually refresh Management Console and reload its contents, select View > Refresh (or press
F5).

Options
Select Tools > Options to open the Options dialog. Use this dialog to change display settings for
the System Log Events display window.

Highlighting

Highlighting controls how Error events are displayed in the System Log Events display window.
Select or clear the Enable Highlighting check box to turn highlighting on or off. Click Set Highlight
Color to change the highlight color for Critical or Error events in the System Log Events display
window.

Events

The Events section of the dialog lets you control how many records appear in the System Log
Events display window and how date and time are displayed.

Customizing the Management Console interface


You can customize what is displayed in the Management Console interface and the tables within
the display windows:

• Select which columns appear in tables.

• Filter, sort and group data in tables.

For instructions on using these features, see Customizing and navigating interface displays.

Display window shortcut menus


To access shortcut menus in the Display window, first click the icon of the System Setup item you
are interested in. Then right-click the display window area or on a network component to display the
shortcut menu. The menu items available vary depending on the network component selected.

830 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• New displays the options available for adding new network items.

• Duplicate and Configure lets you perform batch cloning of devices. When multiple devices
are selected, this right-click shortcut becomes Configure Selected Devices which lets you
perform setup functions such as batch renaming of devices.

• Delete removes the selected items.

• Connect and Disconnect lets you manually connect to or disconnect from the selected site.

NOTE: You cannot connect or disconnect an individual serial device in a site; you can only
connect or disconnect the site for that serial device.

• Connect Ethernet and Disconnect Ethernet let you manually connect to or disconnect from
the selected Ethernet device.

• Security accesses the Meter Security Settings dialog. This is used by the software to gain
access to security-enabled devices (for example, ION8600 or ION7650); it is only available
from the shortcut menu for the Devices display pane.

• Configure <Network Component> opens the <Network Component> Configuration dialog


(where <network component> is the component selected). Use this dialog to make changes to
the properties for the selected network component.

For Devices only:

• Rename opens the Rename Device dialog. Use this to change the device Name.

• Change Group opens the Change Group dialog. Use this to change the device Group.

Management Console network components


This section describes the different components in Management Console: Servers, Sites, Devices,
Dial Out Modems, Connection Schedules, and System Log Events.

See Setting up your network in Management Console for information on adding these components
to your network.

NOTE: Do not use names such as CON, AUX, COM1, and LPT1 when naming sites and devices.
Consult Microsoft documentation regarding restrictions for naming files, paths, and namespaces.

Servers
A server is a computer in the Power Monitoring Expert system that runs administrative software to
control access to the network and its resources, such as metering devices.

Sites
A site is a group of devices in the system that share a common communications link. A site can be
a direct site, a modem site, an Ethernet gateway site, or an OPC site.

Direct site

In a direct site, serial communications occur between a computer and one or more meters. The
standards most commonly used on computers are RS-232 (for connecting one device) and RS-485

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 831


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

(for connecting a loop of up to 32 devices). When connecting to more than one serial device, use an
RS-232 to RS-485 converter. Note that you should keep the number of devices on a daisy chain to a
minimum to reduce the delay in real-time updates.

Modem site

In a modem site, communications occur between a remote modem (at the Modem Site) and a local
modem (on the server).

NOTE: Remote sites that use radio modems or leased-line modems are configured as Direct
(Serial) Sites, not as Modem Sites.

Modem sites can include traditional hardware modems (those that are configured and controlled by
Power Monitoring Expert or WinModems (Windows modems). If multiple modems are set up in the
modem site, Power Monitoring Expert selects the first available modem to establish
communications (this is referred to as “modem pooling”).

Ethernet gateway site

An Ethernet gateway site (for example, EtherGate or Modbus gateway) consists of an RS-485 chain
of devices that communicates with an Ethernet network via an Ethernet device. The Ethernet
device acts as a gateway that transfers data between an Ethernet network and the devices
connected to it via RS-485. The gateway device converts RS-232/RS-485 communications to and
from Ethernet.

OPC site

An OPC site consists of an OPC client that communicates with OPC-compliant devices on the
network.

Devices
A device is a meter or other component that communicates and gathers data, and is installed on a
network.

Release notes and mapping spreadsheets for device drivers recently added to the product are
included in the product's installation location in ...\Power Monitoring
Expert\system\doc\Device Support\. The release notes provide information about the
firmware versions supported by the device drivers, implementation details, images of Vista
diagrams for the devices, and pertinent safety messages. The device driver mapping spreadsheets
contain details such as modbus register addresses and corresponding ION register addresses
(handles). Register mapping information is also provided for any devices using PC logging.

Serial devices

Serial devices belong to direct sites, modem sites, or Ethernet gateway sites — they communicate
through a modem, RS-232, RS-485, or Ethernet-to-Serial gateway connection. You must have the
appropriate sites configured first before you can add serial devices.

832 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Ethernet devices

Ethernet devices are those that are directly connected to the network via Ethernet. You can
manually connect or disconnect your Ethernet device through the Management Console.

Logical devices

Logical devices are a collection of measurements from physical and VIP devices grouped into
single sources for use in the system.

OPC devices

OPC devices represent physical devices to which the system is communicating through an OPC
interface.

Dial Out Modems


A dial-out modem is one that a server computer uses to communicate with a remote modem at a
modem site. The modem implemented can be a traditional hardware-based modem or it can be a
software-based modem that uses the computer’s processor to emulate a traditional hardware-based
modem.

When a modem site needs to establish communications, it selects a modem from the list of
modems configured in the modem site. You can add hardware modems or WinModems to the
modem list.

NOTE: A WinModem is a modem that is directly controlled by the computer’s operating system.

Connection schedules
Connection schedules are programmed routines for a server to regularly connect to and disconnect
from sites (and their associated devices) and Ethernet devices. See Configuring connection
schedules for more information.

System Log Events


System Log Events lists events for the network. You can select what time frame and components
you want to view events for. See System Log events for more information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 833


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Setting up your network in Management Console

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

NOTICE
NETWORK INOPERABILITY
Do not make unauthorized changes in the network configuration.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in an unstable or unusable network.

The Primary Server contains all the Power Monitoring Expert programs and it controls the overall
operation of your energy management system. The primary server is displayed on the Server screen
when you first start Management Console.

To start building your system, add and configure your sites and devices.

Overview
Site and Device Naming restrictions
The following applies to Site, Device Group, and Device Name naming:

834 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Names cannot contain spaces or the following characters: \ / : * ? " < > { } . , ' & @ | % #

• The maximum length for a Group.Device name is 99 characters (+ 1 for the period
separation).

• Do not use names such as CON, AUX, COM1, and LPT1 for sites and devices.

• All characters must exist in the system's Windows code pages. For example. on an English
Windows operating system, certain non-English language characters are not supported.

Adding network components


For details on adding various components, see the following sections.

Follow the procedure below to add a new network component:

1. In the System Setup pane, select the icon for the type of item that you want to add ( Site,
Device, or Dial Out Modem).

2. Right-click the display window, select New, and then select the specific type of network
component from the shortcut menu to open the Configuration dialog.

The options differ depending on which system setup icon you selected.

3. Use the fields and drop-down menus to configure properties. Mandatory items are highlighted
in red. To configure advanced properties, right-click the dialog and select Advanced
Properties. For more shortcut menu options, see Configuration Dialog shortcut menus,
below.

4. Click OK to add the component.

Configuration Dialog shortcut menus


Right-click the Configuration dialog to access the following shortcut menu options:

• Property Details: This opens a window that contains information on the selected property,
including minimum and maximum allowable values, if applicable.

• Advanced Properties: This exposes all the property fields that are hidden in the default (basic)
view. For further information about the Time synchronization option. see Time synchronization
for ION meters for further information.

• Reset All To Default: Resets all properties to their original values.

Adding a server
Click the Servers icon, right-click the display window and select New > Computer. Fill in the
mandatory Name field.

Adding devices
Setting Up devices for direct serial communications
To set up devices for RS-232 or RS-485 communications on a direct serial loop, first add a direct
site in Management Console and specify a serial communications port on the computer.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 835


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Step1: Adding a direct site

Click the Sites icon. Right-click the display window and select New > Direct Site. Fill in the Name
and Serial Port fields. Configure the other fields as you require.

Step 2: Adding a device to the direct site

Click the Devices icon. Right-click the display window and select New > Serial Device on Direct
Site. Fill in these fields:

• Group: Type a name for the group or select an existing group from the list.

• Name: Type the name you want to give the device.

• Device Type: Select the type of the device.

• Unit ID: Type the Unit ID of the device; the range is 1-9999 for ION devices or 1-247 for
Modbus RTU devices.

• Site: Select the direct site you previously set up.

• Time Zone: Select the timezone you want the device data to be displayed in, in the software.
This setting is only used for the display of timestamped data in the software. It does not affect
the configuration of the monitoring device itself.

Configure the other fields as you require.

Setting up devices for Ethernet gateway communications


To set up devices for Ethernet gateway communications, first add and configure an Ethernet
gateway site. Ethernet gateways that can be used include those that are simple Ethernet-to-Serial
converters, or any gateway or data concentrator that provides ModbusTCP communications.

Step 1: Adding an Ethernet gateway site

Click the Sites icon. Right-click the display window and select New > Ethernet Gateway Site.

Complete the Name, IP Address or Host Name and TCP/IP Port fields. (The IP address can be
IPv4 or IPv6.) The TCP/IP Port identifies which communications port is used to connect to the
serial devices. The port you use depends on the type of Ethernet gateway you want to set up (use
7801 for an EtherGate gateway via COM1 or use port 502 for a Modbus gateway).

Configure the other fields as you require.

Step 2: Adding a Device to the Ethernet Gateway Site

Click the Devices icon. Right-click the display window and select New > Serial Device on
Ethernet Gateway Site. Fill in these fields:

• Group: Type a name for the group or select an existing group from the list.

• Name: Type the name you want to give the device.

• Device Type: Select the type of device.

• Unit ID: Type the Unit ID of the device; the range is 1-9999 for ION devices or 1-247 for
Modbus devices.

836 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Site: Select the Ethernet gateway site you previously set up.

• Time Zone: Select the timezone you want the device data to be displayed in, in the software.
This setting is only used for the display of timestamped data in the software. It does not affect
the configuration of the monitoring device itself.

Configure the other fields as you require.

Adding an Ethernet device


Ethernet devices are configured in PME by providing fixed IP addresses (IPv4 or IPv6) and ports, or
based on device names. Device names must be used for devices with dynamic address
assignment, for example using the DHCP protocol. When device names are used, then a form of
name resolution mechanism is required on the network.
To add an Ethernet device, click the Devices icon. Right-click the display window and select
New > Ethernet Device. Fill in the Group, Name, Device Type, IP Address or Host Name, and
Time Zone fields. (The IP address can be IPv4 or IPv6.) Configure the other fields as you require.

NOTE: For the Time Zone field, select the timezone you want the device data to be displayed in,
in the software. This setting is only used for the display of timestamped data in the software. It
does not affect the configuration of the monitoring device itself.

Setting up devices for OPC communications


To set up devices for OPC communications, first add an OPC site.

Step 1: Adding an OPC site

Click the Sites icon. Right-click the display window and select New > OPC Site. Fill in the Name
and Address fields. Configure the other fields as you require.

Make sure you follow the correct syntax when typing in the address for the OPC site. Select the
Address field to see an example address in the Property Description section (near the bottom of the
OPC Site Configuration dialog).

Step 2: Adding a device to the OPC site

NOTE: At least one OPC Device Type needs to be preconfigured before an OPC Device can be
created in Management Console. Contact Technical Support for assistance.

Click the Devices icon. Right-click the display window and select New > OPC Device. Fill in the
Group, Name, Device Type, Site (select the OPC site you previously set up), and Time Zone.
Configure the other fields as you require.

NOTE: For the Time Zone field, select the timezone you want the device data to be displayed in,
in the software. This setting is only used for the display of timestamped data in the software. It
does not affect the configuration of the monitoring device itself.

Adding a modem
1. Click the Dial Out Modems icon, right-click the display window and select New, then select
either Serial Modem (hardware modem) or WinModem (Windows modem).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 837


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2. Fill in the values for the mandatory fields:


For Serial modem, select the Modem Type from the list. If your modem is not in this list,
select “Generic ION Modem - Other”. Select the Serial Port where your modem is
connected.

For WinModems, select the Modem Name from the list.

Configure the other fields as you require.

3. Click OK.

WinModem installation notes

Before you can use a WinModem, you must first install it on your computer (follow the instructions
that came with the WinModem product). After you restart the computer, set up the WinModem:

1. In Microsoft Windows, click Start > Settings > Control Panel, then double-click Phone and
Modem Options.

2. Click the Modems tab, select your WinModem, then click Properties.

3. Click the Advanced tab, then click Change Default Preference.

4. Set Port speed to match the baud rate that is used between the meter and the modem on the
remote end of the connection (both modems must be set to the same baud rate).

5. Set Flow Control to “None”.

6. Click OK to save your changes.

NOTE: You may need to restart your computer for the settings to take effect.

Editing a network component


1. Click the icon in the System Setup pane for the type of component you want to edit.

2. In the display window, right-click the network component you want to edit and select
Configure <Network Component> (with <Network Component> being the type of
component you want to edit).

You can rename devices or groups displayed in the Devices pane without selecting the
Configure option. See Renaming devices and groups for more information.

NOTE: If you rename a group or device, the data that is already stored in the database is
associated with the new group or device name. New data will be added to the database using
the new name.

3. Make the required changes. To display all configurable fields, right-click the Configuration
dialog and select Advanced Properties.

4. Click OK when you are finished to save your changes.

838 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Deleting a network component


1. Click the System Setup icon for the type of component you want to delete.

2. In the display window, right-click the network component you want to delete and select Delete
(or select the item and press the DELETE key).

3. Click Yes to confirm the deletion or No to cancel.

NOTE: When you delete a Site or a Server, all devices associated with it are also deleted.

Renaming devices and groups


You can change the display names of devices and groups without losing any of the real-time or
historical data associated with them.
In the Devices pane in Management Console:

• Group and Name are separate columns.


The Name column is always displayed.

The Group column is displayed by default, but you can use the Column Selector to
remove it from the display area. You can now drag and drop the Group column to the
Group By Box area to show the devices organized within each group.

• Use the Data Availability column for inclusion in the display area.
Data Availability indicates All for devices that are active and have real-time and historical
data, and Historical only for devices that have been deleted and only provide historical
data. Historical devices are included in the devices displayed when you select the Show
historical devices checkbox.

• The Show historical devices option displays devices that have been deleted. Since the data
for these devices still exists in the system, they can be displayed when you select this option.

Renaming a device
Complete the following steps to change the display name of a device. The system (internal) name is
not affected by this name change.

1. Right-click the device name in the Devices pane of Management Console and select Rename
in the menu to open the Rename Device dialog.

2. Enter the new name for the device.

The appearance of the exclamation icon to the right of the field indicates that there are
instructions or errors associated with the device name. Hover over the icon to display the text
and take appropriate action.

3. Click OK to rename the device.

Changing a group name


Change a group name as follows:

1. Right-click a single group name or select multiple group names (Ctrl + left mouse click) in the
Devices pane of Management Console and select Change Group in the menu to open the
Change Group dialog. (You can also select the devices and click the Change Group option

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 839


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

in the Edit menu.)

2. Enter a new group name or select a group name from the list of group names currently used in
the system.

The appearance of the exclamation icon to the right of the field indicates that there are
instructions or errors associated with the group name. Hover over the icon to display the text
and take appropriate action.

3. Click OK to change the group name.

Considerations when renaming devices or groups


Note the following when you rename a device or a group:

• Complete any configuration tasks in progress, such as working in Designer, before changing
names.

• Restart any open components such as Vista, Designer, or Web Applications after the name or
group change has been completed to refresh the names that appear in them.

• Regenerate network diagrams in Vista to update the top-level grouping objects with the
changed Group name.

• Update OPC data mapping after device renaming by selecting the Update OPC Server option
in Management Console's Tools > System menu. You can then update the OPC clients with
the new data.

• System (internal) names, not display names, continue to appear in System Log Events in
Management Console. You can view the system name of a device, in Device Manager, by
selecting Unique System ID in the Column Selector.

Configure managed circuits


The Managed Circuits function in Management Console allows you to automatically create devices
representing the circuits of multi-circuit devices, such as BCPM and PM5350 devices, so that you
can then treat each circuit as a source for both real time and historical data in the system.

These sources represent the physical structure in the system. For information about organizing
these circuits and other metering points into a recognizable system-specific hierarchy view, see
Hierarchy Manager and also the online help in Hierarchy Manager.

The first step in creating managed circuits is to add the multi-circuit device to Management Console
and check that it is communicating.
Once this is done, you can create managed circuits as source entries automatically as follows:

1. Right-click the multi-circuit device you added in Management Console to open the menu and
click Configure Managed Circuits.

2. Click OK on the confirmation window to proceed.

The Configuring Managed Circuits dialog opens showing a progress bar as the circuits are
being created. The number of circuits created are indicated under the progress bar field.

3. Click OK at the completion of the process.

The multi-circuit device now has an expand control (a plus symbol) on that row.

840 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

4. Click the + to expand the entry and view the circuits now associated with the multi-circuit
device.

Managed circuits considerations


Because managed circuits are related to a multi-circuit device and are configured as part of that
device, you cannot change the name of individual managed circuits, delete individual managed
circuits, or change the measurements associated with the individual managed circuits.

However, you can keep the configuration up-to-date through the multi-circuit device configuration
changes and then re-running the configure managed circuits process to update the managed
circuits. Any circuits that have not changed remain unchanged. Any circuits that have been
removed in the multi-circuit device are deleted as managed circuits. Any new circuits are created as
new managed circuits.

By mapping managed circuits into a hierarchy, you can specify more recognizable names and
organize them into a view that matches the facility or building.

If you rename the group name or device name for the multi-circuit device, the name changes are
also applied to the managed circuits associated with the device. See Renaming devices and
groups.

If you delete the multi-circuit device, a dialog message indicates that the managed circuits
associated with the multi-circuit device will also be deleted.

If you have a number of multi-circuit devices configured in different ways, and you want to see
which measurements apply to a specific managed circuit, double-click the specific managed circuit
in Management Console to open the Managed Circuit Properties window. It provides: information
about the managed circuit, its parent device, its group name, and the measurements associated
with the circuit.

You can use the Duplicate and Configure option in Management Console to create multiple
devices and add unit IDs for each device. (See Setting up large systems for additional information.)
After multiple multi-circuit devices have been created, you can select them in Management
Console, right-click to open the menu and click Configure Managed Circuits. In systems with
many multi-circuit devices, the managed circuit creation process takes some time, but the progress
bar provides feedback on the progress of the creation process.

Accessing meters with security


If you have a device in your network with security enabled, use Management Console to allow ION
Windows Services to access the device. This is required for automatic upload of historical data logs
from the device.

To configure ION Windows Services to the device:

1. Right-click the device that has security enabled and select Security to open the Meter
Security Settings dialog.

2. From the Software Access drop down list, select the option as per the following table:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 841


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Option Description
Select this option if standard security is configured on the
device.

Standard Security NOTE: If standard security is not configured on the device,


refer to Changes in security settings of device for more
information.

User List Select the user if advanced security is configured on the device.

NOTE: You can configure the device security settings using Designer or ION Setup. See
Configuring Security module for more information.

3. Click Match Password and type the password in the Password field then re-type it in the
Confirm Password field.

4. Select the check box if you want to allow the software to send secure time synchronization
signals to the device. Clear the check box if you do not want to send secure time
synchronization signals to the device.

5. Click OK.

Configuring connection schedules


You can schedule the times when the server connects to a site or Ethernet device.

Adding a connection schedule


Click the Connection Schedules icon, right-click the display window, then select New >
Connection Schedule to open the Scheduled Site Connection dialog.

The following sections describe the available tabs and how to configure them.

General Settings tab

On the General Settings tab:

• Type the name of your connection schedule (for example “Daily Reading”) in the Name field.

• Type a description of the connection schedule, if required.

• Select Enabled if you want to enable the schedule.

• Select the date from which the schedule is valid.

Sites tab

On the Sites tab:

• Click the box beside the sites and devices to select those that you want to include in the
connection schedule. A check mark appears beside an item to indicate that it is included in the
connection schedule.

• Set your Site Connection Settings. To enter the minimum and maximum time to stay
connected, type the time in the fields or use the arrows to change the time.

842 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Set the Connection Priority. The higher the number, the greater the priority given to that
schedule if there are concurrent connection requests.

Schedule tab

On the Schedule tab:

• Set up the date schedule for the connection (the default is Daily). Schedule options vary
depending on the type of schedule selected.
Daily: Occurs every day.

Weekly: Occurs on the selected day at the specified frequency (in number of weeks) and
stays active for the specified duration. For example, if you set Frequency to 2, Day of week
to Sunday and Active Duration to 2, the connection occurs every second Sunday and stays
active for two days.

Monthly - Day of Week: Occurs at the specified frequency (in months), in the week and on
the day specified and for the specified duration. For example, if you set Frequency to 3,
Day of Month to 2nd and Sunday, and Duration to 1, the connection occurs every third
month on the second Sunday and stays active for 1 day.

Monthly - Day of Month: Occurs at the specified frequency (in months), on the specified
date of the month, and for the duration specified. For example, if you set Frequency to 2,
Day of Month to 15th and Duration to 2, the connection occurs on the fifteenth day of every
second month and stays active for 2 days.

• Set up the time period for the connection to occur by setting a start and an end time. In the Start
Time and End Time fields, type the time or use the arrows to change the time.

If you configure a full-day (i.e., 24-hour) daily schedule, you need to allow enough time between the
end time and the start of the next connection to avoid connection problems. For example, to add a 2-
minute gap to a 24-hour schedule, set the Start Time to 0:00:00 and the EndTime to 23:58:00.

System Log events


System Log Events lists events for components in the system. This information comes from the
ION_SystemLog database.

TIP: For instructions on filtering and sorting columns and customizing the display, see
Customizing and navigating interface displays.

Viewing System Log events


To view System Log Events:

1. Select System Log Events from the System Setup pane.

2. In the Show area select the checkboxes for the system components for which you want to
view events (i.e., servers, sites, devices).

If there are no events for a particular system component, that check box is unavailable.

3. Select the minimum priority level of events to be displayed from the Minimum Priority Level
dropdown list (see below for more information on priority levels).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 843


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Click Modify to change the date/time filter applied to the System Events Log display. See
System Log filter setup.

5. To view details of an event, double-click on the entry in the event log.

Priority

Priority classifies what type of event has occurred. The value corresponds to the severity of the
event: the higher the number, the more severe the event.
The priority is contained in the ION_SystemLog database as a number. In the System Events Log
display, the priority levels are displayed as text strings. The priority numbers are mapped to the text
strings as follows:

Diagnostic 0-5
Information 6 - 20
Warning 21 - 63
Error 64 - 191
Critical 192 - 255

By default, the Cutoff setup register of Log Inserter’s System Log Controller module is set to 192.
This means that system events with a priority less than 192 are not transferred to the ION_Data
database and therefore cannot be viewed in Alarms. If you want to view lower priority events in
Alarms, use the above priority mapping as a guide to set the Cutoff setup register to a lower value
(using Designer).

System Log filter setup


The System Log Filter Setup dialog lets you change the date and time filter applied to the System
Events Log display.

1. Click Modify to display the System Log Filter Setup dialog.

2. Select the time range by which you want to filter from the dropdown list. To set up a custom
filter, select Custom Date Range then use the dropdown lists and arrows in the Select a
Date Range dialog to specify the start and end of the range.

3. Click OK.

Setting up large systems


To perform batch network setup of devices, create the first device in Management Console (see
Adding network components) using a logical naming scheme. After you create this first device, you
can then use it to create multiple duplicate devices and configure their properties.

The Duplicate and Configure interface

NOTE: The Duplicate and Configure function always operates on all devices visible in the table.
When table rows are filtered in the Duplicate and Configure tool, changes done using the
configuration editors on the top pane of the window affect only the devices that are visible in the
Table Editing area. If you want to apply the changes to all devices, clear the filter first before
making the changes.

844 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

NOTE: The Duplicate and Configure function cannot be used with logical devices. See Creating
multiple logical devices for information about creating more than one logical device.

The Duplicate and Configure area


The Duplicate and Configure area has different sections depending on the type of device you are
duplicating.
Ethernet devices have the following sections:

• Configure Names: Use this section to create the duplicates.

• Configure TCP/IP Addresses: Use this section to create a sequence of IP addresses to


assign to the duplicates after they have been created.

• Configure TCP/IP Ports: The port number used in the original device is automatically
assigned to all the duplicates. If required, use this section to select a different port number for all
the displayed devices in the Table Editing area (changes made in this area are applied to all
devices, including the original).

• Configure Unit IDs: This section is disabled by default, since unit IDs do not apply to typical
Ethernet devices. (To enable this section, you must first set up the Table Editing area so that
the “Unit ID” column is visible).

Serial devices have the following sections:

• Configure Names: Use this section to create the duplicates.

• Configure Unit IDs: Use this section to create a sequence of unit IDs to assign to the
duplicates after they have been created.

• Configure Serial Sites: The serial site used in the original device is automatically assigned to
all the duplicates. If required, use this section to select a different serial site for all the displayed
devices in the Table Editing area (changes made in this area are applied to all devices, including
the original).

OPC devices have the following sections:

• Configure Names: Use this section to create the duplicates.

• Configure OPC Address: Use this section to create a sequence of addresses to assign to the
duplicates after they have been created.

• Configure OPC Sites: The OPC site used in the original device is automatically assigned to all
the duplicates. If required, use this section to select a different OPC site for all the displayed
devices in the Table Editing area (changes made in this area are applied to all devices, including
the original).

The Table Editing area


When making configuration changes in the Duplicate and Configure interface, these changes are
applied only to the rows that are visible in the Table Editing area.

See Customizing and navigating interface displays for instructions on filtering and sorting data in the
table.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 845


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: To discard your changes since the last saved state, click Revert. You can also press
CTRL+Z to undo the last action. To redo the last action, press SHIFT+CTRL+Z. You can only
undo your last action (one undo).

Creating multiple copies of a device


This section describes how to duplicate and configure devices.

Step 1: Configuring the first device


1. Add the first device using your logical naming scheme.

For example, you can use a scheme like “FL1_PNL1A.CCT01” to name a device that is
installed on the “1st Floor” of the building, “electrical panel 1A”, and “Circuit breaker #1”. Type
“FL1_PNL1A” as the group name and “CCT01” as the device name when you configure the
first device.

2. Right-click the device you want to duplicate and select Duplicate and Configure. The
Duplicate and Configure interface appears.

Step 2: Configuring names


In the Configure Names area, the device name is displayed. Each letter and number is selectable. A
group of numbers is treated as a single entity. For example, in the name “MY8600” the entities you
can select are “M”, “Y” and “8600”. Leading zeroes are also supported, so you can set sequences
such as “01, 02, 03” or “001, 002, 003”.

1. Select a letter or number in the device name. The Start box displays the selected
number/letter, which is the start value. Use the up or down arrow in the spin box to change the
start value, or simply type it in the box.

2. Click the up or down arrow on the End box edit the range, or type the end value in the box. To
clear the range and start over, click Remove Parameters.

3. For letters, select Upper Case or Lower Case, depending on whether you require upper case
or lower case letters.

4. Set exceptions for individual values or a range of values, if required. Exceptions reduce the
number of names created (i.e., total generated names minus the exceptions). See Setting
exceptions to generated sequences.

Once you have finished configuring names, you can duplicate the device. See Step 3: Duplicating
the device, below, for more information.

846 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Example

For example, if you select the first “1” from the example naming scheme and set the End spin box to
“2”, two names are generated (the original, plus one duplicate). If you select a letter and set its Start
value to “A” and the End value to “C”, three names are generated (the original, plus two duplicates).

The total number of generated names is the product of the first range multiplied by the next, and so
on until the last range, as indicated in the following graphic.

The total generated names are the product:


A
[2 X 3 X 10] = 60

Setting exceptions to generated sequences

The Exceptions option applies to the Configure Names and Configure TCP/IP Addresses
sections only.

1. To set exceptions to the range of generated values, click Edit (this button is unavailable until
you change the name or IP value).

A List of current exceptions

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 847


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2. Use the Add number or Add character (as applicable) spin box to set a value to exclude
from the range you have specified, then click Add. Repeat to set additional values to exclude.
To set a range of values to exclude, select Add number range or Add character range, then
use the Start and End spin boxes to set the range to exclude.

Click Add. Repeat to set additional ranges of values to exclude.

NOTE: You cannot add the same number or letter to the list of exceptions more than once. If
the Add button is disabled, check that the numbers or letters are not already included in the
exceptions list near the top of the window.

3. Use the Remove number or Remove character spin box to remove the exception that was
set for a given value (i.e., put it back in as an acceptable value). Use the Remove number
range or Remove character range spin boxes to remove the exception that was set for a
range of values. Click Remove.

Step 3: Duplicating the device


Once you have finished configuring names, you are ready to duplicate the device. Click Duplicate.
The duplicated devices appear in the Table Editing area of the window.

The first device in the list is the original device. The remaining devices are the duplicates. Asterisks
next to the device names indicate pending changes that have not yet been saved.

Click Apply to save your changes and continue editing devices, click OK to save your changes and
return to Management Console, or click Revert to undo unsaved changes.

In Management Console, duplicated devices are always disabled when they are added.

Step 4: Configuring duplicated devices


See the following section, Configuring multiple devices, for instructions on configuring other
properties for multiple devices.

Configuring multiple devices


After you have duplicated the devices, you can select and configure any or all of them.

1. If you have closed the Duplicate and Configure interface, select the devices you want to
configure from the Devices display window in Management Console. Right-click and select
Configure Selected Devices (this option is only available if multiple devices are selected).

The Configure Selected Devices interface appears. This interface has the same layout and
controls as the Duplicate and Configure interface; see The Duplicate and Configure interface
for information.

NOTE: Devices affected by a configuration change (that has not been saved) are identified
by an asterisk in the first column of the Table Editing area.

2. Scroll to the right in the Duplicate and Configure area to view the Configure TCP/IP
Addresses, Unit IDs, Ports and Sites sections of the interface (depending on the type of
device being configured). If the number of items in this area does not match the number of
items in the |Table Editing area, a message in red text appears in the area. If the numbers
match, the message text is black. Configure these parameters as described in Configuring
addresses, ports, unit IDs and sites then click Configure at the bottom of the applicable

848 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

interface section.

NOTE: Configuration changes only affect the devices that are currently displayed in the
Table Editing area. Use the column sorting and filtering features, described in Customizing
and navigating interface displays, to control which devices are displayed in the table. If you
want to apply the changes to all devices, clear any filtering before making the changes.

3. Click Apply to save your changes and continue working or click OK to save your changes and
return to Management Console.

NOTE: If you changed the name of one or more devices, a message displays with a list of
devices that will be renamed. If data for those devices already exist in the ION_Data
database and you still proceed with the renaming, then the existing data associated with the
old device name is lost (“orphaned”).

Click Continue to proceed or Cancel to go back and edit the device configuration.

4. When you have finished, click OK to save your changes and return to Management Console
or click Cancel to discard your changes.

If you click Cancel, a message prompts you if there are pending (unsaved) changes when you
click Cancel. Click Yes to discard the changes and return to Management Console, or No to
return to the configuration window and continue editing.

If inappropriate values (such as a device that is renamed with the same name as another
existing device) are encountered, a message displays with error details. You cannot save the
configuration changes until you have corrected the errors.

Configuring addresses, ports, unit IDs and sites


The following sections describe how to configure addresses, ports, and unit IDs.

Configuring TCP/IP addresses

1. Select the section of the IP address that you want to configure. The Start box displays the
selected number/letter, which is the start value. Use the up or down arrow in the spin box to
change the start value, or simply type it in the box.

2. Click the up or down arrow on the End box edit the range, or type the end value in the box. To
clear the range and start over, click Remove Parameters.

3. Set exceptions for individual values or a range of values, if required. Exceptions reduce the
number of addresses created (i.e., total generated addresses minus the exceptions). See
Setting exceptions to generated sequences.

4. Click Configure at the bottom of the Configure TCP/IP Addresses section.

Configuring unit IDs

The following instructions apply to serial devices (and Ethernet devices that require a unit ID).

1. Use the up or down arrow in the Start spin box to change the start value, or simply type it in
the box.

2. Click the up or down arrow on the End box edit the range, or type the end value in the box.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 849


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. Click Configure at the bottom of the Configure Unit IDs section.

NOTE: To edit the unit ID of an Ethernet device, you must first add the Unit ID column to the
table in the Table Editing area.

Configuring sites

1. From the dropdown list, select the site you want to use for the selected serial or OPC devices.

2. Click Configure at the bottom of the Configure Sites section.

Configuring ports

1. From the dropdown list, select the port you want to use for the selected Ethernet devices.

2. Click Configure at the bottom of the Configure Ports section.

Editing duplicated device information


The following sections describe how to quickly edit the properties of duplicated devices in the table
editing area.

Copying device information from a spreadsheet


Sometimes device names do not follow any particular naming pattern. In this case, you can use the
copy/paste function to apply configuration changes directly to the Table Editing area.

First, you need to add a new device in Management Console, then create as many duplicates of the
device as the quantity of items you are pasting.

If you have a Microsoft Excel spreadsheet that contains a list of these devices to add to
Management Console, you can use the Configure Names area to create duplicates of that device
type, then use the Table Editing area to copy and paste the device properties from the Excel
spreadsheet.

Example: Copy and paste 20 Ethernet devices from excel

1. Confirm that the names in the Excel spreadsheet conform to the naming convention “[Group].
[DeviceName]”.

2. Add the first device and set up its properties in Management Console. You can assign it a
simple device name such as “A.B1” since it will be overwritten when the values are copied and
pasted from Excel. Set the Enabled property to No so that Management Console does not
attempt to connect to the device.

3. Click OK to add the device.

4. Right-click the device and select Duplicate and Configure.

5. Select the “1” in the Configure Names box, then use the End spin box to set the value to 20.

6. In the Hide/Show Columns area, clear the check box of all non-editable columns to hide those
that contain grayed out values. Also hide the columns you do not want to paste over or those
that are not included in the Excel spreadsheet.

850 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

7. On the Excel spreadsheet, arrange the columns so they match the order of the columns on the
Table Editing area. Hide all columns on the Excel spreadsheet except those corresponding to
columns on the Table Editing area.

8. Select the cells in Excel and copy them (CTRL+C).

9. On the Table Editing area, click on the first cell under the Name column to select it, then paste
the contents of the clipboard (CTRL+V).

10. Click Apply to save your changes or click OK save your changes and return to Management
Console.

Using Find and Replace to edit device information


Use the Find and Replace feature to modify matching characters in the device names or in any
other editable columns on the device table. The Find and Replace feature does not work on read-
only columns.

1. Right-click the device table and select Find and Replace (or press CTRL+H).

2. Type the characters you want to search for in the Find box. Do not use wildcard characters
(“*”). Note that the search is case-sensitive.

3. Find in column lists all available columns. Select the column you want to search in.

4. In the Replace box, type the characters you want to use to replace the characters in the Find
box. If you want to delete characters from a column value, leave the Replace box blank.

5. Click Preview to list the search results in the table. The Replace with column displays the
new name or value resulting from the Find and Replace operation.

6. Use the check box in the Select column to select the rows for which you want to change
values. Click Select All to select all the items or Clear Selected to clear all.

7. Click Apply to save your changes or Cancel to discard your changes

8. Click OK to save your changes and close the dialog.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 851


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Manual Data Editor


TIP: You can open Manual Data Editor in Management Console from the Tools > System >
Manual Data Editor link.

Use Manual Data Editor to edit logged measurement data or to manually enter measurement data
into the PME database. With this tool, you can adjust incorrect data, outliers, roll overs, jitter, and
other unexpected or unwanted data records. You can fill data gaps or enter manually collected data,
such as clipboard readings from mechanical meters. The Manual Data Editor also has the ability to
create new, custom measurements in PME.

NOTE: Manual Data Editor can only be used to edit trend data logs. It cannot be used to edit
waveform logs or event logs.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
Back up the database before making manual database edits.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

For information on how to use the Manual Data Editor , see:

• Editing existing logged measurement data

• Adding manually collected measurement data

• Viewing previous change details

• Reverting previous data edits

• Creating new measurements

For reference information see:

• Manual Data Editor user interface

852 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Editing existing logged measurement data


Edit existing data logs to adjust incorrect data, outliers, roll overs, jitter, and other unexpected or
unwanted data. You can also fill in missing data and insert missing data records.
To edit existing logged measurement data:

1. In Manual Data Editor, click Load New Data to open the Load Data dialog box.

NOTE: Load Data opens automatically when you start Manual Data Editor.

2. In Load Data:
Select the Source for which you want to edit the logged data.

Select the Measurement for which you want to edit the logged data.

Click Add Data to Selection to add the source/measurement to the list of items to be
opened in the data editor.

3. (Optional) Repeat step 2 to add additional sources and measurements to the selection list.

4. In Load Data, select the Time Range for the logged data you want to open in the data editor.

5. (Optional) In Load Data, set the following data editor options:


Timezone - Set the timezone for the display of the configurable timestamp in the data
editor. The data editor shows two timestamps for each data record, one timestamp in
UTC and one in a configurable timezone.

Timestamp Format - Set the format for the timestamp display in the data editor.

Number Format - Set the number of decimals that are displayed for the logged data in the
data editor.

Is Interval Data - Select the check box to enable this property. Set the expected logging
interval for the data.

This setting ensures that there is a data row in the editor for every expected log entry. If
there is no data record for an expected entry in the database, then the Manual Data Editor
inserts a timestamped row with a <no data> data values in the editor. This makes it easier
to identify missing records and correct them.

NOTE: The data editor shows all logged records in the selected time range, regardless of
the Interval Data settings. No records are hidden or filtered out.

6. Click Load Data to open the source/measurement data in the data editor.

7. (Optional) In the data editor, click Load New Data to change which data is loaded, the time
range, or the editor options.

8. (Optional) In the data editor, click View Issue Report to see which data issues were identified
with the loaded data by Manual Data Editor.

9. (Optional) In the data editor, use Locate Issues to find and step through the data issues
identified by Manual Data Editor. The data editor uses different color highlights to mark data
issues.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 853


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

10. Locate data records that you want to edit and use any of the following tools or methods to edit
the data:
Click a data record and edit the data value.

Insert Timestamp - Insert a new data record with a timestamp that you specify. The
timestamp must be in the time range of the data that is loaded into the editor. The new
record has <no data> data values.

NOTE: A historical data log timestamp marks the end of the logging interval. For
example, a data log with a 15 minute logging interval and timestamp of 17:00 represents
data for the time interval of 16:45 - 17:00.

Smart Gap Fill - Automatically fill missing data values in a selected time range, or the
entire time range of the loaded data set. You can choose between different interpolation
algorithms to fill the missing data. See Smart Gap Fill UI for more details.

Delete a data record or data value. These options are available in the right-click context
menu.

Set a data value to <null>. This option is available in the right-click context menu.

Copy one or more data values and paste them into an external editor, such as Microsoft
Excel, for bulk editing. Paste the modified data values back into Manual Data Editor. The
copy and paste options are available in the right-click context menu.

NOTE: Only select the data values for copy/paste, not the timestamps.

TIP: Modified data values are shown in bold font in the Manual Data Editor.

11. (Optional) In the data editor, use Locate Changes to find and step through the edited data
records.

12. (Optional) Revert edited data values back to their original value. This option is available in the
right-click context menu. Use Undo all Changes to revert all edits in the loaded data set.

13. Click Apply Changes to write the data log changes to the database.

NOTE: The Apply Changes command permanently writes the data log changes to the
database. There is no undo option for this command. See Reverting previous data edits for
more information.

14. (Optional) Click View Log to see a historical audit log of all the data log changes.

15. Close Manual Data Editor.

For information on how to use the Manual Data Editor , see:

• Editing existing logged measurement data

• Adding manually collected measurement data

• Viewing previous change details

854 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Reverting previous data edits

• Creating new measurements

For reference information see:

• Manual Data Editor user interface

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 855


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding manually collected measurement data


Manually add data logs to the database that were collected from data sources that do not have a
communication link with the software.
To add manually collected measurement data:

1. In Manual Data Editor, click Load New Data to open the Load Data dialog box.

NOTE: Load Data opens automatically when you start Manual Data Editor.

2. In Load Data:
Select the Source for which you want to add data.

Select the Measurement for which you want to add data. If the measurement does not
exist, click Create new Measurement to create a new measurement.

NOTE: Check the list of available measurements to see if one exists for your application
before creating a new measurement.

Click Add Data to Selection to add the source/measurement to the list of items to be
opened in the editor.

3. (Optional) Repeat step 2 to add additional sources and measurements to the selection list.

4. In Load Data, select the Time Range for the data you want to add in the data editor.

5. (Optional) In Load Data, set the following data editor options:


Timezone - Set the timezone for the display of the configurable timestamp in the data
editor. The data editor shows two timestamps for each data record, one timestamp in
UTC and one in a configurable timezone.

Timestamp Format - Set the format for the timestamp display in the data editor.

Number Format - Set the number of decimals that are displayed for the logged data in the
data editor.

Is Interval Data - Select the check box to enable this property. Set the expected logging
interval for the data. This setting ensures that there is a data row in the editor for every
expected log entry.

6. Click Load Data to open the source/measurement data entry fields in the data editor.

7. (Optional) In the data editor, click Load New Data to change which data is loaded, the time
range, or the editor options.

8. In the data editor enter the measurement data using any of the following tools or methods:
Click a data record and edit the data value.

Insert Timestamp - Insert a new data record with a timestamp that you specify. The
timestamp must be in the time range of the data that is loaded into the editor. The new
record has <no data> data values.

856 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

NOTE: A historical data log timestamp marks the end of the logging interval. For
example, a data log with a 15 minute logging interval and timestamp of 17:00 represents
data for the time interval of 16:45 - 17:00. That means that the last data log for a day has
a timestamp of midnight (or 12 AM) of the following day. For example, the last data log
timestamp for January 31 has a timestamp of February 1, 00:00 hrs (or 12 AM).

Smart Gap Fill - Automatically fill missing data values in a selected time range, or the
entire time range of the loaded data set. You can choose between different interpolation
algorithms to fill the missing data. See Smart Gap Fill UI for more details.

Delete a data record or data value. These options are available in the right-click context
menu.

Set a data value to <null>. This option is available in the right-click context menu.

Copy one or more data values and paste them into an external editor, such as Microsoft
Excel, for bulk editing. Paste the modified data values back into Manual Data Editor. The
copy and paste options are available in the right-click context menu.

NOTE: Only select the data values for copy/paste, not the timestamps.

TIP: Modified data values are shown in bold font in the Manual Data Editor.

9. Click Apply Changes to write the new data log entries to the database.

NOTE: The Apply Changes command permanently writes the data log changes to the
database. There is no undo option for this command. See Reverting previous data edits for
more information.

10. (Optional) Click View Log to see a historical audit log of all the data log changes.

11. Close Manual Data Editor.

For information on how to use the Manual Data Editor , see:

• Editing existing logged measurement data

• Adding manually collected measurement data

• Viewing previous change details

• Reverting previous data edits

• Creating new measurements

For reference information see:

• Manual Data Editor user interface

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 857


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing previous change details


Manual Data Editor maintains an audit log which records all changes to logged data made by the
tool. The log is filtered by source/measurement.
To view previous change details:

1. In Manual Data Editor, click Load New Data to open the Load Data dialog box.

NOTE: Load Data opens automatically when you start Manual Data Editor.

2. In Load Data:
Select the Source for which you want to see the audit log.

Select the Measurement for which you want to see the audit log.

Click Add Data to Selection to add the source/measurement to the list of items to be
opened in the data editor.

3. (Optional) Repeat step 2 to add additional sources and measurements to the selection list.

4. Click Load Data to open the source/measurement data entry fields in the data editor.

NOTE: Ignore the settings for Time Range and Options, they have no influence on the
display of the audit log.

5. (Optional) In the data editor, click Load New Data to change which data is loaded, the time
range, or the editor options.

6. Click View Log to open the audit log for these sources/measurements.

7. View the audit log.

8. Close Manual Data Editor.

For information on how to use the Manual Data Editor , see:

• Editing existing logged measurement data

• Adding manually collected measurement data

• Viewing previous change details

• Reverting previous data edits

• Creating new measurements

For reference information see:

• Manual Data Editor user interface

858 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Reverting previous data edits


It is not possible to directly and automatically revert previous data edits with Manual Data Editor.
However, you can use the information available in the audit log to manually revert previous edits.
To revert previous data edits:

1. In Manual Data Editor, click Load New Data to open the Load Data dialog box.

NOTE: Load Data opens automatically when you start Manual Data Editor.

2. In Load Data:
Select the Source for which you want to revert previous edits.

Select the Measurement for which you want to revert previous edits.

Click Add Data to Selection to add the source/measurement to the list of items to be
opened in the data editor.

3. (Optional) Repeat step 2 to add additional sources and measurements to the selection list.

4. In Load Data, select the Time Range for the logged data you want to open in the data editor.

5. (Optional) In Load Data, set the following editor options:


Timezone - Set the timezone for the display of the configurable timestamp in the data
editor. The data editor shows two timestamps for each data record, one timestamp in
UTC and one in a configurable timezone.

Timestamp Format - Set the format for the timestamp display in the data editor.

Number Format - Set the number of decimals that are displayed for the logged data in the
data editor.

Is Interval Data - Select the check box to enable this property. Set the expected logging
interval for the data.

This setting ensures that there is a data row in the editor for every expected log entry. If
there is no data record for an expected entry in the database, then the Manual Data Editor
inserts a timestamped row with a null value in the editor. This makes it easier to identify
missing records and correct them.

NOTE: The data editor shows all logged records in the selected time range, regardless of
the Interval Data settings. No records are hidden or filtered out.

6. Click Load Data to open the source/measurement data in the data editor.

7. (Optional) Click Load New Data to change which data is loaded, the time range, or the editor
options.

8. Click View Log to open the audit log for these sources/measurements.

9. Find the log entries that you want to revert. Using the information provided in the Original
Value and New Value columns, identify the values you want the logs to be reset to.

TIP: You can copy the values from the audit log and paste them into the data editor or an
external editor such as Microsoft Excel.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 859


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

10. Close the Audit Log.

11. In the data editor, locate data records that you want to edit and use any of the following tools or
methods to reset the data:
Click a data record and edit the data value.

Insert Timestamp - Insert a new data record with a timestamp that you specify. The
timestamp must be in the time range of the data that is loaded into the editor. The new
record has <no data> data values.

NOTE: A historical data log timestamp marks the end of the logging interval. For
example, a data log with a 15 minute logging interval and timestamp of 17:00 represents
data for the time interval of 16:45 - 17:00.

Delete a data record or data value. These options are available in the right-click context
menu.

Set a data value to <null>. This option is available in the right-click context menu.

Paste the data values from the audit log into the data records. The copy and paste options
are available in the right-click context menu.

NOTE: Only select the data values for copy/paste, not the timestamps.

TIP: Modified data values are shown in bold font in the Manual Data Editor.

12. (Optional) In the data editor, use Locate Changes to find and step through the edited data
records.

13. (Optional) Revert edited data values back to their original value. This option is available in the
right-click context menu. Use Undo all Changes to revert all edits in the loaded data set.

14. Click Apply Changes to write the data log changes to the database.

15. Close Manual Data Editor.

For information on how to use the Manual Data Editor , see:

• Editing existing logged measurement data

• Adding manually collected measurement data

• Viewing previous change details

• Reverting previous data edits

• Creating new measurements

For reference information see:

• Manual Data Editor user interface

860 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Creating new measurements


You can use Manual Data Editor to create new, custom measurements in PME. These
measurements are available anywhere in the software.
To create a new measurement:

1. In Manual Data Editor, click Load New Data to open the Load Data dialog box.

NOTE: Load Data opens automatically when you start Manual Data Editor.

2. In Load Data, click Create new Measurement to open the Create new Measurement dialog
box.

NOTE: Check the list of available measurements to see if one exists for your application
before creating a new measurement.

3. In Create new Measurement, enter the relevant information for the new measurement.

4. Click Create to add the new measurement to the system.

5. (Optional) Repeat steps 2-4 to add additional measurements.

6. Close Manual Data Editor.

For information on how to use the Manual Data Editor , see:

• Editing existing logged measurement data

• Adding manually collected measurement data

• Viewing previous change details

• Reverting previous data edits

• Creating new measurements

For reference information see:

• Manual Data Editor user interface

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 861


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

OPC Server Support


Introduction to OPC
OPC is a set of open standards for connectivity and interoperability of industrial automation and the
enterprise system. OPC provides a bridge between Windows based applications and process
control hardware, thereby eliminating the need for proprietary or custom interfaces and drivers for
the various data types and sources residing in your corporate information network. Having
information readily available in a universally-recognized format can cut costs, speed up
development and increase operations efficiency. This is especially true when many diverse
software applications, hardware, and operating systems exist in the corporate and operations
networks.

RECOMMENDATION: Use an OPC tunneling application for OPC data exchange over a network

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the OPC Server.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

OPC is supported through the implementation of IONReal Time Data Service, a .NET-based
system that takes the traditional “register handle-based” ION data and transforms it into structured
“measurement-based” data that complies with open standards such as OPC. ION Real Time Data
Service facilitates the translation and organization of data in this new measurement classification
system.

Power Monitoring Expert supports OPC server and OPC client functionality. The OPC server
translates ION data into OPC data, for exporting and viewing in other third-party OPC client
systems. The OPC client, on the other hand, takes OPC standardized measurements from third-
party systems and translates them into a data format that Power Monitoring Expert can use.

This appendix provides basic configuration and operation instructions for the OPC server
component of Power Monitoring Expert.

NOTE: The OPC client is available in all Power Monitoring Expert installations. However, due to
the number of different third-party OPC-compliant servers in the industry, as well as different
methods and syntax for connecting to these servers and accessing their data, it is highly
recommended that you contact Technical Support for assistance in configuring the OPC client.

862 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Optional OPC server license


The OPC Server Assistant is available during the 90-day trial period. After the trial period, you need
to purchase a Data Exchange Module license and activate it through the License Configuration Tool
to enable OPC server functionality.

OPC server type


The Power Monitoring Expert OPC server complies with the "OPC Data Access Custom Interface
Standard Version 2.05A". The class of data that the current release of OPC Data Access server is
able to provide is Read-Only data (i.e., control functions are not currently supported).

OPC measurement support


OPC measurement support for Power Monitoring Expert allows you to easily translate data from
ION devices and compatible Modbus devices into OPC-compliant measurement data formats, then
make this measurement data available to OPC clients through the OPC server.

Management Console has a command that lets you export default measurements from compatible
devices to the OPC server. In addition, Designer and Device Type Editor user interfaces let you
view and select which OPC measurement data you want the OPC server to expose to OPC clients.

Creating/updating default OPC mapping


Power Monitoring Expert can create the default ION-to-OPC data mapping based on the devices
contained in the ION_Network database. This default mapping translates the most commonly-used
ION data to OPC data and exports the data to the OPC server.

1. Launch Management Console.

2. Click Tools > System > Update OPC Server.

3. Click Yes to create/update the OPC server.

A summary of the configuration details is displayed.

4. Click OK.

NOTE: If you add a new device to the ION_Network database at a later date, you must repeat the
above procedure in order to map the new source device’s data to the OPC server.

OPC Server Assistant


The OPC Server Assistant is a mechanism that lets you select which OPC measurements to
expose to the OPC server. Custom labels are not mapped to OPC server by default. They need to
be manually exported to OPC server.

OPC Server Assistant is accessible through Designer.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 863


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

A Unavailable registers (Grayed-out) B Output Register C Setup Registers

Exporting OPC measurements through Designer


If you customized an ION device’s default templates (for example, custom labels), those
measurements are not exposed to the OPC server by default. To manually export those
measurements to OPC server:

1. Launch Designer and open the ION device node.

2. Navigate to the ION module that contains the register that you want to expose to OPC server.
Right-click to display the module setup dialog.

3. Click OPC to open the OPC Server Assistant.

4. Select (check) the box beside each item you want to expose to the OPC server. Clear
(uncheck) the box beside each item you do not want to expose to the OPC server.

NOTE: Grayed-out items (such as “PF sign a” in the Power Meter module) cannot be
selected or changed. Those registers cannot be removed using OPC Server Assistant.

5. Click File > Export. Click Yes to save your changes.

Description of commands
This section describes the commands available in the OPC Server Assistant.

Command Result
Saves your configuration changes. Items that are selected
File > Export (checked) in the OPC Server Assistant are exposed to the OPC
server, while cleared (unchecked) items are not.
File > Exit Closes the OPC Server Assistant.
Discards your changes and reverts to the last saved configuration
Edit > Reset values
(for the items that are exported to the OPC server).
Edit > Select All Selects (checks) all registers.

864 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Command Result
Edit > Clear All Clears (unchecks) all registers that are not grayed out.
Displays the setup registers, in addition to the output registers, for
View > Setup Registers
the module.
Displays a column containing the measurement names associated
View > Measurements
with the registers.

Viewing OPC data


A third-party OPC client can connect to the ION OPC server using a valid connection address,
which consists of the network node or host machine name where the OPC server is running and the
OPC program ID (ION.OpcDaServer). For example:

opcda://WORKSTATION3/ION.OpcDaServer

NOTE: Syntax use varies across different OPC clients. Refer to your OPC client documentation
for details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 865


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Losses Configuration Utility


TIP: You can open the Power Losses Configuration Utility from the Power Monitoring Expert >
Configuration Tools folder on your desktop.

Use the Power Losses Configuration Tool to configure the Capacity Management Module. With this
tool you define Transformers and UPS Modules for the Power Losses Report.

See Capacity Management Module configuration for details.

Prerequisites
• The monitoring devices that are recording the transformer and UPS data must be configured in
the PME Management Console and must be communicating before you can configure the
components and properties in the configuration tool.

User Interface

Control Description
Help Opens the help for the utility.
New Creates a new entry in the grid.
Delete Deletes the selected entry from the grid.
OK Saves all changes and exits the utility.
Cancel Exits the utility without saving changes.
Apply Saves all changes and leaves the utility open.

866 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Grid Area Columns Description


Modified Displays a status symbol for the record.
+ (plus) A new entry.
* (asterisk) An existing entry has been modified.
! (exclamation mark) The entry is incorrect.

Power Losses configuration restrictions


The Power Losses Configuration Utility enforces certain rules when you create a power losses
system:

• All Devices
Name must be unique.

A meter source must be assigned only once to a device.

• Transformers
Zero, one, or more low voltage transformers may be present in the power losses system.

Zero, one, or more medium voltage transformers may be present in the power losses
system.

• UPS Modules
Zero, one, or more UPS modules may be present in the power losses system.

Defining transformers for Power Losses


To define a transformer used in your power losses system:

1. Select the Transformers tab.

2. Click New. The editable fields are enabled.

3. Define the transformer:


a. Name: Enter a unique name for the transformer.

b. Description: (Optional) Enter a description for the transformer. For example: make,


model.

c. Input Side Meter Source: Select a source name from the drop-down list. The source
represents the Power Monitoring Expert device that records the electrical data from the
input side of the transformer.

d. Output Side Meter Source: Select a source name from the dropdown list. The source
represents the Power Monitoring Expert device that records the electrical data from the
output side of the transformer.

e. Low Voltage/Medium Voltage: Select Low Voltage or Medium Voltage from the drop-
down list to indicate the transformer voltage rating type.

4. Click OK to save the transformer.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 867


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Related Topic: Defining UPS modules for Power Losses

Defining UPS modules for Power Losses


To define a UPS module used in your power losses system:

1. Click the UPS Modules tab.

2. Click New. The editable fields are enabled.

3. Define the UPS module:


a. Name: Enter a unique name for the UPS module.

b. Description: (Optional) Enter a description for the UPS module. For example: make,


model.

c. Input Side Meter Source: Select a source name from the drop-down list. The source
represents the Power Monitoring Expert device that records the electrical data from the
input side of the UPS module.

d. Output Side Meter Source: Select a source name from the drop-down list. The source
represents the Power Monitoring Expert device that records the electrical data from the
output side of the UPS module.

4. Click OK to save the UPS module.

868 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Related Topic: Defining transformers for Power Losses

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 869


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

PQDIF Exporter
PQDIF (Power Quality Data Interchange Format) is a non-proprietary means of exchanging power
quality data between different metering devices and software.

Developed under the guidelines of IEEE P1159.3, PQDIF provides a common ground where
different vendors can export to or import from, using a data format consistent with the defined
PQDIF standard.

Power Monitoring Expert supports PQDIF through the “PQDIF Exporter” add-on. PQDIF Exporter
takes data from the Power Monitoring Expert SQL Server database, converts it to PQDIF, and
stores this formatted file for viewing with any of the various programs that can display PQDIF data.
The PQDIF Exporter allows you to set regularly scheduled exports of ION data to PQDIF, as well
as perform these exports manually.

This guide provides basic configuration and operation instructions for the PQDIF Exporter. It is
assumed that the user already has knowledge of PQDIF. For details on viewing the PQDIF data,
refer to the documentation that came with your PQDIF viewer. For detailed information on the
PQDIF specification, visit the IEEE website.

Configuring the PQDIF Exporter


From Management Console, select Tools > System > PQDIF Exporter.

When you run PQDIF Exporter for the first time, the PQDIF Exporter Configuration dialog opens
with the options to perform the initial configuration steps. To edit these settings at any time, select
Options > Configure PQDIF Exporter. You can also edit the PT/CT Scaling used for the sources
by the PQDIF Exporter; select Options > PT/CT Scaling.

870 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Database options
The Database Options dialog allows you to make changes to the database connection settings
(SQL Server Instance, User Name, and Password). Type your changes in the appropriate fields.

NOTE: Under most conditions, you do not need to change the factory settings.

Click Test These Settings to test your database connection. A prompt displays to indicate whether
or not connection to the database was successful.

Output folder
Click Output Folder to change the folder where PQDIF Exporter stores its output files. Type the
folder path or click Browse to navigate and select the folder (or to create a new folder).

Message logging options


Click Message Logging Options to change the settings for message logging and email
notification. The options available to configure are Log File, System Log, and E-mail Notification.

Log File options


Click Log File Options to specify the location for the log file and the logging level option.

Location

To change the folder location for the log file, type the folder path in the Location field or click Browse
to navigate and select the folder.

Logging Level

Logging Level lists the different options for logging depth. Select the level you want from the
dropdown list:

• Disabled: No messages are stored in the log file.

• Normal: Warning and error messages are stored in the log file.

• Detailed: Warnings, errors, and information are stored in the log file.

• Diagnostic: Warnings, errors, information, and diagnostic messages are stored in the log file.

NOTE: The “Diagnostic” log file option uses a huge amount of system resources. Select this
option only if absolutely necessary.

System Log options


Click System Log Options to specify whether or not messages are stored in the Power Monitoring
Expert system log.
Select from the following options:

• Disabled: No messages are stored in the system log.

• Normal: Warning and error messages are stored in the system log.

Email options
Click E-mail Options to set up email notification from PQDIF Exporter.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 871


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

SMTP Server to set for E-mail messages

Type the name of the SMTP server PQDIF Exporter uses to send the email.

From E-mail Address to use for PQDIF Exporter

Type the address you want to appear in the “From” field in the email message.

E-mail Recipients

Click Add to enter email address recipients for the PQDIF Exporter messages. To delete an email
address from the list, select it then click Remove.

Logging Level

The Logging Level box lists the different options for the amount of information sent in the email
message. If you change this setting, it affects the setting for all email recipients.

• Disabled: No email sent.

• Normal: Email warning and error messages.

When you have finished setting up the email options, click Test These Settings to test the email
connection.

If email settings are configured properly, a test message is sent to your inbox.

Exporter service options


Click Exporter Service Options to specify how often the PQDIF Exporter service restarts from an
idle state to check the database for data to export.

Use the up and down arrows and dropdown list to set the frequency.

NOTE: Setting the Exporter Service Frequency Settings to seconds uses a huge amount of
system resources. Select this option only if absolutely necessary.

872 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

PT/CT scaling
For a network where the PT/CT ratios on the meters are not set to the actual ratio values (for
example, if the ratios are set to 1:1 for revenue metering purposes), the PQDIF Exporter service can
scale the values to the correct primary measurements when it exports data.
To set the PT/CT scaling for the PQDIF Exporter:

1. Click Options > PT/CT Scaling to open the PT/CT Scaling dialog displaying the current
PT/CT scaling for the sources in your network.

2. Select a source(s) and click Edit PT/CT Scaling for Selected Sources to open the Edit
PT/CT Ratios dialog.

3. Enter the multiplier required to convert secondary values to primary values (for example, enter
1000 for a 5000:5 CT). Click OK.

4. Click Save to save your changes.

PQDIF Exporter main window


This is the main user interface for setting up schedules for PQDIF Exporter jobs or for setting up and
running the jobs manually.

From Management Console, click Tools > System > PQDIF Exporter.

A Main menu items B Status of Exporter

Menu items
All the PQDIF Exporter commands are available from the main menu. Some of these commands
are also available when you right-click on the interface background or on a job.

Starting/stopping the exporter service


To start the PQDIF Exporter service:

• Select Options > Start Exporter Service, or

• Right-click the status bar and select Start Service.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 873


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To stop the service:

• Select Options > Stop Exporter Service, or

• Right-click the status bar and select Stop Service.

PQDIF Exporter jobs


The Jobs menu contains commands which allow you to set up PQDIF Exporter jobs that run
automatically, according to the schedule you specify. You can also set up manual jobs to collect
data for a specific date range from the SQL Server database for conversion to PQDIF.

PQDIF data templates


PQDIF data templates are the mapping files that convert ION data to PQDIF. PQDIF Exporter
extracts recorded data for the following default templates:

• Flicker: Short-term and long-term flicker disturbance data on the voltage inputs.

• Sag/Swell: Sag/swell disturbance data for the voltage inputs, including minimum, maximum
and average values.

• Sag/Swell Waveforms: Waveform data for voltage sag/swell.

• Steady-state: Steady-state (RMS) data for trending.

• Steady-state Waveforms: Waveform data for steady-state data.

NOTE: For the Steady-state Waveforms template, you must program the meter to use a
Periodic Timer module to perform periodic waveform recording of the voltage and current
channel inputs. The time interval you specify must be a multiple of 15 minutes.

• Transient Waveforms: Transient disturbance data for voltage inputs.

In addition to the default templates, custom templates can be also be developed — contact
Technical Support if you require customized data templates for your application.

Scheduled export jobs


You can set up PQDIF Exporter to run at a specific time every day, or you can specify a different
time interval (for example, every 12 hours or every 7 days). You can create and store multiple
scheduled jobs for the PQDIF Exporter.

874 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Creating a Scheduled Export Job

1. Click Jobs > New Job > Scheduled Export to open the Scheduled Export dialog.

2. Type a short but descriptive name in the Job Name field. Use the Job Description field to
give more details about the job.

3. Select the sources for your scheduled data export. Click the box beside each source to select
or deselect it.

Click All Sources to select all available devices that log the type of data specified by the data
templates. When this logged data is detected for a new device, that device is automatically
added to all scheduled PQDIF Exporter jobs that have All Sources selected.

4. Select the Data Templates you want to use when the PQDIF Exporter runs. Click the box
beside each template to select or deselect it.

Click All Templates to select all available data templates for the selected devices. When a
new data template is added, that template is automatically added to all scheduled PQDIF
Exporter jobs that have All Templates selected.

5. Use the Export Time section to specify how frequently the PQDIF Exporter should run, as
well as its start/cut-off time. When a scheduled PQDIF Exporter job runs for the first time (at
the specified start time), it collects historical data to create PQDIF files so that the time period
for that export is consistent (“caught up”) with the time periods of all subsequent scheduled
PQDIF exports.

Example 1: If you saved the scheduled job (1) at 4:25 PM, with the Exporter scheduled to
run daily at midnight, the first PQDIF file is generated at midnight (2) the same day, and
includes data spanning from the previous midnight. PQDIF Exporter runs again next
midnight (3), and includes data spanning the first scheduled export (2).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 875


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example 2: If you set a scheduled job to run PQDIF Exporter every 8 hours, starting at
3:00 AM, then the first PQDIF file is generated at 3:00 AM, and will include data spanning
8 hours previous to that time (that is, 7:00 PM). The next export starts 8 hours later, at
11:00 AM, then at 7:00 PM, then at 3:00 AM and so on.

Example 3: To run PQDIF Exporter once a week at 6:00 AM, change Export Time to
“Export every 7 Day(s) at 6:00 AM”. In this example, the PQDIF file contains a full week’s
worth of PQDIF data

6. Click Add Job.

NOTE: Exporter Service must be started in order to run scheduled PQDIF Exporter jobs. See
PQDIF Exporter main window.

Manual export jobs


A manual export job enables you to run the PQDIF Exporter immediately. You can create a different
manual job for each source and/or template, or for specific groups of sources and/or templates.

876 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Creating a manual export job

1. Click Jobs > New Job > Manual Export to open the Manual Data Export dialog.

2. Type a short but descriptive name in the Job Name field. Use the Job Description field to
give more details about the job.

3. Select the sources for your data export. Click the box beside each source to select or deselect
it.
To select all available devices, select the All Sources box.

4. Select the Data Templates you want to use. Click the box beside each template to select or
deselect it.
To select all available templates, select the All Templates box.

5. Use the Export Range From and To boxes to specify the date range of historical data that the
PQDIF Exporter will use. The default time format is local time. If you want to use Coordinated
Universal Time format, select UTC.

6. Use the File Splitting options to specify how PQDIF Exporter exports the data. The default
method is to export the data to a single PQDIF file. You can change this so the data is split
into different PQDIF files — for example, if you want to split the data so each PQDIF file
contains 12 hours worth of data, set the File Splitting to “Export into separate files for each 12
Hour(s) of data”.

7. Click Export Now to run and save this manual PQDIF Exporter job, or click Add Job to save
without running it.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 877


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Running manual jobs

After you enter the manual PQDIF Exporter jobs, you can select and run them:

1. On the PQDIF Exporter interface, select the manual job(s) you want to run.

2. Right-click and select Export Selected Manual Job(s). A command window displays to
indicate the progress of the export. Press the RETURN (ENTER) key when prompted to
return to the PQDIF Exporter interface.

NOTE: To run all manual jobs, click Jobs > Export All Manual Jobs.

Editing the PQDIF Exporter jobs


To make changes to a scheduled or manual job:

1. To edit a job, open the Export Configuration dialog in one of the following ways:
Double-click the job.

Select the job, then click Jobs > Edit Selected Job, or

Right-click the job and select Edit Selected Job.

2. Make your changes and click Save.

Duplicating PQDIF Exporter jobs


If you are creating jobs that have very similar attributes (for example, jobs that use the same set of
devices, templates and/or time schedules), you can set up the first job, duplicate it, then simply edit
the copy.

1. Select the job(s) you want to duplicate, then click Jobs > Duplicate Selected Jobs (or right-
click the job and select Duplicate Selected Jobs).

2. Double-click the copy of the job you want to edit, make your changes, then click Save.

878 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Enabling/disabling the PQDIF Exporter jobs


To enable or disable the scheduled or manual jobs:

1. Select the job(s) you want to enable or disable.

2. To enable the jobs, click Jobs > Enable Selected Jobs. To disable them, click Jobs >
Disable Selected Jobs. You can also right-click the jobs and select Enable Selected Jobs
or Disable Selected Jobs to enable or disable the jobs.

Adjusting the column widths


To change the width of a column, hover the mouse over border of the column headings — the mouse
pointer changes into a double-arrow pointer — click and drag to adjust the column width.

Sorting the PQDIF Exporter job list


Click the title of a column to sort the data according to that column heading. An arrow appears in the
title of the column. Click the title again to toggle the sorting—ascending or descending order.

Deleting PQDIF Exporter jobs


To permanently remove PQDIF Exporter jobs from the list:

1. Select the jobs you want to delete, then:


Click Jobs > Delete,

Press the Delete key on your keyboard, or

Right-click and select Delete Selected Jobs.

2. Click Yes when prompted.

NOTE: You can also disable a job instead of deleting it (that is, Enable = “No”). This way, the job
can be enabled at a later date if required.

Closing the PQDIF Exporter window


To close and exit the PQDIF Exporter window, click the “X” at the top right corner, or click File >
Exit.

If the Exporter Service is stopped when you try to exit, PQDIF Exporter prompts you to start the
service in order to process scheduled jobs. Click Yes to start the Exporter Service.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 879


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Rate Editor

Rate Editor is a Web-based application that lets you change cost values for items included in a
billing report.

Open Rate Editor from Web Applications Settings > System > Billing Rates. You can also open
Rate Editor from Management Console Tools > Web Tools.

The Rate File list on the left lists all of the rate files contained in the ratelibrary folder in the Power
Monitoring Expert install location under applications\config\reports\billing report.
When you add rate files to the folder, they are included in the Rate File list.

Rate Editor User Interface


The Line Item Label and Unit Cost areas on the right list a description of line items and the
associated cost values defined in each rate file. Click a rate file to view its line items and cost
values.
To modify the unit cost value for billing report purposes:

1. Click the unit cost value that you want to change to enable editing.

2. Type the new value and press Enter to complete the update.

3. To return to the previous value, click Undo.

The rate files included in the product are examples of various billing scenarios. The files are
intended to be copied and modified to meet your specific requirements. For further information about
creating or modifying rate files, see the documentation, tutorials, and examples included in the
Billing Module Toolkit (available in the Power Monitoring Expert Exchange).

880 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Remote Modem Setup


Use Remote Modem Setup to preconfigure dialup modems that will be connected to meters at
remote locations. Hardware-based and software-based (WinModems) modems are supported.

Remote Modem Setup provides access to a database that contains configuration data for a variety
of modems you can pick from. Remote Modem Setup also provides direct access to your modem
so you can customize settings and troubleshoot its operation.

Preliminary Setup
Follow the instructions in your modem’s documentation to set up and connect the modem to one of
your computer’s serial ports. Select a port that the Power Monitoring Expert Communications
Server is not using.

Using Remote Modem Setup


1. Start Management Console.

2. Click Tools > System > Remote Modem Setup to open the Remote Modem Setup dialog.

3. Set the Port to the serial communications port that the computer uses to communicate with
(and set up) the modem. Set the Baud Rate to match the modem’s baud rate.

NOTE: To reduce possible communication issues, set the computer, modems and meters to
the same baud rate.

4. Set the following properties for the remote modem:


Select the type of modem from the Type box.

Set the Site Baud Rate.

To set the modem to answer after a specified number of rings, select Auto Answer, then
type the appropriate number in the Number of Rings box.

To save the modem configuration data in the modem’s onboard memory, select Store
Profile. This feature allows the modem to revert to the saved settings after a power
outage. Clear Store Profile to disable this feature.

To turn on the modem’s internal speaker, select Speaker On, then select a setting from
the Volume list. Clear Speaker On to disable this feature.

5. Click Send to save the settings to the modem.

If there are DIP switch settings required for the modem that is being configured, a message
displays with instructions on which switches to turn on or off. Set the DIP switches on the
modem as instructed.

The modem is now ready to be used at the remote power monitoring site.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 881


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Software Logging
Use Software Logging to add or edit software-based data logging for Modbus device types. This is
intended for device types that do not have onboard data logging capabilities. You can also add
software logging to a device type with onboard data logging to log additional measurements that are
not logged by the device.

RECOMMENDATION: Use onboard data logging when possible. The data log timestamps for
onboard data logs are more accurate than the timestamps for software data logging. Onboard data
logging is also more reliable than software data logging since it does not depend on a network
connection to the device.

The Software Logging link in Management Console opens the same Configure Logging and
Calculation dialog that is available through the Device Type Editor. For more information on adding
software logging see Adding Software Logging to a Modbus Device Type.

882 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

System use notification


You can add a system use notification to your PME system that is displayed in Engineering
applications and Web Applications clients every time before users can log into the system.

Use a system use notification to inform persons accessing the system of authorization
requirements, to get user acceptance of terms and conditions before logging in, or to display any
other information that you want to make your users aware of.
To enable a system use notification:

1. In Windows Explorer, locate the system use notification HTML files.


a. For Web Application clients: ...Power Monitoring Expert
\Applications\ApplicationFramework\Authentication\PreLoginDialo
g.html.sample.

b. For Engineering applications: ...Power Monitoring


Expert\config\content\PreAuthDialog.html.sample.

2. Remove the .sample extension from the filenames. The filenames should now be
PreLoginDialog.html and PreAuthDialog.html respectively. This enables the
system use notification.

NOTE: You can enable the notification for Web Application clients only, or for Engineering
applications only, or for both.

3. Open the system use notification files in a text editor, such as Notepad. Edit the default
messages to meet your needs. You can use inline HTML styles to customize the appearance
of the notifications.

Done
To disable the system use notification:

1. In Windows Explorer, locate the system use notification HTML files.


a. For Web Application clients: ...Power Monitoring Expert
\Applications\ApplicationFramework\Authentication\PreLoginDialo
g.html.

b. For Engineering applications: ...Power Monitoring


Expert\config\content\PreAuthDialog.html.

2. Add .sample to the end of the filenames. The filenames should now be
PreLoginDialog.html.sample and PreAuthDialog.html.sample respectively.
This disables the system use notification.

NOTE: You can disable the notification for Web Application clients only, or for Engineering
applications only, or for both.

Done
Default system use notification message:

NOTE: The default notice is meant as an example and placeholder for your own notice. It has not
been reviewed for completeness or legal accuracy.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 883


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

884 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Time of Use Editor


Time of Use (TOU) schedules created with the Time of Use Editor are designed to be used with the
Reports application. When you use a TOU schedule in a report, the report data is presented
according to the time periods you defined in the schedule. See Report definitions in the online help
for Reports in the Web Applications component for information on the Energy Cost Report.

A typical TOU has On Peak, Off Peak and Shoulder periods. Since rate schedules vary not only by
day and week, but also by season, the TOU schedules can be set up to match your precise needs.

Opening the Time of Use Editor


To access the Time of Use Editor, open Management Console and select Tools > System > Time
of Use Editor.

Use the navigation pane on the left to navigate through the schedules. Right-click a schedule or
sub-schedule to access menu items. Select an item to display associated tabs in the tab display
pane on the right.

Overview: Creating a TOU schedule


To create a TOU schedule, you need to:

1. Add a schedule. See Adding or editing a schedule.

2. Add a sub-schedule, if you need more than one sub-schedule. See Adding or editing a sub-
schedule.

3. Add a season, if you need more than one. See Configuring seasons.

4. Configure special days (such as holidays) to include in your TOU schedule. See Adding
special days.

5. Add day groups, if you need groups other than the default day groups. See Configuring Day
groups.

6. Add TOU names, if you need names other than the default names. See Defining TOU names.

7. Assign TOU periods to TOU names. See Defining TOU periods.

To view a sample schedule, right-click the navigation pane and select Import Schedule. Select
SampleSchedule.tou from the ...\Power Monitoring Expert\system\etc folder and click Open.

Adding or editing a schedule


This section describes how to add a blank schedule, and import or copy an existing schedule.

Adding a blank schedule


1. Select File > New Schedule to open the Add a Schedule dialog.

2. Type a name and description for the schedule. Click the arrow beside the effective date to
bring up a calendar where you can select the effective date of the schedule.

3. Click OK. That schedule name appears in the list in the navigation pane.

Copying an existing schedule


1. In the navigation pane, right-click the schedule that you want to copy.

2. Select Save as New Schedule to open the Save as New Schedule dialog.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 885


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. Enter a name and description for the new schedule.

4. Click OK. The new schedule appears in the navigation pane with the attributes of the copied
schedule.

Importing a schedule
1. Place the schedule that you want to import into a folder that can be accessed from the
computer.

2. In the navigation pane, right-click an empty area of the navigation pane then select Import
Schedule to open the Open dialog.

3. Navigate to the folder where you placed the schedule. Select the schedule and click Open.

The schedule is imported with the extension “_imported”. For example, a schedule named
“ScheduleA” becomes “ScheduleA_imported”.

Exporting a schedule
To export a schedule to use in another TOU installation:

1. Right-click the schedule you want to export in the navigation pane. Click Export to open the
Save As dialog.

2. Select the folder where you want to save the schedule.

3. Enter a schedule name in the File name box.

4. Click Save.

The schedule is saved with the extension “.tou”. For example, “ScheduleB” becomes
“ScheduleB.tou”.

Editing an existing schedule


To edit a schedule name or description:

1. From the navigation pane, right-click a schedule name then click Edit Schedule to open the
Edit a Schedule dialog.

2. Change the schedule name or description.

To change the effective date, you must make the change to the sub-schedule(s). See Editing
a sub-schedule effective date.

3. Click OK.

Deleting a schedule
To delete a schedule, right-click the schedule name in the navigation pane then select Delete
Schedule. This deletes the entire schedule, including any sub-schedules.

Adding or editing a sub-schedule


When you add the basic schedule, it contains one sub-schedule, with the effective date (start date)
you entered for the schedule. To add additional sub-schedules with alternate effective dates, follow
the instructions in the following sections.

Expand a schedule to display its sub-schedule(s). Sub-schedules are listed in order of their effective
dates.

886 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

TIP: If you want to have more than one sub-schedule with the same seasons, day groups, TOU
periods, etc., configure the first sub-schedule then right-click it and select Save as New
SubSchedule.

Adding a blank sub-schedule


1. Right-click the schedule name and select New SubSchedule to open the New SubSchedule
dialog.

2. Click the arrow beside the effective date to open a calendar where you can choose an
effective date for the new sub-schedule.

3. Click OK.

The sub-schedule displays in the navigation pane. Continue configuring the sub-schedule by
adding seasons and day groups.

To add a new sub-schedule that has the same settings as an existing sub-schedule, see Copying
an existing sub-schedule, below.

Copying an existing sub-schedule


1. Right-click the sub-schedule that you want to copy and select Save as New SubSchedule to
open the New SubSchedule dialog.

2. Click the arrow beside the effective date to open a calendar where you can choose an
effective date for the new sub-schedule.

3. Click OK. The new sub-schedule displays in the navigation pane with the same attributes
(other than effective date) of the sub-schedule you copied.

Editing a sub-schedule effective date


1. Right-click the sub-schedule for which you want to change the effective date, then select Edit
Effective Date to open the Edit SubSchedule Effective Date dialog.

2. Click the arrow beside the effective date to open a calendar where you can choose an
effective date for the new sub-schedule.

3. Click OK.

Deleting a sub-schedule
To delete a sub-schedule, right-click the sub-schedule name in the navigation pane and select
Delete. This also deletes all seasons in that sub-schedule (and any day groups, special days, etc.,
that they contain).

Configuring seasons
Use seasons to create timeframes for presenting data in reports. A newly created schedule has a
single season, called All Year. Expand a sub-schedule to view its seasons.

If you only need one season (All Year), you can skip the steps below and go to configuring special
days.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 887


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring seasons
Use the Define a Season tab to set up or edit the time spans for each season.

NOTE: A date can only belong to one season; you cannot overlap dates in one season with dates
in another.

1. From the navigation pane, select the sub-schedule to which the season belongs.

2. In the tab display pane, select the Define a Season tab.

After you add a sub-schedule, the tab displays only one season (All Year) that covers the
entire year. The season is listed at the top of the tab, and the calendar that shows the days
and months that belong to that season is full. To make room to add other seasons, you must
edit the All Year season.

3. Select All Year from the Define a Season tab and click Edit to open the Edit a Season
dialog.

4. In the Season Name field, type the name of one of the seasons you want to define (for
example, Summer).

5. Set the Start Date and End Date for the season. You can specify fixed start and end dates
(For example, 12/31) or relative start and end dates (for example, the last Saturday of
October).

Fixed Date: Click on the month or day portion of the date then either type the new date or use
the up and down arrows beside the date to edit it.

Relative Date: Select the day and month from the dropdown lists.

For the end date, select the Time of Day the season ends (Start of Day or End of Day). If you
select Start of Day, the season ends at 12:00:00 AM on the selected day; if you select End of
Day, the season ends at 12:00:00 AM on the next day so there are no gaps in the schedule.

NOTE: If you use relative dates, you can configure a schedule that may become invalid in
future years. Be careful when you configure the schedule that there will be no missing or
overlapping days in the schedule in future years. For example, rather than scheduling one
season to end on the 1st Sunday in June and the next to start on the 1st Monday in June, it is
better to schedule the first season to end at Start of Day on the 1st Sunday in June and the
next season to start on the 1st Sunday in June.

6. If this is a split season (where there is a gap between two parts of the season), select the Split
Season check box and add a second sets of dates. For example, winter is typically a split
season because it occurs in the first and last months of the year.

7. Click OK.

The calendar on the Define a Season tab now shows one season with the rest of the year
unassigned.

8. Click Add to create additional seasons. Repeat steps 4 to 6 to name the season and define
the start and end dates.

NOTE: Do not leave any dates unassigned: unassigned dates are not calculated in the reports.

888 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Editing a season
1. On the Define a Season tab, select the season you want to edit then click Edit to open the
Edit a Season dialog.

2. Make the changes you require then click OK.

Deleting a season
To delete a season, select the season in the Define a Season tab then click Delete. This also
deletes the day groups and TOU periods configured for that season.

Adding special days


After you define a sub-schedule, you need to set up holidays and other special days. You can define
holidays that occur on the same date every year or at some other regular interval (such as the third
Thursday in November). You can also define special days, such as inventory days, that might occur
regularly and require special treatment in reports.
Use the Define Special Days tab to set up holidays and other special days.

1. In the navigation pane, select the sub-schedule for which you want to define special days.

2. In the tab display pane, select the Define Special Days tab.

3. Click Add to open the Add a Special Day dialog.

4. Type a name for the special day in the Name field.

5. Select the frequency of the day:


One time only: Enter the date for a single day that does not repeat in future years; for
example, a special day for your organization that does not repeat every year.

Repeat yearly: Enter the date; for example, a holiday that occurs on the same date every
year.

Repeat on: Complete the fields in the Repeat On section to define how the day repeats
and in which months it occurs. Select whether it occurs on a particular date of the
selected month(s) (Day) or a relative day (i.e., Last Saturday) in the selected month(s).

6. Repeat steps 3 to 5 to add additional special days.

7. Click OK to save your changes and return to the Define Special Days tab.

See Configuring Day groups for instructions on how to apply special days to a sub-schedule.

Deleting a special day


To delete a special day, select the special day in the Define a Special Day tab then click Delete.

Configuring Day groups


Day groups define how days of the week are divided into groups.
Day groups can include:

• days of the week

• special days, such as holidays or other specially designated days (such as inventory days)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 889


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Default settings are weekdays (Monday to Friday) and weekends (Saturday and Sunday) but you
can add additional groups. There can be a maximum of 47 day groups in any season.

Make sure that all days have been accounted for since unaccounted time is not included in any
reports.

Adding a Day group


Before you add a day group, make sure that you have defined seasons and special days for the sub-
schedule.

1. In the navigation pane, select the season for which you want to define day groups. The Define
DayGroups tab appears in the tab display pane.

2. Click Add to open the Add a DayGroup dialog.

If the Add button is unavailable, there are no free days to add to a day group. A day can only
belong to one day group. To add another day group, you must first remove days from an
existing day group.

3. Type a name for the day group.

4. Select one of the following options:


Day of week: Select the check box(es) for the day(s) you want to include. A day can
belong to only one day group; if a day is unavailable, it already belongs to an existing
group. If all days are unavailable, you can only include special days in this group unless
you remove days from another day group.

Special Day(s) Only: Select the special day in the Include Special Days list then click to
select or clear the day. Days with a check mark beside them are included in the day
group. You can only include a special day in one day group.

5. Click OK. The name is added to the day group list.

Editing a Day group


1. On the Define DayGroups tab, select the day group you want to change, then click Edit to
open the Edit a DayGroup dialog.

2. Make the changes you require then click OK.

Deleting a Day group


To delete a day group, select the day group in the Define DayGroups tab then click Delete. When
you delete a day group, you also delete the TOU periods configured for that day group. If you add a
day group again, you will need to reconfigure the TOU periods.

Configuring TOU names and TOU periods


When you run reports, the reports calculate and display data according to the information you enter
in the Define TOU Periods and Define TOU Names tabs.

NOTE: You need to define TOU names and periods for each schedule that you create. Be sure to
apply a TOU name to every square on the calendar. Unaccounted time causes your reports to
display inaccurate information.

890 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Defining TOU names


A TOU name is a designation that is used to differentiate billing rates. Three TOU Names are
already defined: On Peak, Off Peak and Partial Peak. You can edit or delete these names, or add
new names.

To define TOU names:

1. In the navigation pane, select the day group for which you want to define TOU names then
select the Define TOU Names tab.

2. Click Add to open the Add a TOU Name dialog.

3. Type the TOU name you want to add then click OK. The TOU name is added to the list of
TOU names.

Editing an existing TOU name


1. Select the TOU Name in the list on the Define TOU Names tab and click Edit to open the
Edit a TOU Name dialog.

2. Type the new name in the TOU name field.

3. Click OK.

Deleting a TOU name


Select the TOU name in the list on the Define TOU Names tab and click Delete.

NOTE: If you delete a TOU name, the TOU periods assigned to the name are replaced with
“Unaccounted”. Deleting a TOU name in a particular schedule affects all sub-schedules in that
schedule.

Defining TOU periods


A TOU period is the time span within the 24-hour period to which you apply a TOU name (such as
8:00 a.m. to 5:00 p.m. for On Peak). You must have TOU names defined before you can associate
TOU periods with those names.

Two TOU names are already defined: On Peak and Off Peak. You can edit or delete these names,
or add new names.

Adding TOU periods


Select a day groups to set up the TOU time periods (on-peak, off-peak, etc.) for that group.

1. In the navigation pane, select the day group for which you want to define a TOU period then
select the Define TOU Periods tab.

2. Click Add to open the Add a Time Period dialog.

3. In the Start Time field, type the time that the period begins, or select the hours and minutes
and use the up and down arrows to set the start time.

4. In the Stop Time field, type the time that the period begins, or select the hours and minutes
and use the up and down arrows to set the stop time.

5. From the Time of Use Name dropdown list, select the TOU name to associate with the time

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 891


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

period.

6. Click OK.

To add a split time period (i.e., a time period that spans from 19:00 to 6:00), you must add two
separate time periods and associate them with the same time of use name.

If you want to expand a time period into time that already belongs to another period, you must first
edit the other time period to clear the time.

Continue adding time periods until the 24 hour period is filled. Unaccounted time blocks cause your
reports to display inaccurate information.

Editing TOU periods


1. Highlight the period you want to edit and click Edit to open the Edit a Time Period dialog.

2. Make the required changes then click OK.

Deleting TOU periods


To delete a period, highlight the period and click Delete.

Update EWS Server


Use this function to initialize or update the EcoStruxure Web Services (EWS) measurement
mappings in the system. This function is part of the EWS server capabilities of PME.

Update OPC Server


Use this function to initialize or update the OPC measurement mappings in the system. This
function is part of the OPC server capabilities of PME. For information on how to map ION registers
to OPC, see OPC measurement support. For information on how to map Modbus registers to OPC,
see Device Type Editor.

892 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Upload Report Template


TIP: You can open Upload Report Template in Management Console from the Tools > System >
Upload Report Template link.

NOTE: You must have supervisor-level access to use Upload Report Template tool.

Use Upload Report Template to upload reports that are not available by default in the software. You
can upload single report template or multiple report templates. The multiple report templates
together are called as Report Pack.

NOTE: Information on how to create custom Report Templates is not provided in this document.
Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for information on custom Report Templates.

For information on how to use the Upload Report Template, see:

• Uploading Single Report Template

• Uploading Multiple Report Template (Report Pack)

Related topics:
Reports:

• Setting Reports prerequisites

• Meeting individual report requirements

• Adding a new report

• Copying a report

• Editing a report

• Moving a report

• Deleting a report

• Sharing a report

Subscriptions:

• Subscribing to a report

• Changing a report subscription

• Deleting a report subscription

Other

• Changing the Reports theme

• Upload Report Template

• Configuring the Energy Modeling report

• Reports UI

For information on how to use Reports, see Reports.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 893


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Uploading Single Report Template


You can upload single report template to use it along with other report templates.
To upload single report template:

1. In Upload Report Template, select Report Template(.rdl).

2. Click Select File to navigate to the location of the .rdl file.

3. Select the file and click Open.

4. Click Upload.

The uploaded report is in ...\ Power Monitoring Expert\web\ReportDepot\ION Reports\ION


Single Reports

NOTE: After you uploaded the Report Template, you can access it, together with the default
templates, in the Report Library.

For information on how to use the Upload Report Template, see:

• Uploading Single Report Template

• Uploading Multiple Report Template (Report Pack)

Uploading Multiple Report Template (Report Pack)


You can upload multiple report template (Report Pack) at a time as a .zip file to use it along with
other report templates.
To upload multiple report template (Report Pack):

1. In Upload Report Template, select Report Pack(.zip).

NOTE: Make sure that multiple report templates are zipped as a single .zip file.

2. Click Select File to navigate to the location of the .zip file.

3. Select the file and click Open.

4. Click Upload.

A progress bar displays the upload status.

The uploaded report are unzipped and is in ...\ Power Monitoring


Expert\web\ReportDepot\ION Reports\ION Report Packs

NOTE: After you uploaded the Report Template, you can access it, together with the default
templates, in the Report Library.

For information on how to use the Upload Report Template, see:

• Uploading Single Report Template

• Uploading Multiple Report Template (Report Pack)

894 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

UPS Configuration Tool


TIP: You can open the UPS Configuration Tool from the Power Monitoring Expert >
Configuration Tools folder on your desktop.

Use the UPS Configuration Tool to configure the Backup Power Module. With this tool you create
UPS Devices and Groups for the UPS Auto Test Report, and you generate UPS Auto Test Vista
diagrams.

See Backup Power Module configuration for details.

Prerequisites
• The UPS devices must be configured in the PME Management Console and must be
communicating before you can configure the components and properties in the configuration
tool.

Configuring UPS groups


To configure UPS groups:

1. Open the UPS Configuration Tool.

2. In the UPS Configuration Tool, click New and add each new UPS that you added in the
Management Console.

3. (Optional) Change the value for the Display Name that appears in the Vista diagram if you
want.

NOTE: This Display Name appears only in the Vista diagram and does not impact the name
that you use in the Management Console.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 895


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. After adding all new UPS devices, click the Groups tab.

5. Click New to create new groups for the UPS devices.

6. After you finish adding all UPS device and associated groups, click Apply.

896 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Generating a Vista diagram


To generate a Vista diagram:

1. In the UPS Configuration Tool, click Generate Vista Diagrams.

The Vista Diagram Generation dialog appears.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 897


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: The Output Path shows where the Vista diagram DGM file is saved after clicking
Generate Vista Diagrams. The file name or location can be modified from the default value
if desired.

2. Click Include Custom Logo and then navigate to and select the file to include a custom logo
in your diagrams. Otherwise, a Schneider Electric logo appears.

3. Under Options, drag the indicator to define the width and dimensions of Vista diagrams you
generate.

4. Click Generate Vista Diagrams to generate the DGM files, then click Close.

898 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

UPS Power Configuration Utility


TIP: You can open the UPS Power Configuration Tool from the Power Monitoring Expert >
Configuration Tools folder on your desktop.

Use the UPS Power Configuration Utility to configure the Capacity Management Module. With this
tool you define UPS Systems for the UPS Power Report.

See Capacity Management Module configuration for details.

Prerequisites
• The monitoring devices that are recording the UPS data must be configured in the PME
Management Console and must be communicating before you can configure the components
and properties in the configuration tool.

User Interface

Control Description
Help Opens the help for the utility.
New Creates a new entry in the grid.
Delete Deletes the selected entry from the grid.
OK Saves all changes and exits the utility.
Cancel Exits the utility without saving changes.
Apply Saves all changes and leaves the utility open.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 899


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Grid Area Columns Description


Modified Displays a status symbol for the record.
+ (plus) A new entry.
* (asterisk) An existing entry has been modified.
! (exclamation mark) The entry is incorrect.
System Displays the system name.
Type Displays the UPS system type (N, 2N, N+2, etc.)
Description Displays a description of the system

TIP: The tool indicates if there configuration errors. Point at the red exclamation icon to see
configuration error details.

UPS Power configuration restrictions


The UPS Power Configuration Utility enforces certain rules when you create UPS systems, groups,
and modules:

• UPS System
Name must be unique.

One or more systems are allowed.

• UPS Groups
Name must be unique.

At least one group must be present in each system.

A maximum of three groups are allowed in each system.

For N, N+1, and N+2 system types:


Each group in the system may have a different number of UPS modules.

Each UPS module in the group must have the same nameplate rating (kVA) value.

Each UPS module in the group must have the same derated nameplate rating (kW)
value

Each group is connected to one load only. No other group can be connected to the
same load.

See the UPS Power Configuration Utility for more information.

For 2N, 2(N+1) and 2(N+2) system types:


All groups must have the same number of UPS modules.

All UPS modules in the groups must have the same nameplate rating (kVA) value.

All UPS modules in the groups must have the same derated nameplate rating (kW)
value.

900 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Depending on the number of groups present in the system, a load may be shared by
two groups.

See the UPS Power Configuration Utility for more information.

• UPS Modules
Name must be unique.

At least one module must be present in each group.

A maximum of 12 modules is allowed in each group.

For information on UPS redundancy types, see UPS system redundancy types.

Defining UPS systems


A UPS system is a logical system configuration that is used for reporting power capacity.
To define a UPS system:

1. Click New. The Edit System: New System area appears below the grid.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 901


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2. Click anywhere in the editor area. The Properties screen appears.

3. Complete the details for the UPS system:


a. System Name: Enter a name for the UPS system. Each UPS system must have a
unique name.

b. Description: Enter a description for the UPS system. This field is optional.

c. Redundancy Type: Select the redundancy type for the UPS system. The different
redundancy types are explained in UPS system redundancy types.

d. Groups: Shows the number of UPS groups contained in the UPS system. Click Add to
add groups to the UPS system. Click Remove to delete groups.

e. Modules Per Group: Shows the number of UPS modules in each group in the system.
Click Add to add UPS modules to the group. Click Remove to delete modules.

This property is only available when the system redundancy type is 2N, 2(N+1) or 2(N+2).
To define the number of modules for a system with redundancy type N, N+1 or N+2, use
the UPS group properties. See Defining UPS loads for more information.

4. Click Done to save the UPS system.

Related Topics:

• Defining UPS groups

• Defining UPS modules

• Defining UPS loads

Defining UPS groups


A UPS group represents a logical grouping of UPS modules. The UPS system contains at least one
UPS group and can contain multiple UPS groups. Depending on the UPS system type, the
UPS group properties may be different, as shown below. See UPS Power configuration restrictions
for more information.

902 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

To define a UPS group:

1. Click on the group object border. The Properties screen appears.

2. Complete the details for the UPS group:


a. Group Name: Enter a name for the group. Each UPS group must have a unique name.

b. Description: Enter a description for the group. This field is optional.

c. Modules Per Group: Click Add to increase the number of UPS modules in the group.
Click Remove to decrease the number. This property is available only for system
redundancy types N, N+1 or N+2.

3. Click Done to save the UPS group.

Related Topics:

• Defining UPS systems

• Defining UPS modules

• Defining UPS loads

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 903


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Defining UPS modules


A UPS module represents an actual UPS device in the data center. A UPS group contains at least
one UPS module and can contain multiple UPS modules. For some UPS system types, each
UPS group must contain the same number of UPS modules. See UPS Power configuration
restrictions for more information.
To define a UPS module:

1. Click on the module object border. The selected module will be highlighted in blue and the
Properties screen appears.

2. Complete the details for the UPS module:


a. UPS Module Name: Enter the name for the module. This name must be unique for each
UPS module in the system.

b. Description: Enter a description for the module. This field is optional.

c. Data Source: Select the meter source in Power Monitoring Expert where load data is
logged for the UPS module. The source must be unique for each UPS module.

d. Nameplate Rating (kVA): Enter the maximum output power (kVA) of the UPS module.
This value must be greater than zero.

e. Derated Nameplate Rating (kW): Enter the maximum power capacity (kW) that the
UPS module is expected to support. This value must be equal or less than the nameplate
rating value, and greater than zero.

3. Click Done to save the UPS module.

Related Topics:

• Defining UPS systems

• Defining UPS groups

• Defining UPS loads

904 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Defining UPS loads


A UPS load represents the logical load attached to a UPS group. This logical load has no functional
purpose in the calculations for power redundancy. The UPS load is used only to provide a more
complete diagram representation for the UPS system.
To define a UPS load:

1. Click the UPS load element in the system diagram. The Properties screen appears.

2. Complete the details for the UPS load:


a. Load Name: Enter a name for the load.

b. Description: Enter a description for the load. This field is optional.

3. Click Done to save the UPS load.

Related Topics:

• Defining UPS systems

• Defining UPS groups

• Defining UPS modules

UPS system redundancy types


You can create a UPS system to achieve power redundancy for IT equipment loads in different
ways, depending on how the UPS units are grouped together and how they are connected to the
equipment power supplies. This configuration tool supports several industry standard
configurations.
The UPS system supports the following redundancy design types:

• N Type

• N+1 Type

• N+2 Type

• 2N Type

• 2(N+1) Type

• 2(N+2) Type

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 905


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

N Type
The N system configuration is for one or more UPS modules which work together to supply power to
the IT load. There is no redundancy, except optionally to the second power supply of each piece of
equipment.

Each UPS system with an N configuration can have multiple UPS groups, where each group is
connected to a different load. The number of modules within each UPS group can be different.
Within each group, all UPS modules must have the same derated nameplate rating value (kW).

N+1 Type
The N+1 system configuration is for one or more UPS modules that work together to supply power
to the IT load. There is simple module redundancy in that one of the modules can be rendered
inoperative or be taken off-line. The load is spread among all remaining UPS modules, but the peak
load is such that if one module stops working, the others will be able to assume its load. Another
way to look at it is, N UPS modules will be able to support the peak IT load. If the peak IT load is
more than N can support, then system design redundancy will be lost.

There is the option to connect the system of modules to the second power supply of each piece of
equipment, but both power supplies are connected to the group of UPS modules.

Each UPS system with an N+1 configuration can have multiple UPS groups, where each group is
connected to a different load. The number of modules within each UPS group can be different. The
modules within a UPS group must have the same derated nameplate rating value (kW).

906 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

N+2 Type
The N+2 system configuration is for a group of UPS modules that work together to supply power to
the IT load. There is simple module redundancy in that any two of the modules can be rendered
inoperative or be taken off-line. The load is spread among all remaining UPS modules, but the peak
load is such that if two modules stop working, the others will be able to assume their load. Another
way to look at it is, N UPS modules will be able to support the peak IT load. If the peak IT load is
more than N can support, then system design redundancy will be lost. An example of an N+2
system is five UPS modules connected to the IT load, but the peak IT load never exceeds the
capacity of three of the UPS modules.

There is the option to connect the system of modules to the second power supply of each piece of
equipment, but both power supplies are connected to the group of UPS modules.

Each UPS system with an N+2 configuration can have multiple UPS groups, where each group is
connected to a different load. The number of modules within each UPS group can be different. The
modules within a UPS group must have the same derated nameplate rating value (kW).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 907


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2N Type
The 2N system configuration is for two or three groups of UPS modules that supply power to two
different power supplies in each IT load. For redundancy, an entire UPS group can stop working or
be taken off-line, and the IT equipment will still be supplied with power. It also means that either one
of the two power supplies in an IT load can be rendered inoperative. The load is spread among all
UPS modules, but the peak load is such that if an entire group’s worth of modules is not working,
the remaining modules will be able to assume their load. Another way to look at it is, N UPS
modules will be able to support the peak IT load. If the peak IT load is more than N can support, then
system design redundancy will be lost.

Each UPS system with a 2N configuration can have two or three UPS groups. If there are two
groups, both must be connected to the same load. If there are three groups, then there are three
separate loads and each group is connected to two of the loads. The number of modules within each
UPS group in a UPS system must be the same in a 2N configuration. Additionally, all UPS modules
within a UPS group must have the same derated nameplate rating value (kW).

In the first example, there are two groups with four UPS modules each. In a 2N configuration, one
group can stop working and the system will still have the designed redundancy. Therefore, the value
for N is four. So, the total IT load cannot exceed the derated nameplate rating of four of the UPS
modules.

In the second example, there are three groups with four UPS modules each. In a 2N configuration,
one group’s worth of UPS modules can be rendered inoperative and the system will still have the
designed redundancy. Therefore, the value for N is eight. So, the total IT load (for all three IT load
groups shown below) cannot exceed the derated nameplate rating of eight of the UPS modules.

908 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

2(N+1) Type
The 2(N+1) system configuration is for two or three groups of UPS modules that supply power to
two different power supplies in each IT load. The redundancy provided means that an entire group of
UPS modules, plus one more module from the remaining groups, can stop working or be taken off-
line, and the IT equipment will still be supplied with power. It also means that either one of the two
power supplies in an IT load can be rendered inoperative. The load is spread among all UPS
modules, but the peak load is such that if an entire group’s worth of modules be rendered
inoperative, plus one more from each other group, the remaining modules will be able to assume
their load. Another way to look at it is, N UPS modules will be able to support the peak IT load. If the
peak IT load is more than N can support, then system design redundancy will be lost.

Each UPS system with a 2(N+1) configuration can have two or three UPS groups. If there are two
groups, both must be connected to the same load. If there are three groups, then there are three
separate loads and each group is connected to two of the loads. The number of modules within each
UPS group in a UPS system must be the same in a 2(N+1) configuration. Additionally, all UPS
modules within a UPS group must have the same derated nameplate rating value (kW).

In the first example, there are two groups with four UPS modules in each group. One group plus one
UPS module from the other group can be rendered inoperative, and the system will still have the
designed redundancy. Therefore, the value for N is three. So, the total IT load cannot exceed the
derated nameplate rating of three of the UPS modules.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 909


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

In the second example, there are three groups with four UPS modules in each group. One group plus
one module from each of the other two groups can stop working and the system will still have the
designed redundancy. Therefore, the value for N is six. So, the total IT load (for all three IT load
groups shown below) cannot exceed the derated nameplate rating of six of the UPS modules.

2(N+2) Type
The 2(N+2) system configuration is for two or three groups of UPS modules that supply power to
two different power supplies in each IT load. The redundancy provided means that an entire group of
UPS modules, plus two more modules from the remaining groups, can stop working or be taken off-
line and the IT equipment will still be supplied with power. It also means that either one of the two

910 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

power supplies in an IT load can stop working. The load is spread among all UPS modules, but the
peak load is such that, if an entire group stops working, plus two more from the other group, the
remaining modules will be able to assume their load. Another way to look at it is, N UPS modules
will be able to support the peak IT load. If the peak IT load is more than N can support, then system
design redundancy will be lost.

Each UPS system with a 2(N+2) configuration can have two or three UPS groups. If there are two
groups, both must be connected to the same IT load. If there are three groups, then there are three
separate loads and each group is connected to two of the loads. The number of modules within each
UPS group must be the same. All UPS modules within a group must have the same derated
nameplate rating value (kW).

In the first example, there are two groups with four UPS modules each. One group can be rendered
inoperative, plus two more UPS modules from the other group and the system will still have the
designed redundancy. Therefore, the value for N is two. The total IT load cannot exceed the derated
nameplate rating of two of the UPS modules.

In the second example, there are three groups with four UPS modules each. One group plus two
modules from each of the other two groups can stop working, and the system will still have the
designed redundancy. Therefore, the value for N is four. So, the total IT load cannot exceed the
derated nameplate rating of four of the UPS modules.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 911


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

912 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

User Manager

TIP: You can open User Manager from SETTINGS > Users > User Manager in the Web
Applications banner. You can also open User Manager from Management Console > Tools >
Web Tools > User Manager.

NOTE: You must have supervisor-level access to use User Manager, otherwise the link on the
SETTINGS page is not available.

Use User Manager to:

• Configure users and user groups.

• Customize user access level privileges.

• View web application user licensing information.

PME does not provide any pre-configured user accounts or user groups. One supervisor account is
created with a user defined password during the installation of the software. Create user accounts
and groups to meet your needs.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices when configuring user access.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access – such as least privilege and
separation of duties – vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to ensure
that user access adheres to the site-specific cyber security policies.

RECOMMENDATION: Use Windows users instead of standard users in your PME system to
improve cybersecurity. Windows offers advanced user management functions, such as enforcing
password strength and limiting the number of invalid login attempts. These functions are required
for IEC 62443 compliance, the global standard for industrial automation control system security.

NOTE: To only use Windows users, replace any existing standard users in the system with
Windows users. Disallow logins for standard users in Web Applications, this disables the
supervisor user. See Login Options for more information.

To configure users and user groups, see:


Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 913


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

914 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Users
A user is an account in Power Monitoring Expert (PME) that provides access to the system. A user
has a username, which must be unique, and a password. You use the username and password to
log into PME.

PME supports 3 different types of users - standard users, Windows users, and Windows groups.
The following table shows the characteristics of each user type:

User Type Characteristics


This is a PME native user account. The username, password, and
details are defined in the PME User Manager.
Standard user
Note: The email addresses defined for a user can be used for report
subscriptions.
This is an account from an external Windows system. The
Windows user username, password, and details are defined through the Windows
Active Directory or local Windows operating system.
This is a group of accounts from an external Windows system. The
Windows group username, password, and details are defined through the Windows
Active Directory or local Windows operating system.

Each user has an access level, which is set in User Manager. The access level determines which
actions the user is allowed to take in PME.

There are 5 different access levels. The highest level is Supervisor, the lowest level is Observer.
All Windows users that are a member of a Windows group in PME have the same access level as
the one set for the Windows group. For details on the permissions granted by the different access
levels see Default User Access Level Privileges.

Each user is a member of at least one user group. The user group determines which sources and
applications the user can access. By default, users are assigned to the Global user group which has
access to all sources and applications in the system. See user groups for details on how to
configure groups and assign users to groups.

Rules
The following rule applies to users in PME:

• A Windows user that is a member of multiple Windows groups with different access levels in
PME, gets the highest access level of any of the groups.

Example:

Windows user BillG is a member of Windows group A with observer access level in PME.
Windows user BillG is also a member of Windows group B with operator access level in PME.
As a result, BillG has operator access level in PME.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 915


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Limitations
The following limitations exist for standard PME users:

• Usernames must be unique in PME.

• Usernames cannot contain any of the following characters: whitespace character, < > : " / \ | ? *
, ; @ # % ' ^ & ( ) ! = + - ~ . $   

• Usernames and passwords must be between 1-50 characters long.

• Email addresses are not checked for the correct format. Any leading or trailing whitespace
characters are removed.

• Multiple email addresses must be separated by a ; (semicolon).

• First name, last name, and organization must be between 0-50 characters long. Any leading or
trailing whitespace characters are removed.

The following limitations exist for all PME users:

• A user cannot change its own access level.

• A user cannot delete its own account.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

916 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 917


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a standard user


Add a standard user to create an account for accessing PME. Set the access level for the user to
control what they are allowed to do.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices when configuring user access.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access – such as least privilege and
separation of duties – vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to ensure
that user access adheres to the site-specific cyber security policies.

RECOMMENDATION: Use Windows users instead of standard users in your PME system to
improve cybersecurity. Windows offers advanced user management functions, such as enforcing
password strength and limiting the number of invalid login attempts. These functions are required
for IEC 62443 compliance, the global standard for industrial automation control system security.

To add a standard user:

1. In User Manager, select the Users tab, and then click Add Standard User.

2. In Add Standard User, enter a username and password, and assign an access level.

3. (Optional) Enter Details information.

4. Click Add.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

918 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 919


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a Windows user


Add a Windows user to give this user access to PME. Set the access level for the Windows user to
control what they are allowed to do.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices when configuring user access.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access – such as least privilege and
separation of duties – vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to ensure
that user access adheres to the site-specific cyber security policies.

To add a Windows user:

1. In User Manager, select the Users tab, and then click Add Windows User

2. In Add Windows User - Selection:


a. Select a domain name.

Use a Windows domain name to add a user from an Active Directory. Use the local
computer name or use localhost to add a user from the local list of Windows users.

b. To find the Windows user you want, (optional) enter a keyword into the Available
Windows Users search box, and then click Find.

The search result includes all usernames that match all or part of the keyword string.

c. In the search result table, select the Windows user you want to add, and then click Next.

3. In Add Windows User - Details, assign an access level, and then click Finish.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

920 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 921


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adding a Windows group


Add a Windows group to give all Windows users in this group access to PME. Set the access level
for the Windows group to control what they are allowed to do.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices when configuring user access.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access – such as least privilege and
separation of duties – vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to ensure
that user access adheres to the site-specific cyber security policies.

To add a Windows group:

1. In User Manager, select the Users tab, and then click Add Windows Group

2. In Add Windows Group - Selection:


a. Select a domain name.

Use a Windows domain name to add a group from an Active Directory. Use the local
computer name or use localhost to add a group from the local list of Windows groups.

b. To find the Windows group you want, (optional) enter a keyword into the Available
Windows Groups search box, and then click Find.

The search result includes all groups that match all or part of the keyword string.

c. In the search result table, select the Window group you want to add, and then click Next.

3. In Add Windows Group - Details, assign an access level.

(Optional) Click on View Windows Users in this Windows Group to see the Windows
users that are members of the group.

4. Click Finish.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

922 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 923


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Changing a username
Change a username to give the user a better or more meaningful name.

NOTE: You can only change the name of a standard user in User Manager. You cannot change the
name of a Windows user or group.

To change a username:

1. In User Manager, select the Users tab.

2. In the users table, select the row of the user for which you want to change the name, and then
click Edit in this row.

3. In Edit Standard User, change the name under Username to the new name, and then click
Save.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

924 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 925


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Changing a user password


Change a user password to update the password as part of a security best practice, or because the
existing password is lost.

NOTE: You can only change the password for a standard user in User Manager. You cannot
change the password for a Windows user.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices for password creation and management.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access - such as least privilege, separation of
duties - vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to ensure that user
access adheres to the site-specific cybersecurity policies.
To change a user password:

1. In User Manager, select the Users tab.

2. In the users table, select the row of the user for which you want to change the password, and
then click Edit in this row.

3. In Edit Standard User, enter the new password under Password and under Confirm
Password, and then click Save.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

926 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 927


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Changing a user access level


Change a user access level to give this user higher or lower access permissions in PME.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices when configuring user access.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access – such as least privilege and
separation of duties – vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to ensure
that user access adheres to the site-specific cyber security policies.

NOTE: When a user access level is changed, this change will be applied automatically by the
system to logged in users, after a short period of time.

To change a user access level:

1. In User Manager, select the Users tab.

2. In the users table, select the row of the user for which you want to change the access level,
and then click Edit in this row.

3. In the Edit window, choose the new access level under Access Level, and then click Save.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

928 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 929


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Changing user details


Change user details to add additional information or update outdated information.

NOTE: You can only change the details of a standard user in User Manager. You cannot change
the details of a Windows user or group.

To change user details:

1. In User Manager, select the Users tab.

2. In the users table, select the row of the user for which you want to change the details, and then
click Edit in this row.

3. In Edit Standard User, change the details information under Details, and then click Save.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

930 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 931


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Deleting a user
Delete a user if this user is no longer needed, for example if someone no longer needs access to
PME.

NOTE: Windows users or groups are only removed from PME. The group or user is not deleted
from Windows.

NOTE: When a user is deleted, this user will be logged out automatically by the system after a
short period of time, if they are logged in.

To delete a user:

1. In User Manager, select the Users tab.

2. In the users table, select the row of the user you want to delete, and then click Delete in this
row.

3. In the confirmation dialog box, click Delete for a standard user, or Remove for a Windows
user or group.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

932 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 933


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

User Groups
User groups determine which sources and applications users can access in Power Monitoring
Expert (PME). Each user is a member of at least one user group.

PME has two built-in groups, the Global group and the Unassigned group. Members of the Global
group can access all sources and applications in the system. Members of the Unassigned group
can access none of the sources and applications in the system. Members of the Unassigned group
are also not allowed to log into PME Web Applications.

In addition to the built-in groups, you can create any number of custom user groups in PME. Use
User Manager to create a custom group and define which sources and applications its members can
access.

NOTE: User group membership determines which sources and applications are visible to a user.
User groups do not set the user access level for the group members. Access levels are set for
each user individually as part of the user account settings.

The user group feature only applies to the Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, and Reports
applications in PME. For all other applications users have full access to all sources regardless of
their group membership.

Rules
The following rules apply to group membership in PME:

• A user is a member of at least one group.

• A user can be a member of multiple groups.

• When a new user is created, it is automatically added to the Global group.

• If a member of the Global group is added to another group, it is automatically removed from the
Global group.

• If a user is removed from the Global group without being added to a custom group, it is
automatically added to the Unassigned group.

• If a user is removed from its last custom group, or this group is deleted, the user is
automatically added to the Unassigned group.

• If a member of a custom group is added to the Global group, it is automatically removed from all
custom groups.

• A supervisor-level user can only be a member of the Global group.

• If a non-supervisor level user that is a member of a custom group is promoted to supervisor, it is


automatically removed from all custom groups and added to the Global group.

• If the last custom group is deleted, all of its members are moved to the Global group.

The following rules apply to resource access by groups in PME:

• A user that is a member of multiple groups can access the sources of each group.

• If a member of a custom group is deleted or removed from the group, then this user's public
content, such as dashboards or reports, remains available to the group.

934 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

• If a member of a custom group is deleted or removed from the group, then this user's private
content, such as dashboards or reports, is only available to users in that group who have Edit
permissions on this item type.

• If a member of a custom group is removed from the group, then this user has no longer access
to any of its content, such as dashboards or reports, that was created during its group
membership.

Limitations
The following limitations exist for user groups in PME:

• The Global and Unassigned user groups cannot be renamed or deleted.

• The default settings for which sources and applications can be accessed in the Global and
Unassigned user groups cannot be changed.

• User group names must be between 1-255 characters long. Any leading or trailing whitespace
characters are removed.

• If a user group name contains a ] (left angle bracket), the bracket must be followed by a space
or be at the end of the name.

• If a user group name contains a & (ampersand), the ampersand must not be followed by a #
(hash).

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 935


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

936 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Adding a user group


Add a user group to control which sources and applications the group members can access in PME.
To add a user group:

1. In User Manager, select the User Groups tab, and then click Add User Group.

2. In Add User Group - User Group Name, enter a group name, and then click Next.

3. In Add User Group - Users, select the users you want to be in the new group form the list of
available users, and then click Next.

NOTE: Supervisor-level users are not included in the available users list. A supervisor-level
user can only be a member of the Global group, not a custom group.

4. In Add User Group - Sources, in the Available Sources tree, select the sources you want the
users in this group to be able to access, and then click Next.

5. In Add User Group - Applications, select the applications you want the users in this group to
be able to access.

6. Click Finish.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 937


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

938 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Adding a user to a user group


Add a user to a user group to give this user access to the sources and applications assigned to this
group in PME.
To add a user to a user group:

1. In User Manager, select the User Groups tab.

2. In the user groups table, select the row of the user group to which you want to add users, and
then click Edit in this row.

3. In Edit User Group, select the Users tab, and then, in the user table, select the user you want
to add.

NOTE: Supervisor-level users are not included in the available users list. A supervisor-level
user can only be a member of the Global group, not a custom group.

4. Click Save.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 939


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

940 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Adding sources to a user group


Add sources to a user group to give the users in this group access to these sources in PME.
To add sources to a user group:

1. In User Manager, select the User Groups tab.

2. In the user groups table, select the row of the user group to which you want to add sources,
and then click Edit in this row.

3. In Edit User Group, select the Sources tab, and then, in the Available Sources tree, select
the sources you want to add.

4. Click Save.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 941


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

942 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Changing a user group name


Change a user group name to give this group a better or more meaningful name.
To change a user group name:

1. In User Manager, select the User Groups tab.

2. In the user groups table, select the row of the user group for which you want to change the
name, and then click Edit in this row.

3. In Edit User Group, select the User Group Name tab, and then change the name under
Name to the new group name.

4. Click Save.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 943


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

944 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Removing a user from a user group


Remove a user from a user group to no longer give this user access to the sources and applications
assigned to this group in PME.
To remove a user from a user group:

1. In User Manager, select the User Groups tab.

2. In the user groups table, select the row of the user group from which you want to remove a
user, and then click Edit in this row.

3. In Edit User Group, select the Users tab, and then, in the user table, clear the check box for
the user you want to remove.

4. Click Save.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 945


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

946 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Removing sources from a user group


Remove sources from a user group to no longer give the users in this group access to these sources
in PME.
To remove sources from a user group:

1. In User Manager, select the User Groups tab.

2. In the user groups table, select the row of the user group from which you want to remove
sources, and then click Edit in this row.

3. In Edit User Group, select the Sources tab.

4. In the Selected Sources list, select the source you want to remove, and then click Remove

for this source.

5. Repeat step 4 for all the sources you want to remove from the user group.

(Optional) Click Remove All to remove all sources from the group.

6. Click Save.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 947


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

948 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Changing application access for a user group


Change application access for a user group to add or remove access to certain applications for the
members of this group in PME.
To change application access for a user group:

1. In User Manager, select the User Groups tab.

2. In the user groups table, select the row of the user group for which you want to change
application access, and then click Edit in this row.

3. In Edit User Group, select the Applications tab, and then select the check boxes for the
applications you want to add, or clear the check boxes for the applications you want to
remove.

4. Click Save.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 949


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

950 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Moving a user between user groups


Move a user to a different user group to change which sources and applications this user can
access in PME.

To move a user between two user groups, remove the user from the one group and add it to the other
group. The order in which these two tasks are performed is not important.
Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 951


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

952 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Deleting a user group


Delete a user group if this group is no longer needed, for example after all users have been removed
from the group.
To delete a user group:

1. In User Manager, select the User Groups tab.

2. In the user groups table, select the row of the user group you want to delete, and then click
Delete in this row.

3. In Delete User Group, click Delete.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 953


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

954 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Viewing Web Applications user license information


View license information to determine the number of available, free licenses left in the system. You
can also see which users have licenses issued to them, and when they were issued.

NOTE: The license information shown in the User Manager is read-only. Use the License
Configuration Tool to make changes to the Web Application user licenses in the system.

To view license information:

1. In User Manager, select the Licenses tab.

2. View license summary information in the top left area of the page. View detailed license
information in the user license table of the page.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 955


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

956 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Customizing Access Level Privileges


Each user in PME has an access level. This access level determines the actions the user is
allowed to take in the software. There are 5 different access levels. The highest level is supervisor,
the lowest level is observer. Each access level has a default set of privileges. You can customize
many of these privileges, as shown below.

NOTE: When access level privileges are changed for a logged in user, the user must log out and
then log in again for the changes to take effect. If the logged in user's privileges are reduced, some
functionality might no longer be available to them even before they log out and back in.

To customize access level privileges:

1. In User Manager, select the Privileges tab.

2. Find the privileges and access levels you want to customize and set the desired options.

TIP: Use Search to find the privilege you are looking for based on key words.

NOTE: Only correctly licensed features and functions are displayed in the Privileges tab.

3. Click Save Privileges to apply the changed settings.

Related topics:
Users

• Users

• Adding a standard user

• Adding a Windows user

• Adding a Windows group

• Changing a username

• Changing a user password

• Changing a user access level

• Changing user details

• Deleting a user

User groups

• User Groups

• Adding a user group

• Adding a user to a user group

• Adding sources to a user group

• Changing a user group name

• Removing a user from a user group

• Removing sources from a user group

• Changing application access for a user group

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 957


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Moving a user between user groups

• Deleting a user group

For information on the Web Application user licenses, see:

• Viewing Web Applications user license information

For information on related Web Application settings, see:

• Login Options

To customize user access level privileges, see:

• Customizing Access Level Privileges

For reference information see:

• User Manager

• User Manager user interface

• Default User Access Level Privileges

958 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Virtual Processor service (VIP)


The Virtual Processor is a service that operates on the Power Monitoring Expert server, providing
coordinated data collection, data processing, and control functions for groups of meters. This
makes distributed operations possible, providing customized solutions to a variety of industrial,
commercial, and power utility needs.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use control objects for time-critical functions because delays can occur between the
time a control action is initiated and when that action is applied.
• Do not create a custom control object in Virtual Processor for remote equipment operation
without configuring it with the appropriate access level, and without configuring a status object
to indicate the status of the control operation.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

The Virtual Processor lets you gather the information available from your network of power
monitoring devices, and enables you to categorize, manipulate, and/or customize the data before
distributing the information to the different departments in your company. You could think of the
Virtual Processor as a virtual device, capable of collecting and processing data from several power
monitoring devices, analyzing the information and performing control functions as required. The
Virtual Processor's name implies its characteristics:

• Virtual - The Virtual Processor runs in the memory of your PC, not as a remote device.

• Processor - The Virtual Processor contains a wide selection of ION modules, which it uses to
process information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 959


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Using the Virtual Processor


A VIP.DEFAULT Virtual Processor service is created by default. However, this Virtual Processor
is not configured at the factory. To perform data collection, data analysis, Modbus communications,
or distributed control, you must first create ION module frameworks, using Designer. Refer to the
ION Reference for information on ION modules.

Configuring the Virtual Processor with Designer


Use Designer to perform all Virtual Processor configuration, including adding new modules,
configuring module setup registers, and linking module inputs and output registers to other modules.

Creating a second Virtual Processor


Create a second ION Virtual Processor Service and start it using the following steps:

1. Open a command prompt window.

2. Register the Virtual Processor as a service from the ...\Power Monitoring Expert\system\bin
folder by typing: vip.exe -Service -N<custom Virtual Processor name>

3. Open Control Panel > Administrative Tools > Services and start the new registered
Virtual Processor.

Viewing Virtual Processor data with Vista


After you have used Designer to add and link modules in the Virtual Processor, you can create a
user diagram in Vista and link it to the modules in the Virtual Processor. You can then use your user
diagram to display system data, monitor alarms, and control basic functions in your Virtual
Processor framework.

Configuring the Virtual Processor to interact with the desktop


1. Open Control Panel > Administrative Tools > Services.

2. Right-click the ION Virtual Processor Service and select Properties.

3. Select the Log On tab.

4. Select the “Allow service to interact with desktop” check box and click OK.

5. Stop and restart the ION Virtual Processor Service.

Distributed control
Virtual Processor Distributed Control modules are a means of transferring information between the
different devices in your network. These modules can be used to build frameworks for control
processes such as alarm annunciation, plant-wide demand control, power factor control, load
shedding, paging, and generator switching.

Before you decide to use a Virtual Processor to implement a control system, it is important to
understand the various factors that influence the speed with which the Virtual Processor is able to
generate a control action. Some of these factors include network traffic, the number of polled
devices in your network, the reliability of your communications network, and the Virtual Processor
workstation's CPU usage.

960 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use control objects for time-critical functions because delays can occur between the
time a control action is initiated and when that action is applied.
• Do not create a custom control object in Virtual Processor for remote equipment operation
without configuring it with the appropriate access level, and without configuring a status object
to indicate the status of the control operation.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

The information presented in this section assumes that you are familiar with the various ION
modules and their functions. Refer to the ION Reference for details on Distributed Control and other
modules.

Distributed control modules


The Virtual Processor uses four modules to implement Distributed Control frameworks. Three types
of Distributed Control modules (Distributed Boolean, Numeric, and Pulse modules) receive data
from devices or other Virtual Processors within your network and transfer this data to the node
address specified in the module's setup registers. The Data Monitoring module is used as a means
of disabling a control module, if the data at the source input (which is used to make the control
decision) becomes “stale”.

Distributed control module setup registers


All Distributed Control modules (Distributed Boolean, Distributed Numeric, and Distributed Pulse
modules) have a Source input and an Activate input. The Activate input must be linked to another
module, and it must be on for a Distributed Control module to function. These modules also contain
a Destination setup register that specifies the node receiving the data.

Distributed Boolean module


All Distributed Boolean modules have one input that must linked to an External Boolean output
register. Whenever this register’s Boolean value changes state, the new value is sent to the node
defined in the Destination setup register.

Distributed numeric module


A Distributed Numeric module's input must be linked to an External Numeric module. This input’s
value is sent to the node specified in the Destination setup register. This module has two additional
setup registers that are used to determine when and how often new data is sent to the Destination
node.

Distributed pulse module


All Distributed Pulse modules have one input that must link to an External Pulse module. This
module’s pulse is sent to the node defined in the Destination setup register.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 961


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Data monitoring module


The Data Monitor module provides a means of alerting you to communication problems that may
occur between the Virtual Processor and any ION node referenced by the Data Monitor's Source
inputs.

NOTE: ION meters with Advanced Security enabled do not accept control operations from the
Virtual Processor. In order to enable these control operations, you need to provide a device
password in Management Console for these applications to use. See Accessing meters with
security for information on configuring Advanced Security.

Distributed control network performance


It is important to maximize the speed at which the Virtual Processor receives the data used to make
control decisions. The performance of a Virtual Processor using Distributed Control is sensitive to
factors such as network traffic, the Virtual Processor's global parameters, and the workstation's
CPU usage.

The following sections provide some guidelines for improving a distributed control network's
performance.

System configuration
• Minimize the number of devices per site for sites including devices used for distributed control.

• Minimize the number of applications (such as Vista diagrams) that are requesting data from the
control site.

• Decrease the Virtual Processor's Client Polling Period.

• Maximize the site's baud rate.

CPU performance
• Dedicate a single Virtual Processor for control purposes; an additional Virtual Processor can be
run for less critical functions.

• Do not run CPU intensive functions on the same workstation as your distributed control Virtual
Processor.

Distributed control applications


The Virtual Processor's Distributed Control frameworks can perform various control processes; two
examples are presented below. Ensure that you are familiar with the sections above before using
any of these module frameworks in a control system.

962 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Example: Passing a value between devices


The following example shows how the numeric output of the Integrator modules in meter “A” is sent
to an External Numeric module in meter “B”.

Note that the Distributed Numeric module is disabled if the Data Monitor module detects a
communication problem between the meter “A” and the Virtual Processor (for example, timeouts or
slow network connections). As a result, control actions are only performed based on up-to-date
data.

Example: Device control


This example framework monitors total harmonic distortion (THD), which could cause a piece of
equipment (like a power transformer) to overheat. When a setpoint is reached, the system sends a
network message to a workstation and turns on a fan.

Example: Data aggregation


In the following example, meters monitor average current values (I avg). Every day at a specified
time (determined by the Periodic Timer module), the Data Recorder Module stores the maximum
average current value for each meter.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 963


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example: Logging data from meters


The Virtual Processor can be used to log data from meters that do not have Data Recorders. In the
following example, the total kWh from a meter’s Integrator module is recorded every 15 minutes by
a Virtual Processor's Data Recorder module.

Note that the Virtual Processor holds only 100 records at a time, that is, it holds about one day of 15
minute data. If the Virtual Processor stops operating, data logging also stops.

Setting global parameters


The Virtual Processor global operating parameters and Modbus network setup are configured using
Virtual Processor Setup.

The global parameters do not need to be changed for normal operation. The Virtual Processor
operates properly in most applications with the default settings. See Modifying the Global
Parameters for details.

To set up the Virtual Processor’s Modbus network, see Virtual Processor setup.

NOTE: The ION Virtual Processor Service must be restarted for any changes to take effect, as the
Virtual Processor only reads the vipsys.dat file once on startup. The ION Virtual Processor
Service can be restarted, like any other service, using the Services window found via the Control
Panel service applet.

964 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Virtual Processor setup


TIP: You can open Virtual Processor Setup in Management Console from the Tools > System >
ION Virtual Processor Setup link.

The Virtual Processor (VIP) is the Power Monitoring Expert service (ION Virtual Processor Service)
that provides coordinated data collection and aggregation, control, and mathematical analysis of
power monitoring system data from groups of metering or similar intelligent devices. Use Virtual
Processor Setup to configure a Modbus Slave port when using the VIP as a Modbus Slave device
for exporting data to an external, 3rd-party Modbus Master. . Virtual Processor Setup can also be
used to improve the performance of the ION Virtual Processor Service by modifying its global
operating parameters.

See Virtual Processor service (VIP) for application examples using the Virtual Processor.

Configuring the Modbus Slave port


NOTE: The VIP Modbus Slave functionality requires a Data Exchange Module license.

You can configure the VIP to act as a Modbus Slave device to an external Modbus Master. The
Modbus Master can read data from the VIP through the VIP Modbus Slave modules. See the ION
Reference for information on how to configure Modbus Slave modules.

For the Modbus Master to be able to access the VIP, you need to configure a Modbus Slave Port. A
Modbus Slave Port can be a serial port, for example COM1, COM2, and so on, or a Modbus TCP
port.

To add a Modbus Slave Port:

1. Open Management Console and log on with a supervisor level user account.

2. Select Tools > System > ION Virtual Processor Setup. This opens the ION Virtual
Processor Setup dialog box.

3. In ION Virtual Processor Setup, find the VIP for which you want to add a slave port. Double-
click Modbus Network for this VIP. This opens the Network view.

4. Double-click Slave Ports. This shows any configured slave ports for this VIP. If no slave
ports are configured, the list will be empty.

5. Click Add Port. This opens the VIP Setup Modbus Port/Site dialog box.

6. In VIP Setup Modbus Port/Site, select the Port you want to use. Click OK.

7. Double-click the newly added slave port and then double-click Settings. This opens the port
settings.

8. Edit the port settings if required. For more information on port settings, see VIP Modbus Slave
port settings

9. Click Save, then click Exit.

NOTE: You must restart the VIP for the changes to take effect.

Done

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 965


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Modifying the Global Parameters


Typically, you do not need to change the default Virtual Processor’s Global Parameters. However,
the settings in the following table can be modified to improve system performance. To view and
select the settings, expand Global Parameters.

Global Parameter Value Range Description Notes


Frequent module updates
contribute to the workstation's
The interval at which
processor load. By increasing
Module Update ION modules inside
50 to 1000 ms the Module Update Period, you
Period the Virtual Processor
reduce the number of times a
are updated.
module executes in a given time
period.
The interval at which
Increasing the Configuration
the Virtual Processor
Saver Period significantly
Configuration writes its configuration
10 to 600 seconds reduces the processor load if you
Saver Period data to the
have a large Virtual Processor
workstation's hard
configuration file.
disk.
The interval at which
the Virtual Processor You can increase the period for
gets information from less time sensitive Virtual
Client Polling
500 to 300000 ms other nodes in the Processor applications and
Period
network (for example, reduce the period for more time
another Virtual sensitive applications.
Processor or a device).
The interval at which
the Virtual Processor Reducing this value increases
responds to requests the rate at which these
Server Polling 200 to 1440000
for information from responses are sent; however,
Period ms
client nodes such as this can also increase network
Vista or the Log traffic.
Inserter.

966 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

Web Applications settings

TIP: You can open the Settings page from the SETTINGS link in the Web Applications banner.

Use the Settings page to access web application settings and configuration tools.

NOTE: Access to this application or function is controlled by user privileges. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

TIP: Use Search, in the Settings Library, to find the settings and tools you are looking for based on
keywords.

The Settings page consists of a Settings Library and a configuration area. The Settings Library
provides access to the following settings and tools:

Category Settings/Tools
Alarm Views
Alarms Notifications
Software Alarms (tool)
Personal Preferences
Report Theme
Personalization
System Language
System Theme
Diagnostics and Usage
Registration & Analytics
Registration
Diagrams Control Options
Security Login Options
Session Timeout
Integrations (Note: This Authorized Hosts
setting is a sub category EWS Login (Note: This setting is hidden when EWS is disabled.)
under Security.) Integration Utility
Billing Rates (tool)
Device Manager (tool)
System Hierarchies (tool)
Modeling (tool)
System Log (tool)
Users User Manager (tool)

NOTE: The availability of the Billing Rates (Rate Editor) and Modeling are subject to licensing.
EcoStruxure Web Services (EWS) appears in the Settings pane only if it is enabled in the system.

NOTE: You can customize the web application navigation links (Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends,
and so on) in the banner. For example, you can add custom links, hide/unhide/delete links, and re-
order links. For details see Customizing the Web Applications links

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 967


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Alarm Views
Use the alarm view settings to:

• Change the number of items that are displayed in the alarms display.

• Change the priority classifications for alarms and incidents.

• Customize the behavior of the alarm annunciator with these settings.

• Customize the display of Load Impact events in Alarm and Incident views.

To change how many Incidents, Alarms, and Events are shown in the Alarm Viewer:

1. Under Display Settings, enter the maximum number you want to be displayed for Incidents,
Alarms, and Events in the boxes.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change the Alarm Viewer update interval:

1. Under Display Settings, select the Update Interval.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To turn the Alarm Annunciator on or off:

1. Under Annunciator, turn Enable on or off.

When the Annunciator is turned off, it is not visible in the Web Applications banner.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change what type of state counts are shown in the Alarm Annunciator:

1. Under Annunciator, select the state type for Show counts for.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change the Alarm priorities that are shown in the Alarm Annunciator:

1. Under Priority Classification, select or clear the Visible in Annunciator check boxes for
the Alarm priorities you want to include or exclude from the Annunciator.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change for which Alarm priorities an Alarm notification sound is played:

1. Under Priority Classification, select or clear the Audible in Annunciator check boxes for
the Alarm priorities you want a notification sound to be played for or not.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change the sound that is played for Alarm notification:

1. Under Annunciator, click Select Sound File.

2.  In Select Audio File, select the sound you want, or if the sound is not in the Media Library,
a. Click Upload Audio File and either choose a sound file available on your system by
clicking Choose Files or drag a sound file into the application area.

b. Click Finish to add it to the Media Library.

968 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

3. Click OK to complete your sound selection.

4. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change the Alarm Annunciator update interval:

1. Under Annunciator, select the Update Interval.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change the display color and Alarm priority ranges for the Alarm Viewer:

1. Under Priority Classification, set the Color and Start values for the different alarm priorities.
The End values are adjusted automatically.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change the display of Load Impact events in Alarm and Incident views:

1. Under Load Impact Display, select or clear the check boxes for the options you want or not.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

EWS Login
EcoStruxure Web Services (EWS) requires a unique set of credentials to connect to the data
exchange service.
To configure the credentials:

1. Click Change Credentials, or Set Credentials, if you are configuring this setting for the first
time, to enable the input fields.

2. Add a user name.

3. Type the password for the user in the Password and Confirm Password entry fields.

4. Click Save to apply your changes or Discard to retain the existing credentials.

NOTE: The EWS Login settings are only visible if EWS is enabled. When EWS is disabled, the
Integrations and EWS Login settings are hidden.

Personal Preferences
Use the personal preferences settings to update or edit your user profile details, change your
account password, set your personal localization preferences, and choose your personal theme
color.

NOTE: Your personal localization settings overrule the system localization settings for your user
account. By default, your personal localization settings are the same as the system localization
settings. See System and personal localization settings for details on the behavior of these
settings.

NOTE: Your personal localization settings also apply to the Vista and Designer applications.

NOTE: The profile details settings and change password option are only available for standard
accounts. For Windows accounts, this information is managed through Windows.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 969


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: The profile details and account password are the same as the ones configured for your
account with User Manager.

To change any of the personal preferences:

1. Edit the fields or select the options you want from the drop-down lists.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

Report Theme
Change the Report theme to customize the Reports colors and the Reports logo.
To change the Reports colors:

1. Under Report Colors, select Use Theme Colors or Override Theme Colors.

TIP: The system theme colors are defined by the System Theme settings for the Web
Applications. See System Theme for more information.

2. If you choose Override Theme Colors, then set the colors for the Report Title, Section Header,
Table Header, Summary, Row Shading, and Section Title, using the drop-down selectors.

3. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change the Reports Logo:

1. In SETTINGS, open the Settings Library and click Report Theme.

2. Under Report Logo, click Select to open the Select Report Logo Image dialog.

3. Select an image currently available in the repository, or


a. Click Upload Image to choose an image file available on your system or drag an image
file into the application area.

b. Click Finish to add it to the image repository.

4. Click OK to complete your selection.

5. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

NOTE: You can use GIF, JPG, JPEG, or PNG image formats. The recommended file size is 250 x
100 pixels. Images are automatically re-sized to fit the logo area in Reports.

System Language
Use these system localization settings to select the language, region, and currency symbol. The
setting for Region determines date, time, number, and currency formats.

NOTE: Your personal localization settings overrule the system localization settings for your user
account. By default, your personal localization settings are the same as the system localization
settings. See System and personal localization settings for details on the behavior of these
settings.

970 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

NOTE: The system localization settings also apply to the diagrams displayed in the Vista
application.

To change any of the system localization settings:

1. Select the options you want from the drop-down lists.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

System Theme
Use the system theme settings to:

• Choose the Default theme or a User Defined theme

• Specify if you want to display the vendor logo in the top right corner of the Web applications
window.

• Change the image and text that is displayed in the top left corner of the Web Applications
window.

• Choose a theme color for the borders and other elements of the user interface. You can enable
high contrast mode which uses a dark background color for the application.

• Choose the location of the library panel to be on the right or left side of the user interface.

• Specify if you want to use compact mode navigation.

NOTE: Compact navigation replaces the main navigation bar at the top of the Web
Applications user interface with an options button . The options button is displayed at the
top left corner of the banner. When you click the button, the navigation links to the different
Web applications are shown. Compact mode is used for small displays, such as on mobile
devices. The Web Applications user interfaces switches to compact mode automatically
when the browser size is reduced below a certain size. Turning on the Always use compact
mode for Navigation setting forces this mode regardless of browser size.

• Set the colors for the waveform and bust data plots.

• Reset the theme to system defaults.

To select the theme to be default or user defined:

1. Under General Theme, click Default Theme or click User Defined.

NOTE: With the Default Theme all color, image, and logo options are set to the factory
defaults. You can change the location of the navigation panel, choose to always use
compact mode, and you can customize the colors for the waveform and burst data plots.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To specify the display of the vendor logo:

1. Under General Theme, click User Defined.

2. Turn on Show Vendor logo to display the logo or turn off Show Vendor logo to hide the

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 971


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

logo, in the top right corner of the Web Applications window.

3. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change the top left logo and text:

1. Under General Theme, click User Defined.

2. Under Image, click Select.

3.  In Select Image, select the image you want, or if the image is not in the Image Library,
Click Upload Image and either choose an image file available on your system by clicking
Choose Files or drag an image file into the application area.

Click Finish to add it to the Image Library.

4. Click OK to complete your image selection.

The image file name is shown under Image. The image is updated on the banner when you
save your settings. You can use GIF, JPG, JPEG, or PNG image formats. The maximum file
size is 2MB. Images are automatically resized to fit the logo area on the banner.

5. Use the Text field to change the text beside the logo in the banner. The text is updated when
you save your settings.

6. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change the theme color:

1. Under General Theme, click User Defined.

2. Under Theme Color, select from several preset color themes or create your own using the
color selector that opens when you click the color theme icon on the right. When you
click a preset color, it is temporarily applied to the interface to show you the effect of the
change.

TIP: Enable high contrast mode to create a dark mode type theme with dark backgrounds.

3. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To choose the location of the library panel:

1. Under Navigation, select Left or Right.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To specify the use of compact mode navigation:

1. Under Navigation, turn on Always use compact mode for Navigation.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To change the color settings for Waveform and Burst Data:

1. Under Waveform and Burst Data, set the color that is used to display the different
measurement types.

NOTE: Click Reset to Default to set the colors to the system default.

972 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To reset the theme to the system defaults:

1. Click Default Theme.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

Diagnostics and Usage


Diagnostics and Usage
Diagnostics and Usage anonymously sends data to a secure server. Schneider Electric uses this
data to help improve our software by understanding how you use it.

The diagnostics and usage service collects and sends data to Schneider Electric weekly on
Monday at 2:00 a.m. (server time), over HTTPS at port 443. Each time the service runs, it creates a
log file in the system\bin folder in the Power Monitoring Expert install location.

This operation is enabled by default.

NOTE: All diagnostics and usage data are sent to Schneider Electric anonymously. None of the
collected information identifies you or your company. For more information on the Schneider
Electric Privacy Policy, see the Schneider Data Privacy and Cookie Policy. See Resources for
link information.

The following diagnostic and usage data is collected when it is enabled:

Diagnostic Data Usage Data


• Power Monitoring Expert version
• Total number of devices
• Operating system version and type (32- or
• Device type count
64-bit)
• Number of users
• Number of CPU cores

• System memory (RAM)

• .NET Framework version

• SQL Server version

• Distributed or local database

• City or region

• Number of monitors in use

• Client screen resolution

• Screen DPI

To disable the sending of data:

1. Open Web Applications and click Settings > Registration & Analytics > Diagnostics and
Services.

2. Select Disable in the dropdown list and click Save to apply the change.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 973


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Registration
Connected Services
Connected Services lets you share the operational data that is collected by Power Monitoring
Expert with Schneider Electric. The collected energy and power data can then be used by
connected services – such as EcoStruxure™ Power Advisor and EcoStruxure™ Asset Advisor – to
help identify gaps or issues in your power management system. It can also help identify power
quality issues within your electrical distribution system.

The collected data depends on the specific services that the customer receives from Schneider
Electric. For more information on Connected Services, see the Power Advisor User Guide. See
Resources for link information.

To disable the collecting of operational data, select Disable in the drop-down list and click Save to
apply the change.

Software registration
Registration information is used by Schneider Electric to help provide support and to enhance the
service we provide to you. Schneider Electric will never sell or share this information.

By registering you acknowledge that your registration information will be shared with Schneider
Electric and you consent to receiving occasional communications about your product. Product
communication includes new features, service pack releases, and recommended cybersecurity
updates.

You can edit the registration information at any time through the web application settings.

Authorized Hosts
Use the authorized hosts settings to define third-party web resources that are allowed to either
embed (frame) the PME web applications, or to which the PME web applications can redirect
requests.

To define a third-party web resource as a Hosts That Can Frame, add the Uniform Resource
Locator (URL) of that resource to the list, for example https://localhost:446.

NOTE: Add all the names (URLs) that might be used for a host, for example the server name,
"localhost", the IP address, and so on.

To define a third-party web resource as Hosts That Can Be Redirected To, add the hostname (no
protocol, no port number) of that resource to the list, for example localhost.

NOTE: Reset Internet Information Services (IIS) on the PME server after updating the Authorized
Hosts settings.

974 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

An example for an application that requires an entry in the Hosts That Can Frame list is the
integration of PME with EcoStruxure Building Operation. As part of that integration, PME Web
Applications are embedded in Building Operation. For this to work, the Building Operation server
URL must be added to the list of hosts that can frame.

Integration Utility
Use the integration utility settings to generate pre-authenticated links to PME resources. Use these
links to integrate web applications (Dashboard, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, Reports, and EWS
measurements) into third-party systems. You can authenticate the link using standard users or
Windows users.

To enable or disable the pre-authentication for standard users:

1. Under Pre-Authentication for Standard Users, turn Enable pre-authentication on or off.

2. Click Save to apply the changed settings.

To generate links:

1. Under Authentication Method, select the desired user type for authentication:

NOTICE
UNAUTHORIZED OR UNINTENDED ACCESS TO CONFIDENTIAL DATA
• Personnel generating the pre-authenticated links for integration into third-party systems
must be aware that links to data are not secure.
• Do not setup access links to sensitive or secure data.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unauthorized or unintended access
to sensitive or secure data.

Select Windows User.

NOTE: Links for Windows users contain no user information. Windows users accessing
the link must have permission to access the PME system and be authenticated with
Windows. One-click login must be enabled to use the Windows user authenticated links.
See Login Options for information for enabling one-click login.

Select Standard User, select the desired PME User Name and enter the Password.

NOTE: Links for standard users embed the user's account information. Take care on
usage of these links. Links cannot be generated for standard users with supervisor
access level.

2. Under Generate Links For, select the web applications for which you want to generate link.

3. Under Link Format, select the desired link format:

Select XML to generate an XML file of links. Use this option to generate links that can be
imported into applications like EcoStruxure Building Operation.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 975


Configure EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Select HTML to generate an HTML page of links. Use this option to verify the links.

NOTE: The download HTML link must be opened in a different browser to test the links.

4. Click Generate Web Application Links.

An XML or HTML file is downloaded to the default download location of the browser.

An example for an application that requires the generated link is the integration of PME with Building
Operation. As part of that integration, PME Web Applications are embedded in Building Operation.
For this to work, the generated links are imported in to Building Operation.

Login Options
Use the login options settings to define how Windows users can log into the software. You can also
disallow login for standard users and only allow login for Windows users.
You can choose the following login options for Windows users:

• Manual Login Only

Windows users can log into the system by manually entering credentials on the login page.

• One-Click Login Only

Windows users can log into the system by clicking a hyperlink on the login page.

• Manual Login and One-Click Login

Windows users can log into the system by manually entering credentials, or by clicking a
hyperlink on the login page.

NOTE: Standard users, if allowed to log in, always have to enter their credentials manually.

If you only want to allow Windows user accounts to log into the software, you can disable standard
user login. For these options to be available, your system must have at least one Windows user
with supervisor-level access.

Session Timeout
Use the session timeout settings to define the timeout behavior of the software web applications
and Windows applications clients.
You have to following options:

• You can enable and set a timeout for the web applications.

• You can enable and set a timeout for the Windows applications.

NOTE: You can enter a timeout value from 1 minute to 1440 minutes (1 day)

When a session timeout is configured, web application clients are logged out and Windows
application clients (Vista, Designer, Management Console) are locked after a period of inactivity.
The default timeout for both client types is 20 minutes. To restart or unlock the session you must
enter the login credentials.

976 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Configure

A session is considered inactive when none of the following actions are detected for the duration of
the timeout period:

• Mouse movement

• Mouse clicks

• Keyboard activity

• Touch screen activity

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 977


Administer EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Administer
This chapter provides information on tasks and tools for ongoing system maintenance in Power
Monitoring Expert (PME).

Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for.

Function/Tool Task
Basic administration tasks Run Updates, check database maintenance tasks.
Cybersecurity Provides recommended actions to help secure your system.
Use Configuration Manager to back up the configuration on your
Configuration Manager system. (Note: This is an add-on tool. See Resources for
information on where to get it.)
Archive and trim the ION databases, upgrade a database, create a
Database Manager
new database, or export the database registry settings.
Deactivate alarms that are incorrectly stuck in a permanently active
Deactivating alarms
state.
Diagnostics Viewer Monitor system and network performance.
Reconfigure, reset accounts, export System Key, import System
PME Installer
Key, uninstall.
Add or remove PME users. Change user access level, passwords,
User Manager and account information. Change User Group access to devices
and Web Applications.
Windows Updates Routinely apply Microsoft Windows Updates.

978 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Administer

Basic administration tasks


Install Windows updates
Apply critical and routine Windows and SQL Server updates to the PME servers and clients; no prior
approval by Schneider Electric is required.

Check the scheduled database maintenance tasks

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the database at regular intervals.
• Back up the database before upgrading or migrating the system.
• Back up the database before trimming it.
• Back up the database before making manual database edits.
• Verify correct database behavior after making database or system changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

In Standalone PME systems, the database maintenance tasks for backup, archive, maintenance,
and trim are pre-configured and scheduled to run automatically by default. For Distributed Database
PME systems, we recommend that these scheduled tasks are set up manually.

Check the task outputs regularly and confirm that backups are created as expected. Review and
adjust the schedules to meet your application needs, if required. See Database maintenance for
more information on the scheduled database maintenance tasks.

NOTE: You can perform additional, manual backups using standard SQL Server backup
procedures.

Monitor the database size for systems with SQL Server Express databases

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up or archive the database before trimming it.
• Trim the SQL Server Express database before it reaches the size limit.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

SQL Server Express has a maximum database size limit of 10 GB. The database stops logging data
when this size limit is reached. The scheduled default database maintenance tasks include a
database size notification task. When the size threshold is reached, the task logs a system log
event message and triggers a Critical alarm in PME every time the task runs.

Check the PME system log and Alarms on a regular basis for database size notification messages.
Check the database size on a regular basis and take action before reaching the database size limit.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 979


Administer EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Cybersecurity
This section provides information on how to help secure your system during the Administering
phase.

Renew security certificate


Renew the security certificate before it expires.

Securely store the system key


See Protect the System Key for details.

Apply PME updates


Install software updates that apply to your system when they become available. Check the PME
Exchange Community (requires login) or the Schneider Electric Exchange - EcoStruxure Power
Monitoring Expert (Portal) for available updates, or contact your service provider.

Verify update file integrity and authenticity


See Verify install file integrity and authenticity for details.

Apply OS and SQL Server updates

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Apply the latest updates and hotfixes to your Operating System and software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Critical and routine Windows and SQL Server updates can be applied to the operating systems
hosting the PME server and clients without prior approval by Schneider Electric.
Consider implementing best practices, such as:

• Establish a reliable process for finding and applying the latest security updates.

• Use systematic procedures governed by corporate policy.

• Use automated scanners for detecting missing patches, misconfigurations, use of default
accounts, and so on.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before installing the update, verify that the system is not performing critical control actions
that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system operation after the update.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

980 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Administer

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Before installing the update, verify that the system data results are not used for critical
decision making that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system data results after the update.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Review user accounts on a regular basis


Review PME user accounts on a regular basis. Update passwords and user permissions, and
remove unused accounts as required.

RECOMMENDATION: Use Windows users instead of standard users in your PME system to
improve cybersecurity. Windows offers advanced user management functions, such as enforcing
password strength and limiting the number of invalid login attempts. These functions are required
for IEC 62443 compliance, the global standard for industrial automation control system security.

NOTE: To only use Windows users, replace any existing standard users in the system with
Windows users. Disallow logins for standard users in Web Applications, this disables the
supervisor user. See Login Options for more information.

Keep network security up-to-date


Keep security related networking tools and equipment up-to-date and working as expected.

NOTE: Network security equipment, such as firewalls, are complex devices and must be
maintained by trained individuals.

Keep computer hardware secure


See Plan your site security for more information.

Perform security audits


Perform comprehensive system security audits on a regular basis. Regularly scan and verify
security.
Consider implementing best practices, such as:

• Check the OS and PME system logs.

• Check performance monitor profiles

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 981


Administer EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Database Manager
Use Database Manager to manually perform operations on the Power Monitoring Expert databases.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the database at regular intervals.
• Back up the database before upgrading or migrating the system.
• Back up the database before trimming it.
• Back up the database before making manual database edits.
• Verify correct database behavior after making database or system changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

NOTE: Database Manager does not include manual database operations on the Application
Modules database (ApplicationModules). In a disaster recovery situation or when directed by
Technical Support, the Application Modules database can be restored by using the Restore
database function in the SQL Server Management Studio. See Restoring a database for further
information about this operation. ION databases can be restored using the same process.

For information on database maintenance tasks in PME, see Database maintenance.

Prerequisites
The following user prerequisites need to be met to work with Database Manager and database
functions through SQL Server Management Studio:

• For Database Manager: Since Windows authentication is used to access the SQL Server
databases, the user needs to be a member of the sysadmin SQL Server role, which is set in
SQL Server Management Studio.

• For most database functions available in SQL Server Management Studio: The user needs to
be a member of the sysadmin SQL Server role.

NOTE: If the Windows user that you used to log into the system is not a member of the sysadmin
role, and you want to run Database Manager, you can do so without logging out by completing the
following steps:

1. Navigate to the system\bin folder in the product's install location.

2. Locate DatabaseManager.exe.

3. Click the EXE file name to highlight it, then press Shift+Right-click to open the menu.

4. Click Run as different user to open the Windows Security dialog.

5. In the User name field, type a user name that has the sysadmin role, then type the password
for that user.

6. Click OK to open Database Manager.

982 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Administer

Database Manager interface


To access Database Manager, start Management Console then click Tools > Database Manager.
Note that the Windows user running Database Manager needs to be a member of the sysadmin
SQL Server role.

Expand the items in the navigation tree to display the Databases for each instance.

Note that scheduled jobs are available only in Windows Task Scheduler. For further information,
see Database maintenance.

SQL Server Options Show


A B Databases C D
Instance menu Archives

SQL Server instance


The default SQL Server instance that the product uses for its databases is
COMPUTERNAME\INSTANCE, where COMPUTERNAME is the name of the server, and INSTANCE is
the SQL Server instance used with the product.

Databases
The Databases section lets you view information about the databases or perform manual actions on
the databases.

For information on the manual actions you can perform, see Manual actions.

Viewing Database Properties

To view the properties of a particular database, right-click that database and select Properties. The
properties are:

• Size: The current size of the database.

• Primary File Location: The file path for the primary database (.mdf) file.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 983


Administer EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Transaction Log Location: The file path for the transaction log (.ldf) file.

• Creation Date: The date and time when the database was created.

• Last Backup Date: The date when the last backup was performed.

• Disk Space Available: The amount of free space available on the disk where the database
resides.

• Server Version: The type and version of the SQL Server instance that is hosting the database.

Show archives
Select this check box (lower left-hand corner) if you want the list under Databases to include all
archived databases along with the live databases. After Show Archives is selected, you can
upgrade archived databases or view the properties of the archived databases.

Clear the Show Archives check box to hide the archived databases from view. This also prevents
the database actions from being performed on database archives.

Manual actions
The following sections provide information on the manual actions that you can use to manage your
databases.
To perform an action manually, do one of the following:

• Right-click Databases and select the action from the menu, or

• Right-click the specific database and select the action you want to perform from the pop-up
menu.

When you right-click Databases and select an action, a dialog specific to that action opens. The
databases listed in the dialog are those to which the action applies.

When you right-click a specific database, only the actions that apply to that database appear in the
menu and the database is selected by default in the dialog for the action.

Archive
The Archive action creates an archive of the selected database.
Before proceeding, ensure that you have write access to the archive directory location.

1. Right-click Databases or ION_Data and select Archive to open the Database Archive
dialog. If necessary, select the database that you want to archive.

2. Select the directory where the archive will be saved.

For standalone environments:

a. In Save archive to, click the browse button to select the directory where the archive
will be saved.

...\Power Monitoring Expert\Database\Archives\Data is the default


directory for the saved archive, but you can specify another local directory.

984 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Administer

b. (Optional) Specify a different local directory.

NOTE: You can only save an archive to a directory on the local machine, not to a
location on the network.

c. (Optional) Edit the default archive filename to follow your naming conventions.

NOTE: The database name is restricted to characters A-Z, a-z, 0-9, and _ (underscore).

For distributed environments:


a. In Save archive to, enter an existing directory path on the server and a valid filename for
the archive.

For example: C:\Archives\ION_Data_January.mdf. The path – in the example


C:\Archives – must exist on the Database Server.

NOTE: The database name is restricted to characters A-Z, a-z, 0-9, and _ (underscore).

3. Select the data types that you want to archive.

4. Specify the date range of the data that you want to archive. For Start, select The beginning
of the database or select Date and enter a date and time. Enter a date and time for End Date.

5. Under Trim after archive select whether or not you want to remove archived data from the
database.

You need to select The beginning of the database for the start date range for trimming the
live database, otherwise the Trim after archive option is disabled.

6. Click OK.

The Progress field displays the current progress of the archive process. If a manual archive does
not succeed, a message appears and the Database Archive dialog remains open with the OK
button grayed out — examine the Progress field to discover where the process did not succeed. If
the archive is successful, the dialog closes automatically.

Export Registry Setting


The Export Registry Setting action exports settings to a registry (.reg) file. This is useful if you need
to set up client computers in a system where the primary server’s database settings (server
instance name and database name) are customized. After you export the settings to the registry
(.reg) file, you can import that registry file on the client computer.

1. Right-click Databases and select Export Registry Setting to open the Database Registry
Key Export dialog.

2. Type the path and filename for the file or click the browse button to specify the location for
the saved the database registry key.

The directory ...\Power Monitoring Expert\config\cfg\ is the default save location for the
exported database registry key.

3. Click OK.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 985


Administer EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

New ION_Data Database


The New ION_Data Database action creates a new, blank version of the ION_Data database.

1. Right-click Databases and select New ION_Data Database to open the New Historical
Database dialog.

2. Type a name for your new database.

NOTE: Do not name it “ION_Data” as this is the default name for the existing ION database.
Database names are restricted to characters A-Z, a-z, 0-9, and _ (underscore).

3. Click the browse button to specify a location for the database.

4. Click OK.

Trim
The Trim action removes data from a database.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
• Back up the database at regular intervals.
• Back up the database before upgrading or migrating the system.
• Back up the database before trimming it.
• Back up the database before making manual database edits.
• Verify correct database behavior after making database or system changes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in permanent loss of data.

1. Right-click Databases, ION_Data or ION_SystemLog and select Trim to open the Trim
Database dialog.

2. Select the database you want to trim from the Database to trim list.

3. Under Trim Range, specify the date range of data you want to trim (for the ION_Data
database) or set the maximum data age in days (for the ION_SystemLog database).

4. For the ION_Data database, select the data types you want to trim (Data Records,
Waveforms, Events) in the Data Types section. You can select any combination of data
types to trim.

5. Click OK. A message appears to notify you that the selected data will be removed. Click Yes
to continue or No to cancel.

Upgrade Database
The Upgrade Databases action upgrades the selected database to the latest database schema.

1. Right-click Databases and select Upgrade Databases to open the ION Database Upgrade
dialog.

986 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Administer

The Power Monitoring Expert installer automatically upgrades your databases with the new
database schemas when you install Power Monitoring Expert on an existing server. If you
install the latest version of the product on a different server so that you can manually copy
older database files to the new computer, you can run this action on the older databases (that
is, on the ION_Data, ION_SystemLog, and ION_Network databases, and archives) to
upgrade them with the new schema.

2. Select the database in the list that you want to upgrade and click OK.

Restoring a database
You can restore a database from a backup by logging in to SQL Server Management Studio as a
user with syadmin access authority for the Restore Database function. (Database backups are
specified as a scheduled job in Windows Task Scheduler. See Database maintenance for more
information.)

Restoring the latest database

Complete the following to restore a database from the latest backup:

1. Stop all ION services.

2. Open SQL Server Management Studio, enter your password if required and click Connect
to access your SQL Server.

3. In the Object Explorer pane on the left, expand Databases, right-click the database you want
to restore and click Tasks > Restore > Database to open the Restore Database dialog.

4. Under Source, select Database and click the database you want to restore in the dropdown
list if it is not already selected.

5. Under Backup sets to restore, select the checkbox in the Restore column for the database
you want to restore.

6. Click Options in the Select a page pane on the left.

7. On the Options page:


Under Restore options, select Overwrite the existing database (WITH REPLACE).

For Recovery state, select RESTORE WITH RECOVERY from the dropdown list.

RESTORE WITH RECOVERY is described as Leave the database ready to use by


rolling back uncommitted transactions. Additional Transaction logs cannot be
restored.

8. Click OK to begin the restore operation.

A message indicates that the database has been restored successfully. If the restore
operation is not successful, the database reverts to its original state.

NOTE: After you restore the database, you need to assign its ownership to the ION user as
follows:

a. In SQL Server Management Studio, right-click the restored database and click Properties
in the menu to open the Database Properties dialog.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 987


Administer EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

b. Click Files under Select a page.

c. Click the button on the right of the Owner field to open the Select Database Owner dialog.

d. Type ION in the field labeled Enter the object names to select and click Check Names
to adjust the format of your entry to [ION].

e. Click OK to update the owner of the database.

f. Click OK to close the Database Properties dialog.

9. Restart all ION services.

Restoring a specific database

Complete the following to restore a specific database:

1. Repeat steps 1 through 3 from Restoring the latest database above.

2. Under Source, select Device and click Browse to open the Select backup devices dialog.

3. Select File in Backup media type list if it is not already specified and then click Add to open
the Locate Backup File dialog.

4. Navigate to and select the backup file you want to restore and click OK.

5. Verify that the file referenced in the Specify Backup dialog is the one you selected and click
OK to return to the Restore Database dialog.

6. Under Select the backup sets to restore, select the checkbox in the Restore column for the
database you are restoring.

7. Click Options in the Select a page pane on the left.

8. On the Options page:


Under Restore options, select Overwrite the existing database (WITH REPLACE).

Under Recovery state, select RESTORE WITH RECOVERY from the dropdown list.

RESTORE WITH RECOVERY is described as Leave the database ready to use by


rolling back uncommitted transactions. Additional Transaction logs cannot be
restored.

9. Click OK to begin the restore operation.

A message indicates that the database has been restored successfully. If the restore
operation is not successful, the database reverts to its original state.

NOTE: After you restore the database, you need to assign its ownership to the ION user as
follows:

a. In SQL Server Management Studio, right-click the restored database and click Properties
in the menu to open the Database Properties dialog.

b. Click Files under Select a page.

c. Click the button on the right of the Owner field to open the Select Database Owner dialog.

d. Type ION in the field labeled Enter the object names to select and click Check Names.

988 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Administer

The format of your entry changes to [ION].

e. Click OK to update the owner of the database.

f. Click OK to close the Database Properties dialog.

10. Restart all ION services.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 989


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Operate
This chapter describes the different applications for accessing power monitoring information in
Power Monitoring Expert (PME). You use these applications on a regular basis to view real-time
data, historical data, and alarm data. The chapter is organized by applications and software
modules. See Introduction to Power Monitoring Expert (PME) for a general overview.

Use the information in the following tables to find the content you are looking for.

By application or function:

Application/Function Function
Alarms View incidents, alarms, and events. Acknowledge alarms
Dashboards View high level ,historical and real-time data in gadgets.
View low level, historical and real-time data in one-line and graphics
Diagrams
diagrams.
Reports Run reports manually, or schedule automatic report generation.
System integration Use PME integrated with other EcoStruxure™ systems.
Trends View trends for real-time and historical data.
Perform control actions in your power monitoring system, for
example reset counters or activate device digital outputs. View low
Vista
level, historical and real-time data in one-line and graphics
diagrams.
Access the Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, and Reports
Web Applications applications. Access Settings and configurations tools. View the
alarm annunciator.

By software module:

Module Application
Backup Power Module Generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) performance
operation monitoring and reporting, including battery health.
Breaker Performance
Circuit breaker aging and breaker settings monitoring.
Module operation
Generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) capacity
Capacity Management
monitoring and reporting. Includes transformer and UPS loss
Module operation
monitoring.
Energy Analysis Dashboard Gadgets for identifying consumption patterns and anomalies and for
Module operation comparing different consumers over time.
Energy Analysis Reports Reports for energy consumption monitoring and modeling, including
Module operation energy usage by process area or by product output.
Energy Billing Module Energy-based billing and reporting, including consumption
operation monitoring and reporting at the branch circuit level.

990 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Module Application
Event Notification Module
Notifications of power system events via email or SMS.
operation
Insulation Monitoring Monitoring for isolated power systems, such as the ones found in
Module operation hospital operating rooms.
Power Quality Performance Analysis of power quality events and disturbances and their impact
Module operation on the monitored system.

References:

Topic Description
Links to reference information related to the content of the Operating
Operation references
chapter.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 991


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Introduction to Power Monitoring Expert (PME)


PME software is a power management solution for energy suppliers and consumers. It allows you
to manage energy information from metering and control devices installed in your facility or other
remote locations. The product offers control capabilities and comprehensive power quality and
reliability analysis to help you reduce energy-related costs.

The product supports multiple communications standards and protocols available on various
intelligent metering devices. You can also connect to existing power monitoring systems through
industry standard protocols such as Modbus and OPC.

Supported operating systems and SQL Server versions


See Operating Environment for information on supported Windows operating systems and
SQL Server versions and editions.

PME software components


This section outlines the PME software components.

Web Applications
Web applications are the end user facing components of the software. You use web applications in
your daily work with PME. Web Applications has 3 main parts: Apps, Settings, and Configuration
Tools.

Apps
Use Web apps to access power monitoring information. The following apps are included in the Web
Applications:

• Dashboards

• Diagrams

• Trends

• Alarms

• Reports

See Web Applications for details.

Settings
Use Settings to tailor the behavior and appearance of the software. The following Web Application
Settings are available:

• Alarm Views

• Authorized Hosts

• Diagnostics and Services

• Diagrams Control Options

• EWS Login

• Login Options

• Personal Preferences

992 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Registration

• Report Theme

• Security Options

• Session Timeout

• System Language

• System Theme

The Settings page also provides links to the following configuration tools:

• Software Alarms

• Device Manager

• Hierarchy Manager

• Log Viewer

• Modeling Configuration

• Notifications

• Rate Editor

• User Manager

See Web Applications settings for details.

Engineering applications
Engineering applications are the backend components that are used to configure and maintain the
monitoring devices, networks, databases and other elements of the power monitoring system. It
also includes the Vista application which is used to for real-time control and to build diagrams. The
following applications are included:

Management Console
Use Management Console to add and configure network components such as servers, sites
(communication links) and devices. Management Console also provides access to the following
system and database applications, and utilities (listed in menu sequence):
Through Management Console > Tools

• Database Manager

• Event Watcher Manager 

• Reports Configuration

• Logical Device editors

• Deactivating alarms

• Configure managed circuits

Through Management Console > Tools > System

• Diagnostics Viewer

• Device Type Editor

• Manual Data Editor

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 993


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Remote Modem Setup

• Virtual Processor setup

• Update OPC Server

• Update EWS Server

• Upload Report Template

• PQDIF Exporter

• Time of Use Editor 

Through Management Console > Tools > Web Tools

Management Console provides shortcuts to Web Applications configuration tools. See Web
Applications for details.

Vista
Use Vista to reset counters and perform other control actions on monitoring devices. Vista also
displays real-time and historical information using graphical displays. You use Vista to create the
diagrams for the Diagrams Web app.

Designer
Use Designer to perform a wide range of functions, from configuring setup registers of ION devices
on your network to creating complex frameworks using a combination of ION modules from
hardware or software nodes.

OPC Server Assistant


The OPC Server Assistant is a utility that you use to expose ION measurements as OPC tags. You
open the utility from Designer. See OPC Server Support for further information.

The OPC Server Assistant is available during the 90-day trial period. After the trial period, you need
to purchase a Data Exchange Module license and activate it through the License Configuration Tool
to enable OPC server functionality.

Large system setup using Management Console


Use the Duplicate and Configure function to set up large systems efficiently. See Setting up large
systems for more information.

(PME) Windows Services


For a list of PME Windows Services see PME Windows services

Power Monitoring Expert databases


For information on the PME databases, see PME DatabasesPME Databases.

Getting started
This section describes how to start, log on to, and exit most of the components of the Power
Monitoring Expert product.

994 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Starting a component of Power Monitoring Expert


Use one of the following methods to start the main components Management Console, Vista, or
Web Applications of your product installation:

• Open the Power Monitoring Expert folder on your desktop and double-click the icon of the
program you want to start.

• Click Start > All Programs > Schneider Electric > Power Monitoring Expert and select
the program you want to start.

Logging into a component


Most Power Monitoring Expert programs require you to log in before you can access them.

At the logon prompt, type your user name and password in the appropriate box, then click OK.
Some actions are restricted to certain users or groups, depending on how their login permissions
were set up. For information on creating users and user groups, and on setting user access levels,
see the User Manager section in Web Applications Help.

NOTE: For security reasons, using View Only button to login to Vista no longer works and
displays an error message. Alternatively, it is recommended to login to Diagrams application with
Observer access level.

After you log on, the program interface appears.

Ending a session
There are two ways to end a session in a component:

• Log off if you want to end the current user session but keep the program running, or

• Exit if you want to close the program completely.

Some components offer both options; some only offer the Exit option.

Logging off

1. Select File > Logoff.

A message appears, prompting you to confirm your intention to log off.

2. Click Yes to log off or No to return to the program.

If you attempt to log off without saving your work, you are prompted to save your changes.
Click Yes to save your changes, No to discard them, or Cancel to return to the program.

After you log off, the component's Logon screen appears.

Exiting

1. Select File > Exit.

A message appears, prompting you to confirm your intention to exit the application.

2. Click Yes to exit or No to return to the program.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 995


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

If you attempt to exit without saving your work, the program prompts you to save your
changes. Click Yes to save your changes, No to discard them, or Cancel to return to the
program.

Customizing and navigating interface displays


The following sections describe ways to customize and navigate display windows, dialogs, and
tables in components of Power Monitoring Expert.

Navigating tree structures


Information is often displayed in a tree structure. Click “+” to expand items in the tree or “-” to
collapse them.

Selecting multiple items in tables, tree structures, diagrams and folder structures
To select adjacent items, select the first item, hold down the SHIFT key then click the last item.

To select non-adjacent items, hold down the CTRL key then click to select the items.

To select adjacent items in Vista or Designer diagrams, drag a selection box around the items. All
items in the box are selected.

Adjusting the display of a window or dialog


The following sections describe how to resize and hide or reveal panes.

Resizing panes
To resize panes in a window, point the mouse at the border where the two sections meet. When the
resize handle appears, drag to move the border.

Dock (Pin) or hide (Unpin) pane


Some component interfaces have panes that can be hidden (visible temporarily) or docked (visible
all the time).

To hide or dock a pane, click the Pin/Unpin button on the pane. When a pane is hidden, it is
minimized to a button at the edge of the workspace.

To temporarily show a hidden pane, hover the mouse over the button for that pane. Move the mouse
away to hide the pane again.

Grid table controls


Certain windows and utilities display information in “grid” tables. These tables have unique table and
information display commands.

Select columns/column selector


Some tables allow you to select which columns to include in the table.

1. In Management Console, hover over the column selector tab on the right side of the display
window. In other interfaces, click the “Select Columns” link.

2. Select the boxes for the columns you want to include in the table. Clear the boxes for the
columns you do not want to include in the table.

996 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Adjust column width


To change the width of a column, point the mouse to the right edge of the column header. When the
resize handle (double-arrow pointer) appears, click and drag to adjust the width. To adjust the width
for best fit, point to the right edge of the column header, then double-click when the resize handle
appears.

Best Fit

To adjust a column width to the best fit with the least amount of white space:

• For one column, right-click a column header and select Best Fit.

• For all columns, right-click the column title area and select Best Fit (all columns).

Arrange columns
To change the order of the columns, drag a column header to the left or right of its original position.

Group by column
To group data according to the contents of a particular column, drag the column header to the area
above it (marked “Drag a column header here to group by that column”). To expand or collapse the
groups, click the “+” or “-” button. To expand or collapse all groups, right-click the column header in
the Group By Box area and select Full Expand or Full Collapse, respectively.

You can also group by multiple columns in a specific order, with sorting and filtering applied. To do
this drag each column to the Group By Box area in the order that you want to group them.

To ungroup, drag the column header back to its original position (or right-click the column header and
select Ungroup).

To show or hide the Group By Box area, right-click the column header and select or clear Group
By Box.

Sorting data in a column


Click a column header to sort table rows according to data in that column. You can sort in ascending
or descending order (indicated by an up or down arrow, respectively). To cancel sorting and return
the column to its default state, right-click the column and select Clear Sorting.

Filtering data in a column


The following sections describe the available filtering options.

Using the Simple Column Filter

When the mouse is positioned over a column header, the Filter icon appears in the top right corner of
the header. Click it to select one of the listed filter conditions and apply it to the data in that column.
Select (Custom) to apply one or two logic conditions to filter the data. To cancel filtering and return
the column to its default state, right-click the column and select Clear Filter.

Using the Dynamic Column Filter

Some tables have a row between the column header and the table data. This is the dynamic filter
area.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 997


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To use the dynamic filter area, start typing the entry you want to filter on in the space above the
applicable column. You can use an asterisk (*) at the beginning of the filter as a wildcard. Once you
achieve the filter results you want, you can stop typing. For example, to filter out “DST” from
“disturbance” in System Log Events, you only need to type “di”.

Using the Filter Builder

The Filter Builder is an advanced data filtering tool. Use it to create filters with multiple conditions
across multiple columns. To use the Filter Builder:

1. Right-click a column header and select Filter Editor to open the Filter Builder dialog.

2. Specify the filter conditions.

The elements of the filter builder are: <Column Header> <Condition> <Value>

Click an element to display the options available, then select the option you want to use.

3. Select the <Column Header> and the <Condition> you want to apply. Type the <Value> to
test for.

4. To add another filter, click the “+” button on the top.

5. Select a logic to apply to this new filter (in relationship to the current filter).

6. Repeat step 3.

7. To remove a filter, click the delete (“x”) button beside it.

In the following example, the filter finds all devices in group name containing “Mfg” and whose types
begin with “ION”.

The rows returned are as follows:

998 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Select the checkbox to turn the filter on; clear it to turn the filter off.
A
Click the "X" to cancel and exit the filter mode.
B Click Edit Filter to configure the filter conditions

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 999


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Alarms

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

Overview
The alarm viewer is the user interface (UI) for the Alarms application. Use the alarm viewer to see
software generated and device-based alarms in PME.

The alarm viewer UI has two main areas, the view library and the alarms display. To see alarm
information in the alarms display, you select a view in the view library. The library has predefined
system views and you can create additional custom views. For more information, see: Alarm
Viewer UI

TIP: You can open the alarm viewer from the ALARMS link in the Web Applications banner.

View types
There are two types of views, status views and history views.

Status views
Use status views to see existing alarm definitions in the system, their present state, how often they
occurred, their priority, and other relevant information. The following predefined status views are
available in PME:

1000 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

View Name Description


This view shows alarms that are in the active state. It includes low,
medium and high priority alarms from all sources and all categories.
Active Alarms
This view does not include General Event and Unassociated
Dropout type alarms.
This view shows all low, medium and high priority alarms in the
All Alarms
system regardless of state, category, and source.
This view shows unacknowledged alarms. It includes low, medium
Unacknowledged Alarms and high priority alarms from all sources and all categories that are
in the active or inactive state.

History views
Use history views to see a record of Incidents, alarm instances, and events that happened in the
past. The following predefined history views are available in PME:

View Name Description


This view shows Incidents that are categorized as Asset Monitoring
Asset Monitoring Incidents and are in the active or unacknowledged state. It includes low,
medium and high priority Incidents from all sources.
This view shows Incidents that are categorized as General Clutter
Clutter and are in the active or unacknowledged state. It includes low,
medium and high priority Incidents from all sources.
This view shows incidents that are categorized as Power Quality
(Over Voltage, Swell, Under Voltage, Interruption, Sag, Transient,
Load Loss Incidents or Unclassified Disturbance) and that recorded a sustained load
loss after a voltage sag. It includes low, medium and high priority
Incidents that are active or unacknowledged, from all sources.
This view shows Incidents that are categorized as Power Quality
Power Quality Incidents and are in the active or unacknowledged state. It includes low,
medium and high priority Incidents from all sources.
This view shows alarm instances that are in the active or
unacknowledged state. It includes low, medium and high priority
Recent Alarms
alarms from all sources and all categories. This view does not
include Unassociated Dropout and Clock/Time type alarms.
Recent Events This view shows events of all priorities from all sources.
This view shows Incidents that are in the active or unacknowledged
state. It includes low, medium and high priority Incidents from all
Recent Incidents
sources and all categories. This view does not include General
Alarms for type Clutter.
This view shows Diagnostics type alarm instances that are in the
active or unacknowledged state. It includes low, medium and high
System Health
priority alarms from all sources. This view does not include
Diagnostics Alarms of type Clock/Time and Device Settings.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1001


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Incidents, Alarms, and Events


Incidents
Incidents provide a high-level view. They represent real world power events, such as disturbances
or faults. An incident combines alarms, waveforms, and burst data from many sources in the
system into a single representation of the power event. You can look at an incident and see how the
different pieces of information are linked together, instead of having to analyze each data point
individually. Use incidents as a starting point for your alarm analysis.
For more information, see:

• Incidents

• Viewing incidents

• Incident history UI

Alarms
Alarms provide information on the state and history of alarm conditions that are defined for specific
sources and measurements in the system. Use alarms to monitor the state of your power system
and to investigate specific details as part of an Incident analysis.
For more information, see:

• Alarms

• Viewing alarms

• Alarm status UI

• Alarm history UI

Events
Events are records of activities in the system. Activities are performed by users, the system
software, or the connected devices. Events are logged and displayed as they happen in the system
without any processing or aggregation. PME uses event records to determine alarm types and
states. Use events for low level investigations and detailed root cause analysis.
For more information, see:

• Events

• Viewing events

• Event history UI

Alarm Acknowledgment
You can acknowledge alarms in status views and history views. If you acknowledge alarms through
an incident history view, all alarms that are part of this incident will be acknowledged. Whenever
you acknowledge an alarm, from any of these locations, you are acknowledging the alarm definition
itself, not an instance of it. That means acknowledging an alarm marks it as Acknowledged and
resets its Unacknowledged occurrence counter. For more information, see Acknowledging alarms.

1002 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Analysis tools
The alarm viewer includes tools for analyzing the causes and impacts of alarm events. Some of
these tools are for very specific alarm types, others can be used for a broad range of alarms.

For details on the different tools, see:


Disturbance Direction

• Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

Load Impact

• Load Impact

• Viewing Load Impact

Timeline analysis

• Timeline analysis

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Timeline analysis UI

Voltage Tolerance

• Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

Waveforms

• Waveforms

• Viewing waveforms

• Waveforms UI

Time display
See Time Display in Web Applications for information on how time is displayed in a system where
the monitoring devices, the PME/Web server, and the Web client (browser) are in different time
zones.

Terminology
See Alarms terminology for definitions of the terms used in the Alarms application.

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1003


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing incidents
View incidents to investigate system issues, to analyze what happened during a power disturbance
or to identify root causes.
To view incidents:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing incident view from the view library or add a new View.

2. View the incident information displayed in the alarms display pane.


(Optional) In the view library, right-click the view name or click Options , and select Edit to
open the view settings. You can also open the view settings by double-clicking the view
name. Adjust the settings for View Type, Priority, State, Sources, and Categories to
customize the view if necessary. Save the modified view settings or click Cancel to discard
the changes.

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

1004 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1005


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing alarms
View Alarm Status to assess the state of the monitored power system and to respond to important
events and issues. View Alarm History for root cause analysis and to understand the sequence of
events.
To view Alarm Status or Alarm History:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing alarm status or alarm history view from the view library or
add a new View.

2. View the alarm information displayed in the alarms display pane.


(Optional) In the view library, right-click the view name or click Options , and select Edit to
open the view settings. You can also open the view settings by double-clicking the view
name. Adjust the settings for View Type, Priority, State, Sources, and Categories to
customize the view if necessary. Save the modified view settings or click Cancel to discard
the changes.

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

1006 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1007


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing events
View events to investigate system activities in PME or to troubleshoot unexpected system
behavior.
To view events:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing event view from the view library or add a new View.

2. View the event Information displayed in the alarms display pane.


(Optional) In the view Library, right-click the view name or click Options for this view and
select Edit to open the view settings. You can also open the view settings by double-clicking
the view name. Adjust the settings for View Type, Priority and Sources to customize the view
if necessary. Save the modified view settings or click Cancel to discard the changes.

TIP: Double-clicking an event in the events display table opens the associated alarm.

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

1008 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1009


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing Disturbance Direction


View Disturbance Direction to analyze the likely origin of voltage disturbance events in your power
system.

NOTE: Disturbance Direction analysis is only available for alarm instances and incidents, not for
alarm status. Also, the data associated with the alarm or incident must include disturbance
direction information.

To view Disturbance Direction:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing alarm history or incident history view from the view
library or add a new View.

TIP: Add a Disturbance Direction filter to your view to identify disturbance direction relevant
alarms and incidents. You can add this filter in View Settings > Categories > Power
Quality.

NOTE: The Disturbance Direction filter settings only apply to the following Power Quality
alarm or incident types: Interruption, Under Voltage, Over Voltage, Sag, Swell, Unclassified
Disturbance, Transient.

2. Find the alarm instance or Incident for which you want to view Disturbance Direction and click

Open Details to open the details window.

TIP: Alarms or incidents with Disturbance Direction information are tagged with an Upsteam
or Downstream indicator.

3. In the details window, view the Disturbance Direction information of the representative
disturbance for this alarm or incident.

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

1010 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1011


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing Load Impact


View Load Impact to identify changes in steady state electrical loads in your power system
triggered by a voltage disturbance.

NOTE: Load Impact analysis is only available for alarm instances and incidents, not for alarm
status. Also, the data associated with the alarm or incident must meet the prerequisites. See Load
Impact for more information.

To view Load Impact:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing alarm history or incident history view from the view
library or add a new View.

TIP: Add a Load Impact filter to your view to identify load impact relevant alarms and
incidents. You can add this filter in View Settings > Categories > Power Quality.

NOTE: The Load Impact filter settings only apply to the following Power Quality alarm or
incident types: Interruption, Under Voltage, Over Voltage, Sag, Swell, Unclassified
Disturbance, Transient.

2. Find the alarm instance or Incident for which you want to view Load Impact and click Open

Details to open the details window.

TIP: Alarms or incidents with Load Impact calculations are tagged with a Load Loss
or Load Gain label. You can enable or disable the display of
the label in Web Applications > Settings > Alarms > Alarm Views.

3. In the details window, view the Load Impact information related to this alarm or incident.

TIP: See Load Impact calculations for more details.

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

1012 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1013


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing a timeline analysis


View a timeline analysis to investigate the sequence of events that occurred during a single
incident, multiple incidents, or alarms.
To view a timeline analysis for an incident:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing incident view from the view library or add a new View.

2. Find the incident for which you want to view the analysis, and click Open Timeline Analysis

to open the timeline window.


(Optional) Edit the view settings for the timeline analysis and save the view for future
reference.

To view a timeline analysis for multiple incidents:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing Incident view from the view library or add a new View.

2. Find and select the incidents for which you want to view the analysis.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual alarms, use Shift+click to select a block of
alarms.

3. From the in the Options menu at the top of the alarms display pane, select Open
Timeline Analysis on selection.

To view a timeline analysis for an alarm:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing alarm history view from the view library or add a new
View.

2. Find the alarm for which you want to view the analysis and click Open Details.

3. In the alarm details window, click Timeline Analysis.

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

1014 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1015


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing Voltage Tolerance


View Voltage Tolerance to investigate the potential impact of a voltage disturbance on equipment.

NOTE: Voltage Tolerance analysis is only available for alarm instances and incidents, not for
alarm status. Also, the data associated with the alarm or incident must include voltage disturbance
measurements.

To view Voltage Tolerance:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing alarm history or incident history view from the view
library or add a new View.

TIP: Add a Voltage Tolerance filter to your view to identify alarms and incidents that fall into a
certain area of the ITIC/CBEMA curve. You can add this filter in View Settings >
Categories > Power Quality. See Voltage Tolerance for more information.

NOTE: The Voltage Tolerance filter settings only apply to the following Power Quality alarm
or incident types: Interruption, Under Voltage, Over Voltage, Sag, Swell, Unclassified
Disturbance, Transient.

2. Find the alarm instance or Incident for which you want to view Voltage Tolerance, and click

Open Details to open the details window.

3. In the details window, select Tolerance Chart in the display selector on left side of the
window.

For an alarm instance, a single voltage disturbance is displayed in the chart. For incidents, all
available voltage disturbances for the alarms that are part of the Incident are displayed.
Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

1016 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1017


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing waveforms
View waveforms to investigate power quality events and identify root causes of disturbances.
To view waveforms:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing Incident history view or alarm history view from the view
library or add a new View.

2. Find the incident or alarm for which you want to view waveforms and click Details . You
can also open Details by double-clicking the incident or alarm instance.

3. In Details, click Waveforms.

TIP: Click Open Representative Waveform to see the representative waveform for this
Incident or alarm instance.

4. View the waveforms associated with the incident or alarm instance.

(Optional) Click Inspect a waveform to see more details and to analyze the waveform.

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

1018 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1019


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Acknowledging alarms
Acknowledge alarms to show that these alarms are managed. Record relevant information related
to the alarms, as part of the acknowledgment, for future reference. There are many ways to
acknowledge alarms.

NOTE: You can acknowledge alarms in status views and history views. If you acknowledge
alarms through an incident history view, all alarms that are part of this incident will be
acknowledged. Whenever you acknowledge an alarm from any of these locations, you are
acknowledging the alarm definition itself, not an instance of it. That means acknowledging an
alarm marks it as Acknowledged and resets its Unacknowledged occurrence counter.

Acknowledging through an alarm status view


To acknowledge a single alarm:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing alarm status view from the view library or add a new
View.

2. In the alarms display pane, find the alarm definition you want to acknowledge.
(Optional) In the view library, right-click the view name or click Options , and select Edit to
open the view settings. You can also open the view settings by double-clicking the view
name. Adjust the settings for View Type, Priority, State, Sources, and Categories to
customize the view if necessary. Save the modified view settings or click Cancel to discard
the changes.

3. In the Acknowledgment column for this alarm definition, click Acknowledge. This opens the
Acknowledge Alarms window. You can also open the details for this alarm definition and click
Acknowledge in the details window to open Acknowledge Alarms.

4. In Acknowledge Alarms, click Acknowledge.


(Optional) In the Comment box, enter notes related to the alarm definition.

TIP: To later view the acknowledgment notes, open the alarm details and click History on
the top right. The acknowledgment with the note is shown in the alarm instance history
display.

To acknowledge multiple alarms:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing alarm status view from the view library or add a new
View.

2. In the alarms display pane, find and select the alarm definitions you want to acknowledge in
the alarms table.

TIP: Use Ctrl+Click to select individual alarms, use Shift+click to select a block of
alarms.

(Optional) In the view library, right-click the view name or click Options , and select Edit to
open the view settings. You can also open the view settings by double-clicking the view
name. Adjust the settings for View Type, Priority, State, Sources, and Categories to

1020 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

customize the view if necessary. Save the modified view settings or click Cancel to discard
the changes.

3. Click Options in the top right corner of the alarms pane, and then click Acknowledge
Selected in the options menu. This opens the Acknowledge Alarms window.

4. In Acknowledge Alarms, click Acknowledge.


(Optional) In the Comment box, enter notes related to the alarm definitions.

TIP: To later view the acknowledgment notes, open the alarm details, for any of the alarms,
and click History on the top right. The acknowledgment with the note is shown in the alarm
instance history display.

To acknowledge all alarms in a view:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing alarm status view from the view library or add a new
View.

2. Click Options in the top right corner of the alarms pane, and then click Acknowledge All
in the options menu. This opens the Acknowledge Alarms window.

3. In Acknowledge Alarms, click Acknowledge.


(Optional) In the Comment box, enter notes related to the alarm definitions.

TIP: To later view the acknowledgment notes, open the alarm details, for any of the alarms,
and click History on the top right. The acknowledgment with the note is shown in the alarm
instance history display.

Acknowledging through an alarm history view


To acknowledge an alarm:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing alarm history view from the view library or add a new
View.

2. In the alarms display pane, find the alarm you want to acknowledge.
(Optional) In the view library, right-click the view name or click Options , and select Edit to
open the view settings. You can also open the view settings by double-clicking the view
name. Adjust the settings for View Type, Priority, State, Sources, and Categories to
customize the view if necessary. Save the modified view settings or click Cancel to discard
the changes.

3. Open the details for this alarm by clicking on Open Details or double-clicking the alarm.

4. In Alarm Details, click Acknowledge. This opens the Acknowledge Alarms window.

5. In Acknowledge Alarms, click Acknowledge.


(Optional) In the Comment box, enter notes related to the alarm.

TIP: To later view the acknowledgment notes, open the alarm details and click History on
the top right. The acknowledgment with the note is shown in the alarm instance history
display.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1021


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Acknowledging through an incident history view


To acknowledge all alarms in an incident:

1. In the alarm viewer, open an existing incident history view from the view library or add a new
View.

2. In the alarms display pane, find the incident you want to acknowledge.
(Optional) In the view library, right-click the view name or click Options , and select Edit to
open the view settings. You can also open the view settings by double-clicking the view
name. Adjust the settings for View Type, Priority, State, Sources, and Categories to
customize the view if necessary. Save the modified view settings or click Cancel to discard
the changes.

3. Open the details for this incident by clicking on Open Details or double-clicking the incident.

4. In Incident Details, click Acknowledge. This opens the Acknowledge Alarms window.

5. In Acknowledge Alarms, click Acknowledge.


(Optional) In the Comment box, enter notes related to the alarms.

TIP: To later view the acknowledgment notes, open the alarm details, for any of the alarms,
and click History on the top right. The acknowledgment with the note is shown in the alarm
instance history display.

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

1022 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1023


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Incidents
Incidents in PME represent real world power events, such as disturbances or faults. An incident
combines alarms, waveforms, and burst data from many sources in the system into a single
representation of the power event. Instead of having to analyze each data point individually, you can
look at an incident and see how the different pieces of information are linked together.

PME uses alarm types and alarm start times as criteria to determine which alarms to group into a
specific incident. The start of an alarm marks the beginning of an incident. Any alarm of a similar
type, that starts within a certain time interval is considered part this same incident. The grouping
time interval is always based on the most recent alarm in the incident, which means that the counter
is restarted every time a new alarm is added to the incident. If there is no more alarm that falls inside
the interval, the incident is complete. The maximum duration for an incident is 24 hours and the
maximum number of alarms in an incident is 500. A new incident is started the next time an alarm is
recorded. See Alarm to incident mapping for more information.

The incident grouping time interval is different for different alarm types. For example, Over Voltage
alarms have a time interval of 5 minutes. If a new Over Voltage alarm occurs within 5 minutes, for
any source, it is grouped into the same incident. To make it easier to analyze incidents, PME
categorizes them into types. The incident types are based on the alarm types.

The following table shows the Incident types and the grouping time intervals for each type:

Category Type Grouping Time Interval


Flicker 5 minutes
Frequency Variation 5 minutes
Harmonics 5 minutes
Interruption 5 minutes *
Over Voltage 5 minutes *
Power Quality Sag 20 seconds *
Swell 20 seconds *
Transient 20 seconds *
Unbalance 5 minutes
Unclassified Disturbance 20 seconds *
Under Voltage 5 minutes *
Arc Flash 60 seconds
Backup Power 80 minutes
Asset Monitoring Current Monitor 5 minutes
Protection 5 minutes
Thermal Monitor 30 minutes
Air 5 minutes
Demand 5 minutes
Electricity 5 minutes
Energy Management Gas 5 minutes
Power Factor 5 minutes
Steam 5 minutes
Water 5 minutes

1024 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Category Type Grouping Time Interval


Clutter 1 day
General
General Setpoints 5 minutes
Communication Status 10 minutes
Diagnostics Device Status 5 minutes
System Status 0 seconds (one incident per alarm)

* These grouping intervals time settings are default settings. The defaults are extended
automatically to include power quality alarms that are outside the interval but close enough that they
could be related to the incident.
Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1025


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Alarms
An alarm is a defined condition for a source in PME. The software or the device monitors this
condition and records when the condition is met and when not. For example, you can define an Over
Voltage alarm for a certain monitoring device in the system. When the voltage threshold is
exceeded on this device, the alarm goes active. When the voltage drops below the threshold, the
alarm goes inactive. The next time the voltage on this device goes above the threshold again, the
same alarm goes active again. An alarm is always associated with a single source and a single
measurement.

Some alarms are based on instantaneous events such as a voltage transient, others are based on a
condition that lasts a certain period of time such as an over voltage condition. For lasting conditions,
the alarm goes from an inactive state to an active state while the condition lasts and then back to an
inactive state when the condition is over. Instantaneous alarms are always shown in an inactive
state.

The following diagram shows an alarm that is based on a lasting condition. The alarm goes active at
the time T1 and inactive at T2. The time interval between T1 and T2 can be short or long.

0 = inactive alarm state; 1 = active alarm state; T = time

T1 = Alarm goes active

T2 = Alarm goes inactive

The following diagram shows an instantaneous alarm. For this alarm, the start time T1 and end time
T2 are identical.

0 = inactive alarm state, 1 = active alarm state; T = time

T1/2 = Alarm goes active and immediately inactive again

1026 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

After an alarm has gone active, it can be acknowledged in the alarm viewer. When you
acknowledge an alarm, the date and time of the acknowledgment is recorded together with an
optional note that you can enter in the acknowledge window.

An alarm stays unacknowledged until you acknowledge it. After you have acknowledged an alarm,
it stays acknowledged until the next time it goes active. At that point it is reset to unacknowledged
and is waiting for you to acknowledge it again.

PME counts the number of times an alarm goes through an inactive to active state transition. The
number of these transitions is displayed as Occurrences in the alarm viewer in the alarm status
view. There are two counters for each alarm. One counter for the total number of occurrences, and
one for occurrences since the alarm was last acknowledged.

The time period during which an alarm is active, starting when it goes active, ending when it goes
inactive, is called an alarm instance.

Alarm conditions are defined either as software alarms in the Software Alarms tool, or as device-
based alarms in the monitoring devices, using the appropriate device configuration tool.

To make it easier to analyze alarms, PME categorizes them into types and combines alarms of
similar types into incidents, based on the alarm start times.

The following table shows the different alarm categories and types in PME:

Category Type
Flicker
Frequency Variation
Harmonics
Harmonics (Current)
Harmonics (Power)
Harmonics (Voltage)
Interruption
Over Voltage
Power Quality
Sag (Voltage)
Swell (Voltage)
Transient
Unbalance
Unbalance (Current)
Unbalance (Voltage)
Unclassified Disturbance
Under Voltage
Arc Flash
Backup Power
Over Current
Protection
Asset Monitoring
Sag (Current)
Swell (Current)
Thermal Monitor
Under Current

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1027


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Category Type
Air
Demand
Electricity
Energy Management Gas
Power Factor
Steam
Water
General Event
General General Setpoint
Unassociated Dropout
Clock / Time
Communication Status
Diagnostics Device Settings
Device Status
System Status

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

1028 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1029


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Events
An event is a record of an activity or a condition that is logged in PME. Events are generated by
users, the system software, or the connected devices. Examples of events include resetting a
measurement, logging into PME, making a configuration change in a device, or a setpoint going
active on a device. Some of these events are logged automatically, for others logging must be setup
manually. Each event record that is logged has a timestamp and several fields that describe the
activity. Each event record describes one single activity or condition, for example, a setpoint going
active in a monitoring device.

Events are logged and displayed as they happen in the system without any processing or
aggregation. For example, an Over Voltage setpoint going active and then inactive in a device will
cause 3 events to be logged, one for the pickup, one for the dropout, and one for the extreme voltage
value measured during the time the setpoint was active.
Here is an example of the event records for an over voltage setpoint:

Source Timestamp Event Condition Measurement Value Type


8/10/2017 Over Voltage
My.Device ON 145.740 Pick up
1:44:53.000 PM Voltage Phase A
8/10/2017 Over Voltage
My.Device Extreme 145.740 Instantaneous
1:44:53.000 PM Voltage Phase A
8/10/2017 Over Voltage
My.Device OFF 125.230 Drop out
1:45:39.000 PM Voltage Phase A

PME uses event records to determine alarm types and states.


Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

1030 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1031


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Disturbance Direction
Disturbance Direction identifies the origin of a voltage disturbance (sag/swell/transient).

Disturbance direction calculations are done by the monitoring devices. A device determines the
direction of the origin of a disturbance as either Upstream or Downstream from the device location.
It is possible to identify the likely origin of a disturbance within a power system by combining the
direction information from multiple devices in the network. For alarms, the disturbance direction
shown in the software is the direction determined by the device that is associated with the alarm.
For incidents, it is the direction determined by the representative device for the incident.

Use Disturbance Direction to analyze the likely origin of voltage disturbance events in your power
system.

Prerequisites
The monitoring devices must be capable of detecting and logging the disturbance direction.
Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

1032 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1033


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Load Impact
Load Impact identifies changes in the steady state electrical loads of a power system triggered by a
voltage disturbance, such as a voltage sag or interruption.

Loads can be affected by voltage disturbances in different ways. Some loads might shut down and
not automatically restart after the disturbance. Other loads might experience changes in their
operational state and draw more or less power. It is even possible that the power flow reverses, for
example if backup power generation is triggered by the disturbance.

Use Load Impact analysis to identify changes in steady state electrical loads in your power system
triggered by a voltage disturbance.

NOTE: Load Impact identifies changes in loads that persist after the disturbance. It does not
identify changes in loads during the disturbance event.

See Load Impact calculations for more details.

Prerequisites
Load Impact calculations are only available for data captured by the following monitoring device
types:

• ION 9000 (all firmware versions)

• ION 8800 (all firmware versions)

• ION 8650 (all firmware versions)

• ION 7650 (all firmware versions)

• ION 7550 (all firmware versions)

• ION 7400 (all firmware versions)

• PM8000 (all firmware versions)

• ACCESS 9510 (all firmware versions)

• ACCESS 9610 (all firmware versions)

• 9410 (all firmware versions)

• 9810 (all firmware versions)

The monitoring devices must be configured to record the following data:

• Sag/swell and transient event data

• Current and voltage waveforms, for each phase, for the voltage disturbance events.

NOTE: Load Impact calculations are done automatically by the software for any applicable alarm
or incident. No special configuration is required.

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

1034 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1035


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Timeline analysis
Timeline analysis is a sequence of event analysis for items that are associated with one or more
incidents or alarms. The items are shown on a timeline, in chronological order. Items include alarms,
waveforms and burst data recordings. The tools available in timeline analysis allow you to add or
remove items from the timeline, add notes, zoom in or out, and include alarms previously not
associated with this incident. You can save a timeline analysis as new view in the view library for
future reference.

Use timeline analysis to investigate the sequence of events during an alarm or incident. See
Timeline analysis UI for more information.

Prerequisites
None. Any incident can be displayed using timeline analysis.

NOTE: Alarms and data measurements during an incident occur in very short time intervals. To
show the correct sequence of events in the timeline analysis, the timestamps must be accurate.
Consider using monitoring devices with Precision Time Protocol (PTP) or GPS time
synchronization for accurate time stamping.

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline Analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

1036 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1037


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Voltage Tolerance
Voltage Tolerance is available in PME as an analysis tool and as a filter for alarm history and
Incident history views.

Analysis tool
Voltage Tolerance uses a graphical display of the magnitude and duration of a voltage disturbance
to analyze potential impacts of the event on equipment. The voltage magnitude during the
disturbance and the duration of the event are plotted in a Cartesian coordinate system. A voltage
susceptibility curve is overlaid to show how the disturbance compares to established equipment
tolerances. You can plot multiple disturbances in the same chart. The tool provides two
susceptibility curves, ITIC/CBEMA (for information technology equipment) and SEMI F47-0706 (for
semiconductor processing equipment).

Use Voltage Tolerance analysis to investigate potential impacts of a voltage disturbance on the
equipment in your facility.

Prerequisites
The monitoring device data associated with the alarm or incident must include sag, swell, or
transient voltage disturbance measurements.
Examples:
ITIC/CBEMA

SEMI F47-0706

1038 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

View filter

Use the Voltage Tolerance filter to create alarm history or incident history views that select alarms
and incidents based on specific voltage disturbance characteristics. For example, you could define
a view that only includes alarms or incidents with voltage sags of a magnitude between 70 - 90% of
nominal voltage, and a duration of 0.1 - 2 seconds.

NOTE: You can add this filter in View Settings > Categories > Power Quality.

NOTE: The Voltage Tolerance filter settings only apply to the following Power Quality Incident
types: Interruption, Under Voltage, Over Voltage, Sag, Swell, Unclassified Disturbance,
Transient.

Example:

NOTE: The Voltage Tolerance view filter only supports the ITIC/CBEMA voltage susceptibility
curve.

Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1039


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

1040 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Waveforms
Waveforms are graphical representations of voltage and current that show their variations over time.
The waveform displays in PME are based on logged, historical measurements that were recorded
by a monitoring device. The measurements recorded by a device for a waveform capture are called
samples and the speed with which these samples are taken is called sampling rate. The higher the
sampling rate, the more accurately the waveform capture represents the actual voltage or current
waveform. Captures taken by different device types can have different sampling rates, depending
on the capabilities and settings of the device.

Use Waveforms to analyze power quality events by viewing the individual wave shapes, the
magnitudes, the phase angles between voltage and current, and the timing of wave shape
variations. Waveform data is also used to show voltage and current phasors and the individual
harmonic components.

Prerequisites
The monitoring device data associated with the alarm or incident must include waveform captures.
Related topics:

• Viewing incidents

• Viewing alarms

• Viewing events

• Viewing Disturbance Direction

• Viewing Load Impact

• Viewing a timeline analysis

• Viewing Voltage Tolerance

• Viewing waveforms

• Acknowledging alarms

For reference information see:

• Alarms

• Incidents

• Alarms

• Events

• Disturbance Direction

• Load Impact

• Timeline analysis

• Voltage Tolerance

• Waveforms

• Alarms terminology

• Alarms UI

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1041


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Timeline analysis UI

• Waveforms UI

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Alarms configuration.

1042 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Dashboards

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Use the Dashboards application to view high level historical and real-time data, for example Key
Performance Indicators (KPIs). The information in the Dashboards application is accessed through
dashboards with gadgets. Dashboards are saved in the Dashboard Library. In addition to viewing
individual dashboards, you can create slideshows to automatically display a sequence of
dashboards.

TIP: You can open the Dashboards application from the Dashboards link in the Web Applications
banner.

Time display
See Time Display in Web Applications for information on how time is displayed in a system where
the monitoring devices, the PME/Web server, and the Web client (browser) are in different time
zones.
For information on how use the Dashboards application, see:

• Viewing Dashboards

• Dashboard Slideshows

• Playing a Slideshow

• Gadgets

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to configure Dashboards, see Dashboards configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1043


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing Dashboards
View Dashboards to monitor key performance indicators, historical trends, and other high-level
information for the monitored power system. Dashboards are one of the main applications for
viewing power system information.
To view a Dashboard:

1. In Dashboards, open an existing Dashboard from the Dashboard Library or add a new
Dashboard.

2. View the Dashboard Gadgets displayed in the Dashboards display pane.

Related topics:

• Viewing Dashboards

• Dashboard Slideshows

• Playing a Slideshow

• Gadgets

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to configure Dashboards, see Dashboards configuration.

1044 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Dashboard Slideshows
Use slideshows to create collections of dashboards that are displayed in sequence without user
interaction. A slideshow displays each of its dashboards for a short period of time and then displays
the next dashboard. When it reaches the end, it starts over again with the first dashboard. It
continuously cycles through all its dashboards in this way. Slideshows are a good option for
unattended, kiosk type displays. See Configuring a slideshow for more details.
Related topics:

• Viewing Dashboards

• Dashboard Slideshows

• Playing a Slideshow

• Gadgets

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to configure Dashboards, see Dashboards configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1045


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Playing a Slideshow
Slideshows are a good option for unattended, kiosk type displays.

NOTE: Anyone with access to the PME web server can view a slideshow using the slideshow
URL. No user authentication is required, except when using a Table gadget (See Using Table
gadget in Slideshow for more information). Restrict network access and access to the URL to
authorized users for slideshows containing confidential information.

NOTE: If you create a Dashboard that contains multiple gadgets, use the scroll bar to view all the
gadgets. But, if you use this Dashboard in a Slideshow, you do not have access to scroll bar to
view all the gadgets. It is recommended that you consider this condition when choosing which
Dashboard to include in a Slideshow.

To play a Slideshow:

1. In Dashboards, open the Dashboards Library, and click Slideshow Manager in the Options
menu at the top of the Dashboard Library. This opens the Slideshow Manager window.

2. In Slideshow Manager, select the slideshow you want to view, and click Play. This opens a
new browser window, playing the slideshow.

3. Return to the original browser window and click Close in the Slideshow Manager to close it.
The slideshow continues to play in the new browser window until you close that window.

Related topics:

• Viewing Dashboards

• Dashboard Slideshows

• Playing a Slideshow

• Gadgets

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

• Using Table gadget in Slideshow

For information on how to configure Dashboards, see Dashboards configuration.

1046 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Gadgets
Gadgets are graphical display objects used in the dashboard display pane for charting trends over
time, or in comparison with correlated measurements or similar functionality. The gadgets available
for a dashboard are listed in the Gadget Setup dialog, which opens when you click Add Gadget in
the Dashboard Controls area.

TIP: When the gadget is displayed in the dashboard, you can click an item in the gadget legend to
toggle the graphical display of data for that item on and off. When you place the pointer on an item
in the gadget, a tooltip provides information related to that item. You can also click the maximize
gadget icon to fill the browser page with the gadget. Click the Restore icon to return the
gadget to its original size on the dashboard.

Use the following links to jump to the descriptions of the different gadget types:

Bar Chart Power Quality


Energy Equivalency Sankey
Table Pareto Chart
Period over Period Aggregated Pareto Chart
Pie Chart Heat Map
Trend Chart Consumption Ranking
Web Viewer Aggregated Consumption Ranking

Related topics:

• Viewing Dashboards

• Dashboard Slideshows

• Playing a Slideshow

• Gadgets

For reference information see:

• Dashboards user interface (UI)

For information on how to configure Dashboards, see Dashboards configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1047


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Bar Chart gadget


This gadget shows a comparison of several data series, over a selected time period. The
information is shown as horizontal bars.
Example:

TIP: Place your pointer on a bar in the chart to open a tooltip showing the measurement value.
Click a series in the legend to hide or show this series in the chart.

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

1048 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Energy Equivalency gadget


This gadget shows a single value that is equivalent to the aggregated consumption input data, over
a selected time period. The value can be scaled to represent a consumption equivalent
measurement, such as CO2 emissions or primary energy units. The information is shown as a
numeric value with unit, a custom text, and a custom graphic.
Example:

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1049


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Table gadget
This gadget shows real-time data from devices in the system. The information is shown in table
format.
Example:

TIP: The measurements can be arranged in rows or in columns. The real-time data aggregation
can be defined and data values can be highlighted for the defined threshold.

NOTE: User authentication is required if the table gadget is used in the slideshow. See Using
Table gadget in Slideshow for more information.

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

1050 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Period Over Period gadget


This gadget shows consumption data for the same measurement for two different viewing periods
side-by-side. The information is shown in a column chart.
Example:

TIP: Place your pointer on a column in the chart to open a tooltip showing the measurement value.
Click a series in the legend to hide or show this series in the chart.

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1051


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Pie Chart gadget


This gadget shows a comparison of several data series in a single chart, over a selected time
period. The information is shown in a pie chart, as a percentage distribution of the different data
series.
Example:

TIP: Place your pointer on a section in the chart to open a tooltip showing the measurement value.
Click a section in the pie to separate it from the pie. Click a series in the legend to hide or show this
series in the chart.

For information about configuring Power Quality gadgets, see Configuring Gadgets.

1052 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Trend Chart gadget


This gadget shows consumption data, over a selected time period. The information is shown in a
combined column and line chart. You can include one or more data series in a single chart. You can
select how to display the data for both the primary and secondary axes.
Example:

TIP: Place your pointer on a column in the chart to open a tooltip showing the measurement value.
Click a series in the legend to hide or show this series in the chart.

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1053


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Web Viewer gadget


This gadget shows a web page inside the gadget frame in the dashboard.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

NOTE: When you configure the Web Viewer gadget to access a website, you should be careful
that the website does not include hidden malware, viruses, or content that could compromise your
web client computers. It is recommended that the target site specified in the gadget be secured
with the SSL or TLS protocol (accessed via HTTPS).

Example:

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

1054 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Power Quality gadgets

NOTE: These gadgets are part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

See Power Quality Performance events and disturbances, in the Reference section of this
document, for a definition of power quality events.
Use the following links to jump to the descriptions of the different Power Quality gadget types:

Power Factor Impact Power Quality Impact


Power Factor Impact Trend Power Quality Impact Trend
Power Quality Incident Breakdown Power Quality Rating
Power Quality Incident Impact Power Quality Rating Trend
Power Quality Incident Location

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1055


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Factor Impact gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows the power factor and the estimated power factor surcharge, based on the billing
rate, over a selected time period. The information is shown as a graphic display of the power factor
and the estimated surcharge.
Example:

For information about configuring Power Quality gadgets, see Configuring Gadgets.

1056 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Power Factor Impact Trend gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows the estimated power factor surcharge, based on the billing rate, over a selected
time period. The information is shown in a column chart, grouped by aggregation period.
Example:

TIP: Place your pointer on a column in the chart to open a tooltip showing the estimated surcharge.

For information about configuring Power Quality gadgets, see Configuring Gadgets.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1057


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Quality Incident Breakdown gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows a breakdown of the power quality events, by type, over a selected time period.
The information is shown in a pie chart, as a percentage distribution of the events.
Example:

NOTE: The colors in the chart are shown dimmed if the events had no expected impact. The
colors in the chart are shown solid if one or more events had an expected impact.

TIP: Place your pointer on a section in the chart to open a tooltip showing the number of events in
each category. Click a section to separate it from the pie.

For information about configuring Power Quality gadgets, see Configuring Gadgets.

1058 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Power Quality Incident Impact gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows the number of power quality events, over a period of time, that might have had a
process impact, compared to those that most likely did not have an impact. It is a simplified
representation of the CBEMA/ITIC curve in a pie chart format. Events that are inside the curve are
shown as “no impact events” and those outside the curve are shown as “likely impact events”.
Example:

NOTE: The colors in the chart are shown dimmed if the events had no expected impact. The
colors in the chart are shown solid if one or more events had an expected impact.

TIP: Place your pointer on a section in the chart to open a tooltip showing the number of events in
each category. Click a section to separate it from the pie.

For information about configuring Power Quality gadgets, see Configuring Gadgets.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1059


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Quality Incident Location gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows the number of power quality events, over a selected time period, grouped by
location of origin (external, internal, undetermined). In addition, it indicates whether the events had a
likely process impact or not. The information is shown in a column chart, grouped by impact
assessment.
Example:

TIP: Place your pointer on a column in the chart to open a tooltip showing the number of events
and their likely process impact.

For information about configuring Power Quality gadgets, see Configuring Gadgets.

1060 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Power Quality Impact gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows the cost of power quality events with a process impact, over a selected time
period. The information is shown in a column chart, grouped by location of power quality event origin
(external, internal, undetermined).
Example:

TIP: Place your pointer on a column in the chart to open a tooltip showing the event duration.

For information about configuring Power Quality gadgets, see Configuring Gadgets.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1061


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Quality Impact Trend gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows the aggregated cost of power quality events with a process impact, over a
selected time period. The information is shown in a stacked column chart, grouped by aggregation
period. The location of power quality event origin (external, internal, undetermined) is shown by the
color of the columns.
Example:

TIP: Place your pointer on a column in the chart to open a tooltip showing the event origin, cost,
and duration. Click a series in the legend to hide or show this series in the chart.

For information about configuring Power Quality gadgets, see Configuring Gadgets.

1062 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Power Quality Rating gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows a power quality rating in the form of a letter grade (A to F). The rating is a
summary of multiple types of power quality disturbances. The information is shown as a graphic
display of the letter grade, with a % power quality rating and a list of the main contributing
disturbances.

The following formula is used to calculate the power quality rating:

Where:

• PQ.Indicators.Value is a number indicating each power quality indicator status (green = 2,


yellow= 1, red = 0).

• PQ.Indicators.MaxValue = 2 for each individual indicator.

• Weight Factor is an adjustable value (default=1) for assigning different weight to each individual
indicator as per user’s needs.

The power quality rating is mapped to the letter grades in the following way:

• PQ.Rating >= 95% à "A"

• PQ.Rating >= 85% à "B"

• PQ.Rating >= 75% à "C"

• PQ.Rating >= 65% à "D"

• PQ.Rating >= 55% à "E"

• PQ.Rating >= 0% à "F"

With 0% = worst power quality and 100% = optimal power quality.

NOTE: The ratings are based on established thresholds and limits defined in IEEE519, IEC 61000-
4-30, EN50160, and IEEE1159 standards.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1063


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

For information about configuring Power Quality gadgets, see Configuring Gadgets.

1064 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Power Quality Rating Trend gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows the power quality rating, over a selected time period. The information is shown in
a column chart, grouped by aggregation period.
Example:

TIP: Place your pointer on a column in the chart to open a tooltip showing the date and the power
quality rating.

For information about configuring Power Quality gadgets, see Configuring Gadgets.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1065


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Sankey gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Energy Analysis Dashboards Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows a flow diagram, in which the width of the arrows is proportional to the data
values. The diagram starts as a combined flow for all the selected consumers, and then breaks out
into individual flows for each consumer.

Use this gadget to show WAGES consumption broken down by load type, or to visualize
consumption costs by consumer. You can also use it to show power losses.

NOTE: The Sankey gadget must be used with hierarchy data. The Sankey gadget automatically
removes nodes with missing data from the display. A message is displayed in the chart if a node is
removed.

TIP: This gadget supports printing its complete data set and exporting its complete data set in
PNG, JPG, SVG, CSV, and HTML format directly from the Web browser. To export the data,

hover the mouse pointer over the download icon in the gadget and select Print or the desired
format from the pop-up menu.

Example:

TIP: Drag individual nodes horizontally or vertically in the chart for a better view.

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

1066 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Pareto Chart gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Energy Analysis Dashboards Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows consumption data, by consumer, for multiple consumers, over a selected time
period. The information is shown in a combined column and line chart. The columns are arranged
from highest consumption to lowest consumption. The chart includes a cumulative curve based on
the aggregation period consumption values. The chart also contains a configurable marker line
which is used as a target or threshold indicator.

Use this gadget to perform an 80/20 analysis, identifying those consumers that together make up
the largest portion, or 80% of the overall consumption.

TIP: This gadget supports printing its complete data set and exporting its complete data set in
PNG, JPG, SVG, CSV, and HTML format directly from the Web browser. To export the data,

hover the mouse pointer over the download icon in the gadget and select Print or the desired
format from the pop-up menu.

Example:

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1067


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Aggregated Pareto Chart gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Energy Analysis Dashboards Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows consumption data for multiple consumers, over a selected time period. The
information is shown in a combined column and line chart, grouped by aggregation period. The
columns are arranged from highest consumption to lowest consumption. The chart includes a
cumulative curve based on the aggregation period consumption values. The chart also contains a
configurable marker line which is used as a target or threshold indicator.

Use this gadget to perform an 80/20 analysis, identifying those aggregation intervals and
consumers that together make up the largest portion, or 80% of the overall consumption.

TIP: This gadget supports printing its complete data set and exporting its complete data set in
PNG, JPG, SVG, CSV, and HTML format directly from the Web browser. To export the data,

hover the mouse pointer over the download icon in the gadget and select Print or the desired
format from the pop-up menu.

Example:

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

1068 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Heat Map gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Energy Analysis Dashboards Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget creates a graphical representation of your data where the individual values are
represented as colors in a matrix format. The graphical display makes it easy to identify patterns in
complex data sets.

Use this gadget with consumption data to identify usage patterns and anomalies.

TIP: This gadget supports printing its complete data set and exporting its complete data set in
PNG, JPG, SVG, CSV, and HTML format directly from the Web browser. To export the data,

hover the mouse pointer over the download icon in the gadget and select Print or the desired
format from the pop-up menu.

Example:

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1069


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Consumption Ranking gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Energy Analysis Dashboards Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows consumption data, by consumer, for multiple consumers, over a selected time
period. The information is shown side-by-side in a column or bar chart and a doughnut chart. The
columns or bars are arranged in order of consumption. The chart includes the aggregated total
consumption.

Use this gadget to compare the consumption of different consumers over a period of time.

TIP: This gadget supports printing its complete data set and exporting its complete data set in
PNG, JPG, SVG, CSV, and HTML format directly from the Web browser. To export the data,

hover the mouse pointer over the download icon in the gadget and select Print or the desired
format from the pop-up menu.

Example:

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

1070 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Aggregated Consumption Ranking gadget

NOTE: This gadget is part of the Energy Analysis Dashboards Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

This gadget shows consumption data for multiple consumers, by aggregation period, over a
selected time period. The information is shown side-by-side in a column or bar chart and a doughnut
chart. The columns or bars are arranged in order of the aggregated consumption. The chart includes
the aggregated total consumption.

Use this gadget to compare the consumption of consumers during specific time intervals, for
example by hour, by day of week, or by day.

TIP: This gadget supports printing its complete data set and exporting its complete data set in
PNG, JPG, SVG, CSV, and HTML format directly from the Web browser. To export the data,

hover the mouse pointer over the download icon in the gadget and select Print or the desired
format from the pop-up menu.

Example:

For information about configuring the gadget, see Configuring Gadgets.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1071


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Diagrams

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

TIP: You can open the Diagrams application from the DIAGRAMS link in the Web Applications
banner.

Use the Diagrams application to view Vista diagrams in the Web Applications interface. You can
view the network diagram and any custom diagrams created in Vista. In addition, the Diagrams
application provides a Devices diagrams view with device type specific diagrams for each device
that is configured in the system. Objects that can be displayed in the browser include real-time
numeric data, full or partial gauges, background graphics or diagrams, and basic views of event,
data and waveform logs.

You can also perform manual control actions such as resetting values on devices or changing
device configuration settings.

NOTE: See Time Display in Web Applications for information on how time is displayed in a
system where the monitoring devices, the PME/Web server, and the Web client (browser) are in
different time zones.

For information on how use the Diagrams application, see:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

1072 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1073


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The Diagrams user interface


The Diagrams user interface consists of a diagram display pane and a Diagram Library pane.

Diagrams display pane


The diagram display pane shows the diagram selected in the Diagram Library. The system
administrator can set a system default diagram that users see when they first log in.

Diagram Library
The Diagram Library contains all the diagrams that are configured in the system. Diagrams can be
listed individually, or they can be organized within folders. The Devices diagram folder is a system
folder that is automatically generated. It cannot be edited or deleted. You use the Diagram Library to
select the diagram you want to view.

TIP: To hide the library, click the Hide Library icon ( or ) in the top right corner of the library.

To show the library, click the Show Library icon ( or ) at the top of the library ribbon, or click
anywhere in the minimized library ribbon.

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

1074 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

User authentication
If you access Diagrams through the Web Applications framework, you are automatically
authenticated, using the Web Applications login.

If you access Diagrams from outside the Web Applications framework, through a browser using the
URL http://server_name/ion (where server_name is the fully-qualified name of the server
or its IP address), you are prompted to log in using your Power Monitoring Expert user name and
password.
Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1075


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing historical (trend) data


The Diagrams application provides a Web-based graphing utility for viewing historical data in the
diagrams. This utility allows you to select the date range and the data that you want to view.

1. Click the meter icon to open its diagram, then click the link or tab that contains the button for
the trending information you want to view.

2. Click the Data Log Viewer button that corresponds to the data log you want to view.

The data log table displays today's data by default.

When the data log table opens, 30 rows of data are displayed initially. As you scroll or page
down, 30 additional rows of data at a time are added to the table.

3. Click Change Date Range to change the timeframe for the data and select one of the
available options for the data that you want to view. To specify a custom date range, select
Between these dates then click the calendar icons to set start and end dates.

The new date range is applied when you view the graph. Click Show Table to return to the
data log table. (When you return to the data log table, your previous table header selections are
cleared.)

If you select a custom date range, a maximum of 6000 rows of data are displayed initially. If
the custom date range includes more than 6000 rows of data, you can display the additional
records in increments of 30 rows at a time by scrolling down or pressing End.

4. Select the check boxes for the items in the table header for the parameters that you want to
graph.

5. Click Show Graph.

6. Manipulate and control the displayed graph by doing the following:


a. To zoom in on the graph, left click and drag the mouse pointer around the portion you want
to zoom in on.

b. To restore the graph to its original display size, double-click anywhere in the graph.

7. Click:
a. Device Diagram to return to that page.

b. Change Date Range to select a different date range for the data log table. The new date
range is applied when you view the graph.

c. Show Table to return to the data log table. (When you return to the data log table, your
previous table header selections are cleared.)

RMS waveform plotting


The Diagrams application plots the calculated root mean square (RMS) values for waveforms.
Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

1076 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1077


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Viewing meter events


You can view meter events in the diagrams, in a table format, using the Diagrams application.

NOTE: You cannot acknowledge alarms on the screens generated by the Diagrams application
since control functions are not supported. To acknowledge alarms, click the ALARMS icon in the
Web Applications component to open the Alarm Viewer.

Viewing the meter events


1. Click the meter icon to open its diagram, then click the link or tab that contains the Meter
events button.

2. Click the Meter events button to open a table showing the meter events.

The meter events table displays today's data by default.

When the meter events table opens, 30 rows of data are displayed initially. As you scroll or
page down, 30 additional rows of data at a time are added to the table.

3. Click Change Date Range to change the timeframe for the data and select one of the
available options for the data that you want to view. To specify a custom date range, select
Between these dates then click the calendar icons to set a start and end date.

If you select a custom date range, a maximum of 6000 rows of data are displayed. If the
custom date range includes more than 6000 rows of data, you can display the additional
records in increments of 30 rows at a time by scrolling down or pressing End.

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

1078 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Viewing user diagram of devices with security


You can view the user diagram of devices with security settings enabled in Diagrams application.

To view user diagram of the devices with standard security enabled:

1. Log in to Web Applications with username and password.

2. Navigate to Diagrams link.

The network diagram appears in the workspace containing icons that represent groups of
devices on your system.

3. Click Network Diagram.

4. Click one of the grouping objects and display the node icons contained within.

5. Click a node icon to display the user diagram for the associated device.

NOTE: To perform any control object function, enter the device password. The username is set to
default. See Performing manual control actions for more information. If username is prompted
when performing any control object function, see Changes in security settings of device for more
information.

NOTE: You cannot view device data in the user diagram in Diagrams for devices with advanced
security enabled. Control object functions for advanced security enabled devices are not
supported in Diagrams.

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1079


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Performing manual control actions

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

You can use Diagrams to perform manual control actions on devices. Manual control actions
include actions such as resetting values on devices or changing device configuration settings.

For you to be able to perform control actions, the following must be true:

• Control in Diagrams must be enabled. See Set Diagrams control options for information on how
to enable control.

• Your Web Applications client (= web browser) must use an HTTPS connection to the PME
server.

• Your user access level must be at the level required by the control object, or higher. See
Controlling system functions in Vista for information on control object configuration.

• The device you are trying to control does not use Advanced meter security. Control in Diagrams
does not support Advanced security on devices.

To perform a control action:

1. Open the diagram for the device you want to control in Diagrams.

2. Click on the control object you want to trigger or change. This opens a confirmation dialog.

3. Provide any information requested by the confirmation dialog.

4. Click OK in the confirmation dialog.

NOTE: There can be a time delay until Diagrams displays a new control value or state after it has
been written to the device.

TIP: Control actions in Diagrams are recorded in the PME system log. Use Log Viewer to see
system log entries.

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

1080 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1081


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Stale data and error indicators


The Diagrams application uses the Vista stale data settings for its diagrams. Stale data and errors
are displayed in the browser as follows:

• A yellow border surrounding an object indicates stale data.

• An orange border surrounding an object indicates an error in communications, security access,


configuration, or other system error.

NOTE: See the "Identifying Stale Data" topic in the Vista section of the online Power Monitoring
Expert Help for information on stale data. Although you can change the stale data and error flag
colors in Vista , the color indicators for these flags do not change in the Diagrams application.

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

1082 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Power Quality Performance diagrams


NOTE: These diagrams are part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license. The module must be configured before the diagrams can be used.

Power Quality Performance diagrams provide an overview of the power quality of your system. Two
sets of Vista diagrams are available; indicator diagrams and equipment diagrams:

• Indicator diagrams present an aggregated and simplified view of historical power quality data.

• Equipment diagrams provide a real-time summary of the operational status of the corrective
equipment installed in support of your system.

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

NOTE: See Power Quality Performance events and disturbances, in the Reference section of this
document, for a definition of power quality events.

For details on the diagrams, see:

• Power Quality Performance Indicator diagrams

• Power Quality Performance Equipment diagrams

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1083


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

1084 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Power Quality Performance Indicator diagrams


Overview
The Power Quality Indicator diagrams show several power quality indicators. Each indicator
represents a different type of power quality event or disturbance. The indicators are color coded and
provide more detailed information when clicked.

Diagrams
Power Quality Performance Indicator diagram is organized into 3 levels and a setup page:

1. Landing page

2. Details pages

3. Information pages

4. Setup page

1. Landing page

This page shows a high-level power quality summary. The landing page first opens to the LAST 7
DAYS viewing period. The other time periods are LAST 24 HOURS, LAST 30 DAYS, and LAST 12
MONTHS.

The indicators on the page are color-coded based on the state of the specific power quality item.
The color classifications are defined by configurable limits, set for each item. The color coding
indicates how well your system performed, with regards to power quality, over a certain period of
time:

• Green means there are no power quality issues.

• Yellow means there are a few power quality issues, which might be investigated.

• Red means there are frequent power quality issues, which should be investigated.

To open the landing page:

In diagrams, click the grouping object that links to the page , or click the Power Quality Performance
tab in the Web Applications banner. Which of these two options have been implemented depends
on how your system has been configured.

Example landing page:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1085


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2. Details page

This page shows a breakdown of the specific event or disturbance, by time period. It provides the
following details:

• Counts for events with No Impact and Likely Impact.

• Counts for events with Internal, External, and Undetermined origin.

• A log with event details.

The details page also includes a description of the event or disturbance type and potential impacts.
There is a Learn More link to access additional, related information.

To open a details page:

On the landing page, click an event or disturbance to open the details page for that item.

Example details page:

1086 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

3. Information page

This page shows the color classification limits used to determine whether the event or disturbance
is flagged with a green, yellow, or red color.

To open an information page:

On a details page, click the information icon . Click X to return to the details page.

Example information page:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1087


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Setup page

This page has controls to trigger an update of the power quality indicators and the indicator limits.

Use the Initialize/Update Indicators control to manually update all indicators in the Power Quality
Performance diagrams. This triggers an immediate update instead of waiting for automatic updates
(15 minutes to 1 hour).

Use the Import Indicator Limit Information control to update the Power Quality Performance
indicator limits after the limit table in the database has been updated.

The OTHER (OPTIONAL) area is intended for custom controls. This area is empty by default.

To open the setup page:

On the landing page, click the Setup icon . Click the Back icon to return to the landing
page.

Example setup page:

For details on the diagrams, see:

• Power Quality Performance Indicator diagrams

• Power Quality Performance Equipment diagrams

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

1088 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1089


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Quality Performance Equipment diagrams


Overview
The Power Quality Equipment diagrams show status and operational details about the power quality
equipment in your facility. The status indicators are color coded and provide more detailed
information when clicked.

Diagrams
Power Quality Equipment diagram is organized into 3 levels:

1. Landing page

2. Group page

3. Details pages

1. Landing page

This page shows the status for each equipment type and a count for the number of devices of that
type.

(Optional) Click Corrective in the top navigation area of the page to view only the corrective
equipment types, click All Types to see all equipment.

To open the landing page:

On the Power Quality Performance Indicator diagrams landing page, click Equipment in the left
navigation pane.

You can also click one of the buttons under CORRECTIVE EQUIPMENT STATUS on that page,
to open the equipment group page for the devices grouped under the equipment type. The default
types are Capacitor Banks, Active Harmonic Filters, and UPS.

Example landing page:

1090 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

2. Group page

This page shows operational summary information for the equipment, such as load current and
harmonics. Each piece of equipment is shown with its own display area.

To open a group page:

On the landing page, click one of the equipment types. Click the Back icon to return to the
landing page.

Example group page:

3. Details page

This page shows detailed operational information for the equipment, including device status, and
maintenance indicators.

To open a details page:

On a group page, click inside a specific equipment area to open the details page for that item.

To view additional measurements for the device, click the folder icon in the OVERVIEW area on the
details page to open a device diagram for this equipment.

Click the Back icon to return to the landing page.

Example details page:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1091


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For details on the diagrams, see:

• Power Quality Performance Indicator diagrams

• Power Quality Performance Equipment diagrams

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

1092 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Insulation Monitoring diagrams


NOTE: These diagrams are part of the Insulation Monitoring Module. This Module requires a
separate license. The module must be configured before the diagrams can be used.

The Insulation Monitoring diagrams show insulation status and other insulation related
measurements. Use these diagrams to monitor and analyze the insulation status of your
ungrounded IT power system.
Different diagrams are provided for ANSI and IEC applications:

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for ANSI

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for IEC

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1093


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Insulation Monitoring diagrams for ANSI


The Insulation Monitoring module includes several diagrams that show the electrical status of the
areas and circuits that are being monitored.

This section describes each type of diagram.


See the following topics:

• Using the diagrams

• Data logs

Different diagrams are provided for ANSI and IEC regulated applications:

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for ANSI

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for IEC

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

1094 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Using the diagrams


The insulation monitoring diagrams display overview or detail information as well as status.

Facility Summary diagram

The Facility Summary diagram shows each group that contains a number of areas.

The Facilities Summary diagram shows all the groups of areas that were configured for the facility.
Each box in the main area represents a group of areas. This diagram provides a status overview and
links to areas in the facility, as shown next:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1095


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

A Group Icon – Click the group icon to see the area diagram.
Status Indicator – This indicator is green or red to show the general status of the
isolated power system:

• Green – Normal condition. The Total Hazard Current measurements for all areas in
this group are below the limit.

• Red – Alarm condition. The Total Hazard Current measurement in one or more
areas in this group exceeds the limit, or a LIM-IG6 is in test mode.

NOTE: A LIM-IG6 test lasts 5 to 30 seconds. When the test is complete, the
B
status indicator changes back to green. If an insulation fault has occurred, the
indicator remains red until the fault is corrected.

Example of an alarm indication:

C Areas Total number of monitored areas in this facility.

Recommended Actions for Alarm Condition Indication

1. Click the Group icon to open the Areas diagram. One or more area boxes will show an alarm
condition.

2. Click the specific area icons to open the Area Details diagrams. One or more panel boxes will
show an alarm condition. If the optional circuit fault locator devices are installed, the panel box
also indicates each circuit that has a resistance fault.

NOTE: Some types of electrical faults can occur and not be indicated by the individual circuit
fault locators. Only the area status indicator turns red. See Indicators for capacitive faults for
details.

3. Notify the responsible person that can address the condition for the area and specific circuits.

Summary of Areas diagram

The Summary of Areas diagram shows an overview of each area in the facility. Each box represents
a single area.

Example: 

1096 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Each box represents a single area and contains the following information:

A Area Icon – Click the area icon to see LIM-IG6 and circuit details for the area.
Area Status Indicator – Indicates the general conditions of the area. This indicator is
B either green "Normal" or red "Alarm". If the indicator is red, one or more IG6 monitors are in
test mode or the Total Hazard Current measurement exceeds the limit.
LIM-IG6 Status and Current Indicators – Displays the insulation status and real-time
Total Hazard Current, in mA, for each LIM-IG6 in the area. Up to six LIM-IG6 monitors can
be installed in an area. The indicator changes to red if the LIM-IG6 is in test mode or if a
C THC measurement exceeds the limit. When in test mode, the THC measurement changes
to 10.0 mA and the red "Testing" label appears next to the LIM-IG6 name. The test lasts 5
to 30 seconds. When the test is complete, the color changes to green. If a LIM-IG6 detects
an insulation alarm, the THC measurement shows the real-time THC value.

LIM-IG6 in test mode:

LIM-IG6 in alarm condition:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1097


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Area Details diagram

The Area Details diagram shows the details for each LIM-IG6 and connected devices in an area.
The Area Details diagram can show up to 3 LIM-IG6 monitors. If more than 3 monitors are in the
diagram, click the arrow in the upper right corner to see other monitors.

NOTE: For 208/240V systems, one LIM-IG6 can be shared between 2 areas. In this case, the
monitor appears on both area diagrams.

For example, the following image shows a diagram of the area and LIM-IG6 details:

1098 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Each LIM-IG6 area contains these sections to provide specific information about the circuit
conditions:

LIM-IG6 Status – Displays the name and status of the monitor, real-time
THC measurement, and test status. The THC measurement is taken directly from the
LIM-IG6.

This indicator is either green "Normal" or red "Alarm". If the indicator is red, one or more
A panels are in test mode or circuits in the area have THC measurements above the limit.
The red "Test In Progress" label appears when someone starts a LIM-IG6 test. A test is
started by pressing the test button on the LIM-IG6 or by pressing the test button on the
remote test device. This label remains visible during the test.

See Indicators for Test Mode and Alarm condition for details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1099


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Measurements – Displays the real-time measurements for the components connected to


the LIM-IG6.

• Load – Optional. Displays the transformer load if the circuit transformer is connected


to the LIM-IG6. The status indicator turns red if the overload percentage exceeds the
threshold defined for the transformer.

• Volts L1 - L2 – Voltage between L1 and L2, in V.

• Volts L1 - Ground – Voltage between L1 and Ground, in V.

• Volts L2 - Ground – Voltage between L2 and Ground, in V.


B
• Impedance – Impedance Zf in kΩ.

• Resistance – Resistance Rf in kΩ.

• Leakage – Leakage capacitance in nF.

• Temperature – Optional. The status of the transformer temperature, according to the


over-temperature sensor. This appears only if the temperature sensor is installed with
the transformer. The value changes to red "High" if the temperature exceeds the
threshold.

Circuit Status – Appears only if the optional circuit fault locator is connected to the LIM-
IG6. This area shows the status for each circuit being monitored. If the LIM-IG6 detects a
resistance fault, the circuit monitor identifies the specific circuit and the circuit indicator
turns red. When any indicator turns red, the alarm status propagates up to the top-level
C
Facility Summary diagram. If the LIM-IG6 is in test mode, all circuit indicators turn red.

See examples below for indicators in test or alarm condition.

Event Log and Data Log – Contains links to the historical data log and event log for the
D
panel measurements. See Data logs for more information.

Indicators for Test Mode and Alarm condition

LIM-IG6 in test mode, with circuit fault locators (left) and without circuit fault locators (right):

1100 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

LIM-IG6 in alarm condition, with circuit fault locators (left) and without circuit fault locators (right):

Indicators for capacitive faults

DANGER
EQUIPMENT ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
• Do not ignore the main device hazard indicator when all circuit fault locator icons show green
status.
• Determine and correct the cause of the fault if the main device hazard indicator shows a
hazard.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.

In some cases, such as when too many equipment items are connected to circuits, the LIM-IG6
detects a capacitance fault that exceeds the total hazard current (THC). For this situation, the room

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1101


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Status area shows the hazard, as shown next. However, if the optional circuit fault locators are
installed, the circuit indicators do not indicate the capacitive fault, because they show only
resistance faults, as shown next:

If all the circuit fault indicators are green, as above, and the room Status area shows a hazard,
appropriate personnel must determine and correct the cause of the fault.

See the following topics:

• Using the diagrams

• Data logs

Different diagrams are provided for ANSI and IEC regulated applications:

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for ANSI

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for IEC

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

1102 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1103


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Data logs
When you need details about circuit measurements and details, the Area Details diagram provides
links to the historical data log and the event log. These logs provide measurement data for the 5-
minute polling interval of the LIM-IG6. You can filter the data in the logs by date range.

When using the event log, you can also generate a graph that shows THC measurements plotted
across time. If any THC measurement exceeds the hazard threshold, the graph includes a callout at
the specific event point.

Historical data log and graph

The following figure shows the historical log table.

The buttons located at the top of the table are:

• Device Diagram – Click this to return to the diagram.

• Change Date Range – Click this to view data for different dates. See "Select Date Range"
below for more information.

• Show Graph – Select one or more column headers in the table and click this to see a graph of
the data. The graph shows the data at 5-minute intervals. For example, you can check the Total
Hazard Current option in the table and see the values. Click a point on the data line to see
details for that value, as shown next.

The following figure shows the historical log table from the Vista client view:

1104 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1105


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Event Log

The following figure shows the event log table:

The buttons located at the top of the table are:

• Device Diagram – Click this to return to the diagram.

• Change Date Range – Click this to view data for different dates. See "Select Date Range"
below for more information.

Select date range:


For either type of log table, you can select the date range for data you want to see. The default date
range is "Today".

1. Click Select Date Range.

2. Select an available range or click Between these dates and select specific dates in the
calendar.

3. Click Show Table to see the data.

If you select a date range of more than one week, a message appears to inform you that the table
will be very long.

The new table appears.

1106 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

See the following topics:

• Using the diagrams

• Data logs

Different diagrams are provided for ANSI and IEC regulated applications:

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for ANSI

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for IEC

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1107


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Insulation Monitoring diagrams for IEC


The Insulation Monitoring module includes several diagrams that show the electrical status of the
areas and circuits that are being monitored.

This section describes each type of diagram.


See the following topics:

• Using the diagrams

• Data logs

Different diagrams are provided for ANSI and IEC regulated applications:

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for ANSI

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for IEC

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

1108 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Using the diagrams


The insulation monitoring diagrams display overview or detail information as well as status.

Facility Summary diagram

The Facility Summary diagram shows each group that contains a number of areas.

The Facilities Summary diagram shows all the groups of areas that were configured for the facility.
Each box in the main area represents a group of areas. This diagram provides a status overview and
links to areas in the facility, as shown next:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1109


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

A Group Icon – Click the group icon to see the area diagram.
Status Indicator – This indicator is green or red to show the general status of the
isolated power system:

• Green – Normal condition. The insulation resistance measurements for all areas in
this group is above the limit.

• Red – Alarm condition. The insulation resistance measurements for one or more
B areas in this group are below the limit.

Example of an alarm indication:

C Areas – Total number of monitored areas in this facility.

Recommended Actions for Alarm Condition Indication

1. Click the Group icon to open the Areas diagram. One or more area boxes will show an alarm
condition. .

2. Click the specific area icons to open the Area Details diagrams. One or more panel boxes will
show an alarm condition. If the optional circuit fault locator devices are installed, the panel box
also indicates each circuit that has a resistance fault.

3. Notify the responsible person that can address the condition for the area and specific circuits.

Summary of Areas diagram

The Summary of Areas diagram shows an overview of each area in the facility. Each box represents
a single area.

Example:

1110 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Each box represents a single area and contains the following information:

Area Icon – Click the area icon to see the details for the insulation monitoring device
A
measurements for this area.
Area Status Indicator – Indicates the general conditions of the area. This indicator is
B either green "Normal" or red "Alarm". If the indicator is red, the insulation resistance
measurement from the insulation monitoring device is below the limit.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1111


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Area Information and Status Indicators – Displays the area name, the insulation
monitoring device, and the status indicators. If an alarm occurs in the room, these
indicators show the specific type of alarm.

• Insulation Status – Normal condition is green. If the impedance is lower than the
threshold, the indicator turns orange. The impedance threshold is set on the insulation
C monitoring device.

• Electrical Status – Normal condition is green. If the current transformer load or


temperature exceed the threshold set on the insulation monitoring device, this indicator
turns red.

• Wiring Status – Normal condition is green. This indicator turns red if the
device cannot monitor the isolation transformer.
Circuit Status – Appears only if the optional Insulation Fault Locator (IFL) device is
installed. This area shows the status for each circuit being monitored. If the IFL detects a
resistance fault, the circuit monitor identifies the specific circuit and the circuit indicator
D turns red. When any indicator turns red, the alarm status propagates up to the top-level
Facility Summary diagram.

Status indicators in an alarm condition:

1112 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Area Details diagram

The Area Details diagram shows the details for the insulation monitoring and fault locator devices.

Example:

The diagram shows the following details:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1113


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Device Name – The group and name of the device in the area.

Insulation Monitoring Device Status – Green = Normal, Red = Alarm.


A Impedance – The real-time measurement of the impedance to ground, in kiloohms. If the
impedance is lower than the threshold, the indicator turns orange. The impedance limit is
set on the insulation monitoring device.
Transformer Indicators – The load and temperature status for the current transfer

• Load – If the current transformer load exceeds the threshold, this indicator turns red
and displays the real-time load percentage value.
B
• Temperature – If the current transformer temperature rises above the threshold, this
indicator turns red and the status changes to "High."

Event Log and Data Log – Contains links to the historical data log and event log for the
C
panel measurements. See Data logs for more information.
Circuit Status – Appears only if the optional Insulation Fault Locator (IFL) device is
installed. This shows the status for each circuit being monitored. If the IFL detects a
D resistance fault, the circuit monitor identifies the specific circuit and the circuit indicator
turns red. When any indicator turns red, the alarm status propagates up to the top-level
Facility Summary diagram.

Example of status indicators in an alarm condition:

1114 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

See the following topics:

• Using the diagrams

• Data logs

Different diagrams are provided for ANSI and IEC applications:

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for ANSI

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for IEC

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1115


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Data logs
When you need details about circuit measurements and details, the Area Details diagram provides
links to the historical data log and the event log. These logs provide measurement data for the 15-
minute polling interval of the Vigilohm IM20-H. You can filter the data in the logs by date range.

Historical data log

The following image shows the historical log table from the Power Monitoring Expert view:

The buttons located at the top of the table are:

• Device Diagram – Click this to return to the diagram.

• Change Date Range – Click this to view data for different dates. See "Select Date Range"
below for more information.

• Show Graph – Select one or more column headers in the table and then click Show Graph to
see a graph of the data. The graph shows the data at 5-minute intervals.

The following figure shows the historical log table from the Vista client view:

1116 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1117


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Event Log

The following figure shows the event log table from the Power Monitoring Expert view:

The buttons located at the top of the table are:

• Device Diagram – Click this to return to the diagram.

• Change Date Range – Click this to view data for different dates. See "Select Date Range"
below for more information.

Select date range:


For either type of log table, you can select the date range for data you want to see. The default date
range is "Today".

1. Click Select Date Range.

2. Select an available range or click Between these dates and select specific dates in the
calendar.

3. Click Show Table to see the data.

If you select a date range of more than one week, a message appears to inform you that the table
will be very long.

The new table appears.

See the following topics:

• Using the diagrams

• Data logs

1118 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Different diagrams are provided for ANSI and IEC applications:

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for ANSI

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams for IEC

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1119


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

UPS Auto Test diagrams


NOTE: These diagrams are part of the Backup Power Module. This Module requires a separate
license. The module must be configured before the diagrams can be used.

Overview
The diagrams show status and operational details for the UPS devices.

Diagrams
UPS Auto Test diagrams are organized into 3 levels:

1. Groups summary page

2. Group details pages

3. Device details pages

1. Groups summary page


This page shows a summary of the status for each UPS group.

Example groups summary page:

2. Group details page


This page shows details for each UPS device in the group.

TIP: Click the group icon for a group in the groups summary page to open the respective group
details page.

Example group details page:

1120 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

(The colored outline boxes around the measurements indicate that the diagram in this example is
not linked to an actual UPS device.)

3. Device details page


This page shows details for a specific UPS device.

TIP: Click a battery icon for a UPS in the group details page to open the respective device details
page.

Example device details page:

(The colored outline boxes around the measurements indicate that the diagram in this example is
not linked to an actual UPS device.)

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1121


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

1122 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

EPSS diagrams
NOTE: These diagrams are part of the Backup Power Module. This Module requires a separate
license. The module must be configured before the diagrams can be used.

Overview
The diagrams show status and operational details for the generators and transfer switches that are
part of the EPSS system.

Diagrams
EPSS diagrams are organized into 3 levels:

1. Groups summary page

2. Group details pages

3. Device details pages

In addition, there are summary pages for all the generators and all the transfer switches in the
system.

1. Groups summary page


This page shows a summary for each EPSS group.

Example groups summary page:

2. Group details page


This page shows details for each generator and transfer switch device in the group.

TIP: Click the group icon for a group in the groups summary page to open the respective group
details page.

Example group details page:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1123


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

(No data is shown in this example because the diagram is not linked to actual devices.)

3. Device details page


This page shows details for a specific generator or transfer switch device.

TIP: Click a device icon for a generator or transfer switch in the group details page to open the
respective device details page.

Example device details page:

(No data is shown in this example because the diagram is not linked to actual devices.)

Summary pages
These pages show details for all the generators and all the transfer switches that are defined in the
system.

Example generator summary page:

1124 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example transfer switch summary page:

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Performing manual control actions

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1125


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

1126 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Breaker Aging diagrams


NOTE: These diagrams are part of the Breaker Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license. The module must be configured before the diagrams can be used.

The breaker aging diagrams show aging and wear related details for the breaker devices. There are
three different types of diagrams: Group summary diagram, group details diagram, and switchboard
details diagram.

Group Summary Diagram


The group summary diagram shows the group summary status and the number of breakers in the
group, for each of the groups setup with the Breaker Configuration tool.

Example:

Group Details Diagrams


A group details diagram shows the switchboards that are part of the group and the breakers in each
switchboard.

TIP: Click the group icon for a group in the groups summary page to open the respective group
details page.

Example (shows details page for Group 1):

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1127


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Switchboard Details Diagrams


A switchboard details diagram shows detailed information for each breaker in the switchboard.

TIP: Click the switchboard icon for a switchboard in the group details page to open the device
details page.

Example (shows details for Panel A):

Related topics:

• The Diagrams user interface

• User authentication

• Viewing historical (trend) data

• Viewing meter events

• Viewing user diagram of devices with security

• Performing manual control actions

1128 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Stale data and error indicators

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

• EPSS diagrams

• Breaker Aging diagrams

For information on how to configure Diagrams, see Diagrams configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1129


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Reports

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

Use the Reports application to generate historical data reports. You can view the reports in PME or
download them in different formats for sharing or storing externally. To generate a report, you can
either run it manually, setup an automatic schedule, or define trigger events such as a system
disturbance.

Reports are based on historical data that is stored in the PME database. A report can simply display
the historical data, or it can process data to show patterns and relationships. The Tabular Report is
an example of a simple report that shows data in a table. The Energy Modeling report is an example
of a report that processes different types of input data to produce predictions and comparisons
displayed in chart and diagram formats.

Reports are generated based on report templates. PME provides a wide range of default templates.
You can change the colors and logo used for these templates. To customize the types of inputs or
outputs of the default templates you need to create custom templates. Creating custom templates
requires engineering work outside of PME.

The Reports user interface (UI) has two main areas: Report Library and Reports Display. To see a
report in the Reports Display, you select the report in the Report Library.

TIP: You can open Reports from the REPORTS link in the Web Applications banner.

For more information see:

1130 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Reports UI

• Generating a report

• Downloading a report

Report templates
The default PME report templates cover a wide range of applications. The templates are grouped
into categories based on application. Choose the templates that best meet your reporting needs.
The following table shows the default templates and folders.

NOTE: Some report templates are part of add-on software modules for PME. Those reports are
enabled through the module licenses.

Category Template Licensing


- Generator Activity
- Generator Battery Health
- Generator Battery Health Export
Needs Backup Power Module
Backup Power - Generator Load Summary
license.
- Generator Test EPSS
- UPS Auto Test
- UPS Battery Health
- Billing
- Billing Summary
Needs Energy Billing Module
Billing - Billing Verification
license.
- Multiple Billing
- Multiple Billing Export
- Circuit Breaker Aging Needs Breaker Performance
Breaker Performance
- Circuit Breaker Settings Module license.
- Create Model
- Duration Curve
- Energy Regression Analysis
- Energy Usage per State
- KPI
Needs Energy Analysis Reports
Energy Analysis - KPI by TOU
Module license.
- Multiple Equipment Operation
- Power Usage Per State
- PUE Summary
- Single Equipment Operation
- Use Model

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1131


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Category Template Licensing


- Calendar Trend Month
- Calendar Trend Week
- Consumption Ranking
- Energy Comparison
- Energy Cost
- Energy Period over Period
- Energy Usage Included in Base license, except
- Energy Usage by Shift for Measurement Aggregation
- Energy Usage by Time of Use Export and Measurement
Energy Management
(TOU) Statistics Export. Both of these
- Load Profile reports requires a Data Exchange
- Measurement Aggregation Module license.
- Measurement Aggregation
Export
- Measurement Statistics
- Measurement Statistics Export
- Profile
- Scaled Energy Usage
- 100 ms
- Dashboard
- Dashboard - Portrait
- Data Export - Extended
General Included in Base license.
- Data Export - Standard
- Event History
- System Configuration
- Tabular
- Insulation Monitoring (ANSI) Needs Insulation Monitoring
Insulation Monitoring
- Insulation Monitoring (IEC) Module license.
Needs Energy Billing Module
IT Billing - Energy by IT Customer
license.
- Branch Circuit Power
- Equipment Capacity
- Generator Capacity
Needs Capacity Management
Power Capacity - Generator Power
Module license.
- Power Load Demand & Capacity
- Power Losses
- UPS Power

1132 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Category Template Licensing


- EN50160:2000
- EN50160:2000 Mains Signaling
- EN50160:2010
Included in Base license, except
- EN50160:2010 Mains Signaling
for Power Quality Analysis and
- Harmonic Compliance
Power Quality Impact. Both of
Power Quality - Harmonic Compliance 2014
these reports require a Power
- IEC61000-4-30
Quality Performance Module
- Power Quality
license.
- SARFI
- Power Quality Analysis
- Power Quality Impact
- Hourly Usage
- Multi Device Usage
Usage Trending - Multiple Trend Included in Base license.
- Single Device Usage
- Trend

Use the following links to find the descriptions of the different report templates:

Backup Power Reports Insulation Monitoring Reports


Billing Reports IT Billing Reports
Breaker Performance Reports Power Capacity Reports
Energy Analysis Reports Power Quality Reports
Energy Management Reports Usage Trending Reports
General Reports

Subscriptions
Subscribe to a report to have it generated automatically based on a schedule or on a trigger event.
For example, you can subscribe to a report and have it generated daily at a certain time, or monthly
on a certain day and time. A trigger event can be any event in the system, for example a device
setpoint going active, or a breaker tripping.

Time display
See Time Display in Web Applications for information on how time is displayed in a system where
the monitoring devices, the PME/Web server, and the Web client (browser) are in different time
zones.

Terminology
See Reports Terminology for definitions of the terms used in the Reports application.

For information on how to configure Alarms, see Reports configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1133


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Generating a report
Generate a report to view power monitoring system information.
To generate a report:

1. In Reports, open the Report Library and navigate to the report you want to generate.

2. Click the report name to display the report in the Reports Display pane.

3. Set the input parameters for the report and click Generate Report.

NOTE: Saved input parameters are preset to their saved values. Not saved input parameters
have generic default values.

4. The report output is displayed in the Reports Display pane.

Related topics:

• Generating a report

• Downloading a report

• Report descriptions

• Reports

• Reports UI

• Reports Terminology

For information on how to configure Reports, see Reports configuration.

1134 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Downloading a report
Download a report in one of the supported formats (PDF, Excel, Tiff Image) to share the report
output with others, or to save it externally
To download a report:

1. In Reports, generate a report.

2. In the Reports Display pane, view the generated report and click Download report as on the
toolbar immediately above the report output. Choose the format you want to download the
report in.

3. The report is downloaded in the selected format.

Related topics:

• Generating a report

• Downloading a report

• Report descriptions

• Reports

• Reports UI

• Reports Terminology

For information on how to configure Reports, see Reports configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1135


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Report descriptions
Use the following links to find the descriptions of the different report types:

Backup Power Reports Insulation Monitoring Reports


Billing Reports IT Billing Reports
Breaker Performance Reports Power Capacity Reports
Energy Analysis Reports Power Quality Reports
Energy Management Reports Usage Trending Reports
General Reports

Related topics:

• Generating a report

• Downloading a report

• Report descriptions

• Reports

• Reports UI

• Reports Terminology

For information on how to configure Reports, see Reports configuration.

1136 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Backup Power Reports

NOTE: These reports are part of the Backup Power Module. This module requires a separate
license.

PME has the following backup power report templates:

Generator Activity Report Generator Load Summary Report


Generator Battery Health Report UPS Auto Test Report
Generator Battery Health Export Report UPS Battery Health Report
Generator Test EPSS Report

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1137


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Generator Activity Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Backup Power Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Generator Activity Report shows run information for backup generators, such as run times,
durations, run reason, and overall run hours. Use this report to understand and manage your backup
generator operation.

Details

The Generator Activity Report shows:

• The number of non-emergency running hours as an annual total.

• Running hours broken out into categories for Test, Power Outage, Load Shedding.

• Bar graphs for generators with the number of hours of non-emergency run time.

• A table with non-emergency and emergency run hours for each generator.

Prerequisites

• The Backup Power Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• EPSS Group

• Reporting Period

• Threshold

• Include Activity Details

• Include Data Warnings

1138 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1139


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1140 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Generator Battery Health Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Backup Power Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Generator Battery Health Report compares the generator starter battery voltage, during start-
up, with a reference voltage signature. Use this report to check the generator starter battery
performance and to plan preventive maintenance.

Prerequisites

• The Backup Power Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Select EPSS Group

• Exclude Sources

• Select Generator Starts

• Include Data Warnings

• Cumulative Degradation Threshold

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1141


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1142 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Generator Battery Health Export Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Backup Power Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Generator Battery Health Export Report gives the same data as the Generator Battery Health
Report but in a CSV file format. Use this report for sharing the battery performance data with other
systems.

Prerequisites

• The Backup Power Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Select EPSS Group

• Exclude Sources

• Select Generator Starts

• Cumulative Degradation Threshold

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1143


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Generator Test EPSS Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Backup Power Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Generator Test EPSS Report shows load measurements and the sequence of events for
generator test runs. You can configure it to meet the requirements of an Emergency Power Supply
System (EPSS) test, including Automatic Transfer Switches (ATS). Use this report to assess the
performance of your backup generation systems during test runs. You can also use this report to
evaluate pass/fail criteria for EPSS testing.

NOTE: Emergency Power Supply System (EPSS) is a North American term used in the
healthcare segment. It describes an arrangement of generators and automatic transfer switches,
designed to provide backup power in case of a utility power interruption.

Prerequisites

• The Backup Power Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Company Name

• Technician Name

• Report Group

• Exclude Sources

• Use Run History

• Select Date Range

• ATS Summary

• Events Summary

• Generator Summary

• Comments

• Show Data Warnings

1144 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1145


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1146 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1147


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Generator Load Summary Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Backup Power Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Generator Load Summary Report shows load (kW, PF, Iavg, and so on) measurements
recorded during generator runs. Use this report to understand the electrical performance and loading
of your backup generator operations.

Prerequisites

• The Backup Power Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Select EPSS Group

• Exclude Sources

• Use Run History

• Select Date range

• Reporting Period

• Include Electrical Details

• Include Data Warnings

1148 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1149


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1150 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

UPS Auto Test Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Backup Power Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The UPS Auto Test Report shows test information for UPS systems, such as test times, pass/fail
evaluation, and event logs. Use this report to assess the performance of your UPS systems during
test runs.

NOTE: You can only use this report with certain types of UPS systems. See Backup Power
Module configuration for details.

Prerequisites

• The Backup Power Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• UPS Group

• Reporting Period

• Include Event History

• Include Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1151


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1152 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

UPS Battery Health Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Backup Power Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The UPS Battery Health Report compares the UPS battery voltage, during test conditions, with a
reference voltage signature. Use this report to check the UPS battery performance and to plan
preventive maintenance.

For information on the terms and calculations used in this report, see UPS Battery Health Report
calculations.

Prerequisites

• The Backup Power Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Select Waveforms

• Waveform Drop Percentage

• Waveform Drop Sample Size

• Recovery Value Multiplier

• Voltage Threshold

• Include Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1153


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1154 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Billing Reports

NOTE: These reports are part of the Energy Billing Module. This module requires a separate
license.

PME includes the following billing report templates:

• Billing Report

• Billing Summary Report

• Billing Verification Report

• Multiple Billing Export Report

• Multiple Billing Report

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

For information about changing the unit cost values in a rate file used for billing reports, see the Rate
Editor tool.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1155


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Billing Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Billing Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Billing Report shows a single bill with itemized energy and demand cost based on a customer
defined rate structure. It can be configured to include taxes and other charges. Use this report to
produce individual tenant energy bills, allocate cost to departments or processes, or verify utility
bills.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Billing Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Tenant

• Reporting Period

• Rate

1156 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1157


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Billing Summary Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Billing Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Billing Summary Report shows a listing of the consumption costs for multiple consumers in one
report and gives an overall total cost. Use this report to see the costs for multiple consumers in a
single report, for example for an office building with different tenants.

Details

You can select multiple tenants and multiple rates to create a single report for all your tenants.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Billing Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Tenants & Rates

• Reporting Period

• Tenant Filter

• Line Item Filter

• Save Billing Totals

• Keep True Totals

• Order By

1158 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1159


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Billing Verification Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Billing Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Billing Verification Report shows the difference between two bills, generated from different data
sources, or between a generated bill and a manually entered cost value. Use this report to compare
a utility bill with an internally generated bill.

Details

You can configure the report to send out an email notification if the difference in the bill values
exceeds a programmable limit.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Billing Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Private Source

• Check Source

• Reporting Period

• Rate

• Actual Bill Cost

• Alarm Threshold - Check Source vs Actual Total (%)

• Alarm Threshold - Check Source vs Private Source (%)

• Show Bill Details

• Notify On

• Email Address

• Email Subject

1160 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

Comparison summary page

Billing details page for internal source

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1161


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Billing details page for utility source

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1162 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Multiple Billing Export Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Billing Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Multiple Billing Export Report gives the same data as the Multiple Billing Report but in an XML
file format. Use this report for sharing the billing data with third-party billing systems.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Billing Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Tenants & Rates

• Reporting Period

• XML Transform File

• XML Export File

• Overwrite XML Export

• Stylesheet (optional)

• Save Billing Totals

• Email XML Export

• Email Recipients (comma separated)

• Order By

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1163


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Multiple Billing Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Billing Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Multiple Billing Report gives the same output as the Billing Report, but for more than one
consumer. Use this report to create bills for more than one customer, rather than running the Billing
Report multiple times.

Details

The output of this report is a single file, so if you choose to save or subscribe to a PDF file, then
each bill appears on its own page for review and printing purposes.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Billing Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Tenants & Rates

• Reporting Period

• Load Profile Measurements

• Previous Period Energy Measurement

• Energy Period Comparison Range

• Energy Period Rollup

• Align Day of Week for Months on Energy Chart

• Save Billing Totals

• Notes

• Order By

• Show Footer Image

1164 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1165


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Breaker Performance Reports

NOTE: These reports are part of the Breaker Performance Module. This module requires a
separate license.

PME includes the following breaker performance report templates:

• Circuit Breaker Aging Report

• Circuit Breaker Settings Report

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

1166 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Circuit Breaker Aging Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Breaker Performance Module. This Module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Circuit Breaker Aging Report shows the aging and wear related status of circuit breakers. Use
this report to check the condition of your breakers and to plan preventive maintenance.

Prerequisites

• The Breaker Performance Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Select Group

• Grouped By

• Include Breakers with Minor Aging and Wear

• Include Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1167


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1168 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Circuit Breaker Settings Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Breaker Performance Module. This Module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Circuit Breaker Settings Report shows the protection settings for your breakers and highlights
changes in these settings between report runs. Use this report to analyze and plan your protection
schemes and to confirm or detect protection settings changes.

Prerequisites

• The Breaker Performance Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Select Group

• Include Unassociated Breakers

• Baseline Date

• Circuit Breaker Inventory

• Trip Settings

• Protection Modes

• Maintenance Status

• Change Summary

• Include Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1169


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

1170 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1171


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1172 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Energy Analysis Reports

NOTE: These reports are part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a
separate license.

PME includes the following energy analysis report templates:

• Create Model Report

• Duration Curve Report

• Energy Regression Analysis Report

• Energy Usage Per State Report

• KPI Report

• KPI by TOU Report

• Multi Equipment Operation Report

• Power Usage Per State Report

• PUE Summary Report

• Single Equipment Operation Report

• Use Model Report

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1173


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Create Model Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Create Model Report is used to create a model of your facility or process. The model is then
used in the Use Model Report to compare expected consumption to actual consumption. You only
use the Create Model Report during configuration. After you created the model, you do not need to
run this report again, unless you want to create a new model.

Details

See Configuring the Energy Modeling report, in the Configuring chapter of this guide, for more
details.

Prerequisites

To use this report, the data for the independent variables and for the dependent variable must be
available in the Power Monitoring Expert database for the reporting period. If you want to use sub-
models and exception periods, then these must be defined.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Dependent Variable

• Independent Variable(s)

• Reporting Period

• Interval and Sub Model Configuration

• Use Exception Periods

• Show Detailed Results

• Save Model Configuration

Example:

See Model creation example

To calculate the models, PME uses the Accord Framework Library which can be found at:
http://accord-framework.net/index.html.

1174 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Duration Curve Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Duration Curve Report shows the load (kW) levels in a system and the duration this load
persisted over the reporting period. Use this report to find opportunities for reducing peak demand
and for lowering base load.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Analysis Reports Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Single Source – see Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurement – see Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• n % Crossing

• Exclude Values Over

• Exclude Values Under

• Reporting Period

• Target Line

• Source Label

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Include Data Table

• Show Occurrences Chart

• Show Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1175


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

1176 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1177


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Energy Regression Analysis Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Energy Regression Analysis Report uses simple regression analysis to model load behavior
with respect to an influencing driver, such as weather. Use this report to compare the performance
of your facility or of a load to the expected (modeled) behavior.

Details

See Interpreting the Energy Regression Analysis Report results for more information on this topic.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Analysis Reports Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Driver Data Source

• Driver Data Quantity

• Model Data Source

• Model Data Quantity

• Reporting Period

• Regression Type

• X Axis Calculation Method

• Degree Days Pivot Point

• Y Axis Calculation Method

• Aggregation Interval

• Exclude Incomplete Weeks

• Exclude Incomplete Days

• Exclude Days with Rollover

• Deviation Type

• Max Authorized Deviation

• Include Data Warnings

• Include Report Parameters Summary

1178 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1179


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1180 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1181


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Energy Usage Per State Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Energy Usage per State Report shows energy consumption for a process or load based on
certain state variables of this process or load. Use this report to understand the energy consumption
pattern of complex processes and find opportunities for efficiency improvements.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Analysis Reports Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Energy Measurements

• Energy Measurement Label

• State Measurement

• State Labels

• Rollup

• Aggregation Interval

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Include Data Table

• Show Data Warnings

1182 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1183


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1184 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

KPI Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The KPI Report calculates a Key Performance Indicator (KPI) based on one or more input
parameters. The input parameters can be electrical and non-electrical consumption data, weather
data, and business-related data. Use this report to translate energy consumption into business
relevant information that you can use to benchmark and improve your energy productivity.

Details

To calculate the KPI, you must specify the input parameters, the formula that is used to calculate
the KPI from the input parameters, the measurement that is used to represent the KPI output value,
and a number for processing instructions. See the report inputs list below for details.

The KPI data calculated by the report can be stored in the Power Monitoring Expert database to be
used in applications such as Dashboards, Reports, VIP, ... .

Prerequisites

• The Energy Analysis Reports Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Rollup

• Input Source Measurements

• KPI Source

• KPI Measurement

• KPI Measurement Override

• KPI Formula

• Save Calculated Values

• Reporting Period

• Show Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1185


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1186 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

KPI by TOU Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The KPI by TOU Report shows the relative energy consumption for one or more loads based on
time of use schedule. Use this report to translate energy consumption into business relevant
information that you can use to benchmark and improve your energy productivity.

Details

You can configure the report to send out an email notification if any target values (static or
calculated) are exceeded in any of the defined periods.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Analysis Reports Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Select Sources – see Sources (Devices and Views)

• Select Measurement – see Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Multiplier

• Lower Limit - see Lower Target Line

• Upper Limit - see Upper Target Line

• Scale Source

• Scale Measurement

• Scale Multiplier

• Precision

• Custom Units Override

• Reporting Period

• Standard Deviation Calculation Period

• Rollup

• Select Time of Use

• Use Standard Deviation Target in Column Chart

• Show Average in Column Chart

• Standard Deviation Multiplier

• Chart Type

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1187


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Include Data Table

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Exclude Unscaled Values

• Show Data Warnings

• Notify On Target Value Exception

• Notify on Std Dev Exception

• Notify/Show Charts on Last Aggregated Interval Exception Only

• Show Charts with Exception Only

• Email Address

• Email Subject

• Source Label

Example:

1188 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1189


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1190 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Multi Equipment Operation Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Multi Equipment Operation Report shows how much time different equipment spends in a
certain state, the number of activations, and the average activation duration. Use this report to gain
an understanding of the operations of your facility or processes.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Analysis Reports Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs (update)

• Title

• State Measurements

• State Labels

• Reporting Period

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Include Data Table

• Show Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1191


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

1192 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1193


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Usage Per State Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Power Usage per State Report shows the power (kW) consumed by different equipment in
certain states. Use this report to gain an understanding of the operations of your facility or
processes.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Analysis Reports Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs (update)

• Title

• Logged Measurement

• State Measurement

• State Labels

• Reporting Period

• Rollup

• Aggregation Type

• Show Min/Max Timestamps

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Include Data Table

• Show Data Warnings

1194 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1195


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1196 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

PUE Summary Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The PUE Summary Report shows the Power Usage Effectiveness (PUE) index and the average
power consumed for a data center facility. It also shows the average power consumed for the IT
equipment running in the facility. Use this report to check the efficiency of your data center facility.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Analysis Reports Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Data Center Source

• Data Center Power Measurement

• Data Center Energy Measurement

• IT Equipment Source

• IT Equipment Power Measurement

• IT Equipment Energy Measurement

• PUE Category

• Report End Date

• Show Data Warnings

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1197


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1198 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Single Equipment Operation Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Single Equipment Operation Report shows how much time an equipment spends in a certain
state, the number of activations, and the average activation duration. Use this report to gain an
understanding of the operations of your facility or processes.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Analysis Reports Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs (update)

• Title

• State Measurement

• State Labels

• Reporting Period

• Rollup

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Include Data Table

• Show Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1199


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

1200 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1201


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Use Model Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Analysis Reports Module. This module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Use Model Report shows the expected consumption of your facility or process, based on a
model created with the Create Model Report. The report shows modeled data, the measured data,
and the delta between the two. Use this report to find unexpected changes in your consumption, or
to find actual savings as a result of energy management measures.

NOTE: The report is not limited to energy consumption modeling. You can use it to model any
quantity that is dependent on drivers, for example you can model Power Factor based on power
demand.

Prerequisites

To use this report, at least one model must have been defined for your facility or process. The data
for the independent variables must be available in the Power Monitoring Expert database for the
reporting period.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Choose a Model and a Reporting Aggregation Interval

• Display Mode

• Reporting Period

• Include Measured Data

• Enter an optional coefficient in % to be applied on the modeled data

• Insert Data

Example:

1202 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

TIP: Move your pointer over the chart line to see tooltips with measurement details.

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

To calculate the models, PME uses the Accord Framework Library which can be found at:
http://accord-framework.net/index.html

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1203


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Energy Management Reports


PME includes the following energy management report templates:

• Calendar Trend Month Report

• Calendar Trend Week Report

• Consumption Ranking Report

• Energy Comparison Report

• Energy Cost Report

• Energy Period over Period Report

• Energy Usage Report

• Energy Usage by Shift Report

• Energy Usage by TOU Report

• Load Profile Report

• Measurement Aggregation Report

• Measurement Aggregation Export Report

• Measurement Statistics Report

• Measurement Statistics Export Report

• Profile Report

• Scaled Energy Usage Report

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

1204 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Calendar Trend Month Report

Summary

The Calendar Trend Month Report shows a daily demand profile for a load for each day of a month.
Use this report to see out-of-hours usage, benchmark performance targets, and to find peak and off-
peak usage patterns.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Single Source – see Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurement – see Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Start Hour

• End Hour

• Highlight Start

• Highlight End

• Reporting Period

• Target Line

• Source Label

• Display Zero Days

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Show Data Warnings.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1205


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1206 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Calendar Trend Week Report

Summary

The Calendar Trend Week Report shows a daily demand profile for a load for each day of the week.
Use this report to see out-of-hours usage, benchmark performance targets, and to find peak and off-
peak usage patterns.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Single Source – see Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurement – see Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Start Hour

• End Hour

• Highlight Start

• Highlight End

• Reporting Period

• Target Line

• Source Label

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Show Data Warnings.

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1207


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1208 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Consumption Ranking Report

Summary

The Consumption Ranking Report shows the relative ranking of energy consumption for one or
more loads. Use this report to gain an understanding of the operations of your facility or processes.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Select Sources – see Sources (Devices and Views)

• Select Measurement – see Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Multiplier

• Scale Source

• Scale Measurement

• Reporting Period

• Gauge Scale Override

• Select

• Select Number

• Custom Units Label

• Source Label

• Include Chart

• Include Gauges

• Include Tables

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Show Data Warnings.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1209


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1210 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Energy Comparison Report

Summary

The Energy Comparison Report converts different types of energy measurements to a common
energy unit and then normalizes it by criteria, such as area. Use this report to benchmark building or
process energy performance.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Energy Measurements

• Energy Measurement Label

• Rollup

• Reporting Period

• Show Start & End Periods Only

• Chart Type

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Include Data Table

• Show Data Warnings

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1211


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1212 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Energy Cost Report

Summary

The Energy Cost Report shows energy and demand cost based on time of use and flat rate energy
and demand charges. Use this report for internal cost allocation or utility bill verification.

Details

With an Energy Cost Report, you can:

• Use a time of use (TOU) schedule that you define using the Time of Use Editor (see the "Time
of Use Editor" topic in the Management Console Tools section of the online Power Monitoring
Expert Help).

or

• Set a flat rate on the Energy and Demand tab of the Energy Rates dialog. See Rates report
input description for more information.

NOTE: This report is intended to be used for positive power flow applications only (where kW and
kvar are both positive). Use with bi-directional flow gives incorrect results.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Rates

• Reporting Period

• Show Data Warnings

• Source Label

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1213


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1214 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Energy Period over Period Report

Summary

The Energy Period over Period Report shows energy consumption for one or more loads for two
different time periods. Use this report to detect changes in consumption over time, for example this
month vs. the same month last year.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Measurement

• Report Period (with additional options)

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Include Aggregation Chart

• Include Stacked Aggregation Chart

• Include Interval Line Trend

• Include Interval Column Trend

• Source Label

• Include Data Table

• Show Data Warnings.

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1215


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1216 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Energy Usage Report

Summary

The Energy Usage Report shows energy consumption for one or more loads, rolled up by day,
week, month, or year. Use this report to compare energy consumption for different loads and gain an
understanding of the operations of your facility or processes.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Reporting Period

• Rollup

• Start Hour

• End Hour

• Lower Target Line

• Upper Target Line

• Source Label

• Include Column Chart

• Include Stacked Column Chart

• Include Line Chart

• Include Pie Chart

• Include 100% Area Chart

• Include Area Chart

• Include Gauges

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Show Data Warnings.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1217


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

1218 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1219


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Energy Usage by Shift Report

Summary

The Energy Usage by Shift Report shows energy consumption for one or more loads broken down
by shifts. Use this report to compare energy consumption for different loads and gain an
understanding of the operations of your facility or processes.

Details

NOTE: If you generate a report before the end of a shift that spans midnight, a portion of the usage
data for that shift is included under the equivalent shift for the current day.

Example:

1. You specify three 8-hour shifts:

Shift 1: 7:00 AM to 3:00 PM


Shift 2: 3:00 PM to 11:00 PM
Shift 3: 11:00 PM to 7:00 AM

NOTE: Shift 3 spans midnight (12:00 a.m.).

2. Your Reporting Period is Last 7 Days.

3. You generate the report on day 8 before 7:00 a.m., that is, before the end of Shift
3 for day 7.

The generated report will include usage data under Shift 3 for day 8. However, this
shift 3 usage data is the portion of shift 3 from the previous day (day 7) that occurred
after midnight. In addition, this allocation of usage data to the next day for shift 3 from
midnight to 7:00 a.m. occurs for all the days throughout the reporting period. To avoid
this situation, select specific days (Fixed Date) for the Reporting Period.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Measurement

• Reporting Period

• Rollup

• Shifts

• Show Data Warnings

• Source Label

1220 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1221


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1222 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Energy Usage by TOU Report

Summary

The Energy Usage by TOU Report shows energy consumption for one or more loads based on a
Time of Use (TOU) schedule. Use this report to compare energy consumption for different loads and
gain an understanding of the operations of your facility or processes.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Reporting Period

• Rollup

• Select Time of Use

• Lower Target Line

• Upper Target Line

• Source Target Line

• Measurement Target Line

• Chart Type

• Source Label

• Include Data Tables

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Show Data Warnings.

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1223


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1224 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1225


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Load Profile Report

Summary

The Load Profile Report shows demand or load levels, including peak demand, over the reporting
period. Use this report to understand the power consumption patterns of your facility or processes.

Details

The Load Profile report template uses similar measurements as the Energy Cost report template but
does not use a TOU schedule.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Measurements

• Reporting Period

• Include Data Table

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Target Line (kW)

• Target Line (kvar)

• Target Line (kVA)

• Source Label

• Show Data Warnings

1226 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1227


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Measurement Aggregation Report

Summary

The Measurement Aggregation Report gives aggregated logged measurement data in tabular
format. The aggregation intervals are configurable, and the report supports aggregation by time of
use. Use this report to understand the consumption patterns of your facility or processes.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Measurements

• Reporting Period

• Rollup

• Non Cumulative Measurement Calculation

• Apply Time of Use / Select Time of Use Schedule

• Source Label

• Rollup Table Type

• Show Totals

• Show Data Warnings.

• Show Header

Example 1 - Report output with Rollup set to Interval:

1228 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example 2 - Report output with Rollup set to Hour:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1229


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Measurement Aggregation Export Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Data Exchange Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Measurement Aggregation Export Report gives aggregated logged measurement data in tabular
format. It provides the same data as the Measurement Aggregation Report but in CSV, RepGen
compatible, or Tidy file export formats. Use this report to share consumption data with third-party
systems or for use in existing RepGen reports.

NOTE: RepGen is a Microsoft Excel based reporting system that was part of earlier versions of
PME.

NOTE: The output file of this report is saved to the PME server, not the web client computer.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Sources

• Measurements

• Reporting Period

• Rollup

• Non Cumulative Measurement Calculation

• Apply Time of Use / Select Time of Use Schedule

• Include Empty Intervals

• Base Interval

• Export File Path

• Overwrite File

• Export Format

• Show Data Warnings.

1230 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example - CSV output format:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1231


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Measurement Statistics Report

Summary

The Measurement Statistics Report gives a statistics of logged measurement data in tabular and
chart format. The statistics intervals are configurable and the report supports statistics by time of
use. Use this report to understand the consumption patterns of your facility or processes.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Measurements

• Reporting Period

• Statistics Period

• Apply Time of Use / Select Time of Use Schedule

• Show Separate TOU Values For Non-Cumulative Measurements

• Include Chart

• Sort By

• Sort Order

• Source Label

• Show Data Warnings.

1232 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1233


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Measurement Statistics Export Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Data Exchange Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Measurement Statistics Export Report gives a statistics of logged measurement data in tabular
format. It provides the same data as the Measurement Statistics Report but in CSV file export
format. Use this report to share consumption data with third-party systems.

NOTE: The output file of this report is saved to the PME server, not the web client computer.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Measurements

• Reporting Period

• Statistics Period

• Apply Time of Use / Select Time of Use Schedule

• Show Separate TOU Values For Non-Cumulative Measurements

• Sort By

• Sort Order

• Export Data To - see Export File Path

• Source Label

1234 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1235


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Profile Report

Summary

The Profile Report shows all measurements over the reporting period. Use this report to understand
all the measurements patterns of your facility or processes.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Reporting Period

• Show Data Table

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Target Line

• Source Label

• Show Max Values With Charts

• Include Data Warnings

1236 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1237


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Scaled Energy Usage Report

Summary

The Scaled Energy Usage Report shows the relative ranking of energy consumption for one or more
loads, rolled up by day, week, month, or year. Use this report to compare energy consumption for
different loads and gain an understanding of the operations of your facility or processes.

Details

This report provides the same data as the Energy Usage Report and additionally sources and
measurements can be scaled with another source and measurement. The report also provides
tabular information with raw and normalized values of the measurements. All normalization
calculations are made at interval level. Each interval level is calculated individually to accommodate
for frequently changing scale date.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Select Sources – see Sources (Devices and Views)

• Select Measurement – see Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Multiplier

• Scale Source

• Scale Measurement

• Reporting Period

• Rollup

• Start Hour

• End Hour

• Custom Units Label

• Lower Target Line

• Upper Target Line

• Source Label

• Include Column Chart

• Include Stacked Column Chart

• Include Line Chart

• Include Pie Chart

• Include 100% Area Chart

• Include Area Chart

1238 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Include Gauges

• Include Tables

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Show Data Warnings.

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1239


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1240 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1241


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

General Reports
PME includes the following general report templates:

• 100 ms Report

• Dashboard Report

• Dashboard - Portrait Report

• Data Export - Extended

• Data Export - Standard

• Event History Report

• System Configuration Report

• Tabular Report

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

1242 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

100 ms Report

Summary

The 100ms Report shows 100 ms measurements from PowerLogic™ Circuit Monitors, for example
CM4000 in a tabular format. Use this report to analyze high speed data samples from these
devices.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Measurements

• Reporting Period

• Show Data Warnings

• Source Label

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1243


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1244 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Dashboard Report

Summary

The Dashboard Report shows screen captures of a dashboard slideshow in a landscape page
layout. Use this report to share dashboard and Web content in any of the supported report formats,
such as PDF and so on.

Details

You can include the screen capture of an additional, custom page, by specifying the page URL.

TIP: Create separate slideshows for each dashboard page you want to report on.

Prerequisites

• A Dashboard slideshow must be configured.

Report inputs

• Title

• Page Size

• Custom Page Height

• Custom Page Width

• Slideshows

• Custom URL

• Page Wait Time in Seconds

• Show Header & Footer

• Show Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1245


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Dashboard - Portrait Report

Summary

The Dashboard - Portrait Report shows screen captures of a dashboard slideshow in a portrait page
layout. Use this report to share dashboard and Web content in any of the supported report formats,
such as PDF and so on.

Details

You can include the screen capture of an additional, custom page by specifying the page URL.

TIP: Create separate slideshows for each dashboard page you want to report on.

Prerequisites

• A Dashboard slideshow must be configured.

Report inputs

• Title

• Page Size

• Custom Page Height

• Custom Page Width

• Slideshows

• Custom URL

• Page Wait Time in Seconds

• Show Header & Footer

• Show Data Warnings

1246 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Data Export - Extended

Summary

The Data Export - Extended Report gives logged measurement data in CSV file format. Use this
report to import and analyze data in a third-party application, such as Microsoft Excel.

NOTE: This report has more details than the Data Export - Standard Report, but it supports a
smaller data set.

Details

The data is organized in columns labeled Timestamp UTC, Timestamp, Value, Source,
Measurement, and Unit. This makes it easier to create an Excel pivot table for analyzing the data
in the file. The data is listed for each source and measurement by date and in the specified time
segments for the data. This report can export 80 source measurements for 10 months.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Reporting Period

• Include Duplicates

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1247


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1248 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Data Export - Standard

Summary

The Data Export - Standard Report gives logged measurement data in CSV file format. Use this
report to import and analyze data in a third-party application, such as Microsoft Excel.

NOTE: This report has fewer details than the Data Export - Extended Report, but it supports a
larger data set.

Details

The data is organized by column, with column A labeled Timestamp. The remaining columns are
labeled with the source name and measurement. The data is listed by date and in the specified time
segments for the data. This report can export 600 source measurements for 11 months.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Reporting Period

• Include Duplicates

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1249


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Event History Report

Summary

The Event History Report gives a tabular list of event log entries for the selected sources. Use this
report to analyze system events, for example for root cause analysis or sequence of events
analysis.

Details

If no event has occurred that matches the inputs entered when generating the report, no data is
returned.

Prerequisites

• None

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Reporting Period

• Show Data Warnings

• Priority

• Source Label

1250 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1251


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

System Configuration Report

Summary

The System Configuration Report shows details about the monitoring devices in your network,
including communications information. Use this report for device and communications network
inventory and planning.

Prerequisites

• None

Report inputs

• Title

• Show Data Warnings.

Example:

1252 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1253


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Tabular Report

Summary

The Tabular Report gives logged measurement data in tabular format. Use this report to analyze
logged data.

Details

You can create a report with multiple measurements from multiple sources. You can also select the
option to include duplicate data in the report. This data can then be exported for use in another
program, such as Microsoft Excel. If you want to only export your data to an Excel file, use the Data
Export - Extended report or the Data Export - Standard report.

NOTE: The Tabular Report is limited to 30 source-measurement pairs. Multiple reports are
required if the number of source-measurement pairs exceeds 30. Alternatively, consider using the
Data Export - Standard report or the Data Export Extended report to generate a CSV file containing
the data for the selected sources and measurements.

The generated report contains the following information: source; measurement; timestamp; and
values.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Reporting Period

• Source Label

• Include Duplicates

• Show Data Warnings

1254 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1255


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Insulation Monitoring Reports

NOTE: These reports are part of the Insulation Monitoring Module. This module requires a
separate license.

PME includes the following insulation monitoring report templates:

• Insulation Monitoring Report (ANSI)

• Insulation Monitoring Report (IEC)

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

1256 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Insulation Monitoring Report (ANSI)

NOTE: This report is part of the Insulation Monitoring Module. This Module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Insulation Monitoring (ANSI) Report shows Total Hazard Current, relevant event log entries,
and logged insulation related measurements, over the reporting period. Use this report to analyze
and report on the insulation status of your ungrounded IT power system.

Details

The report includes:

• A Total Hazard Current graph, showing measured currents against the Total Hazard Current
limits.

• An events table, showing information for each event that occurred in the reporting range.

• A data log table, showing Total Hazard Current measurements and other meter data.

Prerequisites

• The Insulation Monitoring Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Area

• Reporting Period

• Include Data Table

• Include Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1257


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Hospital Operating Room Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1258 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Insulation Monitoring Report (IEC)

NOTE: This report is part of the Insulation Monitoring Module. This Module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Insulation Monitoring (IEC) Report shows resistance, transformer load, relevant event log
entries, and logged insulation related measurements, over the reporting period. Use this report to
analyze and report on the insulation status of your ungrounded IT power system.

Details

The report includes:

• An impedance graph, showing a comparison of impedance measurements to the impedance


threshold.

• A transformer load graph, showing a comparison of transformer load measurements to the load
threshold.

• An events table, showing information for each event that occurred in the reporting range.

• A data log table, showing measurements for impedance, load, and temperature.

Prerequisites

• The Insulation Monitoring Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Area

• Reporting Period

• Include Data Table

• Include Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1259


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Hospital Operating Room Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1260 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

IT Billing Reports

NOTE: These reports are part of the Energy Billing Module. This module requires a separate
license.

PME includes the following IT billing report templates:

• Energy by IT Customer Report

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1261


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Energy by IT Customer Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Energy Billing Module. This module requires a separate license.

Summary

The Energy by IT Customer Report gives consumption data for different IT customers, down to the
rack and circuit level. Use this report to understand the consumption of IT customer loads in your
data center, and for exporting billing system information.

Prerequisites

• The Energy Billing Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Facility Name

• Facility Location

• Customers

• Reporting Period

• Report Type

• Timestamp Coincidence

• Display Billing ID

• Show Errors

1262 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1263


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Capacity Reports

NOTE: These reports are part of the Capacity Management Module. This module requires a
separate license.

PME includes the following power capacity report templates:

• Branch Circuit Power Report

• Equipment Capacity Report

• Generator Capacity Report

• Generator Power Report

• Power Load Demand & Capacity Report

• Power Losses Report

• UPS Power Report

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

1264 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Branch Circuit Power Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Capacity Management Module. This Module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Branch Circuit Power Report shows branch circuit loading for different IT customers. Use this
report for proactive capacity management, incident management, customer expansion planning,
and Service Level Agreement (SLA) management.

Prerequisites

• The Capacity Management Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Facility Name

• Facility Location

• Customers

• Reporting Period

• Primary Sort

• Include Data Warnings

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1265


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1266 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Equipment Capacity Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Capacity Management Module. This Module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Equipment Capacity Report shows loading (kW) and available capacity for equipment such as
transformers, transfer switches, and so on. Use this report for capacity analysis and planning.

Prerequisites

• The Capacity Management Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• EPSS Group

• Exclude Sources

• Reporting Period

• Threshold

• Show Daily Rollups

• Include Data Table

• Include Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1267


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

1268 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1269


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1270 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1271


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Generator Capacity Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Capacity Management Module. This Module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Generator Capacity Report shows loading (kW) and available capacity for backup generator
systems. Use this report for generator system capacity analysis and planning.

Details

The report shows:

• Power consumption grouped by load type (Equipment, Life Safety, Critical)

• The generator capacity used/available.

• The redundancy levels (N-1, N-2, …).

Prerequisites

• The Capacity Management Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• EPSS Group

• Exclude Sources

• Reporting Period

• Aggregation Period

• Include Data Table

• Include Data Warnings

1272 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1273


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1274 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Generator Power Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Capacity Management Module. This Module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Generator Power Report shows system loading compared to backup generator rating and
redundancy design limits. Use this report for backup power system capacity analysis and planning.

Prerequisites

• The Capacity Management Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Facility Name

• Facility Location

• Report Data

• Reporting Period

• Aggregation Data

• Include Data Tables

• Show Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1275


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

1276 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1277


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Load Demand & Capacity Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Capacity Management Module. This Module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Power Load Demand & Capacity Report shows a comparison of the load capacity and the
applied load, for example for an automatic transfer switch (ATS). The peak load vs. capacity is
shown for preset reporting intervals (last: 5 minutes, hour, 24 hours, 30 days, 12 months) and per
month for the entire available data range. Use this report to analyze and monitor the loading and
compliance of equipment such as an ATS.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

NOTE: This report is designed to be used with Active Power (kW) measurements.

• Title

• Single Source – see Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurement – see Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Demand Rating kW

• Demand Adjustment (%)

• Show Data Warnings.

Example:

1278 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1279


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Losses Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Capacity Management Module. This Module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The Power Losses Report shows losses (kW and cost) in transformers and UPS systems. The
cost calculations are based on a configurable flat rate energy cost. Use this report to analyze and
quantify the power losses in your transformer and UPS networks.

Prerequisites

• The Capacity Management Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Facility Name

• Facility Location

• Reporting Period

• Energy Cost (per kWh)

• Aggregation Data

• Include Data Tables

• Show Data Warnings

1280 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1281


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1282 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

UPS Power Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Capacity Management Module. This Module requires a separate
license.

Summary

The UPS Power Report shows system loading compared to UPS backup power rating and
redundancy design limits. Use this report for backup power system capacity analysis and planning.

Prerequisites

• The Capacity Management Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Facility Name

• Facility Location

• Report Data

• Reporting Period

• Aggregation Data

• Include Data Tables

• Show Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1283


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

1284 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1285


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Quality Reports

NOTE: The Power Quality Analysis and Power Quality Impact reports are part of the Power
Quality Performance Module. This module requires a separate license.

PME includes the following power quality report templates:

• EN50160:2000 Report

• EN50160:2000 Mains Signaling Report

• EN50160:2010 Report

• EN50160:2010 Mains Signaling Report

• Harmonic Compliance Report

• Harmonic Compliance 2014 Report

• IEC61000-4-30 Report

• Power Quality Report

• SARFI Report

• Power Quality Analysis Report

• Power Quality Impact Report

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

1286 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

EN50160:2000 Report

Summary

The EN50160:2000 Report shows an analysis of the compliance of selected sources based on the
EN50160:2000 power quality standard. Use this report for an analysis and compliance assessment
of your facility against the EN50160:2000 power quality standard.

NOTE: This report needs data from monitoring devices with EN50160:2000 monitoring
capabilities.

Details

EN50160:2000 is a set of power quality standards used by certain energy suppliers and energy
consumers.
The EN50160:2000 report uses the following measurements:

• Supply voltage dips

• Temporary overvoltage

• Supply voltage unbalance

• Harmonic voltage

• Interharmonic voltage

• Frequency

• Voltage magnitude

• Flicker

• Short- and long-term interruptions

The compliance summary in the report is based on the EN50160 2000 limits for each observation
period.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Evaluation Limits

• Reporting Period

• Include EN50160 Configuration Parameters

• Include Data Warnings

• Source Label

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1287


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

1288 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1289


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

EN50160:2000 Mains Signaling

Summary

The EN50160:2000 Mains Signaling Report shows an analysis of the compliance of selected
sources based on the mains signaling specifications of the EN50160:2000 power quality standard.
Use this report for an analysis and compliance assessment of your facility against the
EN50160:2000 power quality standard.

NOTE: This report needs data from monitoring devices with EN50160:2000 monitoring
capabilities.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Sources

• Signaling Voltage

• Reporting Period

• Show Data Warnings

• Source Label

1290 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1291


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

EN50160:2010 Report

Summary

The EN50160:2010 Report shows an analysis of the compliance of selected sources based on the
EN50160:2010 power quality standard. Use this report for an analysis and compliance assessment
of your facility against the EN50160:2010 power quality standard.

NOTE: This report needs data from monitoring devices with EN50160:2010 monitoring
capabilities.

Details

EN50160:2010 is a set of power quality standards used by certain energy suppliers and energy
consumers.
The EN50160:2010 report uses the following measurements:

• Supply voltage dips

• Temporary overvoltage

• Supply voltage unbalance

• Harmonic voltage

• Interharmonic voltage

• Frequency

• Voltage magnitude

• Flicker

• Short- and long-term interruptions

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Prerequisites

The following firmware versions are required:

Device Firmware version


8650A_FAC_V4.2.0.0.1
ION8650 8650B_FAC_V4.2.0.0.1
8650C_FAC_V4.2.0.0.1
8000_FAC-PQ_V1.1.0.0.0
PM8000
8000_FAC_V1.1.0.0.0

Use the EN50160:2010 report template to create a report containing comprehensive analysis of all
EN50160 2010 compliance data logged by multiple meters. The compliance summary is based on
the EN50160 2010 limits for each observation period: each default EN50160 measurement
indicates a pass or did not pass on the compliance test with a Y (yes) or N (no) respectively.

1292 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Evaluation Limits

• Reporting Period

• Include EN50160 Configuration Parameters

• Include Data Warnings

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1293


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

EN50160:2010 Mains Signaling

Summary

The EN50160:2010 Mains Signaling Report shows an analysis of the compliance of selected
sources based on the mains signaling specifications of the EN50160:2010 power quality standard.
Use this report for an analysis and compliance assessment of your facility against the
EN50160:2010 power quality standard.

NOTE: This report needs data from monitoring devices with EN50160:2010 monitoring
capabilities.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Prerequisites

The following firmware versions are required:

Device Firmware version


8650A_FAC_V4.2.0.0.1
ION8650 8650B_FAC_V4.2.0.0.1
8650C_FAC_V4.2.0.0.1
8000_FAC-PQ_V1.1.0.0.0
PM8000
8000_FAC_V1.1.0.0.0

Use the EN50160:2010 Mains Signaling report template to create a report for signal line frequency
statistics for multiple sources, for each observation period.

Report inputs:

• Title

• Sources

• Signaling Voltage

• Reporting Period

• Show Data Warnings

1294 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1295


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Harmonic Compliance Report

Summary

The Harmonic Compliance Report shows an analysis of the harmonic compliance of selected
sources based on the IEEE 519-1992 standard. Use this report for an analysis and compliance
assessment of your facility against the IEEE 519-1992 harmonics standard.

NOTE: This report needs data from monitoring devices with IEEE 519-1992 monitoring
capabilities.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Reporting Period

• Comments

• Include THD/TDD Charts

• Include Average Harmonic Charts

• Include Harmonic Detail Charts

• Lock Chart Scales at Zero

• Show Data Warnings

Example:

1296 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1297


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1298 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1299


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Harmonic Compliance 2014 Report

Summary

The Harmonic Compliance 2014 Report shows an analysis of the harmonic compliance of selected
sources based on the IEEE 519-2014 standard. Use this report for an analysis and compliance
assessment of your facility against the IEEE 519-2014 harmonics standard.

NOTE: This report needs data from monitoring devices with IEEE 519-2014 monitoring
capabilities.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Reporting Period

• Comments

• Include THD/TDD Charts

• Include Average Harmonic Charts

• Include Harmonic Detail Charts

• Lock Chart Scales at Zero

• Show Data Warnings

Example:

1300 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1301


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1302 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1303


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1304 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

IEC61000-4-30 Report

Summary

The IEC61000-4-30 Report shows an analysis of power quality relevant measurements that were
taken in compliance with the IEC61000-4-30 standard. Use this report for a power quality analysis
of your facility based on the IEC61000-4-30 measurement standard.

NOTE: This report needs data from monitoring devices with IEC61000-4-30 monitoring
capabilities.

The IEC61000-4-30 report shows the following types of information:

• Voltage profile

• THD profile

• Unbalance profile

• Flicker profile

• Frequency profile

• Summary table

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Measurement Interval

• Voltage Nominal [V]

• Frequency Nominal [Hz]

• Voltage Baseline [%]

• THD Baseline [%]

• Frequency Baseline [%]

• Unbalance Baseline [%]

• Flicker Baseline - High

• Flicker Baseline - Low

• Reporting Period

• Source Label

• Show Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1305


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

1306 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1307


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1308 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1309


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Quality Report

Summary

The Power Quality Report shows the number and severity of voltage sags, swells, and transients
over a period of time. It includes waveform signatures and susceptibility curve plots, such as
CBEMA (1996), CBEMA (Updated), ITIC, or SEMI F47. Use this report to analyze power quality
(PQ) incidents, to assess possible impacts of PQ events on your facility or processes, and to help
identify causes of PQ events.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Incident Interval

• Reporting Period

• Source Label

• CBEMA (1996), CBEMA (Updated), ITIC, SEMI F47 curves

• Y-Axis Max Value (% Nominal)

• Sub-reports

• Show Data Warnings

Additional information about incident details and waveform details.

Incident details:

When you use the Generate Dynamically sub-reports option, you can view details of an incident by
clicking the link in the TimeStamp column in the table.
Detailed information about a single power quality incident is displayed, including:

• A CBEMA (1996), CBEMA (Updated), ITIC, or SEMI F47 curve containing the power quality
disturbances for the selected incident. (The curve used in the plot is dependent on the overlay
options you select for the report.)

• The timestamps, types, phases, duration, and magnitude of disturbances in the selected
incident, with the worst event in the selected incident highlighted (worst event = largest
magnitude x duration).

• The power quality settings of the device that registered the disturbance (for example, sag/swell
limits, transient threshold, and so on).

To return to the summary report, use the report section back button on the report toolbar.

Waveform details:

1310 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

When you use the Generate Dynamically sub-reports option, you can view the waveform details of
an incident by clicking the waveform icon in the incident details table in the Incident sub report.

The waveform details include all the waveforms that were recorded for a disturbance. It displays a
waveform chart along with an optional table with waveform values.
The following waveform plots and data are displayed, based on the timestamp selected:

• A summary waveform plot, displaying a plot of the V1, V2 and V3 waveforms.

• An individual waveform plot for each of:


V1 and I1

V2 and I2

V3 and I3

• If the source queried has digital input logging enabled over the time interval of the waveforms, a
waveform showing the digital input status.

• The timestamp for the time the waveforms were triggered.

• The sampling frequency of the waveforms.

To return to the summary report, use the report section back button on the report toolbar.

NOTE: For incident sub-reports with multiple events, some events might reference the same
waveform recording. This can happen if the time interval between events is very short. In that
case, the waveform and event trigger times for these events do not match exactly.

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1311


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1312 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1313


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

SARFI Report

Summary

The System Average RMS Variation Frequency Index (SARFI) Report shows the count of voltage
sags and / or swells for the selected sources based on the SARFI indices. Use this report to
analyze voltage sag and / or swell incidents, to assess possible impacts on your facility or
processes, and to help quantify the performance of power system.

Details

SARFI index is a power quality index that provides a count of voltage sags and / or swells for one or
more selected sources. There are two types of SARFI indices: SARFI-X and SARFI-Curve:

• SARFI-X corresponds to a count of voltage sags and / or swells below or above a specified
voltage threshold. This report supports the following SARFI-X indices:
SARFI 10

SARFI 50

SARFI 70

SARFI 80

SARFI 90

SARFI 110

SARFI 120

SARFI 140

For example, SARFI-70 counts the voltage sags that are below 70% of the reference
voltage. SARFI-110 counts the voltage swells that are above 110% of the reference
voltage. SARFI indices assess duration of RMS variation based on the selected duration.

• SARFI-Curve corresponds to a rate of voltage sags below an equipment compatibility curve.


This report supports the following SARFI Curves:
SARFI ITIC

SARFI SEMI

For example, SARFI ITIC counts voltage sags that are below the lower ITIC curve. SARFI
SEMI counts voltage sags that are below SEMI curve.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Reporting Period

• Source Filter

1314 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Duration (sec)

• Show Data Warnings

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1315


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Quality Analysis Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

Summary

The Power Quality Analysis Report shows power quality (PQ) summary information, such as
breakdowns of PQ event types, impact, and location. It also includes information on disturbances
(harmonics, unbalance, and so on) and power factor. Use this report to help you understand the
power quality in your facility, reduce downtime, and increase equipment reliability and availability.

Details

Depending on the events and disturbances you select, the generated report provides data
categorized as follows:

• Power Quality Event Summary, consisting of Power Quality Events Breakdown, Power
Quality Events Impact, and Power Quality Events Location.
Power Quality Events Breakdown shows the percent distribution of the events in a pie
chart.

Power Quality Events Impact shows a percent distribution of the events with a likely
impact and no impact in a pie chart.

Power Quality Events Location shows the distribution of the number of events in a bar chart
with likely impact and no impact identified for each of the External, Internal, and
Undetermined locations.

• Power Quality Events — Details, consisting of events impact and events location for each
detected event. and Disturbance Details for each detected disturbance.
Events Impact shows the number of each event type with a likely impact and no impact.

Events Location provides a distribution of the number of each event with a likely impact and
no impact in External, Internal, and Undetermined locations.

• Power Quality Disturbances — Details, consisting of a graphical representation of the


distribution for each disturbance followed by a data table containing measurement and value
details.

• Power Factor — Details, consisting of additional information on power quality disturbances.


The logged data represented in a trend chart is for each Incomer or main meter defined in the
PowerQualityGroups.csv file. The table below the chart shows Active and Reactive energy
data grouped by each power source meter. The red target line in the chart is set to 92 by default
on the report template page.

See Power Quality Performance events and disturbances for additional information.

Prerequisites

• The Power Quality Performance Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

1316 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Related

• Power Quality Impact Report – provides an estimated impact of production downtime.

• Power Quality Events Breakdown, Power Quality Events Impact, and Power Quality Events
Location gadgets – provide a graphical representation of power quality events.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources

• Reporting Period

• Include Events and Disturbances in the Detail Section

• Power Factor Target

• Include Non Impacting Events

• Include Data Tables in the Detail Section

• Include Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1317


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

1318 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1319


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1320 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Power Quality Impact Report

NOTE: This report is part of the Power Quality Performance Module. This Module requires a
separate license.

Summary

The Power Quality Impact Report shows the financial impact of power quality related downtime.
The impact calculations are based on a configurable, flat rate downtime cost. Use this report to see
the cost of power quality related events to your facility or processes.

Prerequisites

• The Power Quality Performance Module must be configured.

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Related

• Power Quality Impact gadget – provides a graphical representation of external. internal, and
undetermined power quality events.

• Power Quality Analysis Report– provides summarizes power quality events and disturbances
occurring in a production environment.

Report inputs

• Title

• Group

• Reporting Period

• Event Location

• Include Undetermined Events

• Include Data Warnings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1321


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1322 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Usage Trending Reports


PME includes the following usage trending report templates:

• Hourly Usage Report

• Multi Device Usage Report

• Multiple Trend Report

• Single Device Usage Report

• Trend Report

CAUTION
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment damage.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1323


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Hourly Usage Report

Summary

The Hourly Usage Report shows the consumption rate, per hour, of various types of utilities, such
as electricity, water, and so on, for different consumers for a specific day. Use this report to check
and analyze resource consumption in your facility or processes.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Reporting Period

• Target Line

• Source Label

• Include Data Table

• Include Chart

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Show Data Warnings.

1324 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1325


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Multi Device Usage Report

Summary

The Multi Device Usage Report shows daily consumption for various types of utilities, such as
electricity, water, and so on, for different consumers. Use this report to check and analyze resource
consumption in your facility or processes.

Details

NOTE: The measurements that you select for the devices need to provide equivalent data results.
For example:

• Correct:

Real Energy selected for MeterA


Real Energy into the Load selected for MeterB

• Incorrect:

Real Energy selected for MeterA


Reactive Energy selected for MeterA

The report provides a summary of consumption by one or more sources, an interval usage table, and
a pie chart.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Rollup

• Reporting Period

• Show Start & End Periods Only

• Source Label

• Chart Type

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Include Data Table

• Show Data Warnings

1326 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1327


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Multiple Trend Report

Summary

The Multiple Trend Report shows aggregated logged measurement data from multiple loads in a
tabular and visual display and as a trend plotted on separate axes. The aggregation intervals are
configurable. Use this report to compare different loads.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources Left and Right– see Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurements Left and Right– see Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Left Axis High Target Line and Right Axis High Target Line

• Left Axis High Target Name and Right Axis High Target Name

• Left Axis Low Target Line and Right Axis Low Target Line

• Left Axis Low Target Name and Right Axis Low Target Name

• Calculation Method Left and Right

• Reporting Period

• Rollup

• Chart Type

• Source Label

• Show Summary Data Table

• Show Detailed Data Table

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Auto Scale Second Y Axis

• Show Data Warnings

1328 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1329


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Single Device Usage Report

Summary

The Single Device Usage Report shows daily consumption of a certain type of utility, such as
electricity, water, and so on, for a certain consumer. It includes a trend display showing the daily
consumption side-by-side. Use this report to check and analyze resource consumption in your
facility or processes.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Single Source – see Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Rollup

• Reporting Period

• Source Label

• Show Start & End Periods Only

• Align Day of Week for Months

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Show Data Warnings

1330 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1331


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Trend Report

Summary

The Trend Report shows logged measurement data for multiple loads as a trend plot on the same
axis. Use this report to compare different loads.

Details

NOTE: The Trend Report is limited to 30 source-measurement pairs. Multiple reports are required
if the number of source-measurement pairs exceeds 30.

NOTE: The Trend Report was upgraded in Power Monitoring Expert 7.2.1 to include two new
parameters: Include Data Table and Include Duplicates.

Trend Reports with subscriptions created prior to version 7.2.1 need to be updated and saved with
the new parameters. To update a Trend Report:

• Open each saved Trend Report. The new parameters are visible in the display pane.

• Keep or change the default selections for the parameters.

• Save the updated report to overwrite the existing version.

Prerequisites

• The measurement data must be available as historical data logs in the database.

Report inputs

• Title

• Sources (Devices and Views)

• Measurements (with Smart Mode)

• Chart Type

• Reporting Period

• Source Label

• Target Line

• Auto-scale Y-Axis

• Include Data Table

• Include Duplicates

• Show Data Warnings.

1332 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1333


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: This example only shows selected content from the report, it does not show the entire
report.

1334 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

System integration
This section provides information on how to use Power Monitoring Expert with other EcoStruxure™
systems.

Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for:

Topic Content
Detailed configuration information on accessing data in an
Integration with EBO
integrated system of PME with EcoStruxure Building Operation.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1335


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Integration with EcoStruxure Building Operation - Operating


This chapter includes the following topics:

1. Accessing Dashboards and Slideshows

2. Accessing Reports

3. Accessing Alarms

4. Accessing EWS real-time values (only for Architecture 2 solutions)

5. Accessing device diagrams (only for Architecture 2 solutions)

NOTE: For these applications to display correctly in Building Operation WebStation, you must use
a supported Web browser version. See Operating Environment for details.

1336 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

1. Accessing Dashboards and Slideshows


See Dashboards for details on how to use dashboards and slideshows.

2. Accessing Reports
See Reports for details on how to use reports.

3. Accessing Alarms
Alarms are automatically transferred from PME to Building Operation through EWS, and appear with
all other alarms in the Alarms pane, when both the Interface and the Alarm Polling are enabled.

NOTE: To verify that the Interface and the Alarm Polling are enabled: In the System Tree, right-
click on the PME/EBO Integration > EWS Client folder, and then select Properties.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To view the Alarms for this client:

1. Log into Building Operation WorkStation

2. Scroll down to the Alarms viewer pane at the bottom of the dialog to see all active alarms,

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1337


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The Building Operation “Sum Alarm” is an ideal way to leverage alarms flowing from EWS. It allows
the users to create actions and notifications on filtered PME alarms. See the EcoStruxure Building
Operation System Reference Guide for more information.

1338 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

4. Accessing EWS real-time values (only for Architecture 2 solutions)


The PME/EBO Integration folder that you imported into Building Operation contains groups, devices
and measurements within the EWS Client folder.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To access EWS real-time values:

1. Log in to Building Operation WorkStation.

2. In the System Tree, navigate to the PME/EBO Integration folder and click the EWS Client
folder. The EWS Client tab appears.

3. Click the “+” icon next to each subfolder in the System Tree to expand the contents of each,
and then click on an item in the subfolder. The List View appears in the right pane and shows a
list of measurements for that item.

4. Double-click a device to view the complete list of measurements for that device.

5. In the EWS Client pane, right-click on a column heading, and then select Add/Remove
Columns.

6. Select the check box next to Value and EWS State. Now, the two new columns with data

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1339


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

appear.

NOTE: The default refresh rate for EWS values is set to 20 seconds.

NOTE: If you find that some measurements for a device are missing from the list of
measurements, do the following:
Confirm that all of the measurements you want for that device are exposed. See Modifying which
measurements EWS Server exposes by default for details. If all of the measurements you want for
the device are exposed but still do not appear in the list of measurements, repeat the procedure to
create and host the EWS interface. (PME takes some time between enabling the EWS server and
when the EWS client shows the exposed measurements.) See Creating and hosting the EWS
interface in Building Operation Workstation for details.

1340 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

5. Accessing device diagrams (only for Architecture 2 solutions)


You can access PME device diagrams from within Building Operation in order to view graphical data
for the device data you imported.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To access device diagrams

1. Log in to Building Operation WorkStation.

2. In the System Tree, navigate to PME/EBO Integration and click the Diagram Links folder. You
will find a list of Web Diagram links in the Diagram Links pane at the right for the default Web
Diagrams that you selected and exported with the web application Integration Utility settings.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1341


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. In the Diagram Links tab, double-click a Web Diagram file. The Web Diagram graphic opens
for this device.

4. Select the different tabs in the Web Diagram screen to view other data values for this device.

1342 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Trends

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

Use the Trends application to monitor current system conditions by displaying real-time data in a
graphical format. You can configure trends to view historical data, or you can combine real-time data
and historical data in the same trend. In addition, you can save the trend data as a csv file.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1343


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

A Title B Upper threshold C Lower threshold


D Target line E Left axis F Scale ( from View setting)
G Right axis H Axis title I Trend options
J Legend K Close/open toggle

TIP: You can open the Trends application from the TRENDS link in the Web Applications banner.

Time display
See Time Display in Web Applications for information on how time is displayed in a system where
the monitoring devices, the PME/Web server, and the Web client (browser) are located in different
time zones.

For information on how use the Trends application, see The Trends user interface.

For information on how to configure Trends, see Trends configuration.

1344 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Vista
Vista is the PME component that displays and controls your power monitoring system.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

For information on starting and logging on to Vista or ending your Vista session, see Getting started.

The Vista interface


The Vista interface consists of a main screen with a title bar, a menu bar, a toolbar, a workspace, a
status bar and (in Edit mode) a toolbox.

For information on opening or generating a Vista diagram, see Generating, opening and closing a
user diagram.

The following image illustrates the Vista interface with a user diagram showing real-time values.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1345


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

A Menu Bar B Toolbar C Workspace

Click to return to the Network


D Click a tab to display its data E F Status Bar
Diagram view

Click this grouping object to open another Receive/Transmit Status


G H Toolbox I
window containing more data indicators

Toolbar
The toolbar offers quick access to the commands that are used most frequently. Each command on
the toolbar is also available from the menus.

A Open G Cut
B Save H Copy
C Zoom I Paste
D Fit to window J Layout
Restore to
E K Up One Level
100%
Plot Selected
F L Help
Data

Zoom

Select View > Zoom In or click the Zoom button to change the mouse pointer to a crosshair. Use
this pointer to drag an outline around the area you want to enlarge.

1346 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Restore to 100%

Select View > Restore to 100% or click the Restore to 100% button to return to the normal view.

Fit to Window

Select View > Fit to Window or click the Fit to Window button to force the user diagram to fit in the
current window.

Up One Level

Select File > Up One Level or click the Up One Level button to return to the previously displayed
window. Note that this also closes the current window. If you want to be prompted when you reach
the top level of a diagram, make sure Options > Browse closes active window is selected.

Workspace
The main area in the center of the Vista screen is the workspace. The workspace is used to display
information such as user diagrams and data and event viewers.

Status Bar
The status bar displays:

• The status line, which describes any active processes and provides a brief description of the
currently selected command or toolbar button.

• The current time on the workstation.

• A progress indicator bar.

• Two communication status lights.

Toolbox
In Edit mode, the toolbox also appears on the screen. You can add objects to the user diagram using
the toolbox. See Creating and customizing a user diagram for more information on the toolbox and
Edit mode.

Other display features


Vistaoffers several display features to assist you when viewing a user diagram. Some of these are
accessible through the toolbar and menu options (see Toolbar). Those only accessible through
menu options are:

Browse closes active window

Select Options > Browse closes active window to have each window that you open replace the
previous one. This option is selected by default. Without this option selected, any previously
opened windows remain open.

Arrange All

Select Window > Arrange All to tile all open windows in the workspace.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1347


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Display mode and Edit mode


There are two display modes in Vista, which affect how you navigate a user diagram. Whether or
not the toolbox is shown indicates the mode you are in: if the toolbox is open, you are in edit mode; if
it is closed, you are in display mode.

• Display mode allows you to monitor your system, view system data, and control some aspects
of your system. In Display mode, single-click objects to view the information they contain or
perform their associated action.

• Edit mode allows you to configure the appearance and function of user diagrams and diagram
objects. In Edit mode, double-click objects to view the information they contain or perform their
associated action. Right-click the objects to view configuration options. See Creating and
customizing a user diagram and Customizing a diagram object for more information.

When instructed to click a diagram object, either single-click or double-click, depending on the mode
you are in.

Vista user diagrams


This section explains how to use Vista user diagrams to view real-time and logged data from your
power monitoring system. The information that you obtain from your Power Monitoring Expert
network is represented graphically in a user diagram.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

What is a user diagram?


A user diagram is a configurable display that consists of two main elements:

• Diagram objects are configurable graphic icons that display your system information. Each
diagram object displays a single piece of information from somewhere in your power monitoring
network. In some cases, diagram objects are stored within grouping windows.

• Grouping object: In some cases, a user diagram stores related information within a grouping
object. Click on a grouping object to open a grouping window and display its contents.

NOTE: To configure a grouping object to open a grouping window, see Specifying an action for
numeric, status, or grouping objects.

1348 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Grouping windows are a type of folder or “sub-window” that contain diagram objects. Vista
uses grouping windows to logically organize diagram objects within a user diagram. When
closed, a grouping window is usually represented by a grouping object icon.

TIP: It is better to use grouping objects to open other user diagrams rather than to open grouping
windows. Large numbers of grouping windows in a user diagram can slow the performance of
Vista.

You can create as many user diagrams as you want and edit each one to suit your needs. You can
share user diagrams with multiple users over your network, and users can view them
simultaneously and share the same information. For more information on creating user diagrams,
see Creating and customizing a user diagram.

Default user diagrams


Vista provides a set of pre-configured user diagrams that you can use to display data. These default
diagrams provide a standard set of options that you can use to access your device's most
commonly required functions.

The default diagram displays real-time data. It includes a simple power system illustration that
displays the various real-time parameters measured by the device.

Generating, opening and closing a user diagram


A user diagram is identified by its “.dgm” extension. You can generate, open, and close user
diagrams as needed.

Generating a network diagram

The network diagram displays your entire power monitoring system by linking to individual default
user diagrams that display data from each device in your system. When you generate a network
diagram, Vista automatically locates all devices in your system and displays them. This diagram is
saved with the default name “network.dgm”.

1. Select File > Generate Network Diagram.

The network diagram appears in the workspace containing icons that represent groups of
devices on your system.

2. Click on one of the grouping objects to open a window and display the node icons contained
within.

3. Click a node icon to display the user diagram for the associated device.

4. Save the network diagram.

NOTE: Regenerating a network diagram and saving it overwrites the previously saved
(network.dgm) file.

Opening a user diagram

To open a user diagram:

1. Select File > Open.

2. Navigate to the user diagram you want to open and select it from the Open Diagram dialog.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1349


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. Click Open to open the selected user diagram.

Specifying the user diagram that opens for a given user

To set a specific Vista workspace and set of diagrams to open every time a given user logs on:

1. Log on to Vista using the particular user’s logon credentials.

2. Organize Vista to appear as you want it to appear on startup.

3. Click Save, then close Vista.

4. Use Windows Explorer to navigate to the ...\Power Monitoring Expert\config\cfg\ud folder.

5. Locate the .wsu file for the user you are setting up (i.e., <username>.wsu). Right-click and
select Properties.

6. Select the Read-only attribute, then click OK.

NOTE: Applying the Read-only attribute prevents the workspace information from being modified,
so Vista opens the same way for a given user every time. The user can still modify and save user
diagrams (if allowed by their access level).

Closing a User Diagram

To close a user diagram:

• Select File > Close to close the current diagram.

• Select File > Close All to close all diagrams.

Navigating a user diagram


After you open a user diagram, you can use it to interact with your power monitoring system. Each
user diagram displays system information through diagram objects, which you can use to monitor
and control various aspects of your system.

Monitoring your system in Vista


Use Vista user diagrams to display real-time and logged data, monitor events and alarms, and
control a variety of system functions.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

1350 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

How data is displayed


Information in your user diagram is displayed using diagram objects. Each diagram object
communicates a single piece of information from somewhere in your power monitoring network; for
example, a single numeric object displays numeric data from a single source.

There are seven types of diagram objects: grouping, text, numeric, status, data log viewer, event
log viewer, and control. Each type of object performs a specific type of function.
In most cases, you can identify an object's function by a caption, a label, or both (the text object
does not use a caption or a label).

• By default, the caption is usually located below the diagram object and identifies the node to
which the diagram object is connected. The caption can be modified to display a custom
description. See Caption options for more information.

• When a label is used, it is usually displayed to one side of the diagram object. By default, the
label identifies the register (on the node) to which the diagram object is connected. The label
can be modified to display a custom label name. See Text options for more information.

TIP: To toggle between default labels and custom labels, select or clear Options > Show Default
Labels. You can identify the type of diagram object by pointing to it with the mouse. The object
type appears on the status line.

Identifying stale data


Real-time data that has not been refreshed is referred to as stale data. Vista detects stale data as it
occurs and identifies it with a colored border. By default, Vista identifies data as stale after 60
seconds. Position the mouse pointer over an object to display a ToolTip that explains why the data
has become stale.

The stale data settings are user-configurable on a per-diagram basis, and can be customized by
anyone with the necessary access level.

Changing the Stale Data settings

To change the amount of time (in seconds) that Vista uses to identify stale data:

1. Ensure that the Toolbox is open (Options > Show Toolbox), right-click the background of the
diagram and click Properties.

2. Click the Updates tab and change the settings in the Stale Data section.

3. Click OK.

Changing the flag settings for Stale Data

To change the flag color:

1. Click Options > Flag Colors.

2. Click the Edit button for the flag color you want to change, select the new color and click OK.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1351


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Identifying errors in communication


Vistadetects errors (such as disabled devices, security access restrictions, or configuration errors)
and identifies these with a colored border around an object (orange, by default). The border color can
be customized (see the previous section, Changing the flag settings for Stale Data). Position the
mouse pointer over an object that Vista is indicating has an error to display a ToolTip that explains
the error.

Increasing the timeout period of a Vista query


When Vista queries the ION_Data database, the query can timeout if the database is large.

To increase the timeout period of a Vista query, a new entry to the registry of ION_SERVER needs
to be created, and the Query Server connect timeout period needs to be increased.

NOTICE
IRREVERSIBLE OPERATING SYSTEM DAMAGE OR DATA CORRUPTION
Before making any changes, back up your Windows Registry in a network folder or other remote
location.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in irreparable damage to the operating
system of the computer and all existing data.

NOTE: Registry edits must be performed only by qualified and experienced personnel.

Increase the Vista query timeout

1. Select Start > Run and type regedit in the Run window to open the registry.

2. Navigate to HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring


Expert\x.x, where x.x is the version number.

If the component is run on a 64-bit operating system, navigate to:

HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Schneider Electric\Power
Monitoring Expert\x.x

3. Right-click an empty area in the pane on the right and select New > DWORD Value.

4. Name the new DWORD VistaQueryTimeout_s.

5. Right-click VistaQueryTimeout_s and select Modify.

6. Enter a value for the timeout period.

The timeout period is 60 (for 60 seconds) by default. You can increase the value to 120
initially. If timeouts still occur, modify the value to 180.

7. Select File > Exit to exit the registry editor.

NOTE: If your system installation includes Client machines running Vista, you need to update the
registry for each one.

1352 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Increase the Query Server timeout

1. Open the Power Monitoring Expert folder and double-click the Designer icon to start Designer.

2. Select File > Open > QUERYSERVER.host_name (where host_name is your workstation
name) to open the Query Server node.

3. Double-click the Query Modules grouping object, then right-click the query module to open its
setup dialog.

4. Select the Connection String setup register and click Modify.

5. Change Connect_Timeout from the default 60 to 120 (or 180 if necessary).

6. Save your change and restart the Query Server Service.

Viewing real-time data


Vista uses numeric objects and status objects to display real-time data. Numeric objects display
real-time numeric values and status objects display real-time Boolean (ON/OFF) information.

Viewing data with numeric objects


Vista uses numeric objects to display real-time numeric data from your power monitoring system.
Numeric objects can display many types of data, such as line voltage or current, power or energy
levels, harmonics, or demand parameters.

Depending on their configuration, numeric objects can display data in different formats:
alphanumeric, dial, horizontal or vertical bar, or scrolling graph.

See Customizing the display of a numeric object for more information on configuring numeric
objects.

Using flags on a numeric object


In some cases, a numeric object may use flags to indicate the low and high limits of the displayed
parameter.

When used on a dial display, flags appear as colored areas on the dial. When used on other types of
numeric objects, flags change the object's background color to indicate that a Low, Low Low, High,
or High High limit is currently exceeded. To view or change the default colors, select Options >
Flag Colors.

The following image depicts a Low Limit of 140, a Low Low Limit of 60, a High Limit of 260, and a
High High Limit of 340. The portion of the dial between 140 and 260 is transparent in Vista (the
background color fills that portion of the dial), and is white in the Web-based Diagrams application.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1353


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

TIP: If you need only Low Low and High High limits, set the Low limit equal to the Low Low limit
and the High limit equal to the High High limit.

Flag colors are stored in the workspace file on a per-user basis. They are configurable and can be
customized by anyone who has the necessary access level. See Display options for more
information on configuring flags.

Viewing data with status objects


Vista uses status objects to display Boolean (ON/OFF) conditions in your system. A status object
may display the status of a digital output (such as a relay), a digital input (status input), or a setpoint
in your system.

The default status object appears as an indicator light that changes color to indicate various
conditions. Gray indicates the status object is not linked or not receiving data.

Like most diagram objects, status objects can be modified by any user with an appropriate access
level. Depending on how a status object has been configured, its appearance and function can differ
significantly from the default settings.

You can specify that it appear as an alphanumeric display or you can select custom images
representing different conditions, for example for ON, OFF, and Unconnected. See Customizing the
display of a status object for more information.

NOTE: In some cases, the active state of a status object may have been changed (inverted) so
that an active state appears as inactive and vice versa. See Customizing a diagram object for
more information.

Viewing logged data


Data and events recorded by the devices in your system are regularly transferred by the Log Inserter
from each device to the database. Vista uses the ION Query Service to transfer this information
from the database to your workstation. Vista provides two ways to view logged data and events: the
Data Log Viewer and the Event Log Viewer.

• The Data Log Viewer displays data logs from all devices represented in the active user diagram.
You can use the Data Log Viewer to display waveform and trend data in tabular format. You can
also select a range of logs from the viewer and display the data graphically in the log view
plotter.

• The Event Log Viewer typically displays events and alarms from each device represented in the
active user diagram. The Event Log Viewer is used primarily to monitor low-priority events and
alarms associated with the active user diagram. Each Event Log Viewer is associated with a
single user diagram.

Using a Data Log Viewer


Use a Data Log Viewer to view system data stored in the database. Data Log Viewers display
historical trend data (from data recorders) and waveform data (from waveform recorders).

You can select any data displayed in a Data Log Viewer and plot it as a graph or copy it to another
application (for example, Microsoft Excel) where you can perform advanced calculations or include
it in a report.

1354 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

See Using the Query options for information on log viewer configuration.

Displaying a Data Log Viewer

Click on a Data Log Viewer object in your user diagram. The Data Log Viewer appears.

Each Data Log Viewer displays data as a table of columns and rows. Each labeled column contains
a single type of data and each numbered row represents a single data record.

Plotting a range of data from the Data Log Viewer


You can plot data from a Data Log Viewer in the Log View Plotter.

1. Highlight the cells containing the data that you want to plot. The range of data can be selected
in one of three ways:
To graph trends for all parameters over a particular time span, select a group of rows.

To graph the trend for a specific parameter using all available records, select the entire
column.

To graph multiple parameters over a specific time span, click on the first cell in the desired
range then drag to highlight the last cell of the range.

2. Select Edit > Plot Selected Data or click .

The Log View Plotter window appears, displaying a graphical representation of the selected data.
See Plotting logged data for more information.

TIP: To quickly plot a single waveform, double-click on its waveform symbol in the Data Log
Viewer.

Copying a selection to another application


1. Highlight the cells containing the data that you want to copy.

2. Select Edit > Copy or click . This copies the selection to the Windows Clipboard.

3. Switch to another application and paste the selection.

Using the Event Log Viewer


Events and alarms that occur in your system are recorded by the meter and transferred via Log
Inserter to the database.
Vista. Use the Event Log Viewer to view event records. The Event Log Viewer displays events and
alarms from the device(s) represented in the active user diagram. Use it to monitor low-priority
events and alarms associated with the active user diagram. The Event Log Viewer is associated
with a single user diagram, so alarms only update when the user diagram is open.

See Using the Query options for information on log viewer configuration.

Displaying an Event Log Viewer

Click an Event Log Viewer object in your user diagram to open the Event Log Viewer.

The Event Log Viewer displays logged events in a table of columns and rows. Each labeled column
contains a single category or event description and each numbered row represents a single event
record.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1355


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Typically, Event Log Viewers display the following information:

• Timestamp: This indicates the event’s date and time.

• Priority: This determines the relative significance of the event. Each type of event has a
numeric value assigned to it that represents its relative priority level.

• Cause: This is the label and value describing the cause of the event. For example, if the label is
“Setpoint #1” and the value is “Active,” then the event was caused by setpoint #1 changing to an
active state.

• Effect: This is the label and value describing the effect of the event. For example, if label is
“Relay #1” and the value is “Forced On,” then the effect of the event was to force relay #1 on.

• Ack Time: This is the date and time that an alarm was acknowledged.

NOTE: Because Event Log Viewers are associated with a single user diagram, they only update
when the user diagram is open. All Event Log Viewers need to be re-opened if a diagram is closed
or the software is shut down.

Acknowledging alarms
Every type of event has a prioritized value that identifies its relative significance on a scale of 0
(zero) to 255. By default, Vista identifies any event with a priority of 128 (default) or greater as an
alarm.

The event record is highlighted in red, and identified under the Ack Time column as "ALARM". The
Cause column lists the source of the alarm and the Effect column describes the event.

By default, Vista plays a "beep" to annunciate an event with a priority range of 128-191, and a beep
combined with a flashing display to annunciate an event with a priority range of 192-255. To
customize these options, see Alarming options.

When you acknowledge an alarm, Vista records the time the alarm was acknowledged (in the Ack
Time column) and your user ID (in the User Name column).

The alarm acknowledgement function is also available in the Alarms application in the Web
Applications component. See the online help for the Alarms application for information about
acknowledging alarms.

NOTE: In some cases, your access level may not be sufficient to acknowledge an alarm; for
example, a critical alarm may require Supervisor access. This is a user-configurable option. See
Alarming options for more information.

Acknowledging an alarm
1. Open an Event Log Viewer, then do one of the following:
To acknowledge a single alarm, click the word ALARM in the Ack Time column or
highlight the row containing the alarm.

To acknowledge all alarms to date, click the Ack Time column heading.

A confirmation box appears, asking if you want to acknowledge the selected alarms.

2. Select Yes to acknowledge the alarms or No to cancel.

1356 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

If you acknowledge the alarm but do not have a sufficient access level, the alarm remains
unacknowledged and the message "Insufficient Authorization" appears in the status line.

NOTE: When an alarm has been acknowledged in the Web-based Alarms application, and you
view the entry in the Event Log Viewer, the Ack Time and User Name columns are populated
with the appropriate acknowledgement entries for the ON value. However, these columns remain
blank for the related OFF value even though the alarm has been acknowledged.

Silencing alarms
If you are not ready or able to acknowledge an alarm, you can silence it until it can be acknowledged
by selecting Options > Silence Outstanding Alarms.

NOTE: Acknowledging an alarm does not change the operating condition that caused the alarm.
You must ensure that the cause is corrected to remove the alarm condition.

Viewing user diagram of devices with security


You can view the user diagram of devices with security settings enabled in Vista.

To view user diagram in Vista for devices with standard security enabled,

1. Select File > Generate Network Diagram.

The network diagram appears in the workspace containing icons that represent groups of
devices on your system.

2. Click on one of the grouping objects to open a window and display the node icons contained
within.

3. Click a node icon to display the user diagram for the associated device.

NOTE: To perform any control object function, enter the device password. The user name is set to
default. Refer for Controlling system functions more information. If user name is prompted when
performing any control object function, then refer to Changes in security settings of device for
more information.

To view user diagram in Vista for devices with advanced security enabled,

1. Select File > Generate Network Diagram.

The network diagram appears in the workspace containing icons that represent groups of
devices on your system.

2. Click on one of the grouping objects to open a window and display the node icons contained
within.

3. Click a node icon to display the user diagram for the associated device.

4. Enter the user name and password of the device.

NOTE: All control object functions can be performed without entering credentials.

Controlling system functions


You can use control objects to send commands from Vista to a node.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1357


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

Each control object in your user diagram is configured to perform a single function. When you click a
control object, it performs the specified function. For example, you could click a control object to
clear an energy accumulator, toggle a relay, reset a counter, or adjust the value of an analog output
device.

The default appearance of a control object depends on the function it has been configured to
perform:

Boolean Pulse Numeric

Regardless of their appearance, all control objects are used the same way—to use a control object,
click it.

NOTE: For information on configuring the message, appearance and access level of control
objects, see Customizing the action for a control object and Customizing the display of a control
object.

When you click on a control object, one of the following happens, depending on how the control
object is configured:

• Vista performs the specified action immediately.

• Vista displays a confirmation message. Click Yes to proceed or No to cancel the operation.

• Vista requests a password. Type the logon password then click OK to proceed.

Depending on the function, a dialog prompting for the meter password may also open. If so, type the
meter password then click OK to proceed.

NOTE: There can be a time delay until Vista displays a new control value or state after it has been
written to the device.

Plotting logged data


This section describes how to use and customize the Log View Plotter to view logged data in a
graphical representation. Use the Log View Plotter to graphically show trends in numeric data,
display logged waveforms, display phasor diagrams, and perform harmonics analysis on waveform
data. You can also plot Sag/Swell voltage disturbances and compare them to industry standard
voltage tolerance curves (such as the CBEMA/ITIC curve).

1358 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

TIP: You can copy information displayed by Vista Log Viewers to the Windows Clipboard and
paste it into other Windows applications.

Plotting logged data

NOTE: To plot high speed transient waveforms, use the Web Applications waveform viewer in
Diagrams or Alarms. High speed transient waveforms cannot be displayed correctly in Vista.

1. Select data from a data log viewer:


To graph trends for all parameters over a particular time span, select a group of rows.

To graph a trend for a specific parameter using all available records, select an entire
column.

To graph multiple parameters over a specific time span, select the first cell in the desired
range and drag to highlight to the last cell of the range.

2. Select Edit > Plot Selected Data or click .

Vistaplots the data and displays it in the Log View Plotter window.

The Log View Plotter interface


The Log View Plotter is a Vista window that graphically displays selected data.

The default display is the Plot Display tab. Depending on the type of data selected, the Log View
Plotter may also offer a Harmonics Analysis tab and a Phasor Diagram tab.

In all cases, the Log View Plotter offers additional information in two floating boxes: the Legend and
the Calculations window.

The Legend
Each line or bar in the graph is represented by a pattern of the same color in the legend.

TIP: Click on the curve sample in the legend to select its equivalent in the graph.

Displaying the Legend

1. Right-click the background of the Log View Plotter window.

2. Select Graph Options in the menu to open the Graph Options dialog.

3. Select the Show legend check box then click OK.

The Calculations window


The Log View Plotter calculates several values for every line or bar in the graph. You can view the
results of these calculations in the Calculations window.

The Calculations window updates automatically, displaying a range of calculated values based on
the currently selected parameter. By default, all values displayed in the Calculations window are
calculated from the first parameter. To view the calculations for a different parameter, select the line
or bar you want.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1359


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For example, to view the calculations for a curve on the Plot Display tab, click on the curve line in
the graph or on its line pattern in the legend. When you click a different tab, the Calculations window
displays the values relevant to that tab.

Displaying the Calculations Window

1. Right-click the background of the Log View Plotter window.

2. Select Graph Options from the menu to open the Graph Options dialog.

3. Select the Show calculations check box then click OK.

Changing graph options


When using the Log View Plotter, you can adjust the graph options to change the title of a graph or
the way data is displayed.

1. Right-click the graph background then select Graph Options. The Graph Options box
appears.
Type a name for the graph in the Title box. This name appears in the title bar of the Log
View Plotter window. The default is Log View Plotter.

Select or clear the Show legend and Show calculations check boxes to show or hide
the legend and Calculations window.

Select the Align triggers check box to align the trigger times of all waveforms in the
graph. (When multiple waveforms are plotted, their trigger times may not always be
correlated.)

Select Separate curves vertically to display each curve separately.

NOTE: See Calculating Harmonics using more than one cycle for more information on the
System Frequency and # of cycles for harmonics options.

2. Click OK to save your changes.

Displaying curve data in a table


After you plot data in the Log View Plotter, you can select a curve and display its data points in a
table. This option is only available on the Plot Display and Harmonic Analysis tabs.

1. Right-click the curve line in the Plot Display or Harmonic Analysis tab and select Data from
the menu.
Plot Display tab: The data points are displayed. The X column lists the x-axis
coordinates and the Y column lists the y-axis coordinates. The first column (#) assigns a
number to each set of points.

Harmonic Analysis tab: A window appears listing each harmonic number and the
magnitude of each harmonic for each parameter. The first column numbers the rows. The
X column lists the harmonics number and the Y1, Y2, Y3, etc., columns list the harmonic
values for each bar in the harmonics histogram. Rows where the X value is not an integer
(i.e., .5, 1.5, 2.25) contain sub-harmonic values.

2. Click Format to change the number of significant digits displayed in the X and Y columns or to
change the width of these columns.

1360 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Width defines the number of characters the column can display.

Precision defines the number of significant digits displayed.

3. Click Copy to copy columns to the clipboard. This allows you paste a copy of the data into
another application, such as a spreadsheet program or a text file.

NOTE: The Log View Plotter can only display one data table at a time. If you want to display
tabular data for another curve (from the same graph or a different one), you must first close any
open data window.

Viewing the Plot Display tab


The Plot Display tab depicts the specified parameters as curves against a graph.

Each parameter is plotted in a different color. The legend identifies the color of each curve in the
selection and what it represents. Click on a curve to select it or right-click it to display additional
options. The timestamp at the top of the tab identifies the first point in the selected curve.

The vertical axis (y-axis) represents the specified range; the horizontal axis (x-axis) represents
time. Vista automatically adjusts the scale of the y-axis and x-axis to accommodate the largest
parameter(s) in the selection. Right-click either axis to change the scale of its properties; right-click
the axis numbers to change their format.

The time unit indicator in the lower right corner identifies the time scale of the x-axis (for example,
“h” indicates an hourly scale). Possible time scale units include months, days, hours, minutes, and
seconds.

Zooming in on the Plot Display tab

To zoom in on the Plot Display tab, click on the Zoom button then drag a selection box around
the area you want to view. To view the entire plot, click the Restore to 100% button .

Calculations window parameters for the Plot Display tab

The Calculations window updates automatically, displaying the following values for the currently
selected curve:

Value Label Description


Cursor 1 The timestamp and the y-value of the selected curve at Cursor 1.
Cursor 2 The timestamp and the y-value of the selected curve at Cursor 2.
The time difference between Cursor 1 and Cursor 2, and the
Delta C
difference between the y-values at Cursor 1 and at Cursor 2.
Min The minimum value of the selected curve between the two cursors.
Max The maximum value of the selected curve between the two cursors.
The maximum peak-to-peak value of the selected curve between
dpeak
the two cursors (Max-Min).
Avg1 The average value of the selected curve between the two cursors.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1361


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Value Label Description


The root-mean-square value of the selected curve between the two
RMS1
cursors.
The integration of the selected curve between the two cursors with
Int(H)1 respect to time in hours (for example, if the curve is in kW, the
information is displayed in kWh.)

1 The last three values (Avg, RMS, INT(H)) on the Calculations window are only available on plots
where the x-axis represents time. They are not offered on other types of plots (for example, CBEMA
plots).

Both numeric data and waveform data can be plotted in the same graph. On waveform plots, the
trigger time is represented by a red vertical line.

Using the cursor lines


There are vertical cursor lines at either end of the curves in the Log View Plotter. These cursor lines
define the start and end points used by the Calculations window. By default, Cursor 1 is located on
the leftmost point of the selected curve and Cursor 2 on the rightmost point.

To define a new start point, drag Cursor 1 along the curve to the new start point. Repeat this
procedure with Cursor 2 to define a new end point. You can also use the arrow keys to move the
active cursor left or right. The active cursor is identified by a small box that appears where the
cursor line meets the curve. Use the TAB key to switch the active cursor between Cursor 1 and
Cursor 2.

As the cursor line moves from point to point along the curve, the information in the Calculations
window is updated. You cannot drag Cursor 1 past Cursor 2 or vice versa.

De-indexing parameters and specifying Y-offsets


If you are plotting multiple parameters with different magnitudes, the lower magnitude values may
be difficult to see in the default graph. Vista allows you to index any parameter to a different axis
that can be scaled and offset independently from the other axes.

The new axis automatically assumes a scale appropriate for the selected parameter. In this way,
you can plot parameters of different magnitudes on the same graph (such as voltage and current).

De-indexing a parameter or offsetting a parameter on the Y-axis

1. Right-click the graph background to display the menu. In the last section of the menu, highlight
the curve you want to change.

The curve's sub-menu appears. (You can also access the sub-menu directly by right-clicking
on the parameter curve or on its curve sample in the legend.)

2. Select Options from the sub-menu to open the Curve Option dialog.

1362 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

3. Choose one of the four axis options for the selected parameter. The axis is indicated by the
location of the tick marks.

Specify a Y-offset if required. This shifts the selected parameter up the y-axis (or down for a
negative number) by the amount you specify.

4. Click OK. A new axis appears with a default title and a scale appropriate for the selected
parameter.

The scale of the default axis can also be adjusted to accommodate the remaining curves. A
parameter has an asterisk after it in the legend if it has been offset.

Repeat these steps for each parameter that you want to de-index from the default axis. You can
assign more than one parameter to an axis and the scale adjusts accordingly to incorporate each
new parameter. For example, if you have plotted three voltage parameters and three current
parameters, you can select the current curves and assign each of them to another common axis,
leaving the three voltage curves to share the default axis.

Displaying Power Factor data


If you have plotted power factor data (from historical logs) in the Log View Plotter, you can improve
the display to avoid discontinuity by setting the vertical axis to Power Factor Display (-100,+100).

Setting any vertical axis for Power Factor display

1. Right-click the vertical axis or right-click the graph background and select the axis after you
have plotted the power factor data.

2. Select Power Factor Display from the menu. A check mark appears beside the option to
indicate that it is selected.

You can plot other non-power factor data on the same graph; however, you should not plot the new
data on the same axis as the power factor data. De-index the new data on a separate axis as
described in De-indexing a parameter or offsetting a parameter on the Y-axis.

Viewing the Harmonics Analysis tab


If any of the parameters you have plotted is a waveform, you can display a histogram of the signal's
harmonic content by selecting the Harmonics tab on the Log View Plotter window. The resulting
histogram shows the harmonics for all waveforms in the plot.

NOTE: The cycle used is the first full cycle to the right of Cursor 1on the Plot Display tab.

The total harmonic distortion (THD), K-factor and Crest factor values for this waveform are
displayed in the Calculations window.

To view the calculations for another parameter, click on it in the graph or on its curve sample in the
legend. The Calculations window updates automatically. The currently selected parameter is
indicated above the calculations.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1363


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Calculating Harmonics using more than one cycle

By default, the harmonics are calculated using one cycle. You can increase the number of cycles by
any power of two cycles (i.e., 2, 4, 8, 16, 32 or 64) up to the maximum number of cycles available for
the waveform.

1. Right-click the background of the graph area then select Graph Options to open the Graph
Options dialog.

2. Select the number of cycles over which harmonics calculations are to be performed from the
“# of cycles for harmonics” list.

3. Select the appropriate frequency in the “System Frequency” box, if the waveform you are
analyzing came from a system with a frequency other than 50Hz or 60Hz. (For example, if the
waveform was captured from a 400 Hz system using a 3710 ACM, specify “400Hz” in this
box.)

NOTE: The Harmonics Analysis tab is only available for waveform records. Vista does not
perform a harmonics analysis for trend data or for waveforms with less than eight samples per
cycle. You cannot display the harmonics of more than 16 parameters at a time.

Viewing the Phasor Diagram tab


If you have plotted waveforms for all three voltages and/or currents of your system, you can view
this information as a phasor diagram. The phasor diagram graphically displays the three phases
(voltages and/or currents), showing their relative magnitudes and angles.

You can use a phasor diagram to evaluate important aspects of your power system such as voltage
balance, per-phase loading, and type of load (or generator operating mode). A phasor diagram also
provides a way to identify PT or CT wiring problems.

NOTE: The timestamp at the top of the Phasor Diagram tab is based on the time of Cursor 1 on the
Plot Display tab.

To display a phasor diagram, select the Phasor Diagram tab from the Log View Plotter window.

The Phasor Diagram and calculations are derived from a one-cycle window starting at Cursor 1 on
the Plot Display tab. The magnitude and angle of the selected phase is displayed in the Calculations
window.

NOTE: The Log View Plotter conforms to the convention where all phasors are plotted with
respect to V1 (always at 0°) and rotate in a positive counter-clockwise direction. On a balanced
power system, all three phases should appear 120 degrees apart.

To edit a phasor displayed on a phasor diagram, right-click a parameter in the legend to display a
menu where you can change the phasor's color or delete the phasor from the diagram.

Symmetrical components
The Log View Plotter calculates the symmetrical components of your power system — the positive,
negative, and zero sequences relative to the first phase — for the cycle selected. If you have plotted

1364 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

waveforms for three voltages and/or currents, you can access their symmetrical component
calculations. To produce correct symmetrical components, the waveforms must have been plotted
in the correct order (for example, V1, V2, V3 — not V1, V3, V2).

The analysis of an unbalanced system, such as determining the effects of a system fault, is made
simpler by using symmetrical components. Symmetrical components are a mathematical tool that
allows any system of three unbalanced phasors to be represented by three balanced phasor
systems. The total current or voltage in any phase wire is expressed as the sum of three balanced,
three-phase components.

Positive Sequence Components (1) - these consist of three phasors that are equal in magnitude and
displaced from each other by 120º and have the same phase sequence as the original phasors.

Negative Sequence Components (2) - these consist of three phasors that are equal in magnitude
and displaced from each other by 120º and have the phase sequence opposite to that of the original
phasors.

Zero Sequence Components (0) - these consist of three phasors that are equal in magnitude and
with zero phase displacement from each other.
If the original phasors of voltages are Va, Vb, and Vc, then the symmetrical components would be
as follows:

• Va = Va1 + Va2 + Va0

• Vb = Vb1 + Vb2 + Vb0

• Vc = Vc1 + Vc2 + Vc0

The symmetrical components function, as implemented inside some ION meters, is useful for
steady state analysis (unbalance), since the parameters are updated every second. However, when
determining the symmetrical components during a fault, per-cycle analysis is required. For this
application, you do not need real-time updates from the meter, because you are only interested in
the relatively short time before, during, and after a system fault. This information is contained in the
waveforms recorded when triggered by a disturbance.

Viewing symmetrical components

1. From a waveform Data Log Viewer (such as Waveforms/Sequence of Events), select all three
phases of a fault (voltage or current).

2. Select Edit > Plot Selected Data.

3. Drag the Cursor and move it to the location of the fault.

4. Click on the Phasor Diagram tab to view the Symmetrical Components in the Calculations
window.

Plotting waveforms from devices with high sampling rates


Waveforms from devices with high sampling rates can be quite large. These large waveforms are
split into a series of smaller waveforms when displayed in the data log. To plot all the sections of the
waveform in Vista, you must select all the rows that relate to the waveform before you click the Plot
button. All the rows related to the one waveform have the same timestamp.

When the waveform is displayed, you may need to zoom in to view the area of the waveform you
are interested in. To zoom in, drag a selection box around the area you are interested in.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1365


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: To plot high speed transient waveforms, use the Web Applications waveform viewer in
Diagrams or Alarms. High speed transient waveforms cannot be displayed correctly in Vista.

Adding parameters to a Log View Plotter


After you have created a graph and the Log View Plotter window is visible, you can add additional
parameters to the graph by copying and pasting them into the graph. These parameters can be
copied from the same data log viewer, a different data log viewer, or from a different Windows
application such as Microsoft Excel. The x and y-axes are automatically re-scaled to accommodate
the new parameters.

When adding waveforms to the log view plotter, you can correlate all of their trigger times. See
Overlaying curves in the Log View Plotter for more information.

Adding data from a Data Log Viewer


You can add additional parameters from any data log viewer configured to provide compatible time-
based data. Any added parameter is plotted using the same x-axis used by the existing curves. To
avoid confusion ensure that the column you selected for your x-axis in the data log viewer (from
which you are adding data) contains the same parameter (typically a timestamp) as the original data
log viewer.

Adding additional parameters from a Data Log Viewer

1. Select the range of cells you want to plot. Ensure that it contains the same type of information
(timestamps) as the data already being plotted.

2. Select Edit > Copy.

3. Click on the title bar of the existing Log View Plotter window then select Edit > Paste. The
parameters you selected are added to the graph.

If you want to plot waveforms on the same graph as historical data, the historical data should
originate from high-speed data recorders and span a short time range, typically a few waveform
cycles (<1 second).

Adding events from an Event Log Viewer


You can add events to a waveform or trend plot. This is useful for comparing abnormalities of the
waveform or trend shape with any corresponding events that happened in the same time period.

1. Select the row(s) you want to add in the Event Log Viewer.

2. Select Edit > Copy.

3. Click on the title bar of the existing Log View Plotter window then select Edit > Paste. The
copied event records are added to the graph.

Each event is represented in the Log View Plotter as a diamond symbol. A diamond symbol is
added to the legend and diamond symbols appear at the appropriate areas along the top of the
diagram.

Point to a diamond symbol to display a description of the event in the status bar at the bottom of the
screen.

1366 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Adding data from a spreadsheet or text file


You can select data from a spreadsheet or text file and paste it into an existing graph. This is useful
if you want to compare trends from different times, waveforms showing different system events,
and other analysis applications.

Ensure that the first column of data in the spreadsheet or text file is the same type as the first
column in the data log viewer from which the log plot originated. In particular, for timestamps, make
sure the entire timestamp is contained in a single column and that it uses the same date and time
format as defined in the Windows Control Panel. If the date portion of the timestamp is in one
column and the time is in another, or if the format is different in any way, the data cannot be pasted
into the Log View Plotter.

When you paste data into a graph, from both spreadsheets and text files, the Log View Plotter
interprets the first row of data in the selection as a heading. The first row in your selection is used to
label the parameter in the legend. So, if the first row is not already used for column headings, insert
a row and type in the label you want to appear in the Log View Plotter.

To copy data from a text file, the text file must be formatted correctly. Each column in the text file
must be separated by a tab and there must be a hard return at the end of each row.

Adding data to a graph from a spreadsheet or text file

1. Open the spreadsheet or text file.

2. Copy the range of values you want to plot, including the first column and the first row. Include
other columns in your selection, if required.

3. Click on the title bar of the Log View Plotter window then select Edit > Paste.

The parameters you copied and pasted are added to the graph. The axis scales are adjusted
automatically to include the new data.

You can define a trigger for waveform records containing timestamps when you copy records from
other applications. Simply add an exclamation mark to the end of the timestamp to indicate that it is
the trigger time. For example, the exclamation mark at the end of 22/05/2015@02:00:41.035 PM!
indicates that the trigger occurred at this time.

Customizing the Log View Plotter display


Many display attributes for each curve can be adjusted. In most cases, if you right-click an area of
the graph, either a menu or a dialog opens with configuration options. Unless otherwise noted, the
options you specify for the Log View Plotter window are saved and restored every time you plot data
from the original data log viewer. If you plot data from a different data log viewer, its graph has its
own optional settings.

Customizing an axis
After you have plotted data in the Log View Plotter, use the following instructions customize the
axis or gridlines, change an axis label’s format or add an axis title, or change the font or color used
on all axes. You can also change the scale of an axis.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1367


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring an axis

1. Right-click the graph background to display the menu. Highlight the axis from the menu to
reveal the sub-menu. You can also right-click the axis to access the sub-menu directly.

2. Select Axis Properties from the sub-menu to open a dialog with the following options.
Range: Make changes in the From and To boxes to adjust the axis range.

Ticks: Make changes in the Major every and Sub-divided by boxes to adjust the
frequency of major and minor ticks respectively.

Grid: Select or clear the Major and Minor check boxes to turn graph gridlines on or off.
Click the Style buttons to change to the line style or width of major and minor gridlines.

Logarithmic scale: Select this check box to enable the logarithmic scale option.

Line: Click this button to display the Line Parameters dialog and change the line style or
the width of the axis.

3. Click OK to save your changes.

NOTE: The axis range and the frequency of the major ticks are not stored in the diagram but are
recalculated for every new plot.

Changing the color of an axis or the gridlines

1. Right-click the graph background to display the menu. Highlight the axis from the menu to
reveal the sub-menu. You can also right-click the axis to access the sub-menu directly.

2. Select Axis Color, Major Grid Color, or Minor Grid Color from the sub-menu to open the
Color dialog.

3. Select the color you want or click Define Custom Colors for more options.

4. Click OK to save your changes.

The axis or the major or minor gridlines change to the color you selected.

Changing the format of the axis labels or adding an axis title

1. Right-click the graph background to display the menu. Highlight the axis from the menu to
reveal the sub-menu. You can also right-click the axis labels to access the sub-menu directly.

2. Select Axis Labels from the sub-menu to open the Axis Labels dialog.

3. Select the format in which you want the axis labels to appear.

Decimal is used by default (for example, .01, .02, .03) but if the labels are too large or too
small, select Scientific (1.0 x 10-2, 2.0 x 10-2, 3.0 x 10-2...) or Engineering (1m, 2m, 3m...).

4. Determine the axis title: select None to have no axis title or Text to enter your own title.

For time-based plots, the default x-axis title is “s” if the timestamps of the data spans a
number of seconds, “mn” for minutes, “h” for hours, “d” for days, “m” for months. (This applies
to the Plot Display tab only.)

1368 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

For non time-based plots (CBEMA or harmonics), you can change the title. Select Text and
type the title in the edit box. The title must be nine characters or less.

5. Click OK to save your changes.

NOTE: If the first column of the source data includes a space or @ sign, the Log View Plotter
assumes time on the horizontal axis and automatically determines the units based on timestamp
information. The axis title is updated whenever the window is updated.

Changing the font used on all axes

1. Right-click anywhere in the graph background and select Graph Font to open the Font dialog.

2. Specify the font, style, size, effects and color options that you want to use for the axes labels.

3. Click OK to save your changes.

Customizing curve style


When displaying multiple parameters, Vista distinguishes between parameters using color. Each
parameter is listed in the graph legend accompanied by a sample of its associated curve. The color
of a curve can be changed after you have plotted data in the Log View Plotter.

If color is not enough to distinguish one curve from another—for example, if you plan to print the
graph on a black and white printer—you can change the curve style after you have plotted data in
the Log View Plotter.
By default:

• Each curve is shown by a thin line that connects each point of data. You can customize the
style of each curve independently and show or hide the coordinates of each data point.

• Harmonics are displayed in a bar graph. You can distinguish between parameters by
customizing the display style of each parameter. Display options include bar type, hatching,
width and color.

Use the following instructions to customize curve styles, bar styles, and curve colors.

Changing the style of a curve on the Plot Display tab

1. Right-click the graph background to display the menu. Highlight the curve from the menu to
reveal the sub-menu. You can also right-click the parameter curve in the diagram or its entry in
the legend to access the sub-menu directly.

2. Select Curve Properties from the sub-menu to open the Curve Style dialog.
Select the type of curve you want from the Type list. Vista offers seven curve types: a
simple line, a line with symbols, a scatter plot of markers, horizontal or vertical bars, or 3-
D horizontal or vertical bars.

Select Spline (available for Line or Line + Symbol types) if you want the line that connects
each point to be a smooth curve. If you leave it cleared, each pair of points is connected
by a straight line.

Select Fill Area (available for Line type) to fill the area under the curve with the line color.
Clear the check box to leave the area under the curve transparent.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1369


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The Marker section is available for Line + Symbol and Scattered types of lines. Specify
the shape, size, and style of the marker used for the points. The Style options apply only
to geometric shapes (for example, circles, boxes, diamonds, etc.).

For any line type, click Line to change the width and the style (for example, solid, dotted,
dashed, etc.) of the line. For bar graph types, a dialog opens where you can specify the
hatching pattern and the width of the bars.

3. Click OK to save your changes.

Changing the bar style for the Harmonics Analysis tab

1. Right-click the bar (or on its curve sample in the legend) and select Curve Properties to open
the Bar Graph Configuration dialog.

2. Select the type of bar to use from the Type list. This selection is applied to all bars in the
graph. Three bar styles are available:
Group Bars: Shows bars side-by-side

Deep Bars: Shows bars one behind the other

Stacked Bars: Shows bars stacked one on top of the other vertically

3. Select a hatching style for the selected bar from the Hatching list. This selection is applied to
the currently selected bar only.

4. Set how wide you want each bar to be in the Width text box. The specified width is applied to
all bars in the graph. The default depends upon the number of parameters.

5. Click OK to save your changes.

Changing the color of a curve

1. Right-click the graph background to display the menu. Highlight the curve from the menu to
reveal the sub-menu. You can also right-click the curve in the diagram or its entry in the legend
to access the sub-menu directly.

2. Select Curve Color from the sub-menu to open the Color dialog.

3. Select the color you want or click Define Custom Colors for more options.

4. Click OK. The curve changes to the color you selected.

Customizing graph and legend options


After you have plotted data in the Log View Plotter, you can change the color of the graphing area
(and the legend) and define a font for the legend.

Changing the color of the graphing area

1. Right-click anywhere in the graph background and select Background Color to open the
Color dialog.

2. Select the color you want or click Define Custom Colors for more options.

3. Click OK. The graphing area changes to the specified color.

1370 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Changing the font used in the legend

1. Right-click the background of the legend to open the Font dialog.

2. Specify the font, style, size, effects, and color options that you want to use for the legend text.

3. Click OK to save your changes.

Removing graph parameters


After you have plotted data in the Log View Plotter, you can remove a parameter from the graph.

1. Right-click the graph background to display the menu. Highlight the curve you want to remove
from the menu to reveal the sub-menu. You can also right-click the curve in the diagram or its
entry in the legend to access the sub-menu directly by right-clicking on the curve.

2. Select Delete Curve from the sub-menu. The curve is deleted without further prompting.

Overlaying curves in the Log View Plotter


After you plot data in the Log View Plotter, you can overlay a curve onto your graph to help analyze
sag/swell data. This applies to devices that measure disturbances in voltage and store the
magnitude and duration of these disturbances. When these values are inserted into the ION_Data
database, they provide a series of coordinates that can be plotted on a voltage tolerance curve. A
voltage tolerance curve is often used to categorize the severity of a voltage disturbance.

NOTE: Most Vista queries are plotted against timestamps (with the timestamp as the x-axis);
however, any query that uses the ION Sag/Swell module must be plotted against duration. When
plotting sag/swell data, select Duration as the X-parameter of the Log View Plotter.

Vista provides common curves or voltage tolerance envelopes that can be used as overlays in the
Log View Plotter:

• CBEMA/ITIC: These curves (for CBEMA, described by the IEEE standard 446-1987, and for
ITIC, described by the IEEE 1100-1999 standard) define an upper and a lower bound on the
types of disturbances that electrical equipment is likely to tolerate. It plots disturbance
magnitude against disturbance duration and indicates at what points a voltage disturbance is
likely to disrupt or damage equipment. Points near or outside the voltage tolerance envelope
indicate events that could interrupt or damage electrical equipment.

• SEMI F47-0200: This specification defines the voltage sag tolerance capability required for
semiconductor processing equipment, though it is now used by other industries. According to
the specification, equipment must tolerate sags to 50% of nominal voltage for up to 200
milliseconds, sags to 70% of nominal voltage for up to 0.5 seconds, and sags to 80% of nominal
voltage for up to 1 second. Points above the voltage tolerance curve indicate disturbances that
exceed these specifications.

Overlaying curves on plotted data

To overlay one of the provided curves, you need a data log viewer that contains the magnitude and
duration values for the sag/swell disturbances. The Duration column must be set as the X-
parameter for the Log View Plotter—it appears in blue in the data log viewer table (See X-parameter
for Log View Plotter for more information on setting the X-parameter for Data Log Viewers). The
Magnitude values can be in any one of the other columns.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1371


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. In the Data Log Viewer, select a range of cells to be plotted.

2. Select Edit > Plot Selected Data. The Log View Plotter window appears with Duration as the
x-axis and Magnitude as the y-axis.

3. Right-click the graph and select Overlay Curve from the menu to open the Overlay Curve
dialog.

4. Select the text file containing the curve data that you want to overlay (from the ...\Power
Monitoring Expert\config\lvp directory).

5. Click Open. The selected curve appears in the graph.

You can review each point in your data and see where it falls in relation to the curve.

NOTE: This process automatically changes your x-axis scale to logarithmic.

Creating and customizing a user diagram


The following sections describe:

• How to customize an existing user diagram by customizing the appearance and function of a
diagram object or diagram window.

• How to create a new user diagram.

• The various types of diagram objects and how to use each type to add function to your user
diagram.

NOTE: You must have the appropriate security clearance to edit or create a user diagram. To
determine if you can edit a diagram, select Options > Show Toolbox. If you can select this
option, then you can edit a diagram. Consult your network administrator if you need to change your
access privileges.

NOTE: Any changes you make to a default diagram affect all other devices using the same
diagram.

Creating a new user diagram


To create a new user diagram, login to Vista and select File > New. A new (blank) user diagram
appears. You can only create a new user diagram if you have supervisor-level access.

To automatically generate a network diagram based on devices added using Management Console,
see Generating a network diagram.

Saving a user diagram


To save changes you made to a user diagram:

1. Select File > Save to save a new or existing user diagram, or File > Save As to open the
Save New Diagram dialog.

2. Type a name for the diagram in the File name field and click Save.

By default, Vista points to the root of the \ud directory when you attempt to save a new diagram. If
required, you can create a new folder within that directory to store your customized diagrams, rather
than storing them in the \ud folder.

1372 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

NOTE: This \ud directory should be located on a networked drive where it can provide multiple
users with access to saved user diagrams.

NOTE: You should notify users of the Diagrams application in the Web Applications component of
the location of the new custom network diagram if they want to use it instead of the automatically
generated diagram. Users of the Diagrams application need to update the registry settings on their
computer to specify the location of the new custom network diagram. See "Custom network
diagram setup" in the Diagrams section of the Web Applications online help.

Editing a user diagram


To edit a user diagram, the Diagram Objects toolbox must be displayed. To open the toolbox, select
Options > Show Toolbox. If the Show Toolbox option is grayed out, your user account does not
have sufficient access; contact your system administrator.

The Enable Undo option


The Enable Undo option enables or disables the undo feature in Vista. With this option active, you
are allowed to undo or “step backward” up to three times. This feature is enabled by default. If you
disable the undo feature, you lose the ability to undo any previous changes. You cannot enable the
feature and undo changes made prior to enabling the feature. A check mark appears beside Enable
Undo in the Options menu when this option is selected.

NOTE: The Show Toolbox option must be selected for the Enable Undo option to become
active — it remains unselectable otherwise.

Adding a diagram object to a user diagram


You can add a new diagram object to a user diagram by dragging it from the Diagram Objects
toolbox.

Types of diagram objects


Diagram objects provide the interface to ION registers in your network. Each diagram object
performs a single function. For example, a single numeric object placed in a user diagram displays
numeric data from a single source. There are seven types of diagram objects available on the
Diagram Objects toolbox:

Grouping Object:
Group a number of related objects within a separate grouping window. Click on a grouping
object to open the grouping window and display its contents.
Text Box:
Display independent headings, titles, and comments in a user diagram.
Numeric Object:
Display real-time numeric values such as Volts, Amps or kW.
Status Object:
Display Boolean data (On/Off, Yes/No, 1/0, etc.) or device-dependent conditions to indicate
the status of a digital output (relay), digital input (status input) or setpoint. The image can be
customized and it can be configured to use animation.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1373


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Data Log Viewer:


Display data logs stored in the ION_Data database (including archives from previous
versions of the product), show waveform data (waveform capture, waveform recorder) and
trends (data recorders) using tables, and provide data for plotting.
Event Log Viewer:
Display event logs stored in the ION_Data database (including archives from previous
versions of the product), show event records from devices and other components, and
display alarms.
Control Object:
Send commands to a device on your network (for example, clear an energy accumulator,
toggle a relay, reset a counter, or adjust the value of an analog output device).

To add a function to a user diagram, choose the type of diagram object you want, drag it into the
user diagram then link it to the appropriate register in a node. The following sections explain how to
add and link a diagram object.

See Monitoring your system in Vista for more information on the function and basic use of each type
of diagram object.

Adding a diagram object to a user diagram


1. Select Options > Show Toolbox if the toolbox is not displayed. The toolbox appears in the
workspace.

2. Click on the diagram object you want and drag it from the toolbox to the diagram.

In most cases, the object appears in the window as the icon from the toolbox. However, there
are two exceptions:
A text box appears in the window as a rectangular box that displays the default message:
“Your text goes here.”

A numeric object appears in the window as a rectangular box with a colon (:). This
indicates that the object is not yet linked to a node.

The object is now ready to be linked to a real-time or logged data source. See Linking a
diagram object to a data source for details on linking an object to a source.

NOTE: When a diagram object is placed in a window, it automatically uses the same node as the
window. If you want to change this source, either relink each diagram object or change the default
window link before placing the objects.

Cutting, copying, and pasting a diagram object


Use the Cut, Copy and Paste commands on the Edit menu to make a copy of a diagram object and
paste it into another window or user diagram.

You can paste the copy as many times as you like to create multiple versions of an object. Each
copy retains all of the attributes and linkage information of the original.

1374 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Cutting or copying a diagram object

1. Select the object(s).

2. Do one of the following:


To remove the original, select Edit > Cut then click Yes to confirm the deletion or No to
cancel.

To retain the original, select Edit > Copy. The selection is copied to the Power Monitoring
Expert clipboard.

NOTE: The Power Monitoring Expert clipboard is a temporary storage area that holds any
information cut or copied from Vista. It should not be confused with the Microsoft Windows
Clipboard.

After the object is copied to the clipboard, you can paste it into the active window.

Pasting a diagram object

1. Select the window you want to paste to.

2. Select Edit > Paste. The object appears in the active window.

Copying a group of diagram objects to a framework


A Vista framework is a template that you can use to record the layout of a group of diagram objects.

When you select Edit > Copy to framework, Vista saves the selection (including the type and
location of each diagram object) as a file. You can then use the Paste from framework command to
copy the group layout to another diagram or grouping window. This is useful for replicating a single
configuration on multiple workstations. You can store a saved framework with its own filename and
retrieve it anytime.

Copying a group of diagram objects to a framework

1. Select the group of objects you want to copy.

2. Select Edit > Copy to framework to open the Copy to framework dialog.

3. Type a name for the framework in the File name box then click Save. The framework file
extension (.fwu) is added automatically.

The selection is saved as a framework.

After you save a group of objects as a framework, you can paste it to another window.

Pasting a group of diagram objects from a framework

1. Select the window you want to paste to.

2. Select Edit > Paste from framework to open the Paste from framework dialog.

3. Navigate to the framework you want to paste and click Open. The framework selection
appears in the active window.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1375


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Adjusting diagram object layout and size


This section describes how to move, align and resize diagram objects.

Moving diagram objects


You can move a single diagram object or a group of diagram objects within a single window or from
one window to another.

1. Select the object(s) you want to move.

2. Drag the selected object(s) to the new location.

You can also use the arrow keys on the keyboard to move the selected diagram object(s) one space
at a time.

When diagram objects overlap, use the Send to Back command to place one object beneath the
others. Select the object then select Edit > Send to Back (or press CTRL+K).

Resizing a single diagram object


You can adjust the size of a diagram object to make it larger or smaller or you can stretch it
horizontally or vertically to change its shape.

1. Click on the diagram object to select it.

2. Do one of the following:


To make the object larger or smaller, drag a corner handle.

To stretch the object horizontally or vertically, drag a middle handle.

Resizing a diagram objects to a standard size


The Size tab in the Layout dialog lets you automatically resize a diagram object or group of diagram
objects to a set of standard dimensions.

1. Select the diagram objects you want to resize.

2. Select Edit > Layout or click to open the Layout dialog.

3. Select the Size tab.

4. Edit the horizontal and vertical dimensions of the object(s) as required.


Select No change to make no changes to that dimension.

Select Shrink to smallest or Grow to largest to adjust the width and/or height to match
that of the smallest or largest object in the selected group.

Select Pixels to enter the exact width or height in pixels.

You can also combine horizontal and vertical options on a single selection. For example, if you
select Shrink to Smallest in the Horizontal section and 30 pixels in the Vertical section, the
entire selection is resized to the width of the shortest object and the specified height of 30
pixels.

5. Click OK to save your changes.

1376 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Aligning diagram objects relative to each other


The Align tab of the Layout dialog lets you specify the horizontal and vertical arrangement of the
selected objects.

1. Select the diagram objects that you want to align.

2. Select Edit > Layout or click to open the Layout dialog.

3. Select the Align tab to specify the horizontal and vertical alignment of the object(s).

The options in the Horizontal and Vertical areas determine the criteria by which you can align
diagram objects. For example, if you select Left sides under Horizontal and Space evenly
under Vertical, Vista aligns all objects in the selection by their left sides (using the leftmost
object for reference) and distributes them evenly along a vertical axis.

4. Select the options you want then click OK.

Aligning diagram objects on a grid


The Grid tab of the Layout dialog lets you activate and configure an invisible grid. Objects placed
onto the grid snap to the nearest gridline to help align and space them evenly.
To activate or deactivate the grid:

1. Select Edit > Layout or click to open the Layout dialog.

2. Select the Grid tab.

3. Select one of the following options:


No grid turns the grid off.

Grid size in pixels activates the grid. Type a number in the “Grid size in pixels” box to
specify the size of the grid (distance between grid lines).

4. Click OK to save your changes.

Customizing a diagram object


After you have placed and linked a diagram object, you can customize it. Right-click a diagram
object in edit mode to display the configuration options available for that object type.

Customizing a diagram object


1. Right-click the diagram object to open the <Object> Configuration dialog (where <Object> is
the type of diagram object selected).

2. Select the appropriate tab and make your changes. Repeat this step for the other tabs until
you have made all your desired changes.

3. Click OK to save your changes to the diagram object.

The options available vary depending on the tab and the object selected. See the sections below for
details on the options available for different tabs and objects.

The Preview pane


Use the Preview pane to view how your proposed changes will appear in the diagram.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1377


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For some tabs, you access dialog boxes by right-clicking on the image in the Preview pane (for
example, the Display tab of a numeric object). More information is given in the relevant sections that
follow.

Available configuration options


The following table lists the various configuration options available for each type of diagram object.

Diagram Objects
Available Option
Grouping Text Box Numeric Status Data Log Event Log Control
Tabs
Object Object Object Object Viewer Viewer Object

Caption x x x x x x
Text x x x x
Edit Text x
Link (or Node)1 x x x x
Query Server2 x x x x x x
Display x x x x
Action x x x x
Box x x
Annunciation x
Query3 x x
Alarming x
1 Node is the tab available with Grouping Objects.

2 Query Server is only available on Grouping, Numeric,Status, and Control objects when the Action is set to something other
than none.
3 See Querying the database for information on configuring this option.

Caption options
To view caption options, right-click the object then select the Caption tab.
Use the Caption tab to add custom, user-defined text to a diagram object. The Caption tab is
available for the following diagram objects: Grouping, Numeric, Status, Data Log Viewer, Event Log
Viewer, and Control.

The Caption tab contains three sections: Caption, Font, and Position.
The Caption section determines whether a diagram object displays a textual comment along with
the diagram object’s icon. This section has three options:

• Select None to display no caption.

• Select Use default to display the default Vista caption (i.e., the device name or data source).

• Select Use custom to display the text that you type into the field provided.

1378 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

The Font section allows you to change the font used in a caption. This section has two options:

• Select Inherit from parent window to use the default font.

• Select Custom to specify a custom font. Click Font to open the Font dialog and change the
font, size, style or color.

The Position section has two options:

• Select Top to place the caption above the diagram object.

• Select Bottom to place the caption below the diagram object.

Text options
Some diagram objects have a text label integrated into the display. To edit the appearance of this
label, use the options offered on the Text tab. The Text tab is available for the following diagram
objects: Numeric, Status, Control, and Text.

NOTE: You can edit the text displayed in a text label. For a numeric, status or control object, use
the Label section of the Link tab. For a text box object, use the Edit Text tab.

To view the Text options, right-click the object then select the Text tab. The Text tab has two
sections: Font and Position.
The Font section has two options:

• Select Inherit from parent window to use the default font

• Select Custom to specify a custom font. Click Font to display the Font dialog and change the
font, size, style or color.

The Position section has three options — Left, Center and Right — to define the alignment of the
text in relation to the diagram object. Use the Preview area located beside the Text tab to view your
proposed changes.

Edit Text options


To view the Edit Text options, right-click the object then select the Edit Text tab.

Use the Edit Text tab to specify a text message for the text box. The Edit Text tab is available on
the text box object only.
The Edit Text tab has two options:

• Use default displays the window link information (i.e., the node).

• Use custom displays your custom text message.

If you select custom, use the text box to enter your text. The text box supports multiple lines of text.
If your message appears incomplete or truncated after you enter text and click OK, you can adjust
the dimensions of the text box object. To resize a text box, select it then drag its handles.

The font used in the text box is based on the default setting specified for the active window. Use the
Text tab to specify a different font or position for the text box. Use the Box tab to specify a border
style or change the background color.

Link options
To view the link options, right-click the object then select the Link tab.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1379


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Use the Link tab to link a diagram object to a real-time source, and to specify a new text label. The
Link tab is available for the following diagram objects: Numeric, Status, and Control.

NOTE: To set a real-time source for a grouping object, use the Node tab.

The Link tab contains two sections: Link and Label.

Use the Link section to specify a real-time source for the diagram object. See Linking a numeric,
status or control object for more information.
Use the Label section to change the object's text label. The Label section has three options:

• Select None to display no label.

• Select Use node label to display the node's register label. This is the default.

• Select Custom to display the label that you type into the text field provided. The custom labels
you create are stored in the user diagram and are only available to users of your diagram.

TIP: If you have specified custom labels in your diagram, or custom labels have been applied to an
ION meter at the device level, you can display the default labels at any time by selecting Show
Default Labels from the Options menu. This displays the default label of the data source instead
of the label assigned in the device or in the user diagram.

Query Server options


Use the Query Server tab to connect a diagram object to a Query Server. The Query Server tab is
available on the Data Log Viewer and Event Log Viewer objects. See Linking a Data Log Viewer or
Event Log Viewer for more information.

The Query Server tab is also available on grouping objects and any object configured to open a
grouping window or user diagram. In this case, use the Query Server tab to specify a default Query
Server for the associated grouping window or user diagram. See Query Server: setting a default
Query Server for a window for more information.

Display options
Use the Display tab to customize the appearance of a diagram object. The Display tab is available
for the following diagram objects: Numeric, Status, Control, and Grouping.

The Display tab offers a unique set of options for each type of diagram object. To view the display
options, right-click the diagram object then select the Display tab.

Customizing the display of a numeric object


Numeric objects display real-time data in your user diagram. The default numeric object appears as
a rectangular alphanumeric display with a single decimal place of resolution and no unit symbol. You
can customize the display to change any of these default elements.

NOTE: Vistasupports a maximum of 59 non-alphanumeric numeric objects within a single window.


To change the way numbers are displayed (thousands separator and decimal point), use the
Regional Settings option of the Windows Control Panel. You can also use this option to customize
the time and date styles. (The year/month/day format can be modified, and the clock can be
changed from am/pm to 24 hour.)

1380 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Setting Display style

The Display style box lets you select a new style from the list of available choices. The following
styles are available:

• Alphanumeric: Default style. General-use text display.

• Partial Dial: General use voltage, current, harmonic distortion, etc.

• Full Dial: power factor, bi-directional power flow, etc.

• Horizontal Bar: General use.

• Vertical Bar: General use.

• Scrolling Graph display: General use. Displays recent readings on a scrolling graph.

• Arc Meter Display: General use voltage, current, harmonic distortion, etc.

• Timestamped display: Displays the value, and the date and time the value was measured by
the device. Useful for min./max. values.

• Timestamp Only: Same as timestamped, but does not display a value. Can be used as a clock.

• PC Timestamped Display: Displays the value, and the date and time the value was received by
Vista.

Setting Units and Resolution

Use the Units box to type the unit name for the measured value (for example, “Volts” or “Amps”).
This name is displayed on the numeric object.

In certain cases, the value is scaled. For example, if the unit name begins with K, M, or G (for
example, kV or MVolts), the displayed value is adjusted accordingly. However, if the unit contains
certain letters (i.e., kW or kVA), the scaling factor is reduced by 1,000 (for example, if the unit
begins with K, the value is not scaled and M is scaled by 1,000). The reason for this is that most
devices provide these values already scaled.

Use the Resolution box to specify the number of decimal places to be displayed for a numeric
object. The default value is 1, but this can be increased to take advantage of any extra resolution
available from the data source.

NOTE: Specifying higher resolution does not result in higher accuracy than the specified accuracy
of the device.

Setting the Font options

Use the Ticks Labels Font section to define font options (such as style, size, and color) for the
numeric object. This section has two options:

• Select Inherit from parent window to use the default style.

• Select Custom to specify a custom style, then click Font to open the Font dialog and make
your changes.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1381


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Setting Flags

Use the Flags button to display the Normal Operating Range dialog. Use this dialog to set a Low
Low Limit, Low Limit, High Limit, and High High Limit, and define a normal operating range to be
displayed on the numeric object. After flags have been set, you can use them to quickly determine
whether a reading is within the normal range you defined.

The effect of setting these limits depends on the display style you have specified. For example, on
the Partial Dial, Full Dial, and Arc Meter displays, flags appear as colored ranges on the dial. On
other types of numeric objects, the flag function changes the object's background color whenever a
limit is exceeded.
To view or change the default colors, select Options > Flag Colors.

NOTE: The flags used in Vista are not linked to setpoints in ION meters. Setpoint activity is
automatically logged by the Log Inserter. Setpoint status can be monitored using a status object
and/or data log viewer.

Other display options for Vertical or Horizontal Bar graphs

In the Preview section of a vertical or horizontal bar graph Display tab:

• Right-click the axis labels to display the Axis Labels dialog. Select the Format (Decimal,
Scientific, or Engineering) and determine the Axis Title (none or custom text).

• Right-click the axis tick marks to display the Vertical or Horizontal Axis dialog. Configure the
Range, Ticks and Grid style. Select Logarithmic scale to enable the logarithmic scale option.

Other display options for Partial Dial, Full Dial and Arc Meter displays

To configure meter parameters on partial dial, full dial or arc meter displays, right-click anywhere in
the Preview section of the Display tab.

Set the Range, Arc Position, Ticks, and dial Position. For full and partial dial displays, set the label
position to inside or outside. Click Line Attributes to set the style and width of the dial.

Other display options for Scrolling graphs

In the Preview section of the Display tab:

• Right-click the vertical or horizontal axis tick marks to open the Vertical and Time Axis dialogs.
Set the Range and Ticks, and (for the vertical axis) Grids Style.

• Right-click the vertical axis labels to display the Axis Labels dialog. Select the Format
(Decimal, Scientific, or Engineering) and determine the Axis Title (none or custom text).

• Right-click the graph background to display the Scrolling Graph dialog where you can set the
Sample Interval and Relative Reset.

The sample interval determines the resolution of the X-axis in seconds. It should be set
between one tenth and one hundredth of the X-axis range; for example, when extending the
range to one hour (3600 seconds), the sample interval should be set to approximately 60
seconds.

1382 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

The relative reset is a percentage that determines the amount the scrolling graph shifts back
upon filling the plotting area. (For example, a relative reset of 0.5 shifts back 50%; a relative
reset of 0.99 scrolls the most smoothly.)

Customizing the display of a status object


Status objects display the status of Boolean “on/off” conditions in one of three ways: an indicator
light, an alphanumeric field, or a custom image.

To view the display options of a status object, right-click the object then select the Display tab.

NOTE: To invert the default color scheme, select “Invert active state” from the Annunciation tab.

The Display tab has three options:

• Select Default image to display the default indicator light image, which changes color to
indicate various conditions: by default, green indicates an OFF condition, red indicates an ON
condition and gray indicates a status object that is not connected or is not receiving information.
Device dependent multi conditions (HighHigh, High, Normal, Low, and LowLow) also use
colors to indicate the various conditions.

• Select Custom images to use custom images for each condition. Custom images can show
animation, customized buttons, and so on.

For each item selected under Condition (ON, OFF, and Unconnected), click Browse to locate
and select the image you want to associate with the condition. To hide the status object in a
given state, leave the image field blank.

Currently, the custom image option supports the following graphic file formats: BMP, animated
GIF, transparent GIF and PNG, WMF (Windows Metafile), EMF, JPG, AVI (without audio and
uncompressed or compressed using RLE8 compression).

NOTE: GIF, JPG, and PNG images need to be in \config\diagrams under the product's
installation location or they will not be shown in the Web-based Diagrams application.

You can use three different files to represent the three display states (ON, OFF, and
Unconnected) of a status object. Each of these files can also be of a different type (for example,
BMP, GIF, and JPG), however you cannot mix AVI and animated GIF images within a status
object.

• Select Alphanumeric to display the Boolean state or multi-condition state labels stored in the
device and choose custom colors to visually indicate the corresponding states.

For example, suppose “Running” has been stored in a meter as the label for the Boolean register
that stores the ON condition of a motor relay and “Stopped” for the OFF condition. You can
show this register label together with the status label using the alphanumeric display style. You
can override the meter labels on the Link tab.

Click ON Color and OFF Color to specify the colors associated with each condition.

You can also have multi conditions if you link the status object to an enumerated register
instead of a boolean. You can do this for BCPM devices.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1383


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Customizing the display of a grouping object


The grouping object can be displayed as the default image, a custom image, or no image. You can
customize the display to change any of these default elements.

To view the display options of a grouping object, right-click the object then select the Display tab.
The Display tab has three options:

• Select Default image to use the default image for a grouping object that appears in the toolbox.

• Select Custom image to display a custom image. Enter the filename of the image you want to
use or click Browse to locate and select an image. The filename should include the file's
extension (.bmp, .jpg, .png, .gif, .emf, .wmf, or .avi).

• Select None to hide the grouping object. With no image specified, the grouping object is
transparent unless you select it (displaying the handles). If you move the mouse over a
transparent object, the status line displays the size and object type (for example,
“30x30:Grouping Object” in the status line means the hidden object is a grouping object and its
size is 30 pixels by 30 pixels).

Hiding a grouping object is especially effective when using a custom background image; you
can integrate your transparent grouping objects into the image by placing them at the
appropriate points on the drawing. Users can display site-specific information by double-
clicking on the appropriate spot in the background. See Image: Displaying a background image
for information on using a custom background.

Customizing the display of a control object


A control object appears differently depending on the type of register to which it is linked. This same
criteria also determines the display options available.

To view the display options of a control object, right-click the object then select the Display tab.

The options available depend on the type of control object.

External Numeric

A control object that is linked to an External Numeric module appears as an alphanumeric display
box. The Display tab has the following sections: Border and Background Color.

In the Border section, select Hide to show no border or select Show to display a border. If you
select Show, you can specify the width in pixels and click Color to choose a color for the border.

In the Background Color section, select Transparent for no background or select Custom then
click Color to define a color for the background.

External Pulse

1384 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

A control object that is linked to an External Pulse module appears as a button icon, by default. The
Display tab has three options: Default image, Custom image and None.

Select Default image to display the button icon. Select Custom image and click Browse to select a
different image. Select None to show no image (the control object is hidden but still functions).

External Boolean

A control object that is linked to an External Boolean module appears as a switch icon, by default.
The Display tab has two options: Default image or Custom images.

Select Default image to display the switch icon. Select Custom images then click Browse to define
custom images for ON, OFF and Unconnected. To hide the control object for a given state, leave
the appropriate box blank. Currently, the custom image option supports the following graphic file
formats: BMP, JPG, PNG, GIF, EMF, WMF (Windows Metafile), and AVI (without audio and
uncompressed or compressed using RLE8 compression).

Note that you cannot mix AVI and animated GIF images within a control object.

Action options
To view the action options, right-click the diagram object then select the Action tab.

Use the Action tab to specify the response of a diagram object when it is clicked (in Display mode)
or double-clicked (in Edit mode).
The Action tab is available for the following diagram objects: Numeric, Status, Grouping, and
Control objects. Depending on the type of diagram object, the Action tab displays one of two sets of
options:

• Specify an action for a numeric, status, or grouping object

• Customize the action for a control object

Specifying an action for numeric, status, or grouping objects

NOTE: If you change the action for a grouping object that is already associated with a grouping
window, the existing window (and any objects within it) is deleted. Vista displays a message
before performing this action.

When you right-click a numeric, status, or grouping object, the Action tab displays the available
options:

• Select None if you do not want the object to support an action. This is the default for numeric,
status, and grouping objects.

• Select Open Grouping Window to open a grouping window when the object is clicked. You
can use this grouping window to display additional information. For example, if a numeric object
displays a total value (such as total kW), you can display specific information (such as kW
readings for each phase) in an associated grouping window.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1385


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• The Open Diagram for Meter Template option is used by default each time a network diagram
is generated. Each meter icon in the network diagram is set to open the default diagrams that
match that meter's configuration.

• Select Open User Diagram to open a user diagram when the object is clicked. Type the full
path and filename into the field provided or click Browse to locate the diagram you want. Using
this action, you can choose a diagram object that displays a representative reading from an
independent diagram and use it to open the other diagram when clicked.

• Select Open File to open a file when the object is clicked. Type the full path and filename into
the field provided or click Browse to locate the file you want. The file can be a third-party
program or some other document; if a document is specified, then the program associated with
the file extension is launched and the specified document is loaded into the application.

• Select Open Web Page to open a specified webpage in your default web browser when the
object is clicked. Type the entire address into the field provided.

NOTE: When you select any action other than None, the Query Server tab is added to the top of
the object configuration box. You can use this tab to specify a source of logged data for the new
user diagram or grouping window. If you enter only the filename into the field provided (and do not
specify a directory), Vista defaults to
...\Power Monitoring Expert\config\diagrams\ud.

Customizing the action for a control object


To view the action options of a control object, right-click the control object and select the Action
tab.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

The Action tab offers three options that you can use to define how the control object responds when
clicked:

• Select No confirmation to have no confirmation message displayed.

• Select Message box confirmation to display a message box when the object is clicked. The
message box requires the user to click either OK or Cancel.

• Select Password confirmation to request the user’s logon password when an object is
clicked.

The Level to operate list allows you to specify the access level required to perform the action.

1386 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Box options
To view the Box options, right-click the object then select the Box tab.

Use the Box tab to add a border or background color to a diagram object. The Box tab is available for
the following diagram objects: Numeric, Text Box, and any status object that has been configured
as an alphanumeric display
The Box tab has two sections:

• Border lets you adjust a border’s width and color as well as whether or not it is displayed.
Select Hide to remove the border or Show to display it. If you select Show, click Color to
define a border color and type a number in the Width in pixels field to change the line
thickness.

• Background Color lets you set the background color of an object. Select Transparent to use
the background color of the parent window or select Custom and click Color to select another
color.

NOTE: A Numeric Object uses the diagram background color in Vista when set to
Transparent, which makes it look transparent. In Diagrams (web application), this same
Numeric Object is displayed as truly transparent. Text Box Objects are truly transparent in
Vista and Diagrams when set to Transparent.

Annunciation options
To view the annunciation options, right-click the Status Object to open the Status Object
Configuration dialog, then select the Annunciation tab.

Use the Annunciation tab to specify how users are notified of a change of status. The Annunciation
tab is available only on the Status Object.

NOTE: The Annunciation feature requires that the Status Object’s diagram is displayed; if the
display is closed or minimized, then the annunciation feature does not work.

The Annunciation tab has three options that set the action that Vista performs when a status object
becomes active:

• Select Command line to automatically launch another application in the event of a change in
status. Type the program's executable (.exe) command into the field provided or click Browse
to locate the appropriate file.

• Select Message box to specify an annunciation message. Type your message into the field
provided. The first line of text appears as the title of the message box.

• Select Invert active state to change the way the status object reacts to an active state. When
this option is selected, the status object treats an active state as inactive and vice-versa. This
is useful, for example, in cases when you want to be notified if a function (such as a cooling fan)
switches off.

NOTE: If you select the Invert active state check box, this also inverts the default colors of the
status object.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1387


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Alarming options
Every type of event that occurs in a Power Monitoring Expert network has a prioritized value that
identifies its relative significance on a scale of zero to 255. By default, Vista identifies any event
with a priority of 128 or greater as an alarm.

To view the Alarming options, right-click the Event Log Viewer then select the Alarming tab.

Use the Alarming tab to create or delete a priority range, specify the security level required to
acknowledge an alarm, or customize the way Vista annunciates an alarm.
The Alarming tab has three main sections:

• Priority ranges lists the currently configured alarm ranges. When you select a range in the
Priority ranges section (for example “Range 192-255”), the other sections (Level to
Acknowledge and Annunciation) display the current settings for that range. You can proceed to
modify any of these settings for the specified range. (Your changes affect only the currently
selected priority range.)

Click New to add a new priority range. In the Priority dialog box, type a number representing
the lower limit of the new range then click OK. The upper limit of the new range is automatically
defined by the lower limit of the existing range. For example, if you have an existing range of
128-191, you can type 100 then click OK and the range 100-127 appears. To delete an existing
range, select it and click Delete.

• The Level to acknowledge list specifies the access level required to acknowledge alarms in
the selected range.

• Annunciation lets you customize the way Vista annunciates an alarm:


Select Beep to play a beeping sound.

Select Flash to have a flashing display.

Select Command line to have Vista to automatically launch another application in the event
of an alarm. Type the program's executable (.exe) command into the field provided or click
Browse to locate the appropriate file. This option can be used to automatically alert other
users of specific events through paging systems, fax transmissions, or any other command
line capable application.

Select Message box to display an annunciation message. When you select this option,
type your message into the field provided. The first line of text appears as the title of the
message box and the remaining text appears as the content of the message box.

By default, Vista uses a beeping sound to annunciate an event with a priority between 128-191
and a beeping sound combined with a flashing display to annunciate an event with a priority
between 192-255.

NOTE: If your computer is equipped with a sound card, you can replace the default alarm sound
with a custom sound. Save the sound file you want to use as “alarm.wav” and store it in the
...\Power Monitoring Expert\system\etc directory.

1388 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Linking a diagram object to a data source


After placing an object in your user diagram, you need to link the object to a data source. Some
types of diagram objects require a real-time data source and others require a logged data source:

• Numeric, status, and control objects require a real-time data source. You can link these diagram
objects to a device.

• Event Log Viewers and Data Log Viewers require a logged data source. You can link these
diagram objects to any log in your system.

Linking a numeric, status or control object


This section describes how to link a numeric, status, or control object to a node. Numeric, status,
and control objects display real-time data. After you have placed one of these objects into a user
diagram, you should link it to a real-time data source. An object cannot receive or display
information until it is linked.

Specifying a real-time link to a node

1. Right-click the diagram object you want to link to open the Configuration dialog.

2. Select the Link tab.

The Link tab contains two sections: Link and Label. Use the Label section to define a label
for the diagram object (see Link options for information on the Label section) and use the Link
section to choose a real-time source.

3. Select one of the following:


Inherit from parent window: The selected diagram object defaults to the same node
used by the parent window (the window in which the object resides). You must specify a
real-time register within the node, but the node itself is pre-selected.

Custom: Allows you to select a new node. Select ION to choose a different device than
that used by the parent window.

4. Click Edit Link to open the Create Link dialog.

5. Specify a node, manager, module and output register:


a. Double-click the node in the Nodes box that contains the data source you want. If you
chose Inherit from parent window in step 3, the node is preselected.

b. Double-click the manager you want (for example, Power Meter modules) from the
Managers box.

c. Double-click the module you want from the Modules box (for example, Power Meter).

d. Double-click the output register you want from the Output Registers box (for example,Vll
avg).

6. Click OK in the Create Link dialog to save your changes.

The Create Link dialog closes and the new link information is displayed along the lower edge
of the Configuration dialog.

7. Click OK on the Configuration dialog to save your new configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1389


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Linking a Data Log Viewer or Event Log Viewer


The Event Log Viewer and Data Log Viewer display logged data. After you have placed an Event
Log Viewer or Data Log Viewer object into a user diagram, you need to link it to the ION Query
Service.

Linking a diagram object to the ION Query Service

1. Right-click the Event or Data Log Viewer object you want to link.

2. Select the Query Server tab in the Configuration dialog.

The Query Server tab has two options:


Select Inherit from parent window to have the selected diagram object default to the
same Query Server used by the parent window (the window in which the object resides). If
you select this option, click OK to exit, skip the following steps, and continue with
Querying the database.

Select Custom Query Server and click Edit Link to open a dialog where you can select a
new Query Server link.

3. Select Custom Query Server and click Edit Link to open the Create Link dialog.
Use this dialog to specify the Query Server, Query Manager, Query module, and Query
register.

Double-click the Query Server that you want from the Nodes box.

Double-click Query Modules from the Managers box.

Double-click the Query module that you want from the Modules box.

Double-click the Query Register that you want from the Output Registers box.

4. Click OK the Create Link dialog to save your changes.

The name of the selected ION Query Service is displayed as the Group Name on the Query
Server tab of the Configuration dialog.

5. Click OK on the Configuration dialog to accept your new configuration.

After you have linked a diagram object to a log server, you need to define a query to specify the type
(s) of logged data that you want the object to display. See Querying the database for more
information.

NOTE: If the Query Server has multiple Query modules that are accessing multiple databases,
you need to select the Query module that is connected to the database that contains the data of
interest.

Querying the database


The Data Log Viewer and the Event Log Viewer query the database, extract logged data, and
display that data in Vista.

A query is a set of instructions that the log viewer uses to request particular data from the database.
Each log viewer has its own individual query. Editing this query information changes what data the
query retrieves and the way a log viewer displays that data.

1390 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Right-click the data or event log viewer object and select the Query tab to view the query options or
access the Query Wizard. Use the query options to define the way a viewer displays data and the
Query Wizard to edit the actual query.

NOTE: Anytime you place and link a new Data Log Viewer or Event Log Viewer, you need to
specify a query for it. You can specify a query using the Query Wizard.

Using the Query options


To define the way a log viewer displays information, configure its query options.

To view the query options for an Event Log Viewer or Data Log Viewer, right-click the viewer object
to open the Configuration dialog. Select the Query tab.
The upper section of the Query tab offers two buttons:

• Edit Query starts the Query Wizard, a user-friendly interface that helps you edit the query.

• Edit SQL accesses the SQL statement via Windows Notepad so you can edit the query
directly using SQL, if preferred.

NOTE: If you edit a query directly (i.e., by editing the SQL statement), your changes may not
be accessible to the Query Wizard. This is not a problem unless you intend to use the Query
Wizard as well.

The Options section of the Query tab offers the following options:

• Records uploaded at a time: This option specifies the number of records Vista uploads into
active memory (RAM) when you first open a Data or Event Log Viewer. The maximum value is
9999. As you scroll down the list of records, Vista uploads additional records as needed. You
may want to change this default value if, for example, you want to select a large number of
records for plotting, without scrolling down repeatedly.

• Update automatically: This option is disabled (cleared) by default. The Data or Event Log
Viewer does not display any new records; rather, the Log Viewer initially uploads the specified
number of records (for example 100) and does not update again unless it is closed (and its query
results deleted) then reopened.
With this option selected, the Log Viewer continually receives and displays new records up
to a maximum of 1000 records; the Log Viewer checks for new records every 20 seconds.
However, the updates can consume a noticeable amount of CPU power, especially if
several Log Viewers remain open simultaneously or if Log Viewers are uploading waveform
data.

• Delete query on close: This option is enabled (selected) by default. The Log Viewer clears its
temporary records from active memory (RAM) upon closing so that every time a Log Viewer is
opened, the database is queried again and all available records are displayed. (This option does
not affect any original records stored in the database.)

If this option is disabled, Vista caches the record set returned to the Log Viewer, meaning that if
the Log Viewer is closed then reopened, the table is populated from memory and not from the
database. Any new records inserted into the database during the time the Log Viewer was
initially open do not appear.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1391


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: Since it is recommended that Update automatically remain disabled in all but the
most compelling circumstances, it is important that the Delete query on close option
remains enabled.

• Use parent node: With this option selected, the log viewer uses the same node linkage as the
parent window. The node is also pre-selected in the Query Wizard - you should not select this
option if you intend to query more than one node.

X-parameter for Log View Plotter

For a Data Log Viewer, the X-parameter for Log View Plotter section is offered at the bottom of the
Query tab. Use this section to specify a column to be used on the X-axis of the Log View Plotter.
This section offers two options:

• Timestamp is selected as the X-parameter by default. In some cases, you may need to specify
a different X-parameter. For example, when you are plotting disturbances, you need to plot your
data against the Duration column.

• Use column # lets you specify a new x-parameter. In the field provided, type the column
number that you want to use as the X-parameter (for example, 3). When you click OK on the
Data Log Viewer Configuration box, the specified column changes to blue.

NOTE: In the Data Log Viewer, the column specified for the X-parameter is colored blue for easy
identification.

Using the Query Wizard


The Query Wizard helps you edit an existing query or create a new query for a Data Log Viewer or
Event Log Viewer.

1. Right-click the log viewer that you want to configure.

2. Select the Query tab in the Configuration box.

3. Click Edit Query to open the Query Wizard.

The Query Wizard consists of four steps designed to guide you through the process of editing
a query. These steps are described in more detail in the following sections.
Selecting the node(s) to query.

Specifying logs within the specified node(s).

Specifying columns and specifying filters.

Choosing a sort order.

Depending on the type of query (new or existing), you may not need to perform all four steps.
When you start the Query Wizard, it automatically opens on the appropriate step in the
process.

4. Use the four buttons at the bottom of the Query Wizard to move through or exit the Query
Wizard:
Use the Back and Next buttons to navigate through the wizard.

Click Cancel to quit the Query Wizard and discard your changes.

1392 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Click Finish to quit the Query Wizard and save your changes.

5. When finished, click OK to save your changes and close the viewer configuration box.

The following example describes each step in the process of creating a typical query: configuring a
Data Log Viewer to display waveforms for three phases (V1, V2, V3).

Step 1: Selecting the nodes


The Available list displays the available nodes (device or software) and the Selected list displays
the currently selected nodes.
Select a node (or nodes) for your query. If a node has already been specified or you select Use
Parent Node on the Query tab, the Query Wizard proceeds directly to Step 2: Specifying logs.

1. Click Edit Query on the Query tab of the Log Viewer Configuration dialog to start the Query
Wizard.

2. Highlight the name of the node that you want from the Available list and click Add. The node
appears in the Selected list. Repeat this procedure to add additional nodes for this query, if
required.

If you want to remove a node from the Selected list, highlight the node and click Remove. The
node disappears from the Selected list.

3. Click Next to continue.

NOTE: If you want to view or edit a node's SQL statement directly, highlight the node in the
Selected list and click the SQL button. The Windows Notepad displays the SQL statement for the
specified node.

Step 2: Specifying logs


Specify one or more data logs to query. If a valid query has already been specified, the Query
Wizard proceeds directly to Step 3: Specifying columns.

1. The Available list displays the logs available on the specified node. The Selected list displays
the currently selected logs.

2. Highlight the name of the log(s) that you want from the Available list and click Add. The log(s)
appears in the Selected list.

NOTE: Check for additional tabs. If you selected more than one node in step 1, this box
requires you to specify logs for each node. Each tab is labeled “Node 1,” “Node 2,” etc. and is
identified at the top of each tab. Select “Advanced log view” to access any logs whose
configuration has changed over time. This check box enables access to old configurations of
snapshot logs.

3. Click Next to continue.

Step 3: Specifying columns and filters


Use the Select the columns to appear in the Log Viewer section to add or remove a column
from your log viewer and the Filter section to establish a range for your query and to screen out
unwanted data.

If you selected multiple logs in step 2, this box contains a tab for each log. Specify the column and
filter information for each tab.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1393


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Specifying columns to appear in the Log Viewer

The Available list displays the available columns and the Selected list displays the currently
selected columns. The Selected list displays the columns in the same order (left to right) that they
will appear in the log viewer (top to bottom).
To specify the columns to appear in the Log Viewer:

1. Highlight the name of the column(s) you want then click Add. The column(s) appears in the
Selected list.
Select the asterisk (*) at the top of the Available list to select all available columns.
For example, if you want to select some basic columns for the first waveform log you chose
in the last step, you could highlight timestamp, node, and V1 in the Available list.

NOTE: The * column option shows all inputs connected to a recorder for Data Log Viewers.
For example, use the * option if you are using a framework and the configuration of the data
log is different for several meters. The * option is not available if more than one table is
selected, as in the example.

2. Repeat this procedure for each column that you want (and for each tab).

3. Adjust the order of the items in the Selected column—highlight the column name you want to
move in the Selected (in order) list then click the up or down arrows to move it. The columns
are listed from top to bottom in the order they will appear from left to right.

For example, if you want the Timestamp column to be the first (leftmost) column in your log
viewer, highlight “timestamp” in the Selected (in order) section then click the up arrow to move
it to the top of the list.

After you have selected the columns you want, proceed to specify filter settings.

Specifying a filter

Use the Filter section to construct one or more filter statements for your log viewer. Filters are
useful for restricting the scope of your query or specifying a priority range for alarms.

To edit an existing filter statement, double-click on it.


For example, if you want to instruct the log viewer to display data for the past month (excluding
today), you could use the following procedure:

1. In the first dropdown list on the left, select “timestamp”.

2. In the second dropdown list to the right, select “BETWEEN”.

3. In the third dropdown list to the right, select “last_month_to_date()”.

4. In the fourth dropdown list (on the right), select “today_12AM()”.

5. Click Insert.
The following filter definition appears in the area below the filter controls:
“timestamp” BETWEEN last_month_to_date() and today_12AM()

1394 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

If you wanted to instruct an Event Log Viewer to display only unacknowledged alarms, create a filter
that only displays alarms that have no acknowledgement time (ack-time).

1. In the first box, select “ack-time”

2. In the second box, select “IS NULL”

3. Click Insert.
The following filter appears in the box below the filter controls:
“ack_time” IS NULL

As you construct a filter statement, each field offers options based on your selection in the previous
field(s). For example, if you select “priority” in the first field, the third field becomes a text field where
you can type a numeric value; if you select “timestamp” in the first field, the third field displays time-
based options (i.e., now, today 12AM, yesterday, etc.).

The following table lists the time-related functions:

Function Description
now_() The current time.
today_12AM() Today at 00:00:00.
yesterday() Yesterday at 00:00:00.
last_week() Seven days ago at 00:00:00.
this_month() The first day of this month at 00:00:00.
last_month_to_date() The same date of the month one calendar month ago at 00:00:00.
last_month() The first day of the last calendar month at 00:00:00.
last_quarter_to_date() The first day of the month three calendar months ago at 00:00:00.

Note that time-related functions only return one record. To return all of the records for the time
period, you also need to specify < today_12AM(). For example, specifying a filter of
=yesterday() returns only one record, but a filter specifying >=yesterday() AND <today_
12AM() returns all of yesterday's records.
The second field offers a standard set of operators.

Operator-specific data

If you select an operator that requires additional information, Vista displays a dialog where you can
specify the required data.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1395


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For example, if you select the “node” column in the first field then select the “IN” operator from the
second field, a dialog opens requesting that you specify the node you want to use.

If you specify any column other than “node” then select “IN”, a box appears requesting numeric
values.

After you have specified a filter, click Next to continue.

Step 4: Choosing a sort order


Specify a sort order. The sort order is the order in which records appear in the viewer.

1. Highlight the name of the column to sort by in the Available Columns list then click Add. The
column appears in the Sort Order list.

Available Columns displays the columns you chose in step 3.

2. Double-click on the column in the Sort Order list to select either an ascending or descending
sort order.

The Sort Order list displays the column(s) that dictate the order in which the records are
sorted.

3. Click Finish to save your changes and quit the Query Wizard.

4. Click OK in the Configuration box to save your changes.

Customizing a diagram window


You can customize the appearance and configuration of any window within a user diagram. You can
customize a window's font or background color, or configure window properties such as background
image, real-time and logged data links, double-click action, and stale data settings.

In many cases, Vista uses the properties specified for the parent window as the default settings for
any diagram objects or grouping windows contained within. By modifying a setting in the parent
window, you automatically modify the same property on all objects inside the window that share this
setting. (For example, any object with an option set to Inherit from parent window shares this
information.) This can be useful when adding multiple diagram objects that are all linked to the same
source.

To access any of these options, right-click anywhere in the background of the user diagram or
window that you want to customize.

NOTE: Right-clicking in the background of a window displays a menu of available options;


however, right-clicking on any object in the window while in Edit mode (including transparent
objects such as text boxes or grouping windows) displays the configuration options for that object.

Default font
The font you select becomes the default setting for all captions and text labels within the window.

Changing the default font

1. Right-click the background of a user diagram and select Default Font to open the Font dialog.

2. Set the default font, style, size, effects, color, and format that you want.

3. Click OK to save your changes.

1396 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Background color
The default background color is gray. However, you can display any solid color as a background for
any window in your user diagram.

Changing the background color

1. Right-click the background of a user diagram and select Background Color to open the
Color dialog.

2. Select the color that you want or click Define Custom Colors for more options.

3. Click OK to save your changes.

Configuring window properties


To view the Window Properties Configuration options, right-click the background of any window in
your user diagram and select Properties.

The Window Properties Configuration dialog opens with five option tabs: Image, Query Server,
Node, Action and Updates.

Image: Displaying a background image


To view the image options, select the Image tab on the Window Properties Configuration dialog.
Use the Image tab to specify a background image for the active diagram or grouping window.
The Image tab has two options:

• Select None if you do not want to display a background image, or if you prefer to display a
single color.

• Select Custom image to display a background image. Enter the path and filename of the image
you want to display. Vista supports images saved in the following formats: .bmp, .jpeg, .png,
.gif, .emf, and .wmf.

You can create your own background image using a scanned photograph or a drawing created within
a standard graphics program. Some ideas include:

• An engineering drawing of your installation depicting the power distribution system and the
location of critical elements.

• A single line diagram illustrating the power distribution network or the individual components of
your facility.

• An aerial photograph of your facility depicting the approximate location of your monitoring
equipment.

• A satellite image or geographical map depicting your transmission and distribution network.

The following illustration depicts a sample Vista background with hidden diagram objects (here the
object is visible by the handles because it is selected in Edit mode):

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1397


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

You can integrate your diagram objects into the image by placing them at the appropriate points on
the drawing. Users then display site-specific information by clicking on the appropriate spot in the
background.

Specifying a custom background image

1. Right-click the background of the window you want to customize and select Properties to
open the Window Properties Configuration dialog.

2. Select the Image tab.

3. Select Custom image and click Browse.

4. Select the image file you want to use and click Open.

5. Click OK to set this image as the background.

Query Server: setting a default Query Server for a window


Use the Query Server tab to specify a logged data source for any window in a user diagram. The
Query Server that you select provides the default source of logged data for all Event Log Viewers,
Data Log Viewers and Grouping Objects within the window.

Setting a default Query Server for a window

1. Right-click the background of the window and select Properties.

2. Click the Query Server tab in the Window Properties Configuration box.

3. Select either Inherit from parent icon or Custom Query Server.


Select Inherit from parent icon for the active window to default to the same Query
Server used by the parent icon. (The parent icon is the diagram object that you clicked to
open this window.)

Select Custom Query Server then click Edit Link to open a dialog where you can select
a new Query Server link.

When you click the Edit Link button, the Create Link dialog opens.

1398 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Use the Create Link dialog to specify a query:

1. Double-click the Query Server that you want from the Nodes box.

2. Double-click Query Modules from the Managers box.

3. Double-click the Query that you want from the Modules box.

4. Double-click the query register that you want from the Output Registers box.

5. Click OK to save your changes.

The name of the selected Query Server and register are displayed as the Group Name on the Query
Server tab of the Window Properties Configuration dialog.

Node: Setting the default node for a window


Use the Node tab to specify a real-time source for any window (or grouping object) in a user
diagram. The node that you select provides the default source of real-time data for all numeric,
status, and control objects within the window. It also is the parent node for any Data Log Viewer or
Event Log Viewer objects placed in the window.

Setting a default node for a window

1. Right-click anywhere in the background of the window and select Properties from the pop-up
menu to open the Window Properties Configuration dialog.

2. Select the Node tab.

3. Do one of the following:


Select Inherit from parent icon to use the same node as the parent icon (the diagram
object you double-clicked to open the window).

Select Custom to select a different node. Select ION and click Select to display the
Select Node dialog. Select a default real-time source for the window from the nodes
available.

4. Click OK to save your changes.

Action: Specifying an action for a window


You can specify an action for Vista to perform upon opening or closing a particular window. For
example, if you want Vista to automatically engage a modem tool (such as the Connection
Manager) every time you open a certain grouping window, you can specify the tool as an action.

Specifying an Open or Close action

1. Right-click the background of the user diagram or grouping window and select Properties to
open the Window Properties Configuration dialog.

2. On the Action tab, select Command line on open or Command line on close.

3. Click Browse to open the Browse dialog, locate the program you want, select the .exe file,
and click Open.

The specified file and path name appears in the box below the selected option.

4. Click OK to save your changes.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1399


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: To remove an action, clear the check box beside the option.

Updates: Setting the time interval


Data that is not updated is considered stale data. Vista detects stale data as it occurs and identifies
it with a colored border around the diagram object (the default color is yellow).
On the Updates tab, you can specify the interval of time Vista uses to detect stale data. The
Updates tab has two sections:

• Update Period allows you to specify how often data in that window is refreshed.

• Stale Data allows you to specify whether data is highlighted and how old data must be to be
considered “stale”.

NOTE: The Update Period and Stale Data settings also apply to Diagrams.

Changing the Update and Stale Data settings

1. Right-click the background of the window and select Properties to open the Window
Properties Configuration dialog.

2. Select the Update tab.

3. Enter a numeric value in seconds in the Update data period or Stale data timeout fields to
set the intervals.

4. Select or clear the Highlight stale data check box to enable or disable checking for stale
data.

5. Click OK to save your changes.

To change the color of the stale data border, close the Window Properties Configuration dialog, then
select Options > Flag Colors to open the Flag Colors dialog. Click Edit beside “Stale Flag Color”
to open a dialog where you can select a different color.

1400 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Web Applications

TIP: Open Web Applications from the EcoStruxure Power Monitoring Expert folder on your
desktop, the Schneider Electric folder on the Start Screen, or by entering the PME server URL into
your browser Address bar, e.g. http://srv1.MyCompany.com/Web

RECOMMENDATION: To reduce the risk of cybersecurity attacks, access Web Applications


only from client computers and not from the PME server.

Overview
Web Applications is the main interface for accessing PME power system information. Use Web
Applications to view real-time data, alarms, historical trends, key performance indicators, reports,
and other information about the power system you are monitoring. Web Applications also provides
several configuration settings and tools to configure and customize your PME system.
The following is a list of applications for accessing power system information through Web
Applications:

Application Function
Alarms View and analyze Incidents, Alarms, and Events; Acknowledge alarms.
Dashboards View high level, historical and real-time data in dashboards and gadgets.
Diagrams View low level, historical and real-time data in one-line and graphics diagrams.
Reports Run reports on demand or scheduled.
Trends View trends for real-time and historical data.

For a list of configuration tools and settings, see Web Applications settings.

When you open Web Applications, you are prompted to log in with your username and password.
The access level assigned to your username determines which applications and which functions
are available to you. See Default User Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level
Privileges for details.

Specifying Which Application to Open First


When you connect to Web Applications through a client computer, the application whose link is on
the left of the series of application links opens in the browser. To specify a different application to
open first, add one of the following application query parameters into the Web address.

/#Dashboards /#Alarms
/#Diagrams /#Reports
/#Trends

For example, http://srv1.MyCompany.com/Web/#Trends opens the Trends application in


the browser.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1401


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Opening Web Applications Without Banner


You can open any of the Web applications by itself without showing the Web Applications banner
and navigation bar. To open a Web application in this way, enter the PME server URL with
/<application name> in a browser address bar. For example,
http://srv1.MyCompany.com/Trends opens the Trends application in the browser without
the Web Applications UI elements.

Web Applications User Interface


The top right of the banner contains:

• Your user name: The user name you used to log in.

• Logout link: Logs you out of Web Applications and returns you to the log in page.

• Help link: Opens the browser-based online help for the Web Applications component and the
integrated applications.

Alarm Annunciator
The Alarm Annunciator shows information on the number of active and unacknowledged Alarms. It
is displayed in the banner area of the Web Applications and is visible from any of the PME Web
apps. The Annunciator alerts you to any new alarms that are occurring in the system. You can
configure it to play a sound when certain alarm conditions are met.

When you click on one of the priority colored areas in the Annunciator, from anywhere in Web
Applications, it opens the Alarm Viewer and automatically filters the view to show all alarms with
that priority. You can customize the behavior of the Annunciator, including the alarm sound, on the
Web Applications settings page.

The Annunciator looks like this:

In this example, the Annunciator shows:

• 1 low priority, active and unacknowledged Alarm (blue)

• 8 medium priority, active and unacknowledged Alarms (yellow)

• 10 high priority, active and unacknowledged Alarms (red)

The presence of the speaker icon indicates that it is configured to play a sound when new active and
unacknowledged alarms occur. Click the speaker icon to mute or unmute the alarm sound.

NOTE: You must have controller, operator, or supervisor-level access to see the Annunciator. If
you have observer or user-level access, it is not displayed.

Library Pane
The library pane contains items and configuration options for the selected application. To show or
hide the library pane, click the bar on the right or left side of the display area.

Display Pane
The display pane loads the data visualization selected in the configuration pane.

1402 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Time Display in Web Applications


Most of the information displayed in the Web Applications is time based, such as timestamped real-
time data and historical data. In a PME system there are 3 reference points for time zones: the
monitoring devices/sources, the PME server, the Web client (browser).

PME supports configurations where the devices/sources, the server, and the client are in different
time zones. For example, a user in time zone A accesses the PME server which is in time zone B.
The monitoring devices that are providing the data are located in time zone C.
The following table shows how the different Web Applications display time with regards to time
zone:

Web Application Time Zone Used for Display


Device/source time zone as configured in Management Console or
Dashboards
Device Manager.
Device/source time zone as configured in Management Console or
Diagrams
Device Manager.
Trends Web client (browser) time zone as configured in the client browser.
Device/source time zone as configured in Management Console or
Alarms
Device Manager. *
Time zone can be manually selected. Default is Web client
Reports
(browser) time zone.

* Alarms has tooltips that show the time in both the device/source time zone, and the Web client
(browser) time zone.

NOTE: Web Applications uses Management Console or Device Manager time zone settings for
the device / source time zone. The time zone settings in Management Console or Device Manager
are set per device and must be configured correctly, for Web Applications to show the correct
time. The time zone settings in Management Console or Device Manager are independent of time
zone settings on the devices themselves. Web Applications does not use the time zone settings
on the devices themselves.

Disabling the time zone option Adjust for daylight saving time automatically in the Windows
Date & Time settings on the PME application server affects the PME Windows applications, not
the web clients. To disable daylight savings time for all the PME applications, perform the following:

1. On the PME application server, in the Windows Date & Time settings select an alternate time
zone without Adjust for daylight saving time automatically option.

For example: If your existing Windows time zone is (UTC-08:00) Pacific Time (US &
Canada), which has the Adjust for daylight saving time automatically option then select
(UTC-8:00) Coordinated Universal Time-08, which does not have the Adjust for daylight
saving time automatically option.

2. On the Management Console for existing devices, set the Time Zone as the selected
Windows time zone.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1403


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: For new devices, the Management Console Time Zone is set to the Windows time
zone automatically.

1404 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Software Modules
Software modules combine different software features and capabilities to create a specific set of
deliverables. Software modules are designed around a particular application. Examples of software
modules include the Power Quality Performance Module, the Energy Analysis Reports Module, and
the Breaker Performance Module.

This section provides information on how to use the Software Modules in Power Monitoring Expert.

Use the links in the following table to find the module you are looking for:

Module Application
Backup Power Module Generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) performance
operation monitoring and reporting, including battery health.
Breaker Performance
Circuit breaker aging and breaker settings monitoring.
Module operation
Generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) capacity
Capacity Management
monitoring and reporting. Includes transformer and UPS loss
Module operation
monitoring.
Energy Analysis Dashboard Gadgets for identifying consumption patterns and anomalies and for
Module operation comparing different consumers over time.
Energy Analysis Reports Reports for energy consumption monitoring and modeling, including
Module operation energy usage by process area or by product output.
Energy Billing Module Energy-based billing and reporting, including consumption
operation monitoring and reporting at the branch circuit level.
Event Notification Module
Notifications of power system events via email or SMS.
operation
Insulation Monitoring Monitoring for isolated power systems, such as the ones found in
Module operation hospital operating rooms.
Power Quality Performance Analysis of power quality events and disturbances and their impact
Module operation on the monitored system.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1405


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Backup Power Module operation


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Backup Power Module provides generator and Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) monitoring
and reporting. It reports on generator and UPS performance and battery health.

The Generator Test EPSS Report can be configured to conform to the requirements for an
Emergency Power Supply System (EPSS) test, including automatic transfer switches (ATS). For
example, the report shows the transfer time of the lead ATS and indicates whether the transfer time
passes or does not pass the test requirements. See Emergency Power Supply Systems for more
information on EPSS.
Use the Backup Power module to:

• Identify generator problems that could prevent a transfer to backup power.

• Automatically record and document the backup generator system test.

• Monitor the generator battery health.

• Report on backup generator run times.

• Monitor the condition of your UPS, including the battery health.

The following reports and diagrams are part of this module:

Type Reports Diagrams


Generator Activity
Generator Generator Battery Health
EPSS Diagrams
Performance Generator Test EPSS
Generator Load Summary
UPS UPS Auto Test
UPS Auto Test diagrams
Performance UPS Battery Health

For information on how use the Backup Power diagrams and reports, see:

• Backup Power Reports

• EPSS diagrams

• UPS Auto Test diagrams

Related topics:
Backup Power Module topics

• Backup Power Module design

• Backup Power Module configuration

• Backup Power Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Breaker Performance Module operation

• Capacity Management Module operation

1406 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation

• Energy Analysis Reports Module operation

• Energy Billing Module operation

• Event Notification Module operation

• Insulation Monitoring Module operation

• Power Quality Performance Module operation

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1407


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Breaker Performance Module operation


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Breaker Performance Module monitors aging and wear of circuit breakers and reports on
breaker protection settings. It provides historical and real-time information for aging and wear related
breaker parameters. You can also set up alarming on these parameters.
Use the Breaker Performance module to:

• Monitor circuit breaker health related to wear and aging.

• Increase the MTBF of the main electrical switchboard.

• Support your predictive maintenance action plan and budget.

• Report on breaker protection settings.

The following reports and diagrams are part of this module:

• Breaker Aging Report

• Breaker Settings Report

• Breaker Aging Vista diagrams

For information on how use the Breaker Performance reports and diagrams, see:

• Breaker Performance Reports

• Breaker Aging diagrams

Related topics:
Breaker Performance Module topics

• Breaker Performance Module Design

• Breaker Performance Module configuration

• Breaker Performance Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module operation

• Capacity Management Module operation

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation

• Energy Analysis Reports Module operation

• Energy Billing Module operation

• Event Notification Module operation

• Insulation Monitoring Module operation

• Power Quality Performance Module operation

1408 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Capacity Management Module operation


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Capacity Management Module provides generator, Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS), and
general equipment monitoring and reporting. It also includes transformer and UPS loss monitoring
and reporting. The losses are reported in terms of energy and cost.

Use the Capacity Management Module to:

• Analyze IT branch circuit power loading.

• Understand remaining capacity at the branch circuit level.

• Understand generator and UPS system power loading.

• Understand if the generator and UPS loading compromises the design redundancy of the
backup supply system.

The following reports are part of this module:

• Branch Circuit Power Report

• Equipment Capacity Report

• Generator Capacity Report

• Generator Power Report

• Power Losses Report

• UPS Power Report

For information on how use the Capacity Management Module reports, see Power Capacity
Reports

Related topics:
Capacity Management Module topics

• Capacity Management Module Design

• Capacity Management Module configuration

• Capacity Management Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module operation

• Breaker Performance Module operation

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation

• Energy Analysis Reports Module operation

• Energy Billing Module operation

• Event Notification Module operation

• Insulation Monitoring Module operation

• Power Quality Performance Module operation

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1409


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Energy Analysis Dashboard Module includes dashboard gadgets that help you break down
consumption by load type, visualize consumption cost, and do an 80/20 analysis to identify the
largest consumers. You can identify consumption patterns and anomalies and compare different
consumers over time.

Use the Energy Analysis Dashboard Module to:

• Break down consumption by load type.

• Visualize consumption cost.

• Do an 80/20 analysis to identify the largest consumers.

• Identify consumption patterns and anomalies.

• Compare different consumers over time.

The following gadgets are part of this module:

• Sankey gadget

• Pareto Chart gadget

• Aggregated Pareto Chart gadget

• Heat Map gadget

• Consumption Ranking gadget

• Aggregated Consumption Ranking gadget

See Gadgets for information on how to use these gadgets.

Related topics:
Energy Analysis Dashboard Module topics

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module design

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module configuration

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module operation

• Breaker Performance Module operation

• Capacity Management Module operation

• Energy Analysis Reports Module operation

• Energy Billing Module operation

• Event Notification Module operation

• Insulation Monitoring Module operation

• Power Quality Performance Module operation

1410 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Energy Analysis Reports Module operation


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Energy Analysis Reports Module includes reports that help you understand energy usage
patterns to find energy waste, analyze transformer and circuit capacity and assess energy usage by
process area or by product output. Use the energy modeling capabilities in this module, to forecast
consumption, identify unexpected changes in your consumption, or identify actual savings as a
result of energy management measures.

Use the Energy Analysis Reports Module to:

• Understand energy usage patterns and find energy waste.

• Analyze transformer and circuit capacity as configurations change and loads are added.

• Determine what factors contribute most to energy usage.

• Assess energy usage by process area or by product output.

• Track KPIs such as Energy Intensity (kWh/unit) or Coefficient of Performance (COP) Evaluate
energy usage in the context of environmental factors or production.

• Create energy usage models and compare actual consumption against expected

• Track and analyze Power Usage Efficiency (PUE)

The following reports are part of this module:

• Create Model Report

• Duration Curve Report

• Energy Modeling Reports

• Energy Regression Analysis Report

• Energy Usage Per State Report

• KPI Report

• KPI by TOU Report

• Multi Equipment Operation Report

• Power Usage Per State Report

• PUE Summary Report

• Single Equipment Operation Report

• Use Model Report

For information on how to use the Energy Analysis Reports Module reports, see Energy Analysis
Reports.

Related topics:
Energy Analysis Reports Module topics

• Energy Analysis Reports Module design

• Energy Analysis Reports Module configuration

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1411


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Energy Analysis Reports Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module operation

• Breaker Performance Module operation

• Capacity Management Module operation

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation

• Energy Billing Module operation

• Event Notification Module operation

• Insulation Monitoring Module operation

• Power Quality Performance Module operation

1412 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Energy Billing Module operation


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Energy Billing Module is a fully functional energy-based billing reporting system. It also
provides load and consumption monitoring and reporting at the branch circuit level, which is typically
used in data center applications.
Use the Energy Billing Module to:

• Allocate energy costs to consumers.

• Verify utility bills through shadow billing.

• Avoid demand charges.

• Export energy billing data to accounting and financial systems.

• Allocate branch circuit consumption to customers and IT racks.

• Produce energy threshold reports.

• Bill clients for excess energy consumption.

The following reports are part of this module:

• Billing Report

• Billing Summary Report

• Billing Verification Report

• Energy by IT Customer Report

• Multiple Billing Report

• Multiple Billing Export Report

For information on how use the Billing reports (except Energy by IT Customer Report), see Billing
Reports

For information on how use the Energy by IT Customer Report, see IT Billing Reports

Related topics:
Energy Billing Module topics

• Energy Billing Module design

• Energy Billing Module configuration

• Energy Billing Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module operation

• Breaker Performance Module operation

• Capacity Management Module operation

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1413


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Energy Analysis Reports Module operation

• Event Notification Module operation

• Insulation Monitoring Module operation

• Power Quality Performance Module operation

1414 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Event Notification Module operation

NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

Use the Event Notification Module (ENM) to notify recipients about critical power system events.
ENM can send notifications of power system events through email or SMS. ENM uses the Alarms
application to detect system events. You can set up notifications for activity in any of the event,
alarm, or incident views. The notification details are defined in a notification rule. A notification rule
can be enabled or disabled, and you can use a schedule to determine when the rule is applied. You
can define more than one notification rule.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not rely solely on Event Notification Module use for alarm notification where human or
equipment safety relies on the operation of the control action.
• Do not use Event Notification Module to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

NOTE: Other parts of the overall communication system, such as email servers and cellular phone
systems, could fail and result in notifications not being delivered. If notifications are not delivered
to recipients, conditions that cause alarming may persist and result in safety critical issues.

Notifications are sent out automatically based on the configuration of the module. See Event
Notification Module configuration for information on how to configure notifications. See Event
Notification Module Design for prerequisites and design considerations.
Related topics:
Event Notification Module topics

• Event Notification Module Design

• Event Notification Module configuration

• Event Notification Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module operation

• Breaker Performance Module operation

• Capacity Management Module operation

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1415


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Energy Analysis Reports Module operation

• Energy Billing Module operation

• Insulation Monitoring Module operation

• Power Quality Performance Module operation

1416 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

Insulation Monitoring Module operation


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Insulation Monitoring Module provides monitoring for isolated (IT) power systems, such as the
ones found in hospital operating rooms. It also helps in locating isolation faults. The module can be
configured for applications based on the IEC standard, and for applications based on the
ANSI standard.

Use the Insulation Monitoring Module to:

• Monitor the status of the isolated power system.

• Identify situations when the isolation of the system might be compromised.

The following report and diagrams are part of this module:

• Insulation Monitoring Report (ANSI and IEC)

• Vista diagrams for group, area, and area details levels (ANSI and IEC)

For information on how to use the Insulation Monitoring diagrams and reports, see:

• Insulation Monitoring diagrams

• Insulation Monitoring Reports

Related topics:
Insulation Monitoring Module topics

• Insulation Monitoring Module Design

• Insulation Monitoring Module configuration

• Insulation Monitoring Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module operation

• Breaker Performance Module operation

• Capacity Management Module operation

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation

• Energy Analysis Reports Module operation

• Energy Billing Module operation

• Event Notification Module operation

• Power Quality Performance Module operation

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1417


Operate EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Quality Performance Module operation


NOTE: This module requires a separate license. See Licensing for more information.

The Power Quality (PQ) Performance Module analyzes power quality event and disturbance data as
well as power factor measurements. It determines the potential impacts of power quality on the
monitored power system and displays the results in graphical formats, with color coding to highlight
problem areas. The module combines standard software features with specialized components to
produce its outputs. The module can also analyzes power quality event and disturbance data as
well as power factor measurements based on the hierarchy sites, which are assigned to a user
group.

Use the Power Quality Performance module to:

• Baseline and monitor PQ in facilities.

• Understand the financial impact of PQ related process disruptions.

• Show the cost of power factor penalties.

• Identify the type and origin (internal vs external) of PQ events.

• Diagnose PQ events and find root causes.

The following reports, diagrams, and Dashboard Gadgets are part of this module:

• Power Quality Impact report

• Power Quality Analysis report

• Power Quality Indicator diagrams

• Standardized Equipment diagrams

• Power Quality Rating gadget

• Power Quality Rating Trend gadget

• Power Quality Incident Breakdown gadget

• Power Quality Incident Impact gadget

• Power Quality Incident Location gadget

• Power Quality Impact gadget

• Power Quality Impact Trend gadget

• Power Factor Impact gadget

• Power Factor Impact Trend gadget

For Power Quality Performance Module for multiple sites, all listed reports, diagrams, and
Dashboard Gadgets except Standardized Equipment diagrams is part of this module.

For information on how use the Power Quality Performance gadgets, diagrams, and reports, see:

• Power Quality Impact Report

• Power Quality Analysis Report

1418 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Operate

• Power Quality Performance diagrams

• Power Quality gadgets

Related topics:
Power Quality Performance Module topics

• Power Quality Performance Module Design

• Power Quality Performance Module configuration

• Power Quality Performance Module operation

Other Software Modules

• Backup Power Module operation

• Breaker Performance Module operation

• Capacity Management Module operation

• Energy Analysis Dashboard Module operation

• Energy Analysis Reports Module operation

• Energy Billing Module operation

• Event Notification Module operation

• Insulation Monitoring Module operation

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1419


Troubleshoot EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Troubleshoot
This chapter provides information on how to troubleshoot Power Monitoring Expert (PME) and how
to resolve problems and issues.

To troubleshoot issues with PME follow these steps:

1. Search the Schneider Electric Knowledge Base/FAQ for a resolution. Use search keywords
including product, version, component and specific issue. See Resources for information on
how to access the knowledge base.

2. (EcoXperts and Schneider Electric employees) Search the Exchange Community for a
resolution. Use keywords including product, version, component and specific issue. See
Resources for information on how to access the Exchange Community.

3. Use the information in this chapter to find a solution to the problem yourself

4. If steps 1-3 don’t resolve your problem, contact Technical Support. See Resources for
information on how to contact technical support.

When you contact Technical Support, be prepared to provide the following information:

• Problem overview.

• Steps to reproduce the problem.

• Relevant PME system history, for example upgrades, expansions, IT policy changes, and so
on.

• Screen captures or videos of the problem.

• Have a recent backup of the PME databases (ION_Data, ION_Network, ApplicationModules


and ION_SystemLog).

• Any additional information that can help with the investigation, for example diagnostics outputs,
PME system log entries, Windows system log entries, and so on.

NOTE: The more information you can provide, the less time it will take to resolve the issue.

For information on troubleshooting tools, see Tools for troubleshooting.

1420 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Troubleshoot

Tools for troubleshooting


The following tools can help you with troubleshooting:

• Windows Event Viewer

• Web browser developer tools

• PME Diagnostics tool

• PME system log

• PME application modules diagnostics

• Modbus test utility

• Diagnostics Viewer

• Network packet analyzer

Windows Event Viewer


The Windows Event Viewer is a Microsoft tool that is part of the Windows operating system.

Use the Event Viewer to see Windows event logs for Application, Security, Setup, and System.
These logs might include messages related to the problem you are trying to solve, for example
entries about services shutting down or other unexpected events.

Open Event Viewer in Windows from Control Panel > Administrative Tools, or search for Event
Viewer in Windows search.

Web browser developer tools


Web browser developer tools are diagnostic features built into most web browsers.

Use the browser tools to investigate issues that happen in the PME web applications interfaces.
When an error happens in the web client, it is not always recorded in the PME or Windows event
logs. For example, when a PME user account is deleted from the system, the web application
sends a HTML request to the PME application server to delete the user. If, for some reason, this
request is not received by the server, it will not be recorded in the PME system log. Web browser
developer tools can help troubleshoot these kind of issues. It is also possible to record a web
session with the tools. This recorded session (saved as .HAR file) can then be viewed by Technical
Support to analyze the web browser activity.

To open the web browser developer tools: Press F12 on your keyboard while the web browser is
open.

PME Diagnostics tool


The Diagnostics tool is a built-in feature of PME.

Use the Diagnostics tool to retrieve diagnostics information from the system databases, files, and
libraries. The information collected by the tool is packaged in a way that makes it easy to send it to
Technical Support.

To open the Diagnostics Tool: Start Diagnostics Tool.exe from ...\Power Monitoring
Expert\Diagnostics Tool\

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1421


Troubleshoot EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

PME system log


The system log is a built-in feature of PME.

Use the system log to find information on system activities, including warnings or errors.

To view the system log: Open the PMELog Viewer.

PME application modules diagnostics


Application modules diagnostics is a built-in feature of PME.

Use application modules diagnostics to find information on issues related to Web Applications.

To view application module diagnostics: Open the Diagnostics.LogEvent table in the


Application Modules database in PME.

Modbus test utility


Modbus test utilities are third party tools that are used to diagnose Modbus communications.

Use a Modbus test utility to monitor and troubleshoot communications between devices and the
software. For example, a Modbus test utility can help you identify if device communication issues
originate outside the software through wiring, incorrect device configuration, or other causes.

To find a Modbus test utility, search the Internet for products that meet your needs.

Diagnostics Viewer
The Diagnostics Viewer is a built-in feature of PME.

NOTE: Diagnostics Viewer and Diagnostics Tool are two different applications in PME.

Use Diagnostics Viewer to find information on the operation of PME services and on device
communications. For example, you can view Log Inserter and Siteserver interactions with the
devices in the system. See Diagnostics Viewer for more information on this tool.

Open Diagnostics Viewer in PME from Management Console > Tools> System.

Network packet analyzer


Network packet analyzers are third party tools that are used to monitor and log digital network
traffic.

Use a packet analyzer for network troubleshooting and analysis. For example, you can monitor the
communications between an Ethernet power monitoring device and PME as part of your
troubleshooting activities.

To find a packet analyzer, search the Internet for products that meet your needs.

NOTE: Wireshark, an open-source product, and Fiddler, a freeware product, are examples of well
known packet analyzers.

1422 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Troubleshoot

Diagnostics Viewer
Diagnostics Viewer is a tool you can use to troubleshoot network communications problems and
related network errors.

Starting Diagnostics Viewer


1. Start Management Console and log in.

2. Click Tools > System > Diagnostics Viewer.

TIP: For instructions on using filtering, sorting, column selection, and pin/unpin to customize the
Diagnostics Viewer display, see Customizing and navigating interface displays.

Navigation pane
Diagnostics information is grouped as follows:

• Service Diagnostics: Contains diagnostics information for certain services (ION Network
Router Service, ION Site Service and ION Log Inserter Service).

• Communication Diagnostics: Contains diagnostics information for the sites, hardware


devices, and software nodes.

Select an item in the navigation pane to display its diagnostics information.

If you add a new device to the system while Diagnostics Viewer is open, you can refresh the tree
view to display the new device by collapsing then expanding the root node of the tree.

Diagnostics Information pane


The diagnostics information pane displays detailed data about the state of your power monitoring
system and devices.

Service Diagnostics
Service Diagnostics records communication problems and similar events occurring with the
product's software components.

Communication Server diagnostics


Information about the communications server is arranged in these tabs:

• Console Messages lists all ION Network Router Service and ION Site Service console
messages for the current session.

TIP: The blank area below the Description column header is a dynamic filter field. Type the
wildcard character (*) in front of the text you want to search (for example, to display only
messages prefixed with WARNING, type *warning). The diagnostics information pane
automatically displays only those records that match the text you typed in the box.

• Connection Status displays the current status of the software components connected to
Network Router.

• Tree States displays the ION tree status of all nodes (hardware devices and software nodes).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1423


Troubleshoot EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Log Inserter diagnostics


The Log Inserter diagnostics information pane is split into two sections. The top section (Select
Nodes pane) contains the available nodes, while the bottom section contains the node details.

Select nodes to display

In the Select Nodes pane, select the check box beside a node to display its diagnostics
information. Clear the check box to hide that node’s diagnostics information.

TIP: If there are many nodes and you want to display only a few of them, right-click the Select
Nodes area then click Clear All. Select only the nodes you want to display. To display all the
nodes again, right-click the Select Nodes area and click Select All.

Node details

The node details are organized in these tabs:

• Node Information provides diagnostics associated with the communication status of each
selected node. If the Log Inserter is not configured to gather data from a given node, it does not
appear in the list in the Node column. If the Log Inserter is configured to automatically gather
information for a node, but that node has not yet been processed, it does not initially appear in
the list. Once information becomes available, the node appears (if it has been selected).

• Node Performance provides per-node performance summary information.

• Log Performance provides performance information on a per log basis.

The following table summarizes the columns on the Node Information tab:

Column Description
Node The name of the device, VIP, or Log Inserter.
The device type of the associated node that is returned by the device
DeviceType
itself. The Log Inserter uses this to detect device swap outs.
The serial number of the device that is returned by the device. The Log
SerialNumber
Inserter uses this to detect device swap outs.
The requested polling interval in effect. It can be configured either from
Configured Polling the log upload control or from the custom Windows Registry value. All
Interval (s) of the nodes for which polling is disabled are identified with Polling
Disabled in this column.

1424 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Troubleshoot

Column Description
A weighted average time between polled results for the device. The
most recent interval accounts for 20% of the value, and the previous
average accounts for the remainder. If the value deviates from the
average by more than 30s, then the old average is discarded and the
Average Update Interval current interval is used. By default, the expected value for devices that
(s) support logs is the Configured Polling Interval (s) value. The expected
value for devices that do not support logs is 60 seconds.
If the Log Inserter is selected but it is not configured to collect data from
its System Log Controller, it appears in the diagnostics and shows
300s for Average Update Interval. Initially this value is n/a.
The time in seconds since the last communication with the node. This
Time Since Update (s)
time includes polling updates, record uploads, and configuration loads.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1425


Troubleshoot EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Column Description
Can be one of the following values:

• alive – The node is communicating.

• late – If a response to a polling program is not received within 3


minutes, the Log Inserter sends a ping. If the ping does not respond
in 10 minutes, the communication status is set to late and
another ping is sent. The system continues pinging every 10
minutes until a response is received.

• expired – If a ping returns before the response for any preceding


request, the original request was lost. The request is abandoned
and the communication status is set to expired. A request can
be lost if a destination Site Server or VIP is shut down. The state
changes from expired when the device responds to a request.

• timeout – A request to the device timed out. The device is not


communicating.

• site not connected – The site is currently not connected.

• cannot send – An unrecoverable error. The Log Inserter cannot


send a program to the communications subsystem. The Log
Inserter shuts down if Network Router is not running. Restart the
system.

CommStatus • invalid password – The password entered for this device in


Management Console is invalid.

• password changed – The password for this device has been


changed. Update the password for the device in Management
Console.

• site not responding – The connection is unexpectedly


broken during communication with the device.

• device disabled – The device or its site is not enabled. Note


that Log Inserter automatically removes this node from this list if
the node had been detected by automatic means.

• does not exist – The device is not registered in the system. In


auto-mode, the device eventually disappears from the list unless it
is referenced remotely by a VIP.

• pending – No responses have been processed.

• nack'd – The request was not acknowledged. This could mean


that the Site Server hosting the device is not running.

• validating – Treemon reported that the device is not


responding. A signal is sent to Treemon to validate the state. This
state clears once Treemon (via Validator) establishes
communications with the device.

1426 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Troubleshoot

Column Description
Under steady-state conditions, this is blank. While the Log Inserter
attempts to upload configuration information, this can contain a string
value indicating that the Tree is in use by another client.
This indicates that the Log Inserter cannot process the device until the
Comments
aforementioned client releases it. If the client is ION Designer, it is not
released until the node is closed in Designer or Designer is closed. If
the client's name ends with -not-clean, the node is currently being
evaluated by Treemon/Validator.
The aggregate setup count of the device. The Log Inserter uses this to
AggregateSetupCount
detect configuration changes.
The number of ION registers, modules, and/or managers that have
been requested from the tree. The Log Inserter needs to upload
configuration information to determine which logs need to be
processed, which labels should be used for measurement mapping and
source resolution, and which labels to use for event cause and effects.
The Log Inserter retrieves the currently cached tree from Treemon,
populating as needed by communicating directly with the device. The
tree is locked for the duration of this process, and this prevents
RequestedIONs Designer from opening the tree.
If the value is:

• none – No configuration information is currently required. This is


typical in a steady-state condition.

• cache – Only the currently cached configuration is required. This


is typically seen at startup.

• A number – The Log Inserter needs specific information and that


number of ION objects has been explicitly requested.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1427


Troubleshoot EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Column Description
The status of the tree requests can include one of the following values:

• ready – The Log Inserter does not require any configuration


information.

• requesting – The Log Inserter requires configuration information


and is in the process of gathering it. The value in Request Update
Time indicates how long it has been processing this request.

• retrying – A previous tree request was not successful. (See the


Comments column for the reason.) The request is retried, as
shown by the value in Request Update Time. The amount of wait
time before retrying a request depends on the nature of the
unsuccessful tree request:
Tree in use by another node – 10 seconds.

Tree dirty – 10 seconds.

Not responding – 60 seconds.

RequestStatus Tree request timed out after 10 minutes – 5 minutes.

Comm error – 10 seconds.

Other errors – 5 minutes.

• blocked – The Log Inserter requires configuration information but


all available resources are in use. By default, the Log Inserter can
simultaneously request only up to 2 trees per site and 6 trees in
total. The Request Update Time value indicates how long the
request has been pending.

• processing – The Log Inserter has received the requested ION


objects and is processing them. The Request Update Time value
indicates how long this request has been processed, including the
time during the "requesting" state.

• abandoned – This is the same as the retrying status but the


request of some of the configuration information was not
successful following the successful receipt of some information.
The Log Inserter recovers when it retries the request.
Request Update Time The time varies depending on the status of the tree requests described
(s) for RequestStatus.
The program ID of the program used to poll the current position
pID counters. The Log Inserter now performs its own polling, and as a
result, the entry in this column is not used for diagnostic purposes.

The following table summarizes the columns on the Node Performance tab:

Column Description
Node The name of the device, VIP, or Log Inserter.

1428 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Troubleshoot

Column Description
Indicates whether or not the node is responding. For a VIP, this
includes all external nodes connected, directly or indirectly, to the input
Responding
of a Recorder. The responding state is used to determine whether or
not the download of the log is caught up.
Indicates if log upload is disabled for all recorders on the device. A Yes
All Logs Polling Disabled
in the column indicates that log upload is disabled.
The total number of Data Recorders, Waveform Recorders, Event Log
Controllers, and System Log Controllers that the Log Inserter is
TotalLogs configured to collect data from a given node. Note that when
automatically detecting these modules, this number may change as the
Log Inserter gathers configuration information.
The total number of records that the Log Inserter has requested from
PendingRecords
the node but has not yet received.
The total number of records not yet uploaded based on the last read
OutstandingRecords position counter on the device and the position of the last uploaded
record, taking into account the maximum depth of each log.
The number of records that have been inserted into the database. Note
ProcessedRecords that a record typically corresponds to a number of DataLog entries. The
term "record" refers to records at the device level.
Generated Rec. per sec An estimate of the number of new records being generated per second.
Retrieved Rec. per sec An estimate of the number of records being uploaded per second.
The average round-trip time in seconds taken to retrieve a record from a
Avg Retrieval Time (s)
device.
The average time in seconds necessary to insert a record into the
Avg Processing Time (s)
database.
The total number of logs that the Log Inserter is configured to gather
RestoredLogs
information for.
The total number from the value in RestoredLogs that is being
ManagedLogs
monitored by an enabled Log Acquisition Module (LAM).
The total number from the value in RestoredLogs that are Recorders
ConfiguredLogs and have source inputs or are Event Log Controllers or System Log
Controllers.
The total number from the value in RestoredLogs for which the current
ConfirmedLogs
configuration is known.
The total number from the value in RestoredLogs for which the node is
NumCaughtUp
responding and there are no records outstanding or pending.

The following table summarizes the columns on the Log Performance tab:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1429


Troubleshoot EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Column Description
Node The name of the device, VIP, or Log Inserter in question.
LogHandle The handle of the Log Register or Event Log Register for this Node.
Indicates whether or not the node is responding. For a VIP, this
includes all external nodes connected, directly or indirectly, to the input
Responding
of a Recorder. This state is used to determine whether or not it is
caught up.
Indicates which individual recorders are excluded from polling
Polling Disabled
requests. A Yes in the column indicates which recorders are excluded.
The total number of records that the Log Inserter has requested from
the node but has not yet received. This number includes event records
PendingRecords that have been uploaded but are cached internally pending
configuration information necessary to complete the processing of the
cause and/or effect ION objects.
The total number of records not yet uploaded based on the last read
OutstandingRecords position counter on the device and the position of the last uploaded
record, taking into account the maximum depth of each log.
The number of records that have been inserted into the database. Note
ProcessedRecords that a record typically corresponds to a number of DataLog entries. In
this context, "record" refers to records at the device level.
Generated Rec. per sec An estimate of the number of new records being generated per second.
Retrieved Rec. per sec An estimate of the number of records being uploaded per second.
The average round-trip time in seconds taken to retrieve a record from a
Avg Retrieval Time (s)
device.
The average time in seconds necessary to insert a record into the
Avg Processing Time (s)
database.
This is always yes. If the log is not "restored", it does not appear in the
Restored
list.
Managed A Log Acquisition Module (LAM) is enabled that is monitoring this log.
The log is a Recorder that has source inputs or it is an Event Log
Configured
Controller or a System Log Controller.
The latest configuration for the log has been uploaded. For a VIP
Confirmed Recorder that references external devices, directly or indirectly, the
configuration information includes information from the external device.
The node is communicating, the current configuration is known, and
CaughtUp there are no outstanding or pending records. For a VIP, any device on
which the log depends for information must also be responding.

Alarm Service
Alarm Service provides the status of alarms that you configure and enable in the Software Alarms
application.

1430 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Troubleshoot

The information is organized in a grid. The column labels indicate the type of information provided,
such as Rule Name, Alarm Name, Alarm Status, and so on. See the Software Alarms Help
(accessible from the Software Alarms application) for further information about configuring alarms
for multiple sources and measurements.

Log Pipeline Service


The Log Pipeline Service diagnostics provides information on the Log Subsystem Data Pipeline. It
shows a variety of statistics on log collection and insertion performance.

Log Inserter writes log data into a message queue instead of writing it to SQL Server directly.
Another process (the Log Subsystem Router Service) reads the messages from the queue and
writes the data to SQL Server.

Previously, the Log Inserter would wait for database writes to complete before processing the next
piece of data. This effectively limited the rate of data insertion to something that SQL Server could
handle. Writing to MSMQ is much faster: MSMQ can store messages in the queue faster than Log
Inserter can retrieve them from the devices. However the performance of SQL Server has not
changed, which means that data can accumulate in the queue faster than it can be inserted into the
database. Allowing the message queues to become full (they have a limited storage capacity)
results in failure modes that are difficult to handle automatically. To avoid this scenario we monitor
the size of the inbound data message queue and prevent writes when it contains more than a set
number of bytes. If the message queue reaches a specified capacity, then no future messages will
be accepted from LogInserter and the write thread is "put on hold" until the message queue has
dropped below a specified capacity. This ensures that LogInserter never considers data written that
may be missed in the message queue due to over capacity.

The following table summarizes the columns on the Pipeline Status tab:

Column Description
Identifies the message queue (Primary or Secondary) and the type of
Name
data being tracked.
Total time that the diagnostics have been counted. In practice this
Duration
value will be identical for all rows.
Number of messages that have been processed from this queue since
Message Count
the service was started.
Messages Per Minute Number of messages that have been processed in the last minute.
Messages Per Minute
Average of the messages per minute over the last hour (60 samples).
Average
Messages Per Minute Maximum number of messages per minute over the last hour (60
Max samples).
Messages Per Second Number of messages that have been processed in the last second.
Messages Per Second Average of the messages per second over the last minute (60
Average samples).
Messages Per Second Maximum number of messages per second over the last minute (60
Max samples).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1431


Troubleshoot EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Column Description
Processing Time
Average time taken to process each message (milliseconds).
Milliseconds Average
Processing Time
Maximum message processing time (milliseconds).
Milliseconds Max
Time Since Last Elapsed time since a message was last processed.
Start Time Utc Time in UTC at which the service was started.

The following table summarizes the columns on the Message Queues tab:

Column Description
Identity Identity of the message queue.
Queue Type Data or Control
Message Count Number of messages currently in the queue.
Message Kilobytes Size of messages currently in the queue (kilobytes).
Maximum size allowed for the queue.  Note that a value of
4294967295.00 (4GB) is the maximum amount of data that the entire
Maximum Kilobytes
MSMQ service can support.  This effectively indicates that no queue-
specific limit has been defined.

The Message Queues tab allows you to inspect messages flowing through the pipeline. Enabling
message capture increases the load on the pipeline so this should not be left activated indefinitely.

The controls on the top select which messages are written to the table. This filtering only occurs as
the messages arrive at the tab; once a message is displayed in the table it will not be removed when
the Message Type or Source Filtering fields are changed. Rows already in the table may be filtered
by the fields below the header.

The viewer buffers messages as they arrive to avoid locking up the receiving thread. If the buffer
fills (which indicates that messages are arriving faster than the viewer can process them) a
message indicating how many messages were missed will be written to the table.

Communications Diagnostics
Communications Diagnostics provides diagnostics information for sites and devices connected to
the workstation.

Site overview
Diagnostics information for the sites are contained in these tabs:

• Device Summary displays communications statistics for each site.

• NetUser Status displays the number of ION programs currently in the ION Network Router
Service queue (awaiting processing) and the total number of ION programs already processed.

NOTE: Requests and responses transmitted between the software components are referred to as
“ION programs”.

1432 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Troubleshoot

Site/Device Diagnostics
Diagnostics information for sites and devices are summarized in these tabs:

• Communication Status displays error rates and connection statistics for the selected site or
device. The following information is available from the Communications Status tab:

Column Description

Node The device (or software node) name.


Requests The number of communications requests transmitted to the meter.
Responses The number of successful responses received.
The number of requests sent to the device to fulfil the last client
Request Ratio request. The value is always 1 for ION devices but it varies for
Modbus devices.
Total Errors The total number of communication errors.
Total Err Rate (%) The ratio of Total Errors to Requests.
The error rate in the last 100 requests. This can indicate a trend in
Sliding Err Rate (%)
communications performance.
The percentage of the communication channel utilized (serial line
Time Util (%)
or Ethernet) on the site.
Avg Resp Time (s) Average time in seconds for the meter to respond.
Last Resp Time (s) The last response time, in seconds.
The number of timeouts. A timeout occurs when no data is
Timeouts
received in response to a request.
The number of bad packets received, that is, those that do not
Bad CRC
pass the error-detection checksum.
The number of incomplete packets received, that is, those that did
Incompl. Frm
not have all the expected bytes.
Broken Conn. Number of times the connection was lost to the meters on a site.
Bad Frames The number of received packets that had an internal error.
Number of errors reported by the computer’s communication
HW Errors
hardware.
Misc Errors Number of other errors that do not fit any of the above descriptions.

• Site Status displays site statistics such as connection status and totals.

• Polling Status displays the number of programs currently in the ION Site Service queue
(awaiting processing) and the total number of programs already processed.

Communication Status vs. Site Status


This section explains the difference between the statistics provided on the Communication Status
tab and those on the Site Status tab.

“Total Errors” in the Communication Status tab is an ION Site Service derived statistic, while “Bad
Responses” in the Site Status tab is a client derived statistic.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1433


Troubleshoot EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To explain this difference, consider a situation where a direct site is experiencing timeouts.
Communications with the device is attempted according to two parameters: Connect Attempts (an
advanced site property) and Maximum Attempts Multiple (an advanced device property).
Multiplying the values of these two properties determines the number of attempts made to re-
establish communications with the device.

For instance, if Connect Attempts is set to 1 and Maximum Attempts Multiple is set to 3, the
device will go offline after 3 attempts (that is, 1 x 3).

The “Total Errors” statistic increases by one every time ION Site Service detects a timeout.
However, the “Bad Responses” statistic only increments every time a response is sent back to a
client.

Using the previous example, consider the case where four timeouts occurred and the device went
offline. In this case, “Total Errors” increases by four, while “Bad Responses” only increases by one.
If only two timeouts occurred, “Total Errors” would increase by two, while “Bad Responses” would
not change.

The following information is available from the Site Status tab.

Column Description

Node The device (or software node) name.


Status The device communication status.
The current number of repeated attempts to communicate with the
Current Attempt
device.
The maximum number of attempts before flagging the device as offline
Max Attempts
(Timed-out).
Offline Count The total number of times the device went offline.
Bad Responses The total number of errors sent back to the clients, such as to Vista.
Last Response The time when the last response was received.
Last Attempt The last time that a request was sent to the device.
The total number of requests to the device sent by the Real Time Data
RT Data Reqs
Service.
The total number of requests to the device sent by the TreeMon
TreeMon Reqs
service.
The total number of one shot requests to the device sent by a Vista
VISTA Reqs
client (control, label requests...).
The total number of requests to the device sent by the LogInserter
LogInserter Reqs
service.
The total number of requests to the device sent by ION real-time
IONSERVICE Reqs
services.

Note that the last five columns on the Site Status tab are dynamic. That is, the columns are only
shown when requests were sent to the device from a Power Monitoring Expert service or client.

1434 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Troubleshoot

Additional commands
The following sections describe additional display options and shortcut menus available in
Diagnostics Viewer.

Diagnostic Details
In the tabs on the diagnostics information pane, double-click a row to display its Diagnostic Details
screen. This displays the diagnostic information for the selected item only.

Use the Previous and Next buttons to view the details of other rows in that tab of the diagnostics
information pane.

To copy information to the clipboard, select the rows you want to copy, then press CTRL+C.

Diagnostics Information pane shortcut menu options


Right-click the diagnostics information pane to display a shortcut menu. The following table lists all
the commands available (though not all panes in Diagnostics Viewer provide all the commands
listed):

Right-click Option Description

Update Refreshes the information in the diagnostic table.


Resets the information in the diagnostic table (not available in the
Reset
Communications Server Diagnostics display).
Copy All Copies all selected information to the clipboard.
Enabled by default, this option is only available in the Console Messages
tab of the Communications Server Diagnostics display. This option
automatically scrolls and selects the latest console message. Clear this
Auto Scroll
option to disable scrolling (that is., select and view an older console
message without jumping to the latest one when Diagnostics Viewer
refreshes).
Displays the Options dialog where you can change the diagnostics refresh
Options rate. Note that changing the refresh rate frequency can affect the product's
performance.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1435


Decommission EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Decommission
Decommissioning removes PME files to prevent potential disclosure of sensitive, confidential and
proprietary data and software from your system. You risk disclosing your power system data,
system configuration, user information, and other sensitive information if you don’t decommission.
We strongly recommend you decommission your system at the end of its life.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Before decommissioning, verify that the system is not performing critical control actions that
may affect human or equipment safety.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
Before decommissioning, verify that the system data results are not used for critical decision
making that may affect human or equipment safety.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To decommission PME you have two choices, Destroy or Overwrite.


Destroy: Choose this if you do not need to use your hard drives for any other software.

Overwrite: Choose this if you still need to use your hard drives for other software. This method
uses a commercial tool to put random data in place of PME files on your hard drives.

See Decommissioning Reference for detailed instructions.

1436 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

Applications
Use the information provided in this chapter to build applications based on Power Monitoring Expert.

Use the links in the following table to find the content you are looking for.

Application Description
This application (also known as DDD Indicators), can help you
Disturbance Direction identify power quality disturbances, their type, and the likely
Indicators location of origin. The disturbance information is shown with visual
indicators that are integrated into an electrical one-line diagram.
This application provides continuous monitoring of the thermal
Thermal Monitoring of Low conditions of low voltage busways. You can see temperature data
Voltage (LV) Busways in real-time, analyze historical temperature trends, and set up
alarming based on temperature thresholds.
This application provides remote, continuous monitoring of the
Thermal Monitoring of
thermal conditions of MV substations. You can see temperature
Medium Voltage (MV)
data in real-time, analyze historical trends, and receive alarms and
Substations
notifications.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1437


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Disturbance Direction Indicators


Overview
In this application (also known as DDD Indicators), we add voltage disturbance indicators to an
electrical one-line diagram. The indicators are associated with the power monitoring devices that
recorded the disturbance. The indicators show the type of voltage disturbance (sag/swell/transient)
and the disturbance direction relative to the monitoring device. By combining the information from
multiple devices in a network we can then identify where the disturbance originated. Up to 5 voltage
disturbance Incidents, going back in time, are displayed.

NOTE: The examples and screen captures shown in this application description are for illustration
purposes only. They are not intended to give guidance on configuration settings or application
details. For guidance on configuration of your system or other application details, consult a
qualified professional.

Examples:

1438 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

Below is an example of a one-line diagram showing a voltage sag that originated outside the
network.

This is an example of a one-line diagram showing a voltage swell that originated inside the network,
most likely in "Building Loads TR16b".

NOTE: The red frames and yellow highlights were added to the images in this document to
highlight the disturbance indicators. The frames and highlights are not displayed in the actual
diagram.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1439


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Components
The DDD Indicators application is based on the following system components and features:

• Power Monitoring Expert 2021 software.

• Power monitoring devices with Disturbance Direction Detection (DDD) functionality. (See
Prerequisites for a list of compatible devices.)

• A one-line diagram of your electrical network.

• A Virtual Processor (VIP) framework.

NOTE: Creating the basic one-line diagram, without indicators, is outside the scope of this
application description. For information on how to create diagrams in PME, see Creating and
customizing a user diagram.

Prerequisites
The following is required to set up the DDD Indicators application:

• PME must be installed and commissioned.

• Power monitoring devices with DDD functionality must be installed in your electrical network in
those locations where you want to monitor for voltage disturbances. The devices must be
connected to PME and must be communicating. The following devices are compatible with this
application:
ION9000

PM8000

ION7650 (v350 and higher)

ION7550 (v350 and higher)

ION7400

ION8650A/B (v407 and higher)

ION8800A/B (v362 and higher)

9410 series

9810 series

ACCESS 9610

• The internal clock of the monitoring devices must be time synchronized. The standard
synchronization (± 1s) between the PME server and the monitoring devices is good enough.
High accuracy (± 1ms) time synchronization (for example, GPS, IRIG-B, or PTP) can also be
used, but is not needed for this application.

• Power quality event detection for Sag/Swell and Transients must be enabled in the power
monitoring devices for which you want to show the disturbance indicators in the one-line
diagram.

1440 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

• You need a one-line diagram for each electrical network that you want to include in this
application. For information on how to create diagrams in PME, see Creating and customizing a
user diagram.

Limitations
To create the voltage disturbance indicators for the one-line diagram, we use the DDD Indicator
Wizard. This tool has the following limitations:

• A maximum of 30 power monitoring devices can be included in this application.

TIP: For information on how to set up this application to support more than 30 devices, see the
How do I extend the DDD Indicators Application to support more than 30 devices
application note. See Resources for link information.

• You can create indicators for up to 5 different electrical networks.

• You can display data for the last 5 voltage disturbance Incidents.

Design
The voltage disturbance indicators in the electrical one-line diagram show the type of the
disturbance (sag/swell/transient) and its direction, relative to the monitoring device
(upstream/downstream). This information is based on DDD event records that are recorded by the
devices and uploaded into the PME database. A VIP framework triggers database scripts that run
every 5 minutes and scan the database for DDD event records, going back in time. Events that
occurred within a short time interval (< 60s between events) are grouped together into an Incident.
The scripts continue to scan for DDD events until 5 Incidents have been found, or the event data is
older than 180 days. The DDD information for each of the Incidents is then processed by the VIP for
display in the one-line diagram.

We create 5 identical copies of the one-line diagram, one for each disturbance Incident. The
diagrams are linked together so you can navigate between them using the Incident Navigator.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1441


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

Configuration
Before configuring the DDD Indicators application, confirm that the Prerequisites are in place for
your system.

New Application
Configuring the DDD Indicators application for the first time in your PME system, requires the
following steps:

• Setting up the DDD Indicator framework in the VIP.

• Running the DDD Indicator Wizard in Vista.

To set up the DDD Indicator framework in the VIP:

1. Open Designer and log in with a supervisor-level user account.

2. Open the VIP.DDD node.

NOTE: The VIP.DDD is part of the default PME install. Only use this VIP for the DDD
Iindicators application. Do not use the VIP.DDD for any application other than the DDD
Indicator. At this point of the configuration process, the VIP.DDD should only contain the
EventLogCtl 1, Diagnostics 1 and VIP ION core modules. If there are other modules in the
VIP.DDD that are not related to this application, then move these modules to a different VIP,
or delete them, before installing the DDD framework. Do not install the DDD framework into
the VIP.DDD as long as it contains other, non-core modules. See Upgrade from a pre- 9.0
version of PME, if your PME system was upgraded and contains a VIP configuration for an
earlier version of the DDD Indicators application.

3. Click Edit > Paste from framework.

4. Navigate to ...\config\fmwk\DDD_Indicator_Wizard and open DDD Indicator_


Wizard.fwn.

5. In Paste Summary, select the framework modules for lock paste.

NOTE: You must lock paste the framework or the DDD Indicator Wizard will not function
correctly.

1442 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

TIP: For information on lock pasting ION modules, see Copying and pasting ION modules.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before pasting an ION framework verify that the system is not performing critical control
actions that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Do not overwrite an existing ION framework in the VIP using lock paste.
• Verify correct system operation after pasting an ION framework.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

6. In Paste Summary, click OK to paste the framework.

7. In Designer, Send & Save the changes.

8. An Operation Incomplete message box is displayed. This is expected. It is caused by the


initial state of some of the modules in the ION framework when they are saved the first time.
Click Continue.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1443


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

9. In Designer, Send & Save the changes again. No message box should appear this time.
View of the DDD framework after pasting and saving:

10. This completes setting up the DDD Indicator framework. Close the VIP.DDD node in
Designer.

11. Close Designer.

To run the DDD Indicator Wizard in Vista:

1. Open Vista and log in with a supervisor-level user account.

2. Click File > Open.

3. Navigate to ...\config\diagrams\ud\DDD_Indicator_Wizard and open How To


Use This Wizard.dgm.

4. Follow the steps in the DDD Indicator Wizard to complete the configuration.

TIP: Later, to simplify the copying of the DDD Indicators from the wizard to the one-line
diagrams, click Window > Arrange All in Vista to show the wizard and the diagrams side-
by-side.

Upgrade from a pre- 9.0 version of PME


If you have a PME system that was upgraded from a version of the software older than PME 9.0 and
that already has the DDD Indicators configured, then you have the following options:

A. Maintain or extend the application, using the methods that were valid in the older version of
PME for which it was first configured.

See the System Technical Note: "How can I …Indicate a Disturbance's Direction Using a
Power Monitoring Expert's One-Line Diagram?" for details.

1444 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

B. (Recommended) Remove the existing DDD Indicators configuration and rebuild it with the
new PME 2021 methods.

To remove the existing DDD Indicators configuration and rebuild it with the new PME 2021
methods:
Delete the existing (old) DDD Indicators VIP framework.

Delete the DDD Indicators and the Incident Navigators from the existing one-line
diagrams.

TIP: Make a note of the devices that were used for this application so you can use that
information when building the new DDD Indicators.

Disable or remove the automatic DDD database table updates. This was done with an
SQL Server Agent job for systems SQL Server Standard, or a task in the Windows Task
Scheduler for systems with SQL Server Express. See the System Technical Note: "How
can I …Indicate a Disturbance's Direction Using a Power Monitoring Expert's One-Line
Diagram?" for details on how this was setup.

Follow the New Application steps to recreate the previous DDD Indicators application.

NOTE: You cannot mix the old ways of configuring this application with the new DDD Indicator
Wizard configuration. The old and the new methods for Incident grouping are not compatible.

TIP: PME 2021 uses a wizard to configure large portions of the DDD Indicators application. This
makes it much easier and faster to implement this application as compared to previous versions.
We recommend you recreate existing DDD Indicators applications in PME 2021 instead of
maintaining them using the old, manual methods.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1445


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Operation
After you have configured the application you can view the voltage disturbance indicators in your
one-line diagram:

You can view the last 5 disturbance Instances by using the Incident Navigator:

1446 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

If your PME database does not have disturbance data for a device for a particular Incident, then the
Indeterminate Event icon is shown for that device:

NOTE: The red frames and yellow highlights were added to the images in this document to
highlight the disturbance indicators. The frames and highlights are not displayed in the actual
diagram.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1447


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Below is a list of the different disturbance indicator icons that can be displayed, depending on the
type of disturbances and the capabilities of the monitoring devices:

Maintenance
No maintenance is needed for the DDD Indicators application. However, you can customize certain
aspects of the application to better meet your specific needs.

Customization: Change the Disturbance Reporting Time Range


The scripts that search the database for disturbance events and create the Incidents are set to go
back in time until they have found 5 Incidents or the data is older than 180 days. If your system did
not record any disturbance events in the last 180 days, then there will be no Incidents and the one-
line will not show any disturbance data. You can change the query time range to include disturbance
data that is older than 180 days.

To change the disturbance reporting time range:

1448 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

1. Open Designer and log in with a supervisor-level user account.

2. Open the VIP.DDD node.

3. Edit the Update DDD Table Database Import module that is part of the DDD Indicator
framework.

Change the @pastDays parameter from a value of 180 to a higher value.

Customization: Change the Incident Grouping Time Interval


The scripts that search the database for disturbance events, group any disturbance event from any
device into the same Incident, if the end time of one event and the start time of the next event are
less than 60 seconds apart. This is based on the assumption that disturbance events that occur so
close in time are related to the same cause. Depending on the application, the 60 second grouping
interval might not be best. You can change the Incident grouping interval to shorten or lengthen the
Incident boundaries.

To change the Incident grouping time interval:

1. Open Designer and log in with a supervisor-level user account.

2. Open the VIP.DDD node.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1449


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. Edit the Update DDD Table Database Import module that is part of the DDD Indicator
framework.

Change the @aggregationSeconds parameter from a value of 60 to a value of 20, for


example, to shorten the Incident Grouping Time Interval.

1450 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

Thermal Monitoring of Low Voltage (LV) Busways


Overview
This application provides remote, continuous monitoring of the thermal conditions of low voltage
busways equipped with Easergy CL110 or TH110 temperature sensors. You can see temperature
data in real-time, analyze historical temperature trends, and set up alarming based on temperature
thresholds. Any applicable PME power monitoring features are available to be used with the busway
temperature data.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

NOTE: The examples and screen captures shown in this application description are for illustration
purposes only. They are not intended to give guidance on configuration settings or application
details. For guidance on configuration of your system or other application details, consult a
qualified professional.

Examples:

The above is an example of a real-time trend showing busway temperature over the last hour.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1451


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The above is an example of a trend report showing the busway temperature over the last 24 hours.

The above is an example of an alarm incident history view showing thermal monitoring related
incidents.

Components
The Thermal Monitoring of LV Busways application is based on the following system components
and features:

1452 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

• Power Monitoring Expert 2021 software.

• Vista diagrams for setup and diagnostics.

NOTE: The diagrams include a sample user diagram. This sample diagram is intended as a
starting point for the development of end user diagrams. Creating customized end user
diagrams is outside the scope of this application description. For information on how to create
diagrams in PME, see Creating and customizing a user diagram.

• Ethernet Gateway, such as the Link150.

• Busway with Easergy CL110 or TH110 temperature sensors.

NOTE: The Easergy CL110 is an environmental sensor that can measure temperature and
humidity. For this application we only use the temperature measurements.

Prerequisites
The following is required to set up the Thermal Monitoring of LV Busways application in PME:

• PME must be installed and commissioned.

• The busway temperature sensors must be connected to the ZBRN32 access point and must be
communicating.

• The ZBRN32 access point must be connected to an Ethernet Gateway, such as the Link150.

• You must know the Ethernet address of the Gateway.

• You must know the Unit ID of the ZBRN32 access point.

NOTE: Each ZBRN32 access point needs a mid-range device license in PME.

• You must know the temperature sensor locations on the busway to be able to assign
meaningful names to the equivalent sources in PME.

Limitations
There are no specific, software-based limitations for this application in addition to the general PME
performance and scalability limits.

Design
Easergy CL110 or TH110 sensors, attached to the busway, wirelessly transmit real-time
temperature measurements to a Harmony ZBRN32 access point. The access point is connected to
PME through an Ethernet Gateway, such as the Link150. PME provides support for the access
point, through an add-on Harmony ZBRN32 access point device driver.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1453


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

After the access point has been configured in PME, the driver creates individual sources for each of
the sensors that are connected to the access point. The driver also supports software logging of the
temperature measurements. This is similar to how branch circuit monitors are handled in PME. One
access point can support up to 60 temperature sensors.

The real-time and historical temperature data is available for display and processing in any of the
relevant PME applications such as Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, and Reports.

NOTE: The selection, installation, and configuration of the sensors, access point, and gateway is
outside the scope of this application description. See Prerequisites for more information.

Configuration
Before configuring the Thermal Monitoring of LV Busways application, confirm that the
Prerequisites are in place for your system.

Configuring this application requires the following steps:

• Adding the Ethernet Gateway and ZBRN32 access point in Management Console or Device
Manager.

NOTE: Each ZBRN32 access point needs a mid-range device license in PME.

• Setting up the temperature sources in Vista.

• Setting up temperature alarms.

1454 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

• Setting up Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, and Reports for temperature data.

• (Optional) Setting up alarm views for temperature sensor communication alarms.

To add the Ethernet Gateway and ZBRN32 access point in Management Console:

1. Open Management Console and log in with a supervisor-level user account.

2. Under Sites, add a new Ethernet Gateway Site.

Set the Name and IP Address for the gateway. For TCP/IP Port select ModbusTCP
Device|502.

Example:

3. Under Devices, add a new Serial Device on Ethernet Gateway Site.

Set the Group, Name, Unit ID, and Time Zone for the access point. For Device Type select
ZBRN32 (CL110/TH110). For Site select the Ethernet Gateway Site added in step 2.

Example:

4. Close Management Console

TIP: For information on how to set up sites and devices in Device Manager, see Device Manager.

To set up the temperature sources in Vista:

1. Open Vista and log in with a supervisor-level user account.

2. Generate a network diagram.

3. Open the diagram for the ZBRN32 access point.

The diagram shows information for 60 possible temperature sensors. Only those sensors that
are installed and connected to the ZBRN32 access point show a temperature measurement.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1455


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

4. Click Setup in the lower right-hand corner of the diagram to open Setup view.

5. Select Options > Show Toolbox from the Vista menu, and then change the names of the
installed sensors by double-clicking the name field, editing the default name, and then
pressing Enter on your keyboard. See Selecting Sensor Names for tips on choosing a sensor
name.

NOTE: Complete the sensor naming before moving to step 6. If you rename the sensors
after enabling logging, this will affect the source names under which the data is logged.

6. Enable the Log. The device driver for the ZBRN32 access point in PME will start logging
temperature measurements for all installed and connected sensors on a 15 minute interval.

7. Close the Vista diagram.

To set up thermal alarms:

1. Open Software Alarms in Web Applications > SETTINGS > Alarms.

2. Add a new alarm rule for the thermal alarm, with the following details:
Alarm Template: Select the Realtime Setpoint template under the All or Common
category.

Measurement: Select the Temperature (°C) measurement under the Environmental


category.

Priority: Select a priority that is appropriate for this alarm, for example High.

Alarm Status Measurements: Turn on Enable Realtime Alarm Status Measurements.

Enter other alarm information as required. See Adding a new Alarm Rule for information on
how to add alarm rules.

3. Add a new alarm rule for a thermal pre-alarm. Use the same details as for the thermal alarm,
but set the temperature thresholds lower so that the pre-alarm is activated before the main
alarm.

Example of a thermal alarm and pre-alarm:

1456 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

4. Exit Software Alarms.

To set up Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, and Reports:

You can set up the Web Applications, or any other relevant data display or processing application to
use the busway temperature data. Follow the standard workflow for configuring these applications.
For details see:

• Dashboards configuration

• Diagrams configuration

• Trends configuration

• Alarms configuration

• Reports configuration

The ZBRN32 access point device driver includes a sample diagram for the display of temperature
sensor real-time measurements and alarm status. You can use this diagram as a starting point for
creating custom end-user diagrams. Find the diagram under
...\config\diagrams\ud\default\ZBRN32_CL110_TH110_V1.0.0\zbrn32_cl110_
th110_v1.0.0_example.dgm.

TIP: Save your diagrams under ...\config\diagrams\ud or a sub-folder of ud but not in the
ud\default folder. This makes it possible to add your diagram to the Diagrams Web application.
The ud\default folder is not visible in Diagrams.

Below is an example of a partially customized diagram based on the diagram provided with the add-
on device driver. The alarm status displays for each sensor have been linked to the pre-alarm and
alarm status measurements.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1457


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

(Optional) Setting up alarm views for temperature sensor communication alarms

The ZBRN32 access point device driver in PME monitors the temperature sensor communication
status and generates alarms on communication interruptions. The alarms are categorized as Asset
Monitoring > Thermal Monitor.

RECOMMENDATION: Configure an alarm view for Asset Monitoring > Thermal Monitor to track
and monitor temperature sensor communication issues. See Alarms configuration for information
on how to setup alarm views.

NOTE: The thermal monitoring data registers (temperature, humidity, and so on) display "NA"
values when communication with the sensor is interrupted.

Operation
After you have configured the application and created views in the Web Applications, you can
monitor the busway temperature. The following are examples of temperature data displayed in the
different Web Applications.

Dashboards:

The above is an example of a dashboard showing busway temperature measurements for the last
24 hours.

1458 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

Diagrams:

The above is an example of a diagram showing sensor data for a ZBRN32 access point.

Trends:

The above is an example of a real-time trend showing busway temperature over the last hour.

Alarms:

The above is an example of an alarm status view showing thermal monitoring related alarms.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1459


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The above is an example of an alarm incident view showing thermal monitoring related incidents.

Reports:

The above is an example of a trend report showing the busway temperature over the last 24 hours.

Maintenance
No maintenance is needed for the Thermal Monitoring of LV Busways application. However, the
ZBRN32 access point device driver includes a diagnostics diagram that shows the sensor battery
voltage (only for CL110 sensors, TH110 sensors are self-powered) and the signal strength. You can
use this diagram to monitor the health of the sensor network.

1460 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

To open the diagnostics diagram in Vista:

1. Open Vista.

2. Generate or open the network diagram.

3. Open the diagram for the ZBRN32 access point device.

4. Click Diagnostics in the lower right-hand corner of the diagram to open Diagnostics view.
Example Diagnostics diagram:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1461


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Thermal Monitoring of Medium Voltage (MV) Substations


Overview
This application provides remote, continuous monitoring of the thermal conditions of MV
substations equipped with Easergy TH110 temperature sensors and Easergy CL110 environmental
sensors. Thermal monitoring can help you find exceptional conditions in the substation equipment,
such as overloads or faulty power connections of cables, busbars, circuit breakers, or transformers.
In addition, this application can monitor the environmental conditions, ambient temperature and
humidity, inside the substation and switchgear cubicles. You can see temperature data in real-time,
analyze historical trends, and receive alarms and notifications. Any applicable PME power
monitoring features can be used with the substation monitoring data.

For more information on the value of Continuous Thermal Monitoring see the EcoStruxure Power
Digital Applications for Large Buildings & Critical Facilities Design Guide. See Resources for
download information.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

NOTE: The examples and screen captures shown in this application description are for illustration
purposes only. They are not intended to give guidance on configuration settings or application
details. For guidance on configuration of your system or other application details, consult a
qualified professional.

Examples:

The above is an example of a real-time trend showing cubicle and transformer temperature and
humidity measurements over the last hour.

1462 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

The above is an example of a trend report showing a 1-week cubicle temperature trend.

The above is an example of an alarm status view showing thermal monitoring related alarms.

Components
The Thermal Monitoring of MV Substations application is based on the following system
components and features:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1463


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Power Monitoring Expert 2021 software.

• Substation with Substation Monitoring Devices (SMDs), Harmony ZBRN32 access points,
Easergy TH110 thermal sensors and Easergy CL110 environmental sensors

NOTE: The device type for the SMD is called Switchgear Monitoring Device in PME.

Prerequisites
The following is required to set up the Thermal Monitoring of MV Substations application in PME:

• PME 2021 must be installed and commissioned.

• The TH110 and CL110 sensors, the ZBRN32 access points, and the SMDs in the substation
must be configured, connected, and communicating.

NOTE: This application supports SMD v4.0 and v3.0. SMD v2.0 is not supported.

• The SMDs must be accessible from the PME server by Ethernet.

• You must know the IP address of the SMDs.

NOTE: Each SMD needs a mid-range device license in PME.

Limitations
There are no specific, software-based limitations for this application in addition to the general PME
performance and scalability limits.

The SMDs and ZBRN32 access points have the following limitations:

• Each SMD can support up to three ZBRN32 access points.

• Each ZBRN32 access point can support up to 60 sensors.

• Each SMD can support up to 16 cubicles and 16 transformers


For each cubicle, the SMD can support sensors for 1 busbar, 2 circuit breakers, 2 cables,
and a set of environmental measurements.

For each transformer, the SMD can support sensors for MV taps, LV taps, windings, and
tapping links.

NOTE: Only those cubicles, transformers, and sensor locations that are configured in the SMD are
shown in PME (non-configured ones are hidden in the diagrams).

NOTE: The selection, installation, and configuration of the sensors, ZBRN32 access points, and
SMDs is outside the scope of this application description. See Prerequisites for more information.

NOTE: This application description only covers certain measurements available from the SMD.
Consult the SMD documentation for information on additional measurements and functions.

1464 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

Design
Easergy CL110 and TH110 sensors are installed in the substation. The sensors wirelessly send
measurement data to the ZBRN32 access points. The access points are connected to SMDs
through Modbus serial communications. The SMDs are connected to PME through an Ethernet
connection.

PME has a pre-configured device driver for the SMD. This driver creates individual sources in PME
for the SMD parent device and for each of its configured cubicles and transformers. You can access
thermal and environmental measurements, pre-alarms, and alarms. The driver also logs data from
the SMD and creates event log records. This is done through driver-based Setpoint modules. The
real-time and historical data is available for display and processing in any of the relevant PME
applications such as Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, and Reports.

NOTE: The selection, installation, and configuration of the sensors, ZBRN32 access points, and
SMDs is outside the scope of this application description. See Prerequisites for more information.

NOTE: This application can also be used with a PME and Power Operation (PO) integrated
system, known as PO with Advanced Reporting and Dashboards. See the PO System Guide
for details. See Resources for link information.

Configuration
Before configuring the Thermal Monitoring of MV Substations application, confirm that the
Prerequisites are in place for your system.

Configuring this application requires the following steps:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1465


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Adding the SMDs in Management Console or Device Manager.

NOTE: Each SMD needs a mid-range device license in PME.

• Setting up the SMD diagrams Setting up the SMD diagrams.

• Setting up Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, and Reports for the thermal monitoring
data.

• (Optional for systems with multiple SMDs) Creating a SMD summary diagram that shows all
the SMDs in the substation with high level status information.

• (Optional) Setting up alarm views for temperature sensor communication alarms.

To add the SMDs in Management Console:

1. Open Management Console and log in with a supervisor-level user account.

2. Under Devices, add a new Ethernet Device.

Set the Group, Name, IP Address, and Time Zone for the SMD device. For Device Type
select Switchgear Monitoring Device.

Example:

NOTE: The date and time are set manually in the SMD. You cannot set the time in the SMD
through PME.

3. Close Management Console.

TIP: For information on how to set up sites and devices in Device Manager, see Device Manager.

To set up the SMD diagrams in Vista:

1. Open Vista and log in with a supervisor-level user account.

2. a) If you want to add a SMD diagram link to an existing Vista diagram:


Open the Vista diagram to which you want to add the link.

Add a grouping object and set the following parameters:


Node = The SMD you want to link to

Action = Open Diagram for Meter Template

1466 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

(Optional) Display = The default SMD icon


(...\config\diagrams\images\default\_
SwitchgearMonitoringDevice.bmp) or any custom image you want to display.

Example:

b) If you want to use a generic Vista Network Diagram to access the SMD information, go to
File > Generate Network Diagram.

Example:

NOTE: When you save the generated network diagram, it will overwrite any existing network
diagram. If the existing network diagram was customized, then these customizations will get
lost.

3. Click the SMD grouping object in the Vista diagram to open the SMD device diagrams.

4. (Optional) Customize the sensor display labels. Click the icon in the SMD device
diagram to edit the display labels for the sensor names.

NOTE: The sensor names for the thermal monitoring points, for example Cubicle 01, Cubicle
02, Transformer 01, and so on, are fixed in PME. These names match the names used in the
SMD for local display. If necessary, you can define custom labels for the sensors in Vista
and Diagrams. These custom labels only appear in Vista and Diagrams. Other PME
applications will continue to display the default names.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1467


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To set up Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, and Reports:

You can set up the Web Applications, or any other relevant data display or processing application to
use the substation temperature and environmental data. Follow the standard workflow for
configuring these applications. For details see:

• Dashboards configuration

• Diagrams configuration

• Trends configuration

• Alarms configuration

• Reports configuration

NOTE: Thermal measurement related functions and settings are configured in the SMD. PME
reads the measurements from the SMD and displays them as they are, including max values and
alarm/pre-alarm statuses.
The configuration of the SMD determines which measurements are available. Only configured
cubicles and transformers are shown in PME.

(Optional) To create a SMD summary diagram:

1. Open Vista and log in with a supervisor-level user account.

2. Create a new diagram. Add labels and status indicators for each SMD as shown in the
following example:

Use status objects to show the pre-alarm and alarm statuses. Link the pre-alarm indicator to
Substation > Global Substation Alarm > Global Status Pre-Alarm in the SMD node. Link
the alarm indicator to Substation > Global Substation Alarm > Global Status Alarm in the
SMD node.

1468 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

Use text boxes to hard-code the cubicle and transformer numbers. Overlay the SMD name
text boxes with transparent grouping objects linked to the SMD diagrams.

3. Save the diagram.

TIP: Save your diagrams under ...\config\diagrams\ud or a sub-folder of ud but not


in the ud\default folder. This makes it possible to add your diagram to the Diagrams Web
application. The ud\default folder is not visible in Diagrams.

(Optional) Setting up alarm views for sensor communication alarms

The SMD device driver in PME monitors the sensor communication status and generates alarms on
communication interruptions. The alarms are categorized as Asset Monitoring > Thermal
Monitor.

RECOMMENDATION: Configure an alarm view for Asset Monitoring > Thermal Monitor to track
and monitor sensor communication issues. See Alarms configuration for information on how to
setup alarm views.

NOTE: The thermal monitoring data registers (temperature, humidity, and so on) display "NA"
values when communication with the sensor is interrupted.

Operation
After you have configured the application and created views in the Web Applications, you can
monitor the Substation conditions. The following are examples of temperature and environmental
data displayed in the different Web Applications.

Dashboards

The above is an example of a dashboard showing cubicle and transformer temperature and humidity
measurements for the last 24 hours.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1469


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Diagrams

The above is an example of a top-level diagram for a SMD which has Cubicle 1-3 and Transformer 3
configured.
The diagram includes the following elements:

• SMD communication status indicator showing: Normal - or Not Normal- .

• Cubicle and transformer overall status indicators showing: Normal - , Pre-Alarm - , or


Alarm - .

• Cubicle and transformer highest instantaneous temperature measured by any of its sensors.

• Event and Data log icons providing access to alarm and communication events, and logged
temperature and humidity measurements.

The above is an example of a cubicle diagram. Only those components that are configured in the
SMD, display data in the diagram. In this example, only the busbar and environmental sensors are
configured.

1470 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Applications

The above is an example of a cubicle details diagram for a SMD which has busbar and
environmental sensors configured.

Trends

The above is an example of a real-time trend showing cubicle and transformer temperature and
humidity measurements over the last hour.

Alarms

The above is an example of an alarm status view showing thermal monitoring related alarms.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1471


Applications EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The above is an example of an alarm incident view showing a thermal monitoring related incident.

Reports

The above is an example of a trend report showing a 1-week cubicle temperature trend.

Maintenance
No maintenance is needed for the Thermal Monitoring of MV Substations application in PME. For
maintenance of the devices installed in the substation, follow any maintenance procedures outlined
in the documentation for SMD, ZBRN32, and sensors.

1472 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Reference
This chapter contains reference information related to planning, deploying, and using PME.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Cybersecurity Reference
Planning references
Installation and Upgrade references
Configuration References
Operation references
Decommissioning Reference
Applications References

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1473


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Cybersecurity Reference
This section contains reference information related to cybersecurity.

Data encryption
At Rest
PME encrypts the passwords of its user accounts, as well as the Windows and SQL Server
accounts using SHA-512 and AES-256 cryptography. PME uses a unique encryption key for each
installation. The key is generated during the installation of PME. The PME installer offers
functionality for exporting/importing encryption keys for the installation of PME clients or system
upgrades.

The power monitoring data that is collected by PME, and system configuration data are not
encrypted.

In Transit
PME uses Transport Layer Security (TLS) 1.2 for an encrypted, authenticated connection using
HTTPS between the server and the web clients. Both self-signed and authority issued certificates
are supported. PME is installed with a self-signed certificate and a self-signed certificate is
configured automatically. We recommend that you replace this with a security certificates from a
Certificate Authority (CA).

The communication between PME and connected monitoring devices is not encrypted.

PME accounts
The following types of accounts are required for a PME system:

PME Users
A user account in PME provides access to the system. There are 3 different types of users -
standard users, Windows users, and Windows groups. Each user has an access level, which
determines the actions the user is allowed to perform in PME. There are no pre-configured user
accounts or user groups in the system. One supervisor account is created with a user defined
password during the installation of the software. Additional user accounts and groups must be
created manually after installation. Users are created and managed through User Manager. PME
supports Windows Active Directory integration for Windows users and groups.

TIP: Use Windows users and groups to take advantage of Windows account security features
such as maximum login attempts or minimum password requirements.

Windows accounts used by PME


PME uses Windows accounts for report subscriptions and database maintenance. The accounts
are created automatically during the installation of the software. The accounts share the same
password, which is set at install time and can be changed at any time through the installer.

If PME is configured to use Windows Integrated Authentication, then an additional Windows


account is required for database access. This Windows account is also used to run the PME
services and the IIS Application Pools. This account must be created manually and account details
must be provided during the installation of the software.

1474 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

See Windows accounts for more information.

SQL Database server accounts


If PME is configured to use SQL Server Authentication, then SQL server accounts are required for
database access. The accounts are created automatically during the installation of the software.
The accounts share the same password, which is set at install time and can be changed at any time
through the installer.

If SQL Server Express is installed with SQL Server Authentication, through the PME installer, a sa
account with a unique, default password is created automatically during install. The password can
be changed at any time through SQL Server Management Studio.

See SQL Server accounts for more information.

EcoStruxure Web Services account


If EcoStruxure™ Web Services (EWS) are used, data exchange credentials must be defined. The
credentials consist of a single username and password. The EWS credentials are set manually in
the Web Applications > SETTINGS > Security > EWS Login area of the software.

PME Services
PME uses a number of services to perform the background server tasks. The services use the
Local Service and NT AUTHORITY\System accounts, or the Windows account used for Windows
Integrated Authentication, if that is configured.

See PME Windows services for more information.

Network shares
PME Engineering Clients and Secondary servers require that the Power Monitoring Expert folder
on the PME server is shared with change and read permissions. This file share must be manually
set up before installing Engineering clients or Secondary servers. See Create a file share for
Engineering clients and Secondary servers for more information.

Session timeout
PME automatically times out inactive client sessions. Web Applications clients are logged out and
Windows application clients (Vista, Designer, Management Console) are locked after a period of
inactivity. The timeout period is configurable, it is set to 20 minutes by default. See Web
Applications settings for details on how to set the timeout.
To restart or unlock the session you must enter the login credentials. A session is considered
inactive, if none of the following actions are detected:

• Mouse movement

• Mouse click

• Keyboard activity

• Touch screen activity

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1475


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: If custom content links are added to the Web Applications framework, then the custom
content must either implement the idle detection, or activity on that content is not registered and
the web client session can time out unexpectedly. See Adding idle detection to custom Web
Application links for details.

System integration security


Specify which third-party web resources are allowed to either embed (frame) the PME web
applications, or to which the PME web applications can redirect requests. This is configurable in the
PME Web Applications settings. See Web Applications settings for details on how to set
authorized hosts.

Specify which web applications of PME needed to integrate with third-party systems based on the
generated links. The generated links are authenticated. This is configurable in the PME Web
Applications settings. See Web Applications settings for details on how to generate links.

Verifying file integrity and authenticity


Verify the file integrity and authenticity for software updates and other components before installing
them in the system. Do not install files for which the integrity and authenticity cannot be confirmed.
To verify the file integrity and authenticity:

1. Right-click the file and select Properties. This opens the Properties dialog.

2. In the Properties dialog, select the Digital Signatures tab.

3. In the Signature list, highlight the Name of signer. Click Details.

NOTE: Only Schneider Electric should be shown in the Signature list.

1476 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

4. Verify that the digital signature is OK and that the signer name shows Schneider Electric.
Example:

5. Close the properties dialog.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1477


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Planning references
This section contains reference information related to the content in the Planning chapter of this
guide.

Use the following links to find the item you are looking for:

Accessing the ION Database with 3rd-party applications


Database growth calculations
Default device support (including licensing)
IIS Application Pools
Insulation Monitoring Design for ANSI
IP Ports
Licensing resources
PME Databases
PME Windows services
SQL Server accounts
Windows accounts

1478 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Accessing the ION Database with 3rd-party applications


The following example uses Microsoft Excel 2007 to retrieve data from the ION_Data database.

NOTE: The database uses Universal Coordinated Time (UTC) time. When you import data into
Excel, the Clock module’s Time Zone Offset register for the meter is applied.

1. To create a database query in Excel, click Data > From Other Sources > From Microsoft
Query.

2. To create a new data source, select <New Data Source> from the list and click OK.

3. Type the name you want to give the data source. Once you type a name, the list of drivers for
the database type becomes available. Select <SQL Server> from the list. Click Connect.

4. Choose your server from the list. Provide your LoginID and Password and click OK. Select a
default table for your data source (optional). Click OK to continue.

5. Select the source name you created and click OK.

6. After you have selected the data you want to view, the Query Wizard opens. Use this to filter
and sort the data.

7. Follow the steps in the Query Wizard to add data to the spreadsheet.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1479


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Database growth calculations


Factory default measurement logging
A measurement record in the database uses approximately 75 bytes of disk space. Based on the
factory default data logging configurations, we can calculate the database growth for data logged
from different device types.

Example

Daily Growth Number of Total Daily Total Annual 


Device Type
Rate (kB) Devices Growth (MB) Growth (GB)
ION7650 780 10 7.62 2.72
PM8000 950 20 19.00 6.94
PM3200 85 70 5.81 2.07
TOTAL - 100 32.43 MB 11.84 GB

NOTE: Use the Database Growth Calculator tool to estimate the database growth for your
system. The tool is available through the Exchange Community. See Resources for link
information.

Custom measurement logging


Custom measurement logging can be configured in the monitoring devices and, as software based
logging, in PME. A measurement record in the database uses approximately 75 bytes of disk
space.

The following shows the database growth estimate for logging of a single measurement every 15
minutes:

NOTE: Use the Database Growth Calculator tool to estimate the database growth for your
system. The tool is available through the Exchange Community. See Resources for link
information.

Power quality event logging


Power quality (PQ) events and waveform capture recording is event driven, which makes it
impossible to accurately predict their impact on database growth. In our experience, power quality
data accounts for approximately 10% - 20% of the total database size.

1480 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

NOTE: Use the Database Growth Calculator tool to estimate the database growth for your
system. The tool is available through the Exchange Community. See Resources for link
information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1481


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Default device type support


The following tables list the pre-configured device types in PME 2021 and the license that is
required for each type:

NOTE: The license types (E, M, S) are for locales (countries other than the US, Canada, and
India) where individual licenses are sold. For locales (the US, Canada, India) where license
bundles are sold, a device license is valid for any device type.

NOTE: Drivers created with the Device Type Editor require mid-range (M) type device licenses.

E = Entry-Range Device License


M = Mid-Range Device License
S = High-End Device License

Device Type License


9410 M
9810 S
3300 ACM E
3710 ACM S
3720 ACM S
3800 RTU M
ACCESS 9200 E
ACCESS 9200 (MODBUS) E
ACCESS 9300 E
ACCESS 9330 M
ACCESS 9340 M
ACCESS 9350 M
ACCESS 9360 M
ACCESS 9500 M
ACCESS 9500 RTU M
ACCESS 9510 M
ACCESS 9510 RTU M
ACCESS 9600 S
ACCESS 9610 S
ACCESS 9700 S
AccuSine PCS M
AccuSine PCS Plus S
AccuSine PCSn S

1482 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Device Type License


AccuSine PFV Plus S
Acti 9 Active E
Acti 9 Smartlink E
Acti 9 Smartlink Ethernet E
Altivar 61 E
ASCO 7000/4000 S
BCPM [license multiplier =
M
0.5] (*)
BCPM Flex Cct [license
M
multiplier = 0.5] (*)
CL110/TH110 [license
M
multiplier = 0.05] (*)
CM100-200 E
CM2000 Series M
CM3000 Series M
CM4000 Series S
CMS460 M
ComX (WAGES) E
DM2000 E
DM6200 E
DM6200 H E
DM6300 E
Easergy P3 S
Easergy P5 S
EDS151 E
EDS461 M
EM1000 Series E
EM3460 E
EM3550 E
EM3555 E
EM4200 E
EM4300 Series E
EM4800-08 Delta M
EM4800-08 Wye M
EM4800-12 M

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1483


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Device Type License


EM4800-24 M
EM4900 M
EM4900 Logical Meter
S
[license multiplier = 0.01] (*)
EM5600 M
EM6400 E
EM6400 NG E
EM6430 E
EM6433 E
EM6433_36_38 H E
EM6434 E
EM6436 E
EM6436 Dual E
EM6438 E
EM6459 E
EM6459 H E
EM7000 Series E
Enercept Meter E
EnerSure BCPM xD M
EnerSure iBCPM xD M
Exertherm ARM XL M
Galaxy VM E
Galaxy VS E
Galaxy VX E
HDPM6000 S
HDPM6000B S
HDPM6000R S
HDPM6000S S
iEM2050/2055/2250 E
iEM2150/2155 E
iEM3x50 Series E
iEM3x55 Series E
IG6 E
ION 6200 E

1484 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Device Type License


ION 6200 (MODBUS) E
ION 7300 E
ION 7330 M
ION 7350 M
ION 7400 S
ION 7500 M
ION 7500 RTU M
ION 7550 M
ION 7550 RTU M
ION 7600 S
ION 7650 S
ION 7700 S
ION 8300 M
ION 8400 S
ION 8500 S
ION 8600 S
ION 8600C M
ION 8650 S
ION 8650C M
ION 8800 S
ION 8800C M
ION 9000 S
LVSMC E
MGE Galaxy 5000 Series M
MGE-UPS E
Micrologic
M
2.0/3.0/5.0/6.0/7.0 X/Xi
Micrologic 2.0/5.0/6.0 E E
Micrologic 2.0/5.0/6.0 E
E
IFE_IFM
Micrologic 2.0/5.0/6.0/7.0 A E
Micrologic 2.0/5.0/6.0/7.0 A
E
IFE_IFM
Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0 H M

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1485


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Device Type License


Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0 H
M
IFE_IFM
Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0 P E
Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0 P
E
IFE_IFM
Micrologic 5.2/6.2/5.3/6.3 A E
Micrologic
E
5.2/6.2/5.3/6.3/7.2/7.3 E
Momentum PLC A8
M
(WAGES)
Momentum PLC D10
M
(WAGES)
Momentum PLC D16
M
(EPSS)
PM1120_30 H E
PM1200 E
PM200 Series E
PM2000 Series E
PM3250 E
PM3255 E
PM5100 Series E
PM5300 Series M
PM5350 E
PM5350 IB/PB E
PM5500/5600/5700 non-PQ M
PM5600/5700 PQ S
PM600 Series E
PM700 Series E
PM800 Series M
PM8000 S
PM810 LE E
PM9C E
PowerTag 63A /
PowerLogic Tag QO & EDB M
[license multiplier = 0.05] (*)

1486 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Device Type License


PowerTag NSX
E
M250/M630
PowerTag Rope & F160 /
E
PowerLogic Tag Rope
Sepam Series 10 E
Sepam Series 20 E
Sepam Series 40 M
Sepam Series 48 M
Sepam Series 60 S
Sepam Series 80 S
SER 2408 M
SER 3200 M
SMD LV Thermal Monitor M
Switchgear Monitoring
M
Device
SymmetraMW M
Tesys T E
Twido Modular PLC
E
(WAGES) D12/28/44
Varlogic_NRC_12 E
VarPlus Logic E
Veeder Root M
Vigilohm IFL12 E
Vigilohm IM20H E
Vigilohm IM400 E
WT4000 Series E
ZBRN32 (CL110/TH110) M

(*) The license multiplier indicates the fraction of a license each device of this type uses. For
example, a multiplier of 0.01 means that 100 devices of this type can share one full license.

NOTE: PME assigns a higher range license to a device, if an appropriate lower range license is not
available. For example, if a system has a ION7350 device, which requires a Mid-Range license,
PME will assign a free High-End license to this device, if a Mid-Range license is not available.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1487


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

IIS Application Pools


The Power Monitoring Expert installer enables and configures IIS to host the different Web
applications. The following table lists the application pools and applications:

Application Pool Identity Application


Dashboards

EWS (EcoStruxure Web


Services)
Application Modules App Pool NetworkService *
Slideshow

System Data Service

Web
ION

ION App Pool NetworkService * ION Report Data Service

Web Services
ModelingConfig
Web Reporter App Pool NetworkService *
reporter

* When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, then the Windows account that is
used to access the database, is also used to run the IIS Application Pools, instead of the Local
System account.

NOTE: The .NET Trust Level for PME web applications and Default Web Site must be set to Full
(internal), in IIS Manager.

1488 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Insulation Monitoring Design for ANSI


The following provides information on the design and architecture for an application of the Insulation
Monitoring Module in the ANSI market in Canada and United States.

Hardware devices
The following insulation monitoring components are available for all ANSI markets:

Isolated Power Panel


The isolated power panel provides isolated power to electrical systems in critical areas. Panel
configurations include a standard single, dual-voltage, and duplex. The single isolated power panel
comes with one Iso-Gard™ IG6 line isolation monitor (LIM-IG6) and one power transformer. Dual-
voltage panels include two LIM-IG6 devices and one transformer. Duplex panels include two LIM-
IG6 devices and two transformers. Other optional devices, including TCP gateways, are available.

Single Isolated Power Panel

The single isolated power panel is a single-voltage, single-system panel. There is no provision for
receptacles, ground jacks, or circuit control. This panel contains one LIM-IG6 and one transformer.
A TCP gateway and other optional devices are available.

Single Panel with Receptacles and Ground Jacks

The single isolated power panel can be configured with power receptacles and ground jacks on the
faceplate of the panel. This panel configuration is suited for areas that require a central location for
receptacles and ground jacks.

Dual-Voltage Isolated Power Panel

The dual-voltage isolated power panel provides two different output voltages simultaneously from
one isolation transformer. The typical configuration contains the following output voltages:

• One side configured for 208 V or 240 V fixed at 15 kVA.

• Second side configured for 120 V at 5.0, 7.5, or 10 kVA.

This panel type contains two LIM-IG6 monitors, one for each power supply side. Additional
components of the dual-voltage panel include:

• 2 reference ground buses

• 1 primary circuit breaker

• 1 secondary main circuit breaker for 120 V side

• 8 branch circuit breakers for 120 V side, field-convertible up to 16

• 1 secondary main circuit breaker for 208 V or 240 V side

• Provision for two 2-pole branch circuit breakers for 208 V or 240 V side.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1489


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Duplex Isolated Power Panel

Duplex isolated power panels provide two separate voltage outputs from two isolation transformers.
This system is equivalent to two independent single isolated power panels in one enclosure. The
duplex panel contains the following:

• 2 single-phase isolation transformers

• 2 LIM-IG6 monitors

• 2 reference ground buses

• 2 primary circuit breakers

• 8 branch circuit breakers for 120 V side, field-convertible up to 16.

Line Isolation Monitor


The LIM-IG6 monitors the impedance to ground of the entire isolated power system. This value is
used to calculate the Total Hazard Current (THC), measured in milliamperes (mA). The standard
THC alarm value set for line isolation monitors is 5 mA. The value may be switched to 2 mA to meet
Canadian Standards Association (CSA) requirements. The LIM-IG6 detects the following
information:

• Resistive and Capacitive fault

• Under voltage and over voltage

• Temperature status, when the optional sensor is installed

• Transformer load percentage, when the optional CT is installed

Isolation Power Transformer


To match the requirements for the room branch circuits, the isolation power transformer can be
configured with a specific rating and different single-phase primary voltages. A single isolated power
panel includes one transformer. A dual-voltage transformer and duplex transformer includes two
transformers. See the following table for power rating and primary voltage options.

1490 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

See the isolation power transformer documentation for wiring diagrams, installation, and other
information about the transformer.

IGC Gateway
The IGC gateway, formerly known as COM460IP, can be included in the isolated power panel for
data communications. The IGC gateway converts data from the Bender serial BMS protocol to
Modbus TCP so the data can be recorded and stored by PME. See the IGC gateway documentation
for more information about the gateway.

Branch Circuit Breakers


The isolated power panel includes eight branch circuit breakers for the 120 V side, field-convertible
up to 16. Each branch circuit can have up to four single receptacles, so the panel supports up to 64
receptacles. An EDS151 circuit fault monitor can be installed on each branch circuit.

Insulation Fault Locator


The EDS151 insulation fault locator works in conjunction with the LIM-IG6 to detect insulation faults
for specific branch circuits in the unearthed power supplies, such as for IT systems. The software
can display information about insulation faults when this device is installed.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1491


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Circuit Transformers
The SWT3 or SWT4 circuit transformer can be installed for performing load monitoring from the
LIMIG6. The software can display information about the transformer load when this device is
installed.

• STW3 type current transformers monitor up to 100 A load current.

• STW4 type current transformers monitor up to 200 A load current.

See the SWT3 or SWT4 documentation for more information about the circuit transformers.

Temperature Sensor
A temperature sensor can be installed to monitor the temperature of the isolation power panel. The
temperature sensor must be connected to the digital input of the LIM-IG6. The software can display
temperature information when this device is installed. See the temperature sensor documentation
for more information about the temperature sensor.

Electrical diagrams
This section provides details for electrical connections of the components in the isolated power
panel and the hardware configurations that could be commissioned on site. The following figure
shows the typical configuration for a single isolated power panel with one 120V isolation
transformer, one LIM-IG6 and TCP gateway.

Each isolated power panel can have optional transformer load monitoring, temperature monitoring,
and EDS151 or EDS460 circuit fault locators as shown next.

1492 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

In order to have the transformer load monitoring and circuit fault location, the panel requires these
components:

• SWT or SWT4 current transformers. These devices perform transformer load monitoring and
are connected to the LIM-IG6 connector plate input 1S1 and 1S2. See the LIM-IG6
documentation for connection details.

• EDS 151 circuit fault locators: Each circuit can have one EDS151 to detect the presence of
insulation faults. See the EDS151 documentation for more information.

In the Insulation Monitoring Module, one area can have a maximum of six LIM-IG6 monitors. This
enables the following panel combinations:

• 6 single isolated power panels. Each panel has 1 LIM-IG6.

• 3 dual-voltage isolated power panels. Each panel has 2 LIM-IG6.

• 3 duplex isolated power panels. Each panel has 2 LIM-IG6.

Network communication
This section shows a network diagram and describes the network communication between the
devices in the isolated power panel and the power monitoring system.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1493


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

This network diagram shows a distributed power monitoring system: the databases are on different
servers from the primary server. The system could also have a client server, where users can view
their system and generate reports. Other client PCs with dashboards can be included in the system.

The LIM-IG6 is connected to other Bender devices in the isolation power panel using RS485 serial
cable. The LIM-IG6 communicates with other Bender devices, such as the EDS151, through the
propriety Bender serial bus protocol.

The IGC gateway converts the Bender protocol to Modbus TCP. PME communicates with the IGC
gateway through port 502, the standard Modbus TCP/IP port. The software can also connect to the
IGC gateway through the Silverlight port 4530. Up to three Silverlight ports can be used
simultaneously. See documentation for the IGC gateway for more details.

The LIM-IG6 continuously measures the leakage impedance between isolated line and ground and
calculates the Total Hazard Current (THC). When the THC increases to a hazardous level of 5 mA
(USA) or 2 mA (Canada), the LIM-IG6 activates alarms internally and on remote devices if available.
If an EDS151 is connected to the LIM-IG6, the EDS151 is activated automatically after an alarm is
generated by the LIM-IG6. A test signal is sent to the EDS151. The signal flows through the location

1494 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

of the ground fault. Current transformers placed around each sub feeder or load will pick up on this
test signal. The EDS151 device will then evaluate the results. The location of the fault is displayed
on the EDS151 via an LED bar graph.

All the information above is also available through Modbus TCP protocol. PME gets the real-time
data and the event log through Modbus TCP. The software performs software logging every 5
minutes for the following measurements:

• Total hazard current

• Line voltage

• Leakage resistance

• Leakage impedance

• Transformer load monitoring (optional, if SWT3 or SWT4 CT is installed)

• Temperature (optional, if temperature sensor is installed)

When PME is installed on the system, drivers for the LIM-IG6 and EDS151 are installed on the
primary server. The Insulation Monitoring Configuration Tool is also installed.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1495


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

IP Ports
The following table lists the ports used by PME for the communication between its components and
the connected devices:

Port Protocol Location Function Configurable

20/21 FTP Power Meter Power meter access No

23 Telnet Power Meter Power meter access No

25 SMTP Power Meter Power meter access No

69 TFTP Power Meter Power meter access No

(1) PME Server (1) IIS server, EWS (1) Yes


80 HTTP
(2) Power Meter (2) Power meter access (2) No

135 OPC PME Server OPC client No

139/445 NetBIOS/SMB PME Server Engineering client (File and Printer Sharing) No

(1) PME Server (1) IIS Server, EWS, Cloud Agent


443 HTTPS No
(2) Power Meter (2) Power meter access

502 Modbus TCP Power Meter Power meter communication No

1433 TCP Database Server SQL Server instance No

1434 UDP Database Server SQL Server Browser No

3721 PML Power Meter Power meter communication No

6000-6099 TCP PME Server Log Inserter No

7070 TCP PME Server Licensing Yes

7176 TCP PME Server Diagnostics Viewer (LogSubsystem.Service.exe) No

7700 ION Power Meter Power meter communication No

7701 Modbus RTU Power Meter Power meter communications No

7800 Modbus/ION/PML Gateway Ethergate (All meter COM ports) No

7801 Modbus/ION/PML Gateway Ethergate (Meter COM1) No

7802 Modbus/ION/PML Gateway Ethergate (Meter COM2 and COM 4) No

7803 Modbus/ION/PML Gateway Ethergate (Meter COM3) No

8090 TCP PME Server Web client browser Yes

8523 TCP PME Server Logical devices (LogicalDevice.AutoConfig.ServiceHost.exe) Yes

13666 TCP PME Server PMLNetman.exe No

13667 TCP PME Server Diagnostics Viewer (Server access from client machine) No

13668 TCP PME Server Secondary server No

13666
13670 TCP PME Server Services (Vista and Designer access from client machines) No
13671

23102 TCP PME Server Application Modules web services No

(1) Real-time data service (to send data to clients)


57777 TCP PME Server Yes
(2) SQL Server (for default instance)

1496 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Port Protocol Location Function Configurable

57778 TCP PME Server DataProcessorService.exe Yes

57779 TCP PME Server Diagnostics Viewer (Alarm Service) Yes

57780 TCP PME Server Diagnostics Viewer (Log Subsystem) Yes

57781 TCP PME Server Diagnostics Viewer (Cloud Agent) Yes

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1497


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Licensing resources
Use the following links and contacts to find additional information and tools related to licensing.

Item Link/Contact Description

This is an online tool.


Use the sales portal to create a license Bill of
Sales Portal https://pme-licensing.schneider-electric.com
Materials (BOM), to activate or renew a service
plan, and to generate licenses.
This is a summary post on the Exchange
https://community.exchange.se.com/t5/EcoStruxure-Power-
community.
Sales Portal Overview Advisor/Introducing-Sales-Portal-Resources-amp-Links- This post provides links to an overview
presentation, user documentation and
Formerly-known-as/m-p/184497/thread-id/353
instructional videos.

Sales Portal Technical Use this email address to contact the Sales Portal
PME-ordersupport@se.com
Support technical support team.

https://schneider- This is an online Web Portal used for offline


Offline Licensing
electric.flexnetoperations.com/flexnet/operationsportal/logon.do activations, refresh and returns.

Licensing Technical
https://www.se.com/ww/en/work/support/ This is a global website for technical support.
Support

1498 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Using Floating License Manager after system upgrade


Starting from PME 2021, License configuration tool is used for license configuration. Floating
License Manager and License Manager are not supported for license configuration. These two
applications are unusable after system upgrade.

You might have other systems installed on the same server for which licensing is based on Floating
License Manager.

To use Floating License Manager after system upgrade, perform the following steps:

1. Copy Floating License Manager folder from the backup folder ( ...\Power Monitoring
Expert\PowerMonitoringExpert_9.1_Backup\Floating License Manager)

NOTE: This backup folder location is based on the system upgrade from PME 2020 to 2021.

2. Paste this inside the folder ...\Power Monitoring Expert\.

The Floating License Manager folder is created.

3. Launch FloatingLicenseManager.exe.

The Floating License Manager opens.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1499


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

PME Databases
Power Monitoring Expert uses four databases to store device communication parameters, system
configuration settings, and logged historical data.

ION_Network database
Sometimes called the NOM (Network Object Model), the ION_Network database stores device
information, such as, device name, device type and connection address (for example, IP address
and TCP/IP port or device/Modbus ID). It also contains information about the optional Application
Module settings, other ION Servers, Sites, Dial Out Modems, and Connection Schedules. There is
only one ION_Network per system.

ION_Data database
The ION_Data database contains the historical data, events and waveforms from devices
connected to the system. This includes: onboard logging configured on devices; and, PC-based
logging configured in the device translators and the Virtual Processors.

Application Modules database


The Application_Modules database contains configuration settings (for example, layouts, colors,
application events, and so on) and cached historical data for some of the Web Applications (for
example, Dashboards and Trends).

ION_System log database


The ION_SystemLog database holds system events and their timestamps, which is accessible to
view in Management Console. Event priorities can range from 0-255 and are grouped into
Diagnostic (0 - 5), Information (6 - 20), Warning (21 - 63), Error (64 - 191), and Critical (192 - 255)
categories. System events can include:

• ION Service stopped or is starting or user connection to an ION Service is lost.

• Device has been declared offline / online.

• ION Site Service connected, disconnected or failed to connect to a Site.

• ION User logs on / off Vista or Designer.

• ION User saves a Vista or Designer node diagram.

• Plus many other Warnings and Errors relating to PME system functions.

1500 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

PME Windows services


All PME applications without a user interface run as Windows services. The following table lists all
PME services:

Startup
Service Name Log On Account Description
Type
Allows the Event Notification Module
(ENM) to read alarms directly from the
ION Application NT
ION_Data database.
Modules Alarm Manual AUTHORITY\System
Starts on demand from other services
Services Host *
(for example, from the Event
Notification Module).
ION Application NT
Hosts common web services used by
Modules Core Automatic AUTHORITY\System
the Web Applications component.
Services Host *
Hosts web services that provide low-
ION Application NT level access to system data (that is,
Modules Data Automatic AUTHORITY\System real-time, historical, alarming, and
Services Host * authentication) for the Web
Applications component.
ION Application NT Hosts web services that provide data
Modules Provider Automatic AUTHORITY\System processing for the Web Applications
Engine Host * component.
NT
ION Cloud Agent Manages interaction with cloud
Automatic AUTHORITY\System
Service services.
*
Locates local and remote product
components.
ION Component
Manual Local Service * Starts shortly after startup by request
Identifier Service
of ION Connection Management
Service.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1501


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Startup
Service Name Log On Account Description
Type
Determines the connection status of
sites and devices in the system, and
handles allocation of resources such
as modems. This service manages the
state of site and device connectivity for
ION Connection NT the system. In order to establish the
Management Manual AUTHORITY\System most appropriate state for the system,
Service * each connection and disconnection
request is evaluated against the overall
state of the system and availability of
communications channels.

Starts shortly after startup by request


of ION Network Router Service.
Collects basic, non-identifying
information from the Power Monitoring
Expert system and uploads it to a
ION Diagnostics
Automatic Local Service * secure location on the cloud for data
and Usage Service
mining by Schneider Electric.
Customers can opt-in or opt-out at any
time.
ION Event Watcher Monitors system events for conditions
Automatic Local Service *
Service specified in Event Watcher Manager.
Provides historical data collection for
NT
ION Log Inserter the power monitoring system (that is,
Automatic AUTHORITY\System
Service devices and Virtual Processor), and
*
stores it in the ION_Data database.
Automatic NT Transfers data received from power
ION Log Subsystem
(Delayed AUTHORITY\System monitoring devices to storage and
Router Service
Start) * processing.
This service is used to create individual
ION Managed
Automatic Local Service * real-time and historical data sources for
Circuit Service
multi-circuit meters.

1502 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Startup
Service Name Log On Account Description
Type
Routes all ION requests between the
software components, such as client
workstations, the Real Time Data
Service, Log Inserter, and the Query
NT
ION Network Router Server. The service dynamically
Automatic AUTHORITY\System
Service detects changes to the network
*
configuration, including the addition of
new servers. It can also recognize new
software nodes, such as Vista, that are
added to an existing server.
Serves real-time OPC data (OPC DA)
NT to OPC client applications.
ION OPC Data
Manual AUTHORITY\System Starts on an OPC client request for
Access Server
* data, if the Data Exchange Module
license has been activated.
Translates power quality data from the
ION PQDIF ION_Data database into PQDIF file
Manual Local Service *
Exporter Service format and manages scheduled PQDIF
exports.
Provides historical data retrieval from
NT
the ION_Data database for client
ION Query Service Automatic AUTHORITY\System
applications (for example, Vista and
*
Diagrams).
Manages and provides access to real-
ION Real Time Data
Automatic Local Service * time data for all client applications
Service
(Vista, Diagrams, Trends, and so on).
Runs Reports subscriptions according
Automatic to user-defined schedules.
ION Report
(Delayed Local Service *
Subscription Service Starts several minutes after the server
Start)
starts.
Manages communication links to and
from the product. ION Site Service is
responsible for handling packet
communications to system devices
NT and controlling direct device
ION Site Service Automatic AUTHORITY\System communications. The service reacts to
* changes in network configuration: for
example, changes to certain channels,
configuration parameters, ports, or
device parameters can often interrupt a
connection.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1503


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Startup
Service Name Log On Account Description
Type
Automatic Performs evaluations based on real
ION Software Data
(Delayed Local Service * time data from the power monitoring
Processing Service
Start) system.
Enables software data services via
ION Software ModbusTCP/IP, and is treated like a
Modbus Gateway Manual Local Service * device in the system. For example, the
Service Circuit Breaker Aging Service uses this
service.
ION Virtual Provides aggregation, control, and
Processor Service - Automatic Local Service * mathematical analysis of power
NVIP.DEFAULT monitoring system data.
Serves up data for the Power Quality
ION Virtual
Performance diagrams. Functions only
Processor Service – Automatic Local Service *
when the Power Quality Performance
NVIP.PQADVISOR
module is licensed and configured.
Serves up data for the Disturbance
ION Virtual Direction Indicators application.
Processor Service – Automatic Local Service * Functions only when the Disturbance
NVIP.DDD Direction Indicators application is
configured.
Manages subscriptions to XML data for
Vista user diagrams. This service is
used only by the Diagrams application.
ION XML When you open a Vista user diagram in
Automatic Local Service *
Subscription Service a web browser, the ION XML
Subscription Service creates a
subscription and delivers the real-time
data in XML format.
Stores XML data subscriptions for the
ION XML
power monitoring devices on the
Subscription Store Automatic Local Service *
network. This service is used only by
Service
the Diagrams application.
This service runs the FlexNet
ImadminSchneider Automatic Local Service
Publisher License Server Manager.
Provides storage, processing and
controlled access of data, and rapid
transaction processing for the ION_
SQL Server (ION) Automatic Local System
Data, ION_Network, ION_SystemLog,
and the ApplicationModules
databases.

1504 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

* When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, the Windows account that is
used to access the database is also used to run the PME services.
** This service only exists on systems with SQL Server, not SQL Server Express.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1505


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

SQL Server accounts


The database server hosts several databases for Power Monitoring Expert (PME). The following
tables lists the SQL Server logins and permissions created for PME:

For installations with SQL Server Authentication:

Server
Login Authentication Database Membership
Role
AMUser SQL Public ApplicationModules AMApplicationRole
ApplicationModules db_owner
ION_Data db_owner
ION SQL Public
ION_Network db_owner
ION_SystemLog db_owner
ION_Data ION_DSD_Reader
ionedsd SQL Public
ION_Network NOM_DSD_Reader
db_backupoperator, db_
ApplicationModules
ddladmin, Maintenance
db_backupoperator, db_
ION_Data
ddladmin, Maintenance
IONMaintenance* Windows Public
db_backupoperator, db_
ION_Network
ddladmin, Maintenance
db_backupoperator, db_
ION_SystemLog
ddladmin, Maintenance

* This account is only created on standalone servers where the SQL Server software and PME are
installed on the same computer.

For installations with Windows Integrated Authentication:

Server
Login Authentication Database Membership
Role
ApplicationModules db_owner
Account used for
ION_Data db_owner
Windows Integrated Windows Public
ION_Network db_owner
Authentication
ION_SystemLog db_owner

1506 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

db_backupoperator,
ApplicationModules db_ddladmin,
Maintenance
db_backupoperator,
ION_Data db_ddladmin,
Maintenance
IONMaintenance * Windows Public
db_backupoperator,
ION_Networks db_ddladmin,
Maintenance
db_backupoperator,
ION_SystemLog db_ddladmin,
Maintenance

* This account is only created on standalone servers where the SQL Server software and PME are
installed on the same computer.

NOTE: When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, the Windows account
that is used to access the database is also used to run the PME services and the IIS Application
Pools.

Other
PME must have access to the master and tempdb System Databases.

The PME Database Manager tool requires that the Windows account that is used to run it has
sysadmin permissions on the PME SQL Server instance. The Database Manager is an optional
tool, used for managing the PME databases.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1507


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Windows accounts
The following tables provide information on the Windows accounts used by Power Monitoring
Expert (PME):

User Account Role/Group/Permissions Notes


- No group membership. - Automatically created during the installation
- Has of PME.
IONUser (account) List/Read/Write/Execute - Used to run report subscriptions.
permissions on the PME - Needs access to the folder where
share folder. subscriptions are saved.
- Automatically created during the installation
IONMaintenance of PME.
Member of Users group
(account)* - Used to run database maintenance jobs in
Windows Task Scheduler.
- Manually created by the user.
- Used to log into Windows to run the PME
Login used to run Needs to be a member of
installer
the PME installer local Administrators group
- If possible, the local Administrator account
should be used.
- Manually created by the user.
Login used to
Needs to be a member of - Used to log into Windows to run the PME
access PME
Users group Web Applications or Engineering Client
applications
applications.
- Manually created by the user.
Login to run - Used to log into Windows to run PME
Needs to be a member of
application application engineering tools. An example is
local Administrators group
engineering tools the Configuration Manager Tool, used for
system upgrades.
- Manually created by the user.
Login to run the Needs sysadmin - Used to log into Windows to run the PME
Database Manager permissions on SQL Database Manager tool.
tool database instance. - This Windows account needs to be added to
the SQL server database.
Must have access to the database folder(s)
SQL Server
and the Temp folder of the installer user during
Database Engine NT AUTHORITY\SYSTEM
installation. Permissions can be lowered after
service
PME is installed.

* This account is only created on standalone servers where the SQL Server software and PME are
installed on the same computer.

NOTE: For information on which accounts are used to run the PME Windows services, see PME
Windows services and IIS Application Pools.

1508 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

For installations using Windows Integrated Authentication, the following additional accounts and
permissions are required:

User Account Role/Group/Permissions Notes


- Needs to be a member of
Account used for local Administrators group - Manually created by the user.
Windows Integrated - Needs 'Log on as a - Used by PME to access the SQL server
Authentication service' privilege on databases.
application server
This is not an additional user account. It is
just an added requirement for the Logins used
to access the Engineering Client applications
Login used to access Needs sysadmin server (Vista, Designer, Management Console,
PME Engineering role for the PME Management Console tools).
Client applications databases.
The PME databases are:
ApplicationModules, ION_Data, ION_
Network, ION_Systemlog.

NOTE: When PME is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication, the Windows account
that is used to access the database is also used to run the PME services and the IIS Application
Pools.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1509


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Installation and Upgrade references


This section contains reference information related to the content in the Installing and Upgrading
chapter of this guide.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Setting SQL Server memory options


Setup Types and applicable Installer pages
Upgrade tools and resources
Estimated task time for SBS upgrades
Network communication test
Enabling TCP/IP protocol in SQL Server Express
Installing and binding security certificates
Enabling HTTP connections for PME
Configuring first time Alarms processing
Installing PME with manual installation of the databases
PME 2021 Install notes
PME 2021 Upgrade notes
PME release history
Configuration Manager

1510 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Setting SQL Server memory options


Note the following recommendations for setting SQLServer memory options on the server where
you install SQL Server:

• Do not set the SQL Server maximum memory to less than 1GB.

• Where only SQL Server is running on the host server, set the SQL Server maximum memory at
the system physical memory less at least 2GB for the Windows operating system. For
example, if your server has 8GB of memory, set the SQL Server maximum memory to no more
than 6GB. This leaves at least 2GB for the operating system.

• Where the SQL Server is sharing the host server with other server processes, including Internet
Information Services (IIS) and ION services, set the SQL Server maximum memory to no more
than half the physical memory on the server. For example, if your server has 8GB of memory,
set the SQL Server memory to no more than 4GB. This leaves at least 4GB for the operating
system and all other server processes.

In addition to setting the maximum memory option, consult with your site administrator to determine
whether or not to enable the Lock pages in memory permission setting in Windows for the SQL
service account on all SQL Server instances.

NOTICE
LOSS OF DATA
Back up or archive any SQL Server database data before adjusting any database memory
options.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in irreversible database changes.

Only personnel with advanced knowledge of SQL Server databases should make database
parameter changes.

To set the maximum memory setting for your SQL Server:

1. Start SQL Server Management Studio and log in to your SQL Server instance.

2. Right-click the SQL Server name and click Properties in the menu to open the Server
Properties dialog.

3. Select Memory in the left pane and adjust the value in the Maximum server memory field.

4. Click OK to apply the changes and close the dialog.

5. Close SQL Server Management Studio.

A server reboot or a restart of the SQL Server service is not required.

To enable the lock pages in memory option:

1. Click Start > Run and type gpedit.msc in the Run dialog to open the Local Group Policy
Editor.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1511


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

2. In the left pane, navigate to Computer Configuration > Windows Settings > Security
Settings > Local Policies.

3. Expand Local Policies and select User Rights Assignment.

The policies are listed in the right pane.

4. Locate Lock pages in memory in the list and then double click the policy name to open the
Lock pages in memory Properties dialog.

5. Click Add User or Group on the Local Security Setting tab.

6. Add an account with the privileges to run sqlserver.exe and then click OK to close the dialog.

7. Click OK to close the Local Group Policy Editor.

A server reboot or a restart of the SQL Server service is not required.

1512 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Setup Types and applicable Installer pages


The following table lists the pages in the Installer associated with each setup type. Because
Secondary Server installations are not common, the Secondary Server setup type is excluded from
the table. The "Y" indicates that the Installer page appears during the installation of that setup type,
and the "n/a" indicates that the page is not applicable to that setup type and does not appear during
the installation.

Setup Types
Installer Pages
Standalone Application Server Engineering Client
Application Language Y for all setup types
Welcome Y for all setup types
License Agreement Y for all setup types
Setup Type Y for all setup types
System Key Y Y n/a
Import System Key n/a n/a Y
Export System Key Y Y n/a
User Information Y for all setup types
Web Application Y Y n/a
Application Server n/a n/a Y
Diagnostic and Usage /
Y Y n/a
Connected Services
File Destination Y for all setup types
Supervisor Account Y Y n/a
Windows Accounts Y Y n/a
Database Accounts Y Y n/a
Database Software Y Y n/a
Database Files Destination Y Y n/a
Check System Y for all setup types
Ready to Configure Y for all setup types
Copy Files Y for all setup types
Configure System Y for all setup types
Complete Y for all setup types

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1513


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Upgrade tools and resources


Tools
The following tools exist to help with PME upgrades:

PME Installer
The PME installer is the installer of the new PME version. It automatically performs an In-Place
upgrade if it detects an existing, supported PME installation on the server. The PME installer is part
of the .iso install file or DVD for PME.

Upgrade Map
The Upgrade Map is a Microsoft Excel based tool that shows the supported upgrade paths and
prerequisites for In-Place and SBS upgrades. The Upgrade Map also shows which tool to use for
the upgrade.

Configuration Manager
The Configuration Manager is a standalone tool that is used for Side-by-Side (SBS) upgrades of
PME. It reads the configuration of the old PME system and copies it to a new PME system. Some
manual steps are needed to complete the upgrade when using the Configuration Manager. The tool
comes with instructions for the manual SBS upgrade steps.

PME Service Packs


The In-Place and SBS upgrade tools require the latest service pack versions of the older PME
systems to be installed before the upgrade.

See Resources for information on where to get the tools and resources.

1514 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Estimated task time for SBS upgrades


Section Estimated Time
Introduction 20 minutes
Step 1 – Prepare both
45 minutes (+ possible troubleshooting time)
systems
Step 2 – Transfer the 30 minutes + 12 min/GB database size (ION_Data, ION_Network,
Configuration ApplicationModules, Archives)
Steps 3 to 5 – Manually
90 minutes (+ possible troubleshooting time)
Complete the Upgrade
Step 6 – Perform a Post-
60 minutes (+ possible troubleshooting time)
upgrade System Check
Step 7 – License the new
15 minutes (+ possible troubleshooting time)
system
Total upgrade time =  260 minutes using Configuration Manager*

* Does not include database transfer or possible troubleshooting time.

NOTE: Time estimates are for engineers who are experienced in deploying and customizing PME.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1515


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Network communication test


Use Ping to test the communication between computers on an Internet Protocol (IP) network.

To perform a ping test, open a command prompt on each computer and type ping <computer_
name>, where <computer_name> is the name of the other computer you want to contact.

A successful response shows 4 attempts to contact the computer, lists the IP Address, indicates
Packets: Sent = 4. Received = 4, Lost = 0 (0% loss), plus timing data. If this is
not the case, it indicates that the computers cannot communicate and that you need to resolve the
connectivity situation.

NOTE: The ping utility requires that Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) is enabled on your
network.

1516 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Enabling TCP/IP protocol in SQL Server Express


To enable the TCP/IP protocol:

1. Click Start > All Programs > Microsoft SQL Server 20xx > Configuration Tools > SQL
Server Configuration Manager, where 20xx is the SQL Server version.

2. Expand SQL Server Network Configuration in the left pane and click Protocols for ION.

3. If the TCP/IP protocol status is Disabled, right-click TCP/IP, and:

a. Select Enable in the menu,

or,

b. Click Properties to open the TCP/IP Properties dialog, select Yes for Enabled, and
click OK.

When you enable the TCP/IP protocol, an informational message indicates that you need
to restart the service before the change takes effect.

4. Click SQL Server Services in the left pane under SQL Server Configuration Manager.

5. Click SQL Server (ION) to select it and then click the Restart service icon in the toolbar to
stop the service and restart it.

6. Close SQL Server Configuration Manager.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1517


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Installing and binding security certificates


The certificate authority may provide root certificates and intermediate certificates in addition to the
actual server certificate. To install the certificates on the PME server, follow the instructions
provided by the certificate authority, or follow the steps below.

Installing a root certificate


To install a root certificate:

1. Open Microsoft Management Console (MMC) by running mmc.exe on the PME server.

2. Under File > Add/Remove Snap-in... add the Certificates Snap-in. In the Certificates snap-
in dialog,
a. Select Computer Account. Click Next.

b. Select Local computer. Click Finish.

3. Click OK to close the Add or Remove Snap-ins dialog window.

4. In the left pane of the Console 1 window, expand the Certificates folder.

5. Right-click the Trusted Root Certification Authorities folder and select All Tasks >
Import…. In the Certificate Import Wizard, click Next, enter
a. File name: (Select your root certificate.) Click Next.

b. Certificate store: (Select Trusted Root Certification Authorities.)

c. Click Next. Click Finish.

6. Repeat step 5 to install additional root certificates if required.

7. Close the MMC.

Installing an intermediate certificate


To install an intermediate certificate:

1. Open Microsoft Management Console (MMC) by running mmc.exe on the PME server.

2. Under File > Add/Remove Snap-in... add the Certificates Snap-in. In the Certificates
snap-in dialog,
a. Select Computer Account. Click Next.

b. Select Local computer. Click Finish.

3. Click OK to close the Add or Remove Snap-ins dialog window.

4. In the left pane of the Console 1 window, expand the Certificates folder.

5. Right-click the Intermediate Certification Authorities folder and select All Tasks >
Import…. In the Certificate Import Wizard, click Next, enter
a. File name: (Select your intermediate certificate.) Click Next.

b. Certificate store: (Select Intermediate Certification Authorities.)

c. Click Next. Click Finish.

6. Repeat step 5 to install additional intermediate certificates if required.

7. Close the MMC.

1518 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Installing the server certificate


To install a server certificate:

1. Open Internet Information Services (IIS) Manager on the PME server.

2. In the Connections pane (left pane) select the server.

3. In the Home pane (middle pane),


a. Select Features View at the bottom of the window.

b. In the IIS section, open Server Certificates.

4. In the Actions pane (right pane) click Complete Certificate Request...

5. In the Complete Certificate Request dialog, enter


a. File name: (Select your server certificate.)

b. Friendly name: (Enter the name under which the certificate will be displayed in Windows
menus and UIs, example: Power Monitoring Expert Certificate.)

c. Certificate store: (Select a certificate store. Choose Personal if in doubt.)

d. Click OK to close the Certificate wizard.

6. Close IIS Manager

Creating a HTTPS binding


Web site bindings define the protocols (HTTP or HTTPS) that are used to access the Web sites.

To create a HTTPS binding for the PME Web sites:

1. Open Internet Information Services (IIS) Manager on the PME server.

2. In the Connections pane (left pane) expand server name > Sites > Default Web Site. Right-
click Default Web Site and select Edit Bindings... from the context menu.

3. In the Site Bindings dialog click Add… to add a new binding

4. In the Add Site Binding dialog:


a. Set Type to https.

b. Set IP address to All Unassigned

c. Set Port to 443.

d. Set Host name to the name shown in the "Issued To" property of the security certificate.

TIP: To find the “Issued To” name of the certificate, click View, after selecting the
certificate in the drop down (step f).

e. Leave the Require Server Name Indication box unchecked.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1519


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

f. Set SSL certificate to the security certificate you want to use with PME.

g. Click OK to close the Add Site Binding dialog.

5. In the Site Bindings dialog remove any existing http binding. Close the dialog.

6. Select Default Web Site in the Connections pane (left pane).

7. In the Home pane (middle pane):


a. Select Features View at the bottom of the window.

b. In the IIS section open SSL Settings.

8. In the SSL Settings window (middle pane):


a. Check the box for Require SSL

b. Set Client certificates to Ignore

c. In the Actions pane (right pane) click Apply.

9. Close IIS Manager.

1520 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Enabling HTTP connections for PME


By default, PME uses HTTPS between the server and the Web clients. Any HTTP connection
requests are automatically redirected to HTTPS. To allow both, HTTP connections and
HTTPS connections, turn off the automatic redirect. To only allow HTTP connections, enable
HTTP and disable HTTPS.

RECOMMENDATION: To increase the cyber resilience of your system, we strongly recommend


that you use HTTPS connections with an authority issued certificate.

Allowing HTTP and HTTPS connections


To disable the automatic redirect and allowing both HTTP and HTTPS connections:

1. Open SQL Server Management Studio (SSMS) and connect to the PME SQL server.

2. Copy the following SQL script into a query window In SSMS:


UPDATE ApplicationModules.Configuration.ConfigurationSettings
SET Value = 'False'
WHERE [key] = 'IsSecureConnectionRequired'

3. Execute the script.

4. Close SSMS

5. Restart Internet Information Services (IIS) on the PME application server.

6. Close all PME Web client browser instances to remove any caching of previous HTTPS
connection information.

NOTE: To enable the automatic redirect, follow the same instructions as above but set the value
for the IsSecureConnectionRequired key in the script to True.

Allowing HTTP connections only


To enable HTTP connections and disable HTTPS connections:

A - Configure Internet Information Services (IIS)


To remove the HTTPS binding:

1. Open IIS Manager on the PME server.

2. In the Connections pane (left pane) expand server name > Sites > Default Web Site. Right-
click Default Web Site and select Edit Bindings... from the context menu.

3. In the Site Bindings dialog remove any bindings to port 443 (https).

4. Click Close.

B - Configure PME for HTTP

Application Modules Database update

1. Open SQL Server Management Studio and connect to the PME SQL server.

2. Navigate to Databases -> ApplicationModules -> Views

3. Right-click on Configuration.ConfigurationSettings and selectEdit Top 200 Rows

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1521


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Find the entry in the result set with the following values:
a. ItemType = Web Framework

b. Item = Server

c. Key = LocalServerAddress

5. Update the Value column to http://localhost/.

6. Find the entry in the result set with the following values:
a. ItemType = Web Framework

b. Item = Server

c. Key = IsSecureConnectionRequired

7. Update the Value column to be False.

ION_Network Database update

1. Open SQL Server Management Studio and connect to the PME SQL server.

2. Navigate to Databases -> ION_Network -> Views

3. Right-click on dbo.vCFG_ConfigItems and select Edit Top 200 Rows

4. Find the entry in the result set with the following values:
a. Module = Reporting

b. Category = General Settings

c. Item = WebServiceUrl

5. Update the Value column to


http://localhost/ionreportdataservice/ReportDataService.asmx.

6. Open a windows Command window (cmd.exe) and run iisreset.

7. Open the windows Services console, and restart the following service: ION Application
Modules Core Services Host. Click Yes when asked to restart the ION Application Modules
services.

Default Web Application link update

1. Open a Windows explorer window and navigate to: Desktop -> Power Monitoring Expert

2. Right-click on Web Applications and select Properties

3. Update the URL value with the updated url.

Example: the correct value would be: http://localhost/Web

C - Reset IIS
1. Open a windows Command window (cmd.exe) and run iisreset

1522 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Configuring first time Alarms processing


After a system upgrade, the Alarms Web application processes existing Events and Power Quality
data the first time it starts up. You can control how much of the existing Power Quality data is
processed by defining how far back in time you want the data to be processed.

The setting that controls the historical Power Quality data range to be processed is stored in the
database. This setting defines the start date from which on the data is processed. The default start
date is set to 1980-01-01 (yyyy-mm-dd).

NOTICE
INOPERABLE DATABASE
Back up the database before executing SQL scripts.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in an inoperable database and loss of data.

To change the start date for the Alarms data processing:

1. On the PME server, open the Windows Services panel. Find the ION Log Subsystem Router
Service and stop this service.

2. On the PME database server, open SQL Server Management Studio (SSMS).

3. Copy the following SQL script into a query window In SSMS:


SELECT *
FROM [ApplicationModules].[Configuration].[ConfigurationSettings]
WHERE [Item] = 'Alarm Service Processing' ORDER BY [Key]

4. Execute the script on the ApplicationModules database. This returns the settings for the Alarm
Service Processing.

5. Find the OldestConsideredPQEventTimeUtc setting in the Key column and check the
date it is set to.

6. Open a new query window in SSMS and copy in the following SQL script:
UPDATE [ApplicationModules].[Configuration].
[ConfigurationSettings]
SET Value = 'Enter the start date in the format yyyy-mm-dd'
WHERE [key]= 'OldestConsideredPQEventTimeUtc'

7. Replace the Enter the start date in the format yyyy-mm-dd text with the start
date for the data processing and then execute the script.

8. Repeat steps 3-5 to review the updated start date.

9. Close SSMS.

10. Open the Windows Services panel. Find the ION Log Subsystem Router Service and start
this service.

When you open the Alarms Web application for the first time, it will start processing existing power
quality events starting with the date you set above.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1523


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Installing PME with manual installation of the databases


NOTE: The procedures described below, for the manual installation of the database, can only be
used for Distributed Database architectures. Do not use the procedures for Standalone
architectures where the database and the application server are on the same computer.

NOTE: To use this procedure you must use Mixed Mode Authentication for the SQL Server. This
procedure does not work if you use SQL Integrated (Windows) Authentication for the SQL Server.

The following describes how you can install PME without having to provide SQL Server account
credentials with sysadmin privileges in the PME installer. This involves using the software installer
and performing manual configuration steps on the database server.

NOTE: The user account that is used on the database server to run the SQL scripts that are part of
this procedure, must have sysadmin privileges on the SQL Server. However, you do not have to
enter information for this account in the PME installer.

Overview
Installing PME with manual installation of the databases consists of the following steps:

1. Running the PME installer to install and configure the application files.

2. Manually running scripts on the database server to create the databases and setup the
database accounts.

See details below.

Prerequisites
• You need the PME install DVD or ISO file.

• You will need to set a password for the three SQL accounts (ION, ionedsd, AMUser) that
PME uses to access the database. This password must comply with the password policies of
the Windows server and the SQL server.

• You need the following SQL server accounts on the database server:
An account that can connect to the SQL server instance. This account does not require
sysadmin privileges. This account is used for the installation of PME and future password
resets.

An account that has sysadmin privileges on the SQL Server. This account is used to run
the SQL scripts to create the databases and setup the database accounts.

• You need a folder on the database server for the database files. This folder must exist before
you start the PME installation.

• You need access to SQL Server Management Studio on the database server.

Installation
Run the PME installer on the application server and follow the regular install process, with the
modifications shown below:

1524 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

1. On the Setup Type installer page, choose Application Server setup type. Continue with the
installer workflow.

2. On the Database Accounts installer page, choose Use SQL Server Authentication and
provide your own password by clicking Change Password. Continue with the installer
workflow.

NOTE: Do not use the installer generate password since it cannot be copied. You will need
access to this password in step 18 below, when editing a script file.

NOTE: If you change the password, the password you are providing must comply with the
password policies of the Windows server and the SQL server.
The software installer cannot validate the password at the time you enter it.
If the password is not valid, the installation will not be successful. In that case, complete the
installation, skipping any unsuccessful steps. See Unsuccessful installation due to invalid
account passwords for information on how to repair the unsuccessful install.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices for password creation and management.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access - such as least privilege,
separation of duties - vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to
ensure that user access adheres to the site-specific cybersecurity policies.

3. On the SQL Server installer page, choose SQL Server Authentication and provide SQL
account information for a low privilege account. This account only needs to be able to connect
to the SQL Server instance. Continue with the installer workflow.

TIP: Make a note of the account username. You will need this username in step 9 and 16
below, when editing a script file.

4. On the Database Files Destination installer page, provide the path to the folder on the
database server, where the database files will be installed. Continue with the installer
workflow.

NOTE: The folder on the database server must exist. The PME installer cannot create a
folder or verify the existence of a folder on the database server. This is because the SQL
account you specified in the previous step has low privileges.

5. After copying files and completing many configuration steps, the installer will stop on the
Create Database step and display an error message. This is because the installer could not
create the databases.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1525


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example:

Leave the installer open in this state. On the PME application server, browse to ...\Power
Monitoring Expert\Database\Diagnostic and copy the following files from there, to
a temporary location on the database server: ION_Data.sql, ION_Network.sql, and
ION_SystemLog.sql.

6. On the database server, open SQL Server Management Studio (SSMS) and enable SQL CMD
by going to Tools > Options, clicking on Query Execution and checking the box By default,
open new queries in SQL CMD mode.

1526 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Example:

7. On the database server, open and execute the three scripts files (ION_Data.sql, ION_
Network.sql, and ION_SystemLog.sql) in SSMS. If an Inconsistent Line Endings
dialog box is displayed, click Yes to continue.

NOTE: The account you use to log into the database server must have sysadmin privileges
on the SQL Server.

NOTE: The order in which you run the scripts is not important.

NOTE: The script files create three of the four PME databases - ION_Data, ION_
Network, and ION_SystemLog. The ApplicationModules database will be created
in a later step.

Example of Inconsistent Line Endings dialog box:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1527


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

8. On the PME install DVD or ISO file, browse to root\ManualInstall\ and copy the
following script file from there, to a temporary location on the database server:
ManualDBInstall_Script1-Make_DBOwner-DataNtwrkSystm.sql.

9. On the database server, open ManualDBInstall_Script1-Make_DBOwner-


DataNtwrkSystm.sql in SSMS. Edit the script by replacing PM_Login with the SQL
account username you entered in the Database Software installer page (step 3). Execute the
script.
Script part where you must set the username:
DECLARE @PM_SQL_User_Account NVARCHAR(MAX) = 'PM_Login';

NOTE: This will add the account to the db_owner role in the databases.

10. Go back to the PME installer on the application server. It still shows the Configure System
page with the unsuccessful Create Database step. Click Skip failed step to skip the failed
Create Database step.

Example:

11. The installer will stop on the Create Database step and display an error message. This is
because the installer could not create the ApplicationsModules database. Leave the
installer open in this state.

12. On the PME application server, browse to ...\Power Monitoring


Expert\Database\Diagnostic and copy the ApplicationsModules.sql file from
there, to a temporary location on the database server.

1528 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

13. On the database server, open and execute the ApplicationsModules.sql script files in
SSMS. This will create the ApplicationsModules database.

14. On the PME install DVD or ISO file, browse to root\ManualInstall\ and copy the
following script file from there, to a temporary location on the database server:
ManualDBInstall_Script2-Make_DBOwner-AppMods.sql.

15. On the database server, open ManualDBInstall_Script2-Make_DBOwner-


AppMods.sql in SSMS. Edit the script by replacing PM_Login with the SQL account
username you entered in the SQL Server installer page (step 3). Execute the script.
Script part where you must set the username:
DECLARE @PM_SQL_User_Account NVARCHAR(MAX) = 'PM_Login';

NOTE: This will add the account to the db_owner role in the database.

16. On the PME install DVD or ISO file, browse to root\ManualInstall\ and copy the
following script file from there, to a temporary location on the database server:
ManualDBInstall_Script3-CreateMap_Logins.sql.

17. On the database server, open ManualDBInstall_Script3-CreateMap_Logins.sql


in SSMS. Edit the script as shown below. Execute the script.
To edit the script:
a. Uncomment the following two statements: DECLARE @IsIntegratedSQLAuthUsed
BIT = 0 and DECLARE @PM_SQL_Account NVARCHAR(MAX) =
'<DOMAIN\USERNAME>'.

b. Set the @PM_SQL_Password variable in the following statement, DECLARE @PM_SQL_


Password NVARCHAR(MAX) = ‘<enter password here>', to the database
accounts password that you chose in step 2 above.

NOTE: This will create the PME database accounts that are used by the software to connect
to the databases.

18. Go back to the PME installer on the application server. It still shows the Configure System
page with the unsuccessful Check Applications Database step. Click Skip failed step to
skip the failed Check Applications Database step. Continue with the installer workflow.

19. The installer will stop on the Configure SQL Server step and display an error message. Click
Yes to continue with the rest of the installation.

20. Click Exit, after the installation is complete.

NOTE: The installer will display a Could not complete all steps message when it finishes.
Ignore this message. The steps that did not complete are the ones that were done manually as per
instructions above, and then skipped.

Final notes
• Delete the low privilege SQL account created for step 3. It is no longer needed.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1529


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Delete the copy of the ManualDBInstall_Script3-CreateMap_Logins.sql script with


the entered password (see step 18) or keep it in a secure location to prevent unauthorized
access to the password.

• You can disable SQL CMD in SSMS on the database server. This option was enabled in step 6
above.

• If, at a later point, you want to change the password used by PME to connect to the databases,
first manually change the password for the three PME logins (ION, ionedsd, AMUser) on
the database server using SQL Server Management Studio.

NOTE: Note that all three logins need to use the same password.

Then run the PME installer on the application server and select Reset Accounts. In Reset
Accounts, change the password for the Database Accounts to match the one you manually set
in SSMS. You can use the low privilege SQL account created for step 3 for the password reset
in the installer.

NOTE: If you use an SQL account without sysadmin level SQL credentials for the password
reset in the installer, you will see an error at the Update Login Credentials step. Ignore the
message and skip this unsuccessful step. The password reset will still be successful.

Reset Accounts error on Update Credentials step:

1530 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

PME 2021 Install notes


The following is a list of release notes related to PME 2021 installs.

• Install path length limitation

• 32-bit version of SQL Server Express is not included with the PME installer

• Install a security certificate for TLS 1.2

Install path length limitation


The installation path for installing PME on your computer is limited to 100 characters. This is done to
ensure that the path length of PME system files, after the installation, does not exceed the
maximum allowable path length of 260 characters. This maximum path length is a limitation on
some of the older supported Windows operating system versions.

32-bit version of SQL Server Express is not included with the PME installer
32-bit versions of SQL Server Express are still supported, but they are not included with the
installer. If you want to use a 32-bit version, you need to install it on the PME server before installing
the software.

The 64-bit version of SQL Server Express is included with the installer and can be installed as part
of the PME installation workflow.

Install a security certificate for TLS 1.2


See Install a security certificate for TLS 1.2 in the Install section of this guide for details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1531


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

PME 2021 Upgrade notes


The following is a list of release notes related to upgrading older versions of the software to PME
2021.

For upgrades from all supported versions:


• VIP Modbus Master functionality removed during upgrade

• VIP Modbus Slave functionality now requires a Data Exchange Module license

• Upgrading systems with Event Notification Module configurations

For upgrades from versions older than PME 2020:


• Upgrades from PME 8.1, 8.0, and 7.2.2

• Reporter (RepGen) database login removed during upgrade

• Tables not migrated to new table gadget in Dashboards

• PQ Advisor has changed to PQ Performance and needs some manual post upgrade steps

• Install a security certificate for TLS 1.2

1532 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Upgrades from all supported versions


VIP Modbus Master functionality removed during upgrade
The Modbus Master feature in the VIP was removed in PME 2020.

If your existing system contains VIP frameworks with Modbus Import or Modbus Export modules,
then these modules will be removed automatically during the upgrade. At the same time, information
on configuration settings of these modules and links to other ION modules in the framework is
captured. You can use this information to configure replacement functionality in the new, upgraded
system. For details on the removal of this feature during upgrade and the information captured, see
knowledge base article FA382887.

NOTE: Only the Modbus Import and Modbus Export modules are removed from VIP frameworks
during upgrade. Other modules in the framework remain unchanged.

NOTE: ION modules that have input or setup registers linked to the Modbus Import and Modbus
Export modules will not be functional after the removal of these modules on upgrade. You need to
review the configuration and links of these modules, after the upgrade, and manually put them
back online.

NOTE: Any links from an affected VIP framework to other parts of the system, for example links to
another VIP, remain unchanged during the module deletion process. That means the functionality
provided by those other parts might no longer work as expected. You need to review any linked
functionality, after the upgrade, and make manual updates as required.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Before installing the upgrade, verify that the system is not performing critical control actions
that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system operation after the upgrade.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Before installing the upgrade, verify that the system data results are not used for critical
decision making that may affect human or equipment safety.
• Verify correct system data results after the upgrade.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1533


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: After the upgrade and before putting the system into service, review any VIP frameworks
that might have had Modbus Import or Modbus Export modules removed during upgrade. Consider
any automated system controls or third-party interactions that might be affected by the module
removal. Make any configuration changes necessary for your system to operate as expected. Do
not put your PME system back into service until you have confirmed its correct operation.

VIP Modbus Slave functionality now requires a Data Exchange Module license
The Modbus Slave functionality in the VIP requires a valid Data Exchange Module license to be
functional from PME 2020. You must activate this license in PME before you can use the Modbus
Slave functionality.

NOTE: On system upgrade, the Modbus Slave functionality will be disabled, if this license has not
been activated. In that case, PME will periodically log high priority events to the system log as a
reminder that the Modbus Slave functionality is disabled due to insufficient licensing.

Upgrading systems with Event Notification Module configurations


The Event Notification Module (ENM) was redesigned in PME 2020. It is now seamlessly integrated
with PME. Notifications are triggered based on alarm views. The module supports SMS and email
notification and you can schedule notification activities.

When you upgrade a pre-PME 2020 system with an existing ENM configuration, this configuration
will continue to work after the upgrade. In addition, the new ENM functionality will also be available
after the upgrade.

For upgrades from versions older than PME 2020:


Upgrades from PME 8.1, 8.0, and 7.2.2
PME 8.1, 8.0, and 7.2.2 systems cannot be upgraded using the PME 2021 installer. To upgrade a
PME 8.1, 8.0, or 7.2.2 system, use the Configuration Manager 2021 tool.

High level upgrade steps:

1. Use Configuration Manager 2021 to archive the configuration of the existing PME 8.1, 8.0, or
7.2.2 system.

2. Uninstall PME 8.1, 8.0, or 7.2.2.

3. Install PME 2021.

NOTE: Install PME 2021 in a different path than PME 8.1, 8.0, or 7.2.2 to avoid potential
conflicts with leftover files from the 8.1, 8.0, or 7.2.2 install.

4. Use Configuration Manager 2021 to write the archived configuration of the old system to the
new PME 2021.

See Configuration Manager for information on this tool. Download the Configuration Manager 2021
from the Schneider Electric Exchange. See Resources for link information. See Upgrade version
support for general upgrade support information.

Reporter (RepGen) database login removed during upgrade

NOTE: Only for upgrades from versions older than PME 9.0.

1534 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Reporter, the Excel based reporting feature, was removed in PME 9.0.

For In-Place upgrades of older PME versions, which includes Reporter, the Reporter functionality is
left in place during the upgrade, but the SQL login account used by Reporter to access data in the
database, is removed. This is done for security reasons.

If you want to continue to use Reporter on an upgraded PME 2021 system, you need to create a
new SQL login account for Reporter and then update the reports with the new account information.

To enable Reporter for an upgraded system:

1. Open Microsoft SQL Server Management Studio (SSMS) on the PME database server
computer.

2. Create a new login with the Login name Report and SQL Server Authentication.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices for password creation and management.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access - such as least privilege,
separation of duties - vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to
ensure that user access adheres to the site-specific cybersecurity policies.

3. Run the following SQL scripts on the ION_Data and ION_Networks databases:
EXEC sp_change_users_login 'Auto_Fix', 'Report'

This re-attaches the login with the users.

4. Update the password information in the Excel reports:


a. On the PME Application server, navigate to ...Power Monitoring
Expert\config\reports and back up the Excel reports that are in this folder and that
you want to update the password for.

b. For each report in the ...Power Monitoring Expert\config\reports folder,


Open the file.

Right-click a sheet tab and click Unhide in the context menu.

In the Unhide sheet box, select |PRIVATE|Datasheets and then click OK.

Scroll to the right of the file and update the PASSWORD value to match that of the
Report SQL Server account.

Verify that the server name (column Y) and the database instance name (column Z)
are correct.

Right-click the PRIVATE|Datasheets tab and click Hide in the context menu.

Save and close the Excel report file.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1535


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury,


equipment damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-
specific cybersecurity policies.

Tables not migrated to new table gadget in Dashboards

NOTE: Only for upgrades from versions older than PME 9.0.

The Tables Web application was removed in PME9.0. Use the table gadget in Dashboards instead,
to setup real-time data displays.

Saved Tables are not migrated to the new table gadgets automatically during the upgrade. You need
to manually recreate the tables in Dashboards, using the table gadget, after the upgrade.

PQ Advisor has changed to PQ Performance and needs some manual post upgrade steps

NOTE: Only for upgrades from versions older than PME 9.0.

The PQ Advisor software module was renamed to PQ Performance in PME 9.0. As part of this
name change, the VIP framework for PQ Performance was updated. If you are using the PQ
Performance module, then we recommend that you update the framework on your system after the
PME upgrade. To do this, delete the existing PQ Advisor framework in the VIP, paste in the new
framework, and check the Vista diagram links to the VIP framework. See Configure Power Quality
Indicator Diagrams for information on pasting the framework.

If you created a custom tab in the Web Applications of the old system for PQ Advisor, you need to
recreate this tab manually in the new system. The procedure for creating custom tabs changed in
PME 9.0. See (Optional) Create a Power Quality Performance link in the Web Applications for
details.

NOTE: The PQ Performance VIP still uses the old VIP.PQADVISOR name.

Install a security certificate for TLS 1.2

NOTE: Only for upgrades from versions older than PME 9.0.

See Install a security certificate for TLS 1.2 in the Install section of this guide for details.

1536 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

PME release history


The following table lists the major releases of PME. Service pack and hot fix releases are not
included in this list.

PME Name and Version Year of release


Power Monitoring Expert 2021 2021
Power Monitoring Expert 2020 2019
Power Monitoring Expert 9.0 2018
Power Monitoring Expert 8.0 2015
Power Monitoring Expert 7.2 2013
StruxureWare Power Monitoring 7.0 2012
ION Enterprise 6.0 2009
ION Enterprise 5.6 2007
ION Enterprise 5.5 2004
ION Enterprise 5.0 2003
ION Enterprise 4.5 2002
ION Enterprise 4.0 2002
ION Enterprise 3.0 2001

The following table shows the support status for recent PME releases.

Release Year Status Support Timeline


(*) Full Support will end on December 31, 2023
PME 2021 2021 Full Support
(**) Limited Support will end on December 31, 2025
Full Support will end on December 31, 2022
PME 2020 2019 Full Support
Limited Support will end on December 31, 2024
Full Support will end on December 31, 2021
PME 9.0 2018 Full Support
Limited Support will end on December 31, 2023
Full Support ended on December 31, 2020
PME 8.2 2017 Limited Support
Limited Support will end on December 31, 2022
Full Support ended on December 31, 2019
PME 8.1 2016 Limited Support
Limited Support will end on December 31, 2021
PME 8.0 and 1992 - Full and Limited Support ended. Recommended to
Mature
earlier 2015 upgrade to latest release.

(*) Full Support:

• Technical investigation and assistance for issues, including creation of critical hotfixes where
deemed necessary by the factory.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1537


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

(**) Limited Support:

• Answering technical questions.

• Providing workarounds and fixes for known problems, when possible. No hotfixes for new
issues.

• Providing information on migration to a newer product release with Full Support.

1538 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Configuration Manager
This section contains reference information related to the Configuration Manager tool.

TIP: See Resources for information on where to get the Configuration Manager tool.

Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

About
Version History
Glossary
Configuration Manager User Interface
Writing to a Customized PME System
Reconfigure fails after Write to System
Save to archive fails because of insufficient SQL Server service account permissions
Configuration Manager 2021 release notes

About
This program is protected by copyright law and international treaties. Unauthorized reproduction or
distribution of this program, or any portion of it, may result in severe civil and criminal penalties, and
will be prosecuted to the maximum extent possible under the law.

Configuration Manager
Version 2021
Language: English
Release date: May 2021

Copyright © 2014-21 Schneider Electric.

Version History
The following information lists the changes that were introduced in each tool release:

Release 6
Release name: Power Monitoring Expert - Configuration Manager 2020

Release date: Nov 2019

NOTE: Archived configurations saved with an earlier version of the Configuration Manager are not
compatible with this release of the tool.
(Exception: PME 8.1 archives created with Configuration Manager 2.0.1 can be loaded and
written.)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1539


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

System support

Server or Machine Version


PME 7.2.2
PME 8.2
Source
PME 9.0
PME 2020
Target PME 2020

NOTE: Upgrades and migrations between different architectures are also supported (Standalone -
> Distributed Database, Distributed Database-> Standalone)

New features

• Support for upgrades and migrations between different architectures.

Release 5
Release name: Power Monitoring Expert - Configuration Manager 9.0

Release date: Aug 2018

NOTE: Archived configurations saved with an earlier version of the Configuration Manager are not
compatible with this release of the tool.
(Exception: PME 8.1 archives created with Configuration Manager 2.0.1 can be loaded and
written.)

System support

Server or Machine Version


PME 7.2.2
Source PME 8.2
PME 9.0
Target PME 9.0

NOTE: Only upgrades and migrations within the same architecture are supported (Standalone ->
Standalone, Distributed Database -> Distributed Database)

New features

• Support for all PME Editions.

• Support for all localized versions of PME.

Release 4
Release name: Power Monitoring Expert - Configuration Manager 2.1.0

Release date: April 2017

1540 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

NOTE: Archived configurations saved with an earlier version of the Configuration Manager are not
compatible with this release of the tool.

System support

Server or Machine Version


ION Enterprise 6.0.1
Source PME 7.2.2
PME 8.2
Target PME 8.2

NOTE: Only Standalone system architectures are supported, except for ION Enterprise 6.0.1
Distributed Database systems, which can be upgraded to PME 8.2 Distributed Database.

Release 3
Release name: Power Monitoring Expert - Configuration Manager 2.0.0

Release date: August 2016

NOTE: Archived configurations saved with an earlier version of the Configuration Manager are not
compatible with this release of the tool.

System support

Server or Machine Version


ION Enterprise 6.0.1
Source PME 7.2.2
PME 8.1
Target PME 8.1

NOTE: Only Standalone system architectures are supported.

New features

• Support for migrating historical data.

• Support for more configurable items.

Release 2
Release name: Power Monitoring Expert - Configuration Manager 1.1.0

Release date: April 2015

NOTE: Archived configurations saved with an earlier version of the Configuration Manager are not
compatible with this release of the tool.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1541


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

System support

Server or Machine Version


Source PME 7.2.2
Target PME 7.2.2

NOTE: Only Standalone system architectures are supported.

New features

• Adding Notes to a Configuration.

• Adding Attachments to a Configuration.

• Save to Archive warns you when free disc space is low.

Improvements

General

• Archive file path and name length can be any length; it is no longer restricted to 256 characters.

• Improved error messaging.

• ETL sources are read, saved, and written as historical sources.

• WebReach Start-up diagrams and Vista start-up diagrams are now supported.

• A hierarchy is always written to the target system, even if it contains broken device references.

User Interface

• Improved messaging and workflows to indicate when services are stopped and restarted.

• Renamed the 'Diagrams' configuration component to 'Customized Diagrams' to better convey


that the tool reads and writes new and edited diagrams only.

• Improved tool workflows when operations are completed or canceled.

• The Configuration Manager now displays the Report Subscription's description field:

• Log pane – Added more detail to log messages and improved log message wording.

• Log pane – Changed the default initial sort to show newest log messages first.

Reports

• Reports that were deleted from Custom Report Packs are no longer imported into the target
system.

• Default report sharing is supported.

Release 1 
Initial release.

Release name: Power Monitoring Expert - Configuration Manager 1.0.0

Release date: November 2014

1542 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

System support

Server or Machine Version


Source PME 7.2.2
Target PME 7.2.2

NOTE: Only Standalone system architectures are supported.

Glossary
The following is an alphabetical list of terms and definitions that are commonly used within the
context of using Configuration Manager.

Term Definition
A computer in a distributed PME system that is running all of the
Application Server PME applications and services. See Distributed System for more
details.
A portion of a configuration. For example: Components vary from
Component
version to version.
Configuration See "PME configuration."
Computer in a distributed PME system that is running the SQL
Database Server database server software and the PME databases. See “Distributed
System” for more details.
DB SQL Server Database System
Device A meter or a point of data collection.
PME installation where parts of the system are installed on different
computers. Different combinations are possible but the most
common is the separation of the PME applications and the
Database server onto different computers.

For example, a simple distributed install would have all the PME
relevant programs and services installed on one computer and SQL
Distributed System Server with the PME databases installed on a second computer. In
this case, the computer running the applications is called
“Application Server” and the computer running SQL Server is called
“Database Server.”

A distributed system can also have “Web Client” computers that are
running web browsers to view the PME web applications like
Dashboard, Alarm Viewer, and Reporter inside the Web framework.
DC Data Center
ENM Event Notification Module
Factory installed system A default PME system that contains no customizations.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1543


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Term Definition
HC Healthcare
HDD Hard disk drive
Historical, timestamped measurement and alarm or event
information that is logged in the database. This information is
gathered during the operation of the system, for example by
ION data
monitoring devices. Examples include 15 interval logs of
Volts/Amps/Power, waveform recordings, and event log entries.
This information is domain-specific and independent from PME.
IIS Internet Information Services
OS Operating System
Information that determines the behavior of a PME system as well
as its look and feel. This information is stored in the software in
various places such as the database, the Windows registry, the file
system, and configuration files. Configuration information is part of
PME configuration the factory install and can be modified or added to during the
commissioning phase and throughout the lifetime of the software.
Configuration information includes settings that are persistent and
determine the state of the software. For example, enable or disable,
boundary conditions, and so on.
A configuration scenario where a field engineer configures a PME
system on a physical computer or Virtual Machine in their office.
After the system has been completely deployed, the configuration is
Off-site configuration exported to a portable archive using the Configuration Manager. The
field engineer then visits the customer site and - using the same tool
- imports the configuration from the archive into the target PME
system that was installed at the client site.
RESL Knowledge base Article - referenced by its RESL number
SSDT SQL Server Data Tools
SSMS SQL Server Management Studio
Single computer running all parts of a PME system. See
Standalone Server
“Standalone System” for more details.
PME installation where all parts of the system are installed on the
same computer, that is all PME applications and services, the SQL
database server, and the PME databases are on a single computer.
Standalone System This single computer is then referred to as “Standalone Server”.

A standalone system can also have “Web Client” computers which


are running web browsers to view the PME web applications like
Dashboard, Alarms, and Web Applications component.
VM Virtual Machine (as compared to a physical computer).

1544 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Term Definition
Computer in a PME system that is running a Web browser to view
Web Client the Web-based Dashboards, applications like Dashboard, Alarm
Viewer, and Reporter in the Web framework.

Configuration Manager User Interface


The topics in this section describe the controls and options available in the Configuration Manager
user interface.

The topics in this section describe the controls and options available in the Configuration Manager
user interface.

Operation toolbar:

Read from System – Reads a PME configuration.

Save to Archive – Saves a read configuration to an archive file.

Load from Archive – Loads an archive of a previously saved configuration.

Write to System – Replaces the system configuration with the archived configuration.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1545


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuration and operation information tabs:

Content – Displays configurations.

Notes – Displays configuration notes.

Attachments – Displays configuration attachments.

Log – Displays messages that are generated by the Configuration Manager when it
performs an operation.
Information pane:

Displays the detailed configuration information. Content displayed varies depending on


the information tab that is clicked.

Writing to a Customized PME System


Performing a Write to System (WtS) on a PME system that was previously customized could
negatively impact the system configuration.

Review the following information to understand how customized components are effected.

Component Tool Behavior Effect on System


The billing rates in the rate library can
Custom and modified default rate files
Billing Rates be different from the default install and
are not updated on the target system
different from the latest WtS archive.
Device type mappings to Vista
diagrams can be different from the
Additions to or customizations of the default install (effects the Generate
Device Types registry related to device type support Network Diagram feature). Additional
remain on the target system device type mappings to Vista
diagrams can exist that do not exist in
a default install.
EWS server remains configured and
active on the target system if it was
Custom and modified default EWS
EWS configured before. The configuration
files remain on the target system
can be different from the latest WtS
archive.
Custom and modified default The framework files can be different
ION Frameworks framework files remain on the target from the default install and different
system from the latest WtS archive.
The LogAquisitionControl file,
if it exists, will remain on the target
The loginserter configuration can be
system. Any modifications to the
Log Inserter different from the default install and
loginserter configuration file that were
different from the latest WtS archive.
done manually on the target system
will remain on the target system.

1546 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Component Tool Behavior Effect on System


It is possible that certain user
preferences for specific user
accounts are retained in these files.
Management MC configuration files remain on the The effect is that some user accounts
Console Options target system might see UX behavior in
Management Console that is different
from the default install and different
from the latest WtS archive.
The node diagram files on the target
Node diagram files remain on the
Node Diagrams system can be different from the
target system
latest WtS archive.
OPC server remains configured on
Custom and modified default OPC the target system if it was configured
OPC Server
files remain on the target system before. The configuration can be
different from the latest WtS archive.
Custom and modified PQDIF
The PQDIF files can be different from
PQDIF Exporter configuration and template files
the default install.
remain on the target system
The query server configuration can be
The query server configuration different from the default install, if
Query Server
remains on the target system they were manually edited after a prior
WtS.
The registry settings can be different
The registry settings remain on the
Registry from the default install, if they were
target system
manually edited after a prior WtS.
The scheduled tasks can be different
The scheduled tasks remain on the
Scheduled Tasks from the default install, if they were
target system
manually edited after a prior WtS.
VIPs can be present that are not part
Custom VIPs are not removed from of the default install or the
VIP
the target system configuration archive that is written to
the system.
The diagram and image files on the
Custom and modified default diagram
target system can be different from
Vista (Diagrams) and image files remain on the target
the default install and different from
system
the latest WtS archive.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1547


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Component Tool Behavior Effect on System


It is possible that certain user
preferences for specific user
accounts are retained in these files.
Vista configuration files remain on the
Vista (Settings) The effect is that some user accounts
target system
might see UX behavior in Vista that is
different from the default install and
different from the latest WtS archive.
Reports can be present in the system
Web Reporting that are not in PME by default. The
Custom report packs remain on the
(Custom Report reports can be non-functional if the
target system
Packs) latest WtS included an
ApplicationModules db.
Reports can be present in the system
Web Reporting that are not in PME by default. The
Custom report templates remain on
(Custom Report reports can be non-functional if the
the target system
Templates) latest WtS included an
ApplicationModules db.
The date range definitions on the
Web Reporting Custom date range definitions remain
target system can be different from
(Date Ranges) on the target system
the default install.
The Report-Logo.jpg file on the
Web Reporting The customized Report-Logo.jpg
target system can be different from
(Other) file remains on the target system
the default install.
Subscriptions can be present that are
Web Reporting Subscriptions are not removed from not part of the default install or the
(Subscriptions) the target system configuration archive that is written to
the system.
Historical data can be left over from
previous WtS or from system
ION_Data is not replaced if it is not
Historical operation. The data might be visible in
present in the source archive or if the
Database queries if the latest WtS includes
user chooses to exclude it in the WtS
devices with names that match
previous names with historical data.
Database archives can be present
Historical
Database archives are not removed that are not part of the default install or
Database
from the target system the configuration archive that is
Archives
written to the system.

Reconfigure fails after Write to System


Issue: The PME installer displays a "Could not complete all steps" message and indicates a fail on
the Secure User Passwords step.

1548 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Likely cause: The system key that was provided to the Configuration Manager during Write to
System is not the correct key for the source system archive.

Resolution: To correct this situation:

1. Exit the incomplete Reconfigure step.

2. Run the PME installer again and choose Export System Key. Save the system key in a
secure location. This key will be needed in step 4 below.

3. Run the PME installer again and choose Import System Key. Provide the correct source
system key. The installer will automatically run a reconfigure after importing the new key.

4. Run the PME installer a third time and choose Import System Key. Provide the original key
for this system from step 2 above. This will ensure that the target system has a unique key
that is different from the source system key.

Save to archive fails because of insufficient SQL Server service account


permissions
Issue: Configuration Manager does not save a configuration to archive and logs an error message in
the tool log. The message says that SQL Server has insufficient write permissions to the
destination folder.

Likely cause: As part of the save to archive, SQL Server creates backups of the PME databases.
The database backup files are saved to the destination folder under the security context of the SQL
Server service account. If SQL Server does not have write access to the destination folder, the
save to archive is not successful.

Resolution: Try saving the archive to a different location or edit the SQL Server service account
permissions and try saving to the same location again.

Configuration Manager 2021 release notes


The following information is specific to the 2021 release of the tool.

No release specific notes available.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1549


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuration References
This section contains reference information related to the content in the Configuring chapter of this
guide.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Topic Reference Links


Software Alarms UI
Software Alarms Add Alarm Rule UI
Schedules Configuration UI
Emergency Power Supply Systems
EPSS test
EPSS Transfer Time alarm
Backup Power Module
ION device frameworks for EPSS monitoring
Remote control of ATS Test mode
Supported measurements and devices
Breaker Performance
Supported devices
Module
Capacity Management Supported measurements and devices (Branch Circuit Power)
Module Supported Measurements and Devices (Other)
Styling a dashboard
Dashboards
Configuring Gadgets
Considerations for trimming archived data from ION_Data
Database maintenance task definitions
Default maintenance task settings
Database Maintenance
Using IONMaintenance for database maintenance tasks
Database maintenance account requirements
Setting up the ION_Data archive task for Distributed PME systems
Device Manager Device Manager user interface
Device Type Editor User Interface
Configuring Logging and Calculation User Interface
Modbus Data Formats
Device Type Editor
Modbus Register Properties
Measurement Tree
OPC Tags
Supported measurements and devices
Energy Analysis Reports
Terms and Definitions
Module
PUE Summary Report Calculations
Energy Billing Module Supported measurements and devices

1550 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Notification Manager user interface


Add Rule UI
Event Notification Module Add Recipient UI
Add Template UI
Notification delay example
Customizing the Web Applications links
General Adding idle detection to custom Web Application links
Configure database connection encryption
Insulation Monitoring
Supported measurements and devices
Module
Manual Data Editor Manual Data Editor user interface
OPC Tunneling of OPC data
Device Selection for Power Quality Performance monitoring
Power Quality Performance Supported Devices for Power Quality Performance monitoring
Module Power Factor Rate File Calculation
Required measurements for Power Quality Performance monitoring
Reports UPS Battery Health Report calculations
Add-on device drivers for PME
Advanced ETL Configuration References
Configuring the PME EWS server for HTTPS
Deploying and configuring a Multi-input Setpoint Display Bar
graphic component
System Integration - Deploying and configuring a Single-input Thermometer graphic
PME/EBO component
Exposing custom device driver measurements through EWS
Manual integration steps without using the web application
Integration Utility settings
Terms and definitions
Web security changes
Trends Configuring a trend
User Manager user interface
User Manager
Default User Access Level Privileges
VIP Setup VIP Modbus Slave port settings
Web Application Settings System and personal localization settings

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1551


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Software Alarms references


This section contains reference information related to Software Alarms.
Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Software Alarms UI
Add Alarm Rule UI
Schedules Configuration UI

1552 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Software Alarms UI
Main UI and Alarm Rules tab

Main UI

Selection tabs
1
Select a tab to see information related to Alarm Rules, Schedules, or Source View.
Help
2
Click Help to open the Software Alarms online help.
Number of displayed items
7
Shows the number of items visible on this page, and the total number in this View.
Page selector
8 Use the page selector to navigate between pages. Set the number of items that are displayed
on a page.

Alarm Rules tab

Add Alarm Rule


3
Use Add Alarm Rule to create a new Alarm Rule.
Alarm Rules table
4
The Alarm Rules table shows all the Alarm Rules that are configured in the system.
Enable Alarm Rule
Each Alarm Rule can be enabled or disabled separately. The Enable Alarm Rule slider shows
5
the enable state of the Alarm Rules. Click the slider for an Alarm Rule to enable or disable this
Rule.
Alarm Rules options
6
Use Alarm Rules options to duplicate, edit, or delete Alarm Rules.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1553


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Schedules UI

Add Schedule
1
Use Add Schedule to create a new Schedule.
Schedules table
2
The Schedules table shows all the Schedules that are configured in the system.
Schedules options
3
Use Schedules options to duplicate, edit, or delete Schedules.

Source View UI

Source View Alarm Rules table


1 The table shows an alternate view of the Alarm Rules. Use this view to see which Alarms are
configured for which sources.
Show Alarm Rule
2 When you click Show Alarm Rule for a row in the Source View table, the Alarm Rules tab
opens with the specific Alarm Rule highlighted.

1554 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Add Alarm Rule UI


Alarm Templates

Alarm Template Search


1
Type a search string into the search box to find the alarm template you are looking for.
Alarm Template groups
2
The available alarm templates are grouped by application.
Alarm Template list
3
A list of alarm templates that are available in the selected group.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1555


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Measurement Selection UI

Measurement Selection with recommended measurements

Measurement Selection without recommended measurements

1556 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Alarm Rule Details UI

Real-time Alarms UI

(The above is one example of a Real-time Alarm. The configuration options may vary for other Real-
time Alarms.)

Alarm Name
1 The Alarm Name is the identifier for this alarm in the system. It is used as a reference by other
applications.
Input Evaluation
2 The Input Evaluation setting determines how often the Alarm evaluates the input measurement
value.
Active Condition
3
The Active Condition settings determine when the Alarm goes into an Active state.
Inactive Condition
4
The Inactive Condition settings determine when the Alarm goes into an Inactive state.
Advanced Settings
5 The Advanced Settings determine which priority value is assigned to the Alarm and if the
extreme measurement value that occurs during the Alarm active state is logged.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1557


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Logged Data Alarms UI (Fixed Setpoint)

(The above is one example of a fixed setpoint logged data Alarm. The configuration options may
vary for other fixed setpoint logged data Alarms)

Alarm Name
1 The Alarm Name is the identifier for the Alarm in the system. It is used by as a reference by
other applications.
Input Evaluation
The Input Evaluation setting determines how the Alarm evaluates the input measurement
value. The following options are available:

1 minute
5 minutes
In this configuration, the Alarm evaluates the logged
10 minutes
Datalog measurement value as it was logged at the specified
15 minutes
2 time intervals.
30 minutes
1hr
In this configuration, the Alarm evaluates the logged
measurements as rolled up values. The interval is
Hourly either Hourly or Daily. The roll up method is defined
Aggregated
Daily by the measurement type. For example, energy
measurements are accumulated and demand
measurements are averaged.
Active Condition
3
The Active Condition settings determine when the Alarm goes into an Active state.
Inactive Condition
4
The Inactive Condition settings determine when the Alarm goes into an Inactive state.

1558 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Advanced Settings
5 The Advanced Settings determine which priority value is assigned to the Alarm and if the
extreme measurement value that occurs during the Alarm active state is logged.

Logged Data Alarms UI (Smart Setpoint)

(The above is one example of a smart setpoint logged data Alarm. The configuration options may
vary for other smart setpoint logged data Alarms)

Alarm Name
1 The Alarm Name is the identifier for the Alarm in the system. It is used by as a reference by
other applications.
Active Condition
2
The Active Condition settings determine when the Alarm goes into an Active state.
Inactive Condition
3
The Inactive Condition settings determine when the Alarm goes into an Inactive state.
Advanced Settings
4 The Advanced Settings determine which priority value is assigned to the Alarm and if the
extreme measurement value that occurs during the Alarm active state is logged.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1559


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Smart Setpoint

A Smart Setpoint evaluates the input measurement against statistical and historical behavior of
that same input measurement. The following pre-defined settings are available:

Highest Value in last 30 days Abnormally High Value


Lowest Value in last 30 Days Abnormally Low Value
Highest Value in last Year Abnormally High Value for similar time of day
Daily Value above 50% of Average Abnormally High Value for the day of week

You can also define a custom rule for evaluating the input based on the options provided in the
Smart Setpoint configuration window.

Schedule Selection UI

1560 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Schedule Selector
1 Select which Schedule you want to use for this Alarm Rule. Using a Schedule is optional.
Select None if you don't want to use a Schedule.
Schedule Options
2
Use these options to edit a selected Schedule or to Add a new Schedule.

Summary UI

Enable Alarm Rule


1 The Enable Alarm Rule slider shows the enable state of the Alarm Rule. Click the slider to
enable or disable this Rule.
Alarm Status Measurement Mappings
By default, real-time Alarm Status measurements are disabled, which means that information
about the state of the Alarm is only available through the Alarms application. Enable real-time
2 Alarm Status measurements if you want to access Alarm state information in Diagrams,
Trends, or other real-time applications in PME.

NOTE: These status measurements are not currently available in the VIP/Designer.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1561


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Schedules Configuration UI

Schedule Name
1
Provide a name for the schedule.
Schedule Preview
2
The graphic shows the time periods for which the schedule will be active and inactive.
Schedule Configuration
Add rows to define the Start Times, End Times, and days of the week when the schedule is
3
active.
Define if the schedule enables or disables the function that is controlled by it.

1562 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Backup Power Module references


This section contains reference information related to configuring the Backup Power Module.

Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Emergency Power Supply Systems


EPSS test
EPSS Transfer Time alarm
ION device frameworks for EPSS monitoring
Remote control of ATS Test mode
Supported measurements and devices

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1563


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Emergency Power Supply Systems


An Emergency Power Supply System (EPSS) in an arrangement of generators and automatic
transfer switches, designed to provide backup power in case of a utility power interruption. The
EPSS provides emergency electrical power to any facilities requiring continuous power,
uninterrupted power, such as hospitals and medical centers.

In many jurisdictions, hospitals and medical centers need to test their EPSS on a regular basis and
keep records of such tests. Hospitals and medical centers in the USA, for example, must meet the
standards specified by the Joint Commission on Accreditation of Hospital Organizations (JCAHO)
to operate their facilities. These standards include the testing of generator systems. These JCAHO
standards are derived from both National Fire Protection Association (NFPA) and National
Electrical Code (NEC) requirements.
Use the Backup Power Module to generate reports for government and organizational inspectors to
help determine if an EPSS is in an adequate state to generate electrical power during a utility
outage. These reports can demonstrate compliance not only with the JCAHO standards, but also
with the standards mandated by many other geographies, such as:

• National Electric Code Article 220.87 for the United States of America.

• HTM 0601 for the United Kingdom.

• AS/NZS 3009 for Australia and New Zealand.

• 60364-7-710 for Europe.

• CSA Z32 for Canada.

1564 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

EPSS test
The goal of an EPSS test is to confirm that the EPSS system can transfer the load from normal
supply to emergency supply in the specified amount of time. Normal supply could be utility power,
while emergency supply could be backup generator power.

To start a test, the Automatic Transfer Switch (ATS) is set into Test mode. This triggers a sequence
of events that start the generators and transfers the load to emergency supply. To end the test, the
ATS is set to Normal mode, which transfers the load back to normal supply and stops the
generators.

EPSS test performance is evaluated based on the time it takes to successfully transfer the load
after the start of the ATS test mode. Different standards define different acceptable transfer times
for EPSS systems. See Emergency Power Supply Systems for more information on standard
compliance.
The following diagram shows the test sequence of events. It shows the ATS status (Normal, Test,
Emergency), the generator status (Stop, Start, Running), and the status transitions that control the
logging of generator electrical (load) and engine data for EPSS reporting.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1565


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

EPSS Transfer Time alarm


The ATS and generator status changes trigger general Backup Power Asset Monitoring alarms in
PME, if the correct status labels are used. See Configure Generator Test EPSS for details. You can
also configure the system to show a Transfer Time Asset Monitoring alarm, including EPSS transfer
time details, for a test run or a real backup power supply incident. To set up such an alarm, you need
to create a setpoint on the device monitoring the ATS status that is triggered by the Test, Power
Outage, and Emergency status signals. The setpoint must use the label: Transfer Time for the
module name and the setpoint status output register.

The following shows an example ION framework to create a Transfer Time alarm in PME:

1566 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

ION device frameworks for EPSS monitoring


PME includes ION device framework templates for EPSS monitoring. These frameworks can be
used as a starting point for configuring ION devices to monitor EPSS generator and automatic
transfer switch (ATS) data. The frameworks are available in the PME install folder under
...\Power Monitoring Expert\config\fmwk\EPSS.

ATS monitoring framework


The ATS monitoring framework template, EPSS ATS.fwn, includes 3 digital input modules and a
data log module to monitor and record the Normal, Test, and Emergency ATS statuses.

Paste this framework into a compatible ION device and complete its configuration using the
information provided in Configure Generator Test EPSS. Extend the framework as needed, to add
additional, optional inputs such as ATS Power Outage.

NOTE: Use lock paste for all the digital input modules in the framework, and do not select
Maintain external inputs. See Pasting ION modules from the clipboard or a framework for
information on ION framework paste options.

NOTICE
UNINTENDED DEVICE OPERATION
Do not use the lock paste option to overwrite existing destination modules.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in operational differences in required


modules.

Only use the lock paste option if you are an advanced user familiar with ION architecture.

The framework creates a new folder on the ION device with the following modules:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1567


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Generator monitoring framework


The generator monitoring framework template, EPSS GEN.fwn, includes 3 digital input modules, 3
analog input modules, and 3 data log modules to monitor and record:

• The Stopped, Running, Starting generator statuses.

• The Engine Temperature, Exhaust Gas Temp Left/Right analog signals.

• The generator electrical data.

Paste this framework into a compatible ION device and complete its configuration using the
information provided in the framework and in Configure Generator Test EPSS. Extend the
framework as needed, to add additional, optional inputs such as the Emergency Power Source
Available signal, or Engine Oil Pressure measurements.

NOTE: Use lock paste for all the digital input and analog input modules in the framework, and do
not select Maintain external inputs. See Pasting ION modules from the clipboard or a framework
for information on ION framework paste options.

NOTICE
UNINTENDED DEVICE OPERATION
Do not use the lock paste option to overwrite existing destination modules.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in operational differences in required


modules.

Only use the lock paste option if you are an advanced user familiar with ION architecture.

The framework creates a new folder on the ION device with the following modules:

1568 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Remote control of ATS Test mode


To be able to remotely switch the ATS into Test mode, configure the monitoring device and PME as
follows:

Device configuration
Connect a device digital output to the ATS Test mode digital input. Configure the digital output on
the device for control by a Control Object in PME Vista.

WARNING
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Do not use the software or devices for critical control or protection applications where human
or equipment safety relies on the operation of the control action.
• Do not use the software to control time-critical functions.
• Do not use the software to control remote equipment without proper access control and status
feedback.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or equipment
damage.

PME Vista configuration


To setup remote control of the ATS Test mode:

1. In a Vista diagram, create a Vista Control Object and configure it to control the status of the
ATS Test mode digital output on the device.

2. Set the user access level on the Control Object to a level appropriate for your operations, for
example Operator (4). This is to prevent unauthorized users from triggering the Control
Object.

3. Set the Double-Click Action for the Control Object to Password confirmation. This is to
reduce the risk of accidental triggering of the Control Object.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

Work with facility IT System Administrators to ensure that the system adheres to the site-
specific cybersecurity policies.

4. In the Vista diagram with the Control Object, create a Status Object and link it to the ATS
status monitored by the device. This is to show the ATS status before and after triggering the
ATS Test mode Control Object in Vista.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1569


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Supported measurements and devices


The reports in the Backup Power Module support the measurements and devices listed in the
following table". For Generator Test EPPS Report related measurement and device information see
Generator Test EPSS Report measurements and devices (below).

Reports Input Measurements Suitable Devices


- Generator Status
Indicators:**
Stopped, Running Any device that can provide
Generator Activity Report
- Transfer Switch Status digital input measurements.
Indicators:
Normal, Test, Emergency
- Generator Status
Indicators:**
Stopped, Running

- Battery Voltage Signature


Generator Battery Health
(voltage signature is measured ION9000/7650/7550
Report/Export
as V4 waveform capture)*

- Digital signal from the


generator crank relay to trigger
the waveform capture
- Generator Status
Indicators:**
Stopped, Running
Generator Load Summary - Generator Electrical ION 9000/7650/7550, PM 8000
Report Measurements:
Vln avg; Vll avg; I avg; kW tot,
kVA tot, PF sign tot, Freq

MGE Galaxy 5500 UPS


- Critical Operation status Galaxy VM UPS
UPS Auto Test Report
reading from the UPS Galaxy VX UPS
Galaxy VS UPS
- Battery Voltage Signature
(voltage signature is measured
UPS Battery Health Report as V4 waveform capture)* ION9000/7650/7550
- Vln a of the UPS output, to
trigger the waveform capture

* A V4 input is required on the monitoring device.


** The monitoring devices must have digital inputs to measure these parameters.

1570 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Generator Test EPSS Report measurements and devices


The Generator Test EPSS Report requires specific generator and ATS data. Depending on the
EPSS configuration and type of equipment used, this data can be provided by one or more
monitoring devices, and the ATS itself.

The following table shows the monitoring device input requirements, per ATS and generator:

NOTE: ATS measurements are only required for EPSS reporting. For general generator test
reporting, ATS measurements are not required.

Measurement Type Channels/Msrmnts Comments


Three inputs for required
statuses (Normal, Test,
Emergency). One input for
optional status (Power
Outage).
ATS Status Digital Input(*) 3-4
NOTE: When one of the
ATS statuses changes, all
the ATS statuses must be
logged by the same device,
with the same timestamp.
Two inputs for required
statuses (Stopped,
Running). Two inputs for
optional status (Starting,
EPA).
Generator Status Digital Input 2-4 NOTE: When one of the
generator statuses
changes, all the generator
statuses must be logged by
the same device, with the
same timestamp.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1571


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Measurement Type Channels/Msrmnts Comments


Two inputs for required
measurements (Engine
Temp, Exhaust Temp). (**)
One or more inputs for
optional measurements (Oil
Pressure, Battery Voltage).
Generator Engine
Analog Input 2 or more NOTE: Engine data must
Data
be logged with a 1-minute
logging interval. Use the
generator Run signal to
start the logging and the
Stop signal to end the data
logging.
One power monitoring
device per ATS.

NOTE: Load data must be


3-Phase Power logged with a 1-minute
ATS Load Data System kW tot or kVA tot logging interval. Use the
Measurements(*) ATS Test and Emergency
signals to start the logging
and the Normal signal to
end the data logging.
One power monitoring
device per generator.
Vln a,b,c,avg; Vll NOTE: Electrical data must
3-Phase Power ab, bc,ca,avg be logged with a 1-minute
Generator Electrical
System I a,b,c,avg; kW tot; logging interval. Use the
Data
Measurements kVA tot; PF sign generator Run signal to
tot; Frequency start the logging and the
Stop signal to end the data
logging.

(*) The ASCO 4000 and ASCO 7000 ATS can provide logging of ATS status and load
measurements. These ATS types are natively supported in PME. Depending on the ATS
configuration, no external ATS status and load measurements might be required if these ATS types
are used.
(**) Generators with dual exhaust systems require 3 inputs (Engine Temp, Exhaust Gas Left,
Exhaust Gas Right).

You can use any monitoring device for this application that meets the measurement requirements
and that is supported in PME.
Below is a list of recommended devices:

• ION 9000/7650/7550, PM8000 (for electrical, status, and analog measurements)

• ION 7550RTU, SER 2408, SER 3200 (for status measurements only)

1572 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

• ASCO 4000/7000 ATS (as automatic transfer switch)

NOTE: The ASCO 4000 and ASCO 7000 ATS can provide logging of ATS status and load
measurements. These ATS types are natively supported in PME. Depending on the ATS
configuration, no external ATS status and load measurements might be required if these ATS
types are used.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1573


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Breaker Performance Module references


This section contains reference information related to configuring the Breaker Performance Module.

Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Supported devices

1574 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Supported devices
The Breaker Performance reports automatically read the required measurements from the breaker
control units. No measurement selection or configuration is required. Not all control unit types
support all the measurements shown in the report. Unsupported measurement data is shown as
"N/A" in the report.

The Breaker Aging Report and Vista diagrams supports the following device types:

Standard /
Circuit Breaker Range Control Unit Range
Country
• Micrologic 2 A/E/X/Xi

• Micrologic 5 A/E/P/H/X/Xi

• Masterpact MTZ 1/2/3 • Micrologic 6 A/E/P/H/X/Xi

• Masterpact NT • Micrologic 7 A/P/H/X/Xi

IEC • Masterpact NW • Micrologic 5.2/6.2/5.3/6.3 A/E


(Compact NSX)
• Compact NS630b-3200
• Micrologic 6.2/6.3 E-M (Compact
• Compact NSX
NSX)

• Micrologic 7.2/7.3 E (Compact


NSX)
• Micrologic 2 A/E/X/Xi
• Masterpact MTZ 1/2/3 • Micrologic 5 A/E/D/P/H/X/Xi
• Masterpact MT • Micrologic 6 A/E/D/P/H/X/Xi
• Masterpact NT for IEC and UL • Micrologic 7 A/P/H/X/Xi
standards
China • Micrologic 5.2/6.2/5.3/6.3 A/E
• Masterpact NW for IEC and (Compact NSX)
ANSI standards
• Micrologic 6.2/6.3 E-M (Compact
• Compact NS630b-1600 NSX)
• Compact NSX • Micrologic 7.2/7.3 E (Compact
NSX)
• Micrologic 2 A/X/Xi
• Masterpact MTZ 1/2/3
• Micrologic 3 A/X/Xi
• Masterpact NT for IEC, UL, and
• Micrologic 5 A/P/H/X/Xi
ANSI standards
• Micrologic 6 A/P/H/X/Xi
• Masterpact NW for IEC, UL, and
USA
ANSI standards • Micrologic 7 X/Xi

• Compact NS630b-3200 • Micrologic 5.2/6.2/5.3/6.3 A/E


(Compact NSX)
• PowerPact H-, J-, D-, and L-
Frame • Micrologic 7.2/7.3 E (Compact
NSX)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1575


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The Breaker Settings Report supports the following device types:

• Micrologic 2 A/E/X/Xi

• Micrologic 3 A/X/Xi

• Micrologic 5 A/E/P/H/X/Xi

• Micrologic 6 A/E/P/H/X/Xi

• Micrologic 7 A/P/H/X/Xi

• Micrologic 5.2 A/E (Compact NSX)

• Micrologic 6.2 A/E/E-M (Compact NSX)

• Micrologic 5.3 A/E (Compact NSX)

• Micrologic 6.3 A/E/E-M (Compact NSX)

• Micrologic 7.2 A/E (Compact NSX)

• Micrologic 7.3 A/E (Compact NSX)

NOTE: The IFE/IFM versions of the above device types are supported as well.

1576 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Capacity Management Module references


This section contains reference information related to configuring the Capacity Management
Module.

Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Supported measurements and devices (Branch Circuit Power Report)


Supported Measurements and Devices (Other Reports)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1577


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Supported measurements and devices


The Branch Circuit Power Report needs branch circuit level measurements. It supports the
measurements listed in the tables below. Only one measurement of each type (Demand, Current) is
required. If multiple types of the same measurement exist in the system, then a look-up method is
used to determine which one to use. The tables list the supported types in order of look-up priority.

NOTE: You can edit this list of measurements in the PME database.

Demand/Power

Measurement Unit ION Name ION Label


Active Power Sliding
Block Demand Active
kW Window Demand Delivered- Demand Real Power
Power
Received
Block Demand Active Active Power Sliding
kW kW sd del
Power Into The Load Window Demand Delivered
Active Power Mean kW Active Power Mean kW tot mean
Active Power kW Active Power kW tot

Current

Measurement Unit ION Name ION Label


Current Phase Average
Current Average Mean A I avg mean
Mean
Current Phase Average
Block Demand Current Avg
A Sliding Window Demand Amps Avg Dmd
Into the Load
Delivered
Current Avg A Current Phase Average Current Avg

The following devices can provide the measurements required for this report:

• BCPM-E

• PM5350 (multi-circuit mode)

1578 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Supported Measurements and Devices


The reports in the Capacity Management Module support the measurements and devices listed in
the tables below.

Reports Input Measurements Suitable Devices Notes


Active Power,
Equipment Capacity ION9000/7650/7550,
Apparent Power, or
Report PM8000
Current
The meter must
Generator Capacity Active Power or ION9000/7650/7550,
monitor the generator
Report Apparent Power PM8000
output.
The meter must
Generator Power Power (See details monitor the load the
ION9000/7650
Report below) generator is expected
to supply.
Transformers:
PM8000, Micrologic P,
PM5320

UPS:
- APC Symmetra MW
Energy and Power (*)
Power Losses Report
(see details below) - APC MGE UPS
Galaxy 5000,
- Galaxy VM UPS (*),
- Galaxy VX UPS (*)
- Galaxy VS UPS (*)
Or external metering
Power (see details
UPS Power Report APC Symmetra MW
below)

* If these UPS devices are used, the energy must be calculated and logged in the VIP. Most UPSs
measure both input and output power from which energy can be calculated in the VIP.

Power and Energy measurements

If multiple types of power and energy measurements exist in the system, then a look-up method is
used to determine which one to use. The following tables list the supported types in order of look-up
priority.

NOTE: You can edit this list of measurements in the PME database.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1579


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power

Measurement Unit ION Name ID ION Labels


Active Power Sliding
Block Demand Active kW demand, kW sd del,
kW Window Demand 116
Power Into The Load kW tot SD
Delivered
Demand Real Power –
Sliding, Demand Real
Active Power Sliding Power, Panel-Main
Block Demand Active
kW Window Demand 107 Demand Real Power,
Power
Delivered-Received kW sd del-rec, kW swd,
kW tot swd, kW Dmd
del-rec
Real Power Total mean,
Active Power Mean kW Active Power Mean 128 Active Power Total
mean, kW tot mean
kW tot, kW total, Real
Active Power kW Active Power 193 Power Total, Panel-
Main Real Power Total

NOTE: If you need to create a new device type for the UPS with the Device Type Editor, use the
ION Labels listed in the table for the measurement definitions. This ensures that the correct
measurements will be logged in the database.

Energy

Measurement Unit ION Name ION Label


Active Energy Into the Load kWh Active Energy Delivered Active Energy Delivered
Active Energy Delivered –
Active Energy kWh kWh del-rec
Received

1580 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Dashboards references
This section contains reference information related to configuring Dashboards.
Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Styling a dashboard
Configuring Gadgets

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1581


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Styling a dashboard
To add an image to a dashboard, change its background color, or modify the opacity setting for
gadgets on the dashboard:

1. Click Styling to open the Dashboard Styling dialog.

2. To use an image for the background of the dashboard:


a. Under Background Image, click Select... to open the Image Library.

b. Select an image in the Image Library and click OK.

You can add your own image to the Image Library by clicking Upload Image... to open
the Upload New Files dialog. Then either drag an image file to the area indicated in the
dialog or click Choose Files... and navigate to an image on your system. Click Finish to
add the image to the Image Library and then click OK after you select the image for the
background.

c. Choose how you want the image to fit from the drop-down list.

3. To use a background color for the dashboard:


a. Select Background Color to enable the color palette.

b. Click the down arrow to open the palette and select a predefined color or click the color
gradient to select a color.

4. To change the opacity setting for the gadgets on the dashboard:


a. Select one of the opacity percentages in the list under Gadget Style.

An opacity setting of 100% indicates that the gadget is not transparent – the background
color or image is not visible through the gadget. A setting of less than 100% results in the
gadget being partially transparent – the background color or image is partially visible in the
gadget.

5. Click OK to close the dialog and apply the settings.

1582 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Configuring Gadgets
The following table shows the different gadget types that are available in Power Monitoring Expert
(PME). Some of the gadgets are included in the base license, others require additional licensing.

Gadget Type Category Data Type Licensing


Gadget Type Category Data Type Licensing
Bar Chart Comparison Historical Base License
Energy Equivalency Comparison Historical Base License
Table Comparison Real-time Base License
Pie Chart Comparison Historical Base License
Period over Period Trend over Time Historical Base License
Trend Chart Trend over Time Historical Base License
Web Viewer Web Historical Base License
Energy Analysis
Sankey Usage Analysis Historical Dashboards Module
License
Energy Analysis
Pareto Chart Usage Analysis Historical Dashboards Module
License
Energy Analysis
Aggregated Pareto
Usage Analysis Historical Dashboards Module
Chart
License
Energy Analysis
Heat Map Usage Analysis Historical Dashboards Module
License
Energy Analysis
Consumption Ranking Usage Analysis Historical Dashboards Module
License
Energy Analysis
Aggregated
Usage Analysis Historical Dashboards Module
Consumption Ranking
License
Blank Space * Layout n/a Base License
Power Quality Incident PQ Performance
Power Quality Details Historical
Breakdown Module License
Power Quality Incident PQ Performance
Power Quality Details Historical
Impact Module License
Power Quality Incident PQ Performance
Power Quality Details Historical
Location Module License
Power Quality PQ Performance
Power Factor Impact Historical
Overview Module License

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1583


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Gadget Type Category Data Type Licensing


Power Factor Impact Power Quality PQ Performance
Historical
Trend Overview Module License
Power Quality PQ Performance
Power Quality Impact Historical
Overview Module License
Power Quality Impact Power Quality PQ Performance
Historical
Trend Overview Module License
Power Quality PQ Performance
Power Quality Rating Historical
Overview Module License
Power Quality Rating Power Quality PQ Performance
Historical
Trend Overview Module License

* The Blank Space gadget does not display any data and requires no configuration. The Blank
Space gadget is only visible during the dashboard Edit. By sizing and positioning this blank gadget,
you can change the location of the other gadgets to get the layout you want.

For information on the functionality of the different gadget types, see Gadgets. For information on
licensing, contact your Schneider Electric representative.

Prerequisites
The data for the gadgets must be available. Gadgets that depend on historical data need the correct
logged data in the database. Gadgets that depend on real-time data need the devices that provide
the data to be online and communicating.

The power quality gadgets are part of the Power Quality Performance module. Before you can use
these gadgets in a dashboard, you must first configure the Power Quality Performance module.
The following table shows the configuration that is required before you can use a power quality
gadget type:

Gadget Type Requirements


A rate must be defined in the Power Factor
Power Factor Impact Impact Rate file.
Power Factor Impact Trend A hierarchy view or a virtual meter must be
configured.

Power Quality Incident Breakdown


Power Quality Incident Impact Which devices to include/exclude for each
Power Quality Incident Location type of power quality event must be
Power Quality Rating configured.
Power Quality Rating Trend

An hourly rate for use in your production


Power Quality Impact
environment must be included in the Power
Power Quality Impact Trend
Quality Group configuration file.

1584 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Configuring
The Gadget Setup dialog opens each time you select a gadget to add to a dashboard. The dialog
leads you through a series of gadget configuration pages. The pages and the options are specific to
each gadget. For example, some gadgets require a data series consisting of sources and
measurements, while other gadgets have no such requirement. The exception is the Blank Space
gadget, which does not require any configuration. Its purpose is to help you position gadgets on the
dashboard by inserting a resizable transparent blank area.

Note that each page of the Gadget Setup dialog is represented by labeled tabs when you edit the
settings for an existing gadget. (See Editing a gadget for more information.)

The following tables indicates the gadget configuration pages that apply to each gadget, where "Y"
indicates that the page applies to that gadget, and "-" indicates that the page is not applicable.

General Data Viewing


Content Equivalency Image
Settings Series Period
Bar Chart Y - - - - Y
Energy
Y - Y Y Y Y
Equivalency
Pie Chart Y - Y - - Y
Web Viewer Y Y - - - -

General
Measurements Sources Layout Calculations Performance
Settings
Table Y Y Y Y Y Y

General Data Viewing Target


Axes
Settings Series Period Lines
Period over
Y Y Y Y Y
Period
Trend Chart Y Y Y Y Y

General Data Viewing Sankey Chart Pareto Chart


Settings Series Period Setup Setup
Sankey Y Y Y Y -
Pareto Chart Y Y Y - Y
Aggregated
Y Y Y - Y
Pareto Chart

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1585


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Heat
General Data Viewing Consumption
Map
Settings Series Period Ranking Setup
Setup
Heat Map Y Y Y Y -
Consumption Ranking Y Y Y - Y
Aggregated Consumption
Y Y Y - Y
Ranking

General PQ Viewing
Sources
Settings Group Period
Power Factor Impact Y Y - Y
Power Factor Impact Trend Y Y - Y
Power Quality Incident
Y Y - Y
Breakdown
Power Quality Incident Impact Y Y - Y
Power Quality Incident
Y Y - Y
Location
Power Quality Impact Y - Y Y
Power Quality Impact Trend Y - Y Y
Power Quality Rating Y Y - Y
Power Quality Rating Trend Y Y - Y

Configuration options

Axes

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Enter a label for the axes in the Title field under Left Axis or Right Axis. (Right Axis is not
applicable to the Period Over Period gadget.)

Axis titles only appear in the gadget if you have configured at least one measurement series
for the gadget.

2. For the Max Value for each axis, select Auto or Fixed for the data in the gadget. Auto is the
default for the maximum value, which is dependent on available data for the selected
measurement. If you select Fixed, enter the maximum value for the axis.

3. For Min Value for each axis, select Auto or Fixed for the data in the gadget. Fixed is the
default value of zero (0). You can enter a different minimum value. If you select Auto, the
minimum value is dependent on available data for the selected measurement and the
minimum value is automatically adjusted.

4. For Chart Type for each axis, select a type from the dropdown list. The default is Column for
the left axis, and Line with Markers for the right axis.

1586 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Calculations

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Enable Show Statistics Row to display a row at the bottom of the table. This row displays the
aggregated value of each column of data in the table. The aggregated value excludes the
statistics column (if enabled) and user defined calculated field (if enabled):
a. Select the Type of aggregation from the available choices in the dropdown menu to apply
to each column of data in the table.

b. Select the Highlighting Rule from the available choices in the dropdown menu to define
a threshold at which the values in the statistics row are highlighted. The threshold values
are highlighted in red. On selection of Under or Over, enter the value for the threshold.

2. Enable Show Statistics Column to display a column to the right of the table. This column
displays the aggregated value of each row of data in the table. The aggregated value excludes
the statistics row (if enabled):
a. Select the Type of aggregation from the available choices in the dropdown menu to apply
to each row of data in the table.

b. Select the Highlighting Rule from the available choices in the dropdown menu to define
a threshold at which the values in the statistics column are highlighted. The threshold
values are highlighted in red. On selection of Under or Over, enter the value for the
threshold.

3. Enable Highlight Regular Cells to highlight the values in the table as per the highlight rules:
a. Select the Highlighting Rule from the available choices in the dropdown menu to define
a threshold at which the values in the table are highlighted. The threshold values are
highlighted in red. On selection of Under or Over, enter the value for the threshold.

4. Enter the desired decimal places in Decimal Places to display in the values.

5. Enable Show User Defined Calculated Field to display a column to right of the table. This
column displays a calculated value as per the defined mathematical expression. The
calculation excludes the statistics row or column (if enabled):
a. Enter a label for the column header of the calculated measured column in the Calculated
Field Name field.

b. Enter the mathematical expression using the variables of Variable Reference Table in
the Formula field to calculate the values. Most of the mathematical expressions (+, -, * , /
, %, ^) can be used.

c. Select the Highlighting Rule from the available choices in the dropdown menu to define
a threshold at which the calculated values in the table are highlighted. The threshold
values are highlighted in red. On selection of Under or Over, enter the value for the
threshold.

d. Refer the Variable Reference Table which displays the variable name and the mapped
source or measurement names. The column name reflects the first column of the table.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1587


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Consumption Ranking Setup

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. For Bars Orientation:


a. Select Horizontal to display a horizontal bar chart.

b. Select Vertical to display a vertical column chart.

2. For Limit:
a. Select No Limit to display all the items.

b. Select Limit to to display the top or bottom items. Select the quantity of items to display.

3. For Sort Order:


a. Select Ascending to show the ranked columns in an ascending order from left to right.
The bars are displayed in an ascending order from top to bottom.

b. Select Descending to show the data in descending order.

4. Select Show Total to display the aggregated total consumption value of all sources above the
chart. Clear the check mark for Show Total to hide the display of the total value.

5. (Optional) Enter a Legend Name. The legend name is displayed below the chart.

Content

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Use the Source field to enter the URL for the website that you want to display.

The URL should start with http or https.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices to help prevent unauthorized access to the software.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

NOTE: When you configure the Web Viewer gadget to access a website, you should be
careful that the website does not include hidden malware, viruses, or content that could
compromise your web client computers. It is recommended that the target site specified in
the gadget be secured with the SSL or TLS protocol (accessed via HTTPS).

2. Use the Refresh Interval to indicate how often to refresh the content. The default of None
indicates that the web site is shown in real time.

3. The Width value indicates the display area within the gadget. The default width is 1,000 pixels
(px).

1588 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

4. Display provides 2 display options for the gadget:


a. Select Scroll the content to enable scrolling for content that exceeds the width or height
of the display area in the gadget.

b. Select Crop/Zoom the content to display a cropped region of the website. Adjust the
Offset X, Width, Offset Y, and Height for the crop values.

The default position is set to the top left corner of the gadget, as indicated by 0 for both the
Offset X and Offset Y positions. The default width is 1,000 pixels and the default height is
848 pixels.

It is recommended that the total of the pixel values for Offset X and Width do not exceed
the display width (1000 pixels).

5. Click Preview to view how the image will appear in the gadget.

Data Series

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Click Add to open the sources and measurements dialog.

2. Click a source name in the Sources area to select it.

By default, the sources are listed in alphabetical order. You can use the Search field to find
sources by name.

NOTE: For large systems with many sources, it takes longer to choose a source from the
source selector if you change the Grouping setting from its default value.

NOTE: For a Sankey Gadget select a hierarchy source. The gadget does not display data if
you select a source from the Devices list.

3. For a selected source, expand a measurement category, for example Energy, and click the
specific measurement you want to include, for example Real Energy Into the Load (kWh).

The measurements are listed in alphabetical order by measurement category. You can use the
Search Measurements field to find a specific measurement category or measurement.

Click Show Advanced to open options for filtering the measurements.

Select Display only Measurements with historical data to narrow the measurement
choices for the selected source.

NOTE: Smart Measurements are not available for gadget configuration.

4. Select Display Name to enter a name of your choice for gadget data purposes. (This is
recommended.)  By default, the name is a combination of the source and the measurement.
For example, for a device main_7650, group BldgA, and measurement Real Energy
Into the Load the display name appears as BldgA.main_7650 Real Energy Into
the Load.

5. Similarly, you can select Display Units and enter a unit of your choice.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1589


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

6. You can modify the following settings for each source measurement:
Series Style: select the color, line thickness, and how data is represented from the
available choices in the dropdown menus.

Axis: select Right Axis or Left Axis to chart the data series against the scale for the
selected measurement.

Multiplier: change the multiplier value to convert the data from its original unit to the
specified display unit. For example, convert the measurement unit from kWh to MWh by
using a multiplier of 0.001.

7. Click OK to close the dialog.

Equivalency

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Click Select Predefined Equivalency to open the Predefined Equivalencies dialog.

2. Select an item from the list of predefined equivalencies.

Default values are automatically entered in the fields on the Equivalency page.

3. You can change the default values as follows:


a. Enter the Multiplier from Wh value to convert from the watt-hour values into the
equivalent measurement.

b. Select the Decimal Places to display for the equivalent value.

c. Enter the Unit for the equivalency. For example, "miles", "kilometers", "lbs", "kg", and so
on.

d. Select Display After Value or Display Before Value to specify the position of the Unit
label.

e. Enter the Energy Equivalency Description to be displayed in the gadget.

General Settings

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Type a title for the gadget.

2. For Opacity, you can:


a. Leave the default option Use Dashboard Opacity selected.

The default opacity setting is controlled in the Dashboard Styling dialog and applies to all
gadgets included on the dashboard. This is the recommended setting.

b. Clear the check box for Use Dashboard Opacity to enable the settings for the gadget
and select one of the available percentages.

An opacity setting of 100% indicates that the gadget is not transparent – the background color
or image is not visible through the gadget. A setting of less than 100% results in the gadget
being partially transparent – the background color or image is partially visible in the gadget.
The effect of the setting varies depending on the gadget and the background image.

1590 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Heat Map Setup

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. For Colors:
a. Select Use fixed value color ranges to manually define the color gradients by entering
values into the boxes. Enter values based on the maximum expected consumption value
per interval.

b. If you clear the Use fixed value color ranges check box, then the gadget assigns colors
for the heat map automatically.

2. For Outliers, select Remove Outliers to exclude data values that exceed the Max
Threshold or fall below the Min Threshold. Define the threshold values by entering limit
values into the boxes.

3. For Heat Map Header:


a. Select Show Data Series Name to display data series name at the top of the Heat Map
chart.

b. Select Show Total to display a Total value at the top of the Heat Map chart.

4. For Data Gaps, select Clear last log after a data gap to exclude large interval values, that
are the result of data gaps, from the displayed data set.

Image

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Select an image to display on the gadget from the available images in the Image Library.

2. (Optional) Add an image to the Image Library by clicking Upload Image to open the Upload
New Files dialog. Then either drag an image file to the area indicated in the dialog or click
Choose Files and navigate to an image on your system. Click Finish to add the image to the
Image Library and then select it.

Layout

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Choose Sources or Measurements for the column headings in the table.

2. Set the Minimum Column Width for the columns in the table.

Measurements

Select specific measurements from the Measurement List or select a template of pre-defined
measurements.

Select specific measurements

1. Select one or more measurements in the Available Measurements area. The measurements
are added to the Selected Measurements list.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1591


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

(Optional) Click Show Advanced to filter the measurements list by Type or popularity
(Show).

Select predefined measurements

1. Click Select From Template to open the Predefined Measurements Templates dialog.

The dialog lists various templates that include specific measurements. The number of
measurements is identified in parentheses for each template name.

2. Select a template and click OK to add the measurements associated with the template to the
Selected Measurements area.

Pareto Chart Setup

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Set the level of the marker line on a scale of 0-100% by entering the Marker Position. For
example, for a marker line at 80%, enter a value of 80.

2. Select Show Total to include a Total value at the top of the Pareto chart.

3. Specify a Legend Name. This name will be shown as an axis label for the left y-axis in the
chart.

Performance

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Set the Update Interval for the data refresh in the table.

2. (Optional) Enable Simple Rendering to improve the display of large tables.

PQ Group

Depending on the scope of the data that you want to display in the gadget, select All Groups (if
there is more than one group in the list), or a specific group in the list. The group names that are
listed in the dialog are defined in the Power Quality Group configuration file, which is configured
during Power Quality Performance commissioning.

Sankey Chart Setup

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. For Hierarchy Depth Limit, select the depth of the Sankey diagram.

The depth is defined from the selected top node. Each bar in the diagram represents a level
and by reducing this number you can create diagrams focusing on the higher levels. There is
no limit to how many levels can be displayed.

2. For Display Mode:


a. Select Automatic to display the gadget to the best available layout.

b. Select Sort by name to sort each Sankey level nodes in ascending order by the node
label from top to bottom.

1592 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

c. Select Sort by value to sort each Sankey level nodes in descending order by the value
from top to bottom.

3. For Unaccounted Values:


a. Select Display unaccounted values as nodes to display the unaccounted values as
nodes.

b. Enter the Node Label.

4. For Options:
a. Select View Only Last Log.

Selecting this option overrides the Viewing Period selection. Instead of displaying data for
the selected viewing period, only the last available data log value for each node in the
hierarchy structure is used. This is useful for viewing the current state of the system, e.g.
Power, Voltage, Current.

b. Select Show Data Warning to display data warning messages.

c. Select Reverse Sankey Chart to reverse the chart from right to left.

5. For Font Size, select the font size of the nodes.

6. For Max Label Width, select the maximum label width of the node labels.

7. For Label Overflow:


a. Select Truncate long text to display the truncated text of the node labels.

b. Select Wrap long text to display the wrapped text of the node labels.

8. For Chart Size:


a. Select Manual to set the width and height. If you clear Manual selection, the chart size is
automatic.

b. Enter the Width and Height for manual chart.

Sources

NOTE: This gadget configuration page is applicable for Table gadget only.

Select the sources that you want to include in the table:

1. Select one or more sources in the Available Sources area. The sources are added to the
Selected Sources list.

(Optional) Use the Search Sources... field to find sources, click Show Advanced to filter the
source list by Type, or click Add All to select all sources.

2. Click a source in the Selected Sources area to remove it as selected.

(Optional) Click Remove All to remove all sources from the Selected Sources area.

Sources

NOTE: This gadget configuration page is applicable for all Power Quality Gadgets except Power
Quality Impact and Power Quality Impact Trend gadget.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1593


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

NOTE: The sources listed are dependent on the views you create in Hierarchy Manager and the
assigned user group. For Power Factor Impact and Power Factor Impact Trend gadgets, you must
select source. For other gadgets, the source selection is optional.

Select the sources that you want to include in the table:

1. Select one or more sources in the Available Sources area. The sources are added to the
Selected Sources list.

(Optional) Use the Search Sources... field to find sources or click Add All to select all
sources.

2. Click a source in the Selected Sources area to remove it as selected.

(Optional) Click Remove All to remove all sources from the Selected Sources area.

Target Lines

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Click Add Target Line to add target line input fields to the page.

Add additional target line input fields by clicking Add Target Line again.

2. Select Fixed Target or Per Day Target for Type to specify how the target line is applied.
a. Fixed Number is a value that applies in all date ranges.

b. Per Day Target is a value that is prorated for the time range that you specify. For
example, a per day target of 100 displays the target line at 100 if viewing By Day, at 3000
if viewing By Month, and at 700 if viewing By Week.

3. Enter a label to display in the chart for the target line and select the axis for the target line in the
respective fields.

4. Use the Color Selector to choose the color of the target line.

5. Click the Remove Target Line icon to delete it.

Viewing Period

Complete the options on this page as follows:

1. Select the time range for the data that is to be displayed in the gadget.

2. If aggregation options are available, select one of the available options.

The time range and aggregation settings are specific to the gadget that you select.

NOTE: For all Power Quality gadgets, except the Trend gadgets, the recommended viewing period
is This Month (for monitoring current data) or Last Month (for monitoring historical data). For the
Trend gadgets, the recommended viewing period is Last 12 Months with a By Month aggregation
period.

1594 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Database maintenance references


This section contains reference information related to database maintenance.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Database maintenance task definitions


Considerations for trimming archived data from ION_Data
Default maintenance task settings
Using IONMaintenance for database maintenance tasks
Database maintenance account requirements
Setting up the ION_Data archive task for Distributed PME systems

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1595


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Database maintenance task definitions


The following are high level definitions of PME relevant database maintenance tasks.

Archive
Database archiving copies older data from the operational database into a separate, new database.
The goal of archiving is to keep data safe for future reference. Data is typically archived based on
calendar time intervals, for example by month or by year.

The PME archive task creates a new archive database each time the task is run. Each new archive
database is attached to SQL server and is available to be accessed by PME.

NOTE: The PME archive task does not trim data from the operational database; it only makes a
copy of the archived data, leaving the original data in the operational database. See
Considerations for trimming archived data from ION_Data for important information on this topic.

Backup
Backing up a database creates a copy of the operational database. The goal of a backup is to have
an identical duplicate of the operational database that can be used to restore the system in case the
operational database becomes nonfunctional. Database backups should be created on a regular
basis, for example daily or weekly.

Maintenance
The PME database Maintenance task defragments the database and updates the database
statistics. The goal of these activities is to maintain database performance. Maintenance tasks
should be run on a regular basis, for example daily.

Size Notification
The size notification task is used to monitor the size of the database and to notify users when a
certain size threshold is reached. When the size threshold is reached, the task logs a system log
event message and triggers a Critical alarm in PME every time the task runs.

NOTE: The Size Notification task is only configured for systems using SQL Server Express,
which has a maximum database size limitation of 10 GB.

Trim
Trimming a database deletes data from the database. The goal of trimming is to prevent the
database from growing to a size that could affect system performance. Databases should be
trimmed on a regular basis, for example daily or weekly. For PME only the system log databases
are trimmed.

1596 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Considerations for trimming archived data from ION_Data


When archiving and then trimming data from the ION_Data database, you are moving this data from
the operational database into an archive store for long-term retention. This data is then no longer
available in the ION_Data database for analysis in PME. PME has very limited access to archived
data.
We recommend that you only trim archived data from the ION_Data operational database, when:

• It approaches its size limit, for example 10 GB for a SQL Server Express database.

• It reaches a size that impacts query performance.

• The database drive is low on available free space and you cannot switch to a larger drive.

When you trim data from an SQL database, the database file size remains unchanged. After the
trim, the database will first fill the new free space before growing the database file size again. To
reduce the database file size after trimming, Shrink the database, using standard SQL Server tools.

NOTE: The PME archive task does not trim the database; it only copies data to the archive.

Archive data access in PME:

Application Archive Data Access


Vista Yes
Can access either data from the operational database or from an
Reports
archive database but not both at the same time.
Dashboards No
Diagrams Yes
Trends No
Alarms No

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1597


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Default maintenance task settings


The default PME database maintenance tasks are defined as Windows PowerShell scripts, and
scheduled and executed using Task Scheduler in Windows. The following table shows the different
configuration settings for these tasks, their defaults, and where they are configured:

Setting Location Default Value Comments


Use IONMaintenance for Standalone systems.
Create a new, dedicated account for
Windows account User account that is
Task Scheduler Distributed systems. See create a Windows
used to run the task creating the task.
user account to run the maintenance tasks for
more details.
The default schedules are configured
See default task automatically for Standalone systems.
Task trigger times Task Scheduler
schedules. The schedules for Distributed systems must be
configured manually.
Task enabling or See default task
Task Scheduler n/a
disabling schedules.
Sets the folder to which the database backups
are saved. The backup script will create the
PowerShell script :
...\Power Monitoring following subfolders in this location:
Backup folder Configuration.ps1
Expert ...\Data for ION_Data
location Variable:
\Database\Backup* ...\Network for ION_Network
$locationForBackupFiles
...\SystemLog for ION_SystemLog
...\Applications for ApplicationModules
PowerShell script :
...\Power Monitoring
Archive folder Configuration.ps1 Sets the folder to which the database archives
Expert
location Variable: are saved.
\Database\Archive*
$locationForArchiveDBFiles
PowerShell script :
Data to keep when Configuration.ps1 Sets how many days' worth of data is left in the
30
trimming Variable: database after trimming.
$diagnosticsDaysToKeep
Sets the maximum database size. This value is
used by the size notification task to assess
PowerShell script :
what percentage of database space has been
Configuration.ps1
Database size used.
Variable: 9
(max)** The maximum size for a SQL Express
$maximumDatabaseSizeIn
database is 10GB. The maximum size in the
Gigabytes
script is set to 9GB to allow for a 1GB warning
buffer before the database stops logging data.
PowerShell script :
Configuration.ps1
Database size Sets the threshold for when a database size
Variable: 85
notification limit** notification will be issued.
$databaseSizeNotification
ThresholdPercentage

* Default setting for Standalone systems.


** The database size notification is only configured for systems with SQL Server Express
databases.

1598 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Using IONMaintenance for database maintenance tasks


IONMaintenance is a Windows user account that is created automatically when PME is installed in
a Standalone architecture. This account is used to run the pre-configured PME database
maintenance tasks in Task Scheduler in Windows. To make changes to the task schedules in Task
Scheduler, you need to enter the password for the IONMaintenance account. By default, the
password for the account is generated automatically by the installer and cannot be retrieved. To
have access to the password, you need to set a custom password for this account.

To set a custom password for IONMaintenance, run the PME installer in maintenance mode and
select Reset Accounts to start the account password reset procedure. Follow the installer
instructions to reset the password. See Installer system maintenance tasks for more information.

NOTE: If you set a custom password for the Windows Accounts during the installation of PME,
then this is the password used by IONMaintenance and you can use this password to make
changes to the task schedules in Task Scheduler.

NOTE: IONMaintenance shares the same password with IONUser, another account that is
generated automatically by the installer and which is used for report subscriptions.

NOTE: If you change the password for the Windows accounts, the password you are providing
must comply with the password policies of the Windows server and the SQL server. The software
installer cannot validate the password at the time you enter it. If the password is not valid, the
password reset and reconfiguration will not be successful. In that case, complete the
reconfiguration, skipping any unsuccessful steps. See Unsuccessful installation due to invalid
account passwords for information on how to repair the unsuccessful reset.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1599


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Database maintenance account requirements


PME uses Task Scheduler in Windows for the scheduling and execution of database maintenance
tasks. Task Scheduler requires a Windows account to run the tasks. In Standalone PME systems,
an account, IONMaintenance, is created by the installer and automatically assigned to the Task
Manager tasks. In Distributed PME systems you need to create an account manually. This account
must meet the following minimum requirements:
In Windows on the computer where the database server is installed, the account:

• must be a member of the Users group.

• must have the following Windows policy settings: Log on as a batch; Deny log on locally.

In SQL Server, the account:

• must have a public server role

• (for archive task only) must have a sysadmin server role

• must have the following role memberships for the PME databases (ION_Data, ION_Network,
ION_SystemLog, ApplicationModules):
db_backupoperator

db_ddladmin

Maintenance

public

NOTE: You will need the password for this account during the initial task setup, and later if you
want to edit the tasks in Task Manager in the future.

1600 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Setting up the ION_Data archive task for Distributed PME systems


Setting up the archive task for ION_Data is similar to setting up other database maintenance tasks
but requires some additional steps.

NOTE: It is best to automate the archive task, but you can also run it manually on demand using
Database Manager.

To set up the scheduled archive task for ION_Data:

1. Complete Steps 1 - 3 described in Setting up database maintenance tasks for Distributed


PME systems.

NOTE: You can use the same Windows user account (created in Step 1) that is used for
other scheduled PME database maintenance tasks to run the archive task. You can also
create a new account that is only used for the archive task, because only this task requires
sysadmin role privileges on the database server (see next step).

2. On the database server, open SQL Server Management Studio and add the sysadmin server
role to the Windows user account created in Step 1. This account is used to run the archive
task; it needs sysadmin permissions to create new archive databases.

3. On the database server, in the folder created in Step 3, create a subfolder called etc and inside
this folder a subfolder called Database, for example C:\PME_Database_
Maintenance\etc\Database.

4. Copy the Data folder from ...\Power Monitoring


Expert\system\etc\Database\, on the PME application server, into the new Database
folder on the database server.

5. On the database server, open Task Scheduler in Windows.

6. (Optional) In the Task Scheduler Library, create a new folder for the PME database
maintenance tasks, if it does not already exist. For example, Task Scheduler Library > Power
Monitoring Expert.

7. Create the scheduled archive task for ION_Data:


Name: [ION_Data] - ARCHIVE - Job
Security options: Set the Windows user account created in Step 1 to run the task.
Security options: Select Run whether user is logged on or not.
Trigger: Monthly at 01:00 (1:00 AM) on January 3rd
Action: Select Start a program.
Action: Program/script:
C:\Windows\syswow64\WindowsPowerShell\v1.0\powershell.exe
Action: Arguments: -noninteractive -nologo -file "<Folder
Path>\DbScheduledTasks\ArchiveDB.ps1" -DatabaseIdentifier ION

NOTE: The "<Folder Path>\DbScheduledTasks\ArchiveDB.ps1" path must be an absolute


path, not a relative path.

NOTE: The task name and trigger time shown above are recommendations. You can choose
a different name or trigger if necessary.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1601


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

8. (Optional) Manually run the archive task to verify its correct operation.

9. Close Task Scheduler.

To change the archive location, open the Configuration.ps1 script file, as described in Step 3
in Setting up database maintenance tasks for Distributed PME systems and change the value of the
variable:

Setting Variable Default Value Comments


Sets the folder to which the database archives
As defined in the are saved.
Archive folder
$locationForArchiveDBFiles script file; see Step NOTE: The Windows user account used to run
location
3-7. the archive task needs Read and Write
permissions on this folder.

1602 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Device Manager references


This section contains reference information related to Device Manager.

Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Device Manager user interface

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1603


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Device Manager user interface


Main user interface (UI) and Devices tab

Main UI

Selection tabs
1
Select a tab to see information related to Devices or Sites.
Help
2
Click Help to open the Device Manager online help.
Number of displayed items
10
Shows the number of items visible on this page, and the total number in the system.
Page selector
11 Use the page selector to navigate between pages of information. Set the number of items that
are displayed on a page.

Devices tab

Add Ethernet Device


Use Add Ethernet Device to add a new Ethernet device to the system. To add a Serial Device,
connected through an Ethernet gateway, or an OPC device, click the down arrow and select
3 the appropriate option from the drop-down menu.

NOTE: To add serial devices that are directly connected to the system, for example through a
RS485 converter, or to add Logical Devices, use Management Console.

Import
Use the import wizard to import device or site configuration into the system. You can import
4 configuration from a different system, from configuration tools, or edited configuration from the
same system. See Importing network configuration from a different system and Editing a
device, Editing a site for more details.

1604 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Devices filter
5 Use the devices filter to customize which devices are displayed in the devices table. You can
filter by Communication Status, Type, and Enabled State.
Search Devices box.
6
Enter a search string to find devices in the devices table.
Refresh
Click Refresh to update the table content and show changes to the device configuration that
might have been done through Management Console.
7
NOTE: The Communication Status indicator in the table is updated automatically every 10
seconds. To update the configuration information use Refresh.

Options menu
The Options menu contains the following options:
- Show/Hide Columns
- Clear Filter
8
- View Device Licenses
- Export Devices Configuration for Editing
- Export Network Configuration for Use in a Different System
- Refresh
Devices table
9 The devices table shows devices that are configured in the system. Which devices are
displayed in the table is controlled by the devices filter, see 5 above.

Sites tab

Add Ethernet Gateway


1 Use Add Ethernet Gateway to add a new Ethernet Gateway site to the system. To add an OPC
site, click the down arrow and select the appropriate option from the drop-down menu.
Import
Use the import wizard to import device or site configuration into the system. You can import
2 configuration from a different system, from configuration tools, or edited configuration from the
same system. See Importing network configuration from a different system and Editing a
device, Editing a site for more details.
Sites filter
3 Use the sites filter to customize which sites are displayed in the sites table. You can filter by
Communication Status, Type, and Enabled State.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1605


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Search Sites box.


4
Enter a search string to find sites in the sites table.
Refresh
Click Refresh to update the table content and show changes to the site configuration that might
have been done through Management Console.
5
NOTE: The Communication Status indicator in the table is updated automatically every 10
seconds. To update the configuration information use Refresh.

Options menu
The Options menu contains the following options:
- Show/Hide Columns
6 - Clear Filter
- Export Sites Configuration for Editing
- Export Network Configuration for Use in a Different System
- Refresh
Sites table
7 The sites table shows sites that are configured in the system. Which sites are displayed in the
table is controlled by the sites filter, see 3 above.

1606 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Device Type Editor references


This section contains reference information related to Device Type Editor.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Device Type Editor User Interface


Configuring Logging and Calculation User Interface
Modbus Data Formats
Modbus Register Properties
Measurement Tree
OPC Tags

Device Type Editor User Interface

Main user interface

Measurement Tree
A B String Register Details pane C Modbus/OPC Map pane
pane

Menu bar

Menu Options

New: Create a new Modbus or OPC device type.


Open: Open an existing device type.
Save: Save the current device type.
File
Save As: Save the current device type to a different location.
Export: Export the current device type as text file in csv format
Exit: Close the Device Type Editor.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1607


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Measurement Tree: Show or hide the Measurement Tree display


pane
Register Detail: Show or hide the String Register Details display
View pane
Register Map: Show or hide the Modbus Register Map display
pane. Show or hide the Enumerations, Address Blocks, Invalid
Addresses, and Device Info tabs.

Show or hide the Handle Exclusions, Transaction Configuration,


Advanced
Time Sync Info, and Plugin Info tabs.

Configure Software Logging: Open the Configure Logging and


Calculation tool
Expose OPC Measurements: Update the OPC measurement
Tools definition in the system
Clean Measurement Tree: Remove any unused managers,
modules, registers from the tree
Install Device Type: Open the Device Type Installer

Help Device Type Editor Help: Open the Device Type Editor help file.

Context Menus

Right-click on a manager, module, or register in the ION Tree to open a context menu. The context
menu provides access to the actions you can perform on the Measurement Tree, such as adding
and editing managers, modules, and registers.

Right-click anywhere inside the Modbus/OPC Map table to open a context menu. The context menu
provides access to the actions you can perform on the Map , such as inserting or deleting rows.

Right-click anywhere inside the Map table header row to open a context menu. The context menu
provides access to actions related to the table format, such as sorting of the table content or
showing or hiding table columns.

Configuring Logging and Calculation User Interface


Use the Configure Logging and Calculation utility to:

• Enable register logging, including setting log frequency.

• Enable low (minimum), high (maximum) and mean (average) calculations and logging.

• Configure stale data settings.

• Append downstream device information to labels.

NOTE: Only numeric output registers can be calculated and logged. All other types of registers (for
example, enumerated) do not appear on the Configure Logging and Calculation screen.

1608 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Screen overview

A Select this check box to make the downstream device columns appear
B Register area C Stale data link D Low area
E High area F Mean area G Help link
H Global register edit area. Use this area to globally edit all rows selected in the upper pane.

All the register information from the device type in the Device Type Editor is pre-populated in this
table when you open the application.

Show downstream device columns: Select this to show all the columns for selecting and setting
the downstream device properties for registers.

Register area: Use this area to individually configure registers.

Low area: Use this area to enable calculation and set logging of low values.

High area: Use this area to enable calculation and set logging of high values.

Mean area: Use this area to enable calculation and set logging of mean values.

Global register edit area: Use the bottom half of the screen to edit individual registers or multiple
registers, after selecting them in the list.

Help link: Click this link to open the Device Type Editor online help.

Stale data link (All): Click this link to open the Configure Stale Data Settings dialog.

Configuring register logging


To edit registers on an individual basis, select the row of the register and edit the cells in the row or
use the editing tools in the Global area.

To edit more than one register, select the rows you want to configure similarly and use the editing
tools in the Global area.

Log: Select to enable logging of the register.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1609


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Interval: This value determines the logging frequency for the register. Note that this value also
controls the reset interval for the min, max and averaging modules, even if these calculations are
not being logged. The valid range is 1 to 4,000,000 seconds.

Configuring Low, High and Mean Calculation and Logging


To edit the suffix used for Low, High and Mean, click on the applicable link. For example, if you
change the suffix to Maximum, VoltsA High becomes VoltsA Maximum.

Low

Select Calculate to enable calculation of low (minimum) values for this register. Select Log to
enable logging of this value. Note how the label is appended to reflect that this is the low value.

High

Select Calculate to enable calculation of high (maximum) values for this register. Select Log to
enable logging of this value. Note how the label is appended to reflect that this is the high value.

Mean

Select Calculate to enable calculation of mean (average) values for this register. Select Log to
enable logging of this value. Note how the label is appended to reflect that this is the mean value.

Configuring Stale Data settings


The “staleness” of data is measured from time data was last read from a physical device until the
current time.

Click the All (Stale Data) link to open the Configure Stale Data Settings dialog.

Mark data stale after: Enter the time you want to elapse before data from this register is marked
stale in the data recorder. The valid range is 0 to 7200 seconds.

When data is stale: Select how you want stale data values logged. The setting “log an empty row”
logs an empty row in the data recorder, while “use last known value” logs the last non-stale value in
the data recorder until the end of the current interval.

NOTE: Stale data settings are global (they apply to all registers) for a device type.

Configuring downstream device functionality


You must select the Show downstream device columns check box in the Configure Logging
and Calculation window before you can edit downstream device functionality.

Show downstream device columns: Select this check box to make the downstream device
columns appear.

Is Downstream Device: Select this checkbox to indicate the register belongs to a downstream
device.

Downstream Device Name: Enter the name of the downstream device in this field. The register
label is appended with this name. For example, if the device name is Meter01, the register label
becomes VoltsA@Meter01.

1610 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

NOTE: Using this option without also using the Include Name of Device Instance option causes
multiple devices to appear as a single device in your energy management system. Do not use this
option on its own unless only a single instance of this device is present in your system.

Include Name of Device Instance: Select this check box to append the actual device instance
name to the register label. The placeholder !!DeviceName!! is then added to the label — the name of
the actual device instance gets inserted when it is created.

For example, if the device instance is named Device01:

VoltsA@!!DeviceName!!Meter01

is replaced with

VoltsA@Device01Meter01

This allows for the creation of unique names within Power Monitoring Expert, as well as enabling
each device instance to appear in the product as multiple virtual devices.

For more information on downstream devices and naming conventions, see Downstream Device
Assistant

Saving and exiting


To exit the Configure Logging and Calculation screen:

• Click OK to save your settings.

• Click Cancel to exit without saving.

You are returned to the main Device Type Editor console screen.

Modbus Data Formats


Power Monitoring Expert supports the following data formats:

Format Type Description


A 16-bit signed value in 2-1 (or big ENDIAN) format. The high order
SINT16
byte is first, the low-order byte second.
A 16-bit unsigned value in 2-1 (or big ENDIAN) format. The high
UINT16
order byte is first, the low-order byte second.
A 32-bit signed value returned in two consecutive 16-bit registers.
The high-order word is returned in the first register, the low order
SINT32 or S32-4321
word in the second. In effect, the 4 bytes are returned in 4-3-2-1 (or
big ENDIAN) format.
A 32-bit unsigned value returned in two consecutive 16-bit registers.
The high-order word is returned in the first register, the low-order
UINT32 or U32-4321
word in the second. In effect, the 4 bytes are returned in 4-3-2-1 (or
big ENDIAN) format.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1611


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Format Type Description


A 32-bit signed value returned in two consecutive 16-bit registers.
Contrary to S32_4321, the high-order word is returned in the second
S32-2143
register, the high-order word in the first. In effect, the 4 bytes are
returned in 2-1-4-3 format.
A 32-bit unsigned value returned in two consecutive 16-bit registers.
Contrary to U32_4321, the high-order word is returned in the second
U32-2143
register, the low-order word in the first. In effect, the 4 bytes are
returned in 2-1-4-3 format.
A 32-bit signed value returned in two consecutive 16-bit registers.
S32-MFP or The word stored in the first 16-bit register is multiplied by 10000 and
S32-M10k-4321 added to the word stored in the second 16-bit register. Also known
as ‘signed Modulo 10000’.
A 32-bit unsigned value returned in two consecutive 16-bit registers.
U32-MFP or The word stored in the first 16-bit register is multiplied by 10000 and
U32-M10k-4321 added to the word stored in the second 16-bit register. Also known
as ‘unsigned Modulo 10000’ or mod-10K.
A 32-bit signed value returned in two consecutive 16-bit registers.
Contrary to S32_M10k_4321, the word stored in the second 16-bit
S32-M10k-2143
register is multiplied by 10000 and added to the word stored in the
first 16-bit register.
A 32-bit unsigned value returned in two consecutive 16-bit registers.
Contrary to U32_M10k_4321, the word stored in the second 16-bit
U32-M10k-2143
register is multiplied by 10000 and added to the word stored in the
first 16-bit register.
A 48-bit signed value returned in three consecutive 16-bit registers.
S48-M10k-21-65 R3*10,000^2 + R2*10,000 + R1, where R3 is the last register and
R1 is the first register. Each registers range is -9,999 to +9,999
A 48-bit unsigned value returned in three consecutive 16-bit
registers. R3*10,000^2 + R2*10,000 + R1, where R3 is the last
U48-M10k-21-65
register and R1 is the first register. Each registers range is 0 to
+9,999
A 64-bit signed value returned in four consecutive 16-bit registers.
R4*10,000^3 + R3*10,000^2 + R2*10,000 + R1, where R4 is the
S64-M10k-21-87
last register and R1 is the first register. Each registers range is -
9,999 to +9,999
A 64-bit unsigned value returned in four consecutive 16-bit registers.
R4*10,000^3 + R3*10,000^2 + R2*10,000 + R1, where R4 is the
U64-M10k-21-87
last register and R1 is the first register. Each registers range is 0 to
+9,999

1612 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Format Type Description


A 64-bit signed value returned in four consecutive 16-bit registers.
The highest order word is returned in the first register, the lowest
S64-87-21
order word in the fourth. In effect, the 8 bytes are returned in 8-7-6-5-
4-3-2-1 (or big ENDIAN) format.
A 64-bit unsigned value returned in four consecutive 16-bit registers.
The highest order word is returned in the first register, the lowest
U64-87-21
order word in the fourth. In effect, the 8 bytes are returned in 8-7-6-5-
4-3-2-1 (or big ENDIAN) format.
A 64-bit signed value returned in four consecutive 16-bit registers.
The highest order word is returned in the fourth register, the lowest
S64-21-87
order word in the first. In effect, the 8 bytes are returned in 2-1-4-3-6-
5-8-7 (or little ENDIAN) format.
A 64-bit unsigned value returned in four consecutive 16-bit registers.
The highest order word is returned in the fourth register, the lowest
U64-21-87
order word in the first. In effect, the 8 bytes are returned in 2-1-4-3-6-
5-8-7 (or little ENDIAN) format.
A 16-bit signed value. Bits 1 to 15 bits are unsigned data. If bit 16 is
S16-1-15
0, the value is positive, if bit 16 is 1, the value is negative.
A 32-bit IEEE floating point value returned in two consecutive 16-bit
registers. The high-order word is returned in the first register and the
IEEEFloat or F32-4321
low order word in the second. In effect, the 4 bytes are returned in 4-
3-2-1 format.
A 32-bit IEEE floating point value returned in two consecutive 16-bit
SwappedFloat or registers. Contrary to F32_4321, the high-order word is returned in
F32-2143 the second register and the low order word in the first. In effect, the
4 bytes are returned in 2-1-4-3 format.
A 16-bit value that is interpreted according to the bit pattern
described by the Mask attribute. Bits exposed by the mask can be
read or written without affecting the value of other bits. Unmasked
bits are interpreted as 0 on a read and are unaffected on a write.
MaskedBool or
Undeclared bits of a mask are interpreted as unmasked (i.e.,
PackedBool
mask="0x7F" is interpreted as 0x007F). The value that is read or
written is determined by using enumeration ordinals, described
below. If used for read-only Boolean data, enumerations are not
required. If no mask is specified, all bits are relevant.
A 16-bit unsigned value, range 0 to 3999, representing 3 decimal
PF-Nexus
places of accuracy.
A number is expressed as a sequence of decimal digits and then
BCD (Binary Coded
each decimal digit is encoded as an 8-bit binary number. For
Decimal)
example, decimal 92 is encoded as 00001001 00000010.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1613


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Format Type Description


The following data types can have their length specified by the “Number of Registers to
Request” setting.
A number is expressed as a sequence of decimal digits and then
Packed BCD each decimal digit is encoded as a 4-bit binary number (nibble) For
example, decimal 92 is encoded as 1001 0010.
A sequence of bytes representing the ASCII character set. Each
ASCII
word stores two ASCII characters. Trailing spaces are removed.
Same as ASCII except every second character is in the reverse
ASCII-Reverse
order.

Additional supported formats: U16-21, S16-21, U16-12, S16-12, U64-M10k-87-21, S64-M10k-87-21,


U48-M10k-65-21, S48-M10k-65-21, U48-65-21, S48-65-21, U48-21-65, S48-21-65,
InvertedMaskedBool, F64-87-21, F64-12-78, PF32, PF_ALT, U16-21-ARRAY, U16-12-ARRAY,
DateTime4_UTC, DateTime4_LOCAL, DateTime4, DateTime3_UTC, DateTime3_LOCAL,
DateTime3, DateTime_YMDhms_UTC, DateTime_YMDhms_LOCAL, DateTime_YMDhms,
DateTime_IEC870_UTC, DateTime_IEC870_LOCAL, DateTime_IEC870, DateTime3_IEC870_
UTC, DateTime3_IEC870_LOCAL, DateTime3_IEC870, DateTime3_MDYhms_UTC,
DateTime3_MDYhms_LOCAL, DateTime3_MDYhms, DateTime4_MDYhms_UTC, DateTime4_
MDYhms_LOCAL, DateTime4_MDYhms, DateTime2_s2000, DateTime3_s2000, DateTime4_
shmMDY, DateTime6_smhDMY, DateTime7_YMDhms, DateTime8_MDYdowhmsc, DateTime6_
MDYhmms, DateTime_NSX2_UTC, DateTime_NSX2_LOCAL, DateTime_NSX3_UTC,
DateTime_NSX3_LOCAL, S64-M1K-87-21, U64-M1K-87-21.

Modbus Register Properties


The following register properties can be configured:

Name

The Modbus register name is an identifier for the register. It is used internally, but not displayed in
the measurement selector user interfaces. The ION register label, to which the Modbus register is
mapped, is used for display. If no ION register label is defined, then the ION register name is used
for display.

For multi-circuit devices, such as the BCPM, the Modbus register name is used to identify the
different circuits, with a special naming convention (example: Real Energy@!!DeviceName!!_
1PH_Ch1). These special register names are then used for the creation of managed circuits, if that
feature is configured for the device type in the Management Console.

NOTE: The register name has a maximum character limit of 50, including spaces. This is
important to consider when creating names for multi-circuit devices.

Constant Value vs. Mapped Value

To have an ION register linked to a measured value from a device, map this register to the
appropriate Modbus register. To assign a constant value to an ION register, enter this value into the
Value box for the ION register in the String Register Details pane. You must unmap a mapped

1614 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

register first before you can edit the value of an ION register. To unmap a register, delete the
ION Handle number for the mapped Modbus register, or delete the entire Modbus register row for the
mapped Modbus register in the Register Map.

Disable Not Available Check

Use this field to skip the Not Available check for a register.

Enumeration

Enumeration is used to convert ordinals (position numbers) read from the device into the values
these ordinals represent.

For example, a device may represent the Baud rate with a number from 0 to 3, where 0 = 19200
Baud and 3 = 115200 Baud. Using enumeration, the value 0 is converted to the string "19200 Baud",
and the value 3 is converted to "115200 Baud". There are many applications for using enumerations
when reading Modbus register data.

To create an enumeration:

1. In Device Type Editor, open the device type for which you want to define enumerations, and
then browse to the Enumerations tab.

NOTE: This tab is hidden by default. To show the tab, check View > Register Map >
Enumerations.

2. In Enumerations, insert a new row, using the context menu commands.

3. Enter a name in the Name field to identify this enumeration.

For the example above, the name could be "Baud_Rate".

4. Enter a default value for the enumeration in the Default Enum Value field.

For the example above, this could be "19200 Baud".

5. Click the Enum Info Option icon in the name field for this enumeration to open the Enum
Info Option table.

6. In Enum Info Option, insert new rows, using the context menu commands and enter the
ordinals into the Ordinal fields and the corresponding values into the Value fields.

For the example above, ordinal 0 has a value of 19200 Baud, ordinal 1 a value of 38400 Baud,
ordinal 2 a value of 57600 Baud, and ordinal 3 a value of 115200 Baud.

7. Click the icon in the op left corner of the Enum Info Option grid to return to the
Enumerations table.

8. Browse to the Register Map table and enter the enumeration name created in step 3 into the
Enum Name field for the registers to which it applies.

Format

This data format is used for decoding the values returned from the meter. The selected data format
must match the format delivered by the device. See Modbus Data Formats for the supported
formats.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1615


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

ION Handle

The ION handle is the reference ID used by Power Monitoring Expert to identify the ION register
that is mapped to the Modbus register. The ION handle is automatically assigned when you map a
Modbus register from the Register Map to the ION register in the ION Tree.

Mask

The mask is used to read individual bit values from a Modbus register value. It is applied to the
register data using an AND logic. For example, if the mask “0x4” is applied, then the register value
displayed is only nonzero if the 3rd least significant bit in the register is a 1. You can apply masks to
both numeric and Boolean data types.

NOTE: For integer values, the bit order of the mask corresponds to the bit order of the actual data
and NOT the order in which the bytes representing the data are returned over Modbus. The high-
order nibble of a 32-bit value is selected as ‘0xf0000000’ regardless of whether the format is U32_
4321 or U32_2143. It should also be noted that the resulting value of a masked integer is NOT bit
shifted. A mask of ‘0xf000’ applied to a 16-bit value of ‘0x1234’ results in ‘0x1000’ (4096 decimal)
and NOT 1.

Modbus Address

This is the physical address of the Modbus register. You can find this address number in the device
documentation. Enter the number in either decimal or hexadecimal format. The address range
depends on the register type as follows:

COIL STATUS = 0xxxx


INPUT STATUS = 1xxxx
INPUT REGISTER = 3xxxx
HOLDING REGISTER = 4xxxx

NOTE: When entered in hexadecimal format, the value is only the register offset and does not
include the Register Type identification.

Not Available Value

If the Modbus register has a control signal value to indicate when the register is not available, then
you can enter this value in this field. The value must match the control signal value that is received
from the device. This allows the user interfaces that display data for this register in Power
Monitoring Expert to indicate when the value is not available.

Number of Registers

This option is only available if the data type is set to ASCII, ASCII-Reverse or Packed BCD. It
allows you to specify the number of registers to retrieve from the device on a request.

Request Type

This tells the system whether the register is for read (R) or write (W). Other options are read/write
(RW), and command write (CW).

1616 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Scale, Multiplier, Offset

The scale, multiplier and offset can be set to any decimal value within the range of -3.402823466 E
+ 38 to 3.402823466 E + 38. These values are applied to the measured value returned from the
device in the following way:

ION value = (Modbus value - offset) * multiplier / scale

Instead of setting these values to a constant, you can also map them to ION registers that hold
these values. This is useful if the value of the ION registers can be read from the device. It is also
useful if you want to use the same scale, multiplier, or offset for multiple registers. In this case you
can map all of the registers to the same ION registers, and set their values to constants. You can
only map to registers already created in the Device Type Editor.

To map the scale, multiplier, or offset to an ION register, enter the ION handle value for this register,
in hex, into the Scale, Multiplier, or Offset fields in the Modbus Register Map.

Setup Reg

Use this field to indicate that a register is a setup register on the device. Setup registers are read at
a lower polling rate than regular data registers, improving the overall performance of the device
driver.

Write Value

This only applies to pulse registers. Use this field to specify the value that is written to the Modbus
register on the device when the ION register is pulsed.

Measurement Tree
The Measurement Tree organizes the device measurements into a structure that is recognized by
Power Monitoring Expert and that determines how you access these measurements in the
software. The Measurement Tree consists of managers, modules, and registers.

Managers

Managers are at the top level of the tree. Managers group together modules of the same type. For
example, a manager called Maximum Readings could contain the modules Max Current, Max
Frequency and Max Voltage. You are free to choose a name for a manager that best meets your
needs. Choose a name that is relevant to the type of modules it contains. You can create up to 127
managers.

Modules

Modules are contained inside managers. Modules group together related registers. For example, a
module called Max Current could contain the registers Max Current A, Max Current B, Max
Current C. You are free to choose a name for a module that best meets your needs. Choose a
name that is relevant to the type of registers it contains. You can create up to 4095 modules inside a
given manager.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1617


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Registers

Registers are contained inside modules. (ION) Registers are linked to the Modbus registers and
hold the measured values. You can map registers to a Modbus address, then use Power Monitoring
Expert to read and write data to this Modbus device. You can create up to 255 registers per module.

Factory registers

You cannot add or remove Factory registers, but you can edit them. All Factory registers are initially
set to a default constant value. You can change these constant values, or map the registers to a
valid Modbus address.

OPC Tags
A complete OPC tag contains the elements shown in the following example:

1618 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Energy Analysis Reports Module references


This section contains reference information related to configuring the Energy Analysis Reports
Module.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Supported measurements and devices


PUE Summary Report Calculations
Terms and Definitions

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1619


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Supported measurements and devices


The reports in the Energy Analysis Reports Module support the measurements listed in the
following table:

Reports Input Measurements Notes


Single power measurement Any device capable of
Duration Curve Report
(kW, kVA, kvar) providing the measurements.
Dependent Variable, Any device capable of
Energy Modeling Reports
Independent Variable (*) measuring the variables.
Two measurements (model
and driver)
Energy Regression Analysis Any device capable of
• Energy or power (model)
Report providing the measurements.
• Environmental or process
variable (driver)
Multiple energy measurements
Any device capable of
Energy Usage Per State Report (electric or non-electric) (**)
providing the measurements.
Single state measurement
Input parameters (application Any device capable of
KPI Report
dependent) providing the input parameters.
Input parameters (application Any device capable of
KPI by TOU Report
dependent) providing the input parameters.
Any device capable of
Multi Equipment Operation Multiple state measurements
providing the state
Report (one for each source)
measurements.
Two measurements (power
and state)
Any device capable of
Power Usage Per State Report
• kW or kVA or kvar (power) providing the measurements.

• Single state measurement


Power:

• Total Data Center Power


PUE Category 1:
• Total IT Equipment Power ION9000 on MV Substation

Energy : and main incomer, APC


Symmetra MW for all IT UPSs
PUE Summary Report • Total Data Center Energy
PUE Category 2: ION9000 on
• Total IT Equipment
MV Substation and main
Energy.
incomer, PM5320 for all
(See PUE power and energy PDUs***
measurements below for more
information)

1620 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Reports Input Measurements Notes


Any device capable of
Single Equipment Operation
Single state measurement providing the state
Report
measurement.

* The dependent variable is the measurement you want to model. For example, if you are modeling
the energy consumption of a building based on outside temperature, then the energy is the
dependent variable.
The independent variable is the driver that influences the measurement you want to model. In the
above example, the outside temperature is the independent variable. You can specify one or more
independent variables.

** The energy measurements are aggregated into one total energy measurement by the report.

*** If the PDUs have embedded energy metering, with an accuracy of 1% or better, and can provide
energy, power, voltage, and current data via an industry standard communications protocol, then no
external metering is required to monitor the PDU mains.

PUE power and energy measurements


PUE Category 1
The VIP framework aggregates total kW values from all Main Incomer Meters and then calculates
and logs 3 values that can be selected in the report and used in the Vista KPI screens: kWh del,
kWh del int, and kW SWD. The VIP framework also aggregates total kW values from all UPS
Meters and then calculates and logs 3 values that can be selected in the report and used in the Vista
KPI screens: kWh del, kWh del int, and kW SWD.

PUE Category 2
The VIP framework aggregates total kW values from all Main Incomer Meters and then calculates
and logs 3 values that can be selected in the report and used in the Vista KPI screens: kWh del,
kWh del int, and kW SWD. The VIP framework also aggregates total kW values from all PDU
Meters and then calculates and logs 3 values that can be selected in the report and used in the Vista
KPI screens: kWh del, kWh del int, and kW SWD.

If multiple types of power and energy measurements exist in the system, then a look-up method is
used to determine which one to use. The following tables lists the supported types in order of look-
up priority.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1621


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Terms and Definitions


• PUE – Power Usage Effectiveness, defined as a ratio between the total power consumed by a
data center facility and the power consumed by the IT equipment that runs in the facility. For
example, a PUE value of 2.0 indicates that for every watt of IT equipment power consumed, an
additional watt is consumed to operate the facility that houses the equipment (e.g. equipment
cooling, power distribution to the equipment).

• Total Data Center Power – Represents all the power consumed by the data center facility at
one point in time. This value should represent an instantaneous power consumption value.

• Total Data Center Energy – Represents all the energy used by the data center facility for a
given time interval. This value typically represents a 15-minute energy usage value.

• Total IT Equipment Power – Represents all the power consumed by the IT equipment used in
a data center facility at one point in time. This value should represent an instantaneous power
consumption value

• Total IT Equipment Energy – Represents all the energy used by the IT equipment in the data
center facility for a given time interval. This value typically represents a 15-minute energy usage
value.

• Support – Represents the overhead amount of energy or power required to operate the data
center, which does not account for IT equipment power consumption. This value represents the
data center power distribution losses, as well as the power consumed to cool down the data
center facility.

1622 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

PUE Summary Report Calculations


In this sample, all time periods are based on July 25, 2013.

24 Hours 7 Days 30 Days Last 12 Months


From July 24 12:00AM From July 18 12:00AM From June 25 12:00AM From July 25, 2012
until until until 12:00AM until
July 25 12:00AM July 25 12:00AM July 25 12:00AM July 25, 2013 12:00AM

The values in the table below are calculated as follows:

PUE – The ratio between the data center and IT equipment energy measurement values. This value
is calculated for each of the required time periods by the following formula:

Sum of Data Center Energy


PUE =
Sum of IT Equipment Energy

IT Equipment – The average of the IT equipment power measurement values for each of the time
periods.

Data Center – The average of the data center power measurement values for each of the time
periods.

The values displayed in the charts below are calculated as follows:

PUE Trend – The weekly PUE values are calculated by the following formula where N represents a
week of the year:

Sum [ Data Center Energy ] week N


PUE week N =
Sum [ IT Equipment Energy ] week N

Energy Trend – The weekly energy values for IT equipment and support are calculated by the
following formulas where N represents a week of the year:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1623


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

IT Equipment Energyweek N = Sum [ IT Equipment Energy ] week N

Sum [ Data Center Energy] week N - Sum [ IT


Support Energy week N =
Equipment Energy ] week N

1624 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Energy Billing Module references


This section contains reference information related to configuring the Energy Billing Module.

Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Supported measurements and devices

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1625


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Supported measurements and devices


The following measurements have been pre-mapped in the Sample WAGES rate file:

Power

Measurement Unit ION Name


Block Demand Apparent Power Sliding Window Demand
kVA
Apparent Power Total Delivered+Received
Block Demand Reactive Power Sliding Window Demand Delivered -
kvar
Reactive Power Received
Block Demand Active Active Power Sliding Window Demand Delivered-
kW
Power Received

Energy

Measurement Unit ION Name


Apparent Energy Total kVAh Apparent Energy Delivered + Received
Reactive Energy Into
kvarh Reactive Energy Delivered
the Load
Active Energy Into the
kWh Active Energy Delivered
Load

The Energy by IT Customer Report supports the measurements listed in the tables below. Only one
measurement of each type (Energy , Current) is required. If multiple types of the same
measurement exist in the system, then a look-up method is used to determine which one to use.
The tables list the supported types in order of look-up priority.

NOTE: You can edit this list of measurements in the PME database.

Energy

Measurement Unit ION Name ION Label


Active Energy Delivered –
Active Energy kWh kWh del-rec
Received
Active Energy Into the Load kWh Active Energy Delivered Active Energy Delivered

Current

Measurement Unit ION Name ION Label


Current Phase Average
Current Average Mean A I avg mean
Mean

1626 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Measurement Unit ION Name ION Label


Current Phase Average
Block Demand Current Avg
A Sliding Window Demand Amps Avg Dmd
Into the Load
Delivered
Current Avg A Current Phase Average Current Avg

The following devices can provide the measurements required for this report:

• BCPM-E, PM5350 (multi-circuit mode)

• Basic, Intermediate, or Advanced Device for main service entrance (PM5xxx, PM8xxx,
ION7650, ION9000)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1627


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Event Notification configuration references


This section contains reference information related to Event Notification configuration.
Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Notification Manager user interface


Add Rule UI
Add Recipient UI
Add Template UI
Notification delay example

1628 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Notification Manager user interface


Main user interface (UI) and Rules tab

Main UI

Selection tabs
1 Select a tab to see information related to notification Rules, Recipients, Templates,
Schedules, or Settings.
Help
2
Click Help to open the Notifications online help.
Number of displayed items
6
Shows the number of items visible on this page, and the total number in this View.
Page selector
7 Use the page selector to navigate between pages of information. Set the number of items that
are displayed on a page.

Rules tab

Add Rule
3
Use Add Rule to create a new notification rule.
Search Rules box.
4
Enter a search string to find rules in the notification rules table.
Notification rules table
5
The notification rules table shows all the notification rules that are configured in the system.

Recipients UI

Add Recipients
1
Use Add Recipients to create a new recipient for notifications.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1629


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Recipients table
2
The recipients table shows all the recipients that are configured in the system.

Templates UI

Add Templates
1
Use Add Templates to create a new template for notifications.
Templates table
2
The templates table shows all the templates that are configured in the system.

Schedules UI

Add Schedule
1
Use Add Schedule to create a new schedule.
Schedules table
2
The schedules table shows all the schedules that are configured in the system.

Settings UI

1630 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Settings topic selector


The topic selector groups settings by function. Click a topic to see the relevant settings in the
1 configuration pane.

NOTE: A red dot beside a topic shows that this topic has not been completely configured.

Settings configuration pane


2 The configuration pane shows the Notifications settings related to the selected topic. (General
settings are shown in the above example.)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1631


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Add Rule UI
Alarm View

Available Alarm Views


1 This shows the alarm views that are available in the system. It shows system views and any
custom views that have been created.
Notify on Alarm View
2 This shows the alarm view that has been selected for this notification rule. Only one alarm view
can be selected.

1632 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Recipients

Available Recipients
1
This shows the recipients that are available in the system.
Selected Recipients
2
This shows the recipients that have been selected for this notification rule.
Add Recipients
3 Click this button to add a new recipient to the system. This is a shortcut to the Add Recipient
function on the Recipients tab.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1633


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Schedule

Select Schedule
1 Use this to select the schedule you want to apply to this notification rule. Using a schedule with
a notification rule is optional.
Edit Schedule
2 Click this button to edit the selected schedule. This is a shortcut to the same function on the
Schedules tab.
Select Timezone
3
Select the timezone that is used to apply the schedule.
Add Schedule
4 Click this button to add a new schedule to the system. This is a shortcut to the Add Schedule
function on the Schedules tab.

1634 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Notification Rule Settings

Rule Name
1
The rule name is the identifier for this notification rule in the system.
Rule Enabled
2
Use this to enable or disable the rule. When a rule is disabled, no notifications are sent for it.
Message Template
3
Select the template you want to use for the notification message.
Add Template
4 Click this button to add a new template to the system. This is a shortcut to the Add Template
function on the Templates tab.
Delivery Options
Set the delivery options you want to use for this notification. You can also select which types of
alarm activity will trigger a notification.
The available options include:
5
- Deliver notifications by email
- Deliver notifications by SMS
- Send notifications on all activity (Note: This setting only applies to alarm views and incident
views, not to event views.)
Delivery Test
6 Click the Test button for the delivery method you want to test. A delivery test will send a test
message to the address configured for this delivery method on the Settings tab.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1635


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Add Recipient UI

Recipient details
The recipient name, email address, and phone number (used for SMS messaging). Email and
phone number are optional; however they are needed if email or SMS notifications should be
1 sent to this recipient.

NOTE: Enter the phone number in E.164 number formatting: [+][country code][area code]
[local phone number]. Example: +14151231234.

Address test
Click the Test button for the address (email or phone number) you want to test. An address test
2
will send a test message to the email address or phone number configured in the recipient
details.

1636 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Add Template UI

Template details
1 The template name, note, and link. This note and link will be added to the notification message,
after the alarm view details.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1637


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Notification delay example


The following example shows how the delay settings for notifications affect the message delivery.

Example settings:

Initial Delay (seconds) = 10


Incremental Delay (seconds) = 7
Maximum Delay (seconds) = 30

A - New alarm activity occurs every 5 seconds


B - Initial and incremental time delays
C - Notification message is sent after maximum delay of 30 seconds

NOTE: After the maximum delay, a notification message is sent that includes all alarms that were
active in the notification time window up to the maximum delay cut off. In the example above, 6
alarms would be included.

1638 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

General references
This section contains general reference information.
Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Customizing the Web Applications links


Adding idle detection to custom Web Application links
Configure database connection encryption
Changes in security settings of device

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1639


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Customizing the Web Applications links


By default, Web Applications shows the following application links: Dashboards, Diagrams,
Trends, Alarms, Reports, Settings. You can add custom links, hide/unhide links, re-order links, and
delete links.

Default links:

Example customized links:

NOTICE
INOPERABLE DATABASE
Back up the database before executing SQL scripts.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in an inoperable database and loss of data.

To add a custom link:

1. On the PME application server, find the Add_PQPerf_To_Web.sql script file in


...\Power Monitoring Expert\diagnostic\PowerQuality\

2. On the database server, open SQL Server Management Studio (SSMS).

3. Open the Add_PQPerf_To_Web.sql script in SSMS.

NOTE: You can also copy and paste the example script below into SSMS.

4. Update the script settings, in the marked areas in the script, to meet your needs.

NOTE: The order value determines the order in which the links are arranged in the web page
banner. The order numbers increase from left to right. The numbers for the default links are:
Dashboards (10), Diagrams (20), Trends (30), Alarms (40), Reports (50). The location of the
SETTINGS link is not controlled by the order value. It is always in the right most position.

5. Execute the script on the ApplicationModules database.

TIP: You can execute this query repeatedly to change any of the settings for the custom link.

6. Close SSMS.

7. Reload Web Applications if it is open in a browser.

Example script to create a MY CUSTOM LINK link between the REPORTS and SETTINGS links in
the Web Applications banner that opens a custom web page:

1640 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

USE ApplicationModules
DECLARE @id NVARCHAR(255)
DECLARE @name NVARCHAR(255)
DECLARE @displayName NVARCHAR(255)
DECLARE @description NVARCHAR(255)
DECLARE @order NVARCHAR(100)
DECLARE @target NVARCHAR(400)
----------------------------------------------------------------------
-- Edit the following values to define your custom settings
----------------------------------------------------------------------
-- Custom application link (internal) name.
SET @id = 'MyCustomLink'
-- Custom application link description
SET @description = 'My custom link shows my custom content'
-- Display Name
set @displayName = 'My Custom Link'

-- Custom application link order. Less than 10 will bring new link to
-- first left position.
SET @order = 60
-- Target URL can be provided in single quote here,
-- e.g. 'https://www.mypage.com'
-- If on the same machine, should be the relative path.
-- e.g., '/myApp/index.html'
SET @target = 'https://www.mypage.com'

----------------------------------------------------------------------
-- DO NOT MODIFY CONTENT BELOW
----------------------------------------------------------------------
DECLARE @configurationValue NVARCHAR(MAX)
SET @configurationValue =
'<FrameworkApplication id="' + @id + '"'
+ ' displayName="' + @displayName + '"'
+ ' description="' + @description + '"'
+ ' resourceSet="ApplicationFrameworkResources"'
+ ' target="' + @target + '"'
+ ' privilege=""'
+ ' order="' + @order + '"'
+ ' enabled="true"'
+ ' xmlns="uri:application-modules/power/framework/application#" />'
EXECUTE [ApplicationModules].[Configuration].[WriteConfigurationValue]
'ApplicationFramework'
,'Applications'
,@id
,@description
,@configurationValue
,NULL
,0

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1641


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

To hide or unhide a link:

1. On the database server, open SQL Server Management Studio (SSMS).

2. Copy the following SQL script into a query window in SSMS:


SELECT *
FROM [ApplicationModules].[Configuration].[ConfigurationSettings]
WHERE ItemType ='ApplicationFramework' AND Item = 'Applications'

3. Execute the query on the ApplicationModules database. This returns the settings for the Web
Applications links.

4. Copy the content of the Value column for the link you want to hide or unhide, into a text editing
tool such as Notepad. For example:
<FrameworkApplication id="MyCustomLink" displayName="My Custom
Link" description="My custom link shows my custom content"
resourceSet="ApplicationFrameworkResources"
target="https://www.mypage.com" privilege="" order="60"
enabled="true" xmlns="uri:application-
modules/power/framework/application#" />

5. Change the enabled property value to "false" in the text editor to hide a link, or to "true" if to
unhide a link

6. Copy the following SQL script into a query window in SSMS:


UPDATE [ApplicationModules].[Configuration].
[ConfigurationSettings]
SET Value = '<Copy entire data from notepad with the modified
enabled property here>'
WHERE [key]= '<Type the custom application link (internal) name
here, in our example this is MyCustomLink>'

7. Update the query settings as described in the script above.

8. Execute the script on the ApplicationModules database.

9. (Optional) Repeat steps 4-8 to hide or unhide additional links.

10. Close SSMS.

11. Reload the Web Applications if they are open in a browser.

To re-order links:

1. On the database server, open SQL Server Management Studio (SSMS).

2. Copy the following SQL script into a query window in SSMS:


SELECT *
FROM [ApplicationModules].[Configuration].[ConfigurationSettings]
WHERE ItemType ='ApplicationFramework' AND Item = 'Applications'

3. Execute the query on the ApplicationModules database. This returns the settings for the Web
Applications links.

1642 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

4. Copy the content of the Value column for the link you want to reorder, into a text editing tool
such as Notepad. For example:
<FrameworkApplication id="MyCustomLink" displayName="My Custom
Link" description="My custom link shows my custom content"
resourceSet="ApplicationFrameworkResources"
target="https://www.mypage.com" privilege="" order="60"
enabled="true" xmlns="uri:application-
modules/power/framework/application#" />

5. Change the order property value to a new value in the text editor.

NOTE: The order value determines the order in which the links are arranged in the web page
banner. The order numbers increase from left to right. The numbers for the default links are:
Dashboards (10), Diagrams (20), Trends (30), Alarms (40), Reports (50). The location of the
SETTINGS link is not controlled by the order value. It is always in the right most position.

6. Copy the following SQL script into a query window in SSMS:


UPDATE [ApplicationModules].[Configuration].
[ConfigurationSettings]
SET Value = '<Copy entire data from notepad with the modified
order property here>'
WHERE [key]= '<Type the custom application link (internal) name
here, in our example this is MyCustomLink>'

7. Update the query settings as described in the script above.

8. Execute the script on the ApplicationModules database.

9. (Optional) Repeat steps 4-8 to re-order additional links.

10. Close SSMS.

11. Reload the Web Applications if they are open in a browser.

To delete a link:

1. On the database server, open SQL Server Management Studio (SSMS).

2. Copy the following SQL script into a query window in SSMS:


DELETE FROM [ApplicationModules].[Configuration].
[ConfigurationValue]
WHERE ConfigurationKeyId = (Select id from [ApplicationModules].
[Configuration].[ConfigurationKey] where Name='<Type the custom
application link (internal) name here, in our example this is
MyCustomLink>')
DELETE FROM [ApplicationModules].[Configuration].
[ConfigurationKey]
WHERE Name='<Type the custom application link (internal) name
here, in our example this is MyCustomLink>'

3. Update the query settings as described in the script above.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1643


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Execute the query on the ApplicationModules database. This deletes the Web Applications
link.

5. (Optional) Repeat steps 3-4 to delete additional links.

6. Close SSMS.

7. Reload the Web Applications if they are open in a browser.

1644 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Adding idle detection to custom Web Application links


PME automatically times out inactive client sessions. If custom content links are added to the Web
Applications framework, then the custom content must implement the idle detection, or activity on
that content is not registered and the Web client session can time out unexpectedly.

Prerequisite: The custom application must be in the same Application Pool as the regular PME
applications, and must use the same authentication configuration.

To add idle detection to custom content:

1. In the custom Web application, Add references to jquery and jquery.idle.js.

2. Create an IdleDetection object when the document has loaded.

NOTE: If you want your application to take part in keeping PME non-idle, but you do not want
your application to log itself out after the idle period, you can add the following JSON as a
parameter to the idle() method: {enableLogoutRedirection: false;}

Example web.config for an application in the PME Application Pool:


<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
<configuration>
<system.web>
<compilation debug="true" targetFramework="4.6" />
<httpRuntime targetFramework="4.6" requestValidationMode="2.0"
enableVersionHeader="false" />
<authentication mode="Forms">
<forms name=".APPLICATIONFRAMEWORK"
loginUrl="/SystemDataService/Auth"
defaultUrl="/SystemDataService/Auth/GenerateAuthUrl" timeout="2880"
protection="All" enableCrossAppRedirects="true" />
</authentication>
<machineKey decryption="AES" decryptionKey="AutoGenerate"
validation="HMACSHA256" validationKey="AutoGenerate" />
<authorization>
<deny users="?" />
</authorization>
</system.web>
</configuration>

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1645


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Example minimal page that has idle detection added to it:

1646 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Configure database connection encryption


You can configure PME to use encryption for the communication between the application server and
the database server. You can also specify if PME trusts self-signed server certificates on the
database server or not. For more information on setting up encryption for database connections, see
Set up encrypted database communication for Distributed Database architectures.

NOTE: Before editing the settings in the registry, confirm that your PME system has been taken
out of service and that all system services have been stopped.

To enable or disable encryption for database connections:

1. Open the Windows Registry Editor.

2. Navigate to the following registry key:Computer\HKEY_LOCAL_


MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring
Expert\10.0\Databases

3. Set the UseEncryption value to 1, to enable encryption, or to 0, to disable encryption.

To configure the software to trust or not trust self-signed certificates on the database server:

1. Open the Windows Registry Editor.

2. Navigate to the following registry key:Computer\HKEY_LOCAL_


MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Schneider Electric\Power Monitoring
Expert\10.0\Databases

3. Set the TrustServerCertificate value to 1, to trust self-signed certificates, or to 0, to


not trust self-signed certificates.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1647


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Changes in security settings of device


The security settings for the following device types have changed starting the firmware version
3.0.0:

• ION9000 series devices

• PM8000 series devices

• ION7400 series devices

The changes in the device security settings are:

• Standard security mode is removed

• Legacy security support is an interim solution for users that use standard security mode.

Because of these changes, configuring the devices and viewing the diagram with firmware version
3.0.0 or higher requires changes in the PME.

To access an existing device in Management Console after firmware upgrade:

1. Right-click the device that has Advanced Security enabled and select Security to open the
Meter Security Settings dialog.

2. From the Software Access drop down list, select User1.

3. Click Match Password and type the password in the Password field then re-type it in the
Confirm Password field.

4. Select the check box if you want to allow the software to send secure time synchronization
signals to the device. Clear the check box if you do not want to send secure time
synchronization signals to the device.

5. Click OK.

To configure the security module in Designer for an existing device after firmware upgrade:

NOTE: The Change Standard Meter Security option is disabled and hence standard security
can not be enabled.

To enable advanced security,

1. Open a node diagram.

2. Right-click the Security Options module icon to open the module setup.

3. Highlight the SOP1 Legacy Security Support register and click Modify.

4. Select Disabled in the options drop down and click OK in the Modify Enumerator Register
dialog.

5. Click OK in the ION Module Setup dialog to close it.

6. Send and save the changes in Designer.

1648 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

To perform control object function of diagram in Vista for an existing device after firmware
upgrade:

1. Enter the username and password. See Controlling system functions for more information.

To perform control object function of diagram in Diagrams for an existing device after firm-
ware upgrade:

1. Enter the username and password. See Performing manual control actions for more
information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1649


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Insulation Monitoring Module references


This section contains reference information related to configuring the Insulation Monitoring Module.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Supported measurements and devices

1650 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Supported measurements and devices


The report and Vista diagrams in the Insulation Monitoring Module support the following
measurements and devices:

Standard Input Measurements Suitable Devices


Iso-Gard Series 6 Line Isolation
Total Hazard Current (THC) Monitor (Schneider Electric device)
Panel Temperature EDS 151 Insulation Fault Locator
ANSI
Line Isolation Monitor (LIM) specific (Bender device)
measurements EDS 461 Insulation Fault Locator
(Bender device)
Insulation Resistance (Ohm)
Vigilohm IM20 (Insulation Monitor)
Insulation Fault
Vigilohm IM400 (Insulation Monitor)
IEC Panel Temperature
Vigilohm IFL12 (Insulation Fault
Insulation Fault Locator (IFL) specific
Locator)
measurements

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1651


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

License Configuration Tool references


This section contains reference information related to License Configuration Tool.

Use the following link to find the content you are looking for:

License Configuration Tool user interface

1652 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

License Configuration Tool user interface


Main UI

Trial License Status and Table


1 View the trial license status. Also view the trial license information such as name, quantity,
version, and expiry date.
Licenses
2
View the license status along with the activation ID of the license.
Activate License
3
Click Activate License for activating license. See Activate License UI for more information.
Refresh License
4
Click Refresh License for refreshing license. See Refresh License UI for more information.
Return License
5
Click Return License for returning license. See Return License UI for more information.
License Information
6 Click License Information for viewing license information. See License Information UI for
more information.
License Table
7
View the activated license information such as name, quantity, version, and expiry date.
Technical Support
8
Click Technical Support to view the technical support web page in a web browser.
Offline Licensing Web Portal
9
Click Offline Licensing Web Portal to view the offline licensing web portal in a web browser.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1653


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

End User License Agreement


10
Click End User License Agreement to view the End User License Agreement.
About
11
Click About to view the License Configuration Tool version information.

Activate / Refresh / Return License UI

NOTE: This section explains about Activate License UI. The Refresh License and Return License
UI are identical to Activate License UI.

Method
Select the method:

1 • Use Online method if the PC has access to the internet.

• Use Offline method if the PC has no access to the internet but you have access to
another PC connected to the internet.
Instructions
2
Display the instructions as per the selected method.

1654 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Activation ID
3
Enter the activation ID.
Location to download the request file

4 NOTE: This option is not available for Online method.

Select a location to download the request file.


Download

5 NOTE: This option is not available for Online method.

Click Download the save the request file to the selected location.
Location of the response file

NOTE: This option is not available for Online method.


6

Select the location of the response file, which you downloaded from the Offline Licensing
Web Portal.
Activate
7
Click Activate to activate the license.
Cancel
8
Click Cancel to go back to the main window.

License Information UI

Feature List
1
View the list of features name, version, and expiry date for the activated licenses.
Server and Device License Usage
2 View the server and device license name, quantity, version, and expiry date for the activated
licenses.
OK
3
Click OK to go back to the main window.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1655


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Manual Data Editor references


This section contains reference information related to Manual Data Editor.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Manual Data Editor user interface

1656 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Manual Data Editor user interface


Data editor user interface (UI)

Load New Data.


Click Load New Data to open the Load Data dialog box. In Load Data you select the sources,
1 measurements, time range, and display options for the data that is loaded into the data editor.
Load Data opens automatically when you start Manual Data Editor. See Load Data UI for
more information.
Locate Changes.
Use Locate Changes to find and step through any changes you made to the data loaded into
2 the data editor, before you apply those changes. After you apply the changes, they become
part of the data set in the database and Manual Data Editor no longer identifies them as
changes.
Locate Issues.
3 Use Locate Issues to find and step through any issues identified by Manual Data Editor in the
data loaded into the data editor.
View Issue Report.
4 Use View Issue Report to see which data issues were identified by Manual Data Editor in the
data loaded into the data editor.
Insert Timestamp.
Insert a new data record in the data loaded into the data editor with a timestamp you can
specify. The timestamp must be in the time range of the data that is loaded into the editor. The
5 new record has <no data> data values. When adding new data records, keep in mind that a
historical data log timestamp marks the end of the logging interval. For example, a data log
with a 15 minute logging interval and timestamp of 17:00 represents data for the time interval
of 16:45 - 17:00.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1657


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Smart Gap Fill.


Use Smart Gap Fill to fill in missing data in the data set loaded into the data editor. You can
6 select a range of data that you want to fill the gaps in or you can fill all gaps in the entire loaded
data range. When selecting a data range in the editor, only select the data values, not the
timestamps. See Smart Gap Fill UI for more information.
Data grid.
The data grid shows the sources/measurements that you specified in the Load Data dialog
box. Use the grid and the functions in the data editor to edit the data as needed.
7
TIP: Move the pointer over the header of a data column to see a tooltip with additional
information.

Context menu.
8 Right-click a data cell in the data grid to open the context menu. The Context menu gives you
access to the commands and functions for editing the data loaded into the data editor.
Color legend for issues highlight
9 The data editor uses different color highlights to mark data issues. This legend tells you which
colors are used for which type of issues.
View Log
10 Click View Log to open the Manual Data Editor historical audit log. See Audit Log UI for more
information.
Undo All Changes
You can undo changes that have not been applied yet. After changes have been applied to the
11
database, they are permanent and can only be modified be manually editing the data again in
the Manual Data Editor.
Apply Changes
After you have completed your data edits, click Apply Changes to write the changes to the
12
database. After changes have been applied to the database, they are permanent and can only
be modified be manually editing the data again in the Manual Data Editor.

1658 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Load Data UI

Available Sources.
1
Select the source for which want to load the data.
Available Measurements.
Select the measurement for which you want to load data. You have the option to only see
2
those measurements that have logged data for the selected source in the drop-down control,
or see all measurements that are defined in the software.
Add Data to Selection
Click Add Data to Selection to add the source/measurement you selected, to the list of data
3
to be loaded into the data editor. You can add multiple measurements from the same source,
and measurements from different sources to the list.
Selected Pairs
4 This shows the list of selected source/measurement pairs that are to be loaded into the data
editor.
Edit commands for the Selected Pairs list
5 Use Clear All to remove all selected list items. Use Remove Selected to remove items that
you selected from the list.
Create new Measurement
Use this to create a new measurement in the software. This function is needed if you want to
add data that was manually collected for a measurement that does not exist in the software.
For example, if you wanted to add a daily count of cars parked in a parking lot, you could
define a measurement called Number of Cars, which doesn't exist in the software by default.
6
Then you can select this measurement and a source in Manual Data Editor and add data
records with the daily counts.

NOTE: Check the list of available measurements to see if one exists for your application
before creating a new measurement.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1659


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Preset
Save and load settings for the Load Data dialog box. This is a way to simplify the data
7 selection for data sets that you frequently access. Set all the settings in Load Data for the
data sets you want and then save the settings to an external file using Save Preset. Load a
pre-defined set of settings into Load Data using Load Preset.
Time Range
8
Select the time range for which you want to load the data from the sources/measurements.
Timezone
Set the timezone for the display of the configurable timestamp in the data editor. The data
9
editor shows two timestamps for each data record, one timestamp in UTC and one in a
configurable timezone.
Timestamp Format
10
Set the format for the timestamp display in the data editor.
Number Format
Set the number of decimals that are displayed for the logged data in the data editor.

11 NOTE: This setting only affects the display of the data in the data editor and the accuracy to
which you can enter new data values. It does not affect data that is loaded into the editor and
then applied to the database without editing the values.

Is Interval Data
Set the expected logging interval for the data. This setting ensures that there is a data row in
the editor for every expected log entry. If there is no data record for an expected entry in the
database, then the Manual Data Editor inserts a timestamped row with a <no data> data
12
values in the editor. This makes it easier to identify missing records and correct them.

NOTE: The data editor shows all logged records in the selected time range, regardless of the
Interval Data settings. No records are hidden or filtered out.

Load Data
13
Click Load Data to open the selected sources/measurements data in the data editor.

1660 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Audit Log UI

Data.
1 Select the source/measurement for which want to see the audit data. The available options
include all sources/measurements that have been loaded into the data editor.
Audit log.
View the change history for edited data records including timestamp, username, action,
2
original value, new value. You can use the information in the audit log to reset data values to
their original value if they were changed accidentally or incorrectly.

Smart Gap Fill UI

Time Range.
Select the range of data that you want to fill the gaps in or you can fill all gaps in the entire
1
loaded data range. When selecting a data range in the editor, only select the data values, not
the timestamps.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1661


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Data.
2 This is a list of all the sources/measurements that are loaded into the editor. Select the
source/measurement pairs for which you want to fill gaps.
Interpolation Mode
Choose which algorithm is used to fill the gaps. You have the following choices:

Linear
Gaps are filled with the average of the last recorded value before the gaps
interpolation
and the first recorded value after the gaps. All consecutive gaps between
between known
3 the known values are filled with the same value.
values.
Last known Gaps are filled with the last recorded value before the gaps. All consecutive
Value gaps after the known value are filled with the same value.
Constant Value Gaps are filled with the value that you specify in the value box.

Optional Invalid Value


You can define a data value that is treated by the gap fill algorithm as if it was a gap. For
4
example, if you define 0 (zero) as the Invalid Value, then any data record in the Smart Gap Fill
range that has a value of 0 is treated as if it was a gap.
Change Log
The Change Log shows how many gaps were filled, for each of the selected
source/measurement pairs, after you click Fill Gaps.
5
NOTE: This is different from the Manual Data Editor audit log. The audit log records changes
that are applied to the data in the database. The Change Log shows which gaps where filled
in the data editor.

1662 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

OPC references
This section contains reference information related to OPC.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Tunneling of OPC data

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1663


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Tunneling of OPC data


The networking protocol for OPC is DCOM. DCOM is difficult to configure, responds poorly to
network interruptions, produces high network traffic, and has significant security weaknesses.

OPC tunneling applications are designed to overcome these limitations when using OPC over a
network. The goal of OPC tunneling is to eliminate DCOM by replacing it with a network protocol
like TCP. Instead of connecting the OPC client to a networked OPC server, the client program
connects to a local OPC tunneling application, which acts as a local OPC server. The tunneling
application accepts requests from the OPC client and converts them to TCP messages, which are
then sent across the network to a companion tunneling application on the OPC server computer.
There the request is converted back to OPC and is sent to the OPC server application for
processing. Any response from the server is sent back across the tunnel to the OPC client
application in the same manner.

Diagram: OPC data is sent over the network by OPC tunneler using common network protocols.

OPC tunneling products are available from several vendors, including Kepware and Matrikon.
When selecting OPC tunneling applications, look for products that

• keep the synchronous OPC transactions local to the client and server, with an asynchronous
tunnel connection

• provide link monitoring

• handle network disruptions effectively

• meet your security needs

1664 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Power Quality Performance Module references


This section contains reference information related to configuring the Power Quality Performance
Module.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Device Selection for Power Quality Performance monitoring


Supported Devices for Power Quality Performance monitoring
Power Factor Rate File Calculation
Required measurements for Power Quality Performance monitoring

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1665


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Device Selection for Power Quality Performance monitoring


The power quality data that is needed for the Power Quality Performance module is aggregated
across multiple devices and depends on data from the right device types in the right monitoring
locations.

The following sections describe the recommended device types for:

• Service entrance

• Feeders and critical loads

• Non-critical loads

Service entrance
Service entrance includes utility feeds and local power sources, such as generators, solar power, or
wind power. Service entrance monitoring should be done with high-end, high accuracy devices with
advanced power quality capabilities. The devices should have revenue accuracy (0.2 Class
accuracy or better) for the calculation of the power factor surcharges.

The following power quality measurements are required for service entrance monitoring:

• Interruption

• Voltage Sag/Swell

• Transient Voltage

• Over/Under Voltage

• Harmonics

• Frequency Variation

• Flicker

• Disturbance Direction Detection

NOTE: We recommend the ION9000 and ION7650 device types for service entrance monitoring.

Feeders and Critical Loads


This category includes low voltage substations, main distribution circuits, and critical loads.
Monitoring in these locations is important for root cause analysis, which involves disturbance
direction detection. Harmonics monitoring is also of great interest on these feeders and circuits.
Feeders and critical loads may be the location for process impact monitoring, which may require
digital or analog input capabilities on the monitoring device.

The following power quality measurements are required for feeder and critical load monitoring:

• Unbalance

• Harmonics

The following power quality measurements provide additional value for feeder and critical load
monitoring:

• Interruption

• Voltage Sag/Swell

1666 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

• Over/Under Voltage

• Frequency Variation

• Disturbance Direction Detection

NOTE: We recommend the PM5500 and PM5300 for the minimum required measurements, and
the PM8000 for full value feeder and critical load monitoring.

Non-critical Loads
This category includes non-critical feeders, power distribution panels, and sub-process unit panels.
Current unbalance and harmonics monitoring are of main interest at these locations. Non-critical
loads may be the location for process impact monitoring, which may require digital or analog input
capabilities on the monitoring device.

The following power quality measurements are required for feeder and critical load monitoring:

• Unbalance

• Harmonics

NOTE: We recommend the PM5300, PM5100, and PM325x device types for non-critical load
monitoring.

Devices List
See the supported devices list for more information on device types that support the power quality
measurements required for the Power Quality Performance module. To find the specific types that
meet your needs, review the device data sheets and specification for the following capabilities:

• Accuracy and sampling rate

• Power quality event and harmonics monitoring

• Data recording

• On-board alarming

• Inputs / Outputs

• Communication

NOTE: If the devices that are used for power quality performance monitoring do not support all the
required power quality measurements, then the information that is based on these measurements
is not displayed in the gadgets, diagrams, and reports. However, other power quality information,
that is based on available measurements might still be displayed.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1667


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Supported Devices for Power Quality Performance monitoring


The following table shows which monitoring device types support the measurements that are
required for the different Power Quality Performance components:

PQ Events and Disturbances Used by Supported Meters Supported Meter Template


ION 7350, 7400, 7550, 7650,
PQ Performance Diagrams 8600A, 8600B, 8650A, 8650B,
PQ Rating Gadget 8650C, 8800A, 8800B, 8800C,
9000, PM8000, PM870, CM3350,
PQ Rating Trend Gadget
CM4000, PM5650, PM5760,
PQ Incident Breakdown Gadget
PM5761
PQ Incident Impact Gadget
Interruptions All default meter template
PQ Incident Location Gadget
DDD Support:
PQ Analysis Report
PQ Impact Gadget
ION7400, ION7550 V350 and
PQ Impact Trend Gadget newer, ION7650 V350 and newer,
PQ Impact Report ION8650A/B V4.20 and newer,
ION9000, PM8000, CM4000
Voltage Sag Same as Interruptions Same as Interruptions All default meter template
Voltage Swell Same as Interruptions Same as Interruptions All default meter template
ION 7650, 8600A, 8650A, 8650B,
8800A, 9000, CM4000T, PM5650,
PM5760, PM5761

Transient Voltage Same as Interruptions All default meter template


DDD Support:
ION7650 V350 and newer,
ION8650A/B V4.20 and newer,
ION9000, CM4000T
ION 7350, 7400, 7550, 7650,
8600A, 8600B, 8650A, 8650B,
Over Voltage Same as Interruptions 8650C, 8800A, 8800B, 8800C, All default meter template
9000, PM8000, PM5650, PM5760,
PM5761
ION 7350, 7400, 7550, 7650,
8600A, 8600B, 8650A, 8650B,
Under Voltage Same as Interruptions 8650C, 8800A, 8800B, 8800C, All default meter template
9000, PM8000, PM5650, PM5760,
PM5761
Logged By Default:

ION 7330, 7350, 7400, 7550, 7650,


8600A, 8600B, 8650A, 8650B, 
8800A, 8800B, 9000, PM8000,
CM3000, CM4000, TesysT,
PQ Performance Diagrams Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0 E/P/H
PQ Rating Gadget (including IFE/IFM), PM5650,
Voltage Unbalance PM5760, PM5761 All default meter template
PQ Rating Trend Gadget
PQ Analysis Report
Not Logged By Default:

PM800 1, PM3250, PM3255,


PM5100, PM5300, PM5350,
PM5500, EM6400, EM7000,
Micrologic 5.2/6.2/5.3/6.3 E

1668 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

PQ Events and Disturbances Used by Supported Meters Supported Meter Template


Logged By Default:

TesysT, Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0


E/P/H (including IFE/IFM), PM5650,
PM5760, PM5761
PQ Performance Diagrams
PQ Rating Gadget
Current Unbalance Not Logged By Default: n/a
PQ Rating Trend Gadget
PQ Analysis Report
PM800 1, CM3000, CM4000,
PM3250, PM3255, PM5100,
PM5300, PM5350, PM5500,
EM6400, EM7000, Micrologic
5.2/6.2/5.3/6.3 A/E
Logged By Default:

ION 7330, 7350, 7400, 7550, 7650,


8600A, 8600B, 8650A, 8650B,
8800A, 8800B, 9000, PM8000,
CM3000, CM4000, PM5650,
PM5760, PM5761
PQ Performance Diagrams
PQ Rating Gadget Not Logged By Default: All default meter template except
Voltage Harmonics
PQ Rating Trend Gadget PM8000 with IEEE 519 template
PQ Analysis Report ION 6200, 7300, 8600C, 8650C,
8800C, PM200, PM700, PM800 1,
PM1200, PM3250, PM3255,
PM5100, PM5300, PM5350,
PM5500, EM3460, EM6400,
EM7000, Micrologic 5.2/6.2/5.3/6.3
E, Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0 H
(including IFE/IFM)
Logged By Default:

ION 7330, 7350, 7400, 7550, 7650,


8600A, 8600B, 8650A, 8650B,
8800A, 8800B, 9000, PM8000,
CM3000, CM4000, PM5650,
PM5760, PM5761

PQ Performance Diagrams Not Logged By Default: All default meter template except
Current Harmonics
PQ Analysis Report PM8000 with IEEE 519 template
ION 6200, 7300, 8600C, 8650C,
8800C, PM200, PM700, PM800 1,
PM1200, PM3250, PM3255,
PM5100, PM5300, PM5350,
PM5500, EM3460, EM6400,
EM7000, Micrologic 5.2/6.2/5.3/6.3
E, Micrologic 5.0/6.0/7.0 H
(including IFE/IFM)
Logged By Default:
PQ Performance Diagrams
PQ Rating Gadget ION 7330, 7350, 7400, 7550, 7650, All default meter template
Frequency Variation
PQ Rating Trend Gadget 8600A, 8600B, 8650A, 8650B, 
PQ Analysis Report 8800A, 8800B, 9000, PM8000,
PM5650, PM5760, PM5761
Logged By Default:
PQ Performance Diagrams
PQ Rating Gadget PQ Framework and EN50160
Flicker ION 7400, 7650, 8600A, 8650A,
PQ Rating Trend Gadget evaluation enabled
8800A, 8800B, 9000, PM5650,
PQ Analysis Report
PM5760, PM5761

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1669


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

PQ Events and Disturbances Used by Supported Meters Supported Meter Template


All meters that have measurements
required by the calculation of the
defined rate structure.

For example:
Power Factor Impact Gadget
Power Factor Power Factor Impact Trend • Active energy n/a
Gadget
• Reactive energy

• Active power

• Reactive power

All meters that measures active


Power Factor PQ Analysis Report energy, reactive energy, and power n/a
factor
Uninterruptible Power Supplies
(UPS):
• Galaxy 5000
• Galaxy 5500

Standardized Equipment Active Harmonic Filters:


n/a n/a
Diagrams
• Accusine PCS+
• Accusine PFV+

Capacitor Banks:
• VarPlus Logic VL6 and VL12

1 The PM810 must be equipped with the PM810LOG option.

1670 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Power Factor Rate File Calculation


This appendix explains the power factor calculations in the default rate files. To learn how to modify
the rate files, please refer to the PME Billing Module Toolkit.

Power Factor Impact – Active Energy Billing with PF Adjustment Option 1

The utility charges according to the active energy and adds a surcharge or adjustment for power
factor.

Power Factor Impact – Active Energy Billing with PF Adjustment Option 2

The utility charges according to the active energy and adds a surcharge or adjustment for power
factor.

Power Factor Impact – Apparent Energy Billing.xml

The utility bills all consumed energy, including the reactive energy.

Power Factor Impact – Reactive Energy Billing.xml

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1671


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Required measurements for Power Quality Performance monitoring


The following table shows which measurements are required for the different Power Quality
Performance components:

NOTE: For each disturbance category, choose only the needed measurements from the supported
list to log. Do NOT Log all of them. Logging all measurements can cause unwanted database
growth, and performance issues.

PQ Disturbances Used by Supported Measurements Label Name


ION Devices
V unbal mean
Voltage Unbalance Mean 
PQ Performance
Voltage
Diagrams Non-ION Devices
Voltage Unbalance L-L
PQ Rating Gadget Voltage Unbalance L-L
Unbalance Worst
PQ Rating Trend Gadget Worst
Voltage
PQ Analysis Report Voltage Unbalance L-N
Unbalance L-N
Worst
Worst
PQ Performance
Diagrams
Current Non-ION Devices Current
PQ Rating Gadget
Unbalance Current Unbalance Worst Unbalance Worst
PQ Rating Trend Gadget
PQ Analysis Report

1672 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

PQ Disturbances Used by Supported Measurements Label Name


ION Devices
Voltage Total Harmonic
Distortion on Input V11
Voltage Total Harmonic
V1 Total HD1
Distortion on Input V21
V2 Total HD1
Voltage Total Harmonic
V3 Total HD1
Distortion on Input V31
V1 THD mean
Voltage Total Harmonic
V2 THD mean
Distortion Mean on Input V1
PQ Performance V3 THD mean
Voltage Total Harmonic
Diagrams
Voltage Distortion Mean on Input V1
PQ Rating Gadget
Harmonics Voltage Total Harmonic
PQ Rating Trend Gadget
Distortion Mean on Input V1
PQ Analysis Report
Non-ION Devices
THD Voltage A-B
THD Voltage A-B
THD Voltage A-N
THD Voltage A-N
THD Voltage B-C
THD Voltage B-C
THD Voltage B-N
THD Voltage B-N
THD Voltage C-A
THD Voltage C-A
THD Voltage C-N
THD Voltage C-N
THD Voltage L-L
THD Voltage L-L
THD Voltage L-N
THD Voltage L-N
ION Devices
Current Total Harmonic
Distortion Phase A1
Current Total Harmonic
I1 Total HD1
Distortion Phase B1
I2 Total HD1
Current Total Harmonic
I3 Total HD1
Distortion Phase C1
I1 THD mean
Current Total Harmonic
I2 THD mean
Distortion Phase A Mean
PQ Performance I3 THD mean
Current Current Total Harmonic
Diagrams
Harmonics Distortion Phase B Mean
PQ Analysis Report
Current Total Harmonic
Distortion Phase C Mean
Non-ION Devices
Current Total Harmonic
Distortion Phase A THD Current A
Current Total Harmonic THD Current B
Distortion Phase B THD Current C
Current Total Harmonic
Distortion Phase C

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1673


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

PQ Disturbances Used by Supported Measurements Label Name


PQ Performance
Diagrams
Frequency ION Devices
PQ Rating Gadget Freq mean
Variation Frequency Mean
PQ Rating Trend Gadget
PQ Analysis Report
ION Devices
Voltage Flicker Plt on Input
V1
Voltage Flicker Plt on Input
V1-Flck Plt
PQ Performance V2
V2-Flck Plt
Diagrams Voltage Flicker Plt on Input
V3-Flck Plt
Flicker PQ Rating Gadget V3
V1-Flck Pst
PQ Rating Trend Gadget Voltage Flicker Pst on Input
V2-Flck Pst
PQ Analysis Report V1
V3-Flck Pst
Voltage Flicker Pst on Input
V2
Voltage Flicker Pst on Input
V3

NOTE: 1 Use only for ION 6200, 7300, 8600C, 8650C and 8800C. These measurements are NOT
logged by default.

NOTE:
• PM8000 is categorized as an ION device.

• ION6200 is categorized as a non-ION device.

1674 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Reports references
This section contains reference information related to configuring Reports.
Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

UPS Battery Health Report calculations

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1675


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

UPS Battery Health Report calculations


The following terms and explanations of various calculations are used in the UPS Battery Health
Report:

First Drop Analysis – Minimum Drop Voltage (V), Maximum Drop Voltage (V) and
Difference (%): The voltage drop minimum, maximum and percentage difference values are shown
in the Drop Analysis table section. To calculate these values, a valid waveform voltage drop must
be found first by sampling the waveform data.

A valid voltage drop is defined as the first waveform section of size n, where the relative minimum
and maximum voltage values have a percentage difference d. In addition, the next sample n+1 must
be greater in value than the minimum voltage, to ensure that the lowest value has been found in the
voltage drop.

The sampling section size n and the percentage difference d are determined by the user-defined
report parameters Waveform Drop Sample Size and Waveform Drop Percentage, respectively.

After the voltage drop has been found, the Minimum Voltage and Maximum Voltage are simply the
min and max values in that drop samples, and the Difference is the percentage of the maximum
voltage over the minimum voltage. For example:
Minimum Drop Voltage = Min(ws1 <= WaveformValues < = wsN)
Maximum Drop Voltage= Max(ws1 <= WaveformValues <= wsN)
ws1 is the first point in the sample and wsN is the last point in the sample
Difference (%) = [(Maximum Drop Voltage – Minimum Drop Voltage) / Maximum Drop Voltage]

Recovery Analysis – Target Recovery Voltage (V), Actual Recovery Voltage (V) and
Recovery Time (ms):

Target Recovery Voltage (V): This value is calculated for the reference waveform only. This is
calculated as follows:
Target Recovery Voltage (V) = [Recovery Voltage * Recovery Value Multiplier]
Where Recovery Voltage = Average(w1 <= WaveformValues < wN)
w1 is the very first point in the waveform and wN is the lowest point in the waveform voltage drop
and Recovery Value Multiplier is a user-defined value in the report pre-requisite page

Actual Recovery Voltage (V): The first point in the reference and comparison waveforms that
occurs after the voltage drop, that is equal or greater than the Target Recovery Voltage value.

Recovery Time (ms): This is the time elapsed from the Minimum Voltage Drop time and the Actual
Recovery Voltage time, expressed in milliseconds.

Additional calculations

Voltage Threshold: This is the red horizontal area that is highlighted in the waveform drop chart. It
represents a nominal voltage value, therefore there are no calculations for the Voltage Threshold.

For example, if the user sets the Voltage Threshold to 50V, then a red line will be drawn at 50v
(based on the Y-axis) and the area below the red line appears shaded in red.

1676 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

System Integration
This section contains reference information related to System Integration.
Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

PME and EBO integration references

PME and EBO integration references


This section contains reference information related to configuring the PME/EBO Integration
solution.
Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Add-on device drivers for PME


Advanced ETL Configuration References
Configuring the PME EWS server for HTTPS
Configuring the PME EWS server regional setting
Deploying and configuring a Multi-input Setpoint Display Bar graphic component
Deploying and configuring a Single-input Thermometer graphic component
Exposing custom device driver measurements through EWS
Manual integration steps without using the web application Integration Utility settings
Terms and definitions
Web security changes

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1677


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Add-on device drivers for PME


You can download add-on device drivers from the Exchange community. See Resources for
contact information.

For devices, for which default drivers or downloadable add-on drivers do not exist, you can use the
Device Type Editor (DTE) tool to create custom device drivers. See Device Type Editor for more
details.

1678 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Advanced ETL Configuration References


This section contains reference information related to the ETL.
Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Position Counters
Logging setup
Extract task: Setting parameters and recommended values
Transform task: Setting parameters and recommended values
Load task: Setting parameters and recommended values
Manage ETL jobs
Tips for working with mappings
ETL tips and tricks
Measurement mapping for ETL

Position Counters

Position counters keep track of the data that is extracted from EBO and then loaded into PME. Each
Trend log specified in ETL has a position counter associated with it. The position counter represents
a timestamp of the most recent data point loaded for each Trend log. When ETL is run, only data
after this timestamp value is extracted from the EBO Trend log.

To view the position counters for the mapped Trend logs:

• Click the Positions tab. The Positions tab appears showing the position counters.

Resetting and resending the data (optional)


If you need to re-extract previously extracted data, or if you want to load data after a specific date,
you can manually update the position counter. Otherwise, manually updating the position counter is
not necessary.

To reset and resend the data for the mapped Trend logs:

1. Enter a specific value in the text box to set all position counters.

2. Click Initialize. Mapped Trend logs appear with associated timestamp data for each.

Now, the next time you run ETL, only data after the given timestamp is loaded.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1679


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Logging setup

The Logging feature allows you to enable the various logs where ETL writes the information
regarding the status of your ETL job. These logs can help when searching for the cause of an
unsuccessful ETL job.

To enable the ETL logs:

1. Select the applicable job in ETL from the dropdown menu and click Edit.

2. Click the Logging tab. The Logging tab appears.

3. Select the Enabled checkbox for the Trace Log, Error Log, Customer Log, and Windows Event
Log as required.

4. Provide the location for the log file in the Log File field or leave at the default location.

1680 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

5. Set the Maximum Log File Size and Maximum Log Files for each log or leave at the default
settings.

6. If required, select the Enabled checkbox for Email Notifications and complete the fields for To
Email Address, From Email Address, and SMTP Server Address.

7. Click OK to save and exit the job.

Extract task: Setting parameters and recommended values

Extract task settings

Setting Name Description Setting Parameters / Recommended Values


Web Service
The maximum number of
threads to use when
contacting the EWS server
for the list of Trend logs. Set
Number of
value to 4 for most cases, Enter a value of 4.
threads to use
however, set value to a
lower number if the EWS
server is overwhelmed with
requests.
The length of time (in
Timeout (in minutes) to wait for a
minutes) for response from the EWS Enter a value of 10.
EWS response server when requesting
information.
Web Service The user name for Web
Provide EBO Workstation user name.
User Name Service.
Web Service Password for the Web
Provide EBO Workstation password.
Password Service user name.
Provide URL information. Default URL

http://localhost:8080/EcoStruxure/DataExchange.
Replace “localhost:8080” with your web server
address and port as needed.

The URL of the NOTE: For HTTPS EcoStruxure Web Service


Web Service
EcoStruxure Web Service connections, with a self-signed certificate, the
URL
called by this task. certificate validation must be disabled for ETL.
To disable certificate validation, set
<IsServerCertificateValidationCheckEnable
d> to false in the ETL job file.
You can find the job file in <ETL
installation folder>\Jobs\

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1681


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Setting Name Description Setting Parameters / Recommended Values


Communication Options
When set to True, ETL will
Enable the reuse digest authentication
Digest tokens for communicating
Authentication with the EWS server. This Set to 'True'
Token Reuse can improve
Feature communication
performance.
Reading Interval
When set to True, allows
the extract task to
Interval Length
determine the reading Set to 'True'
Discovery
interval for each pair based
on each pair's data.
Record State
Filter
When set to True, enables a
check on record state. Only
records with a specified
Limit Results record state will be used. all
Based on other records will be Set to 'False'
Record State ignored. When set to false,
check is disabled and all
records regardless of their
record state are used.
Sets the specific record
check to be used by the
Limit Results Based on
Allowed
Record state setting. Value not used if Limit Results setting is 'False'.
Record State
Record states can be Good,
Uncertain, Forced, Offline,
or Error.

Transform task: Setting parameters and recommended values

Transform task settings

Setting Parameters /
Setting Name Description
Recommended Values
Transform

1682 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Setting Parameters /
Setting Name Description
Recommended Values
Specifies the method used when
Intervalization Use default 'Last Known Value'
converting the values from an irregular
Method setting
interval into a regular interval.
When set to True, the data is
intervalized up to the current system
Intervalize to
time. If set to false, the data is Set value to “False”
present time
intervalized up to the most recent data
point.
Interval value in minutes. Select a
Target Reading Data is intervalized to a reading value from the dropdown list. Default
Interval (minutes) interval specified in this field. value of 15 minutes is suitable in most
cases.

Load task: Setting parameters and recommended values

Load task settings

NOTE: You must set the Enable Recorder and Channel Creation parameter to ‘True’ in order for
some Energy-related reports to run:

Setting Parameters /
Setting Name Description
Recommended Values
Database Settings
Time in seconds before stopping a
SQL Command Default value is 3600 seconds (1
SQL command attempt and
Timeout hour).
generating a message.
Provide connection information to
Application Modules database for
Database Settings Connection string to the
your system. Information can be
(Application Modules) Application Modules database
found through SQL Management
Studio.
Provide connection information to
Database Settings Connection string to the ION_Data ION_Data database for your
(ION_Data) database system. Information can be found
through SQL Management Studio.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1683


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Setting Parameters /
Setting Name Description
Recommended Values
Connection string to the ION_
Network_Database where source Provide connection information to
Database Settings information should be loaded. Only ION_Network database for your
(ION_Network) applicable if the Enable Network system. Information can be found
Database Source Creation setting through SQL Management Studio.
is True.
Group Name Settings
When set to 'True', the task adds a
Add the 'Group Name' group name prefix to all sources
Prefix to Sources if that do not already have one. When Set to 'False'.
Needed set to 'False', a group name prefix
will not be added.
The name provided in this setting is If the previous setting is 'False',
Group Name used as the Group Name prefix this setting does not need to be
setting described above. filled in.
Mapping Options – Source and Quantity End Names
Populate Button –
Automatically Set
Set to ‘False’.
Quantity ‘End Names’
to ‘Start Names’
Populate Button –
Automatically Set
Set to ‘False’.
Source ‘End Names’ to
‘Start Names’
Null Values
When set to 'False' the task
ignores any null values. When set
Allow Null Values Set to 'False'.
to 'True', null values in the data set
are inserted into the database.
Overwrite Values
Allow existing values
Set to ‘False’.
to be overwritten.
Recommended Source-Quantity Pairs Settings
Limit Recommended
Pairs to Known Set to ‘True’.
Quantities
Recorders and Channels

1684 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Setting Parameters /
Setting Name Description
Recommended Values
When set to 'False', the task does
not create recorders and channels
Enable Recorder and
while inserting data. Some reports Set to ‘True’.
Channel Creation
require that the parameter is set to
‘True’ to run.
Set the
ISCurrentConfiguration
Leave this default setting to ‘True’.
Flag to False for New
Channels
Source and Quantity Creation Settings
When set to 'False' disables
Enable Quantity
creating quantities if they are not Set to 'False'.
Creation
already in the database.
When set to 'True', the setting
Enable Source enables the creation of sources
Set to 'True'.
Creation in ION_Data that are not already in the ION_
Data database.
When set to 'True', the setting
Enable Source
enables the creation of sources
Creation in ION_ Set to 'True'.
that are not already in the ION_
Network
Network database.
Set Active Flag for All When set to 'True', all new sources
Set to 'True'.
New Sources are marked as Active.
When set to 'True', enables setting
Set Measurement
the descriptive name of new Set to 'True'.
Descriptive Name
measurements.
When set to 'True', enables setting
Set Measurement
the engineering name of new Set to 'True'.
Engineering Name
measurements.
Source Namespace Settings
Namespace given to all sources
Source Namespace that do not have a namespace or
IONEnterprise
Override that are created during the Load
Task.
Source Type Settings
When set to 'True', enables the use
Override Source Type of the Source Type Override value Set to 'True'.
when creating sources.
The source type to use when
Source Type Override Presumed downstream device.
creating sources.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1685


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Manage ETL jobs

You can set up logging to help manage ETL jobs. You can also switch between ETL jobs, change
the order of ETL tasks, and remove ETL tasks from an ETL job.

Switching between ETL jobs


1. Click OK at the bottom right to save and exit the current job.

2. In the Job Management list select an ETL job and click Edit.

Removing a task from an ETL job


1. In the Job Management list click the applicable ETL job and then click Edit.

2. Click the Tasks tab.

3. Highlight the task that you want to remove from the left pane.

4. Click Delete

5. Click OK to save and exit the job.

Tips for working with mappings

Loading sources can return thousands of rows. To help you manage a large result set, the
ETL Administration Tool includes several features to help you search, filter, and update loaded
sources.

Highlighting rows
Highlighting a source row lets you work with that source. When you highlight a row you can copy,
include or exclude the row from the ETL job, or perform a batch edit on the row.
To highlight a row:

1. Click the row.

To highlight successive rows:

1. Click the row.

2. Press Shift and click another row.

To highlight non-successive rows:

1. Press Ctrl and click the desired rows.

To highlight all rows:

1. Press Ctrl + A.

Batch Edits
A batch edit lets you update all highlighted rows at once.

1686 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

To perform a batch edit:

1. In the Mappings pane highlight the rows you want to edit.

2. Right-click and click Batch Edit.

The Batch Edit Mappings dialog appears.

3. Complete all applicable fields in the dialog as needed.

NOTE: You have to complete the Target Device and Target Measurement fields before you
can select Included for the row.

4. While the rows are still highlighted, right-click and click Include Selected Mapping(s). The
Included check box is checked for the selected rows and these devices are included in the
job.

5. Click OK, and then click Apply to save the changes to the job. The Batch Edit values appear
for the selected rows.

Sorting contents by column


To sort contents by column:

1. Right-click a column heading and from the sort menu choose to sort column contents by
ascending or descending order.

Searching by column
To search by column:

1. Click in the Auto Filter Row (search field below a column heading.)

2. Begin typing characters. Column contents appear based on the search criteria you enter. Note

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1687


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

that characters are not case sensitive.

Filtering content by column


To filter the contents by column:

1. Click the filter symbol to the right of the column heading, and then choose (Custom), (Blanks),
(Non blanks), Checked, Unchecked, or a specific device.

2. If you choose (Custom), you can define a unique filter, based on your input, in the Custom
AutoFilter dialog. Complete the fields in the dialog and then click OK.

Filtering content using the Filter Editor


To filter the contents using the Filter Editor:

1. Right-click the column header you want to filter and select Filter Editor.

You must complete the Target Device and Target Measurement fields before you can select
Included for the row.

2. Click an operator or enter a filter value.

3. Click Apply.

The sources are filtered based on the filtering criteria you enter.

4. Click OK to return to the Mappings tab.

1688 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Copying and pasting devices


You can select and copy one or more devices and paste that data into a document, such as a text
editor or a spreadsheet.
To copy and paste devices into a document:

1. In the Mappings tab select one or more device rows.

2. Press CTRL+C or right-click and click Copy.

3. Open your document and place the cursor where you want to paste.

4. Press CTRL+V or right-click and click Paste.

The device data appears in the document.

ETL tips and tricks

Performing a Batch Edit for Trend logs

To perform a Batch Edit (map multiple Trend logs at once):

1. Highlight multiple rows in the Mappings tab by clicking and dragging downward the handles to
the left of the rows. To select all rows, press Ctrl+A.

2. Right-click and select Batch Edit. The Batch Edit Mappings dialog appears.

3. Complete all applicable fields in the dialog as needed.

You must complete the Target Device and Target Measurement fields before you can select
Included for the row.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1689


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. While the rows are still highlighted, right-click and select Include Selected Mapping(s). The
Included check box is now checked for the selected rows and these Trend logs are now
included in the job.

5. Click OK, and then click Apply to save the changes to the job. The Batch Edit values now
appear for the selected rows.

See Measurement mapping for ETL to learn about the most common, supported measurements in
used in PME and how to link to typical Building Management tags.

Sorting contents by column

To sort contents by column:

• Right-click a column heading and choose from the sort menu to sort column contents by
ascending or descending order.

Searching contents by column

To search the contents by column:

1. Click in the search field below a column heading.

2. Begin typing characters. Only column contents appear based on the search criteria you enter.
Note that characters are not case sensitive.

Searching Target Measurements by column

To search the Target Measurements by column:

1690 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

1. Click in the search field below the column heading.

2. Begin typing characters. Only column contents appear based on the search criteria you enter.
Note that characters are not case sensitive.

See Measurement mapping for ETL to learn about the most common, supported measurements in
use in PME.

Filtering content by column

To filter the contents by column:

1. Click the filter symbol to the right of the column heading, and then choose (All), (Custom),
(Blanks), (Non blanks), or a specific Trend log.

2. If you choose (Custom), you can define a unique filter, based on your input, in the Custom
AutoFilter dialog. Complete the fields in the dialog and click OK.

Copying and pasting Trend logs

You can select and copy one or more Trend logs from Building Operation and paste that data into a
document, such as a text editor or a spreadsheet.

To copy and paste Trend logs into a document:

1. Select one or more rows in the Mappings tab.

2. Press Ctrl + C or right-click and choose Copy.

3. Open your document and place the cursor where you want to paste.

4. Press Ctrl + V or right-click and choose Paste.

5. The Trend log data appears in the document.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1691


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Finding and opening a Trend log in Building Operation

You can find and open a Trend log with the source tag path.

1. From the document created in the previous step Copy Source Tag(s) from the list.

2. Click in the Building Operation address bar.

3. Press Ctrl + V or right-click and choose Paste, and then press Enter. The Trend log opens.

Running a job manually

1. In the ETL Configuration Job Configuration Tool screen, select a job to run from the Job
Management drop-down list.

2. Click Control. The Job Control tab appears.

3. Click Run Once, and then click OK in the dialog when it appears. Wait until the output dialog
box appears (depending on your system size, this could take up to a few hours).

NOTE: To confirm the ETL job, look to see that the job executed successfully.

If the ETL Engine returns a Job execution failed message, click Open Log Folder in the dialog and
open the error log. Locate the timestamp that corresponds to your job and review the log. Based on
this information, make the appropriate changes to the job and then run the job again.

Running a job as a service

You can configure a job to run as a service. Using this method, the job automatically runs at set
times, based on the settings you provide in the Job tab. Make sure to change the Sleep Time
Between Execution value (in seconds) if you require the service to be run on a schedule different
from the default value of 3600 seconds.

NOTE: Run the service under a dedicated Windows user account.

To configure a dedicated Windows user account for an ETL job service:

1. Create a Windows user account with User access permissions.

NOTE: If the ETL is installed in its default location, C:\Program Files\..., then the
Windows user must have Administrator access.

WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
Use cybersecurity best practices for password creation and management.

Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

1692 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Cybersecurity policies that govern user accounts and access - such as least privilege,
separation of duties - vary from site to site. Work with the facility IT System Administrator to
ensure that user access adheres to the site-specific cybersecurity policies.

2. Add the Windows user account to the PME SQL database server with db_owner rights to the
ION_Data and ION_Network databases.

To configure the ETL job to run as a service:

1. In the ETL Configuration Job Configuration Tool screen, select a job to run from the Job
Management drop-down list.

2. Click Control. The Job Control tab appears.

3. Click Register. ETL creates a registered service under the job name. Click OK in the dialog
when it appears. This option is available only after running a job successfully at least once.

4. Open Windows Services and change the Log On account for the service to the dedicated
Windows account.

5. In ETL Configuration Job Configuration, click Start/Continue to start the service.

6. Click Stop to stop the service or click Unregister to unregister the service for this job.

7. Press OK to save and exit job.

Managing your ETL jobs

You can also switch between jobs, change task order and remove tasks from a job.

Switching between jobs

1. Click OK at the bottom right to save and exit the current job.

2. Select another job in the Job Management drop-down list.

3. Click Edit.

Changing the order of tasks for a job

1. Select a job from the Job Management drop-down list and click Edit.

2. Click the Tasks tab.

3. Highlight the task you want to move from the left pane.

4. Click the Up arrow or Down arrow icon to move the task.

5. Press OK to save and exit job.

Removing a task from a job

1. Select a job from the Job Management drop-down list and click Edit.

2. Click the Tasks tab.

3. Highlight the task you want to remove from the left pane.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1693


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Click the Delete icon. The task is removed from the pane.

5. Press OK to save and exit job.

Measurement mapping for ETL

This table describes the suggested mappings for supported EBO values:

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings

Absolute voltage in dB

dBuV

AbsoluteHumidityMass

kg/kg

lb/lb

Acceleration

meters per second squared m/s²


feet per second squared ft/s²

inches per second squared in/s²


Acidity

pH

Angle

radian rad

Fundamental Current Angle A


Fundamental Current Angle B
deg Fundamental Current Angle C
Fundamental Current Angle N
Fundamental Current Angle G

grad

Angular momentum

joule second Js

Area

square meter m²

square inch in²

square foot ft²

square yard yd²

acre a.

square mile mile²

Capacitance

farad F

Compressibility

meters squared per Newton m²/N

Conductance

1694 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings

siemens S

Conductivity

siemens per meter S/m

Corrosion Rate

m/yr

in/yr

Currency

Energy Cost
Energy Cost AUD
currency1 Energy Cost EUR
Energy Cost GBP
Energy Cost CNY

currency2

currency3

currency4

currency5

currency6

currency7

currency8

currency9

currency10

Current

Current Phase
Average
Current Phase A
A Current Phase B
Current Phase C
Neutral Current
Ground Current

Current Density

A/m² Current Density (A/m^2)

Density

grams per cubic meter g/m³

pounds per cubic inch lb/in³

pounds per cubic foot lb/ft³

Diffusivity

meters squared per second m²/s

foot squared per second ft²/s

Dipole Moment

debye

coulombmeter

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1695


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings

Electrical Field Strength

V/m

Energy

Active Energy Delivered (kWh)


Wh Active Energy Received (kWh)
Active Energy Delivered-Received (kWh)
Water Heat Flow (BTU 59)
Energy Consumption (BTU ISO)
Air Heat Flow (BTU 59)
Air Heat Flow (BTU ISO)
Natural Gas Energy Flow (BTU 59)
Btu
Natural Gas Energy Flow (BTU ISO)
Steam Heat Flow (BTU 59)
Steam Heat Flow (BTU ISO)
Hot Water (Btu)
Gas btus

cal

thermal

tonh

Energy Apparent

Apparent Energy
Received (KVAh)
Vah
Apparent Energy
Delivered-Received (KVAh)

Energy Reactive

Reactive Energy
Delivered (kvarh)
Reactive Energy
Varh
Received (kvarh)
Reactive Energy
Delivered-Received (kvarh)

Enthalpy

J/kg Specific Enthalpy (J/kg)

Btu/lb Specific Enthalpy (BTU 59/lb av)

Enthalpy Dry Air

J/kg dry air Specific Enthalpy Dry Air (J/kg)

Btu/lb dry air Specific Enthalpy Dry Air (BTU 59/lb av)

Entropy

J/K

Flow

Steam Volume Flow Rate (m^3/s)


Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (m^3/s)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (m^3/s)
cubic meters per second m³/s Water Volume Flow Rate (m^3/s)
Air Volume Flow Rate (m^3/s)
Natural Gas Volume Flow Rate (m^3/s)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (m^3/s)

1696 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings


Steam Volume Flow Rate (m^3/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate Supply
(m^3/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return
cubic meters per minute m³/min (m^3/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate (m^3/min)
Air Volume Flow Rate (m^3/min)
Natural Gas Volume Flow Rate (m^3/min)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (m^3/min)
Steam Volume Flow Rate (m^3/h)
Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (m^3/h)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (m^3/h)
cubic meters per hour m³/h Water Volume Flow Rate (m^3/h)
Air Volume Flow Rate (m^3/h)
Natural Gas Volume Flow Rate (m^3/h)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (m^3/h)
Steam Volume Flow Rate(cf/s)
Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (cf/s)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (cf/s)
Water Volume Flow Rate (cf/s)
cubic feet per second ft³/s Air Volume Flow Rate (cf/s)
Air Volume Flow Rate (scf/s)
Natural Gas Volume Flow Rate (cf/s)
Natural Gas Volume Flow Rate (scf/s)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (cf/s)
Steam Volume Flow Rate(cf/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (cf/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (cf/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate (cf/min)
cubic feet per minute ft³/min Air Volume Flow Rate (cf/min)
Air Volume Flow Rate (scf/min)
Natural Gas Volume Flow Rate (cf/min)
Natural Gas Volume Flow Rate (scf/min)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (cf/min)
Steam Volume Flow Rate(cf/h)
Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (cf/h)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (cf/h)
Water Volume Flow Rate (cf/h)
cubic feet per hour ft³/h Air Volume Flow Rate (cf/h)
Air Volume Flow Rate (scf/h)
Natural Gas Volume Flow Rate (cf/h)
Natural Gas Volume Flow Rate (scf/h)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (cf/h)
Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (gal/s)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (gal/s)
gallons per second Usgal/s
Water Volume Flow Rate (gal/s)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (gal/s)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (gal/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (gal/min)
gallons per minute Usgal/min
Water Volume Flow Rate (gal/min)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (gal/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (gal/h)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (gal/h)
gallons per hour Usgal/h
Water Volume Flow Rate (gal/h)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (gal/h)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1697


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings


Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (L/s)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (L/s)
liters per second l/s
Water Volume Flow Rate (L/s)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (L/s)
Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (L/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (L/min)
liters per minute l/min
Water Volume Flow Rate (L/min)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (L/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (L/h)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (L/h)
liters per hour l/h
Water Volume Flow Rate (L/h)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (L/h)
Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (fl oz
imp/s)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (fl oz
liq oz/s imp/s)
Water Volume Flow Rate (fl oz imp/s)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (fl oz
imp/s)
Water Volume Flow Rate Supply (gal
imp/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate Return (gal
imperial gallons per minute Ukgal/min imp/min)
Water Volume Flow Rate (gal imp/min)
Wastewater Volume Flow Rate (gal
imp/min)

Flow Rate Mass

g/s

lb/s

oz/s

g/min

g/h

lb/min

Uston/h

Force

lbf

Frequency

Frequency (Hz)
Frequency (MHz)
Hz
Frequency (kHz)
Frequency (MHz)

cycles/min

cycles/h

/s

/min

/h

%/s

1698 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings

Grammage (GSM)

Grammage (GSM) (g/m²)


Grammage (GSM) (mg/m²)
g/m²
Grammage (GSM) (kg/m²)
Grammage (GSM) (Mg/m²)

Heat Capacity

J/(g·C) Specific Heat Capacity (J/(g deg C))

Specific Heat Capacity (BTU 59/(lb av


Btu/(lb·F)
deg F))

Heat Degree Days

°Cdays Heating Degree Days Celsius

°Fdays Heating Degree Days Fahrenheit

Heat Flux

W/m²

Btu/(s·ft²)

W/ft²

Heat Transfer Coefficient

W/(m²·K) Heat Transfer Coefficient (W/(m^2 K))

Heat Transfer Coefficient (BTU 59/(s ft^2


Btu/(s·ft²·K)
K))

Humidity

Relative Humidity (Hour Interval)


Air Relative Humidity Supply (percent)
% Rh Air Relative Humidity Return (percent)
Air Relative Humidity Mixed (percent)
Weather Relative Humidity

Illuminance

Illuminance (lx)
Illuminance (Mlx)
Illuminance (Klx)
Illuminance (Mlx)
lux lx Global Horizontal Illuminance (Hour
Interval)
Direct Normal Illuminance (Hour Interval)
Diffuse Horizontal Illuminance (Hour
Interval)

ft·cd

Illuminance (H)
Illuminance (mH)
Candelas per sq. meter H
Illuminance (kH)
Illuminance (MH)

Inductance

henry H

Length

meter m

inch in

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1699


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings

foot ft

yard yd

mile mile

Linear Momentum

Newton Second Ns

Luminance

candelas per square meter cd/m²

Luminous Flux

lm

Luminous Intensity

cd

Magnetic Dipole Moment

A·m²

Magnetic Field Strength

A/m

Magnetic Flux

Wb

Magnetic Flux Density

Mass

gram g

pound lb

ounce oz

carat

grains

USTon

Mass Transfer Coefficient

(mol/(s·m²))/
(mol/m³)
(mol/(s·ft²))/
(mol/ft³)

Mass Velocity

g/(s·m²)

lb/(s·ft²)

Moles

mole mol

lbmol

Moment of Inertia

1700 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings

g/m²

lb/ft²

Momentum

g·m/s

lb·ft/s

NoCategory

NoUnit

Percent Obscuration

%/m

%/ft

Percentage

Damper Position (percent)


%
Valve Position (percent)
CO₂Concentration Indoor (ppm)
ppm
CO₂Concentration Outdoor (ppm)

ppb

Phase

deg

Power

Active Power Phase B (kW)


W Active Power Phase A (kW)
Active Power Phase C (kW)
Apparent Power Phase A (KVA)
VA Apparent Power Phase B (KVA)
Apparent Power Phase C (KVA)

Btu/s

hp

Water Heat Flow Rate (BTU 59/h)


Water Heat Flow Rate (BTU ISO/h)
Energy Consumption Rate (BTU 59/h)
Energy Consumption Rate (BTU ISO/h)
Air Heat Flow Rate (BTU 59/h)
Air Heat Flow Rate (BTU ISO/h)
Btu/h
Natural Gas Energy Flow Rate (BTU
59/h)
Natural Gas Energy Flow Rate (BTU
ISO/h)
Steam Heat Flow Rate (BTU 59/h)
Steam Heat Flow Rate (BTU ISO/h)

tons refrig

Power Factor

Power Factor Signed Phase A


cosf Power Factor Signed Phase B
Power Factor Signed Phase C

Power Reactive

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1701


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings


Reactive Power Phase A (kvar)
var Reactive Power Phase B (kvar)
Reactive Power Phase C (kvar)

Pressure

Air Pressure (N/m^2)


Natural Gas Pressure (N/m^2)
Steam Pressure (N/m^2)
N/m²
Water Pressure Supply (N/m^2)
Water Pressure Return (N/m^2)
Water Pressure (N/m^2)
Air Pressure (Pa)
Natural Gas Pressure (Pa)
Steam Pressure (Pa)
Pa Water Pressure Supply (Pa)
Water Pressure Return (Pa)
Water Pressure (Pa)
Water Pressure Differential (kPa)
Air Pressure psi Natural Gas Pressure
(psi)
Steam pressure (psi)
psi
Water Pressure Supply (psi)
Water Pressure Return (psi)
Water Pressure (psi)
Air Pressure (m Hg)
Natural Gas Pressure (N/m^2)
Steam Pressure (N/m^2)
mHg
Water Pressure Supply (N/m^2)
Water Pressure Return (N/m^2)
Water Pressure (N/m^2
Air Pressure (in H2O)
Natural Gas Pressure (in H2O)
Steam Pressure (in H2O)
inH₂0
Water Pressure Supply (in H2O)
Water Pressure Return (in H2O)
Water Pressure (in H2O)
Air Pressure (bar)
Natural Gas Pressure (bar)
Steam Pressure (bar)
Water Pressure Supply (bar)
bar
Water Pressure Return (bar)
Water Pressure (bar)
Water Pressure Differential (bar)
Air Pressure Absolute (bar)
Air Pressure (m H2O)
Natural Gas Pressure (m H2O)
Steam Pressure (m H2O)
mH₂0
Water Pressure Supply (m H2O)
Water Pressure Return (m H2O)
Water Pressure (m H2O)
Air Pressure (in Hg)
Natural Gas Pressure (in Hg)
Steam Pressure (in Hg)
inHg
Water Pressure Supply (in Hg)
Water Pressure Return (in Hg)
Water Pressure (in Hg)

db (SPL) Sound Pressure Level (dB)

1702 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings

Pressure Drop Per Length

Air Pressure Drop Per Length (Pa/m)


Natural Gas Pressure Drop Per Length
(Pa/m)
Steam Pressure Drop Per Length (Pa/m)
Pa/m Water Pressure Supply Drop Per Length
(Pa/m)
Water Pressure Return Drop Per Length
(Pa/m)
Water Pressure Drop Per Length (Pa/m)
Air Pressure Drop Per Length (psi/ft)
Natural Gas Pressure Drop Per Length
(psi/ft)
Steam Pressure Drop Per Length (psi/ft)
psi/ft Water Pressure Supply Drop Per Length
(psi/ft)
Water Pressure Return Drop Per Length
(psi/ft)
Water Pressure Drop Per Length (psi/ft)

Resistance

ohm Ω Resistance
Resistivity

ohm meter Ωm

Specific Entropy

J(g·K)

Btu/(lb·R)

J/(kg·K)

Specific Humidity

g H₂0/kg dry air

Specific Volume

m³/g

ft³/lb

Surface Energy Density

J/m²

J/ft²

W/(h·m²)

W/(h·ft²)

Surface Tension

N/m²

lbf/ft

Temperature

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1703


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings


Weather Temperature Celsius
Water Temperature (deg C)
Water Temperature Supply (deg C)
Water Temperature Return (deg C)
Water Temperature Mixed (deg C)
Air Temperature (deg C)
Air Temperature Return (deg C)
°C
Air Temperature Supply (deg C)
Steam Temperature (deg C)
Compressed Air Temperature (deg C)
Natural Gas Temperature (deg C)
Steam Temperature (deg C)
Ambient Temperature Celsius
Temperature Celsius

Weather Temperature Fahrenheit


Water Temperature (deg F)
Water Temperature Supply (deg F)
Water Temperature Return (deg F)
Water Temperature Mixed (deg F)
Air Temperature (deg F)
Air Temperature Return (deg F)
°F
Air Temperature Supply (deg F)
Steam Temperature (deg F)
Compressed Air Temperature (deg F)
Natural Gas Temperature (deg F)
Steam Temperature (deg F)
Ambient Temperature Fahrenheit
Temperature Fahrenheit

Temperature Diff

Weather Temperature Differential (deg C)


Water Temperature Differential (deg C)
Water Temperature Supply Differential
(deg C)
Water Temperature Return Differential
(deg C)
Δ°C
Water Temperature Mixed Differential
(deg C)
Air Temperature Differential (deg C)
Steam Temperature Differential (deg C)
Temperature Differential (deg C)
Ambient Temperature Differential (deg C)

ΔK

Weather Temperature Differential (deg F)


Water Temperature Differential (deg F)
Water Temperature Supply Differential
(deg F)
Water Temperature Return Differential
(deg F)
Δ°F
Water Temperature Mixed Differential
(deg F)
Air Temperature Differential (deg F)
Steam Temperature Differential (deg F)
Temperature Differential (deg F)
Ambient Temperature Differential (deg F)

Temperature Rate of Change

1704 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings


Air Temperature Mixed Rate of Change
(deg C/min)
Air Temperature Rate of Change (deg
C/min)
Air Temperature Return Rate of Change
(deg C/min)
Air Temperature Supply Rate of Change
(deg C/min)
Ambient Temperature Rate of Change
(deg C/min)
Steam Temperature Rate of Change
(deg C/min)
°C/min
Temperature Rate of Change (deg
C/min)
Water Temperature Mixed Rate of
Change (deg C/min)
Water Temperature Rate of Change (deg
C/min)
Water Temperature Return Rate of
Change (deg C/min)
Water Temperature Supply Rate of
Change (deg C/min)
Weather Temperature Rate of Change
(deg C/min

K/min

Air Temperature Mixed Rate of Change


(deg F/min)
Air Temperature Rate of Change (deg
F/min)
Air Temperature Return Rate of Change
(deg F/min)
Air Temperature Supply Rate of Change
(deg F/min)
Ambient Temperature Rate of Change
(deg F/min)
Steam Temperature Rate of Change
°F/min (deg F/min)
Temperature Rate of Change (deg F/min)
Water Temperature Mixed Rate of
Change (deg F/min)
Water Temperature Rate of Change (deg
F/min)
Water Temperature Return Rate of
Change (deg F/min)
Water Temperature Supply Rate of
Change (deg F/min)
Weather Temperature Rate of Change
(deg F/min)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1705


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings


Air Temperature Mixed Rate of Change
(deg C/h)
Air Temperature Rate of Change (deg
C/h)
Air Temperature Return Rate of Change
(deg C/h)
Air Temperature Supply Rate of Change
(deg C/h)
Ambient Temperature Rate of Change
(deg C/h)
Steam Temperature Rate of Change
°C/h (deg C/h)
Temperature Rate of Change (deg C/h)
Water Temperature Mixed Rate of
Change (deg C/h)
Water Temperature Rate of Change (deg
C/h)
Water Temperature Return Rate of
Change (deg C/h)
Water Temperature Supply Rate of
Change (deg C/h)
Weather Temperature Rate of Change
(deg C/h)

K/h

Air Temperature Mixed Rate of Change


(deg F/h)
Air Temperature Rate of Change (deg
F/h)
Air Temperature Return Rate of Change
(deg F/h)
Air Temperature Supply Rate of Change
(deg F/h)
Ambient Temperature Rate of Change
(deg F/h)
Steam Temperature Rate of Change
°F/h (deg F/h)
Temperature Rate of Change (deg F/h)
Water Temperature Mixed Rate of
Change (deg F/h)
Water Temperature Rate of Change (deg
F/h)
Water Temperature Return Rate of
Change (deg F/h)
Water Temperature Supply Rate of
Change (deg F/h)
Weather Temperature Rate of Change
(deg F/h)

Thermal Conductance

W/(m²·K)

Thermal Conductivity

Air Thermal Conductivity (W/(m K))


Water Thermal Conductivity (W/(m K))
W/(m²·K/m) Steam Thermal Conductivity (W/(m K))
Natural Gas Thermal Conductivity (W/(m
K))

1706 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings


Air Thermal Conductivity (BTU 59/(h ft
deg F))
Water Thermal Conductivity (BTU 59/(h ft
deg F))
Btu/(h·ft²·F/ft)
Steam Thermal Conductivity (BTU 59/(h ft
deg F))
Natural Gas Thermal Conductivity (BTU
59/(h ft deg F))

Thermal Linear Expansion

m/C

in/F

ft/F

Thermal Pressure

psi/oF

Thermal Volume Expansion

m³/C

in³/F

ft³/F

Thermoelectric Power

V/K

Time

year

month

week

day

min

Time Accuracy

s/h

Torque

Nm

lbf·in

lbf·ft

Turbidity

NTU

Velocity

m/s Air Velocity (m/s)

m/h Air Velocity (m/h)

mile/h Air Velocity (mile/h)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1707


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Descriptive Name Unit Name Unit Symbol Suggested Mappings

ft/s Air Velocity (ft/s)

ft/min Air Velocity (ft/min)

m/min Air Velocity (m/min)

Velocity Angular

radians per second rad/s

revolutions per minute RPM

Voltage

Average Voltage Line-to-Neutral


Voltage Phases AB
Voltage Phases BC
V Voltage Phases CA
Voltage Phases AN
Voltage Phases BN
Voltage Phases CN

Volume

Air Volume (m^3)


Steam Volume (m^3)
m³ Wastewater Volume (m^3)
Water Volume (m^3)
Natural Gas Volume (m^3)

in³

Air Volume (cubft)


Steam Volume (cf)
ft³ Wastewater Volume (cf)
Water Volume (cf)
Gas Volume (cf)
Wastewater Volume (gal)
Usgal
Water Volume (gal)
Wastewater Volume (L)
litre
Water Volume (L)

1708 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Configuring the PME EWS server for HTTPS


By default, the EWS server in PME is configured for HTTP client connections.

To configure the EWS server for HTTPS client connections:

1. On the PME server, open the web.config file for editing, for example in Notepad. You can
find this file in ...\Power Monitoring Expert\applications\EWS.

2. Search for the <binding name="DataExchange_BP11Binding"> element in the file.


Find the <httpTransport ... /> child element and change it to <httpsTransport
... />.

3. Search for the <behavior name="DataExchange_BP11Behavior"> element in the file.


Find the <serviceMetadata httpGetEnabled="true" /> child element and add the
httpsGetEnabled="true" attribute. After the change the element should look like this:
<serviceMetadata httpGetEnabled="true" httpsGetEnabled="true"/>.

4. Save the web.config file. Close the file.

5. Restart Internet Information Services (IIS) on this computer.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1709


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring the PME EWS server regional setting


By default, the EWS regional setting in PME is set to use the PME system culture.

NOTE: For system to system data exchange using EWS, set the regional setting to INVARIANT.

To configure the EWS server regional setting:

1. On the PME server, open the web.config file for editing, for example in Notepad. You can
find this file in ...\Power Monitoring Expert\applications\EWS.

2. Search for the <add key="RegionalSetting" value="" /> element in the file.

3. Set the value property to a valid regional setting (for example en-US, en-CA, fr-FR, de-DE,
and so on), or to INVARIANT.

4. Save the web.config file.

5. Close the file.

6. Restart Internet Information Services (IIS) on this computer.

1710 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Deploying and configuring a Multi-input Setpoint Display Bar graphic component


You can create and deploy a Multi-input Setpoint Display Bar graphic component in the Graphics
Editor, and then bind and view the graphic object in Building Operation Workstation.

To create the graphic component:

1. Navigate to:
<Extract path>\EBO Integration Files\Graphics Editor\Components\
and double-click the " PME- Generic Components" file. The new thermometer graphic
component is added to the Building Operation Graphics Editor library.

2. Open the Building Operation Graphics Editor.

3. From the PME– Generic Components category at the left, drag the Power Measurement
Display Bar component onto a new page. The Multi-input Setpoint Display Bar component
appears.

4. Select the component. In the Properties pane at the lower right, change the parameter settings
as needed (name, min/max, setpoint values, and so on). Make sure that the settings make
logical sense (for example, all setpoints are within the min/max range and in the following
order: SP4>SP3>SP2>SP1).

5. Save the new graphic component page as a .tgml file.

To deploy the graphic component:

1. Log in to Building Operation Workstation.

2. In the System Tree, select a Server, and then choose File > New > Graphic, enter a name for
the file, and click Create. The new graphic file name appears in the System Tree.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1711


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3. In the System Tree, right-click the graphic file name and select Properties.

4. In the Basic tab, click the button next to the File field and navigate to the .tgml file, select the
file, click Open and then OK. The Multi-input Setpoint Display Bar now appears in the Building
Operation Workstation.

5. In the System Tree, select the Server, and then choose New > Value. The Create Object
dialog appears. Repeat the above steps four times to create four new values.

6. Select Analog Value and complete the fields for Name, Location, and Description as needed,
and then click Create for each new value. The four new Analog Values now appear.

7. For each value, double-click the name after adding it. Click the up or down arrows to select a
number, and then click the Value button to select Forced or Force value for the object. Click
Yes to save the object.

8. To bind the graphic object to the value you just created, in the System Tree, right-click the
graphic file name and select Properties.

9. In the Bindings tab, enter the location of the graphic object in the object value field and click
OK. The Multi-input Setpoint Display Bar now shows the preset setpoint values and bound
values. The reading bar height and color change accordingly.

To verify the bind of the graphic component:

1712 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

1. In the System Tree, right-click on the new graphic file name and click Edit. The Graphics
Editor opens.

2. Revise some graphic component parameters (for example, min/max, setpoint values, or
colors), save the file, and return to Building Operation Workstation. Your changes appear on
the Graphics page in Building Operation Workstation.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1713


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Deploying and configuring a Single-input Thermometer graphic component


You can create and deploy a Single-input Thermometer graphic component in the Graphics Editor,
and then bind and view the graphic object in Building Operation Workstation.

To create the graphic component:

1. Navigate to:
<Extract path>\EBO Integration Files\Graphics Editor\Components\
and double-click the "PME- Generic Components" file. The new thermometer graphic
component is added to the Building Operation Graphics Editor library.

2. Open the Building Operation Graphics Editor.

3. From the PME– Generic Components category at the left, drag the Setpoint Display Bar
component onto a new page. The Single-input Thermometer bar component appears.

4. Select the component. In the Properties pane at the lower right, change the parameter settings
as needed (name, min/max, setpoint values, and so on). Make sure that the settings make
logical sense (for example, all setpoints are within the min/max range and in the following
order: SP4>SP3>SP2>SP1).

5. Save the new graphic component page as a .tgml file.

To deploy the graphic component:

1. Log in to Building Operation Workstation.

2. In the System Tree, select a Server, and then choose File > New > Graphic, enter a name for
the file, and click Create. The new graphic file name appears in the System Tree.

1714 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

3. In the System Tree, right-click the graphic file name and select Properties.

4. In the Basic tab, click the button next to the File field and navigate to the .tgml file, select the
file, click Open and then OK. The Single-input Thermometer bar now appears in the Building
Operation Workstation.

5. In the System Tree, select the Server, and then choose New > Value. The Create Object
dialog appears.

6. Select Analog Value and complete the fields for Name, Location, and Description as needed,
and then click Create. The Analog Value now appears.

7. Double-click the value name after adding it. Click the up or down arrows to select a number,
and then click the Value button to select Forced or Force value for the object. Click Yes to
save the object.

8. To bind the graphic object to the value you just created, in the System Tree, right-click the
graphic file name and select Properties.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1715


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

9. In the Bindings tab, enter the location of the graphic object in the object value field and click
OK. The Single-input Thermometer bar now shows the preset setpoint values and bound
values. The reading bar height and color change accordingly.

To verify the bind of the graphic component:

1. In the System Tree, right-click on the new graphic file name and click Edit. The Graphics
Editor opens.

2. Revise some graphic component parameters (for example, min/max, setpoint values, or
colors), save the file, and return to Building Operation Workstation. Your changes appear on
the Graphics page in Building Operation Workstation.

1716 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Exposing custom device driver measurements through EWS


If you create a custom device driver in PME using the Device Type Editor tool, you need to take
extra steps to expose the measurements from this device through EWS. The default device drivers
in PME and many of the downloadable add-on drivers have their measurements exposed by default.

WARNING
INACCURATE DATA RESULTS
• Do not incorrectly configure the software or the devices.
• Do not base your maintenance or service actions solely on messages and information
displayed by the software.
• Do not rely solely on software messages and reports to determine if the system is functioning
correctly or meeting all applicable standards and requirements.
• Consider the implications of unanticipated transmission delays or failures of communications
links.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, equipment
damage, or permanent loss of data.

To expose custom measurements from a custom device type through EWS:

1. Create a DTE driver. In this example, a driver file was created for “My_DTE” device with two
registers, “My_Label_1” and “My_Label_2”.

2. Go in the following folder: C:\Program Files (x86)\Schneider Electric\Power


Monitoring Expert\system\WebServices\Extensions.

3. Select any XML file (for example: “Types_Measurements_8000.xml”), copy and paste it to the
same folder. Rename it to the newly created DTE "Device Type" name, “My_DTE.xml”

4. Open the XML file with a file editor. The structure of the XML resembles the following:

<?xml version="1.0"?>
<MeasurementStores xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-
instance" xmlns:xsd="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema"> <Store
Name="8000" DisplayName="PM8000" Type="8000" SubType="Common">
...
...
<Measurement IONReferenceName="Active Energy Delivered"
MeasurementName="Real Energy Into the Load" MeasurementUnit="kWh"
Exposed="true" IsManual="false" Handle="22704" Format="double" />
<Measurement IONReferenceName="Active Energy Delivered Interval"
MeasurementName="Real Energy Into the Load Interval"
MeasurementUnit="kWh" Exposed="false" IsManual="false"
Handle="24483" Format="double" />
...
...
</Store>
</MeasurementStores>

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1717


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

5. Modify the bold sections like the following to match your "Device Type" name as well as your
Register "Label". Make sure to change all the bold ones to what fits the new DTE, delete the
"Handle" section and specify the format as necessary.

<?xml version="1.0"?>
<MeasurementStores xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-
instance" xmlns:xsd="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema"> <Store
Name="My_DTE" DisplayName="My_DTE" Type="My_DTE" SubType="Common">
...
...
<Measurement IONReferenceName="My_Label_1" MeasurementName="My_
Label_1" MeasurementUnit="My_Unit_1" Exposed="true"
IsManual="false" Format="Boolean" /> <Measurement
IONReferenceName="My_Label_2" MeasurementName="My_Label_2"
MeasurementUnit="My_Unit_2" Exposed="true" IsManual="false"
Format="double" />
...
...
</Store>
</MeasurementStores>

NOTE: When editing the XML file, format “Boolean” should be used for all Boolean values
and format “Double” for all analog values.

6. After completing the new xml file, go to Management Console > Tools > System and click
Update EWS Server. It will take some time for the server to propagate the change via web
service. An IIS and/or computer restart might even be required.

7. The custom registers/measurements are now expose via EWS. See Hosting EWS values in
Building Operation for information on this topic.

1718 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Manual integration steps without using the web application Integration Utility settings
This section describes how to manually integrate Building Operation and PME without using the
web application Integration Utility settings. Sometimes manual steps are more convenient for
certain tasks, for example: making minor changes to the system.

NOTE: The manual steps cannot fully replace the web application Integration Utility settings for an
PME/EBO Integration deployment. When deploying the PME/EBO Integration, you must use the
web application Integration Utility settings to create the Diagram links.

The following manual steps are described in this section:

• Creating PME users for Building Operation

• Creating Diagrams, Reports, and Dashboards links in Building Operation

• Hosting EWS values in Building Operation

Creating PME users for Building Operation

You need to create two different PME users for the integration with Building Operation:

1. A user for the EWS connection between the two applications.

2. A user for the Building Operation connection to the PME Web applications (Dashboards and
Reports).

For information on how to create the EWS user, see Setting up EWS credentials.

For information on how to create the user to access the Web Applications, see "Adding a standard
user" in the EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert System Guide or the PME Web Applications
Help.

Creating Diagrams, Reports, and Dashboards links in Building Operation

Create links to the PME Diagrams, Reports, and Dashboards applications in Building Operation

To create links in Building Operation:

1. On the PME database server, open Microsoft SQL Server Management Studio.

2. Run the following SQL script to enable the multi-use token:


EXEC
ApplicationModules.Configuration.WriteConfigurationValue 'Web
Framework','Server','MultiUseTokenEnabled',NULL,'true',
'GlobalSetting'

3. After the authentication is enabled, use a web browser to navigate to:


https://<YourServerName>/Web/MUT.

4. Provide supervisor-level login information in the dialog and click OK. This opens the Generate
Authentication URL page.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1719


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

5. In Generate Authentication URL, enter the appropriate information.

Automatic Authentication: Provide the PME account login for an Operator level user
account in the User name and Password fields.

Windows Authentication: Use the current Windows user account as a login. You must add
this Windows user to PME. See User Manager for details on how to add a user in PME.

Destination URL Type: Leave the default settings.

Destination Protocol: Choose HTTP or HTTPS.

Destination Host Name: Enter the PME server name here. Use the fully-qualified server
domain name.

Destination URL:
/Web for the PMEWeb Applications Settings page.
/Dashboard for the PME Dashboards page.
/Reporter for the PME Web Reports page.

6. Click Generate URL. The URL will appear in the Authentication URL box.

7. Log into Building Operation.

8. In Building Operation Workstation, create a new hyperlink for the URL generated in step 6
above.

9. Repeat steps 3 - 7 for each of the web applications.

Hosting EWS values in Building Operation

In order to integrate values from PME with Building Operation, you must:

1. Create the EWS interface in Building Operation Workstation.

2. Host the PME values for that interface.

Configuring the EWS Server


Before you create an EWS interface in Building Operation Workstation, you must first enable the
EWS service. (The EWS service is disabled by default in PME.)

To enable the EWS service:

1720 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

1. Navigate to ...\“Power Monitoring Expert Folder”\ Applications\EWS\

2. Open Web.Config in a text editor, such as Notepad.

3. Search for <add key="EWSEnabled" value="0" /> and change the value from "0" to
"1". (Conversely, to disable the EWS service, change the value from "1" to "0".)

4. Search for <add key="RealTimeRefreshRate" value="20" /> and make sure the
value is set to "20".

5. Save and close >Web.config. The EWS service is now enabled and with the correct refresh
rate. (The service can be enabled or disabled at any time by editing the Web.config file.)

Updating the EWS server


To update the EWS server in PME:

NOTE: Run Management Console as Administrator user. To do this, right-click the Management
Console program icon and select Run as administrator from the context menu. If you do not run
it as Administrator, then certain tools such as Update EWS Server are not functional.

1. Open Management Console.

2. Select Tools > System > Update EWS Server. A dialog box appears, indicating that the
update to EWS server configuration is successful.

3. Click OK.

NOTE: For any changes in the PME Management Console, such as adding a new device or
renaming an existing device, you must 1) update the EWS server, and 2) regenerate a Vista
Diagram before using the Integration Utility.

Modifying which measurements EWS Server exposes by default

NOTE: The following step is optional, however, it becomes necessary if you want to change the
list of measurements that the EWS server exposes by default.

The EWS Server relies on two control files to define which devices are exposed and which
measurements are exposed for those devices.

• The following file contains the list of all PME devices:


...\<Power Monitoring Expert
Folder>\config\WebServices\Devices.Measurements.xml

If you do not want a device to be exposed, delete the complete line of an entry.

• The following file contains the list of measurement exposed for all supported devices types:
...\<Power Monitoring Expert
Folder>\config\WebServices\Types.Measurements.xml

To expose or un-expose a specific measurement for a specific device type, do the following:
a. Browse to that specific device type.

b. Identify the measurement you wish to expose.

c. Set the “Exposed” parameter to “true” to expose or "false" to un-expose.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1721


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

d. Set the “IsManual” parameter to “true”.

If you do not set “IsManual” to true, the next time you run Update EWS Server from the
Management Console, your configuration will be overwritten by the system default.

e. When you finish, select Tools > System > Update EWS Server to make the changes.

Creating and hosting the EWS interface in Building Operation Workstation


You can manually create the EWS interface in Building Operation Workstation and then host PME
values so that you can browse those values from within Building Operation Workstation.

To manually create a new EWS web service interface:

1. Log in to Building Operation.

2. In the System Tree, right-click on Server, and then click New > Interface.

The Create Object: EcoStruxure Web Service dialog appears.

1722 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

3. Enter a name and description for the new web interface in the respective fields and click Next.
The Connection Information dialog appears.

4. Enter the server name or the IP address where PME is hosted in the EWS Server field.

5. Leave unchanged the values for Protocol and EWS Communication Port.

6. Enter EWS/DataExchange.svc?wsdl in the EWS Path field.

7. Enter the same User name and Password that you created for EWS.

8. Click Create. The new web service now appears in the System Tree. Next, proceed to host
the new web service.

To manually host the new EWS web service:

1. In the System Tree, navigate to and expand the Hardware folder.

2. Expand, and then select the newly-created interface for which you want to host values.

3. Right-click Root or any underlying level/devices and choose Host EWS Objects. The Select
EWS Interface dialog appears.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1723


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4. Choose the appropriate interface location, and then click Select.


Depending on the number of devices and measurements, this task can take up to an hour.

Repeat this step for any item you want to host.

The web service is now hosted and appears in the System Tree.

5. After the hosting completes, click the new EWS web service and browse the values in the List
View tab at the right.

To add additional columns of values in the List View tab:

1. In the List View tab, right-click on the Name/Description heading and select Add/Remove
columns.

2. Select the check box next to any column type you want to add to the List View, and then click
OK. The new column types and their respective values now appear in the List View tab.

NOTE: If you find that some measurements for a device are missing from the list of
measurements, do the following:
Check to make sure that all of the measurements you want for that device are exposed; refer to
“Modifying which measurements EWS Server exposes by default”.
If all of the measurements you want for the device are exposed but still do not appear in the list of
measurements, and then you will need to repeat the procedure to create and host the EWS
interface. (PME takes some time between enabling the EWS server and when the EWS client
shows the exposed measurements.) See “Creating and hosting the EWS interface in Building
Operation Workstation”.

NOTE: If you find that EWS measurements are displayed in an incorrect format, check and edit
the EWS regional setting. See Configuring the PME EWS server regional setting for more
information.

1724 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Configuring Alarms
1. Log in to Building Operation.

2. Alarms for Architecture 2 are automatically enabled after they are imported and can be viewed
along with all other alarms within the Alarms pane at the bottom of the dialog.

3. To configure the alarms associated with the devices for the EWS Client, in the System Tree,

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1725


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

right click on EWS Client and select Properties. The EWS Client dialog appears.

4. Complete the various fields and select the options you want on this dialog, and then click OK.
The system saves your configuration changes.

The Building Operation “Sum Alarm” is an ideal way to leverage alarms flowing from EWS. It allows
the users to create actions and notifications on filtered PME alarms. Refer to the EcoStruxure
Building Operation System Reference Guide for more information.

1726 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Terms and definitions


Activation ID: Each license definition has one or more features included in a specific license type.
An activation ID allows you to license the features included in that license type. Only one Activation
ID can be activated in the License Configuration Tool at a time.

American National Standards Institute (ANSI): The primary organization for the development of
technology standards in the United States. ANSI works with industry groups and is the U.S.
member of the International Organization for Standardization (ISO) and the International
Electrotechnical Commission (IEC).

EcoStruxure Building Operation: An integration platform for monitoring, control, and


management of energy, lighting, fire safety, security and HVAC of buildings.

Entitlement ID: A new entitlement is generated for each Purchase Order. The entitlement is sent
by email and includes the Activation ID.

HTTP: This protocol is not secure and is subject to “man-in-the-middle” and eavesdropping attacks
that can allow attackers to gain access to website accounts and sensitive information.

HTTPS: This protocol provides secure communication over a computer network, with especially
wide deployment on the Internet. It results from layering the Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) on
top of the SSL/TLS protocol, thus adding the security capabilities of SSL/TLS to standard HTTP
communications. HTTPS provides authentication of the website and associated web server with
which one is communicating and thereby protects against “man-in-the-middle” attacks. Additionally,
HTTPS provides bidirectional encryption of communications between a client and server. HTTPS
creates a secure channel over insecure, unencrypted networks, such as Wi-Fi networks. HTTPS is
designed to withstand attacks and is considered secure against attacks (with the exception of older
deprecated versions of SSL). The encryption within HTTPS is intended to provide benefits like
confidentiality, integrity and identity. Your information remains confidential because only your
browser and your server can decrypt the traffic. Integrity protects the data from being modified
without your knowledge.

International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC): The primary organization for the development
of International Standards and Conformity Assessment for all electrical, electronic and related
technologies.

License Configuration Tool: All Power Monitoring Expert licenses are activated here. The
License Configuration Tool will also indicate the current state of trial and purchased licenses.

License Portal: The web portal hosted by Schneider Electric (https://schneider-


electric.flexnetoperations.com/flexnet/operationsportal/logon.do) where the licenses are registered
during activation. During an on-line activation, the License Configuration Tool will connect to the
portal automatically. However, during an off-line activation, the user will need to connect to the
portal from an alternate PC or a smart phone.

License Returns: Once activated, a license is “locked” to its host computer (physical or virtual),
and therefore can only be activated on one machine at a time. Returning the license simply means
reversing the activation process that is, “unlocking” the license from its host, thereby making it
available to be activated again, either on another host or the same host.

Management Console “About” Box: This is the first place to check to help ensure that the
licensing components are functioning correctly. It will indicate which modules are licensed or made
available through the Trial.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1727


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Monitoring Expert: A power management software solution for energy suppliers and
consumers. It allows you to manage energy information from metering and control devices installed
in your facility or other remote locations. The product offers control capabilities and comprehensive
power quality and reliability analysis to help you reduce energy-related costs.

1728 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Web security changes


The Generate Authentication URL page allows for generating destination URL types that can be
used in Building Operation. This section provides instructions for enabling the page and describes
the function of the various components.

User authentication

PME Web applications require user authentication to launch. There are multiple methods to access
a PME Web application from inside another EcoStruxure supervisor software:

• Manual PME Authentication: The user must enter PME user credentials into a login window
before a PME Web application can launch. These credentials are then cached for the rest of the
PME session.

• Automatic PME Authentication: (less secure) Specific URL addresses are created for the
target PME web application. When one of these PME URLs is used to launch a PME Web
application from another supervisory software, PME automatically allows access without
prompting the user to enter PME credentials. This method provides a seamless user
experience, but it does not provide the security level of the Manual Authentication method. For
security reasons, supervisor-level user names cannot be used.

• Windows Authentication: (more secure) Logs the user into PME using their current Windows
credentials. This method provides a seamless user experience and is more secure.

NOTE: The Windows Authentication option is more secure but requires that Power Monitoring
Expert has been configured with Windows Active Directory users and user groups.

When testing the generated authentication URL, test the URL in a separate browser session, not
just in a separate tab in the current browser. Otherwise, your current login credentials may be used,
or you may be logged out of this page altogether.

To open a new browser session in Internet Explorer, open the File menu and select New Session. If
you are using Chrome, open a new incognito window.

Setting Up User Authentication with Windows Active Directory in Building Operation

TIP: For information on setting up user authentication with Windows Active Directory in PME, see
Adding a Windows user and Adding a Windows group.

To link Windows Active Directory to a Building Operation Domain:

1. Log on to WorkStation

2. Open Control Panel

3. Click Domains

4. Click Add

5. Give it a name, then click Next

6. In the Authentication window, type the Active Directory Windows domain name (for example,
Example.org). Click Next.

7. Do not add domain members. Click Next.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1729


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

8. Leave the default Domain Policies of 9 login attempts

9. Click Create

To add the Active Directory user groups to the Building Operation Domain:

1. In the System view, right-click the Groups in the new Domain

2. Click New > User Account Group

3. Ignore the Users page. Click Next.

4. Add the default workspace. Click Next.

5. (optional) adjust the policies.

6. click ... for the Windows group name field.

7. Select the AD user group from the list and click OK.

8. Click Create.

To give the User Group permissions in Building Operation:

1. Open the user group.

2. Select the Permissions tab

3. Click + to add a path permissions line

4. Assign read permissions (or more, if needed).

5. Save the changes

To log on to WorkStation with a Windows account:

1. Log into Windows / Remote Desktop with the Windows user

2. Open WorkStation and enter your Windows credentials or select to log on as the currently
signed-in Windows account. Click Log on.

1730 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Trends references
This section contains reference information related to configuring Trends.
Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Configuring a trend

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1731


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring a trend
Configuring General settings
To configure general settings:

1. In the Trend Setup dialog, on the General tab, enter a title for the trend.

2. To add a new data series, click Add under Data Series. This opens the Add Data Series
dialog.

3. To edit an existing series, select it, and then click Edit. This opens the Edit Data Series
dialog.

4. In Add (or Edit) Data Series, click a source in the Sources area to select it.

You can select sources organized by Devices or Hierarchy Views. You can use the Search
Sources field to find entries by source, group name, or a combination of group and source
names.

(Optional) Click Show Advanced to have the option of showing only Devices, only Hierarchy
Views, or both.

5. For the selected source, expand a measurement type, for example Voltage, and click the
specific measurement you want to include in your trend, for example Voltage A-B.

The measurements are listed in alphabetical order by measurement category. You can use the
Search Measurements field to find a specific measurement category or measurement.

(Optional) Click Show Advanced to open options for filtering the measurements.

Select Display only Measurements with historical data to narrow the measurement
choices for the selected source.

6. (Optional) Select Display Name if you want to enter a series name of your choice for trend
data purposes. By default, a series name is a combination of source and measurement
information formatted as group.source measurement, for example BldgA.meterA
Voltage A-B.

7. (Optional) Select Display Units and enter a unit description of your choice.

8. You can modify the following settings for each source measurement:
Style: select the color and line thickness from the available choices in the dropdown
menus.

Decimals: select the number of decimal places for the data displayed in the legend.

Plot on: select Right or Left Axis for the location of the measurement values for the
selected measurement.

Overlay: select the values that you want to overlay on the trend. By default, no items are
selected. The selections are Min, Max, and Mean.

Data Source: select where to access the data for the trend. The options are to gather
series data from the source in real-time, gather series data from the database as it is being
logged, or gather real-time series data from the source and historical data from the
database to fill the trend, if possible.

1732 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

9. Click OK to save your changes and close the Add (or Edit) Data Series dialog and to return to
the Trend Setup dialog.

10. Click Add to specify additional sources and measurements for the trend.

11. Select Private Trend to keep this trend private or clear the check box to make it public.

NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

Configuring Axes settings


To configure axes settings:

1. In the Trend Setup dialog, on the Axes tab, enter a label for the axes in the Title field under
Right Axis (Primary) or Left Axis (Secondary).

Axis titles only appear if you have configured at least one measurement series and it appears
on the trend.

2. For Right Axis (Primary), Max Value and Min Value are set to Auto by default.
a. (Optional) Select Fixed and enter the maximum or minimum values in the respective input
fields.

i. When you select Upper Threshold:


Select a color from the color selector for area shading on the trend between the
maximum value and the upper threshold value.

Enter a value for the upper threshold in the input field.

Each time the latest data point of a measurement series occurs in an upper or
lower threshold, the color defined for the threshold also colors the background of
the measurement series in the legend.

ii. When you select Lower Threshold:


Select a color from the color selector for area shading on the trend between the
minimum value and the lower threshold value.

Enter a value for the lower threshold in the input field.

If the latest data point of a measurement series occurs in an upper or lower


threshold, the color defined for the threshold also colors the background of the
measurement series in the legend.

b. (Optional) Select Target Line, then select a color from the color selector and enter a value
for the target line in the input field.

You can select the Target Line independently from the Upper Threshold or Lower
Threshold settings.

3. For Left Axis (Secondary), Max Value and Min Value are set to Auto by default.

For Fixed maximum or minimum, enter the values in the respective input fields.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1733


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configuring Chart settings


To configure chart settings:

1. In the Trend Setup dialog, on the Chart tab, select the text size from the list.

The text size property is applied to trend axis labels, the size of the legend, the legend text
size, and trend data point tooltips.

The default setting is Medium, and the choices are Small, Medium, or Large.

2. Select the position of the legend included in the trend display area from the list.

The default setting is Right, which places the legend on the right side of the trend. The
available choices are Off, Left, or Right.

3. Select the content that you want to include in the legend from the available settings.

The default selections are Name and Value. The additional selections are Difference and
Difference (%).

Name is either the default measurement name in the form of group.device


measurement, or the custom name that you specified on the Add or Edit Data Series
dialogs.

Value is latest data value and the unit of measurement. For example, for voltage
measurements, the default value is numeric_value V such as 415.2 V.

Difference is the change in the measurement from one update to the next. For example, if the
voltage is 415.8 and it changes to 416.1 at the next trend update, the difference appears as
+0.3 in the legend.

Difference (%) is the percentage change in the measurement from one update to the next. For
example, if the voltage changes from 415.8 to 416.1 at the next trend update, the difference
expressed as a percentage appears as +0.072% in the legend.

Configuring Data display settings


To configure data display settings:

1. In the Trend Setup dialog, on the Data tab, specify the Data Update Intervals in the From
device and From database dropdown lists.

The default setting is 5 seconds for data updates for trends using the data directly from a
device, and 5 minutes for data updates for trends with data from a database.

2. Specify the Data Points for the x-axis of the trend in the Max per series input field.

The default setting is 40000.

The value must be between 100 and 500,000. Increasing the value adds more data points per
series but this can result in a degradation of trend performance.
Examples:

A data interval of 1 second equates to 3600 data points per hour (60 points per minute X 60
minutes per hour). At a setting of 40000 points, approximately 11.1 hours of data is
retained for viewing (40, 000 points / 3600 points per hour = approximately 11.1 hours).

1734 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

A data interval of 5 seconds equates to 720 data points per hour (12 points per minute X 60
minutes per hour). At a setting of 40000 points, approximately 55.5 hours of data is
retained for viewing (40, 000 points / 720 points per hour = approximately 55.5 hours).

A data interval of 10 seconds equates to 360 data points per hour (6 points per minute X 60
minutes per hour). At a setting of 40000 points, approximately 111.1 hours of data is
retained for viewing (40, 000 points / 360 points per hour = approximately 111.1 hours).

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1735


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

User Manager references


This section contains reference information related to User Manager.
Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

User Manager user interface


Default User Access Level Privileges

1736 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

User Manager user interface


Users user interface (UI)

User Manager Help.


1
Click Help to open the online help.
Users, User Groups, and Licenses tabs.
2
Click a tab to open the associated screen.
Add Standard User, Add Windows User, and Add Windows Group buttons.
3
Click a button to activate its function.
Search Users box.
4
Enter a search string to find users in the users table.
Users table.
5
Shows the existing users in the system.
Edit and Delete icons.
6
Click Edit to make changes to this user. Click Delete to delete this user.
Number of displayed users.
7
Shows the number of items visible on this page, and the total number of items in the system.
Page selector.
8
Navigate between pages. Set the number of items that are displayed on a page.

User Groups UI

Add User Group button.


1
Click the button to add a new user group.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1737


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

User Group table.


2
This table shows the existing user groups in the system.

Licenses UI

1 Web Applications User Licenses Summary.


2 Licenses table.

Privileges UI

Save Privileges and Reset Privileges buttons


1 Click a button to activate its function. Note: Reset Privileges resets all access level privileges
to their system defaults. See Default User Access Level Privileges for details.
2 Privileges table.

1738 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Default User Access Level Privileges


The access level that is assigned to a user in Power Monitoring Expert determines the permissions
this user has in the system. There are five access levels - Observer, User, Controller, Operator, and
Supervisor. Certain default privileges are assigned to the different access levels. Some of these
privileges are configurable. See Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

NOTE: Access to the web applications is controlled through user group settings. If a user group
does not have access to a web application, then the group members cannot access this
application regardless of their user access permissions.

The following table shows the system default privileges assigned to the different access levels:

Configurable Application Privilege Observer User Controller Operator Supervisor*

Yes Alarm Views Access the settings No No No No Yes

Yes Alarms Access the application No Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Alarms Acknowledge alarms No No Yes Yes Yes

Yes Alarms Create new alarm views No No Yes Yes Yes

Yes Alarms Delete any alarm view No No No No Yes

Yes Alarms Edit any alarm view No No No No Yes

Yes Alarms Set system default alarm view No No No No Yes

Yes Alarms View incidents No Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Authorized Hosts Access the settings No No No No Yes

Yes Breaker Configuration Tool Access the tool No No No Yes Yes

Yes Cloud Agent Manager Access the tool No No No No Yes

Yes Dashboards Access the application Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Dashboards Create new dashboards No Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Dashboards Delete any dashboard No No No No Yes

Yes Dashboards Edit any dashboard No No No No Yes

Yes Dashboards Manage slideshows No No Yes Yes Yes

Yes Dashboards Set system default dashboard No No No No Yes

Yes Dashboards View slideshow list Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Deactivate Alarms Access the tool No No No No Yes

Yes Device Manager Access the tool No No No Yes Yes

Device Type and Driver Package


Yes Access the tool No No No No Yes
Installer

Yes Diagnostic Viewer Access the tool No No Yes Yes Yes

Yes Diagnostics and Services Access the settings No No No No Yes

Yes Diagrams Access the application Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Diagrams Create new diagrams No No No No Yes

Yes Diagrams Delete any diagram No No No No Yes

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1739


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Configurable Application Privilege Observer User Controller Operator Supervisor*

Yes Diagrams Edit any diagram No No No No Yes

Yes Diagrams Set system default diagram No No No No Yes

Yes Diagrams (Standalone) Access the application Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Event Watcher Access the tool No No No No Yes

Yes EWS Login Access the settings No No No No Yes

Generator Performance
Yes Access the tool No No No Yes Yes
Configuration Tool

Yes Generator Power Configuration Utility Access the tool No No No Yes Yes

Yes Hierarchy Manager Access the tool No No Yes Yes Yes

Insulation Monitoring Configuration


Yes Access the tool No No No Yes Yes
Tool

Yes Log Viewer Access the tool No No No Yes Yes

Yes Logical Device Type Editor Access the tool No No No Yes Yes

Yes Login Options Access the settings No No No No Yes

Yes Management Console Access the application No Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Management Console Configure system No No No Yes Yes

Connect/disconnect sites and


Yes Management Console No No Yes Yes Yes
devices

Yes Manual Data Editor Access the tool No No No No Yes

Modbus Gateway Service


Yes Access the tool No No No No Yes
Configuration

Yes Modeling Configuration Access the tool No No Yes Yes Yes

Yes Notifications Access the tool No No No Yes Yes

Yes Personal Preferences Access the settings No Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Power Losses Configuration Utility Access the tool No No No Yes Yes

Yes Rate Editor Access the tool No No Yes Yes Yes

Yes Realtime and OPC Diagnostics Access the tool No No No Yes Yes

Yes Registration Access the settings No No No No Yes

Yes Report Theme Access the settings No No No No Yes

Yes Reports Access the application Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Reports Create new reports No Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Reports Delete any report No No No No Yes

Yes Reports Edit any report No No No No Yes

Yes Reports Manage report subscriptions No Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Security Options Access the settings No No No No Yes

Yes Session Timeout Access the settings No No No No Yes

Yes Software Alarms Access the tool No No Yes Yes Yes

Yes System Language Access the settings No No No No Yes

1740 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Configurable Application Privilege Observer User Controller Operator Supervisor*

Yes System Theme Access the settings No No No No Yes

Yes Time of Use Editor Access the tool No No Yes Yes Yes

Yes Trends Access the application Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Trends Create new trends No Yes Yes Yes Yes

Yes Trends Delete any trend No No No No Yes

Yes Trends Edit any trend No No No No Yes

Yes Upload Report Template Access the tool No No No No Yes

Yes UPS Configuration Tool Access the tool No No No Yes Yes

Yes UPS Power Configuration Utility Access the tool No No No Yes Yes

Yes User Manager** Access the tool No No No No Yes

Yes User Manager** Add user groups No No No No Yes

Yes User Manager** Add users No No No No Yes

Yes User Manager** Delete any user No No No No Yes

Yes User Manager** Delete any user group No No No No Yes

Yes User Manager** Edit any user No No No No Yes

Yes User Manager** Edit any user group No No No No Yes

Yes User Manager** View user groups No No No No Yes

Yes User Manager** View users No No No No Yes

* Supervisor access level has all privileges. This is not configurable.


** User Manager privileges are not configurable.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1741


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

VIP Setup references


This section contains reference information related to VIP setup.
Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

VIP Modbus Slave port settings

1742 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

VIP Modbus Slave port settings

NOTE: To view or change these settings in your system, open Management Console and go to
Tools > System > ION Virtual Processor Setup. For the VIP for which the Modbus Slave is
configured, expand Modbus Network > Slave Ports.

Serial Port settings:

Setting Range
Unit ID 1 - 247 (default: 100)
Receive Timeout (ms) 100 - 10000 (default: 1800)
Transmit Delay (ms) 10 - 60000 (default: 50)
Baud Rate 300 - 115200 (default: 9600)
Parity NONE, ODD, EVEN, MARK, SPACE (default: NONE)
Stop Bits 1, 1.5, 2 (default: 1)

Modbus TCP settings:

Setting Range Notes


Unit ID 1 - 247 (default: 100)
Receive Timeout (ms) 100 - 10000 (default: 10000)
Transmit Delay (ms) 10 - 60000 (default: 50)
It is possible that other Modbus
Slaves are configured on the system,
such as the ION Modbus Gateway
Service that is used for breaker aging
Listening Port 1 - 9999 (default: 502)
calculations. Configure different
listening ports for the different
Modbus Slaves. Each Modbus Slave
needs its own, unique listening port.
Configure this setting to only allow as
many connections as needed for your
application. Allowing more
Max Number connections than needed increases
1 - 32 (default: 5)
Connections Allowed that attack surface for unauthorized
system access. Keeping the attack
surface as small as possible is a
basic security measure.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1743


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Web Applications settings references


This section contains reference information related to Web Applications settings.
Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

System and personal localization settings


Customizing the Web Applications links

1744 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

System and personal localization settings

NOTE: The language settings in System Language and Personal Preferences determine the
language the web applications are displayed in.

By default, the localization settings in Personal Preferences are the same as the ones in System
Language. Changes to the settings in System Language are automatically copied to the Personal
Preferences settings as long as the Personal Preferences settings have never been customized.
After you customized the Personal Preferences localization settings once, they will no longer
change when the System Language settings are changed.

NOTE: Your personal localization settings overrule the system localization settings for your user
account.

Example 1: Language settings in Personal Preferences follow System Language if they have never
been customized.

Condition Language Settings Comments


This is assuming the software
System Language: English
Default was installed as an English
Personal Preferences: English
system.
The Personal Preferences
Change System Language System Language: French
language settings follow the
to French Personal Preferences: French
System Language settings.

Example 2: Personal Preferences remain at customized setting after having been customized at
some point.

Condition Language Settings Comments


This is assuming the software
System Language: English
Default was installed as an English
Personal Preferences: English
system.
Change Personal System Language: English The Personal Preferences have
Preferences to French Personal Preferences: French been customized.
The settings are back to their
Change Personal System Language: English defaults, but the Personal
Preferences back to English Personal Preferences: English Preferences had been
customized.
The Personal Preferences
Change System Language System Language: French language settings no longer
to French Personal Preferences: English follow the System Language
settings.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1745


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Operation references
This section contains reference information related to the content in the Configuring chapter of this
guide.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Topic Links
Alarms UI
Timeline analysis UI
Waveforms UI
Alarms
Alarm to incident mapping
Load Impact calculations
Alarms terminology
Dashboards Dashboards user interface (UI)
Power Quality Performance Power Quality Performance events and disturbances
Model creation example
Report input parameters
Interpreting the Energy Regression Analysis Report results
Reports
Reports UI
Reports Icons
Reports Terminology
The Trends user interface
Trends
Trend options

1746 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Alarms references
This section contains reference information related to using Alarms.

Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Alarms UI
Timeline analysis UI
Waveforms UI
Alarm to incident mapping
Load Impact calculations
Alarms terminology

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1747


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Alarms UI
1 Main UI

View Library
The view library contains all the alarm views that are configured in the system. Alarm views
can be listed individually, or they can be organized within folders.

1
TIP: To hide the library, click the Hide Library icon ( or ) in the top right corner of the

library. To show the library, click the Show Library icon ( or ) at the top of the library
ribbon, or click anywhere in the minimized library ribbon.

Alarms Display
2
The alarms display pane shows the alarm view selected in the view library.

1748 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

2 Alarms display UI

Update timer
1
The update timer shows the time until the next display refresh.
Update mode
Use the update mode to switch between Date Filter mode and Auto-Update mode.

Date Filter mode: View alarms within a certain date


2 range.

Auto-Update mode: View the latest alarms.

NOTE: This element is only available for history views, not for status views.

Search filter
3 Enter text into the search filter to search and filter the items displayed in the alarms display
pane.
Options menu
4 The Options menu contains options relevant to the content displayed in the alarms display
pane.
Number of displayed items
5
Shows the number of items visible on this page, and the total number in this view.
Page selector
6 Use the page selector to navigate between pages. Set the number of items that are displayed
on a page.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1749


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

3 Alarm status UI

Alarm status table columns


Click on any of the column headers to sort by that column. Use the Show/Hide Columns
option in the alarms display pane Options menu to customize which columns are visible. The
following columns are available:

ID Unique numeric alarm identifier.


Priority Alarm priority number from 0 - 255.
Graphic display of active or inactive status. Also shows the amount of
State
time since the alarm went last active.
Active Active or Inactive status.
1 Name Alarm name.
Type Alarm type, for example Over Voltage.
Source Origin of the alarm.
Unacknowledged Number of unacknowledged alarm activations.
Acknowledgement A link to acknowledge the alarm.
Last Occurrence Datetime of latest alarm activation, in browser local time.
Last Occurrence
Datetime of latest alarm activation, in UTC time.
UTC
First Occurrence Datetime of first alarm activation, in browser local time.
Occurrences Total number of alarm activations.

Details button
2
Click Details to see more information related to an alarm. (See below for more information.)
Alarm status table rows
3 Each row in the table shows an alarm definition that exists in the system. The filter settings in
the view library control which alarm definitions are included in a view.

1750 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

3-1 Alarm definition details

TIP: Click Details for an alarm definition or double-click an alarm definition row in the table to open
the alarm details.

Display selector
1 Select Details to see information about the alarm definition.
Select History to see past instances of this alarm.
Alarm Definition Details information
2
See detailed information about this alarm definition.
Actions
Click Acknowledge to open the Acknowledge Alarms window.
3
Click Open Device Diagram to open the device diagram for the source this alarm is associated
with.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1751


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

4 Alarm history UI

Alarm history table rows


1 Each row in the table shows an alarm instance that occurred. The filter settings in the view
library control which instances are included in a view.
Details button
2 Click Details to see more information related to the alarm instance. (See below for more
information.)

4-1 Alarm instance details

TIP: Click Details for an alarm instance or double-click an alarm instance row in the table to open
the alarm details.

1752 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Display selector
Select Details to see information about this alarm instance.
Select Events to see the events that are associated with this alarm instance.
1
Select Tolerance Chart to see an ITIC/CBEMA or SEMI F47-0706 plot for the alarm instance.
Note: This only applies to voltage disturbance alarms.
Select Waveforms to see all the waveform that are associated with this alarm instance.
Alarm instance details information
2
See detailed information about this alarm instance.
Actions
Click Timeline Analysis to open the Timeline window.
Click Acknowledge to open the Acknowledge Alarms window.
Click Open Representative Waveform to see the waveform of the worst disturbance that is
associated with this alarm instance.
3
Click Open Incident to see information on the incident that is associated with this alarm
instance.
Click Open Alarm Definition to see information on the alarm definition for this alarm.
Click Open Device Diagram to see the device diagram for the source that is associated with
this alarm.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1753


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

5 Incident history UI

Incident history table rows


1 Each row in the table shows an incident that occurred. The filter settings in the view library
control which incidents are included in a view.
Analysis button

Click Open Timeline Analysis to open the timeline analysis window for the incident.

TIP: To analyze multiple Incidents together, select the Incidents in the table and then choose
2 Open Timeline Analysis on selection from the Options menu in the top right corner of the
alarms display pane.

TIP: For multi-selection, use Ctrl+Click to select individual Incidents, use Shift+click
to select a block of Incidents.

Details button
3 Click Details to see more information related to the incident. (See below for more
information.)

5-1 Incident details

TIP: Click Details for an incident or double-click an incident row in the table to open the incident
details.

1754 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Display selector
Select Details to see information about this incident.
Select Alarms to see the alarm instances that are associated with this incident.
1 Select Events to see the events that are associated with this incident.
Select Tolerance Chart to see an ITIC/CBEMA or SEMI F47-0706 plot for the incident. Note:
This only applies to voltage disturbances.
Select Waveforms to see all the waveform that are associated with this incident.
Incident Details information
2
See detailed information about this incident.
Actions
Click Timeline Analysis to see the timeline analysis of the incident.
3 Click Acknowledge to open the acknowledge alarms window.
Click Open Representative Waveform to see the waveform of the worst disturbance that is
associated with this incident.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1755


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

6 Event history UI

Event history table columns


Use the Show/Hide Columns option in the alarms display pane Options menu to customize
which columns are visible. The following columns are available:

ID Unique numeric event identifier.


Source Origin of the event.
Timestamp Datetime when the event was recorded, in browser local time.
1 Timestamp UTC Datetime when the event was recorded, in UTC time.
Event Event string, for example RSP10 Status.
Condition Threshold value of the event trigger at the time the event was recorded.
Measurement Measurement that triggered the event.
Value Measured value at the time the event was triggered.
Type Event trigger type, Pick up, Drop out, or Instantaneous.
Priority Event priority number from 0 - 255.

Event history table rows


2 Each row in the table shows an event that occurred. The filter settings in the view library
control which events are included in a view.

TIP: Double-click an event row in the table to open the alarm instance details for the alarm that is
associated with this event.

1756 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

7 View settings

Alarm Status Alarm and Incident History Event History

Options menu and Hide Library icon .


The Options menu contains options relevant to the view library. The following options are
1 available:
Add View
Add Folder
Search filter
2
Enter text into the search filter to search and filter the views displayed in the library.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1757


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Back button
3
Use the Back button to exit the view settings and go back to the library.
View Name
4
Set the name of the view in the library.
Location
5
Determine where the view is stored in the library.
View Access Permissions selector
Select Public to make this view public. Select Private to make this view private.

6 NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

View Type selector


7 Select Alarm Status to create an alarm status view. Select Alarm History to create an alarm
history view.
Priority filter
8 Click the priority buttons to include or exclude alarms with that priority. The priorities are, from
left to right: No, Low, Medium, High.
State selector
Select which alarm states to include. The following options are available:
Active or Unacknowledged
9 Active and Unacknowledged
Unacknowledged
Active
All
Sources selector
10
Include all sources or select specific sources.
Category selector
Include or exclude certain categories of alarms and choose specific types within each
category. The following categories are available:
Power Quality (includes filter settings for Voltage Tolerance, Load Impact, and Disturbance
Direction)
11
Asset Monitoring
Energy Management
General
Diagnostics
See Alarms for a list of available types in each category.
Level of Detail selector
Select to see incidents, alarms, or events.
12
NOTE: This setting is only available for history views, not for alarm status views.

1758 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Priority filter
Select which priority events to include or exclude. This filter allows more precise priority
filtering than the other priority filter.
13
NOTE: This selector is only available for event history views, not for alarm status or incident
and alarm history views.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1759


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Waveforms UI
Incident and alarm instance waveforms UI

Page selector.
1
Navigate between pages.
Waveforms timeline.
The timeline shows at what point in time the waveforms that are associated with this incident or
2
alarm instance were captured. Each waveform capture is represented by a dot. The
representative waveforms for this incident or alarm instance are shown with black dots.
Inspect button
3
Click the button to open the waveform inspection window for this waveform.
Representative waveform
The black marking identifies the representative waveform for this incident or alarm instance.
4
The representative waveform is the waveform for the worst disturbance in the incident or alarm
instance.

Waveform inspection UI

Region Mode UI

1760 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Display Mode
Select one of the following display modes for the waveform chart: Waveform, Waveform and
RMS, RMS.
1
NOTE: The display mode selector is not available for high speed transient waveform
captures.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1761


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Analysis Mode
Select one of the following analysis modes for the waveform chart: Region, Cursor. The
Region mode is the default analysis mode of captured waveform with the automatically
detected sampling rate. The Cursor mode is the analysis mode of captured waveform with
2
manual selection of sampling rate using cursors. See Cursor Mode UI.

NOTE: The analysis mode selector is not available for high speed transient waveform
captures.

Channels
3
Select which channels (V1, V2, V3, I1, I2, I3) to include or exclude from the waveform chart.
View type selector
Use the view type selector to switch between a Compact View and an Extended View. The
Compact View groups the analysis charts together to fit the window size. The Extended View
4
shows the charts below each other with a larger display area for each chart.

NOTE: The view type selector is not available for high speed transient waveform captures.

1762 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Advanced Options

TIP: The Advanced Options are hidden by default. Click the Advanced Options label to show
or hide these settings.

Auto scale Auto scale adjusts the y-axis automatically as you zoom or pan the waveform
Y-Axis plot.
Shared tooltips display measurement details for all voltage and current phases
as you move the pointer over the waveform plot. Non shared tooltips only
display details for the voltage or current the pointer is hovering over.
Example: Hover the pointer over the Vab voltage waveform plot.
Shared Tooltips (shows all details)

Shared
Tooltips

Non Shared Tooltips (only shows Vab details)

Select which charts (Analysis Area, Phasors, Harmonics (V), Harmonics (I)) to
display in the analysis pane.
View
NOTE: The View option is not available for high speed transient waveform
captures.

Set the number of harmonics to display in the harmonics column chart.

Harmonics NOTE: The harmonics setting is not available for high speed transient
waveform captures.

Select the sampling rate at which the waveform was captured. The sampling
rate is detected automatically. Use this control to make adjustments if the
Source sampling rate setting is incorrect. The sampling rate is set correctly when the
Sampling analysis region covers one cycle of waveform capture.
Rate
NOTE: The sampling rate setting is not available for high speed transient
waveform captures.

Select the source frequency. The frequency is detected automatically. Use this
control to make adjustments if the frequency setting is incorrect.
Source
Frequency NOTE: The frequency setting is not available for high speed transient
waveform captures.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1763


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Analysis area selector


Use the slider to select an analysis area in the waveform chart.
6
NOTE: The analysis area selector is not available for high speed transient waveform
captures.

Zoom
Use the left and right sliders to zoom in and out of the waveform chart. You can also click and
7 drag the pointer on the plot to zoom. To pan while zoomed in, click and drag the area between
the sliders. Click (to the right of the sliders) to zoom out to the original size.
Analysis area chart
This chart shows the waveform signature of the section of the waveform that has been
selected by the analysis area selector (see 6). The phasor and harmonics calculations are
8
based on the waveform data from the analysis area. The y-axis is automatically scaled.

NOTE: The analysis area chart is not available for high speed transient waveform captures.

Phasor chart
This chart shows the phasor analysis of the section of the waveform that has been selected
by the analysis area selector (see 6). Phasor details are shown in a polar diagram and a data
9
table.

NOTE: The phasor chart is not available for high speed transient waveform captures.

Voltage harmonics chart


This chart shows the voltage harmonic analysis of the section of the waveform that has been
selected by the analysis area selector (see 6). Harmonic details are shown in a column chart.
10
NOTE: The voltage harmonics chart is not available for high speed transient waveform
captures.

Current harmonics chart


This chart shows the current harmonic analysis of the section of the waveform that has been
selected by the analysis area selector (see 6). Harmonic details are shown in a column chart.
11
NOTE: The current harmonics chart is not available for high speed transient waveform
captures.

Compare Waveforms
Use this option to open this waveform in a new, Compare Waveforms tab in the browser. You
12
can then select other waveforms to open in the same window. If a Compare Waveforms tab is
already open, then the present waveform is added to that window.
Export Waveform
13 Use this option to download the waveform data of the present waveform in .csv file format.
The file is downloaded to your local Windows Downloads folder.

1764 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Cursor Mode UI

Display Mode
Select one of the following display modes for the waveform chart: Waveform, Waveform and
RMS, RMS.
1
NOTE: The display mode selector is not available for high speed transient waveform
captures.

Analysis Mode
Select one of the following analysis modes for the waveform chart: Region, Cursor. The
Region mode is the default analysis mode of captured waveform with the automatically
detected sampling rate. See Region Mode UI. The Cursor mode is the analysis mode of
2
captured waveform with manual selection of sampling rate using cursors.

NOTE: The analysis mode selector is not available for high speed transient waveform
captures.

Channels
3
Select which channels (V1, V2, V3, I1, I2, I3) to include or exclude from the waveform chart.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1765


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Advanced Options

Auto scale Y- Auto scale adjusts the y-axis automatically as you zoom or pan the
Axis waveform plot.
4 Select to view Phasors in the analysis pane.

View NOTE: The View option is not available for high speed transient
waveform captures.

Cursor area selector


Use the cursors (1 and 2) to select an analysis area in the waveform chart.
5
NOTE: The cursor area selector is not available for high speed transient waveform captures.

Zoom
Use the left and right sliders to zoom in and out of the waveform chart. You can also click and
6 drag the pointer on the plot to zoom. To pan while zoomed in, click and drag the area between
the sliders. Click (to the right of the sliders) to zoom out to the original size.
Cursor Measurement
This table displays 4 columns. The first column displays the time and measurement details
for the voltage and current phases of the cursor 1. The second column displays the time and
measurement details for the voltage and current phases of the cursor 2. The third column
displays the difference of time and measurement details for the voltage and current phases
7 between cursor 2 and cursor 1. The fourth column displays the phase angle of 3rd column
measurements with respect to the first voltage phase angle of 3rd column. The 3rd column
first voltage phase angle is set to 0°.

NOTE: The cursor measurement is not available for high speed transient waveform
captures.

Phasor chart
This chart shows the phasor analysis of the section of the waveform that has been selected
8 by the cursors. Phasor details are shown in a polar diagram and a data table.

NOTE: The phasor chart is not available for high speed transient waveform captures.

Compare Waveforms
Use this option to open this waveform in a new, Compare Waveforms tab in the browser. You
9
can then select other waveforms to open in the same window. If a Compare Waveforms tab is
already open, then the present waveform is added to that window.
Export Waveform
10 Use this option to download the waveform data of the present waveform in .csv file format.
The file is downloaded to your local Windows Downloads folder.

1766 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Timeline analysis UI
Analysis UI

NOTE: Alarms and data measurements during an incident occur in very short time intervals. To
show the correct sequence of events in the timeline analysis, the timestamps must be accurate.
Consider using monitoring devices with Precision Time Protocol (PTP) or GPS time
synchronization for accurate time stamping.

Options menu
1
Contains options relevant to the content displayed in the Analysis UI.
Notes area
2
(Optional) Enter notes related to the Analysis.
Grouping control
3
Choose to group the items in the Analysis by time or by source.
Zoom and Heatmap
Use the sliders or the time controls to zoom in or out of the analysis time window. Use the
4
button on the right of the slider to zoom out to the original size. The colored areas act as a
heatmap, showing you where the analysis items are located on the time window timeline.
Analysis items
These are the alarms, waveforms, and bursts that are associated with this timeline. The color
bars to the left of the items indicate the item priority. Arrows, pointing up or down, to the left of
5 some of the items indicate Disturbance Direction Detection measurements. Hover the pointer
over the arrows to get specific disturbance direction information.

TIP: Click the item name to open a detail view for the item.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1767


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Timeline
Each analysis item is represented by a dot on the timeline or a burst data display. The color of
6 the dot indicates the priority of the item. Alarms with a start and end event are shown with two
dots, connected by a line. Waveforms are shown with a white dot. Zoom in to see the
waveforms timeline. Click a waveform dot to open the waveform viewer.
Analysis item Options
7
Hide an item from view or choose to open a detail view for an item.

1768 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Timeline analysis view settings UI

View Name
1
Shows the name of the timeline view.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1769


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Location and sharing


Determines where the view is stored in the library and who can access it.

2 NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

Quick Expand
3 Click this option to extend the time window of the view and adds all devices, and all
categories.
Priority filter
4 Click the priority buttons to include or exclude alarms with that priority. The priorities are, from
left to right: No, Low, Medium, High.
Sources selector
5
Include all sources or select specific sources.
Show control
Show or hide burst data, waveform data, the notes area, spanning alarms, hidden items.

6 NOTE: Spanning alarms are alarms that started before the time window. Hidden items are
analysis items that are marked as hidden through the item Options menu. Hidden items
appear dimmed when shown.

Category selectors
Include or exclude certain categories of alarms from the analysis and choose specific types
within each category. The following categories are available:
Power Quality
7 Asset Monitoring
Energy Management
General
Diagnostics
See Alarms for a list of available types in each category.

1770 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Alarm to incident mapping


The following table shows the mapping of alarm types to Incidents:

Incident Category Incident Type Alarm Types


Interruption Interruption
Over Voltage Over Voltage
Under Voltage Under Voltage
Unclassified Disturbance Unclassified Disturbance
Sag Sag (Voltage)
Swell Swell (Voltage)
Transient Transient
Flicker Flicker
Power Quality
Frequency Variation Frequency Variation
Harmonics
Harmonics (Current)
Harmonics
Harmonics (Power)
Harmonics (Voltage)
Unbalance
Unbalance Unbalance (Current)
Unbalance (Voltage)
Communication Status Communication Status
Diagnostics Device Status Device Status
System Status System Status
Air Air
Demand Demand
Electricity Electricity
Energy Management Gas Gas
Power Factor Power Factor
Steam Steam
Water Water
Arc Flash Arc Flash
Backup Power Backup Power
Over Current
Sag (Current)
Asset Monitoring Current Monitor
Swell (Current)
Under Current
Protection Protection
Thermal Monitor Thermal Monitor

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1771


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Incident Category Incident Type Alarm Types


General Event
Clock / Time
Clutter
General Device Settings
Unassociated Dropout
General Setpoints General Setpoint

1772 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Load Impact calculations


Load Impact identifies changes in the steady state electrical loads of a power system triggered by a
voltage disturbance, such as a voltage sag or interruption. To assess the impact of a disturbance on
the load, the software compares the real power (kW) measurements of the monitored circuit before
and after the event.

Load Impact is calculated as:


Load Impact (%) = ((Ppost-event - Ppre-event) / Ppre-event) ×100

• A negative Load Impact value between -100% < X < 0% means a load loss. The real power
(kW) of the monitored circuit has been reduced by X%.

NOTE: Load loss is the most common load impact caused by voltage disturbances.

• A positive Load Impact value, X > 0%, means a load gain. The real power (kW) of the
monitored circuit has increased by X%.

• A negative Load Impact value, X < -100%, means a potential load reversal. The energy flow in
the monitored circuit might have been reversed. The percent value less than -100% is the
portion of pre-event real power (kW) flowing in the opposite direction. For example, a Load
Impact value of -125% means that the power flow has been reversed and 25% of the pre-event
real power are now flowing in the opposite direction.

A voltage disturbance event can result in any or all of the above load changes. For example, starting
a large load, such as a motor, can produce a voltage sag that causes another load to disconnect. In
this case, the motor load circuit would show a load gain and the other circuit a load loss.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1773


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Alarms terminology
The following is a list of commonly used terms related to Alarms in PME.

Alarm
The term Alarm is commonly used to describe both, an alarm definition and an alarm instance.
Which one it represents in an application must be derived from the context in which it is used. It is
better to use the terms alarm definition and alarm instance to avoid ambiguity.

Alarm definition
An alarm definition is the specification of a defined condition for a particular measurement from a
particular source. When the condition is met, the alarm goes active. When the condition is no longer
met, the alarm goes inactive. Example: An Overcurrent alarm that goes active when the measured
current for a load goes above a defined limit. The alarm definition includes the alarm name, the
source and measurement, the alarm limits, and any other conditions that are relevant for the alarm.

Alarm instance
An alarm instance is a record of an occurrence where a monitored load exceeds the limits set in the
alarm definition. An alarm instance starts when the alarm state goes active and ends when it goes
inactive. An alarm Instance has a start and end date.

Alarm occurrence count


The alarm occurrence count is the number of alarm instances that have happened for an alarm
definition.

Alarm state
The alarm state shows if the monitored load presently meets the conditions defined in the alarm
definition or not. If it meets the conditions, the alarm state is Active. If it does not meet the
conditions, the alarm state is Inactive.

Alarm acknowledgment
An alarm acknowledgment is a way to indicate in the software that you have seen the alarm and that
it is being managed. When you acknowledge an alarm, the date and time of the acknowledgment is
recorded together with an optional note that you can enter in the acknowledge window.

An alarm can be acknowledged after it has gone active. An alarm stays unacknowledged until you
acknowledge it. After you have acknowledged an alarm, it stays acknowledged until the next time it
goes active. At that point it is reset to unacknowledged and is waiting for you to acknowledge it
again.

NOTE: You can acknowledge alarms in status views and history views. If you acknowledge
alarms through an incident history view, all alarms that are part of this Incident will be
acknowledged. Whenever you acknowledge an alarm, from any of these locations, you are
acknowledging the alarm definition, not an instance of it. That means acknowledging an alarm
marks it as acknowledged for all instances and resets the unacknowledged occurrence counter.

Incident
An incident combines alarms, waveforms, and burst data from many sources in the system. The
elements are combined based on the proximity in time when the data was recorded and based on an
analysis of the type of data. The goal is to create a single representation of a real-world power event

1774 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

that shows the impact of this event on the power system as a whole.

Representative power quality details (representative disturbance)


The representative power quality details describe the representative disturbance for an alarm or
incident. The representative disturbance is used to categorize and quantify the alarm or incident. For
an alarm the representative disturbance is the one that triggered the alarm. For an incident, which
can include multiple alarms, the representative disturbance is the one with the highest severity in
the incident. The representative power quality details include the source, type, direction, maximum
abnormality, start time, end time, and duration of the disturbance.
Example representative power quality details:

• Source: Campus.Residence Hall

• Type: Sag

• Disturbance Direction: Upstream - High Confidence

• Maximum Abnorality: V3: 88.5%

• Start Time: 2019-07-26 9:08:49.330 PM

• End Time: 2019-07-26 9:08:49.530 PM

• Duration: 200.0 ms

Representative waveform
The representative waveform is the waveform that is related to the representative disturbance for an
alarm or an incident. If multiple waveforms are associated with the representative disturbance, then
the representative waveform is selected based on the following priorities:

1. The waveform covers full disturbance

2. The waveform covers the start of the disturbance

3. The waveform covers the end of the disturbance

4. The waveform is inside the disturbance

Burst data
Burst data is pre- and post-event data that is logged during an alarm instance. The recording of the
data is triggered by an alarm going active. Devices that support burst data keep a continuous buffer
of data logs in memory, until a burst data capture is triggered. At that point, the data is recorded and
uploaded to the software, together with the trigger time. By showing both pre- and post-event data,
burst data is a very effective analysis tool. Burst data can be high speed data, such as half-cycle
RMS measurements of voltages, currents, and other quantities, or it can be 1 second
measurements for slowly changing parameters.

Event
Events are records of activity or conditions in the monitoring system. Events are generated by
devices and the software and are logged and displayed as they happen in the system without any
processing or aggregation. The system uses event records to determine alarm types and states.

Status view
A status view in the Alarms application shows alarm definitions in the system, their present state,
how often they occurred, their priority, and other relevant information.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1775


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

History view
A history view in the Alarms application shows instances of incidents, alarms, or events that have
occurred in the system.

1776 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Dashboards references
This section contains reference information related to using Dashboards.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Dashboards user interface (UI)


Using Table gadget in Slideshow

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1777


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Dashboards user interface (UI)


Main UI

Dashboard Library
Contains all the Dashboards that are configured in the system. Dashboards can be listed
individually, or they can be organized within folders.

1
TIP: To hide the library, click the Hide Library icon ( or ) in the top right corner of the

library. To show the library, click the Show Library icon ( or ) at the top of the library
ribbon, or click anywhere in the minimized library ribbon.

Dashboards display pane.


2
Shows the Dashboard selected in the View Library.

Gadget Settings UI

1778 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Gadget settings tabs.


1 The tabs group the different setting options for the gadget. Different gadget types can have
different settings tabs and different settings options within those tabs.

Dashboard Settings

Options menu and Hide Library icon .


Contains options relevant to the Dashboard Library. The following options are available:
1 Add Dashboard
Add Folder
Slideshow Manager

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1779


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Search filter.
2
Enter text to search and filter the Dashboards displayed in the Library.
Back button.
3
Exit the Dashboard Settings and go back to the Library.
Dashboard Name.
4
Set the name of the Dashboard in the Library.
Add Gadget.
5
Add new gadgets to the Dashboard. See Adding a gadget to a dashboard for more information.
Styling.
6 Set the appearance of the Dashboard by adding a background image, setting the background
color, and setting the gadget opacity. See Styling a dashboard for more information.
View Access Permissions selector.
Select Public to make this Dashboard public. Select Private to make this Dashboard private.

7 NOTE: A public item is visible to all users in your user group. A private item is visible to you
and any user in your user group with Edit permissions on this item type. See Default User
Access Level Privileges and Customizing Access Level Privileges for details.

Location.
8
Determine where the Dashboard is stored in the Library.

1780 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Using Table gadget in Slideshow


When you use the table gadget in slideshow, the slideshow in the new browser does not retrieve the
real-time data from devices in the system. To retrieve the real-time data, perform the following:

1. Open a new tab in the browser.

2. Login to the PME web application.

3. Refresh the slideshow page in the browser.

The table gadget slideshow displays the real-time data from devices in the system.

NOTE: The session timeout of the PME web application is enabled by default (See Session
Timeout for more information). After the timeout period, the slideshow display does not retrieve the
real-time data. You must login to the PME web application every time after the timeout period.

Related topics:
Dashboards:

• Configuring a slideshow

• Playing a Slideshow

• Gadgets

• Session Timeout

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1781


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Power Quality Performance Module references


This section contains reference information related to using the Power Quality Performance Module.

Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Power Quality Performance events and disturbances

1782 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Power Quality Performance events and disturbances

Events

Power Quality (PQ) events are short-term disturbances that are characterized by magnitude,
duration, and direction.

The following table provides definitions for the different PQ events:

PQ Events Summary Magnitude Source Duration Consequence


Loss of the ½ cycle to 1
Less than 10% Utility or
Interruptions supply minute or Downtime
of nominal facility
voltage more
Decrease in 90% to 10% of Utility or large
½ cycle to 1 Malfunction or
Voltage Sag voltage nominal voltage motors
minute downtime
magnitude (typical) starting
Increase in 110% to 180% Equipment
Utility or ½ cycle to 1
Voltage Swell voltage of nominal malfunction or
facility minute
magnitude (typical) damage
Potentially Switching
Short-duration Electronic
Transient several activities or <50 ns to 50
high equipment
Voltage thousands of lightning ms
overvoltage damage
volts and amps strikes
Sustained
110% to 120% Equipment
increase in Utility or More than 1
Over Voltage of nominal malfunction or
voltage facility minute
(typical) motor heating
magnitude
Sustained
80% to 90% of Equipment
Under decrease in Utility or More than 1
nominal malfunction or
Voltage voltage facility minute
(typical) damage
magnitude

Power Quality event classifications


The following image illustrates the classification of events in relation to a CBEMA chart. The Power
Quality Performance gadgets and reports follow this same color classification of Power Quality
Events.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1783


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

A Percent of nominal voltage B No impact region C Transient D Swell


E Over Voltage F Sag G Under Voltage H Interruption

Disturbances

Power Quality (PQ) disturbances are long-term disturbances.

The following table provides definitions for the different PQ disturbances:

PQ
Summary Magnitude Source Duration Consequence
Disturbances
Non- 0.5% - 2.5% of
Voltage Utility or Overheating or
symmetrical nominal voltage Steady state
Unbalance facility malfunction
voltages (typical)
Non- 1.0% - 30% of
Current Utility or Malfunction and
symmetrical nominal current Steady state
Unbalance facility breaker trip
current (typical)
Voltage Waveform 0 to 20% Nonlinear Malfunction and
Steady state
Harmonics distortion (typical) loads overheating
Current Waveform 0 to 20% Nonlinear Malfunction and
Steady state
Harmonics distortion (typical) loads breaker trip

1784 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

PQ
Summary Magnitude Source Duration Consequence
Disturbances
Deviation of Up to 5% Standby
Malfunction or
Frequency the frequency deviation of generators or
Intermittent motor
Variation from the nominal poor power
degradation
nominal (typical) infrastructure
Voltage Load exhibits Flickering
waveform 0.1% to 7% significant lights,
Flicker Intermittent
envelope (typical) current equipment
variations variations malfunction

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1785


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Reports references
This section contains reference information related to using Reports.

Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

Report input parameters


Model creation example
Interpreting the Energy Regression Analysis Report results
Reports UI
Reports Icons
Reports Terminology

1786 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Report input parameters


The report input area opens when you select a report in the Report Library. You must specify the
necessary input parameters before you can generate the report. For saved reports, some or all the
input parameters may already be specified.

After you generate a report, you can display or change the input parameters you specified for it by
clicking show inputs in the top-right corner of the report display area. To return to the generated
report without changing any of the input parameters, click hide inputs. If you change any of the
input parameters, click Generate Report to regenerate the report.

The following information describes the inputs for the report templates. The available inputs vary by
report template listed in the Reports Library.

Actual Bill Cost


(Optional) Enter a billing amount, for example from a utility issued bill, which will be compared to the
calculated bill value from the reference source. Set to 0 to ignore.

Aggregation Data
This input determines the period of time over which data is accumulated for presentation in the
report, such as day, week, and so on. From the dropdown list, select the aggregation interval that
you want to use. If a custom report includes a predefined aggregation interval, contact the owner to
adjust the interval for your use.

Aggregation Interval
This input determines the period of time over which data is accumulated for presentation in the
report, such as day, week, and so on. From the dropdown list, select the aggregation interval that
you want to use. If a custom report includes a predefined aggregation interval, contact the owner to
adjust the interval for your use.

Aggregation Period
This input determines the period of time over which data is accumulated for presentation in the
report, such as day, week, and so on. From the dropdown list, select the aggregation interval that
you want to use. If a custom report includes a predefined aggregation interval, contact the owner to
adjust the interval for your use.

Aggregation Type
The aggregation data that will be displayed: Average, Maximum, or Minimum.

Alarm Threshold - Check Source vs Actual Total (%)


(Optional) Set the notification threshold, in %, for the billing difference between the Check source
and the Actual Total. Set to 0 to ignore.

Alarm Threshold - Check Source vs Private Source (%)


(Optional) Set the notification threshold, in %, for the billing difference between the Check source
and the Private source. Set to 0 to ignore.

Align Day of Week for Months


When the Aggregation Interval is Month, selecting Yes includes the data in the table by day of week
(Sun, Mon, Tues, and so on). Selecting No includes the data in the table by the day of the month (1,
2, 3, and so on). The default is Yes.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1787


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Align Day of Week for Months on Energy Chart


Select Yes to show the data for the Previous Period Energy Measurement chart by day of week
(Sat, Sun, Mo, ...) when a monthly rollup period is selected. Select No to show the data by day of
month (1, 2, 3, ...).

Apply TOU Schedule


Select if you want to use a time of use (TOU) schedule with this report. If you want to use a TOU
schedule, select a TOU schedule from the list. The list shows the existing TOU schedules that are
configured in the system. If you have not created a TOU schedule, the field shows that no schedule
is available.

Area
The area whose panels you want to include in the report.

ATS Summary
1. Click ATS Summary.

2. Click Include ATS Summary to include the Automatic Transfer Switch Summary section in
the report. The remaining options in the screen are enabled. Alternatively, clear this check box
to exclude the Automatic Transfer Switch Summary section from the report.

3. Click Include Pass/Fail Indicator to include both the Required Transfer Time and Test
Status results. The Test Status shows the pass/fail grade. Alternatively, clear this check box
to exclude the results from the report.

4. Lead ATS - Select the ATS device that you want to use as the lead ATS in reporting the
transfer time. The lead ATS is the ATS upon which the pass/fail grade is based.

You can choose the Auto Select Lead ATS option if you want the system to
automatically select the lead ATS. The ATS device that is first to enter test mode becomes
the lead ATS. If multiple ATS devices enter test mode at the same time, or if none of the
devices enter test mode, the system selects the ATS based on alphabetical order.

5. Click OK to save your changes and return to the report template.

Auto-scale Y-Axis
Select whether or not to scale the chart normally. Selecting No, sets the starting point of the Y-axis
at zero. The default is Yes.

Auto-scale Second Y-Axis


Select whether or not to scale the chart normally. Selecting No, sets the starting point of the second
(right) Y-axis at zero. The default is Yes.

Base Interval
This setting works together with Include Empty Intervals. When Include Empty Intervals is
turned on, the system uses the Base Interval to determine the timestamps for the empty records
that are inserted.

Baseline Date
Use the Baseline Date to compare the current state of the breaker settings to a baseline point in
time. If a change is detected between the state of the settings today and the state of the settings on
the baseline date the change will be noted in the report.

1788 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Calculation Method (Left and Right)


Select the aggregation method to be used for rolling up both cumulative and non cumulative
measurements. Examples of non cumulative measurements include Voltage, Current, and Power.
An example of a cumulative measurement is Energy. Cumulative measurements are aggregated by
summation.

CBEMA (1996), CBEMA (Updated), ITIC, SEMI F47 curves


Click Yes for the power quality curve (CBEMA (1996), CBEMA (Updated), ITIC, or SEMI F47) that
you want to show in the incident plots. Click No to hide the curve.

You can select one or more of the curves.

Change Summary
Click Yes to include the Change Summary section of the report. Click No to not include it. The
default is No.

Chart Type
Select one of the available chart types from the dropdown list to graphically display the data that you
specified for the report.

Check Source
Use this input to select the reference source for the bill comparison, for example the utility owned
metering source. To select the source, choose a hierarchy view or virtual meter.

Choose a Model and a Reporting Aggregation Interval


Select the model you want to use for the report from the Model drop-down list.

Select the aggregation interval you want to use for the report from the Reporting Aggregation
Interval drop-down list. The options available in this drop-down list depend on the selected model.

Circuit Breaker Inventory


Click Yes to include the Inventory section of the report. Click No to not include it. The default is
Yes.

Comments
Use this field to add comments that will appear at the bottom of the generated report.

Company Name
Type a name for the company in the text box.

Cumulative Degradation Threshold


Enter the value that represents the maximum total voltage difference between the reference
waveform and the evaluated waveforms. For example, if the waveform is off by 1.0 on each point
from the reference, the total degradation is 10. If the threshold value is 8, then the degradation
exceeds the threshold.

Custom Page Height


Specify a custom output page height. This value is ignored if Page Size is set to Fit to Page.

Custom Page Width


Specify a custom output page width. This value is ignored if Page Size is set to Fit to Page.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1789


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Custom Units Label


Enter any text to be used as the measurement label for instances when normalization is used , for
example, kWh/Person. The default is kWh.

Custom URL
(Optional) Specify the URL for any page or image that you would like to include in the report. This
could be a page from an external or internal website, or a local image.

Customers
Click Select Customers. Select the customers that you want to include in the report from the list.
Click Select All to select all the customers from the list. Click None to deselect all the customers.
Click OK.

Data Center Energy Measurement


Click Select Measurement to choose the measurement for interval energy usage for the entire data
center. This will typically be a 15-minute interval value.

Data Center Power Measurement


Click Select Measurement to choose the measurement for instantaneous power consumption for
the entire data center.

Data Center Source


Click Select Source to choose a single source to represent the entire data center facility.

Degree Days Pivot Point


The Degree Days Pivot Point is the point where either heating or cooling is required to keep the
temperature within the designated degree range.

Demand Adjustment (%)


Enter a multiplier, in %, to apply to the load measurements. For example, a demand adjustment of
125% applied to a load measurement of 100 kW, results in an adjusted load measurement of 125
kW. The default value is 125.

Demand Rating
Enter a value for the rated capacity of the equipment, based on the selected measurement. For
example, if you selected an Active Power measurement (kW), enter the rated kW capacity. The
default value is 1000.

Dependent Variable
The dependent variable is the measurement you want to model. For example, if you are modeling
the energy consumption of a building based on outside temperature, then the energy is the
dependent variable.

To specify the dependent variable,

1. Click Select Source and select a device from the Devices list or a Hierarchy node from the
Views list.

2. Click Select Measurement and select the measurement to be modeled.

3. Select an aggregation method for the measurement from the Aggregation Method drop down

1790 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

list.

The following aggregation methods are available:

AVG: calculates the average measurement value over the interval.


SUM: adds up the measurement values over the interval.
DELTA: subtracts the beginning measurement value from the end measurement value of the
interval.

NOTE: If you are using a Hierarchy node as a source for the dependent variable and you are using
a cumulative measurement, such as Real Energy (kWh), you must use SUM as aggregation
method. This is because the hierarchy converts the cumulative measurement into interval
measurements.

Deviation Type
Enter a percentage or specific value to specify the type of deviation to show in the report.

Display Billing ID
Click Yes to show an alphanumeric billing ID for a tenant which can be used by third party billing
engine.

Display Mode
Select in which form you would like to see the report output from the Display Mode drop-down list.

The following display modes are available:

Forecast: Compare the model output for the reporting period to the actually measured data for that
period, where the model was created for a baseline period in the past.
Backcast: Compare the model output for a past period to the actually measured data for that
period, where the model was created for the reporting period in the present time.

Display Zero Days


Select whether or not to show days where data is logged but the values are all zero. Note that days
with no logged values at all are still included in the report. The default is No.

Driver Data Quantity


Click Select Measurement. Navigate to and select a measurement, and then click OK.

Driver Data Source


Click Select Source, and then choose from the dropdown list a Grouping: None, Group Name, Site,
or Device Type. Navigate to and select a source, and then click OK.

Duration (sec)
Select the duration of rms variation that you want to use in the report (such as 15 seconds, 30
seconds, no limit, etc.)

The duration is the time window used by the generated report to count the voltage swag and / or
swell. The default value is 60 seconds.

Email Address
Enter a comma-separated list of email addresses to which notification emails will be sent.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1791


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Email Recipients (comma separated)


Enter a comma-separated list of email addresses to which to email the transformed XML.

Email Subject
Enter the subject line for the notification emails.

Email XML Export


Select Yes to email the transformed XML output ('XML Export File') to the addresses specified in
Email Recipients.

End Hour
Select the end hour to display when filtering the data by the time of day.

The time range in the list is in 24-hour format in descending order.

Energy Cost per kWh


Enter the appropriate value for the blended cost of energy. This value is used in the calculations for
the cost of losses in the report. Only numeric values with up to two decimal places will be used in
the report.

The currency symbol used to display the cost values is set in Web Applications SETTINGS >
Personalization > System Language.

Energy Measurement Label


Type a label to describe the measurements selected in Energy Measurements.

Use this label to aggregate disparate units into a common measurement unit.

For example, for Gas (GJ) and Electricity (kWh) values you could define the Energy Label as 'BTU'.

Energy Measurements
1. Click Select Load Measurement to open the Load Measurement Selector dialog.

2. Under Load, click Select Source to open the Source Selector.

The Source Selector dialog provides options to show Devices or Views.

Use the Devices option to select the devices you want to include in the report.

From the Grouping list, select the way in which you want to display the sources (for
example by device type or by group name). Click + and - to expand and collapse items in
the navigation tree. Click the check box beside a device (or group of devices) to select it.
Click Select All or Select None in the top-right corner to select or clear all the check
boxes.

Use the Views option to select a hierarchy view (a tree of relationships) or virtual meters.

The hierarchy views and virtual meters are configured in the Hierarchy Manager
component. (See the Hierarchy Manager Help for further information about hierarchies,
virtual meters, and views.) Click + and - to expand and collapse items in the tree. Click
the check box beside any hierarchy item in the tree or any virtual meter to select it.

Click OK after making your selections.

1792 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

3. Under Measurements:
a. Click Select Measurement to open the Measurement Selector.

b. Choose the measurement you want to use for the energy comparison and click OK.

c. If required, enter a Multiplier value.

The multiplier lets you add multiple measurements. For example, a multiplier can be used
to get gas and electricity energy currencies onto the same unit footings, so they can be
added together.

4. (Optional) Use Normalization to normalize measurement values. 


a. In Label, enter the normalization label value.

b. In Value, enter the value that you want to normalize.

For example: To normalize energy usage per square foot of a building, enter Energy per
Square Foot in the Label value, and the square footage of the building in the Value field.

5. Click OK.

Energy Period Comparison Range


Select the reporting period for the Previous Period Energy Measurement.

Select the reporting period from the dropdown list. The timeframe options in the timeframe dropdown
are relative to the date the report is run. To run a report that starts and ends in the past, select the
fixed date option. Type a start and end date in the date boxes or click the arrows beside the dates to
display a pop-up calendar and select a date. Type a time in the time boxes or click the up and down
arrows beside the time to adjust the hours or minutes up or down.

Select the timezone you want to view timestamps in.

Energy Period Rollup


Select the aggregation time interval for the Previous Period Energy Measurement data.

Enter an optional coefficient in % to be applied on the modeled data


(Optional) Enter coefficients that are applied to the modeled data to adjust the model output based
on known or expected changes.

For example, if you implemented an energy conservation measure on June 1, 2016 for which you
are expecting an energy saving of 15%, enter -15 as a coefficient and June 1, 2016 as the start date
from which to apply it on. All modeled data, starting with that date, will be adjusted by -15%. You
can add multiple coefficients at multiple dates. Coefficients are applied cumulatively, on top of any
previously applied coefficients.

To specify a coefficient,

1. Enter the coefficient value in percent, including the sign, in the text box.

2. Enter the date on which this coefficient takes effect into the date box.

To add additional coefficients, click the + sign next to the coefficient text box. Click - to remove a
coefficient.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1793


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

EPSS Group
Select the transfer switches and other equipment group for the report. The list shows the groups that
you defined in the configuration utility. When you select a group from the list, the field to the right
shows the devices included in the group.

Evaluation Limits
Click Configure to configure the EN50160 parameters used in the report. Default values are
provided based on the EN50160 standard.
Click the links in the dialog box to access configuration options for various measurements included
in the report:

• Basic Configuration: Type the maximum percentage of intervals in an observation period


where the component does not meet the EN50160 N1 and N2 requirements before the
component is considered non-compliant.

• Supply Voltage Dips: Type the maximum percentage of intervals in an observation period that
the RMS value can drop below 90% of the nominal voltage for each duration and depth
presented in the dialog box before the component is considered non-compliant.

• Short and Long Interruptions: Type the maximum percentage of intervals in an observation
period that the RMS value can be less than 1% of the nominal voltage for the given duration
before the component is considered non-compliant.

• Temporary Overvoltages: Type the maximum percentage of intervals in an observation period


that the RMS value can exceed the nominal voltage by each magnitude for each duration
presented in the dialog box before the component is considered non-compliant.

NOTE: The EN50160 standard defines the observation period for the above components as one
week.

Event Location
Select how you want to identify the location of the events that are included in the generated report.
The available selections are Internal and External, Internal only, or External only.

Event Priority
Select the priority of alarms and events that you want to include in the report. The options include
high, medium, and low priority alarms and events.

Events Summary
1. Click Events Summary.

2. Click Include Events Summary to include the Events Summary section in the report. The
remaining options in the screen are enabled. Alternatively, clear this check box to exclude the
Events Summary section from the report.

3. Click Include Generator Events to include generator events in the report. Alternatively, clear
this check box to exclude generator events from the report.

4. Click Include ATS Events to include ATS events in the report. Alternatively, clear this check
box to exclude ATS events from the report.

5. Click OK to save your changes and return to the report template.

1794 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Exclude Days with Rollover


Exclude days that contain rollover from the report.

Exclude Incomplete Days


Exclude days that are incomplete from the report.

Exclude Incomplete Weeks


Exclude weeks that are incomplete from the report.

Exclude Sources
(Optional) Define the sources to exclude from the report:

a. In the Sources Included area, select sources to exclude and then click > to move those
sources to the Sources Excluded area.

b. To move all of the sources into the Sources Excluded area, click >>.

c. Click OK to save the sources and return to the report template.

The devices in the group appear in the Sources section of the generated report. Excluded devices
appear as grayed-out entries.

Exclude Unscaled Values


Select whether or not to show the zero values, which can not be scaled in the data table of the
generated report. The default is No. If a scaling Source and Measurement pair is selected but for
some of the rolled up intervals (Aggregation + Time of Use), these values cannot be calculated
because of divide by zero error. In this case these values will be set to zero.

Exclude Values Over


Enter a value to indicate the point at which values over this number are not plotted in the chart. The
default value is No Exclusions.

Exclude Values Under


Enter a value to indicate the point at which values over this number are not plotted in the chart. The
default value is No Exclusions.

Export File Path

NOTE: For Measurement Aggregation Export Report, you can use the Export Format parameter
to select the export format. For Measurement Statistics Export Report, you can export the report
output files in CSV format only. No specific parameter is available for selection of export format.

Enter a path or file share on the PME server where the report output files will be saved to. If you do
not provide a file name as part of the path, the system will use the default file name
DefaultExport.csv for the export file. You do not need to include an extension with the file
name.

NOTE: The WebReporterAppPool application pool in IIS must have write permission on the Export
File Path location. This application pool is running under the NetworkServices Identity when PME
is installed with SQL Authentication. When it is installed with Windows Integrated Authentication,
then the Windows account that is used to access the databases is used to run the application
pool.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1795


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Examples:

Path, including file name: C:\Temp\test.

Path, without file name: C:\Temp\. (NOTE: Do not forget to include the \ at the end of the path.)

NOTE: This note is applicable for Measurement Aggregation Export Report. When the CSV 
(RegGen Compatible) Export Format is selected, the report output is organized by source and
saved to a file with the source name. If multiple sources are selected, one output file for each
source is created.

Export Format
Select the format for the CSV export file. The available options are:

• CSV

Standard CSV output format. All the data is saved into a single output file. Example:

• CSV (RegGen compatible)

This format is compatible with RepGen, a Microsoft Excel based reporting system that was part
of earlier versions of PME. One output file is created for each selected source. Example:

• Tidy

This format is similar to the RepGen compatible format. It includes the source names and all the
data is saved into a single output file. Example:

Facility Location
(Optional) Type the data center facility location.

Facility Name
Type the data center facility name.

Flicker Baseline - High


Type the Flicker Baseline High value if the default is not appropriate for your needs.

Flicker Baseline - Low


Type the Flicker Baseline Low value if the default is not appropriate for your needs.

1796 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Frequency Baseline [%]


Type the Frequency Baseline value if the default is not appropriate for your needs.

Frequency Nominal [Hz]


Type the nominal frequency of the system (for example, 60).

Generator Summary
1. Click Generator Summary.

2. Click Include Generator Summary to include the Generator Summary section in the report.
The remaining options in the screen are enabled. Alternatively, clear this check box to exclude
the Generator Summary section from the report.

3. Click Include Pass/Fail Indicator to include both the pass/fail grade and the test method
used to evaluate each generator. The pass/fail grade is based on both the run duration and the
minimum specified percentage of the prime nameplate rating. Alternatively, clear this check
box to exclude the pass/fail grade and the test method from the report.

4. Select the Electric Data options to specify the electrical data in the report:
Include Chart: Select this check box to include a generator chart showing kW Load, kVA
Load, and the threshold for the minimum acceptable power load based on the specified
load percentage for the run duration.

Include Avg., Min, Max Table: Select this check box to include a table showing
minimum, average, and maximum electrical readings for the longest continuous load at (or
above) the specified load percentage. The electrical readings measured are: kW, kVA, Ia,
Ib, Ic, In, Vab, Van, Vbc, Vbn, Vca, Vcn.

Include Details: Select this check box to include a table showing the generator electrical
details. The data is organized by time intervals and displays the readings for kW, kVA,
load (the percentage of maximum load identified on the generator nameplate), Power
Factor (PF), I avg, VLL avg, VLN avg, and Frequency.

5. Select the Engine Temperature Data options to specify the engine temperature data in the
report:
Include Chart: Select this check box to include a chart showing the engine temperature
for the run duration, and a horizontal line identifying the minimum temperature required for
the run duration.

Include Avg, Min, Max Table: Select this check box to include a table showing
Minimum, Average, and Maximum engine temperature readings for the longest continuous
engine temperature equal to or above the minimum acceptable engine temperature.

Include Details: Select this check box to include a table showing the Longest
Continuous ET (Engine Temperature) time period, the Minimum ET, Required Run
Duration (Min), and Actual Run Duration.

NOTE: The configuration tool does not convert the engine temperature values from one
temperature type to another.

6. Select the Exhaust Gas Temperature Data options to specify the exhaust gas temperature
data in the report:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1797


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Include Chart: Select this check box to include a chart showing the exhaust gas
temperature for the run duration, and a horizontal line identifying the minimum temperature
required for the run duration.

Include Avg, Min, Max Table: Select this check box to include a table showing
Minimum, Average, and Maximum exhaust gas temperature readings for the longest
continuous engine temperature equal to or above the minimum acceptable exhaust
temperature.

Include Details: Select this check box to include a table showing the Longest
Continuous EGT (Exhaust Gas Temperature) time period, the Minimum EGT, Required
Run Duration (Min), and Actual Run Duration.

7. Under Engine Data, click Include Details to include engine details in the report. Details for
each generator include:
Generator name

Generator start and stop times by date

A label to indicate whether the data was collected automatically or manually.

A table of measurements; such as battery voltage and coolant temperature. Each


measurement includes a timestamp and the corresponding values.

8. Click OK to save your changes and return to the report template.

Gauge Scale Override


Choose a specific value for all of the gauge scales to use in custom situations, such as when
normalizing data. This input is optional.

Group
Keep the default option All Groups or select a specific power quality group from the list.

The groups are defined in the Power Quality Group configuration file, which is implemented during
Power Quality Performance commissioning.

Grouped By
Select from the dropdown list to determine how the circuit breaker aging and electrical wear analysis
results are sorted.

High Target Line (Left and Right Axis)


Enter a value for the target line representing the target for the high end of your energy use. This
target line is red in the generated report. The default is No Target Line.

High Target Name (Left and Right Axis)


Enter a name to identify the high target line in the chart legend for the left and right axis,
respectively. The defaults are Left Axis High Target and Right Axis High Target, respectively.

Highlight End
Select the end hour to stop the highlighting of the line in the chart.

The time range in the list is in 24-hour format in descending order.

Highlight Start
Select the start hour to begin the highlighting of the line in the chart.

1798 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

The time range in the list is in 24-hour format in ascending order.

Incident Interval
Select the incident interval that you want to use in the report (such as, 20 seconds, 10 minutes, 1
week).

The incident interval is the time window used by the generated report to group multiple disturbances
together into a single incident. The default value is 20 seconds.

Include Activity Details


Click Yes to include a generator details section in the report. Click No to exclude this section.

Include Aggregation Chart


Select whether or not to include a bar chart in the generated report showing a summary of the
measurement you chose for the selected sources. The default is Yes.

Include 100% Area Chart


Select whether or not to include an area chart showing the data results stacked to a 100% level. The
default is Yes.

Include Area Chart


Select whether or not to include an area chart in the generated report to view the contribution of data
over a given period of time.

Include Average Harmonic Charts


Select whether or not to include charts showing the average values related to harmonic compliance.
The default is Yes.

Include Breakers with Minor Aging and Wear


Select Yes or No. Selecting Yes allows all of the breakers to appear in the report regardless of the
current electrical aging and electrical wear levels. Selecting No allows only breakers with moderate
or critical electrical aging and electrical wear to appear.

Include Chart
Select whether or not to include the chart in the generated report. The default is Yes.

Include Column Chart


Select whether or not to include a column chart in the generated report to compare the data
represented in the chart. The default is Yes.

Include Data Table


Select whether or not to show the data table in the generated report. The default is No.

Include Data Tables


Click Yes to include a section for capacity data in the report. Click No to exclude capacity data.

Include Data Tables in the Detail Section


Select whether or not to show data table for power quality events in the generated report. The
default is No.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1799


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Include Data Warnings


Click Yes to include data warnings in the report. If there are none, the section is not included. Click
No to exclude this section.

Include Duplicates
Select whether or not to show duplicate data in the generated report. The default is No.

Duplicate data collection is disabled in Power Monitoring Expert by default. In order to be able to
include duplicate data in a report, duplicate data collection must first be enabled for the system.

Include Electrical Details


Select the option to specify the start records. When you click Select Reference Starts you can
choose the specific start records by generator and date. For example, you can use this option to
compare yesterday's Gen 1 start voltage signature to the Gen 1 start voltage signature from six
months prior.

Include Empty Intervals


Select to include or exclude data records in the report output that have no data. If Rollup is Interval,
an empty data record will be shown as an empty row or column in the table with the corresponding
interval timestamp. This can be useful for data exporting to avoid missing rows.

Include EN50160 Configuration Parameters


Select whether or not to include the configuration inputs entered in the Configure Evaluation Limits
dialog in the generated report.

Include Event History


Click Yes to include event log data in the report. Click No to exclude it.

Include Events And Disturbances in the Detail Section


Click the field to open the Events and Disturbances dialog. By default, all items under Events and
Disturbances are selected, as well as Power Factor.

Clear the checkboxes for any specific items that you do not want to include in the generated report.
If you clear or select Events or Disturbances, the checkboxes for all of the items included in that
category are cleared or selected.

Include Gauges
Select whether or not to include the gauges in the generated report. The default is Yes.

Include Harmonic Detail Charts


Select whether or not to include charts showing a second level of harmonic compliance detail for the
generated report. The default is No.

Include Interval Column Trend


Select whether or not to include a bar chart in the generated report showing the measurement you
chose for the sources for each hour in the 24-hour period for the specified days. The default is Yes.

Include Interval Line Trend


Select whether or not to include a line chart in the generated report showing the measurement you
chose for the sources for each hour in the 24-hour period for the specified days. The default is No.

1800 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Include Line Chart


Select whether or not to include a line chart in the generated report to display the data trend over a
given time period. The default is Yes.

Include Measured Data


Choose to include the actual data with the modeled data or not by selecting Yes or No for Include
Measured Data.

Include Non Impacting Events


Select Yes if you want to include events in the Power Quality Events — Details section of the
generated report that are classified as having no impact on the power quality of your site. By default,
power quality events with no impact are excluded from the generated report.

Include Pie Chart


Select whether or not to include a pie chart in the generated report to show a numerical proportion of
the results. The default is Yes.

Include Report Parameters Summary


Select whether or not to include report parameters in the generated report. The default is Yes.

Include Stacked Aggregation Chart


Select whether or not to include a stacked chart in the generated report showing the measurement
you chose for the selected sources. The default is No.

Include Stacked Column Chart


Select whether or not to include a stacked column chart in the generated report to display the
proportions for the data represented in the chart. The default is Yes.

Include Tables
Select whether or not to include the tables in the generated report. The default is Yes.

Include THD/TDD Charts


Select whether or not to include charts showing the total harmonic distortion (THD) of the voltage
waveform, and the total demand distortion (TDD) of the current waveform, in the generated report.
The default is Yes.

Include Two Specific Periods Only


Select whether or not to include only the first and last period of data in the selected date range. The
default is No.

Include Unassociated Breakers


Include breakers that are not defined as being part of Switchboards and Groups in the report. The
default is Yes.

Include Undetermined Incidents


This option represents the number of events that cannot be classified as External or Internal.
Select Yes or No to include or exclude the data for these events from the generated report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1801


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Independent Variable
The independent variable is the driver that influences the measurement you want to model. For
example, if you are modeling the energy consumption of a building based on outside temperature,
then the outside temperature is the independent variable. You can specify one or more independent
variables.

To specify the independent variables,

1. Click Select Source and select a source from the list. Hierarchies are not supported for
independent variables.

2. Click Select Measurement and select the measurement.

3. Select an aggregation method for the measurement from the Aggregation Method drop down
list.

The following aggregation methods are available:

AVG: Calculates the average measurement value over the interval.


SUM: Sums the measurements values over the interval.
DELTA: Subtracts the beginning measurement value from the end measurement value of the
interval.
MIN: Selects the minimum measurement value over the interval.
MAX: Selects the minimum measurement value over the interval.
CDD: Calculates the Cooling Degree Days.
HDD: Calculates the Heating Degree Days.

For CDD or HDD, enter the base temperature in the Degree Days Base Temperature input
box that is displayed when one of these options is selected.

To add additional variables, click the + sign next to the Select Source button. Click - to remove a
variable. To enable or disable a variable, select or clear the check box next to the Select Source
button.

Input Source Measurements


Select one or more measurements and their sources, to be used in the calculation of the KPI. Each
measurement is associated with a label, for example A,B,C, ... which you use to define the KPI
formula.

Insert Data
You can save the output of the model report into the Power Monitoring Expert database and use it
for display in Dashboards and Trends. The source name created for this data in the database is
Modeled_Data.<model name>. The following measurements will be recorded for this source:

Measured: This is a copy of the dependent variable measured data.


Modeled Data: This is the data calculated by the model for the dependent variable.
Residual: This is the delta between the Measured data and the Modeled data
Residual%: This is the Residual data in percent.

To save the data into the database, select Yes for Insert Data.

1802 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

TIP: Setup a subscription to run the model report weekly for the last 7 days and save the output
into the database. This will ensure you have a complete data set for modeled data for use in
Dashboards and Trends.

Interval and Sub Model Configuration


Select the reporting interval from the Interval drop-down list.

Select the sub model from the Sub Model drop-down list. The options in this drop-down list depend
on the selected Interval and the sub models that have been defined in Settings > System >
Modeling.

The Database Driven option is used to define operating conditions instead of time periods for sub-
modeling. For example, you could define the condition of Power Factor < 0.8. That means that one
sub-model is used when the Power Factor is < 0.8 and a different one when it is >= 0.8. This is
similar to sub-modeling based on weekdays versus weekend days, just that the Power Factor value
is used as a condition instead of the day of the week.

When you select Database Driven, additional input boxes are displayed to select the Source,
Measurement, Key, and Value. The Key is the condition, for example for Power Factory < 0.8,
enter <0.8 in the Key input box. The Value box is just a label to identify the condition, so you could
enter Low PF for low Power Factor.

You can add one or more conditions. Click the + icon to add additional conditions.

NOTE: Conditions are applied in the order in which they are defined in the report.

IT Equipment Energy Measurement


Click Select Measurement to choose the measurement for interval energy usage for all the IT
equipment used. This will typically be a 15-minute interval value.

IT Equipment Power Measurement


Click Select Measurement to choose the measurement for instantaneous power consumption for
all the IT equipment used.

IT Equipment Source
Click Select Source to choose the single source that represents all the IT equipment operated in
the data center facility.

Keep True Totals


Select Yes if you want the totals in the report to be unaffected by the filtering. If you want the totals
in the report to be based on line item and tenant filter, select No.

KPI Formula
Enter the mathematical formula that is used to calculate the KPI from the input parameters. Use the
labels that are associated with the input parameters in the Input Source Measurements section as
variables in the formula. You can use the following operators +, -, /, *, Pow(), Sqrt().

Here are some examples of valid formula syntax:

• (A + B) / C

• A+B+C

• C / (A + B)

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1803


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

• Pow(A+B+C,2)

• Sqrt(A+B)

KPI Measurement
Select the measurement that is used to represent the KPI output value. The calculated KPI values
will be logged under this measurement and the KPI Source. Use the KPI Measurement Override
if you cannot find a suitable output measurement.

KPI Measurement Override


Only use this input if you cannot find a suitable measurement under KPI Measurement.

Manually enter the name of a measurement to be used to represent the KPI output value. This
overrides any measurement selected under KPI Measurement. If the measurement you enter does
not already exist in Power Monitoring Expert, it is created.

KPI Source
Enter the name of the source for which the calculated KPI values are logged in Power Monitoring
Expert. The source is created automatically, if it does not exist already.

Line Item Filter


Anything entered in the Line Item Filter parameter (comma separated) includes rows from the Item
column. For example, to include the On Peak Usage line item, enter On Peak Usage in the Line
Item Filter. To include both On and Off Peak usage, enter Peak Usage.

Load Measurement
Select the source you want.

Load Profile Measurements


Select one or more measurements to be displayed in a trend chart at the end of each bill. The
measurements are associated with the selected tenants. The date range for the chart is the same
as the selected reporting period.

Lock Chart Scales at Zero


Select whether or not to force the y-axis to start at zero rather than scaling the chart normally. The
default is Yes.

Logged Measurement
1. Click Select Source to open the Source Selector dialog.

2. Select the source and then click OK.

3. Click Select Measurement to open the Measurement Selector dialog.

4. Select the instantaneous measurement (power, power factor, current, THD, etc.) and then
click OK.

Low Target Line (Left and Right Axis)


Enter a value for the target line representing the target for the low end of your energy use. This target
line is yellow in the generated report. The default is No Target Line.

Low Target Name (Left and Right Axis)


Enter a name to identify the low target line in the chart legend for the left and right axis, respectively.
The defaults are Left Axis Low Target and Right Axis Low Target, respectively.

1804 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Lower Target Line


Enter a value for the target line representing the target for the low end of the energy use. The lower
target is a yellow line in the report. Columns in charts that are on lower target line, or between the
lower target line and the upper target line, are outlined in yellow. The default value is 0.

Maintenance Status
Click Yes to include the Maintenance Status section of the report. Click No to not include it. The
default is Yes.

Manual
Click Manual to select the runs according to a date range and run reason, and then do the following:

1. Select the Reporting Period date range for the runs to include in the report.

2. Select the Run Reason for the runs to include in the report.

If you select Most recent run and define excluded sources, the exclusions are ignored
when you generate the report.

The devices in the group will appear in the Sources section of the report. Devices that you excluded
from the report will be gray-shaded.

Max Authorized Deviation


Enter a value by which deviation is allowed for the report.

Measurement Label
Input the label to be used to describe the measurements selected in Load Measurement.

Measurements (Reports other than Load Profile)


Use this input to select the measurements you want to include in the report.

Click Select Measurement to open the Measurement Selector dialog. Click + and - to expand and
collapse items in the navigation tree. For reports where you can select multiple measurements,
click the check box beside a measurement (or group of measurements) to select it. For reports
where you can only select a single measurement, click the measurement name to select it.

After selecting the measurements, click OK.

Measurements (with Smart Mode)


Smart Mode is enabled in the Measurement Selector when you select the Views radio button in
the Source Selector, which then lets you select a hierarchy view or a virtual meter for your source
parameter.
When you open the Measurement Selector, Smart Mode lists general measurement names by
default. A Detailed Mode option is also available for the measurements.

Smart Mode provides a general measurement name for you to select. The measurement is based
on a subset derived from all of the available measurements in the particular measurement category.
The underlying operation selects an applicable measurement for each device to produce equivalent
results for reporting purposes.

The following image illustrates how measurements in Smart Mode are determined and applied from
the priority list of measurements. The priority list contains measurements that usually provide
equivalent results for the measurement selected in Smart Mode.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1805


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

For example, for each device included in a hierarchy view or in a virtual meter, the report starts with
the Real Energy measurement in the priority list. If data for that measurement exists, then it is used
in the report. If data does not exist for the Real Energy measurement, then the report goes to the
Real Energy Total measurement in the list. If data exists for that measurement, then it is used. The
report continues to progress through the priority list to select a measurement that pertains to each
device associated with a hierarchy view or a virtual meter.

You can select Detailed to change to the detailed selection mode. This mode allows you to select
from a full list of measurements.

Smart Mode Detailed Mode

1806 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

The Measurement Selector provides a full list of measurements when you select the Devices
radio button in the Source Selector.

Click + and - to expand and collapse items in the navigation tree. For reports where you can select
multiple measurements, click the check box beside a measurement (or group of measurements) to
select it. For reports where you can only select a single measurement, click the measurement name
to select it.

After selecting the measurements, click OK.

Measurements (Load Profile Report)


This input determines whether the report is calculated using demand or power measurements.
Select either Demand or Power from the dropdown list.

Measurement Interval
Select the observation period (that is, the measurement interval) of 2 Hour, 10 Minute, or 3
Second to use for the IEC61000-4-30 report.

Measurement Target Line


Select a measurement to use with the source identified in Source Target Line to establish ON and
OFF peak target lines in the generated report.

Model Data Quantity


Click Select Measurement. Navigate to and select a measurement, and then click OK.

Model Data Source


Click Select Source, and then choose from the dropdown list a Grouping: None, Group Name, Site,
or Device Type. Navigate to and select a source, and then click OK.

Multiplier
Enter a value to use as a multiplier in normalizing the raw data in the report. The default is 1.

n % Crossing
Type a value for the duration percentage. This value indicates where to place a cross on the plotted
line identifying where that percentage value occurs.

Notify On
Select a notification option for when to send out notification emails. The available options are:

• Do Not Notify

No notification email will be sent.

• Both

Send a notification email if either alarm threshold is exceeded.

• Check Source vs Actual Total

Only send a notification if the threshold for the Check vs Actual Total is exceeded.

• Check Source vs Private Source

Only send a notification if the threshold for the Check vs Private Source is exceeded.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1807


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Notify on Std Dev Exception


Select a notification option for when to send out notification emails. The available options are:

• Do Not Notify

No notification email will be sent.

• Both Upper and Lower

Send a notification email if the calculated upper and lower line value exceeds the aggregated
interval value.

• Upper Only

Send a notification email if the calculated upper line value exceeds the aggregated interval
value.

• Lower Only

Send a notification email if the calculated lower line value exceeds the aggregated interval
value.

Notify On Target Value Exception


Select whether or not to send out notification emails whenever the calculated value of aggregated
interval exceeds the specified static target value. The default is No.

Notify/Show Charts on Last Aggregated Interval Exception Only


Select whether or not to send out notification emails and show in charts whenever the last
aggregated interval exceeds the specified target lines. The default is No. The last interval is the
absolute last aggregated interval in the selected reporting period, regardless whether data exists for
that period.

Notes
Any notes appear at the bottom of the report page.

Non Cumulative Measurement Calculation


Select the aggregation method to be used for rolling up non cumulative measurements. Examples of
non cumulative measurements include Voltage, Current, Power. An example of a cumulative
measurement is Energy. Cumulative measurements are aggregated by summation.

Sub-reports
The options available for selection are Generate dynamically and Embed into single report.

• Select Generate dynamically to generate an incident summary report only. You can click the
links in the report to view incident details and also associated waveforms.

This option provides a convenient way to generate a summary of incidents to give you an
indication for investigating a particular incident or waveform. This option is recommended for
interactive viewing and analysis within the reporting period.

• Select Embed into single report to include the incident summary, the incident details, and the
waveforms associated with those incidents in a single generated report. This single report
format facilitates exporting the information to one of the available download formats, and it also
facilitates setting and delivering a report subscription. This option is recommended for attaching
the report to an email.

1808 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

This option provides a convenient way to extract and share power quality-related information.
Although power quality events vary from system to system, it takes longer to generate the
report using this option because the system queries more data, including data-intensive
waveforms. To prevent possible report timeouts, it is suggested that you keep the number of
waveforms to a minimum by:
Selecting a single source.

Specifying a reporting period of a single day or less.

Order By
Select to order the list of bills in the report output by tenant name or by rate file name.

Overwrite File
Selecting Yes overwrites an existing file if it exists and selecting No appends the new data to an
existing file.

Overwrite XML Export


Selecting Yes overwrites an existing file if it exists and selecting No appends the new data to an
existing file.

Page Size
Select from the dropdown list. Select Fit to Page to automatically scale each output page to fit onto
a single report page. Select Custom to scale the output based on the height and width values
provided in the Custom Page Height and Custom Page Width boxes.

Page Wait Time in Seconds


Specify the maximum time the report waits for the slideshow or custom URL to load. If you selected
multiple slideshows, then this maximum wait time is applied to each of the slideshows. If a
slideshow or URL loads faster than the maximum wait time, the report completes before this time
has elapsed.

Power Factor Target


The target power factor for the site. The default target is 92, which you can change to match you site
power factor target.

The target power factor is configured in the Power Factor Impact Rate.xml file when the Power
Quality Performance module is commissioned. This rate file is included in the Energy Billing
Module, which is subject to licensing. Contact your Schneider Electric representative for further
information.

Precision
Enter the decimal value precision to use in report output and saved values.

Previous Period Energy Measurement


Select one or more usage measurements. These measurements will be displayed in a column chart,
as past consumption for the selected tenants, at the end of each bill. The reporting period for these
measurements is set through the Energy Period Comparison Range input.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1809


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Primary Sort
Select the primary sort column from the drop-down list. Your choice sets the primary sort column for
the report; customer, rack or circuit. Depending on how your hierarchy is configured, the sort might
contain customer and circuit only.

Priority
Select the priority of alarms and events that you want to include in the report. The options include
high, medium, and low priority alarms and events.

Private Source
Use this input to select a source for the bill comparison, for example the internal metering source.
To select the source, choose a hierarchy view or virtual meter.

Protection Modes
Click Yes to include the Protection Modes section of the report. Click No to not include it. The
default is Yes.

PUE Category
Select a number for the report category. The value appears as a label below the report title. The label
will be “Category n”, where “n” represents the number selected.

Category 1 is measured at the Uninterrupted Power Supply (UPS). Category 2 is measured at the
Power Distribution Units (PDU). Category 0 and 3 are not included in the PUE Report.

Rate
Select the rate structure to apply to this report. The rate determines how the cost for each source is
calculated.

Rates
Use this input to set up parameters for energy cost reporting. Click Configure Rates to open the
Energy Rates dialog.

• Click Energy and Demand to configure basic rate parameters for the report.
In the Select Measurements section, click the check box beside a measurement to
include it in the report.

In the Select Billing Calculation section, select Flat Rate or select TOU Schedule. If
you select TOU Schedule, select a time of use (TOU) schedule from the dropdown list
(see the Time of Use Editor topic in the online help for Management Console Tools for
information on configuring a time of use schedule).

In the Set Rates section, enter the rates for the selected measurements.

In the Set Demand Calculation section, select the calculation method used to determine
demand: Independent (peak demand is calculated independently for each source) or
Coincident (the demand measurements of the sources are correlated with the peak
demand of the main meter). If you select Coincident for the calculation method, click Main
Meter to select the source to which you want to correlate the demand measurements.

• Click WAGES to include WAGES (Water, Air, Gas, Electricity, Steam) measurements in the
report. Click the +/- buttons to add or remove measurements. Enter a name for the

1810 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

measurement then click Select Source and Select Measurement to select a source and
measurement. Enter a rate for the measurement in the Rate field.

• Click Additional Fees to add additional rate information to the report. Enter a name in the Rate
Name field and rate information in the Amount field.

Recovery Value Multiplier


Enter the multiplier value from 0.01 to 1.00. This value is used by the algorithm to determine the
waveform recovery voltage value and time (relative to the waveform voltage drop) for both reference
and comparison waveforms.

Regression Type
Choose from the dropdown list Single-Line or Broken-Line.

Report Data
Select one or more system configurations to use in the report:

1. Click Select Generator Systems. The Selector screen appears with the UPS systems you
set up in the Generator Power Configuration Utility.

2. Select one or more generator systems.

3. Click OK.

Report Data Generators


Select one or more system configurations to use in the report:

1. Click Select Generator Systems. The Selector screen appears with the UPS systems you
set up in the Generator Power Configuration Utility.

2. Select one or more generator systems.

3. Click OK.

Report Data UPS


Select one or more system configurations to use in the report:

1. Click Select UPS Systems. The Selector screen appears with the UPS systems you set up
in the UPS Power Configuration Utility.

2. Select one or more UPS systems.

3. Click OK.

Report End Date


Select either Today or Fixed Date for the data you want to generate in the report. If using Fixed
Date, enter the desired date.

Select either Server Local Time or UTC (Coordinated Universal Time).

Report Group
Select the group for which the report is intended.

Reporting Period
Use this input to select the timeframe for the data you want to view in the report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1811


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Select the reporting period from the dropdown list. The timeframe options in the timeframe dropdown
are relative to the date the report is run. To run a report that starts and ends in the past, select the
fixed date option. Type a start and end date in the date boxes or click the arrows beside the dates to
display a pop-up calendar and select a date. Type a time in the time boxes or click the up and down
arrows beside the time to adjust the hours or minutes up or down.

Select the timezone you want to view timestamps in.

Reporting Period (with additional options)


The Reporting Period input contains the following fields and dropdown lists:

• Timezone: Select whether you want to view timestamps in either Server Local Time or UTC
(Universal Coordinated Time).

• Aggregation Period: Select the block of time for which you want to compare data (i.e., day,
week).

• Comparison Type: Select what period of data you want to compare the selected Aggregation
Period to (i.e., today vs. the same day from the previous month or current month vs. the same
month from the previous year). The options vary depending on the Aggregation Period selected.

• Number of Comparisons: Enter the number of periods you want to compare.

• Aggregation Interval: This input appears when you select Month for the Aggregation
Period. Select how you want data grouped for the report: by date (Day of Month) or the day of
the week.

• Selected Dates: This box displays the dates of the data that will appear in the report based on
the options selected.

For example, to compare the selected measurements for the same day of the month over the last 12
months, set Aggregation Period to Day, set Comparison Type to Today vs. Same Weekday
From Previous Month, and enter 12 in the Number of Comparisons field.

Reporting Period (for Power Quality report)


Use this input to select the timeframe for the data you want to view in the report. The report retrieves
all events over the duration of the reporting period. The events are summarized into incidents and
displayed on the report according to the Incident Interval setting.

Select the reporting period from the dropdown list. The timeframe options in the timeframe dropdown
are relative to the date the report is run. Use a relative date option for reports that you want to
generate on a regularly scheduled basis. To run a report that starts and ends in the past, select the
fixed date option. Type a start and end date in the date boxes or click the arrows beside the dates to
display a pop-up calendar and select a date. Type a time in the time boxes or click the up and down
arrows beside the time to adjust the hours or minutes up or down.

Select whether you want to view timestamps in either Server Local Time or UTC (Universal
Coordinated Time).

Report Type
Select either Summary or Detail.

• Summary – Shows only the aggregated values for all racks/circuits for a given tenant.

• Detail – Shows the aggregated value as well as child values of the racks and circuits.

1812 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Rollup
Select the aggregation time interval for the reporting data.

NOTE: This note is applicable for KPI report. For the selection of Hourly, Daily, Weekly, or
Yearly value for Rollup parameter, the measurement values are always aggregated for the
selected measurements based on the interval values. For non-cumulative measurements, it is
recommended to select Interval value. For example, if Mean Current measurement is selected
and the Rollup is set to Interval, the Mean Current measurements for the selected interval is
displayed. If Rollup is set to Hourly, the Mean Current measurement values are displayed as
aggregated values and not average values.

Rollup Table Type


Select the format for the report data table. The available options are:

• Horizontal Rollup Table

The data is shown with sources and measurements as columns and timestamps as rows.
Example:

• Vertical Rollup Table

The data is shown with timestamps and measurements as columns and sources as rows.
Example:

• Demand and Consumption Rollup Table

The data is shown with sources and measurements as columns and timestamps as rows. This
view is similar to the horizontal table with more compact measurement column headers.
Example:

• Flat Rollup Table

The data is shown with the source name, measurement name, timestamp, value, and so on, in
a single row per data record.
Example:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1813


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Save Billing Totals


Save Billing Totals calculates the billing total per Tenant (Source) and writes the value back into
the database so that it can be used in other applications, such as Dashboards, Diagrams or
Reports.

Save Calculated Values


Click No to preview the report outputs without saving them to the database. Click Yes to save the
report outputs in the database.

The report overwrites any values, for this KPI, that already exist in the database from previous
report runs.

Save Model Configuration


Choose to save the created model to the database or not by selecting Yes or No for Safe Model
Configuration.

For saving the model, enter the model name in the Model Name input box that is displayed when
Yes is selected for Safe Model Configuration.

Scale Measurement
Select the measurement as the base against which to scale the main dataset. This input is optional.

Scale Multiplier
Enter a value to use as a multiplier in normalizing the raw data of the scale source and
measurements in the report. The default is 1.

Scale Source
Select the source as the base against which to scale the main dataset. This input is optional.

Select
Select Top (highest result) or Bottom (lowest result) to indicate the order of the gauges in the
generated report. The default is Top.

Select Date Range


Select this if you want to select the runs according to a date range and run reason, and then do the
following:

1. Select the Reporting Period date range for the runs to include in the report.

2. Select the Run Reason for the runs to include in the report.

The devices in the group will appear in the Sources section of the report. Devices that you excluded
from the report will be gray-shaded.

Select EPSS Group


Select the group for which the report is intended.

1814 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Select Generator Starts


Select the option to specify the start records. When you click Select Reference Starts you can
choose the specific start records by generator and date. For example, you can use this option to
compare yesterday's Gen 1 start voltage signature to the Gen 1 start voltage signature from six
months prior.

Select Group
Select the group for which the report is intended.

Select Number
Enter the number of sources that you want to include in the ranking. The default is 99.

Select Time of Use


Select a TOU schedule to use for the report. Existing time of use schedules are shown in the list. If
you have not created a time of use schedule, the field shows that no time of use schedule is
available.

Select Waveforms
1. Click Select Source, choose a source from the list, and then click OK.

2. Click Select Reference Waveform, select the check box next to one or more comparison
waveforms, and then click OK.

3. Define the comparison waveforms using one of the following:


Click Enter the number of comparison waveforms and enter a value in the field.

By default, the report looks for the five most recent waveforms that have been captured
for the source to be compared against the reference waveform. Use this mode for reports
that are to be delivered using a report subscription.

Click Select the comparison waveforms, then click Select Comparison Waveforms,
select the check box next to the waveforms you choose, and then click OK.

This mode allows you to select specific comparison waveforms. It is not recommended to
use this mode with a report subscription.

Shifts
Use the +/- buttons to add additional shifts. For each shift, enter a name and set the start and end
time for the shift.

To configure a shift that spans midnight, use two shifts with the same name. For example, to set up
a day shift and a night shift, add three shifts: Day from 8:00 AM to 8:00 PM, Night from 8:00 PM to
12:00 AM, and Night from 12:00 AM to 8:00 AM.

Show all Power Quality Events in Details


Select whether or not to show the Power Quality event details in the generated report. The default is
No.

NOTE: To show all Power Quality events, the Show Event Details must be set to Yes.

Show Average in Column Chart


Select whether or not to show an additional line in each chart representing the average of that series
in the generated report. The default is No.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1815


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Show Bill Details


Click Yes to include the comparison summary page and the individual bills for the source and the
reference source in the report output. Click No to only include the comparison summary page in the
report output.

Show Charts with Exception Only


Select Yes to show charts which contain any aggregated intervals that exceeds the specified cause
target value. If Notify/Show Charts on Last Aggregated Interval Exception Only is set to Yes,
only charts which exceeds the target value in the Last interval is shown.

Show Daily Rollups


Click Yes to include the Time of Use interval selections for non-cumulative measurements. If you
click No, the report excludes the Time of Use interval selections. For cumulative measurements,
the Time of Use interval selection is always considered.

Show Data Warnings


Click Yes to include data warnings in the report. If there are none, the section is not included. Click
No to exclude this section.

Show Detailed Data Table


Select whether or not to show the detailed data table in the generated report. The default is No.

Show Detailed Results


Choose to include details in the report or not by selecting Yes or No for Show Detailed Results.

Details include the calculated formulas and individual relationship between each driver and the sub
model data.

Show Errors
Click Yes to include error messages in the report, or No to exclude them.

Show Event Details


Select whether or not to show the event details in the generated report. The default is No.

Show Footer Image


Select Yes to show an image instead of the Notes at the bottom of each bill. Select No to show the
Notes instead of an image.

NOTE: The report displays the image file BillingFooter.jpg in


...\Web\ReportDepot\ION Reports\ION Report Packs\Billing Reports\ if it
exists. There is no image provided by default. Create your own image and save it under the above
name in the specified location.

Show Header
Click Yes to include the standard report header in the report. Click No to not include the standard
report header in the report.

The standard report header includes the logo and report title.

Show Header & Footer


Click Yes to include the standard report header and footer in the report. Click No to not include the
standard report header and footer in the report.

1816 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

The standard report header includes the logo, report title, and report generation information.

Show Max Values With Charts


Select the options to show the maximum values for each chart. The available options are

• Show All Max Values (Default)

• Show First Max Value

• Do Not Show Max Values

Show Occurrences Chart


Click Yes to include an Occurrences chart in the report. Click No to exclude this chart.

Show Report Parameters Summary


Select whether or not to show report parameters in the generated report. The default is Yes.

Show Separate TOU Values For Non-Cumulative Measurements


Click Yes to include the Time of Use interval selections for non-cumulative measurements. If you
click No, the report excludes the Time of Use interval selections. For cumulative measurements,
the Time of Use interval selection is always considered.

Show Start & End Periods Only


Select to show or not in the report the start and end periods. The default is No.

Show Summary Data Table


Select whether or not to show the summary data table in the generated report. The default is No.

Show Totals
Select to include or exclude totals columns or rows in the data tables.

Show Min/Max Timestamps


Click Yes to include the report period timestamps. Click No to exclude them.

Signaling Voltage 1, 2 and 3 Eval Limit [%]


Type the maximum percentage of intervals in an observation period in which the mean value of the
signaling voltage can exceed the curve defined in the EN50160 standard before that mains signaling
voltage is considered non-compliant.

Slideshows
This box shows all available slideshows in your system. Select the slideshows you want to include
in the report.

Sort By
Select the sort options of the tabular data from the dropdown list. The available options are Source
Name, Period, Maximum Value, Minimum Value, and Total. The selection applies to the entire
table. For example, if Maximum Value is selected, then all maximum values across all
measurements and Time of Use periods are considered.

Sort Order
Select Ascending or Descending to show the tabular data based on the Sort By selection.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1817


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Source Label
Select an option for the format of the label describing the source. The options are Source Name,
Source Description, and Combined Name/Description.

NOTE: The source description is the description that was entered in Management Console or
Device Manager for a source, when the source was added or edited.

Sources
Use this input to select the devices you want to include in the report.

Click Select Sources to open the Source Selector dialog. From the Grouping list, select the way in
which you want to display the sources (for example by device type, by group name, and so on).
Click + and - to expand and collapse items in the navigation tree. Click the check box beside a
device (or group of devices) to select it. Click Select All or Select None in the top-right corner to
select or clear all the check boxes.

After selecting the devices, click OK.

Sources (Devices and Views)


The Source Selector dialog provides options to show Devices or Views:

Use the Devices option to select the devices you want to include in the report.

From the Grouping list, select the way in which you want to display the sources (for example by
device type or by group name). Click + and - to expand and collapse items in the navigation tree.
Click the check box beside a device (or group of devices) to select it. Click Select All or Select
None in the top-right corner to select or clear all the check boxes.

After selecting the devices, click OK.


Use the Views option to select a hierarchy view (a tree of relationships) or virtual meters. The
hierarchy views and virtual meters are configured in the Hierarchy Manager component. (See the
Hierarchy Manager Help for further information about hierarchies, virtual meters, and views.) Click +
and - to expand and collapse items in the tree. Click the check box beside any hierarchy item in the
tree or any virtual meter to select it.
Click OK after making your selections.

Sources (for Power Quality report)


(Optional)Use this input to select the devices you want to include in the report.

NOTE: The sources listed are dependent on the views you create in Hierarchy Manager and the
assigned user group. The hierarchy view is configured in the Hierarchy Manager component. (See
the Hierarchy Manager Help for further information about hierarchies, virtual meters, and views.)

Click + and - to expand and collapse items in the tree. Click the check box beside any hierarchy
item in the tree to select it.
Click OK after making your selections.

Source Filter
Select either Sources with exceptions only or All sources.

1818 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

• Sources with exceptions – Shows only the devices which has voltage sags and / or swells.

• All sources – Shows all selected devices. If the devices does not have voltage sags and / or
swells, the count is displayed as zero.

Source Target Line


Select a source to use with the measurement selected in Measurement Target Line to establish
ON and OFF peak target lines in the generated report.

Standard Deviation Calculation Period


Use this input to select the timeframe, for which standard deviation is calculated. The selected
timeframe should be within the reporting period timeframe.

Select the standard deviation calculation period from the dropdown list. The timeframe options in the
timeframe dropdown are relative to the date the report is run. To run a report that starts and ends in
the past, select the fixed date option. Type a start and end date in the date boxes or click the arrows
beside the dates to display a pop-up calendar and select a date. Type a time in the time boxes or
click the up and down arrows beside the time to adjust the hours or minutes up or down.

Select the timezone you want to view timestamps in.

Standard Deviation Multiplier


Enter a value to adjust the width of the standard deviation banding. The default is 1.

Start Hour
Select the start hour to display when filtering the data by the time of day.

The time range in the list is in 24-hour format in ascending order.

State Labels
Use state labels to add labels to equipment state codes. For example: value = 1, state =
maintenance.

NOTE: State labels are related to the state measurements in the Power Monitoring Expert
database.

For each state that you want to include in the report:

1. In the Value field, enter a state value.

2. In the State field, enter the value's corresponding state. For example, if the state with a value
of 3 = medium, enter 'medium'.

3. (Optional) Click + and then repeat steps 1 and 2 to add a state label for each state that you
want to include in the report.

4. (Optional) Click - to delete a state label.

NOTE: If you do not add state labels for every source state, and you set Include Data Warnings
to Yes, the generated report will include error warnings indicating that equipment states are
unaccounted for in the State Label mapping.

State Measurement
Use state measurement to select a piece of equipment with state values.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1819


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

1. Click Select Source to open the Source Selector dialog.

2. Select the source and then click OK.

3. Click Select Measurement to open the Measurement Selector dialog.

4. Select the equipment state measurement and then click OK.

Depending on how your state measurements are configured, the equipment state
measurement could be grouped under "Miscellaneous" or "Custom".

State Measurements
Use state measurement to select equipment with state values.

1. Click Select Source to open the Source Selector dialog.

2. Select the source and then click OK.

3. Click Select Measurement to open the Measurement Selector dialog.

4. Select the equipment state measurement and then click OK.

Depending on how your state measurements are configured, the equipment state
measurement could be grouped under "Miscellaneous" or "Custom".

5. (Optional) Click + and add another source measurement pair.

Statistics Period
Use this input to select the interval for the data you want to view the statistics in the report.

Select the statistics period from the dropdown list. The available options are Entire Period, Day,
Week, Month and Year.

Stylesheet (optional)
Apply further transformation of the XML file by selecting a stylesheet file to create an HTML page to
display of the billing data with enhanced formatting.

Technical knowledge of XML, XSLT, and HTML is recommended.

Target Line
Enter a value for the target line in relation to the measurement you selected. The default value is not
to include a target line.

Target Line (kW)


Enter a value for the location of the target line in the kW chart in the generated report. The default is
0.

Target Line (kvar)


Enter a value for the location of the target line in the kvar chart in the generated report. The default is
0.

Target Line (kVA)


Enter a value for the location of the target line in the kVA chart in the generated report. The default is
0.

Technician Name
Type a name for the technician in the text box.

1820 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Tenant
Click Select Source to open the Source Selector dialog. Select a view name or Virtual Meter in the
View dropdown list. Select a tenant name, a device under a tenant name, or a virtual meter. Click
OK to add your selection to the report.

Selecting by view allows you to choose a source associated with a hierarchy configuration, such as
a floor in a physical layout or a circuit in an electrical view. Virtual meters available for selection are
defined separately in Hierarchy Manager. For additional information regarding hierarchies and virtual
meters, see Hierarchy Manager Help.

Tenant (multiple selection)


Click Select Source to open the Source Selector dialog. Select a view name or Virtual Meter in the
View dropdown list. Select one or more tenant names, one or more devices under a tenant name, or
one or more virtual meters. Click OK to add your selections to the report.

Selecting by view allows you to choose sources associated with hierarchy configurations, such as
a floor in a physical layout or a circuit in an electrical view. Virtual meters available for selection are
defined separately in Hierarchy Manager. For additional information regarding hierarchies and virtual
meters, see Hierarchy Manager Help.

Tenant Filter
Anything entered in the Tenant Filter parameter (comma separated) that matches any Billing meta
data line items (Tenant column) is included. An '*' can be entered to include everything.

Tenants and Rates


To select a group of tenants that share the same rate, click Select Sources to open the source
selector dialog. Select a view name or Virtual Meter in the View drop-down list. Select one or more
tenant names, one or more devices under a tenant name, or one or more virtual meters. Click OK to
add your selections to the report.

To add additional groups of tenants that share other rates, click the "Plus" icon besides the source
selector.

To add rates for the groups of tenants, select a rate from the drop-down list for each tenant group.

THD Baseline [%]


Type the THD Baseline value if the default percentage is not appropriate for your needs.

Title
Type a title for the report in the text box.

Threshold
Enter the percentage for the maximum test run load capacity. This is the percentage of the
equipment electrical rating (in amps) entered in the Transfer Switches tab or the Equipment tab.

Threshold Hours
Enter the maximum number of hours the generators should run in non-emergency use. Enter a value
that is in compliance with local authority requirements. For example, in the United States, the
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) requires that generators can run no more than 100 hours in
non-emergency use.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1821


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Timestamp Coincidence
Select either with Customer Peak or with Data Center Peak.

Trip Settings
Click Yes to include the Trip Settings section of the report. Click No to not include it. The default is
Yes.

Unbalance Baseline [%]


Type the Unbalance Baseline value if the default percentage is not appropriate for your needs.

Upper Target Line


Enter a value for the target line representing the target for the high end of your energy use. The upper
target is a red line in the report. Columns in charts that on or above the upper target line are outlined
in red. The default value is 0.

UPS Group
Add the UPS groups that you want to include in the report.

Use Exception Periods


Choose to use exception periods or not by selecting Yes or No for Use Exception Periods.

Use Run History


Click Use Run History to select the most recent run, or select other specific runs that are stored in
history, and then do the following:

1. Click Refresh Run History to populate the Runs list with the latest run records.

2. In the Runs list, select Most recent run or the specific run record. The date and reason for
the run appear below the dropdown list.

If you select Most recent run and define excluded sources, the exclusions are ignored
when you generate the report.

Use Standard Deviation Target in Column Chart


Type the Voltage Baseline value if the default percentage is not appropriate for your needs.

Voltage Baseline [%]


Type the Voltage Baseline value if the default percentage is not appropriate for your needs.

Voltage Nominal [V]


Type the nominal voltage of the system (for example, 120).

Voltage Threshold
Enter voltage threshold value. This input represents a nominal voltage that is used by the report to
display a voltage threshold area below the reference waveform voltage drop.

Waveform Drop Percentage


Enter a percentage value from 1.00 to 100.00. This input value represents the percentage that is
used by the algorithm to detect the first voltage drop in the reference and comparison waveforms.

1822 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Waveform Drop Sample Size


Enter a value for this sample size. This input represents the number of waveform samples (or
points) - from 2 to a total number of waveform samples (for example, 1024, 2048, and so forth) -
used by the algorithm in the detection of the waveform voltage drop for the reference and
comparison waveforms.

X Axis Calculation Method


Choose from the dropdown list one of the following methods: Cooling Degree Days, Heating Degree
Days, Average, Sum, or Delta.

XML Export File


Type the name of the XML output file (including the file share or physical path) that is created after
the XML transform has been applied. For example: C:\bill_
report\MonthlyBillingDataMain.xml.

XML Transform File


Select the XML transform (xslt) file (via file share or physical path) to transform the default XML
output into a specific format.

Technical knowledge of XML and XSLT is recommended.

Y Axis Calculation Method


Choose from the dropdown list one of the following methods: Average, Sum, or Delta.

Y-Axis Max Value (% Nominal)


Choose one of the available percentage values to visually increase the level of detail above the
nominal value. The percentage value that you select sets the maximum vertical axis in the incidents
plot. The default value is 500%.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1823


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Model creation example


The following example shows the process of creating a model for use with the Use Model Report. It
shows the steps for creating a basic model and then improving it iteratively.

In this example we use the report to model the HVAC related electrical energy consumption of a
building. Our goal is to create a daily model for energy consumption based on outside temperature
and humidity. We use consumption data for the year 2017 to create the model.

Model creation run 1


The dependent variable is the electrical Real Energy (kWh) measurement for the HVAC system of
the building. The independent variables are the outside temperature and humidity.

We use the following inputs for the Create Model report:

Title Create Model Report


Source = HVAC - Fans and Compressors
Dependent Variable Measurement = Real Energy (kWh)
Aggregation Method = SUM
Source = Victoria.Weather
Measurement = Weather Temperature (°C)
Aggregation Method = AVG
Independent Variable(s)
Source = Victoria.Weather
Measurement = Weather Relative Humidity (%)
Aggregation Method = AVG
Reporting Period 1/1/2017 - 12/31/2017, Server Local Time
Interval and Sub Model Interval = Week
Configuration Sub Model = No Sub Model
Use Exception Periods No
Show Detailed Results No
Save Model Configuration No

For the first run we choose an interval of Week, only to see if there is a strong relationship between
consumption and the independent variables. Later we change this to Day to get a Daily Model.

Results:

1824 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

TIP: Move your pointer over the chart line to see tooltips with measurement details.

The model accuracy, measured by the R² value, is pretty high, which show that the model is a good
match for the correlation between the energy consumption and the outside temperature as well as
humidity.

For the next run, we use a Daily aggregation method.

Model creation run 2


We change the Interval to Day.

We use the following inputs for the Create Model report:

Title Create Model Report


Source = HVAC - Fans and Compressors
Dependent Variable Measurement = Real Energy (kWh)
Aggregation Method = SUM

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1825


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Title Create Model Report


Source = Victoria.Weather
Measurement = Weather Temperature (°C)
Aggregation Method = AVG
Independent Variable(s)
Source = Victoria.Weather
Measurement = Weather Relative Humidity (%)
Aggregation Method = AVG
Reporting Period 1/1/2017 - 12/31/2017, Server Local Time
Interval and Sub Model Interval = Day
Configuration Sub Model = No Sub Model
Use Exception Periods No
Show Detailed Results No
Save Model Configuration No

Results:

1826 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

The R² has dropped and the visual correlation is not very high. The charts show that there is a big
difference in consumption between weekdays and weekends. This difference cannot be explained
by outside temperature or humidity alone. For the next run we use sub-models for weekdays and
weekends.

Model creation run 3


We use a Weekday vs Weekend sub-model.

We use the following inputs for the Create Model report:

Title Create Model Report


Source = HVAC - Fans and Compressors
Dependent Variable Measurement = Real Energy (kWh)
Aggregation Method = SUM
Source = Victoria.Weather
Measurement = Weather Temperature (°C)
Aggregation Method = AVG
Independent Variable(s)
Source = Victoria.Weather
Measurement = Weather Relative Humidity (%)
Aggregation Method = AVG
Reporting Period 1/1/2017 - 12/31/2017, Server Local Time
Interval and Sub Model Interval = Day
Configuration Sub Model = Weekday vs Weekend
Use Exception Periods No
Show Detailed Results No
Save Model Configuration No

Results:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1827


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The R² has much improved. There is a good correlation between outside temperature and humidity
and consumption. There are still a few days with a large negative residual value. Upon closer
inspection we find that most of these days are holidays. For the next run we use exception periods
to account for the holidays.

Model creation run 4


We use exception periods to account for the holidays.

We use the following inputs for the Create Model report:

Title Create Model Report


Source = HVAC - Fans and Compressors
Dependent Variable Measurement = Real Energy (kWh)
Aggregation Method = SUM

1828 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Title Create Model Report


Source = Victoria.Weather
Measurement = Weather Temperature (°C)
Aggregation Method = AVG
Independent Variable(s)
Source = Victoria.Weather
Measurement = Weather Relative Humidity (%)
Aggregation Method = AVG
Reporting Period 1/1/2017 - 12/31/2017, Server Local Time
Interval and Sub Model Interval = Day
Configuration Sub Model = Weekday vs Weekend
Use Exception Periods Yes
Show Detailed Results No
Save Model Configuration No

Results:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1829


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

We have again improved the model. In our example, the building is cooled electrically, which means
the greatest impact of outside temperature on energy consumption is during the cooling season. To
account for that, we change the Aggregation Method for outside temperature to Cooling Degree
Days (CDD) for the next run.

Model creation run 5


We change the Aggregation Method for outside temperature to Cooling Degree Days (CDD) with a
base temperature of 11 °C.

We use the following inputs for the Create Model report:

Title Create Model Report


Source = HVAC - Fans and Compressors
Dependent Variable Measurement = Real Energy (kWh)
Aggregation Method = SUM
Source = Victoria.Weather
Measurement = Weather Temperature (°C)
Aggregation Method = CDD
Independent Variable(s)
Source = Victoria.Weather
Measurement = Weather Relative Humidity (%)
Aggregation Method = AVG
Reporting Period 1/1/2017 - 12/31/2017, Server Local Time
Interval and Sub Model Interval = Day
Configuration Sub Model = Weekday vs Weekend
Use Exception Periods Yes
Show Detailed Results No
Save Model Configuration No

Results:

1830 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

We now have a pretty accurate model of our energy consumption based on outside temperature and
humidity.

TIP: Choose to include model creation details in the report.

Select Yes for Show Detailed Results in the Report Inputs to include information on the modeling
formulas and the relationship between the drivers and the sub model data. The following are
selected examples of the type of details you can get.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1831


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Statistical information:

Weekday sub-model data driven by outside temperature vs measured data:

Weekday sub-model data driven by outside temperature with influence of humidity removed vs
measured data:

1832 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Weekend sub-model data driven by outside temperature vs measured data:

Weekend sub-model data driven by relative humidity vs measured data:

Next Step:

Run the Create Model report one last time with the Save Model Configuration parameter set to
Yes. This saves the model into the database and makes it available for use with the Use Model
Report.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1833


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Interpreting the Energy Regression Analysis Report results


The Energy Regression Analysis Tool is a highly configurable tool that allows you to monitor and
manage a building or facility’s energy and resource consumption. This practice, called energy
modeling, involves analyzing building energy systems, monitoring energy consumption, and
detecting anomalies or changes in system behavior that may require that you perform energy
efficiency upgrades or fixes. The Energy Regression Analysis Report allows you to model energy
data one independent variable at a time with a wide range of desired independent variables, such as
weather or occupancy rate.

It is recommended that users have a basic understanding of energy modeling and understand how
to create an Energy Regression Analysis Report. This section discusses in detail the purpose of
each parameter in the report and how to read and interpret meaningful results of an Energy
Regression Analysis Report. After generating the report, conclusions can be drawn from the
generated tables and charts to monitor energy consumption and make cost saving decisions.
Energy Regression Analysis Report results provide a characterization of a building's performance.
You can perform different types of energy analysis with this information, including the following:

• Energy Benchmarking

• Energy Budgeting

• Energy Savings

Glossary of terms

Term Definition
Cooling Degree Days Measurement designed to reflect the demand for energy needed to
(CDD) cool a building.
Comparing energy profiles against expected profiles and identifying
Cost Savings Analysis
outlying data that may signify areas of improvement.
One degree of departure, on a single day, of the daily mean
Degree Day
temperature from a given standard temperature.
Comparing the energy performance of similar buildings or
Energy Benchmarking
comparing the energy performance of a single building over time.
Determining future energy use and associated costs for different
Energy Budgeting
times of the year.
Computerized simulation of a building that focuses on energy
Energy Modeling consumption, utility bills and life cycle costs of various energy
related items such as air conditioning, lights, and hot water.
Measuring savings by comparing performance profiles before and
Energy Savings
after energy efficiency modifications.
Disaggregating building energy into different categories, such as
Energy Use Breakdowns
weather-dependent energy use or weather-independent energy use.
Heating Degree Days Measurement designed to reflect the demand for energy needed to
(HDD) heat a building.

1834 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Term Definition
Performance (Regression)
The statistical line of best fit.
Line
Statistical process for estimating the relationships among variables.
Includes many techniques for modeling and analyzing several
Regression Analysis
variables, when the focus is on the relationship between a
dependent variable and one or more independent variables.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1835


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Reading the report


This section discusses how to read the different types of information in the report.

Report Parameters Summary table

The Report Parameters Summary table appears at the beginning of the report. Based on what you
select for the Show Report Parameters Summary option on the prerequisite page, you can make
this table appear or be hidden in the report.

This table provides important details, such as data sources, calculation methods, and other
parameters about how the report inputs are configured that can help the user understand report
results.

Regression Analysis Chart

The Regression Analysis Chart shows the relationship between the driver and model data.

In this chart, the blue dots represent real data points. In this case, the data is aggregated weekly
over the course of one year, therefore, there are 52 data points with each data point representing one
week of the year. The yellow line is the regression line, or performance line, of the building. The
performance (regression) line is the best fit line--a line that indicates the expected energy
consumption. The slope of the performance line is a measure of how much extra fuel, energy, or
other resource is consumed for an increase in the independent variable (such as degree days,
production units, and so forth).

1836 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Deviations between building performance lines over time means that something has changed in the
way the facility consumes energy. This may be a result of energy efficiency modifications, or it
could indicate an issue with building systems, equipment, or processes. The performance line
provides a benchmark by which changes in energy consumption can be monitored, and appropriate
actions can be taken if variations are detected.

The point of intersection between the two performance lines is called the breakpoint. For energy
consumption analyzed with respect to average temperature, the breakpoint indicates the
temperature at which heating or cooling of a facility begins. Therefore, having a breakpoint further to
the right is better because this indicates that heating or cooling systems are running for less time,
which results in less energy usage.

Regression Analysis Main Characteristics Table

The Regression Analysis Main Characteristics Table provides information about the Regression
Analysis Chart.

The Side column shows the left and right sides. The Slope column shows the slope values of the
two best-fitting lines intersect. This intersection point is called the breakpoint. The Y-Intercept
column shows a point where the graph of a function or relation intersects with the y-axis of the
coordinate system. Therefore, these points satisfy x = 0.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1837


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The R2 column shows a value that indicates how well the data fits the model. The RMSE column
shows the square root of the mean/average of the square of the error. The X Value and Y Value
columns show the coordinates of the Change point.

Monitoring the slopes and breakpoint values provides useful information about a facility’s energy
consumption. Flatter slope lines are better as they indicate a smaller increase in energy
consumption for every additional unit of the independent X-axis variable.

For more information on interpreting the report results, see Interpreting the report.

Measured Values Against Expected Values Chart

The Measured Values Against Expected Values Chart shows the relationship between the model
data and time.

In this chart, the blue line indicates the real energy usage over time and the performance line
indicates the expected energy usage over time based on the regression analysis.

The time axis, or X-axis, has different units depending on the selected aggregation period. For
weekly aggregation, the numbers on the X-axis represent the weeks of the year and for daily
aggregation, they represent the days of the year. The year or years contained within the reporting
period are displayed on the chart directly below the X-axis values.

Exceptions Table

The Exceptions Table below shows information for any data point that falls outside of the exception
range defined by the Deviation Type and Max Authorized Deviation parameters.

1838 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

If there are no exception points, this table does not appear in the report.

Full Table

The Full Table below shows information for all data points.

Within the Full Table, there is a row with missing values.

This row stores information about the breakpoint from the Regression Analysis Chart.

This report generates with almost any set of data and regardless of other parameter selections.
However, the generated report is only of assistance in monitoring energy consumption if the
parameters are configured correctly and with specific intent.

The following section provides specific examples of how to use the Energy Modeling Report to
monitor certain aspects of a facility’s energy consumption.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1839


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Interpreting the report


After generating the report, the data can be analyzed in different ways to draw different conclusions
about energy and resource consumption. Below are two examples involving different independent
variables.

Example 1: Justifying Energy Efficiency Upgrades

Regression analysis of energy or resource consumption with respect to Degree Days can provide
valuable information about a facility’s energy efficiency with respect to outside changes in
temperature. Such information can be used to determine when energy efficiency upgrades are
necessary, and to monitor the effectiveness of such solutions after implementation.

For example, a facility manager could compare the Heating Degree Day energy profile of their
building to another facility in a similar climate. If the other building proves to be much more energy
efficient, an analysis could be performed on the differences in building design that could cause
these results. Perhaps the only significant difference is that the more efficient building recently
upgraded their insulation. The less efficient building could then use this information, along with the
Regression Analysis charts to pitch the case that an insulation upgrade should take place to reduce
natural gas usage at the facility.

If the upgrade is successful, a change appears in the Regression Analysis chart the following year.
The chart above shows a possible Regression analysis for the year before the energy efficiency
modifications. The red line in the chart shows how the performance lines and breakpoint could
change when the upgrades are successful. The slopes of the lines in the second figure are flatter,
indicating less energy usage for every additional degree day. The breakpoint also occurs later,
indicating that heating does not have to begin at as low of a temperature as before, thereby saving
additional resources.

Example 2: Identifying Equipment Failure

Regression analysis can also be used to detect equipment deterioration or failure. Below are two
Regression Analysis charts showing natural gas consumption with respect to production units.

The red line in the chart has a steeper slope and an earlier X-axis intersection point. This indicates
that more natural gas is being used for every unit of production. If data for these charts is collected
over different periods of time, but with no changes to manufacturing processes or equipment, the
steeper regression line in the second chart could indicate deterioration of equipment.

1840 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Plotting energy consumption data against any independent variable, not just time, allows you to
analyze in greater detail the energy efficiency of your buildings or facilities, and to make necessary
upgrades or cost analysis decisions.

Conclusion

Energy modeling is a relatively new practice for monitoring and analyzing energy consumption in
buildings and facilities. It involves using computerized simulations to analyze energy consumption,
and it allows customers to understand their expected energy consumption and use this information
to make system design decisions and perform cost benefit analysis.

The Energy Modeling Report, or XY Regression Report, allows users to create energy profiles for
their buildings or facilities. These benchmark energy models provide valuable information about
energy and resource consumption that can help Facility Managers save resources by identifying
and addressing consumption issues.

Recommendations

Many of the report parameters on the prerequisite page are interdependent and configuring this page
requires close attention. It is recommended to rely on documentation to correctly configure the
report. Note that there is no filtering of parameters on the prerequisite page.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1841


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Reports UI

Report Library
The Report Library contains all the Reports that are configured in the system. Reports can be
listed individually, or they can be organized within folders.

1
TIP: To hide the library, click the Hide Library icon ( or ) in the top right corner of the

library. To show the library, click the Show Library icon ( or ) at the top of the library
ribbon, or click anywhere in the minimized library ribbon.

Reports Inputs panel


The top part of the Reports Display pane shows the inputs for the selected report. Different
2
reports have different input types. Some inputs are preset with default values, others are
unassigned and must be set before the report can be generated.
Hide Report Inputs / Show Report Inputs link
3
Click this link to hide or show the report input panel.
Generate Report button
4
Click this button to generate the report after you have set all the required input parameters.
Report Display panel
5 View the report output after generating the report. Use Download report as, at the top of the
panel, to download the report in PDF, Excel, or Tiff image format.

1842 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Reports Icons
Reports uses different icons to differentiate between reports and report templates in the Report
Library. The following is a list of icons used.

Private Report with some inputs saved

Private Report with all inputs saved

Public Report with some inputs saved

Public Report with all inputs saved

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1843


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Reports Terminology
The following is a list of commonly used terms related to Reports in PME.

Report
A report is a report template that has been saved with some or all of its input parameters set. Every
time you run a report, it queries the database to retrieve the required data. A report does not store the
output data after it was generated. To save a permanent copy of the output, download the report in
one of the supported formats and save it externally.

Report Template
A report template defines the output layout, the types of inputs and the information in the database
that is accessed for that report. The difference between a report and a report template is that a report
has one or more of its input parameters saved and a template does not.

Downloaded Report
A downloaded report is a copy of the output of a report. You can download a report in different
formats. Download a report to permanently save a copy of its output.

Report Input Parameters (or Inputs)


Report input parameters are the variables that must be entered before a report can be generated. For
example, the input parameters can determine for which devices a report is run, or which
measurements are included. Different report templates have different input parameters.

1844 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Trends references
This section contains reference information related to using Trends.

Use the links below to find the content you are looking for:

The Trends user interface


Trend options

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1845


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

The Trends user interface


The Trends user interface consists of a trends display pane and a Trend Library pane.

Trends display pane


The Trends display pane shows the trends selected in the Trend Library. When you create a trend,
it automatically opens in the display pane and the trend name is selected in the Trend Library. You
can select multiple trends to be shown simultaneously in the display pane. Scroll the display pane to
view all of the trends that you selected in the Trend Library. For information on the options and
controls available in the trend view, see Trend options.

If you log out of the application, your selections are retained and are loaded in the Trends display
pane the next time you log in.

Trend Library
The Trend Library contains all the trends that are configured in the system. Trends can be listed
individually, or they can be organized within folders. You use the Trend Library to select the trends
you want to view.

TIP: To hide the library, click the Hide Library icon ( or ) in the top right corner of the library.

To show the library, click the Show Library icon ( or ) at the top of the library ribbon, or click
anywhere in the minimized library ribbon.

For information on how to configure Trends, see Trends configuration.

1846 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Trend options
The following options are available in the upper right area of the trend in the display pane.

These options are summarized in the following table.

This icon appears only if there is an information,


error, or warning message associated with the
device. If the icon pulses, the viewer contains a
new error or warning message that has not yet
Open the Diagnostic been viewed. When you open the viewer, you
Log Viewer can click Clear Log to remove the existing
entries. This action removes the icon from the
trend display area until new information is logged
in the viewer. Click Close to close the viewer
and return to the trend display.
The setting for the time range on the X-axis.
Select a time range from the dropdown list. The
view window reflects the time in minutes or
hours from the last data point read from the
View list
source. For example, if you are viewing a 15
minute window and the last data point occurred
20 minutes ago, then the trend time range spans
the previous 35 to 20 minutes.
Acts as toggle to enable and disable the
inspection mode for the trend. When you enable
inspection mode, inspect icons appear on the
trend when you place your pointer anywhere on
the diagram. A slider also opens below the X-
Inspect
axis. Use the slider to adjust the time range for
the trend. Data values are not updated in the
trend, but they continue to be updated in the
legend. When you disable inspection mode, all
data that was captured is shown.
Opens the Trend Setup dialog. You can modify
Edit
any of the settings for the trend.
Saves the trend data that is displayed in the
Download trend data diagram in a CSV file on your system. When
as CSV events occur, you can download the data to a
CSV file for further analysis.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1847


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Displays the trend in a full browser page. Click


Maximize the Restore icon to return to the default size
in the trend display area.
Closes the trend. This also clears the checkbox
Close
for the trend in the Trend Library.

Trend legend
The legend opens on the right of the trend by default. You can select Left or Off on the Chart tab in
the Add Trend or Trend Setup dialogs to change the location of the legend or to remove it from the
trend display.

The legend provides the following capabilities:

• You can close and open the legend by clicking the arrow on the left side of the legend.

• If you have enabled multiple axes in your trend, when you place your mouse pointer over a
measurement series in the legend, it indicates which axis the series is drawn on.

• You can temporarily disable a measurement series by clicking the color swatch for the series.

• The background color of a measurement series entry changes to match the threshold colors
when the series passes into the upper or lower threshold. You set the threshold colors on the
Axes tab of the Add Trend or the Trend Setup dialog.

Inspection mode
The following icons appear when you enable the inspection mode and you place your pointer on the
trend.

A Reset Zoom (100%) - resets the trend to its default size.


Pan the chart - after you zoom in to an area of the diagram, click Pan the
B chart, then click and hold the left mouse button on the diagram and drag it left
or right.
Zoom in to selection area - zooms in when you drag the mouse over an area of
C
the chart. The zoom action occurs when you release the left mouse button.

1848 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

When the trend is in inspection mode, the trend remains static until you toggle inspection mode off
to return the trend to its update mode. Note that the data in the legend continues to update in real
time with the latest values even though the trend remains static for analysis purposes. When you
toggle inspection mode off, the trend refreshes and includes all of the data that was captured while
you were in inspection mode.

You can drag the slider below the X-axis to the right to decrease the time range for the trend. For
example, if the time range is set to 15 minutes and you drag the slider to the right, the range values
decrease, and if you continue to drag the slider to the right, the values decrease further to show
minutes and seconds on the scale.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1849


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Decommissioning Reference
This section contains detailed instructions for decommissioning your system. For an overview, see
Decommission.

NOTICE
UNINTENDED DATA LOSS OR LOSS OF SOFTWARE FUNCTION
• Only decommission PME systems that are no longer needed.
• Archive important PME data and files before decommissioning. You cannot recover, reinstall,
or otherwise retrieve any part of PME after decommissioning.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in irreversible damage to software and
databases.

Choose Destroy or Overwrite to decommission your system.

You must decommission PME on all PME Servers, Database Servers, and PME Clients.

Decommissioning does not completely restore your computers to the state they were in before PME
was installed. Decommissioning does not remove third-party software used by PME (for instance,
the .NET framework), even if this software was installed using the PME installer.

NOTE: Decommissioning will not remove PME data that has been exported from PME or PME
information in third-party software. This includes, but is not limited to:

• Data exported to other systems using EcoStruxure Web Services (EWS), OPC DA server,
ETL, ODBC, PQDIF or VIP.

• Registration information shared with Schneider Electric.

• Diagnostics and Usage data sent to Schneider Electric.

• System information sent to Schneider Electric for licensing.

• Archived configurations created with the Configuration Manager.

• PME System Key exported from the Installer.

• PME information configured in third-party whitelisting software.

• Files or data copied, backed-up, exported, or otherwise saved to a file location other than the
PME folder.

Destroy

WARNING
HAZARD OF PHYSICAL INJURY
• Do not destroy hard drives without the proper safety training.
• Never burn a hard drive, put a hard drive in a microwave, or pour acid on a hard drive.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death or serious injury.

1850 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

NOTE: If you do not have the proper safety training, consult your IT department to select an asset
disposal company.

To destroy hard drives:

1. Identify all computers where PME is installed. In a Distributed Database architecture, this
includes all PME Servers, Database Servers, and PME Clients.

2. Remove all hard drives from the computers identified in the previous step.

3. Destroy each hard drive:


a. Puncture, shatter, or sand the hard drive plates. Follow local regulations for proper
disposal of the hard drive.

b. or, provide the hard drive to an asset disposal company.

Overwrite

NOTICE
UNINTENDED DATA LOSS OR LOSS OF SOFTWARE FUNCTION
• Only overwrite files and folders from PME.
• Back up important files from other software before overwriting PME.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in irreversible damage to software and
databases.

To overwrite PME:

1. Open the Windows Control Panel and select Programs and Features.

2. Uninstall PME.

3. Select and install a data destruction tool. There are many commercial and open-source data
destruction tools available. Consult your IT department if you are unsure about which tool to
choose.

4. Detach PME database archives:


a. Open SQL Server Management Studio, enter your password if required and click
Connect to access your SQL Server.

b. In the Object Explorer pane on the left, expand Databases, right-click the database
archive you want to detach and click Tasks > Detach… to open the Detach Database
dialog.

c. In the Detach Database dialog, click OK.

d. Repeat the above steps for all PME database archives.

5. Locate your PME folder under Program Files. The PME folder contains the following
subfolders:
\Applications

\config

\Database

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1851


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

\diagnostic

\Diagnostics Tool

\License Configuration Tool

\Licenses

\Setup

\SetupLogs

\system

\Uninst_PowerMonitoringExpert

\web

6. Follow instructions provided with your data destruction tool to overwrite the entire PME folder
located in the previous step.

7. Locate any custom PME files in folders outside of the PME folder. This may include, but is not
limited to, following file types:
Vista and Designer files: .cfg, .dgm, .wsn, .wsg

ION databases and archives: .LDF, .MDF

ION database backups: .bak

Custom report packs: .rdlc

PMESystem Key: .key

8. Follow instructions provided with your data destruction tool to overwrite the files located in the
previous step.

9. Repeat the steps above on all PME Servers, Database Servers, and PME Clients.

1852 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Applications References
This section contains reference information related to the content in the Applications chapter of this
guide.

Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Topic Reference Links


Thermal Monitoring of LV
Selecting Sensor Names
Busways

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1853


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Thermal Monitoring of LV Busways Application References


This section contains reference information related to this application.
Use the following links to find the content you are looking for:

Selecting Sensor Names

1854 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Selecting Sensor Names


The ZBRN32 Access Point device driver creates individual sources for each of the sensors that are
connected to the Access Point. To name the sources, the driver uses the sensor names. You can
edit the default sensor names through the setup Vista diagram. See the Configuration section of the
application description for details. You can use variable sensor names or fixed sensor names.

NOTE: Use sensor names that are unique in the PME system. This applies to both, variable
names and fixed names. For variable names, they must be unique after the variable has been
replaced with the Access Point name by the device driver.

Using Variable Sensor Names


The default sensor names include the !!DeviceName!! variable. If the sensor names include this
variable, then the driver replaces the variable with the name of the Access Point device as it is
specified in the Management Console. In this case, any reference to these sensor sources in the
system includes the Access Point device name. For example, the source selectors in the
PME applications will group the sensors under the Access Point device name.

NOTE: Diagrams does not recognize the variable and does not replace it with the Access Point
device name. Diagrams displays the !!DeviceName!! string as part of the sensor name.

Example:

Sensors use variable names (!!DeviceName!!_Snsr_TR1-1A, !!DeviceName!!_Snsr_TR1-1B, ...).


Access Point device in the Management Console

Source selector for sensor sources

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1855


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Diagrams display of sensor data

Using Fixed Sensor Names


If you replace the default sensor names, which include the !!DeviceName!! variable, with fixed
names, then the sensor sources will not be associated with the Access Point device. Each sensor
source will appear as if it was its own device.

Example:

Sensors use fixed names (Sensor_TR1-1A, Sensor_TR1-1B, ...).


Access Point device in the Management Console

Source selector for sensor sources

1856 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

Diagrams display of sensor data

Names Used in This Application Description


The sensor names used as examples in the screen captures shown in this document are based on
the following assumed sensor locations:

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1857


Reference EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide

Glossary
Process Impact Alarm
Process impact alarms are used by the Power Quality Performance module. These alarms indicate
that a monitored process has been disrupted. If the disruption coincides with a power quality event,
then the Power Quality Performance module assumes that it was caused by the event. The module
then applies a flat-rate cost estimate to the duration of the process impact alarm to calculate an
impact cost.

Process impact alarms can be generated based on:

• An electrical value, for example a current, voltage, or power measurement, taken by a power
monitoring device. The software detects the process impact based on certain conditions for the
measurement, for example a drop or increase.

• A process impact signal from a third party system or equipment, such as:
A digital or analog value that is hard wired to the input of a power monitor, or PLC, which is
connected to the software.

An OPC tag served up by an OPC server and read by the software through it's OPC client
capabilities.

Software Features
A feature is a system functions that can be used without requiring custom engineering. Most
features require some configuration, such as selecting the input parameters for a report, or the
specification of sources, measurements and time ranges for dashboard gadgets. Examples of
features include the Dashboards, Diagrams, Trends, Alarms, and Reports applications.

Software Modules
Software modules combine different software features and capabilities to create a specific set of
deliverables. Software modules are designed around a particular application. Examples of software
modules include the Power Quality Performance Module, the Energy Analysis Reports Module, and
the Breaker Performance Module.

System databases
Power Monitoring Expert uses four databases to store device communication parameters, system
configuration settings, and logged historical data:

Database Description
Contains all of the configuration data for the Web Applications
ApplicationModules
component.
Contains the logged historical data, events, and waveforms from
ION_Data
devices.
ION_Network Contains device communication information and general settings.
Contains system events that occur during the operation of the
ION_SystemLog
software.

1858 © 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.


EcoStruxure™ Power Monitoring Expert 2021 System Guide Reference

System migration
A system migration is when you move a Power Monitoring Expert system from one computer to
another, or uninstall and re-install it on the same computer.

Alarm
A condition that is being monitored for a particular source in the system. Example: Monitoring for an
over voltage on feeder X.

Occurrence
The alarm condition for the monitored source is met and the alarm goes active. Example: The
voltage on feeder X exceeds the threshold

Alarm Instance
The time period during which an alarm is active, starting when it goes active, ending when it goes
inactive.

Alarm Status
The state the alarm is in. Alarm Status is either active or inactive.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. 1859


Schneider Electric
35 rue Joseph Monier
92500 Rueil Malmaison
France

+33 (0) 1 41 29 70 00

www.se.com

As standards, specifications, and designs change from time to time,


please ask for confirmation of the information given in this publication.

© 2021 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved.

7EN02-0445-00 05/2021

You might also like

pFad - Phonifier reborn

Pfad - The Proxy pFad of © 2024 Garber Painting. All rights reserved.

Note: This service is not intended for secure transactions such as banking, social media, email, or purchasing. Use at your own risk. We assume no liability whatsoever for broken pages.


Alternative Proxies:

Alternative Proxy

pFad Proxy

pFad v3 Proxy

pFad v4 Proxy